AC–1
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
AC–2
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
NEW AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM WITH
R134a
Refrigerant R12 (CFC12), previously used in automo–
biles air conditioning systems is believed to contribute
towards the depletion the earth’s ozone layer. The
ozone layer help to protect us against the harmful
ultraviolet rays of the sun.
A newly developed refrigerant, R134 a (HFC 134 a),
does not the destroy the ozone layer.
PRECAUTIONS FOR SERVICING R134a AIR
CONDITIONERS
1.
USE OF NEW REFRIGERANT R134a
The very different characteristics of refrigerants
R134a and R12 have determined the design of their
respective air conditioning systems. Under no circum–
stances allow R12 to enter an R134a system, or vice
versa, because serious damage could occur.
2.
USE OF PROPER COMPRESSOR OIL
Compressor oil used in conventional R12 air condi–
tioning systems cannot be used in R 134a air condi–
tioning systems.
Always use genuine Toyota R1 34a air conditioning oil
N D – OIL 8, made expressly for use with R 1 34a.
If even a small amount of the wrong oil is changed, it
will result in clouding of the refrigerant.
A large amount will cause the compressor to seize up.
AC–3
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
3.
–
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
USE OF PROPER O – RINGS AND SEALS
0–rings and seals used for conventional R12 air
conditioning systams cannot be used for R134a air
conditioning systems.
Always use genuine Toyota R 134a system 0–rings
and seals for R 1 34a air conditioning systems.
If O–rings and/or seals for R1 2 air conditioning sys–
tems are used by mistake in the connections of an R
134a air conditioning system, the O–ring and seals
will foam and swell resulting in leakage of refrigerant.
4.
TIGHTEN CONNECTING PARTS SECURELY
Securely tighten the connecting parts to prevent leak–
ing of refrigerant gas.
Apply a few drops of compressor oil to 0–ring
fittings for easy tightening and to prevent leaking
of refrigerant gas.
CAUTION: Apply only ND–OIL 8 compressor oil
Tighten the nuts using 2 wrenches to avoid twist–
ing the tube.
Tighten the 0–ring fittings or the bolted type
fittings to the specified torque.
5.
6.
7.
INSERT PLUG IMMEDIATELY IN DISCONNECTED
PARTS
Insert a plug immediately in the disconnected parts to
prevent the ingress of moisture and dust.
DO NOT REMOVE PLUG FROM NEW PARTS UNTIL
IMMEDIATELY BEFORE INSTALLATION
DISCHARGE GAS IN NEW COMPRESSOR FROM
CHARGING VALVE BEFORE INSTALLING IT
If the gas in the new compressor is not discharged
first, compressor oil will spray out with gas when the
plug is removed.
AC–4
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
SERVICE TOOLS FOR R134a AIR
CONDITIONER
When servicing R134a air conditioning systems
always use the R134a dedicated manifold gauges, gas
leak detector and vacuum pump adaptor.
1.
USE MANIFOLD GAUGES FOR R134a AIR CONDITI–
ONER
Always use R134a dedicated manifold gauges to pre–
vent R1 2 and RI 2 compressor oil contaminating the R
134a system.
2.
USE R134a GAS LEAK DETECTOR
Similarly, always use an R 134a dedicated leak detec–
tor. The R1 2 leak detector is not sufficiently sensitive.
3.
USE VACUUM PUMP ADAPTER
By connecting a vacuum pump adapter, the vacuum
pump can be used for both R 134a and R 12 air condi–
tioning systems.
The vacuum pump adaptor has an internal magnetic
valve.
When evacuation is completed and the vacuum pump
switch is turned off, the magnetic valve opens allow–
ing the introduction atmospheric air into the manifold
gauges to prevent the back flow of oil from the
vacuum pump into the gauge hose.
CAUTION:
Be sure to turn off the manifold gauge valve immediately
after evacuating the system. Then you may switch off
the vacuum pump. If this order is reversed, the line will
be temporarily open to atmosphere.
AC–5
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
HANDLING PRECAUTIONS FOR
REFRIGERANT
1.
2.
DO NOT HANDLE REFRIGERANT IN AN ENCLOSED
AREA OR NEAR AN OPEN FLAME
ALWAYS WEAR EYE PROTECTION
3.
BE CAREFUL THAT LIQUID REFRIGERANT DOES
NOT GET IN YOUR EYES OR ON YOUR SKIN
If liquid refrigerant gets in your eyes or on your skin:
(a) Wash the area with lots of cool water.
CAUTION: Do not rub your eyes or skin.
(b) Apply clean petroleum jelly to the skin.
(c) GO immediately to a physician or hospital for profes–
sional treatment.
HANDLING PRECAUTIONS FOR
REFRIGERANT CONTAINER
1.
2.
NEVER HEAT CONTAINER OR EXPOSE IT TO
NAKED FLAME
BE CAREFUL NOT TO DROP CONTAINER AND NOT
TO APPLY PHYSICAL SHOCKS TO IT
CHARGING AND LEAK–CHECK METHODS
Evacuate the refrigeration system according to the
following procedures.
10 min.
Start
Evacuation
Leave for 5 min.
Stop
Evacuation
Check and correct
pipe joints
Airtight
Check
Abnormal indication of
manifold gauges
Refrigerant
Charge
Gas Leak
Check
Refrigerant
Charge
Fill refrigerant in gas state until
gauge pressure reads 1 kglcm2
AC–6
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
CAUTION:
•
•
Be sure to connect both the high and low pressure
quick–connectors onto the A/C system when eva–
cuating. If only one side is connected, the system
would be open to atmosphere through the other
connector, making it impossible to maintain
vacuum.
Be sure to turn off the manifold gauge valve imme–
diately after evacuating the system. Then you may
switch off the vacuum pump.
PRECAUTIONS WHEN CHARGING
REFRIGERANT
1.
2.
3.
DO NOT OPERATE COMPRESSOR WITHOUT
ENOUGH REFRIGERANT IN REFRIGERANT
SYSTEM
If there is not enough refrigerant in the refrigerant
system oil lubrication will be insufficient and compres–
sor burnout may occur, so take care to avoid this.
DO NOT OPEN HIGH PRESSURE MANIFOLD VALVE
WHILST COMPRESSOR IS OPERATING
If the high pressure valve is opened, refrigerant flows
in the reverse direction and could cause the charging
cylinder to rupture, so open and close the low pres–
sure valve only.
BE CAREFUL NOT TO OVERCHARGE WITH RE–
FRIGERANT IN SYSTEM
If refrigerant is overcharged, it causes problems such
as insufficient cooling, poor fuel economy, engine
overheating etc.
ELECTRICAL PARTS
Before removing and inspecting the electrical parts,
set the ignition switch to the LOCK position and
disconnect the negative (–) terminal cable from bat–
tery.
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the Ignition switch is turned to the “LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
AC–7
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
(SRS)
Failure to carry out service operations in the correct
sequence could cause the supplemental restraint
system to deploy, possibly leading to a serious acci–
dent.
During removal or installation of the parts and the
yellow wire harness and connector for the airbag is
necessary, refer to the precautionary notices in the RS
section before performing the operation.
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the “LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
AC–8
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DESCRIPTION
PARTS LOCATION
–
DESCRIPTION
AC–9
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
DESCRIPTION
AC–10
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
DESCRIPTION
ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
(Lever Type On 5S–FE Engine Model)
AC–11
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
DESCRIPTION
AC–12
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
DESCRIPTION
(Push Button Type On 5S–FE Engine Model)
AC–13
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
DESCRIPTION
AC–14
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
DESCRIPTION
(Lever Type On 1 MZ–FE Engine Model)
AC–15
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
DESCRIPTION
AC–16
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
DESCRIPTION
(Push Button Type On 1 MZ–FE Engine Model)
AC–17
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
DESCRIPTION
AC–18
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DAMPERS POSITION
–
DESCRIPTION
AC–19
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
PREPARATION
PREPARATION
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
07110–58060 Air Conditioner Service Tool Set
(07117–58060) Refrigerant Drain Service Valve
(07117–58070) T–Joint
(07117–58080) Quick Coupler
Discharge (diam. 16 mm)
Suction (diam. 13 mm)
(07117–58090) Quick Coupler
(07117–78050) Refrigerant Charging Gauge
(07117–88060) Refrigerant Charging Hose
(07117–88070) Refrigerant Charging Hose
(07117–88080) Refrigerant Charging Nose
07112–66040 Magnetic Clutch Remover
07112–76060 Magnetic Clutch Stopper
07114–84020 Snap Ring Pliers
07116–38360 Gas Leak Detector Assembly
Discharge (Red)
Suction (Blue)
Utility (Green)
AC–20
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOL
09082–00050 TOYOTA Electrical Tester Set
LUBRICANT
Item
Capacity
Classification
ND–OIL 8 or equivalent
Compressor oil
When replacing receiver
10 cc (0.34 fl.oz.)
When replacing condenser
40 cc (1.4 f I.oz.)
When replacing evaporator
40 cc (1.4 fl.oz.)
When replacing compressor
140 cc (4.9 fl.oz.)
AC–21
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
USE OF MANIFOLD GAUGE SET
USE OF MANIFOLD GAUGE SET
MANIFOLD GAUGE SET INSTALLATION
1.
CONNECT CHARGING HOSES TO MANIFOLD
GAUGE SET
Tighten the nuts by hand.
2.
CONNECT QUICK CONNECTORS TO CHARGING
HOSES
Tighten the nuts by hand.
CLOSE BOTH HAND VALVES OF MANIFOLD
GAUGE SET
REMOVE CAPS FROM SERVICE VALVES ON RE–
FRIGERANT LINE
CAUTION: Do not connect the wrong hoses.
3.
4.
5.
CONNECT QUICK CONNECTORS TO SERVICE
VALVES
HINT: Push the quick connector onto the service
valve, then slide the sleeve of the quick connector
downward to lock it.
MANIFOLD GAUGE SET REMOVAL
1.
2.
3.
CLOSE BOTH HAND VALVES OF MANIFOLD
GAUGE SET
DISCONNECT QUICK CONNECTORS FROM SER–
VICE VALVES ON REFRIGERANT LINE
HINT: Slide the sleeve of the quick connector upward
to unlock the connector and remove it from the ser–
vice valve.
INSTALL CAPS TO SERVICE VALVES ON REFRIG–
ERANT LINE
AC–22
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
TROUBLESHOOTING
Use the table below to help you find the cause of problem. The numbers indicate the priority of
the likely cause of the problem. Check each rt in order. If necessary, replace these parts.
No blower operation
No blower control
No air flow mode control
No air inlet control
Insufficient flow of cool air
Insufficient flow of warm air
No cool air comes out
Cool air comes out intermittently
Cool air comes out only at high
engine speed
Insufficient cooling
No warm air comes out
Air temp. control not functioning
No engine idle up when A/C
switch on
A/C Fan Relays
Magnet Clutch Relay
Revolution Detecting Sensor
Evaporator Temp. Sensor
Pressure Switch
Fuse (A/C)
AC–60 AC–62 AC–63 AC–63 AC–64
Fusible Link
Inspect Drive Belt Tension
Trouble
Inspect Refrigeration
System with Manifold Gauge Set
Parts
Name
AC–29 AC–24 AC–30
Inspect Volume of Refrigerant
See page
Wiring or Wiring Connection
Expansion Valve (Replace)
Receiver
Magnet Clutch
Evaporator
–
Condenser
Compressor
A/C Amplifier
A/C Control Assembly
Condenser Fan Motor
Blower Motor
AC–59 AC–57
Air out let Servomotor
Air Inlet Servomotor
Blower Resistor
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
TROUBLESHOOTING
AC–23
AC–58 AC–55 AC–56 AC–67 AC–66 AC–36 AC–47 AC–49 AC–36 AC–45 AC–53
AC–24
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
REFRIGERANT SYSTEM INSPECTION WITH MANIFOLD GAUGE SET
This is a method in which the trouble is located by using a manifold gauge set.
(See ”USE OF MANIFOLD GAUGE SET” on page AC–21)
Read the manifold gauge pressure when the following conditions are established:
(a) Temperature at the air inlet with the switch set at RECIRC is 30 – 35 C (86 – 95 F)
(b) Engine running at 1,500 rpm
(c) Blower speed control switch set at high
(d) Temperature control set at max. cool
HINT: It should be noted that the gauge indications may vary slightly due to ambient temperature
conditions.
1. NORMALLY FUNCTIONING REFRIGERATION SYSTEM
Gauge reading:
Low pressure side:
0.15 – 0.25 MPa (1.5 – 2.5 kgf/cm’)
High pressure side:
1.37 – 1.57 MPa (14 – 16 kgf/emt)
AC–25
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
2.
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
MOISTURE PRESENT IN REFRIGERATION SYSTEM
Condition: Periodically cools and then fails to cool
•
3.
Symptom seen in
refrigeration system
During operation, prea–
sure on low pressure
side sometimes
becomes a vacuum
and sometimes normal
Probable cause
•
Moisture entered in re– •
frigeration system
freezes at expansion
valve orifice and tempo– •
rarily stops cycle, but
normal state is restored
after a time when the ice
melts
Diagnosis
Remedy
(1) Replace receiver/drier
(2) Remove moisture in
cycle through repeat–
Moisture in refrigeration
edly evacuating air
system freezes at expan–
(3)
Charge
new refrigerant
sion valve orifice and
to proper amount
blocks circulation of re–
frigerant
Drier in oversaturated
state
INSUFFICIENT REFRIGERANT
Condition: Insufficient cooling
Symptom seen in
refrigeration system
•
•
•
Pressure low on both
low and high pressure
sides
Bubbles seen in sight
glass continuously
Insufficient cooling per–
formance
Probable cause
•
Gas leakage at some •
place in refrigeration sys–
tem
•
Diagnosis
Remedy
Insufficient refrigerant in (1) Check for gas leakage
system
with leak detector and
repair if necessary
1
(2) Charge refrigerant to
Refrigerant leaking
proper arhount
(3) If pressure indicated
value is near 0 when
connected to gauge,
create the vacuum af–
ter inspecting and re–
pairing the location of
the leak
AC–26
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
4.
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
POOR CIRCULATION OF REFRIGERANT
Condition: Insufficient cooling
•
•
5.
Symptom seen in
refrigeration system
Pressure low on both •
low and high pressure
sides
Frost on tubes from receiver to unit
Probable cause
Refrigerant flow ob– •
structed by dirt in re–
ceiver
Diagnosis
R e c e i v e r
clogged
Remedy
•
Replace receiver
REFRIGERANT DOES NOT CIRCULATE
Condition: Does not cool (Cools from time to time in some cases)
•
•
Symptom seen in
refrigeration system
Vacuum indicated on •
low pressure side, very
low pressure indicated
on high pressure side
Frost or dew seen on •
piping before and after
receiver/drier or expan–
sion valve
Probable cause
Refrigerant flow ob–
•
structed by moisture or
dirt in refrigeration sys–
tem
Refrigerant flow ob–
structed by gas leakage
from expansion valve
heat sensing tube
Diagnosis
Remedy
Refrigerant does not cir– (1) Check heat sensing
culate
tube, expansion valve
and EPR
(2) Clean out dirt in expan–
sion valve by blowing
with air
If not able to remove
dirt, replace expansion
valve
(3) Replace receiver
(4) Evacuate air and
charge new refrigerant
to proper amount.
For gas leakage from
heat sensing tube, re–
place expansion valve.
AC–27
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
6.
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
REFRIGERANT OVERCHARGE OR INSUFFICIENT COOLING OF CONDENSER
Condition: Does not cool sufficiently
Symptom seen in
refrigeration system
•
•
7.
Pressure too high on
both low and high
pressure sides
No air bubbles seen
through the sight glass
even when the engine
rpm is lowered.
Probable cause
•
•
Diagnosis
Unable to develop suffi– •
cient performance due to
excessive refrigerant in
system
•
.Insufficient cooling of
condenser
Remedy
Excessive refrigerant in
(1) Clean condenser
cycle – refrigerant over– (2) Check fan motor oper–
ation
charged:
(3) If (1) and (2) are in nor–
Condenser cooling insuf–
mal state, check
ficient – condenser fins
amount of refrigerant
Charge proper amount
clogged or fan motor
of refrigerant
faulty
AIR PRESENT IN REFRIGERATION SYSTEM
Condition: Does not cool down sufficiently
•
•
•
Symptom seen in
refrigeration system
Pressure too high on •
both low and high
pressure sides
The low pressure piping
is hot to the touch
Bubbles seen in sight
glass
Probable cause
Diagnosis
Air entered in refrigera– •
tion system
•
Remedy
Air present in refrigera– (1) Check compressor oil
tion system
to see if dirty or insuffi–
cient
(2)
Evacuate
air and
Insufficient vacuum
charge new refrigerant
purging
AC–28
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
8.
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
EXPANSION VALVE IMPROPERLY
MOUNTED/HEAT SENSING TUBE DEFECTIVE
(OPENS TOO WIDE)
Condition: Insufficient cooling
Symptom seen in
refrigeration system
•
•
9.
Pressure too high on
both low and high
pressure sides
Frost or large amount
of dew on piping on low
pressure side
Probable cause
•
Trouble in expansion
valve or heat sensing
tube not installed cor–
rectly
Diagnosis
•
Excessive refrigerant in
low pressure piping
•
Expansion valve opened
too wide
Remedy
(1) Check heat sensing
tube installed condition
(2) If (1) is normal, check
expansion valve
Replace if’ defective
DEFECTIVE COMPRESSION COMPRESSOR
Condition: Does not cool
Symptom seen in
ref rigeration system
•
•
Pressure too high on
low pressure side
Pressure too low on
high pressure side
Probable cause
•
Internal leak in compres–
sor
Diagnosis
•
Compression defective
•
Valve leaking or broken,
sliding parts
Remedy
•
Repair or replace com–
pressor
AC–29
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
REFRIGERANT VOLUME
REFRIGERANT VOLUME
REFRIGERANT VOLUME INSPECTION
1.
2.
RUN ENGINE AT IDLE SPEED
OPERATE A/C AT MAXIMUM COOLING FOR A
FEW MINUTES
INSPECT AMOUNT OF REFRIGERANT
OBSERVE THE SIGHT GLASS ON THE LIQUID TUBE.
3.
Item
Amount of refrigerant
Symptom
Bubbles present insight glass
Insufficient’
No bubbles present in sight glass
None, sufficient or too much
No temperature difference between
compressor inlet and outlet
Empty or nearly empty
Remedy
(1) Check for gas lakage with gas leak
tester and repair if necessary
(2) Add refrigerant until bubbles dis–
apear
Refer to items 3 and 4
(1) Check for gas leakage with gas lea–
ktester and repair if necessary
(2) Add refrigerant until bubbles disap–
pear
Temperature between compressor inlet
Proper or too much
and outlet is noticeably different
Refer to items 5 and 6
Immediately after air conditioning is
turned off, refrigerant in sight glass
stays clear
(1) Discharge refrigrant
(2)Evacuate air and charge proper amo–
unto of purified refrigerant
When air conditioning is turned off, re–
frigerant foams and then stay clear
Too much
Proper
*: Bubbles in the sight glass with ambient temperatu–
ers higher can be considered normal if cooling is
suff icient.
REFRIGERANT CHARGE VOLUME
Specified amount:
850 ± 50 g (29.98 ±1.76 oz)
AC–30
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
DRIVE BELT TENSION
DRIVE BELT TENSION
DRIVE BELT TENSION INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT DRIVE BELT’S INSTALLATION CONDI–
TION
Check that the drive belt fits properly in the ribbed
grooves.
2.
INSPECT DRIVE BELT TENSION
Using a belt tension gauge, check the drive belt ten–
sion.
Belt tension gauge:
Nippondenso BTG–20 (95506–00020) or
Borroughs No. BT–33–73F
Drive belt tension:
5S– FE:
New belt 165 ± 26 Ibf
Used belt 110 ± 11 lbf
1 MZ–FE:
New belt 165 ± 26 lbf
Used belt 88 ± 22 lbf
HINT:
•
”New belt” refers to a belt which has been used
less than 5 minutes on a running engine.
•
”Used belt” refers to a belt which has beenused
on a running engine for 5 minutes or more.
•
After installing the drive belt, check that it fits
properly in the ribbed grooves.
IDLE–UP SPEED
IDLE UP SPEED INSPECTION
1.
2.
WARM UP ENGINE
INSPECT IDLE SPEED
5S– FE:
Magnet clutch condition
Standard idle speed (rpm)
No engaged
Approx. 750
Engaged
Approx. 850
1 MZ – FE:
Magnet clutch condition
Standard idle speed (rpm)
No engaged
Approx. 700
Engaged
Approx. 700
AC–31
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
REFRIGERANT LINES
REFRIGERANT LINES
TIGHTENING TORQUE OF REFRIGERATION LINES
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
2.
INSPECTION HOSE AND TUBE CONNECTIONS FOR
LOOSENESS
INSPECT HOSES AND TUBES FOR LEAKAGE
Using a gas leak tester, check for leakage of refriger–
ant.
AC–32
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
REFRIGERANT LINES
REFRIGERANT LINES REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
DISCHARGE REFRIGERANT IN REFRIGERATION
SYSTEM
(See page AC–21)
REPLACE FAULTY TUBE OR HOSE
HINT: Cap the open fittings immediately to keep mois–
ture or dirt out of the system.
TORQUE CONNECTIONS TO SPECIFIED TORQUE
NOTICE: Connections should not be torque tighter than
the specified torque.
4.
EVACUATE AIR IN REFRIGERATION SYSTEM AND
CHARGE WITH REFRIGERANT
Specified amount:
850 ±50g (29.98 ±1.76 oz)
5.
6.
INSPECT FOR LEAKAGE OF REFRIGERANT
Using a gas leak tester, check for leakage of refriger–
ant.
INSPECT AIR CONDITIONING OPERATION
AC–33
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
A/C UNIT REMOVAL
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
DISCHARGE REFRIGERANT FROM REFRIGERA–
TION SYSTEM
(See page AC–21)
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT FROM RADIATOR
HINT: It is not necessary to drain out all the coolant.
DISCONNECT WATER VALVE CONTROL CABLE
FROM WATER VALVE
DISCONNECT WATER HOSES FROM HEATER RA–
DIATOR PIPES
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL AND REINFORCE–
MENT
(See page BO–108)
REMOVE BLOWER UNIT
(See page AC–35)
7.
DISCONNECT LIQUID AND SUCTION TUBE FROM
BLOCK JOINT
Remove 2 bolts and both tubes.
8.
REMOVE REAR AIR DUCTS
Remove the clip and the air duct.
9.
REMOVE HEATER PROTECTOR
Remove the 2 clips and the heater protector.
AC–34
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
10. REMOVE A/C UNIT
(a) Disconnect connectors from the unit.
(b) Remove the 3 nuts and the A/C unit.
A/C UNIT INSTALLATION
1.
(a)
(b)
2.
3.
4.
INSTALL A/C UNIT
Install the A/C unit with the 3 nuts.
Connect connectors.
INSTALL HEATER PROTECTOR
INSTALL REAR AIR DUSTS
CONNECT LIQUID AND SUCTION TUBE TO BLOCK
JOINT
5. INSTALL BLOWER UNIT
6. INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL AND REINFORCE–
MENT
7. CONNECT WATER HOSES TO HEATER RADIATOR
PIPES
8. CONNECT WATER VALVE CONTROL CABLE TO
WATER VALVE
(See step 3 on page AC–33)
9. REFILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
10. EVACUATE AIR FROM REFRIGERATION SYSTEM
11. CHARGE SYSTEM WITH REFRIGERANT AND IN–
SPECT FOR LEAKAGE OF REFRIGERANT
Specified amount:
850 ±50 g (29.98 ±1.76 oz)
AC–35
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
BLOWER UNIT
BLOWER UNIT
BLOWER UNIT REMOVAL
1.
2.
REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT
(See page BO–108)
REMOVE ECU AND ECU BRACKET
3. REMOVE CONNECTOR BRACKET
(a) Disconnect the connector from the connector brack–
et.
(b) Remove the 2 screws and the bracket.
4.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE BLOWER UNIT
Disconnect the connector from the blower unit.
Disconnect the air inlet damper control cable.
Remove the 3 screws, nut and the blower unit.
BLOWER UNIT INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL BLOWER UNIT
(a) Install the blower unit with the 3 screws and the nut.
(b) Connect the air inlet damper control cable to the
blower unit.
(c) Connect the connector.
2. INSTALL CONNECTOR BRACKET
3. INSTALL ECU BRACKET AND ECU
4. INSTALL GLOVE COMPARTMENT
AC–36
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
COMPRESSOR
COMPRESSOR
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
Magnet Clutch:
1.
MAKE THE FOLLOWING VISUAL CHECKS:
Leakage of grease from the clutch bearing.
Signs of oil on the pressure plate or rotor.
Repair or replace, as necessary.
2. INSPECT MAGNET CLUTCH BEARING FOR NOISE
(a) Start engine.
(b) Check for abnormal noise from near the compressor
when the A/C switch is OFF.
If abnormal noise is being emitted, replace the mag–
netic clutch.
3. INSPECT MAGNET CLUTCH
(a) Disconnect the connector from the magnet clutch.
(b) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to the
terminal on the magnetic clutch connector and the
negative (–) lead to the body ground.
(c) Check that the magnet clutch is energized.
If operation is not as specified, replace the magnet
clutch.
Compressor:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
INSTALL MANIFOLD GAUGE SET
(See page AC–21)
START ENGINE
INSPECT COMPRESSOR FOR METALLIC SOUND
Check that there is a metallic sound from the com–
pressor when the A/C switch is turn on.
If metallic sound is heard, replace the compressor
assembly.
INSPECT PRESSURE OF REFRIGERATION SYSTEM
See “Refrigerant System Inspection with Manifold
Gauge Set” on page AC–24.
STOP ENGINE
INSPECT VISUALLY FOR LEAKAGE OF REFRIGER–
ANT FROM SAFETY SEAL
If there is any leakage, replace the compressor assem–
bly.
AC–37
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
COMPRESSOR
COMPRESSOR REMOVAL
5S–FE Engine Model:
1.
2.
3.
RUN ENGINE AT IDLE SPEED WITH A/C ON FOR
APPROX 10 MINUTES
STOP ENGINE
DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) CABLE FROM BAT–
TERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the “LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
4.
DISCHARGE REFRIGERANT FROM REFRIGERA–
TION SYSTEM
(See page AC–21)
6. DISCONNECT DISCHARGE HOSE AND SUCTION
HOSE FROM COMPRESSOR
7. DISCONNECT CONNECTOR FROM MAGNET
CLUTCH
8. REMOVE COMPRESSOR
(a) Loosen the drive belt.
(b) Remove 3 bolts and compressor.
AC–38
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
COMPRESSOR
COMPRESSOR REMOVAL
1 MZ–FE Engine Model:
1.
2.
3.
RUN ENGINE AT IDLE SPEED WITH A/C ON FOR
APPROX 10 MINUTES
STOP ENGINE
DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) CABLE FROM BAT–
TERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ”LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
AC–39
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
4.
5.
6.
7.
–
COMPRESSOR
DISCHARGE REFRIGERANT FROM REFRIGERA–
TION SYSTEM
(See page AC–21)
DISCONNECT DISCHARGE HOSE AND SUCTION
HOSE FROM COMPRESSOR
DISCONNECT CONNECTOR FROM MAGNET
CLUTCH
REMOVE DRIVE BELT
Loosen the pivot bolt and adjusting lock bolt and
remove the drive belt.
8. REMOVE COMPRESSOR
(a) Remove 2 nuts and 2 bolts.
(b) Remove the compressor.
AC–40
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
COMPRESSOR
MAGNET CLUTCH DISASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE PRESSURE PLATE
(a) Using SST and socket wrench, remove the shaft bolt.
SST 07112 – 76060
(b) Install a SST on the pressure plate.
SST 07112–66040
AC–41
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
(c)
–
COMPRESSOR
Using SST and socket wrench, remove the pressure
plate.
SST 07112–76060
(d) Remove the shims from the pressure plate.
2. REMOVE ROTOR
(a) Using SST, remove the snap ring.
SST 07114–84020
CAUTION: Do not spread the point of SST widely.
Max width:
23.1 mm
(b) Using a plastic hammer, tap the rotor off the shaft.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the pulley when tapp–
ing on the rotor.
3. REMOVE STARTER
(a) Disconnect the stator lead wire from the compressor
housing.
AC–42
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
COMPRESSOR
(b) Using a SST, remove the snap ring.
SST 07114–84020
(c)
Remove the stator.
MAGNET CLUTCH ASSEMBLY
1. INSTALL STATOR
(a) Install the stator on the compressor.
(b) Using SST, install the new snap ring.
SST 07114 –84020
NOTICE: The snap ring should be installed so that its
beveled side faces up.
AC–43
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
(c)
–
COMPRESSOR
Using SST and torque wrench, fasten the magnet
clutch lead wire to the cylinder block.
Torque: 3.4 N–m (35 kgf.cm, 30 in.–lbf)
SST 07110–61050
2. INSTALL ROTOR
(a) Install the rotor on the compressor shaft.
(b) Using SST, install the new snap ring.
SST 07114–84020
CAUTION:Do not spread the point of SST widely.
Max width:
23.1 mm
NOTICE: The snap ring should be installed so that its
beveled side faces up.
3. INSTALL PRESSURE PLATE
(a) Put the shims on the pressure plate.
(b) Using SST and torque wrench, install the shaft bolt.
SST 07112–76060
Torque: 13 N–m (135 kgf–cm, 10 ft–lbf)
AC–44
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
COMPRESSOR
4. CHECK CLEARANCE OF MAGNET CLUTCH
(a) Set the dial – gauge to the pressure plate of the
magnet clutch.
(b) Connect the magnet clutch lead wire to the positive
(+) terminal of the battery.
(c) Check the clearance between the pressure plate and
rotor, whenconnect the negative (–) terminal of the
battery.
Standard clearance:
0.5 ± 0.15 mm (0.020 ± 0.059 in.)
If the clearance is not within standard clearance,
adjust the clearance using shims to obtain the stand–
ard clearance.
COMPRESSOR INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL COMPRESSOR
(a) Install compressor with 4 bolts.
Torque: 25 N–m (250 kgf–cm, 18 ft–lbf)
(b)
(c)
2.
3.
Install drive belt.
Inspect drive belt tension.
CONNECT CONNECTOR TO MAGNET CLUTCH
CONNECT DISCHARGE HOSE AND SUCTION HOSE
TO COMPRESSOR
NOTICE: Hoses should be connected immediately after
the caps have been removed.
Torque: 25 N–m (250 kgf–cm, 18 ft–lbf)
4.
EVACUATE AIR IN REFRIGERATION SYSTEM AND
CHARGE WITH REFRIGERANT
Specified amount:
5.
INSPECT FOR LEAKAGE OF REFRIGERANT
Using a gas leak tester, check for leakage of refriger–
ant.
If there is leakage, check the tightening torque at the
joints.
CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) CABLE TO BATTERY
INSPECT A/C OPERATION
850 ±50 g (29.98 ±1.76 oz)
6.
7.
AC–45
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
RECEIVER
RECEIVER
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
INSPECT FITTINGS FOR LEAKAGE
Using a gas leak tester, check for leakage.
If there is leakage, check the tightening torque at the
joints.
RECEIVER REMOVAL
1.
DICHARGER REFRIGERANT FROM REFRIGERA–
TION SYSTEM
(See page AC–21)
2.
REMOVE 2 LIQUID TUBES FROM RECEIVER
Remove the 2 bolts and the both tubes from the
receiver.
3.
REMOVE RECEIVER FROM RECEIVER HOLDER
Remove the bolt, then remove the receiver from re–
ceiver holder.
NOTICE: Cap the open fittings immediately to keeps moi–
sture out of the system.
AC–46
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
RECEIVER
RECEIVER INSTALLATION
1.
2.
INSTALL RECEIVER INTO RECEIVER HOLDER
Install the receiver into the receiver, holder with the
bolt.
INSTALL 2 LIQUID TUBES TO RECEIVER
Install 2 liquid tubes to the receiver with 2 bolts.
Torque: 5.5 N–m (55 kgf–cm, 48 in.–lbf)
NOTICE: Do not remove the caps until the tubes are
connected.
3.
REPLENISH COMPRESSOR OIL IF RECEIVER HAS
BEEN REPLACED
Add 15 cc (0.5 fl.oz.)
Compressor oil:
4.
EVACUATE AIR IN REFRIGERATION SYSTEM AND
CHARGE WITH REFRIGERANT
Specified amount:
ND OIL 8 or equivalent
850 ±50 g (29.98 ±1.76 oz)
5.
6.
INSPECT FOR LEAKAGE OF REFRIGERANT
INSPECT A/C OPERATION
AC–47
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
CONDENSER
CONDENSER
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT CONDENSER FINS FOR BLOCKAGE OR
DAMAGE
If the fins are clogged, wash them with water and dry
with compressed air.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the fins.
2.
If the fins are bent, straighten them with a screwdriver
or pliers.
INSPECT CONDENSER AND FITTINGS FOR LEAK–
AGE
Using a gas leak tester, check for leakage.
If there is leakage, check the tightening torque at the
joints.
CONDENSER REMOVAL
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
DISCHAGE REFRIGERANT FROM REFRIGERATION
SYSTEM
(See page AC–21)
REMOVE UPPER COVER
REMOVE COOLING FAN
(See page EG–351)
REMOVE UPPER SUPPORT
Remove the 2 bolts and 2 upper supports.
REMOVE LIQUID TUBES
Remove the 2 bolts and 2 tubes.
NOTICE: Cap the open fittings immediately to keep mois–
ture out of the system.
6.
REMOVE HEADLIGHTS ON THE BOTH SIDES
AC–48
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
7.
–
CONDENSER
REMOVE CONDENSER
Remove the 2 bolts and lean the radiator backward,
then remove the cond enser.
CONDENSER INSTALLATION
1.
2.
INSTALL CONDENSER
Install the condenser with the 2 bolt.
INSTALL LIQUID TUBES
Install both tubes with the 2 bolts.
Specified torque: 9.8 N–m (100 kgf–cm, 7 ft–lbf)
NOTICE: Do not remove caps until the tube is installed.
3.
4.
INSTALL COOLING FAN
REPLENISH COMPRESSOR OIL IF CONDENSER
HAS BEEN REPLACED
Add 40 cc (1.4 fl.oz.)
Compressor Oil:
ND OIL 8 or equivalent
5.
EVACUATE AIR IN REFRIGERATION SYSTEM AND
CHARGE WITH REFRIGERANT
Specified amount:
850 ±50g (33.51 ±1.76 oz)
6.
7.
INSPECT FOR LEAKAGE OF REFRIGERANT
Using a gas leak tester, check for leakage of refriger–
ant.
INSTALL REMOVAL PARTS
Install the removal parts in reverse order of removal
procedure.
AC–49
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
EVAPORATOR
EVAPORATOR
EVAPORATOR REMOVAL
1.
2.
DISCHARGE REFRIGERANT FROM REFRIGERA–
TION SYSTEM
(See page AC–21)
REMOVE BLOWER UNIT
(See page AC–35)
3. REMOVE EVAPORATOR COVER
(a) Remove 2 bolts for the liquid and suction tube.
(b) Remove 8 screws and evaporator cover.
4. REMOVE EVAPORATOR
(a) Pull and remove the evaporator.
(b) Remove 2 bolts using a hexagon wrench and separate
the evaporator and expansion valve.
EVAPORATOR INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT FINS FOR BLOCKAGE
If the fins are clogged, clean them with compressed
air.
NOTICE: Never use water to clean the evaporator.
2.
INSPECT FITTINGS FOR CRACKS OR SCRATCHES
Repair as necessary.
AC–50
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
EVAPORATOR
EVAPORATOR INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL REMOVAL PARTS
Install the removal parts in reverse order of removal
procedure.
HINT:
The tightening torque for the bolt used to install
the expantion valve on the evaporator is shown
below.
Torque: 5.4 N–m (55 kgf–cm, 48 in.–lbf)
The tightening torque for the bolts used to install
the liquid and suction tube is shown below.
Torque: 9.8 N–m (100 kgf–cm, 7 ft–lbf)
2.
REPLENISH COMPRESSOR OIL IF EVAPORATOR
HAS BEEN REPLACED
Add 40 cc (1.4 fl.oz)
Compressor oil:
ND OIL 8 or equivalent
3.
EVACUATE AIR IN REFRIGERATION SYSTEM AND
CHARGE WITH REFRIGERANT
Specified amount:
850 ± 50g (29.98 ±1.76 oz)
4.
INSPECT FOR LEAKAGE OF REFRIGERANT
Using a gas leak tester, check for leakage of refriger–
ant.
AC–51
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
HEATER RADIATOR
HEATER RADIATOR
HEATER RADIATOR REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE HEATER PROTECTOR
Remove the 2 clips and the heater protector.
2. REMOVE HEATER RADIATOR
(a) Remove the 3 screws and the 3 clamps.
(b) Disconnect the heater pipes.
(c) Pull the heater radiator out.
HEATER RADIATOR INSPECTION
If the fin are clogged, clean them with commpressed
air.
HEATER RADIATOR INSTALLATION
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
2.
INSTALL HEATER RADIATOR TO A/C UNIT
Put the radiator in the A/C unit.
Connect teh heater pipes.
Install the 3 clamps with 3 screws.
INSTALL HEATER PROTECTOR
AC–52
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
WATER VALVE
WATER VALVE
WATER VALVE REMOVAL
1.
2.
3.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT FROM RADIATOR
HINT: It is not necessary to drain out all the coolant.
DISCONNECT WATER VALVE CONTROL CABLE
FROM WATER VALVE
DISCONNECT WATER HOSE FROM WATER VALVE
4. REMOVE WATER VALVE
(a) Disconnect the water hose from the heater radiator
pipe.
(b) Remove the bolt and the water valve
WATER VALVE INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL WATER VALVE
(a) Push the water hose onto the heater radiator pipe as
far as rigs on the pipe and install the hose clip.
(b) Install water valve with the bolt.
2. CONNECT HEATER HOSE TO WATER VALVE
3.
CONNECT WATER VALVE CONTROL CABLE TO
WATER VALVE
(a) Set the temperature control switch to ”COOL”.
(b) Set the water valve lever to ”COOL”, install the control
cable and lock the clamp.
HINT: Lock the clamp while lightly pushing the outer
cable in the direction shown by the arrow.
AC–53
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
EXPANSION VALVE
EXPANSION VALVE
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
2.
3.
4.
CHECK QUANTITY OF GAS DURING REFRIGERA–
TION CYCLE
INSTALL MANIFOLD GAUGE SET
RUN ENGINE
Run the engine at 1,500 rpm for at least 5 minutes.
Then check that the high pressure reading is 1.37 –
1.53 MPa (14 – 16 kgf/cm2, 199 – 228 psi).
CHECK EXPANSION VALVE
If the expansion valve is faulty, the low pressure
reading will drop to 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi).
HINT: When the low pressure drops to 0 kPa (0 kgf/
cm2, 0 psi), feel the receiver’s IN and OUT sides for no
temperature difference.
EXPANSION VALVE REMOVAL
1.
2.
REMOVE EVAPORATOR
(See page AC–50)
REMOVE EXPANSION VALVE
(See page AC–51)
EXPANTION VALVE INSTALLSION
1.
2.
INSTALL EXPANSION VALVE
(See page AC–51)
INSTALL EVAPORATOR
(See page AC–51)
AC–54
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
AIR SWITCHING VALVE (ASV)
AIR SWITCHING VALVE (ASV)
VACUUM HOSE CIRCUIT (5S–FE ENGINE
MODEL)
ASV INSPECTION (5S–FE ENGINE
MODEL)
1.
CHECK VACUUM CIRCUIT CONTINUITY IN ASV BY
BLOWING AIR INTO PIPES
(a) Connect the ASV terminals to the battery terminals as
illustrated.
(b) Blow into pipe ”A” and’ check that air comes out of
pipe ”B”.
(c) Disconnect the battery.
(b) Blow into pipe ”A” and check that air does not come
out of pipe ”B”.
If a problem is bound, replace the ASV.
2.
CHECK FOR SHORT CIRCUIT
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity
between each terminal and the ASV.
If there is continuity, replace the ASV.
3.
CHECK FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
the 2 terminals.
Resistance:
30 – 34 0 at 20° C (68° F)
If resistance value is not as specified, replace the ASV.
AC–55
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
BLOWER MOTOR
BLOWER MOTOR
BLOWER MOTOR REMOVAL
1.
2.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT LOWER PANEL AND
UNDER COVER NO. 2
(See page BO–108)
REMOVE CONNECTOR BRACKET
Remove the 2 screws and the bracket
3. REMOVE MOTOR
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 3 screws and the motor.
BLOWER MOTOR INSPECTION
INSPECT BLOWER MOTOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 2 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 1,
then check that the motor operation is smooth.
BLOWER MOTOR INSTALLATION
1.
(a)
(b)
2.
3.
INSTALL MOTOR
Install the motor with the 3 screws.
Connect the connector.
INSTALL CONNECTOR BRACKET
INSTALL INSTRUMENT LOWER PANEL AND
UNDER COVER NO. 2
AC–56
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
CONDENSER FAN MOTOR
CONDENSER FAN MOTOR
CONDENSER FAN MOTOR INSPECTION
5S–FE ENGINE MODEL:
1.
2.
DISCONNECT CONNECTOR
INSPECT CONDENSER FAN MOTOR
Connect positive (+) lead from battery and negative
(–) lead to terminals, then check that the condenser
fan motor operates smoothly.
Standard current:
6.7±1 (A)
If current value is not as specified, replace the con–
denser fan motor.
AC–57
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
AIR INLET SERVOMOTOR
AIR INLET SERVOMOTOR
AIR INLET SERVOMOTOR REMOVAL
1.
2.
REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT
(See page BO–108)
REMOVE ECU AND ECU BRACKET
3. REMOVE SERVOMOTOR
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 2 screws and the servomotor.
AIR INLET SERVOMOTOR INSPECTION
INSPECT SERVOMOTOR OPERATION
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 1 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 2,
check that the arm rotates to the ”FRESH” side smoot–
hly.
(b) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 1 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 3,
check that the arm rotates to the ”RECI RC” side smo–
othly.
If operation is not as specified, replace the servo
motor.
AIR INLET SERVOMOTOR INSTALLATION
1.
(a)
(b)
2.
3.
INSTALL SERVOMOTOR
Install the servomotor with the 2 screws.
Connect the connector.
INSTALL ECU AND ECU BRACKET
INSTALL GLOVE COMPARTMENT
AC–58
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
AIR OUTLET SERVOMOTOR
AIR OUTLET SERVOMOTOR
AIR OUTLET SERVOMOTOR REMOVAL
1.
2.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT LOWER FINISH PANEL
AND AIR DUCT
(See page BO–108)
REMOVE AIR DUCT NO. 2
3. REMOVE SERVOMOTOR
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 2 screws and the servomotor.
AIR OUTLET SERVOMOTOR INSPECTION
INSPECT SERVOMOTOR OPERATION
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 6 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 7.
(b) Connect the negative (–) lead from the battery to
each terminal and check that the arm rotates to each
position as shown below.
Connected terminal
Position
D EF
FOOT/DEF
FOOT
B/L
FACE
If operation is not as specified, replace the servomo–
tor.
AIR OUTLET SERVOMOTOR
INSTALLATION
1.
(a)
(b)
2.
3.
INSTALL SERVOMOTOR
Install the servomotor with 2 screws.
Connect the connector
INSTALL HEATER DUCT
INSTALL LOWER FINISH PANEL
AC–59
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
BLOWER RESISTOR
BLOWER RESISTOR
BLOWER RESISTOR REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT LOWER FINISH PANEL
(See page BO–108)
2. REMOVE BLOWER RESISTOR
(a) Disconnect the connector from the resistor.
(b) Remove the 2 screws and the resistor.
BLOWER RESISTOR INSPECTION
INSPECT BLOWER RESISTOR CONTINUITY
Continuity
Condition
Constant
Tester connectoin to
terminal number
1–2–3–6
Specified value
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the blower
resistor.
Condition
Tester connectoin to
terminal number
Constant
t –2–3–5–6
Specified value
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the blower
resistor.
BLOWER RESISTOR INSTALLATION
1.
(a)
(b)
2.
INSTALL BLOWER RESISTOR
Install the resistor with the 2 screws.
Connect the connector to the resistor.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT LOWER FINISH PANEL
AC–60
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
PRESSURE SWITCH
PRESSURE SWITCH
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
3.
INSTALL MANIFOLD GAUGE SET
(See page AC–21)
DISCONNECT CONNECTOR FROM PRESSURE
SWITCH
RUN ENGINE AT APPROX. 2000 RPM
4.
INSPECT PRESSURE SWITCH OPERATION
2.
Magnet Clutch Control:
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the ohmmeter to
terminal 4 and negative (–) lead to terminal 1.
(b) Check continuity between terminals when refrigerant
pressure is changed, as shown.
If operation is not as specified, replace the pressure
switch.
Cooling Fan Control:
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the ohmmeter to
terminal 2 and negative (–) lead to terminal 3.
(b) Check continuity between terminals when refrigerant
pressure is changed, as shown.
If operation is not as specified, replace the pressure
switch.
5. STOP ENGINE AND REMOVE MANIFOLD GAUGE
SET
6. CONNECT CONNECTOR TO PRESSURE SWITCH
AC–61
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
PRESSURE SWITCH
PRESSURE SWITCH REMOVAL
1.
DISCHARGE REFRIGERANT IN REFRIGERATION
SYSTEM
2. REMOVE PRESSURE SWITCH
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the pressure switch from the liquid tube.
HINT: Lock the switch mount on the tube with an
open end wrench, being careful not to deform the
tube, and remove the switch.
PRESSURE SWITCH INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL PRESSURE SWITCH
(a) Install the pressure switch to the liquid tube.
Torque: 9.8 N–m (100 kgf–cm, 7 ft–lbf)
HINT: Lock the switch mount on the tube with an
open end wrench, being careful not to deform the
tube, and install the switch.
(b) Connect the connector.
2. EVACUATE AIR IN REFRIGERATION SYSTEM AND
CHARGE WITH REFRIGERANT
Specified amount:
850 ±50 g (29.98 ±1.76 oz)
3.
4.
INSPECT FOR LEAKAGE OF REFRIGERANT
Using a gas leak tester, check for leakage of refriger–
ant from the pressure switch mount.
INSPECT A/C OPERATION
AC–62
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE
SENSOR
EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
REMOVAL
REMOVE EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Remove the screw and the evaporator temperature
sensor (thermistor).
EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
INSPECTION
Check resistance between terminals of evaporator
temperature sensor (thermistor) connector at each
temperature.
Resistance:
at 0C (32F): 4.6 – 5.1 k
at 15C (59F): 2.1 – 2.6 k
In addition as temperature increases, the resistance
decreases gradually.
EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
INSTALLATION
INSTALL EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Install evaporator temperature sensor in reverse order
of removal procedure.
AC–63
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
REVOLUTION DETECTING SENSOR
REVOLUTION DETECTING SENSOR
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) CABLE FROM BAT–
TERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition swithch is turned “LOCK” position
and the negative (–) terminal cable is disconnected from
the battery.
2.
3.
DISCONNECT CONNECTOR OF REVOLUTION DET–
ECTING SENSOR
INSPECT REVOLUTION DETECTING SENSOR
Check the resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of the
sensor.
Specified resistance:
5S–FE:
165 – 205 at 20 C (68 F)
1 MZ– FE:
65 – 125 at 20 C (68 F)
If the resistance value is not as specified, replace the
revolution detecting sensor.
REVOLUTION DETECTING SENSOR
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE COMPRESSOR
(See page AC–37)
2. REMOVE REVOLUTION DETECTING SENSOR
(a) Remove 2 bolts.
(b) Remove the revolution detecting sensor.
REVOLUTION DETECTING SENSOR
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL REVOLUTION DETECTING SENSOR
Using a torque wrench, tighten the bolts.
Torque:6 N–m (60 kgf–cm, 4 ft–lbf)
2.
INSTALL COMPRESSOR
(See page AC–46)
AC–64
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
RELAY
RELAY
RELAYS REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) CABLE FROM BAT–
TERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2.
REMOVE RELAYS
RELAYS INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT MAGNET CLUTCH RELAY CONTINUITY
Condition
Tester connection to
terminal number
Specified value
Constant
1–4
Continuity
2 –3
Continuity
Apply B + between
terminals 1 and 4.
2.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
INSPECT A/C FAN RELAY NO. 2 CONTINUITY
5S–FE Engine Model:
Condition
Constant
Apply6 + between
terminals 1 and 4.
3.
Tester connection to
terminal number
Specified value
1 –4
3–5
Continuity
2–3
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
INSPECT A/C FAN RELAY NO. 3 CONTINUITY
5S–FE Engine Model:
Condition
Tester connection to
terminal number
Specified value
Constant
1–4
Continuity
2–3
Continuity
Apply B + between
terminals 1 and 4.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
AC–65
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
4.
–
RELAY
INSPECT HEATER MAIN RELAY CONTINUITY
Condition
Constant
Apply B + between
terminals 1 and 3.
Tester connection to
terminal number
Specified value
1–3
2–4
Continuity
4–5
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
RELAYS INSTALLATION
1.
2.
INSTALL RELAYS
CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) CABLE TO BATTERY
AC–66
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
A/C AMPLIFIER INSPECTION
INSPECT AMPLIFIER CIRCUIT
Disconnect the amplifier and inspect the connector on
the wire harness side, as shown in the chart below.
Test conditions
•
Ignition switch : ON
•
Temperature control dial : MAX COOL
•
Blower dial: HI
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
5 – Ground
Constant
Continuity
9–13
Constant
1.5 k at 20 C (68 F)
14–13
Constant
Approx. 115 at 20 C (68 F)
12 – Ground
Turn A/C switch ON
Battery voltage
12– Ground
Turn A/C switch OFF
No voltage
2 – Ground
Refrigerant pressure: 196 – 3140 kPa
Battery voltage
2 – Ground
Refrigerant pressure: less than 196 kPa or
more than 3140 kPa
No voltage
10 – Ground
Turn A/C switch ON
Battery voltage
10 – Ground
Turn A/C switch OFF
No voltage
8 – Ground
Turn A/C switch ON
Battery voltage
8 – Ground
Turn A/C switch OFF
No voltage
If circuit is not as specified, replace the amplifier.
AC–67
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL
ASSEMBLY
A/C CONTROL ASSEMBLY REMOVAL
(See page BO–108)
A/C CONTROL ASSEMBLY INSPECTION
(ROTARY SWITCH AND PUSH BUTTON
TYPE)
1. INSPECT A/C INDICATOR
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal A–12 and the negative (–) lead to terminal
A–4.
(b) Push the A/C button in and check that the indicator
light up.
If operation is not as specified, replace the A/C con–
trol assembly.
2. INSPECT MODE INDICATOR
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal A–12 and the negative (–) lead to terminal
A–1.
(b) Push each of the mode bottons in and check that their
indicators light up.
If operation is not as specified, replace the A/C con–
trol assembly.
AC–68
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
3. INSPECT AIR INLET INDICATOR
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal A– 12 and the negative (–) lead to terminal
A–1.
(b) Check that the FRESH and RECIRC indicators light up
alternately each time the air inlet control switch
button is pressed.
If operation is not as specified, replace the A/C con–
trol assembly.
4. INSPECT INDICATOR DIMMING OPERATION
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal A– 12 and the negative (–) lead to terminal
A –1.
(b) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal A–14 and check that the mode indicator
dims.
If operation is not as specified, replace the A/C con–
trol assembly.
5.
INSPECT A/C SWITCH CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection to
terminal number
OFF
Specified value
No continuity
A7 – A8
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the A/C con–
trol assembly.
AC–69
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
6.
–
AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
INSPECT MODE CONTROL SWITCH CONTINUITY
Switch position
FACE
Tester connection to
terminal number
A11 –Al
Specified value
Continuity
B/L
A3 – A 1
Continuity
FOOT
A10 – A1
Continuity
FOOT/ oeF
A2 – A 1
Continuity
D EF
A9 – A 1
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the A/C con–
trol assembly.
7.
INSPECT AIR INLET CONTROL SWITCH CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connectoin to
terminal number
Specified value
RECIRC
A5 – A 1
Continuity
FRESH
A6–A1
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the A/C con–
trol assembly.
AC–70
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
8.
–
AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
INSPECT BLOWER SPEED CONTROL SWITCH CON–
TINUITY
Terminal
B–1
E–2
B–4
B–5
B–7
6–8
B–6
Switch position
OFF
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
AC–71
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
ROTARY SWITCH AND LEVER TYPE:
1.
INSPECT A/C SWITCH CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection to
terminal number
OFF.
Specified value
No continuity
2–5
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
2.
INSPECT MODE CONTROL SWITCH CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection to
terminal number
Specified value
FACE
B/ L
1–8
Continuity
1–7
Continuity
FOOT
1 –6
Continuity
FOOT/ DEF
1–5
Continuity
DEF
1–4
Continuity
3.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
INSPECT BLOWER SPEED CONTROL SWITCH CON–
TINUITY
AC–72
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
Terminal
Switch position
OFF
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
A/C CONTROL CABLES ADJUSTMENT
1.
ADJUST AIR INLET DAMPER CONTROL CABLE
Set the air inlet damper and the control lever to ”
FRESH” position, install the control cable and lock the
clamp.
2.
ADJUST AIR MIX DAMPER CONTROL CABLE
Set the air mix damper and control switch to ”COOL”
position, install the control cable and lock the clamp
while lightly pushing the outer cable in the direction
shown by the arrow.
A/C CONTROL ASSEMBLY
INSTALLATION
(See page BO–108)
AC–73
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE DATA
Refrigerant charge volume
Drive belt tention
New belt
5S–FE:
Used belt
New belt
1 MZ– FE:
Used belt
Idle speed
5S–FE:
Magnetic clutch no engaged
Magnetic clutch engaged
1 MZ– FE:
Magnetic clutch noT engaged
Magnetic clutch engaged
Magnetic clutch clearance
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part tightened
Suction hose x Compressor
Discharge hose x Compressor
Compressor x Engine
Liquid x Receiver
Lequid x Condensor
Expansion valve x Evaporator
Suction tube x A/C unit
Liquid tube x A/C unit
Pressure switch x Liquired tube
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
AX1–1
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
A140E AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
AX1–2
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
DESCRIPTION
DESCRIPTION
PRECAUTIONS
When working with FIPG material, you must observe the following.
• Using a razor blade and gasket scraper, remove all the old FIPG material from the gasket surfaces.
• Thoroughly clean all components to remove all the loose material.
• Clean both sealing surfaces with a non–residue solvent.
• Apply the FIPG in approx.1 mm (0.04 in.) wide bead along the sealing surface.
• Parts must be assembled within 10 minutes of application. Otherwise, the FIPG material must be
removed and reapplied.
If the vehicle is equipped with a mobile communication system, refer to the precaution in the IN
section.
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The A140E Electronically Controlled automatic transaxle described in this AX section is a lock–
up four–speed automatic transaxle developed exclusively for use with transversely–mounted
engines.
AX1–3
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SPECIFICATIONS
Type of Transaxle
Type of Engine
Torque Converter Clutch Stall Torque Ratio
Torque Converter Clutch Lock–up Mechanism
Gear Ratio
Transaxle
2nd Coast Brake (B,) Band Width
1 st Gear
2nd Gear
3rd Gear
0/D Gear
Reverse Gear
Number of Discs / Plates
O/D Direct Clutch (Co)
Forward Clutch (C,)
Direct Clutch (Ct)
2nd Brake (Bz)
1 st & Reverse Brake (B,)
O/D Brake (Bo)
mm (in.)
ATF Type
Capacity liter (US qts, Imp.qts)
Total
Drain & Refill
DESCRIPTION
AX1–4
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OPERATION
OPERATION
0 . . . . . Operating
Shift lever
position
Gear Position
Parking
Reverse
Neutral
2nd
3rd
O/D
2nd
” 3rd
*2nd
’ Down–shift only–no up–shift
AX1–5
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OPERATION
1. FUNCTION OF COMPONENTS
COMPONENT
FUNCTION
O/D Direct Clutch (Co)
Connects Overdrive sun gear and overdrive carrier.
0/D Brake (Bo)
Prevents overdrive sun gear from turning either clockwise or counterclockwise.
O/D One–Clutch (Fo)
When transaxle is being driven by engine, connects overdrive sun gear and
overdrive carrier.
Front Clutch (C1)
Connects input shaft and intermediate shaft.
Rear Clutch (C2)
Connects input shaft and front & rear planetary gear.
No. 1 Brake (B1)
Prevents front & rear planetary sun gear from turning either clockwise or
counterclockwise.
No. 2 Brake (B2)
Prevents outer race of F, from turning either clockwise or counterclockwise, thus
preventing front & rear planetary sun gear from turning counterclockwise.
No. 3 Brake (B3)
Prevents front planetary carrier from turning either clockwise or counterclockwise.
No. 1 One–Way Clutch (F1)
When B2 is operating, prevents front & rear planetary sun gear from turning
counterclockwise.
No. 2 One–Way Clutch (F2)
Prevents front planetary carrier from turning counterclockwise.
AX1–6
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OPERATION
Power from the engine transmitted to the input shaft via the torque converter clutch is then
transmitted to the planetary gears by the operation of the clutch.
By operation of the brake and one–way clutch, either the planetary carrier or the planetary sun
gear are immobilized, altering the speed of revolution of the planetary gear unit.
Shift change is carried out by altering the combination of clutch and brake operation.
Each clutch and brake operates by hydraulic pressure. Gear position are decided according to the
throttle opening angle and vehicle speed, and shift change automatically occurs.
The conditions of operation for each gear position are shown on the following illustrations:
AX1–7
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OPERATION
2. Hydraulic Control System
The hydraulic control system is composed of the oil pump, the valve body, the solenoid valves,
the accumulator, the clutches and brakes, and the governor valve as well as the fluid passages
which connect all of these components.
Based on the hydraulic pressure created by the oil pump, the hydraulic control system governs
the hydraulic pressure acting on the torque converter clutch, clutches and brakes in accordance
with the vehicle driving conditions.
There are three solenoid valves on the valve body.
The shift solenoid valves No. 1 and No.2 are turned on and off by signals from the ECM to operate
the shift valves and change the gear shift position.
The No.3 solenoid valve is operated by signals from the ECM to engage or disengage the lock–
up clutch of the torque converter clutch.
AX1–8
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OPERATION
3. Electronic Control System
The electronic control system for controlling the shift timing and the operation of the lock–up
clutch is composed of the following three parts:
(a) Sensors: These sense the vehicle speed and throttle position and send this data to the ECM in the
form of electronic signals.
(b) ECM: This determines the shift and lock–up timing based upon the signals from the sensors.
(c) Actuators: Solenoid valves divert hydraulic pressure from one circuit of the hydraulic control unit
to another, thus controlling shifting and lock–up timing.
SENSORS
ECM
PATTERN SELECT
SWITCH
Control of shift
timing
PARK/NEUTRAL
POSITION SWITCH
ACTUATORS
SHIFT SOLENOID i
VALVE NO.1
SHIFT SOLENOID I
VALVE NO.2
THROTTLE POSITION
SENSOR
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
Control of lock–
up timing
SHIFT SOLENOID
VALVE SL
BRAKE LIGHT SWITCH
O/D MAIN SWITCH
Self–diagnostic
system
CRUISE CONTROL ECU
ENGINE COOLANT
TEMPERATURE SENSOR
RPM SENSOR
Back–up system
O/D OFF
INDICATOR LIGHT
AX1–9
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
–
OPERATION
AX1–10
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OPERATION
ARRANGEMENT OF COMPONENTS
Functions
Components
No.
O/D OFF Indicator Light
Blinks and warns the driver, while the 0/D main switch is pushed in, when the
electronic control circuit is malfunctioning.
Pattern Select Switch
Selects the Power mode or the Normal mode for shift and lock–up timing.
0/D Switch
Prevents up shift to the O/D gear if the O/D switch is off.
Throttle Position Sensor
Detects the throttle valve opening angle.
ECM
Controls the engine and transaxle,actuators based on signals from each sensor.
Engine Coolant Temp. Sensor
Detects the engine coolant temperature.
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Detect the vehicle speed. Ordinarily, transaxle control uses signals from the
vehicle speed sensor.
Park/Neutral Position Switch
Detects the shift lever position.
Shift Solenoid Valves
No.1 and No.2
Control the hydraulic pressure applied to each shift valve, and control the gear shift
position and timing.
Shift Solenoid Valves SL
For lock–up control
pressure modulation
Controls the hydraulic pressure applied to the lock–up clutch and controls lock–up
timing.
Stop Light Switch
Detects if the brake pedal is depressed.
AX1–11
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
PREPARATION
PREPARATION
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
09043–38100 Hexagon 10 mm Wrench
Remove and install oil pan drain
plug.
09308–00010 Oil Seal Puller
Remove side gear shaft oil seal.
09350–32014 TOYOTA Automatic Transmission
Tool Set
(09351–32010) One–way Clutch Test Toot
(09351–32020) Stator Stopper
(09351–32130) Handle
(09351–32150) Oil Seal Replacer
09843–18020 Diagnosis Check Wire
09992–00094 Automatic Transmission Oil
Pressure Gauge Set
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082–00050 TOYOTA Electrical Tester Set
Line pressure
AX1–12
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
PREPARATION
EQUIPMENT
Straight edge
Check torque converter
clutch installation.
Vernier calipers
Check torque converter
clutch installation.
Dial indicator or dial indicator with magnetic base
Measures drive plate runout.
Torque wrench
LUBRICANT
Item
Automatic transaxle fluid
(w/o Differential oil)
Dry fill
Drain and refill
Differential oil
(w/ Automatic transaxle)
Capacity
5.6 liters (5.9 US qts, 4.9 Imp.qts)
2.5 liters (2.6 US qts, 2.2 Imp.qts)
1.6 liters (1.7 US qts, 1.4 Imp. qts)
Classification
ATF DEXRON
ATF DEXRON
SSM (SPECIAL SERVICE MATERIALS)
08833–00070 Adhesive 1311,
THREE BOND 1311 or equivalent
Torque converter clutch mounting
bolt
AX1–13
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ON–VEHICLE REPAIR
ON–VEHICLE REPAIR
VALVE BODY REMOVAL
1. CLEAN TRANSAXLE EXTERIOR
To help prevent contamination, clean the exterior of
the transaxle.
2. DRAIN TRANSAXLE FLUID
Remove the drain plug with SST, and drain the fluid
into a suitable container.
SST 09043–38100
3. REMOVE OIL PAN AND GASKET
NOTICE: Some fluid will remain in the oil pan.
Remove all pan bolts, and carefully remove the pan
assembly discarding the gasket.
4. EXAMINE PARTICLES IN PAN
Remove the magnets and use them to collect any
steel chips. Look carefully at the chips and particles in
the pan and on the magnet to anticipate what type of
wear you will find in the transaxle.
Steel (magnetic): bearing, gear and plate wear
Brass (non–magnetic): bushing wear
5. REMOVE OIL STRAINER AND APPLY TUBE BRACKET
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and the oil strainer.
NOTICE: Be careful as oil will come out of the strainer
when it is removed.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and the apply tube bracket.
6. DISCONNECT SOLENOID CONNECTORS
AX1–14
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ON–VEHICLE REPAIR
7. REMOVE OIL TUBES
Pry up the both tube ends with a large screwdriver
and remove the four tubes.
8. REMOVE MANUAL DETENT SPRING
9. REMOVE MANUAL VALVE AND MANUAL VALVE
BODY
10. REMOVE VALVE BODY
Remove the 12 bolts.
11. REMOVE THROTTLE CABLE
(a) Disconnect the throttle cable.
(b) Remove the valve body.
12. REMOVE SECOND BRAKE APPLY GASKET
AX1–15
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ON–VEHICLE REPAIR
VALVE BODY INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL SECOND BRAKE APPLY GASKET
2. INSTALL VALVE BODY
(a) While holding the cam down with your hand, slip the
cable and into the slot.
(b) Bring valve body into place.
NOTICE: Be careful not to entangle the solenoid wire.
3. INSTALL BOLTS IN VALVE BODY
Hand tighten the 12 bolts first, then torque with a
torque wrench.
Torque: 10 N–m (100 kgf–cm, 7 ft–lbf)
Bolt length:
A 20 mm (0.79 in.)
B 25 mm (0.98 in.)
C 36 mm (1.42 in.)
D50mm(1.97in.)
4. CONNECT SOLENOID WIRING
(a) Connect the shift solenoid valve No. 1 connector
(white and shorter wire).
(b) Connect the shift solenoid valve No. 2 connector
(black and longer wire).
5. INSTALL MANUAL VALVE BODY DETENT SPRING
(a) Align the manual valve with the pin on the manual
shaft lever.
(b) Lower the manual valve body into place.
(c) Hand tighten the 4 bolts first. Then, tighten them with
a torque wrench.
Torque: 10 N–m (100 kgf–cm, 7 ft–lbf)
AX1–16
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ON–VEHICLE REPAIR
(d) Place the detent spring on the manual valve body and
hand tighten the 2 bolts first.
Then, tighten them with a torque wrench.
Torque: 10 N–m (100 kgf–cm, 7 ft–lbf)
(e) Check that the manual valve lever is touching the
center of the detent spring tip roller.
6. INSTALL OIL TUBES
Tap the tubes with a plastic hammer to install them
into the positions indicated in the illustration.
NOTICE: Be careful not to bend or damage the tubes.
7. INSTALL OIL STRAINER AND APPLY TUBE BRACK–
ET
(a) Install the oil strainer and torque the 3 bolts.
(b) Install the apply tube bracket and the 2 bolts.
Torque: 10 N–m (100 kgf–cm, 7s. ft–lbf)
8. INSTALL MAGNETS IN PAN
Install the 2 magnets in the indentations of the pan.
9. INSTALL OIL PAN WITH NEW GASKET
NOTICE: Make sure that the magnet does not interfere
with the oil tubes.
Torque: 4.9 N–m (50 kgf–cm, 43 in.–Ibf)
10. INSTALL DRAIN PLUG WITH NEW GASKET
Using SST, install the drain plug with a new gasket
and tighten it.
Torque: 49 N–m (500 kgf–cm, 36 ft–lbf)
SST 09043–38100
AX1–17
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ON–VEHICLE REPAIR
11. FILL TRANSAXLE WITH ATF
Add only about 2 liters of ATF.
NOTICE: Do not overfill.
Fluid type:
ATF DEXRON II
12. CHECK FLUID LEVEL
(See page AX1–54)
THROTTLE CABLE REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT THROTTLE CABLE
(a) Disconnect the cable housing from the bracket.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the throttle linkage.
2. REMOVE PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
(a) Remove the clips and, disconnect the transaxle con–
trol cable from manual shift lever.
(b) Remove the manual shift lever.
(c) Remove the park/neutral position switch.
3. REMOVE VALVE BODY
(See page AX–13)
4. PULL THROTTLE CABLE OUT OF TRANSAXLE
CASE
(a) Remove the bolt and retaining plate.
(b) Pull the cable out of the transaxle case.
AX1–18
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ON–VEHICLE REPAIR
THROTTLE CABLE INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL CABLE IN TRANSAXLE CASE
(a) Be sure to push it in all the way.
(b) Install the retaining plate and the bolt.
2. INSTALL VALVE BODY
(See page AX–15)
3. IF THROTTLE CABLE IS NEW, STAKE STOPPER ON
INNER CABLE
(a) Bend the cable so there is a radius of about 200 mm
(7.87 in.).
(b) Pull the inner cable lightly until a slight resistance is
felt, and hold it.
(c) Stake the stopper 0.8–1.5 mm (0.031–0.059 in.)
from the end of outer cable, as shown.
4. CONNECT THROTTLE CABLE
(a) Connect the cable to the throttle linkage.
(b) Connect the cable housing to the bracket.
5. ADJUST THROTTLE CABLE
(See page AX1–55)
6. INSTALL PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
(a) Install the park/neutral position switch.
(b) Install the manual shift lever.
(c) Adjust the park/neutral position switch.
(See page AX1–56)
(d) Connect the transaxle control cable.
AX1–19
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ON–VEHICLE REPAIR
DIFFERENTIAL OIL SEAL REMOVAL
1. REMOVE BOTH DRIVE SHAFTS
(See page SA–38)
2. REMOVE BOTH SIDE GEAR SHAFT OIL SEALS
Using SST, pull out the oil seal.
SST 09308–00010
DIFFERENTIAL OIL SEAL INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL LEFT SIDE GEAR SHAFT OIL SEAL
(1) Using SST, drive in a new oil seal.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32130, 08351–32150)
Oil seal depth:
2.7 ±0.5 mm (0.11 ±0.02 in.)
(2) Coat the lip of oil seal with MP grease.
2. INSTALL RIGHT SIDE GEAR SHAFT OIL SEAL
(1) Using SST, drive in a new oil seal.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32130, 09351–32150)
Oil seal depth:
0 ± 0.5 mm (0 0.02 in.)
(2) Coat the lip of seal with MP grease.
3. INSTALL BOTH DRIVE SHAFTS
(See page SA–40)
4. CHECK TRANSAXLE FLUID LEVEL
(See page AX1–54)
AX1–20
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
ASSEMBLY COMPONENTS
AX1–21
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRANSAXLE REMOVAL
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ”LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
2. REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
3. REMOVE THROTTLE CABLE FROM ENGINE
w/ Cruise Control System:
4. REMOVE CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR COVER
5. DISCONNECT CONNECTOR FROM CRUISE CON–
TROL ACTUATOR
6. REMOVE GROUND TERMINAL
7. DISCONNECT CONNECTOR FROM VEHICLE SPEED
SENSOR
AX1–22
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
8. REMOVE STARTER
(a) Disconnect the connector and nut.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and the starter.
9. DISCONNECT PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
CONNECTOR
10. DISCONNECT SOLENOID CONNECTOR
11. DISCONNECT OIL COOLER HOSE
12. DISCONNECT SHIFT CONTROL CABLE
(a) Remove the clip from the control cable.
(b) Remove the nut.
AX1–23
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
13. REMOVE 2 FRONT SIDE ENGINE MOUNTING BOLT
14. REMOVE 2 BOLT AND CLAMP FROM FRONT
FRAME ASSEMBLY
15. REMOVE 3 UPPER TRANSAXLE TO ENGINE BOLT
16. INSTALL ENGINE SUPPORT FIXTURE
17. TIE STEERING GEAR HOUSING TO ENGINE SUP
– PORT FIXTURE BY CORD OR EQUIVALENT
18. RAISE AND SUITABLE SUPPORT VEHICLE
19. REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
20. REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE
(a) Remove the 3 nuts.
AX1–24
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and nuts from rear exhaust pipe.
21. REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL FLUID DRAIN PLUG AND
GASKET
22. DRAIN DIFFERENTIAL FLUID INTO A SUITABLE
CONTAINER
23. REMOVE RIGHT AND LEFT ENGINE SIDE COVER
NO.2
24. REMOVE ENGINE UNDER FRONT COVER NO.1 AND
NO.2
25. REMOVE DRIVE SHAFT
(See page SA–38)
26. REMOVE FRONT SIDE ENGINE MOUNTING NUT
27. REMOVE 3 REAR SIDE ENGINE MOUNTING NUTS
AX1–25
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
28. REMOVE ENGINE 4 TRANSAXLE MOUNTING
BOLTS
29. REMOVE STEERING GEAR HOUSING
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and disconnect stabilizer bar bus–
hing bracket from the front frame assembly.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and nuts from the steering gear
housing.
(c) Remove the steering gear housing.
30. REMOVE FRONT FRAME ASSEMBLY
(a) Hold the front frame assembly with a jack.
(b) Remove the 2 set screws from the right and left
fender liners.
(c) Remove the 6 bolts and 4 nuts.
(d) Remove the front frame assembly.
AX1–26
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
31. REMOVE STIFFENER PLATE
(a) Hold the transaxle with a jack.
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and stiffener plate.
32. REMOVE REAR END PLATE
(a) Remove the 4 bolts.
(b) Remove the rear end plate.
33. REMOVE TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH MOUNT
–
ING BOLT
(a) Turn the crankshaft to gain access to each bolt.
(b) Hold the crankshaft pulley nut with a wrench and
remove 6 bolts.
HINT: First remove dark green colored bolt and then
remove the others.
34. REMOVE 3 TRANSAXLE TO ENGINE BOLTS
AX1–27
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
35. REMOVE TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
Separate transaxle and engine, and lower the trans–
axle.
36. REMOVE TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH FROM
TRANSAXLE
TRANSAXLE INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH IN TRA–
NSAXLE
If the torque converter clutch has been drained and
washed, refill with new ATF.
Fluid Type:
ATF DEXRON
2. CHECK TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH INSTALLA–
TION
Using a scale and a straight edge, measure from the
installed surface to the front surface of the transaxle
housing.
Correct distance:
13.0 mm (0.51 in.) or more
3. ALIGN TRANSAXLE AT INSTALLATION POSITION
(a) Align the 2 knock pins on the block with the converter
housing.
(b) Temporarily install the bolt.
4. INSTALL TRANSAXLE TO ENGINE BOLT
Install the transaxle to engine bolts.
12 mm head bolt
Torque: 64 N–m (650 kgf–cm, 47 ft–lbf)
AX1–28
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
10 mm head bolt
Torque: 46 N–m (470 kgf–cm, 34 ft–lbf)
5. INSTALL TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH MOUNT–
ING BOLT
(a) Clean the threads of the bolts with the gasoline.
(b) Coat the threads of the bolts with sealer.
Sealer:
Part No.08833–00070, THREE BOND 1324 or equi–
valent.
(c) Tighten the bolts evenly.
Torque: 27 N–m (280 kgf–cm, 20 ft–Ibf)
HINT: First install dark green colored bolt and then the
5 bolts.
6. INSTALL REAR END PLATE
Install the rear end plate with the 4 bolts.
7. INSTALL STIFFENER PLATE
(a) Install the stiffener plate with the 3 bolts.
(b) Torque the 3 bolts.
Torque: 37 N–m (380 kgf–cm, 27 ft–lbf)
8. INSTALL FRONT FRAME ASSEMBLY
(a) Hold the front frame assembly with a jack.
(b) Install the front frame assembly with the 6 bolts and 4
nuts.
(c) Torque the bolts.
19 mm head bolt
Torque: 181 N–m (1,850 kgf–cm, 134 ft–lbf)
12 mm head bolt
Torque: 32 N–m (330 kgf–cm, 24 ft–lbf)
AX1–29
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
(d) Torque the nuts.
Nut
Torque: 36 N–m (370 kgf–cm. 27 ft–lbf)
(c) Install the 2 set screws in the right and left fender
liners.
9. INSTALL STEERING GEAR HOUSING
(a) Install the steering gear housing to the front frame
assembly.
(b) Install and torque the 2 bolts and nuts.
Torque: 181 N–m (1,850 kgf–cm, 134 ft–lbf)
(c) Connect the stabilizer bar bushing bracket with the 4
bolts.
Torque: 19 N–m (195 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
10. INSTALL 4 TRANSAXLE MOUNTING BOLTS
Torque: 52 N–m (530 kgf–cm, 38 ft–lbf)
AX1–30
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
11. INSTALL 3 REAR SIDE ENGINE MOUNTING NUTS
Torque: 66 N–m (670 kgf–cm, 48 ft–Ibf)
12. INSTALL FRONT SIDE ENGINE MOUNTING NUT
Torque: 80 N–m (820 kgf–cm, 59 ft–lbf)
13. INSTALL DRIVE SHAFT
(See page SA–40)
14. INSTALL RIGHT AND LEFT ENGINE SIDE COVER
N O.2
15. INSTALL ENGINE UNDER FRONT COVER NO.1 AND
NO.2
16. INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL FLUID DRAIN PLUG WITH
A NEW GASKET
17. FILL DIFFERENTIAL FLUID
Fluid Type:
ATF DEXRON ll
Capacity:
Differential 1.6 liters (1.7 US qts, 1.4 Imp. qts)
18. CHECK DIFFERENTIAL FLUID LEVEL
19. INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE
(a) Install and torque the 3 nuts.
Torque: 62 N–m (630 kgf–cm, 46 ft–lbf)
AX1–31
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
(b) Install the rear exhaust pipe with the 2 bolts and nuts.
Torque: 103 N–m (1,050 kgf–cm, 76 ft–lbf)
20. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL AND LOWER VEHICLE
Torque: 103 N–m (1,050 kgf–cm, 76 ft–lbf)
21. UNTIE STEERING GEAR HOUSING TO ENGINE SUP
– PORT FIXTURE BY CORD OR EQUIVALENT
22. REMOVE ENGINE SUPPORT FIXTURE
23. INSTALL 3 UPPER TRANSAXLE TO ENGINE BOLTS
Torque: 64 N–m (650 kgf–cm. 47 ft–lbf)
24. INSTALL 2 BOLTS AND CLAMP FROM TO FRAME
ASSEMBLY
25. INSTALL 2 FRONT SIDE ENGINE MOUNTING
BOLTS
Torque: 80 N–m l820 kgf–cm, 59 ft–lbfj
AX1–32
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
26. CONNECT SHIFT CONTROL CABLE
(a) Install the clip to the control cable.
(b) Install the nut.
(c) Adjust the control cable.
(See page AX1–55)
27. CONNECT OIL COOLER HOSE
28. CONNECT SOLENOID CONNECTOR
29. CONNECT PARK/ NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
CONNECTOR
30. INSTALL STARTER
(a) Install the starter with 2 bolts.
Torque: 39 N–m (400 kgf–cm, 29 ft–lbf)
(b) Connect the connector and nut.
AX1–33
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
31. CONNECT VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
32. INSTALL GROUND TERMINAL
w/ Cruise Control System:
33. CONNECT CONNECTOR TO CRUISE CONTROL
ACTUATOR
34. INSTALL CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR COVER
35. INSTALL THROTTLE CABLE TO ENGINE
(a) Torque the nuts.
Torque: 15 N–m (150 kgf–cm, 11 ft–lbf)
(b) Adjust the throttle cable.
(See page AX1–55)
36. INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
37. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE TO
BATTERY
AX1–34
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
38. FILL TRANSAXLE WITH ATF
Fluid type:
ATF DEXRON II
Capacity:
5.6 liters (5.9 US gts, 4.9 Imp.gts)
39. CHECK FLUID LEVEL (See page AX1–64)
40. INSPECT FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
(See page SA–40)
41. PERFORM ROAD TEST
Check for abnormal noise and smooth shifting.
TORQUE CONVERTER CLEANING
If the transaxle is contaminated, the torque converter
and transmission cooler should be thoroughly flushed
with ATF.
TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH AND
DRIVE PLATE INSPECTION
1. INSPECT ONE–WAY CLUTCH
(a) Install SST into the inner race of the one–way clutch.
SST 09350–33014 (09351–32010)
AX1–35
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
(b) Install SST so that it fits in the notch of the converter
hub and outer race of the one–way clutch.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32020)
(c) With the torque converter clutch standing on its side,
the clutch locks when turned counterclockwise, and
rotates freely and smoothly clockwise.
If necessary, clean the converter clutch and retest the
clutch.
Replace the converter clutch if the clutch still fails the
test.
2. MEASURE DRIVE PLATE RUNOUT AND INSPECT
RING GEAR
Set up a dial indicator and measure the drive plate
runout.
If runout exceeds 0.20 mm (0.0079 in.) or if the ring
gear is damaged, replace the drive plate. If installing a
new drive plate, note the orientation of spacers and
tighten the bolts.
Torque: 83 N–m (850 kgf–cm, 61 ft–lbf)
3. MEASURE TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SLEEVE
RUNOUT
(a) Temporarily mount the torque converter clutch to the
drive plate. Set up a dial indicator.
If runout exceeds 0.30 mm (0.0118 in.), try to correct
by reorienting the installation of the converter. If ex–
cessive runout cannot be corrected, replace the
torque converter clutch .
HINT: Mark the position of the converter clutch to
ensure correct installation.
(b) Remove the torque converter clutch.
AX1–36
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM
COMPONENT PARTS LOCATION
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM
AX1–37
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM
ELECTRIC CONTROL COMPONENTS
INSPECTION
1. INSPECT SHIFT LOCK CONTROL ECU
Using a voltmeter, measure the voltage at each termi–
nals.
HINT: Do not disconnect the ECU connector.
Connector
Terminal
Measuring condition
Voltage (V)
Ignition switch ACC position
Ignition switch ON position
Depress brake pedal
Ignition switch ACC position and P position
Ignition switch ACC position and except P position
(Approx–after 1 second)
Ignition switch ON position and P position
Depress brake pedal
(Approx–after 20 seconds)
Except P position
Ignition switch ON, P position and depress brake pedal
Shift except P position under conditions above
Ignition switch ACC position and P position
Shift except P position under condition above
2. INSPECT SHIFT LOCK SOLENOID
(a) Disconnect the solenoid connector.
(b) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
terminals.
Standard resistance:
21–27
(c) Apply the battery positive voltage between terminals.
Check that an operation noise can be heard from the
solenoid.
AX1–38
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM
3. INSPECT KEY INTERLOCK SOLENOID
(a) Disconnect the solenoid connector.
(b) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
terminals.
Standard resistance:
12.5–16.50
(c) Apply the battery positive voltage between terminals.
Check that an operation noise can be heard from the
solenoid.
4. INSPECT SHIFT LOCK CONTROL SWITCH
Inspect that there is continuity between each termi–
nal.
Terminal
Shift
Position
P position
(Release button is not pushed)
P position
(Release button is pushed)
R, N, D, 2, L Position
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE – TROUBLESHOOTING
TROUBLESHOOTING
AX1–40
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
For troubleshooting using a volt/ohm meter, see page AX1–4042.
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING USING VOLT
OHM METER
1. CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
Using the customer problem analysis check sheet for reference, ask the customer in as much
detail as possible about the problem.
2. CHECK AND CLEAR THE DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES (PRECHECK)
Before confirming the problem symptom, first check the diagnostic trouble code if there are any
trouble codes stored in memory. When there are trouble codes, make a note of them, then clear
them and proceed to “3. Problem Symptom Confirmation”.
3. PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
Confirm the problem symptoms.
4. SYMPTOM SIMULATION
If the problem does not reappear, be sure to simulate the problem by mainly checking the circuits
indicated by the diagnostic trouble code in step 2, using “Problem Simulation method”.
5. DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK
Check the diagnostic trouble codes. Check if there is abnormality in the sensors or the wire
harness.
If a trouble code is output, proceed to “6. Diagnostic Trouble Code Chart”.
If the normal code is output, proceed to “7. Matrix Chart of Problem Symptoms”.
Be sure to proceed to “6. Diagnostic Trouble Code Chart” after steps 2 and 3 are completed.
If troubleshooting is attempted only by following the trouble code stored in the memory is output,
errors could be made in the diagnosis.
6. DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a trouble code is confirmed in the diagnostic trouble code check, proceed to the inspection
procedure indicated by the matrix chart for each diagnostic trouble code.
7. PRELIMINARY CHECK
Carry out a preliminary check of the transaxle oil level, throttle cable adjustment, etc.
8. SHIFT POSITION SIGNAL CHECK
Carry out the shift position signal check when the transaxle gears do not up–shift, down–shift
or lock–up. This is to check the signal output condition from the ECM to each solenoid. If the
results are NG, then it is likely that the trouble is in the electrical system (particularly in the
sensors or the ECM).
Proceed to Part 1 (Electrical System) under “
11. Matrix Chart of Problem Symptoms”. If all the
circuits specified in Part 1 are OK, check the ECM and replace it.
9. MECHANICAL SYSTEM TEST
(Stall Test, Time Leg Test, Line Pressure Test)
If the malfunction is found in the stall test, time lag test or line pressure test, check the parts
indicated in the respective tests.
14. MANUAL SHIFTING TEST
If the results of the manual driving test are NG, it is likely that the trouble is in the mechanical
system or hydraulic system. Proceed to Part 2 (Mechanical System) under the Matrix Chart of
Problem Symptoms.
AX1–41
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
11. MATRIX CHART OF PROBLEM SYMPTOMS
If the normal code is confirmed in the diagnostic trouble code check, perform inspection
according to the inspection order in the matrix chart of problem symptoms. Perform diagnosis of
each circuit or part in the order shown in the Matrix Chart. The Matrix Chart contains 3 chapters,
Electronically Controlled Circuits in Chapter 1, On–vehicle Inspection in Chapter 2 and Off–
vehicle Inspection in Chapter 3. If all the circuits indicated in Chapter 1 are normal, proceed to
Chapter 2. If all the parts indicated in Chapter 2 are normal, proceed to Chapter 3. If all the circuits
and parts in Chapter 1–Chapter 3 are normal and the trouble still occurs, check and replace the
ECM.
12. CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Perform diagnosis of each circuit in accordance with the inspection order confirmed in steps 6
and 11. Judge whether the cause of the problem is in the sensor, actuators, wire harness and
connectors, or the ECM. In some cases, the Flow Chart instructs that a throttle signal check,
brake signal check or kick–down signal check (in test mode), be performed. These are diagnosis
functions used to check if signals are being input correctly to the ECM.
13. PART INSPECTION
Check the individual parts of the mechanical system and hydraulic system in the order of the
numbers indicated in the Matrix Chart.
14. REPAIRS
After the cause of the problem is located, perform repairs by following the inspection and
replacement procedures in this manual or’94 Al 40E AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE Repair Manual.
15. CONFIRMATION TEST
After completing repairs, confirm not only that the malfunction is eliminated, but also conduct a
test drive, etc., to make sure the entire electronically controlled transaxle system is operating
correctly.
AX1–42
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Items inside
are titles of pages, in this man–
ual, with the page number indicated in the bot–
tom portion. See the indicated pages for detailed
Customer Problem Analysis
explanations.
P. AX1–43
Step 2, 5, 12, 15: Diagnostic steps permitting
the use of the TOYOTA
Check and Clear Diagnostic Trouble. Codes (Precheck)
hand–held tester or TOYOTA
Precheck) brake–out–box.
P. AX1–44–AX1–46
Vehicle Brought to Workshop
1.
Symptom
does not occur
4.
Problem Symptom Confirmation
Symptom Simulation
P. IN–24
P. AX1–48
Symptom
occurs
OK Code
Preliminary Check
Diagnostic Trouble
Code Check
P.AX–44 AX1–45
NG
P. AX1–54
Shift Position Signal Check
Diagnostic Trouble Code Chart
P. AX1–47
P. AX1–64–
OK
Mechanical System Tests
P. AX1–57
OK
10.
Manual Shifting Test
P. AX1–63
Matrix Chart of Problem Symptoms–
P. AX1–67
Chapter 1
(Electronic)
P. AX1–68
12.
Circuit
Inspection
Chapter 2
(On–Vehicle)
P. AX1–70
Chapter 3
(OFF–Vehicle)
P. AX1–72
13.
• Main Throttle Signal Check
• Stop Light Signal Check
Parts Inspection
P.AX1–80 AX1–112
15.
Identification of Problem
Repair
Confirmation Test
END
AX1–43
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
AX1–44
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
The Electronically Controlled Transaxle has built–in
self–diagnostic functions. If the malfunction occurs
in the system, the ECM stores the diagnostic trouble
code in memory and the O/D OFF (Overdrive OFF)
indicator light blinks to inform the driver. The diagnos–
tic trouble code stored in memory can be read out by
the following procedure.
O/D OFF INDICATOR LIGHT INSPECTION
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON.
2. Check if the O/D OFF indicator light lights up when
the O/D main switch is pushed out to OFF and goes
off when the O/D main switch is pushed in to ON.
HINT:
•
If the O/D OFF indicator light does not light up or
stay on all the time, carry out the check for ’O/D
OFF Indicator Light Circuit” on page AX–102.
•
If the O/D OFF indicator light blinks, a trouble code
is stored in the ECM memory.
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK
1. Turn the ignition switch ON, but do not start the
engine.
2. Push in the O/D main switch to ON.
HINT: Warning and diagnostic trouble codes can be
read only when the O/D main switch is ON. If it is
OFF, the 0/D OFF indicator light up will light continu–
ously and will not blink.
3. Using SST, connect terminals TE1 and El of the
DLC1 or DLC2.
SST 09843–18020
AX1–45
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
4: Read the diagnostic trouble code indicated by the
number of times the O/D OFF indicator light blinks.
HINT: If the system is operating normally, the light will
blink 2 times per second.
Diagnostic trouble code “42” is shown as an example.
HINT: When 2 or more trouble codes are stored in
memory, the lower–numbered code is displayed first.
If no diagnostic trouble code is output, or if a diagnos–
tic trouble code is output even though no diagnostic
trouble code output operation is performed, check the
TE1 terminal circuit on page AX1–110.
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK BY
USING TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER
1. Hook up the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC2.
2. Read the diagnostic trouble codes by following the
prompts on the tester screen.
Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester
operator’s manual for further details.
CANCELLING DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE
CODE
After repair of the trouble area, the diagnostic trouble
code retained in the ECM memory must be cancelled
out by removing the EM fuse for 10 seconds or more,
with the ignition switch off.
Check that the normal code is output after connecting
the fuse.
AX1–46
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
ECM TERMINALS STANDARD VALUE
ECM TERMINAL VALUES
MEASUREMENT BY USING TOYOTA BREAK–OUT–BOX
AND TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER
1. Hook up the TOYOTA break–out–box and TOYOTA
hand–held tester to the vehicle.
2. Read the ECM input/output values by following the
prompts on the tester screen.
HINT: TOYOTA hand–held tester has a “Snapshot”
function. This records the measured values and is
effective in the diagnosis of intermittent problems.
Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester /
TOYOTA break–out–box operator’s manual for fur–
ther details.
AX1–47
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
CHECK TERMINAL TT OUTPUT VOLTAGE
When a voltmeter is connected to the DLC2, the
following items can be checked:
1. Throttle position sensor signal
2. Brake signal
3. Shift position signal
1. VOLTMETER CONNECTION
Connect the positive (+) probe of the voltmeter to
terminal Tt and the negative (–) probe to terminal E1
of the DLC2.
HINT: If a voltmeter with small internal resistance is
used, the correct voltage will not be indicated, so use
a voltmeter with an internal resistance of at least 10 k
.
2. TURN IGNITION SWITCH TO ON (DO NOT START
THE ENGINE)
3. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR SIGNAL
Check if the voltage changes from approximately 0 V
to approximately 8 V when the accelerator pedal is
gradually depressed from the fully closed position.
4. CHECK BRAKE SIGNAL (LOCK–UP CUT SIGNAL)
(a) Open the throttle valve fully to apply approximately 8
V to terminal Tt.
(b) In this condition, check terminal Tr voltage when the
brake pedal is depressed and released.
Tt terminal voltage:
0 V (When brake pedal is depressed)
8 V (When brake pedal is released)
5: START ENGINE
6. CHECK SHIFT POSITION SIGNAL
(VEHICLE SPEED ABOVE 10 KM/H OR 6 MPH)
Check up–shifting together with terminal TT voltage.
HINT: Check for light shocks from up–shifting and
for changes in the tachometer.
Gear Position
Terminal TT output voltage
1 st Gear
Below 0.5 V
2nd Gear
1.5–2.6 V
2nd Lock–up
2.5–3.6 V
3rd Gear
3.5–4.6 V
3rd Lock–up
4.5–5.6 V
O/D
5.5–6.6 V
0/D Lock–up
6.5–7.6 V
If terminal TT output voltage check cannot be perfo–
rmed, check TT terminal circuit on page AX1–112.
AX1–48
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
Taking into consideration the results of the customer problem analysis, try to reproduce the
symptoms of the trouble. If the problem is that the transaxle does not up–shift, does not down
–shift, or the shift point is too high or too low, conduct the following road test to confirm the
automatic shift schedule and simulate the problem symptoms.
ROAD TEST
NOTICE: Perform the test at normal ATF operating tem–
perature 50–80 C (122–176 F).
1. D POSITION TEST
Shift into the D position and keep the accelerator
pedal constant at the full throttle valve opening posi–
tion, and check the following points:
(a) Check up–shift operation.
Check that 1–2, 2–3 and 3–O/D up–shift takes
place, at the shift point shown in the automatic shift
schedule. (See page AX1–52)
HINT:
(1) 0/D Gear Up–shift Prohibition Control.
•
Coolant temp. is 50C (122F) or less
•
If there is a 10 km/h (6 mph) difference between
the set cruise control speed and vehicle speed.
•
0/D main switch is pushed ON
(During the O/D OFF indicator light lights up.)
(2) 0/D Gear Lock–up Prohibition Control.
•
Brake pedal is depressed.
•
Coolant temp. is 50 C (122 F) or less.
(b) Check for shift shock and slip.
Check for shock and slip at the 1–2, 2–3 and 3–0/
D up–shifts.
AX1–50
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
(c) Check for abnormal noise and vibration.
Run at the D position lock–up or O/D gear and check
for abnormal noise and vibration.
HINT: The check for the cause of abnormal noise and
vibration must be performed very thoroughly as it
could also be due to loss of balance in the torque
converter clutch, etc.
(d) Check kick–down operation.
While running in the D position, 2nd, 3rd and O/D
gears, check to see that the possible kick–down
vehicle speed limits for 2 1, 3 2 and O/D 3
kick–downs conform to those indicated on the auto–
matic shift schedule. (See page AX1–52)
(e) Check abnormal shock and slip at kick–down.
(f) Check the lock–up mechanism.
(1) Drive in D position, O/D gear, at a steady speed
(lock–up ON) of about 75 km/h (47 mph).
(2) Lightly depress the accelerator pedal and check
that the RPM does not change abruptly.
If there is a big jump in RPM, there is no lock–up.
2. 2 POSITION TEST
Shift into the 2 position and, while driving with the
accelerator pedal held constantly at the full throttle
valve opening position and check on the following
points:
(a) Check up–shift operation
Check to see that the 1 2 up–shift takes place and
that the shift point conforms to the automatic shift
schedule. (See page AX1–52)
HINT: There is no O/D up–shift and lock–up in the 2
position.
AX1–51
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
(b) Check engine braking.
While running in the 2 position and 2nd gear, release
the accelerator pedal and check the engine braking
effect.
(c) Check for abnormal noises during acceleration and
deceleration, and for shock at up–shift and down–
shift.
3. L POSITION TEST
Shift into the L position and while driving with the
accelerator pedal held constantly at the full throttle
valve opening position, and check the following
points:
(a) Check no up–shift.
While running in the L position, check that there is no
up–shift to 2nd gear.
(b) Check engine braking.
While running in the L position, release the accelera–
tor pedal and check the engine braking effect.
(c) Check for abnormal noises during acceleration and
deceleration.
AX1–52
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
4. R POSITION TEST
Shift into the R position and while starting at full
throttle, check for slipping.
CAUTION: Before conducting this rest ensure that the
test area is free from personnel and obstructions.
5. P POSITION TEST
Stop the vehicle on a gradient (more than 5 ) and
after shifting into the P position, release the parking
brake.
Then check to see that the parking lock pawl holds the
vehicle in place.
AX1–52
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
AUTOMATIC SHIFT SCHEDULE
SHIFT POINT
NORM Mode
Shift position
Shifting point
Vehicle speed km/h (mph)
Shifting point
Vehicle speed km/h (mph)
D position
2 position
L position
PWR Mode
Shift position
D position
2 position
L position
AX1–53
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
LOCK–UP POINT
NORM Mode
D position
Throttle valve opening 596
Lock–up ON
km/h (mph)
Lock–up OFF
km/h (mph)
Lock–up ON
km/h (mph)
Lock–up OFF
km/h (mph)
3rd Gear
O/D Gear
PWR Mode
D position
Throttle valve opening 596
3rd Gear
O/D Gear
*O/D main switch OFF
HINT:
(1) In the 2 and L positions, all stages lock–up is OFF.
(2) In the following cases, the lock–up will be released regardless of the lock–up pattern.
• When the throttle valve is completely closed.
• When the brake light switch is ON.
AX1–54
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
PRELIMINARY CHECK
1. CHECK FLUID LEVEL
HINT:
• Drive the vehicle so that the engine and transaxle
are at normal operating temperature.
Fluid temp.: 70–80 C (158–176 F)
• Only use the COOL range on the dipstick as a
rough reference when the fluid is replaced or the
engine does not run.
(a) Park the vehicle on a level surface and set the parking
brake.
(b) With the engine idling and the brake pedal depressed,
shift the shift lever into all positions from P to L
position and return to P position.
(c) Pull out the oil level gauge and wipe it clean.
(d) Push it back fully into the tube.
(e) Pull it out and check that–the fluid level is in the HOT
range.
If the level is at the low side, add fluid.
Fluid type:
ATF DEXRON II
NOTICE: Do not overfill.
2. CHECK FLUID CONDITION
If the fluid smells burnt or is black, replace it.
3. REPLACE TRANSAXLE FLUID
(a) Using SST, remove the drain plug and drain the fluid.
SST 09043–38100
(b) Reinstall the drain plug securely.
(c) With the engine OFF, add new fluid through the oil
filler tube.
Fluid type:
ATF DEXRON^II
Capacity:
Total: 5.6 liters (5.9 US qts, 4.9 Imp. qts)
Drain and refill: 2.5 liters (2.6 US qts. 2.2 Imp. qts)
(d) Start the engine and shift the shift lever into all posi–
tions from P to L position and then shift into P posi–
tion.
(e) With the engine idling, check the fluid level. Add fluid
up to the COOL level on the dipstick.
(f) Check the fluid level at the normal operating tempera–
ture 70–80 C (158–176 F) and add as neces–
sary.
NOTICE: Do not overfill.
4. CHECK FLUID LEAKS
Check for leaks in the transaxle.
If there are leaks, it is necessary to repair or replace O
–rings, seal packings, oil seals, plugs or other parts.
AX1–55
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
5. INSPECT AND ADJUST THROTTLE CABLE
(a) Check that the throttle valve is fully closed.
(b) Check that the inner cable is not slack.
(c) Measure the distance between the outer cable end
and stopper on the cable.
Standard distance:
0–1 mm (0–0.04 in.)
If the distance is not standard, adjust the cable by the
adjusting nuts.
6. INSPECT AND ADJUST SHIFT CABLE
When shifting the shift lever from the N position to
other positions, check that the lever can be shifted
smoothly and accurately to each position and that the
position indicator correctly indicates the position.
If the indicator is not aligned with the correct position,
carry out the following adjustment procedures:
(a) Loosen the swivel nut on the manual shaft lever.
(b) Push the manual shaft lever fully toward the right side
of the vehicle.
(c) Return the control shaft lever 2 notches to U position.
(d) Set the shift lever to N position.
(e) While holding the shift lever lightly toward the R
position side, tighten the shift lever nut.
AX1–56
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
7. INSPECT AND ADJUST PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION
SWITCH
Check that the engine can be started with the shift
lever only in the N or P position, but not in other
positions.
If not as started above, carry out the following adjust–
ment procedure:
(a) Loosen the park/neutral position switch bolt and set
the shift lever to the N position.
(b) Align the groove and neutral basic line.
(c) Hold in position and tighten the bolt.
Torque: 5.4 N–m (55 kgf–cm, 48 in.¿lbf)
8. INSPECT IDLE SPEED (N POSITION)
Idle speed:
750 rpm
(In N position and air conditioner OFF)
AX1–57
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
MECHANICAL SYSTEM TESTS
STALL TEST
The object of this test is to check the overall performance of the transaxle and engine by
measuring the stall speeds in the D and R positions.
NOTICE:
•
Perform the test at normal operating fluid temperature 50–80 C (122–176 F).
•
Do not continuously run this test longer than 5 seconds.
•
To ensure safety, conduct this test in a wide, clear, level area which provides good traction.
•
The stall test should always be carried out in pairs. One technician should observe the conditions
of the wheels or wheel stoppers outside the vehicle while the other is performing the test.
MEASURE STALL SPEED
(a) Chock the 4 wheels.
(b) Connect a tachometer to the engine.
(c) Fully apply the parking brake.
(d) Keep your left foot pressed firmly on the brake pedal.
(e) Start the engine.
(f) Shift into the D position. Fully depress the accelerator pedal with your right foot.
Quickly read the stall speed.
Stall speed:
2,450 ±150 rpm
(g) Perform the same test in R position.
Quickly read the stall speed.
Stall speed:
2,450 ±150 rpm
AX1–58
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
EVALUATION
Possible cause
Problem
• Engine output may be insufficient.
• Stator one–way clutch is operating properly
(a) Stall speed low in D and R positions.
(b) Stall speed high in D position.
(c) Stall speed high in R position.
(d) Stall speed high in D and R position.
HINT:
If more than 600 rpm below the specified value, the
torque converter clutch could be faulty.
•
•
•
•
Line pressure too low
Forward clutch slipping
No.2 one–way clutch not operating properly
4/D one–way clutch not operating properly
•
•
•
•
Line pressure too low
Direct clutch slipping
First and reverse brake slipping
O/D clutch slipping
• Line pressure too low
• Improper fluid level
• 0/D one–way clutch not operating properly
AX1–59
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
TIME LAG TEST
When the shift lever is shifted while the engine is idling, there will be a certain time lapse or lag
before the shock can be felt. This is used for checking the condition of the 4/D direct clutch,
forward clutch, direct clutch, and first and reverse brake.
NOTICE:
• Perform the test at normal operating fluid temperature 50–80 C (122–176 F).
• Be sure to allow a one minute Interval between tests.
• Make 3 measurements and take the average value.
• MEASURE TIME LAG
(a) Fully apply the parking brake
(b) Start the engine and check idle speed.
Idle speed:
750 rpm (in N position and air conditioner OFF)
(c) Shift the shift lever from N to D position. Using a stop watch, measure the time it takes from
shifting the lever until the shock is felt.
In same manner, measure the time lag for N–R.
Time lag:
ND Less than 1.2 seconds
NR Less than 1 .5 seconds
AX1–60
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
EVALUATION
If ND or NR time lag are longer than specified:
Possible cause
Problem
ND time lag is longer
• Line pressure too low
• Forward clutch worn
• O/D one–way clutch not operating properly
NR time lag is longer
•
•
•
•
Line pressure too low
Direct clutch worn
First and reverse brake worn
O/D clutch worn
AX1–61
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
HYDRAULIC TEST
MEASURE LINE PRESSURE
NOTICE:
•
Perform the test at normal operating fluid temperature 50–80 C (122–176 F).
•
The line, pressure test should always be carried out in pairs. One technician should observe the
conditions of the wheels or wheel stoppers outside the vehicle while the other is performing the
test.
(a) Warm up the transaxle fluid.
(b) Remove the test plug on the transaxle case left side and connect the oil pressure gauge SST.
SST 09992–00094
(c) Fully apply the parking brake and chock the 4 wheels.
(d) Start the engine and check idling RPM.
(e) Keep your left foot pressed firmly on the brake pedal and shift into D position.
(f)’ Measure the line pressure when the engine is idling.
(g) Fully depress the accelerator pedal. Quickly read the highest line pressure when engine speed
reaches stall speed.
(h) In the same manner, perform the test in R position.
SPECIFIED LINE PRESSURE
Line pressure
Idling
Stall
D position
kPa (kgf/emt, psi)
R position
kPa (kgf/cmt, psi)
362–422 (3.7–4.3, 53–61)
618–794 (6.3–8.1,90–115)
750–897 (7.7–9.2,109–130)
1,373–1,608 (14.0–16.4,199–233)
If the measured pressures are not up to specified values, recheck the throttle cable adjustment
and retest.
AX1–62
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
EVALUATION
Possible cause
Problem
If the measured values at all positions are higher.
If the measured values at all positions are lower.
If pressure is low in the D position only.
If pressure is low in the R position only.
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Throttle cable out of adjustment
Throttle valve defective
Regulator valve defective
Throttle cable out of adjustment
Throttle valve defective
Regulator valve defective
Oil pump defective
O/D direct clutch defective
D position circuit fluid leakage
Forward clutch defective
R position circuit fluid leakage
Direct clutch defective
First and reverse brake defective
AX1–63
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
MANUAL SHIFTING TEST
HINT: With this test, it can be determined whether the
trouble is within the electrical circuit or is a mechani–
cal problem in the transaxle.
1. DISCONNECT SOLENOID WIRE
2. INSPECT MANUAL DRIVING OPERATION
Check that the shift and gear positions correspond
with the table below.
Shift Position
Gear Position
D Position
O/D
2 Position
3rd
L Position
R Position
Reverse
P Position
Pawl Lock
HINT: If the L, 2 and D position gear positions are
difficult to distinguish, perform the following road
test.
• While driving, shift through the L, 2 and D positions.
Check that the gear change corresponds to the shift
position.
If any abnormality is found in the above test, the
problem is in the transaxfe itself.
3. CONNECT SOLENOID WIRE
4. CANCEL OUT DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE
(See page AX1–45)
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
-Memo
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
-Memo
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
AX1–66
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
STANDARD VALUE OF ECM TERMINAL
ECM Terminals
Symbols
Condition
Wiring Color
Standard Value
IG OFF
IG ON
Vehicle driving in 2nd gear position
IG OFF
•
G ON
Vehicle driving in 2nd gear position
IG OFF
IG ON
Vehicle driving under lock–up position
IG ON
IG ON
IG ON
•
G ON
lG ON
Pattern select SW: PWR
Pattern select SW: NORM
Brake pedal is depressed
Brake pedal is released
Engine Coolant temp. 80C (1 76T)
Accel. pedal is released
Accel. pedal is depressed
Accel. pedal is released
Accel. pedal is depressed
tG ON
IG ON
OD main SW: ON
OD main SW: OFF
IG ON
Disconnect following
connectors:
• Cruise control ECU
P or N position
IG ON
P and N position
IG ON
2 position
Except 2 position
lG ON
L position
Except L position
Standing still
Turn one front
wheel slowly.
AX1–67
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
MATRIX CHART OF PROBLEM SYMPTOMS
If a normal code is displayed during the diagnostic trouble code check but the trouble still occurs,
check the circuits for each symptom in the order given in the charts on the following pages and
proceed to the page given for troubleshooting.
The Matrix Chart is divided into 3 chapters.
Chapter 1: Electronic Circuit Matrix Chart
Chapter 2: On–vehicle Repair Matrix Chart
Chapter 3: Off–vehicle Repair Matrix Chart
When troubleshooting, check Chapter 1 first. If instructions are given in Chapter 1 to proceed to
Chapter 2 or 3, proceed as instructed.
1. If the instruction “Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on matrix chart” is given in the
flow chart for each circuit, proceed to the circuit with the next highest number in the table to
continue the check.
2. If the trouble still occurs even though there are no abnormalities in any of the other circuits,
then check or replace the ECM.
AX1–68
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Vehicle does not move in any forward position and reverse position
Vehicle does not move in a particular position or positions
1 st ± 2nd
No up–shift
2nd¿¿ 3rd
3rd O/D
0 / D3rd
No down–shift
3rd 2nd
2nd 1 st
No lock–up
No lock–up off
Shift point too high or *too low
Up–shifts to 2nd while in L position
Up–shifts to 3rd while in L position
Up–shifts to O/D from 3rd while O/D switch is OFF
Up–shifts to O/D from 3rd while engine is cold
ND
Harsh engagement
Lock–up
Any driving position
Forward and reverse
Slip or Shudder
Particular position
No engine braking
Poor acceleration
No–kick–down
No pattern select
Large shift shock or engine stalls when starting off or stopping.
EG–396
AX1–92
AX1–96
IDL switch circuit
Park/neutral position
switch circuit
Stop light circuit
AX1–88
Shift solenoid valve
SL circuit
Symptom
AX1–90
AX1–84
Shift solenoid valve
No.1, No.2 circuit
Suspect Area
Throttle position
sensor circuit
AX1–80
See page
Vehicle speed
sensor circuit
Chapter 1. Electronic Circuit
AX1–70
AX1–72
OFF–Vehicle repair
matrix chart
EG–318
EG–356
On–Vehicle repair
matrix chart
ECM
Engine coolant
temperature
sensor circuit
AX1–108
AX1–102
O/D switch and
O/D OFF indicator
switch circuit
O/D cancel signal
circuit
AX1–98
Pattern select switch
circuit
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
AX1–69
AX1–70
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Vehicle does not move in R position
Vehicle does not move in any forward position or reverse position
No lock–up
No lock–up OFF
No kick–down
No engine braking
2nd
1st 2nd
No up–shift
3rd 2nd
3rd O/D
O/D 3rd
No down–shift
3rd2nd
2nd1st
NR
ND
NL
1 st2nd (D position
1 st2nd (2 position)
Harsh engagement
1 st2nd3rd
1st2nd3rdO/D
2nd3rd
3rdO/D
O/D3rd
3rd2nd
Sliper shudder in forward and reverse (Directry after E/G start)
C2
accumulator
B2 accumulator.
C, accumulator
3–4 shift valve
2–3 shift valve
1–2 shift valve
Symptom
Oil strainer
Suspect Area
Manual valve
See page
AX1–13
Chapter 2. On–Vehicle Repair
(*:’94 A140E AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE Repair Manual)
OFF–vehicle repair
matrix chart
AX1–72
–
Primary
regulator valve
Cut back valve
Throttle valve
Lock–up relay valve
Throttle modulator
valve
2nd
modulator valve
Low
modulator valve
Accumulator
control valve
Co accumulator
Bo accumulator
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
TROUBLESHOOTING
AX1–71
AX1–72
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Vehicle does not move in any forward position
Vehicle does not move in reverse position
Vehicle does not move in any forward position and reverse position
No lock–up
No lock–up OFF
Large shock during lock–up
E/G stalls when starting off and stopping
1 st2nd
No up–shift
2nd3rd
3rd ± O/D
No down shift 2nd1 st
NR
N D
Harsh engagement
1 st 2nd (D position)
2nd3rd
3rd O/D
Forward and reverse (After warm–up)
Forward and reverse (Directly after E/G start)
R position
1 St
Slip or shudder
2nd
2nd 3rd (Up–shift
3rd
O/D
1 st 3rd
No engine braking
2nd
All positions
O/D
Other than O/D
Poor acceleration
Other than 2nd
1st and 2nd
1st and R position
R position
Bo O/D brake
C, Direct clutch
C, Forward clutch
Co O/D direct
clutch
Symptom
Parking lock pawl
Suspect Area
Torque converter
clutch
See page
AX1–34
Chapter 3. Off–Vehicle Repair
(*:’94 A140E AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE Repair Manual)
Rear planetary
gear
Front planetary gear
O/D planetary gear
F2 No.2
one–way clutch
F, No.1 one–way
clutch
FO O/D one–way
clutch
B2 Second
brake
B31 st and
reverse brake
B, 2nd coast
brake
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
AX1–73
AX1–74
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
LOCATION OF CONNECTORS
Location of Connectors in Engine Compartment
TROUBLESHOOTING
AX1–75
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Location of Connectors in Body
Sedan
Coupe
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
AX1–76
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Wagon
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
AX1–77
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Location of Connectors in Instrument Panel
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
AX1–78
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
AX1–79
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
J/B No–1
J/B No.3
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
AX1–80
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Diag. Trouble Code 42 No.1 Vehicle Speed Sensor Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The No. 1 vehicle speed sensor outputs a 4–pulse signal for every revolution of the differential case.
After this signal has been converted into a more precise rectangular waveform by the waveform
shaping circuit inside the combination meter, it is then transmitted to the ECM.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detection Condition
If the vehicle speed sensor signal is not input for 2
seconds or longer after condition A or B (described
below) occurs, DTC 42 is recorded and the OD OFF
indicator light lights up simultaneously.
CONDITION A
• 30 seconds or more elapses after the park/
neutral position switch goes OFF.
• The throttle opening ratio and engine RPM are
within the shadded area.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Vehicle speed sensor
Combination meter
Harness or connector between vehicle speed
sensor and ECM
ECM
CONDITION B
Throttle Opening Ratio
• 1 second or more elapses after the park/neutral
position switch goes OFF.
• A vehicle speed sensor signal of 14 km/h ($.7 mph)
or more was input.
• The stop light switch is OFF (brake pedal is
released). voi 547
• Waveform between terminals SPD and E1 when vehicle
speed is approx. 20 km/h (12 MPH).
HINT: The greater the vehicle speed, the greater the number
of vehicle speed sensor signals produced.
AX1–81
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Fail Safe Function
If the vehicle speed sensor fails, shift control takes place so that the throttle opening ratio and RPM
are controlled according to the shift control map.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
5 V Fixed
Measure voltage between terminal SPD of
combination meter connector and body ground.
0 V Fixed
Check speedometer circuit.
See combination meter troubleshooting
on B E section.
Changes
0VH5V
Replace ECM.
Measure voltage between terminals SPD and E1
of ECM connector.
Check and repair harness or connector between
combination meter and ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Replace–ECM.
AX1–82
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Measure voltage between terminal S P D of combination meter
connector and body ground.
(a) Shift the shift lever to N position.
(b) Jack up one of the front wheels.
(c) Disconnect the cruise control ECU and PPS
connectors.
(d) Turn IG switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminal SPD of com–
bination meter connector and body ground when
slowly turning the Jack up wheel.
Voltage:
Constantly 0 V...... Go to Next Step
Constantly 4–6 V...... Go to NG 1
Changes 0 V H 4 H 6 V ..... Go to N G 2
NG1
Check combination meter circuit.
See combination meter troubleshooting.
NG2
Replace ECM.
Measure voltage between terminals SPD and E, of ECM.
(1) Disconnect combination meter and cruise
control ECU connectors.
(2) Turn IG switch ON.
(3) Measure voltage between terminals SPD
and E, of ECM connector.
Voltage: 4–6 V
Replace ECM.
Check and repair harness or connector between com
bination meter and ECM.
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
-Memo
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
AX1–84
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Diag. Trouble Code 62 63 Shift Solenoid Valve No–1 and No.2 Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Shifting from 1 st to O/D is performed in combination with ON and OFF of the shift solenoid valves
No.1 and No.2 controlled by the ECM. If an open or short circuit occurs in either of the solenoid
valves, the ECM controls the remaining normal solenoid to allow the vehicle to be operated smoothly
(Fail safe function).
Fail Safe Function
If either of the solenoid valve circuits develops a short or an open, the ECM turns the other solenoid
ON and OFF to shift to the gear positions shown in the table below. The ECM also turns the lock–up
solenoid valve OFF at this time. If both solenoids malfunction, hydraulic control cannot be performed
electronically and must be done manually.
Manual shifting as shown in the following table must be done. (in the case of a short circuit, the ECM
stops sending current to the short circuited solenoid).
SOLENOID VALVE NO.1
MALFUNCTIONING
NORMAL
Position
Solenoid valve
No. 1
No. 2
Gear
Solenoid valve
No. 1
OFF
OFF
No. 1
Gear
No.2
BOTH SOLENOID VALVES
MALFUNCTIONING
Gear when shift selector
is manually operated
3rd
2nd
3rd
3rd
O/D
OFF
OFF
O/D
OFF
O/D
O/D
3rd
OFF
O/D
O/D
O/D
OFF
O/D
O/D
3rd
OFF
3rd
3rd
3rd
OFF
3rd
3 rd
3rd
2nd
OFF
Solenoid valve
No. 2
OFF
OFF
Gear
SOLENOID VALVE N0.2
MALFUNCTIONING
3rd
OFF
3rd
OFF
2nd
2nd
x : Malfunctions
Check the shift solenoid valve No.1 when diagnostic trouble code 62 is output and check the shift
solenoid valve No.2 when diagnostic trouble code 63 is output.
Code No.
62,63
Diag. Trouble Code Detection Condition
(a) Solenoid resistance is 8 or lower (short
circuit) when solenoid is energized.
(b) Solenoid resistance is 100 k or higher
(open circuit) when solenoid is not
energized.
The ECM checks for an open or short circuit in
the shift solenoid valve No–1 and No.2 circuit
when it changes gear position.
The ECM records diag. trouble code 62 or 63 if condi
tion (a) or (b) is detected once, but it does not blink the
O/D OFF indicator light.
After the ECM detects condition (a) or (b) con–
tinuously 8 times or more, it cancels the O/D OFF indi
cator light to blink until condition (a) or (b) disappears
After that, if the ECM detects condition (a) or
(b) once, it starts blinking the O/D OFF indi–
cator light again.
Trouble area
•
•
•
Shift solenoid valve No.1 or No.2
Harness or connector between shift solenoid
valve No.1 or No.2 and ECM connector
ECM
AX1–85
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Measure resistance between .terminals of
electronically controlled transaxle solenoid
connector and body ground.
Check shift solenoid valve No.1 or No.2 in
transaxle.
Repair or replace malfunctioned
part.
Check harness and connector between
electronically controlled transaxle solenoid
connector and ECM.
Repair or replace harness or con–
nector.
Replace ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
AX1–86
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECT ION PROCEDURE
Measure resistance between terminals of electronically controlled
transaxle solenoid connector and body ground.
Disconnect electronically controlled transaxle so–
lenoid connector.
Measure resistance between terminals of elec–
tronically controlled transaxle solenoid connector
and body ground as shown in the illustration.
Resistance:
1, 2–Body ground 11–15 0
Go to step
Check shift solenoid valve No.1 or No.2 in transaxle.
(1) Jack up the vehicle.
(2) Remove oil pan.
(1) Check shift solenoid valve No.1 and No.2
connector connection.
(2) Measure resistance between shift solenoid
valve No.1 and No.2 connector terminals
and body ground.
Resistance: 11–15
Check for operation sound of solenoids sound
when you apply battery voltage to shift solenoid
valve No.1 and No.2 connector terminals and
body ground.
Check continuity of solenoid wire.
Continuity (Below 1)
Repair or replace malfunctioned part.
Check harness and connector between electronically controlled
transaxle solenoid connector and ECM.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Replace ECM.
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
-Memo
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
AX1–88
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Diag. Trouble Code 64 Shift Solenoid Valve SL Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The shift solenoid valve SL is turned ON and OFF by signals from the ECM to control the hydraulic
pressure acting on the lock–up relay valve, which then controls operation of the lock–up clutch. If a
malfunction occurs in this circuit and diagnostic trouble code 64 is stored in memory, the O/D OFF
indicator light does not blink.
Fail Safe Function
If the ECM detects a malfunction, it turns the lock–up solenoid valve OFF.
Code No.
Diag. Trouble Code Detection Condition
(a) Solenoid resistance is 8 or lower (short
circuit) when solenoid energized.
(b) Solenoid resistance is 100 k or higher
(open circuit) when solenoid is not
energized.
ECM memorizes diag. trouble code 64 if above (a)
or (b) condition is detected once or more, but ECM
does not start O/D OFF indicator light blinking.
Trouble area
•
•
•
Shift solenoid valve SL
Harness or connector between shift solenoid
valve SL and ECM
ECM
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check shift solenoid valve SL.
Repair or replace malfunctioned
part.
Check harness and connector between
electronically controlled transaxle solenoid
connector and ECM.
Repair or replace harness or
connector.
Replace ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
AX1–89
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check shift solenoid valve SL.
(1) Check shift solenoid valve SL connector
connection.
(2) Measure resistance between shift solenoid
valve SL connector terminals and body
ground.
Resistance: 11–15
Check that shift solenoid valve SL makes opera–
tion sound when apply battery voltage shift so–
lenoid valve SL connector terminal and body
ground.
Check continuity of solenoid wire.
Continuity (Below 1)
Repair or replace malfunctioned part.
Check harness and connector between electronically controlled
transaxle solenoid connector–and ECM.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Replace ECM.
AX1–90
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Throttle Position Sensor Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION.
The throttle position sensor detects the throttle valve opening angle and sends signals to the ECM.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Throttle position signal check.
Proceed to next circuit inspection
shown on matrix chart (See page
AX1–68).
Check throttle position sensor.
Replace throttle position sensor.
Check harness and connector between ECM
and throttle position sensor (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or con–
nector.
Check and replace ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
AX1–91
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Throttle position signal check.
Turn ignition switch ON (Do not start the engine).
Check voltage at terminal TT of the DLC2 while
gradually depressing the accelerator pedal from the
fully closed position to the fully opened position.
Voltage changes from 0 V to 8 V by stages.
Do not depress the brake pedal during this test. The
voltage will stay at 0 V if it is depressed.
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart (See page AX1–68).
Check throttle position sensor.
See engine troubleshooting section on page EG–376.
Replace throttle position sensor.
Check harness and connector between ECM and throttle position
sensor (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECM.
AX1–92
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Park Neutral Position Switch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The park/neutral position switch detects the shift lever
position and sends signals to the ECM.
The ECM receives signals (NSW, 2 and L) from the
park/neutral position switch. When the signal is not
sent to the ECM from the park/neutral position switch,
the ECM judges that the shift lever is in the D position.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage between terminals NSW, 2, L
of ECM connector and body ground.
Proceed to next circuit inspection
shown on matrix chart (See page
AX1–68).
Check park/neutral position switch.
Replace park/neutral position
switch.
Check harness and connector between ECM
and park/neutral position switch, park/neutral
position switch and battery (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or con–
nector.
Check and replace ECM.
AX1–93
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
AX1–94
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminals NSW, 2, L of ECM
connector and body ground.
Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminals NSW, 2, L
of ECM connector and body ground when the
shift lever is put in the following positions.
Position
P, N
NSW–body
ground
Below 1 V
10–14 V*
2–body
ground
Below 1 V
L–body
ground
Below 1 V
Below 1 V
Below 1 V
10–14 V
Below 1 V
Below 1 V
10–14 V
10–14V
Below 1 V
10–14 V
Below 1 V
10–14 V
*: The voltage will drop slightly due to lighting up of
the back up light.
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart (See page AX1–68).
Check park/neutral position switch.
Remove park/neutral position switch.
Check continuity between each terminal shown be–
low when the shift lever is put in each position.
Continuity
Terminal
Shift
Position
Replace park/neutral position switch.
Check harness and connector between ECM and park/neutral position
switch, park/neutral position switch and battery (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECM.
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
-Memo
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
AX1–96
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Stop Light Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The purpose of this circuit is to prevent the engine from stalling when the brakes are suddenly applied
while driving in lock–up condition.
When the brake pedal is operated, this switch sends a signal to the ECM. Then the ECM cancels opera–
tion of the lock–up clutch while braking is in progress.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check operation of stop light.
Check and repair stop light circuit
(See page BE–62).
Check stop light signal.
Proceed to next circuit inspection
shown on matrix chart (See page
AX1–50).
Check harness and connector between ECM
and stop light switch (See page IN–31) .
Repair or replace harness of con–
nector.
Check and replace ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
AX1–97
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check operation of stop light.
Check if the stop light goes on and off normally when the brake pedal is depressed and
released .
Check and repair stop light circuit (See
page BE–50)
Check stop light signal.
(1) Connect voltmeter to terminals TT and E l of
the DLC2.
(2) Turn ignition switch ON (Do not start the
engine).
(3) Fully depress the accelerator pedal until the
voltmeter indicates 8 v and hold it.
(4) Depress and release the brake pedal and check
the voltage.
Brake pedal
Voltage
Depressed
Released
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart (See page AX1–68).
Check harness and connector between ECM and stop light switch
(See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECM.
AX1–98
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Pattern Select Switch Circuit
The ECM has stored in its memory the gear shift patterns for D position, 2nd position and L position,
and also the lock–up pattern for D position. Two types of gear shifting pattern and lock–up pattern
are recorded for D position; for POWER use and NORMAL use. The ECM selects the D position gear
shift pattern and lock–up pattern in accordance with the signal from the pattern select switch.
Check shift pattern switch operation.
Proceed to next circuit inspection
shown on matrix chart (See page
AX1–68).
Check PWR indicator light.
Measure voltage between terminal 6 of
pattern select switch connector and body
ground.
Check and repair pattern select
switch power source circuit.
Check pattern select switch.
Replace pattern select switch.
Check connectors and harness between pat–
tern select switch, PWR indicator light and
ECM.
Replace ECM.
Repair or replace connector as harness.
AX1–99
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
AX1–100
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check shift pattern switch operation.
Check that the shift point changes when the pattern select switch is operated.
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart (See page AX1–68).
Check PWR indicator light.
Turn IG switch 4N.
Check that the PWR indicator light lights up when
you push the pattern select switch to PWR.
Go to step
Measure voltage between terminal 6 of pattern select switch and body
ground.
(1) Push pattern select switch to NORMAL.
(2) Turn IG switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminal 6 of pattern
select switch connector and body ground.
Voltage: 10–14 V
Check and repair pattern select switch
power source circuit.
AX1–101
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check pattern select switch.
Disconnect pattern select switch connector.
Measure resistance between terminals 3 and6 of
pattern select switch connector when the select
switch is set to PWR and NORMAL positions.
Pattern
PW R
NORM
Resistance
0 (continuity)
(open)
Replace pattern select switch.
Check connectors and harness between pattern select switch, PWR
indicator light and ECM (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Replace ECM.
AX1–102
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
O–D Main Switch & O–D OFF Indicator Light Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The O/D main switch contacts go off when the switch is pushed in and come on when it is pushed
out. In O/D main switch OFF position, the O/D OFF indicator lights up, and the ECM prohibits shifting
to overdrive. The ECM also causes the O/D OFF indicator light to blink when a malfunction is detected.
However, when the O/D main switch is OFF, the O/D indicator light does not blink, but stays on.
In this case, connecting the terminals in the DLC2 or DLC1 can display the malfunction code.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
See next page.
WIRING DIAGRAM
AX1–103
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check O/D OFF indicator light while engine
starting.
Check O/D main switch operation.
Proceed to next circuit inspection
shown on matrix chart (See page
AX1–68).
Measure voltage between terminal 1 of O/D
main switch and body ground.
Repair or replace harness or connec–
tor between combination meter and
O/D main switch.
Check O/D main switch.
Repair or replace harness or connec–
tor between O/D main switch and
body ground.
Remains OFF
Remains ON
Replace O/D main switch.
Check O/D OFF indicator light when O/D main
switch connector is disconnected.
Replace O/D main switch.
Check O/D OFF indicator light when ECM
(inc. OD2 terminal) is disconnected.
Replace ECM.
Check harness between combination meter,
O/D main switch and ECM.
Repair or replace harness.
Repair or replace combination meter.
Check indicator lights on combination meter
other than O/D OFF indicator light.
Check and repair power source cir–
cuit to combination meter.
Check O/D main switch operation.
Check and repair harness between
O/D main switch and combination
meter.
Check harnesses between connector between
combination meter and ECM.
Repair or replace harness or con–
nector.
Replace ECM.
AX1–104
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check 0 /D OFF indicator light when engine starting.
When starting the engine, check the operating con–
dition of the O/D OFF indicator light.
O/D OFF indicator lights immediately after the
engine is started.
Remains ON..... NG 1
Remains OFF.... NG2
If the O/D OFF indicator light keeps blinking, check
the diag. trouble code and repair the problem.
NG1
Go to step
NG2
Go to stop
Check O/D main switch operation.
(1) Turn ignition switch ON.
(2) Check–O/D OFF” light when O/D main switch
is pushed in to ON.
(3) Start the engine.
“O/D OFF” light goes off.
(3) Check “O/D OFF” light when O/D main switch
is pushed again, to OFF.
“O/D OFF” light lights up.
If the–O/D OFF” light blinks when the O/D main
switch is pushed in to ON, a malfunction is occur–
ing in the system.
Check the diagnostic trouble code.
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart (See page AX1–68).
AX1–105
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Measure voltage between terminal 1 of O/D main switch connector
and body ground.
(1) Disconnect O/D main switch connector.
(2) Turn IG switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminal 1 of O/D main
switch harness side connector and body ground.
Voltage: 10–14 V
Repair or replace harness or connector be–
tween combination meter and O/D main
switch.
Check continuity of O/D main switch.
Disconnect O/D main switch connector.
Check continuity between terminals 1 and 3 of
O/D main switch connector.
ON Position: No continuity (More than 10 k)
OFF Position: Continuity (Below 1)
Replace O/D main switch.
Repair or replace harness or connector between
O/D main switch and body ground.
AX1–106
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Check O/D OFF indicator light when you disconnect O/D main
switch connector.
Turn IG switch ON.
Check that the O/D OFF indicator light goes off
when you disconnect the O/D main switch con–
nector.
Replace O/D main switch.
Check 0 /D OFF indicator light when you disconnect ECM connector
(including OD2 terminal).
Turn IG switch ON.
Check that the O/D OFF indicator light goes off
when you disconnect the ECM connector (includ–
ing OD2 terminal).
Replace ECM.
Check harness between combination meter, O/D main switch and
ECM.
Repair or replace harness.
Repair or replace combination meter (See page
BE–65).
AX1–107
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Check indicator lights on combination meter other than O/D OFF
indicator light.
Turn IG switch ON.
Check the following indicator lights on combination
meter:
• Check Engine Light
• Low Oil Pressure Warning Light
• ABS Warning Light etc.
Above indicator lights light up.
Check and repair power source circuit to
combination meter, or combination meter.
Check O/D main switch operation.
(1) Turn ignition switch ON.
(2) Check–O/D OFF” light when O/D main switch
is pushed in to ON.
(3) Start the engine.
“O/D OFF” light goes off.
(3) Check “O/D OFF” light when O/D main switch is pushed
again, to OFF.
“O/D OFF” light lights up.
If the–O/D OFF” light blinks when the O/D main
switch is pushed in to ON, a malfunction is occur–
ing in the system.
Check the diagnostic trouble code.
Check and repair harness between O/D main
switch and combination meter.
Check harness and connector between combination meter and ECM.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Replace ECM.
AX1–108
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
O–D Cancel Signal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
While driving with cruise control activated, in order to minimize gear shifting and provide smooth cruising
uphill, overdrive may be prohibited temporarily in some conditions.
The cruise control ECU sends OD cut signals to the ECM as necessary and the ECM cancels overdrive
shifting until these signals are disconnected.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage between terminals OD 1 of
ECM connector and body ground.
Proceed to next circuit inspection
shown on matrix chart (See page
AX1–68).
Check voltage between terminal OD of cruise
control ECU harness side connector and body
ground.
Check and replace cruise control
ECU.
Check harness and connector between cruise
control ECU and ECM (See page IN–31).
Repair on replace harness or con–
nector.
Check and replace ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
AX1–109
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminal OD1 of ECM connector and body
ground.
Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminal 01 31 of ECM
connector and body ground.
Voltage: 10–14 V
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart (See page AX1–68).
Check voltage between terminal OD of cruise control ECU harness side con–
nector and body ground.
(1) Disconnect cruise control ECU connector.
(2) Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminal OD of cruise
control ECU harness side connector and body
ground.
Voltage: 10–14 V
Check and replace cruise control ECU.
Check harness or connector between cruise control ECU and ECM
(See page IN–31).
’OK
Check and replace ECM.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
AX1–110
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
TE1 Terminal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ECM displays diagnostic trouble codes using the O/D OFF indicator light when terminals TE1
and E1 of the DLC2 or DLC1 are connected.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage between terminals TE1 and E1
of DLC2 or DLC1.
Proceed to next circuit inspection
shown on matrix chart (See page
AX1–68).
Check harness and connector between ECM
and DLC2, DLC1 and body ground (See
page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or con–
nector.
Check and replace ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
AX1–111
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminals TE, and E, of DLCZ or DLC1.
Measure voltage between terminals TE, and E, of
DLC2 or D LC1.
Voltage: 4–6 V
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart (See page AX1–68).
Check harness and connector between ECM and DLC2, DLC1
and body ground (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECM.
AX1–112
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
TT Terminal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Checks of ECM input and output signals related to the throttle position sensor, brakes, shift position
and other circuits can be performed by measuring the voltages at terminal T, of DLC1.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check harness and connector between ECM
and DLC2, DLC1 and body. ground (See
page IN–31).
Check and replace ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Repair or replace harness or con–
nector.
AX1–113
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE DATA
Engine idling
D position
R position
AT stall
D position
R position
Line pressure (whell locked)
Engine stall revolution
Time lag
Engine idle speed (Cooling fan and A/C OFF)
N position
Throttle cable adjustment (Throttle valve fully opened)
Limit
Limit
Torque converter runout
Drive plate runout
SHIFT POINT
Shifting point
Shift position
D position
2 position
L position
LOCK–UP POINT
D position km/h (mph)
Throttle valve opening 596
’3rd Gear (O/D switch OFF)
O/D Gear
’O/D switch OFF
NORM
PW R
Vehicle speed km/h (mph)
AX1–114
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part tightened
Engine rear mounting bracket x Front suspention member
Engine rear mounting bracket x Front suspention member
LH transaxle mounting
Transaxle x Engine
12 mm bolt
Transaxle x Engine
10 mm bolt
Torque converter clutch x Drive plate
Valve body x Transaxle case
Oil strainer
Oil pan
Oil pan drain plug
Testing plug
Transaxle rear cover x Transaxle case
Park/neutral position switch x Transaxle case (bolt)
Park/neutral position switch (nut)
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
AX2–1
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
A541E AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
AX2–2
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
DESCRIPTION
DESCRIPTION
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The ’94 model years A541 E automatic transaxle is a revised version of the previous model year’s
A540E automatic transaxle. The following changes have been made to match the brand new 1 MZ
–FE engine:
• Adoption of an Electronically Controlled Transaxle with an intelligent control system. This
version has evolved from the previous electronically Controlled Transaxle system.
• The hydraulic pressure contrl system has been revised accordingly.
• The torque converter clutch and the gear train have been revised.
AX2–3
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
Type of Transaxle
Type of Engine
Torque Converter Clutch Stall Torque Ratio
Torque Converter Clutch Lock–up Mechanism
Gear Ratio
Transaxle
B, Band Width
1 st Gear
2nd Gear
3rd Gear
O/D Gear
Reverse Gear
Number of Discs and Plates
0/D Direct Clutch (Co)
Forward Clutch (C,)
. Direct Clutch (Ct)
2nd Brake (B:j
First and Reverse Brake (Bj
O/D Brake (Bo)
mm (in.)
ATF Type
Capacity liter (US qts, Imp.qts)
A/T
D/F
DESCRIPTION
AX2–4
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OPERATION
OPERATION
1. MECHANICAL OPERATION
p . . . . . Operating
Shift lever
position
Gear Position
Parking
Reverse
Neutral
1 st
2nd
3rd
O/D
1 st
2nd
*3rd
1 St
‘2nd
*Down–shift only – no up–shift
AX2–5
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OPERATION
2. FUNCTION OF COMPONENTS
COMPONENT
FUNCTION
Forward Clutch
Connects input shaft and front planetary ring gear
Direct Clutch
Connects input shaft and front & rear planetary sun gear
2nd Coast Brake
Prevents front & rear planetary sun gear from turning either clockwise or
counterclockwi
2nd Brake
Prevents outer race o I from turning either clockwise or counterclockwise, thus
preventing front & rear planetary sun gear from turning counterclockwise
1 st & Reverse Brake
Prevents rear planetary carrier from turning either clockwise or counterclockwise
No. 1 One–Way Clutch
When BZ is operating, prevents front & rear planetary sun gear from turning
counterclockwise .
No.2 One–Way Clutch
Prevents rear .planetary carrier from turning counterclockwise
O/D Direct Clutch
Connects overdrive sun gear and overdrive planetary carrier
O/D Brake
Prevents overdrive sun gear from turning either clockwise or counterclockwise
O/D One–Way
Clutch
Planetary Gears
When transaxle is– being driven by engine, connects overdrive sun gear and overdrive
carrier
These gears change the route through which driving force is transmitted in accor–
dance with the operation of each clutch and brake in order to increase or reduce the in–
put and output speed
AX2–6
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OPERATION
Power from the engine transmitted to the input shaft via the torque converter clutch is then
transmitted to the planetary gears by the operation of the clutch.
By operation of the brake and one–way clutch, either the planetary carrier or the planetary sun
gear are immobilized, altering the speed of revolution of the planetary gear unit.
Shift change is carried out by altering the combination of clutch and brake operation.
Each clutch and brake operates by hydraulic pressure; gear position is decided according to the
throttle opening angle and vehicle speed, and shift change automatically occurs.
The conditions of operation for each gear position are shown on the following illustrations:
D or 2 Position 1 st Gear
2 Position 2nd Gear
D Position 2nd Gear
L Position 1 st Gear
D Position 3rd Gear
R Position Reverse Gear
D Position O/D Gear
AX2–7
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OPERATION
3. HYDRAULIC CONTROL SYSTEM
The hydraulic control system is composed of the oil pump, the valve body, the solenoid valves,
the accumulators, the clutches and brakes as well as the fluid passagas which connect all of
these components.
Based on the hydraulic pressure created by the oil pump, the hydraulic control system governs
the hydraulic pressure acting on the torque converter clutch, clutches and brakes in accordance
with the vehicle driving conditions.
There are three solenoid valves on the valve body.
The No. 1 and No.2 solenoid vales are turned on and off by signals from the ECM to operate the
shift valves and change the gear shift position.
The SL solenoid valve is operated by signals from the ECM to engage or disengage the lock –up
clutch of the torque converter clutch.
The SLN solenoid valve is operated by signals from the ECM to control the engagement speed
and reduce gear shift shock.
AX2–8
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OPERATION
4. ELECTRONIC CONTROL SYSTEM
GENERAL
The electronic control system for the A541 E automatic transaxte provides extremely precise
control of the gear shift timing and lock–up timing in response to driving conditions as sensed
by various sensors located throughout the vehicle and in response to the engine’s running
condition. At the same time, the ECM control reduces vehicle squat when the vehicle starts out
and gear shift shock. The electronic control system is also equipped with a self diagnosis system
which diagnoses malfunctions of electronically controlled components and warns the driver, and
a fail–safe system which makes it possible for the vehicle to continue functioning when a
malfunction occurs.
CONSTRUCTION
The electronic control system can be broadly divided into three groups; the sensors, ECM, and
actuators.
SENSORS
ECM
S
Crankshaft Position Sensor
• Engine Speed Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor
• Idling Signal
• Throttle Position Signal
ACTUATORS
SZ
IDL,VTA
SL
Shift Solenoid Valve No. 1
Shift Solenoid Valve No.2
Shift Solenoid Valve SL
SLN
Shift Solenoid Valve SLN
Engine Coolant Temp. Sensor
Engine Torque Control (ESA)
Park/Neutral Position Switch
• Neutral Start Signal
• Shift Lever Position Signal
NSW, R
2., L
No. 1 Vehicle Speed Sensor
Combination Meter
Direct Clutch Speed Sensor
Ignition Coils
SP 1
Stop Light Switch
Cruise Control ECU
Spark Plugs
NC
O/D OFF indicator Light
Pattern Select Switch
O/D Main Switch
Igniter
OOD2
STP
OD 1
Data Link Connector 3
(For OBD2)
AX2–9
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ARRANGEMENT OF COMPONENTS
–
OPERATION
AX2–10
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
No.
Components
Park/Neutral Position Switch
–
OPERATION
functions
Detects the shift lever position.
Direct Clutch Speed Sensor
Detects the input shaft speed from 1 st gear to 3rd gear.
Shift Solenoid Valve SL
Controls the hydraulic pressure applied to the lock–up
clutch and controls lock–up timing.
Shift Solenoid Valve SLN
Controls the hydraulic pressure applied to the back cham–
ber of the accumulator and smooths the engagement of
clutches and brakes during shifting .
Shift Solenoid Valve No. 1 and No.2
Controls the hydraulic pressure applied to each shift
valve, and control the gear shift position and timing.
Stop Light Switch
Detects if the brake pedal is depressed.
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Detects and sends a vehicle speed signal to the ECM.
Pattern Select Switch
Selects the Power mode or the Normal mode for shift and
lock–up timing.
0/D OFF Indicator Light
Blinks and warns the driver, while the 0/D main switch is
pushed in, when the electronic control circuit is malfunc–
tioning. ’
O/D Switch
Prevents up–shift to the O/D gear if the O/D switch is
off.
ECM
Controls the engine and transaxle actuators based on
signals from each sensor.
Throttle Position Sensor
Detects the throttle valve opening angle.
Engine Coolant Temp. Sensor
Detects the engine coolant temperature.
Cruise Control ECU
This ECM prevents the transaxle from shifting into over–
drive and prohibits lock–up control when the vehicle’s
speed drops below the auto drive set speed parameter.
Data Link Connector 3
By connecting the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–
held tester the transaxle control data can be read.
AX2–11
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
–
OPERATION
AX2–12
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
PREPARATION
PREPARATION
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
09043–38100 Hexagon 10 mm Wrench
Remove and install oil pan drain
plug.
09223–15010 Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal
Replacer
09308–00010 Oil Seal Puller
Remove side gear shaft oil seal.
09316–60010 Transmission & Transfer Bearing
Reptacer
Install RH side bearing to
differential case.
(09316–00010) Replacer Pipe
Install right sid, gear shaft oil
seal.
09350–32014 TOYOTA Automatic Transmission
Tool Set
(09351–32010) One–way Clutch Test Tool
(09351–32020) Stator Stopper
09992–00094 Automatic Transmission Oil
Pressure Gauge Set
Line pressure
AX2–13
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09031–00030 Pin
Punch
Pin diameter 3 mm(0.12 in.)
09082–00050 TOYOTA Electrical Tester Set
EQUIPMENT
Straight edge
Check torque converter clutch
installation.
Vernier calipers
Check torque converter clutch
installation.
Dial indicator or dial indicator with magnetic base
Measure drive plate runout.
Torque wrench
LUBRICANT
Item
Automatic transaxle fluid
(w/o Differential oil)
Dry fill
Drain and refill
Differential Fluid
Capacity
6.75 liters (7.1 US qts, 5.9 Imp. qts)
3.5 liters (3.7 US qts, 3.1 imp. qts)
0.85 liters (0.9 US qts, 0.7 Imp. qts)
Classification
ATF DEXRON’ II
ATF DEXRON’ 1I
SSM (Special Service Materials)
08833–00070 Adhesive 1311,
THREE BOND 1311 or equivalent
Torque converter clutch mounting
bolt
AX2–14
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ON–VEHICLE REPAIR
ON–VEHICLE REPAIR
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ”LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR REPLACEMENT
(w/Speedometer Driven Gear)
1. DISCONNECT VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNEC–
TOR
2. REMOVE VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt and vehicle speed sensor assembly.
(b) Remove the clip and speedometer driven gear from
vehicle speed sensor.
(c) Remove the O–ring from vehicle speed sensor.
3. INSPECT VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
4. INSTALL VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Coat a new 0–ring with ATF and install it to the
vehicle speed sensor.
(b) Install the speedometer driven gear to the vehicle
speed sensor and clip.
(c) Install the vehicle speed sensor assembly and torque
the bolts.
Torque: 16 N–m (160 kgf–cm. 12 ft–lbf)
5. CONNECT VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
AX2–15
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ON–VEHICLE REPAIR
DIRECT CLUTCH SPEED SENSOR
REPLACEMENT
1. DISCONNECT DIRECT CLUTCH SPEED SENSOR
CONNECTOR
2. REMOVE DIRECT CLUTCH SPEED SENSOR
(a) Remove the bolt and direct clutch speed sensor.
(b) Remove the 0 –ring from direct clutch speed sensor.
3. INSPECT DIRECT CLUTCH SPEED SENSOR
(See page AX2–108)
4. INSTALL DIRECT CLUTCH SPEED SENSOR
(a) Coat a new 0–ring with ATF and install it to the
direct clutch speed sensor.
(b) Install the direct clutch speed sensor and torque the
bolt.
Torque: 5.4 N–m (55 kgf–cm, 48 in.–lbf)
AX2–16
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ON–VEHICLE REPAIR
PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
REPLACEMENT
1. DISCONNECT PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
CONNECTOR
2. REMOVE PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
(a) Remove the clip from the shift control cable.
(b) Remove the nut and control cable.
(c) Remove the transaxle control shaft lever.
(d) Remove the park/neutral position switch.
3. INSPECT PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
(See page AX2–116)
4. INSTALL AND ADJUST PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION
SWITCH
(a) Install the park/neutral position switch.
AX2–17
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ON–VEHICLE REPAIR
(b) Adjust the park/neutral position switch.
(See page AX2–69)
(c) Install the transaxle control shaft lever.
(d) Install the control cable and nut.
(e) Install the clip to the shift control cable.
5. CONNECT PARK/ NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
CONNECTOR
6. TEST DRIVE VEHICLE
AX2–18
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ON–VEHICLE REPAIR
VALVE BODY REMOVAL
1. CLEAN TRANSAXLE EXTERIOR
To help prevent contamination, clean the exterior of
the transaxle.
2. DRAIN TRANSAXLE FLUID
Using SST, remove the drain plug and the fluid into
suitable container.
SST 09043 – 38100
3. REMOVE OIL PAN AND GASKET
NOTICE: Some fluid will remain in the oil pan.
Remove all pan bolts, and carefully remove the pan
assembly. Discard the gasket.
4. EXAMINE PARTICLES IN PAN
Remove the magnets and use them to collect any
steel chips. Look carefully at the chips and particles in
the pan and the magnet to anticipate what type of
wear you will find in the transaxle.
Steel (magnetic): bearing, gear and plate wear
Brass (non–magnetic): bushing wear
5. REMOVE OIL STRAINER AND APPLY TUBE BRACK–
ET
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and the oil strainer.
NOTICE: Be careful as oil will come out of the strainer
when it is removed.
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and the apply tube bracket.
6. REMOVE OIL TUBES
Pry up both tube ends with a large screwdriver and
remove the 5 tubes.
AX2–19
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ON–VEHICLE REPAIR
7. DISCONNECT SOLENOID CONNECTORS
8. REMOVE TRANSFER LUBRICATION APPLY TUBE
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and detent spring.
(b) Remove the tube set bolts.
(c) Pry up the tube with a screwdriver and remove the
tube.
9. REMOVE MANUAL VALVE BODY
Remove the 5 bolts and manual valve body.
AX2–20
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ON–VEHICLE REPAIR
10. REMOVE B3 APPLY TUBE
(a) Remove the tube retainer.
(b) Pry up the tube with a screwdriver and remove the
tube.
11. REMOVE VALVE BODY
(a) Remove the 11 bolts.
(b) Disconnect the throttle cable from cam and remove
the valve body.
12. REMOVE SECOND BRAKE APPLY GASKET
AX2–21
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ON–VEHICLE REPAIR
VALVE BODY INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL NEW SECOND BRAKE APPLY GASKET
2. INSTALL VALVE BODY
(a) While holding the cam down with your hand, slip the
cable end into the slot.
(b) Bring valve body into place.
NOTICE: Be careful not to entangle the solenoid wire.
(c) Finger tighten all bolts first. Then tighten them with a
torque wrench.
HINT: Each bolt length (mm, in.) is indicated in the
illustration.
Torque: 11 N–m (110 kgf–cm. 8 ft–lbf)
3. INSTALL 133 APPLY TUBE
(a) Using a plastic hammer, install the tube into the posi–
tion indicated in the illustration.
NOTICE: Be careful not to bend or damage the tubs.
(b) Install the tube retainer.
HINT: The bolt length (mm, in.) is indicated in the
illustration.
Torque: 11 N–m (110 kgf–cm, 8 ft–lbf)
4. INSTALL MANUAL VALVE BODY
(a) Align the manual valve with the pin on the manual
valve lever.
(b) Install the valve body into place.
(c) Finger tighten the 5 bolts first. Then tighten them with
a torque wrench.
HINT: Each bolt length (mm, in.) is indicated in the
illustration.
Torque: 11 N–m (110 kgf–cm, 8 ft–lbf)
AX2–22
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ON–VEHICLE REPAIR
5. INSTALL TRANSFER LUBRICATION APPLY TUBE
AND DETENT SPRING
(a) Using a plastic hammer, install the tube into the posi–
tion indicated in the illustration.
NOTICE: Be careful not to bend or damage the tube.
(b) Install the bolt.
HINT: The bolt length (mm, in.) is indicated in the
illustration.
Torque: 11 N–m (170 kgf–cm, 8 ft–lbf)
(c) Install the detent spring.
HINT: Each bolt length (mm, in.) is indicated in the
illustration.
Torque: 11 N–m (110 kgf–cm, 8 ft–lbf)
(d) Check that the manual valve lever is in contact with
the center of the roller at the tip of the detent spring.
6. CONNECT SOLENOID CONNECTORS
7. INSTALL OIL TUBES
(a) Using a plastic hammer, install the tubes into the
positions indicated in the illustration.
NOTICE: Be careful not to bend or damage the tubes.
AX2–23
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ON–VEHICLE REPAIR
8. INSTALL OIL STRAINER AND APPLY TUBE BRACK–
ET
Install the oil strainer.
Torque: 11 N–m (110 kgf–cm, 8 ft–Ibf)
Install the tube bracket.
Torque: 10 N–m (100 kgf–cm, 7 ft–Ibf)
HINT: Each bolt length (mm, in.) is indicated in the
illustration.
9. INSTALL MAGNETS
NOTICE: Make sure that the magnet does not interfere
with the oil tubes.
10. INSTALL OIL PAN
(a) Install a new gasket and oil pan.
(b) Install and torque 17 bolts.
Torque: 4.9 N–m (50 kgf–cm, 43 ft–lbf)
11. FILL TRANSAXLE WITH ATF
NOTICE: Do not overfill.
Fluid type:
ATF DEXRONII
12. CHECK FLUID LEVEL (See page AX2–68)
AX2–24
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ON –VEHICLE REPAIR
THROTTLE CABLE REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT THROTTLE CABLE FROM ENGINE
Disconnect the cable from the throttle linkage.
2. REMOVE PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
(See page AX2–61)
3. REMOVE VALVE BODY
(See page AX2–18)
4. REMOVE THROTTLE CABLE
(a) Remove the bolt and retaining plate.
(b) Pull out the cable from the transaxle case.
THROTTLE CABLE INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL CABLE INTO TRANSAXLE CASE
(a) Be sure to push it in all the way.
(b) Install the retaining plate and bolt.
2. INSTALL VALVE BODY (See page AX2–21)
3. IF THROTTLE CABLE IS NEW, STAKE STOPPER OR
PAINT MARK ON INNER CABLE
HINT: New cables do not have a staked cable stopper.
(a) Bend the cable so there is a radius of about 200 mm
(7.87 in.).
(b) Pull the inner cable lightly until a light resistance is
felt, and hold it in position there.
(c) Stake the stopper, 0.8–1.5 mm (0.031 –0.059 in.)
from the end of outer cable.
AX2–25
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ON–VEHICLE REPAIR
4. CONNECT THROTTLE CABLE TO ENGINE
5. ADJUST THROTTLE CABLE
(See page AX2–69)
6. INSTALL PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
(See page AX2–16)
7. TEST DRIVE VEHICLE
AX2–26
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ON–VEHICLE REPAIR
SIDE GEAR SHAFT OIL SEAL
REPLACEMENT
1. REMOVE BOTH DRIVE SHAFTS
(See page SA–22)
2. REMOVE BOTH SIDE GEAR SHAFT OIL SEALS
Using SST, pull out the oil seal.
SST 09308–00010
3. INSTALL LEFT SIDE GEAR SHAFT OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST, drive in a new oil seal.
SST 09223–15010
Oil seal depth:
0 ± 0.5 mm (0 ± 0.02 in.)
(b) Coat the lip of oil seal with MP grease.
4. INSTALL RIGHT SIDE GEAR SHAFT OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST, drive in a new oil seal.
SST 09316–60010 (09316–00010)
Oil seal depth:
0 ± 0.5 mm (0 ± 0.02 in.)
(b) Coat the lip of oil seal with MP grease.
5. INSTALL BOTH DRIVE SHAFTS
(See page SA–25)
6. CHECK TRANSAXLE FLUID LEVEL
(See page AX2–68)
AX2–27
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
Remove and install the parts as shown.
AX2–28
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRANSAXLE REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT AND REMOVE BATTERY
2. REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
3. REMOVE THROTTLE CABLE FROM ENGINE
4. REMOVE CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
(a) Remove the cruise control actuator cover.
(b) Disconnect the connector.
(c) Remove the 3 bolts and cruise control actuator with
bracket.
5. REMOVE GROUND TERMINAL
6. DISCONNECT VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNEC–
TOR
7. DISCONNECT DIRECT CLUTCH SPEED SENSOR
CONNECTOR
AX2–29
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
8. DISCONNECT PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
CONNECTOR
9. DISCONNECT SOLENOID CONNECTOR
10. DISCONNECT SHIFT CONTROL CABLE
(a) Remove the clip from the shift control cable.
(b) Remove the unit.
11. REMOVE EARTH CABLES
12. DISCONNECT OIL COOLER HOSE
AX2–30
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
13. REMOVE 2 FRONT SIDE TRANSAXLE MOUNTING
BOLTS
14. REMOVE 2 FRONT SIDE ENGINE MOUNTING
BOLTS
15. REMOVE 2 OIL COOLER CLAMPING BOLTS FROM
FRONT FRAME ASSEMBLY
16. REMOVE STARTER
(a) Disconnect the connector and remove the nut.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and the starter.
17. REMOVE 4 UPPER TRANSAXLE TO ENGINE BOLTS
AX2–31
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
18. INSTALL ENGINE SUPPORT FIXTURE
19. TIE STEERING GEAR HOUSING TO ENGINE SUP–
PORT FIXTURE BY CODE OR EQUIVALENT
20. RAISE AND SUITABLY SUPPORT VEHICLE
21. REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
22. REMOVE EXHAUST FRONT PIPE
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and exhaust front pipe clamp.
(b) Remove the 4 nuts.
(c) Remove the 2 bolts and exhaust front pipe support.
(d) Remove the 2 bolts and nuts.
(e) Remove the exhaust front pipe.
23. REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL FLUID DRAIN PLUG AND
GASKET
24. DRAIN DIFFERENTIAL FLUID INTO A SUITABLE
CONTAINER
AX2–32
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
26. REMOVE RIGHT AND LEFT ENGINE SIDE COVER
NO.2
26. REMOVE ENGINE UNDER FRONT COVER NO.1 AND
NO.2
27. REMOVE DRIVE SHAFT
(See page SA–22)
28. REMOVE FRONT SIDE ENGINE MOUNTING NUT
29. REMOVE REAR SIDE ENGINE MOUNTING BOLTS
(a) Remove 2 hole plugs.
(b) Remove 2 bolts and nuts.
30. REMOVE 4 LEFT SIDE TRANSAXLE MOUNTING
BOLTS
31. REMOVE STEERING GEAR HOUSING
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and disconnect the stabilizer bar
bushing bracket from the front frame assembly.
AX2–33
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
(b) Remove 2 bolts and nuts from the steering gear housing.
(c) Remove the steering gear housing.
32. REMOVE FRONT FRAME ASSEMBLY
(a) Hold the front frame assembly with a jack.
(b) Remove 2 set screws from the right and left fender
liners.
(c) Remove 6 bolts and 4 nuts.
(d) Remove the front frame assembly.
33. HOLD TRANSAXLE WITH A JACK
34. REMOVE TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH MOUNT–
ING BOLTS
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and hole cover.
AX2–34
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
r ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
(b) Turn the crankshaft to gain access to each bolt.
(c) Hold the crankshaft pulley nut with a wrench and
remove the 6 bolts.
35. REMOVE EXHAUST MANIFOLD PLATE
36. REMOVE TRANSAXLE TO ENGINE BOLTS
37. REMOVE TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
Separate transaxle and engine, and lower the trans–
axle.
38. REMOVE TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH FROM
TRANSAXLE
AX2–35
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH AND
DRIVE PLATE INSPECTION
1. INSPECT ONE–WAY CLUTCH
(a) Install SST into the inner race of the one–way clutch.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32020)
(b) Install SST so that it fits in the notch of the converter
hub and outer race of the one–way clutch.
SST 09350–32014 (09351 –32020)
(c) With the torque converter clutch standing on its side,
the clutch locks when turned counterclockwise, and
rotates freely and smoothly clockwise.
If necessary, clean the converter and retest the clutch.
Replace the converter if the clutch still fails the test.
2. MEASURE DRIVE PLATE RUNOUT AND INSPECT
RING GEAR
Set up a dial indicator and measure the drive plate
runout.
If runout exceeds 0.20 mm (0.0079 in.) or if the ring
gear is damaged replace the drive plate. If installing a
new drive plate, note the orientation of spacers and
tighten the bolts.
Torque: 83 N–m (850 kgf–cm, 61 ft–lbf)
AX2–36
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
3. MEASURE TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SLEEVE
RUNOUT
(a) Temporarily mount the torque converter clutch to the
drive plate. Set up a dial indicator.
If runout exceeds 0.30 mm (0.0118 in.), try to correct
by reorienting the installation of the converter. If ex–
cessive runout cannot be corrected replace the torque
converter clutch.
HINT: Mark the position of the converter to ensure
correct installation.
(b) Remove the torque converter clutch.
TRANSAXLE INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH IN TRA–
NSAXLE
If the torque converter clutch has been drained and
washed, refill with new ATF.
Fluid type:
ATF DEXRON II
2. CHECK TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH INSTALLA–
TION
Using calipers and a straight edge, measure from the
installed surface to the front surface of the transaxle
housing.
Correct distance:
More than 13.7 mm (0.539 in.)
AX2–37
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
3. ALIGN TRANSAXLE AT INSTALLATION POSITION
(a) Align the 2 knock pins on the block with the converter
housing.
(b) Temporarily install the bolt.
4. INSTALL TRANSAXLE TO ENGINE BOLTS
Install the transaxle to engine bolts.
12 mm head bolt
Torque: 64 N–m (650 kgf–cm, 47 ft–lbf)
10 mm head bolt
Torque: 46 N–m (470 kgf–cm. 34 ft–lbf)
5. INSTALL EXHAUST MANIFOLD PLATE
(a) Install the exhaust manifold plate.
(b) Install and torque the bolt and nut.
Torque: 20 N–m (200 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
(c) Install and torque the nut.
Torque: 20 N–m (200 kgf–cm, 14 ft–Ibf)
6. INSTALL TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH MOUNT–
ING BOLTS
(a) Clean the threads of the bolts with gasoline.
(b) Coat the threads of the bolts with sealer.
Sealer:
Part No.08833–00070, THREE BOND 1324 or equi–
valent
(c) Tighten the bolts evenly.
Torque: 27 N–m (280 kgf–cm, 20 ft–lbf)
HINT: First install dark green colored bolt and then the
5 bolts.
(d) Install the hole cover with 2 bolts.
AX2–38
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
7. INSTALL FRONT FRAME ASSEMBLY
(a) Hold the front frame assembly.
(b) Install the6 bolts and 4 nuts.
(c) Torque the bolts and nuts.
19 mm head bolt
Torque: 1$1 N–m (1,850 kgf–cm, 134 ft–lbf)
12 mm head bolt
Torque: 32 N–m (330 kgf–cm, 24 ft–lbf)
Nut
Torque: 36 N–m (370 kgf–cm, 27 ft–lbf)
(d) Install the 2 set screws in the right and left fender
liners.
8. INSTALL STEERING GEAR HOUSING
(a) Install the steering gear housing to the front frame
assembly.
(b) Install and torque the 2 bolts and nuts.
Torque: 181 N–m (1,850 kgf–cm, 134 ft–lbf)
(c) Connect the stabilizer bar bushing bracket with the 4
bolts.
Torque: 19 N–m (195 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
AX2–39
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
9. INSTALL FOUR LEFT SIDE TRANSAXLE MOUNT–
ING BOLTS
Torque: 52 N–m (530 kgf–cm. 38 ft–lbf)
10. INSTALL REAR SIDE MOUNTING BOLTS AND
NUTS
(a) Install and torque the 2 bolts and nuts.
Torque:66 N–m (670 kgf–cm, 48 ft–lbf)
(b) Install 2 hole plugs.
11. INSTALL FRONT SIDE ENGINE MOUNTING NUT
Torque: 80 N–m (820 kgf–cm, 59 ft–lbf)
12. INSTALL DRIVE SHAFT
(See page SA–25)
13. INSTALL RIGHT AND LEFT ENGINE SIDE COVER
NO.2
14. INSTALL ENGINE UNDER FRONT COVER NO.1 AND
NO.2
15. INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL FLUID DRAIN PLUG WITH
A NEW GASKET
16. FILL DIFFERENTIAL
Fluid Type:
ATF DEXRON II Capacity:
0.85 liters (0.9 US qts, 0.7 Imp. qts)
17. CHECK DIFFERENTIAL FLUID LEVEL
AX2–40
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
18. INSTALL EXHAUST FRONT PIPE
(a) Install a new gasket.
(b) Install the exhaust front pipe.
(c) Install and torque 2 bolts and new nuts.
Torque: 43 N–m (440 kgf–cm, 32 ft–lbf)
(d) Install the exhaust front pipe support and 2 bolts.
(e) Install 2 new gaskets.
(f) Install and torque 4 new nuts.
Torque: 62 N–m (630 kgf–cm, 46 ft–lbf)
(g) Install the exhaust front pipe clamp and 2 bolts.
Torque: 43 N–m (440 kgf–cm, 32 ft–lbf)
19. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL AND LOWER VEHICLE
Torque: 103 N–m (1,050 kgf–cm, 76 ft–lbf)
20. UNTIE STEERING GEAR HOUSING REMOVE
ENGINE SUPPORT FIXTURE
AX2–41
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
21. INSTALL 4 UPPER TRANSAXLE TO ENGINE BOLTS
Torque: 64 N–m (650 kgf–cm, 47 ft–lbf)
22. INSTALL STARTER
(a) Install the starter with the 2 bolts.
(b) Torque the 2 bolts.
Torque: 38 N–m (400 kgf–cm, 29 ft–lbf)
(c) Connect the connector and install the nut.
23. INSTALL OIL COOLER CLAMPING BOLTS TO
FRONT FRAME ASSEMBLY
24. INSTALL TWO FRONT SIDE ENGINE MOUNTING
BOLTS
Torque: 80 N–m (820 kgf–cm, 59 ft–lbf)
25. INSTALL TWO FRONT SIDE TRANSAXLE MOUNT–
ING BOLTS
Torque: 80 N–m (820 kgf–cm, 59 ft–lbf)
AX2–42
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
26. CONNECT OIL COOLER HOSE
27. INSTALL EARTH CABLES
28. CONNECT SHIFT CONTROL CABLE
(a) Install the clip from the shaft control cable.
(b) Install and torque the nut.
(c) Adjust the shift control cable.
(See page AX2–69)
29. CONNECT SOLENOID CONNECTOR
30. CONNECT PARK/ NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
CONNECTOR
AX2–43
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
31. CONNECT DIRECT CLUTCH SPEED SENSOR CON–
NECTOR
32. CONNECT VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
33. INSTALL GROUND TERMINAL
34. INSTALL CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
(a) Install the cruise control actuator with bracket the 3
bolts.
(b) Connect the connector.
(c) Install the cruise control actuator cover.
35. INSTALL THROTTLE CABLE TO ENGINE
(a) Torque the nuts.
Torque: 15 N–m (150 kgf–cm, 11 ft–lbf)
(b) Adjust the throttle cable.
(See page AX2–69)
36. INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
37. INSTALL BATTERY
AX2–44
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
38. FILL TRANSAXLE WITH ATF AND CHECK FLUID
LEVEL
(See page AX2–68)
NOTICE: Do not overfill.
Fluid type:
ATF DEXRONll
39. INSPECT FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
(See page SA–4)
40. PERFORM ROAD TEST
Check for abnormal noise and smooth shifting.
AX2–45
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM
SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM
COMPONENT PARTS LOCATION
WIRING DIAGRAM
AX2–46
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM
ELECTRIC CONTROL COMPONENTS
INSPECTION
1. INSPECT SHIFT LOCK CONTROL ECU
Using a voltmeter, measure the voltage at each termi–
nal.
HINT: Do not disconnect the computer connector.
Connector
Terminal
Measuring condition
Voltage (V)
Ignition switch ACC position
Ignition switch ON position
Depress brake pedal
Ignition switch ACC position and P position
Ignition switch ACC position and except P position
(Approx–after one second)
Ignition switch ON position and P position
Depress brake pedal
(Approx–after 20 seconds)
Except P position
Ignition switch ON, P position and depress brake pedal
Shift except P position under conditions above
Ignition switch ACC position and P position
Shift except P position under condition above
2. INSPECT SHIFT LOCK SOLENOID
(a) Disconnect the solenoid connector.
(b) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
terminals.
Standard resistance:
21–27
(c) Apply the battery positive voltage between terminals.
Check that an operation noise can be heard from the
solenoid.
AX2–47
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM
3. INSPECT KEY INTERLOCK SOLENOID
(a) Disconnect the solenoid connector.
(b) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
terminals.
Standard resistance:
12.5–16–60
(c) Apply the battery positive voltage between terminals.
Check that an operation noise can be heard from the
solenoid.
4. INSPECT SHIFT LOCK CONTROL SWITCH
Inspect that there is continuity between each termi–
nal.
Terminal
Shift
Position
P position
(Release button is not pushed)
P position
(Release button is pushed)
R, N, D, 2, L position
AX2–48
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–Memo–
–
SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM
AX2–49
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
TROUBLESHOOTING
AX2–50
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
The Transaxle Control System broadly consists of the sensors, ECM and actuators. The ECM
receives signals from various sensors, judges the operating conditions and determines the shift
and lock–up timing.
When troubleshooting OBD n vehicles, use an OBD II Scan Tool complying with SAE J 1978 or
TOYOTA hand–held tester to confirm the diagnostic trouble codes, freezed frame data and
engine data.
This will enable you to determine the system causing the problem.
This section explains the best method of troubleshooting and how to carry out the necessary
repairs.
(1) CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
Using the customer problem analysis check sheet for reference, ask the customer in as much
detail as possible about the problem.
(2) CONNECT THE OBDII SCAN TOOL OR TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER TO DLC3
Connect the OBD ll scan tool complying with SAE J 1978 or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the
vehicle’s data link connector 3.
NOTICE: For OBDll scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester operating instructions, see the instruction
booklet accompanying the scan tool.
If your display shows ”UNABLE TO CONNECT TO VEHICLE” when you have you have connected
the scan tool/TOYOTA hand–held tester cable to DLC3, turned the ignition switch ON and
operated the scan tool/TOYOTA hand–held tester, inspect DLC3 (See page AX2–57).
(3) CHECK DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE AND FREEZED FRAME DATA (PRECHECK)
First check the diagnostic trouble codes. If a code is output, make a note of it.
Also check and note the freezed frame data.
HINT: Output of the malfunction code indicates a circuit malfunction. However, it does not
indicate whether the malfunction is still occurring or occurred in the past and returned to normal.
To determine this, first confirm the problem symptoms in (7) and then recheck the diagnostic
trouble code in¿¿. If troubleshooting has begun based only on the malfunction code in the
diagnostic trouble code check in 0, it could result in a misdiagnosis and troubleshooting of
circuits which are normal, making it more difficult to locate the cause of the problem.
(4) CLEAR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE AND FREEZED FRAME DATA
Use the OBDII scan tool or TOYOTA hand – held tester to erase the diagnostic trouble codes and
freezed frame data.
NOTICE: For OBDII scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester operating instructions, see the instruction
booklet accompanying the scan tool.
(5) VISUAL INSPECTION
(6) SETTING THE CHECK MODE DIAGNOSIS
(7) PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
Confirm the problem symptoms.
(8) SYMPTOM SIMULATION
If the problem does not reappear, be sure to simulate the problem by mainly checking the circuits
indicated by the diagnostic trouble code in step (3), using ”Problem Simulation method”.
(9) DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK
Check the diagnostic trouble codes. Check if there is abnormality in the sensors or the wire
harness.
If a malfunction code is output, proceed to (9) Diagnostic Trouble Code Chart”. If the normal code
is output, proceed to (14) Matrix Chart of Problem Symptoms”.
Be sure to proceed to (9) Diagnostic Trouble Code Chart” after the steps (2) to (6) inclusive are
AX2–51
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
completed. If troubleshooting is attempted only by following the malfunction code stored in the
memory is output, errors could be made in the diagnosis.
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a trouble code is confirmed in the diagnostic trouble code check, proceed to the inspection
procedure indicated by the matrix chart for each diagnostic trouble code.
PRELIMINARY CHECK
Carry out a preliminary check of the transmission oil level, throttle cable adjustment, etc..
MECHANICAL SYSTEM TEST
(Stall Test, Time Leg Test, Line Pressure Test)
If the malfunction is found in the stall test, time lag test or line pressure test, check the parts
indicated in the respective tests.
MANUAL SHIFTING TEST
If the results of the manual driving test are NG, it is likely that the trouble is in the mechanical
system or hydraulic system. Proceed to Part 2 (Mechanical System) under the Matrix Chart of
Problem Symptoms.
MATRIX CHART OF PROBLEM SYMPTOMS
If the normal code is confirmed in the diagnostic trouble code check, perform inspection
according to the inspection order in the matrix chart of problem symptoms. Perform diagnosis of
each circuit or part in the order shown in the Matrix Chart. The Matrix Chart contains 3 chapters,
Electronically Controlled Circuits in Chapter 1, On–vehicle Inspection in Chapter 2 and Off–
vehicle Inspection in Chapter 3. If all the circuits indicated in Chapter 1 are normal, proceed to
Chapter 2. If all the parts indicated in Chapter 2 are normal, proceed to Chapter 3. If all the circuits
and parts in Chapter 1 – Chapter 3 are normal and the trouble still occurs, check and replace the
ECM.
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Perform diagnosis of each circuit in accordance with the inspection order confirmed in (9) and (13).
Judge whether the cause of the problem is in the sensor, actuators, wire harness and connectors,
or the ECM. In some cases, the Flow Chart instructs that a throttle signal check or brake signal
check be performed. These are diagnosis functions used to check if signals are being input
correctly to the ECM.
PARTS INSPECTION
Check the individual parts of the mechanical system and hydraulic system in the order of the
numbers indicated in the Matrix Chart.
REPAIRS
After the cause of the problem is located, perform repairs by following the inspection and
replacement procedures in this manual or’94 A541 E Automatic Transaxle Repair Manual.(for’94
CAM RY)
CONFIRMATION TEST
After completing adjustment or repairs, confirm not only that the malfunction is eliminated, but
also conduct a test drive, etc., to make sure the entire Engine Control System is operating
normally.
AX2–52
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Items inside
are titles of pages, in this man–
ual, with the page number indicated in the bot–
tom portion. See the indicated pages for detailed
explanations.
Vehicle Brought to Workshop
Customer Problem Analysis
P. AX2–53
Diagnostic steps permitting the use of the TOYOTA
hand–held tester or TOYOTA brake–out–box.
Connect the OBD II Scan Tool or TOYOTA Hand–Held Tester to DLC3
If your display shows “UNABLE TO CONNECT TO VEHICLE” when you hvae connected the
scan tool/TOYOTA hand–held tester, inspect DLC3 P.AX2–57
Check Diagnostic Code and Freezed Frame Data (Precheck)
Record or Print DTC and Freezed Frame Data P.AX2–55
Clear Diagnostic Code and Freezed Frame Data P.AX2–58
Visual Inspection
Setting the Check Mode Diagnosis P. AX2–56
Symptom
does not occur
Problem Symptom Confirmation
P. AX2–64
Symptom Simulation
P. AX2–58
Symptom
occurs
OK Code
Diagnostic Code Check
NG
Preliminary Check
P. AX2–55
P. AX2–68
OK
Mechanical System Tests
NG
Diagnostic Code Chart
P. AX2–62
NG
P. AX2–71
OK
Manual Shifting Test
NG
P. AX2–77
OK
Matrix Chart of Problem Symptoms P. AX2–81
Chapter 1
(Electronic)
P. AX2–81
OK
Chapter 2
(On–Vehicle)
P. AX2–82
OK
Chapter 3
(OFF–Vehicle)
P. AX2–84
13.
Circuit
Inspection
• Main Throttle Signal Check
• Stop Light Signal Check
NG
Parts Inspection
P. AX2–92
15.
Identification of Problem
Repair
Confirmation Test
END
AX2–53
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK SHEET
Electronically Controlled
Transaxle Check Sheet
Inspector’s
Name
:
Registration No.
Customer’s Name
Registration Year
Frame No.
Date Vehicle
Brouht In
Odometer Reading
km
Miles
AX2–54
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
DESCRIPTION
When troubleshooting OBDII vehicles, the only dif–
ference from the usual troubleshooting procedure is
that you connect to the vehicle the OBDII scan tool
complying with SAE J1978 or TOYOTA hand–held
tester, and read off various data output from the
vehicle’s ECM.
OBD ll regulations require that the vehicle’s on –
board computer lights up the Malfunction Indicator
Lamp (MIL) on the instrument panel when the com–
puter detects a malfunction in the computer itself or
in drive system components which affect vehicle emi–
ssions. As in previous models, when the ECM detects
a malfunction in the transaxle control section, the MIL
lights up and the O/D OFF indicator light blinks. In
addition to the MIL lighting up when a malfunction is
detected, the applicable diagnostic trouble codes pre–
scribed by SAE J 2012 are recorded in the ECM
memory. (See page EG–404)
If the malfunction only occurs in 3 trips, the MIL goes
off but the diagnostic trouble codes remain recorded
in the ECM memory. The O/D OFF indicator light goes
off as soon as the trouble is no longer detected.
To check the diagnostic trouble codes, connect the
OBDII scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to
Data Link Connector 3 on the vehicle. The OBD ll
scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester also enables
you to erase the diagnostic trouble codes and check
freezed frame data and various forms of engine data.
(For operating instructions, see the OBD III scan tool’s
instruction book.)
Diagnostic trouble codes include SAE controlled
codes and Manufacturer controlled codes.
SAE controlled codes must be set as prescribed by the
SAE, while Manufacturer controlled codes can be set
freely by the manufacturer within the prescribed
limits.
(See diagnostic trouble code chart on page AX2–62)
AX2–55
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
The diagnosis system operates in normal mode during
normal vehicle use, and also has a check mode for
technicians to simulate malfunction symptoms and
perform troubleshooting. Most diagnostic trouble
codes use 2 trip detection logic(‘) to prevent errone–
ous detection. By switching the ECM to check mode
when troubleshooting, the technician can cause the
MIL to light up and 0/D OFF indicator lights to blink
for a malfunction that is only detected once or mo–
mentarily. (TOYOTA hand–held tester)
(See page AX2–56)
’ 2 trip detection logic:
When a logic malfunction is first detected, the mal–
function is temporarily stored in the ECM memory. If
the same malfunction is detected again during the
second test drive, this second detection causes the
MIL to light up and O/D OFF indicator lights to blink.
DIAGNOSIS INSPECTION (NORMAL MODE)
MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP CHECK
1. The malfunction indicator lamp comes on when the
ignition switch is turned ON and the engine is not
running.
HINT: If the malfunction indicator lamp does not light
up, troubleshoot the combination meter (See page BE–65)
2. When the engine is started, the malfunction indicator
lamp should go oft. If the lamp remains on, the diagno–
sis system has detected a malfunction or abnormality
in the system
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK
NOTICE (TOYOTA hand–held tester only): When the
diagnostic system is switched from normal mode to
check node, it erases all diagnostic trouble codes and
freezed frame data recorded in normal mode. So
before switching modes, always check the diagnostic
trouble codes and freezed frame data, and note them
down.
1. Prepare the OBDII scan tool (complying with SAE J
1978) or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
2. Connect the OBDll scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held
tester to data link connector 3 in the fuse box at the
lower left of the instrument panel.
3. Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the OBDII scan
tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester switch ON.
AX2–56
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
4. Use the OBD n scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held
tester to check the diagnostic trouble codes and free–
zed frame data. Note them down. (For operating in–
structions, see the OBD n scan tool’s instruction
book.)
5. See page AX2–62 to confirm the details of the diag–
nostic trouble codes.
NOTICE: When simulating symptoms with an OBD ll
scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester) to
check the diagnostic trouble codes, use normal mode.
For codes on the diagnostic trouble code chart sub–
ject to ”2 trip detection logic”, turn the ignition switch
off after the symptoms have been simulated the first
time. Then repeat the simulation process again. When
the program has been simulated twice, the MIL lights
up and the diagnostic trouble codes are recorded in
the ECM.
DIAGNOSIS INSPECTION (CHECK MODE)
TOYOTA hand–held tester only
Compared to the normal mode, the check mode has
high sensing ability to detect malfunctions.
Furthermore, the same diagnostic items which are
detected in the normal mode can also be detected in
the check mode.
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK
1. Initial conditions.
(a) Battery positive voltage 11 V or more.
(b) Throttle valve fully closed.
(c) Transaxle in PARK position.
(d) Air conditioning switched off.
2. Turn ignition switch off.
3. Prepare the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
4. Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to data link
connector 3 in the fuse box at the lower left of the
instrument panel.
5. Turn the ignition switch ON and switch the
TOYOTA hand–held tester ON.
AX2–57
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
6. Switch the TOYOTA hand – held tester normal
mode check mode. (Check that the MIL flashes.)
7. Start the engine. (MIL and O/D OFF indicator light
go out after the engine starts.)
8. Simulate the conditions of the malfunction descr–
ibed by the customer.
NOTICE: Leave the ignition switch ON until you have
checked the diagnostic trouble codes, etc.
9. After simulating the malfunction conditions, use the
TOYOTA hand–held tester diagnosis selector to
check the diagnostic trouble codes and freezed
frame data, etc.
HINT: Take care not to turn the ignition switch OFF,
Turning the ignition switch off switches the diagnosis
system from check mode to normal mode, so all diag–
nostic codes, etc. are erased.
10. After checking the diagnostic trouble code, inspect
the applicable circuit.
DATA LINK CONNECTOR 3 INSPECTION
The vehicle’s ECM uses V.P.
W. (Variable Pulse Width)
for communication to comply with SAE
J1850. The
terminal arrangement of DLC 3 complies with SAE J
1962 and matches the V.P.
W. format.
Terminal No.
Conn¿ection/Voltage or Resistance
Bus Line
Chassis Ground Body 1 or less
Signal Ground Body 1 or less
Battery Positive Body 1 Body 9 ~ 14 V
Condition
During transmission
Always
Always
Always
HINT: If your display shows ”UNABLE TO CONNECT
TO VEHICLE” when you have connected the cable of
the OBD ll scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to
DLC 3, turned the ignition switch ON and operated the
scan tool, there is a problem on the vehicle side or tool
side.
(1) If communication is normal when the tool is con–
nected to another vehicle, inspect DLC 3 on the
original vehicle.
AX2–58
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
(2) If communication is still not possible when the
tool is connected to another vehicle, the problem
is probably in the tool itself, so consult the Ser–
vice Department listed in the tool’s instruction
manual.
AXON–M
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
–TOYOTA hand–held tester only–
By putting the vehicle’s EC11A in check mode, 1 trip
detection logic is possible instead of 2 trip detection
logic and sensitivity to detect open circuits is in–
creased, This makes it easier to detect a intermittent
problems.
CLEAR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES
See page AX2–58
SET CHECK MODE
See page AX2–56
PERFORM A SIMULATION TEST
Using the symptom simulation (See page IN–24),
apply vibration to and pull lightly on the wire harness,
connector or terminals in the circuit indicated by the
malfunction code. In this test, if the malfunction indi–
cator lamp lights up, it indicates that the place where
the wire harness, connector or terminals being pulled
or vibrated has faulty contact. Check that point for
loose connection, dirt on the terminals, poor fit or
other problems and repair as necessary.
HINT: After canceling out the diagnostic trouble code
in memory and setting the check mode, if the malfunc–
tion indicator lamp does not go off after the engine is
started, check thoroughly for faulty contact, etc., then
try the check again. If the malfunction indicator lamp
still does not go off, check and replace the EC11A.
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CLEARANCE
The following actions will erase the diagnostic trouble
codes and freezed frame data.
1. Operating the OBD ll scan tool (complying with SAE J
1978) or TOYOTA hand–held tester to erase the
codes. (See the OBDII scan tool’s instruction book for
operating instructions.)
2. Disconnect the battery terminal or EFI fuse.
AX2–59
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
NOTICE: If the TOYOTA hand–held tester switches
the ECM from normal mode to check mode or vice –
versa, or if the ignition switch is turned from ON to
ACC or OFF during check mode, the diagnostic trou–
ble codes and freeted frame dada will be erased.
CONNECTOR CONNECTION AND TERMINAL IN–
SPECTION
When checking for an open circuit or short circuit, it is
important to check the connector connection and the
condition of the terminals.
OPEN CIRCUIT:
This could be due to a disconnected wire harness,
faulty contact in the connector, a connector terminal
pulled out, etc.
HINT:
1. A wire rarely breaks in the middle of it’s length.
Most cases occur at the connector. In particular,
carefully check the connectors of sensors and ac–
tuators.
2. Faulty contact could be due to rusting of the con–
nector terminals, to foreign materials entering ter–
minal or a drop in the contact pressure between the
male and female terminals of the connector. Simply
disconnecting and reconnecting the connectors
once changes the condition of the connection and
may result in a return to normal operation. There–
fore, in troubleshooting, if no abnormality is found
in the wire harness and connector check, but the
problem disappears after the check, them the cause
is considered to be in the wire harness or connec–
tors.
SHORT CIRCUIT:
This could be due to a short circuit between the wire
harness and the body ground or to a short inside the
switch etc.
HINT:
When there is a short between the wire harness and
body ground, check thoroughly whether the wire har–
ness is caught in the body or is clamped properly.
AX2–60
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
VISUAL CHECK AND CONTACT PRESSURE CHECK
(a) Disconnect the connectors at both ends.
(b) Check for rust or foreign material, etc. in the terminals
of the connectors.
(c) Check crimped portions for looseness or damage and
check if the terminals are secured in the lock portion.
HINT: The terminals should not come out when pulled
lightly.
(d) Prepare a test male terminal and insert it in the female
terminal, then pull it out.
NOTICE: When testing a gold–plate female terminal,
always use a gold–plated male terminal.
HINT: When the test terminal is pulled out more easily
than others, there may be poor contact in that section.
CONNECTOR HANDLING
When inserting tester probes into a connector, insert
them from the rear of the connector. When necessary,
use mini test leads. For water resistant connectors
which cannot be accessed from behind, take good
care not to deform the connector terminals.
AX2–61
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–MEMO–
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
AX2–62
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a diagnostic trouble code is displayed during the diagnostic trouble code check, check the
circuit listed for that code in the table below and proceed to the page given.
DTC No.
Detection Item
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Output Speed Sensor Circuit Malfunction
(for Electronically Controlled Transaxle)
When DTC No. P0500 is detected
P0750
Shift Solenoid A Malfunction
During normal driving the gear required by the ECM
does not match the actual gear.
(2 trip detection logic)
P0753
Shift Solenoid A Electrical
(Shift Solenoid Valve No.1 j
Open or short in shift solenoid A circuit.
P0755
Shift Solenoid B Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid Valve No.2)
Same as for DTC No.P0750
P0758
Shift Solenoid B Electrical
(Shift Solenoid Valve No.2)
Open or short in shift solenoid B circuit
P0720
P0770
Shift Solenoid E Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid Valve SL)
Lock–up does not occur when driving in the lock–up
range (normal driving at 80 km/h (50 mph). Or lock–up
remains ON in the lock–up OFF range.
(2 trip detection logic)
P0773
Shift Solenoid E Electrical
(Shift Solenoid Valve SL)
Open or short in shift solenoid E circuit for 1 time.
(2 trip detection logic)
P1705
P1765
P1780
”NC2” Revolution Sensor Circuit Malfunction
(Direct Clutch Speed Sensor)
Shift Solenoid Valve SLN Circuit
(For Accumulator Back Pressure Modulation)
Park/neutral Position Switch Malfunction
Output of direct clutch speed sensor (NC2) is 300 rpm or
less under condition a) or b)
a) Vehicle speed: 32 km/h (20 mph) or more
b) Park/neutral position switch: OFF
(2 trip detection logic)
After the engine is warmed up, the current flow to the
shift solenoid valve SLN is 0.2 A or less for at least 1
second under condition a) or b)
(2 trip detection logic)
a) Engine speed: 500 RPM or more
b) Park/neutral position switch: ON
(P or N position)
Two or more switches are ON simultaneously for ’N’, ’2’
and ’L’ position.
(2 trip detection logic)
–––––––
When driving under condition a) and b) for 30 seconds or
more the park/neutral position switch is ON (N position).
(2 trip detection logic) a) Vehicle speed: 44 mph (70 km/
h) or more
b) Engine speed: 1,500–2,500 rpm
AX2–63
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
–...MIL does not light up
...MIL lights up
...MIL lights up, O/D OFF indicator light blinks
Trouble Area
MIL
Memory
See page
• Same as for DTC No. P0500.
AX2–92
• Shift solenoid valve No.1 is stuck open or closed
• Valve body is blocked up or stuck.
AX2–96
• Open or short in shift solenoid valve No.1 circuit.
• Shift solenoid valve No.1
• ECM
AX2–98
• Shift solenoid valve No.2 is stuck open or closed
• Valve body is blocked up or stuck.
AX2–96
• Open or short in shift solenoid valve No.2 circuit.
• Shift solenoid valve No.2
ECM
AX2–98
•
•
•
AX2–102
Shift solenoid valve SL is stuck open or closed.
Lock–up clutch
Valve body is blocked up or stuck.
• Open or short in shift solenoid valve SL circuit.
• Shift solenoid valve SL
• ECM
• Open or short in direct clutch speed sensor circuit.
• Direct clutch speed sensor
• ECM
AX2–104
AX2–108
• Open or short in shift solenoid valve SLN circuit.
• Shift solenoid valve SLN
• ECM
AX2–112
• Short in park/neutral position switch circuit.
• Park/neutral position switch
• ECM
AX2–116
AX2–64
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
ROAD TEST
NOTICE: Perform the test at normal ATF operating tem–
perature 50–80 C (122–176 F).
1. D POSITION TEST (NORM AND PWR PATTERN)
Shift into the D position and fully depress the acceler–
ator pedal and check the following points:
(a) Check up–shift operation.12, 23 and 3O/D up–shift
takes place, at the shift point shown in the automatic shift
schedule. (See page AX2–67)
HINT:
(1) O/D Gear Up–shift Prohibition Control
•
Coolant temp. is 55C (131F) or less
•
If there is a 10 km/h (6 mph) difference between
the set cruise control speed and vehicle speed.
•
0/D main switch is pushed ON
(During the O/D OFF indicator light lights up.)
(2) O/D Gear Lock–up Prohibition Control
•
Brake pedal is depressed.
•
Coolant temp. is 55 C (131 F) or less.
(b) Check for shift shock and slip.
Check for shock and slip at the 1–2, 2–3 and 3–O/
D up–shifts.
(c) Check for abnormal noises and vibration.
Run at the D position lock–up or O/D gear and check
for abnormal noises and vibration.
HINT: The check for the cause of abnormal noises and
vibration must be performed very thoroughly as it
could also be due to loss of balance in the differential,
torque converter clutch, etc..
AX2–65
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
(d) Check kick–down operation
While running in the D position, 2nd, 3rd and 0/D
gears, check to see that the possible kick–down
vehicle speed limits for 21, 32 and 0/D3
kick–downs conform to those indicated on the auto–
matic shift schedule. (See page AX2–67)
(e) Check abnormal shock and slip at kick–down.
(f) Check the lock–up mechanism.
(1) Drive in D position, O/D gear, at a steady speed
(lock–up ON) of about 70 km/h (43 mph).
(2) Lightly depress the accelerator pedal and check
that the engine RPM does not change abruptly.
If there is a big jump in engine RPM, there is no
lock–up.
2. 2 POSITION TEST
Shift into the 2 position and fully depress the acceler–
ator pedal and check the following points:
(a) Check up–shift operation.
Check to see that the 1–)2 up–shift takes place and
that the shift point conforms to the automatic shift
schedule.(See page AX2–67)
HINT: There is no 0/D up–shift and lock–up in the 2
position.
(b) Check engine braking.
While running in the 2 position and 2nd gear, release
the accelerator pedal and check the engine braking
effect.
(c) Check for abnormal noises during acceleration and
deceleration, and for shock at up–shift and down–
shift.
AX2–66
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
3. L POSITION TEST
Shift into the 2 position and fully depress the acceler–
ator pedal and check the following points:
(a) Check no up–shift.
While running in the L position, check that there is no
up–shift to 2nd gear.
(b) Check engine braking.
While running in the L position, release the accelera–
tor pedal and check the engine braking effect.
(c) Check for abnormal noises during acceleration and
deceleration.
4. R POSITION TEST
Shift into the R position and fully depress the acceler–
ator pedal and check for slipping.
CAUTION: Before conducting this test ensure that the
test area is free from personnel and obstruction.
5. P POSITION TEST
Stop the vehicle on a gradient (more than 5) and after
shifting into the P position, release the parking brake.
Then, check to see that the parking lock pawl holds
the vehicle in place.
AX2–67
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
AUTOMATIC SHIFT SCHEDULE
SHIFT POINT
Shift position
Shifting point
Vehicle speed km/h (mph)
Throttle valve fully opened
D position
Throttle valve fully closed
Throttle valve fully opened
2 position
L position
Throttle valve fully opened
LOCK–UP POINT
D position km/h (mph)
Throttle valve opening 596
Lock–up ON
’3rd Gear
0/D Gear
*: 0/D Switch OFF
HINT:
(1) There is no lock–up in the 2 and L positions.
(2) In the following cases, the lock–up will be released regardless of the lock–up pattern.
•
When the throttle valve is completely closed.
•
When the brake light switch is ON.
(3) Shift up to 3rd will not occur when the engine coolant temp. is below 35C (95F) and the
vehicle speed is below 40 km/h (25 mph).
(4) Shift–up to 0/D will not occur when the engine coolant temp. is below 60 C (140 F) and
the vehicle speed is below 63 km/h (39 mph).
(5) During cruise control operation ; the shift pattern is fixed in NORM. And when the vehicle
speed drops to 10 km/h (6 mph) or more below the cruise control set vehicle speed, shift
down from 0/D to 3rd occurs.
(6) The kick–down foot switch turns ON when the accelerator pedal is depressed further with
the throttle valve already fully open.
AX2–68
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
PRELIMINARY CHECK
1. CHECK FLUID LEVEL
HINT:
• Drive the vehicle so that the engine and transmis–
sion are at normal operating temperature.
Fluid temp. : 70–80 C (158–176 F)
• Only use the COOL position on the dipstick as a
rough reference when the fluid is replaced or the
engine does not run.
(a) Park the vehicle on a level surface and set the parking
brake.
(b) With the engine idling and the brake pedal depressed,
shift the shift lever into all positions from P to L
position and return to P position.
(c) Pull out the dipstick and wipe it clean.
(d) Push it back fully into the tube.
(e) Pull it out and check that the fluid level is in the HOT
position.
If the level is at the low side, add fluid.
Fluid type:
DEXRON II or equivalent
NOTICE: Do not overfill.
2. CHECK FLUID CONDITION
If the fluid smells burnt or is black, replace it.
3. REPLACE TRANSAXLE FLUID
(a) Remove the drain plug and drain the fluid.
(b) Reinstall the drain plug securely.
(c) With the engine OFF, add new fluid through the oil
filler tube.
Fluid type:DEXRON^II or Equivalent
Capacity:
Total: 6.75 liters (7.1 US qts, 5.9 Imp. qts)
Drain and refill: 3.5 liters (3.7 US qts, 3.1 Imp. qts)
(d) Start the engine and shift the shift lever into all posi–
tions from P to L position and then shift into P posi–
tion.
(e) With the engine idling, check the fluid level. Add fluid
up to the COOL level on the dipstick.
(f) Check the fluid level at the normal operating tempera–
ture, 70–80 C (158–176 *F), and add as
necessary.
NOTICE: Do not overfill.
4. CHECK FLUID LEAKS
Check for leaks in the transmission.
If there are leaks, it is necessary to repair or replace 0
–rings, seal packings, oil seals, plugs or other parts.
AX2–69
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
5. INSPECT AND ADJUST THROTTLE CABLE
(a) Check that the accelerator pedal is fully released.
(b) Check that the inner cable is not slack.
(c) Measure the distance between the outer cable end
and stopper on the cable.
Standard distance:
0–1 mm (0–0.04 In.)
If the distance is not standard, adjust the cable by the
adjusting nuts.
6. INSPECT AND ADJUST SHIFT LEVER POSITION
When shifting the shift lever from the N position to
other positions, check that the lever can be shifted
smoothly and accurately to each position and that the
position indicator correctly indicates the position.
If the indicator is not aligned with the correct position,
carry out the following adjustment procedures.
(a) Loosen the swivel nut on the manual shift lever.
(b) Push the manual lever fully toward the right side of
the vehicle.
(c) Return the lever 2 notches to N position.
(d) Set the shift lever to N position.
(e) While holding the shift lever lightly toward the R
position side, tighten the swivel nut.
(f) Start the engine and make sure that the vehicle moves
forward when shifting the lever from the N to D
position and reverses when shifting it to the R posi–
tion.
7. INSPECT AND ADJUST PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION
SWITCH
Check that the engine can be started with the shift
lever only in the N or P position, but not in other
positions.
If not as started above, carry out the following adjust–
ment procedure.
(a) Loosen the park/neutral position switch bolt and set
the shift lever to the N position.
(b) Align the groove and neutral basic line.
(c) Hold in position and tighten the bolt.
AX2–70
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Torque: 5.4 N–m (55 kgf–cm, 48 in.–lbf)
For continuity inspection of the park/neutral position
switch, see page AX–116.
8. INSPECT IDLE SPEED
Idle speed:
650–750 RPM
(In N position and air conditioner OFF)
AX2–71
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
MECHANICAL SYSTEM TESTS
STALL TEST
The object of this test is to check the overall performance of the transaxle and engine by
measuring the stall speeds in the D and R positions.
NOTICE:
•
•
•
•
Perform the test at normal operating fluid temperature 50–80 C (122–176F).
Do not continuously run this test longer than 5 seconds.
To ensure safety, conduct this test in a wide, clear, level area which provides good traction.
The stall test should always be carried out in pairs. One technician should observe the conditions
of wheels or wheel stoppers outside the vehicle while the other is performing the test.
MEASURE STALL SPEED
(a) Chock the four wheels.
(b) Connect a tachometer to the engine.
(c) Fully apply the parking brake.
(d) Keep your left foot pressed firmly on the brake pedal.
(e) Start the engine.
(f) Shift into the D position. Press all the way down on the accelerator pedal with your right foot.
Quickly read the stall speed at this time.
Stall speed:
2,600 ±150 RPM
(g) Perform the same test in R position.
AX2–72
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
EVALUATION
Possible cause
Problem
• Engine output may be insufficient.
• Stator one–way clutch is operating properly
(a) Stall speed low in D and R positions.
(b) Stall speed high in D position.
HINT:
If more than 600 RPM below the specified value, the
torque converter could be faulty.
•
•
•
•
Line pressure too low
Forward clutch slipping
No.2 one–way clutch not operating properly
(c) Stall speed high in R position.
•
•
•
•
O/D one–way clutch not operating properly
Line pressure too low
Direct clutch slipping
First and reverse brake slipping
O/D clutch slipping
(d) Stall speed high in D and R position.
•
•
•
Line pressure too low
Improper fluid level
O/D one–way clutch not operating properly
AX2–73
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
TIME LAG TEST
When the shift lever is shifted while the engine is idling, there will be a certain time lapse or lag
before the shock can be felt. This is used for checking the condition of the 0/D direct clutch,
forward clutch, direct clutch, and first and reverse brake.
NOTICE:
•
Perform the test at normal operating fluid temperature 50–80 C (122–176 F).
•
Be sure to allow a one minute interval between tests.
•
Make three measurements and take the average value.
MEASURE TIME LAG
(a) Fully apply the parking brake .
(b) Start the engine and check idle speed.
Idle speed:
650–750 RPM (In N position and air conditioner OFF)
(c) Shift the shift lever from N to D position. Using a stop watch, measure the time it takes from
shifting the lever until the shock is felt.
In same manner, measure the time lag for N R.
Time lag:
N D Less than 1.2 seconds
N R Less than 1.5 seconds
AX2–74
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
EVALUATION
If ND or NR time lag are longer than specified:
Possible cause
Problem
ND time lag is longer
NR time lag is longer
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Line pressure too low
Forward clutch worn
0/D one–way clutch not operating properly
Line pressure too low
Direct clutch worn
First and reverse brake worn
O/D one–way clutch not operating properly
AX2–75
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
MEASURE LINE PRESSURE
NOTICE:
•
•
Perform the test at normal operating fluid temperature 50–80 C (122–176 F).
The line pressure test should always be carried out in pairs. One technician should observe the
conditions of wheels or wheel stoppers outside the vehicle while the other is performing the test.
•
Be careful to prevent the oil pressure gauge hose from interfering with the exhaust pipe.
(a) Warm up the transmission fluid.
(b) Remove the test plug on the transaxle case left side and connect the oil pressure gauge SST.
SST 09992–00094
(c) Fully apply the parking brake and chock the four wheels.
(d) Start the engine and check idling RPM.
(e) Keep your left foot pressed firmly on the brake pedal and shift into D position.
(f) Measure the line pressure when the engine is idling.
(g) Press the accelerator pedal all the way down. Quickly read the highest line pressure when engine
speed reaches stall speed.
(h) In the same manner, perform the test in R position.
AX2–76
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
SPECIFIED LINE PRESSURE
Condition
D position kPa (kgf/cm2, psi)
R position kPa (kgf/cm2, psi)
Idling
Stall
If the measured pressures are not up to specified values, recheck the throttle cable adjustment
and retest.
EVALUATION
Problem
If the measured values at all positions are higher.
If the measured values at all positions are lower.
If pressure is low in the D position only.
If pressure is low in the R position only.
Possible cause
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Throttle cable out of adjustment
Throttle valve defective
Regulator valve defective
Throttle cable out of adjustment
Throttle valve defective
Regulator valve defective
Oil pump defective
0/D direct clutch defective
D position circuit fluid leakage
Forward clutch defective
R position circuit fluid leakage
Direct clutch defective
First and reverse brake defective
AX2–77
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
MANUAL SHIFTING TEST
HINT: With this test, it can be determined whether the
trouble is within the electrical circuit or is a mechani–
cal problem in the transaxle.
1. DISCONNECT SOLENOID WIRE
2. INSPECT MANUAL DRIVING OPERATION
Check that the shift and gear positions correspond
with the table below.
Shift Position
Gear Position
D Position
O/D
2 Position
3rd
L Position
R Position
Reverse
P Position
Pawl Lock
HINT: If the L, 2 and D position gear positions are
difficult to distinguish, perform the following road
test.
• While driving, shift through the L, 2 and D positions.
Check that the gear change corresponds to the shift
position.
If any abnormality is found in the above test, the
problem is in the transmission itself.
3. CONNECT SOLENOID WIRE
4. CANCEL OUT DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE
(See page AX2–58)
AX2–78
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
STANDARD VALUE OF ECM TERMINAL
ECM Terminals
E9
Connector,Terminal No.
Symbols
Wiring Color
E10
Condition
Standard Value
1. Disconnect cruise control connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
Standing still
Turn one front wheel slowly
IG OFF
IG ON
1 st or 2nd gear
3rd or O/D gear
IG OFF
IG ON
2nd or 3rd gear
1 st or O/D gear
IG OFF
IG ON
Vehicle driving under lock–up position
IG OFF
Engine is running
IG switch ON
IG switch ON
0/D main switch ON
O/D main switch OFF
IG switch ON
Pattern select switch ’NORM’
Pattern select switch ’PWR’
AX2–79
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
IG switch ON
Shift lever L position
Shift lever other than L position
1G switch ON
Shift lever 2 position
Shift lever other than 2 position
IG switch ON
Shift lever R position
Shift lever other than R position
IG switch ON
Shift lever P or N position
Shift lever other than P and N position
IG switch ON
Brake pedal is depressed
Brake pedal is released
AX2–80
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
MATRIX CHART OF PROBLEM SYMPTOMS
If a normal code is displayed during the diagnostic trouble code check but the trouble still occurs,
check the circuits for each symptom in the order given in the charts on the following pages and
proceed to the page given for troubleshooting.
The Matrix Chart is divided into 3 chapters.
Chapter 1: Electronic Circuit Matrix Chart
Chapter 2: On–vehicle Repair Matrix Chart
Chapter 3: Off–vehicle Repair Matrix Chart
When troubleshooting, check Chapter 1 first. If instructions are given in Chapter 1 to proceed to
Chapter 2 or 3, proceed as instructed.
1. If the instruction ”Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on matrix chart” is given in the
flow chart for each circuit, proceed to the circuit with the next highest number in the table to
continue the check.
2. If the trouble still occurs even though there are no abnormalities in any of the other circuits,
then check or replace the ECM.
AX2–81
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Vehicle does not move in any forward range and reverse range
Vehicle does not move in particular range or ranges
1st2nd
No up–shift
2nd3rd
3rdO/D
O/D3rd
No down–shift
3rd2nd
2nd1st
No lockup
No lockup off
Shift point too high or too low
Upshifts is to 2nd while in L range
Upshifts to 3rd while in L range
Upshifts to O/D from 3rd while O/D switch is OFF
Upshifts to O/D from 3rd while engine is cold
ND
Harsh engagement
Lockup
Any driving range
Forward and reverse
Slip or Shudder
Particular range
No engine Braking
Poor acceleration
No kickdown
No pattern select
Large shift shock or Engine stalls when starting off or stopping.
AX2–84
Of–Vehicle repair
matrix chart
AX2–82
On–Vehicle repair
matrix chart
AX2–128
Stop Light
Switch Circuit
AX2–116
Park/Neutral Position
Switch Circuit
AX2–122
AX2–126
Pattern Select
Switch Circuit
Symptom
OD Cansel
Signal Circuit
Suspect Area
0/D Main Switch &
O/D OFF Indicator
Light Circuit
See Page
AX2–120
Chapter 1. Electronic Circuit
AX2–82
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Chapter 2. On–Vehicle Repair
(* : A541 E AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE Repair Manual)
Vehicle does not move in R position
Vehicle does not move in any forward position or reverse
position
No lock–up
No lock–up OFF
No kick–down
No engine braking
2nd
1st2nd
No up–shift
2nd 3rd
3rdO/D
O/D 3rd
No down–shift
3rd 2nd
2nd1 st
NR
ND
N L
1 st2nd (D position)
1 st2nd (2 Position)
Harsh engagement
1st2nd3rd
1st2nd 3rdO/D
2nd3rd
3rdO/D
O/D3rd
3rd2nd
Sliper shudder in forward and reverse (Directly after E/G start)
Low coast
modulator valve
2nd coast
modulator valve
Secondary
regulator valve
Cut–Back
valve
Down–shift
plug
Throttle valve
Symptom
Primary
regulator valve
Suspect Area
Manual valve
See page
OFF–Vehicle repair
AX2–84
matrix chart
Oil strainer
Parking lock pawl
Pressure relief
valve
B2accumulator
Bo accumulator
C2 accumulator
–
C1 a cumulator
Co accumulator
Solenoid
modulator valve
Accumulator
control valve
3–4 shift valve
2–3 shift valve
1–2 shift valve
Lock–up relay valve,
B1 Orifice
control valve
2nd lock valve
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
TROUBLESHOOTING
AX2–83
AX2–84
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Chapter 3. Off–Vehicle Repair
( * : A541 E AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE Repair Manual)
Vehicle does not move in any forward position
Vehicle does not move in reverse position
Vehicle does not move in any forward position and reverse position
No lock–up
No lock–up OFF
Large shock during lock–up
E/G stalls when starting off and stopping
1 st2nd
No up–shift
2nd3rd
3rdO/D
No down shift 2nd1 st
NR
Harsh engagement
Slip on shudder
ND
1 st2nd (D position)
2nd3rd
3rdO/D
Forward and reverse (After warm–up)
Forward and reverse (Directly after E/G start)
R position
1 st
2nd
2nd3rd (Up–shift)
3rd
O/D
1 st 3rd
No engine braking
Poor acceleration
2nd
A11 positions
O/D
Other than O/D
Other than 2nd
1 st and 2nd
1 st and R position
R position
O/D brake (Bo)
Direct Clutch (C2)
Forward clutch
(C1 )
O/D direct clutch
(CO)
Symptom
Parking lock pawl
Suspect Area
Torque converter
clutch
See page
–
Rear planetary
gear
Front planetary
gear
O/D planetary
gear
No.2 one–way
clutch IF21
No. 1 one–way
clutch (F i )
O/D one–way
clutch (FD)
1 st and reverse
brake (B3)
Second brake (621
2nd coast brake
(B, )
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
TROUBLESHOOTING
AX2–85
AX2–86
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
LOCATION OF CONNECTORS
Location of Connectors in Engine Compartment
Data Link Connector 1
Electronic Controlled
Transaxle Connector
Junction Connector
EF 1
Park/neutral Position
SW
O/D Direct Clutch
Speed Sensor
AX2–87
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Location of Connectors in Body
Sedan
Light Failure Sensor
AX2–88
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Location of Connectors in Instrument Panel
Combination Meter
E6
Electronic Controlled Transaxle
Pattern Select Switch
C11
Combination Meter
Engine Control Module
C16
Cruise Control ECU
Engine Control Module
AX2–89
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Engine Control Module
Noise Filter
Noise Filter
Junction Connector
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
E10
Engine Control Module
112
Ignition SW and
Unlock Warning SW
S10
Stop Light Switch
O/D Main SW
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
112
IP3
Ia1
1P1
AX2–90
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
J/B No.1
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
AX2–91
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
J/B No.2
J/B No–3
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
AX2–92
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC P0720 Output Speed Sensor Circuit Malfunction
(For Electronically Controlled Transaxle)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The vehicle speed sensor outputs a 4–pulse signal for every revolution of the transaxle differential.
After this signal has been converted into a more precise rectangular wave form by the wave form shaping
circuit inside the combination meter, it is then transmitted to the ECM.
Transaxle
DTC No.
P0720
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
When DTC No. P0500 is detected
Trouble Area
• Same as for DTC No. P0500
< Reference >
• Waveform between terminals SP 1 and E l when
vehicle speed is approx. 20 km/h (12 MPH).
HINT: The greater the vehicle speed, the greater
the number of VSS signals produced.
AX2–93
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Measure voltage between terminals SP 1
and E, of ECM connector.
Go to step
Measure voltage between terminal 14 of
combination meter center connector and
body ground.
Check for open circuit between
ECM and combination meter.
Check combination meter.
Check continuity between terminal SP1 of
ECM connector and body ground.
Replace ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Check for short circuit between
ECM, cruise control ECU and com–
bination meter.
AX2–94
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Measure voltage between terminals SP 1 and E 1 of ECM connector.
1. Disconnect cruise control ECU connector.
2. Turn IG switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminals SP1 and E1 of
ECM connector.
Voltage: 5 V
Go to step
Measure voltage between terminal 14 of combination meter center
connector and body ground.
1. Remove the combination meter, but do not
disconnect the connectors.
2. Turn 1 G switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminal 4 of combina–
tion meter connector and body ground.
Voltage: 5 V
Check for open circuit between ECM
and combination meter.
Check combination meter.
AX2–95
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Check continuity between terminal SP1 of ECM connector and body
ground.
Disconnect connector from ECU.
Check continuity between terminal SP1 of ECM
connector and body ground.
No continuity
Check for short circuit between ECM, cruise
control ECU and combination meter.
Replace ECM.
AX2–96
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DTC P0750 Shift Solenoid A Malfunction Shift Solenoid No.1
DTC P0755 Shift Solenoid B Malfunction Shift Solenoid No.2
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ECM uses signals from the NC2 revolution sensor and vehicle speed sensor to detect the actual gear
position(1 st, 2nd, 3rd or O/D gear).
Then the ECM compares the actual gear with the shift schedule in the ECM memory to detect mechanical
trouble of the shift solenoid valves and valve body.
DTC No.
P0750
P0755
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
During normal driving the gear required by the
ECM does not match the actual gear.
(2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
• Shift solenoid valve No.1lNo.2 is stuck
open or closed.
• Valve body is blocked up or stuck.
Check the No. 1 solenoid when diagnostic trouble code P0750 is output and check No.2 solenoid when
diagnostic trouble code P0755 is output
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check solenoid valve No. 1 or No. 2 opera–
tion.
Replace No. 1 or No. 2 solenoid
valve.
Check valve body (See page AX2–82).
Repair or replace valve body.
Repair or replace transaxle (See page AX2–27).
AX2–97
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check solenoid valve No. 1 or No.2 operation.
1. Remove the oil pan.
2. Remove the No. 1 or No. 2 solenoid valve.
1. Applying 490 kPa (5 kg/flcm2, 71 psi) of com–
pressed air, check that the solenoid valves do
not leak the air.
2. When battery voltage is supplied to the
solenoid valves, check that the solenoid valves
open.
Replace No. 1 or No.2 solenoid valve.
Check valve body (See page AX2–82).
Repair or replace valve body.
Repair or replace transaxle (See page AX2–27).
AX2–98
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DTC P0753 Shift Solenoid A Electrical Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid Valve No. 7)
DTC P0758 Shift Solenoid B Electrical Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid Valve No. 2)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ECM controls the shifting from 1st to O/D in combination with ON and OFF of the shift solenoid valves
No. 1 and No. 2. If an open or short circuit occurs in either of the shift solenoid valves, the ECM controls the
remaining normal shift solenoid valve to allow the vehicle to be operated smoothly (Fail safe function).
Fail Safe Function
If either of the shift solenoid valve circuits develops an open or a short, the ECM turns the other shift
solenoid ON and OFF to shift to the gear positions shown in the table below. The ECM also turns the shift
solenoid valve SL OFF at the same time. If both solenoids malfunction, hydraulic control cannot be perform–
ed electronically and must be done manually.
Manual shifting as shown in the following table must be done. (in the case of a short circuit, the ECM stops
sending current to the short circuited solenoid).
NO. 1 SOLENOID
MALFUNCTIONING
NORMAL
Position
Solenoid valve
No. 1
No. 2
OFF
Gear
Solenoid valve
No. 1
No.2
1 st
2nd
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
3rd
O/D
OFF
NO.2 SOLENOID
MALFUNCTIONING
Gear
Solenoid valve
No. 1
No. 2
BOTH SOLENOIDS
MALFUNCTIONING
Gear
Gear when shift selector
is manually operated
3rd
1 st
O/D
3rd
OFF
O/D
O/D
3rd
O/D
OFF
O/D
O/D
OFF
O/D
O/D
1 st
3rd
1 st
O/D
2nd
3rd
OFF
O/D
O/D
3rd
1 st
OFF
O/D
O/D
3rd
1 st
2nd
OFF
1 st
1 st
2nd
1 st
x; Malfunctions
Check the shift solenoid valve No. 1 when diagnostic trouble code P0753 is output and check the shift
solenoid valve No.2 when diagnostic trouble code P0758 is output.
DTC No.
P0753
P0758
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Short or open in shift solenoid valve No. 1 l No. 2
circuit.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Shift solenoid valve No. 1 INo.2 circuit.
Shift solenoid valve No. 1lNo.2.
ECM
AX2–99
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Measure resistance between S 1 or S2 ter–
minal of ECM connector and body ground.
Check harness and connector between
ECM and automatic transaxle solenoid connector.
Inspect No.1 or No.2 solenoid valve.
Repair or replace solenoid wire.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Replace ECM.
Repair or replace harness or con–
nector.
Replace malfunctioned solenoid
valve.
AX2–100
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Measure resistance between S 1 or S2 terminals of ECM connector and
body ground.
Measure resistance between S 1 or S2 terminals of
ECM connector and body ground.
Resistance: 10–16 9
Replace ECM.
Check harness and connector between ECM and automatic
transaxle solenoid connector.
Disconnect the solenoid connector on the
automatic transaxle.
Check harness and connector between S 1 and S2
terminals of ECM connector and 3 terminals of
solenoid connector.
There is no open and no short circuit.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
AX2–101
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Check No. 1 or No.2 solenoid valves.
1. Jack up the vehicle.
2. Remove oil pan.
3. Disconnect solenoid connector.
4. Remove No. 1 or No. 2 solenoid valve.
Measure resistance between solenoid connector
and body ground.
Resistance: 10–16 Ω
Connect positive lead to terminal of solenoid
connector, negative lead to solenoid body
The solenoid makes an operating noise.
Replace solenoid valve.
Repair or replace solenoid wire.
AX2–102
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DTC P0770 Shift Solenoid E Malfunction (Shift Solenoid
Valve SL)
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ECM uses the signals from the NC2 revolution sensor and
crankshaft position sensor to monitor the engagement condition of
the lock–up clutch.
Then the ECM compares the engagement condition of the lock–up
clutch with the lock–up schedule in the ECM memory to detect
mechanical trouble of the shift solenoid valve SL, valve body and
torque converter.
DTC No.
P0770
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Lock–up does not occur when driving in the lock–
up range (normal driving at 50mph [80kmlh]. Or
lock–up remains ON in the lock–up OFF range. (2
trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
•
Shift solenoid valve SL is stuck open or
closed.
•
•
Valve body, blocked up or stuck.
Lock–up clutch.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check solenoid valve SL operation.
Replace solenoid valve SL.
Check valve body (See page AX2–82).
Repair or replace valve body.
Replace torque converter clutch (See page AX2–27).
AX2–103
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check solenoid valve SL operation.
Remove SL solenoid valve from valve body.
1. Applying 490 kPa (5 kgf/cm2, 71 psi)of com–
pressed air, check that the solenoid valves do
not leak air.
2. When battery voltage is supplied to the
solenoid valves, check that the solenoid valves
open.
Replace solenoid valve SL.
Check valve body (See page AX2–82).
Repair or replace valve body.
Replace torque converter clutch.
AX2–104
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DTC P0773 Shift Solenoid E Electrical Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid Valve SL)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The shift solenoid valve SL is turned ON and OFF by signals from the ECM to control the hydraulic pressure acting on the lock–up relay valve, which then controls operation of the lock–up clutch.
Fail Safe Function
If the ECM detects a malfunction, it turns the shift solenoid valve SL OFF.
DTC No.
P0773
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Open or short in shift solenoid SL circuit for 1
time. (2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
Trouble Area
Open or short in shift solenoid valve SL cir–
cuit.
Shift solenoid valve SL.
ECM
AX2–105
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Measure resistance between terminals SL
and E, of ECM connector.
Replace ECM.
Check harness and connector between
ECM and automatic transaxle.
Repair or replace harness or con–
nector between ECM and automatic
transaxle solenoid connector.
Check SL solenoid valve.
Replace SL solenoid valve.
Check and replace or repair the solenoid wire.
WIRING DIAGRAM
AX2–106
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Measure resistance between terminals SL of ECM connector and body
ground.
Disconnect connector from the ECM.
Measure resistance between terminals SL and E, of
the ECM.
Resistance: 8–100,000
Replace ECM.
Check harness and connector between ECM and automatic transaxle.
1. Disconnect the connector from the ECM.
2. Disconnect the solenoid connector from the
transaxle.
Check harness between terminal SL of the ECM
connector and terminal 3 of automatic transaxle
solenoid connector.
There is no open or short circuit.
Repair or replace harness or connector bet
ween ECM connector and automatic transaxle solenoid connector.
AX2–107
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
1.
2.
3.
4.
Jack–up the vehicle.
Remove oil pan.
Disconnect SL solenoid valve connector.
Remove SL solenoid valve.
Check SL solenoid valve.
Measure resistance between SL solenoid connec–
tor terminal and its body ground.
Resistance: 10–16 9
Check SL solenoid valve operation noise when
applying battery voltage to the solenoid connec–
tor terminal and it’s body.
The SL solenoid valve makes operation noise.
Replace SL solenoid valve.
Check and replace or repair the solenoid wire.
AX2–108
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DTC Pl705 “NC2” Revolution Sensor Circuit Malfunction
(Direct Clutch Speed Sensor)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This sensor detects the rotation speed of the direct clutch drum.
By comparing the direct clutch speed signal and the vehicle speed
sensor signal, the ECM detects the shift timing of the gears and ap–
propriately controls the engine torque and hydraulic pressure in
response to various conditions, thus performing smooth gear shif–
ting.
DTC No.
P1705
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Out put of direct clutch speed sensor (NC2) is
300 rpm or less under condition a) and b).
a) Vehicle speed: 32 km/h (20 mph) or more
b) Park/neutral position switch: OFF
(2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
• Open or short in direct clutch speed sen–
sor circuit.
• Direct clutch speed sensor.
• ECM
AX2–109
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check resistance between terminals NC2+
and NC2–of ECM connector.
Replace ECM.
Check direct clutch speed sensor.
Replace direct clutch speed sen–
sor.
Check and repair harness and connector between
ECM and O/D direct clutch speed sensor.
WIRING DIAGRAM
AX2–110
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check resistance between terminals NC2+ and NC2–of ECM connector.
Check resistance between terminals NC2+ and
NC2–of ECM connector.
Resistance: 560–680 9
Replace ECM.
Check direct clutch speed sensor.
Remove direct clutch speed sensor.
(See page AX2–1 5)
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of
speed sensor.
Resistance: 560–680
Reference
Check the speed sensor’s function
Check voltage between terminals 1 and 2 of the
speed sensor when a magnet is put close to the
front end of the speed sensor then taken away
quickly.
Voltage is generated intermittently.
The voltages generated is extremely low.
Replace direct clutch speed sensor.
Check and repair harness and connector between
ECM and direct clutch speed sensor.
AX2–111
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–MEMO–
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
AX2–112
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DTC P1765 Shift Solenoid Valve SLN Circuit (For
Accumulator Back Pressure Modulation)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The shift solenoid valve SLN controls the hydraulic pressure acting
on the accumulator control valve when gears are shifted and per–
forms smooth gear shifting.
The ECM determines optimum operating pressure according to the
signals from the throttle position sensor, vehicle speed sensor and
direct clutch speed sensor and controls the volume of current flow
to the solenoid valve.
The amount of current to the solenoid is controlled by the (*) duty
ratio of ECM output signals, causing a momentary change to the
hydraulic pressure acting on the clutches during gear shifting.
When the duty ratio is high, the hydraulic pressure acting on the
clutches is low.
(*) Duty Ratio
The duty ratio is the ratio of the period of continuity in one cycle.
For example, if A is the period of continuity in one cycle, and B is the period of non–continuity, then
Duty Ratio = A
X 100%
A+B
DTC No.
P1765
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
After the engine is warmed up, the current flow
to the shift solenoid valve SLN is 0.2A or less for
at least 1 sec. under condition ay or b).
(2 trip detection logic)
aj Engine speed: 500 rpm or more
b) Park/neutral position switch: ON
(P or N position)
< Reference >
• Waveform between terminals SLN–
and E 1 when engine is idling.
Trouble Area
• Open or short in shift solenoid valve SLN
circuit.
• Shift solenoid valve SLN.
• ECM
• Waveform between terminals SLN–
and E 1 during shift change.
AX2–113
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check solenoid valve SLN.
Check harness and connector between bat–
tery and solenoid valve SLN, solenoid valve SLN
and ECM (See page IN–31 ).
Replace ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Replace solenoid valve SLN.
Repair or replace harness or con–
nector.
AX2–114
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check shift solenoid valve SLN.
Check solenoid resistance
1. Jack up the vehicle.
2. Remove oil pan.
3. Disconnect the connector.
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of
solenoid connector.
Resistance: 5.1–5.5 9
Check solenoid operation
Connect positive lead with an 8–10 w bulb to
terminal 1 of solenoid connector and negative
lead to terminal 2, then check the movement of the
valve.
When battery voltage
is applied.
Valve moves in mm1
direction in illustration.
(on the left)
When battery voltage
is cut off.
Valve moves in
direction in illustration.
(on the right)
< Reference >
Check solenoid operation
1. Prepare a variable power supply.
2. Connect positive lead of the variable power
supply to terminal 1 of solenoid connector and
negative 0 lead to terminal 2.
3. Check the movement of the valve when the
voltage is gradually increased. (A current
greater than 1 A should not be supplied.)
As the voltage is increased, the valve should move
slowly in the
direction.
4. Check the movement of the valve when the
voltage is cut off.
The valve should return in the
Replace solenoid valve SLN.
direction.
AX2–115
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Check harness and connector between battery and shift solenoid valve
SLN, shift solenoid valve SLN and ECM (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Replace ECM.
AX2–116
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DTC P1780 Park Neutral Position Switch Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The park/neutral position switch detects the shift lever position and sends signals to ECM.
The ECM receives signals (R, NSW, 2 and L) from the park/neutral position switch. When the signal is not
sent to the ECM from the park/neutral position switch, the ECM judges that the shift lever is in the D posi–
tion.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Two or more switches are ON simultaneously for
”N”, ”2” and ”L” position.
(2 trip detection logic)
P 1780
When driving under conditions a) and b) for 30
seconds or more, the park/neutral position switch
is ON (N position).
(2 trip detection logic)
a) Vehicle speed: 44 mph (70 km/h) or
more
b) Engine speed: 1,500–2,500 rpm
• Short in park/neutral position switch
circuit
• Park/neutral position switch
• ECM
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage between terminal R, NSW,
2, L of ECM connector and body ground.
Proceed to next circuit inspection
shown on matrix chart (See page
AX2–8 1 ).
Check PNP switch.
Replace PNP switch.
Check harness and connector between
ECM and PNP switch, PNP switch and bat–
tery.
Check and replace ECM.
Repair or replace harness or con–
nector.
AX2–117
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
AX2–118
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminal R, NSW, 2, L of ECM connector and body
ground.
Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminals R, NSW, 2, L
of ECM connector and body ground when the shift
lever is shifted to the following positions.
Position
R–body
ground
NSW–body 2–body
ground
ground
L–body
ground
P, N
10–14V*
10–14V*
10–14V
10–14V
10–14V
10–14 V
10–14V
*: The voltage will drop slightly due to lighting up of the
back up light.
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
matrix chart (See page AX2–81 ).
Check PNP switch.
Remove PNP switch (See page AX2–16).
Check continuity between each terminal shown
below when the shift lever is shifted to each posi–
tion.
Continuity
Terminal
Shift
Position
Replace PNP switch.
AX2–119
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Check harness and connector between ECM and PNP switch, PNP
switch and battery.
Repair or replace harness and connector.
Check and replace ECM.
AX2–120
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
OD Cancel Signal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
While driving uphill with cruise control activated, in order to minimize gear shifting and provide smooth cruis–
ing, overdrive may be prohibited temporarily in some conditions.
The cruise control ECU sends O/D cut signals to the ECM as necessary and the ECM cancels overdrive shif–
ting until these signals are discontinued.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage between terminal OD 1 of
ECM connector and body ground.
Proceed to next circuit inspection
shown on matrix chart (See Page
AX2–81).
Check voltage between terminal OD of
cruise control ECU harness side connector
and body ground.
Check and replace cruise control
ECU.
Check harness and connector between
cruise control ECU and ECM.
Check and replace ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Repair or replace harness or con–
nector.
AX2–121
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminal OD 1 of ECM connector and body ground.
Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminal OD 1 of ECM
connector and body ground.
Voltage: 4–6 V
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart (See page AX2–81).
Check voltage between terminal OD of cruise control ECU harness side
connector and body ground.
1. Disconnect cruise control ECU connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminal OD of cruise
control ECU harness side connector and body
ground.
Voltage: 4–6 V
Check and replace cruise control ECU.
Check harness or connector between cruise control ECU and ECM.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECM.
AX2–122
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
OD Main Switch & OD OFF Indicator Light Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The O/D main switch contacts go off when the switch is pushed in and come on when it is pushed out. In
O/D main switch OFF position, the O/D OFF indicator lights up, and the ECM prohibits shifting to overdrive.
The ECM also causes the O/D OFF indicator light to blink when a malfunction is detected. In this case, con–
necting the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3 can display the diagnostic trouble
code.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
O/D OFF indicator light does not light up.
Check operation of O/D main switch.
Check voltage between terminal OD2 of
ECM connector and body ground.
Check. harness and connector between
O/D off indicator light and ECM.
Go to step
Proceed to next circuit inspection
shown on matrix chart (See page AX–81 ).
Repair or replace harness or con–
nector.
Check and replace ECM.
Check O/D main switch.
Check and replace combination meter.
(See combination meter troubleshooting)
Replace O/D main switch.
AX2–123
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
O/D OFF indicator light remains ON
Check O/D main switch.
Replace O/D main switch.
Check harness and connector between
O/D off indicator light and O/D main
switch, O/D off indicator light and ECM.
Repair or replace harness or con–
nector.
Check and replace ECM.
O/D OFF indicator light blinks
Perform diagnostic code check (See page AX2–55).
WIRING DIAGRAM
( * ) O/D Main Switch
Contacts go off with switch pushed in.
Contacts go on with switch pushed out.
AX2–124
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check operation of O/D Main Switch.
1. Turn ignition switch ON
2. Check ”O/D OFF” light when O/D main switch
is pushed in to ON.
“O/D OFF” light goes off.
3. Check ”O/D OFF” light when O/D main switch
is pushed again, to OFF.
“O/D OFF” light lights up.
If the–O/D OFF” lights blinks when the O/D main
switch is pushed in to ON, a malfunction is occurr–
ing in the system.
Check the diagnostic trouble code.
Go to step
Check voltage between terminal OD2 of ECM connector and body
ground.
Turn ignition switch ON.
Check voltage between terminal OD2 of ECM and
body ground.
O/D Main Switch
OFF
Voltage
Below 1 V
10 ^–14 V
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart (See page AX2–81).
AX2–125
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Check harness and connector between O/D off indicator light and ECM.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECM.
Check O/D Main Switch.
1. Disconnect O/D main switch connector.
2. Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 3
of O/D main switch connector.
O/D Main Switch
Resistance
^ 9 (open)
OFF
0 S2 (continuity)
Replace O/D Main Switch.
Check and replace combination meter. (See com–
bination meter troubleshooting.)
AX2–126
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Pattern Select Switch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ECM memory contains the shift programs for the NORMAL and POWER patterns, 2 position, and L
position and the lockup patterns. Following the programs corresponding to the signals from the pattern
select switch, the park/neutral position switch and other various sensors the ECM switches the solenoid
valves ON and OFF, thereby controlling the transaxle gear change and the lockup clutch operation.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage between terminal P of ECM
connector and body ground.
Proceed to next circuit inspection
shown on matrix chart (See page
AX2–81 ) .
Check pattern select switch.
Replace pattern select switch.
Check harness and connector between
ECM and pattern select switch, pattern
select switch and battery (See page IN–31 ).
Check and replace ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Repair or replace harness or con–
nector.
AX2–127
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminal P of ECM connector and body ground.
Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminal P of ECM con–
nector and body ground when the pattern select
switch is set to the PWR (POWER) position and
NORM (NORMAL) position.
Voltage
Pattern select switch
10–14 V
PW R
Below 1 V
NORM
The ECU uses the normal pattern signal if the
power signal is not input.
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart (See page AX2–81).
Check pattern select switch.
Disconnect pattern select switch connector.
(See BO–section)
Measure resistance between terminals 3 and 6 of
pattern select switch connector when the select
switch is set to PWR and NORM positions.
Pattern
Resistance
PWR
0 Q (continuity)
NORM
^ 0 (open)
Replace pattern select switch.
Check harness and connector between ECM and pattern select switch,
pattern select switch, pattern select switch and battery (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECM.
AX2–128
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Stop Light Switch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The purpose of this circuit is to prevent the engine from stalling, while driving in lockup condition, when
brakes are suddenly applied.
When the brake pedal is operated, this switch sends a signal to ECM. Then the ECM cancels operation of the
lockup clutch while braking is in progress.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check operation of stop light.
Check and repair stop light circuit.
Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester and
check STP signal.
Proceed to next circuit inspection
shown on matrix chart (See page
AX2–8 1 ).
Check harness and connector between
ECM and stop light switch.
Repair or replace harness or con–
nector.
Check and replace ECM.
AX2–129
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
AX2–130
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check operation of stop light.
Check if the stop lights go on and off normally
when the brake pedal is operated and released.
Check and repair stop light circuit.
Connect TOYOTA hand–held tester and check STP signal.
1. Remove the fuse cover on the instrument
panel.
2. Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the
DLC 3 (OBD II connector).
3. Turn ignition switch ON and TOYOTA hand–
held tester main switch ON.
Read the STP signal on the TOYOTA hand–held
tester.
Brake pedal is depressed: STP ON
Brake pedal is released: STP OFF
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart (See page AX2–81).
Check harness and connector between ECM and stop light switch.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECM.
AX2–131
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE DATA
Line pressure (whell locked)
Engine idling
D position
R position
AT stall
D position
R position
Engine stall revolution
N position–D position
N position–R position
Time lag
Engine idle speed (Cooling fan and A/C OFF)
N position
Throttle cable adjustment (Throttle valve fully opened)
Torque converter clutch runout
Drive plate runout
Limit
Limit
SHIFT POINT
Shift position
Shifting point
Vehicle speed km/h (mph)
Throttle valve fully opened
D position
Throttle valve fully closed
Throttle valve fully opened
2 position
L position
Throttle valve fully opened
LOCK–UP POINT
D position km/h (mph)
Throttle valve opening 596
3rd Gear (O/D switch OFF)
O/D Gear
Lock–up ON
Lock–up OFF
AX2–132
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part tightened
N–m
Engine front mounting bracket x Front suspention menber
Engine rear mounting bracket x Front suspention menber
LH transaxle mounting
Transaxle x Engine
12mm bolt
Transaxle x Engine
10mm bolt
Torque converter clutch x Drive–plate
Valve body x Transaxle case
Oil strainer
Oil pan
Oil pan drain plug
Park/Neutral position switch x Transaxle case (bolt)
Park/Neutral position switch (nut)
B, apply tube retainer
Manual valve body
Detent spring
Oil tube bracket
Steering gear housing x Front suspention Menber
Stabilizer bar bracket
Vehicle speed sensor
Direct clutch speed sensor
Transfer lubulication apply tube retainer
Exhaust manifold plate
Front frame x Body
19 mm
Front frame x Body
12 mm
Front frame x Body
Nut
Exhaust front pipe x Exhaust tale pipet
Exhaust manifold x Exhaust front pipe
Exhaust pipe clamp
Starter
Throttle cable adjusting nut
kgf–cm
ft–lbf
BE–1
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
BE–2
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
GENERAL INFORMATION
GENERAL INFORMATION
WIRING COLOR CODE
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B=Black
L=Blue
R=Red
BR=Brown LG=Light Green V =Violet
G=Green
O=Orange
W=White
GR=Gray
P=Pink Y
=Yellow
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the
second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
CONNECTOR
1. PIN NUMBER OF FEMALE CONNECTOR
Numbered in order from upper left to lower right.
2. PIN NUMBER OF MALE CONNECTOR
Numbered in order from upper right to lower left.
HINT: When connectors with different of the same
number of terminals are used with the same parts,
each connector name (letter of the alphabet) and pin
number is specified.
3. DISTINCTION OF MALE AND FEMALE CONNEC–
TORS
Male and female connectors are distinguished by
shape of their internal pins.
(a) All connectors are –shown from the open end, and the
lock is on top.
(b) To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector
itself, not the wires.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are
disconnecting before pulling apart.
BE–3
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
GENERAL INFORMATION
HOW TO REPLACE TERMINAL
(with terminal retainer or secondary locking device)
1. PREPARE THE SPECIAL TOOL
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector,
please construct and use the special tool or like object
shown on the left.
2. DISCONNECT CONNECTOR
3. DISENGAGE THE SECONDARY LOCKING DEVICE
OR TERMINAL RETAINER
(a) Locking device must be disengaged before the termi–
nal locking clip can be released and the terminal re–
moved from the connector.
(b) Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the
secondary locking device or terminal retainer.
NOTICE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from con–
nector body.
(c) Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the
terminal out from rear.
4. INSTALL TERMINAL TO CONNECTOR
(a) Insert the terminal.
HINT:
1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly.
2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug locks firmly.
3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the
temporary lock position.
(b) Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer
in to the full lock position.
5. CONNECT CONNECTOR
BE–4
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
GENERAL INFORMATION
FUSE REPLACEMENT
HINT: If replacing the fuse be sure to replace it with a
fuse with an equal amperage rating.
NOTICE:
•
Turn off all electrical components and the ignition
switch before replacing a fuse or fusible link. Do
not exceed the fuse or fusible link amperage rating.
•
Always use a fuse puller for removing and inserting
a fuse. Remove and insert straight in and out with–
out twisting. Twisting could force open the termi–
nals too much, resulting in a bad connection.
If a fuse or fusible link continues to blow, a short
circuit is indicated. The system must be checked by a
qualified technician.
HINT: The puller is located at Junction Block No.2.
BE–5
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
GENERAL INFORMATION
VOLTAGE CHECK
(a) Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the
check point.
Example:
A–Ignition SW on
B–Ignition SW and SW 1 on
C–Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on (SW 2 off)
(b) Using a voltmeter, connect the negative (–) lead to a
good ground point or negative (–) battery terminal
and the positive (+) lead to the connector or compo–
nent terminal. This check can be done with a test bulb
instead of a voltmeter.
CONTINUITY AND RESISTANCE CHECK
(a) Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no
voltage between the check points.
(b) Contact the 2 leads of an ohmmeter to each of the
check points.
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the 2 leads and check
again.
When contacting the negative (–) lead to the diode
positive (+) side and the positive (+) lead to the
negative (–) side, there should be continuity. When
contacting the 2 leads in reverse, there should be no
continuity.
HINT: Specifications may vary depending on the type
of tester, so refer to the tester’s instruction manual
before performing the inspection.
Check LED (Light Emitting Diode) in the same manner
as that for diodes.
HINT:
• Use a tester with a power source of 3 V or
greater to overcome the circuit resistance.
• If a suitable tester is not available, apply battery
positive voltage and check that the LED lights up.
BE–6
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
GENERAL INFORMATION
(c) Use a volt/ohmmeter with high impedance (10 k/V
minimum) for troubleshooting of the electrical circuit.
BULB CHECKING
(a) Remove the bulb.
(b) There should be continuity between the respective
terminals of the bulb together with a certain amount
of resistance.
(c) Apply the 2 leads of the ohmmeter to each of the
terminals.
(d) Apply battery positive voltage and check that the bulb
lights up.
SHORT CIRCUIT CHECK
(a) Remove the blown fuse and eliminate all loads from
the fuse.
(b) Connect a test bulb in place of the fuse.
(c) Establish conditions in which the test bulb comes on.
Example:
A–Ignition SW on
B–Ignition SW and SW 1 on
C–Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on (Connect the
Relay) and SW 2 off (or Disconnect SW 2)
(d) Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while wat–
ching the test bulb. The short lies between the con–
nector where the test bulb stays lit and the connector
where the bulb goes out.
(e) Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking
the problem wire along the body.
BE–7
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
PRECAUTION
PRECAUTION
Take care to observe the following precautions when performing inspections or remOval and
replacement of body electrical related parts.
HEADLIGHT SYSTEM
• Halogen bulbs have pressurized gas inside and require special handling. They can burst or
scatter if scratched or dropped. Hold a bulb only by its plastic or metal case.
Don’t touch the glass part of a bulb with bare hands.
SRS (SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM)
• Work must be started after 90 seconds from the time the ignition switch is turned to the
”LOCK” position and the negative (–) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery.
• When disconnecting any of the connectors in the SRS, be sure to lock the ignition switch and
disconnect the negative (–) terminal cable from the battery first. Since the connectors are
twin lock type connectors, disconnect the connectors only after releasing the first stage
lock.
• When connecting SRS connectors, be sure to lock them securely. (If the connectors are not
locked securely, the system may not operate when needed.)
• Always store the steering wheel pad with the pad surface facing upward. (Storing the pad
with its metallic surface up may lead to a serious accident if the air bag inflates for some
reason.)
• When installing the spiral cable, be sure the vehicle is in the straight ahead condition and
confirm that the spiral cable is in the neutral position when it is installed. (See page BE–28)
• INFORMATION LABELS (NOTICE) are attached to the periphery of the air bag components.
Follow the NOTICE.
AUDIO SYSTEM
• If the negative (–) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery, the preset AM, FM 1 and
FM 2 stations stored in memory are erased, so be sure to note the stations and reset them
after the battery terminal is reconnected.
• If the negative (–) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery, the ”ANTI–THEFT
SYSTEM” will operate when the cable is reconnected, but the radio, tape player and CD
player will not operate. Be sure to input the correct ID number so that the radio, tape player
and CD player can be operated again.
MOBILE COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
• If the vehicle is equipped with a mobile communication system, refer to precautions in the IN
section.
BE–8
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
PREPARATION
PREPARATION
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
09213–31021 Crankshaft Pulley Puller
For removing steering wheel
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09062–00050 TOYOTA Electrical Tester Set
09041–00030 Torx Driver T30
For removing and installing
steering wheel pad
09042–00010 Torx Socket T30
For removing and installing
steering wheel pad
EQUIPMENT
Voltmeter
Ammeter
Ohmmeter
Test lead
Syphon
Bulb (3.4 W)
Brake fluid level warning switch
Bulb (21 W)
Turn signal flasher relay
Dry cell battery
Fuel sender gauge
Fuel sender gauge, Seat belt warning relay
Torque wrench
Masking tape
Rear window defogger wire
Tin foil
Rear window defogger wire
BE–9
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
POWER SOURCE
POWER SOURCE
PARTS LOCATION
BE–10
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
POWER SOURCE
Junction Block No.2
MEDIUM CURRENT FUSES
1. MAIN 40A
2. RDI 30A
3. CDS 30A
FUSES
4. –
5. EFI 15A
15A
6. HORN 10A
10A
7. OBD, TRAC 7.5A
7.5A
8. HAZ 1 OA
10A
20A
9. DOME 20A
15A
10. H–LP LH 15A
15A
11. H–LP RH 15A
7.5A
12. ALT 7.5A
30A
13. AMZ 30A
15A
14. ECU–B 15A
SHORT
15. D.C.
C. SHORT
RELAYS
A. EFI Relay
B. Starter Relay
C. HORN Relay
D. HEAD (Headlight Control) Relay
E. ENG MAI
N. FR–DEF Relay
F. FAN Relay
Junction Block No. 1 (Rear Side)
A. Noise Filter
MEDIUM CURRENT FUSES
a. AM 1 40A
b. POWER 30A
c. DEFOG 40A
FUSES
1. ECU–IG 15A
15A
2. GAUGE 10A
10A
15A
3. STOP 15A
20A
4.
7.5A
5. WIPER 20A
7.5A
6. TURN 7.5A
15A
7. 1G2 7.5A
10A
8. CIGI RADIO 15A
15A
9. MIR HTR 10A
15A
10. TAIL 15A
11. ECU–S 15A
12. –
RELAY
B. Integration Relay
BE–11
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
POWER SOURCE
Junction Block No. 1 (Front Side)
RELAYS
A. Power Main Relay
B. Taillight Control Relay
C. Defogger Relay
Relay Block No–1
FUSE
1. ST Fuse 10A
RELAY
A. Turn Signal Flasher
Relay Block No.4
FUSES
Medium Current Fuse
1. HEATER 40A
Fuse
2. A/C 1 OA
RELAY
A. Heater Relay
BE–12
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
POWER SOURCE
Relay Block No.5
• 5S–FE Engine
FUSES
1. HEAD RH (Lo) 15A (CANADA)
2. HEAD LH (Lo) 15A (CANADA)
RELAYS
A. Daytime Running Light Relay No.2 (CANADA)
B. Magnet Clutch Relay
C. FAN No.2 Relay
D. FAN No.3 Relay
• 1 MZ–FE Engine
Relay Block No.6
FUSES
1. –––
2. –––
3. HEAD RH (Lo) 15A (CANADA)
4. HEAD LH (Lo) 15A (CANADA)
RELAYS
A. Daytime Running Light Relay No.2 (CANADA)
6. Magnet Clutch Relay
C. Fuse Pump Relay
RELAY
A. Circuit Opening Relay
Relay Block No.7 (CANADA)
FUSE
1. DRL 7.5A
RELAYS
A. DRL No.4 Relay
B. DRL No.3 Relay
BE–13
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
POWER SOURCE
WIRING DIAGRAM
BE–14
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
IGNITION SWITCH
IGNITION SWITCH
PARTS LOCATION
IGNITION SWITCH INSPECTION
INSPECT IGNITION SWITCH
Continuity
Inspect the switch continuity between terminals.
Switch position
Tester connection to
terminal number
LOCK
ACC
START
Specified value
No continuity
3–4
Continuity
2–3–4
9–10
Continuity
2–4–7
6–9–10
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
BE–15
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
KEY UNLOCK WARNING SYSTEM
KEY UNLOCK WARNING SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
KEY UNLOCK WARNING SWITCH
INSPECTION
INSPECT KEY UNLOCK WARNING SWITCH
Continuity
Inspect the switch continuity between terminals.
Condition
Tester connection to
terminal number
Switch OFF
(Key removed)
Switch ON
(Key set)
Specified value
No continuity
1–5
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
BE–16
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
KEY UNLOCK WARNING SYSTEM
INTEGRATION RELAY INSPECTION
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY
Relay Circuit/ Key Unlock Warning System
Remove the relay from the junction block No.1 and
inspect the connectors on the junction block side.
Tester connection to
terminal number
Condition
Specified value (Continuity)
A5 – Ground
Key unlock warning switch OFF
No continuity
A5 – Ground
Key unlock warning switch ON
Continuity
A6 – Ground
Driver’s door courtesy switch OFF
No continuity
A6 – Ground
Driver’s door courtesy switch ON
Continuity
A 10 – Ground
Constant
Continuity
Tester connection to
terminal number
A1 – Ground
Condition
Specified value (Voltage)
Battery positive voltage
A7 – Ground
Constant
Ignition switch position LOCK or ACC
No voltage
A7 – Ground
Ignition switch position ON
Battery positive voltage
If circuit is as specified, trying replacing the relay with
a new one.
Is circuit is not as specified, inspect the circuits con–
nected to other parts.
DOOR COURTESY SWITCH
See page BE–43.
BE–17
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT
SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
BE–18
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
BE–19
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
TROUBLESHOOTING
The table below will be useful for you in troubleshooting these electrical problems. The most
likely causes of the malfunction are shown in the order of their probability. Inspect each part in
the order shown, and replace the part when it is found to be faulty.
HEADLIGHT (USA)
Trouble
Parts name
Headlight does not light.
(Taillight is normal)
1. MAIN FL
2. Wire Harness
3. HEAD–(LH, RH) Fuse
4. Headlight Bulb
Headlight does not light.
(Taillight does not light up)
1. MAIN FL
2. Wire Harness
3. Headlight Control Relay
4. HEAD–(LH, RH) Fuse
5. Headlight Bulb
Only one side light does not light.
1. HEAD–(LH, RH) Fuse
2. Headlight Bulb
3. Wire Harness
”Lo– Beam” does not light.
1. Wire Harness
2. Headlight Bulb
3. Light Control Switch
”Hi–Beam” does not light.
’Flash” does not light.
”Auto Turn –off System” dose not operate.
(See page)
(BE–4)
(BE–30)
(BE–4)
(BE–4)
(BE–29)
1. Headlight Dimmer Switch
2. Wire Harness
3. Light Control Switch
(BE–29)
1. Headlight Dimmer Switch
2. Wire Harness
(BE–29)
1. Integration Relay
2. GAUGE Fuse
3. Ignition Switch
4. Door Courtesy Switch (Driver’s)
5. Wire Harness
6. DOME Fuse
(BE–31)
(BE–4)
(BE–14)
(BE–43)
(BE–29)
(BE–4)
BE–20
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
TAILLIGHT (USA)
Trouble
Parts name
(See page)
Taillight does not light. (Headlight does not light)
1. Light Control Switch
2. Integration Relay
3. Wire Harness
(BE–29)
(BE–31)
Taillight does not light.
(Headlight is normal)
1. TAIL Fuse
2. Taillight Control Relay
3. Light Control Switch
4. Integration Relay
5. Wire Harness
(BE–4)
(BE–30)
(BE–29)
(BE–31)
Only one side light does not light.
1. Bulb
2. Wire Harness
Rear Combination light does not light.
1. Wire Harness
2. Light Failure Sensor
3. Bulb
”Auto Turn–Off System” dose not operate.
1. Integration Relay
2. Wire Harness
3. GAUGE Fuse
4. Door Courtesy Switch (Driver’s)
(BE–73)
(BE–31)
(BE–4)
(BE–43)
BE–21
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
HEADLIGHT (CANADA)
Trouble
Parts name
(See page)
Headlight does not light. (Taillight is normal)
1. Wire Harness
Headlight does not light.
(Taillight does not light up)
1. MAIN FL
2. Wire Harness
(BE–4)
Only one side light does not light.
1. HEAD LO (LH, RH) Fuse
2. Headlight Bulb
3. Wire Harness
1. Headlight Control Relay
2. Light Control Switch
3. Integration Relay
4. Wire Harness
5. HEAD LO (LH, RH) Fuse
6. Headlight Bulb
(BE–30)
(BE–29)
(BE–31)
”Lo–Beam” does not light.
’Hi–Beam’ does not light.
”Flash” does n6t light.
’Auto Turn–off System’ does not operate.
1. DRL Fuse
2. Daytime Running Light Relay No.2
3. Daytime Running Light Relay (Main)
4. Daytime Running Light Relay No.3
5. Daytime Running Light Relay No.4
6. ECU – B Fuse
7. Headlight Dimmer Switch
8. Wire Harness
9. HEAD HI (LH, RH) Fuse
10. Headlight Bulb
1. DRL Fuse
2. Daytime Running Light Relay No.2
3. Daytime Running Light Relay (Main)
4. Daytime Running Light Relay No.3
5. Daytime Running Light Relay No.4
6. ECU – B Fuse
7. Headlight Dimmer Switch
8. Wire Harness
9. HEAD HI (LH, RH) Fuse
10. Headlight Bulb
1. Integration Relay
2. GAUGE Fuse
3. Ignition Switch
4. Door Courtesy Switch (Drivers)
5. Wire Harness
6. DOME Fuse
(BE–4)
(BE–4)
(BE–33)
(BE–32)
(BE–33)
(BE–34)
(BE–4)
(BE–29)
(BE–4)
(BE–4)
(BE–33)
(BE–32)
(BE–33)
(BE–34)
(BE–4)
(BE–29)
(BE–4)
(BE–31)
(BE–4)
(BE–14)
(BE–43)
(BE–4)
Headlight does not light with engine running and light control SW in
OFF.
*Terminal L of Generator and Parking Brake Switch
1. GAUGE Fuse
2. ECU – B Fuse
3’. Other Parts
4. Daytime Running Light Relay (Main)
5. Wire Harness
6. HEAD HI (LH, RH) Fuse
7. Headlight Bulb
(BE–4)
(BE–4)
(BE–32)
(BE–4)
BE–22
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
TAILLIGHT (CANADA)
Trouble
Parts name
(See page)
Taillight does not light.
(Headlight does not light)
1. Light Control Switch
2. Integration Relay
3. Wire Harness
(BE–29)
(BE–31)
Taillight does not light.
(Headlight is normal)
1. TAIL Fuse
2. Taillight Control Relay
3. Light Control Switch
4. Integration Relay
5. Wire Harness
(BE–4)
(BE–30)
(BE–29)
(BE–31)
Only one side light does not light.
1. Bulb
2. Wire Harness
Rear Combination light does not light.
1. Wire Harness
2. Light Failure Sensor
3. Bulb
”Auto Turn–Off System” does not operate.
1. Integration Relay
2. GAUGE Fuse
3. Wire Harness
4. Door Courtesy Switch (Driver’s)
*1: Terminal L of Generator and Parking Brake Switch
(BE–73)
(BE–31)
(BE–4)
(BE–43)
BE–23
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
HEADLIGHT AIM ADJUSTMENT
COMBINATION SWITCH REMOVAL
See page BO–108.
BE–24
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
COMBINATION SWITCH DISASSEMBLY
Components
BE–25
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
1. REMOVE WIRE HARNESS HOLDER NO.1
2. REMOVE TERMINALS FROM CONNECTOR
(a) Release the 4 tabs and open the terminal cover.
NOTICE: Do not remove terminal for SRS connector
(Yellow).
(b) From the open end, insert a miniature screwdriver
between the locking lug and terminal.
(c) Pry down the locking lug with the screwdriver and pull
the terminal out from the rear.
3. REMOVE WIRE HARNESS HOLDER NO. 2
(a) Remove the clamp.
(b) Pry loose 2 locking lugs.
(c) Remove the 2 screws and the wire harness holder No.
2.
4. REMOVE SPIRAL CABLE SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 4 screws and the spiral cable sub–
assembly.
BE–26
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
5. REMOVE WIRE HARNESS CLAMP
Remove the screw and the wire harness clamp.
6. REMOVE LIGHT CONTROL AND FOG LIGHT
SWITCH
(a) Remove the 2 screws and the ball set plate from the
switch body.
(b) Remove the ball and side out the switch from the
switch body with the spring.
7. REMOVE HEADLIGHT DIMMER AND TURN SIGNAL
SWITCH
Remove the 4 screws and the headlight dimmer and
turn signal switch from the switch body.
8. REMOVE WIPER AND WASHER SWITCH
Remove the 2 screws and the wiper and washer
switch from the switch body.
BE–27
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
COMBINATION SWITCH ASSEMBLY
INSTALL PARTS OF COMBINATION SWITCH IN RE–
VERSE SEQUENCE OF DISASSEMBLY
(MAIN POINT OF ASSEMBLY)
1. INSTALL LIGHT CONTROL SWITCH
(a) Slide the switch and install the switch body.
(b) Set the lever in the HI position, and install the ball and
plate.
(c) After installing the light control switch to the switch
body, insure that the switch operation is smooth.
2. INSTALL TERMINALS TO CONNECTOR
• Push in the terminal until it is securely locked in
the connector lug.
• Install each switch terminal, as shown in the
figure.
BE–28
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
COMBINATION SWITCH INSTALLATION
For installation, follow the removal procedure in re–
verse.
(MAIN POINT OF INSTALLATION)
ADJUSTMENT OF SPIRAL CABLE
(a) Check that the front wheels are facing straight ahead.
(b) Turn the spiral cable counterclockwise by hand until it
becomes harder to turn the cable.
(c) Then rotate the spiral cable clockwise about 3 turns to
align the red mark.
HINT:
•
The spiral cable will rotate about 3 turns to either
left or right of the center.
•
The connector should be straight up.
(d) Install the steering wheel so that the match marks will
not be misaligned.
BE–29
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
COMBINATION SWITCH INSPECTION
1. INSPECT LIGHT CONTROL SWITCH
Continuity
Inspect the switch continuity between terminals.
Switch position
Tester connection to
terminal number
OFF
TAIL
HEAD
Specified value
No continuity
A2 – All
A2 –All –A13
Continuity
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
2. INSPECT DIMMER SWITCH
Continuity
Inspect the switch continuity between terminals.
Switch position
Flash
Low beam
High beam
Tester connection to
terminal number
Specified value
A9–A12–A14
Continuity
A3 – A9
A9 – A12
Continuity
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
3. INSPECT TURN SIGNAL SWITCH
Continuity
Inspect the switch continuity between terminals.
Switch position
Tester connection to
terminal number
Left turn
A 1 – A5
Neutral
Right turn
Specified value
Continuity
No continuity
A 1 – A8
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
BE–30
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
HEADLIGHT CONTROL RELAY
INSPECTION
INSPECT HEADLIGHT CONTROL RELAY
Continuity
Inspect the relay continuity between terminals.
Condition
Constant
Apply B + between
terminals 1 and 2.
Tester connection to
terminal number
Specified value
1–2
Continuity
3–4
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
TAILLIGHT CONTROL RELAY INSPECTION
INSPECT TAILLIGHT CONTROL RELAY
Continuity
Inspect the relay continuity between terminals.
Condition
Constant
Apply B + between
terminals 1 and 2.
Tester connection to
terminal number
Specified value
1–2
Continuity
3–5
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR
See page BE–73.
BE–31
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
INTEGRATION RELAY INSPECTION
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY
Relay Circuit/ Light Auto Turn Off System
Remove the relay from junction block and inspect the
connectors on the wire harness and junction block
side, as shown in the chart.
Tester connection to
terminal number
Condition
Driver’s door courtesy switch OFF
Specified value (Continuity)
No continuity
Driver’s door courtesy switch ON
Continuity
Constant
Light control switch position OFF
Continuity
Light control switch position TAIL and
HEAD
No continuity
Continuity
Light control switch position OFF or TAIL
No continuity
Light control switch position HEAD
Continuity
Condition
Specified value (Voltage)
Constant
Battery positive voltage
Ignition switch position LOCK or ACC
No voltage
Ignition switch position ON
Battery positive voltage
Constant
Battery positive voltage
Constant
Battery positive voltage
If the circuit is as specified, trying replacing the relay
with a new one.
If the circuit is not as specified, inspect the circuits
connected to other parts.
BE–32
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY (MAIN)
INSPECTION (for CANADA)
INSPECT DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY
(MAIN)
Circuit/ Wire Harness Side
Disconnect the connector from relay and inspect the
connector on wire harness side, as shown.
Tester connection to
terminal number
Condition
Specified value (Continuity)
Light control switch position OFF or TAIL
No continuity
Light control switch position HEAD
Continuity
Headlight dimmer switch position Low beam
No continuity
or high beam
Headlight dimmer switch position Flash
Continuity
Parking brake switch position OFF
No continuity
Parking brake switch position ON
Continuity
Constant
Continuity
Headlight dimmer switch position Low beam No continuity
Headlight dimmer switch position Flash or
High beam
Condition
Continuity
Specified value (Voltage)
Ignition switch position LOCK or ACC
No voltage
Ignition switch position ON or START
Battery positive voltage
Constant
Battery positive voltage
Engine Stop
No voltage
Engine Running
Battery positive voltage
If circuit is as specified, perform the inspection on the
following page.
If circuit is not as specified, inspect the circuits con–
nected to other parts.
BE–33
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY NO.2
INSPECTION (for CANADA)
INSPECT DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY NO.2
Continuity
Inspect the relay continuity between terminals.
Condition
Constant
Apply B + between
terminals 2 and 4.
Tester connection to
terminal number
Specified value
1–4
2–4
Continuity
3–4
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY NO–3
INSPECTION (for CANADA)
INSPECT DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY NO–3
Continuity
Inspect the relay continuity between terminals.
Condition
Constant
Apply B + between
terminals 1 and 3.
Tester connection to
terminal number
Specified value
1–3
2–4
Continuity
4–5
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
BE–34
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY NO.4
INSPECTION
INSPECT DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY NO.4
Continuity
Condition
Constant
Apply B + between
terminals 1 and 2.
Tester connection to
terminal number
Specified value
1–2
Continuity
3–4
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
DOOR COURTESY SWITCH
See page BE–43.
PARKING BRAKE SWITCH
See page BE–72.
IGNITION SWITCH
See page BE–14.
BE–35
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING SYSTEM
TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD
WARNING SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
BE–36
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING SYSTEM
BE–37
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING SYSTEM
TROUBLESHOOTING
The table below will be useful for you in troubleshooting these electrical problems. The most
likely causes of the malfunction are shown in the order of their probability. Inspect each part in
the order shown, and replace the part when it is found to be faulty.
Trouble
Parts name
(See page)
’Hazard’ and ”Turn” do not light up.
1. Hazard Warning Switch
2. Turn Signal Flasher
3. Wire Harness
The flashing frequency is abnormal.
1. Bulb
2. Turn Signal Switch
3. Wire Harness
Hazard warning light does not light up.
(Turn is normal)
1. HAZ–HORN Fuse
2. Wire Harness
(BE–4)
Hazard warning light does not light up in one direction.
1. Hazard Warning Switch
Z. Wire Harness
(BE–38)
*1 Turn signal does not light up.
1. Ignition Switch
2. TURN Fuse
3. Turn Signal Switch
4. Wire Harness
(BE–14)
(BE–4)
(BE–38)
*2 Turn signal does not light up.
1. TURN Fuse
2. Turn Signal Switch
3. Wire Harness
(BE–4)
(BE–38)
Turn signal does not light up in one direction.
1. Turn Signal Switch
2. Wire Harness
(BE–38)
Only one bulb does not light up.
1. Bulb
2. Wire Harness
*1: Combination Meter, Wiper and Washer do not operate.
*2: Combination Meter, Wiper and Washer are normal.
(BE–38)
(BE–38)
(BE–38)
BE–38
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING SYSTEM
TURN SIGNAL SWITCH
See page BE–29.
HAZARD WARNING SWITCH INSPECTION
INSPECT HAZARD WARNING SWITCH
Continuity
Inspect the switch continuity between terminals.
Condition
Tester connection to
terminal number
Specified value
Switch OFF
7–10
Continuity
Switch ON
7–8
5–6–9
Continuity
Illumination circuit
2–3
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
TURN SIGNAL FLASHER INSPECTION
INSPECT TURN SIGNAL FLASHER
Operation
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 2 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 3.
(b) Connect the 2 turn signal light bulbs parallel to each
other to terminals 1 and 3, check that the bulbs flash.
HINT: The turn signal lights should flash 60 or 120
times per minute.
If one of the front or rear turn signal lights has an open
circuit, the number of flashers will be more than 140
per minute.
If operation is not as specified, replace the flasher.
BE–39
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
INTERIOR LIGHT SYSTEM
INTERIOR LIGHT SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
BE–40
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
INTERIOR LIGHT SYSTEM
BE–41
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
INTERIOR LIGHT SYSTEM
TROUBLESHOOTING
The table below will be useful for you in troubleshooting these electrical problems. The most
likely causes of the malfunction are shown in the order of their probability. Inspect each part in
the order shown, and replace the part when it is found to be faulty.
Trouble
Parts name
(See page)
Only one interior light does not light up.
1. Bulb
2. Wire Harness
Interior light does not light up (All).
1. DOME Fuse
2. Wire Harness
(BE–4)
1. Integration Relay
2. Door Open Detection Switch
3. Door Outside Handle Switch
4. Door Courtesy Switch
5. Wire Harness
(BE–42)
(BE–93)
(BE–43)
(BE–43)
”Illuminated Entry System” does not operate.
Interior light does not light up.
1. Bulb
2. Interior Light
3. Wire Harness
(BE–43)
Front personal light does not light up.
1. Bulb
2. Personal Light
3. Wire Harness
(BE–42)
Luggage compartment light does not light up.
1. Bulb
2. Back Door Courtesy Switch
3. Wire Harness
(BE–44)
Courtesy light does not light up.
1. Bulb
2. Door Open Detection Switch
3. Wire Harness
(BE–94)
BE–42
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
INTERIOR LIGHT SYSTEM
PERSONAL LIGHT INSPECTION
INSPECT PERSONAL LIGHT SWITCH
Continuity
Inspect the light switch continuity between terminals.
Switch position
Tester connection to
terminal number
OFF
Specified value
No continuity
1–2
1 –(4)
Continuity
The number in bracket ( ) applies to vehicles with
Sliding Roof System.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the light as–
sembly or bulb.
INTEGRATION RELAY INSPECTION
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY
Relay Circuit/ Illuminated Entry System
Remove the relay from junction block and inspect the
connector on the junction block side, as shown in the
chart.
Tester connection to
terminal number
Condition
Specified value (Continuity)
Door Outside Handle Switch Position OFF
No continuity
Door Outside Handle Switch Position ON
Courtesy Switch Position OFF
(except driver’s side)
Continuity
No continuity
Courtesy Switch Position ON
(except driver’s side)
Continuity
Constant
Continuity
Condition
Specified value (Voltage)
Constant
Battery positive voltage
Constant
Battery positive voltage
If circuit is as specified, trying replacing the relay with
a new one.
If the circuit is not as specified, inspect the circuits
connected to other parts.
BE–43
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
INTERIOR LIGHT SYSTEM
DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE SWITCH
INSPECTION
INSPECT DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE SWITCH
(a) Check that there is continuity between terminals 1
and 2 when door outside handle is pulled.
(b) Check that there is no continuity between terminals 1
and 2 when door outside handle is released.
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
KIM–01
DOOR COURTESY SWITCH INSPECTION
INSPECT DOOR COURTESY SWITCH
(a) Check that there is continuity between terminal and
switch body with the switch ON (switch pin released).
(b) Check that there is no continuity between terminal
and switch body with the switch OFF (switch pin
pushed).
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
BACK DOOR COURTESY SWITCH
INSPECTION
INSPECT BACK DOOR COURTESY SWITCH
(a) Check that there is continuity between terminal 1 and
2 with the switch ON (switch pin released).
(b) Check that there is no continuity between terminal 1
and 2 with the switch OFF (switch pin pushed).
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
INTERIOR LIGHT SWITCH AND DECK
ROOM LIGHT SWITCH INSPECTION
INSPECT INTERIOR LIGHT SWITCH AND DECK
ROOM LIGHT SWITCH
Continuity
Inspect the light switch continuity between terminals.
Switch position
Tester connection to
terminal number
DOOR
2 – Switch body
Specified value
Continuity
No continuity
OFF
1–2
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the light as–
sembly or bulb.
BE–44
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
INTERIOR LIGHT SYSTEM
LUGGAGE DOOR COURTESY SWITCH
INSPECTION
INSPECT LUGGAGE DOOR COURTESY SWITCH
Continuity
Inspect the switch continuity between terminal and
switch body.
Condition
Tester connection to
terminal number
Switch OFF
Switch ON
Specified value
No continuity
1 – Switch body
Continuity
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
BE–45
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
BACK–UP LIGHT SYSTEM
BACK–UP LIGHT SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
BE–46
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
BACK–UP LIGHT SYSTEM
BE–47
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
BACK–UP LIGHT SYSTEM
TROUBLESHOOTING
The table below will be useful for you in troubleshooting these electrical problems. The most
likely causes of the malfunction are shown in the order of their probability. Inspect each part in
the order shown, and replace the part when it is found to be faulty.
Trouble
Parts name
(See page)
1. GAUGE Fuse
2. Ignition Switch
3. Wire Harness
4. Bulb
Back–Up Light does not light up.
(BE–4)
(BE–14)
1. Back–Up Light Switch (M/T)
(BE–47)
2. Park/ Neutral Position Switch (A/T)
5S–FE (AX1–92)
1 MZ–FE (AX2– 116)
Back–Up Light remains always on.
3. Wire Harness
1. Wire Harness
2. Bulb
Only one light does not light up.
BACK–UP LIGHT SWITCH INSPECTION
INSPECT BACK–UP LIGHT SWITCH
Inspect the switch continuity between terminals.
Switch position
Tester connection
No continuity
Free
Push
Specified value
1–2
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
PARK/ NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
(5S–FE Engine)
See page AX1–92.
(lMZ–FE Engine)
See page AX2–116.
BE–48
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
STOP LIGHT SYSTEM
STOP LIGHT SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
BE–49
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
STOP LIGHT SYSTEM
BE–50
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
STOP LIGHT SYSTEM
TROUBLESHOOTING
The. table below will be useful for you in troubleshooting these electrical problems. The most
likely causes of the malfunction are shown in the order of their probability. Inspect each part in
the order shown, and replace the part when it is found to be faulty.
Trouble
(See page)
Parts name
Stop light does not light up.
1. STOP Fuse
2. Stop Light Switch
3. Wire Harness
Only one light always lights up.
1. Wire Harness
Only one light does not light.
1. Bulb
2. Wire Harness
(BE–4)
(BE–50)
STOP LIGHT SWITCH INSPECTION
INSPECT STOP LIGHT SWITCH
Continuity
Inspect the switch continuity between terminals.
Switch position
Tester connection to
terminal number
Specified value
Switch pin free
1–2
Continuity
Switch pin pushed in
3–4
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
BE–51
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
BE–52
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
TROUBLESHOOTING
The table below will be useful for you in troubleshooting these electrical problems. The most
likely causes of the malfunction are shown in the order of their probability. Inspect each part in
the order shown, and replace the part when it is found to be faulty.
Trouble
Parts name
(See page)
Wiper and washers do not operate.
1. WIPER Fuse
2. Wiper Switch
3. Wiper Motor
4. Wire Harness
(BE–4)
(BE–53)
(BE–56)
Wipers do not operate in L0, HI or MIST.
1. Wiper Switch
2. Wiper Motor
3. Wire Harness
(BE–53)
(BE–56)
Wipers do not operate in INT.
1. Wiper Switch
2. Wiper Motor
3. Wire Harness
(BE–53)
(BE–56)
Washer motor does not operate.
1. Washer Switch
2. Washer Motor
3. Wire Harness
(BE–53)
(BE–58)
Wipers do not operate when washer switch in ON.
1. Washer Motor
2. Wire Harness
(BE–58)
Washer fluid does not operate.
1. Washer Hose and Nozzle
•
•
At wiper switch Hl position, the wiper blade is in contact with the 1. *1 Wiper Relay
2. Wire harness
body.
When the wiper switch is OFF, the wiper blade does not retract or
the retract position wrong.
*1: Inspect wiper arm and blade set position
(BE–54)
BE–53
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
COMBINATION SWITCH REMOVAL
See page BO–108
COMBINATION SWITCH DISASSEMBLY
See page BE–25.
COMBINATION SWITCH ASSEMBLY
See page BE–27.
COMBINATION SWITCH INSTALLATION
See page BO–108.
COMBINATION SWITCH INSPECTION
INSPECT WIPER AND WASHER SWITCH
Continuity
Inspect the switch continuity between terminals.
WIPER OFF
Switch position
Tester connection to
terminal number
Specified value
MIST OFF
B4–B7
Continuity
MIST ON
B4–B7
B16–B18
Continuity
WIPER INT
Switch position
MIST OFF
MIST ON
Tester connection to
terminal number
Specified value
B4–B7
B14–B16
Continuity
B4–B7
B14–B16–B18
Continuity
WIPER LO
Switch position
Tester connection to
terminal number
Specified value
MIST OFF
B7–B18
Continuity
MIST ON
B7–B18
Continuity
BE–54
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
WIPER HI
Switch position
Tester connection to
terminal number
Specified value
MIST OFF
B6 B16
B13–B18
Continuity
MIST ON
B6 B16
B13–B18
Continuity
WASHER
Switch position
Tester connection to
terminal number
OFF
No continuity
B8–B16
Condition
*1 Constant
”Apply B+ between
terminals 16 and 18.
Specified value
Tester connection to
terminal number
Continuity
Specified value
B4 – B7
B16 – B18
Continuity
B7–B18
Continuity
*’: With wiper switch OFF or– INT, and MIST ON.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
Intermittent Wiper Operation
(a) Turn the wiper switch to INT position.
(b) Turn the intermittent time control switch to FAST
position.
(c) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 13– 18 and the negative (–) lead to terminal B
–16.
(d) Connect the positive (+) lead from the voltmeter to
terminal B–7 and the negative (–) lead to terminal B
–16, check that the meter needle indicates battery
positive voltage.
BE–55
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
(e) After connecting terminal B–4 to terminal B–18,
connect to terminal B–16.
Then, check that the voltage rises from 0 V to battery
positive voltage within the times, as shown in the
table.
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
I NT time control
switch position
Voltage
FAST
SLOW
Non variable type
Washer Linked Operation
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 13– 18 and the negative (–) lead to terminal B
–16.
(b) Connect the positive (+) lead from the voltmeter to
terminal B–7 and the negative (–) lead to terminal B
–16.
(c) Push the washer switch, check that the voltage cha–
nges, as shown in the table.
If operation is not as specified, replace the wiper and
washer switch.
BE–56
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
WIPER RELAY INSPECTION
WAGON Only:
INSPECT REAR WIPER RELAY
Continuity
(a) Check that there is continuity between terminals 4
and 6.
(b) Check that there is continuity between terminals 1
and 2.
(c) Check that there is no continuity between terminals 1
and 4.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
Operation
(a) Apply battery positive voltage across terminals 4 and
6.
(b) Check that there is continuity between terminals 1
and 4.
(c) Check that there is no continuity between terminals 1
and 2.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
WIPER MOTOR INSPECTION
INSPECT MOTOR
Operation at Low Speed
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 3 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 1,
check that the motor operates at low speed.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
Operation at High Speed
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 2 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 1,
check that the motor operates at high speed.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
BE–57
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
Operation, Stopping at Stop Position
(a) Operate the motor at low speed and stop the motor
operation anywhere except at the stop position by
disconnecting positive (+) lead from terminal 3.
(b) Connect terminals 3 and 5.
(c) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 6 and negative (–) lead to terminal 1, check
that the motor stops running at the stop position after
the motor operates again.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
REAR WIPER MOTOR INSPECTION
WAGON Only:
INSPECT MOTOR
Operation at Low Speed
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 4 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 2,
check that the motor operates at low speed.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
Operation, Stopping at Stop Position
(a) Operate the motor at low speed and stop the motor
operation anywhere except at the stop position by
disconnecting positive (+) lead from terminal 4.
(b) Connect terminals 3 and 4.
(c) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 1 and negative (–) lead to terminal 2, check
that the motor stops running at the stop position after
the motor operates again.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
BE–58
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
WASHER MOTOR INSPECTION
(WAGON Only)
INSPECT WASHER MOTOR
Front Washer Operation
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 2 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 1,
check that the motor operates.
NOTICE: These tests must be performed quickly (within
20 seconds) to prevent the coil from burning out.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
Rear Washer Operation
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 2 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 3,
check that the motor operates.
NOTICE: These tests must be performed quickly (within
20 seconds) to prevent the coil from burning out.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
(Ex. WAGON)
INSPECT WASHER MOTOR
Operation
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 2 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 1,
check that the motor operates.
NOTICE: There tests must be performed quickly (within
20 seconds) to prevent the coil from burning out.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
BE–59
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
COMBINATION METER
COMBINATION METER
PARTS LOCATION
BE–60
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
COMBINATION METER
WIRING DIAGRAM
BE–61
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
COMBINATION METER
No.
Wiring Connector Side
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
Headlight dimmer and turn signal switch
Headlight dimmer and turn signal switch
Ground
ECM
Ground
Ground
Fuel sender gauge–terminal 2
Fuel sender gauge–terminal 3
Cruise Control ECU
0/D OFF Switch
Electronic Controlled Transaxle (PWR)
Speed sensor
Light control rheostat
3
4
5
fi
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
Light failure sensor
DOME fuse
Door courtesy switch
GAUGE fuse
Integration relay
Generator
IG2 fuse
Oil pressure switch
Igniter
Parking brake switch and brake fluid
level warning switch
Headlight dimmer switch
Headlight dimmer switch
Starter relay
TAIL fuse
1
2
3
4
7
8
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
ECU–13 fuse
ECM
ABS ECU
Engine coolant temperature sender gauge
Ground
BE–62
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
COMBINATION METER
A/T SHIFT POSITION INDICATOR
No.
Wiring Connector Side
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
13
Light control rheostat
TAIL fuse
Park/Neutral Position switch
Park/Neutral Position switch
Park/Neutral Position switch
Ground
Park/Neutral Position switch
GAUGE fuse
0/D switch
Park/Neutral Position switch
Park/Neutral Position switch
Electronic Controlled Transaxle select switch (PWR)
BE–63
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
COMBINATION METER
TROUBLESHOOTING
The table below will be useful for you in troubleshooting these electrical problems. The most
likely causes of the malfunction are shown in the order of their probability. Inspect each part in
the order shown, and replace the part when it is found to be faulty.
METER, GAUGES AND ILLUMINATION
Trouble
Tachometer, Voltmeter, Fuel Gauge and Engine Coolant
Temperature Gauge do not operate.
Speedometer does not operate.
Parts name
(See page)
1. GAUGE Fuse
2. Combination Meter Wiring Circuit
3. Wire Harness
4. Meter Circuit Plate
(BE–4)
(BE–61)
(BE–60)
1. No. 1 vehicle speed Sensor
2. Speedometer Driven Gear and Drive Gear
(BE–67)
1. Combination Meter Wiring Circuit
2. Wire Harness
3. Igniter
(BE–61)
Tachometer does not operate.
5S–FE (IG–12, 31)
1 MZ–FE (IG–49)
(BE–60)
4. Meter Circuit Plate
Fuel Gauge does not operate or abnormal operation.
1. Fuel Receiver Gauge
2. Fuel Sender Gauge
3. Combination Meter Wiring Circuit
4. Wire Harness
Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge does not operate or abnormal
operation.
1. Engine Coolant Temperature Receiver Gauge (BE–70)
2. Engine Coolant Temperature Sender Gauge (BE–70)
3. Combination Meter Wiring Circuit (BE–61)
4. Wire Harness
All illumination lights do not light up.
1. TAIL Fuse
2. Light Control Rheostat
3. Wire Harness
Brightness does not change even when rheostat turned.
1. Bulb
2. Wire Harness
Only one illumination light does not light up.
1. Bulb
2. Wire Harness
(BE–68)
(BE–69)
(BE–61)
(BE–4)
(BE–77)
BE–64
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
COMBINATION METER
WARNING LIGHTS
Trouble
Parts name
(See page)
(BE–4)
(BE–61)
Warning light do not fight up. (Except. Discharge)
1. GAUGE Fuse
2. Combination Meter Wiring Circuit
3. Wire Harness
Low Oil Pressure warning light does not light up.
1. Bulb
2. Combination Meter Wiring Circuit
3. Low Oil Pressure Warning Switch
4. Wire Harness
Fuel Level warning light does no light up.
1. Bulb
2. Combination Meter Wiring Circuit
3. Fuel Level Warning Switch
A6S warning light does no light up.
1. Bulb
2. ABS ECU
3. Wire Harness
(BR–90)
Malfunction warning light does not light up.
1. Bulb
2. ECM
3. Wire Harness
(EG–394)
Seat Belt warning light does not light up.
1. Bulb
2. Integration Relay
3. Wiring Harness
Discharge warning light does not light up.
1. IG N Fuse
2. Bulb
3. Wire Harness
4. Generator
(BE–61)
(BE–71)
(BE–61)
(BE–69)
(BE–31)
(BE–4)
5S–FE (CH–7)
1 MZ–FE (CH–31)
Light Failure warning light does no light up.
1. Bulb
2. Light Failure Sensor
3. Wire Harness
4. ”Taillight system”
Brake warning light does not light up.
1. Bulb
2. Combination Meter Wiring Circuit
3. Parking Brake Switch
4. Brake Fluid Level Warning Switch
SRS warning light does not light up.
1. ECU – B Fuse
2. Bulb
3. Wire Harness
4. Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
Open Door warning light does not light up.
1. Bulb
2. Combination Meter Wiring Circuit
3. Door Courtesy Switch
(BE–73)
(BE–17)
(BE–61)
(BE–72)
(BE–71)
(BE–4)
(RS–55)
(BE–61)
(BE–43)
BE–65
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
COMBINATION METER
INDICATOR LIGHTS
Trouble
O/D OFF indicator light does not light up.
(see page)
Parts name
1. Bulb
2. Combination Meter Wiring Circuit
(BE–61)
3. O/D OFF Switch
5S–FE (AX1–102)
1 MZ–FE (AX2–130)
4. Wire Harness
Cruise Control indicator light does not light up.
1. Bulb
2. Cruise Control ECU
3. Wire Harness
High beam indicator light does not light up.
1. Bulb
2. Combination Meter Wiring Circuit
3. Wire Harness
4. ”Headlight System”
Turn indicator light does not light up.
Electrically Controlled Transmission PWR indicator lights does not
light up.
(BE–176)
(BE–61)
(BE–17)
1. Bulb
2. Combination Meter Wiring Circuit
3. Wire Harness
4. ”Turn Signal and Hazard Warning System”
1. Bulb
2. Combination Meter Wiring Circuit
3. TCM Pattern Select Switch
(BE–61)
(BE–35)
(BE–61)
5S–FE (AX1–98)
1 MZ– FE (AX2–126)
4. Wire Harness
1. Bulb
2. Combination Meter Wiring Circuit
3. Park / Neutral Position Switch
Shift indicator lights do not light up. (All)
(BE–61)
5S–FE (AX1–92)
1 MZ– FE (AX2–116)
4. Wire Harness
1. Bulb
2. Combination Meter Wiring Circuit
3. Park / Neutral Position Switch
(BE–61)
5S–FE (AX1–92)
1 MZ– FE (AX2–116)
Shift indicator lights do not light up. (L. 2. D)
4. Light Control Rheostat
5. Wire Harness
Only one shift indicator does not light up.
1. Bulb
2. Combination Meter Wiring Circuit
Indicator lights do not light up. (Except. Turn, Hi–beam)
1. GAUGE Fuse
2. Wire Harness
(BE–77)
(BE–61)
(BE–4)
BE–66
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
COMBINATION METER
SPEEDOMETER INSPECTION
ON–VEHICLE
Using a speedometer tester, inspect the speedometer
for allowable indication error and check the operation
of the odometer.
HINT: Tire wear and tire over or under inflation will
increase the indication error.
If error is excessive, replace the speedometer.
mph/ USA:
Standard indication
Allowable range
km/h/ CANADA:
Standard indication
Allowable range
BE–67
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
COMBINATION METER
SPEED SENSOR INSPECTION
Operation
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from battery to terminal
1 and negative (–) lead to terminal 2.
(b) Connect the positive (+) lead from tester to terminal 3
and negative (–) lead to terminal 2.
(c) Revolve shaft.
(d) Check that there is voltage change from approx. 0 V
to 1 1 V or more between terminals 2 and 3.
HINT: The voltage change should be 4 times par each
revolution of the speed sensor shaft.
If operation is not as specified, replace the sensor.
BE–68
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
COMBINATION METER
TACHOMETER INSPECTION
ON–VEHICLE
(a) Connect a tune–up test tachometer, and start the
engine.
NOTICE: Reversing the connection of the tachometer will
damage the transistors and diodes inside.
(b) Compare the tester and tachometer indications.
If error is excessive, replace the tachometer.
DC 13.5 V, 25 C (77F)/ rpm
Standard indication
Allowable range
FUEL RECEIVER GAUGE INSPECTION
Operation
(a) Disconnect the connector from the sender gauge as–
sembly.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON, check that the receiver
gauge needle indicates EMPTY.
(c) Connect terminals 2 and 3 on the wire harness side
connector through a 3.4 w test bulb.
(d) Turn the ignition switch ON, check that the bulb lights
up and receiver gauge needle moves toward the full
side.
HINT: Because of the silicon oil in the gauge, it will
take a short time for the needle to stabilize.
If operation is not as specified, inspect the receiver
gauge resistance.
Resistance
Measure the resistance between terminals.
Between terminals
Resistance (Ω )
A–B
Approx. 126
A–C
B–C
Approx. 281
Approx. 154
If resistance value is not as specified, replace the fuel
receiver gauge.
BE–69
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
COMBINATION METER
FUEL SENDER GAUGE INSPECTION
Operation
(a) Connect a series of three 1.5 V dry cell batteries.
(b) Connect the positive (+) lead from the dry cell batte–
ries to terminal 2 through a 3.4 W test bulb and the
negative (–) lead to terminal 3.
(c) Check that the voltage rises between terminals 2 and
3 as the float is moved from the top to bottom posi–
tion.
Resistance
Measure the resistance between terminals 2 and 3 for
each float position.
Float position mm (in.)
Approx. 35.5 (1.40)
1/2
Resistance (Ω)
Approx. 90.9 (3.59)
Approx. 3
Approx. 30.8
Approx. 157.4 (6.20)
Approx. 110
If resistance value is not as specified, replace the
sender gauge.
FUEL LEVEL WARNING LIGHT
INSPECTION
INSPECT FUEL LEVEL WARNING LIGHT
a) Disconnect the connector from the sender gauge.
b) Connect terminals 1 and 3 on the wire harness side
connector.
e) Turn the ignition switch ON, check that the warning
light lights up.
If the warning light does not light up, test the bulb or
inspect wire harness.
FUEL LEVEL WARNING SWITCH
INSPECTION
INSPECT FUEL LEVEL WARNING SWITCH
(a) Apply battery positive voltage between terminals 1
and 3 through a 3.4 W test bulb, check that the bulb
lights up.
HINT: It will take a short time for the bulb to light up.
BE–70
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
COMBINATION METER
(b) Submerge the switch in fuel, check that the bulb goes
out.
If operation is not as specified, replace the sender
gauge.
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
RECEIVER GAUGE AND SENDER GAUGE
INSPECTION
Operation
(a) Disconnect the connector from the sender gauge.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON, check that the receiver
gauge needle indicates COOL.
(c) Ground terminal on the wire harness side connector
through a 3.4W test bulb.
(d) Turn the ignition switch ON, check that the bulb lights
up and the receiver gauge needle moves toward the
hot side.
If operation is as specified, replace the sender gauge.
Then recheck the system.
If operation is not as specified, measure the receiver
gauge resistance.
Resistance
Measure the resistance between terminals.
HINT: Connect the test leads so that the current from
the ohmmeter can flow according to the chart order.
Between terminals
Resistance (Ω)
A–B
Approx. 54
A–C
Approx. 176
B–C
Approx. 230
If resistance value is not as specified, replace the
engine coolant temperature receiver gauge.
BE–71
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
COMBINATION METER
LOW OIL PRESSURE WARNING LIGHT
INSPECTION
INSPECT LOW OIL PRESSURE WARNING LIGHT
(a) Disconnect the connector from the warning switch
and ground terminal on the wire harness side connec–
tor.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON, check that the warning
light lights up.
If the warning light does not light up, test the bulb or
inspect wire harness.
LOW OIL PRESSURE WARNING SWITCH
INSPECTION
INSPECT LOW OIL PRESSURE WARNING SWITCH
(a) Check that there is continuity between terminal and
ground with the engine stopped.
(b) Check that there is no continuity between terminal
and ground with the engine running.
HINT: Oil pressure should be over 29 kPa (0.3 kgf/
cm2, 4.3 psi)
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
BRAKE FLUID LEVEL WARNING LIGHT
INSPECTION
INSPECT BRAKE WARNING LIGHT
(a) Disconnect the connector from the brake fluid warn–
ing switch.
(b) Release the parking brake pedal.
(c) Connect terminals on the wire harness side of the
level warning switch connector.
(d) Start the engine, check that the warning light lights
up.
If the warning light does not light up, test the bulb or
wire harness.
BE–72
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
COMBINATION METER
BRAKE FLUID LEVEL WARNING SWITCH
INSPECTION
INSPECT BRAKE FLUID LEVEL WARNING SWITCH
(a) Remove the reservoir tank cap and strainer.
(b) Disconnect the connector.
(c) Check that there is no continuity between terminals
with the switch OFF (float up).
(d) Use syphon, etc. to take fluid out of the reservoir tank.
(e) Check that there is continuity between terminals with
the switch ON (float down).
(f) Pour the fluid back in the reservoir tank.
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
PARKING BRAKE SWITCH INSPECTION
INSPECT PARKING BRAKE SWITCH
(a) Check that there is continuity between terminal and
switch body with the switch ON (switch pin released).
(b) Check that there is no continuity between terminal
and switch body with the switch OFF (switch pin
pushed in).
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch or
inspect ground point.
LIGHT FAILURE WARNING LIGHT
INSPECTION
INSPECT LIGHT FAILURE WARNING LIGHT
(a) Disconnect the connector from the light failure sensor
and ground terminal 4 on the wire harness side con–
nector.
(b) Start the engine, check that the warning light lights
up.
If the warning light does not light up, test the bulb or
inspect wire harness.
BE–73
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
COMBINATION METER
LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR INSPECTION
INSPECT LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR
Relay Circuit
Disconnect the connector from the sensor and in–
spect the connector on the wire harness side, as
shown.
Tester connection to
terminal number
Condition
Specified value (Continuity)
Constant
* Continuity
Constant
Constant
* Continuity
* Continuity
Constant
Continuity
Condition
Specified value (Voltage)
Light control switch position OFF
No voltage
Light control switch position TAIL or HEAD
Battery positive voltage
Engine condition Stop
No voltage
Engine condition Running
Battery positive voltage
Ignition switch position LOCK or ACC
No voltage
Ignition switch position ON
Battery positive voltage
Stop light switch position OFF
No voltage
Stop light switch position ON
Battery positive voltage
*: There is resistance because this circuit is grounded
through the bulb.
If circuit is as specified, replace the sensor. If the
circuit is not as specified, inspect the circuits connect–
ed to other parts.
BE–74
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
COMBINATION METER
OPEN DOOR WARNING LIGHT
INSPECTION
INSPECT OPEN DOOR WARNING LIGHT
Disconnect the connector from the door courtesy
switch, and ground terminal 1 on the wire harness
side connector and check that the warning light lights
up.
If the warning light does not light up, inspect the bulb
or wire harness.
DOOR COURTESY SWITCH
See page BE–43.
SEAT BELT WARNING LIGHT INSPECTION
INSPECT SEAT BELT WARNING LIGHT
(a) Remove the integration relay from the junction block
No. 1.
(b) Ground terminal A9 on the junction block side con–
nector.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON, check that the warning
light lights up.
If the warning light does not light up, inspect the bulb
or wire harness.
BE–75
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
COMBINATION METER
INTEGRATION RELAY INSPECTION
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY
Operation/ Seat belt warning
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminals Al and A7.
(b) Connect the terminal A7 to terminal A9 through the
3.4 W test bulb.
(c) Connect the negative (–) lead from the battery to
terminal Al 0.
(d) Check that the bulb lights and the chime sounds for 4
– 8 seconds.
(e) Return to step
(a), and operate the chime again.
(f) Connect the negative (–) lead from the battery to
terminal A8.
(g) Check that the chime stops sounding.
HINT: Check the chime within a period of 4 to 8
seconds.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
Relay circuit/ Seat belt warning
Remove the relay from the junction block No.1 and
inspect the connectors on the junction block side.
Tester connection to
terminal number
Condition
Specified value (Continuity)
A8 – Ground
Driver’s buckle switch OFF
(Seat best unfastened)
No continuity
A8 – Ground
Driver’s buckle switch ON
(Seat best fastened)
Continuity
A10 – Ground
Constant
Continuity
BE–76
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Tester connection to
terminal number
–
COMBINATION METER
Condition
Specified value (Voltage)
A1 – Ground
Constant
Battery positive voltage
A7 – Ground
A9 – Ground
Ignition switch position OFF or ACC
No voltage
A7 – Ground
A9 – Ground
Ignition switch position ON
Battery positive voltage
If circuit is as specified, trying replacing the relay with
a new one.
Is circuit is not as specified, inspect the circuits con–
nected to other parts.
BUCKLE SWITCH INSPECTION
INSPECT BUCKLE SWITCH
w/o POWER SEAT:
Continuity
(a) Check that there is continuity between terminals on
the switch side connector with the switch ON (belt
fastened).
(b) Check that there is no continuity between terminals
on the switch side connector with the switch OFF
(belt unfastened).
If operation is not as specified, replace the seat belt
inner belt.
BE–77
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
COMBINATION METER
w/ POWER SEAT:
Continuity
(a) Check that there is continuity between terminals 1
and 2 on the switch side connector with the switch
ON (belt fastened). ’
(b) Check that there is no continuity between terminals 1
and 2 on the switch side connector with the switch
OFF (belt unfastened).
If operation is not as specified, replace the seat belt
inner belt.
METER ILLUMINATION CONTROL
SYSTEM
INSPECT LIGHT CONTROL RHEOSTAT
(a) Connect terminals 1 and 3 through a 3.4 W test bulb.
(b) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 1 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 2.
(c) Turn the rheostat knob to fully counterclockwise,
check that the test bulb goes out.
(d) Gradually turn the rheostat knob to clockwise, check
that the test bulb brightness changes from dark to
bright.
If operation is not as specified, replace the rheostat.
BULB CHECK RELAY INSPECTION
INSPECT BULB CHECK RELAY
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal C through a 1.4 W test bulb and the negative
(–) lead to terminal B, check that the test bulb does
not light up.
(b) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal A , check that the test bulb light up.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
BE–78
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
DEFOGGER SYSTEM
DEFOGGER SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
BE–79
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
DEFOGGER SYSTEM
TROUBLESHOOTING
The table below will be useful for you in troubleshooting these electrical problems. The most
likely causes of the malfunction are shown in the order of their probability. Inspect each part in
the order shown, and replace the part when it is found to be faulty.
Trouble
All defogger systems do not operate.
Rear window defogger does not operate.
(See page)
Paris name
1. DEFOG M – Fuse
2. GAUGE Fuse
3. Defogger Relay
4. Defogger Switch
5. Wire Harness
(BE–4)
(BE–4)
(BE–80)
(BE–79)
1. Defogger Wire
2. Choke Coil
3. Wire Harness
(BE–80)
DEFOGGER SWITCH INSPECTION
INSPECT DEFOGGER SWITCH
Continuity
Inspect the switch continuity between terminals.
Condition
Tester connection to
terminal number
No continuity
Switch OFF
Switch ON
Illumination circuit
Specified value
3–6
4–5
Continuity
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, check the bulb or
replace the switch.
INDICATOR LIGHT OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 3 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 1,
check that the indicator light does not light up, replace
the switch.
BE–80
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
DEFOGGER SYSTEM
DEFOGGER RELAY INSPECTION
INSPECT DEFOGGER RELAY
Continuity
Inspect the relay continuity between terminals.
Condition
Tester connection to
terminal number
Constant
Apply B + between
terminals 1 and 2.
Specified value
1–2
Continuity
3–5
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
DEFOGGER WIRE INSPECTION
NOTICE:
•
When cleaning the glass, use a soft, dry cloth, and
wipe the glass in the direction of the wire. Take care
not to damage the wires.
•
Do not use detergents or glass cleaners with abra–
sive ingredients.
•
When measuring voltage, wind a piece of tin foil
around the top of the negative probe and press the
foil against the wire with your finger, as shown.
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Turn the defogger switch ON.
(c) Inspect the voltage at the center of each heat wire, as
shown.
Voltage
Approx. 5V
Approx. 1 OV or OV
Criteria
Okay (No break in wire)
Broken wire
HINT: If there is approximately 10 V, the wire is
broken between the center of the wire and the posi–
tive (+) end. If there is no voltage, the wire is broken
between the center of the wire and ground.
BE–81
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
DEFOGGER SYSTEM
(d) Place the voltmeter positive (+) lead against the def–
ogger positive (+) terminal.
(e) Place the voltmeter negative (–) lead with the foil
strip against the heat wire at the positive (+) terminal
end and slide it toward the negative (–) terminal end.
(f) The point where the voltmeter deflects from zero to
several V is the place where the heat wire is broken.
HINT: If the heat wire is not broken, the voltmeter
indicates 0 V at the positive (+) end of the heat wire
but gradually increases to about 12 V as the meter
probe is moved to the other end.
DEFOGGER WIRE REPAIR
(a) Clean the broken wire tips with a grease, wax and
silicone remover.
(b) Place the masking tape along both sides of the wire to
be repaired.
(c) Thoroughly mix the repair agent (Dupont paste No.
4817).
(d) Using a fine tip brush, apply a small amount to the
wire.
(e) After a few minutes, remove the masking tape.
(f) Allow the repair to stand at least 24 hours.
BE–82
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
POWER WINDOW CONTROL
SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
BE–83
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
TROUBLESHOOTING
The table below will be useful for you in troubleshooting these electrical problems. The most
likely causes of the malfunction are shown in the order of their probability. Inspect each part in
the order shown, and replace the part when it is found to be faulty.
Trouble
Parts name
(See page)
1. ALT H –Fuse
2. P/V11 M–Fuse
3. Wire Harness
(BE–4)
(BE–4)
1. GAUGE Fuse
2. Ignition Switch
3. P/W M–Fuse
4. Power Main Relay
5. Power Window Master Switch
6. Wire Harness
(BE–4)
(BE–14)
(BE–4)
(BE–89)
(BE–84)
”One Touch Power Window System” does not operate.
1. Power Window Master Switch
(BE–84)
Only one window glass does not move.
1. Power Window Master Switch
2. Power Window Switch
3. Power Window Motor
4. Wire Harness
(BE–84)
(BE–87)
(BE–87)
”Window Lock System” does not operate.
1. Power Window Master Switch
(BE–84)
”Window Lock Illumination” does not light up.
1. Power Window Master Switch
(BE–84)
Key–off power window does not operate.
1. DOME Fuse
2. GAUGE Fuse
3. Ignition Switch
4. Door Open Detection Switch
5. Wire Harness
(BE–4)
(BE–4)
(BE–14)
(BE–94)
*1 Power window does not operate.
*2 Power window does not operate.
*1: Door Lock does not operate.
*2: Door Lock is normal.
BE–84
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
POWER WINDOW MASTER SWITCH
INSPECTION
INSPECT POWER WINDOW MASTER SWITCH
Continuity
Inspect the switch continuity between terminals.
Front Driver’s Switch (Window unlock)/ Continuity
Switch position
OFF
DOWN
Tester connection to
terminal number
Specified value
6–7–8
1 –2–13
Continuity
1–2–6–13
Continuity
1–2–6
7–8–13
Continuity
Front Driver’s Switch (Window lock)/ Continuity
Switch position
OFF
DOWN
Tester connection to
terminal number
Specified value
6–7–8
1–2–13
Continuity
1–2–6–13
Continuity
1–2–6
7–8–13
Continuity
Front Passenger’s Switch (Window unlock)/ Conti–
nuity
Switch position
OFF
DOWN
Tester connection to
terminal number
Specified value
7–8–12
Continuity
5–12
Continuity
5–7–8
Continuity
Front Passenger’s Switch (Window lock)/ Continui–
ty
Switch position
OFF
DOWN
Tester connection to
terminal number
Specified value
1–2–5
7–8–12
Continuity
1–2–5–12
Continuity
5–7–8
1–2–12
Continuity
BE–85
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Rear Left Switch (Window unlock)/ Continuity
Switch position
Tester connection to
terminal number
Specified value
7–8–10
Continuity
OFF
9–10
Continuity
DOWN
7–8–9
Continuity
Rear Left Switch (Window lock)/ Continuity
Switch position
OFF
DOWN
Tester connection to
terminal number
Specified value
7–8–10
1–2–9
Continuity
1–2–9–10
Continuity
7–8–9
1–2–10
Continuity
Rear Right Switch (Window unlock)/ Continuity
Switch position
Tester connection to
terminal number
7–8–11
OFF
DOWN
Specified value
Continuity
11–14
Continuity
7–8–14
Continuity
Rear Right Switch (Window lock)/ Continuity
Switch position
Tester connection to
terminal number
7–8–11
1–2–14
OFF
DOWN
1–2–11–14
7–8–14
1–2–11
Specified value
Continuity
Continuity
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, relace the master
switch.
BE–86
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Illumination
(a) Set the window lock switch to the unlock position.
(b) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 7 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 1,
check that all the illuminations light up.
(c) Set the window lock switch to the lock position, check
that all the passenger’s power window switch illumi–
nations go out.
If operation is not as specified, replace the master
switch.
One Touch Power Window System/ Current of Cir–
cuit
Inspection using an ammeter.
(a) Disconnect the connector from the master switch.
(b) Connect the positive (+) lead from the ammeter to
terminal 6 on the wire harness side connector and the
negative (–) lead to negative terminal of the battery.
(c) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 13 on the wire harness side connector.
(d) As the window goes down, check that the current
flow is approximately 7 A.
(e) Check that the current increases approximately 14.5
A or more when the window stops going down.
HINT: The circuit breaker opens some 4 – 40 seconds
after the window stops going down, so that check
must be made before the circuit breaker operates.
If the operation is as specified, replace the master
switch.
Inspection using an ammeter with a current–meas–
uring probe.
(a) Remove the master switch with connector connected.
(b) Attach a current–measuring probe to terminal 6 of
the wire harness.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON and set the power
window switch in the down position.
(d) As the window goes down, check that the current
flow is approximately 7 A.
BE–87
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
(e) Check that the current increases approximately 14.5
A or more when the window stops going down.
HINT: The circuit breaker opens some 4 – 40 seconds
after the window stops going down, so that check
must be made before the circuit breaker operates.
If operation is as specified, replace the master switch.
POWER WINDOW SWITCH INSPECTION
INSPECT POWER WINDOW SWITCH
Switch Continuity
Inspect the switch continuity between terminals.
Switch position
Tester connection to
terminal number
Specified value
1–5
3–4
Continuity
OFF
1–Z
3–4
Continuity
DOWN
1–2
4–5
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
POWER WINDOW MOTOR INSPECTION
INSPECT POWER WINDOW MOTOR
Driver’s Door Motor/ Motor Operation
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 1 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 2,
check that the motor turns clockwise.
(b) Reverse the polarity, check that the motor turns coun–
terclockwise.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
Driver’s Door Motor/ Circuit Breaker Operation
(a) Disconnect the connector from the master switch.
(b) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 6 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 13 on
the wire harness side connector and raise the window
to full closed position.
(c) Continue to apply voltage, check that there is a circuit
breaker operation noise within approximately 4 to 40
seconds.
BE–88
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
(d) Reverse the polarity, check that the window begins to
descend within approximately 60 seconds.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
Front Passenger’s Door Motor/ Motor Operation
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 1 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 2,
check that the motor turns counterclockwise.
(b) Reverse the polarity, check that the motor turns clo–
ckwise.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
Front Passenger’s Door Motor/ Circuit Breaker Op–
eration
(a) Disconnect the connector from the power window
switch.
(b) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 4 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 1 on
the wire harness side connector, and raise the window
to full closed position.
(c) Continue to apply voltage, check that there is a circuit
breaker operation noise within approximately 4 to 40
seconds.
(d) Reverse the polarity, check that the window begins to
descend within approximately 60 seconds.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
BE–89
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Rear Left Side Door Motor/ Motor Operation
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 1 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 2.
check that the motor turns clockwise.
(b) Reverse the polarity, check that the motor turns coun–
terclockwise.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
Rear Left Side Door Motor/ Circuit Breaker Opera–
tion
See step of Front Passenger Door Motor on page
BE–88.
Rear Right Side Door Motor/ Motor Operation
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 2 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 1,
check that the motor turns counterclockwise.
(b) Reverse the polarity, check that the motor turns clo–
ckwise.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
Rear Right Side Door Motor/ Circuit Breaker Opera–
tion
See step of Front Passenger Door Motor on page
BE–88.
POWER MAIN RELAY INSPECTION
INSPECT POWER MAIN RELAY
Continuity
Inspect the relay continuity between terminals.
Condition
Constant
Apply B + between
terminals t and 2.
Tester connection to
terminal number
Specified value
1–2
Continuity
3–5
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
BE–90
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL
SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
BE–91
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
BE–92
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
TROUBLESHOOTING
The table below will be useful for you in troubleshooting these electrical problems. The most
likely causes of the malfunction are shown in the order of their probability. Inspect each part in
the order shown, and replace the part when it is found to be faulty.
Trouble
Parts name
(See page)
”Door lock system” does not operate at all.
1. POWER Fuse
2. RADIO/CIG Fuse
3. Door Lock Control Relay
4. Wire Harness
(BE–4)
(BE–4)
(BE–98)
Door lock system does not operate by manual switch.
1. Power Window Master Switch
2. Door Lock Manual Switch
3. Door Lock Control Relay
4. Wire Harness
(BE–93)
(BE–93)
(BE–98)
Door lock system does not operate by door key.
1. Door Key Lock and Unlock Switch
2. Door Lock Control Relay
3. Wire Harness
4. Door Lock Link Disconnected
(BE–94)
(BE–98)
Fault in 2–Operation unlock function of Driver’s side door key lock
and unlock switch.
1. Door Key Lock and Unlock Switch
2. Door Lock Control Relay
3. Wire Harness
(BE–94)
(BE–98)
Fault in key confine prevention operate.
1. Door Lock Control Relay
2. Key Unlock Warning Switch
3. Door Courtesy Switch
4. Wire Harness
(BE–98)
(BE–15)
(BE–43)
Only one door lock does not operate.
1. Door Lock Motor
2. Wire Harness
(BE–94)
BE–93
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
POWER WINDOW MASTER SWITCH
INSPECTION
INSPECT POWER WINDOW MASTER SWITCH
Master Switch: Driver’s Door Lock Manual Switch/
Continuity
Inspect the switch continuity between terminals.
Switch position
LOCK
Tester connection to
terminal number
1–2–4
OFF
UNLOCK
Specified value
Continuity
No continuity
1–2–3
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
DOOR LOCK MANUAL SWITCH
INSPECTION
INSPECT DOOR LOCK MANUAL SWITCH
Continuity
Inspect the switch continuity between terminals.
Switch position
LOCK
Tester connection to
terminal number
3–4
OFF
UNLOCK
Specified value
Continuity
No continuity
2–4
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
BE–94
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DOOR KEY LOCK AND UNLOCK
SWITCH INSPECTION
INSPECT DOOR KEY LOCK AND UNLOCK SWITCH
Continuity
Inspect the switch continuity between terminals.
Switch position
LOCK
Tester connection to
terminal number
2–3
OFF
UNLOCK
Specified value
Continuity
No continuity
1–2
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
HINT: Door key lock and unlock switch is built into the
front door lock assembly.
KEY UNLOCK WARNING SWITCH
See key confine prevention system on page BE–15.
DOOR COURTESY SWITCH
See open door warning system on page BE–43.
DOOR LOCK MOTOR INSPECTION
(DOOR OPEN DETECTION SWITCH
INSPECTION)
INSPECT DOOR LOCK MOTOR
Motor Operation
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 2 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 4,
check that the door lock link moves to UNLOCK posi–
tion.
(b) Remove the polarity, check that the door lock link
move to LOCK position.
If operation is not as specified, replace the door lock
assembly.
BE–95
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
Ex. WAGON:
PTC THERMISTOR OPERATION
INSPECTION USING AN AMMETER
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 2.
(b) Connect the positive (+) lead from the ammeter to
terminal 4 and the negative (–) lead to battery nega–
tive (–) terminal, check that the current changes from
approximately 3.2 ampere to less than 0.5 ampere
with 20 to 70 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the leads from terminals.
(d) Approximately 60 seconds later, connect the positive
(+) lead from the battery to terminal 4 and the nega–
tive (–) lead to terminal 2 check that the door lock
moves to LOCK position.
If operation is not as specified, replace the door lock
assembly.
Ex. WAGON:
INSPECTION USING AN AMMETER WITH A CUR–
RENT–MEASURING PROBE
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 2 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 4.
(b) Attach a current–measuring probe to either the pos–
itive (+) lead or the negative (–) lead, check that the
current changes from approximately 3.2 ampere to
less than 0.5 ampere within 20 to 70 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the leads from terminals.
(d) Approximately 60 seconds later, reverse the polarity,
check that the door lock moves to LOCK position.
If operation is not as specified, replace the door lock
assembly.
BE–96
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
WAGON Only:
PTC THERMISTOR OPERATION
INSPECTION USING AN AMMETER
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 2.
(b) Connect the positive (+) lead from the ammeter to
terminal 4 and the negative (–) lead to battery nega–
tive (–) terminal, check that the current changes from
approximately 3.2 ampere to less than 0.5 ampere
with 20 to 70 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the leads from terminals.
(d) Approximately 60 seconds later, connect the positive
(+) lead from the battery to terminal 4 and the nega–
tive (–) lead to terminal 2 check that the door lock
moves to LOCK position.
If operation is not as specified, replace the door lock
assembly.
WAGON Only:
INSPECTION USING AN AMMETER WITH A CUR–
RENT–MEASURING PROBE
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 2 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 4.
(b) Attach a current–measuring probe to either the pos–
itive (+) lead or the negative (–) lead, check that the
current changes from approximately 3.2 ampere to
less than 0.5 ampere within 20 to 70 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the leads from terminals.
(d) Approximately 60 seconds later, reverse the polarity,
check that the door lock moves to LOCK position.
If operation is not as specified, replace the door lock
assembly.
BE–97
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION SWITCH
INSPECTION
INSPECT DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION SWITCH
Continuity
Inspect the switch continuity between terminals.
Switch position
Tester connection to
terminal number
OFF (Door lock set
to LOCK)
ON (Door lock set
to UNLOCK)
Specified value
No continuity
1–3
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the door lock
assembly.
BACK DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION
SWITCH INSPECTION
WAGON Only:
INSPECT BACK DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION
SWITCH
Continuity
Inspect the switch continuity between terminals.
Switch position
Tester connection to
terminal number
OFF (Door lock set
to LOCK)
ON (Door lock set
to UNLOCK)
Specified value
No continuity
1–3
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the door lock
assembly.
POWER MAIN RELAY
See power main relay on page BE–89.
BE–98
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DOOR LOCK CONTROL RELAY
INSPECTION
INSPECT DOOR LOCK CONTROL RELAY
Relay Circuit
Disconnect the connector from the relay and inspect
the connector on the wire harness side, as shown in
the chart.
Tester connection to
terminal number
Condition
Specified value (Continuity)
Driver’s door courtesy switch position OFF
(Door closed)
No continuity
Driver’s door courtesy switch position ON
(Door opened)
Continuity
Passenger’s Door Lock Switch position OFF
No continuity
(Door locked)
Passenger’s Door Lock Switch position ON
Continuity
(Door unlocked)
Driver’s Door Lock Switch position OFF
(Doorlocked)
No continuity
Driver’s Door Lock Switch position ON
(Door unlocked)
Continuity
Key Unlock Warning Switch position OFF
(Ignition Key Removed)
No continuity
Key Unlock Warning Switch position ON
(ignition Key Set)
Continuity
Driver’s Door Key Lock and Unlock Switch
Position OFF or LOCK (Door key free or
turned to lock)
No continuity
Driver’s Door Key Lock and Unlock Switch
Position UNLOCK (Door key turned to
unlock)
Continuity
Door Lock Manual Switch Position OFF or
UNLOCK
No continuity
Door Lock Manual Switch Position LOCK
Continuity
Door Lock Manual Switch Position OFF or
LOCK
No continuity
Door Lock Manual Switch Position
UNLOCK
Continuity
Passenger’s Door Key Lock and Unlock
Switch Position OFF or UNLOCK (Door key
No continuity
free or turned to unlock)
Passenger’s Door Key Lock and Unlock
Switch Position LOCK (Door key turned to
lock)
Continuity
BE–99
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
Tester connection to
terminal number
Condition
14 – Ground
Passenger’s door courtesy switch position
OFF (Door closed)
No continuity
14– Ground
Passenger’s door courtesy switch position
ON (Door opened)
Continuity
16 – Ground
Constant
Continuity
Tester connection to
terminal number
Condition
Specified value (Continuity)
Specified value (Voltage)
1 – Ground
Ignition switch position LOCK or ACC
No voltage
1 – Ground
Ignition switch position ON
Battery positive voltage
8 – Ground
Constant
Battery positive voltage
If circuit is as specified, inspect the door lock signal.
If the circuit is not as specified, inspect the circuits
connected to other parts.
DOOR LOCK SIGNAL
HINT: When the relay circuit is as specified, inspect
the door lock signal.
(a) Connect the connector to the relay.
(b) Connect the positive (+) lead from the voltmeter to
terminal 3 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 4.
(c) Set the door lock manual switch to UNLOCK, check
that the voltage rises from 0 volts to battery positive
voltage for approximately 0.2 seconds.
(d) Reverse the polarity of the voltmeter leads.
(e) Set the door lock manual switch to LOCK, check that
the voltage rises from 0 volts to battery positive
voltage for approximately 0.2 seconds.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
BE–100
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
DESCRIPTION
Standby Operation
•
Current flows from the DOME fuse to terminal 12 of the sliding roof control relay (hereafter
called relay).
•
When the ignition switch is ON, the current flows from the power main relay to terminal 6
of the relay.
Operation
1. Limit Switch operation
2. OPEN operation
When the switch on the ’OPEN’ side of the control switch is pushed, continuity is produced
between terminal 1 of the relay and body ground. Then the relay operates, the current flows
through terminal6 of the relay –i terminal 5 –i terminal 1 of the sliding roof motor – terminal 3
–) terminal 4 of the relay – terminal 11 – the body ground, and the motor starts to run in order
to open the sliding roof.
3. CLOSE operation
When the switch on the ”CLOSE” side of the control switch is pushed, continuity is produced
between terminal 2 of the relay and body ground. Then the relay operates, the current flows
through terminal6 of the relay –i terminal 4 –r terminal 3 of the sliding roof motor –i terminal 1
– terminal 5 of the relay –i terminal 11 –i the body ground, and the motor starts to run in order
to close the sliding roof.
Momentary Stop
When the sliding roof reaches about 200 mm (7.87 in.) short of the fully closed position, the limit
switch No.1 is turned from ON to OFF, so there is no continuity between terminal 4 of the relay
and body ground. As a result, the sliding roof stops at that position.
4. TILT UP operation
When the switch on the ”UP” side of the control switch is pushed, continuity is produced between
terminal 3 of the relay and body ground. Then the relay operates, the current flows through
terminal6 of the relay –terminal 4 – terminal 3 of the sliding roof motor –i terminal 1 –i
terminal 5 of the relay – terminal 11 – the body ground, and the motor starts to run in order to
tilt up the sliding roof.
BE–101
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
5. TILT DOWN operation
When the switch on the ”DOWN” side of the control switch is pushed, continuity is produced
between terminal 7 of the relay and body ground. Then the relay operates, the current flows
through terminal6 of the relay – terminal 5 –terminal 1 of the sliding roof motor –) terminal 3
–) terminal 4 of the relay – terminal 11 – the body ground, and the motor starts to. run in order
to tilt down the sliding roof.
PARTS LOCATION
BE–102
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
TROUBLESHOOTING
The table below will be useful for you in troubleshooting these electrical problems. The most
likely causes of the malfunction are shown in the order of their probability. Inspect each part in
the order shown, and replace the part when it is found to be faulty.
Trouble
Parts name
(See page)
1. ALT H –Fuse
2. P/W M – Fuse
3. Wire Harness
(BE–4)
(BE–4)
1. GAUGE Fuse
2. Ignition Switch
3. P/W M –Fuse
4. Power Main Relay
5. Sliding Roof Switch
6. Sliding Roof Control Relay
7. Sliding Roof Motor
8. Wire Harness
(BE–4)
(BE–14)
(BE–4)
(BE–89)
(BE–103)
(BE–104)
(BE–103)
Sliding roof system operates abnormally.
1. Sliding Roof Control Relay
2. Limit Switch
3. Sliding Roof Switch
(BE–104)
(BE–105)
(BE–103)
Sliding roof system stops operation half way.
1. Sliding Roof Control Relay
(BE–104)
2. Limit Switch
(BE–105)
3. Sliding Roof Switch
(BE–103)
4. Sliding Roof Motor
(BE–103)
(Stones to foreign material trapped in motor assembly)
”Key–off Sliding Roof” operation does not operate.
1. DOME Fuse
2. GAUGE Fuse
3. Ignition Switch
4. Door Open Detection Switch
5. Wire Harness
*1 Sliding roof system does not operate.
*2 Sliding roof system does not operate.
*1: Door– Lock does not operate.
*2: Door– Lock is normal.
(BE–4)
(BE–4)
(BE–14)
(BE–94)
BE–103
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
SLIDING ROOF SWITCH INSPECTION
INSPECT SLIDING ROOF SWITCH
Continuity
Inspect the switch continuity between terminals.
Switch position
Tester connection to
terminal number
Specified value
3–4
Continuity
SLIDE CLOSE
4–6
Continuity
TILT DOWN
2–4
Continuity
SLIDE OPEN
No continuity
SLIDE OFF
No continuity
TILT OFF
TILT UP
4–5
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
SLIDING ROOF MOTOR INSPECTION
INSPECT SLIDING ROOF MOTOR
Motor Operation
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 3 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 1,
check that the motor turns to counterclockwise
(moves of the close side).
(b). Reverse the polarity, check that the motor turns to
clockwise (moves to the open side).
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
Circuit Breaker operation
(a) With the sliding roof in the fully opened position, hold
the sliding roof switch in ”OPEN” position and check
that there is a circuit breaker operation noise within
10 to 60 seconds.
BE–104
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
(b) With the sliding roof in fully opened position, hold the
sliding roof switch in ”CLOSE” position and check that
the sliding roof begins to close within 60 seconds.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
SLIDING ROOF CONTROL RELAY
INSPECTION
INSPECT SLIDING ROOF CONTROL RELAY
Circuit
Disconnect the connector from the relay and inspect
the connector on the wire harness side, as shown in
the chart.
Tester connection to
terminal number
Condition
Specified value (Continuity)
Sliding roof control switch position (SLIDE)
OFF or CLOSE
No continuity
Sliding roof control switch position (SLIDE)
OPEN
Continuity
Sliding roof control switch position (SLIDE)
OFF or OPEN
No continuity
Sliding roof control switch position (SLIDE)
CLOSE
Continuity
Sliding roof control switch position (TILT)
OFF or DOWN
No continuity
Sliding roof control switch position (TILT)
UP
Continuity
Constant
No continuity
Constant
Continuity
Constant
No continuity
Sliding roof control switch position (TILT)
OFF or UP
No continuity
Sliding roof control switch position (TILT)
DOWN
Continuity
No. 1 limit switch position OFF (Sliding roof
tilted up or open approx. 200 mm (7.87in.)) No continuity
No. 1 limit switch position ON (Except for
conditions mentioned above)
Continuity
No. 2 limit switch position OFF (Sliding roof
No continuity
closed)
No. 2 limit switch position ON (Sliding roof
open)
Continuity
BE–105
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
11 – Ground
–
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
Continuity
Constant
Tester connection to
terminal number
Specified value (Voltage)
Condition
6 – Ground
Ignition switch position LOCK or ACC
*No voltage
6 – Ground
Ignition switch position ON
Battery positive voltage
12 – Ground
Constant
Battery positive voltage
*: Exceptions: During 60 second period after ignition
switch ON – OFF (ACC) or until driver or passenger
door is opened after ignition switch ON –OFF (ACC).
If circuit is as specified, replace the relay.
LIMIT SWITCH INSPECTION
INSPECT LIMIT SWITCH
Continuity
Inspect the switch continuity between terminals.
Switch position
Tester connection to
terminal number
No. 1 limit switch OFF
(SW pin released)
No. 1 limit switch ON
(SW pin pushed in)
No continuity
1–4
No.2 limit switch OFF
(SW pin released)
No.2 limit switch ON
(SW pin pushed in)
Specified value
Continuity
No continuity
2–4
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
DOOR OPEN DETECTION SWITCH
See page BE–94.
POWER MAIN RELAY
See Power Main Relay on page BE–89.
BE–106
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
POWER MIRROR CONTROL SYSTEM
POWER MIRROR CONTROL SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
BE–107
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
POWER MIRROR CONTROL SYSTEM
TROUBLESHOOTING
The table below will be useful for you in troubleshooting these electrical problems. The most likely
causes of the malfunction are shown in the order of their probability. Inspect each part in the
order shown, and replace the part when it is found to be faulty.
Parts name
(see page)
Mirror does not operate.
1. RADIO Fuse
2. Mirror Switch
3. Mirror Motor
4. Wire Harness
(BE–4)
(BE–108)
(BE–109)
Mirror operates abnormally.
1. Mirror Switch
2. Mirror Motor
3. Wire Harness
(BE–108)
(BE–109)
Trouble
BE–108
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
POWER MIRROR CONTROL SYSTEM
MIRROR SWITCH INSPECTION
INSPECT MIRROR SWITCH
Continuity
Inspect the switch continuity between terminals.
LEFT SIDE
Switch position
Tester connection to
terminal number
OFF
Specified vaIue
No continuity
Continuity
DOWN
Continuity
LEFT
Continuity
RIGHT
Continuity
OFF
Switch position
Tester connection to
terminal number
Specified value
No continuity
OFF
Continuity
DOWN
Continuity
LEFT
Continuity
RIGHT
Continuity
RIGHT SIDE
Switch position
OFF
Tester connection to
terminal number
Specified value
No continuity
Continuity
DOWN
Continuity
LEFT
Continuity
RIGHT
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
BE–109
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
POWER MIRROR CONTROL SYSTEM
MIRROR MOTOR INSPECTION
INSPECT MIRROR MOTOR
Operation
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 3 and negative (–) lead to terminal 2, check
that the mirror turns upward.
(b) Reverse the polarity, check that the mirror turns to
downward.
(c) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 1 and negative (–) lead to terminal 2, check
that the mirror turns to left side.
(d) Reverse the polarity, check that the mirror turns to
right side.
If operation is not as specified, replace the mirror.
BE–110
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
BE–111
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
TROUBLESHOOTING
The table below will be useful for you in troubleshooting these electrical problems. The most
likely causes of the malfunction are shown in the order of their probability. Inspect each part in
the order shown, and replace the part when it is found to be faulty.
Trouble
Parts name
(See page)
Power seat does not operate.
(Door lock system does not operate)
1. ALT H –Fuse
2. Wire Harness
3. P/W M –Fuse
(BE–4)
Power seat does not operate.
(Door lock system is normal)
1. P/W M –Fuse
2. Wire Harness
3. Power Seat Switch
(BE–4)
”Slide operation” does not operate.
”Front Vertical Operation” does not operate.
1. Power Seat Switch
2. Wire Harness
3. Slide Motor
1. Power Seat Switch
2. Wire Harness
3. Front Vertical Motor
”Rear Vertical Operation” does not operate.
1. Power Seat Switch
2. Wire Harness
3. Rear Vertical Motor
”Reclining Operation” does not operate.
1. Power Seat Switch
2. Wire Harness
3. Reclining Motor
(BE–4)
(BE–112)
(BE–112)
(BE–113)
(BE–112)
(BE–113)
(BE–112)
(BE–114)
(BE–112)
(BE–115)
BE–112
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
POWER SEAT SWITCH INSPECTION
INSPECT POWER SEAT SWITCH
Continuity
Inspect the switch continuity between terminals.
SLIDE SWITCH
Switch position
Tester connection to
terminal number
Specified value
FRONT
5–10
8–9
Continuity
OFF
5–9
8–9
Continuity
BACK
5–9
8–10
Continuity
FRONT VERTICAL SWITCH
Switch position
Tester connection to
terminal number
Specified value
10–12
4–11
Continuity
OFF
4–11
4–12
Continuity
DOWN
4–12
10–11
Continuity
REAR VERTICAL SWITCH
Switch position
Tester connection to
terminal number
Specified value
2–10
6–7
Continuity
OFF
2–7
6–7
Continuity
DOWN
2–7
6–10
Continuity
RECLINING SWITCH
Switch position
Tester connection to
terminal number
Specified value
FORWARD
4–10
7–9
Continuity
OFF
4–9
7–9
Continuity
REAR
4–9
7–10
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
BE–113
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
SLIDE MOTOR INSPECTION
INSPECT SLIDE MOTOR
Operation
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 1 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 2,
check that the motor turns clockwise.
(b) Reverse the polarity, check that the motor turns coun–
terclockwise.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
Circuit Breaker Operation
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 2 and negative (–) lead to terminal 1 on the
slide motor connector, and move the seat front end
position.
(b) Continue to apply voltage, check that there is a circuit
breaker operation noise within 3 to 60 seconds.
(c) Reverse the polarity, check that the seat begins to
move backwards within approximately 60 seconds.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
FRONT VERTICAL MOTOR INSPECTION
INSPECT FRONT VERTICAL MOTOR
Operation
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 1 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 2,
check that the motor turns clockwise.
(b) Reverse the polarity, check that the motor turns coun–
terclockwise.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
PTC Thermistor Operation / Driver’s Seat
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 1, the positive (+) lead from the ammeter to
terminal 2 and the negative (–) lead to battery nega–
tive (–) terminal, and move the front edge of seat
cushion to the highest position.
(b) Continue to apply voltage, check the current changes
to less than 1 ampere with 4 to 90 seconds.
BE–114
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
(c) Disconnect the leads from terminals.
(d) Approximately 60 seconds later, connect the positive
(+) lead from battery to terminal 2 and the negative
(–) lead to terminal 1, check that the seat cushion
begins to descend.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
REAR VERTICAL MOTOR INSPECTION
INSPECT REAR VERTICAL MOTOR
Operation
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 1 and negative (–) lead to terminal 2, check
that the motor turns clockwise.
(b) Reverse the polarity, check that the motor turns coun–
terclockwise.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
PTC Thermistor Operation / Driver’s seat
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 1, the positive (+) lead from the ammeter to
terminal 2 and the negative (–) lead to battery nega–
tive (–) terminal, and move the rear edge of seat
cushion to the highest position.
b) Continue to apply voltage, check the current changes
to less than 1 ampere with 4 to 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the leads from terminals.
(d) Approximately 60 seconds later, connect the positive
(+) lead from battery to terminal 2 and the negative
(–) lead to terminal 1, check that the seat cushion
begins to descend.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
BE–115
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
RECLINING MOTOR INSPECTION
(Except 2–door)
INSPECT RECLINING MOTOR
Operation
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 1 and negative (–) lead to terminal 2, check
that the motor turns clockwise.
(b) Reverse the polarity, check that the motor turns coun–
terclockwise.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
PTC Thermistor Operation/ Driver’s Seat
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 2, the positive (+) lead from the ammeter to
terminal 1 and the negative lead to battery negative
(–) terminal, and recline the seat back to the most
forward position.
(b) Continue to apply voltage , check the current change
to less than 1 ampere with 4 to 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the lead from terminals.
(d) Approximately 60 seconds later, connect the positive
(+) lead from battery to terminal 1 and the negative
(–) lead to terminal 2, check that the seat back starts
to fall backwards.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
BE–116
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
AUDIO SYSTEM
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1. RADIO WAVE BAND
The radio wave bands used in radio broadcasting are as follows:
Frequency
30 kHz
300kHz
3 MHz
Designation
30 MHz
300 MHz
VHF
Radio wave
Modulation method
Amplitude modulation
Frequency modulation
LF: low Frequency MF: Medium Frequency HF: High Frequency VHF: Very High Frequency
2. SERVICE AREA
There are great differences in the size of the service
area for AM, FM monaural, and FM stereo broadcasts
cannot be received even though AM comes in very
clearly.
Not only does FM stereo have the smallest service
area, but it also picks up static and other types of
interference (”noise”) easily.
BE–117
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
3. RECEPTION PROBLEMS
Besides the problem of static, there are also the prob–
lems called ”fading”, ”rnultipath” and ”fade out”. These
problems are caused not by electrical noise but by the
nature of the radio waves themselves.
Fading
Besides electrical interference, AM broadcasts are
also susceptible to other types of interference, espe–
cially at night. This is because AM radio waves
bounce off the ionosphere at night. These radio waves
then interfere with the signals from the same trans–
mitter that reach the vehicle’s antenna directly. This
type of interference is called ”fading”.
Multipath
One type of interference caused by the bouncing of
radio waves off of obstructions is called ”multipath”.
Multipath occurs when a signal from the broadcast
transmitter antenna bounces off buildings and moun–
tains and interferes with the signal that is received
directly
Fade Out
Because FM radio waves are of higher frequencies
than AM radio waves, they bounce off buildings, mou–
ntains, and other obstructions. For this reason, FM
signals often seem to gradually disappear or fade
away as the vehicle goes behind a building or other
obstruction. This is called ”fade out”.
BE–118
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
4. COMPACT DISC PLAYER
Compact Disc (hereafter called ”CD”) Players use a
laser beam pick–up to read the digital signals recor–
ded on the CD and reproduce analog signals of the
music, etc. There are 4.7 in. (12 cm) and 3.2 in. (8 cm)
discs in the CD player.
HINT: Never attempt to disassemble or oil any part of
the player unit. Do not insert any object other than a
disc into the magazine.
NOTICE: CD players use an invisible laser beam which
could cause hazardous radiation exposure. Be sure to
operate the player correctly as instructed.
MAINTENANCE
Tape Player/Head Cleaning
(a) Raise the cassette door with your finger.
Next using a pencil or like object, push in the guide.
(b) Using a cleaning pen or cotton applicator soaked in
cleaner, clean the head surface, punch rollers and
capstans.
CD Player/Disc Cleaning
If the disc gets dirty, clean the disc by wiping the
surfaces from the center to outside in the radial direc–
tions with a soft cloth.
NOTICE: Do not use a conventional record cleaner or
anti–static preservative.
BE–119
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
ANTI–THEFT SYSTEM
HINT: The words ”ANTI–THEFT SYSTEM” are dis–
played on the cassette tape slot cover.
For operation instructions for the anti–theft system,
please consult the audio system section in the
Owner’s Manual (hereafter called O/M).
1. SETTING SYSTEM
The system is in operation once the customer has
pushed the required buttons and entered the custom–
er–selected 3–digit ID number.
(Refer to the O/M section, ”Setting the anti–theft
system”)
HINT:
• When the audio system is shipped the ID number
has not been input, so the anti–theft system is
not in operation.
• If the ID number has not been input, the audio
system remains the same as a normal audio
system.
2. ANTI–THEFT SYSTEM OPERATION
If the normal electrical power source (connector or
battery terminal) is cut off, the audio system becomes
inoperable, even if the power supply resumes.
3. CANCELLING SYSTEM
The ID number chosen by the customer is input to
cancel the anti–theft system.
(Refer to the O/M section, ’if the system is activated”)
HINT: To change or cancel the ID number, please refer
to the 0/M section ”Cancelling the system”.
BE–120
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
BE–121
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
BE–122
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
TROUBLESHOOTING
NOTICE: When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the audio system, be careful that no
part of your body or clothing comes in contact with the terminals of the leads from the IC etc. of the
replacement part (spare part),
HINT: This inspection procedure is a simple troubleshooting which should be carried out on the vehicle
during system operation and was prepared on the assumption of system component troubles (except for
the wires and connectors, etc.).
Always inspect the trouble taking the following items into consideration.
• Open or short circuit of the wire harness
• Connector or terminal connection fault
Problem
Radio not operating when power switch turned to ”ON’.
Display indicates when power switch turned to ’ON’, but no sound (including ’noise’) is
produced.
Radio
Noise present, but AM–FM not operating.
Any speaker does not work.
Reception poor.
Sound quality poor.
Preset memory disappears.
Cassette tape cannot be inserted.
Cassette tape inserts, but no power
Power coming in, but tape player not operating.
Tape player
Any speaker does not work.
Sound quality poor.
Tape jammed, malfunction with tape speed or auto–reverse
Cassette tape will not eject.
CD cannot be inserted.
C D inserts, but no power
Power coming in, but CD player not operating.
CD Player
Sound jumps.
Sound quality poor (Volume faint).
Any speaker does not work.
CD will not eject.
Antenna
Antenna–related.
Noise produced by vibration or shock white driving.
Noise
Noise produced when engine starts.
The term”AM” includes LW, MW and SW, and the term ”FW” includes UKW.
No.
BE–123
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
HOW TO USE DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Reference:
Radio
NO POWER COMING IN
Check if RADIO fuse is OK?
Replace fuse
Yes
Check if DOME fuse is OK?
Replace fuse
Yes
Is ACC applied to radio?
ACC wire harness faulty
Yes
Check if GND (Wire harness side) to
radio is OK?
GND wire harness faulty
Yes
Radio faulty
1 : Phenomenon
: Problem
2 : Check item
3
: Trouble part or disposal
BE–124
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
Troubleshooting for ANTI–THEFT SYSTEM
Turn Ignition key from LOCK position to ACC position.
Display A:
I D Number is set.
”SEC” display disappears after
second.
Display E:
ANTI–THEFT SYSTEM
operation condition.
(ID number input error
10 times or more.)
Display B.
Radio switch ON.
Yes
Display6
Display D
Refer to each
malfunction item.
Normal
operation.
Take to designated radio
service station.
Radio switch ON.
Normal operation.
Cancel ID number, refer to each malfunction item.
ANTI–THEFT SYSTEM operation condition.
(ID number input error 9 times or less.)
Input ID number to cancel ANTI–THEFT SYSTEM, and check display.
Display A –B
Display B
Display E
Display C –+ A
Radio switch ON.
Refer to each mal–
function item.
Take to designated radio
service station.
ANTI–THEFT SYSTEM not
cancelled.
(ID number input error 10
times or less.)
Display D
ANTI–THEFT SYSTEM cancelled.
Check audio system again.
Normal operation.
Cancel I D number, refer to each malfunction item.
(Liquid Crystal Display (LCD) or VFD for Audio System)
HINT;
• Refer to Owner’s Manual for operation details of ANTI–THEFT SYSTEM.
• When the ID number has been cancelled, reset the same number after completing the operation, or
inform the customer that it has been cancelled.
BE–125
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Radio
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
RADIO NOT OPERATING WHEN POWER SWITCH
TURNED TO ’ON’
Check if RADIO fuse is OK?
Replace fuse.
Is ACC applied to radio ?
ACC wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check if DOME fuse is OK?
Replace fuse.
Is +B applied to radio?
+ B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check if GND (wire harness side) to radio is OK?
Radio assembly faulty.
G N D .faulty.
BE–126
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Is tape player operating normally?
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
Check if RADIO fuse is OK?
Replace fuse.
Is ACC applied to radio?
ACC wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check if DOME fuse is OK?
Replace fuse.
Is +B applied to radio?
+ B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check if GND (wire harness side) to radio is OK?
Radio assembly faulty.
GND faulty.
BE–127
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Is tape player operating normally?
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
Check if RADIO fuse is OK?
Replace fuse.
Is ACC applied to power amplifier?
ACC wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check if DOME fuse is OK?
Replace fuse.
Is + B applied to power amplifier?
+ B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check if GND (wire harness side) to power amplier is OK?
GND faulty.
Is ACC applied to radio assembly?
Power amplifier faulty.
Yes
Is + B applied to radio assembly?
Power amplifier faulty.
Yes
Check if GND (wire harness side) to radio assembly is OK?
Radio assembly faulty.
GND faulty.
BE–128
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Radio
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
DISPLAY INDICATES WHEN POWER SWITCH TURNED TO
’ON’, BUT NO SOUND (INCLUDING ’NOISE’) IS PRODUCED
Check if RADIO fuse is 0K?
Replace fuse.
Is ACC applied to radio?
ACC wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check if DOME fuse is OK?
Replace fuse.
Is +B applied to radio?
+ B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check if GND (wire harness side) to radio is OK?
GND faulty.
Is there continuity in speaker wire harness?
Speaker wire harness faulty.
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker.
Yes
If radio side faulty
Go to No. 15
Radio faulty.
Speaker faulty.
BE–129
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Is tape player operating normally?
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
Yes
Radio faulty.
Check if RADIO fuse is OK?
Replace fuse.
Is ACC applied to radio?
ACC wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check if DOME fuse is OK?
Replace fuse.
Is + B applied to radio?
+ B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check if GND (wire harness side) to radio is OK?
GND faulty.
Is there continuity in speaker wire harness?
Speaker wire harness faulty.
Yes
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker.
If radio side faulty
Go to No. 15
Radio faulty.
Speaker faulty.
BE–130
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
Yes
Is tape player operating normally?
Is power for the antenna being output
from the tape player?
Yes
Yes
Is power for the antenna being
output from the power
amplifier?
Radio assembly
faulty.
If power amplifier side faulty
Power amplifier faulty.
Go to No. 15
Check if RADIO fuse is OK?
Replace fuse.
Is ACC applied to power amplifier.
ACC wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check if DOME fuse is OK?
Replace fuse.
Is + B applied to power amplifier.
+B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check if GNO (wire harness side) to power amplifier is OK?
GND faulty.
Is ACC applied to radio assembly?
Power amplifier faulty.
Yes
Is + B applied to radio assembly?
Power amplifier faulty.
Yes
Check if G N D (wire harness side) to radio assembly is OK?
CONTINUED ON NEXT PAGE
G N D faulty.
BE–131
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
CONTINUED FROM PREVIOUS PAGE
!s there continuity in speaker wire harness?
Speaker wire harness faulty.
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker. Functions OK?
Yes
Hissing sound from speaker?
Speaker faulty.
Power amplifier faulty.
Recheck system after repair.
Yes
Radio assembly faulty. Recheck system after repair.
Radio
NOISE PRESENT, BUT AM–FM NOT OPERATING
Go to No. 15
if radio side faulty
Radio
Radio faulty.
ANY SPEAKER DOES NOT WORK
Is hiss produced by non–functioning speaker?
Yes
Radio faulty.
Speaker wire harness faulty.
!s there continuity in speaker wire harness?
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker. Functions OK?
Radio faulty.
Yes
Speaker faulty.
BE–132
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Is tape player operating normally?
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
Yes
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
Is hiss produced by non–functioning speaker?
Radio assembly faulty.
Is there continuity in speaker wire harness?
Speaker wire harness faulty.
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker. Functions OK?
Yes
Speaker faulty.
Radio assembly faulty.
Yes
Is tape player operating normally?
Is hiss produced by non–functioning speaker?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
Radio assembly faulty.
Recheck system after repair.
Speaker wire harness faulty.
Is there continuity in speaker wire harness?
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker? Functions OK?
Power amplifier faulty. Recheck system after repair.
Yes
Speaker faulty.
BE–133
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Radio
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
EITHER AM OR FM DOES NOT WORK, RECEPTION
POOR (VOLUME FAINT), FEW PRESET TUNING BANDS
Problem with radio wave signals or location?
Yes
Are both AM or FM defective?
Poor signals, poor location.
Radio faulty.
Yes
Is power for the antenna being output from the radio?
Yes
Go to No. 15
Temporarily install another speaker. Functions OK?
Yes
Speaker faulty.
Radio faulty.
Problem with radio wave signals or location?
Are both AM or FM defective?
Yes
Is power for the antenna being output from the radio assembly?
Yes
Go to No. 15
CONTINUED ON NEXT PAGE
Yes
Poor signals, poor location.
Radio assembly faulty.
BE–134
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
CONTINUED FROM PREVIOUS PAGE
Is tape player operating normally?
Temporarily install another speaker. Functions OK?
Yes
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
Speaker faulty.
Radio assembly faulty.
Problem with radio wave signals or location?
Yes
Are both AM and FM defective?
Poor signals, poor location.
Radio assembly faulty.
Yes
Is power for the antenna being output from the radio assembly?
I Yes
Go to No. 15
Is tape player operating normally?
Temporarily install another speaker. Functions OK?
Hissing sound from speaker?
¿Yes
Radio assembly faulty. Recheck system after repair.
Yes
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
Speaker faulty.
Power amplifier faulty.
Recheck system after repair.
BE–135
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Radio
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
SOUND QUALITY POOR
Is sound quality always bed?
Is sound quality bad in certain
area only?
Yes
Poor signals, poor
location.
Yes
Radio faulty.
Install properly.
is speaker properly installed?
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker. Functions OK?
Yes
Speaker faulty.
Radio faulty.
Is power for the antenna being output from the radio?
Yes
If radio side faulty
Go to No. 15
Is sound quality always bad?
Is sound quality bad in certain
area only?
Yes
Poor signals, poor
location.
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
Is tape player operating normally?
Yes
Is power for the antenna being
output from the radio assembly?
Yes
If radio side
faulty
Go to No. 15
Is speaker properly installed?
Radio assembly
faulty.
Install property.
Yes
CONTINUED ON NEXT PAGE
Radio assembly
faulty.
BE–136
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
CONTINUED FROM PREVIOUS PAGE
Yes
Speaker faulty.
Temporarily install another speaker. Functions OK?
Radio assembly faulty.
Is sound quality bad in
certain areas only?
Is sound quality always bad?
Yes
Poor signals, poor
location.
Yes
Yes
Is tape player operating normally?
Is tape player operating normally?
Yes
Radio assembly or power
amplifier faulty.
Radio assembly faulty.
Is power for the antenna
being output from the
radio assembly?
Radio assembly faulty.
Yes
Is power for the antenna
being output from the
power amplifier?
Is speaker properly installed?
Install properly.
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker. Functions OK?
Radio assembly or power amplifier faulty.
Recheck system after repair.
Yes
Speaker faulty.
Power amplifier faulty.
BE–137
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Radio
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
PRESET MEMORY DISAPPEARS
Check if DOME fuse is OK?
Replace fuse.
Is + B applied to radio?
+ B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check if GND (wire harness side) to radio?
GND faulty.
Radio faulty.
Can cassette tape be inserted in tape player?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
Check if DOME fuse is OK?
Replace fuse.
Is + B applied to radio assembly?
+B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check if GND (wire harness side) to radio?
Radio assembly faulty.
GND faulty.
BE–138
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Can cassette tape be inserted in tape player?
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
Check if DOME fuse is OK?
Replace fuse.
Is + B applied to power amplifier?
+ B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check if GND (wire harness side) to power amplifier?
GND faulty.
Is + B applied to radio assembly?
Power amplifier faulty.
Yes
Check if GND (wire harness side) to radio assembly?
Radio assembly faulty.
Power amplifier faulty.
BE–139
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Tape Player
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
CASSETTE TAPE CANNOT BE INSERTED
Is there a foreign object inside tape player?
Is auto search button of radio operating normally?
Yes
Yes
Remove foreign object.
Radio assembly faulty.
Check if DOME fuse is OK?
Replace fuse.
Is +B applied to radio assembly?
+B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check if GND (wire harness side) to radio assembly?
GND faulty.
Radio assembly faulty.
Is there a foreign object inside tape player?
Is auto search button radio operating normally?
Check if DOME fuse is OK?
Yes
Yes
Remove foreign object.
Radio assembly faulty.
Replace fuse.
OK
CONTINUED ON NEXT PAGE
BE–140
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
CONTINUED FROM PREVIOUS PAGE
+ B wire harness faulty.
Is + B applied to power amplifier?
Yes
Check if GND (wire harness side) to power amplifier is OK?
GND faulty.
Is + B applied to radio assembly
Power amplifier faulty.
Yes
Power amplifier faulty.
Check if GND (wire harness side) to radio assembly is OK?
Radio assembly faulty.
CASSETTE TAPE INSERTS, BUT NO POWER
¿¿
Tape Player
Yes
Is radio operating normally?
Radio assembly faulty.
Check if RADIO fuse is OK?
Replace fuse.
Is ACC applied to radio assembly?
ACC wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check if DOME fuse is OK?
Is + B applied to radio assembly?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
NG
No
Replace fuse.
+ B wire harness faulty.
BE–141
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
Yes
Is radio operating normal?
Radio assembly faulty.
Check if RADIO fuse is OK?
Replace fuse.
Is ACC applied to power amplifier?
ACC wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check if DOME fuse is OK?
Replace fuse.
Is + B applied to power amplifier?
+ B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Is ACC applied to radio assembly?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
Power amplifier faulty.
BE–142
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Tape Player
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
POWER COMING IN, BUT TAPE PLAYER NOT
OPERATING
Functions OK if different cassette tape inserted?
Is radio operating normally?
Yes
Yes
Is there continuity in speaker wire harness?
Cassette tape faulty.
Radio assembly faulty.
Speaker wire harness faulty.
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker.
Functions OK?
Yes
Speaker faulty.
Radio assembly faulty.
Function 4K if different cassette tape inserted?
Is radio operating normally?
Is there continuity in speaker wire harness?
Yes
CONTINUED ON NEXT PAGE
Yes
Yes
Cassette tape faulty.
Radio assembly faulty.
Speaker wire harness faulty.
BE–143
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
CONTINUED FROM PREVIOUS PAGE
Temporarily install another speaker.
Function OK?
Yes
Hissing sound from speaker?
Speaker faulty.
Power amplifier faulty.
Recheck system after repair.
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
Recheck system after repair.
Tape Player
EITHER SPEAKER DOES NOT WORK
Is radio operating normally?
Is hiss produces by non–functioning speaker.
Yes
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
Is there continuity in speaker wire harness?
Temporarily install another speaker.
Functions OK?
Radio assembly faulty.
Radio assembly faulty.
Speaker wire harness faulty.
Yes
Speaker faulty.
BE–144
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
Yes
Is radio operating normally?
Is hiss produced by non–functioning speaker?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
Radio assembly faulty.
Recheck system after repair.
Speaker wire harness faulty.
Is there continuity in speaker wire harness?
Yes
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker.
Function OK?
Speaker faulty.
Radio assembly or power amplifier faulty.
Tape Player
SOUND QUALITY POOR (VOLUME FAINT)
Functions OK if different cassette tape inserted?
Operates normally after cleaning the heads?
Yes
Yes
Cassette tape faulty.
Head dirty.
Yes
Is radio operating normally?
Radio assembly faulty.
Is speaker properly installed?
Yes
CONTINUED ON NEXT PAGE
Install properly.
BE–145
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
CONTINUED FROM PREVIOUS PAGE
Temporarily install another speaker.
Function OK?
Yes
Speaker faulty.
Radio assembly faulty.
Functions OK different cassette tape inserted?
Operates normally after cleaning the heads?
Is radio operating normally?
Yes
Yes
Yes
Is speaker properly installed?
Cassette tape faulty.
Head dirty.
Radio assembly faulty.
Install properly.
Yes
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker.
Functions OK?
Radio assembly faulty,
Speaker faulty.
BE–146
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Tape Player
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
TAPE JAMMED MALFUNCTION WITH TAPE SPEED
OR AUTO–REVERSE
Function OK if different tape (less than 120 mins.) is inserted?
Is there a foreign abject inside tape player?
Operates normally after cleaning the heads?
Yes
Yes
Yes
Cassette tape faulty.
Remove foreign object.
Head dirty.
Radio assembly faulty.
Tape Player
CASETTE TAPE WILL NOT EJECT
Is tape player operating normally?
Cassette tape jammed.
Yes
Is auto search button of radio operating normally?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
Check if DOME fuse is OK?
Replace fuse.
Is + B applied to radio assembly?
+ B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Radio assembly faulty?
BE–147
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
Cassette tape jammed.
Is tape player operating normally?
Yes
Yes
Is auto search button of radio operating normally?
Radio assembly faulty.
Check if DOME fuse is OK?
Replace fuse.
!s + B applied to power amplifier?
+ B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Power amplifier faulty.
Is +B applied to radio assembly?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
CD Player
CD CANNOT BE INSERTED
Yes
Is CD already inserted?
Is auto search button of radio operating normally?
Yes
Eject CD.
Is + B applied to CD player?
Yes
Check if GND wire harness side
to CD player is OK?
CD player faulty.
Check if DOME fuse is OK?
Replace fuse.
OK
CONTINUED ON NEXT PAGE
Radio assembly
faulty.
BE–148
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
CONTINUED FROM PREVIOUS PAGE
Is +B applied to power amplifier?
+B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check if GND (wire harness side) to radio assembly is OK?
Radio assembly faulty.
CD Player
CD INSERTS, BUT NO POWER
Yes
Is radio operating normally?
Is ACC applied to CD player?
Radio assembly
faulty.
Yes
CD player faulty.
Check if RADIO fuse is OK?
Replace fuse.
Is ACC applied to power amplifier?
ACC wire harness faulty.
Yes
Is ACC applied to radio assembly?
Power amplifier faulty.
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
CD Player
POWER COMING IN, BUT CD PLAYER NOT
OPERATING
Is CD inserted correct side up?
Insert correctly.
Yes
Yes
function OK if different CD inserted?
Is radio operating normally?
CD faulty.
Yes
Is temperature inside cabin hot?
Yes
Protective circuit in
operation.
CONTINUED ON NEXT PAGE
CONTINUED ON NEXT PAGE
BE–149
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
CONTINUED FROM PREVIOUS PAGE
Yes
CONTINUED FROM PREVIOUS PAGE
Formation of condensation
due to temp. change.
Has sudden temperature change
occurred inside cabin?
CD player faulty.
Speaker wire harness faulty.
Is there continuity in speaker wire harness?
Yes
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker,
Functions OK?
Speaker faulty.
Hissing sound from speaker?
Power amplifier faulty.
Recheck system after repair.
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
Recheck system after repair.
CD Player
SOUND JUMPS
Yes
Does sound jump only during strong vibration?
Jumping caused by vibration.
Is CD player properly installed?
Install properly.
Yes
Functions OK if different CD inserted?
Has sudden temperature change occurred inside cabin?
CD player faulty.
Yes
Yes
CD faulty.
Formation of condensation due to
temp. change.
BE–150
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
CD Player
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
SOUND QUALITY POOR (VOLUME FAINT)
Functions OK if different CD inserted?
Yes
Yes
Is radio operating normally?
Is speaker properly installed?
CD faulty.
CD player faulty.
Install properly.
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker.
Functions OK?
Yes
Speaker faulty.
Radio assembly or CD player or Power amplifier faulty.
CD Player
EITHER SPEAKER DOES NOT WORK
Is radio operating normally?
Is hiss produced by non–functioning speaker?
Yes
Yes
Is there continuity in speaker wire harness?
C D player faulty.
Radio assembly faulty.
Recheck system after repair.
Speaker wire harness faulty.
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker.
Function OK.
Power amplifier faulty.
Recheck system after repair.
Yes
Speaker faulty.
BE–151
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
CD Player
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
CD WILL NOT EJECT
Is auto search button of radio operating
normally?
Yes
Is + B applied to CD player?
Radio assembly
faulty.
Yes
CD player faulty.
Check if DOME fuse is OK?
Replace fuse.
Is +B applied to power amplifier?
+ B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Is + B applied to radio assembly?
Power amplifier faulty.
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
Antenna
ANTENNA – RELATED
Antenna w/o Motor Type
Is antenna extended?
Extend fully.
Yes
Temporarily install another antenna, Functions OK?
Radio side faulty.
Yes
Antenna faulty.
BE–152
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
Motor Antenna Type
Does antenna extend when radio switched ON?
Yes
Temporarily install another antenna.
Functions OK?
Yes
Motor antenna
faulty.
Radio side faulty.
Inspect antenna motor.
Antenna motor faulty.
Inspect antenna motor control relay. (Relay circuit)
Relay faulty.
Yes
Is power related to the antenna being input to the antenna
motor control relay?
Check continuity between antenna motor control relay and radio.
Relay circuit faulty.
Wire harness faulty.
Radio side faulty.
Motor Antenna and Glass Printed Antenna Type
Yes
Does antenna extend when radio switched ON?
Inspect glass printed antenna.
Glass printed antenna faulty.
Temporarily install another
antenna.
Functions OK?
Radio side faulty.
CONTINUED ON NEXT PAGE
Yes
Motor antenna faulty.
BE–153
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
CONTINUED FROM PREVIOUS PAGE
Inspect antenna motor.
Antenna motor faulty.
Inspect antenna motor control relay.
(Relay circuit)
Relay faulty.
Is power related to the antenna being input to the antenna
motor control relay?
Yes
Relay circuit faulty.
Wire harness faulty.
Check continuity between antenna motor control relay and radio.
Radio side faulty.
Noise
NOISE PRODUCED BY VIBRATION OR SHOCK WHILE
DRIVING
Install properly.
Is speaker properly installed?
Yes
Is each system correctly installed?
Yes
Yes
With vehicle stopped lightly tap each system.
Is noise produced?
Noise produced by static electricity accumulating in the vehicle body.
Each system faulty.
BE–154
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Noise
–
NOISE PRODUCED WHEN ENGINE STARTS
Whistling noise which becomes high–pitched when accelerator
strongly depressed, disappears shortly after engine stops.
Whining noise occurs when A/C is operating.
Scratching noise occurs during sudden acceleration, driving on
rough roads or when ignition switch is turned on.
Clicking sound heard when horn button is pressed, then
released. Whirring /grating sound when pushed continuously.
Murmuring sound, stops when engine stops.
Tick–tock noise occurs in co–ordination with blinking of
flasher.
Noise occurs during window washer operation.
Scratching noise occurs while engine is running, continues
a while even after engine stops.
Scraping noise in time with wiper beat.
Other type of noise.
AUDIO SYSTEM
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Generator noise.
A/C noise.
Fuel gauge noise.
Horn noise.
Ignition noise.
Turn signal noise.
Washer noise.
Engine coolant temp. gauge noise.
Wiper noise.
BE–155
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
MOTOR ANTENNA REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
1. REMOVE MOTOR ANTENNA
(a) Remove the antenna nut.
(b) Remove the RH side cover.
(c) Disconnect the motor antenna connector.
(d) Remove the nut and the motor antenna assembly.
(e) Disconnect the antenna cord.
(f) Remove the drain hose.
2. INSTALL MOTOR ANTENNA
(a) Connect the motor antenna connector and the anten–
na cord.
(b) Install the antenna nut.
(c) Install the nut.
(d) Connect the drain hose.
ANTENNA ROD REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
1. REMOVE ANTENNA ROD
HINT: Perform this operation with the battery nega–
tive (–) cable connected to the battery terminal.
(a) Turn the ignition switch to ”LOCK” position.
(b) Remove the antenna nut.
(c) Press the ’AM’ or ”FM” button on the radio receiver,
and simultaneously turn the ignition switch to ”ACC”
position.
HINT:
• The rod will extend fully and be released from the
motor antenna.
• After removing the antenna rod, leave the igni–
tion switch at ”ACC”.
NOTICE: To prevent body damage when the antenna rod
Is released, hold the rod while It comes out.
BE–156
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
2. INSTALL ANTENNA ROD
(a) Insert the cable of the rod until it reaches the bottom.
HINT:
• When inserting the cable, the teeth on the cable
must face toward the rear of the vehicle.
• Insert the cable approx. 400 mm (15.7 in.).
(b) Wind the cable to retract the rod by turning the
ignition switch to ”LOCK” position.
HINT:
• If the ignition switch is already in ”LOCK” posi–
tion, perform step 1 (c) first, then turn the ignition
switch to ”ACC” position.
• In case the cable is not wound, twist it, as shown
in the illustration.
• Even if the rod has not retracted fully, install the
antenna nut and inspect the antenna rod opera–
tion. It will finally retract fully.
(c) Inspect the antenna rod operation by pushing the
radio wave band select buttons.
MOTOR ANTENNA INSPECTION
1. INSPECT MOTOR ANTENNA
Circuit
Disconnect the motor antenna connector from the
body wire harness and inspect the connector on body
wire harness side, as shown.
Tester connection to
terminal number
Condition
Specified value (Voltage)
3 – Ground
Battery positive voltage
Constant
Ignition switch ACC or ON and radio switch
No voltage
ON Others
3 – Ground
Ignition switch ACC or ON and radio switch
Battery positive voltage
ON AM or FM (87.9 – 96.0 MHz)
4 – Ground
Ignition switch ACC or ON Radio switch
OFF
4 – Ground
Ignition switch ACC or ON Radio switch ON Battery positive voltage
5 – Ground
Ignition switch position ACC or LOCK
No voltage
5 – Ground
Ignition switch position ON
Battery positive voltage
6 – Ground
Ignition switch position LOCK
No voltage
6 – Ground
Ignition switch position ACC or ON
Battery positive voltage
2 – Ground
No voltage
BE–157
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Tester connection to
terminal number
1 – Ground
Condition
Constant
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
Specified value (Continuity)
Continuity
If circuit is not as specified, inspect radio or wire
harness.
If circuit is as specified, replace motor antenna.
2. INSPECT ANTENNA MOTOR
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 1 and negative (–) lead to terminal 4.
(b) Check that the motor turns (moves upward).
NOTICE: These tests must be performed quickly (within 3
– 5 seconds) to prevent the coil from burning out.
(c) Then, reverse the polarity, check that the motor turns
the opposite way (moves downward).
NOTICE: These tests must be performed quickly (within 3
– 5 seconds) to prevent the coil from burning out.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
BE–158
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
3. INSPECT ANTENNA MOTOR CONTROL RELAY
Relay Circuit
Disconnect the connector from the relay and inspect
the connector on wire harness side, as shown in the
chart.
Tester connection to
terminal number
1–4
2 – Ground
Tester connection to
terminal number
3 – Ground
Condition
Specified value (Continuity)
Constant
Continuity
Constant
Continuity
Condition
Specified value (Voltage)
5 – Ground
Constant
Ignition switch position LOCK
Battery positive voltage
No voltage
5 – Ground
Ignition switch position ACC or ON
Battery positive voltage
6 – Ground
Ignition switch position LOCK
No voltage
6 – Ground
Ignition switch position ACC or ON Radio
switch and cassette OFF
No voltage
6 – Ground
Ignition switch position ACC or ON Radio
switch or cassette ON
Battery positive voltage
8 – Ground
Ignition switch position LOCK
No voltage
8 – Ground
Ignition switch position ACC or ON Radio
switch OFF or casette ON
No voltage
8 – Ground
Ignition switch position ACC or ON Radio
switch ON and casette OFF
Battery positive voltage
9 – Ground
Ignition switch position LOCK or ACC
No voltage
9 – Ground
Ignition switch position ON
Battery positive voltage
If circuit is as specified, replace the relay.
GLASS PRINTED ANTENNA INSPECTION
1. INSPECT GLASS PRINTED ANTENNA
(Use same procedure as for ”INSPECT DEFOGGER
WIRES” on page BE–80.)
2. REPAIR GLASS PRINTED ANTENNA
(Use same procedure as for ” REPAIR DEFOGGER
WIRES” on page BE–80.)
BE–159
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CLOCK
CLOCK
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT: Troubleshoot the clock according to the table
below.
Clock will not operate
Clock loses or gains time
± 1.5 seconds/day
CLOCK WILL NOT OPERATE
(a) Check that the battery positive voltage is 10 – 16 V.
If voltage is not as specified, replace the battery.
(b) Check that the DOME fuse is not blown.
If the fuse is blown, replace the fuse and check for short.
(c) Troubleshoot the clock as follows.
HINT: Inspect the connector on the wire harness side.
BE–160
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CLOCK
Open or short circuit in wire harness
between terminal + B and DOME fuse.
Is there battery positive voltage between terminal + B and body
ground?
Yes
Is there continuity between terminal GND and body ground?
Open circuit in wire harness between
terminal GND and body ground.
Yes
Replay clock.
CLOCK LOSES OR GAINS TIME
(a) Check that the battery positive voltage is 10 – 16 V.
If voltage is not as specified, replace the battery.
(b) Inspect the error of the clock.
Allowable error (per day): ± 1.5 seconds
If the error exceeds the allowable error, replace the clock.
(c) Check that the clock adjusting button is sticking in posi–
tion and has failed to return.
If the button is not returned, repair or replace the clock.
(d) Troubleshoot the clock as follows.
HINT: Inspect the connector on the wire harness side.
Is there 10 – 16 V between terminal +B and body ground?
Yes
Adjust or replace clock.
Below 10 V
Locate cause and repair, or recharge
battery.
BE–161
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
– MEMO –
–
CLOCK
BE–162
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–MEMO –
–
CLOCK
BE–163
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
BE–164
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DESCRIPTION
The cruise control system is standard, which is convenient when driving continuously at a constant speed.
The cruise control ECU controls all cruise control functions.
A diagnosis function is built in. In the unlikely event of a malfunction in the system, the problem area is
detected by the cruise control ECU and it causes the power indicator light on the combination meter to
blink, warning the driver that there is an abnormality as well as storing a malfunction code in the ECU
memory for the service technician to retrieve.
PARTS LOCATION
BE–165
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
Perform troubleshooting in accordance with the procedure on the following page.
1. CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
Using the customer problem analysis check sheet for reference, ask the customer in as much detail as
possible about the problem.
2. CHECK AND CLEAR THE DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES (PRECHECK)
When there is a problem with the cruise control being canceled or failing to set, first check the
diagnostic trouble code if there are any trouble codes stored in memory. If there are trouble codes, make
a note of them, then clear them and proceed to ”3 Problem Symptom Confirmation”.
3. PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION, 4 SYMPTOM SIMULATION
Confirm the problem symptoms. If the problem does not reappear, be sure to simulate the problem by
mainly checking the circuits indicated by the diagnostic trouble code in step 2, using ”Problem
Simulation Method”.
5. DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK
Check the diagnostic trouble codes. Determine if the problem is in the sensors or the wire harness.
If a malfunction code is present, proceed to ”6 Diagnostic Trouble Code Chart”. If the normal code is
output, proceed to ”7 Matrix Chart Problem Symptoms”.
Be sure to proceed to ”6 Diagnostic Trouble Code Chart” after 2 and 3 .
If troubleshooting is attempted after only the first malfunction code in the memory is output, errors
could be made in the diagnosis.
6. DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a trouble code is confirmed in the diagnostic trouble code check, proceed to the check procedure indi–
cated by the matrix chart for each diagnostic code.
7. MATRIX CHART OF PROBLEM SYMPTOMS
If the normal code is confirmed in the diagnostic trouble code check, perform inspection in accordance
with the inspection order in the matrix chart of problem symptoms.
8. CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Proceed with diagnosis of each circuit in accordance with the inspection order in 6 and 7 .
Determine whether the cause of the problem is in the sensor, actuators, wire harness and connectors,
or the ECU.
9. INPUT SIGNAL CHECK
Check whether signals from the stop light switch and park/neutral position switch, etc. are input nor–
mally to the ECU. This check is indicated in the flow chart for each circuit.
10. CONFIRMATION TEST
After completing repairs, confirm not only that the malfunction is eliminated, but also perform a drive
test, etc. to make sure the entire cruise control system is operating correctly.
BE–166
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Items inside are
titles of pages in this manual,
with the page number indicated in the bottom
portion.
Seethe indicated pages for detailed–explanations:
Vehicle Brought to
Workshop
Customer Problem Analysis
P. BE–167
Check and Clear Diagnostic Trouble Codes
(Precheck)
P. BE–170
Symptom
does not occur
Symptom Simulation .
Problem Symptom Confirmation
P. IN–24
Symptom
occur
Diagnostic Trouble Code Check
Normal code
P. BE–168 ~ BE–171
Malfunction Code
Diagnostic Trouble Code Chart
Matrix Chart of Problems Symptoms
P. BE–178
P. BE–171
Circuit Inspection
Input Signal
Check
Parts Inspection
P. BE–190 ~ BE–231
Identification of Problem
Repair
Confirmation Test
Step 2 , 5 , 8 , 10
END
: Diagnostic steps permitting the use of
the TOYOTA hand–held tester or TOYOTA
break–out–box.
BE–167
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK SHEET
BE–168
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
INDICATOR CHECK
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON.
2. Check that the CRUISE MAIN indicator light comes on
when the cruise control main switch is turned on, and that
the indicator light goes oft when the main switch is turned
OFF.
HINT: If the indicator check result is not normal, pro–
ceed to troubleshooting (See page BE–65) for the com–
bination meter section.
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK
HINT: If a malfunction occurs in the speed sensors or
actuator, etc. during cruise control driving, the ECU
actuates AUTO CANCEL of the cruise control and blinks
the CRUISE MAIN indicator light 5 times to inform the
driver of a malfunction. At the same time, the malfunction
is stored in memory as a diagnostic trouble code.
Output of Diagnostic Trouble Code
Using diagnosis check wire:
1. Turn the ignition switch ON.
2. Using SST, connect terminals Tc and E1 of DLC2.
3. Read the diagnostic trouble code on the CRUISE MAIN in–
dicator light.
HINT: If the diagnostic trouble code is not output, in–
spect the Tc circuit (See page BE–230).
As an example, the blinking patterns for codes; normal,
11 and 21 are shown in the illustration.
4. Check for the problem using the diagnostic trouble code
table on the next page.
5. After completing the check, disconnect terminals Tc and
E1, and turn off the display.
BE–169
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
ECU DATA MONITOR USING TOYOTA
HAND–HELD TESTER
1. Hook up the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC2.
2. Monitor the ECU data by following the prompts on the
tester screen.
HINT: TOYOTA hand–held tester had a ”Snapshot”
function which records the monitored data.
Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester operator’s
manual for further details.
ECU TERMINAL VALUES MEASUREMENT
USING TOYOTA BREAK–OUT–BOX AND
TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER
1. Hook up the TOYOTA hand–held tester and TOYOTA break–out–
box to the vehicle.
2. Read the ECU input/output values by following the
prompts on the tester screen.
HINT: TOYOTA hand–held tester has a ”Snapshot” func–
tion.
This records the measured values and is effective in the
diagnosis of intermittent problems.
Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester/TOYOTA break
out–box operators manual for further details.
BE–170
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE
Code No.
CRUISE MAIN Indicator
Light Blinking Pattern
Diagnosis
Normal
•
•
Duty ratio of 100% output to motor acceleration side.
Overcurrent (short) in motor circuit.
•
•
Overcurrent (short) in magnet clutch circuit.
Open in magnet clutch circuit.
•
•
•
Open in actuator motor circuit.
Position sensor detects abnormal voltage.
Position sensor signal value does not
change when the motor operates.
•
Speed signal is not input to the ECU.
•
Actual vehicle speed has dropped by 16 km/h
(10 mph) or more below the set speed during cruising.
•
Short in control switch circuit.
•
Voltage abnormality in control switch circuit.
When 41 code is indicated, replace the cruise control ECU.
HINT: When 2 or more codes are indicated, the lowest numbered code will be displayed first.
(*)
When the vehicle speed is reduced on uphill roads, the speed can be set again and driving
continued. (This is not a malfunction.)
Diagnostic Trouble Code Clearance
1. After completing repairs the diagnostic trouble code re–
tained in memory can be cleared by removing the STOP
fuse for 10 seconds or more, with the ignition switch off.
2. Check that the normal code is displayed after connecting
the fuse.
BE–171
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a malfunction code is displayed during the diagnostic trouble code check, check the circuit listed for that
code in the table below and proceed to the page given.
Circuit Inspection
Code No.
32,34
Page
•
Actuator Motor Circuit
BE–190
•
Actuator Magnet Clutch Circuit
BE–192
•
•
Actuator Motor Circuit
Actuator Position Sensor Circuit
BE–190
BE–196
•
Speed Sensor Circuit
BE–198
•
•
•
Actuator Control Cable
Speed Sensor Circuit
Actuator Motor Circuit
BE–232
BE–198
BE–190
•
Control switch circuit. (cruise control switch
BE–202
HINT:
1. If the instruction ”Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on matrix chart” is given in the flow chart
for each circuit, proceed to the circuit with the next highest number in the table to continue the check.
2. If the trouble still reappears even though there are no abnormalities in any of the other circuits, then
check or replace the Cruise control ECU as the last step.
BE–172
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INPUT SIGNAL CHECK
Output of Code
1. (a) For check No. 1 – No.2
Turn the ignition switch on.
(b) For check No.3 – No.7
(1) Turn the ignition switch on.
(2) Shift to D position.
(e) For check No.8 – No.9
(1) Jack up the vehicle.
(2) Start the engine. (3) shift to D position.
2. Press the control switch to SET/COAST or RES/ACC posi–
tion and hold it down 1 or up 1.
3. Push the main switch on 2.
4. Check that the CRUISE MAIN indicator light blinks twice
or 3 times repeatedly after 3 seconds.
5. Turn the SET/COAST or RES/ACC switch oft.
6. Operate each switch as listed in the table below.
7. Read the blinking pattern of the CRUISE MAIN indicator
light.
8. After performing the check, turn the main switch oft.
HINT: When two or more signals are input to the ECU,
only the lowest–numbered code is displayed.
No.
Operation Method
CRUISE MAIN Indicator Light
Blinking Pattern
Diagnosis
Turn SET/COAST switch ON.
SET/COAST switch
circuit is norm al.
Turn RES/ACC switch ON.
RES/ACC switch circuit
is normal.
Turn CANCEL switch ON.
CANCEL switch circuit
is normal.
Turn stop light switch ON.
(Depress brake pedal)
Stop light switch circuit
is normal.
Turn parking brake
switch ON.
Par–king brake switch
circuit is normal.
Turn park/neutral position switch
ON. (Shift to N or P position.)
Park/Neutral Position
switch circuit is normal.
Turn clutch start switch ON.
(Depress clutch pedal.)
Clutch switch circuit
is normal.
Drive at 40 km/h (25 mph)
or higher.
Speed sensor is normal.
Drive at 40 km/h (25 mph)
or below.
BE–173
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
– MEMO –
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
BE–174
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
BE–175
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
CRUISE Control ECU
Terminal Name
No. Symbol
Terminal Name
No. Symbol
Stop Light Switch
Power Source
Park/Neutral Position Switch or Clutch Switch
Backup Power Source
Parking Brake Switch
Stop Light Switch
Cruise Main Switch
CRUISE MAIN Indicator Light
CRUISE Control Switch
Speed Sensor
DLC2
ECM
Electronically Controlled Transaxle No. 2 Solenoid
Magnet Clutch (Actuator)
Throttle Position Sensor
Motor (Actuator)
Position Sensor (Actuator)
Motor (Actuator)
Position Sensor (Actuator)
Ground
Position Sensor (Actuator)
BE–176
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
STANDARD VALUE OF ECU TERMINAL
Terminals
Symbols
Wiring
Color
Condition
Always
IG ON. Depress clutch pedal or P or N positions
IG ON. Release clutch pedal and other positions.
IG ON. Parking brake is operating.
IG ON. Parking brake is not operating.
IG ON. Main switch hold ON. (Indicator light ON)
IG ON. Main switch OFF. (Indicator light OFF.)
IG ON. Main switch ON. Main indicator light ON.
IG ON. Main switch OFF. Main indicator light OFF.
Ignition switch ON.
Ex. during cruise control driving.
During cruise control driving and O/D switch OFF
(3rd driving)
During cruise control driving.
Ex. during cruise control driving.
During cruise control driving and SET/COAST Switch
hold ON.
Ex. during cruise control driving.
During cruise control driving.
Ex. during cruise control driving.
Always
Ignition switch ON.
Always
Standard
Value
BE–177
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Terminals
Symbols
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Wiring
color
Condition
Depress brake pedal.
Release brake pedal.
IG ON. Main switch ON.
Switch neutral position.
IG ON. Main switch ON.
CANCEL Switch hold ON.
IG ON. Main switch ON.
SET/COAST Switch hold ON.
IG ON. Main switch ON.
RESUME/ACCEL Switch hold ON.
English start.
Stop a vehicle.
During driving.
During cruise control. driving.
O/D Switch ON.
During cruise control driving. O/D Switch OFF
(3rd driving)
IG ON. Throttle valve fully opened.
IG ON. Throttle valve fully closed.
Ignition switch ON.
During cruise control driving.
IG ON. Control plate fully opened.
IG ON. Control plate fully closed.
Always
Standard
Value
BE–178
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
MATRIX CHART OF PROBLEM SYMPTOMS
SET not occurring or CANCEL occurring. (Diag. trouble
code is Normal)
SET not occurring or CANCEL occurring.
Diag trouble code does not output.
Actual vehicle speed deviates above or below the set
speed.
Gear shifting is frequent between 3rd and OD when
driving on uphill road. (Hunting)
Cruise control not cancelled, even when parking brake
pedal is depressed.
Cruise control not cancelled, even when parking brake is
operating.
Cruise control not cancelled, even when clutch pedal is
depressed.
Cruise control not cancelled, even when transaxle is
shifted to ”N” position.
Control switch does not operate. (SET/COAST, ACC/RES,
CANCEL not possible)
SET possible at 44 km/h (25 mph) or less, or CANCEL does
not operate at 40 km/h (25 mph) or less.
Poor response in ACCEL and RESUME modes.
O/D does not Resume, even though the road is not uphill.
Diagnostic trouble code memory is erased.
Diagnostic trouble code is not output, or is output when
it should not be.
Cruise MAIN indicator light remains ON or fall to light up.
BE–216
BE–212
Combination meter troubleshooting on page BE–65.
Parking Brake
Switch Circuit
Electrically Controlled
Transaxle
Communication
Circuit
BE–206
BE–210
Idle Switch Circuit
(main throttle
position sensor)
Control Switch
Circuit (Cruise
Control Switch)
Speed Sensor
Circuit
Symptom
Actuator
Suspect Area
Stop Light Switch
Circuit
BE–202
BE–198
See Page
BE–190
BE–192
BE–196
If a normal code is displayed during the diagnostic trouble code check but the trouble still occurs (reappears), perform troubleshooting for each problem symptom, checking the circuits for each symptom in
the order given in the table below. Proceed to the page located for each circuit.
BE–179
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
BE–232
IN–36
Actuator Control
Cable
Cruise Control
ECU
BE–230
TC Terminal
Circuit
BE–228
Main Switch
Circuit (Cruise
Control Switch)
BE–226
BE–222
ECU Power
Source Circuit
Back–up Power
Source Circuit
BE–220
Symptom
Clutch switch
Circuit
Suspect Area
BE–218
See Page
Park/Neutral Position
Switch Circuit
HINT:
1. If the instruction ”Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on matrix chart” is given in the flow chart
for each circuit, proceed to the circuit with the next highest number in the table to continue the check.
2. If the trouble still reappears even though there are no abnormalities in any of the other circuits, then
check or replace the cruise control ECU as the last step.
SET not occurring or CANCEL occurring. (Diag. trouble
code is Normal)
SET not occurring or CANCEL occurring.
Diag trouble code does not output.
Actual vehicle speed deviates above or below the set
speed.
Gear shifting is frequent between 3rd and OD when
driving on uphill road. (Hunting)
Cruise control not cancelled, even when parking brake
pedal is depressed.
Cruise control not cancelled, even when parking brake is
operating.
Cruise control not cancelled, even when clutch pedal is
depressed.
Cruise control not cancelled, even when transmission is
shifted to ”N” position.
Control switch does not operate. (SET/COAST, ACC/RES,
CANCEL not possible)
SET possible at 40 km/h (25 mph) or less, or CANCEL does
not operate at 40 km/h (25 mph) or less.
Poor response in ACCEL and RESUME modes.
O/D does not Resume, even though the road is not uphill.
Diagnostic trouble code memory is erased.
Diagnostic trouble code is not output, or is output when
is should not be.
Cruise MAIN indicator light remains ON or fall to light up.
Combination meter troubleshooting on page BE–65
BE–180
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
LOCATION OF CONNECTORS
Location of Connectors in Engine Compartment
BE–181
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
1 MZ–FE
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
BE–182
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
5S–FE
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
BE–183
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
5S–FE
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
BE–184
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Location of Connectors in Instrument Panel
BE–185
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
BE–186
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Location of Connectors in Instrument Panel
BE–187
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
J/B No. 1
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM_
BE–188
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
JI6 No.3
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
BE–189
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Location of Connectors in Body
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
BE–190
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC 11 13 Actuator Motor Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The actuator motor is operated by signals from the EC
U. Acceleration and deceleration signals are
transmitted by changes in the Duty Ratio (See note below).
Duty Ratio
The duty ratio is the ratio of the period of continuity in one cycle. For example, if A is the period of
continuity in one cycle, and B is the period of non–continuity, then
Duty Ratio = AA B x 100 (o)
Code No.
•
•
•
Diagnosis
Duty ratio of 100% output to motor
acceleration side.
Overcurrent (short) in motor circuit.
Open in actuator motor circuit.
Trouble area
•
•
•
Cruise control actuator motor.
Harness or connector between actuator motor
and ECU.
ECU
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check actuator motor.
Check harness and connector between
cruise control ECU and actuator motor.
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart (See page BE–178).
However, when diag. trouble code 11, 13
is displayed, check and replace Cruise
Control ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Replace actuator assembly.
Repair or replace harness or
connector.
BE–191
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check actuator motor.
1. Remove cruise control actuator.
2. Disconnect actuator connector.
1. Connect positive + lead to terminal 5 and
negative – lead to terminal 4 of actuator
connector. (Magnet clutch ON)
2. When battery positive voltage is applied to
each terminals of actuator connector, check
that the control plate moves smoothly with–
out hesitating.
Connect
Terminal
Moving
direction
Acceleration
side
Deceleration
side
3. With the motor rotating as in 2, check that
the motor is stopped by limit switches when
the control plate moves to fully opened or
fully closed position.
Replace actuator assembly.
Check harness and connector between cruise control ECU and actuator
motor. (See page IN–31)
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
matrix chart (See page BE–178).
However, when diag. trouble code 11, 13 is
displayed, check and replace Cruise Control
ECU.
BE–192
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC 12 Actuator Magnet Clutch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit turns on the magnet clutch inside the actuator during cruise control operation according
to the signal from the ECU. If a malfunction occurs in the actuator or speed sensor, etc. during cruise
control, the rotor shaft between the motor and control plate is released.
When the brake pedal is depressed, the stoplight switch turns on, supplying electrical power to the
stoplight. Power supply to the magnet clutch is mechanically cut and the magnet clutch is turned OFF.
When driving downhill, if the vehicle speed exceeds the set speed by 15 km/h (9 mph), the ECU turns
the magnet clutch OFF. If the vehicle speed later drops to within 10 km/h (6 mph) above the set speed,
then cruise control at the set speed is resumed.
Diagnosis
Code No.
•
•
Overcurrent (short) in magnet clutch circuit.
Open in magnet clutch circuit.
Trouble area
•
•
•
Cruise control magnet clutch.
Harness or connector between ECU and
magnet clutch, magnet clutch and body
ground.
ECU
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check actuator magnet clutch.
Replace actuator assembly.
Check stop light switch.
Replace stop light switch.
Check harness and connector between
cruise control ECU and stop light
switch, stop light switch and magnet
clutch, magnet clutch and body
ground.
Repair or replace harness or
connector.
Proceed to next circuit inspection
shown on matrix chart (See page
BE–178).
However, when diag. trouble code 12 is
displayed, check harness and
connector for loose connection. If
connection is normal, check and
replace Cruise Control ECU.
BE–193
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
BE–194
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check actuator magnet clutch.
1. Remove cruise control actuator.
2. Disconnect actuator connector.
Move the control plate by hand.
Control plate moves. (Magnet clutch off)
1. Connect positive + lead to terminal 5 and
negative – lead to terminal 4 of actuator
connector.
2. Move the control plate by hand.
Control plate doesn’t move. (Magnet clutch on)
Replace actuator assembly.
Check stop light switch.
Disconnect stop light switch connector.
Check continuity between terminals.
Continuity
Terminal
Switch position
Switch pin free
(Brake pedal depressed)
Switch pin pushed in
(Brake pedal released)
Replace stop light switch.
Check harness and connectors between cruise control ECU and stop light switch, stop
light switch and magnet clutch, magnet clutch and body ground. (See page IN–31)
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on matrix chart (See page BE–178). However, when
diag trouble code 12 is displayed, check harness and connector for loose connection. If
connection is normal, check and replace Cruise Control ECU.
BE–195
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
– MEMO –
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
BE–196
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC 13 Actuator Position Sensor Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit detects the rotation position of the actuator control plate and sends signal to the ECU.
Trouble area
Diagnosis
Code No.
•
•
Position sensor detects abnormal voltage.
Position sensor signal value does not change
when the motor operates.
•
•
•
Cruise control actuator Position sensor.
Harness or connector between actuator
position sensor and body ground.
ECU
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage between terminals VR2
and VR3 of cruise control ECU
connector.
Check actuator position sensor.
Replace actuator assembly.
Check harness and connector between
cruise control ECU and actuator
position sensor.
Replace or replace harness or
connector.
Check harness and connector for loose
connection. If connection is normal,
check and replace Cruise Control ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
BE39
Proceed to next circuit
inspection shown on matrix
chart (See page BE–178).
BE–197
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminals VR2 and VR3 of cruise control ECU
connector.
Remove cruise control ECU with connectors still
connected.
1 Turn ignition switch on.
2. Measure voltage between terminals VR2 and
VR3 of cruise control ECU connector while
turning control plate slowly by hand from the
deceleration side to the acceleration side.
Voltage:
Fully closed: 1.1–1.4 V
Fully opened: 3.8–4.5 V
In addition, as the control plate is turned, the
voltage should increase gradually without
interruption.
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
matrix chart (See page BE–178).
Check actuator position sensor.
1 Remove cruise control actuator.
2. Disconnect the actuator connector.
Measure resistance between actuator terminals 1
and 3 of actuator connector.
Resistance: 1.8–2.2 kΩ
Measure resistance between terminals 2 and 3 of
actuator connector, while turning the control
plate slowly by hand from the deceleration side to
the acceleration side.
Resistance:
Fully closed: 500–550Ω
Fully opened: 1.5–2.0 kΩ
In addition, as the control plate turns, the
resistance should increase gradually without
interruption.
Replace actuator assembly.
Check harness and connector between cruise control ECU and actuator
position sensor. (See page IN–31)
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check harness and connector for loose
connection. If connection is normal check and
replace cruise control ECU.
BE–198
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC 21 23 Speed Sensor Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The speed sensor signal is sent to cruise control ECU as vehicle speed signal.
Code No.
Trouble area
Diagnosis
Speed signal is not input to the ECU
•
•
•
•
Actual vehicle speed has dropped by 16 km/h
(10 mph) or more below the set speed during
cruising.
HINT: When speed sensor circuit is opened
intermittently (Below 0.2 sec), code 23
is output.
•
•
•
•
•
Speed sensor
Combination meter
Harness or connector between speed sensor
and combination meter, combination meter
and ECU.
ECU
Actuator
Actuator control cable
Speed sensor
Harness or connector in OD and SPD circuit
(Open or short intermittently)
ECU
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Input signal check.
Proceed to next circuit
inspection shown on matrix
chart (See page BE–178).
Check speedometer circuit.(See
combination meter troubleshooting on
page BE–63).
Repair or replace speed
sensor, harness, connector or
combination meter assembly.
Check harness and connector for loose
connection. If connection is normal,
check and replace cruise control ECU.
BE–199
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
BE–200
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Input signal check.
1 See input signal check on page BE–172.
2. Check indicator light operation when driving
with vehicle speed above 40 km/h (25 mph),
and with vehicle speed below 40 km/h (25
mph).
Vehicle speed above 40 km/h (25 mph)
: Indicator light blinks
Vehicle speed below 40 km/h (25 mph)
: Indicator light stays on
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart (See page BE–178).
Check speedometer circuit. (See combination meter troubleshooting on
page BE–63).
Repair or replace speed sensor, harness,
connector or combination meter assembly.
Check harness and connector for loose
connection. If connection is normal,
check and replace cruise control ECU.
BE–201
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
– MEMO –
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
BE–202
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC 32 34 Control Switch Circuit (Cruise Control Switch)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit carries the SET/COAST, RESUME/ACCEL and CANCEL signals (each voltage) to the
ECU.
Code No.
Diagnosis
Short in, control switch circuit.
Voltage abnormality in control switch circuit.
Trouble area
•
•
•
Cruise control switch.
Harness or connector between control switch
and ECU.
ECU
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Input signal check.
Proceed to next circuit
inspection shown on matrix
chart (See page BE–178).
Check voltage between terminal CCS of
cruise control ECU connector and body
ground.
Proceed to next circuit
inspection shown on matrix
chart (See page BE–178).
Check control switch.
Replace cruise control switch.
Check harness and connector between
cruise control ECU and control switch.
Repair or replace harness or
connector.
Check and replace cruise control
ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
BE–203
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Input signal check.
Input signal
SET/COAST
SWITCH
RESUME ACCEL
SWITCH
CANCEL SWITCH
Indicator light
blinking pattern
1 See input signal check on page BE–172.
2. Check the indicator light operation when each
of the SET/COAST, RESUME/ACCEL and
CANCEL is turned ON.
SET/COAST, RESUME/ACCEL switch
The signals shown in the table on the left
should be output when each switch is ON. The
signal should disappear when the switch is
turned OFF. CANCEL switch
The indicator light goes off when the cancel
switch is turned ON.
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart (See page BE–178).
Check voltage between terminal CCS of cruise control ECU connector and
body ground.
Remove cruise control ECU with connectors still
connected.
1 Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Measure voltage between terminal CCS of
cruise control ECU connector and body
ground, when each of the SET/COAST,
RESUME/ACCEL and CANCEL is turned ON.
Switch position
Neutral
RES/ACC
Voltage
10–14 V
0.7–2.5 V
SET/COAST
2.3–4.6 V
CANCEL
4.1–7.2 V
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart (See page BE–178).
Go to step
BE–204
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Check control switch.
1 Remove steering wheel center pad.
2. Disconnect control switch connector.
Measure resistance between terminals 3 and 4 of
control switch connector when control switch is
operated.
Switch position
Neutral
RES/ACC
Resistance
1 Mn or higher
SET/COAST
60–80
190–2100
CANCEL
410–4300
When diagnostic trouble code 34 is displayed,
carefully check that resistance is always 1 Mil or
higher in neutral position, particularly when
switching between REC/ACC and SET/COAST.
Replace cruise control switch.
Check harness and connector between cruise control ECU and control
switch. (See page IN–31)
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace cruise control ECU.
BE–205
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
– MEMO –
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
BE–206
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Stop Light Switch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the brake is on, battery voltage normally applies through the stop fuse and stop switch to
terminal STP– of the ECU, and the ECU turns the cruise control off.
A fail–safe function is provided so that the cancel functions normally, even if there is a malfunction in
the stop light signal circuit.
1 If the harness connected to terminal STP– has an open, terminal STP– will have battery positive
voltage and the cruise control will be turned off, also SET not occurring.
2 If the stop fuse is open, terminal STP+ becomes approx. 0 V when the brake is turned on, so the
ECU performs cancel function normally.
Also, shown the brake is on, the magnet clutch circuit is cut mechanically by the stop light switch, turn–
ing the cruise control off. (See page BE–190 for operation of the magnet clutch.)
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check operation of stop light.
Check stop light circuit
(See page BE–50).
Input signal check.
Proceed to next circuit
inspection shown on matrix
chart (See page BE–178).
Check voltage between terminal
STP+ STP– of cruise control ECU
connector and body ground.
Proceed to next circuit
inspection shown on matrix
chart (See page BE–178).
Check for open in harness and
connectors between terminal STP+ of
cruise control ECU and stop light
switch, terminal STP– of cruise control
ECU and stop Iight switch.
Check and replace cruise control
ECU.
Repair or replace harness or
connector.
BE–207
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
BE–208
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check operation of stop light.
Check that stop light comes on when brake pedal is depressed, and turns off when brake pedal
is released.
Check stop light circuit (See page
BE–50).
Input signal check.
1. See input signal check on page BE–172.
2. Check the indicator light when the brake
pedal is depressed.
The indicator light goes off when the brake
pedal is depressed.
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart (See page BE–178).
Check voltage between terminal STP+, STP– of cruise control ECU
connector and body ground.
Remove cruise control ECU with connectors still
connected.
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Measure voltage between terminal STP+,
STP– of cruise control ECU connector and
body ground, when the brake pedal is
depressed and released.
STP+
STP–
Depressed
10– 14V
10– 14V
Released
10–14V
Below 1 V
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart (See page BE–178).
Check for open in harness and connectors between terminal STP+ of cruise control ECU
and stop light switch, terminal STP– of cruise control ECU and stop light switch. (See
page IN–31)
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace cruise control ECU.
BE–209
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
– MEMO –
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
BE–210
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Idle Switch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the idle switch is turned ON, a signal is sent to the ECU. The ECU uses this signal to enable
accurate cruise control at the set speed quickly. If the idle switch is malfunctioning, problem
symptoms also occur in the engine, so also inspect the engine.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage between terminal IDL of
cruise control ECU connector and body
ground.
Proceed to next circuit
inspection shown on matrix
chart (See page BE–178).
Check throttle position sensor.
Replace throttle position
sensor.
Check harness and connector between
cruise control ECU and throttle position
sensor, throttle position sensor and
body ground.
Repair or replace harness or
connector.
Check and replace cruise control
ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
BE–211
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminal IDL of cruise control ECU connector and
body ground.
1. Remove cruise control ECU with connectors
still connected.
2. Disconnect ECM and ABS & TRAC ECU con–
nector.
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Measure voltage between terminal IDL of
cruise control ECU connector and body
ground, when the throttle valve is fully
closed and fully opened.
Throttle valve position
Voltage
Fully opened
10– 14V
Fully closed
Below 1 V
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart (See page BE–178).
Check throttle position sensor.
Disconnect throttle position sensor connector.
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of
throttle position sensor connector, when the
throttle valve is fully closed and fully opened.
Throttle valve position
Fully opened
Fully closed
Resistance
1 Mil or higher
Below 2
Replace throttle position sensor.
Check harness and connector between cruise control ECU and throttle
position sensor, throttle position sensor and body ground. (See page IN–31)
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace cruise control ECU.
BE–212
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM_
Electronically Controlled Transaxle Communication Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
CIRCUIT
DESCRIPTION
When driving uphill under cruise control, in order to reduce shifting due to ON–OFF overdrive opera–
tion and to provide smooth driving, when down shifting in the electronically controlled transaxle oc–
curs, a signal to prevent upshift until the end of the uphill slope is sent from the cruise control ECU to
the ECM.
Terminal ECT of the cruise control ECU detects the shift change signal (out–put to electronically con–
trolled transaxle No.2 solenoid) from the ECM.
If vehicle speed down and terminal ECT of the control ECU receivers down shifting signal, it sends a
signal from terminal OD to ECM to cut overdrive until the end of the uphill slope, and the gearshifts are
reduced.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check operation of overdrive.
Check and repair electronically
controlled transaxle
(See page AX’ Section).
Check voltage between terminal OD of
harness side connector of cruise
control ECU and bod round.
Check voltage between terminal ECT
of cruise control ECU connector and
body ground (ON test drive).
Proceed to next circuit
inspection shown on matrix
chart (See page BE–178).
Check harness and connector between terminal ECT
of cruise control ECU and electronically controlled
transaxle No.2 solenoid. (Seepage IN–31 )
Repair or replace harness or
connector.
Check and repair cruise control ECU.
Check harness and connector between
terminal OD of cruise control ECU and
terminal OD 1 of ECM.
Check and replace ECM.
Repair or replace harness or
connector.
BE–213
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
BE–214
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check operation of overdrive.
Test drive after engine warm up.
Check that overdrive ON H OFF occurs with operation of OD switch ON–OFF.
Check and Repair Electronically Controlled Transaxle (See page AX Section).
Check voltage between terminal OD of harness side connector of cruise
control ECU and body ground.
Remove cruise control ECU with connectors still
connected.
1. Disconnect cruise control ECU connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Measure voltage between terminal OD of
harness side connector of cruise control ECU
and body ground.
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
Go to step
Go to step
BE–215
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Check voltage between terminal ECT of cruise control ECU connector and
body ground (On test drive).
1. Connect cruise control electronically controlled
transaxle connector.
2. Test drive after engine warm up.
Check voltage between terminal ECT of cruise
control ECU connector and body ground when
OD switch is on and off.
Gear Position
Voltage
O/D
Below 1 V
3rd
10 – 14 V
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
matrix chart (See page BE–178).
Check harness and connector between terminal ECT of cruise control ECU
and solenoid. (See page IN–31)
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and repair cruise control
ECU.
Check harness and connector between terminal OD of cruise control ECU
and terminal OD1 of ECM. (See page IN–31)
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECU.
BE–216
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Parking Brake Switch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the parking brake is operating , the parking brake switch sends a signal to the ECU. When
this signal is input to the ECU during cruise control driving, the ECU cancels cruise control.
DIAGNOSTIC
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
CHART
Check operation of brake warning light.
Check brake warning light
circuit (See page BE–61).
Input signal check.
Proceed to next circuit
inspection shown on matrix
chart (See page BE–178).
Check voltage between terminal PKB of
cruise control ECU connector and body
ground.
Proceed to next circuit
inspection shown on matrix
chart (See page BE–178).
Check for open in harness and
connector between cruise control ECU
and brake warning light.
Repair or replace harness or
connector.
Check and replace cruise control ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
BE–217
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check operation of brake warning light.
Check that the brake warning light in the instrument panel comes on when the parking brake is
operating with the engine running, and the light goes off when the parking brake is not operating.
Check brake warning light circuit (See
page BE–64).
Input signal check.
1. See input signal check on page BE–172.
2. Check the indicator light when the parking
brake is operating.
The indicator light goes off when the parking
brake is operating.
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
matrix chart (See page BE–178).
Check voltage between terminal PKB of cruise control ECU connector and
body ground.
Remove cruise control ECU with connectors still
connected.
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Measure voltage between terminal PKB of
cruise control ECU connector and body
ground, when the parking brake lever is
operating.
Switch Position
Voltage
ON (lever pulled)
Below 1 V
OFF (lever released)
10 – 14 V
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
matrix chart (See page BE–178).
Check for open in harness and connector between cruise control ECU
and brake warning light. (See page IN–31)
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace cruise control ECU.
BE–218
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Park Neutral Position Switch Circuit
CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
DESCRIPTION
When the shift position is put in P or N, a signal is sent from the park/neutral position switch to the
ECU. When this signal is input during cruise control driving, the ECU cancels the cruise control.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check operation of starter.
Proceed to engine trouble–
shooting.(See page EG Section)
Input signal check.
Proceed to next circuit
inspection shown on matrix
chart (See page BE–178).
Check voltage between terminal N & C
of cruise control ECU connector and
body round.
Proceed to next circuit
inspection shown on matrix
chart (See page BE–178).
Check for open in harness and
connector between cruise control ECU
and ST fuse. (See page IN–31)
Repair or replace harness or
connector.
Check and replace cruise control ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
BE–219
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check operation of starter.
Check that the starter operates normally and that the engine starts.
Proceed to engine troubleshooting (See
page EG Section).
Input signal check.
1. See input signal check on page BE–172.
2. Check the indicator light when shifting into P
position or N position.
The indicator light goes off when shifting into
P position or N position.
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart (See page BE–178).
Check voltage between terminal N & C of cruise control ECU connector and
body ground.
Remove cruise control ECU with connectors still
connected.
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Measure voltage between terminal N & C of
cruise control ECU connector and body
ground, when shifting into P, N position and
other positions.
Switch Position
Voltage
P or N position
Below 1 V
Other positions
10– 14V
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart (See page BE–178).
Check for open in harness and connector between cruise control ECU and
ST fuse. (See page IN–31)
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace cruise control ECU.
BE–220
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Clutch Switch Circuit (5S–FE MT Vehicles)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the clutch pedal is depressed, the clutch switch sends a signal to the ECU, when this signal is
input to the ECU during cruise control driving, the ECU cancels cruise control.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check operation of starter.
Proceed to engine trouble–
shooting.(See page EGI Section)
Input signal check.
Proceed to next circuit
inspection shown on matrix
chart (See page BE–178).
Check voltage between terminal N & C
of cruise control ECU connector ECU
connector and body ground.
Proceed to next circuit
inspection shown on matrix
chart (See page BE–178).
Check for open in harness and
connector between terminal N & C of
cruise control ECU and clutch switch.
(See page IN–31)
Repair or replace harness or
connector.
Check and replace cruise control ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
BE–221
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check operation of starter.
Check that the starter operates normally and that the engine
starts.
Proceed to engine troubleshooting (See
page EG Section).
Input signal check.
1. See input signal check on page BE–172.
2. Check the indicator light when shifting into P
range or N position.
The indicator light goes off when the clutch
pedal is depressed.
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart (See page BE–178).
Check voltage between terminal N & C of cruise control ECU connector and
body ground.
Remove cruise control ECU with connectors still
connected.
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Measure voltage between terminal N & C of
cruise control ECU connector and body
ground, when the clutch pedal is depressed.
Switch Position
Voltage
ON (pedal depressed)
Below 1 V
OFF
10 – 14 V
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart (See page BE–178).
Check for open in harness and connector between cruise control ECU
and ST fuse.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace cruise control ECU.
BE–222
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
ECU Power Source Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ECU power source supplies power to the actuator. Terminal GND and the cruise control ECU case
are grounded.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check ECU–IG fuse.
Check for short in all the
harness and components
connected to the ECU–IG
fuse
(See attached wire diagram).
Check voltage between terminals B and
GND of cruise control ECU connector.
Proceed to next circuit
inspection shown on matrix
chart (See page BE–178).
Check continuity between terminal
GND of cruise control ECU connector
and body ground.
Repair or replace harness or
connector.
Check and repair harness and
connector between battery and cruise
control ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
BE–223
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check ECU–IG fuse.
Remove ECU–IG fuse from J/B No. 1.
Check continuity of ECU–IG fuse.
Continuity
Check for short in all the harness and
components connected to the ECU–IG
fuse (See attached wiring diagram).
Check voltage between terminals +B and GND of cruise control ECU
connector.
Remove cruise control ECU with connectors still
connected.
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Measure voltage between terminals +B and
GND of cruise control ECU connector.
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart (See page BE–178).
Go to step
BE–224
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Check continuity between terminal GND of cruise control ECU connector
and body ground.
Measure resistance between terminal GND of
cruise control ECU connector and body ground.
Resistance: Below 1
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and repair harness and connector
between battery and cruise control ECU.
BE–225
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
– MEMO –
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
BE–226
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Back–up Power Source Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ECU back–up power source provides power even when the ignition switch is off and is used for
diagnostic code memory, etc.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check STOP fuse.
Check voltage between terminals BATT
of cruise control ECU connector and
body ground.
Check and repair harness and
connector between battery and cruise
control ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Check for short in all the
harness and components
connected to the STOP fuse
(See attached wiring
diagram).
Proceed to next circuit
inspection shown on matrix
chart (See page BE–178).
BE–227
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check STOP fuse.
Remove STOP fuse from JIB No. 1.
Check continuity of STOP fuse.
Continuity
Check for short in all the harness and
components connected to the STOP fuse
(See attached wiring diagram).
Check voltage between terminals BATT of cruise control ECU connector
and body ground.
Remove cruise control ECU with connectors still
connected.
Measure voltage between terminal BATT of
cruise control ECU connector and body ground.
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart (See page BE–178).
Check and repair harness and connector
between battery and cruise control ECU.
BE–228
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Main Switch Circuit (Cruise Control Switch)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the cruise control main switch is turned oft, the cruise control does not operate.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage between terminals CMS
and GND of cruise control ECU
connector.
Proceed to next circuit
inspection shown on matrix
chart (See page BE–178).
Check main switch.
Replace cruise control switch.
Check harness and connector between
cruise control ECU and main switch,
main switch and body ground.
Repair or replace harness or
connector.
Check and replace cruise control ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
BE–229
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminals CMS and GND of cruise control ECU
connector.
1. Remove cruise control ECU with connectors
still connected.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminals CMS and
GND of cruise control ECU connector when
main switch is hold on and off.
Main switch
Voltage
OFF
10 – 14 V
Hold on
Below 1 V
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart (See page BE–178).
Check main switch.
1. Remove steering wheel pad (See page
RS–19).
2. Disconnect cruise control switch connector.
Check continuity between terminals 3 and 5 of
cruise control switch connector when main switch
is hold on and off.
continuity
Terminals
Main switch
OFF
Hold on
Replace control switch.
Check harness and connector between cruise control ECU and main switch,
main switch and body ground.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace cruise control
ECU.
BE–230
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
TC Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit sends a signal to the ECU that diagnostic code output is required.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage between terminals TC
and El of DLC2.
Proceed to next circuit
inspection shown on matrix
chart (See page BE–178).
Check harness and connector between
cruise control ECU and DCL2, DLC2
and body ground.
Repair or replace harness or
connector.
Check and replace cruise control ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
BE–231
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminals TC and E1 of DLC2.
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Measure voltage between terminals TC and
El of DLC2.
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart (See page BE–178).
Check harness and connector between cruise control ECU and DCL2, DLC2
and body ground. (See page IN–31)
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace cruise control ECU.
BE–232
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Actuator Control Cable Inspection
1. Check that the actuator, control cable and throttle link are properly installed and that the
cable and link are connected correctly.
2. Check that the actuator and throttle link are operating smoothly.
3. Check that the cable is not loose or too tight.
1. If the control cable is very loose, the vehicle’s loss of speed going uphill will be large.
2. If the control cable is too tight, the idle rpm will become high.
BO–1
BODY
–
BODY
BO–2
BODY
–
GENERAL INFORMATION
GENERAL INFORMATION
HANDLING PRECAUTIONS
Taping
When it is possible that the body or parts may be
scratched during the operation, apply protection tape
before starting work.
Example:
1. Before starting work, apply protection tape to
body surfaces around parts to be removed and
installed.
2. Before prying parts loose with a screwdriver or
scraper etc., apply protection tape to the tip of
the tool to avoid scratching parts or painted sur–
faces of the body.
Battery
In order to prevent a short circuit while doing work on
the electrical circuit such as disconnecting a connec–
tor, first turn off the ignition switch and disconnect
the negative (–) terminal cable from the battery ter–
minal before starting work.
HINT: When battery voltage is required for operation
of a functioning part, connect the cable to the battery
when needed, and promptly disconnect it when no
longer necessary.
CAUTION:
• Work must be started after 90 seconds from the
time the ignition switch is turned to the ’LOCK‘
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is dis–
connected from the battery.
• To avoid erasing the memory of each memory
system, never use a back–up power supply from
outside the vehicle.
Fitting Adjustments
When removing and installing body panels which have
a preload value, after their installation refer to the
page containing the installation adjustment methods,
and make adjustments according to the required spe–
cifications.
HINT: When making adjustments, do not completely
loosen the bolts and nuts of the part being adjusted.
Tighten them appropriately, and move the panels by
hand to align them.
BO–3
BODY
–
GENERAL INFORMATION
ANTI–RUST TREATMENT
Anti–rust treatment used on the vehicle body in–
cludes body sealer, undercoat, rust inhibitor and paint.
HINT: Refer to the Body Collision Damage ’Repair
Manual for details of which parts have received anti –
rust treatment.
Body Sealer
If the body sealer is damaged (peeling, cracks, etc.)
during the operation, replace it with new body sealer.
HINT: If body sealer gets on other parts, promptly
wipe it off with a clean cloth dipped in a grease, wax
and silicone remover.
Undercoat
If the undercoat is damaged during the operation,
apply new undercoat.
HINT:
• Cover the surrounding area with masking paper
to avoid applying undercoat where it is not
needed.
• Do not apply undercoat to high temperature
parts such as the tailpipe, or to drive parts such
as the drive shaft.
Rust Inhibitor
After removing and re–installing hinges and outer
panel parts, apply rust inhibitor to the parts.
HINT: If rust inhibitor gets spilled on other parts,
promptly wipe it off with a clean cloth dipped in a
grease, wax and silicon remover.
Touch– Up Paint
If a small scratch is made in the body surface, correct
the scratch using touch–up paint the same color as
the body color.
BO–4
BODY
–
GENERAL INFORMATION
CLIPS
The removal and installation methods of typical clips
used in body parts are shown in the table below.
HINT: If the clip is damaged during the operation,
always replace it with a new clip.
Shape (Example)
Removal/installation
BO–5
BODY
–
GENERAL INFORMATION
CLIPS (Cont’d)
Shape (Example)
Removal/installation
BO–6
BODY
–
GENERAL INFORMATION
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System)
The 1994 CAMRY is equipped with an SRS, such as
the driver airbag and front passenger airbag assembly.
Failure to carry out service operations in the correct
sequence could cause the SRS to deploy, possibly
leading to a serious accident.
When removing or installing, refer to the pre–
cautionary notices in the RS section before perform–
ing the operation.
• Work must be started after 90 seconds from the
time the ignition switch is set to the LOCK posi–
tion and the negative (–) terminal cable is dis–
connected from the battery.
(The SRS is equipped with a back–up power
source so that if work is started within 90 sec–
onds of disconnecting the negative (–) terminal
cable from the battery, the SRS may deploy.)
• To avoid erasing the memory of each memory
system, never use a back–up power supply from
outside the vehicle.
• Before repairs, remove the airbag sensors if
shocks are likely to be applied to the sensors
during repairs.
• The front airbag sensor set bolt has been anti–
rust treated. When the sensor is removed, always
replace the set bolt with a new one.
• If the front airbag sensors, center airbag sensor
assembly, steering wheel pad or front passenger
airbag assembly have been dropped, or if there
are cracks, dents or other defects in the case,
bracket or connector, replace them with new
ones.
• Never use SRS parts from another vehicle. When
replacing parts, replace them with new parts.
• Do not expose the front airbag sensors, center
airbag sensor assembly, steering wheel pad or
front passenger airbag assembly directly to hot
air or flames.
• The SRS wire harness is integrated with the cowl
wire harness assembly. The wires for the SRS
wire harness are encased in a yellow corrugated
tube. All the connectors for the system are also a
standard yellow color. If the SRS wire harness
becomes disconnected or the connector bec–
omes broken due to an accident, etc., repair or
replace it. (See RS section)
BO–7
BODY
–
GENERAL INFORMATION
• The steering wheel must be fitted correctly to the
steering column with the spiral cable at the neu–
tral position; otherwise, cable disconnection and
other troubles may result. Refer to RS section of
this manual concerning correct steering wheel
installation.
• When removing or handling the steering wheel
pad or front passenger airbag assembly, it should
be placed with them top surface facing up. In this
case, the twin–lock type connector lock lever
should be in the locked state and care should be
taken to place it so the connector will not be
damaged. (Storing the pad with its metallic sur–
face up, the front passenger airbag assembly
with the airbag door facing down may lead to a
serious accident if the airbag inflates for some
reason.)
• Grease should not be applied to the steering
wheel pad or the front passenger airbag assem–
bly, and they should not be cleaned with deter–
gents of any kind.
• Store the steering wheel pad or the front passen–
ger airbag assembly where the ambient tempera–
ture remains below 93 C (200 F), without high
humidity and away from electrical noise.
• Information labels are attached to the periphery
of the SRS components. Follow the notices.
• When the ignition switch is at ACC or ON and the
SRS warning light remains on, the center airbag
sensor assembly has detected a malfunction
code. (See RS section)
BO–8
BODY
–
PREPARATION
PREPARATION
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
09812–00020 Door Hinge Set Bolt Wrench
09804–24010 Luggage Compartment Door Torsion
Bar Tool
LUBRICANT
Item
Capacity
Classification
MP grease
SSM (SPECIAL SERVICE MATERIALS)
08833–00070 Adhesive 1311,
THREE BOND 1311 or equivalent
Front Door
Rear Door
Sliding Roof
08850–00070 Windshield glass adhesive set
No. 15 or equivalent
Windshield
Back Window Glass
(0–15C or 32–59F)
08850–00080 Windshield glass adhesive set
No.35 or equivalent
Windshield
Back Window Glass
(15–35C or 59–95F)
08850–00090 Windshield glass adhesive set
No.45 or equivalent
Windshield
Back Window Glass
(35 – 45 C o r 95 –113 F)
08833–00030 Auto glass sealer or equivalent
Windshield Moulding
Back Window Moulding
Windshield
Back Window Glass
08850–00051 Adhesive (Super Special) or
equivalent
Side Protection Moulding
BO–9
BODY
Ambient
temperature
0 – 160C
(32 – 59F)
(59 – 95F)
35 – 45C
(95 – 113F)
Part No.
Part Name
Windshield
o8850–00070 glass adhesive
set No. 15
Windshield
08850–00080 glass adhesive
set No. 35
–
PREPARATION
1. CHOOSE SUITABLE ADHESIVE SET
Use an adhesive set suitable for the ambient temper–
ature.
Windshield
08850–00090 glass adhesive
set No. 45
2. CHECK ADHESIVE USABLE TIME
After mixing main and hardening agents, finish glass
installation within the specified time as shown.
Example: For glass installation in an ambient tempera–
ture of 25 C (77 F), apply adhesive set No.35 within
45 minutes.
3. CHECK ADHESIVE HARDENING TIME
After main and hardening agents are mixed, leak tests
should be made only after the hardening time has
elapsed.
Example: The hardening time for adhesive set No.35
with and ambient temperature of 25C (77F) is 2 1/
2 hours.
NOTICE: Do not drive the vehicle until at least double the
hardening time has elapsed.
BO–10
BODY
–
FRONT BUMPER
FRONT BUMPER
COMPONENTS
BO–11
BODY
–
FRONT BUMPER
FRONT BUMPER REMOVAL
1. REMOVE RADIATOR GRILLE
Remove 2 screws and the grille.
2. REMOVE CLEARANCE LIGHT
(a) Remove the screw.
(b) Pull the light forwards to remove it, then disconnect
the connector.
3. REMOVE HEADLIGHT
(a) Disconnect the connectors.
(b) Remove 3 bolts, the nut and the headlight.
4. REMOVE FENDER LINER
(a) Remove 7 screws.
(b) Remove 3 bolts and the fender liner.
5. REMOVE SIDE MARKER LIGHT
Remove the screw and the light, then disconnect the
connector.
6. REMOVE TURN SIGNAL LIGHT
Remove the screw and the light, then disconnect the
connector.
BO–12
BODY
–
FRONT BUMPER
7. REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER
(a) Remove the clip
(b) Remove 4 screws an the cover.
8. REMOVE INTAKE AIR RESONATOR
Remove 2 bolts and the resonator.
9. REMOVE BUMPER COVER
(a) Remove 4 clips and the upper retainer.
(b) Remove 3 clips and the lower retainer.
(c) Remove 2 clips.
(d) Remove 3 bolts and 2 nuts.
(e) Pull the cover forwards to remove it.
10. REMOVE FRONT BUMPER ENERGY ABSORBER
(a) Remove 2 plates.
(b) Remove 2 absorber from the bumper cover.
(c) Remove 2 clips and 2 license brackets.
(d) Remove 4 nuts.
(e) Remove 2 fillers.
BO–13
BODY
–
FRONT BUMPER
11. REMOVE FRONT BUMPER END RETAINER
Remove 2 clips and the retainer.
12. REMOVE FRONT BUMPER SIDE SUPPORT
(a) Using about 3.2 mm (0.128 in.) drill, drill out 2 rivet
heads.
(b) Remove the side support.
13. REMOVE UPPER REINFORCEMENT
(a) Remove 4 nuts.
(b) Remove 5 bolts and the upper reinforcement.
(c) Remove 2 bolts and 2 deflectors.
14. REMOVE REINFORCEMENT EXTENSION
Remove 4 bolts and the extension.
15. REMOVE FRONT BUMPER REINFORCEMENT
Remove 4 bolts and the reinforcement.
BO–14
BODY
–
FRONT BUMPER
16. REMOVE FRONT BUMPER ARM
Remove 3 nuts and the bumper arm.
FRONT BUMPER INSTALLATION
INSTALL FRONT BUMPER PARTS BY FOLLOWING RE–
MOVAL SEQUENCE IN REVERSE
1. INSTALL FOLLOWING PARTS:
(a) Front bumper arm
Torque: 8.8 N–m (90 kgf–cm, 78 in.–lbf)
(b) Front bumper reinforcement
Torque: 8.8 N–m (90 kgf–cm, 78in.–lbf)
(c) Reinforcement extension
Torque: 21 N–m (210 kgf–cm. 15 ft.–lbf)
2. INSTALL FRONT BUMPER SIDE SUPPORT
(a) Place the side support in the bumper cover.
(b) Using a riveter, install 2 rivets.
BO–15
BODY
–
REAR BUMPER
REAR BUMPER
COMPONENTS
BO–16
BODY
–
REAR BUMPER
COMPONENTS (Cont’d)
BO–17
BODY
–
REAR BUMPER
REAR BUMPER REMOVAL
1. REMOVE REAR FLOOR FINISH PLATE
Remove the finish plate by pulling.
2. REMOVE REAR LUGGAGE TRIM
Using a clip remover, remove 4 clips and the trim.
3. REMOVE RIGHT SIDE LUGGAGE TRIM
Using a clip remover, remove 6 clips and the trim.
4. REMOVE LEFT SIDE LUGGAGE TRIM
Using a clip remover, remove 6 clips and the trim.
5. REMOVE REAR LICENSE PLATE LIGHT
Remove 3 screws and the light, then disconnect the
connector.
6. REMOVE REAR BUMPER COVER
(a) Remove 9 bolts and 10 nuts.
(b) Pull the cover rearwards to remove it.
BO–18
BODY
–
REAR BUMPER
7. REMOVE REAR BUMPER ENERGY ABSORBER
Remove the absorber from the bumper cover.
8. REMOVE REAR BUMPER SIDE SUPPORT
(a) Using an approx. 3.2 mm (0.26 in.) drill, drill out 3 rivet
heads.
(b) Remove the side support.
9. REMOVE REAR BUMPER UPPER RETAINER
(a) Remove 2 clips.
(b) Remove 6 spacers.
(c) Remove the retainer from the bumper cover.
10. REMOVE QUARTER AIR DUCT
Remove 4 screws and the duct.
11. REMOVE REAR BUMPER REINFORCEMENT
Remove 2 bolts and the reinforcement.
BO–19
BODY
–
REAR BUMPER
12. REMOVE REAR BUMPER ARM
(a) Remove 2 grommets.
(6) Remove 2 bolts and the bumper arm_
REAR BUMPER INSTALLATION
INSTALL REAR BUMPER PARTS BY FOLLOWING RE–
MOVAL SEQUENCE IN REVERSE
1. INSTALL FOLLOWING PARTS:
(a) Rear bumper arm
Torque: 79 N–m (810 kgf–cm, 59 ft–lbf)
(b) Rear bumper reinforcement
Torque: 43 N–m (440 kgf–cm, 32 ft–lbf)
2. INSTALL REAR BUMPER SIDE SUPPORT
(a) Place the side support in the bumper cover.
(b) Using a riveter, install 3 rivets.
(c) Install 2 seal rubbers to 2 bolts.
BO–20
BODY
–
HOOD
HOOD
HOOD ADJUSTMENT
HINT: Since the centering bolt is used as the hood
hinge and lock set bolt, the hood and lock cannot be
adjusted with it on. Substitute the bolt with washer
for the centering bolt.
1. ADJUST HOOD IN FORWARD / REARWARD AND
LEFT/RIGHT DIRECTIONS
Adjust the hood by loosening the hood side hinge
bolts.
Torque: 14 N–m (145 kgf–cm, 10 ft–lbf)
2. ADJUST FRONT EDGE OF HOOD IN VERTICAL DI–
RECTIONS
Adjust the hood by turning the cushions.
3. ADJUST HOOD LOCK
(a) Adjust the lock by loosening the bolts.
Torque: 7.8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–lbf)
(b) Install radiator support upper seal with 10 clips.
BO–21
BODY
–
FRONT DOOR
FRONT DOOR
COMPONENTS
BO–22
BODY
–
FRONT DOOR
COMPONENTS (Cont’d)
BO–23
BODY
–
FRONT DOOR
FRONT DOOR ADJUSTMENT
1. ADJUST DOOR IN FORWARD/ REARWARD AND
VERTICAL DIRECTIONS
Using SST, adjust the door by loosening the body side
hinge bolts.
SST 09812–00020
2. ADJUST DOOR IN LEFT/ RIGHT AND VERTICAL
DIRECTIONS
Loosen the door side hinge bolts to adjust.
HINT: Substitute the bolt with washer for the center–
ing bolt.
3. ADJUST DOOR LOCK STRIKER
(a) Check that the door fit and door lock linkages are
adjusted correctly.
(b) Loosen the striker mounting screws to adjust.
(c) Using a plastic hammer, tap the striker to adjust it.
FRONT DOOR DISASSEMBLY
1. w/o Power Window:
REMOVE REGULATOR HANDLE
Pull off the snap ring with a shop rag and remove the
regulator handle and plate.
2. REMOVE INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL
(a) Using a screwdriver, pry out the bezel.
HINT: Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Pull the bezel rearwards to remove it.
BO–24
BODY
–
FRONT DOOR
3. Coupe:
REMOVE DOOR COURTESY LIGHT
Remove the light by pulling, then disconnect the con–
nector.
4. REMOVE DOOR TRIM
Sedan, Wagon:
HINT: Tape the screwdriver, remove tip before use.
(a) Remove 2 clips.
(b) Using a screwdriver, remove 2 screw caps and the
tweeter cover.
(c) Remove 6 screws.
(d) Insert the screwdriver between the door and the door
trim to pry out.
(e) Pull the trim upwards to remove it, then disconnect
the connector.
(f) Remove the inner weatherstrip.
(g) Remove 2 screws and the power window switch.
(h) Remove 6 screws and the armrest.
(i) Remove 2 screws and the lower speaker cover.
(j) Remove the clip, 9 screws and the door pocket.
Coupe:
HINT: Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(a) Remove the 2 clips.
(b) Using a screwdriver, remove the 3 caps and tweeter
cover.
(c) Remove 5 screws.
(d) Insert the screwdriver between the door and the door
trim to pry out.
(e) Pull the trim upwards to remove it, then disconnect
the connectors.
(f) Remove the inner weatherstrip.
(g) Remove 3 screws and power window switch.
(h) Remove 3 screws and tweeter speaker.
(i) Remove 2 screws and front speaker cover.
(j) Remove 7 screws and door armrest.
(k) Remove the trim support.
(1) Remove 8 screws and door pocket.
BO–25
BODY
–
FRONT DOOR
5. REMOVE REAR VIEW MIRROR
(a) Remove the cover.
(b) Remove 3 screws and the mirror.
(c) w/ Remote Control Mirror:
Disconnect the connector.
6. REMOVE DOOR INSIDE HANDLE
(a) Disconnect 2 links.
(b) Remove 3 screws and the handle.
7. REMOVE SPEAKER
(a) Remove 4 screws and the speaker.
(b) Disconnect the connector.
8. REMOVE SERVICE HOLE COVER
9. REMOVE DOOR GLASS RUN
Pull the glass run upwards and remove it.
10. REMOVE FRONT DOOR BELT MOULDING
Pry out the clips from the edge of the weatherstrip
and remove the moulding.
11. REMOVE FRONT DOOR FRAME MOULDING
(a) Sedan, Wagon: Remove 3 screws and the moulding.
(b) Coupe: Remove 3 screws.
(c) Pry out the clips and remove the moulding.
12. REMOVE FRONT DOOR UPPER MOULDING
(a) Sedan, Wagon: Remove 7 screws.
BO–26
BODY
–
FRONT DOOR
(b) Coupe: Remove 9 screws.
(c) Pry out the clip and remove the moulding.
13. REMOVE DOOR GLASS
HINT: Insert a shop rag inside the panel to prevent
scratching the glass.
(a) Remove 2 glass mounting bolts.
(b) Remove the door glass by pulling it upwards.
14. REMOVE FRONT DOOR WEATHERSTRIP
While pulling the weatherstrip by hand, remove the
clips using a clip remover.
HINT: Do not pull stronger on the weatherstrip as it
may tear.
15. Sedan, Wagon:
REMOVE DOOR INSIDE PANEL FRAME
(a) Remove 4 nuts.
(b) Remove 3 bolts and the frame.
16. REMOVE WINDOW REGULATOR
Sedan, Wagon:
(a) Remove 2 nuts.
(b) w/ Power Window:
Disconnect the connector.
(c) Remove the regulator through the service hole.
BO–27
BODY
–
FRONT DOOR
Coupe:
(a) Remove 4 nuts and 3 bolts.
(b) w/ Power Window:
Disconnect the connector.
(c) Remove the regulator through the service hole.
17. REMOVE FRONT LOWER FRAME
Remove the nut, 2 bolts and the frame.
18. REMOVE REAR LOWER FRAME
Remove the nut, the bolt and the frame.
19. REMOVE DOOR LOCK
(a) Remove 2 clips.
(b) Disconnect 2 links from the door lock and remove 2
links.
(c) Disconnect 2 links from the outside handle and the
lock cylinder.
(d) Remove 3 screws.
(e) w/ Power Door Lock:
Disconnect the connector.
(f) Remove the door lock through the service hole.
20. REMOVE OUTSIDE HANDLE
(a) Remove the hole plug.
(b) Remove 2 bolts and the outside handle with the lock
cylinder.
21. REMOVE DOOR LOCK CYLINDER
Remove the bolt and the lock cylinder from the out–
side handle.
BO–28
BODY
–
FRONT DOOR
FRONT DOOR ASSEMBLY
1. BEFORE INSTALLING PARTS, COAT THEM WITH
MP GREASE
(a) Apply MP grease to the window regulator rollers.
(b) Apply MP grease to the sliding surface of the door
lock.
2. INSTALL DOOR LOCK CYLINDER
Install the lock cylinder with the bolt to the outside
handle.
BO–29
BODY
–
FRONT DOOR
3. INSTALL OUTSIDE HANDLE
(a) Install the outside handle with 2 bolts.
(b) Install hole plug.
4. INSTALL DOOR LOCK
(a) Apply adhesive to 3 screws.
Part No.08833–00070, THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
(b) Install the lock with 3 screws.
Torque: 5.4 N–m (55 kgf–cm, 48 in.–lbf)
(c) w/ Power Door Lock:
Connect the connector.
(d) Connect 2 links to the outside handle and the door
lock cylinder.
(e) Connect 2 links to the door lock.
(f) Install 2 clips.
5. INSTALL FRONT LOWER FRAME
Install the frame with the nut and 2 bolts.
6. INSTALL REAR LOWER FRAME
Install the frame with the nut and the screw.
7. INSTALL WINDOW REGULATOR
Sedan. Wagon:
(a) Place the regulator through the service hole.
(b) w/ Power Window:
Connect the connector.
(c) Install the regulator with 2 riuts.
Torque: 5.4 N–m (55 kgf–cm, 48 in.–lbf)
Coupe:
(a) Install the regulator through the service hole.
(b) w/ Power Window:
Connect the connector.
(c) Install the 3 nuts and the 3 bolts.
BO–30
BODY
–
FRONT DOOR
8. Sedan, Wagon:
INSTALL DOOR INSIDE PANEL
(a) Install the frame with the 3 bolts.
(b) Install the 4 nuts.
Torque: 5.4 N–m (55 kgf–cm, 48in.–lbf)
9. INSTALL FRONT DOOR WEATHERSTRIP
Push down on the clips of the weatherstrip.
10. INSTALL DOOR GLASS
HINT: Insert a shop rag inside the panel to prevent
scratching the glass.
(a) Insert the glass to the frame.
(b) Temporarily tighten 2 glass mounting bolts.
11. INSTALL FRONT DOOR UPPER MOULDING
(a) Sedan, wagon: Install the moulding with the 7 screws.
(b) Coupe: Install the moulding with the 9 screws.
12. INSTALL FRONT DOOR FRAME MOULDING
Install the moulding with the 3 screws and the nut.
13. INSTALL FRONT DOOR BELT MOULDING
Install the claw of the clips into the upper panel slit
and push the moulding onto the panel.
14. INSTALL DOOR GLASS RUN
Insert the glass run to the door frame.
BO–31
BODY
–
FRONT DOOR
15. ADJUST DOOR GLASS
Adjust the glass and tighten when dimension A and B,
as shown, are equal.
HINT: Substitute the bolt with washer for the center–
ing bolt.
16. INSTALL SERVICE HOLE COVER
Seal the service hole cover with adhesive.
HINT: Bring out the links through the service hole
cover.
17. INSTALL DOOR INSIDE HANDLE
(a) Install the handle with 3 screws.
(b) Connect the 2 links.
18. INSTALL SPEAKER
Install the speaker with 4 screws, then connect the
connector.
18. INSTALL REAR VIEW MIRROR
(a) w/ Remote Control Mirror:
Connect the connector.
(b) Install the mirror with 3 screws.
(c) Install the cover.
20. INSTALL DOOR TRIM
Sedan, Wagon:
(a) Install the door pocket with the clip and 9 screws.
(b) Install the lower speaker cover with 2 screws.
(c) Install the armrest with 6 screws.
(d) Install the power window switch with 2 screws.
(e) Install the inner weatherstrip.
BO–32
BODY
–
FRONT DOOR
(f) Insert the upper edge of the trim from above, tap the
trim by hand, fix it in place with the clips, then connect
the connectors.
(g) Install the 6 screws.
(h) Install the 2 screw caps and the tweeter cover.
(i) Install the 2 clips.
Coupe:
(a) Install the 8 screws and door pocket.
(b) Install the door trim support.
(c) Install the 7 screws and door armrest.
(d) Install the 2 screws and door speaker cover.
(e) Install the 3 screws and tweeter speaker.
(f) Install the 3 screws and power window switch.
(g) Install the inner weatherstrip.
(h) Insert the upper edge of the trim from above, tap the
trim by hand, fix it in place with the clips, then connect
the connector.
(i) Install the 5 screws.
(j) Install the 3 caps and tweeter cover.
(k) Install the 2 clips.
21. Coupe:
INSTALL DOOR COURTESY LIGHT
Tap the light to install it, then connect the connector.
22. INSTALL INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL
Tap the bezel to install it.
BO–33
BODY
–
FRONT DOOR
23. INSTALL REGULATOR HANDLE
With door window fully closed, install the plate and
the regulator handle with the snap ring, as shown.
BO–34
BODY
–
REAR DOOR
REAR DOOR
COMPONENTS
BO–35
BODY
–
REAR DOOR
COMPONENTS (Cont’d)
BO–36
BODY
–
REAR DOOR
REAR DOOR ADJUSTMENT
1. ADJUST DOOR IN FORWARD/ REARWARD AND
VERTICAL DIRECTIONS
(a) Remove rear seat cushion and rear seat back.
(b) Sedan: Remove roof side inner garnish.
(c) Sedan: Remove rear seat side garnish.
(d) Sedan: Remove front door inside scuff plate.
(e) Remove center pillar lower garnish.
(f) Loosen the body side hinge nuts to adjust.
(g) Install center pillar lower garnish.
(h) Sedan: Install front door inside scuff plate.
(i) Sedan: Install rear seat side garnish.
(j) Sedan: Install roof side inner garnish.
(k) Install rear seat back and rear seat cushion.
Torque: 19 N–m (195 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
BO–37
BODY
–
REAR DOOR
2. ADJUST DOOR IN LEFT/RIGHT AND VERTICAL
DIRECTIONS
Loosen the door side hinge bolts to adjust.
HINT: Substitute the bolt with washer for the center–
ing bolt.
3. ADJUST DOOR LOCK STRIKER
(a) Check that the door fit and door lock linkages are
adjusted correctly.
(b) Loosen the striker mounting screws to adjust.
(c) Using a plastic hammer, tap the striker to adjust it.
REAR DOOR DISASSEMBLY
1. w/o Power Window:
REMOVE REGULATOR HANDLE
Pull off the snap ring with a shop rag and remove the
regulator handle and plate.
2. w/ Power Window:
REMOVE POWER WINDOW SWITCH
Using a screwdriver, remove the switch, then discon–
nect the connector.
HINT: Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
3. REMOVE INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL
(a) Using a screwdriver, pry out the bezel.
HINT: Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Pull the bezel rearwards to remove it.
BO–38
BODY
–
REAR DOOR
4. REMOVE DOOR TRIM
HINT: Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(a) Remove 4 clips.
(b) Using a screwdriver, remove the screw cap.
(c) Remove 2 screws.
(d) Insert the screwdriver between the door and the door
trim to pry out.
(e) Pull the trim upwards to remove it then disconnect the
connector.
(f) Remove the inner weatherstrip.
(g) Remove 6 screws and the armrest.
5. REMOVE DOOR INSIDE HANDLE
(a) Disconnect 2 links.
(b) Remove 3 screws and the handle.
6. REMOVE SERVICE HOLE COVER
(a) w/ Power Window:
Using a clip remover, remove 2 screw grommets.
w/o Power Window:
Using a clip remover, remove 3 screw grommets.
(b) Remove service hole cover.
7. REMOVE DOOR GLASS RUN
Pull the glass run upwards to remove it.
BO–39
BODY
–
REAR DOOR
8. REMOVE REAR DOOR BELT MOULDING
Pry out the clips from the edge of the weatherstrip
and remove the moulding.
8. Sedan:
REMOVE DOOR GLASS DIVISION BAR
(a) Remove the screw.
(b) Remove 2 bolts and the division bar.
10. Wagon:
REMOVE REAR LOWER FRAME
(a) Remove the cover.
(b) Remove nut.
(c) Remove bolt and frame.
11. REMOVE DOOR GLASS
HINT: Insert a shop rag inside the panel to prevent
scratching the glass.
(a) Remove 2 glass mounting bolts.
(b) Remove the door glass by pulling it upwards.
12. Sedan:
REMOVE QUARTER WINDOW GLASS WITH WEA–
THERSTRIP
(a) Remove the quarter window glass together with the
weatherstrip by pulling it forwards.
(b) Remove the weatherstrip from the quarter window
glass.
BO–40
BODY
–
REAR DOOR
13. Wagon:
REMOVE REAR DOOR FRAME MOULDING
(a) Remove 2 screws and nut.
(b) Pry out the clips and remove the moulding.
14. REMOVE REAR DOOR FRAME MOULDING
(a) Remove 3 screws.
(b) Pry out the clips and remove the moulding.
15. REMOVE REAR DOOR UPPER MOULDING
(a) Sedan: Remove the clip.
(b) Remove 5 screws and the moulding.
(c) Wagon: Remove 3 screws and the moulding.
16. REMOVE REAR DOOR WEATHERSTRIP
While pulling the weatherstrip by hand, remove the
clips using a clip remover.
HINT: Do not pull strongly on the weatherstrip as it
may tear.
BO–41
BODY
–
REAR DOOR
17. REMOVE DOOR INSIDE PANEL FRAME
(a) Remove 4 nuts.
(b) Remove 3 bolts and the frame.
18. REMOVE WINDOW REGULATOR
(a) Remove 2 nuts.
(b) w/ Power Window:
Disconnect the connector.
(c) Remove the regulator through the service hole.
19. REMOVE CHILD PROTECTOR LOCK LEVER KNOB
Using a screwdriver, remove the knob.
HINT: Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
20. REMOVE DOOR LOCK
(a) Remove the clip.
(b) Disconnect 2 links from the door lock and remove 2
links.
(c) Remove 3 screws.
(d) w/ Power Door Lock:
Disconnect the connector.
(e) Remove the door lock through the service hole.
21. REMOVE OUTSIDE HANDLE
Remove 2 bolts and the outside handle.
BO–42
BODY
–
REAR DOOR
POWER WINDOW MOTOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
1. REMOVE POWER WINDOW MOTOR
(a) Remove the cover plate by bending its tabs.
(b) Pull out the drum while detaching the cable guide out
from the motor.
HINT:
• Pull out the drum and the cable guide evenly
without tilting the drum.
• Handle the window regulator carefully so that the
cable does not get detached.
• Do not pry above parts with a screwdriver.
2. INSTALL POWER WINDOW MOTOR
(a) Install the motor by fitting the shaft of the motor into
the window regulator drum.
HINT:
• If the shaft does not fit properly into the drum,
slowly move the window glass bracket by hand
to turn the drum.
• While turning the drum, make sure that it does
not detach away from the cable guide.
(b) Reattach the cover plate.
(c) Use a plastic hammer to bend the cover plate tabs.
HINT:
• Do not strike on the tabs with excessive force.
• Attach the cover plate firmly onto the motor to
eliminate any looseness.
In case the cable detaches from the drum, it can be
reattached as follows:
(a) Attach the drum, cable guide, and regulator as shown.
BO–43
BODY
–
REAR DOOR
(b) Attach the compression spring onto the cable.
(c) Attach the cable onto the cable guide.
(d) Attach the cable onto the drum.
HINT: Do not cross the cable ends.
(e) Wrap the cable around the drum from the top.
(f) Wrap the cable around the drum from the bottom.
HINT: Do not flip the drum while wrapping the cable
around it.
(g) Before installing the drum into the guide, verify that
the cable is not taut.
HINT: Verify that the cable ends are not crossed.
(h) Flip the drum over, and the cable will now be crossed.
(i) Verify that the cable is wrapped properly in the
groove.
BO–44
BODY
–
REAR DOOR
REAR DOOR ASSEMBLY
1. BEFORE INSTALLING PARTS, COAT THEM WITH
MP GREASE
(a) Apply MP grease to the window regulator rollers.
(b) Apply MP grease to the sliding surface of the door
lock.
2. INSTALL OUTSIDE HANDLE
Install the outside handle with 2 bolts.
3. INSTALL DOOR LOCK
(a) Apply adhesive to 3 screws.
Part No.08833–00070, THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
(b) Install the door lock with 3 screws.
Torque: 5.4 N–m (55 kgf–cm, 48 in.–lbf)
(c) w/ Power Door Lock:
Connect the connector.
(d) Connect 2 links to the door lock.
(e) Install the clip.
4. INSTALL CHILD PROTECTOR LOCK LEVER KNOB
5. INSTALL WINDOW REGULATOR
(a) Place the regulator through the service hole.
(b) w/ Power Window:
Connect the connector.
(c) Install the regulator with 2 nuts.
Torque: 5.4 N–m (55 kgf–cm, 48 in.–lbf)
BO–45
BODY
–
REAR DOOR
6. INSTALL DOOR INSIDE PANEL FRAME
(a) Install the frame with 3 bolts.
(b) Install 4 nuts.
Torque: 5.4 N–m (55 kgf–cm, 48 in.–lbf)
7. INSTALL REAR DOOR WEATHERSTRIP
Push down on the clips of the weatherstrip.
8. INSTALL REAR DOOR UPPER MOULDING
(a) Sedan: Install the moulding with 5 screws and the clip.
(b) Wagon: Install the moulding with 3 screws.
9. INSTALL REAR DOOR FRAME MOULDING
(a) Sedan: Install the moulding with 3 screws.
(b) Wagon: Install the moulding with 2 screws and nut.
10. Sedan:
INSTALL QUARTER WINDOW GLASS WITH WEA–
THERSTRIP
(a) Install the weatherstrip to the quarter window glass.
(b) Install the quarter window glass together with the
weatherstrip.
11. Wagon:
INSTALL REAR DOOR REAR FRAME MOULDING
Install the moulding with 2 screws and nut.
BO–46
BODY
–
REAR DOOR
12. INSTALL DOOR GLASS
HINT: Insert a shop rag inside the panel to prevent
scratching the glass.
(a) Insert the glass to the frame.
(b) Temporarily tighten 2 glass mounting bolts.
13. Sedan:
INSTALL DOOR GLASS DIVISION BAR
Install the division bar with 2 bolts and the screw.
14. Wagon:
INSTALL REAR LOWER FRAME
Install the frame with the bolt and screw.
15. INSTALL REAR DOOR BELT MOULDING
Install the claw of the clips into the upper panel slit
and push the moulding onto the panel.
16. INSTALL DOOR GLASS RUN
Insert the glass run to the door frame.
17. ADJUST DOOR GLASS
Adjust the glass and tighten when dimension A and B,
as shown, are equal.
HINT: Substitute the bolt with washer for the center–
ing bolt.
BO–47
BODY
–
REAR DOOR
18. INSTALL SERVICE HOLE COVER
(a) Seal the service hole cover with adhesive.
HINT: Bring out the links through the service hole
cover.
(b) w/ Power Window:
Install 2 screw grommets.
(c) w/o Power Window:
Install 3 screw grommets.
19. INSTALL DOOR INSIDE HANDLE
(a) Install the handle with 3 screws.
(b) Connect 2 links.
20. INSTALL DOOR TRIM
(a) Install the armrest with 6 screws.
(b) Install the inner weatherstrip.
(c) Insert the upper edge of the trim from above, tap the
trim by hand fix it in place with the clips, then connect
the connector.
(d) Install 2 screws.
(e) Install the screw cap.
(f) Install 4 clips.
21. INSTALL INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL
Tap the bezel to install it.
22. w/ Power Window:
INSTALL POWER WINDOW SWITCH
Tap the switch to install it, then connect the connec–
tor.
BO–48
BODY
–
REAR DOOR
23. INSTALL REGULATOR HANDLE
With door window fully closed, install the plate and
the regulator handle with the snap ring, as shown.
BO–49
BODY
–
BACK DOOR
BACK DOOR
COMPONENTS
BO–50
BODY
–
BACK DOOR
BACK DOOR ADJUSTMENT
1. ADJUST DOOR IN FORWARD / REARWARD AND
LEFT /RIGHT DIRECTIONS
(a) Remove the rear header trim.
(b) Loosen the body side hinge nuts to adjust.
Torque: 13 N–m (130 kgf–cm, 9.4 ft–lbf)
(c) Install the rear header trim.
(d) Install the rear seat side cushion.
Torque: 19 N–m (195 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
2. ADJUST DOOR IN LEFT /RIGHT AND VERTICAL
DIRECTIONS
Loosen the door side hinge bolts to adjust.
Torque: 13 N–m (130 kgf–cm, 9.4 ft–lbf)
3. ADJUST DOOR LOCK STRIKER
(a) Remove rear floor finish plate by pulling.
(b) Loosen the striker mounting screws to adjust.
(c) Using a plastic hammer, tap the striker to adjust it.
(d) Install the rear floor finish plate.
BO–51
BODY
–
BACK DOOR
BACK DOOR DAMPER STAY
NOTICE: Handling the damper.
• Do not disassemble the damper because the cylinder
is filled with pressurized gas.
• If the damper is to be replaced, drill a 2.0 – 3.0 mm
(0.079 – 0.118 in.) hole in the bottom of the re–
moved damper cylinder to completely release the
high–pressure gas before disposing of it.
• When drilling, chips may fly out so work carefully.
• The gas is colorless, odorless and non–toxic.
• When working, handle the damper carefully. Never
score or scratch the exposed part of the piston rod,
and never allow paint or oil to get on it.
• Do not turn the piston rod and cylinder with the
damper fully extended.
BACK DOOR DISASSEMBLY
REMOVE FOLLOWING PARTS:
(a) Rear wiper arms
(b) w/ High Mount Stop Light:
High mount stop light
(c) Back door trim upper board
(d) Back door trim cover LH
BO–52
BODY
–
BACK DOOR
(e) Back door trim cover RH
(f) Back door inside handle bezel
(g) Speaker cover and speaker
(h) Back door trim board
(i) Wiper motor and link
(j) License plate light
(k) Back door outside garnish
(1) Back door outside handle
(m) Rear combination lights
(n) Back door control
(o) Back door inside handle
(p) Child protector lock
(q) Door lock cylinder
(r) Back door lock
BACK DOOR ASSEMBLY
ASSEMBLE BACK DOOR PARTS BY FOLLOWING DISASS–
EMBLY SEQUENCE IN REVERSE
BEFORE INSTALLING PARTS, COAT THEM WITH MP
GREASE
Apply MP grease to the sliding surface of the door
lock control.
BO–53
BODY
–
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT
COMPONENTS
BO–54
BODY
–
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR
ADJUSTMENT
1. ADJUST DOOR IN FORWARD/ REARWARD AND
LEFT/RIGHT DIRECTIONS
(a) Remove rear seat cushion and rear seat back.
(b) Remove roof side inner garnish.
(c) Remove package tray trim garnish.
(d) Remove package tray trim.
(e) Loosen 2 body side hinge bolt to adjust.
2. ADJUST DOOR LOCK STRIKER
(a) Remove the rear floor finish plate by pulling.
(b) Remove the clips and the rear luggage trim.
(c) Loosen the bolts to adjust.
BO–55
BODY
–
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT
TORSION BAR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
1. REMOVE FOLLOWING PARTS:
(a) Rear floor finish plate
(b) Rear luggage trim
(c) Right side luggage trim
(d) Left side luggage trim
2. REMOVE TORSION BAR
(a) Remove the torsion bar from center bracket.
(b) Install SST to the torsion bar on the hinge side.
SST 09804–24010
(c) Push down on SST, and pull the luggage compartment
door hinge from the torsion bar.
(d) Slowly lift SST, and remove the torsion bar from the
torsion bar bracket with SST.
(e) Remove the torsion bar.
(f) Do the same for the other side.
3. INSTALL TORSION BAR
(a) Insert the torsion bar into the bracket as shown.
BO–56
BODY
–
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT
(b) Install SST to the torsion bar of the hinge side.
SST 09804–24010
(c) Slowly lift the torsion bar with SST and place in the
torsion bar bracket.
(d) Slowly push down SST, and install the torsion bar to
the hinge.
(e) Slowly lift SST, and install the torsion bar.
(f) Install the torsion bar to center bracket.
(g) Do the same for the other side.
4. INSTALL FOLLOWING PARTS:
(a) Left side luggage trim
(b) Right side luggage trim
(c) Rear luggage trim
(d) Rear floor finish plate
BO–57
BODY
–
WIPER AND WASHER
WIPER AND WASHER
COMPONENTS
BO–58
BODY
–
WIPER AND WASHER
COMPONENTS (Cont’d)
BO–59
BODY
–
WIPER AND WASHER
WIPER AND WASHER REMOVAL
1. REMOVE WIPER ARMS
Remove 2 nuts and 2 wiper arms.
2. REMOVE COWL LOUVER
(a) Using a clip remover, remove the clips and the weath–
erstrip.
(b) Pull out the cowl louver forwards as shown.
3. REMOVE WIPER MOTOR
(a) Disconnect the connector, then unfasten 4 bolts and
remove the motor.
(b) Disconnect the wiper link.
4. REMOVE WIPER LINK
(a) Remove 6 bolts.
(b) Remove the wiper link through the service hole.
5. REMOVE WINDOW WASHER NOZZLE
(a) Remove the cover.
(b) Using a screwdriver, remove the nozzle.
HINT: Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
BO–60
BODY
–
WIPER AND WASHER
WIPER AND WASHER INSTALLATION
INSTALL FOLLOWING PARTS:
(a) Window washer nozzle
(b) Wiper link
(c) Wiper motor
(d) Wiper arms
Torque: 19 N–m (195 kgf–cm. 14 ft–lbf)
REAR WIPER REMOVAL
1. REMOVE,REAR WIPER ARMS
(a) Remove 2 ’nuts and 2 wiper arms.
(b) Remove 2 caps.
(c) Remove 2 nuts and 2 washers.
2. REMOVE FOLLOWING PARTS:
(a) Back door trim upper board
(b) Back door trim board
3. REMOVE REAR WIPER MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector, then unfasten 3 bolts.
(b) Remove the motor assembly.
(c) Remove the wiper link assembly.
BO–61
BODY
–
WIPER AND WASHER
REAR WIPER INSTALLATION
ASSEMBLE REAR WIPER PARTS BY FOLLOWING RE–
MOVAL SEQUENCE IN REVERSE
INSTALL REAR WIPER ARM
(a) Install 2 washers with 2 nuts.
Torque: 11 N .m (110 kgf–cm, 8 ft–Ibf)
(b) Install the wiper arm and operate the wiper once and
turn the wiper switch OFF.
(c) Adjust the installation position of the wiper arm to the
position shown in the installation.
(A) Approx. 20 mm (0.79 in.)
(d) Torque the nut.
Torque: 5.4 N–m (55 kgf–cm, 48in.–lbf)
REAR WASHER NOZZLE ADJUSTMENT
1. INSPECT REAR WASHER NOZZLE
While operating the washer, check whether the point
where the washer fluid hits the back door glass and
the upsurge area are with in the range indicated by the
hatched line.
(A)Approx. 600 mm (23.62 in.)
(B)Approx. 200 mm (7.84 in.)
2. ADJUST FRONT WASHER NOZZLE
Using a tool like that shown in the installation, change
the direction of the nozzle hole to adjust the point
where washer fluid strikes the windshield.
BO–62
BODY
–
WINDSHIELD MOULDING
WINDSHIELD MOULDING
COMPONENTS
WINDSHIELD MOULDING REMOVAL
1. REMOVE WEATHERSTRIP
Remove the weatherstrip by pulling.
2. REMOVE WINDSHIELD OUTSIDE MOULDING
Remove 3 screws and the moulding.
BO–63
BODY
–
WINDSHIELD MOULDING
3. REMOVE WINDOWSHIELD UPPER MOULDING
(a) Insert the top of scraper between the body and the
moulding.
HINT: Tape the scraper tip before use.
(b) Pry up the scraper to loosen the moulding from the
claws of the clips and retainers.
(c) Remove the moulding.
FASTENER REPLACEMENT
REPLACE FASTENER
(a) Remove the damaged fastener.
(b) Cut off the old adhesive around the fastener installa–
tion area.
HINT: Be careful not to damage the body.
(c) Clean the installation area.
(d) Install a new fastener onto the body.
WINDSHIELD MOULDING INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL NEW CLIP INTO MOULDING
Install the clip to the appropriate place on the mould–
ing, where the clip would engage with the fastener.
2. APPLY ADHESIVE AT NEW CLIP INSTALLATION
AREA
(a) When the clip being engaged with the moulding is
removed, cut out the old adhesive around the clip
installation area.
NOTICE: Do not damage the body and fastener.
(b) Apply adhesive at the clip installation area so water
does not collect there.
3. INSTALL WINDSHIELD UPPER MOULDING
(a) Place the moulding onto the body.
(b) Tap the moulding with your hand to fasten the clips at
the glassedge.
At the same time, install the fastener, by tapping them
by hand.
4. INSTALL WINDSHIELD OUTSIDE MOULDING
5. INSTALL WEATHERSTRIP
BO–64
BODY
–
BODY OUTSIDE MOULDING
BODY OUTSIDE MOULDING
COMPONENTS
BO–65
BODY
–
BODY OUTSIDE MOULDING
FRONT DOOR BELT AND FRAME
MOULDING REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
1. REMOVE FRONT DOOR COMPONENT PARTS
(See steps 1 to 5 and 9 pages BO–23 to 25)
2. REMOVE FRONT DOOR BELT MOULDING
(See step 10 on page BO–25)
3. REMOVE FRONT DOOR FRAME MOULDING
(See step 11 on page BO –25)
4. REMOVE FRONT DOOR UPPER MOULDING
(See step 12 on page BO–25 to 26)
5. INSTALL FOLLOWING PARTS:
(See steps 11 to 14 and 19 to 23 on pages BO–30 to
33)
(a) Front door upper moulding
(b) Front door frame moulding
(c) Front door belt moulding
(d) Front door component parts
REAR DOOR BELT AND FRAME
MOULDING REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
1. REMOVE REAR DOOR COMPONENT PARTS
(See steps 1 to 4 on pages BO–37 to 38)
2. REMOVE REAR DOOR BELT MOULDING
(See step 8 on page BO–39)
3. REMOVE REAR DOOR COMPONENT PARTS
(See steps 5 to 7 and 9 to 12 on pages BO–38 to 39)
4. REMOVE REAR DOOR FRAME MOULDING
(See step 14 on page BO–40)
5. REMOVE REAR DOOR UPPER MOULDING
(See step 15 on page BO–40)
6. INSTALL FOLLOWING PARTS:
(a) Rear door upper moulding
(b) Rear door frame moulding
(c) Rear door belt moulding
(d) Rear door component parts
BO–66
BODY
–
BODY OUTSIDE MOULDING
SIDE PROTECTION MOULDING REMOVAL
Precautions for storing moulding material:
• Store in a cool place, avoiding direct sunlight, high
temperature and dust.
• The moulding is of polyvinyl chloride, so do not allow
it to come in contact with thinner or other solvents,
open flame, or boiling water.
• The storage time for the moulding and adhesive is
limited to about 9 months.
1. REMOVE ENDS OF MOULDING
Using a scraper, pry the moulding loose about 30 mm
(1.18 in.) from the ends.
HINT: Tape the scraper tip before use.
2. REMOVE MOULDING AND ADHESIVE
(a) Pull oft the moulding by cutting the adhesive with a
knife.
(b) Scrape oft adhesive from the body with sandpaper
cutter.
NOTICE:
• Remember that 30–80 mm (1.18–3.15 in.) of the
ends of the moulding are glued tightly with a strong
adhesive.
• Do not reuse moulding.
SIDE PROTECTION MOULDING
INSTALLATION
1. CLEAN MOULDING MOUNTING SURFACE
Wipe off stains with cleaner.
2. HEAT BODY MOUNTING SURFACE
Using a heat light, heat the body mounting surface to
40 – 60 C (104 –140 F).
NOTICE: When the moulding is installed, the temperature
of the mounting surface should be 20* C (68 F) or higher.
BO–67
BODY
–
BODY OUTSIDE MOULDING
3. HEAT MOULDING
Using a heat light, heat the moulding to 20 – 30 C (68– 86 F)
NOTICE: Do not heat moulding excessively.
The temperature should not be higher than 80C (176F).
4. APPLY ADHESIVE TO DOOR OUTSIDE MOULDING
Apply adhesive to both punched out ends of the
moulding.
NOTICE: Install the moulding within 30 minutes after
applying the adhesive.
Part No. 08850–00051
5. LIFT MOULDING RELEASE SHEET FROM FACE OF
MOULDING
NOTICE: When the moulding release sheet is removed, be
sure that no dirt or dust can get onto the uncoverd area.
6. INSTALL MOULDING
Align the bosses an the moulding with the body holes,
and push the moulding to the body.
NOTICE:
• Be sure that the body and moulding are heated to
the proper temperature.
• Do not depress the adhesive – coated parts ex–
cessively just hold them down with your thumb.
• Scrape off any overflowing adhesive with a plastic
spatula and clean the surface with a dry rag.
• After installation, do not wash the vehicle for 24
hours.
BO–68
BODY
–
BODY OUTSIDE MOULDING
OUTSIDE LOWER MOULDING REMOVAL
AND INSTALLATION
1. REMOVE FRONT FENDER LOWER MOULDING
(a) Remove the screw.
(b) Pry out the clip and remove the moulding.
2. REMOVE FRONT DOOR LOWER MOULDING
(a) Remove 2 hole plugs.
(b) Remove 2 nuts.
(c) Pry out the clips and remove the moulding.
3. REMOVE REAR DOOR LOWER MOULDING
(a) Remove 2 hole plugs.
(b) Remove 2 nuts.
(c) Pry out the clips and remove the moulding.
4. INSTALL FOLLOWING PARTS:
(a) Front fender lower moulding
(b) Front door lower moulding
(c) Rear door lower moulding
ROCKER PANEL MOULDING REMOVAL
AND INSTALLATION
1. REMOVE ROCKER PANEL MOULDING
(a) Remove 3 screws.
(b) Pry out the clips and remove the moulding.
2. INSTALL ROCKER PANEL MOULDING
REAR DOOR BELT AND FRAME
MOULDING REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
1. REMOVE REAR DOOR COMPONENT PARTS
BO–69
BODY
–
BODY OUTSIDE MOULDING
2. REMOVE REAR DOOR BELT MOULDING
Pry out the clips from the edge of the weatherstrip
and remove the moulding.
3. REMOVE REAR DOOR REAR FRAME MOULDING
(a) Remove 2 screws and the nut.
(b) Pry out the clips and remove the moulding.
4. REMOVE REAR DOOR FRONT FRAME MOULDING
(a) Remove 3 screws and the nut.
(b) Pry out the clips and remove the moulding.
5. REMOVE REAR DOOR UPPER MOULDING
Remove 3 screws and the moulding.
6. INSTALL FOLLOWING PARTS:
(a) Rear door upper moulding
(b) Rear door front frame moulding
(c) Rear door rear frame moulding
(d) Rear door belt moulding
(e) Rear door component parts
BO–70
BODY
–
BODY OUTSIDE MOULDING
QUARTER WINDOW MOULDING
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
1. REMOVE QUARTER WINDOW FRONT MOULDING
Pry out the clips and remove the moulding.
2. REMOVE QUARTER WINDOW UPPER MOULDING
Pry out the clips and remove the moulding.
3. REMOVE QUARTER WINDOW REAR MOULDING
Pry out the clips and remove the moulding.
4. REMOVE QUARTER WINDOW BELT MOULDING
Pry out the clips and remove the moulding.
5. INSTALL FOLLOWING PARTS:
(a) Quarter window belt moulding
(b) Quarter window rear moulding
(c) Quarter window upper moulding
(d) Quarter window front moulding
BO–71
BODY
–
BACK WINDOW MOULDING
BACK WINDOW MOULDING
COMPONENTS
BACK WINDOW MOULDING REMOVAL
1. REMOVE BACK WINDOW LOWER MOULDING
Using a scraper, pry off the moulding from the clips
and remove the moulding.
HINT: Tape the scraper tip before use.
2. REMOVE BACK WINDOW MOULDING
Using a knife, cut off the moulding as shown.
NOTICE: Do not damage the body with the knife.
BO–72
BODY
–
BACK WINDOW MOULDING
BACK WINDOW MOULDING
INSTALLATION
1. CUT ADHESIVE AT MOULDING INSTALLATION
AREA
Using the knife, cut off the adhesive around the mou–
Iding installation area.
2. APPLY ADHESIVE AT MOULDING INSTALLATION
AREA
3. INSTALL BACK WINDOW MOULDING
Place the moulding onto the body and tap it by hand.
4. INSTALL BACK WINDOW LOWER MOULDING
Place the moulding onto the body and tap it by hand.
BO–73
BODY
–
BACK DOOR MOULDING
BACK DOOR MOULDING
COMPONENTS
BO–74
BODY
–
BACK DOOR MOULDING
BACK DOOR MOULDING REMOVAL
REMOVE BACK DOOR MOULDING
Using a knife, cut off the moulding as shown.
NOTICE: Do not damage the body with the knife.
BACK DOOR MOULDING INSTALLATION
1. CUT ADHESIVE AT MOULDING INSTALLATION
AREA
Using the knife, cut off the adhesive around the mou–
lding installation area.
2. APPLY ADHESIVE AT MOULDING INSTALLATION
AREA
3. INSTALL BACK DOOR MOULDING
Place the moulding onto the body and tap it by hand.
BO–75
BODY
–
WINDSHIELD
WINDSHIELD
COMPONENTS
BO–76
BODY
–
WINDSHIELD
WINDSHIELD REMOVAL
1. REMOVE FOLLOWING PARTS:
(a) Inner rear view mirror
(b) Sunvisors and holders
(c) Front assist grip
(d) Interior light
2. REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH
(a) Sedan, Wagon: Remove the clips by your hand.
(b) Sedan, Wagon: Pull the garnish rearwards to remove
it.
(c) Coupe: Rear side garnish must be removed before
front piller garnish.
3. REMOVE HOOD
4. REMOVE FOLLOWING PARTS:
(a) Wiper arms
(b) Cowl louver
5. REMOVE WEATHERSTRIP
Remove the weatherstrip by pulling.
6. REMOVE WINDSHIELD OUTSIDE MOULDING
Remove 3 screws and the moulding.
7. REMOVE WINDSHIELD UPPER MOULDING
(a) Insert the top of scraper between the body and the
moulding.
HINT: Tape the scraper tip before use.
(b) Pry up the scraper to loosen the moulding from the
claw of the clips and retainers.
(c) Remove the moulding.
BO–77
BODY
–
WINDSHIELD
8. REMOVE WINDSHIELD GLASS
(a) Push piano wire through from the interior.
(b) Tie both wire ends to a wooden block or like object_
HINT: Apply adhesive tape to the outer surface to
keep the surface from being scratched.
NOTICE: When separating the glass, take care not to
damage the paint and interior and exterior ornaments. To
prevent scratching the safety pad when removing the w
indshield, place a plastic sheet between the piano wir–
eand safety pad.
(c) Cut the adhesive by pulling the piano wire around it.
(d) Remove the glass.
NOTICE: Leave as much of the adhesive on the body as
possible when cutting off the glass.
WINDSHIELD INSTALLATION
1. CLEAN AND SHAPE CONTACT SURFACE OF BODY
(a) Using a knife, cut away any rough areas on the body.
HINT: Leave as much of the adhesive on the body as
possible.
(b) Clean the cutting surface of the adhesive with a piece
of shop rag saturated in cleaner.
HINT: Even if all the adhesive has been removed, clean
the body.
2. REPLACE FASTENER
(a) Remove the damaged fastener.
(b) Cut off the old adhesive around the fastener installa–
tion area.
HINT: Be careful not to damage the body.
(c) Clean the installation area.
(d) Install a new fastener onto the body.
3. CLEAN REMOVED GLASS
(a) Using a scraper, remove the adhesive sticking to the
glass.
(b) Clean the glass with cleaner.
NOTICE: Do not touch the glass after cleaning it.
BO–78
BODY
–
WINDSHIELD
4. INSTALL RETAINER
Install the retainers as shown.
5. INSTALL SPACER
6. POSITION GLASS
(a) Place glass in correct position.
(b) Check that all contacting parts of the glass rim are
perfectly even and do not make contact with the
fasteners.
(c) Place reference marks between the glass and body.
(d) Remove the glass.
7. CLEAN CONTACT SURFACE OF GLASS
Using a cleaner, clean the contact surface black–
colored area around the entire glass rim.
NOTICE: Do not touch the glass face after cleaning it.
8. INSTALL DAM
Install the dam with double–stick tape as shown in
the illustration.
NOTICE: Do not touch the glass face after cleaning it.
BO–79
BODY
–
WINDSHIELD
9. COAT CONTACT SURFACE OF BODY WITH
PRIMER ”M”
Using a brush, coat the contact surface on the body
with Primer M.
NOTICE:
• Let the primer coating dry for 3 minutes or more.
• Do not coat to the adhesive.
• Do not keep any of the opened primer M and G for
later use.
10. COAT CONTACT SURFACE OF GLASS WITH
PRIMER ”G”
(a) Using a brush or sponge, coat the edge of the glass
and the contact surface with Primer G.
(b) Before the Primer dries, wipe it off with a clean shop
rag.
NOTICE: Let the primer coating dry for 3 minutes or
more.
11. MIX ADHESIVE COATING
NOTICE:
• Be sure that installation of the moulding is finished
within usable time. (See step 3 on page BO–9)
• The mixture should be made in 5 minutes or less.
(a) Thoroughly clean the glass plate and putty spatula
with solvent.
(b) Thoroughly mix 500 g (117.64 oz.) of the main agent
and 75 g (2.65 oz.) of the hardening agent on a glass
plate or like object with a putty spatula.
12. APPLY ADHESIVE
(a) Cut off the tip of the cartridge nozzle. Fill the cartridge
with adhesive.
(b) Load the cartridge into the sealer gun.
(c) Coat the glass with adhesive as shown.
BO–80
BODY
–
WINDSHIELD
(d) Coat the body with adhesive as shown.
13. INSTALL GLASS
HINT: Confirm that the dam is attached the body
panel as shown in the illustration.
(a) Position the glass so that the reference marks are
lined up, and press in gently along the rim.
(b) Using a spatula, apply adhesive on the glass rim.
(c) Use a scraper to remove any excess or protruding
adhesive.
(d) Fasten glass securely until the adhesive sets.
BO–81
BODY
–
WINDSHIELD
14. INSPECT FOR LEAKS AND REPAIR
(a) Perform a leak test after the hardening time has ela–
psed.
(b) Seal any leak with auto glass sealer.
Part No. 08833–00030
15. INSTALL WINDSHIELD UPPER MOULDING
(a) Place the moulding onto the body.
(b) Tap the moulding with your hand to fasten the clips at
the glass edge.
At the same time, install the fastener, by tapping them
by hand.
16. INSTALL WINDSHIELD OUTSIDE MOULDING
17. INSTALL WEATHERSTRIP
18. INSTALL FOLLOWING PARTS:
(a) Cowl louver
(b) Wiper arms
(c) Hood
(d) Front pillar garnish
(e) Interior light
(f) Front assist grip
(g) Sunvisors and holders
(h) Inner rear view mirror
BO–82
BODY
–
BACK WINDOW GLASS
BACK WINDOW GLASS
COMPONENTS
BO–83
BODY
–
BACK WINDOW GLASS
BACK WINDOW GLASS REMOVAL
1. REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION AND SEAT BACK
2. REMOVE ROOF SIDE INNER GARNISH
(a) Remove the clips.
(b) Remove the garnish by pulling.
3. w/o Rear Spoiler:
REMOVE HIGH MOUNT STOP LIGHT
(a) Remove the cover.
(b) Remove 2 bolts and the stop light, then disconnect
the connector.
4. REMOVE PACKAGE TRAY GARNISH
Remove the garnish by pulling.
5. REMOVE PACKAGE TRAY TRIM
(a) Remove 2 screw caps.
(b) Remove 2 screws.
(c) Remove the trim by pulling forwards.
6. REMOVE FOLLOWING PARTS:
(a) Assist grips.
(b) Rear side of roof headlining.
7. DISCONNECT DEFOGGER WIRE CONNECTORS
8. REMOVE SACK WINDOW LOWER MOULDING
Using a scraper, pry off the moulding from the clips
and remove the moulding.
HINT: Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
BO–84
BODY
–
BACK WINDOW GLASS
9. REMOVE BACK WINDOW MOULDING
Using a knife, cut off the moulding as shown.
NOTICE: Do not damage the body with the knife.
10. REMOVE BACK WINDOW GLASS
Remove the glass in the same manner as windshield.
(See step 8 on page BO–77)
11. REMOVE RETAINERS
Remove retainers from the body.
BACK WINDOW GLASS INSTALLATION
1. CLEAN AND SHAPE CONTACT SURFACE OF BODY
(See step 1 on page BO–77)
2. REPLACE LOWER MOULDING CLIP
(a) Remove the screw and the damaged clip.
(b) Install the new clip with the screw.
3. CLEAN REMOVED GLASS
(See step 3 on page BO–77)
4. REMOVE STOPPERS
Using a knife, remove the stoppers.
5. POSITION GLASS
(See step6 on page BO–77)
6. CLEAN CONTACT SURFACE OF GLASS
(See step 7 on page BO–78)
7. INSTALL DAM
Install the dam with double–stick tape as shown in
the drawing.
NOTICE: Do not touch the glass face after cleaning it.
8. COAT CONTACT SURFACE OF BODY WITH
PRIMER ’M’
(See step 9 on page BO–79)
BO–85
BODY
–
BACK WINDOW GLASS
9. COAT CONTACT SURFACE OF GLASS WITH
PRIMER ’G”
(SEE STEP 10 ON PAGE BO–79)
10. MIX ADHESIVE COATING
(SEE STEP 11 ON PAGE BO–79)
11. APPLY ADHESIVE
(SEE STEP 12 ON PAGE BO–79)
12. INSTALL GLASS
(SEE STEP 13 ON PAGE BO–80)
13. INSTALL BACK WINDOW MOULDING
Place the moulding onto the body and tap it by hand.
14. INSTALL BACK WINDOW LOWER MOULDING
Place the moulding onto the body and tap it by hand.
15. INSPECT FOR LEAKS AND REPAIR
(SEE STEP 14 ON PAGE BO–81)
16. CONNECT DEFOGGER WIRE CONNECTORS
17. INSTALL FOLLOWING PARTS:
(a) Rear side of roof headlining
(b) Assist grips
(c) Package tray trim
(d) Package tray trim garnish
(e) w/o Rear Spoiler:
High mount stop light
(f) Roof side inner garnish
(g) Rear seat back and seat cushion
Torque: 19 N–m (195 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
BO–86
BODY
–
QUARTER WINDOW GLASS
QUARTER WINDOW GLASS
COMPONENTS
BO–87
BODY
–
QUARTER WINDOW GLASS
COMPONENTS (Cont’d)
BO–88
BODY
–
QUARTER WINDOW GLASS
QUARTER WINDOW GLASS REMOVAL
Coupe:
1. REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION
2. REAR SIDE SEAT BACK
3. REMOVE FOLLOWING PARTS:
(a) Front seat outer belt shoulder anchor
(b) Front seat outer belt bezel
(c) Rear seat outer belt anchor
(d) Roof side inner garnish.
(e) Front door scuff plate.
(f) Quarter trim board.
(g) Front door weatherstrip.
4. REMOVE QUARTER WIND GLASS
(a) Remove 5 nuts.
(b) Using a knife, cut loose the adhesive.
(c) Remove glass.
NOTICE: Do not damege the body.
BO–89
BODY
–
QUARTER WINDOW GLASS
QUARTER WINDOW GLASS REMOVAL
Wagon:
1. REMOVE REAR HEADER TRIM
Remove the trim by pulling, then disconnect the con–
nector.
2. REMOVE REAR FLOOR FINISH PLATE
(a) Remove 2 cushions.
(b) Remove 6 covers and 6 screws.
(c) Remove the plate.
3. REMOVE FOLLOWING PARTS:
Right Side:
(a) Rear side seatback RH
(b) w/ Third Seat:
Spare wheel cover
(c) Tonneau side cover RH
(d) Deck trim side panel RH
BO–90
BODY
–
QUARTER WINDOW GLASS
(e) w/ Third Seat:
Deck side rear garnish
(f) Roof side inner garnish RH
Left Side:
(a) Rear side seatback LH
(b) Tonneau side cover LH
(c) Deck trim side panel LH
(d) Roof side inner garnish LH
BO–91
BODY
–
QUARTER WINDOW GLASS
4. REMOVE QUARTER WINDOW FRONT MOULDING
Pry out the clips and remove the moulding.
5. REMOVE QUARTER WINDOW UPPER MOULDING
Pry out the clips and remove the moulding.
6. REMOVE QUARTER WINDOW REAR MOULDING
Pry out the clips and remove the moulding.
7. REMOVE QUARTER WINDOW BELT MOULDING
Pry out the clips and remove the moulding.
8. REMOVE QUARTER WINDOW GLASS
(a) Remove 9 nuts.
(b) Using a knife, cut loose the adhesive.
(c) Remove glass.
NOTICE: Do not damage the body.
QUARTER WINDOW GLASS
INSTALLATION
Coupe:
1. CLEAN BODY OR GLASS
Wipe off any adhesive left on the body and glass with
cleaner.
2. INSTALL QUARTER WINDOW GLASS
(a) Apply adhesive at glass installation area.
(b) Install the glass to the body.
(c) Install 5 nuts.
BO–92
BODY
–
QUARTER WINDOW GLASS
3. INSTALL FOLLOWING PARTS:
(a) Front door weatherstrip.
(b) Quarter trim board
(c) Front door scuff plate
(d) Roof side inner garnish
(e) Rear seat outer belt anchor
Torque: 43 N–m (440 kgf–cm. 32 ft–lbf)
(f) Front seat outer belt bezel
(g) Front seat outer belt shoulder anchor
Torque: 43 N–m (440 kgf–cm, 32 ft–lbf)
(h) Rear side seat back
Torque: 19 N–m (195 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
(i) Rear seat cushion
QUARTER WINDOW GLASS
INSTALLATION
Wagon:
1. CLEAN BODY OR GLASS
Wipe off any adhesive left on the body and glass with
cleaner.
2. INSTALL QUARTER WINDOW GLASS
(a) Apply adhesive at glass installation area.
(b) Install the glass to the body.
(c) Install 9 nuts.
3. INSTALL QUARTER WINDOW MOULDING
(a) Install the quarter window belt moulding.
(b) Install the quarter window rear moulding.
(c) Install the quarter window upper moulding.
(d) Install the quarter window front moulding.
4. INSTALL FOLLOWING PARTS:
RIGHT SIDE:
(a) Roof side inner garnish RH
BO–93
BODY
–
QUARTER WINDOW GLASS
(b) w/ Third Seat:
Deck side rear garnish
(c) Deck trim side panel RH
(d) Tonneau side cover RH
(e) w/ Third Seat:
Spare wheel cover
(f) Rear side seatback RH
Torque: 19 N–m (195 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
Left Side:
(a) Roof side inner garnish LH
(b) Deck trim side panel LH
(c) Tonneau side cover LH
(d) Rear side seatback LH
Torque: 19 N–m (195 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
BO–94
BODY
–
BACK DOOR GLASS
BACK DOOR GLASS
COMPONENTS
BO–95
BODY
–
BACK DOOR GLASS
BACK DOOR GLASS REMOVAL
1. REMOVE FOLLOWING PARTS:
(a) Back door trim upper board
(b) w/ High Mount Stop Light:
High mount stop light
(c) Back door trim cover LH
(d) Back door trim cover RH
2. DISCONNECT DEFOGGER WIRE CONNECTORS
3. REMOVE BACK DOOR MOULDING
Using a knife, cut off the moulding as shown.
NOTICE: Do not damage the body with the knife.
4. REMOVE BACK DOOR GLASS
(a) Remove 2 screws.
(b) Remove the glass in the same manner as windshield.
BO–96
BODY
–
BACK DOOR GLASS
BACK DOOR GLASS INSTALLATION
HINT: Install the glass in the same manner as the
windshield.
1. CLEAN AND SHAPE CONTACT SURFACE OF BODY
2. CLEAN REMOVED GLASS
3. POSITION GLASS
4. CLEAN CONTACT SURFACE OF GLASS
5. COAT CONTACT SURFACE OF BODY WITH
PRIM ER ”M”
6. COAT CONTACT SURFACE OF GLASS WITH
PRIM ER ”G”
7. MIX ADHESIVE COATING
8. APPLY ADHESIVE
9. INSTALL GLASS
10. INSTALL BACK DOOR MOULDING
Place the moulding onto the body and tap it by hand.
11. INSPECT FOR LEAKS AND REPAIR
12. CONNECT DEFOGGER WIRE CONNECTORS
13. INSTALL FOLLOWING PARTS:
(a) Back door trim cover RH
(b) Back door trim cover LH
(c) w/ High Mount Stop Light:
High mount stop light
(d) Back door trim upper board
BO–97
BODY
–
SLIDING ROOF
SLIDING ROOF
COMPONENTS
BO–98
BODY
–
SLIDING ROOF
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
INSPECT SLIDING ROOF GLASS ALIGNMENT
(a) Start the engine and check the operation time of the
sliding roof.
Operation time:
Approx.6 sacs.
(b) Check for abnormal noise or binding during operation.
(c) With the sliding roof fully closed, check for water
leakage.
(d) Check for a difference in level between the sliding roof
weatherstrip and roof panel.
Front end:
1 ±1 mm (0.039±0.039 in.)
Rear end:
0±1 mm (0±0.039 in.)
If the sliding roof does not operate:
(e) Remove the control switch cover.
(f) Remove the large screw inside.
NOTICE: Be careful not to lose the spring washer or shim.
(g) Manually operate the moon roof by inserting a special
crank–shaped screwdriver into the hole and turning
the drive shaft.
SLIDING ROOF ADJUSTMENT
1. REMOVE SLIDING ROOF GARNISHES
Before making adjustments, remove the left and right
sliding roof garnishes.
HINT: After adjustment, reinstall the sliding roof gar–
nishes.
2. TO ADJUST LEVEL DIFFERENCE
Adjust by increasing or decreasing the number of
shims between the bracket and sliding roof.
BO–99
BODY
–
SLIDING ROOF
3. TO ADJUST FORWARD OR REARWARD
(a) Adjust by loosening the sliding roof installation nuts,
and move the sliding roof bracket forwards and back–
wards.
(b) When the front or rear alignment is not correct,
remove the glass and adjust the drive rail.
(c) Using a screwdriver, slide the link forwards or back–
wards to align the 2 marks as shown.
4. TO ADJUST RIGHT OR LEFT
Adjust by loosening the sliding roof rear shoe installa–
tion nuts, and move the sliding roof to the right and
left.
5. TO ADJUST CLEARANCE
(Difference in left and right clearance)
BO–100
BODY
–
SLIDING ROOF
Adjust by loosening the sliding roof installation nuts
and readjust the sliding roof to the proper position.
SLIDING ROOF REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT BATTERY CABLE FROM NEGATIVE
TERMINAL
CAUTION: Work must be started after. 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ”LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. REMOVE SLIDING ROOF SWITCH
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the cover.
HINT: Tape the screw driver tip before use.
(b) Remove 2 screws and the switch, then disconnect the
connectors.
3. REMOVE FOLLOWING PARTS:
(a) Inner rear view mirror
(b) Sunvisors and holders
(c) Front assist grip
4. REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH
(a) Sedan, Wagon: Remove the 2 clips by hand.
(b) Sedan, Wagon: Pull the garnish rearwards to remove
it.
(c) Coupe: Rear side garnish must be removed before
front piller garnish.
5. REMOVE FRONT SIDE OF ROOF HEADLINING
(a) Disconnect the front side of roof headlining from the
front side of housing.
(b) Pull down the front side of roof headlining by hand.
BO–101
BODY
–
SLIDING ROOF
2
6. REMOVE SLIDING ROOF CONTROL RELAY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the bolt, the connector and the relay.
7. REMOVE DRIVE GEAR
(a) Disconnect the connectors.
(b) Remove 3 bolts and the drive gear.
8. REMOVE SIDE GARNISH
Using a screwdriver, remove the garnishes.
HINT: Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
9. REMOVE SLIDING ROOF GLASS
(a) Remove 6 nuts and shims.
HINT: Make sure of the number of shims.
(b) Pull the glass upwards to remove it.
10. REMOVE FRONT AND REAR GARNISH
Using a screwdriver, remove the garnishes.
HINT: Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
BO–102
BODY
–
SLIDING ROOF
11. REMOVE ROOF DRIP CHANNEL
(a) Remove 2 screws.
(b) Pull the channel forwards to remove it.
12. REMOVE WIND DEFLECTOR PANEL
(a) Slide the drive cable backwards.
(b) Remove 4 screws and the panel.
13. REMOVE CABLE GUIDE CASING ASSEMBLY
(a) Slide the drive cable forwards.
(b) Remove 11 screws.
(c) Apply adhesive tape to protect the body.
(d) Pull the cable guide casing assembly forwards to
remove it.
BO–103
BODY
–
SLIDING ROOF
SLIDING ROOF DISASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE SLIDING ROOF PANEL STOPPER
Remove the screw and the stopper.
2. REMOVE SUNSHADE TRIM
Pull the trim rearwards to remove it.
3. REMOVE CABLE GUIDE CASING
Remove 2 screws and the casing.
4. REMOVE SLIDING ROOF FRONT STOPPER
Remove the screw and the stopper.
5. REMOVE DRIVE CABLE
(a) Remove 2 screws and the cable guide block.
(b) Pull the drive cable from the guide rail.
BO–104
BODY
–
SLIDING ROOF
SLIDING ROOF ASSEMBLY
1. INSTALL DRIVE CABLE
(a) Insert the drive cable to the drive rail.
(b) Install the cable guide block with 2 screws.
2. INSTALL SLIDING ROOF FRONT STOPPER
Install the stopper with the screw.
3. INSTALL CABLE GUIDE CASING
(a) Install the casing with 2 screws.
(b) Use butyl tape to cover the cut position of the weath–
erstrip at the connection between the guide casing
and the guide rail.
4. INSTALL SUNSHADE TRIM
5. INSTALL SLIDING ROOF PANEL STOPPER
Install the stopper with the screw.
BO–105
BODY
–
SLIDING ROOF
SLIDING ROOF INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL CABLE GUIDE CASING ASSEMBLY
(a) Apply adhesive tape to protect the body.
(b) Push the cable guide casing assembly rearwards to
remove it.
(c) Install 11 screws.
2. INSTALL WIND DEFLECTOR PANEL
Install the panel with 4 screws.
3. ADJUST DRIVE RAIL
HINT: Adjust the drive rail to a closed and tilted down
position.
Using a screwdriver, slide the link forwards or rear–
wards to align the 2 marks as shown.
BO–106
BODY
–
SLIDING ROOF
4. INSTALL ROOF DRIP CHANNEL
(a) Push the channel rearwards to install it.
(b) Install 2 screws.
5. INSTALL FRONT AND REAR GARNISH
Tap the garnishes to install it.
6. INSTALL SLIDING ROOF GLASS
Install the glass and the shims with 6 nuts.
7. INSTALL DRIVE GEAR
(a) Remove the screw and cam plate cover.
(b) Remove the large screw, washers and shims.
(c) Turn the drive shaft by screwdriver to align the hous–
ing and gear point mark as shown.
(d) Install the cam plate cover with the screw.
(e) Apply adhesive to 2 gear side bolts.
Part No.08833–00070, THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
(f) Install the drive gear with 3 bolts.
Torque: 5.4 N–m (55 kgf–cm, 48 in.–lbf)
(g) Connect the connectors.
BO–107
BODY
–
SLIDING ROOF
8. INSTALL SLIDING ROOF CONTROL RELAY
(a) Install the relay with the bolt.
(6) Connect the connector.
9. INSTALL FRONT SIDE OF ROOF HEADLINING
Connect the front side of roof headlining to the front
side of housing.
10. INSTALL SLIDING ROOF SWITCH
(a) Install the switch with 2 screws, then connect the
connectors.
(b) Install the cover.
11. INSPECT AND ADJUST SLIDING ROOF
(See pages BO–98 to 100)
12. INSTALL SIDE GARNISH
Tap the garnishes to install it.
13. INSTALL FOLLOWING PARTS:
(a) Front pillar garnish
(b) Front assist grip
(c) Sunvisors and holders
(d) Inner rear view mirror
14. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE TO
BATTERY
BO–108
BODY
–
INSTRUMENT PANEL
INSTRUMENT PANEL
COMPONENTS
BO–109
BODY
–
INSTRUMENT PANEL
COMPONENTS (Cont’d)
BO–110
BODY
–
INSTRUMENT PANEL
HINT: Screw sizes in the illustration on the previous
page are indicated using the code below for removal
and installation of instrument panel.
INSTRUMENT PANEL REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT BATTERY CABLE FROM NEGATIVE
TERMINAL
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH
(a) Sedan, Wagon: Remove the clips by your hand.
BO–111
BODY
–
INSTRUMENT PANEL
(b) Sedan, Wagon: Pull the garnish rearwards to remove
it.
(e) Coupe: Rear side garnish must ba removed before
front piller garnish.
3. REMOVE FRONT DOOR INSIDE SCUFF PLATE
Remove the scuff plate by pulling.
4. REMOVE FRONT DOOR OPENING COVER
Remove the cover by pulling.
5. REMOVE HOOD LOCK RELEASE LEVER
(a) Remove 2 screws.
(b) Slide the lever forwards to remove it.
BO–112
BODY
–
INSTRUMENT PANEL
6. REMOVE COWL SIDE TRIM
(a) Remove the clip.
(b) Remove the trim by pulling.
7. REMOVE STEERING WHEEL
(See page SR–5)
8. REMOVE STEERING COLUMN COVER
Remove 5 screws and the covers.
9. REMOVE CONSOLE UPPER PANEL
Using a screwdriver, remove the panel then discon–
nect the connector.
HINT: Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
10. REMOVE REAR CONSOLE BOX
Remove 2 bolts, 2 screws and the box.
11. REMOVE COIN BOX
(a) Press on the sides of the box while pulling the box
outwards.
(b) Remove the box.
BO–113
BODY
–
INSTRUMENT PANEL
12. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL LOWER PAD
(a) Remove 2 screws and the coin box bezel.
(b) Remove 4 bolts, the screw and the lower pad.
13. REMOVE COMBINATION SWITCH
(a) Disconnect the connectors.
(b) Remove 4 screws and the combination switch.
14. REMOVE UNDER COVER NO. 2
Remove the under cover No.2 by pulling.
15. REMOVE INSTRUMENT LOWER PANEL
(a) Remove 2 screws.
(b) Remove the lower panel by pulling.
16. REMOVE FRONT CONSOLE BOX
(a) Remove 2 clips.
(b) Remove 2 screws and the box.
BO–114
BODY
–
INSTRUMENT PANEL
17. REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR
Remove 3 nuts and the door.
18. REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT
HINT: Tape a screwdriver tip before use.
(a) Remove the glove compartment door finish plate
inside the instrument panel box.
NOTICE: When handling the airbag connector, take care
not to damage the airbag wire harness.
(b) Pull up and disconnect the airbag connector.
(c) Remove 5 screws.
(d) Remove the compartment by pulling.
19. REMOVE CENTER CLUSTER FINISH PANEL
Using a screwdriver, remove the panel then discon–
nect the connectors.
HINT: Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
20. REMOVE CLUSTER FINISH PANEL
(a) Remove 4 screws.
(b) Using a screwdriver remove the panel.
HINT: Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(c) Disconnect the connectors.
BO–115
BODY
–
INSTRUMENT PANEL
21. REMOVE REGISTER NO. 1 AND NO. 2
(a) Remove 2 screws and the register No.1.
(b) Remove 2 screws and the register No.2.
22. REMOVE RADIO
Remove 4 bolts and the radio, then disconnect the
connectors.
23. REMOVE COMBINATION METER
Remove 4 screws and the meter, then disconnect the
connectors.
24. REMOVE HEATER CONTROL
(a) Pull of the heater control knobs.
(b) Remove 5 screws and hang the heater control.
(c) Disconnect the air mix damper control cable.
(d) Remove the heater control.
BO–116
BODY
–
INSTRUMENT PANEL
25. REMOVE DUCT HEATER TO REGISTER NO. 2
Remove the clip and the register No.2.
26. REMOVE FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the LH side installation bolt.
(b) Remove 5 bolts and 2 clips.
CAUTION:
• Do not store the front passenger airbag assembly
with the airbag door facing down.
• Never disassemble the front passenger airbag as–
sembly.
27. REMOVE SIDE DEFROSTER NOZZLE NO. 2
Using a screwdriver, remove the nozzle No.2.
HINT: Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
28. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL
(a) Disconnect the connectors.
(b) Remove the bolt.
(c) Remove the connector holder.
BO–117
BODY
–
INSTRUMENT PANEL
(d) Disconnect the connectors.
(e) Remove the bolt.
(f) Remove the connector holder.
(g) Disconnect the connector.
(h) Remove the bolt.
(i) Remove 8 bolts, 2 nuts and the instrument panel.
(j) Remove the duct heater to register No.4 and No.5.
BO–118
BODY
–
INSTRUMENT PANEL
29. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL REINFORCEMENT
Remove the parts as shown below.
INSTRUMENT PANEL DISASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE FOLLOWING PARTS FROM INSTRUMENT
PANEL
(a) Duct heater to register No.1
(b) Duct heater to register No.3
(c) Defroster nozzle
(d) Register No.3
(e) Center bracket
(f) Mounting bracket No.1
(g) Safety Pad Sub–Assembly
(h) Side Defroster nozzle No.1
(i) Lower finish panel
2. REMOVE LOWER MOUNTING BRACKET NO. 1
Remove 2 bolts and the bracket No.1.
3. REMOVE LOWER MOUNTING BRACKET NO. 2
Remove 2 bolts and the bracket No.2.
4. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
Remove 5 screws, the clip and the wire.
BO–119
BODY
–
INSTRUMENT PANEL
INSTRUMENT PANEL ASSEMBLY
ASSEMBLE INSTRUMENT PANEL PARTS BY FOLLOW–
ING DISASSEMBLY SEQUENCE IN REVERSE
INSTRUMENT PANEL INSTALLATION
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL PARTS BY FOLLOWING
REMOVAL SEQUENCE IN REVERSE
TORQUE FOLLOWING BOLTS:
Front passenger airbag assembly (See page RS–34)
To instrument panel reinforcement
Torque: 20 N–m (210 kgf–cm, 15 ft–lbf)
To instrument panel
Torque: 8.0 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–lbt)
NOTICE: The 2 bolts to the instrument panel have been
anti–rust treated. When the front passenger airbag as–
sembly is removed, always replace the bolts with now
ones.
BO–120
BODY
–
SEAT
SEAT
COMPONENTS
BO–121
BODY
–
SEAT
COMPONENTS (Cont’d)
BO–122
BODY
–
SEAT
COMPONENTS (Cont’d)
BO–123
BODY
–
SEAT
COMPONENTS (Cont’d)
BO–124
BODY
–
SEAT
COMPONENTS (Cont’d)
BO–125
BODY
–
SEAT
COMPONENTS (Cont’d)
BO–126
BODY
–
SEAT
COMPONENTS (Cont’d)
BO–127
BODY
–
SEAT BELT
SEAT BELT
COMPONENTS
BO–128
BODY
–
SEAT BELT
COMPONENTS (Cont’d)
BO–129
BODY
–
SEAT BELT
COMPONENTS (Cont’d)
BO–130
BODY
–
SEAT BELT
COMPONENTS (Cont’d)
BO–131
BODY
–
SEAT BELT
COMPONENTS (Cont’d)
BO–132
BODY
–
SEAT BELT
COMPONENTS (Cont’d)
BO–133
BODY
–
SEAT BELT
SEAT BELT INSPECTION
Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR) and
Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) type
1. RUNNING TEST (INN SAFE AREA)
for all seat:
(a) Fasten the front seat belts.
(b) Drive the car at 10 mph (16 km/h) and make a very
hard stop.
(c) Check that the belt is locked and cannot be extended
at this time.
HINT: Conduct this test in a safe area. If the belt does
not lock, remove the belt mechanism assembly and
conduct the following static check. Also, whenever
installing a new belt assembly, verify the proper oper–
ation before installation.
2. STATIC TEST
for driver’s seat (ELR):
(a) Verify that the belt locks when pulled out quickly.
(b) Remove the locking retractor assembly.
(c) Tilt the retractor slowly.
(d) Verify that the belt can be pulled out at a tilt of 15
degrees or less, and cannot be pulled out over 45
degrees of tilt.
If a problem is found, replace the assembly.
except for driver’s seat (ALR/ ELR):
(a) Verify that the belt locks when pulled out quickly.
(b) Remove the locking retractor assembly.
(c) Pull out the whole belt and measure the length of the
whole belt.
Then retract the belt slightly and pull it out again.
(d) Verify that the belt cannot be extended further.
If a problem is found, replace the assembly.
(e) Retract the whole belt, then pull out the belt until 200
mm (7.87 in.) of belt remains retracted.
(f) Tilt the retractor slowly.
(g) Verify that the belt can be pulled out at a tilt of 15
degrees or less, and cannot be pulled out at over 45
degrees of tilt.
If a problem is found, replace the assembly.
BO–134
BODY
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part tightened
FRONT BUMPER
Front bumper arm x Body
Front bumper reinforcement x Front bumper arm
Reinforcement extension x Body
REAR BUMPER
Rear bumper arm x Body
Rear bumper reinforcement x Rear bumper arm
Rear bumper cover x Body
HOOD.
Hood hinge x Hood
Hood Lock x Body
FRONT DOOR AND REAR DOOR
Door lock x Door panel
Window regulator x Door inside panel frame
Window regulator x Door panel
BACK DOOR
Back door hinge x Body
Back door hinge x Back door
Back door lock x Back door
Back door damper stay x Body
Back door damper stay x Back door
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT
Luggage compartment door hinge x Luggage compartment door
WIPER AND WASHER
Wiper arm x Wiper link
Wiper arm x Wiper pivot
Wiper pivot x Back door
SLIDING ROOF
Drive gear x Body
SEAT
Front Seat
Seat truck x Body
Rear Seat
Seat back x Body
Seat back x Seat hinge
Seat hinge x Body
Second Seat
Rear side seatback x Body
Seat back x Seatback hinge
Seatback hinge x Body
Seat cushion hinge x Body
Third Seat
Seatback link x Bracket
BO–135
BODY
Bracket x Body
SEAT BELT
Front Seat Belt
Shoulder anchor x Adjustable anchor
Outer belt anchor x Body
ELR x Body
Adjustable anchor x Body
Inner belt x Seat
Rear Seat Belt
Shoulder anchor x Body
Outer belt anchor x Body
ELR x Body
Inner belt x Body
Center belt x Body
(CANADA) CRS, tether anchor x Body
Second Seat Belt
Shoulder anchor x Body
Outer belt anchor x Body
ELR x Body
Inner belt x Body
Center belt x Body
(CANADA) CRS, tether anchor x Body
Third Seat Belt
Shoulder anchor x Body
Outer belt anchor x Body
ELR x Body
Inner belt x Body
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
BR–1
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
BRAKE SYSTEM
BR–2
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
1. Care must be taken to replace each part properly as it could affect the performance of the
brake system and result in a driving hazard. Replace the parts with parts of the same part
number or equivalent.
2. It is very important to keep parts and the area clean when repairing the brake system.
3. If the vehicle is equipped with a mobile communication system, refer to the precautions in the
IN section.
DESCRIPTION
The service brakes consist of a foot brake which changes rotational energy to thermal energy to
stop the vehicle while it is being driven and a parking brake to keep the vehicle from moving while
it is parked.
BR–3
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
OPERATION
OPERATION
FOOT BRAKE
when the brake pedal is depressed, a vacuum builds up in the booster which amplifies the pedal
force, pressing on the piston in the master cylinder. The piston movement raises the hydraulic
pressure in the cylinder. This hydraulic pressure is then applied to each front caliper and rear
wheel cylinder (or rear caliper), and acts to press the front brake pads and rear brake shoes (or
rear brake pads) against the rotating drums (or discs). The resulting friction converts the
rotational energy to thermal energy, stopping the vehicle.
BR–4
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
OPERATION
PARKING BRAKE
Rear Drum Brake:
When the parking brake lever is pulled, the parking brake shoe lever is pulled via the parking brake
wire. This causes the adjuster to push the front shoe, which expands and is pressed against the
brake drum. If the parking brake lever continues to be pulled, the contact point of the parking
brake shoe lever and adjuster then becomes the fulcrum so that the parking brake shoe lever
causes the rear shoe to expand. This results in the brake drum being locked by the front shoe and
rear shoe.
PARKING BRAKE
Rear Disc Brake:
When the parking brake lever is pulled or pedal is depressed, the parking brake shoe lever is
pulled via the parking brake wire. This causes the shoe strut to push the front shoe, which
expands and is pressed against the disc. If the parking brake lever or pedal continues to be pulled
or depressed, the contact point of the parking brake shoe lever and shoe strut then becomes the
fulcrum so that the parking brake shoe lever causes the rear shoe to expand. This results in the
disc being locked by the front shoe and rear shoe.
BR–5
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
PREPARATION
PREPARATION
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
09023–00100 Union Nut Wrench 10 mm
09703–30010 Brake Shoe Return Spring Tool
09709–29017
LSPV Gauge Set
09718–00010 Shoe Hold Down Spring Driver
09737–00010 Brake Booster Push Rod Gauge
09751–36011 Brake Tube Union Nut 10 x 12 mm
Wrench
09843–18020 Diagnosis Check Wire
09990–00150 A6S Actuator Checker and
Sub–harness
TMC made vehicle
(NIPPONDENSO ABS)
09990–00163 ABS Actuator Checker Sheet ’A’
TMC made vehicle
(NIPPONDENSO ABS)
09990–00200 ABS Actuator Checker Sub–harness
“C”
TMC made vehicle
(NIPPONDENSO ABS)
09990–00210 ABS Actuator Checker Sub–harness
“E”
TMC made vehicle
(NIPPONDENSO ABS)
BR–6
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082–00050 TOYOTA Electrical Tester Set
09905–00013 Snap Ring Pliers
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
Micrometer
Brake disc
Dial indicator
Brake disc
Vernier calipers
Brake drum and disc
LUBRICANT
Item
Brake fluid
Capacity
Classification
SAE J 1703 or FMVSS No. 116 DOT3
Low pedal or spongy pedal
Brake drag
Brake pull
Hard pedal but brake inefficient
Noise from brakes
Part Name
(Trouble)
Hold–down spring (Damaged)
Anti–squeal shim (Damaged)
Pad or lining (Hardened)
Pad or lining (Dirty)
Rotor (Scored)
Sliding pin (Worn)
Installation bolt (Loose)
Pad support plate (Loose)
Booster system (Vacuum leaks)
Piston (Frozen)
Pad or lining (oily)
Piston (Stuck)
Pad or lining (Cracked or distorted)
Anchor or return spring (Faulty)
Booster push rod (Out of adjustment)
BR–37
BR–21,29,44
BR–21,29,37,44
BR–21,29,37,44
BR–21,29,44
BR21, 29, 44
BR–21,29,37,44
BR–21,29,44
BR–9
BR–21,29,37,44
BR–21,29,37,44
BR–21,29,37,44
BR–21,29,37,44
BR–37
BR–17
BR–10,11
Parking brake (Lever or pedal travel out of adjustment)
–
Parking brake wire (Sticking)
BR–37,44
BR–12
BR–8
BR–21,29,44
BR–21,29,37,44
Rear brake (Shoe clearance out of adjustment)
Master cylinder (Faulty)
Brake pedal (Freeplay minimal)
Piston seal (Worn or damaged)
See page
Brake pad or lining (Worn)
Brake system (Air in)
Brake system (Fluid leaks)
BRAKE SYSTEM
TROUBLESHOOTING
BR–7
TROUBLESHOOTING
!M19–0F
Use the table below to help you find the cause of the problem. The numbers indicate the priority
of the likely cause of the problem. Check each part in order. If necessary, replace these parts.
BR–8
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
CHECK AND ADJUSTMENT
CHECK AND ADJUSTMENT
BRAKE PEDAL CHECK AND ADJUSTMENT
1. CHECK THAT PEDAL HEIGHT IS CORRECT
Pedal height from asphalt sheet:
147.5–157.5 mm (5.81–6.20 fn.)
If the pedal height is incorrect, adjust it.
2. IF NECESSARY, ADJUST PEDAL HEIGHT
(a) Disconnect the connector from the stop light switch.
(b) Loosen the stop light switch lock nut and remove the
stop light switch.
(c) Loosen the push rod lock nut.
(d) Adjust the pedal height by turning the pedal push rod.
(e) Tighten the push rod lock nut.
Torque: 25 N–m (260 kgf–cm, 19 ft–lbf)
(f) Install the stop light switch and turn it until it lightly
contacts the pedal stopper.
(g) Turn the stop light switch back one turn.
(h) Check the clearance (A) between stop light switch and
pedal.
Clearance:
0.5–2.4 mm (0.02–0.09 in.)
(i) Tighten the stop light switch lock nut.
(j) Connect the connector to the stop light switch.
(k) Check that the stop lights come on when the brake
pedal is depressed, and go off when the brake pedal is
released.
(l) After adjusting the pedal height, check that pedal
freeplay.
HINT: If clearance (A) between the stop light switch
and the brake pedal stopper has been adjusted cor–
rectly, the pedal freeplay will meet the specifications.
3. CHECK THAT PEDAL FREEPLAY IS CORRECT
(a) Stop the engine and depress the brake pedal several
times until there is no more vacuum left in the boost–
er.
(b) Push in the pedal by hand until the beginning of the
resistance is felt, then measure the distance.
Pedal freeplay:
1–6 mm (0.04–0.24 in.)
HINT: The freeplay to the 1st point of resistance is
due to the play between the clevis and pin. It is 1–3
mm (0.04–0.12 in.) on the pedal.
If incorrect, check the stop light switch clearance.
And if the clearance is OK, then troubleshoot the
brake system.
BR–9
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
CHECK AND ADJUSTMENT
4. CHECK THAT PEDAL RESERVE DISTANCE IS COR–
RECT
Release the parking brake.
With the engine running, depress the pedal and meas–
ure the pedal reserve distance.
Pedal reserve distance from asphalt sheet at 490 N
(50 kgf, 110.2 lbf):
More than 70 mm (2.76 in.)
If the reserve distance is incorrect, troubleshoot the
brake system.
BRAKE BOOSTER OPERATIONAL TEST
1. OPERATING CHECK
(a) Depress the brake pedal several times with the engine
off and check that there is no change in the pedal
reserve distance.
(b) Depress the brake pedal and start the engine. If the
pedal goes down slightly, operation is normal.
2. AIR TIGHTNESS CHECK
(a) Start the engine and stop it after 1 or 2 minutes.
Depress the brake pedal several times slowly. If the
pedal goes down farthest the 1 st time, but gradually
rises after the 2nd or 3rd time, the booster is air tight.
(b) Depress the brake pedal while the engine is running,
and stop the engine with the pedal depressed. If there
is no change in the pedal reverse travel after holding
the pedal for 30 seconds, the booster is air tight.
BRAKE SYSTEM BLEEDING
HINT: If any work is done on the brake system or if air
in the brake lines is suspected, bleed the system of air.
NOTICE: Do not let brake fluid remain on a painted sur–
face. Wash it off immediately.
1. FILL BRAKE RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID
Fluid: SAE J1703 or FMVSS No. 116 DOT3
2. BLEED MASTER CYLINDER
HINT: If the master cylinder has been disassembled or
if the reservoir becomes empty, bleed the air from the
master cylinder.
(a) Disconnect the brake lines from the master cylinder.
(b) Slowly depress the brake pedal and hold it.
BR–10
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
CHECK AND ADJUSTMENT
(c) Block off the outer holes with your fingers, and re–
lease the brake pedal.
(d) Repeat (b) and (c) 3 or 4 times.
3. BLEED BRAKE LINE
(a) Connect the vinyl tube to the brake caliper.
(b) Depress the brake pedal several times, then loosen
the bleeder plug with the pedal held down.
(c) At the point when fluid stops coming out, tighten the
bleeder plug, then release the brake pedal.
(d) Repeat (b) and (c) until all the air in the fluid has been
bled out.
(e) Repeat the above procedure to bleed the air out of the
brake line for each wheel.
4. CHECK FLUID LEVEL IN RESERVOIR
Check the fluid level and add fluid if necessary.
Fluid: SAE J1703 or FMVSS No.116 DOT3
LEVER TYPE PARKING BRAKE CHECK
AND ADJUSTMENT
1. CHECK THAT PARKING BRAKE LEVER TRAVEL IS
CORRECT
Pull the parking brake lever all the way up, and count
the number of clicks.
Parking brake lever travel at 196 N (20 kgf, 44 lbf):
5–8 clicks
If incorrect, adjust the parking brake.
2. IF NECESSARY, ADJUST PARKING BRAKE LEVER
TRAVEL
HINT: Before adjusting the parking brake, make sure
that the rear brake shoe clearance has been adjusted.
For shoe clearance adjustment, see step 9 on page BR–43 or
step 8 on page BR–58.
(a) Remove the rear console box.
(b) Loosen the lock nut and turn the adjusting nut until
the lever travel is correct.
BR–11
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
CHECK AND ADJUSTMENT
(c) Tighten the lock nut.
Torque: 5.4 N–m (55 kgf–cm. 48 in.¿lbf)
(d) Install the rear console box.
PEDAL TYPE PARKING BRAKE CHECK
AND ADJUSTMENT
1. CHECK THAT PARKING BRAKE PEDAL TRAVEL IS
CORRECT
Slowly depress the parking brake pedal all the way,
and count the number of clicks.
Parking brake pedal travel at 294 N (30 kgf,66 lbf):
3–6 clicks
If incorrect, adjust the parking brake.
2. IF NECESSARY, ADJUST PARKING BRAKE PEDAL
TRAVEL
HINT: Before adjusting the parking brake, make sure
that the rear brake shoe clearance has been adjusted.
For shoe clearance adjustment, see step 8 on page BR
–58.
(a) Remove the hole cover.
(b) Loosen the lock nut and turn the adjusting nut until
the lever travel is correct.
(c) Tighten the lock nut.
Torque: 13 N–m (130 kgf–cm, 9 ft–lbf)
(d) Install the hole cover.
BR–12
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
MASTER CYLINDER
MASTER CYLINDER
MASTER CYLINDER REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT LEVEL WARNING SWITCH CONNEC
– TOR
2. TAKE OUT FLUID WITH SYRINGE
NOTICE: Do not let brake fluid remain on a painted sur–
face. Wash it off immediately.
3. DISCONNECT BRAKE LINES
Using SST, disconnect the brake lines from the master
cylinder.
SST 09023–00100
4. REMOVE MASTER CYLINDER
Remove the mounting nuts and pull out the master
cylinder and gasket.
BR–13
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
MASTER CYLINDER
COMPONENTS
BR–14
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
MASTER CYLINDER
MASTER CYLINDER DISASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE MASTER CYLINDER BOOT
Using a screwdriver, remove the master cylinder boot.
2. REMOVE RESERVOIR
(a) Remove the set screw and pull out the reservoir.
(b) Remove the cap and strainer from the reservoir.
3. REMOVE 2 GROMMETS
4. PLACE CYLINDER IN VISE
5. REMOVE PISTON STOPPER BOLT
Using a screwdriver, push the pistons in all the way
and remove the piston stopper bolt and gasket.
HINT: Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
6. REMOVE 2 PISTONS AND SPRINGS
(a) Push in the piston with a screwdriver and remove the
snap ring with snap ring pliers.
(b) Remove the No.1 piston and spring by hand, pulling
straight out, not at an angle.
NOTICE: If pulled out at an angle, there is a possibility
that the cylinder bore could be damaged.
(c) Place a rag and 2 wooden blocks on the work table
and lightly tap the cylinder flange against the blocks
until the piston drops out of the cylinder.
HINT: Make sure the distance (A) from the rag to the
top of the blocks is at least 100 mm (3.94 in.).
BR–15
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
MASTER CYLINDER
MASTER CYLINDER INSPECTION
HINT: Clean the disassembled parts with compressed
air.
1. INSPECT CYLINDER BORE FOR RUST OR SCORING
2. INSPECT CYLINDER FOR WEAR OR DAMAGE
If necessary, clean or replace the cylinder.
MASTER CYLINDER ASSEMBLY
1. APPLY LITHIUM SOAP BASE GLYCOL GREASE TO
RUBBER PARTS INDICATED BY ARROWS
2. INSTALL 2 SPRINGS AND PISTONS
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the rubber lips on the
pistons.
(a) Install the 2 springs and pistons straight in, not at an
angle.
NOTICE: If install at an angle, there is a possibility of
damaging the cylinder bore.
(b) Push in the piston with a screwdriver and install the
snap ring with snap ring pliers.
HINT: Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
3. INSTALL PISTON STOPPER BOLT
Using a screwdriver, push the piston in all the way and
install the piston stopper bolt over a new gasket.
Torque the bolt.
Torque: 10 N .m (100 kgf–cm, 7 ft–lbf)
BR–16
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
MASTER CYLINDER
4. INSTALL 2 GROMMETS
5. INSTALL RESERVOIR
(a) Install the strainer and cap to the reservoir.
(b) Push the reservoir onto the cylinder.
(c) Install the set screw while pushing on the reservoir.
Torque: 1.7 N–m (17.5 kgf–cm, 15.2 in.–lbf)
6. INSTALL MASTER CYLINDER BOOT
Facing the UP mark on the master cylinder boot up–
wards, install the cylinder boot to the master cylinder.
MASTER CYLINDER INSTALLATION
1. ADJUST LENGTH OF BRAKE BOOSTER PUSH ROD
BEFORE INSTALLING MASTER CYLINDER
(See page BR–19)
2. INSTALL MASTER CYLINDER
Install the master cylinder and a new gasket on the
brake booster with 3 nuts.
Torque: 13 N–m (130 kgf–cm, 9 ft–lbf)
BR–17
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
MASTER CYLINDER
3. CONNECT 2 BRAKE LINES
Using SST, connect the brake lines to the master
cylinder_ Torque the union nuts.
SST 09023–00100
Torque: 15 N–m (155 kgf–cm, 11 ft–lbf)
4. CONNECT LEVEL WARNING SWITCH CONNECTOR
5. FILL BRAKE RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID AND
BLEED BRAKE SYSTEM
(See page BR–9)
6. CHECK FOR LEAKS
7. CHECK AND ADJUST BRAKE PEDAL
(See page BR–8)
BR–18
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
BRAKE BOOSTER
BRAKE BOOSTER
BRAKE BOOSTER REMOVAL
1. REMOVE MASTER CYLINDER
(See page BR–12)
2. PUSH DOWN CHARCOAL CANISTER
Loosen the clamp screw and push the charcoal canis–
ter down slightly.
BR–19
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
BRAKE BOOSTER
3. DISCONNECT VACUUM HOSE FROM BRAKE BOO–
STER
4. REMOVE PEDAL RETURN SPRING
5. REMOVE CLIP AND CLEVIS PIN
6. REMOVE BRAKE BOOSTER, GASKET AND CLEVIS
(a) Remove the 4 nuts and clevis.
(b) Pull out the brake booster and gasket.
BRAKE BOOSTER INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL BRAKE BOOSTER
(a) Install the booster and a new gasket.
(b) Install the clevis to the operating rod.
(c) Install and torque the booster installation nuts.
Torque: 13 N–m (130 kgf–cm, 9 ft–lbf)
(d) Install the clevis pin into the clevis and brake pedal,
and install the clip to the clevis pin.
(e) Install the pedal return spring.
2. ADJUST LENGTH OF BOOSTER PUSH ROD
(a) Install the gasket on the master cylinder.
(b) Set the SST on the gasket, and lower the pin until its
tip slightly touches the piston.
(c) Turn the SST upside down, and set it on the booster.
(d) Measure the clearance between the booster push rod
and pin head (SST).
Clearance:
0 mm (0 in.)
(e) Adjust the booster push rod length until the push rod
slightly touches the pin head.
3. INSTALL CHARCOAL CANISTER TO ORIGINAL PO–
SITION
4. INSTALL MASTER CYLINDER
5. CONNECT VACUUM HOSE TO BRAKE BOOSTER
6. FILL BRAKE RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID AND
BLEED BRAKE SYSTEM
(See page BR–9)
7. CHECK FOR LEAKS
BR–20
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
BRAKE BOOSTER
8. CHECK AND ADJUST BRAKE PEDAL
(See page BR–8)
Check and adjust the brake pedal, then tighten the
clevis lock nut.
Torque: 25 N–m (260 kgf–cm, 19 ft–lbf)
9. PERFORM OPERATIONAL CHECK
(See page BR–9)
BR–21
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
FRONT BRAKE(Single–Piston Type)
FRONT BRAKE
(Single–Piston Type)
COMPONENTS
BRAKE PADS REPLACEMENT
1. REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
Remove the wheel and temporarily fasten the disc
with hub nuts.
BR–22
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
FRONT BRAKE(Single–Piston Type)
2. INSPECT PAD LINING THICKNESS
Check the pad thickness through the caliper inspec–
tion hole and replace the pads if it is not within the
specification.
Minimum thickness:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
3. LIFT UP CALIPER
(a) Hold the sliding pin on the bottom and loosen the
installation bolt.
(b) Remove the installation bolt.
(c) Lift up the caliper and suspend the caliper with string.
HINT: Do not disconnect the flexible hose from the
caliper.
4. REMOVE FOLLOWING PARTS:
(a) 2 anti–squeal springs
(b) 2 brake pads
(c) 4 anti–squeal shims
(d) 1 MZ–FE engine:
Pad wear indicator
(e) 4 pad support plates
5. CHECK DISC THICKNESS AND RUNOUT
(See page BR–26)
BR–23
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
FRONT BRAKE(Single–Piston Type)
6. INSTALL PAD SUPPORT PLATES
Install the 4 pad support plates.
7. INSTALL NEW PADS
(a) 1 MZ–FE engine:
Install a pad wear indicator plate on the inside pad.
(b) Apply disc brake grease to both sides of the inner anti
–squeal shim.
(c) Install the 2 anti–squeal shims on each pad.
(d) install inside pad with the pad wear indicator plate
facing upward.
(e) Install outside pad.
NOTICE: There should be no oil or grease adhering to the
friction surfaces of the pads or the disc.
(f) Install the 2 anti–squeal springs.
8. INSTALL CALIPER
(a) Draw out a small amount of brake fluid from the
reservoir.
(b) Press in the piston with water pump pliers or similar
implement.
HINT: If the piston is difficult to push in, loosen the
bleeder plug and push in the piston while letting some
brake fluid escape.
BR–24
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
FRONT BRAKE(Single–Piston Type)
(c) Install the caliper.
(d) Hold the sliding pin and torque the installation bolt.
Torque: 34 N–m (350 kgf–cm, 25 ft–lbf)
9. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
10. CHECK THAT FLUID LEVEL IS AT MAX LINE
CALIPER REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT FLEXIBLE HOSE
(a) Remove the union bolt and 2 gaskets from the caliper,
then disconnect the flexible hose from the caliper.
(b) Use a container to catch the brake fluid as it drains
out.
2. REMOVE CALIPER
(a) Hold the sliding pin and loosen the 2 installation bolts.
(b) Remove the 2 installation bolts.
(c) Remove the caliper from the torque plate.
3. REMOVE 2 BRAKE PADS
Remove the inside and outside pads.
CALIPER DISASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE CYLINDER BOOT SET RING AND CYLIN–
DER BOOT
Using a screwdriver, remove the cylinder boot set ring
and cylinder boot from the caliper.
BR–25
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
FRONT BRAKE(Single–Piston Type)
2. REMOVE PISTON
(a) Place a piece of cloth or similar article between the
piston and the caliper.
(b) Use compressed air to remove the piston from the
cylinder.
CAUTION: Do not place your fingers in front of the piston
when using compressed sir.
3. REMOVE PISTON SEAL
Using a screwdriver, remove the piston seal from the
cylinder.
4. REMOVE SLIDING PINS AND DUST BOOTS
(a) Remove the 2 sliding pins from the torque plate.
(b) Using a screwdriver and hammer, tap out the 2 dust
boots.
BR–26
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
FRONT BRAKE(Single–Piston Type)
FRONT BRAKE COMPONENTS
INSPECTION AND REPAIR
1. MEASURE PAD LINING THICKNESS
Using a ruler, measure the pad lining thickness.
Standard thickness:
5S–FE engine
12.0 mm (0.472 In.)
1 MZ–FE engine
11.0 mm (0.433 in.)
Minimum thickness:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Replace the pad if the pad’s thickness is at the mini–
mum thickness or less, or if the pad has excessively
uneven wear.
2. MEASURE DISC THICKNESS
Using a micrometer, measure the disc thickness.
Standard thickness:
28.0 mm (1.102 in.)
Minimum thickness:
26.0 mm (1.024 in.)
Replace the disc if the disc’s thickness is at the mini–
mum thickness or less. Replace the disc or grind it on
a lathe if it is badly scored or worn unevenly.
3. MEASURE DISC RUNOUT
Measure disc runout 10 mm (0.39 in.) from the outer
edge of the disc.
Maximum disc runout:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If runout is greater than maximum, attempt to adjust
to below this maximum figure.
HINT: Before measuring the runout, confirm that the
front bearing play is within specification.
4. IF NECESSARY, ADJUST DISC RUNOUT
(a) Remove the torque plate from the knuckle.
(b) Remove the hub nuts and the disc. Reinstall the disc
1/5 of a turn round from its original position on the
hub. Install and torque the hub nuts.
Torque: 103 N–m (1,050 kgf–cm, 76 ft–lbf)
Remeasure the disc runout. Make a note of the runout
and the disc’s position on the hub.
BR–27
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
FRONT BRAKE(Single–Piston Type)
(c) Repeat (b) until the disc has been installed on the 3
remaining hub positions.
(d) If the minimum runout recorded in (b) and (c) is less
than 0.05 mm (0.0020in.), install the disc in that
position.
(e) If the minimum runout recorded in (b) and (c) is greater
than 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.), replace the disc and repeat
step 3.
(f) Install the torque plate and torque the mounting bolts.
Torque: 107 N–m (1,090 kgf–cm, 79 ft–lbf)
CALIPER ASSEMBLY
1. APPLY LITHIUM SOAP BASE GLYCOL GREASE TO
PARTS INDICATED WITH ARROWS
2. INSTALL DUST BOOTS AND SLIDING PINS
(a) Using a 19 mm socket wrench and hammer, tap in 2
new dust boots into the torque plate.
(b) Confirm that the metal plate portion of the dust boot
fits snugly in the torque plate.
(c). Insert 2 sliding pins into the torque plate.
NOTICE: Insert the sliding pin with sliding bushing into
the bottom side.
3. INSTALL PISTON SEAL AND PISTON IN CYLINDER
BR–28
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
FRONT BRAKE(Single–Piston Type)
4. INSTALL CYLINDER BOOT AND CYLINDER BOOT
SET RING
CALIPER INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL 2 BRAKE PADS
Install the inside and outside pads.
2. INSTALL CALIPER
(a) Temporarily install the caliper on the torque plate with
the 2 installation bolts.
(b) Hold the sliding pin and torque the installation bolt.
Torque: 34 N–m (350 kgf–cm, 25 ft–lbf)
3. CONNECT FLEXIBLE HOSE
Install the flexible hose on the caliper with 2 new
gaskets.
Torque: 29 N–m (300 kgf–cm, 21 ft–lbf)
HINT: Install the flexible hose lock securely in the lock
hole in the caliper.
4. FILL BRAKE RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID AND
BLEED BRAKE SYSTEM
(See page BR–9)
5. CHECK FOR LEAKS
BR–29
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
FRONT BRAKE(2–Piston Type)
FRONT BRAKE
(2–Piston Type)
COMPONENTS
BRAKE PADS REPLACEMENT
1. REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
Remove the wheel and temporarily fasten the disc
with the hub nuts.
BR–30
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
FRONT BRAKE(2–Piston Type)
2. INSPECT PAD LINING THICKNESS
Check the pad thickness through the caliper inspec–
tion hole and replace the pads if it is not within the
specification.
Minimum thickness:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
3. LIFT UP CALIPER
(a) Hold the sliding pin on the bottom and loosen the
installation bolt.
(b) Remove the installation bolt.
(c) Lift up and suspend the caliper.
HINT: Do not disconnect the flexible hose from the
brake caliper.
4. REMOVE FOLLOWING PARTS:
(a) 2 anti–squeal springs
(b) 2 brake pads
(c) 4 anti–squeal shims
(d) 4 pad support plates
(e) Pad wear indicator
5. CHECK DISC THICKNESS AND RUNOUT
(See page BR–33)
6. INSTALL PAD SUPPORT PLATES
Install the 4 pad support plates.
BR–31
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
FRONT BRAKE(2–Piston Type)
7. INSTALL NEW PADS
(a) Install the pad wear indicator plate on the pad.
(b) Apply disc brake grease to both sides of the inner
anti–squeal shim.
(c) Install the 2 anti–squeal shims on each pad.
(d) Install the inner pad with the pad wear indicator plates
facing upward.
(e) Install the outer pad.
NOTICE: There should be no oil or grease adhering to the
friction surface’s of the pads or the disc.
(f) Install the 2 anti–squeal springs.
8. INSTALL CALIPER
(a) Draw out a small amount of brake fluid from the
reservoir.
(b) Press in the piston with a hammer handle or similar
implement.
HINT: If the piston is difficult to push in, loosen the
bleeder plug and push in the piston while letting some
brake fluid escape.
(c) Install the caliper.
(d) Hold the sliding pin and torque the installation bolt.
Torque: 34 N .m (350 kgf–cm, 25 ft–lbf)
9. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
10. CHECK THAT FLUID LEVEL IS AT MAX LINE
CALIPER REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT FLEXIBLE HOSE
(a) Remove the union bolt and 2 gaskets from the caliper,
then disconnect the flexible hose from the caliper.
(b) Use a container to catch the brake fluid as it drains
out.
BR–32
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
FRONT BRAKE(2–Piston Type)
2. REMOVE CALIPER
(a) Hold the sliding pin and loosen the 2 installation bolts.
(b) Remove the 2 installation bolts.
(c) Remove the caliper from the torque plate.
3. REMOVE FOLLOWING PARTS:
(a) 2 anti–squeal springs
(b) 2 brake pads with anti–squeal shims
(c) 4 pad support plates
CALIPER DISASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE CYLINDER BOOT SET RINGS AND CYLIN–
DER BOOTS
Using a screwdriver, remove the 2 cylinder boot set
rings and cylinder boots from the caliper.
2. REMOVE PISTONS
(a) Place a piece of cloth or similar article between the
piston and caliper.
(b) Use compressed air to remove the pistons from the
cylinder.
CAUTION: Do not place your fingers in front of the piston
when using compressed air.
3. REMOVE PISTON SEALS
Using a screwdriver, remove the 2 piston seals from
the cylinder.
BR–33
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
FRONT BRAKE(2–Piston Type)
4. REMOVE SLIDING PINS AND DUST BOOTS
(a) Remove the 2 sliding pins from the torque plate.
(b) Using a screwdriver and hammer, tap out the 2 dust
boots.
FRONT BRAKE COMPONENTS
INSPECTION AND REPAIR
1. MEASURE PAD LINING THICKNESS
Using a ruler, measure the pad lining thickness.
Standard thickness:
11.0 mm (0.433 in.)
Minimum thickness:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Replace the pad if the pad’s thickness is at the mini–
mum thickness or less, or if the pad has excessively
uneven wear.
2. MEASURE DISC THICKNESS
Using a micrometer, measure the disc thickness.
Standard thickness:
28 mm (1.102 in.)
Minimum thickness:
26 mm (1.024 in.)
Replace the disc if the disc’s thickness is at the mini–
mum thickness or less. Replace the disc or grind it on
a lathe if it is badly scored or worn unevenly.
3. MEASURE DISC RUNOUT
Measure disc runout 10 mm (0.39 in.) from the outer
edge of the disc.
Maximum disc runout:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If runout is greater than maximum, attempt to adjust
to below this maximum figure.
BR–34
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
FRONT BRAKE(2–Piston Type)
HINT: Before measuring the runout, confirm that the
front bearing play is within specification.
4. IF NECESSARY, ADJUST DISC RUNOUT
(a) Remove the torque plate from the knuckle.
(b) Remove the hub nuts and the disc. Reinstall the disc
1/5 of a turn round from its original position on the
hub. Install and torque the hub nuts.
Torque: 103 N–m (1,050¿¿f¿cm, 76 ft–lbf)
Remeasure the disc runout. Make a note of the runout
and disc’s position on the hub.
(c) Repeat (b) until the disc has been installed on the 3
remaining hub positions.
(d) If the minimum runout recorded in (b) and (c) is less
than 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.), install the disc in that
position.
(e) If the minimum runout recorded in (b) and (c) is greater
than 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.), replace the disc and repeat
step 3.
(f) Install the torque plate and torque the mounting bolts.
Torque: 107 N–m (1,090 kgf–cm, 79 ft–lbf)
CALIPER ASSEMBLY
1. APPLY LITHIUM SOAP BASE GLYCOL GREASE TO
PARTS INDICATED WITH ARROWS
BR–35
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
FRONT BRAKE(2–Piston Type)
2. INSTALL DUST BOOTS AND SLIDING PINS
(a) Using a 19 mm socket and a hammer, tap in 2 new
dust boots into the torque plate.
(b) Confirm that the metal plate portion of the dust boot
fits snugly in the torque plate.
(c) Insert 2 sliding pins into the torque plate.
NOTICE: Insert the sliding pin with sliding bushing into
the bottom side
3. INSTALL PISTON SEALS AND PISTONS IN CYLIN
– DER
4. INSTALL CYLINDER BOOTS AND CYLINDER BOOT
SET RINGS
CALIPER INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL FOLLOWING PARTS:
(a) 4 pad support plates
(b) 2 brake pads with anti–squeal shims
(c) 2 anti–squeal springs
BR–36
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
FRONT BRAKE(2–Piston Type)
2. INSTALL CALIPER
(a) Temporarily install the caliper on the torque plate with
the 2 installation bolts.
(b) Hold the sliding pin and torque the installation bolt.
Torque: 34 N–m (350 kgf–cm, 26 ft–lbf)
3. CONNECT FLEXIBLE HOSE
Install the flexible hose on the brake caliper with 2
new gaskets.
Torque: 29 N–m (300 kgf–cm, 21 ft–lbf)
HINT: Insert the flexible hose lock securely in the lock
hole in the brake caliper.
4. FILL BRAKE RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID AND
BLEED BRAKE SYSTEM
(See page BR–9)
5. CHECK FOR LEAKS
BR–37
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Drum Brake)
REAR BRAKE
(Drum Brake)
COMPONENTS
REAR DRUM BRAKE REMOVAL
1. INSPECT SHOE LINING THICKNESS
Remove the inspection hole plug, and check the shoe
lining thickness through the hole.
If less than minimum, replace the shoes.
Minimum thickness:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
2. REMOVE REAR WHEEL
3. REMOVE BRAKE DRUM
HINT: If the brake drum cannot be removed easily,
perform the following steps.
(a) Insert a bent wire or an equivalent through the hole in
the brake drum, and hold the automatic adjusting
lever away from the adjuster.
(b) Using a screwdriver, reduce the brake shoe adjust–
ment by turning the adjuster.
BR–38
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Drum Brake)
4. REMOVE FRONT SHOE
(a) Using SST, disconnect the return spring.
SST 09703–30010
(b) Using SST, remove the shoe hold–down spring, cups
and pin.
SST 09718–00010
(c) Disconnect the anchor spring from the front shoe and
remove the front shoe.
(d) Remove the anchor spring from the rear shoe.
5. REMOVE REAR SHOE
(a) Using SST, remove the shoe hold–down spring, cups
and pin.
SST 09718–00010
(b) Using a screwdriver, disconnect the parking brake
cable from the anchor plate.
(c) Using pliers, disconnect the parking brake cable from
the lever and remove the rear shoe together with the
adjuster.
6. REMOVE ADJUSTER FROM REAR SHOE
(a) Remove the adjusting lever spring.
(b) Remove the adjuster together with the return spring.
7. DISCONNECT BRAKE LINE FROM WHEEL CYLIN–
DER
Using SST, disconnect the brake line. Use a container
to catch the brake fluid.
SST 09751–36011
BR–39
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Drum Brake)
8. REMOVE WHEEL CYLINDER
Remove the 2 bolts and the wheel cylinder.
9. IF NECESSARY, DISASSEMBLE WHEEL CYLINDER
Remove the following parts from the wheel cylinder.
• 2 boots
• 2 pistons
• 2 piston cups
• Spring
REAR DRUM BRAKE COMPONENTS
INSPECTION AND REPAIR
1. INSPECT DISASSEMBLED PARTS
Inspect the disassembled parts for wear, rust or
damage.
2. MEASURE BRAKE SHOE LINING THICKNESS
Standard thickness:
5.0 mm (0.197 in.)
Minimum thickness:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
If the shoe lining is less than minimum or shows signs
of uneven wear, replace the brake shoes.
HINT: If any of the brake shoes have to be replaced,
replace all of the rear shoes in order to maintain even
braking.
3. MEASURE BRAKE DRUM INSIDE DIAMETER
Standard inside diameter:
228.6 mm (9.000 in.)
Maximum inside diameter:
230.6 mm (9.079 in.)
If the drum is scored or worn, the brake drum may be
lathed to the maximum inside diameter.
BR–40
•
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Drum Brake)
4. INSPECT REAR BRAKE LINING AND DRUM FOR
PROPER CONTACT
If the contact between the brake lining and drum is
improper, repair the lining with a brake shoe grinder,
or replace the brake shoe assembly.
REAR DRUM BRAKE INSTALLATION
HINT: Assemble the parts in the correct direction as
shown.
1. ASSEMBLE WHEEL CYLINDER
(a) Apply lithium soap base glycol grease to the cups and
pistons as shown.
(b) Assemble the wheel cylinder.
HINT: Install in proper direction only.
• Spring
• 2 cups
• 2 pistons
• 2 boots
2. INSTALL WHEEL CYLINDER
Install the wheel cylinder on the backing plate with the
2 bolts.
Torque: 10 N–m (100 kgf–cm, 7 ft–lbf)
BR–41
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Drum Brake)
3. CONNECT BRAKE LINE TO WHEEL CYLINDER
Using SST, connect the brake line.
SST 09751–36011
Torque: 15 N–m (155 kgf–cm, 11 ft–lbf)
4. APPLY HIGH TEMPERATURE GREASE TO BACK
– ING PLATE AND ADJUSTER
(a) Apply high temperature grease to the brake shoe
contact surfaces.
(b) Apply high temperature grease to the adjuster bolt
threads and ends.
5. INSTALL ADJUSTER ONTO REAR SHOE
Set the adjuster and return spring and install the
adjusting lever spring.
6. INSTALL REAR SHOE
(a) Using pliers, connect the parking brake cable to the
lever.
(b) Pass the parking brake cable through the notch in the
anchor plate.
(c) Set the rear shoe in place with the end of the shoe
inserted in the wheel cylinder and the other end in the
anchor plate.
BR–42
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Drum Brake)
(d) Using SST, install the shoe hold–down spring, cups
and pin.
SST 09718–00010
NOTICE: Do not allow oil or grease to get on the rubbing
face.
7. INSTALL FRONT SHOE
(a) Install the anchor spring between the front and rear
shoes.
(b) Set the front shoe in place with the end of the shoe
inserted in the wheel cylinder and the adjuster in
place.
(c) Using SST, install the shoe hold–down spring, cups
and pin.
SST 09 718–00010
NOTICE: Do not allow oil or grease to get on the rubbing
face.
(d) Using SST, connect the return spring.
SST 09703–30010
8. CHECK OPERATION OF AUTOMATIC ADJUSTING
MECHANISM
(a) Move the parking brake lever of the rear shoe back
and forth. Check that the adjuster turns.
If the adjuster does not turn, check for incorrect
installation of the rear brakes.
(b) Adjust the adjuster length to the shortest possible
amount.
BR–43
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Drum Brake)
(c) Align the adjusting hole on the brake drum and largest
hole on the axle carrier, install the brake drum.
(d) Pull the parking brake lever all the way up until a
clicking sound can no longer be heard.
9. CHECK CLEARANCE BETWEEN BRAKE SHOES
AND DRUM
(a) Remove the brake drum.
(b) Measure the brake drum inside diameter and diameter
of the brake shoes. Check that the difference between
the diameters is the correct shoe clearance.
Shoe clearance:
0.6 mm (0.024 in.)
If incorrect, check the parking brake system.
10. INSTALL BRAKE DRUM
11. INSTALL REAR WHEEL
12. FILL BRAKE RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID AND
BLEED BRAKE SYSTEM
(See page BR–9)
13. CHECK FOR LEAKS
BR–44
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Disc Brake)
REAR BRAKE
(Disc Brake)
COMPONENTS
BR–45
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Disc Brake)
BRAKE PADS REPLACEMENT
1. REMOVE REAR WHEEL
Remove the wheel and temporarily fasten the disc
with the hub nuts.
2. INSPECT PAD LINING THICKNESS
Check the pad thickness through the caliper inspec–
tion hole and replace pads if not within specification.
Minimum thickness:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
3. LIFT UP CALIPER
(a) Remove the flexible hose bracket.
(b) Remove the installation bolt from the torque plate.
(c) Lift up the caliper and suspend the caliper with string.
HINT: Do not disconnect the flexible hose from the
caliper.
BR–46
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Disc Brake)
4. REMOVE FOLLOWING PARTS:
(a) 2 brake pads
(b) 4 anti–squeal shims
(c) 4 pad support plates
5. CHECK DISC THICKNESS AND RUNOUT
(See page BR–50)
6. INSTALL PAD SUPPORT PLATES
Install the 4 pad support plates.
7. INSTALL NEW PADS
(a) Apply disc brake grease to both side of the inner anti
–squeal shims.
(b) Install the 2 anti–squeal shims on each pad.
(c) Install 2 pads with the pad wear indicator plates
facing up ward.
NOTICE: There should be no oil or grease adhering to the
friction surfaces of the pads or the disc.
6. INSTALL CALIPER
(a) Draw out a small amount of brake fluid from the
reservoir.
(b) Press in the piston with water pump pliers or similar
implement.
HINT: If the piston is difficult to push in, loosen the
bleeder plug and push in the piston while letting some
brake fluid escape.
BR–47
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Disc Brake)
(c) Install the caliper and torque the installation bolt.
Torque: 20 N–m (200 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
(d) Install the flexible hose bracket.
Torque: 29 N–m (300 kgf–cm, 22 ft–lbf)
9. INSTALL REAR WHEEL
14. CHECK THAT FLUID LEVEL IS AT MAX LINE
CALIPER REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT FLEXIBLE HOSE
(a) Remove the union bolt and 2 gaskets from the caliper,
then disconnect the flexible hose from the caliper.
(b) Use a container to catch the brake fluid as it drains
out.
2. REMOVE CALIPER
(a) Remove the installation bolt.
(b) Remove the caliper from the torque plate.
BR–48
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Disc Brake)
3. REMOVE 2 PADS
Remove the inside and outside pads.
4. REMOVE MAIN PIN
Loosen the. main pin installation bolt and remove the
main pin.
CALIPER DISASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE SLIDING BUSHING
Pull out the sliding bushing.
2. REMOVE MAIN PIN BOOT
Pull out the main pin boot.
3. REMOVE DUST BOOTS
(a) Place the caliper in vise.
(b) Using a screwdriver and hammer, tap out the 2 dust
boots.
BR–49
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Disc Brake)
4. REMOVE CYLINDER BOOT SET RING AND CYLIN–
DER BOOT
Using a screwdriver, remove the cylinder boot set ring
and cylinder boot from the cylinder.
5. REMOVE PISTON
(a) Place a piece of cloth or similar article between the
piston and the caliper.
(b) Use compressed air to remove the piston from the
cylinder.
CAUTION: Do not place your fingers in front of the piston
when using compressed air.
6. REMOVE PISTON SEAL
Using a screwdriver, remove the piston seal from the
cylinder.
REAR DISC BRAKE COMPONENTS
INSPECTION AND REPAIR
1. MEASURE PAD LINING THICKNESS
Using a ruler, measure the pad lining thickness.
Standard thickness:
10.0 mm (0.394 in.)
Minimum thickness:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Replace the pad if the pad’s thickness is at the mini–
mum thickness or less, or if the pad has excessively
uneven wear.
BR–50
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Disc Brake)
2. MEASURE DISC THICKNESS
Using a micrometer, measure the disc thickness.
Standard thickness:
10.0 mm (0.394 in.)
Minimum thickness:
9.0 mm (0.354 in.)
Replace the disc if the disc’s thickness is at the mini–
mum thickness or less. Replace the disc or grind it on
a lathe if it is badly scored or worn unevenly.
3. MEASURE DISC RUNOUT
Measure the disc runout 10 mm (0.39 in.) from the
outer edge of the disc.
Maximum disc runout:
0.15 mm (0.0059 in.)
If the runout is greater than the maximum, replace the
disc.
HINT: Before measuring the runout, confirm that the
hub bearing play is within specification.
4. IF NECESSARY, REPLACE DISC
(a) Remove the torque plate.
(b) Remove the hub nuts of the temporarily installed disc
and pull off the disc.
(c) Install a new disc and loosely install the hub nuts.
(d) Install the torque plate and tighten the mounting
bolts.
Torque: 47 N–m (475 kgf–cm, 34 ft–lbf)
CALIPER ASSEMBLY
1. APPLY LITHIUM SOAP BASE GLYCOL GREASE TO
PARTS INDICATED WITH ARROWS
2. INSTALL PISTON SEAL AND PISTON IN CYLINDER
BR–51
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Disc Brake)
3. INSTALL CYLINDER BOOT AND SET RING IN CYL–
INDER
4. INSTALL DUST BOOTS
(a) Place the caliper in vise.
(b) Using a 19 mm socket wrench and hammer, tap in 2
new dust boots into the torque plate.
(c) Confirm that the metal plate portion of the dust boot
fits snugly in the torque plate.
5. INSTALL MAIN PIN BOOT
6. INSTALL SLIDING BUSHING
CALIPER INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL MAIN PIN
Install the main pin and torque the main pin installa–
tion bolt.
Torque: 26 N–m (270 kgf–cm. 20 ft–lbf)
BR–52
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Disc Brake)
2. INSTALL 2 PADS
Install 2 pads with the pad wear indicator plate facing
upward.
NOTICE: There should be no oil or grease adhering to the
friction surfaces of the pads or the disc.
3. INSTALL CALIPER
Install the caliper and torque the installation bolt.
Torque: 20 N–m (200 k9f¿cm, 14 ft–lbf)
4. CONNECT FLEXIBLE HOSE
Install the flexible hose on the caliper with 2 new
gaskets.
Torque: 29 N–m (300 kgf–cm, 21 ft–Ibf)
HINT: Insert the flexible hose lock securely in the lock
hole in the caliper.
5. FILL BRAKE RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID AND
BLEED BRAKE SYSTEM
(See page BR–9)
6. CHECK FOR LEAKS
BR–53
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Parking Brake for Rear Disc Brake)
REAR BRAKE
(Parking Brake for Rear Disc Brake)
COMPONENTS
PARKING BRAKE DISASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2. REMOVE REAR DISC BRAKE ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 mounting bolts and remove the disc
brake assembly.
(b) Suspend the disc brake so the hose is not stretched.
3. REMOVE DISC
HINT: If the disc cannot be removed easily, turn the
shoe adjuster
BR–54
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Parking Brake for Rear Disc Brake)
4. REMOVE SHOE RETURN SPRINGS
Using needle–nose pliers, remove the shoe return
springs.
5. REMOVE FRONT SHOE, ADJUSTER AND TENSION
SPRING
(a) Slide out the front shoe and remove the shoe adjuster.
(b) Remove the shoe strut with the spring.
(c) Disconnect the tension spring and remove the front
shoe.
6. REMOVE REAR SHOE
(a) Slide out the rear shoe.
(b) Remove the tension spring from the rear shoe.
(c) Using needle–nose pliers, disconnect the parking
brake cable from the parking brake shoe lever.
(d) Remove the shoe hold–down spring cups, springs
and pins.
PARKING BRAKE COMPONENTS
INSPECTION AND REPAIR
1. INSPECT DISASSEMBLED PARTS
Inspect the disassembled parts for wear, rust or
damage.
BR–55
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Parking Brake for Rear Disc Brake)
2. MEASURE BRAKE SHOE LINING THICKNESS
Using a scale, measure the thickness of the shoe
lining.
Standard thickness:
2.0 mm (0.079 in.)
Minimum thickness:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
If the lining thickness is at the minimum thickness or
less, or if there is excessively uneven wear, replace
the brake shoe.
3. MEASURE DISC INSIDE DIAMETER
Using a vernier caliper, measure the inside diameter of
the disc.
Standard inside diameter:
170 mm (6.69 in.)
Maximum inside diameter:
171 mm (6.73 in.)
Replace the disc if the inside diameter is at the maxi–
mum value or more. Replace the disc or grind it with a
lathe if the disc is badly scored or worn unevenly.
4. INSPECT PARKING BRAKE LINING AND DISC FOR
PROPER CONTACT
Apply chalk to the inside surface of the disc, then
grind down the brake shoe lining to fit. If the contact
between the disc and the brake shoe lining is improp–
er, repair it using a brake shoe grinder or replace the
brake shoe assembly.
5. MEASURE CLEARANCE BETWEEN PARKING
BRAKE SHOE AND LEVER
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance.
Standard clearance:
Less than 0.35 mm (0.0138 in.)
If the clearance is not within the specification, replace
the shim with one of the correct size.
Shim Thickness
Shim Thickness
0.3 mm (0.012 in.)
0.9 mm (0.035 in.)
0.6 mm (0.024 in.)
BR–56
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Parking Brake for Rear Disc Brake)
6. IF NECESSARY, REPLACE SHIM
(a) Remove the parking brake lever, and install the cor–
rect size shim.
(b) Install the parking brake lever with a new C–washer.
(c) Remeasure the clearance.
PARKING BRAKE ASSEMBLY
HINT: Assemble the parts in the correct direction as
shown.
BR–57
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Parking Brake for Rear Disc Brake)
1. APPLY HIGH TEMPERATURE GREASE ON BACK–
ING PLATE
2. APPLY HIGH TEMPERATURE GREASE TO ADJUSTER
3. CONNECT PARKING BRAKE CABLE TO PARKING
BRAKE LEVER
(a) Install the shoe hold–down springs, cups and pins.
(b) Using needle–nose pliers, connect the parking brake
cable to the parking brake lever.
4. INSTALL REAR SHOE
Slide in the rear shoe between the shoe hold–down
spring cup and the backing plate.
NOTICE: Do not allow oil or grease to get on the rubbing
faces.
5. INSTALL TENSION SPRING, FRONT SHOE, AD–
JUSTER AND STRUT
(a) Install the tension spring to the rear shoe.
(b) Install the front shoe to the tension spring.
(c) Install the adjuster between the front and rear shoes.
BR–58
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Parking Brake for Rear Disc Brake)
(d) Install the shoe strut with the spring.
(e) Slide in the front shoe between the shoe hold–down
spring cup and the backing plate.
6. INSTALL SHOE RETURN SPRINGS
Using needle–nose pliers, install the shoe return spr–
ings.
7. INSTALL DISC
(a) Before installing, polish the disc and shoe surfaces
with sandpaper.
(b) Align the hole on the rear axle hub flange and service
hole on the disc.
8. ADJUST PARKING BRAKE SHOE CLEARANCE
(a) Temporarily install the hub nuts.
(b) Remove the hole plug.
(c) Turn the adjuster and expand the shoes until the disc
locks.
(d) Return the adjuster 8 notches.
(e) install the hole plug.
BR–59
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Parking Brake for Rear Disc Brake)
9. INSTALL DISC BRAKE ASSEMBLY
Install the disc brake assembly and torque the 2 mot
nting bolts.
Torque: 47 N–m (475 kgf–cm, 34 ft–lbf)
10. INSTALL REAR WHEEL
11. SETTLING PARKING BRAKE SHOES AND DISC
(a) LEVER TYPE:
With the parking brake release button pushed in, pull
the lever with 98 N (10 kgf, 22 lbf) of force.
(b) PEDAL TYPE:
Depress the parking brake pedal with 147 N (15 kgf,
33 lbf).
(c) Drive the vehicle at about 50 km/h (31 mph) on a safe,
level and dry road.
(d) Drive the vehicle for about 400 meters (0.25 mile) in
this condition.
(e) Repeat this procedure 2 or 3 times.
12. RECHECK AND ADJUST PARKING BRAKE LEVER/
PEDAL TRAVEL
BR–60
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
PARKING BRAKE
PARKING BRAKE
PARKING BRAKE PEDAL DISASSEMBLY
AND ASSEMBLY
Remove and install the parts as shown.
MAIN POINT OF PEDAL INSTALLATION
INSTALL SHOCK ABSORBER
(a) Loosen the union lock nut.
(b) Install the shock absorber to the pin on the pedal
bracket side, then extend the piston rod fully.
(c) Return the pedal until it hits the cushion.
(d) Make adjustments so that the shock absorber’s union
and the pin on the pedal side are aligned, then turn the
union 1 turn counterclockwise.
(e) Install the shock absorber to the pedal and tighten the
lock nut.
Torque: 13 N–m (130 kgf–cm, 9 ft–lbf)
BR–61
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
PARKING BRAKE
PARKING BRAKE INTERMEDIATE LEVER
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY
Remove and install the parts as shown.
MAIN POINT OF INTERMEDIATE LEVER
INSTALLATION
MEASURE CLEARANCE BETWEEN INTERMEDIATE
LEVER SHAFT AND LEVER
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance.
Standard clearance:
0.09–0.5 mm (0.004–0.02 in.)
If the clearance is not within the specification, replace
the shim with one of the correct size.
Shim Thickness
Shim Thickness
0.3 mm (0.012 in.)
1.2 mm (0.047 in.)
0.6 mm (0.024 in.)
1.5 mm (0.059 in.)
0.9 mm (0.035 in.)
1.8 mm (0.071 in.)
BR–62
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
PROPORTIONING VALVE (P VALVE)
PROPORTIONING VALVE (P VALVE)
P VALVE INSPECTION
1. CONNECT FLUID PRESSURE GAUGE TO P VALVE
2. BLEED AIR FROM FLUID ’PRESSURE GAUGE
3. RAISE MASTER CYLINDER PRESSURE AND CHECK
REAR WHEEL CYLINDER PRESSURE
Master cylinder fluid pressure
Rear brake cylinder fluid pressure
5S–FE w/o ABS:
2,452 kPa (25 kgf/cm2 , 356 psi)
7,845 kPa (80 kgf/cm2 , 1,138 psi)
2,452 kPa (25 kgf/cm2 , 356 psi)
4,452 kPa (45.4 kgf/cm2 , 648 psi)
1 MZ–FE w/o A6S:
2,942 kPa–(30 kgf/cm2 , 427 psi)
2,942 kPa (30 kgf/cm2 , 427 psi)
7,845 kPa (80 kgf/cm2 , 1,138 psi)
4,756 kPa (48.5 kgf/cm2 , 690 psi)
5S–FE w/ABS, 1 MZ–FE w/ABS:
3,432 kPa (35 kgf/cm2 , 498 psi)
7,845 kPa (80
kgf/cm2
, 1,138 psi)
3,432 kPa (35 kgf/cm2 , 498 psi)
5,070 kPa (51.7 kgf/crn2 , 735 psi)
If the rear brake cylinder pressure is incorrect, replace
the P valve assembly.
4. BLEED BRAKE SYSTEM
5. CHECK FOR LEAKS
BR–63
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
LOAD SENSING PROPORTIONING VALVE (LSPV)
LOAD SENSING PROPORTIONING
VALVE (LSPV)
COMPONENTS
FLUID PRESSURE INSPECTION
1. SET REAR AXLE LOAD
(a) Set the vehicle to its curb weight.
(b) Measure the rear axle load and note the value.
(c) Set the rear axle load.
Rear axle load: Rear axle curb weight + 31 kg (68 Ib)
2. INSTALL LSPV GAUGE (SST) AND BLEED BRAKE
SYSTEM
SST 09709–.29017
BR–64
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
LOAD SENSING PROPORTIONING VALVE (LSPV)
3. RAISE FRONT BRAKE FLUID PRESSURE TO FOL–
LOWING SPECIFICATION AND CHECK REAR
BRAKE FLUID PRESSURE
Rear brake fluid pressure:
5S–FE All, 1 MZ–FE w/ABS
Front brake fluid pressure
kPa (kgf/cm2 , psi)
9,807
(100, 1,422)
Rear brake fluid pressure
kPa (kgf/cm2 , psi)
6,139–7,120
(62.6–72.6, 890–1,033)
1 MZ–FE w/o A6S
Front brake fluid pressure
kPa (kgf/cm2 , psi)
12,747
(130 , 1,849)
Rear brake fluid pressure
kPa (kgf/cm2 , psi)
8,865–9,846
(90.4–100.4,1,286–1,428)
HINT:
• Depress the brake pedal while the engine is run–
ning.
• The brake pedal should not be depressed twice
and/or returned while setting to the specified
pressure. Read the value of rear pressure 2 sec–
onds after adjusting to the specified fluid pres–
sure.
4. IF NECESSARY, ADJUST FLUID PRESSURE
(a) Set the shaft length A to initial set length and tighten
the adjusting bolt lock nut.
Initial set length:
26.0 mm (1.02 in.)
(b) Check the rear brake fluid pressure.
(c) If not within the specification, adjust the fluid pres–
sure by changing the shaft length.
Low pressure–Lengthen A
High pressure–Shorten A
HINT:–For every full turn of the adjusting nut, the fluid
pressure will change as follows:
Fluid Pressure changed kPa (kgf/cm2, psi)
5S–FE All, 1 MZ–FE w/ABS
294 (3.0, 42.7)
1 MZ–FE w/o ABS
422 (4.3, 61.2)
BR–65
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
LOAD SENSING PROPORTIONING VALVE (LSPV)
(d) Torque the lock nut.
Torque: 13 N–m (130 kgf–cm, 9 ft–lbf)
If it cannot be adjusted, replace the valve body.
LSPV REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT BRAKE LINES
Using SST, disconnect the brake lines from the valve
body.
SST 09751–36011
2. REMOVE LSPV ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the lock nut and disconnect the adjusting
bolt from the rear suspension arm.
(b) Remove the 2 mounting bolts and remove the LSPV
assembly.
LSPV INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL LSPV ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the valve assembly with the 2 mounting bolts.
Torque: 39 N–m (400 kgf–cm, 29 ft–lbf)
(b) Install the adjusting nut to the adjusting bolt and then
install the adjusting bolt to the rear suspension arm
with the lock nut.
BR–66
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
LOAD SENSING PROPORTIONING VALVE (LSPV)
2. CONNECT BRAKE LINES
Using SST, connect the brake lines.
SST 09751–36011
Torque: 15 N–m (155 kgf–cm, 11 ft–lbf)
3. FILL BRAKE RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID AND
BLEED BRAKE SYSTEM
(See page BR–9)
4. CHECK FOR LEAKS
5. CHECK AND ADJUST FLUID PRESSURE
(See page BR–63)
6. REMOVE LSPV GAUGE (SST) AND BLEED BRAKE
SYSTEM
7. CHECK FOR LEAKS
BR–67
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DESCRIPTION
• ABS controls the brake cylinder hydraulic pressure to all 4 wheels during sudden braking and
braking on slippery road surfaces, preventing the wheels from locking. ABS provides the
following benefits:
(1) Steering round an obstacle with a greater degree of certainty even when panic braking.
(2) Stopping during panic braking while keeping the effect up on stability and steerability to a
minimum, even on curves.
• In case a malfunction occurs, a diagnosis function and fail–safe system have been adopted for
the ABS.
• An ABS actuator manufactured by BOSCH is used on the Camry produced by TMM (Toyota
Motor Manufacturing U.S.A., Inc.).
BR–68
BRAKE SYSTEM
SYSTEM PARTS LOCATION
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–69
BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
TMC Made Vehicle/NIPPONDENSO ABS:
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–70
BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
TMM Made Vehicle/BOSCH ABS:
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–71
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
ECU TERMINALS
TMC Made Vehicle/NIPPONDENSO ABS:
Terminal
No.
Connection
Symbol
Right front solenoid
Terminal
No.
Connection
Symbol
Left rear speed sensor
Ground
Right front speed sensor
DLC2
DLC1, DLC2
ABS control (motor) relay monitor
Stop light switch
Sealed wiring harness
Right rear speed sensor
Left front speed sensor
Left rear speed sensor
Sealed wiring harness
ABS control (solenoid) relay
Ignition switch
Left front solenoid
Left rear solenoid
Ground
Right front speed sensor
A8S control (solenoid) relay monitor
Left front speed sensor
ABS control (motor) relay
Relay ground
Battery
Right rear solenoid
ABS warning light
Parking brake switch
DLC1
Right rear speed sensor
BR–72
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
ECU TERMINALS
TMM Made Vehicle/BOSCH ABS:
Terminal
No.
Connection
Symbol
Terminal
No.
Symbol
Connection
A6S warning fight
Battery
Left rear speed sensor
Ignition switch
DLC1
Left rear speed sensor
Right front speed sensor
Right rear speed sensor
Left front speed sensor
Stop light switch
Right front speed sensor
DLC1, DLC2
Left front speed sensor
Right rear speed sensor
DLC1
Ground
BR–73
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
ECU TERMINALS STANDARD VALUE
TMC Made Vehicle/NIPPONDENSO ABS:
Symbols
(Terminals No.)
STD Voltage (V)
Condition
Always
IG switch ON
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
IG switch ON
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
IG switch ON, AIRS warning light ON
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
IG switch ON, PKB switch ON, Fluid in M/C reservoir above MIN level
IG switch ON, PKB switch OFF, Fluid in M/C reservoir above MIN level
Stop light switch OFF
Stop light switch ON
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
!G switch ON
lG switch ON
AC generation
IG switch ON
Slowly turn right front wheel
AC generation
IG switch ON
Slowly turn left front wheel
AC generation
IG switch ON
Slowly turn right rear wheel
AC generation
IG switch ON
Slowly turn left rear wheel
BR–74
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
ECU TERMINALS STANDARD VALUE
TMM Made Vehicle/BOSCH ABS:
Symbols
(Terminals No.)
STD Voltage (V)
Condition
Always
IG switch ON
IG switch ON, A6S warning light ON
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
IG switch ON, ABS warning light ON
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
Stop light switch OFF
Stop light switch ON
lG switch ON
I G switch 0 N
AC generation
IG switch ON, slowly turn right front wheel
AC generation
IG switch ON, slowly turn left front wheel
AC generation
IG switch ON, slowly turn right rear wheel
AC generation
IG switch ON, slowly turn left rear wheel
BR–75
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
ABS ACTUATOR
(TMC Made Vehicle NIPPONDENSO
ABS)
ABS ACTUATOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
Remove and install the parts as shown.
BR–76
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
MAIN POINTS OF REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
1. DISCONNECT AND CONNECT BRAKE LINE
Using SST, disconnect and connect the brake lines
from/to the ABS actuator.
SST 09023–00100
Torque: 15 N–m (155 kgf–cm. 11 ft–lbf)
2. BLEED BRAKE SYSTEM
(See page BR–9)
BR–77
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
ABS ACTUATOR INSPECTION
1. INSPECT BATTERY POSITIVE VOLTAGE
Battery positive voltage:
10–14.5 V
2. DISCONNECT CONNECTORS
(a) Disconnect the connector from the actuator.
(b) Disconnect the 2 connectors from the control relay.
3. CONNECT ACTUATOR CHECKER (SST) TO ACTUA–
TOR
(a) Connect the actuator checker (SST) to the actuator,
control relay and body side wire harness through the
sub–wire harness C and E (SST) as shown.
SST 09990–00150, 09990–00200, 09990–00210
(b) Connect the red cable of the checker to the battery
positive (+) terminal and black cable to the negative
(–) terminal. Connect the black cable of the sub–wire
harness to the battery negative (–) terminal or body
ground.
BR–78
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
(c) Place the ”SHEET A” (SST) on the actuator checker.
SST 09990–00163
4. INSPECT BRAKE ACTUATOR OPERATION
(a) Start the engine, and run it at idle.
(b) Turn the selector switch of the actuator checker to
”FRONT RH” position.
(c) Push and hold in the MOTOR switch for a few sec–
onds.
(d) Depress the brake pedal and hold it until step (g) is com
pleted.
(e) Push the POWER SWITCH, and check that the brake
pedal does not go down.
NOTICE: Do not keep the POWER SWITCH pushed down
for more than 10 seconds.
(f) Release the switch, and check that the pedal goes
down.
–
(g) Push and hold in the MOTOR switch for a few sec
onds, and check that the pedal returns.
(h) Release the brake pedal.
(i) Push and hold in the MOTOR switch for a few sec–
onds.
(j) Depress the brake pedal and hold it for about 15
seconds. As you hold the pedal down, push the
MOTOR switch for a few seconds. Check that the
brake pedal does not pulsate.
(k) Release the brake pedal.
BR–79
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
(l) Turn the selector switch to ”FRONT LH” position.
(m) Repeat (c) to 6), checking the actuator operation sim–
ilarly.
(n) Similarly, inspect ”REAR RH” and ”REAR LH” position.
HINT: When inspecting ”REAR LH” position, push the
REAR LH switch instead of the POWER SWITCH, and
you can inspect in any selector switch position.
(o) Push and hold in the MOTOR switch for a few sec–
onds.
(p) Stop the engine.
5. DISCONNECT ACTUATOR CHECKER (SST) FROM
ACTUATOR
Remove the ”SHEET A” (SST) and disconnect the
actuator checker (SST) and sub–wire harness (SST)
from the actuator, control relay and body side wire
harness.
SST 09990–00150, 09990–00200, 09990–00210 ,
09990–00163
6. CONNECT CONNECTORS
(a) Connect the 2 connectors to the control relay.
(b) Connect the connector to the actuator.
7. CLEAR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES
(See page BR–94)
BR–80
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
ABS ACTUATOR
(TMM Made Vehicle BOSCH ABS)
ABS ACTUATOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
Remove and install the parts as shown.
BR–81
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
MAIN POINTS OF REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
1. DISCONNECT AND CONNECT BRAKE LINE
Using SST, disconnect and connect the brake lines
from/to the ABS actuator.
SST 09751–36011
Torque: 15 N–m (155 kgf–cm, 11 ft–lbf)
2. INSTALL ABS ACTUATOR
NOTICE: Use the bolts which have a notch to securely
ground the actuator ground wire.
3. BLEED BRAKE SYSTEM
(See page BR–9)
BR–82
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
ABS ACTUATOR DISASSEMBLY AND
ASSEMBLY
Remove and install the parts as shown.
BR–83
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
MAIN POINTS OF DISASSEMBLY AND
ASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE AND INSTALL COVER
Using a T15 torx wrench, loosen and tighten the
screw.
Torque: 1.4 N–m(14 kgf–cm, 12 in.lbf)
2. DISCONNECT AND CONNECT 4–PIN AND 6–PIN
CONNECTORS
NOTICE: When installing, place the 4–pin connector’s
cables into the cable guide.
3. REMOVE AND INSTALL ECU
Using T15 and T20 torx wrenches, loosen and tighten
the 5 screws.
Torque: 1.7 N–m(17 kgf–cm, 15 in.–Ibf)
NOTICE: There are 2 kinds of screw, so install a correct
screw into each hole.
4. PERFORM TEST DRIVE
(a) Drive for at least 20 seconds at 30 Km/h (119 mph).
(b) The ABS warning light may not light.
If the ABS warning light lights, read the diagnostic
trouble code.
BR–84
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
FRONT SPEED SENSOR
COMPONENTS
FRONT SPEED SENSOR AND SENSOR
ROTOR SERRATIONS INSPECTION
(REFERENCE)
INSPECT FRONT SPEED SENSOR AND SENSOR
ROTOR SERRATIONS BY USING AN OSCILLO–
SCOPE
(a) Connect an oscilloscope to the speed sensor connec–
tor.
(b) Run the vehicle at 20 km/h (112.4 mph), and inspect
speed sensor output wave.
(c) Check that C is 0.5 V or more.
If not as specified, replace the speed sensor.
(d) Check that B is 30% or more of A.
If not as specified, replace the drive shaft.
FRONT SPEED SENSOR REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
(a) Remove the fender shield.
(b) Disconnect the speed sensor connector.
BR–85
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
2. REMOVE SPEED SENSOR
(a) Remove the 3 clamp bolts holding the sensor harness
to the body and shock absorber_
(b) Remove the speed sensor from the steering knuckle.
FRONT SPEED SENSOR INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL SPEED SENSOR
Install the speed sensor to the steering knuckle.
Torque: 7.8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–lbf)
2. CONNECT SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
(a) Install the sensor harness.
Torque: 5.4 N–m (55 kgf–cm. 48 in.–lbf)
(b) Connect the speed sensor connector.
¿¿”–07
BR–86
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
REAR SPEED SENSOR
COMPONENTS
REAR SPEED SENSOR AND SENSOR
ROTOR SERRATIONS INSPECTION
(REFERENCE)
INSPECT REAR SPEED SENSOR AND SENSOR
ROTOR SERRATIONS BY USING AN OSCILLO–
SCOPE
(a) Connect an oscilloscope to the speed sensor connec–
tor.
(b) Run the vehicle at 20 km/h (12.4 mph), and inspect
speed sensor output wave.
(c) Check that C is 0.5 V or more.
If not as specified, replace the speed sensor.
(d) Check that B is 40 96 or more of A.
If not as specified, replace the rear axle hub.
BR–87
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
REAR SPEED SENSOR REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
(a) Remove the seat cushion and side seatback.
(b) Disconnect the speed sensor connector, and pull out
the sensor wire harness with the grommet.
(c) Remove the 2 clamp bolts holding the sensor wire
harness to the body and shock absorber.
2. REMOVE SPEED SENSOR
Remove the speed sensor from the axle carrier.
REAR SPEED SENSOR INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL SPEED SENSOR
Install the speed sensor to the axle carrier.
Torque: 7.8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.lbf)
2. CONNECT SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
(a) Pass the sensor harness through the body panel hole,
and connect the connector.
BR–88
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
(b) install the grommet securely.
(c) Install the sensor harness.
Torque: 5.4 N–m (55 kgf–cm, 48 in.–lbf)
BR–89
BRAKE SYSTEM
–MEMO–
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–90
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
TROUBLESHOOTING
(TMC Made Vehicle NIPPONDENSO ABS)
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
Perform troubleshooting in accordance with the procedure on the following pages.
(1) CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
Using the customer problem analysis check sheet for reference, ask the customer in as much detail
as possible about the problem.
(2) CHECK AND CLEAR THE DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES (PRECHECK)
If the ABS warning light lights up, and the ABS does not operate, the ECU stores diagnostic trouble
codes corresponding to the problem in memory.
Before confirming the trouble, first check the diagnostic trouble codes to see if there are any
malfunction codes stored in memory. When there are malfunction codes, make a note of them, then
clear them and proceed to ”3” Problem Symptom Confirmation”.
(3) PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION, (4) SYMPTOM SIMULATION
Confirm the problem symptoms. If the problem does not recur, simulate the problem by initially
checking the circuits indicated by the diagnostic trouble code in step “2” , using ”Problem simulation
method”.
(5) DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK
Check the diagnostic trouble codes.
If a malfunction code is output, proceed to ” 6” Diagnostic Trouble Code Chart”. If the normal code
is output, proceed to ” 7” Problem Symptoms Chart”.
Be sure to proceed to ” 6” Diagnostic Trouble Code Chart” after steps “2” and “3” are completed. If
troubleshooting is attempted only by following the malfunction code stored in the memory, errors
could be made in the diagnosis.
(6) DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a malfunction code is confirmed in the diagnostic trouble code check, proceed to the inspection
procedure indicated by the matrix chart for each diagnostic trouble code.
(7) PROBLEM SYMPTOMS CHART
If the normal code is confirmed in the diagnostic trouble code check, perform inspection in accordance
with the inspection order in the problem symptoms chart.
(8) CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Proceed with diagnosis of each circuit in accordance with the inspection order confirmed in 6 and
7 . Determine whether the cause of the problem is in the sensor, actuators, wire harness and
connectors, or the ECU.
(9) SENSOR CHECK
Use the ABS warning light to check if each of the signals from the speed sensors are being input
correctly to the ECU. Instructions for this check are given in the circuit inspection.
(10) REPAIRS
After the cause of the problem is located, perform repairs by following the inspection and replacement
procedures in this manual.
(11) CONFIRMATION TEST
After completing repairs, confirm not only that the malfunction is eliminated, but also conduct a test
drive to make sure the entire ABS system is operating correctly.
BR–91
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Items inside
are titles of pages in this manu–
al, with the page number in the bottom portion.
See the pages for detailed explanations.
Vehicle brought to workshop
Customer Problem Analysis
P. BR–92
2
Check and Clear Diagnostic Trouble Code Precheck)
P. BR–93BR–94
Symptom
does not occur
3
Problem Symptom Confirmation
Symptom Simulation
P.!N–21
Symptom
occurs
5
Normal code
Diagnostic Trouble Code Check
P. BR–93
6
Diagnostic Trouble Code Chart
Problem Symptoms Chart
P. BR–95
Circuit Inspection
P. BR–98
Sensor Check
Check for Fluid Leakage
P. BR–108BR–138
P. BR–139
Identification of Problem
10
Repair
Confirmation Test
End
Step
5
8
Diagnostic steps permitting the
use of the TOYOTA hand–held
tester or TOYOTA break–out–box.
BR–92
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK SHEET
BR–93
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
INDICATOR CHECK
When the ignition switch is turned ON, check that the ABS
warning light goes on for 3 seconds.
HINT: If the indicator check result is not normal, proceed to
troubleshooting for the ABS warning light circuit (See page BR–
130).
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK
1. Disconnect the Short Pin from DLC1.
2. Using SST, connect terminals Tc and E1 of DLC2 or DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
3. Turn the ignition switch to ON.
4. Read the diagnostic trouble code from the ABS warning
light on the combination meter.
HINT: If no code appears, inspect the diagnostic circuit
or ABS warning light circuit (See page BR–134 or BR–130).
As an example, the blinking patterns for normal code and
codes 11 and 21 are shown on the left.
5. Codes are explained in the code table on page BR–95.
6. After completing the check, disconnect terminals Tc and
E1, and turn off the display.
If 2 or more malfunctions are indicated at the same time,
the–lowest numbered diagnostic trouble code will be
displayed first. .
BR–94
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK
USING TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER
1. Hook up the Toyota hand–held tester to the DLC2.
2. Read the diagnostic trouble codes by following the prompts
on the tester screen.
Please refer to the Toyota hand–held tester operator’s
manual for further details.
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CLEARANCE
1. Using SST, connect terminals Tc and E1 of DLC2 or DLC1
and remove the short pin from DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
2. IG switch ON.
3. Clear the diagnostic trouble codes stored in ECU by de–
pressing the brake pedal 8 or more times within 3 seconds.
4. Check that the warning light shows the normal code.
5. Remove the SST from the terminals of DLC2 or DLC1.
6. Connect the Short Pin to DLC1
HINT: Cancellation can also be done by removing the ECU–13
fuse, but in this case, other memory systems will also be
cancelled out.
ECU TERMINAL VALUES MEASUREMENT
USING TOYOTA BREAK–OUT–BOX AND TOYOTA
HAND–HELD TESTER
1. Hook up the Toyota break–out–box and Toyota hand–held
tester to the vehicle.
2. Read the ECU input/output values by following the prompts
on the tester screen.
HINT: Toyota hand–held tester has a ”Snapshot” function.
This records the measured values and is effective in the
diagnosis of intermittent problems.
Please refer to the Toyota hand–held tester/Toyota break–
out–box operator’s manual for further details.
BR–95
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a malfunction code is displayed during the diagnostic trouble code check, check the circuit listed for that
code.
HINT: Using SST 09843–18020, connect the terminals Tc and E1, and remove the short pin.
Code
ABS Warning Light
Blinking Pattern
Diagnosis
Open circuit in ABS control (solenoid) relay circuit
Short circuit in ABS control (solenoid) relay circuit
Open circuit in ABS control (motor) relay circuit
Short circuit in ABS control (motor) relay circuit
Open or short circuit in 3–position solenoid circuit for right
front wheel
Open or short circuit in 3–position solenoid circuit for left
front wheel
Open or short circuit in 3–position solenoid circuit for right
rear wheel
Open or short circuit in 3–position solenoid circuit for left
rear wheel
Right front wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
Left front wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
Right rear wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
Left rear wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
Open circuit in left front or right rear speed sensor circuit
Open circuit in right front or left rear speed sensor circuit
Faulty rear speed sensor rotor
Low battery positive voltage or abnormally high battery
positive voltage
Pump motor is locked
Open in pump motor ground
Always
ON
Malfunction in ECU
BR–96
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL CHECK
1. Turn the ignition switch to OFF.
2. Using SST, connect terminals Ts and E1 of DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
3. Start the engine.
4. Check that the ABS warning light blinks
HINT: If the ABS. warning light does not blink, inspect
the ABS warning light circuit (See page BR–130).
5. Drive vehicle straight forward.
HINT: Drive vehicle faster than 45 km/h (28 mph) for
several seconds.
6. Stop the vehicle.
7. Using SST, connect terminals Tc and E1 of DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
8. Read the number of blinks of the ABS warning light.
HINT: See the list of diagnostic trouble codes shown on
the next page.
If every sensor is normal, a normal code is output (A cycle
of 0.25 sec. ON and 0.25 sec. OFF is repeated).
If 2 or more malfunctions are indicated at the same time,
the lowest numbered code will be displayed first.
9. After performing the check, disconnect terminals Ts and
E1, Tc and E1 of DLC1, and ignition switch turned off.
BR–97
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK
USING TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER
1. Perform steps 1.–6. on the previous page.
2. Hook up the Toyota hand–held tester to the DLC2.
3. Read the diagnostic trouble codes by following the prompts
on the tester screen.
Please refer to the Toyota hand–held tester operator’s
manual for further details.
Diagnostic Trouble Code of Speed Sensor Check Function
Code No.
Diagnosis
Trouble Area
Low output voltage of right front speed sensor
•
•
Right front speed sensor
Sensor installation
Low output voltage of left front speed sensor
•
•
Left front speed sensor
Sensor installation
Low output voltage of right rear speed sensor
•
•
Right rear speed sensor
Sensor installation
Low output voltage of left rear speed sensor
•
•
Left rear speed sensor
Sensor installation
Abnormal change in output voltage of right front speed
sensor
•
Right front speed sensor rotor
Abnormal change in output voltage of left front speed
sensor
•
Left front speed sensor rotor
Abnormal change in output voltage of right rear speed
sensor
•
Right rear speed sensor rotor
Abnormal change in output voltage of left rear speed
sensor
•
Left rear speed sensor rotor
BR–98
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS CHART
If a normal code is displayed during the diagnostic trouble code check but the problem still occurs, check
the circuits for each problem symptom in the order given in the table below and proceed to the relevant
troubleshooting page.
Inspection Circuit
Symptoms
A6S does not
operate.
A6S does not operate
efficiently.
ABS warning light
abnormal.
Diagnostic trouble
code check cannot
be performed.
Speed sensor signal
check cannot be
performed.
Only when 1.–4. are all normal and the problem is still occurring,
replace the ABS ECU.
1. Check the diagnostic trouble code, reconfirming that the normal
code is output.
2. IG power source circuit.
3. Speed sensor circuit.
4. Check the ABS actuator with a checker.
If abnormal, check the hydraulic circuit for leakage (see page
BR–139).
Only when 1.–4. are all normal and the problem is still occurring,
replace the ABS ECU.
1. Check the diagnostic trouble code, reconfirming that the normal
code is output.
2. Speed sensor circuit.
3. Stop light switch circuit.
4. Check the ABS actuator with a checker.
If abnormal, check the hydraulic circuit for leakage (see page
BR–139).
1. ABS warning light circuit.
2. ABS ECU.
Only when 1. and 2. are all normal and the problem is still occurring,
replace the ABS ECU.
1. ABS warning light circuit.
2. Tc terminal circuit.
1. Ts terminal circuit.
2. ABS ECU.
See page
BR–93
BR–123
BR–119
BR–77
BR–93
BR–119
BR–128
BR–77
BR–130
BR–130
BR–134
BR–137
BR–99
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
LOCATION OF CONNECTORS
Location of Connectors in Engine Compartment
1MZ–FE Engine:
BR–100
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–101
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Location of Connectors in Engine Compartment
5S–FE Engine:
BR–102
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–103
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Location of Connectors in Instrument Panel
BR–104
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–105
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–106
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
J/B No. 1
J/B No. 3
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–107
BRAKE SYSTEM
Location of Connectors in Body
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–108
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC 11,12 ABS Control (Solenoid) Relay Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This relay supplies power to each ABS solenoid. After the ignition switch is turned ON, if the initial
check is OK, the relay goes on.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Conditions (1) and (2) continue for 0.2 sec. or
more:
(1) ABS control (solenoid) relay terminal (SR)
voltage: Battery positive voltage
(2) ABS control (solenoid) relay monitor termi–
nal (AST) voltage: 0 V
Conditions (1) and (2) continue for 0.2 sec. or
more:
(1) ABS control (solenoid) relay terminal (SR)
voltage: 0 V
(2) ABS control (solenoid) relay monitor termi–
nal (AST) voltage: Battery positive voltage
Trouble area
•
•
•
ABS control (solenoid) relay.
Open or short in ABS control (solenoid) relay
circuit.
ECU.
•
•
•
ABS control (solenoid) relay.
B+ short in ABS control (solenoid) relay circuit.
ECU.
Fail safe function: If trouble occurs in the control (solenoid) relay circuit, the ECU cuts off current to
the ABS control (solenoid) relay and prohibits ABS control.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage of ABS control relay connector.
Check and repair harness or connector.
Check continuity between relay and actuator
and ECU.
Repair or replace harness or ABS ac–
tuator.
Check ABS control relay.
Replace ABS control relay.
Check for open and short in harness and con–
nector between relay and ECU.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
If the same code is still output after the diagnostic trouble code is deleted, check the contact condition
of each connection.
If the connections are normal, the ECU may be defective.
BR–109
BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–110
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
2 and
Check voltage between terminals
connector.
6 of ABS control relay
Disconnect the ABS control relay connector.
Measure voltage between terminals A72 and
A76 of ABS control relay harness side connec–
tor.
Voltage: 10–14 V
Check and repair harness or connector.
Check continuity between terminals
A4 2,
A4 2 and
A13 18.
5 and
4 and
Disconnect the 2 connectors from ABS actuator.
Check continuity between terminals (A7) 5 and
(A5)4, (A5)4 and (A4)2, (A4)2 and (A13)18.
Continuity
HINT: There is a resistance of 4–6 between terminals
A5 4 and A4 2.
Repair or replace harness or ABS actuator.
BR–111
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Check ABS control relay.
Check continuity between each terminal of ABS
control relay.
Continuity (Reference
value 80)
Terminals
1 and
Terminals
5 and
Continuity
Terminals
2 and
Open
1. Apply battery positive voltage between termi–
nals A7 1 and A6 3.
2. Check continuity between each terminal of
ABS control relay.
Terminals
Terminals
5 a rid
Open
2 and
Continuity
Replace ABS control relay.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ABS
control relay and ABS ECU (See page IN–28).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
If the same code is still output after the diagnostic trouble code is deleted, check the contact
condition of each connection.
If the connections are normal, the ECU may be defective.
BR–112
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DTC 13,14 ABS Control (Motor) Relay Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ABS control (motor) relay supplies power to the ABS pump motor. While the ABS is activated,
the ECU switches the control (motor) relay ON and operates the ABS pump motor.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Conditions (1) and (2) continued for 0.2 sec. or
more:
(1) ABS control (motor) relay terminal (MR)
voltage: Battery positive voltage
(2) ABS control (motor) relay monitor terminal
(MT) voltage: 0 V
Conditions (1) and (2) continued for 4 sec. or
more:
(1) ABS control (motor) relay terminal (MR)
voltage: 0 V
(2) ABS control (motor) relay monitor terminal
(MT) voltage: Battery positive voltage
Fail safe function:
Trouble area
•
•
•
ABS control (motor) relay.
Open or short in ABS control (motor) relay
circuit.
ECU.
•
•
•
ABS control (motor) relay.
B+ short in ABS control (motor) relay circuit.
ECU.
If trouble occurs in the control (motor) relay circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the
ABS control (solenoid) relay and prohibits ABS control.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage of ABS control relay connector.
Check and repair harness or connector.
Check continuity between relay and pump motor
and ECU.
Repair or replace harness or ABS ac–
tuator.
Check ABS control relay.
Replace ABS control relay.
Check for open and short in harness and con–
nector between relay and ECU.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
If the same code is still output after the diagnostic trouble code is deleted, check the contact condition
of each connection.
If the connections are normal, the ECU may be defective.
BR–113
BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–114
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminals
ground.
1 of ABS control relay and body
Disconnect the ABS control relay connector.
Measure voltage between terminals A6 1 of ABS
control relay harness side connector and body
ground.
Voltage: 10–14 V
Check and repair harness or connector.
Check continuity between terminals
A4 5, A4 5 and
A13 6.
2 and
3 and
Disconnect the 2 connectors from ABS actuator.
Check continuity between terminals A6 2 and
A5 3, A5 3 and A4 5, A4 5 and A13 6.
Continuity
HINT: There is a resistance of 4–6 between
terminals A5 3 and A4 5.
Repair or replace harness or ABS actuator.
BR–115
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Check ABS control relay.
Check continuity between each terminal of ABS
control relay.
Terminals
3 and
Continuity (Reference
value 62
Terminals
1 and
Open
1. Apply battery positive voltage between termi–
nals A6 3 and A6 4.
2. Check continuity between each terminal of
ABS control relay.
Terminals
1 and
Continuity
Replace ABS control relay.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ABS
control relay and ABS ECU (See page IN–28).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
If the same code is still output after the diagnostic trouble code is deleted, check the contact condition
of each connection. If the connections are normal, the ECU may be defective.
BR–116
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DTC 21, 22, 23, 24 ABS, Actuator Solenoid Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This solenoid goes on when signals are received from the ECU and controls the pressure acting on
the wheel cylinders, thus controlling the braking force.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Conditions (1) through (3) continue for 0.05 sec.
or more:
(1) ABS control (solenoid) relay terminal (SR)
•
voltage: Battery positive voltage
•
(2) Voltage of ABS ECU terminal
•
AST: Battery positive voltage
(3) When power transistor of ECU is ON, voltage
of terminal SFR is 0 V or battery positive voltage.
Conditions (1) through (3) continue for 0.05 sec.
or more:
(1) ABS control (solenoid) relay terminal (SR)
•
voltage: Battery positive voltage
•
(2) Voltage of ABS ECU terminal
•
AST: Battery positive voltage
(3) When power transistor of ECU is ON, voltage
of terminal SFL is 0 V or battery positive voltage.
Trouble area
ABS actuator.
Open or short in SFR circuit.
ECU.
ABS actuator.
Open or short in SFL circuit.
ECU.
Conditions (1) through (3) continue for 0.05 sec.
or more:
(1) ABS control (solenoid) relay terminal (SR)
•
voltage: Battery positive voltage
•
(2) Voltage of ABS ECU terminal
•
AST: Battery positive voltage
(3) When power transistor of ECU is ON, voltage
of terminal SRR is 0 V or battery positive voltage.
ABS actuator.
Open or short in SRR circuit.
ECU.
Conditions (1) through (3) continue for 0.05 sec.
or more:
(1) ABS control (solenoid) relay terminal (SR)
•
voltage: Battery positive voltage
•
(2) Voltage of ABS ECU terminal
•
AST: Battery positive voltage
(3) When power transistor of ECU is ON, voltage
of terminal SRL is 0 V or battery positive voltage.
ABS actuator.
Open or short in SRL circuit.
ECU.
Fail safe function: If trouble occurs in the actuator solenoid circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the
control (solenoid) relay and prohibits ABS control.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check ABS actuator solenoid.
Replace ABS actuator.
Check for open and short in harness and con–
nector between ECU and actuator.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
If the same code is still output after the diagnostic trouble code is deleted, check the contact condition
of each connection.
If the connections are normal, the ECU may be defective.
BR–117
BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–118
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check ABS actuator solenoid.
Disconnect the 2 connectors from ABS actuator.
Check continuity between terminals A5 4and A4
1, 3, 4, 6 of ABS actuator connector.
Continuity
HINT: Resistance of each solenoid coil is 1.2.
Replace ABS actuator.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ABS ECU and
actuator (See page IN–28).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
If the same code is still output after the diagnostic trouble code is deleted, check the contact condition of
each connection. If the connections are normal, the ECU may be defective.
BR–119
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DTC 31, 32, 33, 34, 35, 36 Speed Sensor Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The speed sensor detects the wheel speed and sends the
appropriate signals to the ECU. These signals are used to
control the ABS system. The front and rear rotors each have
48 serrations. When the rotors rotate, the magnetic field
emitted by the permanent magnet in the speed sensor
generates an AC voltage. Since the frequency of this AC
voltage changes in direct proportion to the speed of the
rotor, the frequency is used by the ECU to detect the speed
of each wheel.
DTC No.
31,32,
33,34
Trouble area
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Detection of any of conditions (1) through (3):
(1) At vehicle speed of 10 km/h (6 mph) or
more, pulses are not input for 5 sec.
(2) Momentary interruption of the speed sensor
signal occurs at least 7 times in the time be–
tween switching the ignition switch ON and
switching it OFF.
(3) Abnormal fluctuation of speed sensor signals
with the vehicle speed 20 km/h (12 mph) or
more.
Speed sensor signal is not input for about 1 sec.
while the left front and right rear speed sensor
signals are being checked with the IG switch ON.
Speed sensor signal is not input for about 1 sec.
while the right front and left rear speed sensor
signals are being checked with the IG switch ON.
•
Right front, left front, right rear and left rear
speed sensor.
Open or short in each speed sensor circuit.
ECU.
•
•
•
•
•
Open in left front or right rear speed sensor
circuit.
ECU.
Open in right front or left rear speed sensor
circuit.
•
ECU.
HINT: DTC No. 31 is for the right front speed sensor.
DTC No. 32 is for the left front speed sensor.
DTC No. 33 is for the right rear speed sensor
DTC No. 34 is for the left rear speed sensor.
Fail safe function:
If trouble occurs in the speed sensor circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS
control (solenoid) relay and prohibits ABS control.
BR–120
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check speed sensor.
Replace speed sensor.
Check for open and short in harness and con–
hector between each speed sensor and ECU.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check sensor rotor and sensor installation.
Replace speed sensor or rotor.
Check and replace ABS ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
BR–121
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check speed sensor.
Front
1. Remove front fender liner.
2. Disconnect speed sensor connector.
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of
speed sensor connector.
Resistance: 0.6–1.8 k
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of
speed sensor connector and body ground.
Resistance: 1 M or higher
Rear
1. Remove the seat cushion and side seat back.
2. Disconnect speed sensor connector.
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of
speed sensor connector.
Resistance: 0.9–1.3 k
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of
speed sensor connector and body ground.
Resistance: 1 M or higher
Replace speed sensor.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between each
speed sensor and ECU (See page IN–28).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
BR–122
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Check sensor rotor and sensor installation.
Front
Remove front drive shaft (See SA section).
Check sensor–rotor serrations.
No scratches or missing teeth.
Check the front speed sensor installation
The installation bolt is tightened properly.
Rear
Remove the axle hub (See SA section).
Check the sensor rotor serrations.
No scratches or missing teeth.
Check the speed sensor installation
The installation bolt is tightened properly and
there is no clearance between the sensor and
rear axle carrier.
Replace speed speed or rotor.
Check and replace ABS ECU.
BR–123
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DTC 41 IG Power Source Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This is the power source for the ECU, hence the CPU and the actuators.
DTC No.
Trouble area
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Vehicle speed is 3 km/h (1.9 mph) or more and
voltage of ECU terminal IG1 remains at more
than 17 V or below 9.5 V for more than 10 sec.
•
•
•
•
Battery.
IC regulator.
Open or short in power source circuit.
ECU.
Fail safe function: If trouble occurs in the power source circuit, the ECU cuts oft current to the ABS
control (solenoid) relay and prohibits ABS control.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check battery positive voltage.
Check and repair the charging system.
Check voltage between terminals IG1 and GND
of ABS ECU connector.
Check and replace ABS ECU.
Check continuity between terminals GND of ABS
ECU connector and body ground.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check ECU–IG fuse.
Check for short in all the harness and
components connected to ECU–IG fuse
(See attached wiring diagram).
Check for open in harness and connector between
ABS ECU and battery.
BR–124
BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–125
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check battery positive voltage.
Voltage: 10–14V
Check and repair the charging system,
Check voltage between terminals IG1 and GND of ABS ECU connector.
Remove ABS ECU with connectors still connected.
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Measure voltage between terminals IG1 and
GND of ABS ECU connector.
Voltage: 10–14 V
Check and replace ABS ECU.
Check continuity between terminals GND of ABS ECU connector and
body ground.
Measure resistance between terminals GND of
ABS ECU connector and body ground.
Resistance: 1 or less
Repair or replace harness or connector.
BR–126
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Check ECU–IG fuse.
Remove ECU–IG fuse from J/6 No. 1.
Check continuity of ECU–IG fuse.
Continuity
Check for short in all the harness and components connected to ECU–IG fuse (See attached
wiring diagram).
Check for open in harness and connector between ABS ECU and battery (See page IN–28).
BR–127
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DTC 51 ABS Pump Motor Lock
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Pump motor is not operating normally during
initial check.
Trouble area
• ABS pump motor.
Fail safe function: If trouble occurs in the ABS pump motor, the ECU cuts off current to the control
(solenoid) relay and prohibits ABS control.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
See inspection of ABS actuator (See page BR–77).
WIRING DIAGRAM
(Reference)
BR–128
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Stop Light Switch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This stop light switch senses whether the brake pedal is depressed or released, and sends the signal
to the ECU.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check operation of stop light.
Repair stop light circuit (See page BE–
65).
Check voltage of terminal STP.
Proceed to next circuit inspection
shown on problem symptoms chart
(See page BR–98).
Check for open in harness and connector be–
tween ABS ECU and stop light switch (See page
IN–27).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ABS ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
BR–129
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check operation of stop light.
Check that stop light lights up when brake pedal is depressed and turns off when brake pedal is
released.
Repair stop light circuit (See page BE–65).
Check voltage between terminal STP of ABS ECU and body ground.
Remove ABS ECU with connectors still connected.
Measure voltage between terminal STP of ABS
ECU and body ground when brake pedal is de–
pressed.
Voltage: 8–14 V
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms chart (See page BR–98).
Check for open in harness and connector between ABS ECU and stop light
switch (See page IN–28).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ABS ECU.
BR–130
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
ABS Warning Light Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
If the ECU detects trouble, it lights the ABS warning light while at the same time prohibiting ABS
control. At this time, the ECU records a diagnostic trouble code in memory.
After removing the short pin of the DLC1, connect terminals Tc and E1 of the DLC1 or DLC2 to make
the ABS warning light to blink and output the diagnostic trouble code.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Perform troubleshooting in accordance with the chart below for each trouble symptom.
ABS warning light does not light up
G o to step
1
. . ...
ABS warning light remains on
WIRING DIAGRAM
Go to step
3
BR–131
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
ABS warning light does not light up.
Check ABS warning light.
Repair or replace ABS warning light
bulb or circuit.
Check ABS control relay.
Replace ABS control relay.
Check for open in harness and connector
between
GAUGE fuse and J/B No. 3.
A6S warning light remains on.
Is diagnostic trouble code output?
Does ABS warning light go off if short pin is
removed?
YES
Check ABS control relay.
Check for short in harness and connector
between
DLC1 and ABS control relay.
YES
Repair circuit indicated by the code
output.
Check for–short in harness and
connec–
tor between warning light and DLC1
and ECU.
Replace ABS control relay.
BR–132
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check ABS warning light.
See Combination Meter Troubleshooting on page BE–1 18.
Replace bulb or combination meter assembly.
Check ABS control relay.
Disconnect the connectors from control relay.
Check continuity between each terminal of ABS
control relay.
Terminals
1 and
Continuity (Reference
value 80)
Terminals
5 and
Continuity
Terminals
2 and
Open
1. Apply battery positive voltage between termi–
nals A7 1 and A6 3.
2. Check continuity between each terminal of
ABS control relay.
Terminals
Terminals
5 and
2 and
Open
Continuity
Connect the test lead to terminal 4 of A7 and
the lead to terminal 5 of A7 . Check continuity
between the terminals.
Continuity
If there is no continuity, connect the test lead to
terminal 4 of A7 and the lead to terminal 5
of A7 . Recheck continuity between terminals.
Replace ABS control relay.
Check for open in harness and connector between DLC1 and A6S control relay and body ground
(See page IN–27).
BR–133
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Is diagnostic trouble code output?
Perform diagnostic trouble code check on page BR–93.
YES
Repair circuit indicated by the code output.
Does ABS warning light go off if short pin is removed?
YES
Check for short in harness and connector
between warning light and DLC1 and ECU (See
page IN–28 ).
Check ABS control relay (See step No. 2).
Replace ABS control relay.
Check for short in harness and connector between DLC1 and ABS control relay (See page
IN–28).
BR–134
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Tc Terminal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Connecting terminals Te and E1 of the DLC1 or the DLC2 causes the ECU to display the diagnostic
trouble code by flasing the ABS warning light.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage between terminals Tc and E1 of
DLC2 or DLC 1.
Check for open and short in harness and connec–
tor between ABS ECU and DLC2 or DLC1, DLC2
or DLC1 and body ground (See page IN–28).
Check and replace ABS ECU.
If ABS warning light does not blink
even after Tc and E1 are connected,
the ECU may be defective.*
Repair or replace harness or connector.
*: Provided that the harness between
terminal Tc of DLC2 or DLC1 and
terminal Te of ECU is not open.
BR–135
BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
1 MZ–FE:
5S–FE:
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–136
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminals Te and E1 of DLC2 or DLC1.
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Measure voltage between terminals Tc and E1
of DLC2 or DLC1.
Voltage: 10–14 V
If ABS warning light does not blink even after Tc
and E1 are connected, the ECU may be defective.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ABS ECU
and DLC2 or DLC1, DLC2 or DLC1 and body ground (See page IN–28).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ABS ECU.
BR–137
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Ts Terminal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The sensor check circuit detects abnormalities in the speed sensor signal which cannot be detected
with the diagnostic trouble code check.
Connecting terminals Ts and E1 of the DLC1 in the engine compartment starts the check.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage between terminals Ts and E1 of
DLC 1.
If ABS warning light does not blink
even after Ts and E 1 are connected,
the ECU may be defective.
Check for open and short in harness and connec–
tor between ABS ECU and DLC1, DLC1 and body
ground (See page IN–28).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ABS ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
BR–138
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminals and E1 of DLC1.
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Measure voltage between terminals Ts and E1
of DLC 1.
Voltage: 10–14 V
If ABS warning light does not blink even after Ts
and E1 are connected, the ECU may be defective.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ABS ECU
and DLC1, DLC1 and body ground (See page IN–28).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ABS ECU.
BR–139
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Check for Fluid Leakage
Check for fluid leakage from actuator or hydraulic lines.
BR–140
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
TROUBLESHOOTING
(TMM Made Vehicle BOSCH ABS)
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
Perform troubleshooting in accordance with the procedure on the following pages.
(1) CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
Using the customer problem analysis check sheet for reference, ask the customer in as much detail
as possible about the problem.
(2) CHECK AND CLEAR THE DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES (PRECHECK)
If the ABS warning light lights up, and the ABS does not operate, the ECU stores diagnostic trouble
codes corresponding to the problem in memory.
Before confirming the trouble, first check the diagnostic trouble codes to see if there are any malfunc–
tion codes stored in memory. When there are malfunction codes, make a note of them, then clear
them and proceed to ”3” Problem Symptom Confirmation”.
(3) PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION, (4) SYMPTOM SIMULATION
Confirm the problem symptoms. If the problem does not recur, simulate the problem by initially
checking the circuits indicated by the diagnostic trouble code in step 2 , using ”Problem simulation
method”.
(5) DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK
Check the diagnostic trouble codes.
If a malfunction code is output, proceed to ”6” Diagnostic Trouble Code Chart”. If the normal code
is output, proceed to ” 7” “Problem Symptoms Chart”.
Be sure to proceed to ” 6 “Diagnostic Trouble Code Chart” after steps “2” and “3” are completed. If
troubleshooting is attempted only by following the malfunction code stored in the memory, errors
could be made in the diagnosis.
(6) DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a malfunction code is confirmed in the diagnostic trouble code check, proceed to the inspection
procedure indicated by the matrix chart for each diagnostic trouble code.
(7) PROBLEM SYMPTOMS CHART
If the normal code is confirmed in the diagnostic trouble code check, perform inspection in accordance
with the inspection order in the problem symptoms chart.
(8) CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Proceed with diagnosis of each circuit in accordance with the inspection order confirmed in 6 and
7 . Determine whether the cause of the problem is in the sensor, actuators, wire harness and con–
nectars, or the ECU.
(9) SENSOR CHECK
Use the ABS warning light to check if each of the signals from the speed sensors are being input
correctly to the ECU. Instructions for this check are given in the circuit inspection.
(10) REPAIRS
After the cause of the problem is located, perform repairs by following the inspection and replacement
procedures in this manual.
(11) CONFIRMATION TEST
After completing repairs, confirm not only that the malfunction is eliminated, but also conduct a test
drive to make sure the entire ABS system is operating correctly.
BR–141
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Items inside E7 are titles of pages in this manu–
al, with the page number in the bottom portion.
See the pages for detailed explanations.
Vehicle brought to workshop
Customer Problem Analysis
P. BR–142
Check and Clear Diagnostic Trouble Code (Precheck)
P. BR–143–BR–144
.
Symptom
does not
occur
. Symptom Simulation
P. IN–21
Problem Symptom Confirmation
.Symptom..
occurs
Normal
code
Diagnostic Trouble Code Check
Problem Symptoms Chart
P. BR–143
P. BR–14$
Diagnostic Trouble Code Chart
P. BR–160BR–184
Sensor
Circuit
Check
Inspection P. BR–160–BR–184
Check for Fluid Leakage
P. BR–185
Identification of Problem
Repair
Confirmation Test
End
Step
5.
9.
: Diagnostic steps permitting the use
of the TOYOTA hand–held.
BR–142
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK SHEET
BR–143
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
INDICATOR CHECK
When the ignition switch is turned ON, check that the ABS
warning light goes on for 3 seconds.
HINT: If the indicator check result is not normal, proceed to
troubleshooting for the ABS warning light circuit (See page BR–
177).
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK
1. Using SST, connect terminals Tc and E1 of DLC2 or DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
2. Turn the ignition switch to ON.
3. Read the diagnostic trouble code from the ABS warning
light on the combination meter.
HINT: If no code appears, inspect the diagnostic circuit
or ABS warning light circuit (See page BR–180 or BR–177y.
As an example, the blinking patterns for normal code and
codes 11 and 21 are shown on the left.
4. Codes are explained in the code table on page BR–145.
5. After completing the check, disconnect terminals Tc and
E1, and turn off the display.
If 2 or more malfunctions are indicated at the same time,
the lowest numbered diagnostic trouble code will be
displayed first.
BR–144
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK
USING TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER
1. Hook up the Toyota hand–held tester to the DLC2.
2. Read the diagnostic trouble codes by following the prompts
on the tester screen.
Please refer to the Toyota hand–held tester operator’s
manual for further details.
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CLEARANCE
1. Using SST, connect terminals Tc and E1 of DLC2 or DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
2. IG switch ON.
3. Clear the diagnostic trouble codes stored in ECU by de–
pressing the brake pedal 8 or more times within 3 seconds.
4. Check that the warning light shows the normal code.
5. Remove the SST from the terminals of DLC2 or DLC1.
HINT: Cancellation cannot be done by removing the battery
cable or ECU–13 fuse.
BR–145
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a malfunction code is displayed during the diagnostic trouble code check, check the circuit listed for that
code.
Code
ABS Warning Light
Blinking Pattern
Diagnosis
Open or short circuit in ABS solenoid relay circuit
Open or short circuit in ABS motor relay circuit
Open or short circuit in 3–position solenoid circuit for right
front wheel
Open or short circuit in 3–position solenoid circuit for left
front wheel
Open or short circuit in 3–position solenoid circuit for rear
wheels
Right front wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
Left front wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
Right rear wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
Left rear wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
Open circuit in right front speed sensor circuit
Open circuit in left front speed sensor circuit
Faulty rear speed sensor rotor
Open circuit in right rear speed sensor circuit
Open circuit in left rear speed sensor circuit
Low battery positive voltage
Pump motor is locked
Open in pump motor circuit in actuator
Malfunction in ECU
BR–146
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL CHECK
1. When the ignition switch is turned ON, check that the ABS
warning light goes on for 3 seconds.
2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF.
3. Using SST, connect terminals Ts and El of DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
4. Start the engine.
5. Check that the ABS warning light blinks
HINT: If the ABS warning light does not blink, inspect
the ABS warning light circuit (See page BR–177j.
6. Drive vehicle straight forward.
HINT:
•
Drive vehicle at 45–55 km/h (28–34 mph) for several
seconds.
•
If the brake is applied during the check, the check
routine must be started again.
7. Stop the vehicle.
8. Turn the ignition switch to OFF.
9. Disconnect terminals Ts and E1, and connect Te and E1.
10. Turn the ignition switch to ON.
11. Read the number of blinks of the ABS warning light.
HINT: See the list of diagnostic trouble codes shown on
the next page.
If every sensor is normal, a normal code is output (A cycle
of 0.25 sec. ON and 0.25 sec. OFF is repeated).
If 2 or more malfunctions are indicated at the same time,
the lowest numbered code will be displayed first.
12. After performing the check, disconnect terminals Tc and
E1 of DLC1, and ignition switch turned off.
BR–147
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK
USING TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER
1. Perform steps 1. 7. on the previous page.
2. Hook up the Toyota hand–held tester to the DLC2.
3. Read the diagnostic trouble codes by following the prompts
on the tester screen.
Please refer to the Toyota hand–held tester operator’s
manual for further details.
Diagnostic Trouble Code of Speed Sensor Check Function
Code No.
Trouble Area
Diagnosis
Low output voltage of right front speed sensor
•
•
Right front speed sensor
Sensor installation
Low output voltage of left front speed sensor
•
•
Left front speed sensor
Sensor installation
Low output voltage of right rear speed sensor
•
•
Right rear speed sensor
Sensor installation
Low output voltage of left rear speed sensor
•
•
Left rear speed sensor
Sensor installation
Abnormal change in output voltage of right front speed
sensor
•
Right front speed sensor rotor
Abnormal change in output voltage of left front speed
sensor
•
Left front speed sensor rotor
Abnormal change in output voltage of right rear speed
sensor
•
Right rear speed sensor rotor
Abnormal change in output voltage of left rear speed
sensor
•
Left rear speed sensor rotor
BR–148
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS CHART
If a normal code is displayed during the diagnostic trouble code check but the problem still occurs, check
the circuits for each problem symptom in the order given in the table below and proceed to the relevant
troubleshooting page.
Inspection Circuit
Symptoms
ABS does not
operate.
ABS does not operate
efficiently.
Only when 1. 4. are all normal and the problem is still occurring,
replace the ABS ECU.
1. Check the diagnostic trouble code, reconfirming that the normal
code is output.
2. IG power source circuit.
3. Speed sensor circuit.
4. Check the hydraulic circuit for leakage.
Only when 1. 4. are all normal and the problem is still occurring,
replace the ABS ECU.
1. Check the diagnostic trouble code, reconfirming that the normal
code is output.
2. Speed sensor circuit.
3. Stop light switch circuit.
4. Check the hydraulic circuit for leakage.
ABS warning light
abnormal.
1. ABS warning light circuit.
2. ABS ECU.
Diagnostic trouble
code check cannot
be performed.
Only when 1. and 2. are all normal and the problem is still occurring,
replace the ABS ECU.
1. ABS warning light circuit.
2. Tc terminal circuit.
Speed sensor signal
check cannot be
performed.
See page
BR–143
BR–170
BR–166
BR–185
BR–143
BR–166
BR–175
BR–185
BR–177
BR–177
BR–180
BR–183
1. Ts terminal circuit.
2. ABS ECU.
BR–149
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
LOCATION OF CONNECTORS
Location of Connectors in Engine Compartment
1M2–FE Engine:
BR–150
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–151
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Location of Connectors in Engine Compartment
5S–FE Engine:
BR–152
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–153
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Location of Connectors in instrument Panel
BR–154
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–155
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–156
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
J/B No. 1
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–157
BRAKE SYSTEM
Location of Connectors in Body
Sedan:
Coupe:
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–158
BRAKE SYSTEM
Wagon:
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–159
BRAKE SYSTEM
–MEMO–
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–160
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC 11,13 ABS Solenoid and Motor Relay Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The solenoid relay supplies power to each ABS solenoid. After the ignition switch is turned ON, if the
initial check is OK, the relay goes on. The motor relay supplies power to the ABS pump motor. While
the ABS is activated, the ECU switches the motor relay ON and operates the ABS pump motor.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Trouble area
(1) 5V is applied to the solenoid voltage monitor
terminal (AST) for 30 sec. or more, with the
IG switch ON and the warning light on.
(2) 5V is applied to the solenoid voltage monitor
terminal (AST) for 0.02 sec. or more, after the
warning light goes off.
•
•
Open or short in ABS solenoid relay circuit.
ECU.
(1) The motor voltage monitor terminal (MT) is
ON for 5 sec. or more, with the motor relay
operation signal OFF.
(2) The motor voltage monitor terminal (MT) is
OFF for 0.04 sec. with the motor relay opera–
tion signal ON.
•
•
•
Pump motor.
Open in ABS motor relay circuit.
ECU.
Fail safe function: If trouble occurs in the control (solenoid) relay circuit, the ECU cuts off current to
the ABS solenoid relay and prohibits ABS control.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage of ABS ECU connector.
Check and repair harness or connector.
If the same code is still output after the diagnostic trouble code is deleted, check the contact condition
of each connection.
If the connections are normal, the ECU may be defective.
HINT: When DTC13 is output, check that the pump motor ground wire is installed correctly.
BR–161
BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–162
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminals connector.
1 and
4 of ABS ECU
Disconnect the ABS ECU connector.
Measure voltage between terminals A5 1 and
A5 4 of ABS ECU harness side connector.
Voltage: 10–14 V
Check and repair harness or connector.
If the same code is still output after the diagnostic trouble code is deleted, check the contact condition
of each connection.
If the connections are normal, the ECU may be defective.
BR–163
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DTC 21, 22, 23 ABS Actuator Solenoid Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This solenoid goes on when signals are received from the ECU and controls the pressure acting on
the wheel cylinders, thus controlling the braking force.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Trouble area
(1) OV is applied to terminal SFR for 0.035 sec.
while battery voltage is applied to the sole–
noid voltage monitor terminal (AST) and the
ECM power transistor is OFF.
(2) Battery voltage is applied to terminal SFR for
0.035 sec. while battery voltage is applied to
the solenoid voltage monitor terminal (AST)
and the ECM power transistor is ON.
•
•
•
ABS actuator (solenoid valve).
Open or short in right front solenoid circuit.
ECU.
(1) OV is applied to terminal SFL for 0.035 sec.
while battery voltage is applied to the sole–
noid voltage monitor terminal (AST)and the
ECM power transistor is OFF.
(2) Battery voltage is applied to terminal SFL for
0.035 sec. while battery voltage is applied to
the solenoid voltage monitor terminal (AST)
and the ECM power–transistor is ON.
•
•
•
ABS actuator (solenoid valve).
Open or short in left front solenoid circuit.
ECU.
(1) OV is applied to terminal SRA for 0.035 sec.
while battery voltage is applied to the sole–
noid voltage monitor terminal (AST) and the
ECM power transistor is OFF.
(2) Battery voltage is applied to terminal SRA for
0.035 sec. while battery voltage is applied to
the solenoid voltage monitor terminal (AST)
and the ECM power transistor is ON.
•
•
•
ABS actuator (solenoid valve).
Open or short in rear solenoid circuit.
ECU.
Fail safe function; If trouble occurs in the actuator solenoid circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the
solenoid relay and prohibits ABS control.
Check ABS actuator solenoid.
Replace ABS actuator.
If the same code is still output after the diagnostic trouble code is deleted, check the contact condition
of each connection.
If the connections are normal, the ECU may be defective.
BR–164
BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–165
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check ABS actuator solenoid.
Remove the ABS ECU cover and disconnect 6–pin
connector.
Check continuity between terminals 1 and 2, 3 and
4, 5 and6.
Continuity
HINT: Resistance of each solenoid coil is 1.1.
Replace ABS actuator.
If the same code is still output after the diagnostic trouble code is deleted, check the contact condition
of each connection.
If the connections are normal, the ECU may be defective.
BR–166
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DTC 31,32,33,34,35, 36, 38, 39 Speed Sensor Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The speed sensor detects the wheel speed and sends the
appropriate signals to the ECU. These signals are used to
control the ABS system. The front and rear rotors each have
48 serrations. When the rotors rotate, the magnetic field
emitted by the permanent magnet in the speed sensor
generates an AC voltage. Since the frequency of this AC
voltage changes in direct proportion to the speed of the
rotor, the frequency is used by the ECU to detect the speed
of each wheel.
DTC No.
31,32,
33,34
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
(1) No pulse is input when the vehicle speed
reaches 12 km/h (7 mph).
(2) No pulse is input when the vehicle speed
reaches 20 km/h (12 mph).
(3) When the vehicle speed is 10 km/h (7 mph) or
above, a pulse is not input for at least 20 sec.
Trouble area
•
•
•
•
•
•
35,36,
38,39
The hardware detects a constant open is each
sensor circuit.
•
•
Right front, left front, right rear and left rear
speed sensor.
Open in each speed sensor circuit.
Sensor installation
Sensor rotor
ECU.
Right front, left front, right rear and left rear
speed sensor.
Open in each speed sensor circuit.
ECU.
HINT: DTC Nos. 31 and 35 are for the right front speed sensor.
DTC Nos. 32 and 36 are for the left front speed sensor.
DTC Nos. 33 and 38 are for the right rear speed sensor
DTC Nos. 34 and 39 are for the left rear speed sensor.
Fail safe function:
If trouble occurs in the speed sensor circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS
solenoid relay and prohibits ABS control.
BR–167
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check speed sensor.
Replace speed sensor.
Check for open and short in harness and con–
nector between each speed sensor and ECU.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check sensor rotor and sensor installation.
Replace speed sensor or rotor.
Check and replace ABS ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
BR–168
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check speed sensor.
Front
1. Remove front fender liner.
2. Disconnect speed sensor connector.
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of
speed sensor connector.
Resistance: 0.6–1.8 k
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of
speed sensor connector and body ground.
Resistance: 1 MO or higher
Rear
1. Remove the seat cushion (and side seat back).
2. Disconnect speed sensor connector.
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of
speed sensor connector.
Resistance: 0.6–1.8 tc
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of
speed sensor connector and body ground.
Resistance: 1 M or higher
Replace speed sensor.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between each speed
sensor and ECU (See page IN–28).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
BR–169
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Check sensor rotor and sensor installation.
Front
Remove front drive shaft (See SA section).
Check sensor rotor serrations.
No scratches or missing teeth.
Check the front speed sensor installation
The installation bolt is tightened properly.
Rear
Remove the axle hub (See SA section).
Check the sensor rotor serrations.
No scratches or missing teeth.
Check the speed sensor installation
The installation bolt is tightened properly and
there is no clearance between the sensor and
rear axle carrier.
Replace speed speed or rotor.
Check and replace ABS ECU.
BR–170
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DTC 41 +BS Power Source Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This is the power source for the ECU, hence the CPU, and the actuators.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
(1) Voltage of 5V or more, or 9.4V or less, is
applied for at least 60 sec. to terminal +BS
before the ABS primary check and ABS
operation.
(2) Voltage of 5V or more, or 9.4V or less, is
applied to terminal +BS for 0.2 sec. or more,
after the ABS primary check and before ABS
operation.
(3) During ABS operation, voltage of 5V or more,
or 8.8V or less, is applied to terminal +BS for
0.2 sec. or more.
Trouble area
•
•
•
•
Battery.
IC regulator.
Open or short in power source circuit.
ECU.
Fail safe function: If trouble occurs in the power source circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS
solenoid relay and prohibits ABS control.
If the voltage applied to terminal +BS becomes 9.9V or less, the warning light goes
off and ABS control becomes possible.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check battery positive voltage.
Check and repair the charging system.
Check voltage between terminals +BS and GND
of ABS ECU connector.
Check and replace ABS ECU.
Check continuity between terminals GND of
ABS ECU connector and body ground.
Check ECU–IG fuse.
Check for open in harness and connector
between ABS ECU and battery.
Repair or replace harness or
connector.
Check for short in all the harness and
components connected to ECU–IG
fuse (See attached wiring diagram).
BR–171
BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–172
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check battery positive voltage.
Voltage: 10–14 V
Check and repair the charging system.
Check voltage between terminals +BS and GND of ABS ECU connector.
Disconnect ABS ECU connector.
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Measure voltage between terminals IG1 and
GND of ABS ECU connector.
Voltage: 10–14 V
Check and replace ABS ECU.
Check continuity between terminal GND of ABS ECU connector and
body ground.
Measure resistance between terminal GND of ABS
ECU connector and body ground.
Resistance: 1 or less
Repair or replace harness or connector.
BR–173
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Check ECU–IG fuse.
Remove ECU–IG fuse from J/B No. 1.
Check continuity of ECU–IG fuse.
Continuity
Check for short in. a1I the harness and components connected to ECU–IG fuse (See attached wiring diagram).
Check for open in harness and connector between ABS ECU and battery (See page IN–28).
BR–174
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DTC 51 ABS Pump Motor Lock
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Pump motor is not operating normally during
initial check.
Trouble area
• ABS pump motor.
Fail safe function: If trouble occurs in the ABS pump motor, the ECU cuts off current to the solenoid
relay and prohibits ABS control.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check that the pump motor ground wire is installed correctly.
If it is OK, replace the ABS actuator assembly.
BR–175
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Stop Light Switch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This stop light switch senses whether the brake pedal is depressed or released, and sends the signal
to the ECU.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check operation of stop light.
Repair stop light circuit (See page BE–
65).
Check voltage of terminal STP.
Proceed to next circuit inspection
shown on problem symptoms chart
(See page BR–148y.
Check for open in harness and connector be–
tween ABS ECU and stop light switch
(See page IN–27).
Repair–or replace harness or
connector.
Check and replace ABS ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
BR–176
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check operation of stop light.
Check that stop light lights up when brake pedal is depressed and turns off when brake pedal is
released.
Repair stop light circuit (See page BE–65).
Check voltage between terminal STP of ABS ECU connector and
body ground.
Disconnect ABS ECU connector.
Measure voltage between terminal STP and body
ground.
Voltage: 8–14 V
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms chart (See page BR–148 ).
Check for open in harness and connector between ABS ECU and stop
light switch (See page IN–28).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ABS ECU.
BR–177
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
ABS Warning Light Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
If the ECU detects trouble, it lights the ABS warning light while at the same time prohibiting ABS
control. At this time, the ECU records a diagnostic trouble code in memory.
Connect terminals Tc and E1 of the DLC1 or DLC2 to make the ABS warning light to blink and output
the diagnostic trouble code.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Perform troubleshooting in accordance with the chart below for each trouble symptom.
ABS warning light does not light up
Go to step
ABS warning light remains on
Go to step
WIRING DIAGRAM
BR–178
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
ABS warning light does not light up.
Repair or replace ABS warning light
bulb or circuit.
Check ABS warning light.
Check for–open in harness and connector–be–
tween GAUGE fuse and ECU.
ABS warning light remains on.
Is diagnostic trouble code output?
Does ABS warning light go off if short pin is
removed?
YES
Check for short in harness and connector be–
tween DLC1 and ECU terminal WB.
YES
Repair circuit indicated by the code
output.
Check for short in harness and connec–
tor between warning light and DLC1,
DLC2 and ECU terminal WA.
BR–179
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check ABS warning light.
See Combination Meter–Troubleshooting on page BE–1 18.
Replace bulb or combination meter assembly.
Check for open in harness and connector between GAUGE fuse and ECU (See page IN–27).
Is diagnostic trouble code output?
Perform diagnostic trouble code check on page BR–143.
YES
Repair circuit indicated by the code output.
Does ABS warning light go off if short pin is removed?
YES
Check for short in harness and connector
between warning light and DLC1, DLC2 and
ECU terminal WA (See page IN–28).
Check for short in harness and connector between DLC1 and ECU terminal WB (See page IN–27).
BR–180
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Terminal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Connecting terminals Te and E1 of the DLC1 or the DLC2 causes the ECU to display the diagnostic
trouble code by flasing the ABS warning light.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage between terminals Tc and El of
DLC2 or DLC 1.
If ABS warning light does not blink
even after Tc and E1 are connected,
the ECU may be defective.*
Check for open and short in harness and connec–
tor between ABS ECU and DLC2 or DLC1, DLC2
or DLC1 and body ground (See page IN–28).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace A6S ECU.
*: Provided that the harness between
terminal Tc of DLC2 or DLC1 and
terminal Tc of ECU is not open.
BR–181
BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
1 M^–FE:
5S–FE:
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–182
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminals Te and E1 of DLC2 or DLC1.
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Measure voltage between terminals Tc and E1
of DLC2 or DLC1.
Voltage: 10–14 V
If ABS warning light does not blink even after Tc
and E 1 are connected, the ECU may be defective.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ABS ECU
and DLC2 or DLC1, DLC2 or DLC1 and body ground (See page IN–28).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ABS ECU.
BR–183
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Ts Terminal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The sensor check circuit detects abnormalities in the speed sensor signal which can not be detected with
the diagnostic trouble code check.
Connecting terminals Ts and E1 of the DLC1 in the engine compartment starts the check.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage between terminals Ts and E1 of
DLC1.
If ABS warning light does not blink
even after Ts and E1 are connected,
the ECU may be defective.
Check for open and short in harness and connec–
tor between ABS ECU and DLC1, DLC1 and body
ground (See page IN–28).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ABS ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
BR–184
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminals¿¿and E1 of DLC1.
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Measure voltage between terminals Ts and E1
of DLC 1.
Voltage: 10–14 V
If ABS warning light does not blink even after Ts
and E1 are connected, the ECU may be defective.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ABS ECU
and DLC1, DLC1 and body ground (See page IN–28).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ABS ECU.
BR–185
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Check for Fluid Leakage
Check for fluid leakage from actuator or hydraulic lines.
BR–186
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
BRAKE BOOSTER
BRAKE BOOSTER
BRAKE BOOSTER REMOVAL
1. REMOVE MASTER CYLINDER
(See page BR–12)
2. PUSH DOWN CHARCOAL CANISTER
Loosen the clamp screw and push the charcoal canis–
ter down slightly.
BR–187
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
BRAKE BOOSTER
3. DISCONNECT VACUUM HOSE FROM BRAKE BOO
– STER
4. REMOVE PEDAL RETURN SPRING
5. REMOVE CLIP AND CLEVIS PIN
6. REMOVE BRAKE BOOSTER, GASKET AND CLEVIS
(a) Remove the 4 nuts and clevis.
(b) Pull out the brake booster and gasket.
BRAKE BOOSTER INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL BRAKE BOOSTER
(a) Install the booster and a new gasket.
(b) Install the clevis to the operating rod.
(c) Install and torque the booster installation nuts.
Torque: 13 N–m (130 kgf–cm, 9 ft–lbf)
(d) Install the clevis pin into the clevis and brake pedal,
and install the clip to the clevis pin.
(e) Install the pedal return spring.
2. ADJUST LENGTH OF BOOSTER PUSH ROD
(a) Install the gasket on the master cylinder.
(b) Set the SST on the gasket, and lower the pin until its
tip slightly touches the piston.
(c) Turn the SST upside down, and set it on the booster.
(d) Measure the clearance between the booster push rod
and pin head (SST).
Clearance:
0 mm (0 in.)
(e) Adjust the booster push rod length until the push rod
slightly touches the pin head.
3. INSTALL CHARCOAL CANISTER TO ORIGINAL PO–
SITION
4. INSTALL MASTER CYLINDER
5. CONNECT VACUUM HOSE TO BRAKE BOOSTER
6. FILL BRAKE RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID AND
BLEED BRAKE SYSTEM
(See page BR–9)
7. CHECK FOR LEAKS
BR–188
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
BRAKE BOOSTER
8. CHECK AND ADJUST BRAKE PEDAL
(See page BR–8)
Check and adjust the brake pedal, then tighten the
clevis lock nut.
Torque: 25 N–m (260 kgf–cm, 19 ft–lbf)
9. PERFORM OPERATIONAL CHECK
(See page BR–9)
BR–189
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
FRONT BRAKE(Single–Piston Type)
FRONT BRAKE
(Single–Piston Type)
COMPONENTS
BRAKE PADS REPLACEMENT
1. REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
Remove the wheel and temporarily fasten the disc
with hub nuts.
BR–190
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
FRONT BRAKE(Single–Piston Type)
2. INSPECT PAD LINING THICKNESS
Check the pad thickness through the caliper inspec–
tion hole and replace the pads if it is not within the
specification.
Minimum thickness:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
3. LIFT UP CALIPER
(a) Hold the sliding pin on the bottom and loosen the
installation bolt.
(b) Remove the installation bolt.
(c) Lift up the caliper and suspend the caliper with string.
HINT: Do not disconnect the flexible hose from the
caliper.
4. REMOVE FOLLOWING PARTS:
(a) 2 anti–squeal springs
(b) 2 brake pads
(c) 4 anti–squeal shims
(d) 1 MZ–FE engine:
Pad wear indicator
(e) 4 pad support plates
5. CHECK DISC THICKNESS AND RUNOUT
(See page BR–26)
BR–191
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
FRONT BRAKE(Single–Piston Type)
6. INSTALL PAD SUPPORT PLATES
Install the 4 pad support plates.
7. INSTALL NEW PADS
(a) 1 MZ–FE engine:
Install a pad wear indicator plate on the inside pad.
(b) Apply disc brake grease to both sides of the inner anti
–squeal shim.
(c) Install the 2 anti–squeal shims on each pad.
(d) install inside pad with the pad wear indicator plate
facing upward.
(e) Install outside pad.
NOTICE: There should be no oil or grease adhering to the
friction surfaces of the pads or the disc.
(f) Install the 2 anti–squeal springs.
8. INSTALL CALIPER
(a) Draw out a small amount of brake fluid from the
reservoir.
(b) Press in the piston with water pump pliers or similar
implement.
HINT: If the piston is difficult to push in, loosen the
bleeder plug and push in the piston while letting some
brake fluid escape.
BR–192
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
FRONT BRAKE(Single–Piston Type)
(c) Install the caliper.
(d) Hold the sliding pin and torque the installation bolt.
Torque: 34 N–m (350 kgf–cm, 25 ft–lbf)
9. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
10. CHECK THAT FLUID LEVEL IS AT MAX LINE
CALIPER REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT FLEXIBLE HOSE
(a) Remove the union bolt and 2 gaskets from the caliper,
then disconnect the flexible hose from the caliper.
(b) Use a container to catch the brake fluid as it drains
out.
2. REMOVE CALIPER
(a) Hold the sliding pin and loosen the 2 installation bolts.
(b) Remove the 2 installation bolts.
(c) Remove the caliper from the torque plate.
3. REMOVE 2 BRAKE PADS
Remove the inside and outside pads.
CALIPER DISASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE CYLINDER BOOT SET RING AND CYLIN–
DER BOOT
Using a screwdriver, remove the cylinder boot set ring
and cylinder boot from the caliper.
BR–193
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
FRONT BRAKE(Single–Piston Type)
2. REMOVE PISTON
(a) Place a piece of cloth or similar article between the
piston and the caliper.
(b) Use compressed air to remove the piston from the
cylinder.
CAUTION: Do not place your fingers in front of the piston
when using compressed sir.
3. REMOVE PISTON SEAL
Using a screwdriver, remove the piston seal from the
cylinder.
4. REMOVE SLIDING PINS AND DUST BOOTS
(a) Remove the 2 sliding pins from the torque plate.
(b) Using a screwdriver and hammer, tap out the 2 dust
boots.
BR–194
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
FRONT BRAKE(Single–Piston Type)
FRONT BRAKE COMPONENTS
INSPECTION AND REPAIR
1. MEASURE PAD LINING THICKNESS
Using a ruler, measure the pad lining thickness.
Standard thickness:
5S–FE engine
12.0 mm (0.472 In.)
1 MZ–FE engine
11.0 mm (0.433 in.)
Minimum thickness:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Replace the pad if the pad’s thickness is at the mini–
mum thickness or less, or if the pad has excessively
uneven wear.
2. MEASURE DISC THICKNESS
Using a micrometer, measure the disc thickness.
Standard thickness:
28.0 mm (1.102 in.)
Minimum thickness:
26.0 mm (1.024 in.)
Replace the disc if the disc’s thickness is at the mini–
mum thickness or less. Replace the disc or grind it on
a lathe if it is badly scored or worn unevenly.
3. MEASURE DISC RUNOUT
Measure disc runout 10 mm (0.39 in.) from the outer
edge of the disc.
Maximum disc runout:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If runout is greater than maximum, attempt to adjust
to below this maximum figure.
HINT: Before measuring the runout, confirm that the
front bearing play is within specification.
4. IF NECESSARY, ADJUST DISC RUNOUT
(a) Remove the torque plate from the knuckle.
(b) Remove the hub nuts and the disc. Reinstall the disc
1/5 of a turn round from its original position on the
hub. Install and torque the hub nuts.
Torque: 103 N–m (1,050 kgf–cm, 76 ft–lbf)
Remeasure the disc runout. Make a note of the runout
and the disc’s position on the hub.
BR–195
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
FRONT BRAKE(Single–Piston Type)
(c) Repeat (b) until the disc has been installed on the 3
remaining hub positions.
(d) If the minimum runout recorded in (b) and (c) is less
than 0.05 mm (0.0020in.), install the disc in that
position.
(e) If the minimum runout recorded in (b) and (c) is greater
than 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.), replace the disc and repeat
step 3.
(f) Install the torque plate and torque the mounting bolts.
Torque: 107 N–m (1,090 kgf–cm, 79 ft–lbf)
CALIPER ASSEMBLY
1. APPLY LITHIUM SOAP BASE GLYCOL GREASE TO
PARTS INDICATED WITH ARROWS
2. INSTALL DUST BOOTS AND SLIDING PINS
(a) Using a 19 mm socket wrench and hammer, tap in 2
new dust boots into the torque plate.
(b) Confirm that the metal plate portion of the dust boot
fits snugly in the torque plate.
(c). Insert 2 sliding pins into the torque plate.
NOTICE: Insert the sliding pin with sliding bushing into
the bottom side.
3. INSTALL PISTON SEAL AND PISTON IN CYLINDER
BR–196
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
FRONT BRAKE(Single–Piston Type)
4. INSTALL CYLINDER BOOT AND CYLINDER BOOT
SET RING
CALIPER INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL 2 BRAKE PADS
Install the inside and outside pads.
2. INSTALL CALIPER
(a) Temporarily install the caliper on the torque plate with
the 2 installation bolts.
(b) Hold the sliding pin and torque the installation bolt.
Torque: 34 N–m (350 kgf–cm, 25 ft–lbf)
3. CONNECT FLEXIBLE HOSE
Install the flexible hose on the caliper with 2 new
gaskets.
Torque: 29 N–m (300 kgf–cm, 21 ft–lbf)
HINT: Install the flexible hose lock securely in the lock
hole in the caliper.
4. FILL BRAKE RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID AND
BLEED BRAKE SYSTEM
(See page BR–9)
5. CHECK FOR LEAKS
BR–197
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
FRONT BRAKE(2–Piston Type)
FRONT BRAKE
(2–Piston Type)
COMPONENTS
BRAKE PADS REPLACEMENT
1. REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
Remove the wheel and temporarily fasten the disc
with the hub nuts.
BR–198
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
FRONT BRAKE(2–Piston Type)
2. INSPECT PAD LINING THICKNESS
Check the pad thickness through the caliper inspec–
tion hole and replace the pads if it is not within the
specification.
Minimum thickness:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
3. LIFT UP CALIPER
(a) Hold the sliding pin on the bottom and loosen the
installation bolt.
(b) Remove the installation bolt.
(c) Lift up and suspend the caliper.
HINT: Do not disconnect the flexible hose from the
brake caliper.
4. REMOVE FOLLOWING PARTS:
(a) 2 anti–squeal springs
(b) 2 brake pads
(c) 4 anti–squeal shims
(d) 4 pad support plates
(e) Pad wear indicator
5. CHECK DISC THICKNESS AND RUNOUT
(See page BR–33)
6. INSTALL PAD SUPPORT PLATES
Install the 4 pad support plates.
BR–199
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
FRONT BRAKE(2–Piston Type)
7. INSTALL NEW PADS
(a) Install the pad wear indicator plate on the pad.
(b) Apply disc brake grease to both sides of the inner
anti–squeal shim.
(c) Install the 2 anti–squeal shims on each pad.
(d) Install the inner pad with the pad wear indicator plates
facing upward.
(e) Install the outer pad.
NOTICE: There should be no oil or grease adhering to the
friction surface’s of the pads or the disc.
(f) Install the 2 anti–squeal springs.
8. INSTALL CALIPER
(a) Draw out a small amount of brake fluid from the
reservoir.
(b) Press in the piston with a hammer handle or similar
implement.
HINT: If the piston is difficult to push in, loosen the
bleeder plug and push in the piston while letting some
brake fluid escape.
(c) Install the caliper.
(d) Hold the sliding pin and torque the installation bolt.
Torque: 34 N .m (350 kgf–cm, 25 ft–lbf)
9. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
10. CHECK THAT FLUID LEVEL IS AT MAX LINE
CALIPER REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT FLEXIBLE HOSE
(a) Remove the union bolt and 2 gaskets from the caliper,
then disconnect the flexible hose from the caliper.
(b) Use a container to catch the brake fluid as it drains
out.
BR–200
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
FRONT BRAKE(2–Piston Type)
2. REMOVE CALIPER
(a) Hold the sliding pin and loosen the 2 installation bolts.
(b) Remove the 2 installation bolts.
(c) Remove the caliper from the torque plate.
3. REMOVE FOLLOWING PARTS:
(a) 2 anti–squeal springs
(b) 2 brake pads with anti–squeal shims
(c) 4 pad support plates
CALIPER DISASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE CYLINDER BOOT SET RINGS AND CYLIN–
DER BOOTS
Using a screwdriver, remove the 2 cylinder boot set
rings and cylinder boots from the caliper.
2. REMOVE PISTONS
(a) Place a piece of cloth or similar article between the
piston and caliper.
(b) Use compressed air to remove the pistons from the
cylinder.
CAUTION: Do not place your fingers in front of the piston
when using compressed air.
3. REMOVE PISTON SEALS
Using a screwdriver, remove the 2 piston seals from
the cylinder.
BR–201
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
FRONT BRAKE(2–Piston Type)
4. REMOVE SLIDING PINS AND DUST BOOTS
(a) Remove the 2 sliding pins from the torque plate.
(b) Using a screwdriver and hammer, tap out the 2 dust
boots.
FRONT BRAKE COMPONENTS
INSPECTION AND REPAIR
1. MEASURE PAD LINING THICKNESS
Using a ruler, measure the pad lining thickness.
Standard thickness:
11.0 mm (0.433 in.)
Minimum thickness:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Replace the pad if the pad’s thickness is at the mini–
mum thickness or less, or if the pad has excessively
uneven wear.
2. MEASURE DISC THICKNESS
Using a micrometer, measure the disc thickness.
Standard thickness:
28 mm (1.102 in.)
Minimum thickness:
26 mm (1.024 in.)
Replace the disc if the disc’s thickness is at the mini–
mum thickness or less. Replace the disc or grind it on
a lathe if it is badly scored or worn unevenly.
3. MEASURE DISC RUNOUT
Measure disc runout 10 mm (0.39 in.) from the outer
edge of the disc.
Maximum disc runout:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If runout is greater than maximum, attempt to adjust
to below this maximum figure.
BR–202
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
FRONT BRAKE(2–Piston Type)
HINT: Before measuring the runout, confirm that the
front bearing play is within specification.
4. IF NECESSARY, ADJUST DISC RUNOUT
(a) Remove the torque plate from the knuckle.
(b) Remove the hub nuts and the disc. Reinstall the disc
1/5 of a turn round from its original position on the
hub. Install and torque the hub nuts.
Torque: 103 N–m (1,050¿¿f¿cm, 76 ft–lbf)
Remeasure the disc runout. Make a note of the runout
and disc’s position on the hub.
(c) Repeat (b) until the disc has been installed on the 3
remaining hub positions.
(d) If the minimum runout recorded in (b) and (c) is less
than 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.), install the disc in that
position.
(e) If the minimum runout recorded in (b) and (c) is greater
than 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.), replace the disc and repeat
step 3.
(f) Install the torque plate and torque the mounting bolts.
Torque: 107 N–m (1,090 kgf–cm, 79 ft–lbf)
CALIPER ASSEMBLY
1. APPLY LITHIUM SOAP BASE GLYCOL GREASE TO
PARTS INDICATED WITH ARROWS
BR–203
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
FRONT BRAKE(2–Piston Type)
2. INSTALL DUST BOOTS AND SLIDING PINS
(a) Using a 19 mm socket and a hammer, tap in 2 new
dust boots into the torque plate.
(b) Confirm that the metal plate portion of the dust boot
fits snugly in the torque plate.
(c) Insert 2 sliding pins into the torque plate.
NOTICE: Insert the sliding pin with sliding bushing into
the bottom side
3. INSTALL PISTON SEALS AND PISTONS IN CYLIN
– DER
4. INSTALL CYLINDER BOOTS AND CYLINDER BOOT
SET RINGS
CALIPER INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL FOLLOWING PARTS:
(a) 4 pad support plates
(b) 2 brake pads with anti–squeal shims
(c) 2 anti–squeal springs
BR–204
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
FRONT BRAKE(2–Piston Type)
2. INSTALL CALIPER
(a) Temporarily install the caliper on the torque plate with
the 2 installation bolts.
(b) Hold the sliding pin and torque the installation bolt.
Torque: 34 N–m (350 kgf–cm, 26 ft–lbf)
3. CONNECT FLEXIBLE HOSE
Install the flexible hose on the brake caliper with 2
new gaskets.
Torque: 29 N–m (300 kgf–cm, 21 ft–lbf)
HINT: Insert the flexible hose lock securely in the lock
hole in the brake caliper.
4. FILL BRAKE RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID AND
BLEED BRAKE SYSTEM
(See page BR–9)
5. CHECK FOR LEAKS
BR–205
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Drum Brake)
REAR BRAKE
(Drum Brake)
COMPONENTS
REAR DRUM BRAKE REMOVAL
1. INSPECT SHOE LINING THICKNESS
Remove the inspection hole plug, and check the shoe
lining thickness through the hole.
If less than minimum, replace the shoes.
Minimum thickness:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
2. REMOVE REAR WHEEL
3. REMOVE BRAKE DRUM
HINT: If the brake drum cannot be removed easily,
perform the following steps.
(a) Insert a bent wire or an equivalent through the hole in
the brake drum, and hold the automatic adjusting
lever away from the adjuster.
(b) Using a screwdriver, reduce the brake shoe adjust–
ment by turning the adjuster.
BR–206
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Drum Brake)
4. REMOVE FRONT SHOE
(a) Using SST, disconnect the return spring.
SST 09703–30010
(b) Using SST, remove the shoe hold–down spring, cups
and pin.
SST 09718–00010
(c) Disconnect the anchor spring from the front shoe and
remove the front shoe.
(d) Remove the anchor spring from the rear shoe.
5. REMOVE REAR SHOE
(a) Using SST, remove the shoe hold–down spring, cups
and pin.
SST 09718–00010
(b) Using a screwdriver, disconnect the parking brake
cable from the anchor plate.
(c) Using pliers, disconnect the parking brake cable from
the lever and remove the rear shoe together with the
adjuster.
6. REMOVE ADJUSTER FROM REAR SHOE
(a) Remove the adjusting lever spring.
(b) Remove the adjuster together with the return spring.
7. DISCONNECT BRAKE LINE FROM WHEEL CYLIN
– DER
Using SST, disconnect the brake line. Use a container
to catch the brake fluid.
SST 09751–36011
BR–207
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Drum Brake)
8. REMOVE WHEEL CYLINDER
Remove the 2 bolts and the wheel cylinder.
9. IF NECESSARY, DISASSEMBLE WHEEL CYLINDER
Remove the following parts from the wheel cylinder.
• 2 boots
• 2 pistons
• 2 piston cups
• Spring
REAR DRUM BRAKE COMPONENTS
INSPECTION AND REPAIR
1. INSPECT DISASSEMBLED PARTS
Inspect the disassembled parts for wear, rust or
damage.
2. MEASURE BRAKE SHOE LINING THICKNESS
Standard thickness:
5.0 mm (0.197 in.)
Minimum thickness:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
If the shoe lining is less than minimum or shows signs
of uneven wear, replace the brake shoes.
HINT: If any of the brake shoes have to be replaced,
replace all of the rear shoes in order to maintain even
braking.
3. MEASURE BRAKE DRUM INSIDE DIAMETER
Standard inside diameter:
228.6 mm (9.000 in.)
Maximum inside diameter:
230.6 mm (9.079 in.)
If the drum is scored or worn, the brake drum may be
lathed to the maximum inside diameter.
BR–208
•
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Drum Brake)
4. INSPECT REAR BRAKE LINING AND DRUM FOR
PROPER CONTACT
If the contact between the brake lining and drum is
improper, repair the lining with a brake shoe grinder,
or replace the brake shoe assembly.
REAR DRUM BRAKE INSTALLATION
HINT: Assemble the parts in the correct direction as
shown.
1. ASSEMBLE WHEEL CYLINDER
(a) Apply lithium soap base glycol grease to the cups and
pistons as shown.
(b) Assemble the wheel cylinder.
HINT: Install in proper direction only.
• Spring
• 2 cups
• 2 pistons
• 2 boots
2. INSTALL WHEEL CYLINDER
Install the wheel cylinder on the backing plate with the
2 bolts.
Torque: 10 N–m (100 kgf–cm, 7 ft–lbf)
BR–209
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Drum Brake)
3. CONNECT BRAKE LINE TO WHEEL CYLINDER
Using SST, connect the brake line.
SST 09751–36011
Torque: 15 N–m (155 kgf–cm, 11 ft–lbf)
4. APPLY HIGH TEMPERATURE GREASE TO BACK
– ING PLATE AND ADJUSTER
(a) Apply high temperature grease to the brake shoe
contact surfaces.
(b) Apply high temperature grease to the adjuster bolt
threads and ends.
5. INSTALL ADJUSTER ONTO REAR SHOE
Set the adjuster and return spring and install the
adjusting lever spring.
6. INSTALL REAR SHOE
(a) Using pliers, connect the parking brake cable to the
lever.
(b) Pass the parking brake cable through the notch in the
anchor plate.
(c) Set the rear shoe in place with the end of the shoe
inserted in the wheel cylinder and the other end in the
anchor plate.
BR–210
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Drum Brake)
(d) Using SST, install the shoe hold–down spring, cups
and pin.
SST 09718–00010
NOTICE: Do not allow oil or grease to get on the rubbing
face.
7. INSTALL FRONT SHOE
(a) Install the anchor spring between the front and rear
shoes.
(b) Set the front shoe in place with the end of the shoe
inserted in the wheel cylinder and the adjuster in
place.
(c) Using SST, install the shoe hold–down spring, cups
and pin.
SST 09 718–00010
NOTICE: Do not allow oil or grease to get on the rubbing
face.
(d) Using SST, connect the return spring.
SST 09703–30010
8. CHECK OPERATION OF AUTOMATIC ADJUSTING
MECHANISM
(a) Move the parking brake lever of the rear shoe back
and forth. Check that the adjuster turns.
If the adjuster does not turn, check for incorrect
installation of the rear brakes.
(b) Adjust the adjuster length to the shortest possible
amount.
BR–211
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Drum Brake)
(c) Align the adjusting hole on the brake drum and largest
hole on the axle carrier, install the brake drum.
(d) Pull the parking brake lever all the way up until a
clicking sound can no longer be heard.
9. CHECK CLEARANCE BETWEEN BRAKE SHOES
AND DRUM
(a) Remove the brake drum.
(b) Measure the brake drum inside diameter and diameter
of the brake shoes. Check that the difference between
the diameters is the correct shoe clearance.
Shoe clearance:
0.6 mm (0.024 in.)
If incorrect, check the parking brake system.
10. INSTALL BRAKE DRUM
11. INSTALL REAR WHEEL
12. FILL BRAKE RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID AND
BLEED BRAKE SYSTEM
(See page BR–9)
13. CHECK FOR LEAKS
BR–212
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Disc Brake)
REAR BRAKE
(Disc Brake)
COMPONENTS
BR–213
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Disc Brake)
BRAKE PADS REPLACEMENT
1. REMOVE REAR WHEEL
Remove the wheel and temporarily fasten the disc
with the hub nuts.
2. INSPECT PAD LINING THICKNESS
Check the pad thickness through the caliper inspec–
tion hole and replace pads if not within specification.
Minimum thickness:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
3. LIFT UP CALIPER
(a) Remove the flexible hose bracket.
(b) Remove the installation bolt from the torque plate.
(c) Lift up the caliper and suspend the caliper with string.
HINT: Do not disconnect the flexible hose from the
caliper.
BR–214
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Disc Brake)
4. REMOVE FOLLOWING PARTS:
(a) 2 brake pads
(b) 4 anti–squeal shims
(c) 4 pad support plates
5. CHECK DISC THICKNESS AND RUNOUT
(See page BR–50)
6. INSTALL PAD SUPPORT PLATES
Install the 4 pad support plates.
7. INSTALL NEW PADS
(a) Apply disc brake grease to both side of the inner anti
–squeal shims.
(b) Install the 2 anti–squeal shims on each pad.
(c) Install 2 pads with the pad wear indicator plates
facing up ward.
NOTICE: There should be no oil or grease adhering to the
friction surfaces of the pads or the disc.
6. INSTALL CALIPER
(a) Draw out a small amount of brake fluid from the
reservoir.
(b) Press in the piston with water pump pliers or similar
implement.
HINT: If the piston is difficult to push in, loosen the
bleeder plug and push in the piston while letting some
brake fluid escape.
BR–215
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Disc Brake)
(c) Install the caliper and torque the installation bolt.
Torque: 20 N–m (200 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
(d) Install the flexible hose bracket.
Torque: 29 N–m (300 kgf–cm, 22 ft–lbf)
9. INSTALL REAR WHEEL
14. CHECK THAT FLUID LEVEL IS AT MAX LINE
CALIPER REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT FLEXIBLE HOSE
(a) Remove the union bolt and 2 gaskets from the caliper,
then disconnect the flexible hose from the caliper.
(b) Use a container to catch the brake fluid as it drains
out.
2. REMOVE CALIPER
(a) Remove the installation bolt.
(b) Remove the caliper from the torque plate.
BR–216
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Disc Brake)
3. REMOVE 2 PADS
Remove the inside and outside pads.
4. REMOVE MAIN PIN
Loosen the. main pin installation bolt and remove the
main pin.
CALIPER DISASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE SLIDING BUSHING
Pull out the sliding bushing.
2. REMOVE MAIN PIN BOOT
Pull out the main pin boot.
3. REMOVE DUST BOOTS
(a) Place the caliper in vise.
(b) Using a screwdriver and hammer, tap out the 2 dust
boots.
BR–217
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Disc Brake)
4. REMOVE CYLINDER BOOT SET RING AND CYLIN–
DER BOOT
Using a screwdriver, remove the cylinder boot set ring
and cylinder boot from the cylinder.
5. REMOVE PISTON
(a) Place a piece of cloth or similar article between the
piston and the caliper.
(b) Use compressed air to remove the piston from the
cylinder.
CAUTION: Do not place your fingers in front of the piston
when using compressed air.
6. REMOVE PISTON SEAL
Using a screwdriver, remove the piston seal from the
cylinder.
REAR DISC BRAKE COMPONENTS
INSPECTION AND REPAIR
1. MEASURE PAD LINING THICKNESS
Using a ruler, measure the pad lining thickness.
Standard thickness:
10.0 mm (0.394 in.)
Minimum thickness:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Replace the pad if the pad’s thickness is at the mini–
mum thickness or less, or if the pad has excessively
uneven wear.
BR–218
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Disc Brake)
2. MEASURE DISC THICKNESS
Using a micrometer, measure the disc thickness.
Standard thickness:
10.0 mm (0.394 in.)
Minimum thickness:
9.0 mm (0.354 in.)
Replace the disc if the disc’s thickness is at the mini–
mum thickness or less. Replace the disc or grind it on
a lathe if it is badly scored or worn unevenly.
3. MEASURE DISC RUNOUT
Measure the disc runout 10 mm (0.39 in.) from the
outer edge of the disc.
Maximum disc runout:
0.15 mm (0.0059 in.)
If the runout is greater than the maximum, replace the
disc.
HINT: Before measuring the runout, confirm that the
hub bearing play is within specification.
4. IF NECESSARY, REPLACE DISC
(a) Remove the torque plate.
(b) Remove the hub nuts of the temporarily installed disc
and pull off the disc.
(c) Install a new disc and loosely install the hub nuts.
(d) Install the torque plate and tighten the mounting
bolts.
Torque: 47 N–m (475 kgf–cm, 34 ft–lbf)
CALIPER ASSEMBLY
1. APPLY LITHIUM SOAP BASE GLYCOL GREASE TO
PARTS INDICATED WITH ARROWS
2. INSTALL PISTON SEAL AND PISTON IN CYLINDER
BR–219
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Disc Brake)
3. INSTALL CYLINDER BOOT AND SET RING IN CYL–
INDER
4. INSTALL DUST BOOTS
(a) Place the caliper in vise.
(b) Using a 19 mm socket wrench and hammer, tap in 2
new dust boots into the torque plate.
(c) Confirm that the metal plate portion of the dust boot
fits snugly in the torque plate.
5. INSTALL MAIN PIN BOOT
6. INSTALL SLIDING BUSHING
CALIPER INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL MAIN PIN
Install the main pin and torque the main pin installa–
tion bolt.
Torque: 26 N–m (270 kgf–cm. 20 ft–lbf)
BR–220
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Disc Brake)
2. INSTALL 2 PADS
Install 2 pads with the pad wear indicator plate facing
upward.
NOTICE: There should be no oil or grease adhering to the
friction surfaces of the pads or the disc.
3. INSTALL CALIPER
Install the caliper and torque the installation bolt.
Torque: 20 N–m (200 k9f¿cm, 14 ft–lbf)
4. CONNECT FLEXIBLE HOSE
Install the flexible hose on the caliper with 2 new
gaskets.
Torque: 29 N–m (300 kgf–cm, 21 ft–Ibf)
HINT: Insert the flexible hose lock securely in the lock
hole in the caliper.
5. FILL BRAKE RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID AND
BLEED BRAKE SYSTEM
(See page BR–9)
6. CHECK FOR LEAKS
BR–221
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Parking Brake for Rear Disc Brake)
REAR BRAKE
(Parking Brake for Rear Disc Brake)
COMPONENTS
PARKING BRAKE DISASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2. REMOVE REAR DISC BRAKE ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 mounting bolts and remove the disc
brake assembly.
(b) Suspend the disc brake so the hose is not stretched.
3. REMOVE DISC
HINT: If the disc cannot be removed easily, turn the
shoe adjuster
BR–222
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Parking Brake for Rear Disc Brake)
4. REMOVE SHOE RETURN SPRINGS
Using needle–nose pliers, remove the shoe return
springs.
5. REMOVE FRONT SHOE, ADJUSTER AND TENSION
SPRING
(a) Slide out the front shoe and remove the shoe adjuster.
(b) Remove the shoe strut with the spring.
(c) Disconnect the tension spring and remove the front
shoe.
6. REMOVE REAR SHOE
(a) Slide out the rear shoe.
(b) Remove the tension spring from the rear shoe.
(c) Using needle–nose pliers, disconnect the parking
brake cable from the parking brake shoe lever.
(d) Remove the shoe hold–down spring cups, springs
and pins.
PARKING BRAKE COMPONENTS
INSPECTION AND REPAIR
1. INSPECT DISASSEMBLED PARTS
Inspect the disassembled parts for wear, rust or
damage.
BR–223
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Parking Brake for Rear Disc Brake)
2. MEASURE BRAKE SHOE LINING THICKNESS
Using a scale, measure the thickness of the shoe
lining.
Standard thickness:
2.0 mm (0.079 in.)
Minimum thickness:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
If the lining thickness is at the minimum thickness or
less, or if there is excessively uneven wear, replace
the brake shoe.
3. MEASURE DISC INSIDE DIAMETER
Using a vernier caliper, measure the inside diameter of
the disc.
Standard inside diameter:
170 mm (6.69 in.)
Maximum inside diameter:
171 mm (6.73 in.)
Replace the disc if the inside diameter is at the maxi–
mum value or more. Replace the disc or grind it with a
lathe if the disc is badly scored or worn unevenly.
4. INSPECT PARKING BRAKE LINING AND DISC FOR
PROPER CONTACT
Apply chalk to the inside surface of the disc, then
grind down the brake shoe lining to fit. If the contact
between the disc and the brake shoe lining is improp–
er, repair it using a brake shoe grinder or replace the
brake shoe assembly.
5. MEASURE CLEARANCE BETWEEN PARKING
BRAKE SHOE AND LEVER
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance.
Standard clearance:
Less than 0.35 mm (0.0138 in.)
If the clearance is not within the specification, replace
the shim with one of the correct size.
Shim Thickness
Shim Thickness
0.3 mm (0.012 in.)
0.9 mm (0.035 in.)
0.6 mm (0.024 in.)
BR–224
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Parking Brake for Rear Disc Brake)
6. IF NECESSARY, REPLACE SHIM
(a) Remove the parking brake lever, and install the cor–
rect size shim.
(b) Install the parking brake lever with a new C–washer.
(c) Remeasure the clearance.
PARKING BRAKE ASSEMBLY
HINT: Assemble the parts in the correct direction as
shown.
BR–225
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Parking Brake for Rear Disc Brake)
1. APPLY HIGH TEMPERATURE GREASE ON BACK
– ING PLATE
2. APPLY HIGH TEMPERATURE GREASE TO ADJUSTER
3. CONNECT PARKING BRAKE CABLE TO PARKING
BRAKE LEVER
(a) Install the shoe hold–down springs, cups and pins.
(b) Using needle–nose pliers, connect the parking brake
cable to the parking brake lever.
4. INSTALL REAR SHOE
Slide in the rear shoe between the shoe hold–down
spring cup and the backing plate.
NOTICE: Do not allow oil or grease to get on the rubbing
faces.
5. INSTALL TENSION SPRING, FRONT SHOE, AD–
JUSTER AND STRUT
(a) Install the tension spring to the rear shoe.
(b) Install the front shoe to the tension spring.
(c) Install the adjuster between the front and rear shoes.
BR–226
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Parking Brake for Rear Disc Brake)
(d) Install the shoe strut with the spring.
(e) Slide in the front shoe between the shoe hold–down
spring cup and the backing plate.
6. INSTALL SHOE RETURN SPRINGS
Using needle–nose pliers, install the shoe return spr–
ings.
7. INSTALL DISC
(a) Before installing, polish the disc and shoe surfaces
with sandpaper.
(b) Align the hole on the rear axle hub flange and service
hole on the disc.
8. ADJUST PARKING BRAKE SHOE CLEARANCE
(a) Temporarily install the hub nuts.
(b) Remove the hole plug.
(c) Turn the adjuster and expand the shoes until the disc
locks.
(d) Return the adjuster 8 notches.
(e) install the hole plug.
BR–227
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
REAR BRAKE(Parking Brake for Rear Disc Brake)
9. INSTALL DISC BRAKE ASSEMBLY
Install the disc brake assembly and torque the 2 mot
nting bolts.
Torque: 47 N–m (475 kgf–cm, 34 ft–lbf)
10. INSTALL REAR WHEEL
11. SETTLING PARKING BRAKE SHOES AND DISC
(a) LEVER TYPE:
With the parking brake release button pushed in, pull
the lever with 98 N (10 kgf, 22 lbf) of force.
(b) PEDAL TYPE:
Depress the parking brake pedal with 147 N (15 kgf,
33 lbf).
(c) Drive the vehicle at about 50 km/h (31 mph) on a safe,
level and dry road.
(d) Drive the vehicle for about 400 meters (0.25 mile) in
this condition.
(e) Repeat this procedure 2 or 3 times.
12. RECHECK AND ADJUST PARKING BRAKE LEVER/
PEDAL TRAVEL
BR–228
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
PARKING BRAKE
PARKING BRAKE
PARKING BRAKE PEDAL DISASSEMBLY
AND ASSEMBLY
Remove and install the parts as shown.
MAIN POINT OF PEDAL INSTALLATION
INSTALL SHOCK ABSORBER
(a) Loosen the union lock nut.
(b) Install the shock absorber to the pin on the pedal
bracket side, then extend the piston rod fully.
(c) Return the pedal until it hits the cushion.
(d) Make adjustments so that the shock absorber’s union
and the pin on the pedal side are aligned, then turn the
union 1 turn counterclockwise.
(e) Install the shock absorber to the pedal and tighten the
lock nut.
Torque: 13 N–m (130 kgf–cm, 9 ft–lbf)
BR–229
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
PARKING BRAKE
PARKING BRAKE INTERMEDIATE LEVER
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY
Remove and install the parts as shown.
MAIN POINT OF INTERMEDIATE LEVER
INSTALLATION
MEASURE CLEARANCE BETWEEN INTERMEDIATE
LEVER SHAFT AND LEVER
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance.
Standard clearance:
0.09–0.5 mm (0.004–0.02 in.)
If the clearance is not within the specification, replace
the shim with one of the correct size.
Shim Thickness
Shim Thickness
0.3 mm (0.012 in.)
1.2 mm (0.047 in.)
0.6 mm (0.024 in.)
1.5 mm (0.059 in.)
0.9 mm (0.035 in.)
1.8 mm (0.071 in.)
BR–230
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
PROPORTIONING VALVE (P VALVE)
PROPORTIONING VALVE (P VALVE)
P VALVE INSPECTION
1. CONNECT FLUID PRESSURE GAUGE TO P VALVE
2. BLEED AIR FROM FLUID ’PRESSURE GAUGE
3. RAISE MASTER CYLINDER PRESSURE AND CHECK
REAR WHEEL CYLINDER PRESSURE
Master cylinder fluid pressure
Rear brake cylinder fluid pressure
5S–FE w/o ABS:
2,452 kPa (25 kgf/cm2 , 356 psi)
7,845 kPa (80 kgf/cm2 , 1,138 psi)
2,452 kPa (25 kgf/cm2 , 356 psi)
4,452 kPa (45.4 kgf/cm2 , 648 psi)
1 MZ–FE w/o A6S:
2,942 kPa–(30 kgf/cm2 , 427 psi)
2,942 kPa (30 kgf/cm2 , 427 psi)
7,845 kPa (80 kgf/cm2 , 1,138 psi)
4,756 kPa (48.5 kgf/cm2 , 690 psi)
5S–FE w/ABS, 1 MZ–FE w/ABS:
3,432 kPa (35 kgf/cm2 , 498 psi)
7,845 kPa (80
kgf/cm2
, 1,138 psi)
3,432 kPa (35 kgf/cm2 , 498 psi)
5,070 kPa (51.7 kgf/crn2 , 735 psi)
If the rear brake cylinder pressure is incorrect, replace
the P valve assembly.
4. BLEED BRAKE SYSTEM
5. CHECK FOR LEAKS
BR–231
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
LOAD SENSING PROPORTIONING VALVE (LSPV)
LOAD SENSING PROPORTIONING
VALVE (LSPV)
COMPONENTS
FLUID PRESSURE INSPECTION
1. SET REAR AXLE LOAD
(a) Set the vehicle to its curb weight.
(b) Measure the rear axle load and note the value.
(c) Set the rear axle load.
Rear axle load: Rear axle curb weight + 31 kg (68 Ib)
2. INSTALL LSPV GAUGE (SST) AND BLEED BRAKE
SYSTEM
SST 09709–.29017
BR–232
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
LOAD SENSING PROPORTIONING VALVE (LSPV)
3. RAISE FRONT BRAKE FLUID PRESSURE TO FOL–
LOWING SPECIFICATION AND CHECK REAR
BRAKE FLUID PRESSURE
Rear brake fluid pressure:
5S–FE All, 1 MZ–FE w/ABS
Front brake fluid pressure
kPa (kgf/cm2 , psi)
9,807
(100, 1,422)
Rear brake fluid pressure
kPa (kgf/cm2 , psi)
6,139–7,120
(62.6–72.6, 890–1,033)
1 MZ–FE w/o A6S
Front brake fluid pressure
kPa (kgf/cm2 , psi)
12,747
(130 , 1,849)
Rear brake fluid pressure
kPa (kgf/cm2 , psi)
8,865–9,846
(90.4–100.4,1,286–1,428)
HINT:
• Depress the brake pedal while the engine is run–
ning.
• The brake pedal should not be depressed twice
and/or returned while setting to the specified
pressure. Read the value of rear pressure 2 sec–
onds after adjusting to the specified fluid pres–
sure.
4. IF NECESSARY, ADJUST FLUID PRESSURE
(a) Set the shaft length A to initial set length and tighten
the adjusting bolt lock nut.
Initial set length:
26.0 mm (1.02 in.)
(b) Check the rear brake fluid pressure.
(c) If not within the specification, adjust the fluid pres–
sure by changing the shaft length.
Low pressure–Lengthen A
High pressure–Shorten A
HINT:–For every full turn of the adjusting nut, the fluid
pressure will change as follows:
Fluid Pressure changed kPa (kgf/cm2, psi)
5S–FE All, 1 MZ–FE w/ABS
294 (3.0, 42.7)
1 MZ–FE w/o ABS
422 (4.3, 61.2)
BR–233
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
LOAD SENSING PROPORTIONING VALVE (LSPV)
(d) Torque the lock nut.
Torque: 13 N–m (130 kgf–cm, 9 ft–lbf)
If it cannot be adjusted, replace the valve body.
LSPV REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT BRAKE LINES
Using SST, disconnect the brake lines from the valve
body.
SST 09751–36011
2. REMOVE LSPV ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the lock nut and disconnect the adjusting
bolt from the rear suspension arm.
(b) Remove the 2 mounting bolts and remove the LSPV
assembly.
LSPV INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL LSPV ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the valve assembly with the 2 mounting bolts.
Torque: 39 N–m (400 kgf–cm, 29 ft–lbf)
(b) Install the adjusting nut to the adjusting bolt and then
install the adjusting bolt to the rear suspension arm
with the lock nut.
BR–234
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
LOAD SENSING PROPORTIONING VALVE (LSPV)
2. CONNECT BRAKE LINES
Using SST, connect the brake lines.
SST 09751–36011
Torque: 15 N–m (155 kgf–cm, 11 ft–lbf)
3. FILL BRAKE RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID AND
BLEED BRAKE SYSTEM
(See page BR–9)
4. CHECK FOR LEAKS
5. CHECK AND ADJUST FLUID PRESSURE
(See page BR–63)
6. REMOVE LSPV GAUGE (SST) AND BLEED BRAKE
SYSTEM
7. CHECK FOR LEAKS
BR–235
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DESCRIPTION
• ABS controls the brake cylinder hydraulic pressure to all 4 wheels during sudden braking and
braking on slippery road surfaces, preventing the wheels from locking. ABS provides the
following benefits:
(1) Steering round an obstacle with a greater degree of certainty even when panic braking.
(2) Stopping during panic braking while keeping the effect up on stability and steerability to a
minimum, even on curves.
• In case a malfunction occurs, a diagnosis function and fail–safe system have been adopted for
the ABS.
• An ABS actuator manufactured by BOSCH is used on the Camry produced by TMM (Toyota
Motor Manufacturing U.S.A., Inc.).
BR–236
BRAKE SYSTEM
SYSTEM PARTS LOCATION
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–237
BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
TMC Made Vehicle/NIPPONDENSO ABS:
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–238
BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
TMM Made Vehicle/BOSCH ABS:
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–239
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
ECU TERMINALS
TMC Made Vehicle/NIPPONDENSO ABS:
Terminal
No.
Connection
Symbol
Right front solenoid
Terminal
No.
Connection
Symbol
Left rear speed sensor
Ground
Right front speed sensor
DLC2
DLC1, DLC2
ABS control (motor) relay monitor
Stop light switch
Sealed wiring harness
Right rear speed sensor
Left front speed sensor
Left rear speed sensor
Sealed wiring harness
ABS control (solenoid) relay
Ignition switch
Left front solenoid
Left rear solenoid
Ground
Right front speed sensor
A8S control (solenoid) relay monitor
Left front speed sensor
ABS control (motor) relay
Relay ground
Battery
Right rear solenoid
ABS warning light
Parking brake switch
DLC1
Right rear speed sensor
BR–240
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
ECU TERMINALS
TMM Made Vehicle/BOSCH ABS:
Terminal
No.
Connection
Symbol
Terminal
No.
Symbol
Connection
A6S warning fight
Battery
Left rear speed sensor
Ignition switch
DLC1
Left rear speed sensor
Right front speed sensor
Right rear speed sensor
Left front speed sensor
Stop light switch
Right front speed sensor
DLC1, DLC2
Left front speed sensor
Right rear speed sensor
DLC1
Ground
BR–241
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
ECU TERMINALS STANDARD VALUE
TMC Made Vehicle/NIPPONDENSO ABS:
Symbols
(Terminals No.)
STD Voltage (V)
Condition
Always
IG switch ON
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
IG switch ON
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
IG switch ON, AIRS warning light ON
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
IG switch ON, PKB switch ON, Fluid in M/C reservoir above MIN level
IG switch ON, PKB switch OFF, Fluid in M/C reservoir above MIN level
Stop light switch OFF
Stop light switch ON
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
!G switch ON
lG switch ON
AC generation
IG switch ON
Slowly turn right front wheel
AC generation
IG switch ON
Slowly turn left front wheel
AC generation
IG switch ON
Slowly turn right rear wheel
AC generation
IG switch ON
Slowly turn left rear wheel
BR–242
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
ECU TERMINALS STANDARD VALUE
TMM Made Vehicle/BOSCH ABS:
Symbols
(Terminals No.)
STD Voltage (V)
Condition
Always
IG switch ON
IG switch ON, A6S warning light ON
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
IG switch ON, ABS warning light ON
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
Stop light switch OFF
Stop light switch ON
lG switch ON
I G switch 0 N
AC generation
IG switch ON, slowly turn right front wheel
AC generation
IG switch ON, slowly turn left front wheel
AC generation
IG switch ON, slowly turn right rear wheel
AC generation
IG switch ON, slowly turn left rear wheel
BR–243
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANT!–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
ABS ACTUATOR
(TMC Made Vehicle NIPPONDENSO
ABS)
ABS ACTUATOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
Remove and install the parts as shown.
BR–244
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
MAIN POINTS OF REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
1. DISCONNECT AND CONNECT BRAKE LINE
Using SST, disconnect and connect the brake lines
from/to the ABS actuator.
SST 09023–00100
Torque: 15 N–m (155 kgf–cm. 11 ft–lbf)
2. BLEED BRAKE SYSTEM
(See page BR–9)
BR–245
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
ABS ACTUATOR INSPECTION
1. INSPECT BATTERY POSITIVE VOLTAGE
Battery positive voltage:
10–14.5 V
2. DISCONNECT CONNECTORS
(a) Disconnect the connector from the actuator.
(b) Disconnect the 2 connectors from the control relay.
3. CONNECT ACTUATOR CHECKER (SST) TO ACTUA
– TOR
(a) Connect the actuator checker (SST) to the actuator,
control relay and body side wire harness through the
sub–wire harness C and E (SST) as shown.
SST 09990–00150, 09990–00200, 09990–00210
(b) Connect the red cable of the checker to the battery
positive (+) terminal and black cable to the negative
(–) terminal. Connect the black cable of the sub–wire
harness to the battery negative (–) terminal or body
ground.
BR–246
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
(c) Place the ”SHEET A” (SST) on the actuator checker.
SST 09990–00163
4. INSPECT BRAKE ACTUATOR OPERATION
(a) Start the engine, and run it at idle.
(b) Turn the selector switch of the actuator checker to
”FRONT RH” position.
(c) Push and hold in the MOTOR switch for a few sec–
onds.
(d) Depress the brake pedal and hold it until step (g) is com
pleted.
(e) Push the POWER SWITCH, and check that the brake
pedal does not go down.
NOTICE: Do not keep the POWER SWITCH pushed down
for more than 10 seconds.
(f) Release the switch, and check that the pedal goes
down.
–
(g) Push and hold in the MOTOR switch for a few sec
onds, and check that the pedal returns.
(h) Release the brake pedal.
(i) Push and hold in the MOTOR switch for a few sec–
onds.
(j) Depress the brake pedal and hold it for about 15
seconds. As you hold the pedal down, push the
MOTOR switch for a few seconds. Check that the
brake pedal does not pulsate.
(k) Release the brake pedal.
BR–247
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
(l) Turn the selector switch to ”FRONT LH” position.
(m) Repeat (c) to 6), checking the actuator operation sim–
ilarly.
(n) Similarly, inspect ”REAR RH” and ”REAR LH” position.
HINT: When inspecting ”REAR LH” position, push the
REAR LH switch instead of the POWER SWITCH, and
you can inspect in any selector switch position.
(o) Push and hold in the MOTOR switch for a few sec–
onds.
(p) Stop the engine.
5. DISCONNECT ACTUATOR CHECKER (SST) FROM
ACTUATOR
Remove the ”SHEET A” (SST) and disconnect the
actuator checker (SST) and sub–wire harness (SST)
from the actuator, control relay and body side wire
harness.
SST 09990–00150, 09990–00200, 09990–00210 ,
09990–00163
6. CONNECT CONNECTORS
(a) Connect the 2 connectors to the control relay.
(b) Connect the connector to the actuator.
7. CLEAR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES
(See page BR–94)
BR–248
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
ABS ACTUATOR
(TMM Made Vehicle BOSCH ABS)
ABS ACTUATOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
Remove and install the parts as shown.
BR–249
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
MAIN POINTS OF REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
1. DISCONNECT AND CONNECT BRAKE LINE
Using SST, disconnect and connect the brake lines
from/to the ABS actuator.
SST 09751–36011
Torque: 15 N–m (155 kgf–cm, 11 ft–lbf)
2. INSTALL ABS ACTUATOR
NOTICE: Use the bolts which have a notch to securely
ground the actuator ground wire.
3. BLEED BRAKE SYSTEM
(See page BR–9)
BR–250
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
ABS ACTUATOR DISASSEMBLY AND
ASSEMBLY
Remove and install the parts as shown.
BR–251
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
MAIN POINTS OF DISASSEMBLY AND
ASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE AND INSTALL COVER
Using a T15 torx wrench, loosen and tighten the
screw.
Torque: 1.4 N–m(14 kgf–cm, 12 in.lbf)
2. DISCONNECT AND CONNECT 4–PIN AND 6–PIN
CONNECTORS
NOTICE: When installing, place the 4–pin connector’s
cables into the cable guide.
3. REMOVE AND INSTALL ECU
Using T15 and T20 torx wrenches, loosen and tighten
the 5 screws.
Torque: 1.7 N–m(17 kgf–cm, 15 in.–Ibf)
NOTICE: There are 2 kinds of screw, so install a correct
screw into each hole.
4. PERFORM TEST DRIVE
(a) Drive for at least 20 seconds at 30 Km/h (119 mph).
(b) The ABS warning light may not light.
If the ABS warning light lights, read the diagnostic
trouble code.
BR–252
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
FRONT SPEED SENSOR
COMPONENTS
FRONT SPEED SENSOR AND SENSOR
ROTOR SERRATIONS INSPECTION
(REFERENCE)
INSPECT FRONT SPEED SENSOR AND SENSOR
ROTOR SERRATIONS BY USING AN OSCILLO–
SCOPE
(a) Connect an oscilloscope to the speed sensor connec–
tor.
(b) Run the vehicle at 20 km/h (112.4 mph), and inspect
speed sensor output wave.
(c) Check that C is 0.5 V or more.
If not as specified, replace the speed sensor.
(d) Check that B is 30% or more of A.
If not as specified, replace the drive shaft.
FRONT SPEED SENSOR REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
(a) Remove the fender shield.
(b) Disconnect the speed sensor connector.
BR–253
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
2. REMOVE SPEED SENSOR
(a) Remove the 3 clamp bolts holding the sensor harness
to the body and shock absorber_
(b) Remove the speed sensor from the steering knuckle.
FRONT SPEED SENSOR INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL SPEED SENSOR
Install the speed sensor to the steering knuckle.
Torque: 7.8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 MAW)
2. CONNECT SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
(a) Install the sensor harness.
Torque: 5.4 N–m (55 kgf–cm. 48 in.–lbf)
(b) Connect the speed sensor connector.
¿¿”–07
BR–254
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
REAR SPEED SENSOR
COMPONENTS
REAR SPEED SENSOR AND SENSOR
ROTOR SERRATIONS INSPECTION
(REFERENCE)
INSPECT REAR SPEED SENSOR AND SENSOR
ROTOR SERRATIONS BY USING AN OSCILLO–
SCOPE
(a) Connect an oscilloscope to the speed sensor connec–
tor.
(b) Run the vehicle at 20 km/h (12.4 mph), and inspect
speed sensor output wave.
(c) Check that C is 0.5 V or more.
If not as specified, replace the speed sensor.
(d) Check that B is 40 96 or more of A.
If not as specified, replace the rear axle hub.
BR–255
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
REAR SPEED SENSOR REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
(a) Remove the seat cushion and side seatback.
(b) Disconnect the speed sensor connector, and pull out
the sensor wire harness with the grommet.
(c) Remove the 2 clamp bolts holding the sensor wire
harness to the body and shock absorber.
2. REMOVE SPEED SENSOR
Remove the speed sensor from the axle carrier.
REAR SPEED SENSOR INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL SPEED SENSOR
Install the speed sensor to the axle carrier.
Torque: 7.8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.lbf)
2. CONNECT SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
(a) Pass the sensor harness through the body panel hole,
and connect the connector.
BR–256
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
(b) install the grommet securely.
(c) Install the sensor harness.
Torque: 5.4 N–m (55 kgf–cm, 48 in.–lbf)
BR–257
BRAKE SYSTEM
–MEMO–
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–258
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
TROUBLESHOOTING
(TMC Made Vehicle NIPPONDENSO ABS)
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
Perform troubleshooting in accordance with the procedure on the following pages.
(1) CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
Using the customer problem analysis check sheet for reference, ask the customer in as much detail
as possible about the problem.
(2) CHECK AND CLEAR THE DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES (PRECHECK)
If the ABS warning light lights up, and the ABS does not operate, the ECU stores diagnostic trouble
codes corresponding to the problem in memory.
Before confirming the trouble, first check the diagnostic trouble codes to see if there are any
malfunction codes stored in memory. When there are malfunction codes, make a note of them, then
clear them and proceed to ”3” Problem Symptom Confirmation”.
(3) PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION, (4) SYMPTOM SIMULATION
Confirm the problem symptoms. If the problem does not recur, simulate the problem by initially
checking the circuits indicated by the diagnostic trouble code in step “2” , using ”Problem simulation
method”.
(5) DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK
Check the diagnostic trouble codes.
If a malfunction code is output, proceed to ” 6” Diagnostic Trouble Code Chart”. If the normal code
is output, proceed to ” 7” Problem Symptoms Chart”.
Be sure to proceed to ” 6” Diagnostic Trouble Code Chart” after steps “2” and “3” are completed. If
troubleshooting is attempted only by following the malfunction code stored in the memory, errors
could be made in the diagnosis.
(6) DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a malfunction code is confirmed in the diagnostic trouble code check, proceed to the inspection
procedure indicated by the matrix chart for each diagnostic trouble code.
(7) PROBLEM SYMPTOMS CHART
If the normal code is confirmed in the diagnostic trouble code check, perform inspection in accordance
with the inspection order in the problem symptoms chart.
(8) CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Proceed with diagnosis of each circuit in accordance with the inspection order confirmed in 6 and
7 . Determine whether the cause of the problem is in the sensor, actuators, wire harness and
connectors, or the ECU.
(9) SENSOR CHECK
Use the ABS warning light to check if each of the signals from the speed sensors are being input
correctly to the ECU. Instructions for this check are given in the circuit inspection.
(10) REPAIRS
After the cause of the problem is located, perform repairs by following the inspection and replacement
procedures in this manual.
(11) CONFIRMATION TEST
After completing repairs, confirm not only that the malfunction is eliminated, but also conduct a test
drive to make sure the entire ABS system is operating correctly.
BR–259
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Items inside
are titles of pages in this manu–
al, with the page number in the bottom portion.
See the pages for detailed explanations.
Vehicle brought to workshop
Customer Problem Analysis
P. BR–92
2
Check and Clear Diagnostic Trouble Code Precheck)
P. BR–93BR–94
Symptom
does not occur
3
Problem Symptom Confirmation
Symptom Simulation
P.!N–21
Symptom
occurs
5
Normal code
Diagnostic Trouble Code Check
P. BR–93
6
Diagnostic Trouble Code Chart
Problem Symptoms Chart
P. BR–95
Circuit Inspection
P. BR–98
Sensor Check
Check for Fluid Leakage
P. BR–108BR–138
P. BR–139
Identification of Problem
10
Repair
Confirmation Test
End
Step
5
8
Diagnostic steps permitting the
use of the TOYOTA hand–held
tester or TOYOTA break–out–box.
BR–260
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK SHEET
BR–261
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
INDICATOR CHECK
When the ignition switch is turned ON, check that the ABS
warning light goes on for 3 seconds.
HINT: If the indicator check result is not normal, proceed to
troubleshooting for the ABS warning light circuit (See page BR–
130).
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK
1. Disconnect the Short Pin from DLC1.
2. Using SST, connect terminals Tc and E1 of DLC2 or DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
3. Turn the ignition switch to ON.
4. Read the diagnostic trouble code from the ABS warning
light on the combination meter.
HINT: If no code appears, inspect the diagnostic circuit
or ABS warning light circuit (See page BR–134 or BR–130).
As an example, the blinking patterns for normal code and
codes 11 and 21 are shown on the left.
5. Codes are explained in the code table on page BR–95.
6. After completing the check, disconnect terminals Tc and
E1, and turn off the display.
If 2 or more malfunctions are indicated at the same time,
the–lowest numbered diagnostic trouble code will be
displayed first. .
BR–262
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK
USING TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER
1. Hook up the Toyota hand–held tester to the DLC2.
2. Read the diagnostic trouble codes by following the prompts
on the tester screen.
Please refer to the Toyota hand–held tester operator’s
manual for further details.
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CLEARANCE
1. Using SST, connect terminals Tc and E1 of DLC2 or DLC1
and remove the short pin from DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
2. IG switch ON.
3. Clear the diagnostic trouble codes stored in ECU by de–
pressing the brake pedal 8 or more times within 3 seconds.
4. Check that the warning light shows the normal code.
5. Remove the SST from the terminals of DLC2 or DLC1.
6. Connect the Short Pin to DLC1
HINT: Cancellation can also be done by removing the ECU–13
fuse, but in this case, other memory systems will also be
cancelled out.
ECU TERMINAL VALUES MEASUREMENT
USING TOYOTA BREAK–OUT–BOX AND TOYOTA
HAND–HELD TESTER
1. Hook up the Toyota break–out–box and Toyota hand–held
tester to the vehicle.
2. Read the ECU input/output values by following the prompts
on the tester screen.
HINT: Toyota hand–held tester has a ”Snapshot” function.
This records the measured values and is effective in the
diagnosis of intermittent problems.
Please refer to the Toyota hand–held tester/Toyota break–
out–box operator’s manual for further details.
BR–263
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a malfunction code is displayed during the diagnostic trouble code check, check the circuit listed for that
code.
HINT: Using SST 09843–18020, connect the terminals Tc and E1, and remove the short pin.
Code
ABS Warning Light
Blinking Pattern
Diagnosis
Open circuit in ABS control (solenoid) relay circuit
Short circuit in ABS control (solenoid) relay circuit
Open circuit in ABS control (motor) relay circuit
Short circuit in ABS control (motor) relay circuit
Open or short circuit in 3–position solenoid circuit for right
front wheel
Open or short circuit in 3–position solenoid circuit for left
front wheel
Open or short circuit in 3–position solenoid circuit for right
rear wheel
Open or short circuit in 3–position solenoid circuit for left
rear wheel
Right front wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
Left front wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
Right rear wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
Left rear wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
Open circuit in left front or right rear speed sensor circuit
Open circuit in right front or left rear speed sensor circuit
Faulty rear speed sensor rotor
Low battery positive voltage or abnormally high battery
positive voltage
Pump motor is locked
Open in pump motor ground
Always
ON
Malfunction in ECU
BR–264
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL CHECK
1. Turn the ignition switch to OFF.
2. Using SST, connect terminals Ts and E1 of DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
3. Start the engine.
4. Check that the ABS warning light blinks
HINT: If the ABS. warning light does not blink, inspect
the ABS warning light circuit (See page BR–130).
5. Drive vehicle straight forward.
HINT: Drive vehicle faster than 45 km/h (28 mph) for
several seconds.
6. Stop the vehicle.
7. Using SST, connect terminals Tc and E1 of DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
8. Read the number of blinks of the ABS warning light.
HINT: See the list of diagnostic trouble codes shown on
the next page.
If every sensor is normal, a normal code is output (A cycle
of 0.25 sec. ON and 0.25 sec. OFF is repeated).
If 2 or more malfunctions are indicated at the same time,
the lowest numbered code will be displayed first.
9. After performing the check, disconnect terminals Ts and
E1, Tc and E1 of DLC1, and ignition switch turned off.
BR–265
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK
USING TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER
1. Perform steps 1.–6. on the previous page.
2. Hook up the Toyota hand–held tester to the DLC2.
3. Read the diagnostic trouble codes by following the prompts
on the tester screen.
Please refer to the Toyota hand–held tester operator’s
manual for further details.
Diagnostic Trouble Code of Speed Sensor Check Function
Code No.
Diagnosis
Trouble Area
Low output voltage of right front speed sensor
•
•
Right front speed sensor
Sensor installation
Low output voltage of left front speed sensor
•
•
Left front speed sensor
Sensor installation
Low output voltage of right rear speed sensor
•
•
Right rear speed sensor
Sensor installation
Low output voltage of left rear speed sensor
•
•
Left rear speed sensor
Sensor installation
Abnormal change in output voltage of right front speed
sensor
•
Right front speed sensor rotor
Abnormal change in output voltage of left front speed
sensor
•
Left front speed sensor rotor
Abnormal change in output voltage of right rear speed
sensor
•
Right rear speed sensor rotor
Abnormal change in output voltage of left rear speed
sensor
•
Left rear speed sensor rotor
BR–266
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS CHART
If a normal code is displayed during the diagnostic trouble code check but the problem still occurs, check
the circuits for each problem symptom in the order given in the table below and proceed to the relevant
troubleshooting page.
Inspection Circuit
Symptoms
A6S does not
operate.
A6S does not operate
efficiently.
ABS warning light
abnormal.
Diagnostic trouble
code check cannot
be performed.
Speed sensor signal
check cannot be
performed.
Only when 1.–4. are all normal and the problem is still occurring,
replace the ABS ECU.
1. Check the diagnostic trouble code, reconfirming that the normal
code is output.
2. IG power source circuit.
3. Speed sensor circuit.
4. Check the ABS actuator with a checker.
If abnormal, check the hydraulic circuit for leakage (see page
BR–139).
Only when 1.–4. are all normal and the problem is still occurring,
replace the ABS ECU.
1. Check the diagnostic trouble code, reconfirming that the normal
code is output.
2. Speed sensor circuit.
3. Stop light switch circuit.
4. Check the ABS actuator with a checker.
If abnormal, check the hydraulic circuit for leakage (see page
BR–139).
1. ABS warning light circuit.
2. ABS ECU.
Only when 1. and 2. are all normal and the problem is still occurring,
replace the ABS ECU.
1. ABS warning light circuit.
2. Tc terminal circuit.
1. Ts terminal circuit.
2. ABS ECU.
See page
BR–93
BR–123
BR–119
BR–77
BR–93
BR–119
BR–128
BR–77
BR–130
BR–130
BR–134
BR–137
BR–267
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
LOCATION OF CONNECTORS
Location of Connectors in Engine Compartment
1MZ–FE Engine:
BR–268
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–269
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Location of Connectors in Engine Compartment
5S–FE Engine:
BR–270
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–271
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Location of Connectors in Instrument Panel
BR–272
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–273
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–274
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
J/B No. 1
J/B No. 3
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–275
BRAKE SYSTEM
Location of Connectors in Body
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–276
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC 11,12 ABS Control (Solenoid) Relay Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This relay supplies power to each ABS solenoid. After the ignition switch is turned ON, if the initial
check is OK, the relay goes on.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Conditions (1) and (2) continue for 0.2 sec. or
more:
(1) ABS control (solenoid) relay terminal (SR)
voltage: Battery positive voltage
(2) ABS control (solenoid) relay monitor termi–
nal (AST) voltage: 0 V
Conditions (1) and (2) continue for 0.2 sec. or
more:
(1) ABS control (solenoid) relay terminal (SR)
voltage: 0 V
(2) ABS control (solenoid) relay monitor termi–
nal (AST) voltage: Battery positive voltage
Trouble area
•
•
•
ABS control (solenoid) relay.
Open or short in ABS control (solenoid) relay
circuit.
ECU.
•
•
•
ABS control (solenoid) relay.
B+ short in ABS control (solenoid) relay circuit.
ECU.
Fail safe function: If trouble occurs in the control (solenoid) relay circuit, the ECU cuts off current to
the ABS control (solenoid) relay and prohibits ABS control.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage of ABS control relay connector.
Check and repair harness or connector.
Check continuity between relay and actuator
and ECU.
Repair or replace harness or ABS ac–
tuator.
Check ABS control relay.
Replace ABS control relay.
Check for open and short in harness and con–
nector between relay and ECU.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
If the same code is still output after the diagnostic trouble code is deleted, check the contact condition
of each connection.
If the connections are normal, the ECU may be defective.
BR–277
BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–278
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
2 and
Check voltage between terminals
connector.
6 of ABS control relay
Disconnect the ABS control relay connector.
Measure voltage between terminals A72 and
A76 of ABS control relay harness side connec–
tor.
Voltage: 10–14 V
Check and repair harness or connector.
Check continuity between terminals
A4 2,
A4 2 and
A13 18.
5 and
4 and
Disconnect the 2 connectors from ABS actuator.
Check continuity between terminals A7 5 and
A5 4, A5 4 and A4 2, A4 2 and A13 18.
Continuity
HINT: There is a resistance of 4–6 between terminals
A5 4 and A4 2.
Repair or replace harness or ABS actuator.
BR–279
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Check ABS control relay.
Check continuity between each terminal of ABS
control relay.
Continuity (Reference
value 80)
Terminals
1 and
Terminals
5 and
Continuity
Terminals
2 and
Open
1. Apply battery positive voltage between termi–
nals A7 1 and A6 3.
2. Check continuity between each terminal of
ABS control relay.
Terminals
Terminals
5 a rid
Open
2 and
Continuity
Replace ABS control relay.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ABS control relay a
ABS ECU (See page IN–28).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
If the same code is still output after the diagnostic trouble code is deleted, check the contact
condition of each connection.
If the connections are normal, the ECU may be defective.
BR–280
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DTC 13,14 ABS Control (Motor) Relay Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ABS control (motor) relay supplies power to the ABS pump motor. While the ABS is activated,
the ECU switches the control (motor) relay ON and operates the ABS pump motor.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Conditions (1) and (2) continued for 0.2 sec. or
more:
(1) ABS control (motor) relay terminal (MR)
voltage: Battery positive voltage
(2) ABS control (motor) relay monitor terminal
(MT) voltage: 0 V
Conditions (1) and (2) continued for 4 sec. or
more:
(1) ABS control (motor) relay terminal (MR)
voltage: 0 V
(2) ABS control (motor) relay monitor terminal
(MT) voltage: Battery positive voltage
Fail safe function:
Trouble area
•
•
•
ABS control (motor) relay.
Open or short in ABS control (motor) relay
circuit.
ECU.
•
•
•
ABS control (motor) relay.
B+ short in ABS control (motor) relay circuit.
ECU.
If trouble occurs in the control (motor) relay circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the
ABS control (solenoid) relay and prohibits ABS control.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage of ABS control relay connector.
Check and repair harness or connector.
Check continuity between relay and pump motor
and ECU.
Repair or replace harness or ABS ac–
tuator.
Check ABS control relay.
Replace ABS control relay.
Check for open and short in harness and con–
nector between relay and ECU.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
If the same code is still output after the diagnostic trouble code is deleted, check the contact condition
of each connection.
If the connections are normal, the ECU may be defective.
BR–281
BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–282
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminals
ground.
1 of ABS control relay and body
Disconnect the ABS control relay connector.
Measure voltage between terminals A6 1 of ABS
control relay harness side connector and body
ground.
Voltage: 10–14 V
Check and repair harness or connector.
Check continuity between terminals
A4 5, A4 5 and
A13 6.
2 and
3 and
Disconnect the 2 connectors from ABS actuator.
Check continuity between terminals A6 2 and
A5 3, A5 3 and A4 5, A4 5 and A13 6.
Continuity
HINT: There is a resistance of 4–6 between terminals
A5 3 and A4 5.
Repair or replace harness or ABS actuator.
BR–283
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Check ABS control relay.
Check continuity between each terminal of ABS
control relay.
Terminals
3 and
Continuity (Reference
value 62
Terminals
1 and
Open
1. Apply battery positive voltage between termi–
nals A6 3 and A6 4.
2. Check continuity between each terminal of
ABS control relay.
Terminals
1 and
Continuity
Replace ABS control relay.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ABS
control relay and ABS ECU (See page IN–28).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
If the same code is still output after the diagnostic trouble code is deleted, check the contact condition of each
connection.
If the connections are normal, the ECU may be defective.
BR–284
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DTC 21 22 23 24 ABS Actuator Solenoid Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This solenoid goes on when signals are received from the ECU and controls the pressure acting on
the wheel cylinders, thus controlling the braking force.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Conditions (1) through (3) continue for 0.05 sec.
or more:
(1) ABS control (solenoid) relay terminal (SR)
•
voltage: Battery positive voltage
•
(2) Voltage of ABS ECU terminal
•
AST: Battery positive voltage
(3) When power transistor of ECU is ON, voltage
of terminal SFR is 0 V or battery positive voltage.
Conditions (1) through (3) continue for 0.05 sec.
or more:
(1) ABS control (solenoid) relay terminal (SR)
•
voltage: Battery positive voltage
•
(2) Voltage of ABS ECU terminal
•
AST: Battery positive voltage
(3) When power transistor of ECU is ON, voltage
of terminal SFL is 0 V or battery positive voltage.
Trouble area
ABS actuator.
Open or short in SFR circuit.
ECU.
ABS actuator.
Open or short in SFL circuit.
ECU.
Conditions (1) through (3) continue for 0.05 sec.
or more:
(1) ABS control (solenoid) relay terminal (SR)
•
voltage: Battery positive voltage
•
(2) Voltage of ABS ECU terminal
•
AST: Battery positive voltage
(3) When power transistor of ECU is ON, voltage
of terminal SRR is 0 V or battery positive voltage.
ABS actuator.
Open or short in SRR circuit.
ECU.
Conditions (1) through (3) continue for 0.05 sec.
or more:
(1) ABS control (solenoid) relay terminal (SR)
•
voltage: Battery positive voltage
•
(2) Voltage of ABS ECU terminal
•
AST: Battery positive voltage
(3) When power transistor of ECU is ON, voltage
of terminal SRL is 0 V or battery positive voltage.
ABS actuator.
Open or short in SRL circuit.
ECU.
Fail safe function: If trouble occurs in the actuator solenoid circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the
control (solenoid) relay and prohibits ABS control.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check ABS actuator solenoid.
Replace ABS actuator.
Check for open and short in harness and con–
nector between ECU and actuator.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
If the same code is still output after the diagnostic trouble code is deleted, check the contact condition
of each connection.
If the connections are normal, the ECU may be defective.
BR–285
BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–286
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check ABS actuator solenoid.
Disconnect the 2 connectors from ABS actuator.
Check continuity between terminals A5 4and A4
1, 3, 4, 6 of ABS actuator connector.
Continuity
HINT: Resistance of each solenoid coil is 1.2.
Replace ABS actuator.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ABS ECU and
actuator (See page IN–28).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
If the same code is still output after the diagnostic trouble code is deleted, check the contact condition of each
connection.
If the connections are normal, the ECU may be defective.
BR–287
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DTC 31, 32, 33, 34, 35, 36 Speed Sensor Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The speed sensor detects the wheel speed and sends the
appropriate signals to the ECU. These signals are used to
control the ABS system. The front and rear rotors each have
48 serrations. When the rotors rotate, the magnetic field
emitted by the permanent magnet in the speed sensor
generates an AC voltage. Since the frequency of this AC
voltage changes in direct proportion to the speed of the
rotor, the frequency is used by the ECU to detect the speed
of each wheel.
DTC No.
31,32,
33,34
Trouble area
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Detection of any of conditions (1) through (3):
(1) At vehicle speed of 10 km/h (6 mph) or
more, pulses are not input for 5 sec.
(2) Momentary interruption of the speed sensor
signal occurs at least 7 times in the time be–
tween switching the ignition switch ON and
switching it OFF.
(3) Abnormal fluctuation of speed sensor signals
with the vehicle speed 20 km/h (12 mph) or
more.
Speed sensor signal is not input for about 1 sec.
while the left front and right rear speed sensor
signals are being checked with the IG switch ON.
Speed sensor signal is not input for about 1 sec.
while the right front and left rear speed sensor
signals are being checked with the IG switch ON.
•
Right front, left front, right rear and left rear
speed sensor.
Open or short in each speed sensor circuit.
ECU.
•
•
•
•
•
Open in left front or right rear speed sensor
circuit.
ECU.
Open in right front or left rear speed sensor
circuit.
•
ECU.
HINT: DTC No. 31 is for the right front speed sensor.
DTC No. 32 is for the left front speed sensor.
DTC No. 33 is for the right rear speed sensor
DTC No. 34 is for the left rear speed sensor.
Fail safe function:
If trouble occurs in the speed sensor circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS
control (solenoid) relay and prohibits ABS control.
BR–288
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check speed sensor.
Replace speed sensor.
Check for open and short in harness and con–
hector between each speed sensor and ECU.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check sensor rotor and sensor installation.
Replace speed sensor or rotor.
Check and replace ABS ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
BR–289
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check speed sensor.
Front
1. Remove front fender liner.
2. Disconnect speed sensor connector.
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of
speed sensor connector.
Resistance: 0.6–1.8 k
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of
speed sensor connector and body ground.
Resistance: 1 M or higher
Rear
1. Remove the seat cushion and side seat back.
2. Disconnect speed sensor connector.
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of
speed sensor connector.
Resistance: 0.9–1.3 k
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of
speed sensor connector and body ground.
Resistance: 1 M or higher
Replace speed sensor.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between each
speed sensor and ECU (See page IN–28).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
BR–290
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Check sensor rotor and sensor installation.
Front
Remove front drive shaft (See SA section).
Check sensor–rotor serrations.
No scratches or missing teeth.
Check the front speed sensor installation
The installation bolt is tightened properly.
Rear
Remove the axle hub (See SA section).
Check the sensor rotor serrations.
No scratches or missing teeth.
Check the speed sensor installation
The installation bolt is tightened properly and
there is no clearance between the sensor and
rear axle carrier.
Replace speed speed or rotor.
Check and replace ABS ECU.
BR–291
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DTC 41 IG Power Source Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This is the power source for the ECU, hence the CPU and the actuators.
DTC No.
Trouble area
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Vehicle speed is 3 km/h (1.9 mph) or more and
voltage of ECU terminal IG1 remains at more
than 17 V or below 9.5 V for more than 10 sec.
•
•
•
•
Battery.
IC regulator.
Open or short in power source circuit.
ECU.
Fail safe function: If trouble occurs in the power source circuit, the ECU cuts oft current to the ABS
control (solenoid) relay and prohibits ABS control.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check battery positive voltage.
Check and repair the charging system.
Check voltage between terminals IG1 and GND
of ABS ECU connector.
Check and replace ABS ECU.
Check continuity between terminals GND of ABS
ECU connector and body ground.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check ECU–IG fuse.
Check for short in all the harness and
components connected to ECU–IG fuse
(See attached wiring diagram).
Check for open in harness and connector between
ABS ECU and battery.
BR–292
BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–293
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Remove ABS ECU with connectors still connected.
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Measure voltage between terminals IG1 and
G N D of ABS ECU connector.
Voltage: 10–14 V
Check continuity between terminals GND of ABS ECU connector and
body ground.
Measure resistance between terminals GND of
ABS ECU connector and body ground.
Resistance: 1 or less
BR–294
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Check ECU–IG fuse.
Remove ECU–IG fuse from J/6 No. 1.
Check continuity of ECU–IG fuse.
Continuity
Check for short in all the harness and components connected to ECU–IG fuse (See attached
wiring diagram).
Check for open in harness and connector between ABS ECU and battery (See page IN–28).
BR–295
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DTC 51 ABS Pump Motor Lock
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Pump motor is not operating normally during
initial check.
Trouble area
• ABS pump motor.
Fail safe function: If trouble occurs in the ABS pump motor, the ECU cuts off current to the control
(solenoid) relay and prohibits ABS control.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
See inspection of ABS actuator (See page BR–77).
WIRING DIAGRAM
(Reference)
BR–296
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Stop Light Switch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This stop light switch senses whether the brake pedal is depressed or released, and sends the signal
to the ECU.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check operation of stop light.
Repair stop light circuit (See page BE–
65).
Check voltage of terminal STP.
Proceed to next circuit inspection
shown on problem symptoms chart
(See page BR–98).
Check for open in harness and connector be–
tween ABS ECU and stop light switch (See page
IN–27).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ABS ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
BR–297
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check operation of stop light.
Check that stop light lights up when brake pedal is depressed and turns off when brake pedal is
released.
Repair stop light circuit (See page BE–65).
Check voltage between terminal STP of ABS ECU and body ground.
Remove ABS ECU with connectors still connected.
Measure voltage between terminal STP of ABS
ECU and body ground when brake pedal is de–
pressed.
Voltage: 8–14 V
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms chart (See page BR–98).
Check for open in harness and connector between ABS ECU and stop light
switch (See page IN–28).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ABS ECU.
BR–298
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
ABS Warning Light Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
If the ECU detects trouble, it lights the ABS warning light while at the same time prohibiting ABS
control. At this time, the ECU records a diagnostic trouble code in memory.
After removing the short pin of the DLC1, connect terminals Tc and E1 of the DLC1 or DLC2 to make
the ABS warning light to blink and output the diagnostic trouble code.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Perform troubleshooting in accordance with the chart below for each trouble symptom.
ABS warning light does not light up
G o to step
1
. . ...
ABS warning light remains on
WIRING DIAGRAM
Go to step
3
BR–299
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
ABS warning light does not light up.
Check ABS warning light.
Repair or replace ABS warning light
bulb or circuit.
Check ABS control relay.
Replace ABS control relay.
Check for open in harness and connector between
GAUGE fuse and J/B No. 3.
A6S warning light remains on.
Is diagnostic trouble code output?
Does ABS warning light go off if short pin is
removed?
YES
Repair circuit indicated by the code
output.
Check for–short in harness and connec–
tor between warning light and DLC1
and ECU.
YES
Check ABS control relay.
Check for short in harness and connector between
DLC1 and ABS control relay.
Replace ABS control relay.
BR–300
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check ABS warning light.
See Combination Meter Troubleshooting on page BE–1 18.
Replace bulb or combination meter assembly.
Check ABS control relay.
Disconnect the connectors from control relay.
Check continuity between each terminal of ABS
control relay.
Terminals
1 and
Continuity (Reference
value 80)
Terminals
5 and
Continuity
Terminals
2 and
Open
1. Apply battery positive voltage between termi–
nals A7 1 and A6 3.
2. Check continuity between each terminal of
ABS control relay.
Terminals
Terminals
5 and
2 and
Open
Continuity
Connect the test lead to terminal 4 of A7 and
the lead to terminal 5 of A7 . Check continuity
between the terminals.
Continuity
If there is no continuity, connect the test lead to
terminal 4 of A7 and the lead to terminal 5
of A7 . Recheck continuity between terminals.
Replace ABS control relay.
Check for open in harness and connector between DLC1 and A6S control relay and body ground
(See page IN–27).
BR–301
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Is diagnostic trouble code output?
Perform diagnostic trouble code check on page BR–93.
YES
Repair circuit indicated by the code output.
Does ABS warning light go off if short pin is removed?
YES
Check for short in harness and connector
between warning light and DLC1 and ECU (See
page IN–28 ).
Check ABS control relay (See step No. 2).
Replace ABS control relay.
Check for short in harness and connector between DLC1 and ABS control relay (See page
IN–28).
BR–302
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Tc Terminal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Connecting terminals Te and E1 of the DLC1 or the DLC2 causes the ECU to display the diagnostic
trouble code by flasing the ABS warning light.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage between terminals Tc and E1 of
DLC2 or DLC 1.
Check for open and short in harness and connec–
tor between ABS ECU and DLC2 or DLC1, DLC2
or DLC1 and body ground (See page IN–28).
Check and replace ABS ECU.
If ABS warning light does not blink
even after Tc and E1 are connected,
the ECU may be defective.*
Repair or replace harness or connector.
*: Provided that the harness between
terminal Tc of DLC2 or DLC1 and
terminal Te of ECU is not open.
BR–303
BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
1 MZ–FE:
5S–FE:
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–304
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminals Te and E1 of DLC2 or DLC1.
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Measure voltage between terminals Tc and E1
of DLC2 or DLC1.
Voltage: 10–14 V
If ABS warning light does not blink even after Tc
and E1 are connected, the ECU may be defective.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ABS ECU
and DLC2 or DLC1, DLC2 or DLC1 and body ground (See page IN–28).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ABS ECU.
BR–305
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Ts Terminal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The sensor check circuit detects abnormalities in the speed sensor signal which cannot be detected
with the diagnostic trouble code check.
Connecting terminals Ts and E1 of the DLC1 in the engine compartment starts the check.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage between terminals Ts and E1 of
DLC 1.
If ABS warning light does not blink
even after Ts and E 1 are connected,
the ECU may be defective.
Check for open and short in harness and connec–
tor between ABS ECU and DLC1, DLC1 and body
ground (See page IN–28).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ABS ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
BR–306
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminals and E1 of DLC1.
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Measure voltage between terminals Ts and E1
of DLC 1.
Voltage: 10–14 V
If ABS warning light does not blink even after Ts
and E1 are connected, the ECU may be defective.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ABS ECU
and DLC1, DLC1 and body ground (See page IN–28).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ABS ECU.
BR–307
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Check for Fluid Leakage
Check for fluid leakage from actuator or hydraulic lines.
BR–308
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
TROUBLESHOOTING
(TMM Made Vehicle BOSCH ABS)
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
Perform troubleshooting in accordance with the procedure on the following pages.
(1) CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
Using the customer problem analysis check sheet for reference, ask the customer in as much detail
as possible about the problem.
(2) CHECK AND CLEAR THE DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES (PRECHECK)
If the ABS warning light lights up, and the ABS does not operate, the ECU stores diagnostic trouble
codes corresponding to the problem in memory.
Before confirming the trouble, first check the diagnostic trouble codes to see if there are any malfunc–
tion codes stored in memory. When there are malfunction codes, make a note of them, then clear
them and proceed to ”3” Problem Symptom Confirmation”.
(3) PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION, (4) SYMPTOM SIMULATION
Confirm the problem symptoms. If the problem does not recur, simulate the problem by initially
checking the circuits indicated by the diagnostic trouble code in step 2 , using ”Problem simulation
method”.
(5) DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK
Check the diagnostic trouble codes.
If a malfunction code is output, proceed to ”6” Diagnostic Trouble Code Chart”. If the normal code
is output, proceed to ” 7” “Problem Symptoms Chart”.
Be sure to proceed to ” 6 “Diagnostic Trouble Code Chart” after steps “2” and “3” are completed. If
troubleshooting is attempted only by following the malfunction code stored in the memory, errors
could be made in the diagnosis.
(6) DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a malfunction code is confirmed in the diagnostic trouble code check, proceed to the inspection
procedure indicated by the matrix chart for each diagnostic trouble code.
(7) PROBLEM SYMPTOMS CHART
If the normal code is confirmed in the diagnostic trouble code check, perform inspection in accordance
with the inspection order in the problem symptoms chart.
(8) CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Proceed with diagnosis of each circuit in accordance with the inspection order confirmed in 6 and
7 . Determine whether the cause of the problem is in the sensor, actuators, wire harness and con–
nectars, or the ECU.
(9) SENSOR CHECK
Use the ABS warning light to check if each of the signals from the speed sensors are being input
correctly to the ECU. Instructions for this check are given in the circuit inspection.
(10) REPAIRS
After the cause of the problem is located, perform repairs by following the inspection and replacement
procedures in this manual.
(11) CONFIRMATION TEST
After completing repairs, confirm not only that the malfunction is eliminated, but also conduct a test
drive to make sure the entire ABS system is operating correctly.
BR–309
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Items inside E7 are titles of pages in this manu–
al, with the page number in the bottom portion.
See the pages for detailed explanations.
Vehicle brought to workshop
Customer Problem Analysis
P. BR–142
Check and Clear Diagnostic Trouble Code (Precheck)
P. BR–143–BR–144
.
Symptom
does not
occur
. Symptom Simulation
P. IN–21
Problem Symptom Confirmation
.Symptom..
occurs
Normal
code
Diagnostic Trouble Code Check
Problem Symptoms Chart
P. BR–143
P. BR–14$
Diagnostic Trouble Code Chart
P. BR–160BR–184
Sensor
Circuit
Check
Inspection P. BR–160–BR–184
Check for Fluid Leakage
P. BR–185
Identification of Problem
Repair
Confirmation Test
End
Step
5.
9.
: Diagnostic steps permitting the use
of the TOYOTA hand–held.
BR–310
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK SHEET
BR–311
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
INDICATOR CHECK
When the ignition switch is turned ON, check that the ABS
warning light goes on for 3 seconds.
HINT: If the indicator check result is not normal, proceed to
troubleshooting for the ABS warning light circuit (See page BR–
177).
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK
1. Using SST, connect terminals Tc and E1 of DLC2 or DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
2. Turn the ignition switch to ON.
3. Read the diagnostic trouble code from the ABS warning
light on the combination meter.
HINT: If no code appears, inspect the diagnostic circuit
or ABS warning light circuit (See page BR–180 or BR–177y.
As an example, the blinking patterns for normal code and
codes 11 and 21 are shown on the left.
4. Codes are explained in the code table on page BR–145.
5. After completing the check, disconnect terminals Tc and
E1, and turn off the display.
If 2 or more malfunctions are indicated at the same time,
the lowest numbered diagnostic trouble code will be
displayed first.
BR–312
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK
USING TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER
1. Hook up the Toyota hand–held tester to the DLC2.
2. Read the diagnostic trouble codes by following the prompts
on the tester screen.
Please refer to the Toyota hand–held tester operator’s
manual for further details.
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CLEARANCE
1. Using SST, connect terminals Tc and E1 of DLC2 or DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
2. IG switch ON.
3. Clear the diagnostic trouble codes stored in ECU by de–
pressing the brake pedal 8 or more times within 3 seconds.
4. Check that the warning light shows the normal code.
5. Remove the SST from the terminals of DLC2 or DLC1.
HINT: Cancellation cannot be done by removing the battery
cable or ECU–13 fuse.
BR–313
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a malfunction code is displayed during the diagnostic trouble code check, check the circuit listed for that
code.
Code
ABS Warning Light
Blinking Pattern
Diagnosis
Open or short circuit in ABS solenoid relay circuit
Open or short circuit in ABS motor relay circuit
Open or short circuit in 3–position solenoid circuit for right
front wheel
Open or short circuit in 3–position solenoid circuit for left
front wheel
Open or short circuit in 3–position solenoid circuit for rear
wheels
Right front wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
Left front wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
Right rear wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
Left rear wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
Open circuit in right front speed sensor circuit
Open circuit in left front speed sensor circuit
Faulty rear speed sensor rotor
Open circuit in right rear speed sensor circuit
Open circuit in left rear speed sensor circuit
Low battery positive voltage
Pump motor is locked
Open in pump motor circuit in actuator
Malfunction in ECU
BR–314
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL CHECK
1. When the ignition switch is turned ON, check that the ABS
warning light goes on for 3 seconds.
2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF.
3. Using SST, connect terminals Ts and El of DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
4. Start the engine.
5. Check that the ABS warning light blinks
HINT: If the ABS warning light does not blink, inspect
the ABS warning light circuit (See page BR–177j.
6. Drive vehicle straight forward.
HINT:
•
Drive vehicle at 45–55 km/h (28–34 mph) for several
seconds.
•
If the brake is applied during the check, the check
routine must be started again.
7. Stop the vehicle.
8. Turn the ignition switch to OFF.
9. Disconnect terminals Ts and E1, and connect Te and E1.
10. Turn the ignition switch to ON.
11. Read the number of blinks of the ABS warning light.
HINT: See the list of diagnostic trouble codes shown on
the next page.
If every sensor is normal, a normal code is output (A cycle
of 0.25 sec. ON and 0.25 sec. OFF is repeated).
If 2 or more malfunctions are indicated at the same time,
the lowest numbered code will be displayed first.
12. After performing the check, disconnect terminals Tc and
E1 of DLC1, and ignition switch turned off.
BR–315
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK
USING TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER
1. Perform steps 1. 7. on the previous page.
2. Hook up the Toyota hand–held tester to the DLC2.
3. Read the diagnostic trouble codes by following the prompts
on the tester screen.
Please refer to the Toyota hand–held tester operator’s
manual for further details.
Diagnostic Trouble Code of Speed Sensor Check Function
Code No.
Trouble Area
Diagnosis
Low output voltage of right front speed sensor
•
•
Right front speed sensor
Sensor installation
Low output voltage of left front speed sensor
•
•
Left front speed sensor
Sensor installation
Low output voltage of right rear speed sensor
•
•
Right rear speed sensor
Sensor installation
Low output voltage of left rear speed sensor
•
•
Left rear speed sensor
Sensor installation
Abnormal change in output voltage of right front speed
sensor
•
Right front speed sensor rotor
Abnormal change in output voltage of left front speed
sensor
•
Left front speed sensor rotor
Abnormal change in output voltage of right rear speed
sensor
•
Right rear speed sensor rotor
Abnormal change in output voltage of left rear speed
sensor
•
Left rear speed sensor rotor
BR–316
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS CHART
If a normal code is displayed during the diagnostic trouble code check but the problem still occurs, check
the circuits for each problem symptom in the order given in the table below and proceed to the relevant
troubleshooting page.
Inspection Circuit
Symptoms
ABS does not
operate.
ABS does not operate
efficiently.
Only when 1. 4. are all normal and the problem is still occurring,
replace the ABS ECU.
1. Check the diagnostic trouble code, reconfirming that the normal
code is output.
2. IG power source circuit.
3. Speed sensor circuit.
4. Check the hydraulic circuit for leakage.
Only when 1. 4. are all normal and the problem is still occurring,
replace the ABS ECU.
1. Check the diagnostic trouble code, reconfirming that the normal
code is output.
2. Speed sensor circuit.
3. Stop light switch circuit.
4. Check the hydraulic circuit for leakage.
ABS warning light
abnormal.
1. ABS warning light circuit.
2. ABS ECU.
Diagnostic trouble
code check cannot
be performed.
Only when 1. and 2. are all normal and the problem is still occurring,
replace the ABS ECU.
1. ABS warning light circuit.
2. Tc terminal circuit.
Speed sensor signal
check cannot be
performed.
See page
BR–143
BR–170
BR–166
BR–185
BR–143
BR–166
BR–175
BR–185
BR–177
BR–177
BR–180
BR–183
1. Ts terminal circuit.
2. ABS ECU.
BR–317
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
LOCATION OF CONNECTORS
Location of Connectors in Engine Compartment
1M2–FE Engine:
BR–318
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–319
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Location of Connectors in Engine Compartment
5S–FE Engine:
BR–320
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–321
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Location of Connectors in instrument Panel
BR–322
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–323
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–324
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
J/B No. 1
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–325
BRAKE SYSTEM
Location of Connectors in Body
Sedan:
Coupe:
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–326
BRAKE SYSTEM
Wagon:
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–327
BRAKE SYSTEM
–MEMO–
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–328
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC 11,13 ABS Solenoid and Motor Relay Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The solenoid relay supplies power to each ABS solenoid. After the ignition switch is turned ON, if the
initial check is OK, the relay goes on. The motor relay supplies power to the ABS pump motor. While
the ABS is activated, the ECU switches the motor relay ON and operates the ABS pump motor.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Trouble area
(1) 5V is applied to the solenoid voltage monitor
terminal (AST) for 30 sec. or more, with the
IG switch ON and the warning light on.
(2) 5V is applied to the solenoid voltage monitor
terminal (AST) for 0.02 sec. or more, after the
warning light goes off.
•
•
Open or short in ABS solenoid relay circuit.
ECU.
(1) The motor voltage monitor terminal (MT) is
ON for 5 sec. or more, with the motor relay
operation signal OFF.
(2) The motor voltage monitor terminal (MT) is
OFF for 0.04 sec. with the motor relay opera–
tion signal ON.
•
•
•
Pump motor.
Open in ABS motor relay circuit.
ECU.
Fail safe function: If trouble occurs in the control (solenoid) relay circuit, the ECU cuts off current to
the ABS solenoid relay and prohibits ABS control.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage of ABS ECU connector.
Check and repair harness or connector.
If the same code is still output after the diagnostic trouble code is deleted, check the contact condition
of each connection.
If the connections are normal, the ECU may be defective.
HINT: When DTC13 is output, check that the pump motor ground wire is installed correctly.
BR–329
BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–330
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminals connector.
1 and
4 of ABS ECU
Disconnect the ABS ECU connector.
Measure voltage between terminals A5 1 and
A5 4 of ABS ECU harness side connector.
Voltage: 10–14 V
Check and repair harness or connector.
If the same code is still output after the diagnostic trouble code is deleted, check the contact condition
of each connection.
If the connections are normal, the ECU may be defective.
BR–331
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DTC 21, 22, 23 ABS Actuator Solenoid Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This solenoid goes on when signals are received from the ECU and controls the pressure acting on
the wheel cylinders, thus controlling the braking force.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Trouble area
(1) OV is applied to terminal SFR for 0.035 sec.
while battery voltage is applied to the sole–
noid voltage monitor terminal (AST) and the
ECM power transistor is OFF.
(2) Battery voltage is applied to terminal SFR for
0.035 sec. while battery voltage is applied to
the solenoid voltage monitor terminal (AST)
and the ECM power transistor is ON.
•
•
•
ABS actuator (solenoid valve).
Open or short in right front solenoid circuit.
ECU.
(1) OV is applied to terminal SFL for 0.035 sec.
while battery voltage is applied to the sole–
noid voltage monitor terminal (AST)and the
ECM power transistor is OFF.
(2) Battery voltage is applied to terminal SFL for
0.035 sec. while battery voltage is applied to
the solenoid voltage monitor terminal (AST)
and the ECM power–transistor is ON.
•
•
•
ABS actuator (solenoid valve).
Open or short in left front solenoid circuit.
ECU.
(1) OV is applied to terminal SRA for 0.035 sec.
while battery voltage is applied to the sole–
noid voltage monitor terminal (AST) and the
ECM power transistor is OFF.
(2) Battery voltage is applied to terminal SRA for
0.035 sec. while battery voltage is applied to
the solenoid voltage monitor terminal (AST)
and the ECM power transistor is ON.
•
•
•
ABS actuator (solenoid valve).
Open or short in rear solenoid circuit.
ECU.
Fail safe function; If trouble occurs in the actuator solenoid circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the
solenoid relay and prohibits ABS control.
Check ABS actuator solenoid.
Replace ABS actuator.
If the same code is still output after the diagnostic trouble code is deleted, check the contact condition
of each connection.
If the connections are normal, the ECU may be defective.
BR–332
BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–333
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check ABS actuator solenoid.
Remove the ABS ECU cover and disconnect 6–pin
connector.
Check continuity between terminals 1 and 2, 3 and
4, 5 and6.
Continuity
HINT: Resistance of each solenoid coil is 1.1.
Replace ABS actuator.
If the same code is still output after the diagnostic trouble code is deleted, check the contact condition
of each connection.
If the connections are normal, the ECU may be defective.
BR–334
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DTC 31,32,33,34,35, 36, 38, 39 Speed Sensor Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The speed sensor detects the wheel speed and sends the
appropriate signals to the ECU. These signals are used to
control the ABS system. The front and rear rotors each have
48 serrations. When the rotors rotate, the magnetic field
emitted by the permanent magnet in the speed sensor
generates an AC voltage. Since the frequency of this AC
voltage changes in direct proportion to the speed of the
rotor, the frequency is used by the ECU to detect the speed
of each wheel.
DTC No.
31,32,
33,34
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
(1) No pulse is input when the vehicle speed
reaches 12 km/h (7 mph).
(2) No pulse is input when the vehicle speed
reaches 20 km/h (12 mph).
(3) When the vehicle speed is 10 km/h (7 mph) or
above, a pulse is not input for at least 20 sec.
Trouble area
•
•
•
•
•
•
35,36,
38,39
The hardware detects a constant open is each
sensor circuit.
•
•
Right front, left front, right rear and left rear
speed sensor.
Open in each speed sensor circuit.
Sensor installation
Sensor rotor
ECU.
Right front, left front, right rear and left rear
speed sensor.
Open in each speed sensor circuit.
ECU.
HINT: DTC Nos. 31 and 35 are for the right front speed sensor.
DTC Nos. 32 and 36 are for the left front speed sensor.
DTC Nos. 33 and 38 are for the right rear speed sensor
DTC Nos. 34 and 39 are for the left rear speed sensor.
Fail safe function:
If trouble occurs in the speed sensor circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS
solenoid relay and prohibits ABS control.
BR–335
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check speed sensor.
Replace speed sensor.
Check for open and short in harness and con–
nector between each speed sensor and ECU.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check sensor rotor and sensor installation.
Replace speed sensor or rotor.
Check and replace ABS ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
BR–336
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check speed sensor.
Front
1. Remove front fender liner.
2. Disconnect speed sensor connector.
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of
speed sensor connector.
Resistance: 0.6–1.8 k
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of
speed sensor connector and body ground.
Resistance: 1 MO or higher
Rear
1. Remove the seat cushion (and side seat back).
2. Disconnect speed sensor connector.
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of
speed sensor connector.
Resistance: 0.6–1.8 tc
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of
speed sensor connector and body ground.
Resistance: 1 M or higher
Replace speed sensor.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between each speed
sensor and ECU (See page IN–28).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
BR–337
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Check sensor rotor and sensor installation.
Front
Remove front drive shaft (See SA section).
Check sensor rotor serrations.
No scratches or missing teeth.
Check the front speed sensor installation
The installation bolt is tightened properly.
Rear
Remove the axle hub (See SA section).
Check the sensor rotor serrations.
No scratches or missing teeth.
Check the speed sensor installation
The installation bolt is tightened properly and
there is no clearance between the sensor and
rear axle carrier.
Replace speed speed or rotor.
Check and replace ABS ECU.
BR–338
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DTC 41 +BS Power Source Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This is the power source for the ECU, hence the CPU, and the actuators.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
(1) Voltage of 5V or more, or 9.4V or less, is
applied for at least 60 sec. to terminal +BS
before the ABS primary check and ABS
operation.
(2) Voltage of 5V or more, or 9.4V or less, is
applied to terminal +BS for 0.2 sec. or more,
after the ABS primary check and before ABS
operation.
(3) During ABS operation, voltage of 5V or more,
or 8.8V or less, is applied to terminal +BS for
0.2 sec. or more.
Trouble area
•
•
•
•
Battery.
IC regulator.
Open or short in power source circuit.
ECU.
Fail safe function: If trouble occurs in the power source circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS
solenoid relay and prohibits ABS control.
If the voltage applied to terminal +BS becomes 9.9V or less, the warning light goes
off and ABS control becomes possible.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check battery positive voltage.
Check and repair the charging system.
Check voltage between terminals +BS and GND
of ABS ECU connector.
Check and replace ABS ECU.
Check continuity between terminals GND of
ABS ECU connector and body ground.
Check ECU–IG fuse.
Check for open in harness and connector
between ABS ECU and battery.
Repair or replace harness or
connector.
Check for short in all the harness and
components connected to ECU–IG
fuse (See attached wiring diagram).
BR–339
BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–340
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check battery positive voltage.
Voltage: 10–14 V
Check and repair the charging system.
Check voltage between terminals +BS and GND of ABS ECU connector.
Disconnect ABS ECU connector.
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Measure voltage between terminals IG1 and
GND of ABS ECU connector.
Voltage: 10–14 V
Check and replace ABS ECU.
Check continuity between terminal GND of ABS ECU connector and
body ground.
Measure resistance between terminal GND of ABS
ECU connector and body ground.
Resistance: 1 or less
Repair or replace harness or connector.
BR–341
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Check ECU–IG fuse.
Remove ECU–IG fuse from J/B No. 1.
Check continuity of ECU–IG fuse.
Continuity
Check for short in. a1I the harness and components connected to ECU–IG fuse (See attached wiring diagram).
Check for open in harness and connector between ABS ECU and battery (See page IN–28).
BR–342
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
DTC 51 ABS Pump Motor Lock
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Pump motor is not operating normally during
initial check.
Trouble area
• ABS pump motor.
Fail safe function: If trouble occurs in the ABS pump motor, the ECU cuts off current to the solenoid
relay and prohibits ABS control.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check that the pump motor ground wire is installed correctly.
If it is OK, replace the ABS actuator assembly.
BR–343
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Stop Light Switch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This stop light switch senses whether the brake pedal is depressed or released, and sends the signal
to the ECU.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check operation of stop light.
Repair stop light circuit (See page BE–
65).
Check voltage of terminal STP.
Proceed to next circuit inspection
shown on problem symptoms chart
(See page BR–148y.
Check for open in harness and connector be–
tween ABS ECU and stop light switch
(See page IN–27).
Repair–or replace harness or
connector.
Check and replace ABS ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
BR–344
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check operation of stop light.
Check that stop light lights up when brake pedal is depressed and turns off when brake pedal is
released.
Repair stop light circuit (See page BE–65).
Check voltage between terminal STP of ABS ECU connector and
body ground.
Disconnect ABS ECU connector.
Measure voltage between terminal STP and body
ground.
Voltage: 8–14 V
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms chart (See page BR–148 ).
Check for open in harness and connector between ABS ECU and stop
light switch (See page IN–28).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ABS ECU.
BR–345
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
ABS Warning Light Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
If the ECU detects trouble, it lights the ABS warning light while at the same time prohibiting ABS
control. At this time, the ECU records a diagnostic trouble code in memory.
Connect terminals Tc and E1 of the DLC1 or DLC2 to make the ABS warning light to blink and output
the diagnostic trouble code.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Perform troubleshooting in accordance with the chart below for each trouble symptom.
ABS warning light does not light up
Go to step
ABS warning light remains on
Go to step
WIRING DIAGRAM
BR–346
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
ABS warning light does not light up.
Repair or replace ABS warning light
bulb or circuit.
Check ABS warning light.
Check for–open in harness and connector–be–
tween GAUGE fuse and ECU.
ABS warning light remains on.
Is diagnostic trouble code output?
Does ABS warning light go off if short pin is
removed?
YES
Check for short in harness and connector be–
tween DLC1 and ECU terminal WB.
YES
Repair circuit indicated by the code
output.
Check for short in harness and connec–
tor between warning light and DLC1,
DLC2 and ECU terminal WA.
BR–347
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check ABS warning light.
See Combination Meter–Troubleshooting on page BE–1 18.
Replace bulb or combination meter assembly.
Check for open in harness and connector between GAUGE fuse and ECU (See page IN–27).
Is diagnostic trouble code output?
Perform diagnostic trouble code check on page BR–143.
YES
Repair circuit indicated by the code output.
Does ABS warning light go off if short pin is removed?
YES
Check for short in harness and connector
between warning light and DLC1, DLC2 and
ECU terminal WA (See page IN–28).
Check for short in harness and connector between DLC1 and ECU terminal WB (See page IN–27).
BR–348
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Terminal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Connecting terminals Te and E1 of the DLC1 or the DLC2 causes the ECU to display the diagnostic
trouble code by flasing the ABS warning light.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage between terminals Tc and El of
DLC2 or DLC 1.
If ABS warning light does not blink
even after Tc and E1 are connected,
the ECU may be defective.*
Check for open and short in harness and connec–
tor between ABS ECU and DLC2 or DLC1, DLC2
or DLC1 and body ground (See page IN–28).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace A6S ECU.
*: Provided that the harness between
terminal Tc of DLC2 or DLC1 and
terminal Tc of ECU is not open.
BR–349
BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
1 M^–FE:
5S–FE:
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
BR–350
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminals Te and E1 of DLC2 or DLC1.
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Measure voltage between terminals Tc and E1
of DLC2 or DLC1.
Voltage: 10–14 V
If ABS warning light does not blink even after Tc
and E 1 are connected, the ECU may be defective.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ABS ECU
and DLC2 or DLC1, DLC2 or DLC1 and body ground (See page IN–28).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ABS ECU.
BR–351
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Ts Terminal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The sensor check circuit detects abnormalities in the speed sensor signal which can not be detected with
the diagnostic trouble code check.
Connecting terminals Ts and E1 of the DLC1 in the engine compartment starts the check.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage between terminals Ts and E1 of
DLC1.
If ABS warning light does not blink
even after Ts and E1 are connected,
the ECU may be defective.
Check for open and short in harness and connec–
tor between ABS ECU and DLC1, DLC1 and body
ground (See page IN–28).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ABS ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
BR–352
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminals¿¿and E1 of DLC1.
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Measure voltage between terminals Ts and E1
of DLC 1.
Voltage: 10–14 V
If ABS warning light does not blink even after Ts
and E1 are connected, the ECU may be defective.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ABS ECU
and DLC1, DLC1 and body ground (See page IN–28).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ABS ECU.
BR–353
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
Check for Fluid Leakage
Check for fluid leakage from actuator or hydraulic lines.
BR–354
BRAKE SYSTEM
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE DATA
Brake pedal height (from asphalt sheet)
Brake pedal freeplay
Brake pedal reserve distance at 490 N (50 kgf, 110.2 lbf)
Brake booster push rod to piston clearance (w/SST)
Front brake pad thickness (5S–FE engine)
STD
Front brake pad thickness (5S–FE engine)
Limit
Front brake pad thickness (1 MZ–FE engine)
STD
Front brake pad thickness (1 MZ–FE engine)
Limit
Front brake disc thickness
STD
Front brake disc thickness
Limit
Front brake disc runout
Limit
Rear brake drum inside diameter
STD
Rear brake drum inside diameter
Limit
Rear brake shoe lining thickness
STD
Rear brake shoe lining thickness
Limit
Rear brake drum to shoe clearance
Rear brake pad thickness
STD
Rear brake pad thickness
Limit
Rear brake disc thickness
STD
Rear brake disc thickness
Limit
Rear brake disc runout
Limit
Rear brake disc inside diameter
STD
Rear brake disc inside diameter
Limit
Parking brake lining thickness for rear disc brake
STD
Parking brake lining thickness for rear disc brake
Limit
Parking brake lever travel at 196 N (20 kgf, 44 lbf)
Parking brake pedal travel at 294 N (30 kgf, 66 lbf)
Parking brake clearance between rear shoe and lever
Parking brake adjusting shim thickness for rear disc brake
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
CH–1
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
CHARGING SYSTEM
CH–2
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
(5S–FE)
DESCRIPTION
The generator is a small, high speed, high performance type with an voltage regulator incorporat–
ed. The voltage regulator uses integrated circuits and controls the voltage produced by the
generator.
PRECAUTION
1.
2.
3.
4.
Check that the battery cables are connected to the correct terminals.
Disconnect the battery cables when the battery is given a quick charge.
Do not perform tests with a high voltage insulation resistance tester.
Never disconnect the battery while the engine is running.
CH–3
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
SYSTEM CIRCUIT
OPERATION
EH00N–0a
When the ignition switch is turned ON, current from the battery flows from terminal L of the
generator through the voltage regulator to terminal E, causing the discharge warning light to light
up.
Then when the engine is started, the voltage output increases as the generator rpm increases.
When the voltage output becomes greater than the battery voltage, current for recharging flows
from terminal B. Simultaneously, voltage at terminal L increases and the potential difference
between battery and terminal L disappears, causing the discharge warning light to go off. When
the voltage output exceeds the regulator adjustment voltage, the transistor inside the voltage
regulator regulates the voltage so that the voltage from the generator remains constant.
CH–4
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
PREPARATION
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
09285–76010 Injection Pump Camshaft Bearing
Cone Replacer
Rotor rear bearing cover
09286–46011 Injection Pump Spline Shaft
Puller
Rectifier end frame
09608–20012 Front Hub & Drive Pinion Bearing
Tool Set
(09608–00030) Replacer
Rotor front bearing
09820–00021 Alternator Rear Bearing Puller
09$20–00030 Alternator Rear Bearing Replacer
Rotor rear bearing
09820–63010 Alternator Pulley Set Nut Wrench
Set
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082–00050 TOYOTA Electrical Tester Set
EQUIPMENT
Ammeter(A)
Battery specific gravity gauge
Belt tension gauge
Torque wrench
Vernier calipers
Rotor (Slip ring), Brush
CH–5
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1. Except Delco Battery:
CHECK BATTERY ELECTROLYTE LEVEL
Check the electrolyte quantity of each cell.
A. Maintenance Free Battery
If under the lower level, replace the battery (or add
distilled water if possible). Check the charging system.
6. Except Maintenance Free Battery
If under the “LOWER” or “MIN” line, add distilled
water.
2. Except Delco Battery:
CHECK BATTERY VOLTAGE AND SPECIFIC
GRAVITY
A. Maintenance Free Battery
Measure the battery voltage between the terminals
negative (–) and positive (+) of the battery.
Standard voltage:
12.7 – 12.9 V at 200C (680F)
HINT:
• Before measuring the voltage, turn the ignition
switch to LOCK and turn off the electrical sys–
tems (headlight, blower motor, rear defogger etc.)
for 60 seconds to remove the surface charge.
• If the vehicle has been running, wait 5 minutes or
more after the vehicle stops before measuring
the battery voltage.
If the voltage is less than specification, charge the
battery.
HINT: Check the indicator as shown in the illustration.
CH–6
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
B. Except Maintenance Free Battery
Check the specific gravity of each cell.
Standard specific gravity:
55D23L battery for GNB Incorporated
1.25 – 1.27 at 20°C (68° F)
55D23L battery for JOHNSON CONTROLS
1.26 – 1.28 at 27°C (81°F)
80D26L battery for GNB Incorporated
1.27 – 1.29 at 20°C (68°F)
80D26L battery for JOHNSON CONTROLS
1.28 – 1.30 at 27°C (81°F)
If the gravity is less than specification, charge the
battery.
HINT: Check the indicator as shown in the illustration.
3. Delco Battery:
CHECK HYDROMETER
Green Dot visible:
Battery is adequately charged
Dark (Green Dot not visible):
Battery must be charged
Clear or Light Yellow:
Replace battery
HINT: There is no need to add water during the entire
service life of the battery.
4. CHECK BATTERY TERMINALS, FUSIBLE LINK AND
FUSES
(a) Check that the battery terminals are not loose or
corroded.
(b) Check the fusible link and fuses for continuity.
Fusible link:
MAIN 2.0L
H – Fuse:
ALT 100A
M – Fuse:
AM 1 40A
Fuse:
AM2 30A
IG2 7.5A
GAUGE 10A
ALT 7.5A
CH–7
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
5. INSPECT DRIVE BELT
(a) Visually check the drive belt for excessive wear,
frayed cords etc.
If any defect has been found, replace the drive belt.
HINT: Cracks on the rib side of a drive belt are consid–
ered acceptable. If the drive belt has chunks missing
from the ribs, it should be replaced.
(b) Using a belt tension gauge, measure the belt tension.
Belt tension gauge:
Nippondenso BTG–20 (95506–00020)
Borroughs No. BT–33–73F
Drive belt tension:
w/ A/C
Now belt
175 ± 5 lbf
Used belt
130 ± 10 lbf
w/o A/C
New belt
125 ± 25 lbf
Used belt
95 ± 20 lbf
If the belt tension is not as specified, adjust it.
HINT:
• ”New belt” refers to a belt which has been used
less than 5 minutes on a running engine.
• ”Used belt” refers to a belt which has been used
on a running engine for 5 minutes or more.
• After installing a belt, check that it fits properly in
the ribbed grooves.
• Check with your hand to confirm that the belt has
not slipped out of the groove on the bottom of
the pulley.
• After installing a new belt, run the engine for
about 5 minutes and recheck the belt tension.
6. VISUALLY CHECK GENERATOR WIRING AND
LISTEN FOR ABNORMAL NOISES
(a) Check that the wiring is in good condition.
(b) Check that there is no abnormal noise from the gener–
ator while the engine is running.
CH–8
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
7. CHECK DISCHARGE WARNING LIGHT CIRCUIT
(a) Warm up the engine and then turn it off.
(b) Turn off all accessories.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ’”ON’. Check that the dis–
charge warning light is lit.
(d) Start the engine. Check that the light goes off.
If the light does not go off as specified, troubleshoot
the discharge light circuit.
8. INSPECT CHARGING CIRCUIT WITHOUT LOAD
HINT: If a battery/generator tester is available, con–
nect the tester to the charging circuit as per
manufacturer ’s instructions.
(a) If a tester is not available, connect a voltmeter and
ammeter to the charging circuit as follows:
•
Disconnect the wire from terminal B of the gener–
ator, and connect it to the negative (–) tester
probe of the ammeter.
•
Connect the positive (+) tester probe of the am–
meter to terminal B of the generator.
•
Connect the positive (+) tester probe of the volt–
meter to terminal B of the generator.
•
Ground the negative (–) tester probe of the volt–
meter.
(b) Check the charging circuit as follows:
With the engine running from idling to 2,000 rpm,
check the reading on the ammeter and voltmeter.
Standard amperage:
10 A or less
Standard voltage:
13.9 – 15.1 V at 25°C (77°F)
13.5 – 14.3 V at 115 C (239 F)
If the voltmeter reading is more than standard voltage,
replace the voltage regulator.
If the voltmeter reading is less than standard voltage,
check the voltage regulator and generator as follows:
•
With terminal F grounded, start the engine and
check the voltmeter reading of terminal B.
CH–9
CHARGING SYSTEM
•
•
–
(5S–FE)
If the voltmeter reading is more than standard
voltage, replace the voltage regulator.
If the voltmeter reading is less than standard
voltage, check the generator.
9. INSPECT CHARGING CIRCUIT WITH LOAD
(a) With the engine running at 2,000 rpm, turn on the
high beam headlights and place the heater blower
switch at ’Hl”.
(b) Check the reading on the ammeter.
Standard amperage:
30 A or more
If the ammeter reading is less than the standard am–
perage, repair the generator.
HINT: If the battery is fully charged, the indication will
sometimes be less than standard amperage.
CH–10
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
GENERATOR
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
GENERATOR REMOVAL
(See Components for Removal and installation)
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the “LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. REMOVE GENERATOR
(a) Disconnect the wire clamp from the wire clip on the
rectifier end frame.
(b) Disconnect the generator connector.
(c) Remove the rubber cap and nut, and disconnect the
generator wire.
CH–11
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(5S– FE)
(d) Loosen the adjusting lock bolt (w/ A/C), adjusting
bolt and pivot bolt.
(e) Remove the drive belt.
(f) Remove the adjusting lock bolt (w/ A/C) or adjusting
bolt (w/o A/C) and pivot bolt.
(g) Remove the generator.
CH–12
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
COMPONENTS FOR DISASSEMBLY AND
ASSEMBLY
GENERATOR DISASSEMBLY
(See Components for Disassembly and Assembly)
1. REMOVE REAR END COVER
(a) Remove the nut and terminal insulator.
(b) Remove the 3 nuts and end cover.
CH–13
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
2. REMOVE BRUSH HOLDER AND VOLTAGE
REGULATOR
(a) Remove the 5 screws, brush holder and voltage regu–
lator.
(b) Remove the brush holder cover from the brush holder.
3. REMOVE RECTIFIER HOLDER
(a) Remove the 4 screws and rectifier holder.
(b) Remove the 4 rubber insulators.
4. REMOVE PULLEY
(a) Hold SST
(A) with a torque wrench, and tighten SST
(B) clockwise to the specified torque.
SST 09820–63010
Torque: 39 N⋅m (400 kgf⋅cm. 29 ft⋅lbf)
(b) Check that SST
(A) is secured to the rotor shaft.
CH–14
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
(c) Mount SST
(C) in a vise.
(d) Insert SST
(B) into SST
(C), and attach the pulley nut to
SST
(C).
(e) To loosen the pulley nut, turn SST
(A) in the direction
shown in the illustration.
NOTICE: To prevent damage to the rotor shaft, do not
loosen the pulley nut more than one–half of a turn.
(f) Remove the generator from SST (C).
(g) Turn SST (B), and remove SST (A and B).
(h) Remove the pulley nut and pulley.
5. REMOVE RECTIFIER END FRAME
(a) Remove the 4 nuts and wire clip.
CH–15
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
(b) Using SST, remove the rectifier end frame.
SST 09286 – 46011
(c) Using snap ring pliers, remove the generator washer
from the rectifier end frame.
6. REMOVE ROTOR FROM DRIVE END FRAME
GENERATOR INSPECTION AND REPAIR
Rotor
1. INSPECT ROTOR FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between the slip rings.
Standard resistance:
2.8 – 3.0 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If there is no continuity, replace the rotor.
2. INSPECT ROTOR FOR GROUND
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity
between the slip ring and rotor.
If there is continuity, replace the rotor.
CH–16
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
3. INSPECT SLIP RINGS
(a) Check that the slip rings are not rough or scored.
If rough or scored, replace the rotor.
(b) Using a vernier caliper, measure the slip ring diameter.
Standard diameter:
14.2 – 14.4 mm (0.559 – 0.567 in.)
Minimum diameter:
12.8 mm (0.504 in.)
If the diameter is less than minimum, replace the rotor.
Stator (Drive End Frame)
1. INSPECT STATOR FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between the coil leads.
If there is no continuity, replace the drive end frame
assembly.
2. INSPECT STATOR FOR GROUND
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity
between the coil lead and drive end frame.
If there is continuity, replace the drive end frame
assembly.
Brushes
1. INSPECT EXPOSED BRUSH LENGTH
Using vernier calipers, measure the exposed brush
length.
Standard exposed length:
10.5 mm (0.413 In.)
Minimum exposed length:
1.5 mm (0.059 in.)
If the exposed length is less than minimum, replace
the brushes.
CH–17
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
2. IF NECESSARY, REPLACE BRUSHES
(a) Unsolder and remove the brush and spring.
(b) Run the wire of a new brush through the spring and
the hole in the brush –holder, and insert the spring and
brush into the brush holder.
(c) Solder the brush wire to the brush holder at specified
exposed length.
Exposed length:
10.5 mm (0.413 in.)
(d) Check that the brush moves smoothly in the brush
holder.
(e) Cut off the excess wire.
(f) Apply insulation paint to *the soldered area.
Rectifiers (Rectifier Holder)
1. INSPECT POSITIVE RECTIFIER
(a) Using an ohmmeter, connect one tester probe to the
positive (+) terminal and the other to each rectifier
terminal.
(b) Reverse the polarity of the tester probes and repeat
step (a).
(c) Check that one shows continuity and the other shows
no continuity.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the rectifier
holder.
2. INSPECT NEGATIVE RECTIFIER
(a) Using an ohmmeter, connect one tester probe to each
negative (–) terminal and the other to each rectifier
terminal.
(b) Reverse the polarity of the tester probes and repeat
step (a).
(c) Check that one shows continuity and the other shows
no continuity.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the rectifier
holder.
CH–18
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
Bearings
1. INSPECT FRONT BEARING
Check that the bearing is not rough or worn.
2. IF NECESSARY, REPLACE FRONT BEARING
(a) Remove the 4 screws, bearing retainer and bearing.
(b) Using a socket wrench and press, press out the bear–
ing.
(c) Using SST and a press, press in a new bearing.
SST 09608–20012 (09608–00030)
(d) Install the bearing retainer with the 4 screws.
Torque: 2.6 N⋅m (27 kgf⋅cm, 23 in.⋅lbf)
CH–19
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
3. INSPECT REAR BEARING
Check that the bearing is not rough or worn.
4. IF NECESSARY, REPLACE REAR BEARING
(a) Using SST, remove the bearing cover (outside) and
bearing.
SST 09820–00021
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the fan.
(b) Remove the bearing cover (inside).
(c) Place the bearing cover (inside) on the rotor.
(d) Using SST and a press, press in a new bearing.
SST 09820–00030
(e) Using SST, push in the bearing cover (outside).
SST 09285 – 76010
CH–20
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
GENERATOR ASSEMBLY
(See Components for Disassembly and Assembly)
1. PLACE RECTIFIER END FRAME ON PULLEY
2. INSTALL ROTOR TO DRIVE END FRAME
3. INSTALL RECTIFIER END FRAME
(a) Insert the generator washer into the rectifier end
frame.
NOTICE: Be careful of the generator washer installation
direction.
(b) Using a 29 mm socket wrench and press, slowly press
in the rectifier end frame.
(c) Install the wire clip and 4 nuts.
Torque: 4.5 N⋅m (46 kgf⋅cm, 40 in.⋅lbf)
CH–21
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
4. INSTALL PULLEY
(a) Install the pulley to the rotor shaft by tightening the
pulley nut by hand.
(b) Hold SST (A) with a torque wrench, and tighten SST
(B) clockwise to the specified torque.
SST 09820 – 63010
Torque: 39 N⋅m (400 kgf⋅cm, 29 ft⋅lbf)
(c) Check that SST (A) is secured to the pulley shaft.
(d) Mount SST (C) in a vise.
(e) Insert SST (B) into SST (C), and attach the pulley nut to
SST (C).
(f) To torque the pulley nut, turn SST (A) in the direction
shown in the illustration.
Torque: 110 N⋅m (1,125 kgf⋅cm, 81 ft⋅lbf)
(g) Remove the generator from SST (C).
(h) Turn SST (B), and remove SST (A and B).
CH–22
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
5. INSTALL RECTIFIER HOLDER
(a) Install the 4 rubber insulators on the lead wires.
NOTICE: Be careful of the rubber insulators installation
direction.
(b) Install the rectifier holder while pushing it with the 4
screws.
Torque: 2.0 N⋅m (20 kgf⋅cm, 17 in.⋅lbf)
6. INSTALL VOLTAGE REGULATOR AND BRUSH
HOLDER
(a) Install the brush holder cover to the brush holder.
NOTICE: Be careful of the holder installation direction.
(b) Place the voltage regulator together with the brush
holder horizontally on the rectifier end frame.
(c) Install the 5 screws until there is a clearance of
approx. 1 mm (0.04 in.) between the brush holder and
voltage regulator.
CH–23
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
(d) Fit the brush holder cover.
7. INSTALL REAR END COVER
(a) Install the end cover with the 3 nuts.
Torque: 4.5 N⋅m (46 kgf⋅cm, 40 in.⋅lbf)
(b) Install the terminal insulator with the nut.
Torque: 4.1 N⋅m (42 kgf⋅cm, 36 in.⋅lbf)
8. CHECK THAT ROTOR ROTATES SMOOTHLY
CH–24
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
GENERATOR INSTALLATION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. INSTALL GENERATOR
(a) Temporarily install the generator with the pivot bolt
and adjusting lock bolt (w/ A/C) or adjusting bolt
(w/o A/C).
(b) Install the drive belt with the adjusting bolt.
(c) Adjust the drive belt with the adjusting bolt.
(See step 5 on page CH–7)
(d) Tighten the pivot bolt, adjusting lock bolt (w/ A/C)
and adjusting bolt (w/o A/C).
Torque:
Pivot bolt
52 N⋅m (530 kgf⋅cm, 38 ft⋅lbf)
Adjusting lock bolt (w/ A/C) or
adjusting bolt (w/o A/C)
18 N⋅m (185 kgf⋅cm, 13 ft⋅lbf)
(f) Connect the generator connector.
(g) Connect the generator wire with the nut and rubber
cap.
(h) Install the wire clamp to the wire clip on the rectifier
end frame.
2. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE TO
BATTERY
3. PERFORM ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
(See page CH–5)
CH–25
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE DATA
Battery
(Except
Delco Battery)
Voltage (Maintenance free battery)
Specific gravity (Except maintenance free battery)
55D23L Battery
GNB Incorporated
JHONSON CONTROLS
80D26L Battery
GNB Incorporated
JHONSON CONTROLS
Drive belt
Tension
Generator
Rated output
Rotor coil resistance
Slip ring diameter
Brush exposed length
Voltage
regulator
Regulating voltage
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part tightened
Bearing cover x Drive end frame
Rectifier end frame x Drive end frame
Generator pulley x Rotor
Rectifier holder x Coil lead on rectifier end frame
Rear end cover x Rectifier holder
Terminal insulator x Rectifier holder
Generator x Generator bracket
Generator x Adjusting bar
(5S–FE)
CH–26
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
(1MZ–FE)
DESCRIPTION
The generator is a small, high–speed, high–performance type with a voltage regulator incorpo–
rated. The voltage regulator uses integrated circuits and controls the voltage produced by the
generator.
PRECAUTION
1.
2.
3.
4.
Check that the battery cables are connected to the correct terminals.
Disconnect the battery cables when the battery is given a quick charge.
Do not perform tests with a high voltage insulation resistance tester.
Never disconnect the battery while the engine is running.
CH–27
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
SYSTEM CIRCUIT
OPERATION
When the ignition switch is turned ON, current from the battery flows from terminal L of the
generator through the voltage regulator to terminal E, causing the discharge warning light to light
up. Then when the engine is started, the voltage output increases as the generator speed
increases. When the voltage output becomes greater than the battery voltage, current for
recharging flows from terminal B. Simultaneously, voltage at terminal L increases and the
potential difference between battery and terminal L disappears, causing the discharge warning
light to go off. When the voltage output exceeds the regulator adjustment voltage, the transistor
inside the voltage regulator regulates the voltage so that the voltage from the generator remains
constant.
CH–28
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
PREPARATION
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
09285–76010 Injection Pump Camshaft Bearing
Cone Replacer
Rotor rear bearing cover
09286–46011 Injection Pump Spline Shaft
Puller
Rectifier end frame
09808–20012 Front Hub & Drive Pinion Bearing
Tool Set
(09608–00030) Replacer
Rotor front bearing
09820–00021 Alternator Rear Bearing Puller
09820–00030 Alternator Rear Bearing Replacer
Rotor rear bearing
09620–63010 Alternator Pulley Set Nut Wrench
Set
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082–00050 TOYOTA Electrical Tester Set
EQUIPMENT
Ammeter(A)
Battery specific gravity gauge
Except maintenance free battery
Belt tension gauge
Torque wrench
Vernier calipers
Rotor (Slip ring)
CH–29
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1. Except Delco Battery:
CHECK BATTERY ELECTROLYTE LEVEL
Check the electrolyte quantity of each cell.
A. Maintenance Free Battery
If under the lower level, replace the battery (or add
distilled water if possible). Check the charging system.
B. Except Maintenance Free Battery
If under the “LOWER” or ’MIN” line, add distilled
water.
2. Except Delco Battery:
CHECK BATTERY VOLTAGE AND SPECIFIC
GRAVITY
A. Maintenance Free Battery
Measure the battery voltage between the terminals
negative (–) and positive (+) of the battery.
Standard voltage:
12.7 – 12.9 V at 20°C (68°F)
HINT:
•
Before measuring the voltage, turn the ignition
switch to LOCK and turn off the electrical sys–
tems (headlight, blower motor, rear defogger etc.)
for 60 seconds to remove the surface charge.
•
If the vehicle has been running, wait 5 minutes or
more after the vehicle stops before measuring
the battery voltage.
If the voltage is less than specification, charge the
battery.
HINT: Check the indicator as shown in the illustration.
CH–30
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
B. Except Maintenance Free Battery
Check the specific gravity of each cell.
Standard specific gravity:
SSD23L battery for GNB Incorporated
1.25 – 1.27 at 20°C (68°F)
55D23L battery for JOHNSON CONTROLS
1.28 – 1.28 at 27°C (81°F)
80D26L battery for GNB Incorporated
1.27 – 1.29 at 20°C (68°F)
80D28L battery for JOHNSON CONTROLS
1.28 – 1.30 at 27°C (81°F)
If the gravity is less than specification, charge the
battery.
HINT: Check the indicator as shown in the illustration.
3. Delco Battery:
CHECK HYDROMETER
Green Dot visible:
Battery I: adequately charged
Dark (Green Dot not visible):
Battery must be charged
Clear or Light Yellow:
Replace battery
HINT: There is no need to add water during the entire
service life of the battery.
4. CHECK BATTERY TERMINALS, FUSIBLE LINK AND
FUSES
(a) Check that the battery terminals are not loose or
corroded.
(b) Check the fusible link and fuses for continuity.
Fusible link:
MAIN 2.0L
H–fuse:
ALT 100A
M – fuse:
AM 1 40A
Fuse:
AM2 30 A
IG2 7.5A
GAUGE 10A
ALT 7.5A
CH–31
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
5. INSPECT DRIVE BELT
(a) Visually check the belt for excessive wear, frayed
cords etc.
If any defect has been found, replace the drive belt.
HINT: Cracks on the rib side of a belt are considered
acceptable. If the belt has chunks missing from the
ribs, it should be replaced.
(b) Using a belt tension gauge, measure the drive belt
tension.
Belt tension gauge:
Nippondenso BTG–20 (95506–00020)
Borroughs No.BT–33 – 73F
Drive belt tension:
New belt
175 ± 5 lbf
Used belt
115 ± 20 lbf
If the belt tension is not as specified, adjust it.
HINT:
•
”New belt” refers to a belt which has been used less
than 5 minutes on a running engine.
•
”Used belt” refers to a belt which has been used on a
running engine for 5 minutes or more.
•
After installing a belt, check that it fits properly in the
ribbed grooves.
•
Check with your hand to confirm that the belt has not
slip out of the groove on the bottom of the pulley.
•
After installing a new belt, run the engine for about 5
minutes and recheck the belt tension.
6. VISUALLY CHECK GENERATOR WIRING AND
LISTEN FOR ABNORMAL NOISES
(a) Check that the wiring is in good condition.
(b) Check that there is no abnormal noise from the gener–
ator while the engine is running.
CH–32
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
7. CHECK DISCHARGE WARNING LIGHT CIRCUIT
(a) Warm up the engine and then turn it off.
(b) Turn off all accessories.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ’ON”. Check that the dis–
charge warning light is lit.
(d) Start the engine. Check that the light goes off.
If the light does not go off as specified, troubleshoot
the discharge light circuit.
8. INSPECT CHARGING CIRCUIT WITHOUT LOAD
HINT: If a battery/generator tester is available, con–
nect the tester to the charging circuit as per the
manufacturer ’s instructions.
(a) If a tester is not available, connect a voltmeter and
ammeter to the charging circuit as follows:
•
Disconnect the wire from terminal B of the gener–
ator, and connect it to the negative (–) probe of
the ammeter.
•
Connect the positive (+) probe of the ammeter to
terminal B of the generator.
•
Connect the positive (+) probe of the voltmeter
to terminal B of the generator.
•
Ground the negative (–) probe of the voltmeter.
(b) Check the charging circuit as follows:
With the engine running from idling to 2,000 rpm,
check the reading on the ammeter and voltmeter.
Standard amperage:
10 A or less
Standard voltage:
14.0 – 15.0 V at 25°C (77°F)
13.5 – 14.3 V at 115°C (239°F)
If the voltmeter reading is more than standard voltage,
replace the voltage regulator.
If the voltmeter reading is less than standard voltage,
check the voltage regulator and generator as follows:
•
With terminal F grounded, start the engine and
check the voltmeter reading of terminal6.
CH–33
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
If the voltmeter reading is more than standard
voltage, replace the voltage regulator.
If the voltmeter reading is less than standard
voltage, check the generator.
9. INSPECT CHARGING CIRCUIT WITH LOAD
(a) With the engine running at 2,000 rpm, turn on the
high beam headlights and place the heater blower
switch –at “HI”.
(b) Check the reading on ’the ammeter.
Standard amperage:
30 A or more
If the ammeter reading is less than the standard am–
perage, repair the generator.
HINT: If the battery is fully charged, the indication will
sometimes be less than standard amperage.
CH–34
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
GENERATOR
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
GENERATOR REMOVAL
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the “LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. REMOVE DRIVE BELT
Loosen the pivot bolt, adjusting lock bolt, and adjusting
bolt, and remove the drive belt.
CH–35
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
3. REMOVE GENERATOR
(a) Disconnect the generator connector.
(b) Remove the nut, and disconnect the generator wire.
(c) Disconnect the wire harness from the clip.
(d) Remove the pivot bolt, plate washer, adjusting lock
bolt and generator.
COMPONENTS FOR DISASSEMBLY AND
ASSEMBLY
CH–36
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
GENERATOR DISASSEMBLY
(See Components for Disassembly and Assembly)
1. REMOVE REAR END COVER
(a) Remove the nut and terminal insulator.
(b) Remove the screw, 3 nuts, plate terminal and end
cover.
2. REMOVE BRUSH HOLDER AND VOLTAGE REGULA–
TOR
(a) Remove the brush holder cover from the brush holder.
(b) Remove the 5 screws, brush holder and voltage regu–
lator.
3. REMOVE RECTIFIER HOLDER
(a) Remove the 4 screws and rectifier holder.
CH–37
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
(b) Remove the 4 rubber insulators.
(c) Remove the seal plate.
4. REMOVE PULLEY
(a) Hold SST (A) with a torque wrench, and tighten SST
(B) clockwise to the specified torque.
SST 09820–63010
Torque: 39 N⋅m (400 kgf⋅cm, 29 ft⋅lbf)
(b) Check that SST (A) is secured to the rotor shaft.
(c) Mount SST (C) in a vise.
(d) Insert SST (B) into SST (C), and attach the pulley nut to
SST (C).
(e) To loosen the pulley nut, turn SST (A) in the direction
shown in the illustration.
NOTICE: To prevent damage to the rotor shaft, do not
loosen the pulley nut more than one–half of a turn.
(f) Remove the generator from SST (C).
CH–38
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
(g) Turn SST (B), and remove SST (A and B).
(h) Remove the pulley nut and pulley.
6. REMOVE RECTIFIER END FRAME
(a) Remove the 4 nuts and cord clip.
(b) Using SST, remove the rectifier end frame.
SST 09286–46011
(c) Remove the thrust washer.
CH–39
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
6. REMOVE ROTOR FROM DRIVE END FRAME
GENERATOR INSPECTION AND REPAIR
Rotor
1. INSPECT ROTOR FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between the slip rings.
Standard resistance:
2.8–3.0 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If there is no continuity, replace the rotor.
2. INSPECT ROTOR FOR GROUND
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity
between the slip ring and rotor.
If there is continuity, replace the rotor.
3. INSPECT SLIP RINGS
(a) Check that the slip rings are not rough or scored.
If rough or scored, replace the rotor.
(b) Using a vernier caliper, measure the slip ring diameter.
Standard diameter:
14.2–14.4 mm (0.559–0.587 In.)
Minimum diameter:
12.8 mm (0.504 In.)
If the diameter is less than minimum, replace the rotor.
Stator (Drive End Frame)
1. INSPECT STATOR FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between the coil leads.
If there is no continuity, replace the drive end frame
assembly.
CH–40
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
2. INSPECT STATOR FOR GROUND
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity
between the coil lead and drive end frame.
If there is continuity, replace the drive end frame
assembly.
Brushes
1. INSPECT EXPOSED BRUSH LENGTH
Using a vernier caliper, measure the exposed brush
length.
Standard exposed length:
10.5 mm (0.413 In.)
Minimum exposed length:
1.5 mm (0.059 in.)
If the exposed length is less than minimum, replace
the brushes and brush holder assembly.
Rectifiers (Rectifier Holder)
1. INSPECT POSITIVE RECTIFIER
(a) Using an ohmmeter, connect one tester probe to the
positive (+) terminal and the other to each rectifier
terminal.
(b) Reverse the polarity of the tester probes and repeat
step (a).
(c) Check that one shows continuity and the other shows
no continuity.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the rectifier
holder.
CH–41
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
2. INSPECT NEGATIVE RECTIFIER
(a) Using an ohmmeter, connect one tester probe to each
negative (–) terminal and the other to each rectifier
terminal.
(b) Reverse the polarity of the tester probes and repeat
step (a).
(c) Check that one shows continuity and the other shows
no continuity.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the rectifier
holder.
Bearings
1. INSPECT FRONT BEARING
Check that the bearing is not rough or worn.
2. IF NECESSARY, REPLACE FRONT BEARING
(a) Remove the 4 screws, bearing retainer and bearing.
(b) Using a socket wrench and press, press out the bear–
ing.
(c) Using SST and a press, press in a new bearing.
SST 09608 – 20012 (09608 – 00030)
CH–42
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
(d) Install the bearing retainer with the 4 screws.
3. INSPECT REAR BEARING
Check that the bearing is not rough or worn.
4. IF NECESSARY, REPLACE REAR BEARING
(a) Using SST, remove the bearing cover (outside) and
bearing.
SST 09820–00021
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the fan.
(b) Remove the bearing cover (inside).
(c) Place the bearing cover (inside) on the rotor.
(d) Using SST and a press, press in a new bearing.
SST 09820–00030
CH–43
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
(e) Using SST, push in the bearing cover (outside).
SST 09285 – 76010
GENERATOR ASSEMBLY
(See Components for Disassembly and Assembly)
1. INSTALL ROTOR TO DRIVE END FRAME
(a) Place the rectifier end frame on the pulley.
(b) Install the rotor to the rectifier end frame.
2. INSTALL RECTIFIER END FRAME
(a) Place the thrust washer on the rotor.
(b) Using a 29 mm socket wrench and press, slowly press
in the rectifier end frame.
(c) Install the 3 nuts.
Torque: 4.5 N⋅m (46 kgf⋅cm, 40 in.⋅Ibf)
(d) Install the cord clip with the nut.
Torque: 5.4 N⋅m (55 kgf⋅cm. 48 in.⋅lbf)
CH–44
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
3. INSTALL PULLEY
(a) Install the pulley to the rotor shaft by tightening the
pulley nut by hand.
(b) Hold SST (A) with a torque wrench, and tighten SST
(B) clockwise to the specified torque.
SST 09820 – 63010
Torque: 39 N⋅m (400 kgf⋅cm, 29 ft⋅lbf)
(c) Check that SST (A) is secured to the pulley shaft.
(d) Mount SST (C) in a vise.
(e) Insert SST (B) into SST (C), and attach the pulley nut to
SST (C).
(f) To torque the pulley nut, turn SST (A) in the direction
shown in the illustration.
Torque: 110 N⋅m (1,125 kgf⋅cm, 81 ft⋅lbf)
(g) Remove the generator from SST (C).
(h) Turn SST (B), and remove SST (A and B).
CH–45
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
4. INSTALL RECTIFIER HOLDER
(a) Place the seal plate on the rectifier end frame.
(b) Install the 4 rubber insulators on the lead wires.
(c) Install the rectifier holder with the 4 screws.
Torque: 2.94 N⋅m (30 kgf⋅cm, 26 In.⋅Ibf)
5. INSTALL VOLTAGE REGULATOR AND BRUSH
HOLDER
(a) Place the voltage regulator and brush holder on the
rectifier end frame.
NOTICE: Be careful of the holder installation direction.
(b) Install the 5 screws until there is a clearance of
approx. 1 mm (0.04 in.) between the brush holder and
connector.
(c) Place the brush holder cover on the brush holder.
CH–46
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
6. INSTALL REAR END COVER
(a) Install the end cover and plate terminal with the 3 nuts
and screw.
Torque:
3.85 N⋅m (39 kgf⋅cm, 34 in.⋅lbf) for screw
4.4 N⋅m (45 kgf⋅cm, 39 in.⋅Ibf) for nut
(b) Install the terminal insulator with the nut.
Torque: 4.1 N⋅m (41.5 kgf⋅cm. 36 in.⋅lbf)
7. CHECK THAT ROTOR ROTATES SMOOTHLY
CH–47
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
GENERATOR INSTALLATION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. INSTALL GENERATOR
(a) Mount generator on the generator bracket with the
pivot bolt and adjusting lock bolt. Do not tighten the
bolts yet.
(b) Connect the generator connector.
(c) Connect the generator wire with the nut.
2. INSTALL DRIVE BELT
(a) Install the drive belt with the adjusting bolt.
(b) Using a belt tension gauge, measure the drive belt
tension.
Belt tension gauge:
Nippondenso BTG–20 (95506–00020)
Borroughs No. BT–33–73F
Drive belt tension:
New belt
175 ± 5 lbf
Used belt
115 ± 20 lbf
(c) Tighten the pivot bolt and adjusting lock bolt.
Torque:
56 N⋅m (570 kgf⋅cm. 41 ft⋅lbf) for pivot bolt
18 N⋅m (180 kgf⋅cm. 13 ft⋅lbf) for lock bolt
HINT:
•
•
•
•
•
”New belt” refers to a belt which has been used
less than 5 minutes on a running engine.
”Used belt” refers to a belt which has been used
on a running engine for 5 minutes or more.
After installing a belt, check that it fits properly in
the ribbed grooves.
Check by hand to confirm that the belt has not
slip out of the groove on the bottom of the pulley.
After installing a new belt, run the engine for
about 5 minutes and recheck the belt tension.
3. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
TO BATTERY
4. PERFORM ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
(See steps 7 to 9 on pages CH–32 and 33)
CH–48
CHARGING SYSTEM
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE DATA
Battery
(Except
Delco Battery)
Voltage (Maintenance free battery)
Specific gravity (Except maintenance free battery)
55D23L Battery
GNB Incorporated
JHONSON CONTROLS
8OD26L Battery
GNB Incorporated
JHONSON CONTROLS
Drive belt
Tension
New belt
Used belt
Generator
Rated output
Rotor coil resistance
Slip ring diameter
Brush exposed length
Voltage
regulator
Regulating voltage
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part tightened
Rectifier end frame x Drive end frame
Cord clamp x Rectifier end frame
Generator pulley x Rotor
Rectifier holder x Coil lead on rectifier end frame
Rear end cover x Rectifier holder
Plate terminal x Rectifier holder
Terminal insulator x Rectifier holder
Generator x Generator bracket
Generator x Adjusting bar
(1MZ–FE)
CL–1
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH
CL–2
CLUTCH
–
DESCRIPTION
DESCRIPTION
The diaphragm spring turnover type clutch providing lighter release performance.
CL–3
CLUTCH
–
PREPARATION
PREPARATION
SST(SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
09023–00100 Union Nut Wrench 10 mm
09301–00210 Clutch Guide Tool
09333–00013 Clutch Diaphragm Spring Aligner
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082–00050 TOYOTA Electrical Tester Set
09905–00013 Snap Ring Pliers
EQUIPMENT
Calipers
Dial indicator
Torque wrench
Clutch line tube
Clutch grabs/chatters
Clutch pedal spongy
Clutch noisy
Clutch slips
Clutch does not disengage
CL–8
CL–11
CL–14
MX–33
CL–14
CL–14
CL–14
CL–14
CL–14
CL–14
CL–14
CL–14
CL–16
CL–14
CL–16
CL–14
Master cylinder cup (Damaged)
Release cylinder cup
(Damaged)
Engine mounting (Loosen)
Release bearing (Worn, dirty or damaged)
Input shaft bearing (Worn or damaged)
Clutch disc (Out of true)
Clutch disc (Runout is excessive)
Clutch disc (Lining broken)
Clutch disc (Dirty or burred)
Clutch disc (Oily)
Clutch disc (Worn out)
Clutch disc torsion rubber (Damaged)
Clutch disc (Harden)
Clutch disc (Lack of spline grease)
Diaphragm spring (Damaged)
Diaphragm spring (Out of tip alignment)
Pressure plate (Distortion)
CLUTCH
–
Flywheel (Distortion)
CL–5
Trouble
Clutch line (Air in line)
Parts Name
CL–6
See Page
Clutch pedal (Freeplay out of adjustment)
CL–4
TROUBLESHOOTING
TROUBLESHOOTING
Use the table below to help you find the cause of the problem. The numbers indicate the priority
of the likely cause of the problem. Check each part in order. If necessary, replace these parts.
CL–5
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH SYSTEM BLEEDING
CLUTCH SYSTEM BLEEDING
HINT: If any work is done on the clutch system or if air
is suspected in the clutch lines, bleed the system of
air.
NOTICE: Do not let brake fluid remain on a painted sur–
face. Wash it off immediately.
1. FILL CLUTCH RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID
2. CONNECT VINYL TUBE TO BLEEDER PLUG
Insert the other end of the tube in a half–full contain–
er of brake fluid.
HINT: Check the reservoir frequently. Add fluid if
necessary.
3. BLEED CLUTCH LINE
(a) Slowly pump the clutch pedal several times.
(b) While pressing on the pedal, loosen the bleeder plug
until the fluid starts to run out. Then close the bleeder
plug.
SST 09023–00100
(c) Repeat this procedure until there are no more air
bubbles in the fluid.
CL–6
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH PEDAL
CLUTCH PEDAL
CLUTCH PEDAL CHECK AND
ADJUSTMENT
1. CHECK THAT PEDAL HEIGHT IS CORRECT
Pedal height from asphalt sheet:
160.8–170.8 mm (6.33–6.72 in.)
2. IF NECESSARY, ADJUST PEDAL HEIGHT
Loosen the lock nut and turn the stopper bolt until the
height is correct. Tighten the lock nut.
3. CHECK THAT PEDAL FREEPLAY AND PUSH ROD
PLAY ARE CORRECT
Pedal freeplay:
Push in on the pedal until the beginning of clutch
resistance is felt.
Pedal fresplay:
5.0–15.0 mm (0.197–0.591 in.)
Push rod play:
Push in on the pedal with a finger softly until the resistance begins to increase a little.
Push rod play at pedal top:
1.0–5.0 mm (0.039–0.197 in.)
4. IF NECESSARY, ADJUST PEDAL FREEPLAY AND PUSH
ROD PLAY
(a) Loosen the lock nut and turn the push rod until the
freeplay and push rod play are correct.
(b) Tighten the lock nut.
(c) After adjusting the pedal freeplay, check the pedal
height.
(d) Connect the air duct and install the lower finish panel.
CL–7
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH PEDAL
5. INSPECT CLUTCH RELEASE POINT
(a) Pull the parking brake lever and install wheel stopper.
(b) Start the engine and idle the engine.
(c) Without depressing the clutch pedal, slowly shift the
shift lever into reverse position until the gears con–
tact.
(d) Gradually depress the clutch pedal and measure the
stroke distance from the point the gear noise stops
(release point) up to the full stroke end position.
Standard distance:
25 mm (0.98 in.) or more
(From pedal stroke end position to release point)
If the distance not as specified, perform the following
operation.
• Inspect pedal height.
• Inspect push rod play and pedal freeplay.
• Bleed the clutch line.
• Inspect the clutch cover and disc.
6. CHECK CLUTCH START SYSTEM
(a) Check that the engine does not start when the clutch
pedal is released.
(b) Check that the engine starts when the clutch pedal is
fully depressed.
If necessary, adjust or replace the clutch start switch.
7. CHECK CONTINUITY OF CLUTCH START SWITCH
(a) Check that there is continuity between terminals
when the switch is ON (pushed).
(b) Check that there is no continuity between terminals
when the switch is OFF (free).
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
CL–8
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH MASTER CYLINDER
CLUTCH MASTER CYLINDER
COMPONENTS
MASTER CYLINDER REMOVAL
1. DRAW OUT FLUID WITH SYRINGE
2. DISCONNECT CLUTCH LINE TUBE
Using SST, disconnect the clutch line tube. Use a
container to catch the brake fluid.
SST 09023–00100
3. REMOVE CLIP AND CLEVIS PIN
4. REMOVE 2 MOUNTING NUTS AND PULL OUT MASTER
CYLINDER
MASTER CYLINDER DISASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE RESERVOIR TANK
(a) Using a pin punch and a hammer, drive out the slotted
spring pin.
(b) Remove the reservoir tank and grommet.
CL–9
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH MASTER CYLINDER
2. REMOVE PUSH ROD
Pull back the boot, and using snap ring pliers, remove
the snap ring.
3. REMOVE PISTON
MASTER CYLINDER INSPECTION
HINT: Clean the disassembled parts with compressed
air.
1. INSPECT MASTER CYLINDER BORE FOR SCORING
OR CORROSION
If a problem is found, clean or replace the cylinder.
2. INSPECT PISTON AND CUPS FOR WEAR, SCORING,
CRACKS OR SWELLING
If either one requires replacement, use the parts from
the cylinder kit.
3. INSPECT PUSH ROD FOR WEAR OR DAMAGE
If necessary, replace the push rod.
MASTER CYLINDER ASSEMBLY
1. COAT PARTS WITH LITHIUM SOAP BASE GLYCOL
GREASE. AS SHOWN
2. INSERT PISTON INTO CYLINDER
3. INSTALL PUSH ROD ASSEMBLY WITH SNAP RING
4. INSTALL RESERVOIR TANK
(a) Install the reservoir tank and new grommet.
(b) Using a pin punch and a hammer, drive in the slotted
spring pin.
CL–10
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH MASTER CYLINDER
MASTER CYLINDER INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL MASTER CYLINDER
Install the 2 mounting nuts, and torque them.
Torque: 7.8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 58 in,.lbf)
2. CONNECT CLUTCH LINE TUBE
Using SST, connect the clutch line tube.
SST 09023–00100
Torque: 15 N–m (155 kgf–cm, 11 ft–lbf)
3. CONNECT PUSH ROD AND INSTALL PIN
Install the clip in the push rod pin.
4. BLEED SYSTEM AND ADJUST CLUTCH PEDAL
(See page CL–5,6)
CL–11
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH RELEASE CYLINDER
CLUTCH RELEASE CYLINDER
COMPONENTS
RELEASE CYLINDER REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT CLUTCH LINE TUBE
Using SST, disconnect the tube. Use a container to
catch the brake fluid.
SST 09023–00100
2. REMOVE 2 BOLTS AND PULL OUT RELEASE CYLINDER
RELEASE CYLINDER DISASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE UNION FROM RELEASE CYLINDER
Remove the union bolt, 2 gaskets and union from the
release cylinder.
CL–12
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH RELEASE CYLINDER
2. PULL OUT BOOT WITH PUSH ROD
3. REMOVE PISTON
Using compressed air, remove the piston with the
spring from the cylinder.
RELEASE CYLINDER INSPECTION
HINT: Clean the disassembled parts with compressed
air.
1. INSPECT RELEASE CYLINDER BORE FOR SCORING
OR CORROSION
If a problem is found, clean or replace the
cylinder.
2. INSPECT PISTON AND CUPS FOR WEAR, SCORING,
CRACKS OR SWELLING
If either one requires replacement, use the parts from
the cylinder kit.
3. INSPECT PUSH ROD FOR WEAR OR DAMAGE
If necessary, replace the push rod.
RELEASE CYLINDER ASSEMBLY
1. COAT PISTON WITH LITHIUM SOAP BASE GLYCOL
GREASE, AS SHOWN
2. INSTALL PISTON WITH SPRING INTO CYLINDER
3. INSTALL BOOT WITH PUSH ROD TO CYLINDER
4. INSTALL UNION TO RELEASE CYLINDER
(a) Adjust the center line of the union is in parallel with
the release cylinder.
(b) Install the union bolt.
Torque: 25 N–m (250 kgf–cm, 18 ft–lbf)
CL–13
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH RELEASE CYLINDER
RELEASE CYLINDER INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL RELEASE CYLINDER WITH 2 BOLTS
Torque: 13 N–m (130 kgf–cm. 9 ft–lbf)
2. CONNECT CLUTCH LINE TUBE
Using SST, connect the tube.
SST 09023–00100
Torque: 15 N–m (155 kgf–cm, 11 ft–lbf)
3. FILL CLUTCH RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID
AND BLEED CLUTCH SYSTEM
(See page CL–5)
4. CHECK FOR LEAKS
CL–14
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH UNIT
CLUTCH UNIT
COMPONENTS
CLUTCH UNIT REMOVAL
1. REMOVE TRANSAXLE FROM ENGINE
(See page MX–10)
2. REMOVE CLUTCH COVER AND DISC
(a) Place matchmarks on the flywheel and clutch cover.
(b) Loosen each set bolt one turn at a time until spring
tension is released.
(c) Remove the set bolts, and pull off the clutch cover
with the clutch disc.
NOTICE: Do not drop the clutch disc.
CL–15
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH UNIT
3. REMOVE RELEASE BEARING AND FORK FROM TRANSAXLE
(a) Remove the release bearing together with the fork
and then separate them.
(b) Remove the boot.
CLUTCH PARTS INSPECTION
1. INSPECT CLUTCH DISC FOR WEAR OR DAMAGE
Using calipers, measure the rivet head depth.
Minimum rivet depth:
0.3 mm (0.0121n.)
If a problem is found, replace the clutch disc.
2. INSPECT CLUTCH DISC RUNOUT
Using a dial indicator, check the disc runout.
Maximum runout:
0.8 mm (0.031 in.)
If runout is excessive, replace the clutch disc.
3. INSPECT FLYWHEEL RUNOUT
Using a dial indicator, check the flywheel runout.
Maximum runout:
0.1 mm (0.004 in.)
If runout is excessive, replace the flywheel.
4. INSPECT DIAPHRAGM SPRING FOR WEAR
Using calipers, measure the diaphragm spring for
depth and width of wear.
Maximum:
A: Depth 0.6 mm (0.024 in.)
B: Width 5.0 mm 10.197 In.)
If necessary, replace the clutch cover.
CL–16
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH UNIT
5. INSPECT RELEASE BEARING
Turn the bearing by hand while applying force in the
axial direction.
HINT: The bearing is permanently lubricated and re–
quires no cleaning or lubrication.
If a problem is found, replace the bearing.
CLUTCH UNIT INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL CLUTCH DISC AND CLUTCH COVER ON
FLYWHEEL
(a) Insert the SST in the clutch disc, and then set them
and the clutch cover in position.
SST 09301–00210
(b) Align the matchmarks on the clutch cover and fly–
wheel.
(c) Temporarily tighten the topmost bolt from the 3 near
the knock pins.
HINT: Temporarily tighten the No.3 bolt.
(d) Torque the bolts on the clutch cover in the order
shown.
Torque: 19 N–m (195 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
2. CHECK DIAPHRAGM SPRING TIP ALIGNMENT
Using a dial indicator with roller instrument, check the
diaphragm spring tip alignment.
Maximum non–alignment:
0.5 mm (0.020 in.)
If alignment is not as specified, using SST, adjust the
diaphragm spring tip alignment.
SST 09333–00013
CL–17
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH UNIT
3. APPLY MOLYBDENUM DISULPHIDE LITHIUM BASE
GREASE (NLGI NO.2) TO FOLLOWING PARTS
• Release fork and hub contact point
• Release fork and push rod contact point
• Release fork pivot point
• Clutch disc spline
4. INSTALL RELEASE BEARING AND FORK TO TRANSAXLE
Install the bearing to the release fork, and then install
them to the transaxle.
5. INSTALL TRANSAXLE TO ENGINE
(See page MX–15)
CL–18
CLUTCH
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE DATA
Pedal height from asphalt sheet
Push rod play at pedal top
Pedal freeplay
Clutch release point from pedal full stroke end position
Disc rivet head depth (Minimum)
Disc runout (Maximum)
Diaphragm spring tip non–alignment (Maximum)
Diaphragm spring finger wear (Maximum depth)
Diaphragm spring finger wear (Maximum width)
Flywheel runout (Maximum)
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part tightened
Master cylinder installation nut
Release cylinder installation nut
Union bolt
Clutch line union
Bleeder plug
Release fork support
Clutch cover x Flywheel
Flywheel set bolt
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
EG1–1
5S–FE ENGINE
–
5S–FE ENGINE
EG1–2
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
ENGINE MECHANICAL
DESCRIPTION
The 5S–FE engine is an in–line, 4–cylinder, 2.2 liter DOHC 16–valve engine.
EG1–3
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
The 5S–FE engine is an in–line, 4–cylinder engine with the cylinders numbered 1–2–3–4
from the front. The crankshaft is supported by five bearings inside the crankcase. These bearings
are made of aluminum alloy.
The crankshaft is integrated with eight weights for balance. Oil holes are placed in the center of
the crankshaft to supply oil to the connecting rods, bearing, pistons and other components.
The firing order is 1–3–4–2. The cylinder head is made of aluminum alloy, with a cross flow
type intake and exhaust layout and with pent–roof type combustion chambers. The spark plugs
are located in the center of the combustion chambers.
The intake manifold has four independent long ports and utilizes the inertial supercharging effect
to improve engine torque at low and medium speeds.
Exhaust and intake valves are equipped with irregular pitch springs made of special valve spring
carbon steel which are capable of functioning no matter what the engine speed.
The intake camshaft is driven by a timing belt, and a gear on the intake camshaft engages with
a gear on the exhaust camshaft to drive it. The cam journal is supported at five places between
the valve lifters of each cylinder and on the front end of the cylinder head. Lubrication of the cam
journals and gears is accomplished by oil being supplied through the oiler port in the center of the
camshaft.
Adjustment of the valve clearance is done by means of an outer shim type system, in which valve
adjusting shims are located above the valve lifters. This permits replacement of the shims without
removal of the camshafts.
Pistons are made of high temperature–resistant aluminum alloy, and a depression is built into
the piston head to prevent interference with the valves.
Piston pins are the full–floating type, with the pins fastened to neither the piston boss nor the
connecting rods. Instead, snap rings are fitted on both ends of the pins, preventing the pins from
falling out.
The No.1 compression ring is made of steel and the No.2 compression ring is made of cast iron.
The oil ring is made of a combination of steel and stainless steel. The outer diameter of each
piston ring is slightly larger than the diameter of the piston and the flexibility of the rings allows
them to hug the cylinder walls when they are mounted on the piston. Compression rings No.1 and
No.2 work to prevent gas leakage from the cylinder and the oil ring works to scrape oil off the
cylinder walls to prevent it from entering the combustion chambers.
The cylinder block is made of cast iron. It has four cylinders which are approximately twice the
length of the piston stroke. The top of each cylinder is closed off by the cylinder head and the
lower end of the cylinders becomes the crankcase, in which the crankshaft is installed. In
addition, the cylinder block contains a water jacket, through which coolant is pumped to cool the
cylinders.
The oil pan is bolted onto the bottom of the cylinder block. The oil pan is an oil reservoir made of
pressed sheet steel. A dividing plate is included ’inside the oil pan to keep sufficient oil in the
bottom of the pan even when the vehicle is tilted. This dividing plate also prevents the oil from
making waves when the vehicle is stopped suddenly and the oil shifts away from the oil pump
suction pipe.
The 5S–FE engine uses two balance shafts. The balance shafts are fitted in balance shaft
housings that are located at the bottom of the cylinder block. The No. 1 balance shaft is driven by
the drive gear of the crankshaft No.3 counterweight at twice the speed of the crankshaft. The No.
2 balance shaft is driven by the No–1 balance shaft at the same speed in the same direction as the
crankshaft. The balance shafts are designed to eliminate secondary inertia force from the engine,
thereby reducing the engine noise (booming noise).
EG1–4
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
PREPARATION
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
09011–38121 12 mm Socket wrench for 12 Pointed
Head
Cylinder head bolt and connecting
rod bolt
09201–41020 Valve Stem Oil Seal Replacer
09201–70010 Valve Guide Bushing Remover & Replacer
09202–70010 Valve Spring Compressor
09213–54015 Crankshaft Pulley Holding Tool
(91651 –60855) Bolt
09213–80017 Crankshaft Pulley & Gear Puller Set
(09213–00020) Body With Bolt
(09213–00030) Handle
(09213–00060) Bolt set
09222–30010 Connecting Rod Bushing Remover
& Replacer
09223–46011 Crankshaft Front Oil Seal
Replacer
09223–63010 Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal
Replacer
Camshaft oil seal
EG1–5
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
09224–74010 Engine Balancer Backlash
Adjusting Tool
09248–55020 Valve Clearance Adjust Tool Set
(09248–05011) Valve Lifter Press
(09248–05021) Valve Lifter Stopper
09249–63010 Torque Wrench Adaptor
09226–10010 Crankshaft Front & Rear Bearing
Replacer
09278–54012 Drive Shaft Holding Tool
Camshaft timing pulley
09330–00021 Companion Flange Holding Tool
Crankshaft pulley
09616–30011 Steering Worm Bearing Adjusting
Screw Wrench
Oil pump pulley
09816–30010 Oil Pressure Switch Socket
Knock sensor
09843–18020 Diagnosis Check Wire
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09090–04010 Engine Sling Device
09200–00010 Engine Adjust Kit
For suspension engine
EG1–6
5S–FE ENGINE
09256–00030 Hose Plug Set
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Plug for vacuum hose, fuel hose
etc.
09904–00010 Expander Set
EQUIPMENT
Battery specific gravity gauge
Caliper gauge
CO/HC meter
Compression gauge
Connecting rod aligner
Cylinder gauge
Dial indicator
Dye penetrant
Engine tune–up tester
Heater
Magnetic finger
Micrometer
Piston ring compressor
Piston ring expander
Plastigage
Precision straight edge
Soft brush
Spring tester
Valve spring
Steel square
Valve spring
Thermometer
Torque wrench
EG1–7
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Valve seat cutter
Vernier calipers
SSM (SERVICE SPECIAL MATERIALS)
08826–00080 Seal packing or equivalent
Camshaft bearing cap
Cylinder head cover
Rear oil sear retainer
08833–00070 Adhesive 1311,
THREE BOND 1311 or equivalent
Flywheel or drive plate bolt
EG1–8
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
TUNE–UP
ENGINE COOLANT INSPECTION
1. CHECK ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL AT RESERVOIR
TANK
The engine coolant level should be between the
“LOW” and “FULL” lines at low temperature.
If low, check for leaks and add engine coolant up to
the “FULL”
2. CHECK ENGINE COOLANT QUALITY
There should be no excessive deposits of rust or
scales around the radiator cap or radiator filler hole,
and the engine coolant should be free from oil.
If excessively dirty, replace the engine coolant.
ENGINE OIL INSPECTION
1. CHECK OIL QUALITY
Check the oil for deterioration, entry of water, dis–
coloring or thinning.
If oil quality is visibly poor, replace it.
Oil grade:
API grade SG or SH, Energy Conserving II multi–
grade engine oil or ILSAC multigrade engine oil.
Recommended viscosity is as shown in the illustra–
tion.
2. CHECK ENGINE OIL LEVEL
The oil level should be between the “L” and “F” marks
on the dipstick.
If low, check for leakage and add oil up to the “F”
mark.
EG1–9
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
BATTERY INSPECTION
1. Except Delco Battery:
CHECK BATTERY ELECTROLYTE LEVEL
Check the electrolyte quantity of each cell.
A. Maintenance Free Battery
If under the lower level, replace the battery (or add
distilled water if possible). Check the charging system.
B. Except Maintenance Free Battery
If under the “LOWER” or “MIN” line, add distilled
water.
2. Except Delco Battery:
CHECK BATTERY VOLTAGE AND SPECIFIC
GRAVITY
A. Maintenance Free Battery
Measure the battery voltage between the terminals
negative (–) and positive (+) of the battery.
Standard voltage:
12.7 – 12.9 V at 20°C (68°F)
HINT:
• Before measuring the voltage, turn the ignition
switch to LOCK and turn off the electrical sys–
tems (headlight, blower motor, rear defogger etc.)
for 60 seconds to remove the surface charge.
• If the vehicle has been running, wait 5 minutes or
more after the vehicle stops before measuring
the battery voltage.
If the voltage is less than specification, charge the
battery.
HINT: Check the indicator as shown in the illustration.
EG1–10
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
B. Except Maintenance Free Battery
Check the specific gravity of each cell.
Standard specific gravity:
55D23L battery for GNB Incorporated
1.25 – 1.27 at 20°C (68°F)
55D23L battery for JOHNSON CONTROLS
1.26 – 1.28 at 27°C (81°F)
80D26L battery for GNB Incorporated
1.27 – 1.29 at 20°C (68°F)
80D26L battery for JOHNSON CONTROLS
1.28 – 1.30 at 27C (81F)
If the gravity is less than specification, charge the
battery.
HINT: Check the indicator as shown in the illustration.
3. Delco Battery:
CHECK HYDROMETER
Green Dot visible:
Battery is adequately charged
Dark (Green Dot not visible):
Battery must be charged
Clear or Light Yellow:
Replace battery
HINT: There is no need to add water during the entire
service life of the battery.
AIR FILTER INSPECTION
1. INSPECT AIR FILTER
Visually check that the element is not excessively
dirty, damaged or oily.
2. CLEAN AIR FILTER
Clean the element with compressed air.
First blow air from the inside thoroughly. Then blow
off the outside of the element.
HIGH–TENSION CORDS INSPECTION
1. DISCONNECT HIGH–TENSION CORDS FROM
SPARK PLUGS
Disconnect the high – tension cords at the rubber
boot. Do not pull on the high–tension cords.
NOTICE: Pulling on or bending the cords may damage the
conductor inside.
EG1–11
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
2. CALIFORNIA ONLY:
DISCONNECT HIGH–TENSION CORD FROM
IGNITION COIL
3. DISCONNECT HIGH –TENSION CORDS FROM
DISTRIBUTOR CAP
4. INSPECT HIGH–TENSION CORD RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance.
Maximum resistance:
25 k per cord
If the resistance is greater than maximum, check the
terminals. If necessary, replace the high – tension
cord.
5. RECONNECT HIGH–TENSION CORDS TO
DISTRIBUTOR CAP
6. CALIFORNIA ONLY:
RECONNECT HIGH–TENSION CORD TO IGNITION
COIL
7. RECONNECT HIGH–TENSION CORDS TO SPARK
PLUGS
GENERATOR DRIVE BELT INSPECTION
INSPECT DRIVE BELT
(a) Visually check the drive belt for excessive wear,
frayed cords etc.
If any defect has been found, replace the drive belt.
HINT: Cracks on the rib side of a drive belt are consid–
ered acceptable. If the drive belt has chunks missing
from the ribs, it should be replaced.
(b) Using a belt tension gauge, measure the belt tension.
Belt tension gauge:
Nippondenso BTG–20 (95506–00020)
Borroughs No. BT–33–73F
EG1–12
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Drive belt tension:
w/ A/C
New belt
175 ± 5 lbf
Used belt
130 ± 10 lbf
w/o A/C
New belt
125 ± 25 lbf
Used belt
95 ± 20 lbf
If the belt tension is not as specified, adjust it.
HINT:
• “New belt” refers to a belt which has been used
less than 5 minutes on a running engine.
• “Used belt” refers to a belt which has been used
on a running engine for 5 minutes or more.
• After installing a belt, check that it fits properly in
the ribbed grooves.
• Check with your hand to confirm that the belt has
not slipped out of the groove on the bottom of
the pulley.
• After installing a new belt, run the engine for
about 5 minutes and recheck the belt tension.
VALVE CLEARANCE INSPECTION AND
ADJUSTMENT
HINT: Inspect and adjust the valve clearance when
the engine is cold.
1. DISCONNECT HIGH – TENSION CORDS FROM
SPARK PLUGS
Disconnect the high – tension cords at the rubber
boot. DO NOT pull on the cords.
NOTICE: Pulling on or bending the cords may damage the
conductor inside.
2. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER
(a) Disconnect the PCV hoses.
(b) Loosen the 2 wire harness clamp bolts (No.2 timing
belt cover) mounting bolts.
(c) Remove the 4 nuts, grommets, head cover and gasket.
EG1–13
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
HINT: Arrange the grommets in correct order, so that
they can be reinstalled into their original positions.
This minimizes any possibility of oil leakage due to
reuse of grommets.
3. SET NO.1 CYLINDER TO TDC/COMPRESSION
(a) Turn the crankshaft pulley and align its groove with
timing mark “0” of the No.1 timing belt cover.
(b) Check that the valve lifters on the No.1 cylinder are
loose and valve lifters on the No.4 are tight.
If not, turn the crankshaft one revolution (360*) and
align the mark as above.
4. INSPECT VALVE CLEARANCE
(a) Check only the valves indicated.
Using a thickness gauge, measure the clearance
between the valve lifter and camshaft.
Record the out– of –specification valve clear–
ance measurements. They will be used later to
determine the required replacement adjusting
shim.
Valve clearance (Cold):
Intake
0.19 – 0.29 mm (0.007 – 0.011 in.)
Exhaust
0.28 – 0.38 mm (0.011 – 0.015 in.)
(b) Turn the crankshaft one revolution (360) and align
the mark as above. (See procedure in step 3)
(c) Check only the valves indicated as shown. Measure
the valve clearance. (See procedure in step (a))
EG1–14
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
5. ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE
(a) Remove the adjusting shim.
•
Turn the crankshaft so that the cam lobe for the
valve to be adjusted faces up.
•
Using SST (A), press down the valve lifter and
place SST (B) between the camshaft and valve
lifter. Remove SST (A).
SST 09248 – 55020 (09248 – 05011, 09248–05021)
HINT: Before pressing down the valve lifter, position
its notch toward the spark plug side.
•
Remove the adjusting shim with a’ small screw–
driver and magnetic finger.
HINT: For easy removed of the shim, when positioning
SST (B), set it on the lifter so there is space enough to
be able to remove the shim.
(b) Determine the replacement adjusting shim size by
following the Formula or Charts:
•
Using a micrometer, measure the thickness of
the removed shim.
•
Calculate the thickness of a new shim so that the
valve clearance comes within specified value.
T ........... Thickness of removed shim
A ........... Measured valve clearance
N ........... Thickness of new shim
Intake:
N = T + (A – 0.24 mm (0.009 in.))
Exhaust:
N = T + (A – 0.33 mm (0.013 In.))
•
Select a new shim with a thickness as close as
possible to the calculated value.
HINT: Shims are available in seventeen sizes in incre–
ments of 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.), from 2.50 mm (0.0984
in.) to 3.30 mm (0.1299 in.).
EG1–15
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c) Install a new adjusting shim.
•
Place a new adjusting shim on the valve lifter.
•
Using SST (A), press down the valve lifter and
remove SST (B).
SST 09248–50020 (09248–05011, 09248–05021)
(d) Recheck the valve clearance.
6. REINSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material.
(b) Apply seal packing to the cylinder head as shown in
the illustration.
Seal pecking:
Part No.08826–00080 or equivalent
(c) Install the gasket to the head cover.
(d) Install the head cover with the 4 grommets and nuts.
Uniformly tighten the nuts in several passes.
Torque: 23 N–m (230 kgf–cm. 17 ft–lbf)
HINT: Install the grommets so that their markings are
as shown in the illustration.
(e) Tighten the 2 wire harness clamp (No.2 timing belt
cover) mounting bolts.
(f) Connect the PCV hoses.
7. RECONNECT HIGH–TENSION CORDS TO SPARK
PLUGS
EG1–16
5S–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE – ENGINE MECHANICAL
EG1–17
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
EG1–18
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
IGNITION TIMING INSPECTION AND
ADJUSTMENT
1. WARM UP ENGINE
Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating
temperature.
2. CONNECT TACHOMETER AND TIMING LIGHT TO
ENGINE
Connect the test probe of a tachometer to terminal IG
(–) of the data link connector 1.
NOTICE:
•
NEVER allow the tachometer terminal to touch
ground as it could result in damage to the igniter
and/or ignition coif.
•
As some tachometers are not compatible with this
Ignition system, we recommend that you confirm
the compatibility of yours before use.
3. ADJUST IGNITION TIMING
(a) Using SST, connect terminals TE1 and E1 of the data
link connector 1.
SST 09843–18020
HINT: After engine speed is kept at 1,000 – 1,300
rpm for 5 seconds, check that it returns to idle speed.
(b) Using a timing light, check the ignition timing.
Ignition timing:
10 BTDC @ idle
(Transmission in neutral position)
EG1–19
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c) Loosen the bolt (California) or 2 bolts (except Califor–
nia), and adjust by turning the distributor.
(d) Tighten the bolt (California) or 2 bolts (except Califor–
nia), and recheck the ignition timing.
Torque: 19 N–m (195 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
(e) Remove the SST.
SST 09843–18020
4. FURTHER CHECK IGNITION TIMING
Ignition timing:
0 – 10 BTDC @ idle
(Transmission in neutral position)
HINT: The timing mark moves in a range between 0
and 10.
5. DISCONNECT TACHOMETER AND TIMING LIGHT
FROM ENGINE
EG1–20
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
IDLE SPEED INSPECTION
1. INITIAL CONDITIONS
(a) Engine at normal operating temperature
(b) Air cleaner installed
(c) All pipes and hoses of air induction system connected
(d) All vacuum lines properly connected
(e) MFI/SFI system wiring connectors fully plugged
(f) All operating accessories switched OFF
(g) Ignition timing set correctly
(h) Transmission in neutral position
2. CONNECT TACHOMETER
Connect the test probe of a tachometer to terminal IG
(–) of the data link connector 1.
NOTICE:
•
Never allow the tachometer terminal to touch
ground as it could result in damage to the Igniter
and/or ignition coil.
•
As some tachometers are not compatible with this
ignition system, we recommend that you confirm
the compatibility of yours before use.
3. INSPECT IDLE SPEED
(a) Race the engine at 2,500 rpm for approx. 90 seconds.
(b) Check the idle speed.
Idle speed (w/ Cooling fan OFF):
750±50 rpm
If the idle speed is not as specified, check the IAC
system.
4. DISCONNECT TACHOMETER
EG1–21
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
IDLE AND OR 2,500 RPM CO/HC
CHECK
HINT: This check is used only to determine whether or
not the idle CO/HC complies with regulations.
1. INITIAL CONDITIONS
(a) Engine at normal operating temperature
(b) Air cleaner installed
(c) All pipes and hoses of air induction system connected
(d) All accessories switched OFF
(e) All vacuum lines properly connected
HINT: All vacuum hoses for EGR systems, etc. should
be properly connected.
(f) MFI/SFI system wiring connectors fully plugged
(g) Ignition timing set correctly
(h) Transmission in neutral position
(i) Tachometer and CO/HC meter calibrated by hand.
2. START ENGINE
3. RACE ENGINE AT 2,500 RPM FOR APPROX. 180
SECONDS
4. INSERT CO/HC METER TESTING PROBE AT LEAST
40 cm (1.3 ft) INTO TAILPIPE DURING IDLING
5. IMMEDIATTELY CHECK CO/HC CONCENTRATION
AT IDLE AND/OR 2,500 RPM
Complete the measuring within 3 minutes.
HINT: When performing the 2 mode (2,500 rpm and
idle) test, follow the measurement order prescribed by
the applicable local regulations.
EG1–22
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Troubleshooting
If the CO/HC concentration does not comply with
regulations, perform troubleshooting in the order
given below.
(a) Check oxygen sensor operation.
(See page EG1–231)
(b) See the table below for possible causes, then inspect
and correct the applicable causes if necessary.
Problems
High
Normal
Rough idle
High
Low
Rough idle
(Fluctuating HC reading)
High
High
Rough idle
(Black smoke from exhaust)
Causes
1. Faulty ignitions:
• Incorrect timing
• Fouled, shorted or improperly gapped plugs
• Open or crossed high–tension cords
• Cracked distributor cap
2. Incorrect valve clearance
3. Leaky EGR valve
4. Leaky intake and exhaust valves
5. Leaky cylinder
1. Vacuum leaks:
• PCV hose
• EGR valve
• Intake manifold
• Throttle body
• !AC valve
• Brake booster line
2. Lean mixture causing misfire
1. Restricted air filter
2. Faulty MFI/SFI systems
• Faulty pressure regulator
• Clogged fuel return line
• Defective engine coolant temp. sensor
• Defective intake air temp. sensor
• Faulty ECM
• Faulty injector
• Faulty throttle position sensor
• MAP sensor
EG1–23
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
COMPRESSION CHECK
HINT: If there is lack of power, excessive oil consump–
tion or poor fuel economy, measure the compression
pressure.
1. WARM UP AND STOP ENGINE
Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating
temperature.
2. DISCONNECT DISTRIBUTOR CONNECTOR(S)
3. DISCONNECT HIGH –TENSION CORDS FROM
SPARK PLUGS
Disconnect the high – tension cords at the rubber
boot.
DO NOT pull on the cords.
NOTICE: Pulling on or bending the cords may damage the
conductor inside.
4. REMOVE SPARK PLUGS
Using a 16 mm plug wrench, remove the spark plug.
5. CHECK CYLINDER COMPRESSION PRESSURE
(a) Insert a compression gauge into the spark plug hole.
(b) Fully open the throttle.
(c) While cranking the engine, measure the compression
pressure.
HINT: Always use a fully charged battery to obtain
engine speed of 250 rpm or more.
(d) Repeat steps
(a) through
(c) for each cylinder.
NOTICE: This measurement must be done in as short a
time as possible.
Compression pressure:
1,226 kPa (12.5 kgf/cm. 178 psi) or more
Minimum pressure:
981 kPa (10.0 kgf/cm, 142 psi)
Difference between each cylinder:
98 kPa (1.0 kgf/cm. 14 psi) or less
EG1–24
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(e) If the cylinder compression in one or more cylinders is
low, pour a small amount of engine oil into the cylin–
der through the spark plug hole and repeat steps (a)
through
(c) for cylinders with low compression.
•
If adding oil helps the compression, chances are
that the piston rings and/or cylinder bore are
worn or damaged.
•
If pressure stays low, a valve may be sticking or
seating is improper, or there may be leakage past
the gasket.
6. REINSTALL SPARK PLUGS
Using a 16 mm plug wrench, install the spark plug.
Torque: 18 N–m (180 kgf–cm, 13 ft–lbf)
7. RECONNECT HIGH–TENSION CORDS TO SPARK
PLUGS
8. RECONNECT DISTRIBUTOR CONNECTOR(S)
EG1–25
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
TIMING BELT
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
EG1–26
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
TIMING BELT REMOVAL
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. REMOVE ENGINE COOLANT RESERVOIR TANK
(a) Disconnect the reservoir hose.
(b) While pushing the tab of the bracket, remove the
reservoir tank.
3. REMOVE GENERATOR (See page CH–10)
4. REMOVE RH FRONT WHEEL
5. REMOVE RH FENDER APRON SEAL
6. REMOVE PS DRIVE BELT
Loosen the 2 bolts, and remove the drive belt.
7. SLIGHTLY JACK UP ENGINE
Raise the engine enough to remove the weight from
the engine mounting on the right side.
8. REMOVE ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD
Remove the 3 bolts and control rod.
9. DISCONNECT CONNECTOR FROM GROUND WIRE
ON RH FENDER APRON
EG1–27
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
10. REMOVE No.2 ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET
Remove the 3 bolts and mounting bracket.
11. REMOVE SPARK PLUGS
(a) Disconnect the high – tension cords at the rubber
boot.
DO NOT pull on the cords.
NOTICE: Pulling on or bending the cords may damage the
conductor inside.
(b) Using a 16 mm plug wrench, remove the spark plug.
12. REMOVE NO.2 TIMING BELT COVER
Remove the 5 bolts, timing belt cover and 2 gaskets.
13. SET NO.1 CYLINDER TO TDC/COMPRESSION
(a) Turn the crankshaft pulley and align its groove with
timing mark “0” of the No.1 timing belt cover.
EG1–28
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b) Check that the hole of the camshaft timing pulley is
aligned with the timing mark of the bearing cap.
If not, turn the crankshaft one revolution (360’*).
14. REMOVE TIMING BELT FROM CAMSHAFT TIMING
PULLEY
HINT (When re–using timing belt): Place the match–
marks on the timing belt and camshaft timing pulley,
and place matchmark on timing belt to match the end
of the No.1 timing belt cover.
(a) Loosen the mounting bolt of the No.1 idler pulley and
shift the pulley toward the left as far as it will go, and
temporarily tighten it.
(b) Remove the timing belt from the camshaft timing
pulley.
15. REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
Using SST, remove the bolt, plate washer and timing
pulley.
SST 09249–63010 and 09278–54012
EG1–29
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
16. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
(a) Using SST, remove the pulley bolt.
SST 09213–54015 (91651– 60855),
09330–00021
HINT (When re–using timing belt): After loosening
the crankshaft pulley bolt, check that the timing belt
matchmark aligns with the end of the No. 1 timing belt
cover when the crankshaft pulley groove is aligned
with the timing mark “0” of the No. 1 timing belt cover.
If the matchmark does not align, align as follows:
When matchmark is misaligned clockwise:
• Align the matchmark by pulling the timing belt up
on the water pump pulley side while turning the
crankshaft pulley counterclockwise.
• After aligning the matchmark, hold the timing
belt, turn the crankshaft pulley clockwise, and
align its groove with timing mark “0” of the No.1
timing belt cover.
When matchmark is misaligned counterclockwise:
• Align the rnatchmarks by pulling the timing belt up
on the No.1 idler pulley side while turning the
crankshaft pulley clockwise.
EG1–30
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
• After aligning the matchmark, hold the timing
belt, turn the crankshaft pulley counterclockwise,
and align its groove with timing mark “0” of the
No.1 timing belt cover.
(b) Using SST, remove the pulley.
SST 09213–60017 (09213–00020, 09213–00030,
09213–00060)
HINT (When re–using timing belt): Remove the pulley
without turning it.
17. REMOVE No.1 TIMING BELT COVER
Remove the 4 bolts, timing belt cover and gasket.
18. REMOVE TIMING BELT GUIDE
19. REMOVE TIMING BELT
HINT (When re–using timing belt): Draw a direction
arrow on the timing belt (in the direction of engine
revolution), and place matchmarks on the timing belt
and crankshaft timing pulley.
EG1–31
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
20. REMOVE NO.1 IDLER PULLEY AND TENSION
SPRING
Remove the bolt, pulley and tension spring.
21. REMOVE NO.2 IDLER PULLEY
Remove the bolt and pulley.
22. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
If the pulley cannot be removed by hand, use 2 screw–
drivers.
HINT: Position shop rags as shown to prevent
damage.
23. REMOVE OIL PUMP PULLEY
Using SST, remove the nut and pulley.
SST 09616–30011
TIMING BELT COMPONENTS INSPECTION
1. INSPECT TIMING BELT
NOTICE:
•
Do not bend, twist or turn the timing belt Inside out.
•
Do not allow the timing belt to come into contact
with oil, water or steam.
EG1–32
5S–FE ENGINE
•
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Do not utilize timing belt tension when installing or
removing the mounting bolt of the camshaft timing
pulley.
If there are any defects as shown in the illustration,
check the following points:
(a) Premature parting
•
Check for proper installation.
•
Check the timing cover gasket for damage and
proper installation.
(b) If the belt teeth are cracked or damaged, check to see
if either camshaft or water pump is locked.
(c) If there is noticeable wear or cracks on the belt face,
check to see if there are nicks on the side of the idler
pulley lock.
(d) If there is wear or damage on only one side of the belt,
check the belt guide and the alignment of each pulley.
(e) If there is noticeable wear on the belt teeth, check the
timing cover for damage, correct gasket installation,
and for foreign material on the pulley teeth.
If necessary, replace the timing belt.
EG1–33
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
2. INSPECT IDLER PULLEYS
Check that the idler pulley turns smoothly.
If necessary, replace the idler pulley.
3. INSPECT TENSION SPRING
(a) Measure the free length of tension spring.
Free length:
46.0 mm (1.811 in.)
If the free length is not as specified, replace the
tension spring.
(b) Measure the tension of the tension spring at the
specified installed length.
Installed tension (at 50.5 mm (1.988 in.)):
Green color
32 – 37 N (3.25 – 3.75 k9f, 7.2 – 8.3 lbf)
Silver color
47 – 52 N (4.75 – 5.25 kgf, 10.5 – 11.8 lbf)
If the installed tension is not as specified, replace the
tension spring.
TIMING BELT INSTALLATION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. INSTALL OIL PUMP PULLEY
(a) Align the cutouts of the pulley and shaft, and slide on
the pulley.
(b) Using SST, install the nut.
SST 09616 – 30011
Torque: 28 N–m (290 kgf–cm, 21 ft–lbf)
EG1–34
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
2. INSTALL CRANKSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
(a) Align the timing pulley set key with the key groove of
the pulley.
(b) Slide on the timing pulley, facing the flange side
inward.
3. INSTALL NO.2 IDLER PULLEY
(a) Install the pulley with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N–m (425 kgf–cm, 31 ft–lbf)
HINT: Use a bolt 35 mm (1.38 in.) in length.
(b) Check that the idler pulley moves smoothly.
4. TEMPORARILY INSTALL NO.1 IDLER PULLEY AND
TENSION SPRING
(a) Install the pulley with the bolt. Do not tighten the bolt
yet.
HINT: Use a bolt 42 mm (1.65 in.) in length.
(b) Install the tension spring.
(c) Pry the pulley toward the left as far as it will go and
tighten the bolt.
(d) Check that the idler pulley moves smoothly.
5. TEMPORARILY INSTALL TIMING BELT
NOTICE: The engine should be cold.
(a) Using the crankshaft pulley bolt, turn the crankshaft
and position the key groove of the crankshaft timing
pulley upward.
(b) Remove any oil or water on the crankshaft pulley, oil
pump pulley, water pump pulley, No. 1 idler pulley, No.
2 idler pulley and keep them clean.
(c) Install the timing belt on the crankshaft timing pulley,
oil pump pulley, No.1 idler pulley, water pump pulley
and No.2 idler pulley.
HINT (When re–using timing belt): Align the points
marked during removal, and install the belt with the
arrow pointing in the direction of engine revolution.
EG1–35
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
6. INSTALL TIMING BELT GUIDE
Install the guide, facing the cup side outward.
7. INSTALL NO.1 TIMING BELT COVER
(a) Install the gasket to the timing belt cover.
(b) Install the timing belt cover with the 4 bolts.
8. INSTALL CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
(a) Align the pulley set key with the key groove of the
pulley, and slide on the pulley.
(b) Using SST, install the pulley bolt.
SST 09213–54015 (91651 –60855)
09330–00021
Torque: 108 N–m (1,100 kgf–cm, 80 ft–lbf)
9. INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
(a) Align the camshaft knock pin with the knock pin
groove of the pulley, and slide on the timing pulley.
(b) Using SST, install the plate washer and bolt.
SST 09249 – 63010 and 09278 – 54012
Torque: 37 N–m (380 kgf–cm, 27 ft–lbf)
HINT: Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of
340 cm (13.39 in.)
10. SET No.1 CYLINDER TO TDC/COMPRESSION
(a) Turn the crankshaft pulley, and align its groove with
timing mark “0” of the No.1 timing belt cover.
EG1–36
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b) Using SST, turn the camshaft, and align the hole of
the camshaft timing pulley with the timing mark of the
bearing cap.
SST 09278–54012
11. INSTALL TIMING BELT
HINT. (When re–using timing belt):
• Check that the matchmark on the timing belt
matches the end of the No.1 timing belt cover.
If the matchmark does not align, shift the meshing of
the timing belt and crankshaft timing pulley until they
align. (See page EG1–29)
• Align the matchmarks of the timing belt and
camshaft timing pulley.
(a) Remove any oil or water on the camshaft timing
pulley, and keep it clean.
(b) Install the timing belt, and check the tension between
the crankshaft timing pulley and camshaft timing
pulley.
12. CHECK VALVE TIMING
(a) Loosen the No.1 idler pulley bolt 1/2 turn.
EG1–37
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b) Turn the crankshaft pulley 2 revolutions from TDC to
TDC.
NOTICE: Always turn the crankshaft clockwise.
(c) Check that each pulley aligns with the timing marks as
shown in the illustration..
If the timing marks do not align, remove the timing
belt and reinstall it.
(d) w/ Green Tension Spring:
Slowly turn the crankshaft pulley 1 and 7/8 revolu–
tions, and align its groove with the mark at 45 BTDC
(for No.1 cylinder) of the No.1 timing belt cover.
NOTICE: Always turn the crankshaft clockwise.
(e) Torque the mounting bolt of the No.1 idler pulley.
Torque: 42 N–m (425 kgf–cm, 31 ft–lbf)
13. INSTALL NO.2 TIMING BELT COVER
(a) Install the 2 gaskets to the No. 1 and No.2 belt covers.
(b) install the belt cover with the 5 bolts.
(c) Align the 2 clamps of the engine wire with cover
mounting bolts.
EG1–38
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
14. INSTALL SPARK PLUGS
(a) Using a 16 mm plug wrench, install the spark plug.
(b) Connect the high–tension cords.
15. INSTALL NO.2 ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET
(a) Temporarily install the No.2 engine mounting bracket
with the 2 bolts.
(b) Install the remaining bolt.
(c) Tighten the 3 bolts in the sequence shown.
Torque: 52 N–m (530 kgf–cm, 38 ft–lbf)
16. CONNECT CONNECTOR TO GROUND WIRE ON RH
FENDER APRON
17. INSTALL ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD
(a) Temporarily install the engine moving control rod with
the 3 bolts in the sequence shown.
EG1–39
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b) Tighten the 3 bolts in the sequence shown.
Torque: 64 N–m (650 kgf–cm. 47 ft–lbf)
18. INSTALL AND ADJUST PS DRIVE BELT
Install the drive belt with the pivot and adjusting bolts.
Drive belt tension:
New belt
125 ± 25 lbf
Used belt
80 ± 20 I bf
19. INSTALL RH FENDER APRON SEAL
20. INSTALL RH FRONT WHEEL
21. INSTALL GENERATOR (See page CH–24)
Drive belt tension:
w/ A/C
New belt
175 ± 5 lbf
Used belt
130 ± 10 lbf
w/o A/C
New belt
125 ± 25 lbf
Used belt
95 ± 20 lbf
22. INSTALL ENGINE COOLANT RESERVOIR TANK
23. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE TO
BATTERY
EG1–40
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
CYLINDER HEAD
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
EG1–41
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
COMPONENTS (Cont’d)
EG1–42
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
CYLINDER HEAD REMOVAL
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the “LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
3. A/T:
DISCONNECT THROTTLE CABLE FROM
THROTTLE BODY
4. DISCONNECT ACCELERATOR CABLE FROM
THROTTLE BODY
5. REMOVE AIR CLEANER CAP, RESONATOR AND
AIR CLEANER HOSE
(a) Disconnect the intake air temperature sensor connec–
tor.
(b) California only:
Disconnect the air hose from the air cleaner hose.
(c) Loosen the air cleaner hose clamp bolt.
(d) Disconnect the 4 air cleaner cap clips.
(e) Disconnect the air cleaner hose from the throttle
body, and remove the air cleaner cap together with
the resonator and air cleaner hose.
6. REMOVE GENERATOR (See page CH–10)
7. REMOVE DISTRIBUTOR
(See page IG–13 end 32)
8. DISCONNECT FRONT EXHAUST PIPE
(a) Loosen the 2 bolts, and disconnect the bracket.
(b) Using a 14 mm deep socket wrench, remove the 3
nuts holding the front exhaust pipe to the WU–TWC.
(c) Disconnect the front exhaust pipe and gaskets.
EG1–43
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
9. REMOVE EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND WARM UP
THREE–WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the main oxygen and sub oxygen sensor
connectors.
(b) Remove the 4 bolts and upper heat insulator.
(c) Remove the bolt, nut and No. 1 manifold stay.
(d) Remove the bolt, nut and manifold stay.
(e) Remove the 6 nuts, the exhaust manifold and WU –
TWC assembly.
10. SEPARATE EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND WARM UP
THREE–WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER
Remove the following parts:
(1) 3 bolts
(2) Manifold lower heat insulator
(3) 8 bolts
(4) 2 WU–TWC heat insulators
EG1–44
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(5) 3 bolts and 2 nuts
(6) Exhaust manifold
(7) Gasket
(8) Retainer
(9) Cushion
(10) WU–TWC
11. DISCONNECT OIL PRESSURE SWITCH
CONNECTOR
12. DISCONNECT ENGINE WIRE (FOR OXYGEN
SENSORS) FROM ENGINE HANGER
13. REMOVE WATER OUTLET
(a) Disconnect the following connectors:
(1) Engine coolant temperature sender gauge con–
nector
(2) Engine coolant temperature sensor connector
(b) Disconnect the following hoses:
(1) Upper radiator hose
(2) Water bypass pipe hose
(3) Heater water hose
(4) IAC water bypass hose
(5) 2 TVV (for EVAP) vacuum hoses
(c) Remove the 2 bolts, water outlet and gasket.
14. REMOVE WATER BYPASS PIPE
(a) Disconnect the following hoses:
(1) IAC water bypass hose
(2) Heater water hose
(3) w/ Oil Cooler:
2 oil cooler water bypass hoses
EG1–45
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b) Remove the 2 bolts, 2 nuts, water bypass pipe and
gasket.
(c) Remove the O–ring from the water bypass hose.
15. REMOVE THROTTLE BODY
(a) Disconnect the throttle position sensor connector.
(b) Disconnect the IAC valve connector.
(c) Disconnect the following hoses from the throttle
body.
(1) PCV hose
(2) 2 vacuum hoses from EGR vacuum modulator
(3) Vacuum hose from TVV (for EVAP)
(d) Type A:
Remove the 4 bolts.
(e) Type B:
Remove the 2 bolts and 2 nuts.
(f) Disconnect the following hoses from the throttle
body, and remove the throttle body.
(1) Water bypass hose from water outlet
(2) Water bypass hose from water bypass pipe
(3) California:
Air hose from cylinder head
Except California:
Air hose from air tube
EG1–46
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
I6. REMOVE EGR VALVE AND VACUUM MODULATOR
(a) Disconnect the EGR gas temperature sensor connec–
tor.
(b) Disconnect the following hoses:
(1) 2 vacuum hoses from VSV (for EGR)
(2) Vacuum hose from charcoal canister
(c) Disconnect the vacuum hose clamp.
(d) Loosen the union nut of the EGR pipe, and remove the
2 nuts, EGR valve, vacuum modulator, vacuum hoses
assembly and gasket.
17. DISCONNECT VACUUM HOSES
Disconnect the following hoses:
(1) MAP sensor hose from air intake chamber
(2) Brake booster vacuum hose from air intake cha–
mber
(3) PS vacuum hose from air intake chamber
(4) Vacuum sensing hose from fuel pressure regula–
tor 1
S. W/ A/C:
DISCONNECT A/C IDLE–UP VALVE CONNECTOR
19. EXCEPT CALIFORNIA:
REMOVE AIR TUBE
(a) Disconnect the following hoses from the air tube:
(1) w/ A/C:
Air hose from ASV
(2) 2 air hoses from PS pump
(b) Remove the 3 bolts, wire clamp and air tube.
EG1–47
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
20. CALIFORNIA:
REMOVE AIR TUBE
(a) Disconnect the following hoses:
(1) w/ A/C:
A/C hose (from ASV) from air tube
(2) 2 air hoses (from PS pump) from air tube
(3) California only:
2 vacuum hoses from VSV (for fuel pressure
control)
(4) Vacuum hose from air intake chamber
(b) Remove the 3 bolts, wire clamp and air tube.
21. DISCONNECT 2 ENGINE WIRE GROUND STRAPS
FROM INTAKE MANIFOLD
22. DISCONNECT KNOCK SENSOR AND VSV (FOR
EGR) CONNECTORS
23. CALIFORNIA ONLY:
DISCONNECT VSV (FOR FUEL PRESSURE CON–
TROL) CONNECTOR
24. REMOVE VSV OR VSV ASSEMBLY
25. REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD
(a) Remove the 4 bolts, wire bracket, No.1 air intake
chamber and manifold stays.
(b) Remove the bolt, vacuum hose bracket, and discon–
nect the engine wire.
(c) Remove the6 bolts, 2 nuts, intake manifold and
gasket.
EG1–48
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(d) Disconnect the 2 wire clamps from the wire brackets
on the intake manifold.
26. REMOVE DELIVERY PIPE AND INJECTORS
(a) Disconnect the injector connectors.
(b) Loosen the pulsation damper, and disconnect the fuel
inlet hose.
(c) Disconnect fuel return hose.
(d) Remove the 2 bolts and delivery pipe together with
the 4 injectors.
NOTICE: Be careful not to drop the injectors when rem–
oving the delivery pips.
(e) Remove the 4 insulators (except California) and 2
spacers from the cylinder head.
(f) Pull out the 4 injectors from the delivery pipe.
(g) California:
Remove the 2 O–rings, insulator and grommet from
each injector.
(h) Except California:
Remove the 0–ring and grommet from each injector.
EG1–49
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
27. REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
(See steps 2 to 15 on pages EG1–26 to 28)
28. REMOVE NO. 1 IDLER PULLEY AND TENSION
SPRING
Remove the bolt, pulley and tension spring.
29. REMOVE NO.3 TIMING BELT COVER
Remove the 4 bolts and timing and cover.
NOTICE:
•
•
•
Support the timing belt, :o the meshing of crank–
shaft timing pulley and timing belt does not shift.
Be careful not to drop anything inside the timing
belt cover.
Do not allow the belt to come into correct with oil,
water or dust.
30. REMOVE ENGINE HANGERS
Remove the bolt and engine hanger. Remove the 2
engine hangers. Remove the ground strap.
31. REMOVE GENERATOR BRACKET
Remove the 3 bolts and generator bracket.
32. REMOVE OIL PRESSURE SWITCH
33. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER
Remove the 4 nuts, grommets, head cover and gasket.
EG1–50
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
HINT: Arrange the grommets in correct order, so that
they can be reinstalled into their original positions.
This minimizes any possibility of oil leakage due to
reuse of grommets.
34. REMOVE HIGH – TENSION CORDS CLAMP AND
PCV VALVE
35. REMOVE CAMSHAFTS
NOTICE: Since the thrust clearance of the camshaft is
small, the camshaft must be kept level while it is being
removed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the portion of
the cylinder head receiving the shaft thrust may crack or
be damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To
avoid this, the following steps should be carried out.
A. Remove exhaust camshaft
(a) Set the knock pin of the intake camshaft at 10–45°
BTDC of camshaft position.
HINT: The above angle allows No.2 and No.4 cylinder
cam lobes of the exhaust camshaft to push their valve
lifters evenly.
(b) Secure the exhaust camshaft sub gear to drive gear
with a service bolt.
Recommended service bolt:
Thread diameter6 mm
Thread pitch 1.0 mm
Bolt length 16–20 m m (0.63–0.79 in.)
HINT: When removing the camshaft, make sure that
the torsional spring force of the sub gear has been
eliminated by the above operation.
EG1–51
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c) Remove the 2 bolts and rear bearing cap.
(d) Uniformly loosen and remove the6 bolts on the No. 1,
No.2 and No.4 bearing caps in several passes in the
sequence shown.
NOTICE: Do not remove the No.3 bearing cap bolts at this
stage.
(e) Remove the No. 1, No.2 and No.4 bearing caps.
(f) Alternately loosen and remove the 2 bolts on the No.
3 bearing cap.
HINT:
• As the 2 No.3 bearing cap bolts are loosened, make
sure that the camshaft is lifted out straight and level.
• If the camshaft is not being lifted out straight and
level, retighten the 2 No.3 bearing cap bolts. Then
reverse the order of above steps from (f) to (a) and
reset the knock pin of the intake camshaft at 10–45
BTDC, and repeat steps from
(b) to
(f) once again.
NOTICE: Do not pry on or attempt to force the camshaft
with a tool or other object.
(g) Remove the No.3 bearing cap and exhaust camshaft.
B. Remove intake camshaft
(a) Set the knock pin of the intake camshaft at 80–115
BTDC of camshaft angle.
HINT: The above angle allows the No.1 and No.3
cylinder cam lobes of intake camshaft to push their
valve lifters evenly.
EG1–52
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b) Remove the 2 bolts, front bearing cap and oil seal.
(c) Uniformly loosen and remove the6 bolts on the No.1,
No.3 and No.4 bearing caps in several passes in the
sequence shown.
NOTICE: Do not remove the No.2 bearing cap bolts at this
stage.
(d) Remove the No. 1, No.3 and No.4 bearing caps.
(e) Alternately loosen and remove the 2 bolts on the No.
2 bearing cap.
HINT:
•
As the 2 No.2 bearing cap bolts are loosened, make
sure that the camshaft is lifted out straight and level,
after breaking adhesion on the front bearing cap.
•
If the camshaft is not being lifted out straight and
level, retighten the 2 No.2 bearing cap bolts. Reverse
the order of above steps from (e) to (a) and reset the
knock pin of the intake camshaft at 80–115*6TDC,
and repeat steps from (b) to (e) once again.
NOTICE: Do not pry on or attempt to force the camshaft
with a tool or other object.
(f) Remove the No.2 bearing cap and camshaft.
36. DISASSEMBLE EXHAUST CAMSHAFT
(a) Mount the hexagon wrench head portion of the cam–
shaft in a vise.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the camshaft.
EG1–53
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b) Insert a service bolt (A) into the service hole of the
camshaft sub gear.
(c) Using a screwdriver, turn the sub gear clockwise, and
remove the service bolt (B).
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the camshaft.
(d) Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring.
(e) Remove the following parts:
(1) Wave washer
(2) Camshaft sub gear
(3) Camshaft gear spring
37. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD
(a) Using SST, uniformly loosen and remove the 10 cylin–
der head bolts in several passes, in the sequence
shown.
SST 09011– 38121
NOTICE: Cylinder head warpage or cracking could result
from removing bolts in incorrect order.
EG1–54
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b) Lift the cylinder head from the dowels on the cylinder
block, and place the cylinder head on wooden blocks
on a bench.
HINT: If the cylinder head is difficult to lift off, pry
between the cylinder head and cylinder block with a
screwdriver.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the contact surfaces
of the cylinder head and cylinder block.
CYLINDER HEAD DISASSEMBLY
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. REMOVE VALVE LIFTERS AND SHIMS
HINT: Arrange the valve lifters and shims in correct
order.
2. REMOVE VALVES
(a) Using SST, compress the valve spring and remove the
2 keepers.
SST 09202 – 70010
(b) Remove the spring retainer, valve spring, valve and
spring seat.
HINT: Arrange the valves, valve springs, spring seats
and spring retainers in correct order.
EG1–55
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c) Using needle–nose pliers, remove the oil seal.
CYLINDER HEAD COMPONENTS
INSPECTION, CLEANING AND REPAIR
1. CLEAN TOP SURFACES OF PISTONS AND
CYLINDER BLOCK
(a) Turn the crankshaft, and bring each piston to top dead
center (TDC). Using a gasket scraper, remove all the
carbon from the piston top surface.
(b) Using a gasket scraper, remove all the gasket material
from the cylinder block surface.
(c) Using compressed air, blow carbon and oil from the
bolt holes.
CAUTION: Protect your eyes when using high pressure
compressed air.
2. CLEAN CYLINDER HEAD
A. Remove gasket material
Using a gasket scraper, remove all the gasket material
from the cylinder block contact surface.
NOTICE: Be careful not to scratch the cylinder block
contact surface.
B. Clean combustion chambers
Using a wire brush, remove all the carbon from the
combustion chambers.
NOTICE: Be careful not to scratch the cylinder block
contact surface.
EG1–56
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
C. Clean valve guide bushings
Using a valve guide bushing brush and solvent, clean
all the guide bushings.
D. Clean cylinder head
Using a soft brush and solvent, thoroughly clean the
cylinder head.
3. INSPECT CYLINDER HEAD
A. Inspect for flatness
Using a precision straight edge and thickness gauge,
measure the surfaces contacting the cylinder block
and the manifolds for warpage.
Maximum warpage:
Cylinder block side
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Manifold side
0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
If warpage is greater than maximum, replace the cylin–
der head.
B. Inspect for cracks
Using a dye penetrant, check the combustion cham–
bers, intake ports, exhaust ports and cylinder block
surface for cracks.
If cracked, replace the cylinder head.
EG1–57
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
4. CLEAN VALVES
(a) Using a gasket scraper, chip off any carbon from the
valve head.
(b) Using a wire brush, thoroughly clean the valve.
5. INSPECT VALVE STEMS AND GUIDE BUSHINGS
(a) Using a caliper gauge, measure the inside diameter of
the guide bushing.
Bushing inside diameter:
6.010 –6.030 mm (0.2366 – 0.2374 in.)
(b) Using a micrometer, measure the diameter of the
valve stem.
Valve stem diameter:
Intake
5.970 – 5.985 mm (0.2350 – 0.2356 in.)
Exhaust
5.965 – 5.980 mm (0.2348 – 0.2354 In.)
(c) Subtract the valve stem diameter measurement from
the guide bushing inside diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
Intake
0.025 – 0.060 mm (0.0010 – 0.0024 in.)
Exhaust
0.030 – 0.065 mm (0.0012 – 0.0028 in.)
Maximum oil clearance:
Intake
0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
Exhaust
0.10 mm (0.0039 In.)
If the clearance is greater than maximum, replace the
valve and guide bushing.
EG1–58
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
6. IF NECESSARY, REPLACE VALVE GUIDE
BUSHINGS
(a) w/ Snap Ring:
Insert an old valve wrapped with tape into the valve
guide bushing, and break off the valve guide bushing
by hitting it with a hammer. Remove the snap ring.
HINT: Wrap the tape approx. 8 mm (0.31 in.) from the
valve stem end.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the valve lifter hole.
(b) Gradually heat the cylinder head to 80–100°C (176–
212°F).
(c) Using SST and a hammer, tap out the guide bushing.
SST 09201–70010
(d) Using a caliper gauge, measure the bushing bore di–
ameter of the cylinder head.
Both intake and exhaust
Bushing bore diameter
mm (in.)
Bushing size
11.000 – 11.027
10.4331 – 0.4341)
Use STD
11.050 – 11.077
(0.4350 – 0.4361)
Use O/S 0.05
(e) Select a new guide bushing (STD size or O/S 0.05).
If the bushing bore diameter of the cylinder head is
greater than 11.027 mm (0.4341 in.), machine the
bushing bore to the following dimension:
11.050 – 11.077 mm (0.4350 – 0.4301 in.)
If the bushing bore diameter of the cylinder head is
greater than 11.077 mm (0.4361 in.), replace the
cylinder head.
EG1–59
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(f) Gradually heat the cylinder head to 80 –100 C (117 –
212F).
(g) Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new guide bushing
until the snap ring makes contact with the cylinder
head.
SST 09201– 70010
(h) Using a sharp6 mm reamer, ream the guide bushing
to obtain the standard specified clearance (See page
EG1–57) between the guide bushing and valve stem.
7. INSPECT AND GRIND VALVES
(a) Grind the valve enough to remove pits and carbon.
(b) Check that the valve is ground to the correct valve
face angle.
Valve face angle:
44.5
(c) Check the valve head margin thickness.
Standard margin thickness:
0.8 – 1.2 mm (0.031 – 0.047 in.)
Minimum margin thickness:
0.5 mm (0.020 in.)
If the margin thickness is less than minimum, replace
the valve.
EG1–60
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(d) Check the valve overall length.
Standard overall length:
Intake
97.60 mm (3.8425 in.)
Exhaust
98.45 mm (3.8760 in.)
Minimum overall length:
Intake
97.1 mm (3.823 in.)
Exhaust
98.0 mm (3.858 in.)
If the overall length is less than minimum, replace the
valve.
(e) Check the surface of the valve stem tip for wear.
If the valve stem tip is worn, resurface the tip with a
grinder or replace the valve.
NOTICE: Do not grind off more than minimum.
8. INSPECT AND CLEAN VALVE SEATS
(a) Using a 45 carbide cutter, resurface the valve seats.
Remove only enough metal to clean the seats.
(b) Check the valve seating position.
Apply a light coat of prussian blue (or white lead) to
the valve face. Lightly press the valve against the
seat. Do not rotate valve.
(c) Check the valve face and seat for the following:
If blue appears 360 around the face, the valve is
concentric. If not, replace the valve.
EG1–61
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
• If blue appears 360 around the valve seat, the
guide and face are concentric. If not, resurface
the seat.
• Check that the seat contact is in the middle of the
valve face with the following width:
1.0 – 1.4 mm (0.039 – 0.055 in.)
If not, correct the valve seat as follows:
(1) If the seating is too high on the valve face, use
30 and 45 cutters to correct the seat.
(2) If the seating is too low on the valve face, use
75 and 45 cutters to correct the seat.
(d) Hand–lap the valve and valve seat with an abrasive
compound.
(e) After hand–lapping, clean the valve and valve seat.
9. INSPECT VALVE SPRINGS
(a) Using a steel square, measure the deviation of the
valve spring.
Maximum deviation:
2.0 mm (0.079 in.)
If the deviation is greater than maximum, replace the
valve spring.
(b) Using a vernier caliper, measure the free length of the
valve spring.
Free length:
41.96 – 41.99 mm (1.6520 – 1.6531 in.)
If the free length is not as specified, replace the valve
spring.
EG1–62
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c) Using a spring tester, measure the tension of the valve
spring at the specified installed length.
Installed tension:
164 – 189 N (16.7 – 19.3 kgf, 36.8 – 42.5 lbf)
at 34.7 mm (1.336 in.)
If the installed tension is not as specified, replace the
valve spring.
10. INSPECT CAMSHAFTS AND BEARINGS
A. Inspect camshaft for runout
(a) Place the camshaft on V – blocks.
(b) Using a dial indicator, measure the circle runout at the
center journal.
Maximum circle runout:
0.04 mm (0.0016 in.)
If the circle runout is greater than maximum, replace
the camshaft.
B. Inspect cam lobes
Using a micrometer, measure the cam lobe height.
Standard cam lobe height:
Intake
42.01 – 42.11 mm (1.6539 – 1.6579 in.)
Exhaust
40.06 – 40.18 mm (1.5772 – 1.5811 In.)
Minimum cam lobe height:
Intake
41.90 mm (1.6496 in.)
Exhaust
39.95 mm (1.5728 in.)
If the cam lobe height is less than minimum, replace
the camshaft.
C. Inspect camshaft journals
Using a micrometer, measure the journal diameter.
Journal diameter:
26.959 – 28.975 mm 11.0814 – 1.0620 in.)
If the journal diameter is not as specified, check the oil
clearance.
EG1–63
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
D. Inspect camshaft bearings
Check that bearings for flaking and scoring.
If the bearings are damaged, replace the bearing caps
and cylinder head as a set.
E. Inspect camshaft gear spring
Using a vernier caliper, measure the free distance
between the spring ends.
Free distance:
22.5 – 22.9 mm (0.886 – 0.902 in.)
If the free distance is not as specified, replace the gear
spring.
F. Inspect camshaft journal oil clearance
(a) Clean the bearing caps and camshaft journals.
(b) Place the camshafts on the cylinder head.
(c) Lay a strip of Plastigage across each of the camshaft
journals.
(d) Install the bearing caps.
(See step 4 on pages EG1–69 to 71)
Torque: 19 N–m (190 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
NOTICE: Do not turn the camshaft.
(e) Remove the bearing caps.
EG1–64
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(f) Measure the Plastigage at its widest point.
Standard oil clearance:
0.025 – 0.062 mm (0.0010 – 0.0024 In.)
Maximum oil clearance:
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than maximum, replace
the camshaft. If necessary, replace the bearing caps
and cylinder head as a set.
(g) Completely remove the Plastigage.
G. Inspect camshaft thrust clearance
(a) Install the camshaft.
(See step 4 on pages EG1–69 to 71)
(b) Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance
while moving the camshaft back and forth.
Standard thrust clearance:
Intake
0.045 – 0.100 mm (0.0018 – 0.0039 in.)
Exhaust
0.030 – 0.085 mm (0.0012 – 0.0033 in.)
Maximum thrust clearance:
Intake
0.12 mm (0.0047 in.)
Exhaust
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
If the thrust clearance is greater than maximum, re–
place the camshaft. If necessary, replace the bearing
caps and cylinder head as a set.
H. Inspect camshaft gear backlash
(a) Install the camshafts without installing the exhaust
cam sub gear.
(See step 4 on pages EG1–69 to 71)
(b) Using a dial indicator, measure the backlash.
Standard backlash:
0.020 – 0.200 mm (0.0008 – 0.0079 in.)
Maximum backlash:
6.30 mm (0.0188 in.)
If the backlash is greater then maximum, replace the
camshafts.
EG1–65
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
11. INSPECT VALVE LIFTERS AND LIFTER BORES
(a) Using a caliper gauge, measure the lifter bore diame–
ter of the cylinder head.
Lifter bore diameter:
31.000 – 31.018 mm (1.2205 – 1.2213 In.)
(b) Using a micrometer, measure the lifter diameter.
Lifter diameter:
30.966 – 30.976 mm (1.2191 – 1.2195 in.)
(c) Subtract the lifter diameter measurement from the
lifter bore diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
0.024 – 0.052 mm (0.0009 – 0.0020 in.)
Maximum oil clearance:
0.07 mm (0.0028 In.)
If the oil clearance is greater than maximum, replace
the lifter. If necessary, replace the cylinder head.
12. INSPECT MANIFOLDS
Using a precision straight edge and feeler gauge, mea–
sure the surface contacting the cylinder head for war–
page.
Maximum warpage:
0.30 mm (0.0 118 In.)
If warpage is greater than maximum, replace the man–
ifold.
EG1–66
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
CYLINDER HEAD ASSEMBLY
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
HINT:
• Thoroughly clean all parts to be assembled.
Before installing the parts, apply new engine oil to all
sliding and rotating surfaces.
• Replace all gaskets and oil seals with new ones.
1. INSTALL VALVES
(a) Using SST, push in a new oil seal.
SST 09201 –41020
HINT: The intake valve oil seal is brown and the
exhaust valve oil seal is black.
(b) Install the following parts:
(1) Valve
(2) Spring seat
(3) Valve spring
(4) Spring retainer
(c) Using SST, compress the valve spring and place the 2
keepers around the valve stem.
SST 09202 – 70010
EG1–67
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(d) Using a plastic–faced hammer, lightly tap the valve
stem tip to assure proper fit.
2. INSTALL VALVE LIFTERS AND SHIMS
(a) Install the valve lifter and shim.
(b) Check that the valve lifter rotates smoothly by hand.
CYLINDER HEAD INSTALLATION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD
A. Place cylinder head on cylinder block
(a) Place a new cylinder head gasket in position on the
cylinder block.
NOTICE: Be careful of the installation direction.
(b) Place the cylinder head in position on the cylinder
head gasket.
B. Install cylinder head bolts
HINT:
• The cylinder head bolts are tightened in 2 progressive
steps (steps (b) and (d)).
• If any cylinder head bolt is broken or deformed, re–
place it.
(a) Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and
under the heads of the cylinder head bolts.
(b) Using SST, install and uniformly tighten the 10 cylin–
der head bolts and plate washers in several passes, in
the sequence shown.
SST 09011– 38121
Torque: 49 N–m (500 kgf–cm, 36 ft–lbf)
If any one of the cylinder head bolts does not meet the
torque specification, replace the cylinder head bolt.
EG1–68
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c) Mark the front of the cylinder head bolt head with
paint.
(d) Retighten the cylinder head bolts 90 in the sequence
shown on the previous page.
(e) Check that the painted mark is now at a 90 angle to
front.
2. INSTALL SPARK PLUG TUBES
(a) Clean the cylinder head tube holes of any residua!
adhesive, oil or foreign particles. Remove any oil with
kerosene or gasoline.
(b) Screw the threads of the spark plug tube coated with
adhesive into the cylinder head.
(c) Using the spark plug tube nut and a 30 mm socket
wrench, tighten the spark plug tubes.
Torque: 39 N–m (400 kgf–cm, 29 ft–lbf)
3. ASSEMBLY EXHAUST CAMSHAFT
(a) Mount the hexagon wrench head portion of the cam–
shaft in a vise.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the camshaft.
(b) Install the following parts:
(1) Camshaft gear spring
(2) Camshaft sub gear
(3) Wave washer
HINT: Align the pins on the gears with the spring ends.
EG1–69
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c) Using snap ring pliers, install the snap ring.
(d) Insert a service bolt (A) into the service hole of the
camshaft sub gear.
(e) Using a screwdriver, align the holes of the camshaft
main gear and sub gear by turning camshaft sub gear
clockwise, and install a service bolt (13).
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the camshaft.
4. INSTALL CAMSHAFTS
NOTICE: Since the thrust clearance of the camshaft is
small, the camshaft must be kept level while it is being
installed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the portion of
the cylinder head receiving the shaft thrust may crack or
be damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To
avoid this, the following steps should be carried out.
A. Install intake camshaft
(a) Apply MP grease to the thrust portion of the cam–
shaft.
(b) Place the intake camshaft at 80–115° BTDC of cam–
shaft angle, on the cylinder head.
HINT: The above angle arrows the No.1 and No.3
cylinder cam lobes of the intake camshaft to push
their valve lifters evenly.
(c) Apply seal packing to the No. 1 bearing cap as shown.
Seal packing:
Part No.08826 –00080 or equivalent
EG1–70
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(d) Install the bearing caps in their proper locations.
(e) Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and
under the heads of the bearing cap bolts.
(f) Install and uniformly tighten the 10 bearing cap bolts
in several passes, in the sequence shown.
Torque: 19 N–m (190 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
(g) Apply MP grease to a new oil seal lip.
(h) Using SST, tap in the oil seal.
SST 09223–4601 1
B. Install exhaust camshaft
(a) Set the knock pin of the intake camshaft at 10–45°
BTDC of camshaft angle.
HINT: The above angle allows the No.2 and No.4
cylinder cam lobes of the exhaust camshaft to push
their valve lifters evenly.
EG1–71
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b) Apply MP grease to the thrust portion of the cam–
shaft.
(c) Engage the exhaust camshaft gear to the intake cam–
shaft gear by matching the timing marks on each gear.
(d) Roll down the exhaust camshaft onto the bearing
journals while engaging gears with each other.
NOTICE: There are also assembly reference marks on
each gear as shown in the Illustration. Do not use these
marks.
(e) Turn the intake camshaft clockwise or counterclockwise little
by little until the exhaust camshaft sits in
the bearing journals evenly without rocking the cam–
shaft on the bearing journals.
NOTICE: It is very important to replace the camshaft in
the bearing journals evenly while tightening bearing caps
in the subsequent steps.
(f) Install the bearing caps in their proper locations.
(g) Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and
under the heads of the bearing cap bolts.
(h) Install and uniformly tighten the 10 bearing cap bolts
in several passes, in the sequence shown.
Torque: 19 N–m (190 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
(i) Remove the service bolt (B).
5. CHECK AND ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE
(See page EG1–12)
Turn the camshaft and position the cam lobe upward,
and check and adjust the valve clearance.
Valve clearance (Cold):
Intake
0.19 – 0.29 mm (0.007 – 0.011 In.)
Exhaust
0.28 – 0.38 mm (0.011 – 0.015 In.)
EG1–72
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
6. INSTALL SEMI–CIRCULAR PLUGS
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material.
(b) Apply seal packing to the semi–circular plug grooves.
Seal packing:
Part No.08826–00080 or equivalent
(c) Install the 2 semi–circular plugs to the cylinder head.
7. INSTALL PCV VALVE AND HIGH–TENSION
CORDS CLAMP
8. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material.
(b) Apply seal packing to the cylinder head as shown in
the illustration.
Seal packing:
Part No.08826–00080 or equivalent
EG1–73
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c) Install the gasket to the head cover.
(d) Install the head cover with the 4 grommets and nuts.
Uniformly tighten the nuts in several passes.
Torque: 23 N–m (230 kgf–cm, 17 ft–lbf)
HINT: Install the grommets so that their markings are
as shown in the illustration.
9. INSTALL OIL PRESSURE SWITCH
Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads.
Adhesive:
Part No.08833–00080, THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
10. INSTALL GENERATOR BRACKET
Install the generator bracket with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 42 N–m (425 kgf–cm, 31 ft–lbf)
11. INSTALL ENGINE HANGERS
Install the engine hanger with the bolt. Install the 2
engine hangers. Install the ground strap.
Torque: 25 N–m (250 kgf–cm, 18 ft–lbf)
12. INSTALL NO.3 TIMING BELT COVER
Install the timing belt cover with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 7.8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in–lbf)
EG1–74
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
13. TEMPORARILY INSTALL NO.1 IDLER PULLEY AND
TENSION SPRING
(a) Install the pulley with the bolt. Do not tighten the bolt
yet.
HINT: Use bolt 42 mm (1.65 in.) in length.
(b) Install the tension spring.
(c) Pry the pulley toward the left as far as it will go and
tighten the bolt.
(d) Check that the idler pulley moves smoothly.
14. INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY AND
TIMING BELT
(See page EG1–33)
15. INSTALL INJECTORS AND DELIVERY PIPE
(a) California:
Install new insulator and grommet to each injector.
(b) Except California:
Install a new grommet to each injector.
(c) California:
Apply a light coat of gasoline to 2 new 0–rings, and
install them to each injector.
(d) Except California:
Apply a light coat of gasoline to a new 0–ring, and
install it to each injector.
(e) While turning the injector left and right, install it to the
delivery pipes. Install the 4 injectors.
EG1–75
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(f) Install the following parts to the intake manifold:
(1) 2 spacers
(2) Except California:
4 new insulators
(g) Place the 4 injectors together with the delivery pipe in
position on the cylinder head.
(h) Temporarily install the 2 bolts holding the delivery
pipe to the cylinder head.
(i) Check that the injectors rotate smoothly.
HINT: If injectors do not rotate smoothly, the probable
cause is incorrect installation of O–rings. Replace the
O–rings.
(j) Position the injector connector upward.
(k) Tighten the 2 bolts holding the delivery pipe to the
cylinder head.
Torque: 13 N–m (130 kgf–cm, 9 ft–lbf)
(l) Connect the fuel return hose.
(m) Connect the fuel inlet pipe to the delivery pipe with 2 new
gaskets and the pulsation damper.
Torque: 34 N–m (350 kgf–cm, 25 ft–lbf)
EG1–76
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
16. INSTALL INTAKE MANIFOLD
(a) Connect the 2 wire clamps to the wire brackets on the
intake manifold.
(b) Install a new gasket and the intake manifold with the
6 bolts and 2 nuts. Uniformly tighten the bolts and
nuts in several passes.
Torque: 19 N–m (195 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
(c) Install the vacuum hose bracket and engine wire har–
ness with the bolt.
(d) Install the No.1 air intake chamber and manifold stays,
wire bracket with the 4 bolts.
14 mm head bolt
Torque: 42 N–m (425 kgf–cm, 31 ft–lbf)
12 mm head bolt
Torque: 22 N–m (220 kgf–cm, 16 ft–lbf)
17. INSTALL VSV OR VSV ASSEMBLY
18. CALIFORNIA ONLY:
CONNECT VSV (FOR FUEL PRESSURE CONTROL)
CONNECTOR
19. CONNECT KNOCK SENSOR AND VSV (FOR EGR)
CONNECTORS
20. INSTALL 2 ENGINE WIRE GROUND STRAPS TO
INTAKE MANIFOLD
21. CALIFORNIA:
INSTALL AIR TUBE
(a) Install the air tube and wire clamp with the 3 bolts.
EG1–77
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b) Connect the following hoses:
(1) w/ A/C:
A/C hose (from ASV) to air tube
(2) 2 air hoses (from PS pump) to air tube
(3) 2 vacuum hoses to VSV (for fuel pressure con–
trol)
(4) Vacuum hose to air intake chamber
22. EXCEPT CALIFORNIA:
INSTALL AIR TUBE
(a) Install the air tube and wire clamp with the 3 bolts.
(b) Connect the following hoses to the air tube:
(1) w/ A/C:
Air hose from ASV
(2) 2 air hose from PS pump
23. CONNECT VACUUM HOSES
Connect the following hoses:
(1) MAP sensor hose to air intake chamber
(2) Brake booster vacuum hose to air intake chamber
(3) PS vacuum hose to air intake chamber
(4) Vacuum sensing hose to fuel pressure regulator.
24. w/ A/C:
CONNECT A/C IDLE–UP VALVE CONNECTOR
25. INSTALL EGR VALVE AND VACUUM MODULATOR
(a) Install a new gasket and the EGR valve with the union
nut and 2 nuts.
Union nut:
Torque: 59 N–m (600 kgf–cm, 43 ft–lbf)
Nut:
Torque: 13 N–m (130 kgf–cm, 9 ft–lbf)
(b) Install the EGR modulator to the clamp.
EG1–78
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c) Connect the vacuum hose clamp.
(d) Connect the following hoses:
(1) Vacuum hose to charcoal canister
(2) Vacuum hose (from EGR valve) to E port of VSV
(for EGR)
(3) Vacuum hose (from Q port of EGR vacuum mod–
ulator) to G port of VSV (for EGR)
(e) Connect the EGR gas temperature sensor connector.
26. INSTALL THROTTLE BODY
(a) Connect the following hoses to the throttle body:
(1) Water bypass hose from water outlet
(2) Water bypass hose from water bypass pipe
(3) California:
Air hose from cylinder head
Except California:
Air hose from air tube
(b) Place a new gasket on the intake chamber, facing the
protrusion downward.
(c) Type A:
Install the throttle body with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 19 N–m (195 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
HINT: Each bolt is indicated in the illustration.
Bolt length:
A 45 mm (1.77 in.)
B 55 mm (2.17 in.)
(d) Type e:
Install the throttle body with the 2 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 19 N–m (195 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
(e) Connect the following hoses to the throttle body:
(1) PCV hose
(2) 2 vacuum hoses from EGR vacuum modulator
(3) Vacuum hose from TVV (for EVAP)
EG1–79
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(f) Connect the IAC valve connector.
(g) Connect the throttle position sensor connector.
27. INSTALL WATER BYPASS PIPE
(a) Install a new 0–ring to the bypass pipe.
(b) Apply soapy water on the 0– ring.
(c) Install a new gasket and the bypass pipe with the 2
nuts and 2 bolts.
Torque (Nut): 8.8 N–m (90 kgf–cm. 78 in.–lbf)
(d) Connect the following hoses:
(1) IAC water bypass hose
(2) Heater water hose
(3) w/ Oil Cooler:
2 oil cooler water bypass hoses
28. INSTALL WATER OUTLET
(a) Install a new gasket and the water outlet with the 2
bolts.
Torque: 15 N–m (150 kgf–cm, 11 ft–lbf)
(b) Connect the following hoses:
(1) Upper radiator hose
(2) Water bypass pipe hose
(3) Heater water hose
(4) IAC water bypass hose
(5) TVV (for EVAP) vacuum hose (from P port of
throttle body)
(6) TVV (for EVAP) vacuum hose (from charcoal canister)
EG1–80
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c) Connect the following connectors:
(1) Engine coolant temperature sender gauge con–
nector
(2) Engine coolant temperature sensor connector
29. CONNECT ENGINE WIRE (FOR OXYGEN SENSORS)
TO ENGINE HANGER
30. CONNECT OIL PRESSURE SWITCH CONNECTOR
31. ASSEMBLE EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND WARM UP
THREE–WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER
Assemble the following parts:
(1) WU–TWC
(2) Cushion
(3) Retainer
(4) Gasket
(5) Exhaust manifold
(6) 3 bolts and 2 nuts
Torque: 29 N–m (300 kgf–cm, 22 ft–lbf)
(7) 2 converter heat insulators
(8) 8 bolts
(9) Manifold lower heat insulator
(10) 3 bolts
32. INSTALL EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND WARM UP
THREE–WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
(a) Install a new gasket, the exhaust manifold and WU –
TWC assembly with the 6 nuts. Uniformly tighten the
nuts in several passes.
Torque: 49 N–m (540 kgf–cm, 36 ft–lbf)
EG1–81
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b) Install the manifold stay with the bolt and nut.
Torque: 42 N–m (425 kgf–cm, 31 ft–lbf)
(c) Install the No. 1 manifold stay with the bolt and nut.
Torque: 42 N–m (425 kgf–cm, 31 ft–lbf)
(d) Install the manifold upper heat insulator with the 4
bolts.
(e) Connect the main oxygen and sub oxygen sensor
connectors.
33. CONNECT FRONT EXHAUST PIPE
(a) Place a new gasket on the front exhaust pipe.
(b) Using a 14 mm deep socket wrench, install the 3 new
nuts holding the front exhaust pipe to the WU –TWC.
Torque: 62 N–m (630 kgf–cm, 46 ft–lbf)
(c) Install the bracket with the 2 bolts.
34. INSTALL DISTRIBUTOR
(See page IG–17 and 37)
35. INSTALL GENERATOR (See page CH–24)
36. INSTALL AIR CLEANER CAP, RESONATOR AND
AIR CLEANER HOSE
(a) Connect the air cleaner hose to the throttle body.
(b) Install the air cleaner cap together with the resonator
and air cleaner hose.
(c) California only:
Connect the air hose to the air cleaner hose.
(d) Connect the intake air temperature sensor connector.
EG1–82
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
37. A/T:
CONNECT AND ADJUST THROTTLE CABLE
38. CONNECT AND ADJUST ACCELERATOR CABLE
39. FILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
Capacity:
6.3 liters (6.7 US qts, 5.5 Imp. qts)
40. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE TO
BATTERY
41. START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR LEAKS
42. ADJUST IGNITION TIMING
(See page IG –19 and 38)
Ignition timing:
10 BTDC @ idle
(w/ Terminals TO and E1 connected)
43. PERFORM ROAD TEST
Check for abnormal noise, shock, slippage, correct shift
points and smooth operation.
44. RECHECK ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL AND OIL
LEVEL
EG1–83
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
CYLINDER BLOCK
COMPONENTS FOR ENGINE REMOVAL
AND INSTALLATION
EG1–84
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
EG1–85
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
ENGINE REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable Is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. REMOVE BATTERY AND TRAY
3. REMOVE HOOD
4. REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER
5. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
6. DRAIN ENGINE OIL
7. DISCONNECT ACCELERATOR CABLE FROM
THROTTLE BODY
8. A/T:
DISCONNECT THROTTLE CABLE FROM
THROTTLE BODY
9. REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY, RESONATOR
AND AIR CLEANER HOSE
(a) Disconnect the intake air temperature sensor connec–
tor.
(b) California only:
Disconnect the air hose from the air cleaner hose.
(c) Loosen the air cleaner hose clamp bolt.
(d) Disconnect the 4 air cleaner cap clips.
(e) Disconnect the air cleaner hose from the throttle
body, and remove the air cleaner cap together with
the resonator and air cleaner hose.
(f) Remove the element.
(g) Remove the 3 bolts and air cleaner case.
10. w/ CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM:
REMOVE CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
(a) Remove the actuator cover.
(b) Disconnect the actuator connector.
(c) Remove the 3 bolts, and disconnect the actuator with
the bracket.
11. REMOVE RADIATOR
EG1–86
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
12. DISCONNECT WIRES AND CONNECTORS
(a) Remove the engine relay box, and disconnect the 5
connectors.
(b) Connector from LH fender apron
(c) Disconnect the following connectors:
(1) Igniter connector
(2) California only:
Ignition coil connector
(3) Noise filter connector
(4) 2 ground straps from LH fender apron
(5) Connector from LH fender apron
(6) Data link connector 1
(7) 2 ground straps from RH fender apron
(d) Disconnect the MAP sensor connector.
13. DISCONNECT HEATER HOSES
14. DISCONNECT FUEL RETURN HOSE
CAUTION: Catch leaking fuel in a container.
EG1–87
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
15. DISCONNECT FUEL INLET HOSE
CAUTION: Catch leaking fuel in a container.
16. M/T:
REMOVE STARTER
17. M/T:
REMOVE CLUTCH RELEASE CYLINDER WITHOUT
DISCONNECTING TUBE
Remove the 4 bolts, release cylinder and tube from
the transaxle.
18. DISCONNECT TRANSAXLE CONTROL CABLE (S)
FROM TRANSAXLE
19. DISCONNECT VACUUM HOSES
(a) MAP sensor hose from air intake chamber
(b) Brake booster vacuum hose from air intake chamber
EG1–88
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c) Charcoal canister vacuum hose
20. DISCONNECT ENGINE WIRE FROM CABIN
(a) Remove the under cover.
(b) Remove the lower instrument panel.
(c) Remove the glove compartment door.
(d) Remove the glove compartment.
(e) Disconnect the following connectors:
(1) 2 ECM connectors
(2) 2 cowl wire connector
(f) Remove the 2 nuts, and pull out the engine wire from
the cowl panel.
EG1–89
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
21. w/ A/C:
REMOVE A/C COMPRESSOR WITHOUT
DISCONNECTING HOSES
(a) Disconnect the A/C compressor connector.
(b) Remove the drive belt.
(c) Remove the 3 bolts, and disconnect the A/C compres–
sor.
HINT: Put aside the compressor, and suspend it to the
radiator support with a string.
22. DISCONNECT FRONT EXHAUST PIPE
(a) Loosen the 2 bolts, and disconnect the bracket.
(b) Using a 14 mm deep socket wrench, remove the 3
nuts holding the front exhaust pipe to the WU–TWC.
(c) Disconnect the front exhaust pipe and gaskets.
23. REMOVE DRIVE SHAFTS (See page SA–38)
24. REMOVE PS PUMP WITHOUT DISCONNECTING
HOSES
(a) Disconnect the 2 air hoses from the air pipe.
(b) Remove the PS drive belt.
(c) Remove the 2 bolts, and disconnect the PS pump from
the engine.
HINT: Put aside the pump and suspend it from the
cowl with a string.
25. DISCONNECT LH ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
M/T:
Remove the 3 bolts, and disconnect the mounting
insulator.
A/T:
Remove the 4 bolts, and disconnect the mounting
insulator.
EG1–90
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
26. DISCONNECT RR ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
(a) Remove the hole plugs.
(b) Remove the 3 nuts, and disconnect the mounting
insulator.
27. DISCONNECT FR ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
Remove the 3 bolts, and disconnect the mounting
insulator.
28. ATTACH ENGINE SLING DEVICE TO ENGINE
HANGERS
29. REMOVE ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD
Remove the 3 bolts and control rod.
30. REMOVE ENGINE AND TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
FROM VEHICLE
(a) Lift the engine out of the vehicle slowly and carefully.
NOTICE: Be careful not to hit the PS gear housing or
perk/neutral position switch (A/T).
(b) Make sure the engine is clear of all wiring, hoses and
cables.
(c) Place the engine and transaxle assembly onto the
stand.
EG1–91
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
31. A/T:
REMOVE STARTER
32. SEPARATE ENGINE AND TRANSAXLE
M/T (See page MX–10)
A/T (See page AX1–21)
33. REMOVE N0.2 RH ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET
Remove the 3 bolts and engine mounting bracket.
34. REMOVE FR ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
(a) Remove the bolt, nut and manifold stay.
(b) Remove the 4 bolts and mounting insulator.
35. REMOVE RR ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
Remove the 4 bolts and mounting insulator.
EG1–92
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
COMPONENTS FOR CYLINDER BLOCK
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY
EG1–93
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
PREPARATION FOR DISASSEMBLY
1. M/T:
REMOVE CLUTCH COVER AND DISC
2. M/T:
REMOVE FLYWHEEL
3. A/T:
REMOVE DRIVE PLATE
4. REMOVE REAR END PLATE
Remove the bolt and end plate.
5. INSTALL ENGINE TO ENGINE STAND FOR
DISASSEMBLY
6. REMOVE GENERATOR
7. REMOVE DISTRIBUTOR
8. REMOVE PS PUMP BRACKET
Remove the 3 bolts and PS pump bracket.
9. REMOVE TIMING BELT AND PULLEYS
10. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD
11. REMOVE WATER PUMP AND GENERATOR
ADJUSTING BAR
12. REMOVE OIL PAN AND OIL PUMP
13. REMOVE OIL FILTER
14. w/ OIL COOLER:
REMOVE OIL COOLER
15. REMOVE KNOCK SENSOR
Using SST, remove the knock sensor.
SST 09816 – 30010
EG1–94
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
CYLINDER BLOCK DISASSEMBLY
(See Components for Cylinder Block Disassembly
and Assembly)
1. REMOVE REAR OIL SEAL RETAINER
Remove the 6 bolts, retainer and gasket.
2. CHECK THRUST CLEARANCES OF NO.1 AND NO.2
BALANCE SHAFT OF ENGINE BALANCER
Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance
while moving the balance shaft back and forth.
Standard thrust clearance:
0.065 – 0.110 mm (0.0026 – 0.0043 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.11 mm (0.0043 in.)
If the clearance is greater than maximum, replace the
balance shaft housings and bearings. If necessary,
replace the balance shafts.
3. CHECK BACKLASH OF CRANKSHAFT GEAR AND
NO.1 BALANCE SHAFT GEAR
NOTICE:
• Backlash between the crankshaft gear and No.1
balance shaft gear varies with the rotation of the
balance shaft and the deviation of the crankshaft
gear.
• Accordingly, it is necessary to measure the backlash
at the 4 points shown in the illustration on the left.
When this inspection is performed on–vehicle, the
specifications are increased by approx. 0.025 mm
(See specifications below)
(a) Rotate the crankshaft 2 or 3 times to settle the crank–
shaft gear and No.1 balance shaft gear.
(b) When No.1 piston is at TDC, check that the punch
marks shown in the illustration of the balance shafts
are aligned with the grooves of the No.2 housing.
EG1–95
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c) Check that the punch marks A and B are at the
positions on the No.1 balance shaft indicated in the
illustration.
(d) 1 st turn the crankshaft clockwise, and align the
groove of the No.2 balance shaft housing with the
punch mark A of the No. 1 balance shaft.
(e) Set the SST and the dial indicator as shown in the
illustration.
SST 09224– 74010
HINT: Make sure that the–needle of the dial indicator is
perpendicular to the SST and that it is placed in the
middle of the third indention.
(f) Lightly turn the No. 1 balance shaft by hand and meas–
ure the backlash.
HINT:
• Turn the No.1 balance shaft 4 or 5 times to
provide a steady backlash reading.
• To prevent excessive backlash due to thrust cle–
arance, measure the backlash while pressing on
the rear of the No.1 balance shaft.
Standard backlash:
Off–vehicle
0–0.06 mm (0–0.0024 In.)
On–vehicle
0.025 – 0.080 mm (0.0010 – 0.0035 in.)
NOTICE: Do not turn the No.1 balance shaft strongly.
(g) Remove the dial gauge and the SST.
EG1–96
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(h) Turn the crankshaft clockwise to align the groove of
the No.2 housing with the punch mark B.
(i) Set the dial gauge. (See procedure in step (e))
(j) Measure the backlash. (See procedure in step (f))
Standard backlash:
0 – 0.06 mm (0 – 0.0024 in.)
(k) Remove the dial gauge.
(I) Turn the crankshaft clockwise again to align the
groove of the No.2 housing with the punch mark A.
(m) Set the dial gauge. (See procedure in step (e))
(n) Measure the backlash. (See procedure in step (f))
Standard backlash:
0 – 0.06 mm (0 – 0.0024 in.)
(o) Remove the dial gauge.
(p) Turn the crankshaft clockwise again to align the
groove of the No.2 housing with the punch mark B.
(q) Set the dial gauge. (See procedure in step (e))
(r) Measure the backlash. (See procedure in step (f))
Standard backlash:
0 – 0.06 mm (0 – 0.0024 In.)
(s) Remove the dial gauge.
If even one of the 4 points measured above exceeds
the backlash specification, adjust the backlash with
new spacers.
NOTICE: Use the same size spacers for both the left and
right sides.
HINT:
•
Varying the spacer thickness by 0.02 mm
(0.0008 in.) change the backlash by about 0.014
mm (0.0006 in.).
•
If the backlash is greater than permitted maxi–
mum, select a thinner shim.
•
If the backlash is less than the specification,
select a thicker shim.
EG1–97
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
EG1–98
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
4. REMOVE ENGINE BALANCER
(a) Uniformly loosen and remove the 6 bolts in several
passes, in the sequence shown.
(b) Remove the engine balancer and spacers.
5. CHECK CONNECTING ROD THRUST CLEARANCE
Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance
while moving the connecting rod back and forth.
Standard thrust clearance:
0.160 – 0.312 mm (0.0063 – 0.0123 in.)
Maximum thrust clearance:
0.36 mm (0.0138 in.)
If the thrust clearance is greater than maximum, re–
place the connecting rod assembly. If necessary, re–
place the crankshaft.
6. REMOVE CONNECTING ROD CAPS AND CHECK
OIL CLEARANCE
(a) Check the matchmarks on the connecting rod and cap
to ensure correct reassembly.
(b) Using SST, remove the connecting rod cap nuts.
SST 09011–38121
(c) Using a plastic–faced hammer, lightly tap the con–
necting rod bolts and lift off the connecting rod cap.
HINT: Keep the lower bearing inserted with the con–
necting rod cap.
EG1–99
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(d) Cover the connecting rod bolts with a short piece of
hose to protect the crankshaft from damage.
(e) Clean the crank pin and bearing.
(f) Check the crank pin and bearing for pitting and scrat–
ches.
If the crank pin or bearing is damaged, replace the
bearings. If necessary, grind or replace the crankshaft.
(g) Lay a strip of Plastigage across the crank pin.
(h) Install the connecting rod cap.
(See step 6 on pages EG1–122)
1st
Torque: 25 N–m (250 kgf–cm, 18 ft–lbf)
2nd Turn 90°
NOTICE: Do not turn the crankshaft.
(i) Remove the connecting rod cap.
(See procedure (b) and (c) on the previous page)
EG1–100
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(j) Measure the Plastigage at its widest point.
Standard oil clearance:
STD
0.024 – 0.055 mm (0.0009 – 0.0022 in.)
U/S 0.25
0.023 – 0.069 mm (0.0009 – 0.0027 in.)
Maximum oil clearance:
0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than maximum, replace
the bearings. If necessary, grind or replace the crank–
shaft.
HINT: If using a standard bearing, replace it with one
having the same number marked on the connecting
rod cap. There are 3 sizes of standard bearings,
marked *11’, “2” and “3” accordingly.
Standard sized bearing center wall thickness:
Mark “1”
1.484 – 1.488 mm (0.0584 – 0.0586 in.)
Mark “2”
1.488 – 1.492 mm (0.0586 – 0.0587 in.)
Mark “3”
1.492 – 1.498 mm (0.0587 – 0.0589 in.)
(k) Completely remove the Plastigage.
7. REMOVE PISTON AND CONNECTING ROD
ASSEMBLIES
(a) Using a ridge reamer, remove all the carbon from the
top of the cylinder.
(b) Cover the connecting rod bolts with a short piece of
hose to protect the crankshaft from damage.
(c) Push the piston, connecting rod assembly and upper
bearing through the top of the cylinder block.
EG1–101
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
HINT:
• Keep the bearings, connecting rod and cap to–
gether.
• Arrange the piston and connecting rod assembl–
ies in correct order.
8. CHECK CRANKSHAFT THRUST CLEARANCE
Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance
while prying the crankshaft back and forth with a
screwdriver.
Standard thrust clearance:
0.020 – 0.220 mm (0.0008 – 0.0087 in.)
Maximum thrust clearance:
0.30 mm l0.0118 in.)
If the thrust clearance is greater than maximum, re–
place the thrust washers as a set.
Thrust washer thickness:
2.440 – 2.490 mm 10.0961 – 0.0980 in.)
9. REMOVE MAIN BEARING CAPS AND CHECK OIL
CLEARANCE
(a) Uniformly loosen and remove the main bearing cap
bolts in several passes, in the sequence shown.
(b) Using the removed main bearing cap bolts, pry the
main bearing cap back and forth, and remove the main
bearing caps, lower bearings and lower thrust wash–
ers (No.3 main bearing cap only).
HINT:
• Keep the lower bearing and main bearing cap
together.
• Arrange the main bearing caps and lower thrust
washers in correct order.
EG1–102
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c) Lift out the crankshaft.
HINT: Keep the upper bearing and upper thrust wash–
ers together with the cylinder block.
(d) Clean each main journal and bearing.
(e) Check each main journal and bearing for pitting and
scratches.
If the journal or bearing is damaged, replace the bear–
ings. If necessary, grind or replace the crankshaft.
(f) Place the crankshaft on the cylinder block.
(g) Lay a strip of Plastigage across each journal.
(h) Install the main bearing caps.
(See step 4 on page EG1–121)
Torque: 59 N–m (600 kgf–cm, 43 ft–lbf)
NOTICE: Do not turn the crankshaft.
(i) Remove the main bearing caps.
(See procedure (a) and (b) on the previous page)
EG1–103
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Measure the Plastigage at its widest point.
Standard clearance:
No.3
STD
0.025 – 0.044 mm (0.0010 – 0.0017 in.)
U/S 0.25
0.027 – 0.067 mm (0.0011 – 0.0026 in.)
Others
STD
0.015 – 0.034 mm (0.00015 – 0.0013 in.)
U/S 0.25
0.019 – 0.059 mm (0.0007 – 0.0023 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.08 mm (0.0031 In.)
HINT: If replacing the cylinder block subassembly, the
bearing standard clearance will be:
No.3:
0.027 – 0.054 mm (0.0011 – 0.0021 in.)
Others
0.017 – 0.044 mm (0.0007 – 0.0017 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than maximum, replace
the bearings. If necessary, grind or replace the crank–
shaft.
HINT: If using a standard bearing, replace it with one
having the same number. If the number of the bearing
cannot be determined, select the correct bearing by
adding together the numbers imprinted on the cylin–
der block and crankshaft, then selecting the bearing
with the same number as the total. There are 5 sizes
of standard bearings, marked “1”, “2”, “3”, “4” and “5”
accordingly.
Number marked
Cylinder block
Crankshaft
Use bearing
EXAMPLE: Cylinder block “2” + Crankshaft “11”
= Total number 3 (Use bearing “3”)
EG1–104
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Reference:
Cylinder block main journal bore diameter:
Mark “1”
59.020 – 59.026 mm (2.32318 – 2.3239 in.)
Mark “2”
59.026 – 59.032 mm (2.3239 – 2.3241 in.)
Mark “3”
59.032 – 59.038 mm (2.3241 – 2.3243 in.)
Crankshaft journal diameter:
Mark “0”
54.998 – 55.003 mm (2.1653 – 2.1655 in.)
Mark “11”
54.993–54.998 mm (2.1651 – 2.1653 in.)
Mark “2”
54.988 – 54.993 mm (2.1649 – 2.1651 in.)
Standard sized bearing center wall thickness:
No–3
Mark “I”
1.992 – 1.995 mm (0.0784 – 0.0785 in.)
Mark ’2”
1.995 – 1.998 mm (0.0785 – 0.0787 in.)
Mark “3”
1.998 – 2.001 mm (0.0787 – 0.0788 in.)
Mark ’4”
2.001 – 2.004 mm (0.0788 – 0.0789 in.)
Mark ’5’
2.004 – 2.007 mm (0.0789 – 0.0790 in.)
Others
Mark “I”
1.997 – 2.000 mm (0.0786 – 0.0787 in.)
Mark ’2’
2.000 – 2.003 mm (0.0787 – 0.0789 in.)
Mark “3”
2.003 – 2.006 mm (0.0789 – 0.0790 in.)
Mark ’4’
2.006 – 2.009 mm (0.0790 – 0.0791 in.)
Mark ’5’
2.009 – 2.012 mm (0.0791 – 0.0792 in.)
(k) Completely remove the Plastigage.
10. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT
(a) Lift out the crankshaft.
(b) Remove the upper bearings and upper thrust washers
from the cylinder block.
EG1–105
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
HINT: Arrange the main bearing caps, bearings and
thrust washers in correct order.
CYLINDER BLOCK INSPECTION
1. CLEAN CYLINDER BLOCK
A. Remove gasket material
Using a gasket scraper, remove all the gasket material
from the top surface of the cylinder block.
B. Clean cylinder block
Using a soft brush and solvent, thoroughly clean the
cylinder block.
2. INSPECT TOP SURFACE OF CYLINDER BLOCK FOR
FLATNESS
Using a precision straight edge and thickness gauge,
measure the surfaces contacting the cylinder head
gasket for warpage.
Maximum warpage:
0.05 mm (0.0020 In.)
If warpage is greater than maximum, replace the cylin–
der block.
3. INSPECT CYLINDER FOR VERTICAL SCRATCHES
Visually check the cylinder for vertical scratches.
If deep scratches are present, rebore all the 4 cylin–
ders. If necessary, replace the cylinder block.
EG1–106
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
4. INSPECT CYLINDER BORE DIAMETER
HINT: There are 3 sizes of the standard cylinder bore
diameter, marked “1”, “2” and “3” accordingly. The
mark is stamped on the top of the cylinder block.
Using a cylinder gauge, measure the cylinder bore
diameter at positions A, B and C in the thrust and axial
directions.
Standard diameter:
STD
Mark “1”
87.000 – 87.010 mm (3.4252 – 3.4256 in.)
Mark “2”
87.010 – 87.020 mm (3.4256 – 3.4260 in.)
Mark “3”
87.020 – 87.030 mm (3.4260 – 3.4264 In.)
Maximum diameter:
STD
87.23 mm (3.4342 in.)
O/S 0.50
87.73 mm (3.4350 In.)
If the diameter is greater than maximum, rebore all the 4
cylinders. If necessary, replace the cylinder block.
5. REMOVE CYLINDER RIDGE
If the wear is less than 0.2 mm (0.008 in.), using a
ridge reamer, grind the top of the cylinder.
EG1–107
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
PISTON AND CONNECTING ROD ASSY
DISASSEMBLY
1. CHECK FIT BETWEEN PISTON AND PISTON PIN
Try to move the piston back and forth on the piston
pin.
If any movement is felt, replace the piston and pin as
a set.
2. REMOVE PISTON RINGS
(a) Using a piston ring expander, remove the 2 compres–
sion rings.
(b) Remove the 2 side rails and oil ring by hand.
HINT: Arrange the rings in correct order only.
3. DISCONNECT CONNECTING ROD FROM PISTON
(a) Using a small screwdriver, pry out the 2 snap rings.
(b) Gradually heat the piston to 80–90C (176–194F).
EG1–108
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c) Using plastic–faced hammer and brass bar, lightly
tap out the piston pin and remove the connecting rod.
HINT:
The piston and pin are a matched set.
Arrange the pistons, pins, rings, connecting rods
and bearings in correct order.
PISTON AND CONNECTING ROD
INSPECTION
1. CLEAN PISTON
(a) Using a gasket scraper, remove the carbon from the
piston top.
(b) Using a groove cleaning tool or broken ring, clean the
piston ring grooves.
(c) Using solvent and a brush, thoroughly clean the
piston.
NOTICE: Do not use a wire brush.
EG1–109
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
2. INSPECT PISTON
A. Inspect piston oil clearance
HINT: There are 3 sizes of the standard piston diame–
ter, marked “1”, “2” and “3” accordingly. The mark is
stamped on the piston top.
(a) Using a micrometer, measure the piston diameter at
ring angles to the piston pin center line, 23.5 mm
(0.925 in.) from the piston head.
Piston diameter:
STD
Mark “I”
86.85–86.86 mm (3.4193 – 3.4197 in.)
Mark “2”
86.86–86.87 mm (3.4197 – 3.4201 In.)
Mark “3”
86.87 – 86.88 mm (3.4201 – 3.4205 in.)
O/S 0.50
87.35 – 87.38 mm (3.4390 – 3.4402 in.)
(b) Measure the cylinder bore diameter in the thrust di–
rections.
(See step 4 on page EG1–106)
(c) Subtract the piston diameter measurement from the
cylinder bore diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
0.14 – 0.16 mm (0.0055 – 0.0063 in.)
Maximum oil clearance:
0.18 mm (0.0071 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than maximum, replace
all the 4 pistons and rebore all the 4 cylinders. If
necessary, replace the cylinder block.
HINT (Use new cylinder block): Use a piston with the
same number mark as the cylinder bore diameter
marked on the cylinder block.
EG1–110
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
B. Inspect piston ring groove clearance
Using a thickness gauge, measure the clearance be–
tween new piston ring and the wall of the piston ring
groove.
Ring groove clearance:
No.1
0.040 – 0.080 mm (0.0016 – 0.0031 In.)
No.2
0.030 – 0.070 mm (0.0012 – 0.0028 in.)
If the clearance is greater than maximum, replace the
piston.
C. Inspect piston ring end gap
(a) Insert the piston ring into the cylinder bore.
(b) Using a piston, push the piston ring a little beyond the
bottom of the ring travel, 115 mm (4.53 in.) from the
top of the cylinder block.
(c) Using a thickness gauge, measure the end gap.
Standard and gap:
No.1
0.270 – 0.500 mm (0.0106 – 0.0197 in.)
No.2
0.350 – 0.600 mm (0.0138 – 0.0234 in.)
Oil (Side rail)
0.200 – 0.550 mm (0.0079 – 0.0217 in.)
Maximum end gap:
No.1
1.10 mm (0.0433 in.)
No.2
1.20 mm (0.0472 In.)
Oil (Side rail)
1.15 mm (0.0453 In.)
If the end gap is greater than maximum, replace the
piston ring. If the end gap is greater than maximum,
even with a new piston ring, rebore all the 4 cylinders
or replace the cylinder block.
EG1–111
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
D. Inspect–piston pin fit
At 60C (140 F), you should be able to push the
piston pin into the piston pin hole with your thumb.
3. INSPECT CONNECTING ROD
A. Inspect connecting rod alignment
Using a rod aligner and thickness gauge, check the
connecting rod alignment.
• Check for bend.
Maximum bend:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.) per 100 mm (3.94 In.)
If bend is greater than maximum, replace the connect–
ing rod assembly.
• Check for twist
Maximum twist:
0.15 mm (0.0059 in.) per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
If twist is greater than maximum, replace the connect–
ing rod assembly.
B. Inspect piston pin oil clearance
(a) Using a caliper gauge, measure the inside diameter of
the connecting rod bushing.
Bushing inside diameter:
22.005 – 22.017 mm (0.8663 – 0.8668 in.)
(b) Using a micrometer, measure the piston pin diameter.
Piston pin diameter:
21.997 – 22.009 mm (0.8660 – 0.8865 in.)
EG1–112
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c) Subtract the piston pin diameter measurement from
the bushing inside diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
0.005 – 0.011 mm (0.0002 – 0.0004 in.)
Maximum oil clearance:
0.05 mm (0.0020 In.)
If the oil clearance is greater than maximum, replace
the bushing. If necessary, replace the piston and
piston pin as a set.
C. If necessary, replace connecting rod bushing
(a) Using SST and a press, press out the bushing.
SST 09222 – 30010
(b) Align the oil holes of a new bushing and the connect–
ing rod.
(c) Using SST and a press, press in the bushing.
SST 09222–30010
(d) Using a pin hole grinder, hone the bushing to obtain
the standard specified clearance (see step B above)
between the bushing and piston pin.
(e) Check the piston pin fit at normal room temperature.
Coat the piston pin with engine oil, and push it into the
connecting rod with your thumb.
EG1–113
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
D. Inspect connecting rod bolts
(a) Install the cap nut to the connecting rod bolt. Check
that the cap nut can be turned easily by hand to the
end of the thread.
(b) If the cap nut cannot be turned easily, measure the
outside diameter of the connecting rod bolt with a
vernier caliper.
Standard outside diameter:
7.860–8.000 mm (0.3094–0.3150 in.)
Minimum outside diameter:
7.60 mm (0.2992 in.)
HINT: If the location of this area cannot be judged by
visual inspection, measure the outer diameter at the
location shown in the illustration.
If the outside diameter is less than minimum, replace
the connecting rod bolt and nut as a set.
EG1–114
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
CYLINDER BORING
HINT:
• Bore all the 4 cylinders for the oversized piston
outside diameter.
• Replace all the piston rings with ones to match
the oversized pistons.
1. KEEP OVERSIZED PISTONS
Oversized piston diameter:
O/S 0.50
87.35 – 87.38 mm (3.4390–3.4402 in.)
2. CALCULATE AMOUNT TO BORE CYLINDERS
(a) Using a micrometer, measure the piston diameter at
right angles to the piston pin center line, 23.5 mm
(0.925 in.) from the piston head.
(b) Calculate the amount of each cylinder is to be rebored
as follows:
Size to be rebored = P + C–H
P = Piston diameter
C = Piston clearance
0.14 – 0.18 mm (0.0055 – 0.0063 in.)
H = Allowance for honing
0.20 mm (0.0008 in.) or less
3. BORE AND HONE CYLINDER TO CALCULATED
DIMENSIONS
Maximum honing:
0.02 mm (0.0008 in.)
NOTICE: Excess honing will destroy the finished round–
ness.
EG1–115
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
CRANKSHAFT INSPECTION AND REPAIR
1. INSPECT CRANKSHAFT FOR RUNOUT
(a) Place the crankshaft on V–blocks.
(b) Using a dial indicator, measure the circle runout at the
center journal.
Maximum circle runout:
0.06 mm (0.0024 In.)
If the circle runout is greater than maximum, replace
the crankshaft.
2. INSPECT MAIN JOURNALS AND CRANK PINS
(a) Using a micrometer, measure the diameter of each
main journal and crank pin.
Main journal diameter:
STD size
54.988 – 55.003 mm (2.1653–2.1655 in.)
U/S 0.25
54.745 – 54.755 mm (2.1553–2.1557 in.)
Crank pin diameter:
STD size
51.985 – 52.000 mm (2.0466–2.0472 in.)
U/S 0.25
51.745 – 51.755 mm (2.0372–2.0376 in.)
If the diameter is not as specified, check the oil clear–
ance (See pages EG1–98 to 104). If necessary, grind
or replace the crankshaft.
(b) Check each main journal and crank pin for taper and
out–of–round as shown.
Maximum taper and out–of–round:
0.02 mm (0.0008 in.)
If the taper and out–of–round is greater than maxi–
mum, replace the crankshaft.
3. IF NECESSARY. GRIND AND HONE MAIN JOUR–
NALS AND/OR CRANK PINS
Grind and hone the main journals and/or crank pins to
the finished undersized diameter (See procedure in
step 2).
Install new main journal and/or crankshaft pin under–
sized bearings.
EG1–116
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
CRANKSHAFT OIL SEALS
REPLACEMENT
HINT: There are 2 methods (A and B) to replace the oil
seal which are as follows:
1. REPLACE CRANKSHAFT FRONT OIL SEAL
A. If oil pump is removed from cylinder block:
(a) Using a screwdriver and a hammer, tap out the oil
seal.
(b) Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new oil seal until its
surface is flush with the oil pump case edge.
SST 09223 – 63010
(c) Apply MP grease to the oil seal lip.
B. If oil pump is installed to the cylinder block:
(a) Using a knife, cut off the oil seal lip.
(b) Using a screwdriver, pry out the oil seal.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the crankshaft. Tape
the screwdriver tip.
(c) Apply MP grease to a new oil seal lip.
(d) Using SST and a hammer, tap in the oil seal until its
surface is flush with the oil pump case edge.
SST 09226 –10010
EG1–117
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
2. REPLACE CRANKSHAFT REAR OIL SEAL
A. If rear oil seal retainer is removed from cylinder
block:
(a) Using screwdriver and hammer, tap out the oil seal.
(b) Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new oil seal until its
surface is flush with the rear oil seal edge.
SST 09223–63010
(c) Apply MP grease to the oil seal lip.
B. If rear oil seal retainer Is installed to cylinder block:
(a) Using a knife, cut off the oil seal lip.
(b) Using a screwdriver, pry out the oil seal.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the crankshaft. Tape
the screwdriver tip.
(c) Apply MP grease to a new oil seal lip.
(d) Using SST and a hammer, tap in the oil seal until its
surface is flush with the rear oil seal retainer edge.
SST 09223 – 63010
EG1–118
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
PISTON AND CONNECTING ROD
ASSEMBLY
1. ASSEMBLE PISTON AND CONNECTING ROD
(a) Install a new snap ring on one side of the piston pin
hole.
(b) Gradually heat the piston to 80–90C
(176–194F).
(c) Coat the piston pin with engine oil.
(d) Align the front marks of the piston and connecting
rod, and push in the piston pin with your thumb.
(e) Install a new snap ring on the other side of the piston
pin hole.
2. INSTALL PISTON RINGS
(a) Install the oil ring expander and 2 side rails by hand.
EG1–119
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b) Using a piston ring expander, install the 2 compres–
sion rings with the code mark facing upward.
Code mark:
N o.1
1N orT
No.2
2N or 2T
(c) Position the piston rings so that the ring ends are as
shown.
NOTICE: Do not align the ring ends.
3. INSTALL BEARINGS
(a) Align the bearing claw with the groove of the connect–
ing rod or connecting cap.
(b) Install the bearings in the connecting rod and con–
necting rod cap.
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSEMBLY
(See Components for Cylinder Block Disassembly and
Assembly)
HINT:
• Thoroughly clean all parts to be assembled.
• Before installing the parts, apply new engine oil
to all sliding and rotating surfaces.
• Replace all gaskets, 0–rings and oil seals with
new parts.
1. INSTALL MAIN BEARINGS
HINT:
• Main bearings come in widths of 19.2 mm (0.756
in.) and 22.9 mm (0.902 in.). Install the 22.9 mm
(0.902 in.) bearings in the No.3 cylinder block
journal position with the main bearing cap. Install
the 19.2 mm (0.756 in.) bearings in the other
positions.
EG1–120
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
• Upper bearings have an oil groove and oil holes;
lower bearings do not.
(a) Align the bearing claw with the claw groove of the
cylinder block, and push in the 5 upper bearings.
(b) Align the bearing claw with the claw groove of the
main bearing cap, and push in the 5 lower bearings.
HINT: A number is marked on each main bearing cap
to indicate the installation position.
2. INSTALL UPPER THRUST WASHERS
Install the 2 thrust washers under the No.3 journal
position of the cylinder block with the oil grooves
facing outward.
3. PLACE CRANKSHAFT ON CYLINDER BLOCK
EG1–121
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
4. INSTALL MAIN BEARING CAPS AND LOWER
THRUST WASHERS
(a) Install the 2 thrust washers on the No.3 bearing cap
with the grooves facing outward.
(b) Install the 5 main bearing caps in their proper loca–
tions.
HINT: Each bearing cap has a number and front mark.
(c) Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and
under the heads of the main bearing cap bolts.
(d) Install and uniformly tighten the 10 bolts of the main
bearing caps in several passes, in the sequence
shown.
Torque: 59 N–m (600 kgf–cm, 43 ft–lbf)
(e) Check that the crankshaft turns smoothly.
(f) Check the crankshaft thrust clearance.
Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clear–
ance while prying the crankshaft back an forth
with a screwdriver.
Standard thrust clearance:
0.020 – 0.220 mm (0.0008 – 0.0087 in.)
Maximum thrust clearance:
0.30 mm (0.0118 In.)
If the thrust clearance is greater than maximum, re–
place the thrust washers as a set.
5. INSTALL PISTON AND CONNECTING ROD
ASSEMBLES
(a) Cover the connecting rod bolts with a short piece of
hose to protect the crankshaft from damage.
EG1–122
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b) Using a piston ring compressor, push the correctly
numbered piston and connecting rod assemblies
into
each cylinder with the front mark of the piston facing
forward.
6. INSTALL CONNECTING ROD CAPS
A. Place connecting rod cap on connecting rod
(a) Match the numbered connecting rod cap with the
connecting rod.
(b) Install the connecting rod cap with the front mark
facing forward.
B. Install connecting rod cap nuts
HINT:
The cap nuts are tightened in 2 progressive steps
(steps
(b) and
(d)).
If any one of the connecting rod bolts is broken or
deformed, replace it.
(a) Apply a light of engine oil on the threads and under
the nuts of the connecting rod cap.
(b) Using SST, install and alternately tighten the cap nuts
in several passes.
SST 09011– 38121
Torque: 25 N–m (250 kgf–cm, 18 ft–lbf)
If any one of the cap nuts does not meet the torque
specification, replace the connecting rod bolt and cap
nut as a set.
(c) Mark the front of the cap nut with the paint.
EG1–123
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(d) Retighten the cap nuts 90 as shown.
(e) Check that the painted mark is now at a 90 angle to
the front.
(f) Check that the crankshaft turns smoothly.
(g) Check the connecting rod thrust clearance.
Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clear–
ance while moving the connecting rod back an
forth.
Standard thrust clearance:
0.160 – 0.312 mm (0.0063 – 0.0123 In.)
Maximum thrust clearance:
0.35 mm 10.0138 In.)
If the thrust clearance is greater than maximum, re–
place the connecting rod assembly. If necessary, re–
place the crankshaft.
7. INSTALL ENGINE BALANCER
(a) Turn the crankshaft, and set the No. 1 cylinder TDC as
shown in the illustration.
(b) Set the balance shafts so that the punch marks of the
balance shafts are aligned with the grooves of the
No.
2 housing.
EG1–124
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c) Wipe clean the installation surface of the spacer.
(d) Place the spacers on the cylinder block.
HINT: When replacing the crankshaft and/or balance
shaft, use the thickest spacers.
(e) Place the engine balancer on the cylinder block.
(f) Check that punch marks shown in the illustration of
the balance shafts are align with the grooves of the
No.2 housing.
(g) While pulling the center part of the engine balancer
in the direction of the arrow, uniformly tighten the
6
bolts in several passes, in the sequence shown.
Torque: 49 N–m (500 kgf–cm, 36 ft–lbf)
(h) Recheck that the punch marks of the balance shafts
are aligned with the grooves of No.2 housing.
8. CHECK AND ADJUST BACKLASH OF
CRANKSHAFT GEAR AND NO.1 BALANCE SHAFT
GEAR (See page EG1–94)
9. INSTALL REAR OIL SEAL RETAINER
Install a new gasket and the retainer with the 6 bolts.
Torque: 9.3 N–m (95 kgf–cm, 82 in.–lbf)
EG1–125
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
POST ASSEMBLY
1. INSTALL KNOCK SENSOR
Using SST, install the knock sensor.
SST 09816–30010
Torque: 37 N–m (380 kgf–cm. 27 ft–lbf)
2. w/ OIL COOLER:
INSTALL OIL COOLER
3. INSTALL OIL FILTER
4. INSTALL OIL PUMP AND OIL PAN
5. INSTALL WATER PUMP AND GENERATOR
ADJUSTING BAR
6. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD
7. INSTALL PULLEYS AND TIMING BELT
8. INSTALL PS PUMP BRACKET
Install the PS pump bracket with 3 bolts.
Torque: 43 N–m (440 kgf–cm, 32 ft–lbf)
9. INSTALL GENERATOR
10. INSTALL DISTRIBUTOR
11. REMOVE ENGINE STAND
12. INSTALL REAR END PLATE
Torque: 9.3 N–m (95 kgf–cm, 82 in.–lbf)
EG1–126
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
13. M/T:
INSTALL FLYWHEEL
(a) Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the mounting bolt
end.
Adhesive:
Part No.08833–00070. THREE BOND 1324 or equi–
valent
(b) Install the flywheel on the crankshaft.
(c) install and uniformly tighten the mounting bolts in
several passes, in the sequence shown.
Torque: 88 N–m (900 kgf–cm, 66 ft–lbf)
14. A/T:
INSTALL DRIVE PLATE (See procedure step 13)
Torque: 83 N–m (850 kgf–cm, 61 ft–lbf)
15. M/T:
INSTALL CLUTCH DISC AND COVER
EG1–127
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
ENGINE INSTALLATION
(See Components for Engine Removal and Installation)
1. INSTALL RR ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
Install the mounting insulator with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 64 N–m (650 kgf–cm. 47 ft–lbf)
2. INSTALL FR ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
(a) Install the mounting insulator with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 77 N–m (790 kgf–cm. 57 ft–lbf)
(b) Install the manifold stay with the bolt and nut.
Torque: 42 N–m (425 kgf–cm, 31 ft–lbf)
3. INSTALL N0.2 ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET
(a) Temporarily install the No.2 engine mounting bracket
with the 2 bolts.
(b) Install the remain bolt.
(c) Tighten the 3 bolts in the sequence shown.
Torque: 52 N–m (530 kgf–cm, 38 ft–lbf)
4. ASSEMBLE ENGINE AND TRANSAXLE
M/T (See page MX–15)
A/T (See page AX1–27)
5. A/T:
INSTALL STARTER
EG1–128
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
6. INSTALL ENGINE AND TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY IN
VEHICLE
(a) Attach the engine sling device to the engine hangers.
(b) Lower the engine into the engine compartment.
Tilt the transaxle downward, lower the engine and
clear the LH mounting.
NOTICE: Be careful not to hit the PS gear housing or
park/neutral position switch (A/T).
(c) Keep the engine level, and align RH and LH mountings
with the body bracket.
7. INSTALL ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD
(a) Temporarily install the engine moving control rod with
the 3 bolts in the sequence shown.
(b) Tighten the 3 bolts in the sequence shown.
Torque: 64 N–m (650 kgf–cm, 47 ft–lbf)
8. CONNECT FR ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
Connect the mounting insulator with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 80 N–m (820 kgf–cm. 59 ft–lbf)
EG1–129
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
9. CONNECT RR ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
(a) Connect the mounting insulator with the 3 nuts.
Torque: 66 N–m (670 kgf–cm, 48 ft–lbf)
(b) Install the hole plugs:
10. CONNECT LH ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
M/T:
Connect the mounting insulator with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 64 N–m (650 kgf–cm, 47 ft–lbf)
A/T:
Connect the mounting insulator with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 64 N–m (650 kgf–cm, 47 ft–lbf)
11. REMOVE ENGINE SLING DEVICE
12. INSTALL PS PUMP
(a) Install the PS pump with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 43 N–m (440 kgf–cm. 31 ft–lbf)
(b) Install the drive belt.
(c) Connect the 2 air hoses to the air pipe.
13. INSTALL DRIVE SHAFTS
(See page SA–40)
EG1–130
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
14. CONNECT FRONT EXHAUST PIPE
(a) Place a new gasket on the front exhaust pipe.
(b) Using a 14 mm deep socket wrench, install the 3 new
nuts holding the front exhaust pipe to the WU–TWC.
Torque: 82 N–m (630 kgf–cm, 46 ft–lbf)
(c) Install the bracket with the 2 bolts.
15. w/ A/C:
INSTALL A/C COMPRESSOR
(a) Install the compressor with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 27 N–m (280 kgf–cm, 20 ft–lbf)
(b) Install the drive belt.
(c) Connect the A/C compressor connector.
16. CONNECT ENGINE WIRE TO CABIN
(a) Push in the engine wire through the cowl panel. Install
the 2 nuts.
(b) Connect the following connectors:
(1) 2 ECM connectors
(2) 2 cowl wire connectors
(c) Install the glove compartment.
(d) Install the glove compartment door.
(e) Install the lower instrument panel.
(f) Install the under cover.
EG1–131
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
17. CONNECT VACUUM HOSES
(a) MAP sensor hose to air intake chamber
(b) Brake booster vacuum hose to air intake chamber
(c) Charcoal canister vacuum hose
18. CONNECT TRANSAXLE CONTROL CABLE
(S) TO TRANSAXLE
19. M/T:
INSTALL CLUTCH RELEASE CYLINDER
Install the release cylinder and tube with the 4 bolts.
20. M/T:
INSTALL STARTER
EG1–132
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
21. CONNECT FUEL INLET HOSE
Torque: 29 N–m (300 kgf–cm, 22 ft–lbf)
22. CONNECT FUEL RETURN HOSE
23. CONNECT HEATER HOSES
24. CONNECT WIRES AND CONNECTORS
(a) Connect the 5 connectors to the relay box.
(b) Connectors from LH fender apron.
(c) Install the engine relay box.
(d) Connect the following connectors:
(1) Igniter connector
(2) California only:
Ignition coil connector
(3) Noise filter connector
(4) 2 ground straps from LH fender apron
(5) Connector from LH fender apron
EG1–133
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(6) Data link connector 1
(7) 2 ground straps from RH fender apron
(e) Connect the MAP sensor connector.
25. INSTALL RADIATOR
26. w/ CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM:
INSTALL CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
(a) Install the actuator and bracket with the 3 bolts.
(b) Connect the actuator connector.
(c) Install the actuator cover.
27. INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY, RESONATOR
AND AIR CLEANER HOSE
(a) Install the air cleaner case with 3 bolts.
(b) Install the element.
(c) Connect the air cleaner hose to the throttle body.
(d) Install the air cleaner cap together with the resonator
and air cleaner hose.
(e) California only:
Connect the air hose to the air cleaner hose.
(f) Connect the intake air temperature sensor connector.
28. A/T:
CONNECT AND ADJUST THROTTLE CABLE
29. CONNECT AND ADJUST ACCELERATOR CABLE
30. FILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
31. FILL WITH ENGINE OIL
32. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE TO
BATTERY
33. START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR LEAKS
34. PREFORM ENGINE ADJUSTMENT
35. INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVERS
36. INSTALL HOOD
37. PERFORM ROAD TEST
Check for abnormal noises, shock, slippage, correct
shift points and smooth operation.
38. RECHECK ENGINE COOLANT AND ENGINE OIL
LEVELS
EG1–134
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
BALANCE SHAFT BACKLASH
ADJUSTMENT ON VEHICLE
1. CHECK BACKLASH OF CRANKSHAFT GEAR AND
NO.1 BALANCE SHAFT GEAR
NOTICE: Backlash between the crankshaft gear and No.1
balance shaft gear varies with the rotation of the balance
shaft and the deviation of the crankshaft gear.
Accordingly, it is necessary to measure the backlash at
the 4 points shown in the illustration on the left.
(a) Rotate the crankshaft 2 or 3 times to settle the crank–
shaft gear and No. 1 balance shaft gear.
(b) When No.1 piston is at TDC, check that the punch
marks C shown in the illustration of the balance shafts
are aligned with the grooves of the No. 2 housing.
(c) Check that the punch marks A and B are at the
positions on the No.1 balance shaft indicated in the
illustration.
(d) First turn the crankshaft clockwise, and align the
groove of the No.2 balance shaft housing with the
punch mark A of the No. 1 balance shaft.
EG1–135
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(e) Position the SST and dial indicator as shown in the
illustration.
SST 09224 – 74010
HINT: Make sure that the stem of the dial indicator is
perpendicular to the SST and that it is placed in the
middle of the 3rd indentation.
(f) Gently turn the No.1 balance shaft by hand, until
resistance is felt, and measure the backlash.
HINT:
• Rotate the No. 1 balance shaft 4 or 5 times to
provide a steady backlash reading.
• To prevent excessive backlash due to thrust cle–
arance, measure the backlash while pressing on
the rear of the No.1 balance shaft.
Standard backlash (use SST):
0.060 – 0.100 mm (0.0024 – 0.0039 In.)
NOTICE: Do not turn the No.1 balance shaft strongly.
(g) Remove the dial gauge and the SST.
(h) Turn the crankshaft clockwise to align the groove of
the No.2 housing with the punch mark B.
(i) Set the dial gauge. (See procedure in step (e))
(j) Measure the backlash. (See procedure in step (f))
Standard backlash ( use SST ):
0.080 – 0.100 mm (0.0024 – 0.0039 in.)
(k) Remove the dial gauge.
EG1–136
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(I) Turn the crankshaft clockwise again to align the
groove of the No.2 housing with the punch mark A.
(m) Set the dial gauge. (See procedure in step (e))
(n) Measure the backlash. (See procedure in step (f))
Standard backlash ( use SST ):
0.060 – 0.100 mm (0.0024 – 0.0039 in.)
(o) Remove the dial gauge.
(p) Turn the crankshaft clockwise again to align the
groove of the No.2 housing with the punch mark B.
(q) Set the dial gauge. (See procedure in step (e))
(r) Measure the backlash. (See procedure in step (f))
Standard backlash( use SST ):
0.06 – 0.100 mm (0.0024 – 0.0039 in.)
(s) Remove the dial gauge.
If even one of the 4 points measured above exceeds
the backlash specification, adjust the backlash with
new spacers.
NOTICE: Use the same size spacers for both the left and
right sides.
HINT:
• Varying the spacer thickness by 0.02 mm
(0.0008 in.) changes the backlash by about 0.042
mrn (0.0017 in.).
• If the backlash is greater than permitted maxi–
mum, select a thinner shim.
• If the backlash is less than the specification,
select a thicker shim.
EG1–137
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
EG1–138
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
2. REPLACE THE SPACERS
(a) Uniformly loosen the6 bolts in the sequence shown.
(b) Replace the spacers with new ones.
3. TORQUE BALANCESHAFT ASSEMBLY
While pulling the center part of the engine balancer in
the direction of the arrow, uniformly tighten the6
bolts in several passes, in the sequence shown.
Torque: 49 N–m (500 kgf–cm, 36 ft–lbf)
4. CHECK AND ADJUST BACKLASH OF CRANK–
SHAFT GEAR AND No.1 BALANCE SHAFT GEAR
(See procedure in step 1)
EG1–139
5S–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
EXHAUST SYSTEM
COMPONENTS
EG1–140
5S–FE ENGINE
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE DATA
Idle speed
Intake
manifold
vacuum
at idle speed
Compression
pressure
et 250 rpm
Difference of pressure between each cylinder
Idler pulley
tension spring
Free length
Installed load at 50.5 mm (1.988 in.)
Cylinder
head
Warpage
Cylinder block side
Manifold side
Valve seat
Refacing angle
Contacting angle
Contacting width
Valve guide
bushing
Inside diameter
Outside diameter (for repair part)
Valve
Valve overall length
Vale face angle
Stem diameter
Stem oil clearance
Margin thickness
Valve spring
Deviation
Free length
Installed tension et 34.7 mm (1.366 in.)
Valve lifter
Lifter diameter
Lifter bore diameter
Oil clearance
Manifold
Warpage
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
EG1–141
5S–FE ENGINE
Camshaft
Thrust clearance
Journal oil clearance
Journal diameter
Circle runout
Cam lobe height
Camshaft gear backlash
Camshaft gear spring end free distance
Cylinder block
Cylinder head surface warpage
Cylinder bore diameter
Piston and
piston ring
Piston diameter
Piston oil clearance
Piston ring groove clearance
Piston ring end gap
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
EG1–142
5S–FE ENGINE
Connecting
rod
Thrust clearance
Connecting rod bearing center wall thickness
(Reference)
Connecting rod oil clearance
Rod bend
Rod twist
Bushing inside diameter
Piston pin diameter
Piston pin oil clearance
Connecting rod bolt outside diameter
Crankshaft
Thrust clearance
Thrust washer thickness
Main journal oil clearance
Main journal diameter
Main bearing center wall thickness (Reference)
Crank pin diameter
Circle runout
Main journal taper and out–of–round
Crank pin taper and out–of–round
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
EG1–143
5S–FE ENGINE
Engine
balancer
Thrust clearance
Backlash
Crankshaft x No. 1 balance shaft
Off–vehicle
On–vehicle
No. 1 balance shaft x No.2 balance shaft
at D mark
at E mark
at F mark
Spacer thickness
Balance shaft housing bolt outer diameter
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part tightened
Cylinder head cover x Cylinder head
Spark plug x Cylinder head
Oil pump pulley x Oil pump drive ’shaft
No. 2 idler pulley x Cylinder block
Crankshaft pulley x Crankshaft
Camshaft timing pulley x Camshaft
Camshaft timing pulley x Camshaft (For use with SST)
No. 1 idler pulley x Cylinder heed
No. 2 engine mounting bracket x Cylinder block
Engine moving control rod X Fender apron
Engine moving control rod x No. 2 engine mounting bracket
Cylinder head x Cylinder block (1 sty
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
EG1–144
5S–FE ENGINE
Cylinder head x Cylinder block (2nd)
Spark plug tube x Cylinder head
Camshaft bearing cap x Cylinder head
Generator bracket x Cylinder head
Engine hanger x Cylinder head
No. 3 timing belt cover x Cylinder head
Delivery pipe x Cylinder head
Pulsation damper x Delivery pipe
Intake manifold x Cylinder heed
Intake manifold stay x Intake manifold
Intake manifold stay x Cylinder block
No. 1 air intake chamber stay x Intake manifold
No. 1 air intake chamber stay x Cylinder head
EGR valve x intake manifold
EGR pipe x Cylinder head
Throttle body x Intake manifold
Water bypass pipe x Water pump cover
Water outlet x Cylinder head
WU–TWC x Exhaust manifold
Exhaust manifold x Cylinder head
Exhaust manifold stay x WU –TWC
Exhaust manifold stay x FR engine mounting insulator
No. 1 exhaust manifold stay x WU –TWC
No. 1 exhaust manifold stay x Cylinder block
Main bearing cap x Cylinder block
Connecting rod cap x Connecting rod (1 st)
Connecting rod cap x Connecting rod (2nd)
No. 1 balance shaft housing x No. 2 balance shaft housing (1st)
No. 1 balance shaft housing x No. 2 balance shaft housing (2nd)
Engine balancer x Cylinder block
Rear oil seal retainer x Cylinder block
Knock sensor x Cylinder block
PS pump bracket x Cylinder block
Rear end plate x Cylinder block
Flywheel x Crankshaft (M/T)
Drive plate x Crankshaft (A/T)
RR engine mounting insulator x Cylinder block
FR engine mounting insulator x Cylinder block
FR engine mounting insulator x Front suspension member
RR engine mounting insulator x Front suspension member
LH engine mounting insulator x Transaxle
PS pump x PS pump bracket
Front exhaust pipe x WU –TWC
A/C compressor x Cylinder block
Fuel inlet hose x Fuel filter (Union bolt)
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
EG1–145
5S–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
SYSTEM PURPOSE
Purpose
Abbreviation
system
Positive crankcase ventilation
Fuel evaporative emission control
Exhaust gas recirculation
Three–way catalytic converter
*Multiport fuel injection/Sequential
multiport fuel injection
PCV
EVAP
EG R
TWC
MFI/SFI
Reduces blow–by gas (HC)
Reduces evaporative HC
Reduces NOx
Reduces C0, HC and NOx
Regulates all engine conditions for reduction
of exhaust emissions.
” For inspection and repair of the MFI/SFI system, refer to MFI/SFI Section.
PREPARATION
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
09843–18020 Diagnosis Check Wire
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082–00050 TOYOTA Electrical Tester Set
EQUIPMENT
Heater
TVV
Thermometer
TVV
Tachometer
Torque wrench
Vacuum gauge
SSM (SPECIAL SERVICE MATERIALS)
08833–00070 Adhesive 1311,
THREE BOND 1311 or equivalent
¿¿V
EG1–146
5S–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
LAYOUT AND SCHEMATIC DRAWING
EG1–147
5S–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION (PCV) SYSTEM
To reduce HC emission, crankcase blow–by gas is routed through the PCV valve to the air intake
chamber for combustion in the cylinders.
Engine not Running
Normal Operation
Idling or Deceleration
Acceleration or High Load
EG1–148
5S–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
PCV VALVE INSPECTION
1. REMOVE PCV VALVE
2. INSTALL CLEAN HOSE TO PCV VALVE
3. BLOW AIR FROM CYLINDER HEAD SIDE
Check that air passes through easily.
NOTICE: Do not suck air through the valve.
Petroleum substances inside the valve are harmful.
4. BLOW AIR FROM AIR INTAKE CHAMBER SIDE
Check that air passes through with difficulty.
If the PCV valve fails either of the checks, replace it.
5. REMOVE CLEAN HOSE FROM PCV VALVE
6. REINSTALL PCV VALVE
PCV HOSES AND CONNECTIONS
INSPECTION
VISUALLY INSPECT HOSES, CONNECTIONS AND
GASKETS
Check for cracks, leaks or damage.
EG1–149
5S–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP)
CONTROL SYSTEM
To reduce NC emissions, evaporated fuel from the fuel tank is routed through the charcoal canister to the intake manifold
for combustion in the cylinders.
Engine Coolant
Temp.
Below
35C (95F)
Above
54C (129F)
High pressure
in tank
High vacuum
in tank
TVV
Throttle Valve
Opening
Canister Check Valve
Check
Valve In
Cap
Evaporated Fuel (HC)
CLOSED
OPEN
NC from tank is absorbed
into the canister
Positioned below
port P
CLOSED
Positioned above
port P
OPEN
HC from canister is led
into air intake chamber.
OPEN
HC from tank is absorbed
CLOSED CLOSED into the canister.
CLOSED OPEN
OPEN
Air is led into the fuel
tank.
EG1–150
5S–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
FUEL VAPOR LINES. FUEL TANK AND
TANK CAP INSPECTION
1. VISUALLY INSPECT LINES AND CONNECTIONS
Look for loosen connections, sharp bends or damage.
2. VISUALLY INSPECT FUEL TANK
Look for deformation, cracks or fuel leakage.
3. VISUALLY INSPECT FUEL TANK CAP
Check if the cap and/or gasket are deformed or dam–
aged.
If necessary, repair or replace the cap.
CHARCOAL CANISTER INSPECTION
1. REMOVE CHARCOAL CANISTER
2. VISUALLY INSPECT CHARCOAL CANISTER
Look for cracks or damage.
3. CHECK FOR CLOGGED FILTER AND STUCK CHECK
VALVE
(a) Using low pressure compressed air (4.71 kPa, 48
gf/cm2, 0.68 psi), blow into port A and check that air
flows without resistance from the other ports.
(b) Blow air (4.71 kPa, 48 gf/cm, 0.68 psi) into port B
and check that air does not flow from the other ports.
If a problem is found, replace the charcoal canister.
4. CLEAN FILTER IN CANISTER
Clean the filter by blowing 294 kPa (3 kgf/cm, 43 psi)
of compressed air into port A while holding port B
closed.
NOTICE:
•
Do not attempt to wash the canister.
•
No activated carbon should come out.
5. REINSTALL CHARCOAL CANISTER
EG1–151
5S–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
TVV INSPECTION
1. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
2. REMOVE TVV FROM WATER INLET HOUSING
(a) Disconnect the following hoses:
(1) Vacuum hose (from throttle body)
(2) Vacuum hose (from charcoal canister)
(b) Remove the TVV.
3. INSPECT TVV OPERATION
(a) Cool the TVV to below 35C (95F) with cool water.
(b) Check that air does not flow from the upper port to
lower port.
(c) Heat the TVV to above 54C (129F) with hot water.
(d) Check that air flows from the upper port to lower port.
If operation is not as specified, replace the TVV.
4. REINSTALL TVV
(a) Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the TVV, and
install it.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08833–00070, THREE BOND 1324
or equivalent
Torque: 29 N–m (300 kgf–cm, 22 ft–lbf)
(b) Reconnect 2 vacuum hoses.
5. REFILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
CHECK VALVE INSPECTION
INSPECT CHECK VALVE
(a) Check that air flows from the yellow port to the black
port.
(b) Check that air does not flow from the black port to the
yellow port.
If operation is not as specified, replace the check
valve.
EG1–152
5S–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SYSTEM
EG1–153
5S–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
EGR SYSTEM INSPECTION
1. CHECK AND CLEAN FILTER IN EGR VACUUM
MODULATOR
(a) Check the filter for contamination or damage.
(b) Using compressed air, clean the filter.
HINT: Install the filter with the coarser surface facing
the atmospheric side (outward).
2. PREPARATION
Using a 3–way connector, connect a vacuum gauge
to the hose between the EGR valve and VSV.
3. CHECK SEATING OF EGR VALVE
Start the engine and check that the engine starts and
runs at idle.
4. CONNECT TERMINALS TE1 AND E1
Using SST, connect terminals TE 1 and E 1 of the data
link connector 1.
SST 09843–18020
5. CHECK VSV
(a) The engine coolant temperature should be below
60C (140F) (A/T) or 55C (131 F) (M/T).
(b) Check that the vacuum gauge indicates zero at 2.500
rpm.
6. CHECK VSV AND EGR VACUUM MODULATOR
WITH HOT ENGINE
(a) Warm up the engine.
(b) Check that the vacuum gauge indicates low vacuum
at 2,500 rpm.
EG1–154
5S–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
(c) Disconnect the vacuum hose port R of the EGR
vacuum modulator and connect port R directly to the
intake manifold with another hose.
(d) Check that the vacuum gauge indicates high vacuum
at 2,500 rpm.
HINT: As a large amount of exhaust gas enters, the
engine will misfire slightly.
(e) Remove the vacuum gauge, and reconnect the
vacuum hoses to the proper locations.
7. CHECK EGR VALVE
(a) Apply vacuum directly to the EGR valve with the
engine idling.
(b) Check that the engine runs rough or dies.
(c) Reconnect the vacuum hoses to the proper locations.
8. DISCONNECT TERMINALS TE1 AND E1
Remove the SST.
SST 09843–18020
IF NO PROBLEM IS FOUND WITH THIS
INSPECTION, SYSTEM IS NORMAL; OTHERWISE
INSPECT EACH PART
VSV INSPECTION (California)
1. REMOVE VSV
(a) Disconnect the following connectors and hoses:
(1) VSV for EGR
(A) connector
(2) VSV for fuel pressure control
(B) connector
(3) Vacuum hose (from EGR valve) from port E of
VSV (A)
(4) Vacuum hose (from port “a” of EGR vacuum
modulator) from port G of VSV (A)
(5) Vacuum hose (from fuel pressure regulator) from
port E of VSV (B)
(6) Vacuum hose (from air intake chamber) from port
G of VSV (B)
(b) Remove the bolt and VSV assembly.
EG1–155
5S–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
2. INSPECT VSV
A. Inspect VSV for open circuit
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between the terminals.
Resistance (Cold):
33–39
If there is no continuity, replace the VSV.
B. Inspect VSV for ground
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity
between each terminal and the body.
If there is continuity, replace the VSV.
C. Inspect VSV operation
(a) Check that air flows from port E to port G.
(b) Apply battery voltage across the terminals.
(c) Check that air flows from port E to the filter.
If operation is not as specified, replace the VSV.
3. REINSTALL VSV
VSV INSPECTION (Except California)
1. REMOVE VSV
(a) Disconnect the following connector and hoses:
(1) VSV connector
(2) Vacuum hose (from EGR valve) from port E of
VSV
(3) Vacuum hose (from port “Q” of EGR vacuum
modulator) from port G of VSV
EG1–156
5S–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
(b) Remove the bolt and VSV.
2. INSPECT VSV
A. Inspect VSV for open circuit
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between the terminals.
Resistance (Cold):
33–39
If there is no continuity, replace the VSV.
B. Inspect VSV for ground
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity
between each terminal and the body.
If there is continuity, replace the VSV.
C. Inspect VSV operation
(a) Check that air flows from port E to port G.
(b) Apply battery voltage across the terminals.
(c) Check that air flows from port E to the filter.
If operation is not as specified, replace the VSV.
3. REINSTALL VSV
EG1–157
5S–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
EGR VACUUM MODULATOR INSPECTION
CHECK EGR VACUUM MODULATOR OPERATION
(a) Disconnect the vacuum hoses from ports P, Q and R
of the EGR vacuum modulator.
(b) Block ports P and R with your finger.
(c) Blow air into port Q, and check that the air passes
through to the air filter side freely.
(d) Start the engine, and maintain speed at 2.500 rpm.
(e) Repeat the above test. Check that there is a strong
resistance to air flow.
(f) Reconnect the vacuum hoses to the proper locations.
EGR VALVE INSPECTION
1. REMOVE EGR VALVE
Check for sticking and heavy carbon deposits.
If a problem is found, replace the valve.
2. REINSTALL EGR VALVE WITH NEW GASKET
Nut
Torque: 13 N–m (130 kgf–cm, 9 ft–lbf)
Union nut
Torque: 59 N–m (600 kgf–cm, 43 ft–lbf)
EG1–158
5S–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
THREE–WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER (TWC) SYSTEM
To reduce C0, HC end NOx emissions, they are oxidized, reduced and converted to carbon dioxide (CO2), water (H20)
and nitrogen (N2) by the catalyst.
Exhaust Port
WU–TWC
TWC
Exhaust Gas
EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY INSPECTION
1. CHECK CONNECTIONS FOR LOOSENESS OR
DAMAGE
2. CHECK CLAMPS FOR WEAKNESS, CRACKS OR
DAMAGE
THREE–WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER
INSPECTION
TWC:
CHECK FOR DENTS OR DAMAGE
If any part of protector is damaged or dented to the
extent that it contacts the TWC, repair or replace it.
EG1–159
5S–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
HEAT INSULATOR INSPECTION
TWC:
1. CHECK HEAT INSULATOR FOR DAMAGE
2. CHECK FOR ADEQUATE CLEARANCE BETWEEN
THREE – WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER AND
HEAT INSULATOR
THREE–WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER
REPLACEMENT
WU–TWC:
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. REMOVE FRONT EXHAUST PIPE
(a) Loosen the 2 bolts, and disconnect the bracket.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and nuts holding the front exhaust
pipe to the center exhaust pipe.
(c) Using a 14 mm deep socket wrench, remove the 3
nuts holding the front exhaust pipe to the WU–TWC.
(d) Remove the front exhaust pipe and gaskets.
3. REMOVE WARM UP THREE – WAY CATALYTIC
CONVERTER
(a) Check that the WU–TWC is cool.
(b) Disconnect the sub oxygen sensor connector.
(c) Remove the bolt, nut and No. 1 manifold stay.
EG1–160
5S–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
(d) Remove the bolt, nut and manifold stay.
(e) Remove the 3 bolts, 2 nuts, WU –TWC, gasket, re–
tainer and cushion.
(f) Remove the 8 bolts and 2 heat insulators from the
WU –TWC.
4. REINSTALL WARM–UP THREE–WAY
CATALYTIC CONVERTER
(a) Install the 2 heat insulators to a new WU –TWC with
the 8 bolts.
(b) Place new cushion, retainer and gasket on the WU–
TWC.
(c) Install the WU–TWC with the 3 bolts and 2 new nuts.
Torque: 29 N–m (300 kgf–cm, 22 ft–lbf)
EG1–161
5S–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
(d) Install the manifold stay with the bolt and nut.
Torque: 42 N–m (425 kgf–cm. 31 ft–lbf)
(e) Install the No. 1 manifold stay with the bolt and nut.
Torque: 42 N–m (425 kgf–cm. 31 ft–lbf)
(f) Connect the sub oxygen sensor connector.
5. REINSTALL FRONT EXHAUST PIPE
(a) Place 2 new gaskets on the front and rear of the front
exhaust pipe.
(b) Temporarily install the 2 bolts and 2 new nuts holding
the front exhaust pipe to the center exhaust pipe.
(c) Using a 14 mm deep socket wrench, install the 3 new
nuts holding the front exhaust pipe to the WU –TWC.
Torque: 62 N–m (630 kgf–cm, 46 ft–lbf)
(d) Tighten the 2 bolts and nuts holding the front exhaust
pipe to the center exhaust pipe.
Torque: 58 N–m (570 kgf–cm, 41 ft–lbf)
(e) Install the bracket with the 2 bolts.
6. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE TO
BATTERY
EG1–162
5S–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
TWC:
1. REMOVE FRONT EXHAUST PIPE (THREE – WAY
CATALYTIC CONVERTER)
(a) Loosen the 2 bolts, and disconnect the bracket.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and nuts holding the front exhaust
pipe to the center exhaust pipe.
(c) Using a 14 mm deep socket wrench, remove the 3
nuts holding the front exhaust pipe to the WU–TWC.
(d) Remove the front exhaust pipe and gasket.
2. REINSTALL FRONT EXHAUST PIPE (THREE–WAY
CATALYTIC CONVERTER)
(a) Place 2 new gaskets on the front and rear of the front
exhaust pipe.
(b) Temporarily install the 2 bolts and 2 new nuts holding
the front exhaust pipe to the center exhaust pipe.
(c) Using a 14 mm deep socket wrench, install the 3 new
nuts holding the front exhaust pipe to the WU –TWC.
Torque: 412 N–m (630 kgf–cm, 46 ft–lbf)
(d) Tighten the 2 bolts and nuts holding the front exhaust
pipe to the center exhaust pipe.
Torque: 58 N–m (570 kgf–cm, 41 ft–lbf)
(e) Install the bracket with the 2 bolts.
EG1–163
5S–FE ENGINE
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE DATA
VSV (for EGR)
Resistance
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part tightened
TVV x Water outlet housing
EGR valve x Intake manifold
EG R valve x EGR pipe
WU–TWC x Exhaust manifold
Exhaust manifold stay x WU–TWC
Exhaust manifold stay x FR engine mounting insulator
No.1 exhaust manifold stay x WU–TWC
No.1 exhaust manifold stay x Cylinder block
Front exhaust pipe x WU–TWC
Front exhaust pipe x Center exhaust pipe
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
EG1–164
5S–FE ENGINE
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
DESCRIPTION
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
EG1–165
5S–FE ENGINE
Except California (MFI System)
–
FE ENGINE – MFI/SFI SYSTEM
EG1–166
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
The MFI (Multiport Fuel Injection)/SFI (Sequential Multiport Fuel Injection) system is composed
of 3 basic sub–systems: Fuel, Air Induction and Electronic Control Systems.
FUEL SYSTEM
Fuel is supplied under constant pressure to the MFI/SFI injectors by an electric fuel pump. The
injectors inject a metered quantity of fuel into the intake port in accordance with signals from the
ECM (Engine Control Module).
AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
The air induction system provides sufficient air for engine operation.
ELECTRONIC CONTROL SYSTEM
The CAMRY 5S–FE engine is equipped with a TOYOTA Computer Controlled System (TCCS)
which centrally controls the MFI/SFI, ESA, IAC diagnosis systems etc. by means of an Engine
Control Module (ECM–formerly MFI/SFI computer) employing a microcomputer.
The ECM controls the following functions:
1. Multiport Fuel Injection (MFI)/Sequential Multiport Fuel Injection (SFI)
The ECM receives signals from various sensors indicating changing engine operation conditions
such as:
Intake manifold pressure
Intake air temperature
Engine coolant temperature
Engine speed
Throttle valve opening angle
Exhaust oxygen content etc.
The signals are utilized by the ECM to determine the injection duration necessary for an optimum
air–fuel ratio.
2. Electronic Spark Advance (ESA)
The ECM is programmed with data for optimum ignition timing under all operating conditions.
Using data provided by sensors which monitor various engine functions (RPM, engine coolant
temperature, etc.), the microcomputer (ECM) triggers the spark at precisely the right instant.
3. Idle Air Control (IAC)
The ECM is programmed with target idling speed values to respond to different engine conditions
(engine coolant temperature, air conditioning ON/OFF, etc.). Sensors transmit signals to the ECM
which controls the flow of air through the bypass of the throttle valve and adjusts idle speed to
the target value.
4. Diagnosis
The ECM detects any malfunctions and abnormalities in the sensor network and lights a
malfunction indicator lamp in the combination meter. At the same time, trouble is identified and
a diagnostic trouble code is recorded by the EC
5. The diagnostic trouble code can be read by the
number of blinks of the malfunction indicator lamp when terminals TE1 and E1 are connected.
The diagnostic trouble codes are referred to in later page. (See page EG1–300)
Fail–Safe Function
In the event of the sensor malfunction, a back–up circuit will take over to provide minimal
driveability, and the malfunction indicator lamp will illuminate.
EG1–167
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
OPERATION
FUEL SYSTEM
Fuel pumped up by the fuel pump, flows through the fuel filter and is distributed to each injector
at a set pressure maintained by the pressure regulator.
The fuel pressure regulator adjusts the pressure of the fuel from the fuel line (high pressure side)
to a pressure 284 kPa (2.9 kgf/cm, 41 psi) higher than the pressure inside the cylinder head, and
excess fuel is returned to the fuel tank through the return pipe.
The pulsation damper absorbs the slight fluctuations in fuel pressure caused by fuel injector from
the injector.
The injectors operate on input of injection signals from the ECM and inject fuel into the cylinder
head.
EG1–168
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
Air is filtered through the air cleaner and the amount flowing to the air intake chamber is
determined according to the throttle valve opening in the throttle body and the engine speed.
Intake air controlled by the throttle valve opening is distributed from the air intake chamber to the
manifold of each cylinder and is drawn into the combustion chamber.
At low temperatures the IAC valve opens and the air flows through the IAC valve and the throttle
body, into the air intake chamber. During engine warming up, even if the throttle valve is
completely closed, air flows to the air intake chamber, thereby increasing the idle speed (first idle
operation).
The air intake chamber prevents pulsation of the intake air. It also prevents intake air interference
in each cylinder.
EG1–169
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
ELECTRONIC CONTROL SYSTEM
The control system consists of sensors which detect various engine conditions, and a ECM which
determines the injection volume (timing) based on the signals from the sensors.
The various sensors detect the intake air pressure, engine speed, oxygen density in the exhaust
gas, engine coolant temperature, intake air temperature and atmospheric pressure etc. and
convert the information into an electrical signal which. is sent to the ECM. Based on these signals,
the ECM calculates the optimum ignition timing for the current conditions and operates the
injectors.
The ECM not only controls the fuel injection timing, but also the self diagnostic function which
records the occurrence of a malfunction, ignition timing control, idle speed control and EGR
control.
EG1–170
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
PREPARATION
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
09268–41045 Injection Measuring Tool Set
(09268–41080) No.6 union
(09268–41090) No.7 union
(90405–09015) No.1 Union
09268–45012 EFI Fuel Pressure Gauge
09631–22020 Power Steering Hose Nut
14 x 17 mm Wrench Set
Fuel line flare nut
09842–30070 Wiring “F” EFI Inspection
09843–18020 Diagnosis Check Wire
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082–00050 TOYOTA Electrical Tester Set
09200–00010 Engine Adjust Kit
09258–00030 Hose Plug Set
Plug for vacuum hose, fuel hose
etc.
EG1–171
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
EQUIPMENT
Carburetor cleaner
Throttle body
Graduated cylinder
Injector
Soft brush
Throttle body
Sound scope
Injector
Tachometer
Torque wrench
Vacuum gauge
EG1–172
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1. Before working on the fuel system, disconnect the
negative (–) terminal cable from the battery.
HINT: Any diagnostic trouble code retained by the
computer will be erased when the battery terminal is
removed.
Therefore, if necessary, read the diagnosis before
removing the terminal.
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. Do not smoke or work near an open flame when
working on the fuel system.
3. Keep gasoline away from rubber or leather parts.
MAINTENANCE PRECAUTIONS
1. CHECK CORRECT ENGINE TUNE–UP
(See page EG1–8)
2. PRECAUTION WHEN CONNECTING GAUGE
(a) Use battery as the power source for the timing light,
tachometer, etc.
(b) Connect the tester probe of a tachometer to the termi–
nal IGE) of the data link connector 1.
3. IN EVENT OF ENGINE MISFIRE, FOLLOWING
PRECAUTIONS SHOULD BE TAKEN
(a) Check proper connection of battery terminals, etc.
(b) Handle high–tension cords carefully.
(c) After repair work, check that the ignition coil termi–
nals and all other ignition system lines are reconne–
cted securely.
(d) When cleaning the engine compartment, be especially
careful to protect the electrical system from water.
4. PRECAUTIONS WHEN HANDLING OXYGEN
SENSOR
(a) Do not allow oxygen sensor to drop or hit against an
object.
(b) Do not allow the sensor to come into contact with
water.
EG1–173
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
IF VEHICLE IS EQUIPPED WITH MOBILE
RADIO SYSTEM (HAM, CB, ETC.)
If the vehicle is equipped with a mobile communica–
tion system, refer to the precaution in the IN section.
AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
1. Separation of the engine oil dipstick, oil filler cap, PCV
hose, etc. may cause the engine to run out of tune.
2. Disconnection, looseness or cracks in the parts of the
air induction system between the throttle body and
cylinder head will allow air suction and cause the
engine to run out of tune.
ELECTRONIC CONTROL SYSTEM
1. Before removing MFI/SFI wiring connectors, termi–
nals, etc., first disconnect the power by either turning
the ignition switch OFF or disconnecting the battery
terminals.
HINT: Always check the diagnostic trouble code
before disconnecting the negative (–) terminal cable
from the battery.
2. When installing the battery, be especially careful not
to incorrectly connect the positive (+) and negative
(–) cables.
3. Do not permit parts to receive a severe impact during
removal or installation. Handle all MFI/SFI parts care–
fully, especially the ECM.
4. Do not be careless during troubleshooting as there are
numerous transistor circuits and even slight terminal
contact can further troubles.
5. Do not open the ECM cover.
6. When inspecting during rainy weather, take care to
prevent entry of water. Also, when washing the
engine compartment, prevent water from getting on
the MFI/SFI parts and wiring connectors.
7. Parts should be replaced as an assembly.
EG1–174
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
8. Care is required when pulling out and inserting wiring
connectors.
(a) Release the lock and pull out the connector, pulling on
the connectors.
(b) Fully insert the connector and check that it is locked.
9. When inspecting a connector with a volt/ohmmeter.
(a) Carefully take out the water–proofing rubber if it is a
water–proof type connector.
(b) Insert the test probe into the connector from wiring
side when checking the continuity, amperage or volt–
age.
(c) Do not apply unnecessary force to the terminal.
(d) After checking, install the water–proofing rubber on
the connector securely.
10. Use SST for inspection or test of the injector or its
wiring connector.
SST 09842–30070
EG1–175
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
FUEL SYSTEM
1. When disconnecting the high pressure fuel line, a
large amount of gasoline will spill out, so observe the
following procedures:
(a) Put a container under the connection.
(b) Slowly loosen the connection.
(c) Disconnect the connection.
(d) Plug the connection with a rubber plug.
2. When connecting the flare nut or union bolt on the
high pressure pipe union, observe the following proce–
dures:
Union Bolt Type:
(a) Always use a new gasket.
(b) Tighten the union bolt by hand.
(c) Tighten the union bolt to the specified torque.
Torque: 29 N–m (300 kgf–cm, 22 ft–lbf)
Flare Nut Type:
(s) Apply alight coat of engine oil to the flare and tighten
the flare nut by hand.
(b) Using SST, torque the flare nut.
SST 09631–22020
Torque:
28 N–m (285 kgf–cm, 21 ft–lbf) for fuel pump side
30 N–m (310 kgf–cm, 22 ft–lbf) for others
HINT: Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of
30 cm (11.81 in.).
3. Observe the following precautions when removing
and installing the injectors.
(a) Never reuse the O–ring.
(b) When placing a new O–ring on the injector, take care
not to damage it in any way.
(c) Coat a new 0– ring with spindle oil or gasoline before
installing–never use engine, gear or brake oil.
4. Install the injector to delivery pipe and intake manifold
as shown in the illustration.
EG1–176
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
5. Check that there are no fuel leaks after performing
maintenance anywhere on the fuel system.
(a) Using SST, connect terminals + B and FP of the data
link connector 1.
SST 09843–18020
(b) With engine stopped, turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Pinch the fuel return hose. The pressure in high pres–
sure line will rise to approx. 392 kPa (4kgf/cm2, 57
psi). In this state, check to see that there are no leaks
from any part of the fuel system.
NOTICE: Always pinch the hose. Avoid bending as it may
cause the hose to crack.
(d) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(9) Remove the SST.
SST 09843–18020
EG1–177
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
FUEL PUMP
SYSTEM CIRCUIT
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1. CHECK FUEL PUMP OPERATION
(a) Using SST; connect terminals +B and FP of the data
link connector 1.
SST 09843–18020
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
NOTICE: Do not start the engine.
EG1–178
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
(c) Check that there is pressure in the hose from the fuel
filter.
HINT: At this time, you will hear fuel return noise.
(d) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(e) Remove the SST.
SST 09843–18020
If
•
•
•
•
•
there is no pressure, check the following parts:
Fusible link
Fuses (AM2 30A, EFI 15A, IGN 7.5A)
EFI main relay
Fuel pump
Wiring connections
2. CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
(a) Check that the battery voltages is above 12 volts.
(b) Disconnect the negative (–) terminal cable from the
battery.
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the “LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
EG1–179
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
(c) Put a suitable container or shop towel under the fuel
filter.
(d) Remove the union bolt and 2 gaskets, and disconnect
the fuel inlet hose from the fuel filter outlet.
HINT: Slowly loosen the union bolt.
(e) Install the fuel inlet hose and SST (pressure gauge) to
the fuel filter outlet with 3 new gaskets and the union
bolt.
SST 09268–45012
Torque: 29 N–m (300 kgf–cm, 22 ft–lbf)
(f) Wipe off any splattered gasoline.
(g) Reconnect the battery negative (–) cable.
(h) Using SST, connect terminals +B and FP of the data
link connector 1.
SST 09843–18020
(i) Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the fuel pressure.
Fuel pressure:
265 – 304 kPa (2.7 – 3.1 kgf/cm, 38 – 44 psi)
If pressure is high, replace the fuel pressure regulator.
If pressure is low, check the following parts:
• Fuel hoses and connections
• Fuel pump
• Fuel filter
• Fuel pressure regulator
EG1–180
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
(k) Remove the SST.
SST 09483–18020
(l) Start the engine.
(m) Disconnect the vacuum sensing hose from the air
intake chamber and plug the air intake chamber
outlet.
(n) Measure the fuel pressure at idle.
Fuel pressure:
265 – 304 kPa (2.7 – 3.1 kgf/cm, 38 – 44 psi)
(o) Reconnect the vacuum sensing hose to the air intake
chamber.
(p) Measure the fuel pressure at idle.
Fuel pressure:
206 – 255 kPa (2.1 – 2.6 kgf/cm, 31 – 37 psi)
If pressure is not as specified, check the vacuum
sensing hose and fuel pressure regulator.
(q) Stop the engine.
(r) Check that the fuel pressure remains 147 kPa (1.5
kgf/cm2, 21 psi) or more for 5 minutes after the
engine is turned off.
If pressure is not as specified, check the fuel pump,
pressure regulator and/or injector.
(s) After checking fuel pressure, disconnect the battery
negative (–) cable and carefully remove the SST to
prevent gasoline from splashing.
SST 09268–45012
(t) Connect the fuel inlet hose with 2 new gaskets and
the union bolt.
Torque: 29 N–m (300 kgf–cm. 22 ft–lbf)
(u) Reconnect the cable to the negative (–) terminal of
the battery.
(v) Check for fuel leakage.
EG1–181
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
FUEL PUMP INSPECTION
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the Ignition switch Is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION
3. DISCONNECT FUEL PUMP & SENDER GAUGE CON–
NECTOR
4. INSPECT FUEL PUMP
A. Inspect fuel pump resistance
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
terminals 4 and 5.
Resistance (Cold):
0.2–3.0 Ω
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the fuel
pump.
B. Inspect fuel pump operation
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery terminal 4 of the
connector, and the negative (–) lead
to terminal 5. Check that the fuel pump operates.
NOTICE:
• These tests must be performed quickly (within 10
seconds) to prevent the coil from burning out.
• Keep the fuel pump a: far away from the battery as
possible.
• Always perform switching at the battery side.
If operation is not as specified, replace the fuel pump.
5. RECONNECT FUEL PUMP & SENDER GAUGE
CONNECTOR
6. INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION
7. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE TO
BATTERY
EG1–182
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
FUEL PUMP REMOVAL
CAUTION: Do not smoke or work near an open flame
when working on the fuel pump.
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the “LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION
EG1–183
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
3. REMOVE FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER
(a) Disconnect the fuel pump connector.
(b) Remove the 5 screws and service hole cover.
4. REMOVE FUEL PUMP LEAD WIRE
5. DISCONNECT FUEL PIPE AND HOSE FROM FUEL
PUMP BRACKET
CAUTION: Remove the fuel filter cap to prevent the fuel
from flowing out.
(a) Using SST, disconnect the outlet pipe from the pump bracket.
SST 09631–22020
(b) Disconnect the return hose from the pump bracket.
6. REMOVE FUEL PUMP BRACKET ASSEMBLY FROM
FUEL TANK
(a) Remove the 8 bolts.
(b) Pull out the pump bracket assembly.
(c) Remove the gasket from the pump bracket.
EG1–184
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
COMPONENTS FOR DISASSEMBLY AND
ASSEMBLY
FUEL PUMP DISASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE FUEL PUMP FROM FUEL PUMP BRACKET
(a) Remove the fuel pump lead wire.
(b) Pull off the lower side of the fuel pump from the pump
bracket.
(c) Disconnect the fuel hose from the fuel pump, and
remove the fuel pump.
(d) Remove the rubber cushion from the fuel pump.
2. REMOVE FUEL SENDER GAUGE FROM FUEL PUMP
BRACKET
(a) Disconnect the fuel sender gauge connector.
(b) Remove the 2 screws and sender gauge.
EG1–185
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
3. REMOVE FUEL PUMP FILTER FROM FUEL PUMP
(a) Using a small screwdriver, remove the clip.
(b) Pull out the pump filter.
4. REMOVE CONNECTOR
Remove the 2 screws, connector support, connector
and gasket.
FUEL PUMP ASSEMBLY
(See Components for Disassembly and Assembly)
1. INSTALL CONNECTOR
Install the gasket, connector and connector support
with the 2 screws.
2. INSTALL FUEL PUMP FILTER TO FUEL PUMP
Install the pump filter with a new clip.
3. INSTALL FUEL SENDER GAUGE TO FUEL PUMP
BRACKET
(a) Install the sender gauge with the 2 screws.
(b) Connect the fuel sender gauge connector.
4. INSTALL FUEL PUMP TO FUEL PUMP BRACKET
(a) Install the rubber cushion to the fuel pump.
(b) Connect the fuel hose to the outlet port of the fuel
pump.
(c) Install the fuel pump by pushing the lower side of the
fuel pump.
(d) Install the fuel pump connector.
EG1–186
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
FUEL PUMP INSTALLATION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. INSTALL FUEL PUMP BRACKET ASSEMBLY TO
FUEL TANK
(a) Install a new gasket to the pump bracket.
(b) Insert the pump bracket assembly into the fuel tank.
(c) Install the pump bracket with the 8 screws.
Torque: 3.9 N–m (40 kgf–cm, 35 in.–Ibf)
2. CONNECT FUEL PIPE AND HOSE TO FUEL PUMP
BRACKET
(a) Using SST, connect the outlet pipe to the pump
bracket.
SST 09631–22020
Torque: 28 N–m (285 kgf–cm, 21 ft–lbf)
(b) Connect the return hoses to the pump bracket.
3. CHECK FOR FUEL LEAKAGE
(See page EG1–176)
4. CONNECT FUEL PUMP LEAD WIRE
5. INSTALL FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER
(a) Install the service hole cover with the 5 screws.
(b) Connect the fuel pump (with fuel sender gauge)
connector.
6. INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION
7. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE TO
BATTERY
EG1–187
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
INSPECT FUEL PRESSURE
(See page EG1–178)
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT VACUUM SENSING HOSE FROM
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR
2. DISCONNECT FUEL RETURN PIPE FROM FUEL
PRESSURE REGULATOR
(a) Put a suitable container or shop rag under the pres–
sure regulator.
(b) Remove the union bolt and 2 gaskets, and disconnect
the return pipe from the pressure regulator.
HINT: Slowly loosen the union bolt.
EG1–188
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
3. REMOVE FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR
(a) Remove the 2 bolts, and pull out the pressure regula–
tor.
(b) Remove the O–ring from the pressure regulator.
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR
INSTALLATION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. INSTALL FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR
(a) Apply a light coat of gasoline to a new O–ring, and
install it to the pressure regulator.
(b) Install the pressure regulator with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 5.4 N–m (55 kgf–cm, 48 in.–lbf)
2. CONNECT FUEL RETURN PIPE TO FUEL PRESSURE
REGULATOR
Install the return pipe with 2 new gaskets and the
union bolt.
Torque: 19 N–m (195 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
3. CONNECT VACUUM SENSING HOSE TO FUEL
PRESSURE REGULATOR
4. CHECK FOR FUEL LEAKAGE
(See page EG1–176)
EG1–189
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
INJECTOR
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1. INSPECT INJECTOR OPERATION
Check operation sound from each injector.
(a) With the engine running or cranking, use a sound
scope to check that there is normal operating noise in
proportion to engine speed.
(b) If you have no sound scope, you can check the injec–
tor transmission operation with your finger.
If no sound or unusual sound is heard, check the
wiring connector, injector or injection signal from the
ECM.
2. INSPECT INJECTOR RESISTANCE
(a) Disconnect the injector connector.
(b) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
the terminals.
Resistance:
Approx. 13.8
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the injector.
(c) Reconnect the injector connector.
EG1–190
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
EG1–191
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
INJECTORS REMOVAL
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch i: turned to the “LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
3. A/T:
DISCONNECT THROTTLE CABLE FROM
THROTTLE BODY
4. DISCONNECT ACCELERATOR CABLE FROM
THROTTLE BODY
5. REMOVE AIR CLEANER CAP, RESONATOR AND
AIR CLEANER HOSE
(a) Disconnect the intake air temperature sensor connector.
(b) California only:
Disconnect the air hose from the air cleaner hose.
(c) Loosen the air cleaner hose clamp bolt.
(d) Disconnect the 4 air cleaner cap clips.
(e) Disconnect the air cleaner hose from the throttle
body, and remove the air cleaner cap together with
the resonator and air cleaner hose.
6. REMOVE THROTTLE BODY
(a) Disconnect throttle position sensor connector.
(b) Disconnect IAC valve connector.
EG1–192
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
(c) Disconnect the following hoses from the throttle
body.
(1) PCV hose
(2) 2 vacuum hoses from EGR vacuum modulator
(3) Vacuum hose from TVV (for EVAP)
(d) Type A:
Remove the 4 bolts.
(e) Type B:
Remove the 2 bolts and 2 nuts.
(f) Disconnect the following hoses from the throttle
body, and remove the throttle body.
(1) Water bypass hose from water outlet
(2) Water bypass hose from water bypass pipe
(3) California:
Air hose from cylinder head
Except California:
Air hose from air tube
7. DISCONNECT PS VACUUM HOSES
8. DISCONNECT VACUUM HOSES FROM TVV (FOR
EVAP)
EG1–193
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
9. REMOVE EGR VALVE AND VACUUM MODULATOR
(a) Disconnect the EGR gas temperature sensor connector.
(b) Disconnect the following hoses:
(1) 2 vacuum hoses from VSV (for EGR)
(2) Vacuum hose from charcoal canister
(c) Disconnect the vacuum hose clamp.
(d) Loosen the union nut of the EGR pipe, and remove the
2 nuts, the EGR valve, vacuum modulator, vacuum
hoses assembly and gasket.
10. DISCONNECT VACUUM HOSES
Disconnect the following hoses:
(1) MAP sensor hose from air intake chamber
(2) Brake booster vacuum hose from air intake chamber
(3) Vacuum sensing hose from fuel pressure regulator
11. w/ A/C:
DISCONNECT A/C IDLE–UP VALVE CONNECTOR
12. DISCONNECT 2 ENGINE WIRE GROUND STRAPS
FROM INTAKE MANIFOLD
13. DISCONNECT KNOCK SENSOR AND VSV (FOR
EGR) CONNECTORS
14. CALIFORNIA ONLY:
DISCONNECT VSV (FOR FUEL PRESSURE CONTROL)
CONNECTOR AND VACUUM HOSES
15. REMOVE BOLT AND WIRE CLAMP, AND DISCON–
NECT ENGINE WIRE HARNESS
16. REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD
(a) Remove the 4 bolts, wire bracket, No.1 air intake
chamber and manifold stays.
EG1–194
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
(b) Remove the 6 bolts, 2 nuts, intake manifold and
gasket.
(c) Disconnect the 2 wire clamps from the wire brackets
on the intake manifold.
17. DISCONNECT INJECTOR CONNECTORS
18. REMOVE DELIVERY PIPE AND INJECTORS
(a) Loosen the pulsation damper, and disconnect the fuel
inlet pipe.
(b) Disconnect the fuel return hose.
(c) Remove the 2 bolts and delivery pipe together with
the 4 injectors.
NOTICE: Be careful not to drop the injectors when rem–
oving the delivery pipe.
(d) Remove the 4 insulators (except California) and 2
spacers from the cylinder head.
(e) Pull out the 4 injectors from the delivery pipe.
EG1–195
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
(f) California:
Remove the 2 O–rings, insulator and grommet from
each injector.
(g) Except California:
Remove the O–ring and grommet from each injector.
INJECTORS INSPECTION
1. INSPECT INJECTOR INJECTION
CAUTION: Keep injector clear of sparks during the test.
(a) Disconnect the fuel hose from the fuel filter outlet.
(b) Connect SST (union and hose) to the fuel filter outlet
with 2 new gaskets and union bolts.
SST 09268–41045 (90405–09015)
Torque: 29 N–m (300 kgf–cm, 22 ft–lbf)
HINT: Use the vehicle’s fuel filter.
(c) Install a new O–ring to the fuel inlet of pressure
regulator.
(d) Connect SST (hose) to the fuel inlet of the pressure
regulator with SST (union) and the 2 bolts.
SST 09268–41045 (09268–41090)
Torque: 5.4 N–m (55 kgf–cm, 48 ft–lbf)
(e) Connect the fuel return hose to the fuel outlet of the
pressure regulator with SST (union), 2 new gaskets
and union bolts.
EG1–196
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
SST 09268–41045 (09268–41080)
Torque: 18 N–m (180 kgf–cm, 13 ft–lbf)
(f) Install the grommet and a new O–ring to the injector.
(g) Connect SST (union and hose) to the injector, and hold
the injector and union with SST (clamp).
SST 09268–41045
(h) Put the injector into a graduated cylinder.
HINT: Install a suitable vinyl hose onto the injector to
prevent gasoline from splashing out.
(i) Using SST, connect terminals +B and FP of the data
link connector 1.
SST 09843–18020
(j) Reconnect the negative (–) terminal cable to the
battery.
(k) Turn the ignition switch ON.
NOTICE: Do not start the engine.
(l) Connect SST (wire) to the injector and battery for 15
seconds, and measure the injection volume with a
graduated cylinder. Test each injector 2 or 3 times.
SST 09842–30070
Volume:
49 – 59 cm (3.0–3.6 cu in.) per 15 sec.
Difference between each Injector:
5 cm (0.3 cu in.) or less
If the injection volume is not as specified, replace the
injector.
2. INSPECT LEAKAGE
(a) In the condition above, disconnect the test probes of
SST (wire) from the battery and check the fuel leakage
from the injector.
SST 09842–30070
Fuel drop:
One drop or less per minute
(b) Disconnect the negative (–) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Remove the SST.
SST 09268–41045 and 09843–18020
EG1–197
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
INJECTORS INSTALLATION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. INSTALL INJECTORS AND DELIVERY PIPE
(a) California:
Install new insulator and grommet to each injector.
(b) Except California:
Install a new grommet to each injector.
(c) California:
Apply a light coat of gasoline to 2 new O–rings, and
install them to each injector.
(d) Except California:
Apply a light coat of gasoline to a new O–ring, and
install it to each injector.
(e) While turning the injector left and right, install it to the
delivery pipes. Install the 4 injectors.
(f) Install the following parts to the cylinder head:
(1) 2 spacers
(2) Except California:
4 new insulators
(g) Place the 4 injectors together with the delivery pipe in
position on the cylinder head.
(h) Temporarily install the 2 bolts holding the delivery
pipe to the cylinder head.
EG1–198
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
(i) Check that the injectors rotate smoothly.
HINT: If injectors do not rotate smoothly, the probable
cause is incorrect installation of O – rings. Replace the
O–rings.
(j) Position the injector connector upward.
(k) Tighten the 2 bolts holding the delivery pipe to the
cylinder head.
Torque: 13 N–m (130 kgf–cm, 9 ft–lbf)
(l) Connect the fuel return hose.
(m) Connect the fuel inlet pipe to the delivery pipe with 2
new gaskets and the pulsation damper.
Torque: 34 N–m (350 kgf–cm, 25 ft–lbf)
2. CONNECT INJECTOR CONNECTORS
3. INSTALL INTAKE MANIFOLD
(a) Connect the 2 wire clamps to the wire brackets
on the intake manifold.
EG1–199
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
(b) Install a new gasket and the intake manifold with the
6 bolts and 2 nuts. Uniformly tighten the bolts and
nuts in several passes.
Torque: 19 N–m (195 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
(c) Install the No. 1 air intake chamber and manifold stays,
wire bracket with the 4 bolts.
14 mm head bolt
Torque: 42 N–m (425 kgf–cm, 31 ft–lbf)
12 mm head bolt
Torque: 22 N–m (220 kgf–cm, 16 ft–lbf)
4. CONNECT ENGINE WIRE HARNESS WITH WIRE
CLAMP AND BOLT
5. CALIFORNIA ONLY:
CONNECT VSV (FOR FUEL PRESSURE CONTROL)
CONNECTOR AND VACUUM HOSES
6. CONNECT KNOCK SENSOR AND VSV (FOR EGR)
CONNECTORS
7. CONNECT 2 ENGINE WIRE GROUND STRAPS TO
INTAKE MANIFOLD
8. CONNECT VACUUM HOSES
Connect the following hoses:
(1) MAP sensor hose to air intake chamber
(2) Brake booster vacuum hose to air intake chamber
(3) Vacuum sensing hose to fuel pressure regulator.
9. w/ A/C:
CONNECT A/C IDLE–UP VALVE CONNECTOR
10. INSTALL EGR VALVE AND VACUUM MODULATOR
(a) Install a new gasket and the EGR valve with the union
nut and 2 nuts.
Union nut
Torque: 59 N–m (600 kgf–cm. 43 ft–lbf)
Nut
Torque: 13 N–m (130 kgf–cm. 9 ft–lbf)
(b) Install the EGR vacuum modulator to the clamp.
EG1–200
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
(c) Connect the vacuum hose clamp.
(d) Connect the following hoses:
(1) Vacuum hose to charcoal canister
(2) Vacuum hose (from EGR valves) to E port of VSV
(for EGR)
(3) Vacuum hose (from Q port EGR vacuum modula–
tor) to G port of VSV (for EGR)
(e) Connect the EGR gas temperature sensor connector.
11. CONNECT VACUUM HOSES TO VSV (FOR EVAP)
(a) From P port of throttle body
(b) From charcoal canister
12. CONNECT PS VACUUM HOSES
13. INSTALL THROTTLE BODY
(a) Connect the following hoses to the throttle body:
(1) Water bypass hose from water outlet
(2) Water bypass hose from water bypass pipe
(3) California:
Air hose from cylinder head
Except California:
Air hose to air tube
(b) Place a new gasket on the intake chamber, facing the
protrusion downward.
EG1–201
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
(c) Type A:
Install the throttle body with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 19 N–m (195 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
Bolt length:
A 45 mm (1.77 in.)
B 55 mm (2.17 in.)
(d) Type B:
Install the throttle body with the 2 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 19 N–m (195 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
(e) Connect the following hoses to the throttle body:
(1) PCV hose
(2) 2 vacuum hoses from EGR vacuum modulator
(3) Vacuum hose from TVV (for EVAP)
(f) Connect the IAC valve connector.
(g) Connect the throttle position sensor connector.
14. INSTALL AIR CLEANER CAP, RESONATOR AND
AIR CLEANER HOSE
(a) Connect the air cleaner hose to the throttle body.
(b) Install the air cleaner cap together with the resonator
and air cleaner hose.
(c) California only:
Connect the air hose to the air cleaner hose.
(d) Connect the intake air temperature sensor connector.
15. A/T:
CONNECT AND ADJUST THROTTLE CABLE
16. CONNECT AND ADJUST ACCELERATOR CABLE
17. FILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
Capacity:
6.3 liters (6.7 US qts. 5.5 Imp. qts)
18. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE TO
BATTERY
EG1–202
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
FUEL TANK AND LINE
COMPONENTS
EG1–203
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
PRECAUTIONS
1. Always use new gaskets when replacing the fuel
tank or component parts.
2. Apply the proper torque to all parts tightened.
FUEL LINES AND CONNECTIONS
INSPECTION
(a) Check the fuel lines for cracks, leakage and all con–
nections for deformation.
(b) Check the fuel tank vapor vent system hoses and
connections for looseness, sharp bends or damage.
(c) Check the fuel tank for deformation, cracks, fuel leak–
age and tank band looseness.
(d) Check the filler neck for damage or fuel leakage.
(e) Hose and tube connections are as shown in the illus–
tration.
If a problem is found, repair or replace the part as
necessary.
EG1–204
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
THROTTLE BODY
ON–VEHICLE INPSECTION
1. INSPECT THROTTLE BODY
(a) Check that the throttle linkage moves smoothly.
(b) Check the vacuum at each port.
• Start the engine.
• Check the vacuum with your finger.
Port name
At idle
Other than idle
No vacuum
Vacuum
No vacuum
No vacuum
No vacuum
Vacuum
2. INSPECT THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
(a) Apply vacuum to the throttle opener.
(b) Disconnect the sensor connector.
(c) Insert a thickness gauge between the throttle stop
screw and stop lever.
EG1–205
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
(d) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
each terminal.
Clearance between
lever and stop screw
Between
terminals
Resistance
0 mm (0 in.)
VTA – E2
0.2 – 5.7 k
0.50 mm (0.020 in.)
IDL – E2
2.3 k or less
0.70 mm (0.028 in.)
IDL – E2
Infinity
VTA – E2
2.0 – 10.2 k
Throttle valve fully
open
VC – E2
2.5 – 5.9 k
(e) Reconnect the sensor connector.
3. INSPECT AND ADJUST THROTTLE OPENER
A. Warm up engine
Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating
temperature.
B. Check idle speed
Idle speed:
750 ± 50 rpm
C. Check and adjust throttle opener setting speed
(a) Disconnect the vacuum hose from the throttle opener,
and plug the hose end.
(b) Maintain the engine at 2,500 rpm.
(c) Release the throttle valve.
(d) Check that the throttle opener is set.
Throttle opener setting speed:
1,300 – 1,500 rpm (w/ Cooling fan OFF)
EG1–206
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
(e) Adjust the throttle opener setting speed by turning
the throttle opener adjusting screw.
(f) Reconnect the vacuum hose to the throttle opener.
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
EG1–207
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
THROTTLE BODY REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the “LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
3. DISCONNECT ACCELERATOR CABLE FROM
THROTTLE LINKAGE
4. A/T:
DISCONNECT THROTTLE CABLE FROM
THROTTLE LINKAGE
5. REMOVE AIR CLEANER CAP, RESONATOR AND
AIR CLEANER HOSE
(a) Disconnect the intake air temperature sensor connec–
tor.
(b) California only:
Disconnect the air hose from the air cleaner hose.
(c) Loosen the air cleaner hose clamp bolt.
(d) Disconnect the 4 air cleaner cap clips.
(e) Disconnect the air cleaner hose from the throttle
body, and remove the air cleaner cap together with
the resonator and air cleaner hose.
6. REMOVE THROTTLE BODY
(a) Disconnect the throttle position sensor connector.
(b) Disconnect the IAC valve connector.
EG1–208
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
(c) Disconnect the following hoses from the throttle
body.
(1) PCV hose
(2) 2 vacuum hoses from EGR vacuum modulator
(3) Vacuum hose from TVV (for EVAP)
(d) Type A:
Remove the 4 bolts.
(e) Type B:
Remove the 2 bolts and 2 nuts.
(f) Disconnect the following hoses from the throttle
body, and remove the throttle body.
(1) Water bypass hose from water outlet
(2) Water bypass hose from water bypass pipe
(3) California:
Air hose from cylinder head
Except California:
Air hose from air tube
7. IF NECESSARY, REMOVE IAC VALVE FROM
THROTTLE BODY
Remove the 4 screws, IAC valve and gasket.
THROTTLE BODY INSPECTION
1. CLEAN THROTTLE BODY
(a) Using a soft brush and carburetor cleaner, clean the
cast parts.
(b) Using compressed air, clean all the passengers and
apertures.
NOTICE: To prevent deterioration, do not clean the
throttle position sensor.
EG1–209
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
2. INSPECT THROTTLE VALVE
(a) Apply vacuum to the throttle opener.
(b) Check that there is no clearance between the throttle
stop screw and throttle lever when the throttle valve
is fully closed.
3. INSPECT THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
(a) Apply vacuum to the throttle opener.
(b) Insert a thickness gauge between the throttle stop
screw and stop lever.
(c) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
each terminal.
Clearance between
lever and stop screw
0 mm (0 in.)
Between terminals
VTA – E2
Resistance
0.2 – 5.7 k
0.50 mm (0.020 in.)
IDL–E2
2.3 k or less
0.70 mm (0.028 in.)
IDL–E2
Infinity
Throttle valve fully
open
VTA – E2
2.0 – 10.2 k
VC – E2
2.5 – 5.9 k
4. IF NECESSARY, ADJUST THROTTLE POSITION
SENSOR
(a) Loosen the 2 set screws of the sensor.
(b) Apply vacuum to the throttle opener.
(c) Insert a 0.60 mm (0.024 in.) thickness gauge between
the throttle stop screw and stop lever.
(d) Connect the test probe of an ohmmeter to the termi–
nals IDL and E2 of the sensor.
(e) Gradually turn the sensor clockwise until the ohmmeter
deflects, and secure it with the 2 set screws.
EG1–210
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
(f) Recheck the continuity between terminals IDL and E2.
Clearance between
lever and stop screw
Continuity (IDL – E2)
0.50 mm (0.020 in.)
Continuity
0.70 mm (0.028 in.)
No continuity
THROTTLE BODY INSTALLATION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. INSTALL IAC VALVE TO THROTTLE BODY
(a) Place a new gasket on the throttle body.
(b) install the IAC valve with the 4 screws.
2. INSTALL THROTTLE BODY
(a) Connect the following hoses to the throttle body:
(1) Water bypass hose from water outlet
(2) Water bypass hose from water bypass pipe
(3) California:
Air hose from cylinder head
Except California:
Air hose from air tube
(b) Place a new gasket on the intake chamber, facing the
protrusion downward.
EG1–211
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
(c) Type A:
Install the throttle body with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 19 N–m (195 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
Bolt length:
A 45 mm (1.77 in.)
B 55 mm (2.17 in.)
(d) Type B:
Install the throttle body with the 2 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 19 N–m (195 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
(e) Connect the following hoses to the throttle body:
(1) PCV hose
(2) 2 vacuum hoses from EGR vacuum modulator
(3) Vacuum hose from TVV (for EVAP)
(f) Connect the IAC valve connector.
(g) Connect the throttle position sensor connector.
3. INSTALL AIR CLEANER CAP, RESONATOR AND
AIR CLEANER HOSE
(a) Connect the air cleaner hose to the throttle body.
(b) Install the air cleaner cap together with the resonator
and air cleaner hose.
(c) California only:
Connect the air hose to the air cleaner hose.
(d) Connect the intake air temperature sensor connector.
4. A/T:
CONNECT AND ADJUST THROTTLE CABLE
5. CONNECT AND ADJUST ACCELERATOR CABLE
6. FILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
7. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE TO
BATTERY
EG1–212
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
IDLE AIR CONTROL (IAC) VALVE
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1. INSPECT IAC VALVE OPERATION
(a) Initial conditions:
•
Engine at normal operating temperature
•
Idle speed set correctly
•
Transmission in neutral position
(b) Using SST, connect terminals TE1 and E1 of the data
link connector 1.
SST 09843–18020
(c) Maintain engine speed in the range between 900 –
1,300 rpm for 5 seconds. Check that it returns to idle
speed.
If the engine speed operation is not as specified,
check the IAC valve, wiring and ECM.
(d) Remove the SST.
SST 09843–18020
EG1–213
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
2. INSPECT IAC VALVE RESISTANCE
(a) Disconnect the IAC valve connector.
(b) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
terminal + B and other terminals (ISCC, ISCO).
Resistance:
19.3–22–3Ω
If resistance is not as specified, replace the IAC valve.
(c) Reconnect the IAC valve connector.
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
EG1–214
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
IAC VALVE REMOVAL
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. REMOVE THROTTLE BODY
(See steps 1 to 6 on pages EG1–207 and 208)
2. REMOVE IAC VALVE
Remove the 4 screws, IAC valve and gasket.
IAC VALVE INSPECTION
INSPECT IAC VALVE OPERATION
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal +B and negative (–) lead to terminal ISCC,
and check that the valve is closed.
(b) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal +B and negative (–) lead to terminal ISCO,
and check that the valve is open.
IAC VALVE INSTALLATION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. INSTALL IAC VALVE
(a) Place a new gasket on the throttle body.
EG1–215
5S–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE – MFI/SFI SYSTEM
(b) Install the IAC valve with the 4 screws.
2. INSTALL THROTTLE BODY
(See steps 2 to 7 on pages EG1–210 and 211)
EG1–216
5S–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE – MFI/SFI SYSTEM
EFI MAIN RELAY
EFI MAIN RELAY INSPECTION
7. REMOVE EFI MAIN RELAY
2. INSPECT EFI MAIN RELAY
A. Inspect relay continuity
(a) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals 1 and 2.
(b) Check that there is no continuity between terminals 3
and 5.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
B. Inspect relay operation
(a) Apply battery voltage across terminals 1 and 2.
(b) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals 3 and 5.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
3. REINSTALL EFI MAIN RELAY
EG1–217
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
EG1–218
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY INSPECTION
1. INSPECT RELAY CONTINUITY
(a) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals ST and E1.
(b) Check that there is continuity between terminals +B
and FC.
(c) Check that there is no continuity between terminals +
B and FP.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
2. INSPECT RELAY OPERATION
(a) Apply battery voltage across terminals ST and E1.
(b) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals +B and FP.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
EG1–219
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
(ECT) SENSOR
ECT SENSOR INSPECTION
1. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
2. REMOVE ECT SENSOR
3. INSPECT ECT SENSOR RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
the terminals.
Resistance:
Refer to the graph above
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the
sensor.
4. REINSTALL ECT SENSOR
5. FILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
EG1–220
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE (IAT)
SENSOR
IAT SENSOR INSPECTION
1. REMOVE IAT SENSOR
2. INSPECT IAT SENSOR RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
the terminals.
Resistance:
Refer to the graph above
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the
sensor.
3. REINSTALL IAT SENSOR
EG1–221
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE
(MAP) SENSOR
MAP SENSOR INSPECTION
1. INSPECT POWER SOURCE VOLTAGE OF MAP
SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the MAP sensor connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Using a voltmeter measure the voltage between con–
nector terminals VC and E2 of the wiring harness side.
Voltage:
4.75 – 5.25 V
(d) Reconnect the MAP sensor connector.
EG1–222
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
2. INSPECT POWER OUTPUT OF MAP SENSOR
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Disconnect the vacuum hose on the air intake cham–
ber side.
(c) Connect a voltmeter to terminals PIM and E2 of the
ECM, and measure the output voltage under ambient
atmospheric pressure.
(d) Apply vacuum to the MAP sensor in 13.3 kPa (100
mmHg, 3.94 in.Hg) segments to 66.7 kPa (500 mmHg,
19.69 in.Hg).
(e) Measure the voltage drop from step
(c) above for each
segment.
Voltage drop:
Applied
Vacuum
kPa
(mmHg
in.Hg)
13.3
(100
3.94 )
Voltage
drop V
0.3–0.5
26.7
(200
7.87)
40.0
( 300
111.8)
0.7–0.9 1.1 –1.3
53.5
( 400
15.75)
1.5 – 1.7
66.7
( 500
19.69)
1.9 – 2.1
EG1–223
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
VSV FOR EGR
VSV INSPECTION (California)
1. REMOVE VSV
(a) Disconnect the following connectors and hoses:
(1) VSV for EGR (A) connector
(2) VSV for fuel pressure control (B) connector
(3) Vacuum hose (from EGR valve) from port E of
VSV (A)
(4) Vacuum hose (from port “Q” of EGR vacuum
modulator) from port G of VSV (A)
(5) Vacuum hose (from fuel pressure regulator) from
port E of VSV (B)
(6) Vacuum hose (from air intake chamber) from port
G of VSV (B)
(b) Remove the bolt and VSV assembly.
2. INSPECT VSV
A. Inspect VSV for open circuit
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between the terminals.
Resistance (Cold):
33–39
If there is no continuity, replace the VSV.
EG1–224
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
B. Inspect VSV for ground
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity
between each terminal and the body.
If there is continuity, replace the VSV.
C. Inspect VSV operation
(a) Check that air flows from port E to port G.
(b) Apply battery voltage across the terminals.
(c) Check that air flows from port E to the filter.
If operation is not as specified, replace the VSV.
3. REINSTALL VSV
VSV INSPECTION (Except California)
1. REMOVE VSV
(a) Disconnect the following connector and hoses:
(1) VSV connector
(2) Vacuum hose (from EGR valve) from port E of
VSV
(3) Vacuum hose (from port “a” of EGR vacuum
modulator) from port G of VSV
(b) Remove the bolt and VSV.
2. INSPECT VSV
A. Inspect VSV for open circuit
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between the terminals.
Resistance (Cold):
33–39
If there is no continuity, replace the VSV.
EG1–225
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
B. Inspect VSV for ground
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity
between each terminal and the body.
If there is continuity,. replace the VSV.
C. Inspect VSV operation
(a) Check that air flows from port E to port G.
(b) Apply battery voltage across the terminals.
(c) Check that air flows from port E to the filter.
If operation is not as specified, replace the VSV.
3. REINSTALL VSV
EG1–226
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
VSV FOR FUEL PRESSURE CONTROL
(California only)
VSV INSPECTION
1. REMOVE VSV
(a) Disconnect the following connectors and hoses:
(1) VSV for EGR (A) connector
(2) VSV for fuel pressure control (B) connector
(3) Vacuum hose (from EGR valve) from port E of VSV (A)
(4) Vacuum hose (from port “a” of EGR vacuum
modulator) from port G of VSV (A)
(5) Vacuum hose (from fuel pressure regulator) from
port E of VSV (B)
(6) Vacuum hose (from air intake chamber) from port
G of VSV (B)
(b) Remove the bolt and VSV assembly.
2. INSPECT VSV
A. Inspect VSV for open circuit
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between the terminals.
Resistance (Cold):
33–39
If there is no continuity, replace the VSV.
EG1–227
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
B. Inspect VSV for ground
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity
between each terminal and the body.
If there is continuity, replace the VSV.
C. Inspect VSV operation
(a) Check that air flows from pipe E to pipe G.
(b) Apply battery voltage across the terminals.
(c) Check that air flows from pipe E to the filter.
If operation is not as specified, replace the VSV.
3. REINSTALL VSV
EG1–228
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
A–C IDLE–UP VALVE
A/C IDLE– UP VALVE INSPECTION
1. REMOVE IDLE–UP VALVE
(a) Disconnect the following connector and hoses:
(1) Idle–up valve connector
(2) Air hose from air intake chamber
(3) Air hose from air tube
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and idle–up valve together with
the 2 air hoses.
(c) Disconnect the 2 air hoses from the idle–up valve.
2. INSPECT IDLE–UP VALVE
A. Inspect idle–up valve for open circuit
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between the terminals.
Resistance (Cold):
30–34
If there is no continuity, replace the idle–up valve.
B. Inspect idle–up valve for ground
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity
between each terminal and the body.
If there is continuity, replace the idle–up valve.
EG1–229
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
C. Inspect idle–up valve operation
(a) Check that air does not flow from port E to port F.
(b) Apply battery voltage across the terminals.
(c) Check that air flows from port E to port F.
If operation is not as specified, replace the idle–up
valve.
3. REINSTALL IDLE– UP VALVE
EG1–230
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR
EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR
INSPECTION
1. REMOVE EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR
2. INSPECT EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
the terminals.
Resistance:
64–97 k at 50C (122F)
11–16 k at 100C (212F)
2–4 k at 150C (302F)
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the
sensor.
3. REINSTALL EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR
EG1–231
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
OXYGEN SENSOR
OXYGEN SENSOR INSPECTION
1. WARM UP ENGINE
Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating
temperature.
2. INSPECT FEEDBACK VOLTAGE
Connect the positive (+) probe of a voltmeter to
terminal VF1 of the data link connector 1 and nega–
tive (–) probe to terminal E1. Perform the test as
follows:
Warm up the oxygen sensor with the engine at 2,500 rpm
for approx. 90 seconds.
Using SST, connect terminals TE1 and E1 of the data link
connector 1.
SST 09843–18020
And maintain engine speed at 2,500 rpm.
Replace the ECM.
Zero again After replacing
1 the oxygen sensor
Check the number of times the voltmeter needle fluctuates in 10 seconds.
8 times
or more
Less than 8 times
Warm up the oxygen sensor with the engine at 2,500 rpm
for approx. 90 seconds. And maintain engine speed at
2,500 rpm.
Check the number of times the voltmeter needle fluctuates
in 10 seconds.
Normal
8 times or more
Zero
Less than 8 times
Disconnect terminals TE1 and E1 of the data link
connector 1. And maintain engine speed at 2,500 rpm.
Measure voltage between terminals VF1 and E1.
More than 0 V
Read and record diagnostic trouble codes. (See page EG1–297)
Normal code, code
Nos. 21, 25 and 26
Malfunction code(s)
(Ex. code Nos. 21, 25 and 26)
Repair the relevant diagnostic trouble code.
CONTINUED ON PAGE EG1–232
Zero
EG1–232
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
CONTINUED FROM PAGE EG1–231
Repair the relevant diagnostic trouble code.
Malfunction code(s)
(Ex. code Nos. 21, 25 and 26)
Read and record diagnostic trouble codes. (See page
EG1–297)
Normal code, code Nos.
21, 25 and 26
Disconnect terminals TE1 and E1 of the data link connector 1.
And maintain engine at 2,500 rpm.
Measure voltage between terminals VF1 and E1.
Disconnect the PCV hose.
Measure voltage between terminals VF1 and E1.
More than 0 V
Repair (Over rich)
Disconnect the engine coolant temp. sensor connector and
connect resistor with a resistance of 4 – 8 k or send an
equivalent simulation signal.
Connect terminals TE1 and E1 of the data link connector 1.
Warm up the oxygen sensor with the engine at 2,500 rpm for
approx. 90 seconds. And maintain engine at 2,500 rpm.
Measure voltage between terminals VF1 and E1,
Replace the oxygen sensor.
Repair (Over Lean)
EG1–233
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
SUB OXYGEN SENSOR
SUB OXYGEN SENSOR INSPECTION
INSPECT SUB OXYGEN SENSOR
HINT: Inspect only when code No. 27 is displayed.
(a) Cancel the diagnostic trouble code. (See page EG1–299)
(b) Warm up the engine until it reaches normal operating
temperature.
(c) M/T:
Drive for 5 minutes or more at a speed less than 80
km/h (50 mph) in 4th or 5th gear.
A/T:
Drive for 5 minutes or more at a speed less than 80
km/h (50 mph) in “D” position.
(d) Following the conditions in step (c), fully depress on
the accelerator pedal for 2 seconds or more.
(e) Stop the vehicle and turn the ignition switch OFF.
(f) Carry out steps (b), (c) and (d) again to test accelera–
tion. If code No.27 appears again, check the sub oxygen
sensor circuit. If the circuit is normal, replace the sub
oxygen sensor.
EG1–234
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECM)
ECM REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
ECM INSPECTION
(See page EG1–318)
EG1–235
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
FUEL CUT RPM
FUEL CUT RPM INSPECTION
1. WARM UP ENGINE
Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating
temperature.
2. CONNECT TACHOMETER TO ENGINE
Connect the test probe of a tachometer to terminal IG
(–) of the data link connector 1.
NOTICE:
•
NEVER allow the tachometer terminal to touch
ground as it could result in damage to the igniter
and/or ignition coil.
•
As some tachometers are not compatible with this
ignition system, we recommend that you confirm
the compatibility of yours before use.
3. INSPECT FUEL CUT RPM
(a) Increase the engine speed to at least 2,500 rpm.
(b) Use a sound scope to check for injector operating
noise.
(c) Check that when the throttle lever is released, injector
operation noise stops momentarily and then resumes.
HINT: Measure with the A/C OFF.
Fuel return speed:
1,500 rpm
4. DISCONNECT TACHOMETER
EG1–236
5S–FE ENGINE
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE DATA
Fuel pressure
regulator
Fuel pressure
Fuel pump
Resistance
Injector
Resistance
at no vacuum
Injection volume
Difference between each cylinder
Fuel leakage
Throttle body
Throttle body fully closed angle
Throttle opener setting speed
Throttle
Clearance between stop screw and lever
position
0 mm (0 in.)
sensor
0.50 mm (0.020 in.)
0.70 mm (0.028 in.)
Throttle valve fully open
IAC valve
Resistance (+B – ISCC or ISCO)
ECT sensor
Resistance
IAT sensor
Resistance
MAP sensor
Power source voltage
VSV for EG R
Resistance
VSV for Fuel
pressure
(California
only)
Resistance
A/C idle –up
valve
Resistance
EG R gas
Resistance
temperature
sensor
Fuel cut rpm
Fuel return rpm
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
EG1–237
5S–FE ENGINE
–
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part tightened
Fuel line (Union bolt type)
Fuel line (Flare nut type – use SST)
Fuel tank band x Body
Fuel pump x Fuel tank
Fuel pressure regulator x Delivery pipe
Fuel return pipe x Fuel pressure regulator
Delivery pipe x Cylinder head
Fuel pulsation damper x Delivery pipe
Intake manifold x Cylinder head
Intake manifold stay x Intake manifold
Intake manifold stay x Cylinder block
No.1 air intake chamber stay x Intake manifold
No.1 air intake chamber stay x Cylinder head
EGR pipe union nut
EGR pipe x Intake manifold
Throttle body x Intake manifold
Fuel pump side
Others
MFI/SFI SYSTEM
EG1–238
5S–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
COOLING SYSTEM
DESCRIPTION
This engine utilizes a pressurized forced circulation cooling system which includes a thermostat
equipped with a bypass valve mounted on the inlet side.
OPERATION
The cooling system is composed of the water jacket (inside the cylinder block and cylinder head),
radiator, water pump, thermostat, electric fan, hoses and other components.
Engine coolant which is heated in the water jacket is pumped to the radiator, through which an
electric fan blows air to cool the coolant as it passes through. Engine coolant which has been
cooled is then sent back to the engine by the water pump, where it cools the engine.
The water jacket is a network of channels in the shell of the cylinder block and cylinder head
through which coolant passes. It is designed to provide adequate cooling of the cylinders and
combustion chambers which become heated during engine operation.
EG1–239
5S–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
RADIATOR
The radiator performs the function of cooling the coolant which has passed through the water
jacket and become hot, and it is mounted in the front of the vehicle. The radiator consists of an
upper tank and lower tank, and a core which connects the two tanks. The upper tank contains the
inlet for coolant from the water jacket and the filler inlet. It also has a hose attached through
which excess coolant or steam can flow. The lower tank has an outlet and drain cock for the
coolant. The core contains many tubes through which coolant flows from the upper tank to the
lower tank as well as to cooling fins which radiate heat away from the coolant in the tubes. The
air sucked through the radiator by the electric fan, as well as the wind generated by the vehicle’s
travel, passes through the radiator, cooling the coolant. Models with automatic transmission
include an automatic transmission fluid cooler built into the lower tank of the radiator. A fan with
an electric motor is mounted behind the radiator to assist the flow of air through the radiator. The
fan operates when the engine coolant temperature becomes high in order to prevent it from becoming too high.
RADIATOR CAP
The radiator cap is a pressure type cap which seals the radiator, resulting in pressurization of the
radiator as the coolant expands. The pressurization prevents the coolant from boiling even when
the engine coolant temperature exceeds 100°C (212°F). A relief valve (pressurization valve) and a
vacuum valve (negative pressure valve) are built into the radiator cap. The relief valve opens and
lets steam escape through the overflow pipe when the pressure generated inside the cooling system exceeds the limit (coolant temperature: 110–120°C (230–248°F), pressure; 58.8103.0 kpa
(0.6–1.05 kgf/cm2, 8.5–14.9 psi). The vacuum valve opens to alleviate the vacuum which develops
in the cooling system after the engine is stopped and the engine coolant temperature drops. The
valve’s opening allows the coolant in the reservoir tank to return to the cooling system.
RESERVOIR TANK
The reservoir tank is used to catch coolant which overflows from the cooling system as a result
of volumetric expansion when the coolant is heated. The coolant in the reservoir tank returns to
the radiator when the coolant temperature drops, thus keeping the radiator full at all times and
avoiding needless coolant loss.
Check the reservoir tank level to learn if the coolant needs to be replenished.
WATER PUMP
The water pump is used for forced circulation of coolant through the cooling system. It is
mounted on the front of the cylinder block and driven by a timing belt.
THERMOSTAT
The thermostat has a wax type bypass valve and is mounted in the water inlet housing. The
thermostat includes a type of automatic valve operated by fluctuations in the engine coolant
temperature. This valve closes when the engine coolant temperature drops, preventing the
circulation of coolant through the engine and thus permitting the engine to warm up rapidly. The
valve opens when the engine coolant temperature has risen, allowing the circulation of coolant.
Wax inside the thermostat expands when heated and contracts when cooled. Heating the wax
thus generates pressure which overpowers the force of the spring which keeps the valve closed,
thus opening the valve. When the wax cools, its contraction allows the force of the spring to take
effect once more, closing the valve. The thermostat in this engine operates at a temperature of
82C (180F).
EG1–240
5S–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
PREPARATION
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
09228–06500 Oil Filter Wrench
09230–01010 Radiator Service Tool Set
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082–00050 TOYOTA Electrical Tester Set
EQUIPMENT
Heater
Engine coolant temperature switch
Radiator cap tester
Thermometer
Engine coolant temperature switch
Torque wrench
COOLANT
Item
Engine coolant (w/ Heater)
Capacity
6.3 liters (6.7 US qts, 5.5 Imp. qts)
Classification
Ethylene–glycol base
EG1–241
5S–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
COOLANT CHECK AND
REPLACEMENT
1. CHECK ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL AT RESERVOIR
TANK
The engine coolant level should be between the
”LOW” and “FULL” lines.
If low, check for leaks and add engine coolant up to
the “FULL” line.
2. CHECK ENGINE COOLANT QUALITY
There should not be any excessive deposits of rust or
scales around the radiator cap or radiator filler hole,
and the engine coolant should be free from oil.
If excessively dirty, replace the engine coolant.
3. REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT
(a) Remove the radiator cap.
CAUTION: To avoid the danger of being burned, do not
remove It while the engine and radiator are still hot, as
fluid and steam can be blown out under pressure.
(b) Drain the engine coolant from the radiator drain cock
and engine drain plug. (Engine drain plug at the right
rear of cylinder block.)
(c) Close the drain cock and plug.
Torque (Engine drain plug):
13 N–m (130 kgf–cm, 9 ft–lbf)
(d) Slowly fill the system with coolant.
Use a good brand of ethylene–glycol base
coolant and mix it according to the
manufacturer ’s directions.
Using engine coolant which includes more than
5096 ethylene–glycol (but not more than 7096) is
recommended.
NOTICE:
•
Do not use a alcohol type coolant.
•
The engine coolant should be mixed with demineral–
ized water or distilled water.
Capacity (w/ Heater):
8.3 liters (6.7 US qts, 5.5 Imp.qts)
(a) Reinstall the radiator cap.
(f) Warm up the engine and check for leaks.
(g) Recheck the engine coolant level and refill as neces–
sary.
EG1–242
5S–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
WATER PUMP
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
WATER PUMP REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds
from the time the Ignition switch is turned to the
“LOCK” position and the negative (–) terminal cable
is disconnected from the battery.
2. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page EG1–241)
3. REMOVE TIMING BELT (See page EG1–26)
4. REMOVE NO. 1 IDLER PULLEY AND TENSION
SPRING
Remove the bolt, pulley and tension spring.
EG1–243
5S–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
5. REMOVE NO.2 IDLER PULLEY
Remove the bolt and pulley.
6. DISCONNECT LOWER RADIATOR HOSE FROM
WATER INLET
7. REMOVE GENERATOR BELT ADJUSTING BAR
Remove the bolt and adjusting bar.
8. REMOVE WATER PUMP AND WATER PUMP
COVER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 nuts holding the pump to the water
bypass pipe.
(b) Remove the 3 bolts in the sequence shown.
(c) Pull out the water pump together with the water pump
cover.
(d) Remove the gasket and 2 O–rings from the water
pump and water bypass pipe.
9. SEPARATE WATER PUMP AND WATER PUMP
COVER
Remove the 3 bolts, water pump and gasket from the
water pump cover.
EG1–244
5S–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
10. REMOVE WATER INLET AND THERMOSTAT FROM
WATER PUMP COVER
(a) Remove the 2 nuts and water inlet from the water
pump.
(b) Remove the thermostat.
(c) Remove the gasket from the thermostat.
WATER PUMP INSPECTION
INSPECT WATER PUMP
Turn the pulley and check that the water pump bear–
ing moves smoothly and quietly.
WATER PUMP INSTALLATION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. INSTALL THERMOSTAT AND WATER INLET TO
WATER PUMP COVER
(a) Install a new gasket to the thermostat.
(b) Align the jiggle valve of the thermostat with the upper
side of the stud bolt, and insert the thermostat in the
water pump.
HINT: The jiggle valve may be set within 5 of either
side of the prescribed position.
(c) Install the water inlet with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 8.8 N–m (90 kgf–cm. 78 in.–lbf)
EG1–245
5S–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
2. ASSEMBLE WATER PUMP AND WATER PUMP
COVER
Install a new gasket and the water pump to the pump
cover with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 9.3 N–m (95 kgf–cm, 82 In.–lbf)
3. INSTALL WATER PUMP AND WATER PUMP
COVER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install new O–ring and gasket to water pump cover.
(b) Instal a new O–ring to the water bypass pipe.
(c) Apply soapy water to the O–ring on the water bypass
pipe.
(d) Connect the pump cover to the water bypass pipe.
Do not install the nuts yet.
(e) Install the water pump with the 3 bolts. Tighten the
bolts in the sequence shown.
Torque: 9.3 N–m (95 kgf–cm, 82 in.–lbf)
EG1–246
5S–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
(f) Install the 2 nuts holding the water pump cover to the
water bypass pipe.
Torque: 8.8 N–m (90 kgf–cm, 78 in.–Ibf)
4. INSTALL GENERATOR BELT ADJUSTING BAR
Temporarily install the adjusting bar with the bolt.
5. CONNECT LOWER RADIATOR HOSE TO WATER
INLET
6. INSTALL NO.2 IDLER PULLEY
(a) Install the pulley with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N–m (425 kgf–cm, 31 ft–lbf)
HINT: Use a bolt 35 mm (1.38 in.) in length.
(b) Check that the idler pulley moves smoothly.
7. TEMPORARILY INSTALL NO.1 IDLER PULLEY AND
TENSION SPRING
(a) Install the pulley with the bolt. Do not tighten the bolt
yet.
HINT: Use bolt 42 mm (1.65 in.) in length.
(b) Install the tension spring.
(c) Pry the pulley toward the left as far as it will go and
tighten the bolt.
(d) Check that the idler pulley moves smoothly.
8. INSTALL TIMING BELT (See page EG1–33)
9. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE TO
BATTERY
10. FILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
(See page EG1–241)
EG1–247
5S–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
THERMOSTAT
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
THERMOSTAT REMOVAL
HINT: Removal of the thermostat would have an ad–
verse effect, causing a lowering of cooling efficiency.
Do not remove the thermostat, even if the engine
tends to overheat.
1. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page EG1–241)
2. REMOVE OIL FILTER
Using SST, remove the oil filter.
SST 09228–06500
3. REMOVE WATER INLET AND THERMOSTAT
(a) Remove the 2 nuts and water inlet from the water
pump.
(b) Remove the thermostat.
(c) Remove the gasket from the thermostat.
EG1–248
5S–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
THERMOSTAT INSPECTION
INSPECT THERMOSTAT
HINT: The thermostat is numbered with the valve
opening temperature.
(a) Immerse the thermostat in water and gradually heat
the water.
(b) Check the valve opening temperature.
Valve opening temperature:
80 – 84C (176 – 183F)
If the valve opening temperature is not as specified,
replace the thermostat.
(c) Check the valve lift.
Valve rift:
8 mm (0.31 in.) or more at 95C (203F)
If the valve lift is not as specified, replace the thermo–
stat.
(d) Check that the valve spring is tight when the thermo–
stat is fully closed.
If not closed, replace the thermostat.
THERMOSTAT INSTALLATION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. PLACE THERMOSTAT IN WATER PUMP
(a) Install a new gasket to the thermostat.
(b) Align the jiggle valve of the thermostat with the upper
side of the stud bolt, and insert the thermostat in the
water pump.
HINT: The jiggle valve may be set within 5of either
side of the prescribed position.
2. INSTALL WATER INLET
Install the water inlet with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 8.8 N–m (90 kgf–cm, 78in.–Ibf)
EG1–249
5S–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
3. INSTALL OIL FILTER
(a) Clean the oil filter contact surface on the filter
mounting.
(b) Lubricate the filter rubber gasket with engine oil.
(c) Tighten the oil filter by hand until the rubber gasket
contacts the seat of the filter mounting. Then using
SST, give it an additional 3/4 turn to seat the oil filter.
SST 09228–06500
4. FILL WITH ENGINE OIL
5. FILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT (SEE PAGE EG1–241)
6. START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR LEAKS
7. CHECK ENGINE OIL LEVEL
The oil level should be between the “L” and “F” marks
on the dipstick.
If low, check for leakage and add oil up to “F” mark.
EG1–250
5S–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
RADIATOR
RADIATOR CLEANING
Using water or a steam cleaner, remove any mud or
dirt from the radiator core.
NOTICE: If using a high pressure type cleaner, be care–
full not to deform the fins of the radiator core. If the
cleaner nozzle pressure is 2,942 – 3,432 kPa (30 – 35
kgf/cm, 427 – 498 psi), keep a distance of at least 40
cm (15.75 in.) between the radiator core and cleaner
nozzle.
RADIATOR INSPECTION
1. INSPECT RADIATOR CAP
NOTICE: When performing steps (a) and (b) below, keep
the radiator pump tester at an angle of over 30 above
the horizontal.
(a) Using a radiator cap tester, slowly pump the tester
and check that air is coming from the relief valve.
Pump speed:
1 push/ 3 seconds or more
NOTICE: Push the pump at a constant speed.
If air is not coming from the relief valve, replace the
radiator cap.
(b) Pump the tester several times and measure the relief
valve opening pressure.
Pump speed:
1 at time
1 push/1 second or less
2nd time or more
Any speed
Standard opening pressure:
74–103 kPa
(0.75–1.05 kgf/cm, 10.7 – 14.9 psi)
Minimum opening pressure:
59 kPa (0.6 kgf/cm, 8.5 psi)
If the opening pressure is less than minimum, replace
the radiator cap.
EG1–251
5S–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
2. INSPECT COOLING SYSTEM FOR LEAKS
(a) Fill the radiator with coolant and attach a radiator cap
tester.
(b) Warm up the engine.
(c) Pump it to 118 kPa (1.2 kgf/cm, 17.1 psi), and check
that the pressure does not drop.
If the pressure drops, check the hoses, radiator or
water pump for leaks. If no external leaks are found,
check the heater core, cylinder block and head.
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
RADIATOR REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the “LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
EG1–252
5S–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
2. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page EG1–241)
3. w/ CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM:
REMOVE CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR COVER
4. DISCONNECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SWITCH CONNECTOR FROM FAN SHROUD
5. DISCONNECT ELECTRIC COOLING FAN
CONNECTORS
6. DISCONNECT RADIATOR HOSES
(a) Disconnect the upper hose from the radiator side.
(b) Disconnect the lower from the water inlet pipe.
7. DISCONNECT ENGINE COOLANT RESERVOIR
HOSE
8. A/T:
DISCONNECT OIL COOLER HOSES
9. REMOVE RADIATOR AND ELECTRIC COOLING
FANS
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and 2 upper supports.
(b) Lift out the radiator.
(c) Remove the 2 lower radiator supports.
10. REMOVE RADIATOR LOWER HOSE
11. A/T:
REMOVE A/T OIL COOLER HOSES
EG1–253
5S–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
12. REMOVE ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SWITCH WIRE
13. REMOVE ELECTRIC COOLING FANS FROM
RADIATOR
Remove the 8 bolts and cooling fans.
14. REMOVE ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SWITCH
(a) Remove the engine coolant temperature switch.
(b) Remove the 0–ring.
EG1–254
5S–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
COMPONENTS FOR DISASSEMBLY AND
ASSEMBLY
RADIATOR DISASSEMBLY
1. ASSEMBLE SST
SST 09230–01010
(a) Install the claw to the overhaul handle, inserting it in
the hole in part “A” as shown in the diagram.
(b) While gripping the handle, adjust the stopper bolt so
that dimension “B” shown in the diagram is 0.2–0.5
mm (0.008–0.020 in.).
NOTICE: If this adjustment is not performed, the claw
may be damaged.
EG1–255
5S–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
2. UNCAULK LOCK PLATES
Using SST to release the caulking, squeeze the handle
until stopped by the stopper bolt.
SST 09230–01010
3. REMOVE TANKS AND O–RINGS
(a) Lightly tap the radiator hose inlet (or outlet) with a
soft–faced hammer and remove the tank.
(b) Remove the 0–ring.
4. A/T:
REMOVE OIL COOLER FROM LOWER TANK
(a) Remove the pipes.
HINT: Make a note of the direction to face the pipes.
(b) Remove the nuts and plate washers.
(c) Remove the oil cooler and 0–rings.
RADIATOR ASSEMBLY
(See Components for Disassembly and Assembly)
1. A/T:
INSTALL OIL COOLER TO LOWER TANK
(a) Clean the 0–ring contact surface of the lower tank
and oil cooler.
(b) Install new 0–rings (1) to the oil cooler (2).
(c) Install the oil cooler with the 0–rings to the lower
tank (3).
(d) Install the plate washers (4) and nuts (5). Torque the
nuts.
Torque: 8.3 N–m (85 kgf–cm, 74 in.–lbf)
(e) Install the pipes (6).
Torque: 22 N–m (220 kgf–cm, 16 ft–lbf)
HINT: Face the pipes in the same direction as before
disassembly.
EG1–256
5S–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
2. INSPECT LOCK PLATE
Inspect the lock plate for damage.
HINT:
• If the sides of the lock plate groove are deformed,
reassembly of the tank will be impossible.
• Therefore, first correct any deformation with pliers or
similar object. Water leakage will result if the bottom
of the lock plate groove is damaged or dented. There–
fore, repair or replace if necessary.
3. INSTALL NEW O–RINGS AND TANKS
(a) After checking that there are no foreign objects in the
lock plate groove, install the new O–ring without
twisting it.
HINT: When cleaning the lock plate groove, lightly rub
it with sand paper without scratching it.
(b) Install the tank without damaging the 0–ring.
(c) Tap the lock plate with a soft–faced hammer so that
there is no gap between it and the tank.
4. ASSEMBLE SST
SST 09230–01010
(a) Install the punch assembly to the overhaul handle,
inserting it in the hole in part “A” as shown in the
illustration.
(b) While gripping the handle, adjust the stopper bolt so
that dimension “B” shown in the diagram is 7.7 mm
(0.03 in.)
5. CAULK LOCK PLATE
(a) Lightly press SST against the lock plate in the order
shown in the illustration.
EG1–257
5S–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
After repeating this a few times, fully caulk the lock
plate by squeezing the handle until stopped by the
stopper plate.
SST 09230 – 01010
HINT:
• Do not stake the areas protruding around the
pipes, brackets or tank ribs.
• The points shown in the illustration and oil cooler
near here (A/T) cannot be staked with the SST.
Use a plier or like object and be careful not to
damage the core plates.
(b) Check the lock plate height (H) after completing the
caulking.
Plate height:
7.75–8.25 mm (0–3051–0.3248 in.)
If not within the specified height, adjust the stopper
bolt of the handle again and perform the caulking
again.
6. INSPECT FOR WATER LEAKS
(a) Tighten the drain cock.
(b) Plug the inlet and outlet pipes of the radiator with
SST.
SST 09230 – 01010
(c) Using a radiator cap tester, apply pressure to the
radiator.
Test pressure:
177 kPa (1.8 kgf/cm, 26 psi)
EG1–258
5S–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
(d) Inspect for water leaks.
HINT: On radiators with resin tanks, there is a clear–
ance between the tank and lock plate where a minute
amount of air will remain, giving the appearance of an
air leak when the radiator is submerged in water.
Therefore, before performing the water leak test, first
switch the radiator around in the water until all air
bubbles disappear.
7. PAINT LOCK PLATES
HINT: If the water leak test checks out okay, allow the
radiator to completely dry and then paint the lock
plates.
RADIATOR INSTALLATION
(See Components for Removal and installation)
1. INSTALL ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SWITCH
(a) Install a new O–ring to the engine coolant tempera–
ture switch.
(b) Install the engine coolant temperature switch.
2. INSTALL ELECTRIC COOLING FANS TO RADIATOR
Install the cooling fans with the 8 bolts.
3. INSTALL ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SWITCH WIRE
EG1–259
5S–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
4. A/T:
INSTALL A/T OIL COOLER HOSES
5. INSTALL RADIATOR LOWER HOSE
6. INSTALL RADIATOR AND ELECTRIC COOLING
FANS
(a) Place the 2 lower radiator supports in position on the
body.
(b) Place the radiator in position, and install the 2 upper
supports with the 2 bolts.
HINT: After installation, check that the rubber cushion
(A) of the support is not depressed.
Torque: 13 N–m (130 kgf–cm, 9 ft–lbf)
7. A/T:
CONNECT OIL COOLER HOSES
8. CONNECT ENGINE COOLANT RESERVOIR HOSE
9. CONNECT RADIATOR HOSES
EG1–260
5S–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
10. CONNECT ELECTRIC COOLING FAN CONNECTORS
11. CONNECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SWITCH CONNECTOR TO FAN SHROUD
12. w/ CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM:
INSTALL CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR COVER
13. FILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
(See page EG1–241)
14. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE TO
BATTERY
15. START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR LEAKS
16. A/T:
CHECK AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION (A/T) FLUID
LEVEL
NOTICE: Do not overfill.
EG1–261
5S–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
ELECTRIC COOLING FAN
PART LOCATION
SYSTEM CIRCUIT
EG1–262
5S–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
Low Temperature (Below 83C (181F))
1. TURN IGNITION SWITCH “ON”
Check that the cooling fan stops.
If not, check the cooling fan relay and engine coolant
temperature switch, and check for a separated con–
nector or severed wire between the cooling fan relay
and engine coolant temperature switch.
2. DISCONNECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SWITCH CONNECTOR
Check that the cooling fan rotates.
If not, check the cooling fan relay, cooling fan, engine
main relay and fuse, and check for a short circuit
between the cooling fan relay and engine coolant
temperature switch.
3. CONNECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SWITCH CONNECTOR
High Temperature (Above 93C (199F))
4. START ENGINE
(a) Raise engine coolant temperature to above 93C
(199F).
(b) Check that the cooling fan rotates.
If not, replace the engine coolant temperature switch.
9=4 –01
ELECTRIC COOLING FAN COMPONENTS
INSPECTION
1. INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SWITCH
(a) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity
between the terminals when the engine coolant tem–
perature is above 93C (199F).
(b) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between the terminals when the engine coolant tem–
perature is below 83C (181 F).
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
EG1–263
5S–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
2. INSPECT COOLING FAN RELAY (”FAN’)
A. Remove cooling fan relay
B. Inspect relay continuity
(a) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals 1 and 2.
(b) Check that there is continuity between terminals 3
and 4.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
C. Inspect relay operation
(a) Apply battery voltage across terminals 1 and 2.
(b) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity
between terminals 3 and 4.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
D. Reinstall cooling fan relay
3. INSPECT ENGINE MAIN RELAY (“ENG MAIN”)
A. Remove engine main relay
B. Inspect relay continuity
(a) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals 3 and 5.
(b) Check that there is continuity between terminals 2
and 4.
(c) Check that there is no continuity between terminals 1
and 2.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
EG1–264
5S–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
C. Inspect relay operation
(a) Apply battery voltage across terminals 3 and 5.
(b) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity
between terminals 2 and 4.
(c) Check that there is continuity between terminals 1
and 2.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
D. Reinstall engine main relay
4. INSPECT COOLING FAN
(a) Connect battery and ammeter to the cooling fan con–
nector.
(b) Check that the cooling fan rotates smoothly, and
check the reading on the ammeter.
Standard amperage:
5.8 – 7.4 A
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
EG1–265
5S–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
ELECTRIC COOLING FAN REMOVAL
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page EG1–241)
3. w/ CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM:
REMOVE CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR COVER
4. DISCONNECT UPPER RADIATOR HOSE FROM
RADIATOR
5. REMOVE ELECTRIC COOLING FAN
(a) Disconnect the engine coolant temperature switch
connector from the radiator.
(b) Disconnect the engine coolant temperature switch
and electric cooling fan connectors from the fan
shroud.
(c) Remove the 4 bolts and cooling fan.
COMPONENTS FOR DISASSEMBLY AND
ASSEMBLY
EG1–266
5S–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
ELECTRIC COOLING FAN DISASSEMBLY
(See Components for Disassembly and Assembly)
1. REMOVE FAN
Remove the nut and fan.
2. REMOVE FAN MOTOR
Remove the screws and fan motor.
ELECTRIC COOLING FAN ASSEMBLY
(See Components for Disassembly and Assembly)
1. INSTALL FAN MOTOR
2. INSTALL FAN
ELECTRIC COOLING FAN INSTALLATION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. INSTALL ELECTRIC COOLING FAN
(a) Install the cooling fan with the 4 bolts.
(b) Connect the engine coolant temperature switch and
electric cooling fan connectors to the fan shroud.
(c) Connect the engine coolant temperature switch connector
to the radiator.
2. CONNECT UPPER RADIATOR HOSE TO RADIATOR
3. w/ CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM:
INSTALL CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR COVER
4. FILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
(See page EG1–241)
5. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE TO
BATTERY
6. START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR LEAKS
EG1–267
5S–FE ENGINE
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE DATA
Thermostat
Valve opening temperature
Radiator cap
Relief valve opening pressure
Radiator
Plate height
Electric
Rotating amperage
Valve lift
cooling fan
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part tightened
Cylinder block x Drain plug
Water inlet x Water pump cover
Water pump x Water pump cover
Water pump x Cylinder block
Water bypass pipe x Water pump cover
No.2 idler pulley x Cylinder block
Water inlet x Water pump
Radiator oil cooler x Radiator lower tank
Radiator oil cooler pipe
Radiator support bolt
–
COOLING SYSTEM
EG1–268
5S–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
DESCRIPTION
A fully pressurized, fully filtered lubrication system has been adopted for this engine.
OPERATION
EG1–269
5S–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
A pressure feeding lubrication system has been adopted to supply oil to the moving parts of this
engine. The lubrication system consists of an oil pan, oil pump, oil filter and other external parts
which supply oil to the moving parts in the engine block. The oil circuit is shown in the illustration
at the top of the previous page. Oil from the oil pan is pumped up by the oil pump. After it passes
through the oil filter, it is through the various oil holes in the crankshaft and cylinder block. After
passing through the cylinder block and performing its lubricating function, the oil is returned by
gravity to the oil pan. A dipstick on the center left side of the cylinder block is provided to check
the oil level.
OIL PUMP
The oil pump pumps up oil from the oil pan and feeds it under pressure to the various parts of the
engine. An oil strainer is mounted in front of the inlet to the oil pump to remove impurities. The
oil pump itself is a trochoid type pump, inside of which is a drive rotor and a driven rotor. When
the drive rotor rotates, the driven rotor rotates in the same direction, and since the axis of the
drive rotor shaft is different from the center of the driven rotor, the space between the two rotors
changes as they rotate. Oil is drawn in when the space widens and is discharged when the space
becomes narrow.
OIL PRESSURE REGULATOR (RELIEF VALVE)
At high engine speeds, the engine oil supplied by the oil pump exceeds the capacity of the engine
to utilize it. For that reason, the oil pressure regulator works to prevent an oversupply of oil.
During normal oil supply, a coil spring and valve keep the bypass closed, but when too much oil
is being fed, the pressure becomes extremely high, overpowering the force of the spring and
opening the valves. This allows the excess oil to flow through the valve and return to the oil pan.
OIL FILTER
The oil filter is a full flow type filter with a relief valve built into the paper filter element. Particles
of metal from wear, airborne dirt, carbon and other impurities can get into the oil during use and
could cause accelerated wear or seizing if allowed to circulate through the engine. The oil filter,
integrated into the oil line, removes these impurities as the oil passes through it. The filter is
mounted outside the engine to simplify replacement of the filter element. A relief valve is also
included ahead of the filter element to relieve the high oil pressure in case the filter element
becomes clogged with impurities. The relief valve opens when the oil pressure overpowers the
force of the spring. Oil passing through the relief valve bypasses the oil filter and flows directly
into the main oil hole in the engine.
EG1–270
5S–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
PREPARATION
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
09032–00100 Oil Pan Seat Cutter
09226–10010 Crankshaft Front & Rear Bearing
Replacer
Crankshaft front oil seal
09228–06500 Oil Filter wrench
09616–30011 Steering Worm Bearing Adjusting
Screw Wrench
Oil pump pulley
09620–30010 Steering Gear Box Replacer Set
(09627–30010) Steering Sector Shaft Bushing
Replacer
Oil pump oil seal
(09631–00020) Handle
Oil pump oil seal
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09090–04000 Engine Sling Device
For suspending engine
09200–00010 Engine Adjust Kit
09905–00013 Snap Ring Pliers
EQUIPMENT
Oil pressure gauge
Precision straight edge
Torque wrench
Oil pump
EG1–271
5S–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
LUBRICANT
Item
Engine oil (M/T)
Dry fill
Capacity
Classification
API grade SG or SH, Energy–Conserving ΙΙ
4.2 liters (4.4 US qts, 3.7 Imp. qts)
Drain and refill
mutigrade engine oil or ILSAC multigrade
engine oil and recommended viscosity oil
w/ Oil filter change
3.6 liters (3.8 US qts, 3.2 Imp. qts)
w/o Oil filter change
3.4 liters (3.6 US qts, 3.0 Imp. qts)
Engine oil (A/T)
Dry fill
4.3 liters (4.5 US qts, 3.8 imp. qts)
Drain and refill
w/ Oil filter change
3.6 liters (3.8 US qts, 3.2 Imp. qts)
w/o Oil filter change
3.4 liters (3.6 US qts, 3.0 Imp. qts)
SSM (SPECIAL SERVICE MATERIALS)
08826–00080 Seal packing or equivalent
Oil pan
08833–00080 Adhesive 1344,
THREE BOND 1344,
LOCTITE 242 or equivalent
Oil pressure switch
EG1–272
5S–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
OIL PRESSURE CHECK
1. CHECK ENGINE OIL QUALITY
Check the oil for deterioration, entry of water, dis–
coloring or thinning.
If the quality is visibly poor, replace the oil.
Oil grade:
API grade SG or SH, Energy Conserving II multi–
grade engine oil or ILSAC multigrade engine oil.
Recommended viscosity is as shown in the illustra–
tion.
2. CHECK ENGINE OIL LEVEL
The oil level should be between the “L” and “F” marks
on the dipstick.
If low, check for leakage and add oil up to “F” mark.
NOTICE:
•
When inserting the oil dipstick, insert the curved tip
of the dipstick facing the same direction as the
curve of the guide.
•
If the dipstick gets caught while inserting it, do not
force it in. Reconfirm the direction of the dipstick.
3. REMOVE OIL PRESSURE SWITCH, AND INSTALL
OIL PRESSURE GAUGE
4. WARM UP ENGINE
Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating
temperature.
5. CHECK OIL PRESSURE
Oil pressure:
At idle
29 kPa (0.3 kgf/cm, 4.3 psi) or more
At 3,000 rpm
245 – 490 kPa (2.5 – 5.0 kg f/cm, 36 – 71 psi)
EG1–273
5S–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
6. REMOVE OIL PRESSURE GAUGE AND REINSTALL
OIL PRESSURE SWITCH
(a) Remove the oil pressure gauge.
(b) Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the oil pressure
switch.
Adhesive:
Part No.08833 – 00080, THREE BOND 1344,
LOCTITE 242 or equivalent
(c) Reinstall the oil pressure switch.
7. START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR LEAKS
EG1–274
5S–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
OIL AND FILTER REPLACEMENT
CAUTION:
•
Prolonged and repeated contact with mineral oil will
result in the removal of natural fats from the skin,
leading to dryness, irritation and dermatitis. In addi–
tion, used engine oil contains potentially harmful
contaminants which may cause skin cancer.
•
Care should be taken, therefore, when changing
engine, oil to minimize the frequency and length of
time your skin is exposed to used engine oil. Protec–
tive clothing and gloves that cannot be penetrated
by oil should be worn. The skin should be thorought–
hly washed with soap and water, or use water–less
hand cleaner, to remove any used engine oil. Do not
use gasoline, thinners, or solvents.
•
In order to preserve the environment, used oil and
used oil filter must be disposed of only at designated
disposal sites.
1. DRAIN ENGINE OIL
(a) Remove the oil filler cap.
(b) Remove the oil drain plug, and drain the oil into a
container.
2. REPLACE OIL FILTER
(a) Using SST, remove the oil filter.
SST 09228–06500
(b) Check and clean the oil filter installation surface.
EG1–275
5S–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
(c) Apply clean engine oil to the gasket of a new oil filter.
(d) Lightly screw the oil filter into place, and tighten it
until the gasket contacts the seat.
(e) Using SST, tighten it an additional 3/4 turn.
SST 09228–06500
3. FILL WITH ENGINE OIL
(a) Clean and install the oil drain plug with a new gasket.
Torque: 39 N–m (400 kgf–cm, 29 ft–lbf)
(b) Fill with new engine oil.
Oil grade: (See step 1 on page EG1–272)
Capacity (M/T):
Drain and refill
w/ Oil filter change
3.6 liters (3.8 US qts, 3.2 Imp. qts)
w/o Oil filter change
3.4 liters (3.6 US qts, 3.0 Imp. qts)
Dry fill
4.2 liters (4.4 US qts, 3.7 Imp. qts)
Capacity (A/T):
Drain and refill
w/ Oil filter change
3.6 liters (3.8 US qts, 3.2 Imp. qts)
w/o Oil filter change
3.4 liters (3.6 US qts, 3.0 Imp. qts)
Dry fill
4.3 liters (4.5 US qts, 3.8 Imp. qts)
(c) Reinstall the oil filler cap.
4. START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR LEAKS
5. RECHECK ENGINE OIL LEVEL
(See page EG1–272)
EG1–276
5S–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
OIL PUMP
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
OIL PUMP REMOVAL
HINT: When repairing the oil pump, the oil pan and
strainer should be removed and cleaned.
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the “LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. REMOVE HOOD
3. DRAIN ENGINE OIL (See page EG1–274)
EG1–277
5S–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
4. REMOVE FRONT EXHAUST PIPE
(a) Loosen the 2 bolts, and disconnect the bracket.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and nuts holding the front exhaust
pipe to the center exhaust pipe.
(c) Using a 14 mm deep socket wrench, remove the 3
nuts holding the front exhaust pipe to the WU–TWC.
(d) Remove the front exhaust pipe and gaskets.
5. REMOVE STIFFENER PLATE
Remove the 3 bolts and stiffener plate.
6. REMOVE OIL PAN
(a) Remove the dipstick.
(b) Remove the 17 bolts and 2 nuts.
(c) Insert the blade of SST between the cylinder block
and oil pan, and cut off applied sealer and remove the
oil pan.
SST 09032 – 00100
NOTICE:
•
Do not use SST for the oil pump body side and rear
oil seal retainer.
•
Be careful not to damage the oil pan flange.
7. REMOVE OIL STRAINER
Remove the bolt, nuts, oil strainer and gasket.
EG1–278
5S–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
8. SUSPEND ENGINE WITH ENGINE SLING DEVICE
9. REMOVE TIMING BELT (See page EG1–26)
10. REMOVE NO.2 IDLER PULLEY
Remove the bolt and pulley.
11. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
If the pulley cannot be removed by hand, use 2 screw–
drivers.
HINT: Position shop rags as shown to prevent
damage.
12. REMOVE OIL PUMP PULLEY
Using SST, remove the nut and pulley.
SST 09616 – 30011
13. REMOVE OIL PUMP
(a) Remove the 12 bolts.
EG1–279
5S–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
(b) Using a plastic–faced hammer, remove the oil pump
by carefully tapping the oil pump body.
(c) Remove the gasket.
COMPONENTS FOR DISASSEMBLY AND
ASSEMBLY
OIL PUMP DISASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE RELIEF VALVE
(a) Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring.
(b) Remove the retainer, spring and relief valve.
EG1–280
5S–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
2. REMOVE DRIVE AND DRIVEN ROTORS
Remove the 2 bolts, pump body cover, O–ring, the
drive and driven rotors.
OIL PUMP INSPECTION
1. INSPECT RELIEF VALVE
Coat the valve with engine oil and check that it falls
smoothly into the valve hole by its own weight.
If it doesn’t, replace the relief valve. If necessary,
replace the oil pump assembly.
2. INSPECT DRIVE AND DRIVEN ROTORS
A. Inspect rotor body clearance
Using a thickness gauge, measure the clearance be–
tween the driven rotor and body.
Standard body clearance:
0.10 – 0.16 mm (0.0039 – 0.0063 in.)
Maximum body clearance:
0.20 mm (0.0079 in.)
If the body clearance is greater than maximum, re–
place the rotors as a set. If necessary, replace the oil
pump assembly.
B. Inspect rotor tip clearance
Using a thickness gauge, measure the clearance be–
tween the drive and driven rotor tips.
Standard tip clearance:
0.04 – 0.16 mm (0.0016 – 0.0063 in.)
Maximum tip clearance:
0.20 mm (0.0079 in.)
If the tip clearance is greater than maximum, replace
the rotors as a set.
EG1–281
5S–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
OIL PUMP OIL SEAL REPLACEMENT
1. REMOVE OIL SEAL
Using a screwdriver, pry out the oil seal.
2. INSTALL OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new oil seal until its
surface is flush with the oil pump cover edge.
SST 09620–30010 (09627–30010, 09631–00020)
(b) Apply MP grease to the oil seal lip.
CRANKSHAFT FRONT OIL SEAL
REPLACEMENT
HINT: There are 2 methods (A and B) to replace the oil
seal which are as follows:
REPLACE CRANKSHAFT FRONT OIL SEAL
A. If oil pump is removed from cylinder block:
(a) Using screwdriver and hammer, tap out the oil seal.
(b) Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new oil seal until its
surface is flush with the oil pump case edge.
SST 09226 –10010
(c) Apply MP grease to the oil seal lip.
EG1–282
5S–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
B. If oil pump is installed to the cylinder block:
(a) Using a knife, cut off the oil seal lip.
(b) Using a screwdriver, pry out the oil seal.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the crankshaft. Tape
the screwdriver tip.
(c) Apply MP grease to a new oil seal lip.
(d) Using SST and a hammer, tap in the oil seal until its
surface is flush with the oil pump case edge.
SST 09226 –10010
OIL PUMP ASSEMBLY
(See Components for Disassembly and Assembly)
1. INSTALL DRIVE AND DRIVEN ROTORS
(a) Place the drive and driven rotors into pump body with
the marks facing the pump body cover side.
(b) Install the pump body cover with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 8.8 N–m (90 kgf–cm. 78 in.–lbf)
2. INSTALL RELIEF VALVE
(a) Insert the relief valve, spring and retainer into the
pump body hole.
(b) Using snap ring pliers, install the snap ring.
EG1–283
5S–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
OIL PUMP INSTALLATION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. INSTALL OIL PUMP
Install a new gasket and the oil pump with the 12
bolts.
Torque: 9.3 N–m (95 kgf–cm, 82 in.–lbf)
HINT: Long bolts are indicated in the illustration.
Bolt length:
Long bolt
35 mm (1.38 in.)
Others
25 mm (0.98 in.)
2. INSTALL OIL PUMP PULLEY
(a) Align the cutouts of the pulley and shaft, and slide on
the pulley.
(b) Using SST, install the nut.
SST 09616–30011
Torque: 28 N–m (290 kgf–cm, 21 ft–lbf)
3. INSTALL CRANKSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
(a) Align the timing pulley set key with the key groove of
the pulley.
(b) Slide on the timing pulley, facing the flange side
inward.
EG1–284
5S–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
4. INSTALL NO.2 IDLER PULLEY
(a) Install the pulley with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N–m (425 kgf–cm, 31 ft–lbf)
HINT: Use a bolt 35 mm (1.38 in.) in length.
(b) Check that the idler pulley moves smoothly.
5. INSTALL TIMING BELT (See page EG1–33)
6. REMOVE ENGINE SLING DEVICE
7. INSTALL OIL STRAINER
Install a new gasket and the oil strainer with bolt and
nuts.
Torque: 5.4 N–m (55 kgf–cm, 48 in.–lbf)
8. INSTALL OIL PAN
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be care–
ful not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces of the
oil pan and cylinder block.
•
Using a razor blade and gasket scraper, remove
all the old packing (FIPG) material from the
gasket surfaces and sealing groove.
•
Thoroughly clean all components to remove all
the loose material.
•
Using a non–residue solvent, clean both sealing
surfaces.
NOTICE: Do not use a solvent which will affect the paint–
ed surfaces.
(b) Apply seal packing to the oil pan as shown in the
illustration.
Seal packing:
Part No.08826 – 00080 or equivalent
•
Install a nozzle that has been cut to a 3–5 mm
(0.12–0.20 in.) opening.
•
Parts must be assembled within 5 minutes of
application. Otherwise the material must be re–
moved and reapplied.
•
Immediately remove nozzle from the tube and
reinstall cap.
EG1–285
5S–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
(c) Install the oil pan with 17 bolts and 4 nuts.
Torque: 5.4 N–m (55 kgf–cm, 48 in.–lbf)
(d) Install the dipstick.
9. INSTALL STIFFENER PLATE
Install the stiffener plate with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 37 N–m (380 kgf–cm, 27 ft–Ibf)
10. INSTALL FRONT EXHAUST PIPE
(a) Place 2 new gaskets on the front and rear of the front
exhaust pipe.
(b) Temporarily install the 2 bolts and 2 new nuts holding
front exhaust pipe to the center exhaust pipe.
(c) Using a 14 mm deep socket wrench, install the 3 new
nuts holding the front exhaust pipe to the WU–TWC.
Torque: 62 N–m (630 kgf–cm, 46 ft–lbf)
(d) Tighten the 2 bolts and 2 nuts holding front exhaust
pipe to the center exhaust pipe.
Torque: 56 N–m (570 kgf–cm, 41 ft–lbf)
(e) Install the bracket with the 2 bolts.
11. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE TO
BATTERY
12. FILL WITH ENGINE OIL (See page EG1–275)
13. START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR LEAKS
14. RECHECK ENGINE OIL LEVEL
15. INSTALL HOOD
EG1–286
5S–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
OIL COOLER
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
OIL COOLER REMOVAL
1. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
2. REMOVE OIL FILTER
Using SST, remove the oil filter.
SST 09228–06500
3. DISCONNECT WATER BYPASS HOSES FROM OIL
COOLER
Disconnect the 2 water bypass hoses.
EG1–287
5S–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
4. REMOVE OIL COOLER
(a) Remove the relief valve and plate washer.
(b) Remove the nut and oil cooler.
(c) Remove the O–ring and gasket from the oil cooler.
OIL COOLER INSPECTION
1. INSPECT RELIEF VALVE
Push the valve with a wooden stick to check if it is
stuck.
If stuck, replace the relief valve.
2. INSPECT OIL COOLER
Check the oil cooler for damage or clogging.
If necessary, replace the oil cooler.
OIL COOLER INSTALLATION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. INSTALL OIL COOLER
(a) Install new O–ring and gasket to the oil cooler.
(b) Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and
under the head of the relief valve.
(c) Temporarily install the oil cooler with the nut.
(d) Install the plate washer and relief valve.
Torque: 78 N–m (800 kgf–cm, 58 ft–lbf)
(e) Tighten the nut.
Torque: 7.8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 In.–lbf)
EG1–288
5S–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
2. CONNECT WATER BYPASS HOSES
Connect the 2 water bypass hoses.
3. INSTALL OIL FILTER
(a) Clean the oil filter contact surface on the filter
mounting.
(b) Lubricate the filter rubber gasket with engine oil.
(c) Tighten the oil filter by hand until the rubber gasket
contacts the seat of the filler mounting. Then using
SST, give it an additional 3/4 turn to seat the oil filter.
SST 09228–06500
4. FILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
(See page EG1–241)
5. START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR LEAKS
6. CHECK ENGINE OIL LEVEL
EG1–289
5S–FE ENGINE
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE DATA
Oil pressure
Oil pump
Body clearance
Tip clearance
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part tightened
Oil pan x Drain plug
Oil pump body cover x Oil pump body
Oil pump x Cylinder block
Oil pump pulley x Oil pump drive shaft
No.2 idler pulley x Cylinder block
Oil strainer x Cylinder block
Oil strainer x Oil pump
Oil pan x Cylinder block
Oil pan x Oil pump
Stiffener plate x Cylinder block
Stiffener plate x Transaxle case
Front exhaust pipe x WU–TWC
Front exhaust pipe x Center exhaust pipe
Oil cooler x Cylinder block (Relief valve)
Oil cooler x Cylinder block (Nut)
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
5S-FE ENGINE –
-Memo
EG1–291
5S–FE ENGINE
–
5S–FE ENGINE TROUBLESHOOTING
EG1–292
5S–FE ENGINE
–
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
The Engine Control System broadly consists of the sensors, Engine Control Module (ECM) and actuators.
The ECM receives signals from various sensors, judges the operating conditions and determines the
optimum injection duration, timing, ignition timing and idle speed.
In general, the Engine Control System is considered to be a very intricate system to troubleshoot. But, the
fact is that if you proceed to inspect the circuit one by one following the procedures directed in this manual, troubleshooting of this system is not complex.
This section explains the most ideal method of troubleshooting and tells how to carry out the necessary
repairs.
1. CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
Using the customer problem analysis check sheet for reference, ask the customer in as much details
as possible about the problem.
2. CHECK AND CLEAR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE (PRECHECK)
Before confirming the problem symptom, first check the diagnostic trouble code and make a note of
any malfunction code which is output, then clear the code.
HINT: Output of the malfunction code indicates that there is a malfunction in the circuit indicated.
However, it does not indicate whether the malfunction is still occurring or occurred in the past and
returned to normal. In order to determine this, the problem sym toms should be confirmed in step 4
first and the diagnostic trouble code be rechecked in step [6].
Accordingly, if troubleshooting is begun based on the malfunction code only in diagnostic trouble
code check in step [2], it could result in a misdiagnosis, leading to troubleshooting of circuits which
are normal and making it more difficult to locate the cause of the problem.
3. SETTING THE TEST MODE DIAGNOSIS, [4] PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION,
[5] SYMPTOM SIMULATION
In order to find out the trouble more quickly, set the diagnosis check in test mode and with higher
sensing ability of the ECM, confirm the problem symptoms. If the trouble does not reappear, use the
symptom simulation method to make sure the trouble is reproduced.
6. DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK IN TEST MODE
Check the diagnostic trouble code in test mode. If the malfunction code is output, proceed to step. If the
normal code is output, proceed to step [7].
7. BASIC INSPECTION
Carry out basic inspection such as the spark check and fuel pressure check, etc.
8. DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If the malfunction code is displayed, proceed to inspect the circuit indicated by the chart for each
code.
9. MATRIX CHART OF PROBLEM SYMPTOMS
If the normal code is displayed in the diagnosis in test mode, perform troubleshooting according to
the inspection order in the Matrix Chart of Problem Symptoms.
10. PARTS INSPECTION
When the Matrix Chart of Problem Symptoms instructs to check the parts, proceed to parts inspection
section included in this manual.
11. CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Determine if the malfunction is the sensor, actuator, wire harness, connector or the ECM.
EG1–293
5S–FE ENGINE
–
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
CHECK FOR MOMENTARY INTERRUPTION
By performing the check for momentary interruption, the place where momentary interruptions or
momentary shorts are occurring due to poor contacts can be isolated.
ADJUSTMENT, REPAIR
After the cause of the problem is located, perform adjustment or repairs by following the inspection
and replacement procedures in this manual.
CONFIRMATION TEST
After completing adjustment or repairs, confirm not only that the malfunction is eliminated, but also
conduct a test drive, etc., to make sure the entire Engine Control System is operating normally.
EG1–294
5S–FE ENGINE
–
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
Titles inside
are titles of pages
in this manual, with the page number
indicated in the bottom portion.
See the indicated pages for detailed
explanations
Vehicle Brought to Workshop
Customer Problem Analysis
P. EG1–295
Check and clear Diagnostic Trouble Code (Precheck.)
P. EG1–297, 299
Setting the Test Mode Diagnosis
P. EG1–298
Problem Symptom Confirmation
Malfunction does not occur.
Malfunction
occurs:
Symptom Simulation
P. IN–24
Diagnostic Trouble Code Check
P. EG1–298
Malfunction code
Normal code
Basic Inspection
Diagnostic Trouble Code Chart
P. EG1–300
p.
EG1–310
Matrix Chart of Problem Symptoms
P. EG1–327
Circuit Inspection
P. EG1–336
Check for Momentary Interruption
Parts Inspection
P. EG1–309
Identification of Problem
Adjustment, Repair
Confirmation Test
End
Step
: Diagnostic steps per–
mitting the use of the
TOYOTA hand–held
tester or TOYOTA
break–out–box.
EG1–295
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK SHEET
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK SHEET
EG1–296
5S–FE ENGINE
–
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
DESCRIPTION
The ECM contains a built–in self–diagnosis system by which
troubles with the engine signal network are detected and a
Malfunction indicator lamp on the instrument panel lights up.
By analyzing various signals as shown in the later table (See
page EG1–300) the Engine Control Module (ECM) detects
system malfunctions relating to the sensors or actuators.
In the normal mode, the self–diagnosis system monitors 14
items, indicated by code No. as shown in EG1–300. A malfunction indicator lamp informs the driver that a malfunction
has been detected. The light goes off automatically when the
malfunction has been repaired. But the diagnostic trouble
code(s) remains stored in the ECM memory (except for code
Nos. 16). The ECM stores the code(s) until it is cleared by
removing the EFI fuse with the ignition switch off.
The diagnostic trouble code can be read by the number of
blinks of the malfunction indicator lamp when TE1 and E1
terminals on the data link connector 1 or 2 are connected.
When 2 or more codes are indicated, the lowest number
(code) will appear first.
In the test mode, 9 items, indicated by code No. as shown in
EG1–300 are monitored. If a malfunction is detected in any
one of the systems indicated by code Nos. 13, 22, 24, 25, 26,
27, 31, 41 and 71 the ECM lights the malfunction indicator
lamp to warn the technician that malfunction has been detected. In this case, TE2 and E1 terminals on the data link
connector 1 or 2 should be connected as shown later. (See
page EG1–298).
In the test mode, even if the malfunction is corrected, the
malfunction code is stored in the ECM memory even when
the ignition switch is off (except code Nos. 43 and 51). This
also applies in the normal mode. The diagnostic mode (normal or test) and the output of the malfunction indicator lamp
can be selected by connecting the TE1, TE2 and E1 terminals on the data link connector 1 or 2, as shown later.
A test mode function has been added to the functions of the
self–diagnostic system of the normal mode for the purpose of
detecting malfunctions such as poor contact, which are difficult to detect in the normal mode. This function fills up the
self–diagnosis system. The test mode can be implemented
by the technician following the appropriate procedures of
check terminal connection and operation described later.
(See page
EG1–298)
EG1–297
5S–FE ENGINE
–
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
Diagnosis Inspection (Normal Mode)
MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP CHECK
1. The Malfunction indicator lamp will come on when the
ignition switch is turned ON and the engine is not run–
ning.
HINT: If the malfunction indicator lamp does not light
up, proceed to troubleshooting of the combination meter
(See page BE–64).
2. When the engine is started, the malfunction indicator
lamp should go off.
If the light remains on, the diagnosis system has detected
a malfunction or abnormality in the system.
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK
1. Turn ignition switch on.
2. Using SST, connect terminals between TE1 and E1 of
data link connector 1 or 2.
SST 09843–18020
3. Read the diagnostic trouble code from malfunction indi–
cator lamp.
HINT: If a diagnostic trouble code is not output, check
the TE1 terminal circuit (See page EG1–430).
As an example, the blinking patterns for codes;normal,
12 and 31 are as shown on the illustration.
4. Check the details of the malfunction using the diagnostic
trouble code table on page EG1–300.
5. After completing the check, disconnect terminals TE1
and E1, and turn off the display.
HINT: I n the event of 2 or more malfunction codes,
indication will begin from the smaller numbered code
and continue in order to the larger.
EG1–298
5S–FE ENGINE
–
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
Diagnosis Inspection (Test Mode)
Compared to the normal mode, the test mode has high sens–
ing ability to detect malfunctions.
It can also detect malfunctions in the starter signal circuit, the
IDL contact signal of the throttle position sensor, air condi–
tioning signal and Park/Neutral Position switch signal.
Furthermore, the same diagnostic items which are detected in
the normal mode can also be detected in the test mode.
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK
1. Initial conditions.
(a) Battery voltage 11 V or more.
(b) Throttle valve fully closed.
(c) Transmission in neutral position.
(d) Air conditioning switched off.
2. Turn ignition switch off.
3. Using SST, connect terminals TE2 and E1 of data link
connector 1 or 2.
SST 09843–18020
4. Turn ignition switch on.
HINT:
•
To confirm that the test mode is operating, check that
the malfunction indicator lamp flashes when the igni–
tion switch is turned to ON.
•
If the malfunction indicator lamp does not flash, pro–
ceed to troubleshooting of the TE2 terminal circuit on
page EG1–430.
5. Start the engine.
6. Simulate the conditions of the malfunction described by
the customer.
7. After the road test, using SST, connect terminals TE1 and
E1 of data link connector 1 or 2.
SST 09843–18020
8. Read the diagnostic trouble code on malfunction indica–
tor lamp on the combination meter (See page EG1–297).
9. After completing the check, disconnect terminals TE1,
TE2 and E1, and turn off the display.
HINT:
• The test mode will not start if terminals TE2 and E1 are
connected after the ignition switch is turned on.
• When vehicle speed is 3 mph (5 km/h) or below,
diagnostic trouble code “42” (Vehicle speed signal) is
output, but this is not abnormal.
• When the engine is not cranked, diagnostic trouble
code “43” (Starter signal) output, but this is not ab–
normal.
• When the automatic transmission shift lever is in the
“D”, “2”, “L” or “R” shift position, or when the air
conditioning is on or when the accelerator pedal is
depressed, code “51” (Switch condition signal) is
output, but this is not abnormal.
EG1–299
5S–FE ENGINE
–
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK
USING TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER
1. Hook up the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC2.
2. Read the diagnostic trouble codes by following the
prompts on the tester screen.
Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester operator’s
manual for further details.
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CLEARANCE
1. After repair of the trouble areas, the diagnostic trouble
code retained in the ECM memory must be cleared out by
removing the E F I fuse (15A) from J/13 No. 2 for 10 seconds or
more, with the ignition switch OFF.
HINT:
• Cancellation can also be done by removing the battery
negative (–) terminal, but in this case, other memory
systems (clock, etc.) will also be cancelled out.
• If it is necessary to work on engine components requir–
ing removal of the battery terminal, a check must first
be made to see if a diagnostic trouble code has been
recorded.
2. After cancellation, road test the vehicle to check that a
normal code is now read on the malfunction indicator
lamp.
If the same diagnostic trouble code appears, it indicates
that the trouble area has not been repaired thoroughly.
ECM DATA MONITOR USING TOYOTA
HAND–HELD TESTER
1. Hook up the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the D LC2.
2. Monitor the ECM data by following the prompts on the
tester screen.
HINT: TOYOTA hand–held tester has a “Snapshot”
function which records the monitored data.
Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester operator’s
manual for further details.
ECM TERMINAL VALUES MEASUREMENT
USING TOYOTA BREAK–OUT–BOX AND
TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER
1. Hook up the TOYOTA break–out–box and TOYOTA
hand–held tester to the vehicle.
2. Read the ECM input/output values by following the
prompts on the tester screen.
HINT: TOYOTA hand–held tester has “Snapshot” func–
tion. This records the measured values and is effective in
the diagnosis of intermittent problems.
Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester/Toyota
break–out–box operator’s manual for further details.
EG1–300
5S–FE ENGINE
–
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
HINT: Parameters listed in the chart may not be exactly same as your reading due to type of the instruments or other factors.
DTC
No.
Number of
MIL Blinks
Circuit
Diagnostic Trouble Code
Detecting Condition
Normal
No code is recorded.
G, NE Signal
Circuit (No. 1)
(Exc. California
spec.)
No NE signal to ECM within 2 sec. or more after cranking.
G, N E Signal
Circuit (No. 1)
(Only for
California spec,)
No G signal to ECM for 3 sec. or more with engine speed between
600 rpm and 4,000 rpm.
No N E or G 1 and G2 signal to ECM for 2 sec. or more after
cranking.
Open in G (–) circuit
No NE signal to ECM for 0.3 sec. or more at 1,500 rpm or more.
G, NE Signal
Circuit (No. 2)
No G signal to ECM while NE signal is input 4 times to ECM when
engine speed is between 500 rpm and 4,000 rpm.
* No N E signal to ECM for 0.1 sec. or more at 1,000 rpm or more.
* NE signal does not pulse 12 times to ECM during the interval
between G1 and G2 pulses.
Ignition Signal
Circuit
No IGF signal to ECM for 4 consecutive IGT signals.
* No IGF signal to ECM for 8 consecutive IGT signals.
A/T Control
Signal
*,* : See page EG1–306
Fault in communications between the engine CPU and A/T CPU
in the ECM
EG1–301
5S–FE ENGINE
–
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a malfunction code is displayed during the diagnostic trouble code check in test mode, check the circuit
for that code listed in the table below (Proceed to the page given for that circuit).
Trouble Area
Malfunction
Indicator
Lamp*
Normal
Mode
Memory*
See page
Test
Mode
EG1–336
• Open or short in NE, G circuit
• Distributor
• Open or short in STA circuit
9 ECM
N.A.
EG1–339
N.A.
N.A.
• Open or short in NE circuit
• Distributor
• ECM
E G –343
N.A.
N.A.
• Open or short in IGF or IGT circuit from igniter to ECM
• Igniter
• ECM
N.A.
EG1–344
• ECM
N.A.
EG1–351
*,*: See page EG1–306
EG1–302
5S–FE ENGINE
DTC
No.
Number of
MIL Blinks
Circuit
Main Oxygen
Sensor Signal
–
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
Diagnostic Trouble Code
Detecting Condition
Main oxygen sensor signal voltage is reduced to between 0.35 V
and 0.70 V for 60 sec. under conditions (a) ∼ (d).
(2 trip detection logic) *5
(a) Engine coolant temp.: 80C (176F) or more.
(b) Engine speed: 1,500 rpm or more.
(c) Load driving (Ex. A/T in overdrive (5th for M/T),
A/C ON, Flat road, 50 mph (80 km/h)).
(d)Main oxygen sensor signal voltage: Alternating above and
below 0.45 V.
Engine Coolant
Temp. Sensor
Signal
Open or short in engine coolant temp. sensor circuit for 0.5 sec.
or more.
Intake Air Temp.
Sensor Signal
Open or short in intake air temp. sensor circuit for 0.5 sec. or more.
(1) Main oxygen sensor voltage is 0.45 V or less (lean) for 90
sec. under conditions (a) and (b).
(2 trip detection logic)*
(a) Engine coolant temp.: 60C (140F) or more.
(b) Engine speed: 1,500 rpm or more.
Air–Fuel Ratio
Lean Malfunction
(2) Engine speed varies by more than 15 rpm over the preceding
crankshaft position period during a period of 50 sec. or more under
conditions (a) and (b).
(2 trip detection logic)*
(a) Engine speed: Idling
(b) Engine coolant temp.: 60C (140F) or more.
*: See page EG1–307
EG1–303
5S–FE ENGINE
–
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
Malfunction
Indicator
Lamp*
Trouble Area
Normal
Mode
•
•
Main oxygen sensor circuit
Main oxygen sensor
Memory‘
See page
Test
Mode
EG1–352
•
•
•
Open or short in engine coolant temp. sensor circuit
Engine coolant temp. sensor
ECM
EG1–356
•
•
•
Open or short in intake air temp. sensor circuit
Intake air temp. sensor
ECM
EG1–360
•
•
•
•
Open or short in main oxygen sensor circuit
Main oxygen sensor
ignition system
ECM
•
•
•
Open or short in injector circuit
Fuel line pressure (injector leak, blockage)
Mechanical system malfunction (skipping teeth of timing
belt)
Ignition system
Compression pressure (foreign object caught in valve)
Air leakage
ECM
•
•
•
•
EG1–363
*,*: See page EG1–306
EG1–304
5S–FE ENGINE
DTC
No.
Number of
MIL Blinks
Circuit
Air–Fuel Ratio
Rich Malfunction
–
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
Diagnostic Trouble Code
Detecting Condition
Engine speed varies by more than 15 rpm over the preceding
crankshaft position period during a period of 50 sec. or more
under conditions (a) and (b),
(2 trip detection logic)*
(a) Engine speed: Idling
(b) Engine coolant temp.:60C (140F) or more.
Sub Oxygen
Sensor Signal
Main oxygen sensor signal is 0.45 V or more and sub oxygen
sensor signal is 0.45 V or less under conditions
(a) and
(b).
(2 trip detection logic)*
(a) Engine coolant temp.: 80C (176F) or more.
(b) Accel. pedal: Fully depressed for 2 sec. or more.
Manifold Absolute
Pressure Sensor
Signal
Open or short in manifold absolute pressure sensor circuit
for 0.5 sec. or more.
Throttle Position
Sensor Signal
Open or short in throttle position sensor circuit for 0.5 sec. or more.
No–1 Vehicle
Speed Sensor
Signal
(for A/T)
All conditions below are detected continuously for 8 sec. or more.
(a) No.1 vehicle speed sensor signal: 0 mph (km/h)
(b) Engine speed: 3,100 rpm or more.
(c) Park/Neutral position switch: OFF
All conditions below are detected continuously for 8 sec. or more.
No.1 Vehicle
Speed Sensor
Signal
(for M /T)
*: See page EG1–307
(a) No.1 vehicle speed sensor signal: 0 mph (km/h)
(b) Engine speed: Between 3,100 rpm and 5,000 rpm.
(e) Engine coolant temp.: 80C (176F) or more.
(d) Load driving.
EG1–305
5S–FE ENGINE
–
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
Malfunction
Indicator
Lamp*
Trouble Area
Normal
Mode
•
•
•
Memory*
See page
Test
Mode
•
•
•
•
Open or short in injector circuit
Fuel line pressure (injector leak, blockage)
Mechanical system malfunction (skipping teeth of timing
belt)
Ignition system
Compression pressure (foreign object caught in valve)
Air leakage
ECM
•
•
•
Open or short in sub oxygen sensor circuit
Sub oxygen sensor
ECM
EG1–369
•
•
•
Open or short in manifold absolute pressure sensor circuit.
Manifold absolute pressure sensor
ECM
EG1–372
•
•
•
Open or short in throttle position sensor circuit
Throttle position sensor
ECM
•
•
•
•
Open or short in No.1 vehicle speed sensor circuit
No.1 vehicle speed sensor
Combination meter
ECM
*,*: See page EG1–306
EG1–363
EG1–376
OFF
OFF
EG1–380
EG1–306
5S–FE ENGINE
DTC
No.
Number of
MIL Blinks
–
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
Diagnostic trouble Code
Detecting Condition
Circuit
Starter Signal
No starter signal to ECM.
Knock Sensor
Signal
Open or short in knock sensor circuit with engine speed
between 1,200 rpm and 6,000 rpm.
EG R System
Malfunction
EGR gas temp. is 70C (158F) or below for 50 sec. under
conditions (a) and (b).
(2 trip detection logic)*
(a) Engine coolant temp.: 80C (176F) or more.
(b) EGR operation possible (Ex. A/T in 3rd speed (5th for
M/T), 55 – 60 mph (88 – 96 km/h), Flat road).
(1)
Switch Condition
Signal
3 sec. or more after engine starts with closed throttle position
switch OFF (IDL).
(2) * Park/Neutral switch OFF (PNP).
(Shift position in “R”, “D”, “2”, or “L” positions).
(3) A/C switch ON.
*1; “ON” displayed in the diagnosis mode column indicates that the Malfunction Indicator Lamp is lighted up when a
malfunction is detected. “OFF” indicates that the “CHECK” does not light up during malfunction diagnosis, even if a
malfunction is detected. “N.A.” indicates that the item is not included in malfunction diagnosis.
*2; “O” in the memory column indicates that a diagnostic trouble code is recorded in the ECM memory when a malfunction
occurs. “X” indicates that a diagnostic trouble code is not recorded in the ECM memory even if a malfunction occurs.
Accordingly, output of diagnostic results in normal or test mode is performed with the IG switch ON.
*3; Only for California specification vehicles.
*4; Only vehicles with A/T.
EG1–307
5S–FE ENGINE
Trouble Area
•
•
Open or short in starter signal circuit
Open or short in ignition switch or starter relay circuit ECM
•
•
•
Open or short in knock sensor circuit
Knock sensor (looseness).
ECM
•
•
•
•
•
open in EGR gas temp. sensor circuit
Short in VSV circuit for EGR
EGR hose disconnected, valve stuck
Clogged EGR gas passage
ECM
•
•
•
•
•
Throttle position sensor IDL circuit
Accelerator pedal and cable
Park/Neutral Position switch circuit
A/C switch circuit
ECM
–
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
Malfunction
Indicator
Lamp*
Memory*
See page
Normal
Mode
Test
Mode
N.A.
OFF
EG1–383
N.A.
EG1–385
EG1–390
N.A.
OFF
EG1–396
*5: This indicates items for which “2 trip detection logic” is used. With this logic, when a logic malfunction is first detected, the
malfunction is temporarily stored in the ECM memory. If the same case is detected again during the second drive test, this
second detection causes the Malfunction Indicator Lamp to light up.
The 2 trip repeats the same mode a 2nd time. (However, the IG switch must be turned OFF between the 1st trip and 2nd
trip),
In the Test Mode, the Malfunction Indicator Lamp lights up the 1st trip a malfunction is detected.
EG1–308
5S–FE ENGINE
–
FAIL–SAFE CHART
FAIL–SAFE CHART
If any of the following codes is recorded, the ECM enters fail–safe mode.
Fail–Safe Operation
DTC No.
Fail–Safe Deactivation Conditions
Fuel cut
1 IGF detected in consecutive 2 (4*) ignitions.
Torque control prohibited.
Returned to normal condition.
THW is fixed at 80C (176F).
Returned to normal condition.
THA is fixed at 20C (68F).
Returned to normal condition.
•
•
•
Ignition timing fixed at 5 BTDC.
Injection time fixed
Starting ..... 12.1 m sec.
I D L 0 N ..... 3.3 m sec.
IDL OFF .... 6.1 m sec.
Intake manifold vacuum is fixed at 46.7 kPa.
(350 mmHg, 13.8 inHg)
Returned to normal condition.
VTA1 is fixed at 0.
The following must each be repeated at least 2 time
consecutively.
• 0.1 V VTA 0.95 V
• IDL : ON
Max. timing retardation.
IG switch OFF.
*: Only for California specification vehicles.
Back–Up Function
If there is trouble with the program in the ECM and the ignition signals (IGT) are not output from
microcomputer the ECM controls fuel injection and ignition timing at predetermined levels as a back–up
function to make it possible to continue to operate the vehicle.
Furthermore, the injection duration is calculated from the starting signal (STA) and the throttle position
signal (IDL). Also, the ignition timing is fixed at the initial ignition timing, 5 BTDC, without relation to
the engine speed.
HINT: If the engine is controlled by the back–up function, the malfunction indicator lamp lights up to
warn the driver of the malfunction but the diagnostic trouble code is not output.
EG1–309
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CHECK FOR MOMENTARY INTERRUPTION
CHECK FOR MOMENTARY
INTERRUPTION
DTC
Circuit
G, NE signal circuit (No.2)
Engine coolant temp. sensor
circuit
Intake air temp. sensor circuit
Manifold absolute pressure
sensor circuit
As described in the preceding paragraph, abnormality detec–
tion ability in the test mode is increased compared to that in
the normal mode, so that when momentary interruptions or
momentary shorts occur in the ECM signal circuits (G, NE,
THW, THA, PIM, VTA) shown in the table below, the appro–
priate diagnostic trouble code is output.
Accordingly, when the diagnostic trouble codes shown in the
table below (13, 22, 24, 31, 41) are output during the diag–
nostic trouble code check, and inspection of the appropriate
circuits reveals no abnormality, perform the check for momen–
tary interruption as described below.
By performing the check for momentary interruption, the
place where momentary interruptions or momentary shorts are
occurring due to poor contacts can be isolated.
Throttle position sensor circuit
CLEAR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES
See page EG1–299.
SET TEST MODE
1. With the ignition switch off, using SST, connect the ter–
minals TE2 and E1 of the data link connector 1 and 2.
SST 09843–18020
2. Start the engine and check to see the malfunction indica–
tor lamp to go off.
PERFORM A SIMULATION TEST
Using the symptom simulation (See page IN –24), apply vibra–
tion to and pull lightly on the wire harness, connector or
terminals in the circuit indicated by the malfunction code.
In this test, if the malfunction indicator lamp light up, it indi–
cates that the place where the wire harness, connector or
terminals being pulled or vibrated has faulty contact. Check
that point for loose connections, dirt on the terminals, poor fit
or other problems and repair as necessary.
HINT: After cancelling out the diagnostic trouble code in
memory and set the test mode, if the malfunction indicator
lamp does not go off after the engine is started, check thor–
oughly for faulty contact, etc., then try the check again. If the
malfunction indicator lamp still does not go off, check and
replace ECM.
EG1–310
5S–FE ENGINE
–
BASIC INSPECTION
BASIC INSPECTION
When the normal code is displayed in the diagnostic trouble code check, troubleshooting should be
performed in the order for all possible circuits to be considered as the causes of the problems.
In many cases, by carrying out the basic engine check shown in the following flow chart, the location
causing the problem can be found quickly and efficiently. Therefore, use of this check is essential in engine troubleshooting.
Is battery positive voltage 11 V or more when engine is stopped?
YES
Charge or replace battery.
Is engine cranked ?
YES
Proceed to matrix chart of problem
symptoms on page EG1–327.
Does engine start
YES
Go to step
Check air filter.
Remove air filter.
Visually check that the air filter is not excessively
damaged or oily.
If necessary, clean the air filter with compressed
air. First blow from inside thoroughly, then blow
off outside of the air filter.
Repair or replace.
Go to step
EG1–311
5S–FE ENGINE
–
BASIC INSPECTION
Check idle speed.
(1) Shift transmission into “N” position or neutral.
(2) Warm up engine at normal operating temperature.
(3) Switched off all accessories.
(4) Switched off air conditioning.
(5) Connect tachometer test probe to terminal
IG (–) of data link connector 1, and set the
tachometer to the 4–cylinder range.
Check idle speed.
Idle speed: 700 ~ 800 rpm
• NEVER allow tachometer test probe to touch
ground as it could result in damage to igniter
and/or ignition coil.
• As some tachometers are not compatible
with this ignition system, we recommended
that you confirm compatibility of your unit
before use.
Proceed to matrix chart of problem
symptoms on page EG1–327.
Check ignition timing.
(1) Shift transmission into “N” position or neutral.
(2) Warm up engine at normal operating temperature.
(3) Keep the engine speed at idle.
(4) Using SST, connect terminals TE1 and E1 of
data link connector 1.
SST 09843–18020
(5) Using a timing light, connect the tester to
No. 1 high–tension cord.
Check ignition timing.
Ignition timing: 10 BTDC at idle
Proceed to page IG–19, 38* and continue
to troubleshoot.
*Except California specification vehicles.
Proceed to matrix chart of problem symptoms
on page EG1–327.
EG1–312
5S–FE ENGINE
–
BASIC INSPECTION
Check fuel pressure.
(1) Be sure that fuel is enough in tank.
(2) Turn ignition switch on.
(3) Using SST, connect terminals FP and + B of
data link connector 1.
SST 09843–18020
Check for fuel pressure in the return hose when it
is pinched off.
At this time, you will hear fuel return noise.
Never make a mistake with the terminal con–
nection position as this will cause a malfunc–
tion.
Proceed to page EG1–178 and continue
to troubleshoot.
Check for spark.
Disconnect the high–tension cord from the distributor and, hold the end about 12.5 mm (1/2”)
from the ground, see if spark occurs while the engine is being cranked.
To prevent excessive fuel injected from the injectors during this test, don’t crank the engine for
more than 1–2 seconds at a time.
Proceed to page IG–6, 26* and continue
to troubleshoot.
* : Except California specification vehicles.
Proceed to matrix chart of problem symptoms
on page EG1–327.
EG1–313
5S–FE ENGINE
PARTS LOCATION
–
PARTS LOCATION
EG1–314
5S–FE ENGINE
–
WIRING DIAGRAM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Except California specification vehicles.
EG1–315
5S–FE ENGINE
–
WIRING DIAGRAM
EG1–316
5S–FE ENGINE
–
WIRING DIAGRAM
WIRING DIAGRAM (Cont’d)
Only for California specification vehicles.
EG1–317
5S–FE ENGINE
–
WIRING DIAGRAM
EG1–318
5S–FE ENGINE
–
TERMINALS OF ECM
TERMINALS OF ECM
When measuring the voltage or resistance of the connector part of the ECM, always insert the test probe
into the connector from the wire harness side.
ECM (Except California specification vehicles with M/T)
Terminal
No.
Symbol
E11– 1
ISCV
Connection
Terminal
No.
Connection
Symbol
VSV for A/C Idle up
Starter relay
Injectors (No.1 and No.3)
Igniter
Power ground
Distributor
Distributor
Distributor
Distributor
IAC valve
IAC valve
EG1–319
5S–FE ENGINE
Terminal
No.
Symbol
Connection
–
TERMINALS OF ECM
Terminal
No. Symbol
Connection
Throttle position sensor
Igniter
EG R gas temp. sensor
VSV for EG R
ECM ground
Data link connector 1 and 2
Injectors (No.2 and No.4)
Sensor ground
Power ground
EFI main relay
Sub oxygen sensor
Battery
Manifold absolute pressure sensor
A/C amplifier
Intake air temp. sensor
Circuit opening relay
Engine coolant temp. sensor
Knock sensor
A/C amplifier
Main oxygen sensor
EFI main relay
Data link connector 1 and 2
Malfunction indicator lamp
Data link connector 1
Sensor ground
Throttle position sensor
• Manifold absolute pressure sensor
• Throttle position sensor
No.1 vehicle speed sensor
• Defogger relay
• Taillight relay
EG1–320
5S–FE ENGINE
–
TERMINALS OF ECM
TERMINAL OF ECM (Cont’d)
ECM (California specification vehicles and except California specification vehicles with A/T)
Terminal
Symbol
No.*
Connection
Terminal
No.*
Connection
Symbol
A/T SL solenoid
Distributor
A/T No.1 solenoid
Distributor
Igniter
Distributor
Igniter
Distributor
VSV for A/C Idle up
VSV for EG R
VSV for fuel pressure control
No.4 injector
IAC valve
No.3 injector
IAC valve
Power ground
No.2 injector
•
•
No.2 and No.4 injectors
No.1 injector
Manifold absolute pressure sensor
Throttle position sensor
Manifold absolute pressure sensor
No.1 and No.3 injectors
Power ground
Intake air temp. sensor
ECM ground
Engine coolant temp. sensor
A/T No,2 solenoid
Sub oxygen sensor
Main oxygen sensor
*: Only for California specification vehicles.
*: Except California specification vehicles with A/T.
EG1–321
5S–FE ENGINE
Terminal
Symbol
No.
Connection
Data link connector 2
–
TERMINALS OF ECM
Terminal Symbol
No.
Connection
O/D main switch
Data link connector 1
Sensor ground
No.1 vehicle speed sensor
EGR gas temp. sensor
A/C amplifier
Throttle position sensor
Starter relay
Throttle position sensor
EFI main relay
Knock sensor
EFI main relay
Data link connector 1 and 2
Circuit opening relay
Data link connector 1 and 2
Sensor ground
Battery
•
•
Defogger relay
Taillight relay
Park/neutral position switch
Park/neutral position switch
•
•
Stoplight switch
Stoplight
Cruise control ECU
Malfunction indicator lamp
A/C amplifier
•
Park/neutral position switch
Park/neutral position switch
*: Only for California specification vehicles.
*: Except California specification vehicles with A/T.
EG1–322
5S–FE ENGINE
–
STANDARD VALUE OF ECM TERMINALS
STANDARD VALUE OF EC TERMINALS
ECM (Except California specification vehicles with M/T)
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
STD Voltage (V)
Condition
Always
IG switch ON
IG switch ON
IG switch ON and apply vacuum to the
throttle opener. Throttle valve fully closed.
IG switch ON
Throttle valve fully open
IG switch 0 N
Throttle valve fully closed
IG switch ON
Throttle valve fully open
IG switch ON
Idling
Idling, Intake air temp. 20C (68F)
Idling, Engine coolant temp, 80C (176F)
IG switch ON
Pulse generation
Idling
Pulse generation
Idling
(See page EG1–347)
Below 2.0
IG switch ON
Pulse generation
(See page EG1–347) Idling
Pulse generation
Idling
(See page EG1–336)
Pulse generation
Idling
(See page EG1–336)
EG1–323
5S–FE ENGINE
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
–
STANDARD VALUE OF ECM TERMINALS
STD Voltage (V)
Condition
IG switch ON
Maintain engine speed at 2,500 rpm for
2 minutes after warming up then return to
idling
Maintain engine speed at 2,500 rpm for
Pulse generation
(See page EG1–355) 2 minutes after warming up
lG switch ON
Pulse generation
Idling
(See page EG1–389)
Pulse generation
IG switch ON
(See page EG1–380) Rotate driving wheel slowly
IG switch ON
IG switch ON
Idling
IG switch ON
A/C switch ON (at idling)
A/C switch OFF
Idling, A/C switch ON
Idling, A/C switch OFF
EG1–324
5S–FE ENGINE
–
STANDARD VALUE OF ECM TERMINALS
STANDARD VALUE OF ECM TERMINALS (Cont’d)
ECM (California specification vehicles and except California specification vehicles with A/T)
Symbols (Terminals No.)*3
Wiring Color
STD Voltage (V)
Condition
Always
IG switch ON
lG switch ON
IG switch ON and apply vacuum to the
throttle opener. Throttle valve fully closed.
IG switch ON
Throttle valve fully open
IG switch ON
Throttle valve fully closed
IG switch ON
Throttle valve fully open
IG switch ON
Idling
Idling, Intake air temp. 20C (68F)
Idling, Engine coolant temp. 80C (176F)
IG switch ON
Pulse generation
(See page EG1–410) Idling
Pulse generation
(See page EG1–347) Idling
Below 2.0
IG switch ON
Pulse generation
(See page EG1–347)Idling
Pulse generation
Idling
(See page EG1–341)
Pulse generation
Idling
(See page EG1–341)
Pulse generation
Idling
(See page EG1–336)
Pulse generation
(See page EG1–336) Idling
*: Only for California specification vehicles.
*: Except California specification vehicles with A/T.
EG1–325
5S–FE ENGINE
Symbols (Terminals No.)*
Wiring Color
–
STANDARD VALUE OF ECM TERMINALS
STD Voltage (V)
Condition
IG switch ON
Maintain engine speed at 2,500 rpm for
2 minutes after warming up then return
to idling
Pulse generation
Maintain engine speed at 2,500 rpm for
(See page EG1–355) 2 minutes after warming up
IG switch ON
Pulse generation
(See page EG1–389) Idling
IG switch ON
Other shift position in “P”, “N” position
IG switch ON
Shift position in “P”, “N” position
IG switch ON
Pulse generation
(See page EG1–380) Rotate driving wheel slowly
IG switch ON
IG switch O N
Idling
IG switch ON
IG switch ON
IG switch ON
O/D main switch pushed in
IG switch ON
0/D main switch pushed out
A/C switch ON (At idling)
A/C switch OFF
Idling, A/C switch ON
Idling, A/C switch OFF
IG switch ON
Restarting at high engine coolant temp.
*: Only for California specification vehicles.
*:
EG1–326
5S–FE ENGINE
–
REFERENCE VALUE OF ECM DATA
REFERENCE VALUE OF ECM DATA
HINT: ECM data can be monitored by TOYOTA hand–held
tester.
1. Hook up the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC2.
2. Monitor ECM data by following the prompts on the tester
screen.
Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester operator’s
manual for further details.
REFERENCE VALUE
Item
Inspection condition
Reference value
INJECTOR
Engine cold to hot
Engine idling at normal operating temp.
IGNITION
Increase engine speed
Gradually increases
IAC DUTY
Engine idling at normal operating temp.
30∼60%
Gradually decreases
Approx. 2 ∼ 5 msecs
RPM kept stable (Comparison with tachometer)
No great changes
MAP
Engine idling at normal operating temp.
increase engine load
Approx. 180 ∼ 280 mm Hg
Gradually increases
ECT
Engine at normal operating temp.
75 – 95C (185 – 203F) *1
Closed throttle position
Wide open throttle
From closed throttle position to wide open throttle
Below 5
Above 70
Gradually increases
VEHICLE SPD
During driving (Comparison with speedometer)
No large differences
TARGET A/F L
Engine idling at normal operating temp.
2.50± 1.25 V *2
ENGINE SPEED
THROTTLE
A/F FB LEFT
RPM stable at 2,500 rpm with normal operating temp.
STA SIGNAL
During cranking
CTP SIGNAL
Closed throttle position
A/C SIGNAL
A/C switch ON
PNP SIGNAL *3
OxL
When shifting from “P” or “N” position into a position
other than “P” or “N”
PRM stable at 2,500 rpm with normal operating temp.
G EAR
RICH LEAN is repeated
*1: If the engine coolant temp, sensor circuit is open or shorted, the ECM assumes an engine coolant temp, value of 80C (176F).
*2: When feedback control is forbidden, 0 V is displayed,
*3: A/T only.
EG1–327
5S–FE ENGINE
–
MATRIX CHART OF PROBLEM SYMPTOMS
MATRIX CHART OF PROBLEM SYMPTOMS
Does not
start
Engine does not crank
No initial combustion
No complete combustion
Difficult to
start
Under normal condition
Cold engine
Hot engine
Incorrect first idle
Poor Idling
High engine idle speed
Low engine idle speed
Rough idling
Poor
Driveability
Hunting
Hesitation/Poor acceleration
Muffler explosion (after fire)
Surging
Soon after starting
Engine Stall
After acceleration pedal depressed
After acceleration pedal released
During A/C operation
When N to D shift
*: Except California specification vehicles.
IG–6,26*
IG–8,28*
lG–10,30*
IG–11,30
EG1–23
AX1–68
IN–36
Spark plug
Ignition coil
Distributor
Compression
A/T faulty
Engine control module
EG1–419
Fuel system circuit
ST–19,21
EG1–415
IAC valve circuit
Starter and Starter relay
EG1–410
Ignition signal circuit (Spark test)
EG1–408
Back up power source circuit
Injector circuit
EG1 –424
EG1–403
ECM power source circuit
EG1–428
EG1–400
Park/Neutral position switch circuit
A/C cut control circuit
EG1–396
Switch condition signal circuit
VSV circuit for fuel pressure control
EG1–390
EG R system
Symptom
EG1–383
Suspect area
Starter signal circuit
See page
Manifold absolute pressure sensor circuit EG1–372
When the malfunction code is not confirmed in the diagnostic trouble code check and the problem still can
not be confirmed in the basic inspection, then proceed to this step and perform troubleshooting according
to the numbered order given in the table below.
EG1–328
5S–FE ENGINE
–
LOCATION OF CONNECTORS
LOCATION OF CONNECTORS
Location of Connectors in Engine Compartment
EG1–329
5S–FE ENGINE
–
LOCATION OF CONNECTORS
EG1–330
5S–FE ENGINE
–
LOCATION OF CONNECTORS
Location of Connectors in Instrument Panel
EG1–331
5S–FE ENGINE
!/B No.1
–
LOCATION OF CONNECTORS
EG1–332
5S–FE ENGINE
–
LOCATION OF CONNECTORS
Location of Connectors in Instrument Panel (Cont’d)
J/B No.1
J/B No.3
R/B No.1
R/B No.6
EG1–333
5S–FE ENGINE
–
Location of Connectors in Body
Sedan
Coupe
LOCATION OF CONNECTORS
EG1–334
5S–FE ENGINE
–
LOCATION OF CONNECTORS
Location of Connectors in Body (Cont’d)
Wagon
5S-FE ENGINE –
-Memo
EG1–336
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC 12 G NE Signal Circuit (No.1) (Exc. California spec.)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The distributor in the Engine Control System contains 3 pickup coils.
The G signals inform the ECM of the standard crankshaft position.
The NE signals inform the ECM of the crankshaft position and the engine speed.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
No N E signal to ECM with 2 sec. or more after
cranking.
No G signal to ECM for 3 sec. or more with
engine speed between 600 rpm and 4,000 rpm.
Reference
•
•
•
•
Open or short in NE, G circuit
Distributor
Open or short in STA circuit
ECM
INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
• During cranking or idling, check waveforms
between terminals G (+) and G (–),
NE (+) and NE (–) of engine control module.
HINT: The correct waveforms appear as shown
in the illustration on the left.
EG1–337
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check resistance of each pickup coils in
distributor.
Replace distributor housing.
Check for open and short in harness and
connector between ECM and distributor.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check air gap.
Replace distributor housing.
Check and replace ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
EG1–338
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check resistance of each pickup coils in distributor.
Disconnect distributor connector.
Measure resistance between each terminal
shown in table below.
Resistance
G Pickup Coil
(G1 –G (–))
Cold
185 ~ 275
Hot
240 ~ 325
NE Pickup Coil
(NE (+) – NE (–) )
Cold
370 ~ 550
Hot
475 ~ 650
“Cold” is from –10C (14F) to 50C (122F) and
“Hot” is from 50C (122F) to 100C (212F).
Replace distributor housing.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between
engine control module and distributor (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check air gap.
Remove distributor cap and rotor.
Using a thickness gauge, measure the air gap be–
tween the signal rotor and pickup coil projection.
Air gap: 0.2 – 0.4 mm (0.008 – 0.006 in.)
Replace distributor housing.
Check and replace engine control module.
EG1–339
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC 12 G NE Signal Circuit (No.1) (Only for California spec.)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The distributor in the Engine Control System contains 3 pick–up coils (G1, G2 and NE).
The G1, G2 signals inform the ECM of the standard crankshaft angle.
The NE signals inform the ECM of the crankshaft angle and the engine speed.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
No NE or G1 and G2 signal to ECM for
2 sec. or more after cranking.
Open in G (–) circuit.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Open or short in NE, G circuit.
Distributor
Open or short in STA circuit.
ECM
EG1–340
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check resistance of each pickup coils in
distributor.
Replace distributor.
Check for open and short in harness and
connector between ECM and distributor.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check air gap.
Replace distributor.
Check and replace ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
EG1–341
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check resistance of each pickup coils in distributor.
Disconnect distributor connector.
Measure resistance between each terminal
shown in table below.
Resistance
“Cold” is from –10C (14 F) to 50C (122F) and “Hot” is
from 50C (122F) to 100C (212F).
Reference
INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
•
During cranking or idling, check waveforms be–
tween terminals G1, G2, NE and G O of engine
control module.
HINT: The correct waveforms appear as shown in the
illustration on the left.
Replace distributor.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between
engine control module and distributor (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
EG1–342
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check air gap.
Remove distributor cap & rotor.
Using SST (G1 and G2 pickups) and a thickness
gauge (NE pickup), measure the air gap between
the signal rotor and pickup coil projection.
SST 09240–00020 for G1 and G2 pickups
Air gap: 0.2–0.5 mm (0.008–0.020 in.)
Replace distributor housing assembly.
Check and replace engine control module.
EG1–343
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC 13 G NE Signal Circuit (No.2)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to G, NE signal circuit (No. 1) on page EG1–336, 339.
DTC No.
Trouble Area
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
No NE signal to ECM for 0.3 sec. or more at
1,500 rpm or more.
No G signal to ECM while N E signal is input 4
times to ECM when engine speed is between
500 rpm and 4,000 rpm.
* No NE signal to ECM for 0.1 sec. or more at
1,000 rpm or more.
•
•
•
Open or short in NE circuit
Distributor
ECM
* NE signal does not pulse 12 times to ECM
during the interval between G1 and G2 pulses.
*: Only for California specification vehicles.
DIAGNOSIS
This code indicates that a momentary interruption of the G, N E signal from the distributor to the
ECM has occurred, but that it is returned to normal. Note that although this problem may not necessarily appear at the time of inspection, it cannot be ignored because this diagnostic trouble code
is output, indicating that there is or was a malfunction in the G, NE signal circuit; this “malfunction”
is usually a loose connector.
The distributor connector and the N E terminal of the ECM connector must therefore be checked
for the following:
1. Loose connectors
2. Dirty connector terminals
3. Loose connector terminals
EG1–344
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC 14 Ignition Signal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ECM determines the ignition timing, turns on Tr, at a predetermined angle (’*CA) before the
desired ignition timing and outputs an ignition signal (IGT) “1” to the igniter.
Since the width of the IGT signal is constant, the dwell angle control circuit in the igniter determines
the time the control circuit starts primary current flow to the ignition coil based on the engine rpm and
ignition timing one revolution ago, that is, the time the Tr2 turns on.
When it reaches the ignition timing, the ECM turns Tr, off and outputs the IGT signal “O”.
This turns Tr2 off, interrupting the primary current flow and generating a high voltage in the secondary
coil which causes the spark plug to spark. Also, by the counter electromotive force generated when
the primary current is interrupted, the igniter sends an ignition confirmation signal (IGF) to the ECM.
The ECM stops fuel injection as a fail safe function when the lG F signal is not input to the ECM.
DTC No.
Trouble Area
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
• Open or short in IG F or IGT circuit from
No IGF signal to ECM for 4 (8*2) consecutive
IGT signals.
WIRING DIAGRAM
igniter to ECM.
• Igniter
• ECM
EG1–345
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check for spark.
Check for open and short in IGF signal circuit
between igniter and ECM.
Repair or replace harness or
connector.
Check voltage of terminal I G F.
Replace igniter.
Check and replace ECM.
Check voltage of terminal IGT.
Check voltage of igniter power source.
Check and repair igniter power
source circuit.
Check for open and short in primary coil
circuit.
Repair or replace harness or
connector.
Check ignition coil.
Replace ignition coil.
Replace igniter.
Check voltage of terminal IGT (Disconnect
igniter connector).
Replace igniter.
Check for open and short in IGT signal circuit
between igniter and ECM.
Repair or replace harness or
connector.
Check and replace ECM.
EG1–346
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check for spark.
Disconnect the high–tension cord from the distributor, hold its end about 12.5 mm (11 /2”)
from the ground, see if spark occurs while the engine is being cranked.
Spark should be generated.
To prevent excessive fuel injected from the injectors during this check, don’t crank the
engine for more than 1 – 2 seconds at a time.
Go to step
Check for open and short in harness and connector in IGF signal
circuit between engine control module and igniter (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Disconnect igniter connector and check voltage between terminal
IGF of engine control module connector and body ground.
(1) Disconnect igniter connector.
(2) Remove glove compartment.
(See page EG1–234).
(3) Turn ignition switch on.
Measure voltage between terminal IGF of engine
control module connector and body ground.
Voltage: 4.5 ∼ 5.5 V
Replace igniter.
Check and replace engine control module.
EG1–347
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check voltage between terminal IGT of engine control module
connector and body ground.
Remove glove compartment.
(See page EG1–234) .
Measure voltage between terminal IGT of engine
control module connector and body ground
when engine is cranked.
Voltage: 0.5 – 1.0 V
(Neither 0 V nor 5 V)
Reference
INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
• During cranking or idling, check waveform between
terminal IGT and E1 of engine control module.
HINT: The correct waveform appears as shown in the
illustration on the left, with rectangle waves.
Go to step
EG1–348
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check voltage between terminal 3 of igniter connector and body
ground.
Disconnect igniter connector.
Measure voltage between terminal 3 of igniter
connector and body ground, when ignition
switch is turned to “ON” and “STA” position.
Voltage: 9 ∼ 14 V
Check and repair igniter power source
circuit.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ignition
switch and ignition coil, ignition coil and igniter (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
EG1–349
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check ignition coil.
For California spec.
(1) Disconnect ignition coil connector.
(2) Disconnect high–tension cord from ignition
coil.
Exc. California spec.
(1) Disconnect distributor connectors.
(2) Remove distributor cap and rotor.
(3) Remove ignition coil dust cover.
(1) Check primary coil.
Measure resistance between the positive
(+) and negative (–) terminals.
(2) Check secondary coil.
Measure resistance between the positive
(+) and high–tension terminals.
Resistance
Primary
Coil
Cold
Secondary
Coil
Cold
Hot
Hot
“Cold” is from –10C (14F) to 50C (122F) and
“Hot” is from 50C (122F) to 100C (212F).
Replace ignition coil.
Replace igniter.
EG1–350
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Disconnect igniter connector and check voltage between terminal
IGT of engine control module connector and body ground.
Disconnect igniter connector.
Measure voltage between terminal IGT of engine
control module connector and body ground
when engine is cranked.
Voltage: 0.5–1.0 V
(Neither 0 V nor 5 V)
Replace igniter.
Check for open and short in harness and connector in IGT signal
circuit between engine control module and igniter (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace engine control module.
EG1–351
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC 16 A–T Control Signal Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The signal from the A/T CPU retards the ignition timing of the engine during A/T shifting, thus
momentarily reducing torque output of the engine for smooth clutch operation inside the transmission and reduced shift shock.
DTC No.
Trouble Area
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Fault in communications between the engine
CPU and A/T CPU in the ECM
• ECM
If the ECM detects the diagnostic trouble code “16” in memory, it prohibits the torque control of the
A/T which performs smooth gear shifting.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Are there any other codes (besides Code 16)
being output?
Replace ECM.
YES
Go to relevant diagnostic trouble code
chart.
EG1–352
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC 21 Main Oxygen Sensor Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
To obtain a high purification rate for the C0, HC and NOx components of the exhaust gas, a three–
way catalytic converter is used, but for most efficient use of the three–way catalytic converter, the
air–fuel ratio must be precisely controlled so that it is always close to the stoichiometric air–fuel ratio. The oxygen sensor has the characteristic whereby its output voltage changes suddenly in the
vicinity of the stoichiometric air–fuel ratio. This characteristic is used to detect the oxygen concentration in the exhaust gas and provide feedback to the computer for control of the air–fuel ratio.
When the air–fuel ratio becomes LEAN, the oxygen concentration in the exhaust increases and the
oxygen sensor informs the ECM of the LEAN condition (small electromotive force; 0 V).
When the air–fuel ratio is RICHER than the stoichiometric air–fuel ratio the oxygen concentration in
the exhaust gas is reduced and the oxygen sensor informs the ECM of the RICH condition (large
electromotive force: 1 V). The ECM judges by the electromotive force from the oxygen sensor
whether the air–fuel ratio is RICH or LEAN and controls the injection time accordingly. However, if
malfunction of the oxygen sensor causes output of abnormal electromotive force, the ECM is unable to perform accurate air–fuel ratio control.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Main oxygen sensor signal voltage is reduced to
between 0.35 V and 0.70 V for 60 sec. under
conditions (a) – (d).
(2 trip detection logic) *
(a) Engine coolant temp. : 80C (176F) or more.
(b) Engine speed : 1,500 rpm or more.
(c) Load driving (EX. A/T in overdrive (5th for
M/T), A/C ON, Flat road, 50 mph (80km/h)).
(d) Main oxygen sensor signal voltage :
Alternating above and below 0.45 V.
*See page EG1–307
Trouble Area
• Main oxygen sensor circuit.
• Main oxygen sensor.
EG1–353
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION (Cont’d)
DIAGNOSIS TROUBLE CODE DETECTION DRIVING PATTERN
Purpose of the driving pattern.
(a) To simulate diagnostic trouble code detecting condition after diagnostic trouble code is
recorded.
(b) To check that the malfunction is corrected when the repair is completed confirming that diagnostic trouble code is no longer detected.
Malfunction: Main Oxygen Sensor Deterioration
Disconnect the EFI fuse (15A) for 10 sec. or more, with IG switch OFF.
Initiate test mode (Connect terminal TE2 and E1 of data link connector 1 or 2 with IG switch
OFF).
Start the engine and warm up with all ACC switch OFF.
After the engine is warmed up, let it idle for 3 min.
After performing the idling in (3) , perform gradual acceleration with in the range
1,300∼1,700 rpm (centered around 1,500 rpm) with the A/C switch ON and D position for A/T
(5th for M /T).
(Take care that the engine speed does not fall below 1,200 rpm when shifting. Gradually
depress the accelerator pedal and keep it. Steady so that engine braking does not occur).
Maintain the vehicle speed at 40 – 50 mph (64 – 80 km/h).
Keep the vehicle running for 1 – 2 min. after starting acceleration.
HINT: If a malfunction exists, the malfunction indicator lamp will light up after approx.
60 sec. from the start of acceleration.
NOTICE: If the conditions in this test are not strictly followed, detection of the malfunction will not be possible.
EG1–354
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Are there any other codes (besides code 21)
being output ?
Replace main oxygen sensor.
WIRING DIAGRAM
YES
Go to relevant diagnostic trouble code
chart.
EG1–355
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Reference INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
• With the engine racing (4,000 rpm) measure wave–
form between terminals OX1 and E1 of engine con–
trol module.
HINT: The correct waveform appears as shown in the
illustration on the left, oscillating between approx. 0.1 V
and 0.9 V.
If the oxygen sensor is deteriorated, the amplitude of
the voltage is reduced as shown on the left.
EG1–356
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC 22 Engine coolant Temp. Sensor Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The engine coolant temperature sensor senses the
engine coolant temperature. A thermistor built in the
sensor changes its resistance value according to the
engine coolant temperature. The lower the engine
coolant temperature, the greater the thermistor resis–
tance value, and the higher the engine coolant tem–
perature, the lower the thermistor resistance value
(See Fig. 1.).
The engine coolant temperature sensor is connected
to the ECM (See next page). The 5 V power source
voltage in the ECM is applied to the engine coolant
temperature sensor from the terminal THW via a resistor R. That is, resistor R and the engine coolant tem–
perature sensor are connected in series. When the
resistance value of the engine coolant temperature
sensor changes in accordance with changes in the
engine coolant temperature, the potential at the ter–
minal THW also changes. Based on this signal, the
ECM increases the fuel injection volume to improve
driveability during cold engine operation. If the ECM
detects the diagnostic trouble code 22, it operates the
fail safe function in which the engine coolant temper–
ature is assumed to be 80C (176F).
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
( Reference )
Engine coolant Resistance
Temp. C (F)
(k)
Voltage
(V)
–20 (–4)
16.0
4.3
0 (32)
5.9
3.4
20 (68)
2.5
2.4
60 (140)
0.6
0.9
80 (176)
0.3
0.5
100 (212)
0.2
0.3
40 (104)
Trouble Area
• Open or short in engine coolant temp,
Open or short in engine coolant temp. sensor
circuit for 0.5 sec. or more.
sensor circuit
• Engine coolant temp. sensor
• ECM
EG1–357
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
HINT If diagnostic trouble codes “22” (engine coolant temperature sensor circuit), “24” (intake air temperature sensor circuit), “31” (manifold absolute pressure sensor circuit) and “41” (throttle position sensor circuit) are output simultaneously, E2
(sensor ground) may be open, OK Check for momentary interruption
Check voltage of sensor.
Check for momentary interruption
(See page EG1–309).
Check resistance of sensor.
Replace engine coolant temp. sensor.
Check for open and short in harness and connector
between ECM and engine coolant temp. sensor.
Repair or replace harness or
connector.
Check and replace ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
EG1–358
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT: If diagnostic trouble codes “22” (engine coolant temperature sensor circuit), “24” (intake air
temperature sensor circuit), “31” (manifold absolute pressure sensor circuit) and “41 “ (throttle
position sensor circuit) are output simultaneously, E2 (sensor ground) may be open,
Check voltage between terminals THW and E2 of engine control
module connector.
(1) Remove glove compartment
(See page EG1–234)
(2) Turn ignition switch on.
Measure voltage between terminals THW and E2 of engine
control module connector.
Engine Coolant Temp. C (F)
20 (68)
( Engine is cool )
80 (176)
(Engine is hot)
Voltage
0.5 ∼ 3.4 V
0.2 ∼1.0 v
Check for momentary interruption
(See page EG1–309)
EG1–359
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check engine coolant temp. sensor.
Disconnect the engine coolant temp. sensor con–
nector.
Measure resistance between terminals.
Resistance is within Acceptable Zone on chart.
Engine coolant Resistance
Temp. C (F)
20(68)
2 – 3 k
80(176)
0.2 – 0.4 k
Replace engine coolant temp. sensor.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between engine
control module and engine coolant temp. sensor (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace engine control module.
EG1–360
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC 24 Intake Air Temp. Sensor Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The intake air temp. sensor is built into the air cleaner cap and senses the intake air temperature. The structure of the sensor and connection to the ECM is the same as in the engine coolant
temp. sensor shown on page EG1–356.
If the ECM detects the diagnostic trouble code “24”, it operates the fail safe function in which the
intake air temperature is assumed to be 20C (68F)
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Open or short in intake air temp. sensor circuit
for 0.5 sec. or more.
Trouble Area
• Open or short in intake air temp. sensor circuit.
• Intake air temp. sensor
• ECM
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
HINT: If diagnostic trouble codes “22” (engine coolant temperature sensor circuit), “24” (intake air
temperature sensor circuit), “31” (manifold absolute pressure sensor circuit) and “41” (throt–
tle position sensor circuit) are output simultaneously, E2 (sensor ground) may be open.
Check voltage of sensor.
Check for momentary
interruption (See page EG1–309).
Check resistance of sensor.
Replace intake air temp. sensor.
Check for open and short in harness and
connector between ECM and intake air temp.
sensor.
Repair or replace harness or
connector.
Check and replace ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
EG1–361
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminals THA and E2 of engine control
module connector.
(1) Remove glove compartment.
(See page EG1–234)
(2) Turn ignition switch on.
Measure voltage between terminals THA and E2
of engine control module connector.
Intake air temp.
°C (°F)
Voltage
20 (68)
0.5 ∼ 3.4 V
60 (140)
0.2 ∼ 1.0 V
Check for momentary interruption
(See page EG1–309).
EG1–362
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check intake air temp. sensor.
Disconnect the air temp. sensor connector.
Measure resistance between terminals.
Resistance is within Acceptable Zone on chart.
Intake air temp.
Resistance
°C (° F)
2 –3k
20(68)
60 (140)
0.4 – 0.7 k
Replace intake air temp. sensor.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between
engine control module and intake air temp. sensor (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace engine control module.
EG1–363
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC 25 26 Air–Fuel Ratio Lean Rich Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The main oxygen sensor is located in the exhaust manifold.
It indirectly determines whether the fuel mixture is rich or lean by detecting the concentration of
oxygen present in the exhaust gas.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
(1) Main oxygen sensor voltage is 0.45 V or
less (lean) for 90 sec. under conditions (a)
and (b).
(2 trip detection logic) *
(a) Engine coolant temp.: 60C (140F) or more.
(b) Engine speed: 1,500 rpm or more.
(2) Engine speed varies by more than 15 rpm
over the preceding crank position period during
a period of 50 sec. or more under conditions
(a) and (b).
(2 trip detection logic) *
(a) Engine speed: Idling
(b) Engine coolant temp.: 60C (140F) or more.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Open or short in main oxygen sensor circuit
Main oxygen sensor
Ignition system
ECM
•
•
•
Open or short in injector circuit
Fuel line pressure (injector leak, blockage)
Mechanical system malfunction
(skipping teeth of timing belt)
Ignition system
Compression pressure
(foreign object caught in valve)
Air leakage
ECM
•
•
•
•
Engine speed varies by more than 15 rpm over
the preceding crank position period during a period
of 50 sec. or more under conditions (a) and (b).
(2 trip detection logic) *
(a) Engine speed: Idling
(b) Engine coolant temp.: 60C (140F) or more
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
*: See page EG1–307
Open or short in injector circuit
Fuel line pressure (injector leak, blockage)
Mechanical system malfunction
(skipping teeth of timing belt)
Ignition system
Compression pressure
(foreign object caught in valve)
Air leakage
ECM
EG1–364
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION (Cont’d)
DIAGNOSIS TROUBLE CODE DETECTION DRIVING PATTERN
Purpose of the driving pattern.
(a) To simulate diagnostic trouble code detecting condition after diagnostic trouble code is recorded.
(b) To check that the malfunction is corrected when the repair is completed confirming that diagnostic
trouble code is no longer detected.
Malfunction: Open or Short in Main Oxygen Sensor.
Open or Short in Injector Circuit, Injector Leak or Blockage.
H I NT: Before this test, check the feedback voltage for oxygen sensor.
Disconnect the EFI fuse (15 A) for 10 sec. or more, with IG switch OFF.
Initiate test mode (Connect terminal TE2 and E1 of data link connector 1 or 2 with
IG switch OFF).
Start engine and warm up.
After the engine is warmed up, let it race at 2,500 rpm for 3 min.
After performing the racing in (3) , perform idling 1 min.
HINT: If a malfunction exists, the malfunction indicator lamp will light up during step (4).
NOTICE: If the conditions in this test are not strictly followed, detection of the malfunction
will not be possible.
EG1–365
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
N G TypeΙΙ
Check voltage of terminal VF1.
NG Type I
Check voltage of terminal OX1.
Check for open and short in harness and
connector.
Repair or replace harness or
connector.
Check each item found to be a possible cause
of problem.
Repair or replace.
Check compression.
Repair or replace.
Does malfunction disappear when a good main
oxygen sensor is installed?
YES
Replace main oxygen sensor.
Check and replace ECM.
Check each item found to be a possible cause
of problem.
Repair or replace.
Check compression.
Repair or replace.
Does malfunction disappear when a good main
oxygen sensor is installed?
Check and replace ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to page EG1–354 for the WIRING DIAGRAM.
YES
Replace main oxygen sensor.
EG1–366
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminals VF1 and E1 of data link connector 1.
(1) Warm up engine at normal operating tem–
perature.
(2) Connect terminals TE1 and E1 of data link
connector 1.
(3) Connect positive prove to terminal VF1 and
negative prove to terminal E1 of data link
connector 1.
(1) Warm up the oxygen sensor by running en–
gine at 2,500 rpm for about 2 minutes.
(2) Then, maintaining engine at 2,500 rpm,
count how many times needle of voltmeter
fluctuates between 0 and 5 V.
Result
Needle fluctuates of 8 times or more
for every ten seconds
NG
Type Ι
NG
Type ΙΙ
Continue at 0 V
NG Type ΙΙ
Continue at 5 V
NG Type ΙΙ
Go to step
Check voltage between terminals OX1 and E1 of data link connector 1.
Warm up engine at normal operating temperature.
Measure voltage between terminals OX1 and E1
of data link connector 1 when engine is suddenly
raced to full throttle.
The voltage should be 0.5 V or higher at least
once.
Perform inspection within 1 second.
Go to step
EG1–367
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check for open and short in harness and connector between engine control module and
main oxygen sensor, engine control module and data link connector 1 (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check each item found to be a possible cause of problem.
Check each circuit found to be a possible cause of trouble according to the results of the check in
or
. The numbers in the table below show the order in which the checks should be performed.
Main oxygen sensor
signal continue at OV.
Possible Cause
See page
Faulty sensor installation.
Injector circuit
EG1–410
Misfire
IG–6, 26*
Valve timing
EG1–36
Air leakage
EG1–173
Fuel system
EG1–419
Characteristics deviation in
EG1–372
manifold absolute pressure sensor.
Characteristics deviation
in engine coolant temp. sensor.
EG1–356
Characteristics deviation
in intake air temp. sensor.
EG1–360
*: Except California specification vehicles.
Repair or replace.
Check compression (See page EG1–23).
Repair or replace.
Does malfunction disappear when a good main oxygen sensor is
installed?
YES
Check and replace engine control module.
Replace main oxygen sensor.
EG1–368
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check each item found to be a possible cause of problem.
Check each circuit found to be a possible cause of trouble according to the results of the check in
.The numbers in the table below show the order in which the checks should be performed.
Main oxygen sensor
signal continue at 5.0 V.
Main oxygen sensor
signal is normal.
Possible Cause
Injector circuit
See page
EG1–410
Misfire
IG–6, 26*
Valve timing
EG1–36
Air leakage
EG1–173
Fuel system
EG1–419
Characteristics deviation in
manifold absolute pressure sensor.
EG1–372
Characteristics deviation
EG1–356
in engine coolant temp. sensor.
Characteristics deviation
in intake air temp. sensor.
x: Except California specification vehicles.
Repair or replace.
Check compression (See page EG1–23).
Repair or replace.
Does malfunction disappear when a good main oxygen sensor is
installed?
YES
Check and replace engine control module.
Replace main oxygen sensor.
EG1–360
EG1–369
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC 27 Sub Oxygen Sensor Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The sub oxygen sensor is installed on the exhaust pipe. Its construction and operation is the same as
the main oxygen sensor on page EG1–352.
DTC No.
Trouble Area
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Main oxygen sensor signal is 0.45 V or more
and sub oxygen sensor signal is 0.45 V or less
under conditions (a) and (b).
(2 trip detection logic) *
(a) Engine coolant temp. : 80C (1 76F) or more.
(b) Accel. pedal : Fully depressed for 2 sec. or more.
* : See page EG1–307.
•
•
•
Open or short in sub oxygen sensor circuit.
Sub oxygen sensor
ECM
EG1–370
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION (Cont’d)
DIAGNOSIS TROUBLE CODE DETECTION DRIVING PATTERN
Purpose of the driving pattern.
(a) To simulate diagnostic trouble code detecting condition after diagnostic trouble code is
recorded.
(b) To check that the malfunction is corrected when the repair is completed confirming that diagnos–
tic trouble code is no longer detected.
Malfunction: Open or Short in Sub Oxygen Sensor
Disconnect the E F I fuse (15 A) for 10 sec. or more, with IG switch OFF.
Initiate test mode (Connect terminals TE2 and E1 of data link connector 1 or 2
with I G switch OFF).
Start the engine and warm up, with all ACC switch OFF.
After the engine is warmed up, let it drive at 50 ∼ 55 mph (80 ∼ 88 km/h)
for 10 min. or more.
After driving, stop at a safe place and perform idling for 2 min. or less.
After performing the idling in (4) , perform acceleration to 60 mph (96 km/h)
with the throttle valve fully open.
HINT: If a malfunction exists, the malfunction indicator lamp will light up during
step.
NOTICE: If the conditions in this test are not strictly followed, detection of the
malfunction will not be possible.
EG1–371
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Are there any other codes (beside Code 27)
being output?
Replace sub oxygen sensor.
WIRING DIAGRAM
YES
Go to relevant diagnostic trouble
code chart.
EG1–372
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC 31 Manifold Absolute Pressure Sensor Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
By a built–in sensor unit, the manifold absolute
pressure sensor detects the intake manifold absolute
pressure as a voltage.
The ECM then determines the basic injection dura–
tion and basic ignition advance angle based on this
voltage.
Since the manifold absolute pressure sensor does
not use the atmospheric pressure as a criterion, but
senses the absolute pressure inside the intake man–
ifold (the pressure in proportion to the preset abso–
lute vacuum O), it is not influenced by fluctuations
in the atmospheric, pressure due to high altitude
and other factors. This permits it to control the air–
fuel ratio at the proper level under all conditions.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
• Open or short in manifold absolute pressure
Open or short in manifold absolute pressure sensor
circuit for 0.5 sec. or more.
sensor circuit.
• Manifold absolute pressure sensor.
• ECM
If the ECM detect diagnostic trouble code “31 “, it operates the fail safe function, keeping the ignition
timing and fuel injection volume constant and making it possible to drive the vehicle.
EG1–373
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage of terminal VC.
Check and replace ECM.
Check voltage of terminal PIM.
When diagnostic trouble code 31 is
displayed, check and replace ECM.
Check for open and short in harness and
connector between manifold absolute pressure
sensor and ECM.
Repair or replace harness or
connector.
Check and replace manifold absolute pressure
sensor.
WIRINGDIA
DIAGRAM
RAM
EG1–374
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminals VC and E2 of engine control
module connector.
(1) Remove glove compartment.
(See page EG1–234).
(2) Turn ignition switch on.
Measure voltage between terminals VC and E2 of
engine control module connector.
Voltage: 4.5 ∼ 5.5 V
Check and replace engine control module.
EG1–375
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check voltage between terminals PIM and E2 of engine control
module connector.
Turn ignition switch on
Measure voltage between terminals PI M
and E2 of engine control module connector.
Voltage: 13 – 3.9 V
When diagnostic trouble code 31 is displayed, check and replace engine control
module.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between engine
control module and manifold absolute pressure sensor
(See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace manifold absolute pressure
sensor.
EG1–376
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC 41 Throttle Position Sensor Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The throttle position sensor is mounted in the throttle
body and detects the throttle valve opening angle. When
the throttle valve is fully closed, the I D L contacts in the
throttle position sensor are on, so the voltage at the ter–
minal I D L of the ECM become 0 V. At this time, a voltage
of approximately 0.7 V is applied to the terminal VTA of
the ECM. When the throttle valve is opened, the I D L
contacts go off and thus the power source voltage of
approximately 12 V in the ECM is applied to the terminal
IDL of the ECM. The voltage applied to the terminal VTA
of the ECM increases in proportion to the opening angle
of the throttle valve and becomes approximately 3.2 –
4.9 V when the throttle valve is fully opened. The ECM
judges the vehicle driving conditions from these signals
input from the terminals VTA and IDL, and uses them as
one of the conditions for deciding the air–fuel ratio cor–
rection, power increase correction and fuel–cut control etc.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Open or short in throttle position sensor circuit
for 0.5 sec. or more.
Trouble Area
• Open or short in throttle position sensor circuit.
• Throttle position sensor.
• ECM
HINT;
• When the connector for the throttle position sensor is disconnected, diagnostic trouble code 41
is not displayed. Diagnostic trouble code 41 is displayed only when there is an open or short in
the VTA signal circuit of the throttle position sensor.
EG1–377
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
HINT: If diagnostic trouble codes “22” (engine coolant temperature sensor circuit), “24” (intake air
temperature sensor circuit),“31” (manifold absolute pressure sensor circuit) and “41” (throttle posi–
tion sensor circuit) are output simultaneously, E2 (sensor ground) may be open.
Check voltage of throttle position sensor.
Check for momentary interruption
(See page EG1–309).
Check operation for throttle position sensor.
Adjust or replace throttle position
sensor.
Check for open and short in harness and
connector between throttle position sensor and
ECM.
Repair or replace harness or
connector.
Check and replace ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
EG1–378
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT: If diagnostic trouble code “22” (engine coolant temperature sensor circuit), “24” (intake air
temperature sensor circuit), “31” (manifold absolute pressure sensor circuit) and “41 “ (throttle
position sensor circuit) are output simultaneously, E2 (sensor ground) may be open.
Check voltage between terminals VTA, IDL and E2 of engine
control module connector.
(1) Remove glove compartment.
(See page EG1–234).
(2) Disconnect the vacuum hose from the throt–
tle body, then apply vacuum to the throttle
opener (See page EG1–204).
(3) Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminals VTA, IDL and
E2 of engine control module connector when the
throttle valve is opened gradually from the closed
condition.
Terminal
VTA – E2
IDL – E2
Throttle Valve
Fully Closed
Fully Open
The voltage should increase steadily in propor–
tion to the throttle valve opening angle.
Check for momentary interruption
(See page EG1–309).
EG1–379
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check throttle position sensor.
(1) Disconnect throttle position sensor connector.
(2) Disconnect the vacuum hose from the throt–
tle body, then apply vacuum to the throttle
opener (See page EG1–204).
Measure resistance between terminals 3 (VTA), 2
(IDL) and 1 (E2) of throttle position sensor con–
nector when the throttle valve is opened gradu–
ally from the closed condition.
Terminal
3 (VTA) – 1 (E2)
2 (IDL) – 1 (E2)
Throttle Valve
Fully Closed
Fully Open
Resistance between terminals 3 (VTA) and 1
(E2) should increase gradually in accordance
with the throttle valve opening angle.
Adjust or replace throttle position sensor
(See page EG1–209).
Check for open and short in harness and connector between engine
control module and throttle position sensor (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace engine control module.
EG1–380
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC 42 No.1 Vehicle Speed Sensor Signal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The No.1 vehicle speed sensor outputs a 4–pulse signal for every revolution of the rotor shaft,
which is rotated by the transmission output shaft via the driven gear. After this signal is converted
into a more precise rectangular waveform by the waveform shaping circuit inside the combination
meter, it is then transmitted to the ECM. The ECM determines the vehicle speed based on the frequency of these pulse signals.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
For A/T
All conditions below are detected continuously
for 8 sec. or more.
(a) No.1 Vehicle speed signal: 0 mph (km/h)
(b) Engine speed: 3,100 rpm or more
(c) Park/Neutral position switch: OFF
For M /T
All conditions below are detected continuously
for 8 sec. or more.
(a) No.1 vehicle speed signal: 0 mph (km/h)
(b) Engine speed: Between 3,100 rpm and
5,000 rpm
(c) Engine coolant temp.: 80C (176F) or more
(d) Load driving
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Open or short in No.1 vehicle speed sensor
circuit.
No.1 vehicle speed sensor.
Combination meter.
ECM
HINT: In test mode, diagnostic trouble code 42 is output when vehicle speed is 3 mph (5 km/h)
or below.
• Waveform between terminals SPD and E1 when vehicle
speed is approx. 12 mph (20 km/h).
HINT: The greater the vehicle speed, the greater the num–
ber of No.1 vehicle speed sensor signals produced.
EG1–381
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check operation of speedometer.
Check speedometer circuit.
(See page BE–66).
Check voltage of terminal SPD.
Check speedometer circuit.
(See page BE–66).
Check and replace ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
EG1–382
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check operation of speedometer.
Drive the vehicle and check if the operation of the speedometer in the combination meter is
normal.
The No. 1 vehicle speed sensor is operating normally if the speedometer display is normal.
Check speedometer circuit. See combination
meter troubleshooting on page BE–66.
Check voltage between terminal SPD of engine control module
connector and body ground.
(1) Remove glove compartment.
(See page EG1–234).
(2) Disconnect cruise control ECU connector.
(3) Shift the shift lever to N position or neutral.
(4) Jack up a front wheel on one side.
(5) Turn ignition switch on.
Measure voltage between terminal SPD of
engine control module connector and body
ground when the wheel is turned slowly.
Voltage is generated intermittently.
Check speedometer circuit. See combination
meter troubleshooting on page BE–66.
Check and replace engine control module.
EG1–383
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC 43 Starter Signal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the engine is cranked, the intake air flow is slow, so fuel vaporization is poor. A rich mixture
is therefore necessary in order to achieve good startability. While the engine is being cranked, the
battery positive voltage is applied to terminal STA of the ECM. The starter signal is mainly used to
increase the fuel injection volume for the starting injection control and after–start injection control.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
No starter signal to ECM.
Trouble Area
• Open or short in starter signal circuit.
• Open or short in ignition switch or starter
relay circuit.
• ECM
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
HINT: This diagnostic chart is based on the premise that the engine is cranked normally. If the
engine is not cranked, proceed to the matrix chart of problem symptoms on page EG1–327,
Check for the test mode.
Check for open in harness and connector
between ECM and relay.
Check and replace ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Proceed to next circuit inspection
shown on matrix chart (See page
E–G–327).
Repair or replace harness or
connector.
EG1–384
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check output condition of diagnostic trouble code 43.
Setting the test mode.
(1) Turn ignition switch OFF.
(2) Connect terminals TE2 and E1 of DLC2.
(3) Turn ignition switch ON.
(Don’t start the engine)
(4) Connect terminals TE1 and E1 of DLC2.
Check if code “43” is output by the malfunction indicator lamp.
Code “43” is output.
Start the engine.
Check if the code “43” disappear.
Code “43” is not output.
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
matrix chart (See page EG1–327).
Check for open in harness and connector between engine control
module and starter relay (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace engine control module.
EG1–385
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC 52 Knock Sensor Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Knock sensor is fitted the cylinder block to detect engine knocking. This sensor contains a piezoelectric element which generates a voltage when it becomes deformed, which occurs when the cylinder
block vibrates due to knocking. If engine knocking occurs, ignition timing is retarded to suppress it.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Open or short in knock sensor circuit with engine
speed between 1,200 rpm and 6,000 rpm.
Trouble Area
• Open or short in knock sensor circuit.
• Knock sensor (looseness)
• ECM
If the ECM detects the above diagnosis conditions, it operates the fail safe function in which the
corrective retard angle value is set to the maximum value.
DIAGNOSIS TROUBLE CODE DETECTION DRIVING PATTERN
Purpose of the driving pattern.
(a) To simulate diagnostic trouble code detecting condition after diagnostic trouble code is
recorded.
(b) To check that the malfunction is corrected when the repair is completed confirming that diagnostic trouble code is no longer detected.
Malfunction: Open or Short in Knock Sensor
Start engine and warm up.
After engine is warmed up, let it idle for 3 min.
With the A/C ON, perform quick racing (5,000 rpm) 3 times.
(Rapidly depress the accelerator pedal and suddenly release it.)
HINT: If a malfunction exists, the malfunction indicator lamp will light up when sudden
racing is performed.
NOTICE: If the conditions in this test are not strictly followed, detection of the malfunction will not be possible.
EG1–386
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check no continuity of knock sensor circuit.
Check knock sensor.
Replace knock sensor.
Check for open and short in harness and
connector between knock sensor and ECM.
Repair or replace harness or
connector.
Does malfunction disappear when a good knock
sensor is installed?
Check and replace ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
YES
Replace knock sensor.
EG1–387
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check continuity between terminal KNK of engine control module
connector and body ground.
(1) Remove glove compartment.
(See page EG1–234)
(2) Disconnect the engine control module con–
nector.
Measure resistance between terminal KNK
of engine control module connector and
body ground.
Resistance: 1 M or higher
Go to step
EG1–388
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check knock sensor.
Disconnect knock sensor connector.
Measure resistance between the knock
sensor terminal and body.
Resistance: 1 M or higher
Replace knock sensor (See page EG1–93).
Check for open and short in harness and connector between engine
control module and knock sensor (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Does malfunction disappear when a good knock sensor is installed?
YES
Check and replace engine control module.
Replace knock sensor (See page EG1–93).
EG1–389
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Reference INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
• With the engine racing (4,000 rpm) measure
waveform between terminal KN K of engine
control module and body ground.
HINT: The correct waveform appears as shown in the
illustration on the left.
• Spread the time on the horizontal axis, and
confirm that period of the wave is 132 sec.
(Normal mode vibration frequency of knock
sensor: 7.6 KHz).
HINT: If normal mode vibration frequency is not 7.6
KHz, the sensor is malfunctioning.
EG1–390
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC 71 EGR System Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The EGR system recirculates exhaust gas, which is controlled to the proper quantity to suit the
driving conditions, into the intake air mixture to slow down combustion, reduce the combustion
temperature and reduces NOx emissions. The amount of EGR is regulated by the EGR vacuum
modulator according to the engine load.
If even one of the following conditions is fulfilled,
the VSV is turned ON by a signal from the ECM.
This results in atmospheric air acting on the EGR
valve, closing the EGR valve and shutting off the
exhaust gas (EGR cut–OFF).
Under the following conditions, EGR is cut to
maintain driveability.
• Engine coolant temp. below 60C (140F).
• During deceleration (throttle valve closed).
• Light engine load (amount of intake air very
small).
• Engine speed over 4,400 rpm.
• Engine racing.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
EG R gas temp. is 70C (158F) or below for 50
sec. under conditions (a) and (b).
(2 trip detection logic) *
(a) Engine coolant temp.: 80C (176F) or more.
(b) EGR operation possible (EX. A/T in 3rd speed
(5th for M/T), 55 – 60 mph (88 – 96 km/h),
Flat road).
*: See page EG1–307 .
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
•
Open in EGR gas temp. sensor circuit.
Short in VSV circuit for EGR.
EGR hose disconnected, valve stuck.
Clogged EGR gas passage.
ECM
EG1–391
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION (Cont’d)
DIAGNOSIS TROUBLE CODE DETECTION DRIVING PATTERN
Purpose of the driving pattern.
(a) To simulate diagnostic trouble code detecting condition after diagnostic trouble code is
recorded.
(b) To check that the malfunction is corrected when the repair is completed confirming that diagnostic trouble code is no longer detected.
Malfunction: Open in EGR gas temp. sensor circuit
Disconnect the EFI fuse (15 A) for 10 sec. or more, with IG switch OFF. Initiate
test mode (Connect terminals TE2 and E1 of data link connector, 1 or 2 with IG
switch OFF).
Start the engine and warm up.
After the engine is warmed up, let it idle for 3 min.
With the A/C ON and transmission in 5th gear A/T in “D” position), drive at
55 – 60 mph (88 – 96 km/h) for 4 min. or less.
HINT: If a malfunction exists, the malfunction indicator lamp will light up during step (4) .
NOTICE: If the conditions in this test are not strictly observed, detection of
the malfunction will not be possible.
EG1–392
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage of VSV for EGR Power source.
Check resistance of VSV for EG R.
Replace VSV for EG R.
Check for open and short in harness and
connector between EFI main relay and ECM.
Repair or replace harness or
connector.
Check and replace ECM.
Check EGR system (See page EG1–153) .
Repair EGR system.
Check resistance of EGR gas temp. sensor.
Replace EGR gas temp. sensor.
Check for open in harness and connector
between EGR gas temp. sensor and ECM.
Repair or replace harness or
connector.
Check and replace ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
EG1–393
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminal EGR of engine control module
connector and body ground.
(1) Remove glove compartment.
(See page EG1–234).
(2) Warm up engine to normal operating temperature.
Measure voltage between terminal EGR of engine control module connector and body ground.
Voltage: 9 –14 V
Go to step
EG1–394
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check resistance between terminals of VSV for EGR.
Remove VSV for EGR. (See page EG1–154, 155*).
Measure resistance between terminals of VSV for
EG R.
Resistance: 33 – 39 (Cold)
*: Except California specification vehicle.
Replace VSV for EGR.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between EFI
main relay and VSV for EGR, VSV and engine control module. (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace engine control module.
Check EGR system (See page EG1–153).
Repair EGR system.
EG1–395
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check resistance of EGR gas temp, sensor.
Remove EGR gas temp. sensor.
Measure resistance between terminals of EG R
gas temp. sensor connector.
Resistance: 64 – 97 k at 50C (122F)
11 –16 k at 100C (212F)
2 – 4 k at 150C (302F)
Replace EGR gas temp. sensor.
Check for open in harness and connector between EGR gas temp.
sensor and engine control module (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace engine control module.
EG1–396
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC 51 Switch Condition Signal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Park/Neutral Position Switch Signal*
The ECM uses the signals from the park/neutral position switch to determine whether the transmis–
sion is in park or neutral, or in some other gear.
Air Conditioning Switch Signal
The ECM uses the output from the air conditioning switch to determine whether or not the air
conditioning is operating so that it can increase the idling speed of the engine if necessary.
Throttle Position Sensor IDL Signal
The IDL contacts are mounted in the throttle position sensor, and detects the idle condition.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
(1) 3 sec. or more after engine starts with closed
throttle position switch OFF (IDL).
(2) * Park/ Neutral position switch OFF.
(Shift position in “R”, “D”, “2” or “L” positions).
(3) A/C switch ON.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
•
Throttle position sensor IDL circuit
Accelerator pedal and cable
Park/Neutral position switch circuit
A/C switch circuit
ECM
*: Only vehicles with A/T.
HINT: In this circuit, diagnosis can only be made in the test mode.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
WIRING DIAGRAM
EG1–397
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
NG (PNP)
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
matrix chart (See page EG1–327).
Check resistance of throttle position sensor.
NG (A/C)
See page EG1–400.
NG (IDL)
Check for input signal.
Adjust or replace throttle position sensor
(See page EG1–209).
Check and repair harness or connector between
sensor and ECM.
Check input circuit of A/C.
Check and replace A/C amplifier.
Check for open and short in harness and
connector between A/C amplifier and ECM.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECM.
EG1–398
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check output condition of diagnostic trouble code 51.
Setting the test mode.
(1) Turn ignition switch OFF.
(2) Connect terminals TE2 and E1 of DLC2.
(3) Turn ignition switch ON.
(For checking terminal IDL, disconnect the
vacuum hose from the throttle body, then
apply vacuum to the throttle opener (See page
EG1–204).)
(For checking terminal A/C, start the engine.)
(4) Connect terminals TE1 and E1 of DLC2.
Check if code “51” is output by the malfunction indicator lamp.
Condition
Park/Neutral Position
Switch (PNP)
Throttle Position
Sensor ( IDL)
A/C Switch (A/C)
P or N position
R, D, 2 or L position
Code
Normal*
51*
Accelerator pedal
released
Normal*
Accelerator pedal
depressed
51*
A/C SW ON
A/C SW OFF
Normal
*: Before the STA signal is input (ST is not ON),
diagnostic trouble code 43 is also output.
Diagnostic trouble code 42 is output with vehicle
speed 3 mph (5 km/h) or below.
IDL .... Go to step
A/C ... Go to step
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
matrix chart (See page EG1–327).
PN P ... Go to page
EG1–400.
EG1–399
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check resistance of throttle position sensor.
(1) Disconnect throttle position sensor connec–
tor.
(2) Disconnect the vacuum hose from the throt–
tle body, then apply vacuum to the throttle
opener (See page EG1–204).
Measure resistance between terminals 2 (IDL)
and 1(E2) of throttle position sensor connector.
Resistance
Throttle Valve
Fully closed
Opened
Less than 2.3 k
1 M or higher
Adjust or replace throttle position sensor
(See page EG1–209).
Check and repair harness or connector between
engine control module and throttle position sensor.
Disconnect A/C amplifier connector, check voltage between
terminal AC2 of A/C amplifier connector and body ground.
(1) Remove glove compartment
(See page BO–114).
(2) Disconnect A/C amplifier connector.
(3) Turn ignition switch on.
Measure voltage between terminal AC2 of A/C
amplifier connector and body ground.
Voltage: 9 –14 V
Check and replace A/C amplifier.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between
engine control module and A/C amplifier (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace engine control module.
EG1–400
5S–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE TROUBLESHOOTING – CIRCUIT
INSPECTION
Park Neutral Position Switch Circuit (Only vehicles with
A–T)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The Park/Neutral position switch goes on when the shift lever is in the N or P shift position. When
it goes on the terminal NSW of the ECM is grounded to body ground via the starter relay and theft
deterrent ECU, thus the terminal NSW voltage becomes 0V. When the shift lever is in the D, 2, L or
R position, the Park/Neutral position switch goes off, so the voltage of ECM terminal NSW becomes
battery voltage, the voltage of the ECM internal power source. If the shift lever is moved from the N position to the D position, this signal is used for air–fuel ratio correction and for idle speed control (estimated
control), etc. When the Park/Neutral position switch is off, code “51” is output in the test mode diagnosis.
(This is not abnormal.)
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
HINT: This diagnosis chart is based on premise that the engine is cranked normally. If the engine
is not cranked, proceed to the matrix chart of problem symptoms on page EG1–327.
Check for open in harness and connector
between park/neutral position switch and ECM.
N G Type ΙΙ
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart (See age EG1–327).
NGType Ι
Check output condition of diagnostic trouble
code 51.
Check and replace ECM.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check park/neutral position switch.
(See page AX1–92)
Check and replace ECM.
Replace park/neutral position switch.
EG1–401
5S–FE ENGINE
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
EG1–402
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check output condition of diagnostic trouble code 51.
(1) Connect terminals TE2 and E1 of DLC2.
(2) Turn ignition switch on.
(3) Crank the engine.
(4) Connect terminals TE1 and E1 of DLC2.
Check if diagnostic trouble code “51” is output
when the shift lever is in the P and D shift positions.
Result
Shift
Position
N G Type Ι
NG Type ΙΙ
“P”
Normal Code
Code 51
Normal Code
”D”
Code 51
Code 51
Normal Code
NG
Type Ι
Go to step
NG
Type ΙΙ
Go to step
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
matrix chart (See age EG1–327).
Check for open in harness and connector between engine control
module and park/neutral position switch (See page IN–31).
Check and replace engine control module.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check park/neutral position switch (See page AX1–92).
Replace park/neutral position switch.
Check and replace engine control module.
EG1–403
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
ECM Power Source Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the ignition switch is turned on, battery positive voltage is applied to the coil, closing the
contacts of the EFI main relay and supplying power to the terminals + B and + 131 of the ECM.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage of ECM power source.
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart (See page EG1–327).
Check continuity between terminal E1 and
body ground.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check EFI main relay.
Replace EFI main relay.
Check IGN fuse.
Check for short in all the harness and
components connected to IGN fuse.
Check ignition switch.
Replace ignition switch.
Check for open in harness and connector
between IG switch and EFI main relay, EFI main
relay and body ground.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check EFI fuse.
Check for open in harness and connector
between EFI main relay and battery, EFI main
relay and ECM.
Check for short in all the harness and
components connected to EFI fuse.
EG1–404
5S–FE ENGINE
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
EG1–405
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminals + B, + 131 and E1 of engine control
module connector.
(1) Remove glove compartment.
(See page EG1–234)
(2) Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminals + B, + 131
and E1 of engine control module connector.
Voltage: 9 –14 V
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
matrix chart (See page EG1–327).
Check for open in harness and connector between terminal E1 of
engine control module and body ground (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
EG1–406
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check EFI main relay.
Remove EFI main relay from J/B No–2.
Check continuity between terminals of EFI main
relay shown below.
Terminals 3 and 5
Open
Terminals 1 and 2
Continuity
(Reference value 72)
(1) Apply battery voltage between terminals 1
and 2.
(2) Check continuity between terminals 3 and 5.
Terminals 3 and 5
Continuity
Replace EFI main relay.
Check IGN fuse.
Remove IGN fuse from J/B No.1.
Check continuity of IGN fuse.
Continuity
Check for short in all the harness and
components connected to IGN fuse (See
attached wiring diagram).
EG1–407
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check ignition switch.
Remove under cover and finish panel.
Check continuity between terminals.
continuity
Terminal
Switch position
10
3
6
7
9
2
4
lG1 ACC AM1 ST2 ST1 IG2 AM2
LOCK
ACC
START
Replace ignition switch.
Check for open in harness and connector between IG switch and
EFI main relay, EFI main relay and body ground (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check EFI fuse.
Remove EFI fuse from J/B No.2.
Check continuity of EFI fuse.
Continuity
Check for short in all the harness and
components connected to EFI fuse (See
attached wiring diagram).
Check for open in harness and connector
between EFI main relay and battery, EFI main
relay and engine control module.
EG1–408
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Back Up Power Source Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Battery positive voltage is supplied to terminal BATT of the ECM even when the ignition switch is off
for use by the diagnostic trouble code memory and air–fuel ratio adaptive control value memory, etc.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check EFI fuse.
Check for short in all the harness and
components connected to EFI fuse.
Check voltage of terminal6ATT.
Check and repair harness or connector
between battery, EFI fuse and ECU.
Check operation for the back up.
Check and replace ECM.
Proceed to next circuit inspection
shown on matrix chart (See page EG1–327).
WIRING DIAGRAM
EG1–409
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check EFI fuse.
Remove EFI fuse from J/B No.2.
Check continuity of EFI fuse.
Continuity
Check for short in all the harness and
components connected to EFI fuse
(See attached wiring diagram).
Check voltage between terminal BATT of engine control module
connector and body ground.
Remove glove compartment.
(See page EG1–234)
Measure voltage between terminal BATT of en–
gine control module connector and body ground.
Voltage: 9 –14 V
Others
Check and repair harness or connector
between engine control module and EN
fuse, EFI fuse and battery.
Are the diagnostic trouble codes still in the memory when the
ignition switch is turned OFF?
YES
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
matrix chart (See page EG1–327).
Check and replace engine control module.
EG1–410
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Injector Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The injectors are provided to the intake manifold. They inject fuel into the cylinders based on the
signals from the engine control module.
Reference INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
INJECTOR SIGNAL WAVEFORM
• With the engine idling measure waveform between terminals #10, #20 (#1, #2, #3 and #4*)
and E01 of engine control module.
HINT: The correct waveform appears as shown in the illustration on the below.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage of terminals #10 and #20
(#1. #2. #3 and #4*).
Check AM2 fuse.
Check for short in all the harness and
components connected to AM2 fuse.
Check for open in harness and connector
between ECM and battery.
Check continuity between terminals E01, E02
and body ground.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check operation for injectors.
Replace injector.
Check and replace ECM.
*: Only for California specification vehicles.
EG1–411
5S–FE ENGINE
WIRING DIAGRAM
Except California specification vehicles.
Only for California specification vehicles.
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
EG1–412
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminals #10, #20 (#1, #2, #3 and #4) of
engine control module connector and body ground.
(1) Remove glove compartment.
(See page EG1–234)
(2) Turn ignition switch ON.
Exc. California spec.
Measure voltage between terminals #10, #20 of
engine control module connector and body
ground.
Only for California spec,
Measure voltage between terminals #1, #2, #3
and #4 of engine control module connector and
body ground.
Voltage: 9 –14 V
Go to step
EG1–413
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check AM2 fuse.
Remove AM2 fuse from J/B No. 2.
Check continuity of AM2 fuse.
Continuity
Check for short in all the harness and
components connected to AM2 fuse.
Check for open in harness and connector
between engine control module and battery.
Check for open in harness and connector between terminals E01, E02
of engine control module connector– and body ground (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
EG1–414
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check injectors.
Disconnect injector connector
(See page EG1–189) .
Measure resistance of injector.
Resistance: Approx. 13.8 at 20C (68F)
Check injection volume of injector
(See page EG1–195).
• Injection volume
49 – 59 cm (3.0 – 3.6 cu in.)/15 sec.
Difference between each injector:
Less than 5 cm3 (0.3 cu in.)
• Leakage
Fuel drop: One drop or less per minute.
Replace injector.
Check and replace engine control module.
EG1–415
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
IAC Valve Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The rotary solenoid type IAC valve is provided on the intake air chamber and intake air bypassing
the throttle valve is directed to the IAC valve through a passage.
In this way the intake air volume bypas–
sing the throttle valve is regulated, con–
trolling the engine speed.
The ECM operated only the IAC valve to
perform idle–up and provide feedback for
the target idling speed, a VSV for idle–up
control is also added (for air condition–
ing).
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage terminals ISCO, ISCC.
Check and replace ECM.
Check operation of the IAC valve.
Replace IAC valve.
Check for open and short in harness and
connector between J/B No.2 and IAC valve,
IAC valve and ECM.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check for ECM power source circuit.
EG1–416
5S–FE ENGINE
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
EG1–417
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminals ISCO, ISCC of engine control
module connector and body ground.
(1) Remove glove compartment
(See page EG1–234),
(2) Disconnect the engine control module con–
nectors.
(3) Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminals ISCO, ISCC
of engine control module connector and body
ground.
Voltage: 9 –14 V
Check and replace engine control module.
EG1–418
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check operation of the IAC valve.
(1) Disconnect IAC valve connector.
(2) Remove IAC valve (See page EG1–213).
(1) Connect the positive (+) lead from the bat–
tery to terminal 2 (+ B) and negative (–) lead
to terminal 3 (ISCC), and check that the valve
is closed.
(2) Connect the. positive (+) lead from the bat–
tery to terminal 2 (+ B) and negative (–) lead
to terminal 1 (ISCO), and check that the valve
is open.
(1) The valve is closed.
(2) The valve is open.
Replace IAC valve.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between J/B No.2
and IAC valve, IAC valve and engine control module (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check for ECM power source circuit (See page
EG1–403).
EG1–419
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Fuel System Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Fuel pump control
The fuel pump is switched on (low voltage at terminal FC) when STA is on or while the NE signal
is input to the ECM.
In the diagram below, when the engine is cranked, current flows from terminal ST of the ignition
switch to the starter relay coil, the starter relay switches on and current flows to coil L1 of the circuit
opening relay. Thus the circuit opening relay switches on, power is supplied to the fuel pump and the
fuel pump operates.
When the STA signal and NE signal are input to the ECM, Tr is turned ON, current flows to coil L2
of the circuit opening relay, the relay switches on and the fuel pump operates.
While the NE signal is generated (engine running), the ECM keeps Tr ON (circuit opening relay ON)
and the fuel pump also keeps operating.
EG1–420
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage terminal FC.
Check and replace ECM.
Check for ECM power source circuit.
Repair or replace.
Check for circuit opening relay.
Replace circuit opening relay.
Check for open in harness and connector
between EFI main relay and circuit opening
relay and ECM.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check fuel pump.
Replace fuel pump.
Check for open in harness and connector
between circuit opening relay and fuel pump
and body ground.
EG1–421
5S–FE ENGINE
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
EG1–422
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminals FC of engine control module
connector and body ground.
(1) Remove glove compartment.
(See page EG1–234).
(2) Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminal FC of engine
control module connector and body ground.
Voltage: 9 –14 V
Check and replace engine control module.
Check for ECM power source circuit (See page EG1–403).
Repair or replace.
EG1–423
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check circuit opening relay.
(1) Remove glove compartment
(See page EG1–217).
(2) Remove circuit opening relay from R/B No.6.
Check continuity between terminals of circuit
opening relay shown below.
Terminals 1 and 2
Open
Terminals 2 and 4
Continuity
Terminals 3 and 6
Continuity
(1) Apply battery voltage between terminals 3
and 6.
(2) Check continuity between terminals 1 and 2.
Terminals 1 and 2
Continuity
Replace circuit opening relay.
Check for open in harness and connector between EFI main relay and
circuit opening relay, circuit opening relay and engine control module
(See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check fuel pump (See page EG1–177).
Replace fuel pump.
Check for open in harness and connector between circuit opening relay and fuel pump, fuel
pump and body ground.
EG1–424
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
VSV Circuit for Fuel Pressure Control (Only for California
spec.)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ECM turns on a VSV (Vacuum Switching
Valve) to draw the air into the diaphragm chamber
of the pressure regulator if it detects that the temperature of the engine coolant is too high during
engine starting. The air drawn into the chamber
increases the fuel pressure to prevent fuel vapor
lock at high engine temperature in order to help the
engine start when it is warm.
Fuel pressure control ends approx. 90 secs. after
the engine is started.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check VSV for fuel pressure control.
Replace VSV.
Check voltage of VSV power source.
Proceed to next circuit inspection
shown on matrix chart
(See page EG1–327).
Check for open and short in harness and
connector between EFI main relay and ECM.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECM.
EG1–425
5S–FE ENGINE
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
EG1–426
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check VSV for fuel pressure control.
(1) Disconnect VSV connector.
(2) Remove VSV.
(1) Measure resistance between terminals.
(2) Measure resistance between each terminal
and the body.
(1) Resistance: 33 – 39 at 20C (68F)
(2) Resistance: 1 M or higher.
Check operation of VSV when battery positive
voltage is applied and released to the VSV termi–
nals.
Battery positive voltage is applied:
The air from port E is flowing out through the
air filter.
Battery positive voltage is not applied:
The air from port E is flowing out through port
G.
Replace VSV for fuel pressure control VSV.
G o to step
EG1–427
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check voltage between terminal FPU of engine control module
connector and body ground.
(1) Remove glove compartment
(See page EG1–234).
(2) Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminal FPU of engine
control module connector and body ground.
Voltage: 9 –14 V
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart (See page EG1–327).
Check for open and short in harness and connector between engine
control module and VSV, VSV and EFI main relay (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace engine control module.
EG1–428
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Air Conditioning Cut Control Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit cuts air conditioning operation during vehicle acceleration in order to increase accelera–
tion performance. During acceleration with the vehicle speed at 16 mph (25 km/h) or less, engine
speed at 1,200 rpm or less and throttle valve opening angle at 60 or more, the A/C magnet switch
is turned OFF for several seconds.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage terminal ACT.
Check and replace ECM.
Check for open and short in harness and
connector between ECM and A/C amplifier.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace A/C amplifier.
WIRING DIAGRAM
EG1–429
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminal ACT of engine control module
connector and body ground.
(1) Remove glove compartment.
(See page EG1–234).
(2) Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminal ACT of engine
control module connector and body ground
when A/C switch is turned to ON.
Voltage: 9 –14 V
Check and replace engine control module.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between engine
control module and A/C amplifier (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace A/C amplifier.
EG1–430
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
TE1 TE2 Terminal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Terminals TE1 and TE2 are located in the data link connector 1 and 2.
The data link connector 1 located in the engine compartment and the data link connector 2 located
in the cabin. When these terminals are connected with the E1 terminal, diagnostic trouble codes in
normal mode or test mode can be read from the malfunction indicator lamp on the combination meter.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
HINT: If terminals TE1 and TE2 are connected with terminal E1, diagnostic trouble code is not
output or test mode is not activated.
Even though terminal TE1 is not connected with terminal E1, the malfunction indicator lamp
blinks.
For the above phenomenon, the likely cause is an open or short in the wire harness, or
malfunction inside the ECM.
Check voltage of terminals TE1, TE2.
Check and replace ECM.
Check continuity between terminal E1 and body
ground.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check for open and short in harness and
connector between data link connector 1, 2
and ECM.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
EG1–431
5S–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminals TE1, TE2, and E1 of data link
connector 1 and 2.
Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminals TE1,
TE2 and E1 of data link connector 1 and 2.
Voltage: 9 –14 v
Check and replace engine control module.
Check continuity between terminal E1 of data link connector 1, 2
and body ground.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between engine
control module and data link connector 1, 2 (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace engine control module.
EG2–1
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
1MZ–FE ENGINE
EG2–2
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
ENGINE MECHANICAL
DESCRIPTION
The 1 MZ–FE engine is a V–6, 3.0 liter 24 valve DOHC engine.
OPERATION
EG2–3
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
The 1 MZ–FE engine has 6 cylinders in a V arrangement at a bank angle of 60. From the front
of the RH bank cylinders are numbered 1–3–5, and from the front of the LH bank cylinders are
numbered 2–4–6. The crankshaft is supported by 4 bearings inside the crankcase. These
bearings are made of copper and lead alloy.
The crankshaft is integrated with 9 semi counterweights for balance. Oil holes are placed in the
center of the crankshaft for supply oil to the connecting rods, bearings, pistons and other
components.
This engine’s firing order is 1–2–3–4–5–6. The cylinder head is made of aluminum alloy, with
a cross flow type intake and exhaust layout and with pent–roof type combustion chambers. The
spark plugs are located in the center of the combustion chambers.
At the front and rear of the intake manifold, a water passage has been provided which connects
the RH and LH cylinder heads.
Exhaust and intake valves are equipped with irregular pitch springs made of special valve spring
carbon steel which are capable of following the cam profile at all engine speeds.
The RH and LH exhaust camshafts are driven by a single timing belt, and a gear on the exhaust
camshaft engages with a gear on the intake camshaft to drive it. The camshaft journal is
supported at 5 places between the valve lifters of each cylinder and on the front end of the
cylinder head. Lubrication of the cam journals and gears is accomplished by oil being supplied
through the oiler port in the center of the camshaft.
Adjustment of the valve clearance is done by means of an outer shim type system, in which valve
adjusting shims are located above the valve lifters. This permits replacement of the shims without
removal of the camshafts.
The timing belt covers consist of the resin type No.2 and No.1 above and below the engine RH
mounting bracket.
Pistons are made of high temperature–resistant aluminum alloy, and a depression is built into the
piston head to prevent interference with the valves.
Piston pins are the full–floating type, with the pins fastened to neither the piston boss nor the
connecting rods. Instead, snap rings are fitted on both ends of the pins, preventing the pins from
falling out.
The No.1 compression ring is made of steel and the No.2 compression ring is made of cast iron.
The oil ring also is made of a combination of steel and stainless steel. The outer diameter of each
piston ring is slightly larger than the diameter of the piston and the flexibility of the rings allows
them to hug the cylinder walls when they are mounted on the piston. Compression rings No. 1 and
No.2 work to prevent gas leakage from the cylinder and the oil ring works to clear oil off the
cylinder walls to prevent it from entering the combustion chambers.
The cylinder block is made of aluminum alloy with a bank angle of 60. It has 6 cylinders which
are approximately 1.6 times the length of the piston stroke. The top of the cylinders is closed off
by the cylinder heads and the lower end of the cylinders becomes the crankcase, in which the
crankshaft is installed. In addition, the cylinder block contains a water jacket, through which
coolant is pumped to cool the cylinders.
The No. 1 and No.2 oil pans are bolted onto the bottom of the cylinder block. The No. 1 oil pan is
made of aluminum alloy. The No.2 oil pan is an oil reservoir made of pressed sheet steel. An oil
pan baffle plate keeps sufficient oil in the bottom of the No.2 oil pan even when the vehicle is
tilted. This dividing plate also prevents the oil from sloshing when the vehicle is stopped suddenly
and the oil shifts away from the oil pump suction pipe.
Plastic region tightening bolts are used for the cylinder head, main bearing caps and connecting
rods.
EG2–4
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
PREPARATION
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
09201–01055 Valve Guide Bushing Remover &
Replacer 5.5
09201–41020 Valve Stem Oil Seal Replacer
09202–70010 Valve Spring Compressor
09213–54015 Crankshaft Pulley Holding Tool
09213–60017 Crankshaft Pulley & Gear Puller
Set
(09213–00020) Body With Bolt
(09213–00030) Handle
(09213–00050) Bolt set
Crankshaft timing pulley
(09213–00060) Bolt set
Crankshaft pulley
08223–00010 Cover & Seal Replacer
Crankshaft front oil seal
09223–15030 Oil Seal & Bearing Replacer
09223–46011 Crankshaft Front Oil Seal
Replacer
09248–55040 Valve Clearance Adjust Tool set
Crankshaft rear oil seal
Crankshaft timing pulley
EG2–5
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(09248 –05410) Valve Lifter Press
(09248–05420) Valve Lifter Stopper
09249–63010 Torque Wrench Adaptor
09330–00021 Companion Flange Holding Tool
RH camshaft timing pulley
Crankshaft pulley
09608–20012 Front Hub & Drive Pinion Bearing
Tool Set
(09608–03020) Handle
(09608–03070) Replacer
Crankshaft rear oil seal
Valve guide bushing
Spark plug tube gasket
09631–22020 Power Steering Hose Nut
14 x 17 mm Wrench Set
09816–30010 Oil Pressure Switch Socket
Knock sensor
Oil pressure switch
09843–18020 Diagnosis Check Wire
09960–10010 Variable Pin Wrench Set
(09962–01000) Variable Pin Wrench Arm Assy
Camshaft timing pulley
EG2–6
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE – ENGINE MECHANICAL
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09040–00010 Hexagon Wrench Set
09090–04010 Engine Sling Device
For suspending engine
09200–00010 Engine Adjust Kit
09258–00030 Hose Plug set
09904–00010 Expander Set
EQUIPMENT
Battery specific gravity gauge
Caliper gauge
CO/HC meter
Connecting rod aligner
Cylinder gauge
Dial indicator
Dye penetrant
Engine tune–up tester
Heater
Micrometer
Piston ring compressor
Piston ring expander
Plastigage
Precision straight edge
Magnetic finger
Plug for the vacuum hose, fuel
hose etc.
EG2–7
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Soft brush
Spring tester
Valve spring
Steel square
Valve spring
Thermometer
Torque wrench
Valve seat cutter
Vernier calipers
COOLANT
Item
Classification
Capacity
Ethylene–glycol base
8.7 liters (9.2 US qts, 7.7 Imp. qts)
Engine coolant
LUBRICANT
Item
Engine oil
Dry fill
Drain and refill
w/ Oil filter change
w/o Oil filter change
Capacity
Classification
5.5 liters (5.8 US qts, 4.8 Imp. qts)
API grade SG or SH, Energy–Conserving II
or ILSC multigrade and recommended
viscosity oil with SAE 5W–30 being
the preferred engine oil
4.7 liters (5.0 US qts, 4.1 Imp. qts)
4.5 liters (4.8 US qts, 4.0 Imp. qts)
SSM (SERVICE SPECIAL MATERIALS)
08826–00080 Seal packing or equivalent
Camshaft bearing cap
Semi–circular plug
Spark plug tube
Cylinder head cover
08826–00080 Seal packing or equivalent
Intake air control valve
Rear oil seal retainer
No. 1 oil pan
No.2 oil pan
08826–00100 Seal Packing 1282B,
THREE BOND 1282B or equivalent
Engine coolant drain cock
Water seal plate
Water inlet housing
08833–00070 Adhesive 1311,
THREE BOND 1311 or equivalent
Drive plate bolt
TVV
08833–00080 Adhesive 1344,
THREE BOND 1344,
LOCTITE 242 or equivalent
Oil pressure switch
EG2–8
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
TUNE–UP
ENGINE COOLANT INSPECTION
1. CHECK ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL AT RESERVOIR
TANK
The engine coolant level should be between the
”LOW” and ”FULL” lines.
If low, check for leaks and add engine coolant up to
the ”FULL” line.
2. CHECK ENGINE COOLANT QUALITY
(a) Remove the radiator cap from the water outlet.
CAUTION: To avoid the danger of being burned, do not
remove the radiator cap while the engine and radiator are
still hot, as fluid and steam can be blown out under
pressure.
(b) There should not be any excessive deposits of rust or
scale around the radiator cap or water outlet filler
hole, and the coolant should be free from oil.
If excessively dirty, clean the coolant passages and
replace the coolant.
Capacity:
8.7 liters (9.2 US qts, 7.7 Imp. qts)
HINT:
• Use a good brand of ethylene–glycol base cool–
ant and mix it according to the manufacturer’s
directions.
• Using coolant which includes more than 50 %
ethylene–glycol (but not more than 70 %) is
recommended.
NOTICE:
• Do not use an alcohol type coolant.
• The coolant should be mixed with demineralized
water or distilled water.
(c) Reinstall the radiator cap.
EG2–9
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
ENGINE OIL INSPECTION
1. CHECK OIL QUALITY
Check the oil for deterioration, entry of water, dis–
coloring or thinning.
If oil quality is visibly poor, replace the oil.
Oil grade:
API grade SG or SH, Energy – Conserving H or
ILSAC multigrade engine oil. Recommended viscosi–
ty is as shown in the illustration, with SAE 5W–30
being the preferred engine oil.
Drain and refill capacity:
w/ Oil filter change
4.7 liters (5.0 US qts, 4.1 Imp, qts)
w/o Oil filter change
4.5 liters (4.8 US qts, 4.0 Imp. qts)
2. CHECK ENGINE OIL LEVEL
The oil level should be between the ”L” and ”F” marks
on the dipstick.
If low, check for leakage and add oil up to the ”F”
mark.
NOTICE:
• Do not fill with engine oil above the ’F’ mark.
• Install the oil dipstick facing the direction shown in
the illustration.
EG2–10
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
BATTERY INSPECTION
1. Except Delco Battery:
CHECK BATTERY ELECTROLYTE LEVEL
Check the electrolyte quantity of each cell.
A. Maintenance Free Battery
If under the lower level, replace the battery (or add
distilled water if possible). Check the charging system.
B. Except Maintenance Free Battery
If under the ”LOWER” or ”MIN’ line, add distilled
water.
2. Except Delco Battery:
CHECK BATTERY VOLTAGE AND SPECIFIC
GRAVITY
A. Maintenance Free Battery
Measure the battery voltage between the terminals
negative (–) and positive (+) of the battery.
Standard voltage:
12.7 – 12.9 V at 20°C (68°F)
HINT:
• Before measuring the voltage, turn the ignition
switch to LOCK and turn off the electrical sys–
tems (headlight, blower motor, rear defogger etc.;
for 60 seconds to remove the surface charge.
• If the vehicle has been running, wait 5 minutes or
more after the vehicle stops before measuring
the battery voltage.
If the voltage is less than specification, charge the
battery.
HINT: Check the indicator as shown in the illustration.
EG2–11
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
B. Except Maintenance Free Battery
Check the specific gravity of each cell.
Standard specific gravity:
55D23L battery for GNB Incorporated
1.25 – 1.27 at 20°C (60°F)
5513231– battery for JOHNSON CONTROLS
1.26 – 1.28 at 27°C (81°F)
80D26L battery for GNB Incorporated
1.27 – 1.29 at 20°C (68°F)
80D26L battery for JOHNSON CONTROLS
1.28 – 1.30 at 27°C (80°F)
If the gravity is less than specification, charge the
battery.
HINT: Check the indicator as shown in the illustration.
3. Delco Battery:
CHECK HYDROMETER
Green Dot visible:
Battery is adequately charged
Dark (Green Dot not visible):
Battery must be charged
Clear or Light Yellow:
Replace battery
HINT: There is no need to add water during the entire
service life of the battery.
4. CHECK BATTERY TERMINALS, FUSIBLE LINK AND
FUSES
(a) Check that the battery terminals are not loose or
corroded.
(b) Check the fusible link and fuses for continuity.
AIR FILTER INSPECTION AND CLEANING
1. REMOVE AIR FILTER
EG2–12
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
2. INSPECT AND CLEAN AIR FILTER
(a) Visually check that the air filter is not excessively
dirty, damaged or oily.
If necessary, replace the air filter.
(b) Clean the air filter with compressed air.
First blow from the inside thoroughly, then blow from
the outside of the air filter.
3. REINSTALL AIR FILTER
GENERATOR DRIVE BELT INSPECTION
INSPECT DRIVE BELT
(a) Visually check the belt for excessive wear, frayed
cords etc.
If necessary, replace the drive belt.
HINT: Cracks on the rib side of a belt are considered
acceptable. If the belt has chunks missing from the
ribs, it should be replaced.
(b) Using a belt tension gauge, measure the drive belt
tension.
Belt tension gauge:
Nippondenso BTG – 20 (95506–00020)
Borroughs No. BT–33–73F
Drive belt tension:
New belt
175 ± 5 lbf
Used belt
115 ±20 lbf
If the belt tension is not as specified, adjust it.
HINT:
• ”New belt” refers to a belt which has been used
less than 5 minutes on a running engine.
• ”Used belt” refers to a belt which has been used
on a running engine for 5 minutes or more.
• After installing the belt, check that it fits properly
in the ribbed grooves.
• Check by hand to confirm that the belt has not
slipped out of the groove on the bottom of the
pulley.
• After installing a new belt, run the engine for
about 5 minutes and recheck the belt tension.
EG2–13
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
VALVE CLEARANCE INSPECTION AND
ADJUSTMENT
HINT: Inspect and adjust the valve clearance when
the engine is cold.
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE TO
BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ”LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
3. DISCONNECT RADIATOR INLET HOSE
4. DISCONNECT ACCELERATOR CABLE
5. DISCONNECT THROTTLE CABLE
6. REMOVE AIR CLEANER CAP, VOLUME AIR FLOW
METER AND AIR CLEANER HOSE
(a) Disconnect the volume air flow meter connector and
wire clamp.
(b) Disconnect the accelerator cable clamp.
(c) Disconnect the PCV hose.
(d) Loosen the air cleaner hose clamp bolt.
(e) Disconnect the 4 air cleaner cap clips.
(f) Remove the air cleaner cap and volume air flow meter
together with the air cleaner hose.
7. REMOVE V–BANK COVER
Using a 5 mm hexagon wrench, remove the 2 nuts and
V–bank cover.
EG2–14
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
8. REMOVE EMISSION CONTROL VALVE SET
(a) Disconnect the following vacuum hoses:
(1) Vacuum hose from fuel pressure control VSV
(2) Vacuum hose from fuel pressure regulator
(3) Vacuum hose from cylinder head rear plate
(4) Vacuum hose from intake air control valve VSV
(5) Vacuum hose from EGR vacuum modulator
(6) Vacuum hose from EGR valve
(b) Disconnect the following connectors:
(1) Intake air control valve connector
(2) Fuel pressure connector
(3) EGR VSV connector
(c) Remove the 2 nuts and emission control valve set.
9. REMOVE AIR INTAKE CHAMBER
(a) Disconnect the following hoses:
(1) Brake booster vacuum hose
(2) PCV hose
(3) Intake air control valve vacuum hose
(b) Disconnect the data link connector 1.
(c) Remove the nut and disconnect the 2 ground straps.
EG2–15
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(d) Remove the bolt and disconnect the hydraulic motor
pressure hose from the air intake chamber.
(e) Remove the bolt, and disconnect the ground strap.
(f) Disconnect the RH oxygen sensor connector clamp
from the PS pressure tube.
(g) Remove the 2 nuts, and disconnect the PS pressure
tube.
(h) Disconnect the 2 PS air hoses.
(i) Remove the 2 bolts and No.1 engine hanger.
(j) Remove the 2 bolts and air intake chamber stay.
(k) Remove the 4 nuts, EGR pipe and 2 gaskets.
EG2–16
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE – ENGINE MECHANICAL
(I) Disconnect the following connectors:
(1) Throttle position sensor connector
(2) IAC valve connector
(3) EGR gas temperature sensor connector
(4) A/C idle–up connector
(m) Disconnect the following vacuum hoses:
(1) 2 vacuum hoses from TVV
(2) Vacuum hose from cylinder head rear plate
(3) Vacuum hose from charcoal canister
(n) Disconnect the following hoses:
(1) 2 water bypass hoses
(2) Air assist hose
(o) Using an 8 mm hexagon wrench, remove the 2 bolts,
2 nuts, air intake chamber and gasket.
EG2–17
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
10. DISCONNECT ENGINE WIRE FROM ENGINE LH
SIDE
(a) Disconnect the following connectors:
(1) 3 injector connectors
(2) 3 ignition coil connectors
(b) Remove the 2 nuts, and disconnect the engine wire.
11. DISCONNECT ENGINE WIRE FROM NO.3 TIMING
BELT COVER
Remove the bolt and 3 clamps, and disconnect the
engine wire.
12. DISCONNECT ENGINE WIRE FROM ENGINE REAR
SIDE
Remove the 2 nuts, and disconnect the engine wire.
13. DISCONNECT ENGINE WIRE FROM ENGINE RH
SIDE
(a) Disconnect the following connectors:
(1) 3 injector connectors
(2) 3 ignition coil connectors
(b) Remove the 5 nuts, and disconnect the engine wire.
EG2–18
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
14. REMOVE IGNITION COILS
Remove the 6 bolts and 6 ignition coils from the RH
and LH cylinder heads.
HINT: Arrange the ignition coils in the correct order.
15. REMOVE SPARK PLUGS
Using a 16 mm plug wrench, remove the 6 spark plugs
from the RH and LH cylinder heads.
16. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVERS
Remove the 8 bolts, cylinder head cover and gasket.
Remove the 2 cylinder head covers.
17. SET NO.1 CYLINDER TO TDC/COMPRESSION
(a) Turn the crankshaft pulley, and align its groove with
the timing mark ”0” of the No.1 timing belt cover.
(b) Check that the valve lifters on the No.1 (IN) are loose
and valve lifters on the No.1 (EX) are tight.
If not, turn the crankshaft 1 revolution (360°) and
align the mark as above.
EG2–19
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
18. INSPECT VALVE CLEARANCE
(a) Check only those valves indicated in the illustration.
• Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance be–
tween the valve lifter and camshaft.
• Record out of specification valve clearance mea–
surements. They will be used later to determine
the required replacement adjusting shim.
Valve clearance (Cold):
Intake
0.15 – 0.25 mm (0.006 – 0.010 in.)
Exhaust
0.25 – 0.35 mm (0.010 – 0.014 in.)
(b) Turn the crankshaft 2/3 of a revolution (240), and
check only. the valves indicated in the illustration.
Measure the valve clearance.
(See procedure step (a))
EG2–20
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c) Turn the crankshaft a further 2/3 of a revolution
(240), and check only the valves indicated in the
illustration.
Measure the valve clearance.
(See procedure step (a))
19. ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE
(a) Remove the adjusting shim.
• Turn the camshaft so that the cam lobe for the
valve to be adjusted faces up.
• Turn the valve lifter with a screwdriver so that
the notches would be perpendicular to the cam–
shaft.
• Using SST (A), press down the valve lifter and
place SST (B) between the camshaft and valve
lifter. Remove SST (A).
SST 09248–55040 (09248–05410, 09248–05420)
HINT:
• Apply SST (B) at a slight angle on the side marked
with ”9” or ”7”, at the position shown in the
illustration.
• When SST (B) is inserted too deeply, it will get
pinched by the shim. To prevent it from being
stuck, insert it gently from the intake side, at a
slight angle.
EG2–21
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
• Using a small screwdriver and a magnetic finger,
remove the adjusting shim.
(b) Determine the replacement adjusting shim size ac–
cording to the following Formula or Charts on the next
2 pages:
• Using a micrometer, measure the thickness of
the removed shim.
• Calculate the thickness of a new shim so the
valve clearance comes within specified value.
T .......... Thickness of used shim
A .......... Measured valve clearance
N .......... Thickness of new shim
Intake
N = T + (A – 0.20 mm (0.008 in.))
Exhaust
N = T + (A – 0.30 mm (0.012 in.))
• Select a new shim with a thickness as close as
possible to the calculated values.
HINT: Shims are available in 17 sizes in increments of
0.050 mm (0.0020 in.), from 2.500 mm (0.0984 in.) to
3.300 mm (0.1299 in.).
(c) Install a new adjusting shim.
• Place a new adjusting shim on the valve lifter,
with imprinted numbers facing down.
• Press down the valve lifter with SST (A), and
remove SST (B).
SST 09248–55040 (09248–05410, 09248–05420)
(d) Recheck the valve clearance.
EG2–22
Adjusting Shim Selection Chart (Intake)
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Adjusting Shim Selection Chart (Exhaust)
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
EG2–23
EG2–24
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
20. REINSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVERS
(a) Apply seal packing to the cylinder heads as shown in
the illustration.
Seal packing:
Part No. 08826–00080 or equivalent
(b) Install the gasket to the cylinder head cover.
(c) Install the cylinder head cover with the 8 bolts. Uni–
formly tighten the bolts in several passes. Install the 2
cylinder head covers.
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–lbf)
21. REINSTALL SPARK PLUGS
Using a 16 mm plug wrench, install the 6 spark plugs
to the RH and LH cylinder heads.
Torque: 18 N–m (180 kgf–cm, 13 ft–lbf)
22. REINSTALL IGNITION COILS
Install the6 ignition coils to the RH and LH cylinder
heads.
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–lbf)
EG2–25
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
23. RECONNECT ENGINE WIRE TO ENGINE RH SIDE
(a) Connect the engine wire with the 5 nuts.
(b) Connect the following connectors:
(1) 3 injector connectors
(2) 3 ignition coil connectors
24. RECONNECT ENGINE WIRE TO ENGINE REAR SIDE
Connect the engine wire with the 2 nuts.
25. RECONNECT ENGINE WIRE TO ENGINE LH SIDE
(a) Connect the engine wire with the 2 nuts.
(b) Connect the following connectors:
(1) 3 injector connectors
(2) 3 ignition coil connectors
26. RECONNECT ENGINE WIRE TO NO.3 TIMING BELT
COVER
(a) Connect the 3 clamps.
(b) Connect the engine wire with the bolt.
EG2–26
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
27. REINSTALL AIR INTAKE CHAMBER
(a) Using an 8 mm hexagon wrench, install a new gasket
and the air intake chamber with the 2 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 43 N–m (440 kgf–cm, 32 ft–lbf)
(b) Connect the following hoses:
(1) 2 water bypass hoses
(2) Air assist hose
(c) Connect the following vacuum hoses:
(1) 2 vacuum hoses to TVV
(2) Vacuum hose to cylinder head rear plate
(3) Vacuum hose to charcoal canister
(d) Connect the following connectors:
(1) Throttle position sensor connector
(2) IACV valve connector
(3) EGR gas temperature sensor connector
(4) A/C idle–up connector
EG2–27
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(e) Install 2 new gaskets and EGR pipe with the 4 nuts.
Torque: 12 N–m (120 kgf–cm. 9 ft–lbf)
(f) install the No. 1 engine hanger with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 39 N–m (400 kgf–cm, 19 ft–lbf)
(g) Install the air intake chamber stay with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 19.5 N–m (200 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
(h) Connect the 2 PS air hoses.
(i) Connect the PS pressure tube with the 2 nuts.
(j) Connect the RH oxygen sensor connector clamp to
the PS pressure tube.
(k) Connect the ground strap with the bolt.
(1) Connect the hydraulic pressure pipe to the air intake
chamber with the bolt.
EG2–28
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(m) Connect the following hoses:
(1) Brake booster vacuum hose
(2) PCV hose
(3) Intake air control valve vacuum hose
(n) Connect the data link connector 1.
(o) Connect the 2 ground straps with the nut.
28. REINSTALL EMISSION CONTROL VALVE SET
(a) Install the emission control valve set with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–lbf)
(b) Connect the following connectors:
(1) Intake control valve connector
(2) Fuel pressure connector
(3) EGR VSV connector
(c) Connect the following vacuum hoses:
(1) Vacuum hose to fuel pressure control VSV
(2) Vacuum hose to fuel pressure regulator
(3) Vacuum hose to cylinder head rear plate
(4) Vacuum hose to intake air control valve
(5) Vacuum hose to EGR vacuum modulator
(6) Vacuum hose to EGR valve
28. REINSTALL V–BANK COVER
Using a 5 mm hexagon wrench, install the V– bank
cover with the 2 nuts.
EG2–29
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
29. REINSTALL AIR CLEANER CAP, VOLUME AIR
FLOW METER AND AIR CLEANER HOSE
(a) Connect the air cleaner hose, and install the air clean–
er cap and volume air flow meter with the 4 clips.
(b) Tighten the air cleaner hose clamp bolt.
(c) Connect the PCV hose.
(d) Connect the accelerator cable clamp.
(e) Connect the volume air flow meter connector and
wire clamp.
30. RECONNECT THROTTLE CABLE
31. RECONNECT ACCELERATOR CABLE
32. RECONNECT RADIATOR INLET HOSE
33. FILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
Capacity:
8.7 liters (9.2 US qts, 7.7 Imp. qts)
34. RECONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE TO
BATTERY
EG2–30
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
IGNITION TIMING INSPECTION
1. WARM UP ENGINE
Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating
temperature.
2. CONNECT TACHOMETER TO ENGINE
Connect the tester probe of a tachometer to terminal
IG(–) of the data link connector 1.
NOTICE:
• Never allow the tachometer terminal to touch
ground as it could result In damage to the igniter
and/or ignition coil.
• As some tachometers are not compatible with this
ignition system, we recommend that you confirm
the compatibility of your unit before use.
3. CONNECT TIMING LIGHT TO ENGINE
(a) Using a 5 mm hexagon wrench, remove the 2 cap nuts
and V– bank cover.
(b) Connect the timing light pickup clip to the the green
lead wire for the No.4 ignition coil.
HINT: Use a timing light that can detect the primary
signal.
4. CHECK IDLE SPEED
(a) Race the engine speed at 2,500 rpm for approx. 90
seconds.
EG2–31
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b) Check the idle speed.
Idle speed:
700 ± 60 rpm
5. INSPECT IGNITION TIMING
(a) Using SST, connect terminals TE1 and E1 of the data
link connector 1.
SST 09843–18020
(b) Using a timing light, check the ignition timing.
Ignition timing:
8 – 12 BTDC @ idle
(Transmission in neutral position)
If the ignition timing is not as specified, check that
following conditions are normal:
• Throttle valve fully closed
• Continuity between terminals IDL1 and E2 of the
throttle position sensor.
• Valve timing
(c) Remove the SST from the data link connector 1.
SST 09843–18020
6. FURTHER CHECK IGNITION TIMING
Ignition timing:
7 – 17 BTDC @ idle
(Transmission in neutral position)
HINT: The timing mark moves in a range between 7
and 17.
EG2–32
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
7. DISCONNECT TIMING LIGHT FROM ENGINE
(a) Remove the timing light.
(b) Using a 5 mm hexagon wrench, install the V–bank
cover with the 2 cap nuts.
8. DISCONNECT TACHOMETER FROM ENGINE
EG2–33
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
IDLE SPEED INSPECTION
1. INITIAL CONDITIONS
(a) Engine at normal operating temperature
(b) Air cleaner installed
(c) All pipes and hoses of air induction system connected
(d) All accessories switched OFF
(e) All vacuum lines properly connected
HINT: All vacuum hoses for EGR system, etc. should
be properly connected.
(f) SFI system wiring connectors fully plugged
(g) Ignition timing set correctly
(h) Transmission, in neutral position
2. CONNECT TACHOMETER
Connect the tester probe of a tachometer to terminal
IG(–) of the data link connector 1.
NOTICE:
• Never allow the tachometer terminal to touch
ground as it could result in damage to the igniter
and/or ignition coil.
• As some tachometers are not compatible with this
ignition system, we recommend that you confirm
the compatibility of your unit before use.
3. INSPECT IDLE SPEED
(a) Race the engine speed at 2,500 rpm for approx. 90
seconds.
(b) Check the idle speed.
Idle speed:
700 ± 50 rpm
If the idle speed is not as specified, check the IAC
valve and air intake system.
4. DISCONNECT TACHOMETER
EG2–34
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
IDLE AND OR 2500 RPM CO HC
CHECK
HINT: This check is used only to determine whether or
not the idle CO/HC complies with regulations.
1. INITIAL CONDITIONS
(a) Engine at normal operating temperature
(b) Air cleaner installed
(c) All pipes and hoses of air induction system connected
(d) All accessories switched OFF
(e) All vacuum lines properly connected
HINT: All vacuum hoses for EGR systems, etc. should
be properly connected.
(f) SFI system wiring connectors fully plugged
(g) Ignition timing set correctly
(h) Transmission in neutral position
(i) Tachometer and CO/HC meter calibrated by hand
2. START ENGINE
3. RACE ENGINE AT 2,500 RPM FOR APPROX. 180
SECONDS
4. INSERT CO/NC METER TESTING PROBE AT LEAST
40 cm (1.3 ft) INTO TAILPIPE DURING IDLING
5. IMMEDIATELY CHECK CO/HC CONCENTRATION
AT IDLE AND/OR 2,500 RPM
HINT: When performing the 2 mode (2,500 rpm and
idle) test, follow the measurement order prescribed by
the applicable local regulations.
EG2–35
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Troubleshooting
If the CO/HC concentration does not comply with
regulations, perform troubleshooting in the order
given below.
See the table below for possible causes, and then
inspect and correct the applicable causes if neces–
sary.
Phenomenon
Causes
Normal
High
Rough idle
1. Faulty ignitions:
• Incorrect timing
• Fouled, shorted or improperly gapped plugs
• Open or crossed high–tension cords
• Cracked distributor cap
2. Incorrect valve clearance
3. Leaky EGR valve
4. Leaky intake and exhaust valves
5. Leaky cylinder
Low
High
Rough idle
(Fluctuating HC reading)
1. Vacuum leaks:
• PCV hose
• EGR valve
• Intake manifold
• Air intake chamber
• Throttle body
• IAC valve
• Brake booster line
2. Lean mixture causing misfire
High
High
Rough idle
(Black smoke from exhaust)
1. Restricted air filter
2. Faulty SFI systems:
• Faulty fuel pressure regulator
• Clogged fuel return line
• Defective ECT switch
• Faulty ECM
• Faulty injector
• Faulty throttle position sensor
• Faulty volume air flow meter
EG2–36
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
COMPRESSION CHECK
HINT: If there is lack of power, excessive oil consump–
tion or poor fuel economy, measure the compression
pressure.
1. WARM UP AND STOP ENGINE
Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating
temperature.
2. REMOVE V–BANK COVER
Using a 5 mm hexagon wrench, remove the 2 cap nuts
and V– bank cover.
3. REMOVE IGNITION COILS
(a) Disconnect the 6 connectors from the RH and LH
cylinder heads.
(b) Remove the 6 bolts and 6 ignition coils from the RH
and LH cylinder heads.
HINT: Arrange the ignition coils in the correct order.
EG2–37
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
4. REMOVE SPARK PLUGS
Using a 16 mm plug wrench, remove the 6 spark plugs
from the RH and LH cylinder heads.
5. CHECK CYLINDER COMPRESSION PRESSURE
(a) Insert a compression gauge into the spark plug hole.
(b) Fully open the throttle.
(c) While cranking the engine, measure the compression
pressure.
HINT: Always use a fully charged battery to obtain
engine speed of 250 rpm or more.
(d) Repeat steps
(a) through
(c) for each cylinder.
NOTICE: This measurement must be done in as short a
time as possible.
Compression pressure:
1,226 kPa (12.5 kgf/cm2, 178 psi) or more
Minimum pressure:
981 kPa (10.0 kgf/cm2, 142 psi)
Difference between each cylinder:
98 kPa (1.0 kgf/cm2, 14 psi) or less
(e) If the cylinder compression in 1 or more cylinders is
low, pour a small amount of engine oil into the cylin–
der through the spark plug hole and repeat steps (a)
through (c) for cylinders with low compression.
• If adding oil helps the compression, it is likely that
the piston rings and/or cylinder bore are worn or
damaged.
• If pressure stays low, a valve may be sticking or
seating is improper, or there may be leakage past
the gasket.
6. REINSTALL SPARK PLUGS
Using a 16 mm plug wrench, install the 6 spark plugs
to the RH and LH cylinder heads.
Torque: 18 N–m (180 kgf–cm, 13 ft–lbf)
EG2–38
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
7. INSTALL IGNITION COILS
(a) Install the 6 ignition coil to the RH and LH cylinder
heads with the 6 bolts.
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–lbf)
(b) Connect the 6 ignition coil connectors.
8. REINSTALL V–BANK COVER
Using a 5 mm hexagon wrench, install the V –bank
cover with the 2 cap nuts.
EG2–39
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
TIMING BELT
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
EG2–40
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
EG2–41
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
TIMING BELT REMOVAL
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. REMOVE ENGINE COOLANT RESERVOIR TANK
(a) Disconnect the reservoir hose.
(b) Using a screwdriver, remove the reservoir tank.
3. REMOVE GENERATOR DRIVE BELT
Loosen the pivot bolt and adjusting lock bolt, and
remove the drive belt.
4. REMOVE RH FRONT WHEEL
5. REMOVE RH FENDER APRON SEAL
EG2–42
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
6. REMOVE PS DRIVE BELT
Loosen the 2 bolts, and remove the drive belt.
7. DISCONNECT GROUND STRAPS
Disconnect the 2 straps.
8. REMOVE RH ENGINE MOUNTING STAY
Remove the 3 bolts and RH engine mounting stay.
9. REMOVE ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD AND
NO.2 RH ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET
Remove the 3 bolts, control rod and mounting brack–
et.
10. REMOVE NO.2 GENERATOR BRACKET
(a) Loosen the generator pivot bolt.
(b) Remove the nut and bracket.
EG2–43
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
11. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
(a) Using SST, remove the pulley bolt.
SST 09213–54016, 09330–00021
(b) Using SST, remove the pulley.
SST 09213–00060
12. REMOVE No.1 TIMING BELT COVER
Remove the 4 bolts and timing belt cover.
13. DISCONNECT ENGINE WIRE
(a) Remove the bolt holding the engine wire to the No.3
timing belt cover.
(b) Disconnect the engine wire from the clamp.
14. REMOVE N0.2 TIMING BELT COVER
Remove the 5 bolts and timing belt cover.
EG2–44
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
15. REMOVE ENGINE RH MOUNTING BRACKET
Remove the 2 bolts, nut and mounting bracket.
16. REMOVE TIMING BELT GUIDE
17. SET NO.1 CYLINDER TO TDC/COMPRESSION
(a) Temporarily install the crankshaft pulley bolt to the
crankshaft.
(b) Turn the crankshaft and align the crankshaft timing
pulley groove with the oil pump alignment mark.
NOTICE: Always turn the crankshaft clockwise.
(c) Check that timing marks of the camshaft timing pul–
leys and No.3 timing belt cover are aligned.
If not, turn the crankshaft 1 revolution (360°).
(d) Remove the crankshaft pulley bolt.
EG2–45
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
18. IF REUSING TIMING BELT, CHECK
INSTALLATION MARKS ON TIMING BELT
Check that there are 3 installation marks and front
mark on the timing belt.
If the installation and front marks have disappeared,
before removing the timing belt, place new installation
and front marks on the timing belt to the following
position:
• Timing mark of RH camshaft timing pulley
• Timing mark of LH camshaft timing pulley
• Dot mark of crankshaft timing pulley
19. REMOVE TIMING BELT TENSIONER
Alternately loosen the 2 bolts, and remove them, the
tensioner and dust boot.
20. REMOVE TIMING BELT
21. REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEYS
(a) Using SST, remove the bolt and RH timing pulley.
SST 09249 – 63010, 09960 –10010 (09962 – 01000)
EG2–46
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b) Using SST, remove the LH timing pulley.
SST 09960–10010 (09962–01000)
HINT: Arrange the camshaft timing pulleys (RH and
LH sides).
22. REMOVE NO.2 IDLER PULLEY
Remove the bolt and idler pulley.
23. REMOVE No.1 IDLER PULLEY
Using a 10 mm hexagon wrench, remove the bolt,
idler pulley and plate washer.
24. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
(a) Remove the bolt and timing belt plate.
EG2–47
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b) Using SST, remove the crankshaft timing pulley.
SST 09213–60017 (09213–00020, 09213–00030,
09213–00050)
NOTICE: Do not scratch the sensor part of the crankshaft
timing pulley.
TIMING BELT INSPECTION
1. INSPECT TIMING BELT
NOTICE:
• Do not bend, twist or turn the timing belt inside out.
• Do not allow the timing belt to come into contact
with oil, water or steam.
• Do not utilize timing belt tension when installing or
removing the mount bolt of the camshaft timing
pulley.
If there are any defects, as shown in the illustrations,
check the following points:
(a) Premature parting
• Check for proper installation.
• Check the timing cover gasket for damage and
proper installation.
(b) If the belt teeth are cracked or damaged, check to see
if either camshaft is locked.
(c) If there is noticeable wear or cracks on the belt face,
check to see if there are nicks on the side of the idler
pulley lock and water pump.
EG2–48
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(d) If there is wear or damage on only one side of the belt,
check the belt guide and the alignment of each pulley.
(e) If there is noticeable wear on the belt teeth, check
timing cover for damage and check gasket has been
installed correctly and for foreign material on the
pulley teeth.
If necessary, replace the timing belt.
2. INSPECT IDLER PULLEYS
Check that the idler pulley turns smoothly.
If necessary, replace the idler pulley.
3. INSPECT TIMING BELT TENSIONER
(a) Visually check tensioner for oil leakage.
HINT: If there is only the faintest trace of oil on the
seal on the push rod side, the tensioner is all right.
If leakage is found, replace the tensioner.
P12429
(b) Hold the tensioner with both hands and push the push
rod strongly as shown to check that it doesn’t move.
If the push rod moves, replace the tensioner.
NOTICE: Never hold the tensioner push rod facing down–
ward.
EG2–49
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c) Measure the protrusion of the push rod from the
housing end.
Protrusion:
10.0 – 10.8 mm (0.394 – 0.425 In.)
If the protrusion is not as specified, replace the tensi–
oner.
TIMING BELT INSTALLATION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. INSTALL CRANKSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
(a) Align the pulley set key with the key groove of the
timing pulley and slide on the timing pulley.
(b) Using SST and a hammer, tap in the timing pulley,
facing the sensor side rearward.
SST 09223–46011
NOTICE: Do not scratch the sensor part of the crankshaft
timing pulley.
(c) Install the timing belt plate with the bolt.
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–lbf)
2. INSTALL NO.1 IDLER PULLEY
(a) Using a 10 mm hexagon wrench, install the idler
pulley with the plate washer and bolt.
Torque: 34 N–m (350 kgf–cm, 25 ft–lbf)
(b) Check that the pulley bracket moves smoothly.
EG2–50
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
3. INSTALL No.2 IDLER PULLEY
(a) Install the idler pulley with the bolt.
Torque: 43 N–m (440 kgf–cm, 32 ft–lbf)
(b) Check that the idler pulley moves smoothly.
4. INSTALL RH CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
(a) Install the timing pulley, facing the flange side out–
ward.
(b) Align the knock pin hole of the camshaft with the
knock pin groove of the timing pulley as shown.
(c) Using SST, install and torque the bolt.
SST 09249–63010, 09960–10010 (09962–01000)
Torque: 88 N–m (900 kgf–cm, 65 ft–lbf)
HINT: Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of
340 mm (113.39 in.)
5. INSTALL LH CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
(a) Install the timing pulley, facing the flange side inward.
(b) Align the knock pin hole of the camshaft with the
knock pin groove of the timing pulley as shown.
(d) Using SST, install and torque the bolt.
SST 09960–10010 (09962–01000)
Torque: 126 N–m (1,300 kgf–cm, 94 ft–lbf)
EG2–51
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
6. SET NO.1 CYLINDER TO TDC/COMPRESSION
(a) Crankshaft Timing Pulley Position:
Temporarily install the crankshaft pulley bolt to
the crankshaft.
Turn the crankshaft and align the crankshaft
timing pulley groove with the oil pump alignment
mark.
(b) RH Camshaft Timing Pulley Position:
Using SST, turn the camshaft pulley, align the timing
marks of the camshaft and the No.3 timing belt cover.
SST 09960–10010 (09962–01000)
(c) LH Camshaft Timing Pulley Position:
Using SST, turn the camshaft pulley, align the timing
marks of the camshaft and the No.3 timing belt cover.
SST 09960 –10010 (09962 – 01000)
7. INSTALL TIMING BELT
NOTICE: The engine should be cold.
(a) Remove any oil or water on the pulleys, and keep them
clean.
(b) Check the timing belt front mark.
(c) Align the installation mark on the timing belt with the
dot mark of the crankshaft timing pulley.
(d) Align the installation marks on the timing belt with the
timing marks of the camshaft timing pulleys.
(e) Install the timing belt with the following order:
• Crankshaft timing pulley
• Water pump pulley
• LH camshaft timing pulley
• No.2 idler pulley
• RH camshaft timing pulley
• No.1 idler pulley
EG2–52
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
8. SET TIMING BELT TENSIONER
(a) Using a press, slowly press in the push rod using 981
–9,807 N (1100–1,000 kgf, 200–2,205 Ibf) of pres–
sure.
(b) Align the holes of the push rod and housing, pass a
1.27 mm hexagon wrench through the holes to keep
the setting position of the push rod.
(c) Release the press.
(d) Install the dust boot to the tensioner.
9. INSTALL TIMING BELT TENSIONER
(a) Temporarily install the tensioner with the 2 bolts.
(b) Alternately tighten the 2 bolts.
Torque: 27 N–m (280 kgf–cm, 20 ft–lbf)
(c) Remove the 1.27 mm hexagon wrench from the tensi–
oner.
10. CHECK VALVE TIMING
(a) Turn the crankshaft, and align the crankshaft timing
pulley groove with the oil pump alignment mark.
NOTICE: Always turn the crankshaft clockwise.
EG2–53
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE – ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b) Check that the timing marks of the RH and LH timing
pulleys with the timing marks of the No.3 timing belt
cover as shown in the illustration.
If the marks do not align, remove the timing belt and
reinstall it.
(c) Remove the crankshaft pulley bolt.
11. INSTALL TIMING BELT GUIDE
Install the belt guide, facing the cup side outward.
12. INSTALL ENGINE RH MOUNTING BRACKET
Install the mounting bracket with the 2 bolts and nut.
Torque: 28 N–m (290 kgf–cm, 21 ft–lbf)
13. INSTALL N0.2 TIMING BELT COVER
(a) Check that the timing belt cover gasket has no cracks
or peeling, etc.
If the gasket does have cracks or peeling, etc., replace
it using following steps.
(1) Using a screwdriver and gasket scraper, remove
all the old gasket material.
(2) Thoroughly clean all components to remove all
the loose material.
(3) Remove the backing paper from a new gasket
and install the gasket evenly to the part of the
belt cover shaded black in the illustration.
(4) After installing the gasket, press down on it sc
that the adhesive firmly sticks to the belt cover.
(b) Install new gasket to the No.2 belt cover.
EG2–54
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c) Install the belt cover with the 5 bolts.
Torque: 8.5 N–m (85 kgf–cm. 74 in.–lbf)
14. CONNECT ENGINE WIRE
(a) Connect the engine wire with the clamp.
(b) Install the bolt holding the engine wire to the No.3
timing belt cover.
15. INSTALL NO.1 TIMING BELT COVER
(a) Check that the timing belt cover gaskets have cracks
or peeling, etc.
If the gasket does have cracks or peeling, etc., replace
it using following steps, peeling, etc., replace them
using following steps.
(1) Using a screwdriver and gasket scraper, remove
all the old gasket material.
(2) Thoroughly clean all components to remove all
the loose material.
(3) Remove the backing paper from a new gasket
and install the gasket evenly to the part of the
belt cover shaded back in the illustration.
NOTICE: When joining 2 gaskets, do not leave a gap
between them. Cut off any excess gasket.
(4) After installing the gasket, press down on it so
that the adhesive firmly sticks to the belt cover.
(b) Install new gaskets to the No.1 belt cover.
(c) Install the belt cover with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 8.5 N–m (85 kgf–cm, 74 in.–lbf)
EG2–55
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
16. INSTALL CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
(a) Align the pulley set key with the key groove of the
pulley, and slide the pulley.
(b) Using SST, install and torque the bolt.
SST 09213–54015, 09330–00021
Torque: 216 N–m (2,200 kgf–cm, 159 ft–lbf)
17. INSTALL NO.2 GENERATOR BRACKET
Install the bracket with the pivot bolt and nut. Do not
tighten the bolt yet.
Torque: 28 N–m (290 kgf–cm, 21 ft–lbf) for Nut
18. INSTALL NO.2 RH ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET
AND ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD
Install the mounting bracket and control rod with the
3 bolts.
Torque: 63.7 N–m (650 kgf–cm, 47 ft–lbf)
19. INSTALL RH ENGINE MOUNTING STAY
Install the mounting stay with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 31.4 N–m (320 kgf–cm. 23 ft–lbf)
24. CONNECT GROUND STRAPS
Connect the 2 straps.
EG2–56
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE – ENGINE MECHANICAL
21. INSTALL AND ADJUST PS DRIVE BELT
Install the drive belt with the pivot and adjusting bolts.
Drive belt tension:
New belt
150 ± 185 I bf
Used belt
115 ± 20 lbf
22. INSTALL GENERATOR DRIVE BELT
Adjust the drive belt. (See CH section)
Drive belt tension:
New belt
175 ± 5 lbf
Used belt
115 ± 20 lbf
23. INSTALL COOLANT RESERVOIR TANK
24. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE TO
BATTERY
25. START ENGINE, AND CHECK FOR ABNORMAL
NOISE AND SMOOTH OPERATION
26. INSTALL RH FENDER APRON SEAL
27. INSTALL RH FRONT WHEEL
EG2–57
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
CYLINDER HEAD
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
EG2–58
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
EG2–59
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
EG2–60
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
EG2–61
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
EG2–62
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
CYLINDER HEADS REMOVAL
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. REMOVE BATTERY AND TRAY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
3. DISCONNECT ACCELERATOR CABLE
4. DISCONNECT THROTTLE CABLE
5. REMOVE AIR CLEANER CAP, VOLUME AIR FLOW
METER AND AIR CLEANER HOSE
(a) Disconnect the volume air flow meter connector and
wire clamp.
(b) Disconnect the accelerator cable clamp.
(c) Disconnect the PCV hose.
(d) Loosen the air cleaner hose clamp bolt.
(e) Disconnect the 4 air cleaner cap clips.
(f) Remove the air cleaner cap and volume air flow meter
together with the air cleaner hose.
6. w/ CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM:
REMOVE CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
(a) Remove the bolt, clip and actuator cover.
(b) Disconnect the actuator connector and clamp.
(c) Remove the 3 bolts, and disconnect the actuator with
the bracket.
7. DISCONNECT GROUND STRAPS
Disconnect the 2 straps.
EG2–63
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
8. REMOVE RH ENGINE MOUNTING STAY
Remove the 3 bolts and RH engine mounting stay.
9. DISCONNECT RADIATOR HOSES
10. DISCONNECT HEATER HOSES
Disconnect the 2 hoses.
11. DISCONNECT FUEL HOSES
Disconnect the fuel inlet and return hoses.
CAUTION: Catch leaking fuel in a container.
12. DISCONNECT PRESSURE HOSE OF HYDRAULIC
MOTOR
Remove the bolt, and disconnect the pressure hose
from the water inlet.
EG2–64
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE – ENGINE MECHANICAL
13. REMOVE V – BANK COVER
Using a 5 mm hexagon wrench, remove the 2 nuts and
V–bank cover.
14. REMOVE EMISSION CONTROL VALVE SET
(a) Disconnect the following vacuum hoses:
(1) Vacuum hose from fuel pressure control VSV
(2) Vacuum hose from fuel pressure regulator
(3) Vacuum hose from cylinder head rear plate
(4) Vacuum hose from intake air control valve VSV
(5) Vacuum hose from EGR vacuum modulator
(6) Vacuum hose from EGR valve
(b) Disconnect the following connectors:
(1) Intake air control valve connector
(2) Fuel pressure connector
(3) EGR VSV connector
(c) Remove the 2 nuts and emission control valve set.
15. REMOVE AIR INTAKE CHAMBER
(a) Disconnect the following hoses:
(1) Brake booster vacuum hose
(2) PCV hose
(3) Intake air control valve vacuum hose
(b) Disconnect the data link connector 1.
(c) Remove the nut and disconnect the 2 ground straps.
EG2–65
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE – ENGINE MECHANICAL
(d) Remove the bolt and disconnect the hydraulic motor
pressure hose from the air intake chamber.
(e) Remove the bolt, and disconnect the ground strap.
(f) Disconnect the RH oxygen sensor connector clamp
from the PS pressure tube.
(g) Remove the 2 nuts, and disconnect the PS pressure
tube.
(h) Disconnect the 2 PS air hoses.
(i) Remove the 2 bolts and No.1 engine hanger.
(j) Remove the 2 bolts and air intake chamber stay.
(k) Remove the 4 nuts, EGR pipe and 2 gaskets.
EG2–66
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(I) Disconnect the following connectors:
(1) Throttle position sensor connector
(2) IAC valve connector
(3) EGR gas temperature sensor connector
(4) A/C idle–up connector
(m) Disconnect the following vacuum hoses:
(1) 2 vacuum hoses from TVV
(2) Vacuum hose from cylinder head rear plate
(3) Vacuum hose from charcoal canister
(n) Disconnect the following hoses:
(1) 2 water bypass hoses
(2) Air assist hose
(o) Using an 8 mm hexagon wrench, remove the 2 bolts,
2 nuts, air intake chamber and gasket.
EG2–67
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
16. REMOVE INTAKE AIR CONTROL VALVE FROM AIR
INTAKE CHAMBER
(a) Disconnect the A/C air hose.
(b) Remove the 3 nuts and data link connector 1 clamp.
(c) Remove the intake air control valve by prying a screw–
driver between the intake air control valve and air
intake chamber.
(d) Remove the gasket.
17. REMOVE A/C IDLE–UP VSV FROM AIR INTAKE
CHAMBER
(a) Disconnect the air hose.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and A/C idle–up VSV.
18. REMOVE THROTTLE BODY FROM AIR INTAKE
CHAMBER
(a) Disconnect the following vacuum hoes:
(1) Vacuum hose from P port of EGR vacuum modu–
lator
(2) Vacuum hose from R port of EGR vacuum modu–
lator
(b) Remove the 2 bolts, 2 nuts, throttle body and gasket.
19. REMOVE EGR VALVE AND VACUUM MODULATOR
FROM AIR INTAKE CHAMBER
Remove the 3 nuts, EGR valve, vacuum modulator and
gasket.
20. DISCONNECT ENGINE WIRE FROM ENGINE LH
SIDE
(a) Disconnect the following connectors:
(1) 3 injector connectors
(2) 3 ignition coil connectors
(b) Remove the 2 nuts, and disconnect the engine wire.
EG2–68
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
21. DISCONNECT ENGINE WIRE FROM NO.3 TIMING
BELT COVER
Disconnect the 2 clamps and engine wire.
22. DISCONNECT ENGINE WIRE FROM ENGINE REAR
SIDE
(a) Disconnect the following connectors:
(1) LH oxygen sensor
(2) Engine coolant temperature sensor
(3) Camshaft position sensor
(b) Disconnect the 3 clamps.
(c) Remove the 2 nuts, and disconnect the engine wire.
23. DISCONNECT ENGINE WIRE FROM ENGINE RH
SIDE
(a) Disconnect the following connectors:
(1) 3 injector connectors
(2) 3 ignition coil connectors
(3) Water temperature sender gauge connector
(4) Water temperature sensor connector
(5) RH oxygens sensor connector
(b) Remove the 5 nuts, and disconnect the engine wire.
EG2–69
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
24. REMOVE IGNITION COILS
Remove the6 bolts and6 ignition coils from the RH
and LH cylinder heads.
HINT: Arrange the ignition coils in the correct order.
25. REMOVE SPARK PLUGS
Using a 16 mm plug wrench, remove the6 spark plugs
from the RH and LH cylinder heads.
26. REMOVE FRONT EXHAUST PIPE
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and front exhaust pipe clamp.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts, and disconnect the bracket.
(c) Remove the 2 bolts and 2 nuts holding the front
exhaust pipe to the three–way catalytic converter.
(d) Remove the 4 nuts holding the front exhaust pipe to
the exhaust manifolds.
(e) Remove the front exhaust pipe and gaskets.
EG2–70
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
27. REMOVE TIMING BELT
(See steps 2 to 20 on pages EG2–41 to 45)
28. REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEYS
(a) Using SST, remove the bolt and RH timing pulley.
SST 09249–63010, 09960–10010 (09862–01000)
(b) Using SST, remove the LH timing pulley.
SST 09960–10010 (09962–01000)
HINT: Arrange the camshaft timing pulleys (RH and
LH sides).
29. REMOVE NO.2 IDLER PULLEY
Remove the bolt and idler pulley.
EG2–71
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
30. REMOVE NO.3 TIMING BELT COVER
Remove the 6 bolts and belt cover.
31. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD REAR PLATE
(a) Disconnect the vacuum hose from the vacuum tank.
(b) Remove the nut, and disconnect the ground strap.
(c) Remove the bolt and rear plate.
32. REMOVE WATER INLET PIPE
(a) Remove the bolt and inlet pipe.
(b) Remove the O–ring.
33. REMOVE AIR ASSIST HOSE AND VACUUM HOSE
34. REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD, DELIVERY PIPES
AND INJECTORS
Remove the 9 bolts, 2 nuts, 2 plate washers and
intake manifold together with the delivery pipes, and
injectors.
EG2–72
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
35. REMOVE FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR FROM LH
DELIVERY PIPE
(a) Remove the 2 bolts, and pull out the pressure regula–
tor.
(b) Remove the 0–ring from the pressure regulator.
36. REMOVE TVV FROM INTAKE MANIFOLD
37. REMOVE FUEL PULSATION DAMPER AND No.1
FUEL PIPE
Remove the bolt, pulsation damper, No. 1 fuel pipe and
2 gaskets.
38. REMOVE No.2 FUEL PIPE
Remove the 2 union bolts, No.2 fuel pipe and 4 gas–
kets.
39. REMOVE DELIVERY PIPES AND INJECTORS
(a) Remove the 4 bolts, delivery pipes together with the 6
injectors.
NOTICE: Be careful not to drop the injectors when rem–
oving the delivery pipes.
(b) Remove the 4 spacers from the intake manifold.
EG2–73
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c) Pull out the 6 injectors from the delivery pipes.
Remove the 0–ring and grommet from each injector.
40. REMOVE WATER OUTLET
(a) Remove the 2 bolts, 2 nuts and 2 plate washers.
(b) Disconnect the water bypass hose and remove the
water outlet.
(c) Remove the 2 intake manifold gaskets.
41. REMOVE No.2 ENGINE HANGER
Remove the 2 bolts and engine hanger.
42. REMOVE LH EXHAUST MANIFOLD
(a) Remove the main heated oxygen sensor (Bank 2
Sensor 1).
(b) Remove the bolt, nut and exhaust manifold stay.
EG2–74
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c) Remove the 6 nuts, exhaust manifold and gasket.
43. REMOVE OIL DIPSTICK AND GUIDE
(a) Remove the bolt holding the dipstick guide to the LH
cylinder head.
(b) Pull out the dipstick guide together with the dipstick
from the No.1 oil pan.
(c) Remove 0–ring from the dipstick guide.
44. REMOVE PS BRACKET
Remove the 3 bolts and PS bracket.
45. REMOVE RH EXHAUST MANIFOLD
(a) Remove the main heated oxygen sensor (Bank 1
Sensor 1).
(b) Remove the 4 nuts, EGR pipe and 2 gaskets.
EG2–75
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c) Remove the bolts, 2 nuts, exhaust manifold stay and
exhaust manifold plate.
(d) Remove the 6 nuts, exhaust manifold and gasket.
46. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVERS
Remove the 8 bolts, cylinder head cover and gasket.
Remove the 2 cylinder head covers.
47. REMOVE CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Remove the bolt and position sensor.
(b) Remove the gasket from the position sensor.
48. REMOVE CAMSHAFTS
NOTICE: Since the thrust clearance of the camshaft is
small, the camshaft must be held level while it is being
removed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the portion of
the cylinder head receiving the shaft thrust may crack or
be damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To
avoid this, the following steps should be carried out.
EG2–76
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE – ENGINE MECHANICAL
A. Remove intake camshaft of RH cylinder head
(a) Align the timing marks (2 dot marks) of the camshaft
drive and driven gears by turning the camshaft with a
wrench.
(b) Secure the exhaust camshaft sub–gear to the main
gear with a service bolt.
Recommended service bolt:
Thread diameter 6 mm
Thread pitch 1.0 mm
Bolt length 16–20 mm
HINT: When removing the camshaft, mark certain that
the torsional spring force of the sub–gear has been
eliminated by the above operation.
(c) Uniformly loosen and remove the 10 bearing cap
bolts, in several passes, in the sequence shown.
(d) Remove the 5 bearing caps and intake camshaft.
B. Remove exhaust camshaft of RH cylinder head
(a) Uniformly loosen and remove the 10 bearing cap
bolts, in several passes, in the sequence shown.
(b) Remove the 5 bearing caps, oil seal and exhaust cam–
shaft.
C. Remove intake camshaft of LH cylinder head
(a) Align the timing marks (11 dot mark) of the camshaft
drive and driven gears by turning the camshaft with a
wrench.
EG2–77
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b) Secure the exhaust camshaft sub–gear to the main
gear with a service bolt.
Recommended service bolt:
Thread diameter 6 mm
Thread pitch 1.0 mm
Bolt length 16–20 mm
HINT: When removing the camshaft, make sure that
the torsional spring force of the sub–gear has been
eliminated by the above operation.
(c) Uniformly loosen and remove the 10 bearing cap
bolts, in several passes, in the sequence shown.
(d) Remove the 5 bearing caps and intake camshaft.
D. Remove exhaust camshaft of LH cylinder head
(a) Uniformly loosen and remove the 10 bearing cap
bolts, in several passes, in the sequence shown.
(b) Remove the 5 bearing caps, oil seal and exhaust cam–
shaft.
HINT:
• Arrange the camshafts in the correct order.
• Arrange the bearing caps in the correct order.
EG2–78
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
49. DISASSEMBLE EXHAUST CAMSHAFTS
(a) Mount the hexagonal wrench head portion of the
camshaft in a vise.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the camshaft.
(b) Using SST, turn the sub–gear counterclockwise, and
remove the service bolt.
SST 09960–10010 (09962–0100)
(c) Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring.
(d) Remove the following parts:
(1) Wave washer
(2) Camshaft sub–gear
(3) Camshaft gear spring
HINT: Arrange the camshaft sub–gears and gear spr–
ings (RH and LH sides).
EG2–79
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
50. REMOVE CYLINDER HEADS
(a) Using a 8 mm hexagon wrench, remove the cylinder
head (recessed head) bolt on each cylinder head, then
repeat for the other side, as shown.
(b) Uniformly loosen and remove the 8 cylinder head (12
pointed head) bolts on each cylinder head, in several
passes, in the sequence shown, then repeat for the
other side, as shown.
Remove the 16 cylinder head bolts and plate washers.
NOTICE: Head warpage or cracking could result from
removing bolts in an incorrect order.
(c) Lift the cylinder head from the dowels on the cylinder
block and place the 2 cylinder heads on wooden
blocks on a bench.
HINT: If the cylinder head is difficult to lift off, pry
with a screwdriver between the cylinder head and
cylinder block saliences.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the contact surfaces
of the cylinder head and cylinder block.
EG2–80
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
CYLINDER HEAD DISASSEMBLY
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. REMOVE VALVE LIFTERS AND SHIMS
HINT: Arrange the valve lifters and shims in the cor–
rect order.
2. REMOVE VALVES
(a) Using SST, compress the valve spring and remove the
2 keepers.
SST 09202 – 70010
(b) Remove the following parts:
(1) Spring retainer
(2) Valve spring
(3) Valve
(c) Using needle–nose pliers, remove the oil seal.
EG2–81
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(d) Using compressed air and a magnetic finger, remove
the spring seat by blowing air.
HINT: Arrange the valves, valve springs, spring seats
and spring retainers in the correct order.
CYLINDER HEAD COMPONENTS
INSPECTION AND REPAIR
1. CLEAN TOP SURFACES OF PISTONS AND
CYLINDER BLOCK
(a) Turn the crankshaft, and bring each piston to top dead
center (TDC). Using a gasket scraper, remove all the
carbon from the piston top surface.
(b) Using a gasket scraper, remove all the gasket material
from the cylinder block surface.
(c) Using compressed air, blow carbon and oil from the
bolt holes.
CAUTION: Protect your eyes when using high pressure
compressed air.
2. CLEAN CYLINDER HEAD
A. Remove gasket material
Using a gasket scraper, remove all the gasket material
from the cylinder block contact surface.
NOTICE: Be careful not to scratch the cylinder block
contact surface.
EG2–82
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
B. Clean combustion chambers
Using a wire brush, remove all the carbon from the
combustion chambers.
NOTICE: Be careful not to scratch the cylinder block
contact surface.
C. Clean cylinder head
Using a soft brush and solvent, thoroughly clean the
cylinder head.
D. Clean valve guide bushings
Using a valve guide bushing brush and solvent, clean
all the guide bushings.
3. INSPECT CYLINDER HEAD
A. Inspect for flatness
Using a precision straight edge and feeler gauge, mea–
sure the surfaces contacting the cylinder block and
the manifolds for warpage.
Maximum warpage:
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
If warpage is greater than maximum, replace the cylin–
der head.
EG2–83
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
B. Inspect for cracks
Using a dye penetrant, check the combustion cham–
ber, intake ports, exhaust ports and cylinder block
surface for cracks.
If cracked, replace the cylinder head.
4. CLEAN VALVES
(a) Using a gasket scraper, chip off any carbon from the
valve head.
(b) Using a wire brush, thoroughly clean the valve.
5. INSPECT VALVE STEMS AND GUIDE BUSHINGS
(a) Using a caliper gauge, measure the inside diameter of
the guide bushing.
Bushing inside diameter:
5.510 – 5.530 mm (0.2169 – 0.2177 in.)
(b) Using a micrometer, measure the diameter of the
valve stem.
Valve stem diameter:
Intake
5.470 – 5.485 mm (0.2154 – 0.2159 in.)
Exhaust
5.465 – 5.480 mm (0.2152 – 0.2157 in.)
(c) Subtract the valve stem diameter measurement from
the guide bushing inside diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
Intake
0.025 – 0.060 mm (0.0010 – 0.0024 in.)
Exhaust
0.030 – 0.065 mm (0.0012 – 0.0026 in.)
EG2–84
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Maximum oil clearance:
Intake
0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
Exhaust
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
If the clearance is greater than maximum, replace the
valve and guide bushing.
6. IF NECESSARY, REPLACE VALVE GUIDE
BUSHINGS
(a) Gradually heat the cylinder head to 80 – 100 C (176
– 212 F).
(b) Using SST and a hammer, tap out the guide bushing.
SST 09201– 01055, 09608–20012 (09608–03020)
(c) Using a caliper gauge, measure the bushing bore di–
ameter of the cylinder head.
Both intake and exhaust
Bushing bore diameter
Bushing size
mm (in.)
10.295 –10.313
Use STD
(0.4053 – 0.4060)
10.345 – 10.363
(0.4073 – 0.4080)
Use O/S 0.05
(d) Select a new guide bushing (STD or O/S 0.05).
If the bushing bore diameter of the cylinder head is
greater than 10.313 mm (0.4060 in.), machine the
bushing bore to the following dimension:
10.345 – 10.363 mm (0.4073 – 0.4080 in.)
If the bushing bore diameter of the cylinder head is
greater than 10.363 mm (0.4080 in.), replace the
cylinder head.
EG2–85
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
HINT: Different bushings are used for the intake and
exhaust.
(e) Gradually heat the cylinder head to 80 – 100C (176
– 212F).
(f) Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new guide bushing
to the specified protrusion height.
SST 09201– 01055, 09608–20012 (09608–03020)
Protrusion height:
Intake
11.1 – 11.3 mm (0.437 – 0.445 in.)
Exhaust
8.9 – 9.3 mm (0.350 – 0.366 in.)
(h) Using a sharp 5.5 mm reamer, ream the guide bushing
to obtain the standard specified clearance (See step 5
above) between the guide bushing and valve stem.
7. INSPECT AND GRIND VALVES
(a) Grind the valve enough to remove pits and carbon.
(b) Check that the valve is ground to the correct valve
face angle.
Valve face angle:
44.5
EG2–86
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c) Check the valve head margin thickness.
Standard margin thickness:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Minimum margin thickness:
0.5 mm (0.020 in.)
If the margin thickness is less than minimum, replace
the valve.
(d) Check the valve overall length.
Standard overall length:
Intake
95.45 mm (3.5779 in.)
Exhaust
95.40 mm (3.7559 in.)
Minimum overall length:
Intake
94.95 mm (3.7382 in.)
Exhaust
94.90 mm (3.7362 in.)
If the overall length is less than minimum, replace the
valve.
(e) Check the surface of the valve stem tip for wear.
If the valve stem tip is worn, resurface the tip with a
grinder or replace the valve.
NOTICE: Do not grind off more than minimum.
8. INSPECT AND CLEAN VALVE SEATS
(a) Using a 45 carbide cutter, resurface the valve seats.
Remove only enough metal to clean the seats.
EG2–87
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b) Check the valve seating position.
Apply a light coat of prussian blue (or white lead) to
the valve face. Lightly press the valve against the
seat. Do not rotate valve.
(c) Check the valve face and seat for the following:
• If blue appears 360 around the face, the valve is
concentric. If not, replace the valve.
• If blue appears 360 around the valve seat, the
guide and face are concentric. If not, resurface
the seat.
• Check that the seat contact is in the middle of the
valve face with the following width:
1.0 – 1.4 mm (0.039 – 0.055 In.)
If not, correct the valve seats as follows:
(1) If the seating is too high on the valve face, use
30 and 45 cutters to correct the seat.
(2) If the seating is too low on the valve face, use
75 and 45 cutters to correct the seat.
(d) Hand–lap the valve and valve seat with an abrasive
compound.
(e) After hand–lapping, clean the valve and valve seat.
9. INSPECT VALVE SPRINGS
(a) Using a steel square, measure the deviation of the
valve spring.
Maximum deviation:
2.0 mm (0.079 in.)
If the deviation is greater than maximum, replace the
valve spring.
EG2–88
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b) Using a vernier caliper, measure the free length of the
valve spring.
Free length:
45.50 mm (1.7913 in.)
If the free length is not as specified, replace the valve
spring.
(c) Using a spring tester, measure the tension of the valve
spring at the specified installed length.
Installed tension:
186 – 206 N (19.0 – 21.0 kgf, 41.9 – 46.3 lbf)
at 33.8 mm (1.331 in.)
If the installed tension is not as specified, replace the
valve spring.
10. INSPECT CAMSHAFTS AND BEARINGS
A. Inspect camshaft for runout
(a) Place the camshaft on V – blocks.
(b) Using a dial indicator, measure the circle runout at the
center journal.
Maximum circle runout:
0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
If the circle runout is greater than maximum, replace
the camshaft.
B. Inspect cam lobes
Using a micrometer, measure the cam lobe height.
Standard cam lobe height:
Intake
42.11 – 42.21 mm (1.6579 – 1.6618 in.)
Exhaust
41.96 – 42.06 mm (1.6520 – 1.6559 in.)
Minimum cam lobe height:
Intake
41.96 mm (1.6520 in.)
Exhaust
41.81 mm (1.6461 in.)
If the cam lobe height is less than minimum, replace
the camshaft.
EG2–89
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
C. Inspect camshaft journals
Using a micrometer, measure the journal diameter.
Journal diameter:
26.949 – 26.965 mm (1.0610 – 1.061 6 in.)
If the journal diameter is not as specified, check the oil
clearance.
D. Inspect camshaft bearings
Check that bearings for flaking and scoring.
If the bearings are damaged, replace the bearing caps
and cylinder head as a set.
E. Inspect camshaft journal oil clearance
(a) Clean the bearing caps and camshaft journals.
(b) Place the camshafts on the cylinder head.
(c) Lay a strip of Plastigage across each of the camshaft
journals.
(d) Install the bearing caps.
(See step 3 on pages EG2–98 to 102)
Torque: 16 N–m (160 kgf–cm, 12 ft–lbf)
NOTICE: Do not turn the camshaft.
(e) Remove the bearing caps.
EG2–90
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(f) Measure the Plastigage at its widest point.
Standard oil clearance:
0.035 – 0.072 mm (0.0014 – 0.0028 in.)
Maximum oil clearance:
0.10 mm (0.0039 fn.)
If the oil clearance is greater than maximum, replace
the camshaft. If necessary, replace the bearing caps
and cylinder head as a set.
(g) Completely remove the Plastigage.
(h) Remove the camshafts.
F. Inspect camshaft thrust clearance
(a) Install the camshafts.
(See step 3 on pages EG2–98 to 102)
(b) Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance
while moving the camshaft back and forth.
Standard thrust clearance:
0.040 – 0.090 mm (0.0016 – 0.0035 in.)
Maximum thrust clearance:
0.12 mm (0.0047 in.)
If the thrust clearance is greater than maximum, re–
place the camshaft. If necessary, replace the bearing
caps and cylinder head as a set.
(c) Remove the camshafts.
G. Inspect camshaft gear backlash
(a) Install the camshafts without installing the exhaust
cam sub–gear.
(See step 3 on pages EG2–98 to 102)
(b) Using a dial indicator, measure the backlash.
Standard backlash:
0.020 – 0.200 mm (0.0008 – 0.0079 In.)
Maximum backlash:
0.30 mm (0.0188 in.)
If the backlash is greater then maximum, replace the
camshafts.
(c) Remove the camshafts.
EG2–91
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
H. Inspect camshaft gear spring
Using a vernier caliper, measure the free distance
between the spring ends.
Free distance:
18.2 – 18.8 mm (0.712 – 0.740 in.)
If the free distance is not as specified, replace the gear
spring.
11. INSPECT VALVE LIFTERS AND LIFTER BORES
(a) Using a caliper gauge, measure the lifter bore diame–
ter of the cylinder head.
Lifter bore diameter:
31.000 – 31.018 mm (1.2205 – 1.2212 in.)
(b) Using a micrometer, measure the lifter diameter.
Lifter diameter:
30.966 – 30.976 mm (1.2191 – 1.2196 in.)
(c) Subtract the lifter diameter measurement from the
lifter bore diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
0.024 – 0.050 mm (0.0009 – 0.0020 in.)
Maximum oil clearance:
0.07 mm (0.0028 In.)
If the oil clearance is greater than maximum, replace
the lifter. If necessary, replace the cylinder head.
12. INSPECT AIR INTAKE CHAMBER
Using a precision straight edge and feeler gauge, mea–
sure the surface contacting the intake manifold for
warpage.
Maximum warpage:
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
If warpage is greater than maximum, replace the cha–
mber.
EG2–92
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
13. INSPECT INTAKE MANIFOLD
Using a precision straight edge and feeler gauge, mea–
sure the surface contacting the cylinder head and air
intake chamber for warpage.
Maximum warpage:
Air Intake Chamber Side
0.15 mm (0.0059 in.)
Cylinder Head Side
0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
If warpage is greater than maximum, replace the man–
ifold.
14. INSPECT EXHAUST MANIFOLD
Using a precision straight edge and feeler gauge, mea–
sure the surface contacting the cylinder head for war–
page.
Maximum warpage:
0.50 mm (0.0196 in.)
If warpage is greater than maximum, replace the man–
ifold.
15. INSPECT CYLINDER HEAD BOLTS
(for 12 Pointed Head Bolts)
Using a caliper gauge, measure the thread outside
diameter of the bolt.
Standard outside diameter:
8.95 – 9.05 mm (0.3524 – 0.3563 in.)
Minimum outside diameter:
8.75 mm (0.3445 in.)
If the diameter is less than minimum, replace the bolt.
EG2–93
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
16. IF NECESSARY, REPLACE SPARK PLUG TUBE
GASKETS
(a) Bend up the tab on the ventilation baffle plate which
prevents the gasket from the slipping out.
(b) Using a screwdriver and hammer, tap out the gasket.
(c) Using needle–nose pliers, ply out the gasket.
(d) Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new gasket until its
surface is flush with the upper edge of the cylinder
head cover.
SST 09608–20012 (09608–03070)
(e) Apply a light coat of MP grease to the gasket lip.
(f) Return the ventilation plate tab to its original position.
CYLINDER HEAD ASSEMBLY
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
HINT:
• Thoroughly clean all parts to be assembled.
• Before installing the parts, apply new engine oil
to all sliding and rotating surfaces.
• Replace all gaskets and oil seals with new ones.
1. INSTALL SPARK PLUG TUBES
HINT: When using a new cylinder head, spark plug
tubes must be installed.
(a) Apply adhesive to the end of the spark plug tube.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08833–00070, THREE BOND 1324
or equivalent
EG2–94
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b) Using a press, press in a new spark plug tube until
there is 42.4 – 43.4 mm (1.669 – 1.749) protruding
from the camshaft bearing cap installation surface of
the cylinder head.
NOTICE: Avoid pressing a new spark plug tube In too far
by measuring the amount of the protrusion while press–
ing.
2. INSTALL PCV PIPES
HINT: When using a new cylinder head, PCV pipe
must be installed.
Using a wooden block and hammer, tap in a new spark
tube until its top side is flush with the cylinder head
edge.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the cylinder head
edge.
3. INSTALL VALVES
(a) Using SST, push in a new oil seal.
SST 09201 –41020
HINT: The intake valve oil seal is silver and the ex–
haust valve oil seal is black.
(b) Install the following parts:
(1) Valve
(2) Spring seat
(3) Valve spring
(4) Spring retainer
EG2–95
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c) Using SST, compress the valve spring and place the 2
keepers around the valve stem.
SST 09202 – 70010
(d) Using a plastic–faced hammer, lightly tap the valve
stem tip to ensure a proper fit.
4. INSTALL VALVE LIFTERS AND SHIMS
(a) Install the valve lifter and shim.
(b) Check that the valve lifter rotates smoothly by hand.
EG2–96
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
CYLINDER HEAD INSTALLATION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. INSTALL CYLINDER HEADS
A. Place cylinder head on cylinder block
(a) Place 2 new cylinder head gaskets in position on the
cylinder block.
NOTICE: Be careful of the installation direction.
(b) Place the 2 cylinder heads in position on the cylinder
head gaskets.
B. Install cylinder head (12 pointed head) bolts
HINT:
• The cylinder head bolts are tightened in 2 pro–
gressive steps (steps (b) and (d)).
• If any bolt is broken or deformed, replace it.
(a) Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and
under the heads of the cylinder head bolts.
(b) Install and uniformly tighten the . cylinder head bolts
on each cylinder head, in several passes, in the se–
quence shown, then repeat for the other side, as
shown.
Torque: 64 N–m (550 kgf–cm, 40 ft–lbf)
If any of the cylinder head bolts does not meet the
torque specification, replace the cylinder head bolt.
(c) Mark the front of the cylinder head bolt head with
paint.
(d) Retighten the cylinder head bolts by 90 in the numer–
ical order shown.
(e) Check that the painted mark is now at a 90 angle to
the front.
EG2–97
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
C. Install cylinder head (recessed head) bolts
(a) Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and
under the heads of the cylinder head bolts.
(b) Using a 8 mm hexagon wrench, install the cylinder
head bolt on each cylinder head, then repeat for the
other side, as shown.
Torque: 18.5 N–m (185 kgf–cm, 13 ft–lbf)
2. ASSEMBLY EXHAUST CAMSHAFTS
(a) Mount the hexagonal wrench head portion of the
camshaft in a vise.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the camshaft.
(b) Install the following parts:
(1) Camshaft gear spring
(2) Camshaft sub–gear
(3) Wave washer
(c) Using snap ring pliers, install the snap ring.
EG2–98
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(d) Using SST, align the holes of the camshaft main gear
and sub–gear by turning camshaft sub–gear coun–
terclockwise, and install a service bolt.
SST 09960–10010 (09962–0100)
HINT: Align the pins on the gears with the gear spring
ends.
3. INSTALL CAMSHAFTS
NOTICE: Since the thrust clearance of the camshaft is
small, the camshaft must be held level while it Is being
installed. If the camshaft Is not level, the portion of the
cylinder head receiving the shaft thrust may crack or be
damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To
avoid this, the following steps should be carried out.
A. Install exhaust camshaft of RH cylinder head
(a) Apply new engine oil to the thrust portion and journal
of the camshaft.
(b) Place the exhaust camshaft at 90 angle of timing
mark (2 dot marks) on the cylinder head.
(c) Apply MP grease to a new oil seal lip.
(d) Install the oil seal to the camshaft.
EG2–99
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(e) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material.
(f) Apply seal packing to the No. 1 bearing cap as shown.
Seal packing:
Part No. 08826–00080 or equivalent
(g) Install the 5 bearing caps in their proper locations.
(h) Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and
under the heads of the bearing cap bolts.
(i) Install and uniformly tighten the 10 bearing cap bolts,
in several passes, in the sequence shown.
Torque: 16 N–m (160 kgf–cm, 12 ft–lbf)
B. Install intake camshaft of RH cylinder head
(a) Apply new engine oil to the thrust portion and journal
of the camshaft.
(b) Align the timing marks (2 dot marks) of the camshaft
drive and driven gears.
(c) Place the intake camshaft on the cylinder head.
(d) Install the 5 bearing caps in their proper locations.
EG2–100
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(e) Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and
under the heads of the bearing cap bolts.
(f) Install and uniformly tighten the 10 bearing cap bolts,
in several passes, in the sequence shown.
Torque: 16 N–m (160 kgf–cm, 12 ft–Ibf)
(g) Remove the service bolt
C. Install exhaust camshaft of LH cylinder head
(a) Apply MP grease to the thrust portion of the cam–
shaft.
(b) Place the intake camshaft at 90 angle of timing mark
(1 dot mark) on the cylinder head.
(c) Apply MP grease to a new oil seal lip.
EG2–101
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(d) Install the oil seal to the camshaft.
(e) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material.
(f) Apply seal packing to the No. 1 bearing cap as shown.
Seal packing:
Part No. 08826–00080 or equivalent
(g) Install the 5 bearing caps in their proper locations.
(h) Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and
under the heads of the bearing cap bolts.
(i) Install and uniformly tighten the 10 bearing cap bolts,
in several passes, in the sequence shown.
Torque: 16 N–m (160 kgf–cm, 12 ft–lbf)
D. Install intake camshaft of LH cylinder head
(a) Apply MP grease to the thrust portion of the cam–
shaft.
(b) Align the timing marks (1 dot mark) of the camshaft
drive and driven gears.
(c) Place the intake camshaft on the cylinder head.
EG2–102
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(d) Install the 5 bearing caps in their proper locations.
(e) Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and
under the heads of bearing cap bolts.
(f) Install and uniformly tighten the 10 bearing cap bolts,
in several passes, in the sequence shown.
Torque: 16 N–m (160 kgf–cm, 12 ft–lbf)
(g) Remove the service bolt.
4. CHECK AND ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE
(See steps 17 to 19 on pages EG2–18 to 23)
Turn the camshaft and position the cam lobe upward,
and check and adjust the valve clearance.
Valve clearance (Cold):
Intake
0.15 – 0.25 mm (0.006 – 0.010 in.)
Exhaust
0.25–0.35mm(0.010–0.014in.)
6. INSTALL SEMI–CIRCULAR PLUGS
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material.
(b) Apply seal packing to the semi–circular plug grooves,
Seal packing:
Part No. 08826–00080 or equivalent
EG2–103
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c) Install the 4 semi–circular plugs to the cylinder
heads.
6. INSTALL CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Install a new gasket to the position sensor.
(b) Install the positron sensor with the bolt.
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–lbf)
7. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVERS
(a) Apply seal packing to the cylinder heads as shown in
the illustration.
Seal packing:
Part No. 08826–00080 or equivalent
EG2–104
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b) Install the gasket to the cylinder head cover.
(c) Install the cylinder head cover with the 8 bolts. Uni–
formly tighten the bolts in several passes. Install the 2
cylinder head covers.
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–lbf)
8. INSTALL RH EXHAUST MANIFOLD
(a) Install a new gasket and the exhaust manifold with the
6 nuts.
Torque: 49 N–m (500 kgf–cm, 36 ft–lbf)
(b) Install the exhaust manifold stay and plate with the
bolt and 2 nuts.
Torque: 19.5 N–m (200 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
HINT: Install the manifold stay so that the tip of the
stay touches the head of the differential retainer in–
stalllation bolt as shown in the illustration.
(c) Install 2 new gaskets and the EGR pipe with the 4
nuts.
Torque: 12 N–m (120 kgf–cm, 9 ft–lbf)
(d) Install the main heated oxygen sensor (Bank 1 Sensor
1).
Torque: 44 N–m (450 kgf–cm, 33 ft–lbf)
EG2–105
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
9. INSTALL PS BRACKET
Install the PS bracket with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 43 N–m (440 kgf–cm, 32 ft–lbf)
10. INSTALL OIL DIPSTICK AND GUIDE
(a) Install a new O–ring to the dipstick guide.
(b) Apply soapy water to the 0– ring.
(c) Push in the dipstick guide end into the guide hole of
the No. 1 oil pan.
(d) Install the dipstick guide with the bolt.
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–lbf)
(e) Install the dipstick.
11. INSTALL LH EXHAUST MANIFOLD
(a) Install a new gasket and the exhaust manifold with the
6 nuts.
Torque: 49 N–m (500 kgf–cm, 36 ft–lbf)
(b) Install the exhaust main manifold stay with the bolt
and nut.
Torque: 19.5 N–m (200 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
(c) Install the main heated oxygen sensor (Bank 2 Sensor
1).
Torque: 44 N–m (450 kgf–cm, 33 ft–lbf)
EG2–106
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
12. INSTALL No.2 ENGINE HANGER
Install the engine hanger with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 19.5 N–m (200 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
13. INSTALL WATER OUTLET
(a) Connect the water outlet to the bypass hose.
(b) Install 2 new gaskets and the water outlet with the 2
bolts, 2 nuts and 2 plate washers.
Torque: 15 N–m (150 kgf–cm, 11 ft–lbf)
NOTICE: Do not scratch the seal surface of the water
outlet with the stud bolt.
14. INSTALL INJECTORS AND DELIVERY PIPES
(a) Install 2 new grommets to each injector.
(b) Apply a light coat of gasoline to 2 new 0–rings and
install them to each injector.
(c) While turning the injector clockwise and counter–
clockwise, push it to the delivery pipes. Install the 6
injectors.
(d) Position the injector connector outward.
(e) Place the 4 spacers in position on the intake manifold.
EG2–107
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(f) Place the delivery pipes together with the 6 injectors
in position on the intake manifold.
(g) Temporarily install the 4 bolts holding the delivery
pipes to the intake manifold.
(h) Check that the injectors rotate smoothly.
HINT: If injectors do not rotate smoothly, the probable
cause is incorrect installation of O–rings. Replace the
O–rings.
(i) Position the injector connector outward.
(j) Tighten the 4 bolts holding the delivery pipes to the
intake manifold.
Torque: 10 N–m (100 kgf–cm, 7 ft–lbf)
15. INSTALL No.2 FUEL PIPE
Install the No.2 fuel pipe with the 2 union bolts and 4
gaskets.
Torque: 32.5 N–m (330 kgf–cm, 24 ft–lbf)
16. INSTALL NO.1 FUEL PIPE AND PULSATION
DAMPER
Install the No.1 fuel pipe with the pulsation damper, 4
new gaskets and bolt.
Torque: 32.5 N–m (330 kgf–cm, 24 ft–lbf) for Pulsation
damper
Torque: 15 N–m (150 kgf–cm, 11 ft–lbf) for Bolt
EG2–108
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
17. INSTALL TVV
(a) Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08833–00070, THREE BOND 1324
or equivalent
(b) Install the TVV.
Torque: 30 N–m (305 kgf–cm, 22 ft–lbf)
18. INSTALL FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR
(a) Apply a light coat of gasoline to a new 0–ring, and
install it to the pressure regulator.
(b) Attach the pressure regulator to the delivery pipe.
(c) Check that the pressure regulator rotates smoothly.
NOTICE: If it does not rotate smoothly, the O–ring may
be pinched, so remove the pressure regulator and repeat
steps (b) and (e) above.
EG2–109
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(d) Install the pressure regulator with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–lbf)
19. INSTALL INTAKE MANIFOLD
Install the intake manifold with the 9 bolts, 2 nuts and
2 plate washers.
Torque: 15 N–m (150 kgf–cm, 11 ft–lbf)
20. RETIGHTEN WATER OUTLET MOUNTING BOLTS
AND NUTS
Torque: 15 N–m (150 kgf–cm, 11 ft–lbf)
21. INSTALL AIR ASSIST HOSE
22. INSTALL WATER INLET PIPE
(a) Install a new O–ring to the water inlet pipe.
(b) Apply soapy water to the O–ring.
EG2–110
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c) Connect the water inlet pipe to the water inlet.
(d) Install the bolt holding the water inlet pipe to the
cylinder head.
Torque: 19.5 N–m (200 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
23. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD REAR PLATE
(a) Install the rear plate and grand strap with the bolt and
nut.
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–lbf)
(b) Connect the vacuum hose to the air intake chamber.
(c) Connect the 2 vacuum hoses to the vacuum tank.
24. INSTALL NO–3 TIMING BELT COVER
(a) Check that the timing belt cover gaskets have no
cracks or peeling, etc.
If the gaskets do have cracks or peeling etc., replace
them using following steps.
(1) Using a screwdriver and gasket scraper, remove
all the old gasket material.
(2) Thoroughly clean all components to remove all
the loose material.
(3) Remove the backing paper from a new gasket
and install the gasket evenly to the part of the
belt cover shaded black in the illustration.
NOTICE: When joining gaskets, do not leave a gap be–
tween them. Cut off any excess gasket.
(4) After installing the gasket, press down on it so
that the adhesive firmly sticks to the belt cover.
(b) Install new gaskets to the No.3 belt cover.
(c) Install the belt cover with the 6 bolts.
Torque: 8.5 N–m (85 kgf–cm, 74 in–lbf)
EG2–111
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
25. INSTALL NO.2 IDLER PULLEY
(a) Install the idler pulley with the bolt.
Torque: 43 N–m (440 kgf–cm, 32 ft–lbf)
(b) Check that the idler pulley moves smoothly.
26. INSTALL RH CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
(a) Install the timing pulley, facing the flange side out–
ward.
(b) Align the knock pin hole of the camshaft with the
knock pin groove of the timing pulley as shown.
(c) Using SST, install and torque the bolt.
SST 09249–63010, 09960–10010 (09962–01000)
Torque: 88 N–m (900 kgf–cm, 65 ft–lbf)
HINT: Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of
340 mm (13.39 in.)
27. INSTALL LH CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
(a) Install the timing pulley, facing the flange side inward.
(b) Align the knock pin hole of the camshaft with the
knock pin groove of the timing pulley as shown.
(d) Using SST, install and torque the bolt.
SST 09960–10010 (09962–01000)
Torque: 125 N–m (1,300 kgf–cm, 94 ft–lbf)
EG2–112
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
28. INSTALL TIMING BELT
(See steps 6 to 27 on pages EG2–51 to 66)
29. INSTALL FRONT EXHAUST PIPE
(a) Temporarily install 3 new gaskets and the front ex–
haust pipe with the 2 bolts and 6 nuts.
(b) Tighten the 4 nuts holding the exhaust manifolds to
the front exhaust pipe.
Torque: 62 N–m (630 kgf–cm, 46 ft–lbf)
(c) Tighten the 2 bolts and 2 nuts holding the three–way
catalytic converter to the front exhaust pipe.
Torque: 56 N–m (570 kgf–cm, 41 ft–lbf)
(d) Connect the bracket with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 19 N–m (195 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
(e) Connect the front exhaust pipe clamp with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 29 N–m (300 kgf–cm, 22 ft–lbf)
30. INSTALL SPARK PLUGS
Using a 16 mm plug wrench, install the6 spark plugs
to the RH and LH cylinder heads.
31. INSTALL IGNITION COILS
Install the6 ignition coils to the RH and LH cylinder
heads.
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–lbf)
EG2–113
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
32. CONNECT ENGINE WIRE TO ENGINE RH SIDE
(a) Connect the following connectors:
(1) 3 injector connectors
(2) 3 ignition coil connectors
(3) Water temperature sender gauge connector
(4) Water temperature sensor connector
(5) RH oxygens sensor connector
(b) Connect the engine wire with the 5 nuts.
33. CONNECT ENGINE WIRE TO ENGINE REAR SIDE
(a) Connect the following connectors:
(1) LH oxygen sensor
(2) Engine coolant temperature sensor
(3) Camshaft position sensor
(b) Connect the 3 clamps.
(c) Connect the engine wire with the 2 nuts.
34. CONNECT ENGINE WIRE TO N0.3 TIMING BELT
COVER
Connect the engine wire with the 2 clamps.
EG2–114
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
35. CONNECT ENGINE WIRE TO ENGINE LH SIDE
(a) Connect the following connectors:
(1) 3 injector connectors
(2) 3 ignition coil connectors
(b) Connect the engine wire with the 2 nuts.
36. INSTALL EGR VALVE AND VACUUM MODULATOR
TO AIR INTAKE CHAMBER
Install a new gasket, the EGR valve and vacuum mod–
ulator with the 3 nuts.
Torque: 12 N–m (120 kgf–cm, 9 ft–lbf)
37. INSTALL THROTTLE BODY TO AIR INTAKE
CHAMBER
(a) Place a new gasket on the air intake chamber.
(b) Install the throttle body with the 2 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 19.5 N–m (200 kgf–cm. 14 ft–lbf)
(c) Connect the following vacuum hoses:
(1) Vacuum hose to P port of EGR vacuum modula–
tor
(2) Vacuum hose to R port of EGR vacuum modula–
tor
38. INSTALL A/C IDLE–UP VSV TO AIR INTAKE
CHAMBER
(a) Install the A/C idle–up VSV with the 2 bolts.
(b) Connect the air hose.
EG2–115
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
39. INSTALL INTAKE AIR CONTROL VALVE TO AIR
INTAKE CHAMBER
(a) Install a new gasket to the air intake chamber.
(b) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the rubber portions.
(c) Apply seal packing to the positions of the intake air
control valve as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing:
Part No. 08826–00080 or equivalent
(d) Install the intake air control valve and data link con–
nector 1 clamp with the 3 nuts.
Torque: 14.5 N–m (145 kgf–cm, 10 ft–lbf)
(d) Connect the A/C air hose.
40. INSTALL AIR INTAKE CHAMBER
(a) Using an 8 mm hexagon wrench, install a new gasket
and the air intake chamber with the 2 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 43 N–m (440 kgf–cm, 32 ft–lbf)
(b) Connect the following hoses:
(1) 2 water bypass hoses
(2) Air assist hose
(c) Connect the following vacuum hoses:
(1) 2 vacuum hoses to TVV
(2) Vacuum hose to cylinder head rear plate
EG2–116
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE – ENGINE MECHANICAL
(3) Vacuum hose to charcoal canister
(d) Connect the following connectors:
(1) Throttle position sensor connector
(2) IAC valve connector
(3) EGR gas temperature sensor connector
(4) A/C idle–up connector
(e) Install 2 new gaskets and EGR pipe with the 4 nuts.
Torque: 12 N–m (120 kgf–cm, 9 ft–lbf)
(f) Install the No.1 engine hanger with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 39 N–m (400 kgf–cm, 19 ft–lbf)
(g) Install the air intake chamber stay with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 19.5 N–m (200 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
(h) Connect the 2 PS air hoses.
(i) Connect the PS pressure tube with the 2 nuts.
EG2–117
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(j) Connect the RH oxygen sensor connector clamp to
the PS pressure tube.
(k) Connect the ground strap with the bolt.
(1) Connect the hydraulic pressure pipe to the air intake
chamber with the bolt.
(m) Connect the following hoses:
(1) Brake booster vacuum hose
(2) PCV hose
(3) Intake air control valve vacuum hose
(n) Connect the data link connector 1.
(o) Connect the 2 ground straps with the nut.
Torque: 14.5 N–m (145 kgf–cm, 10 ft–lbf)
41. INSTALL EMISSION CONTROL VALVE SET
(a) Install the emission control valve set with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–lbf)
(b) Connect the following connectors:
(1) Intake air control connector
(2) Fuel pressure connector
(3) EGR VSV connector
EG2–118
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c) Connect the following vacuum hoses:
(1) Vacuum hose to fuel pressure control VSV
(2) Vacuum hose to fuel pressure regulator
(3) Vacuum hose to cylinder head rear plate
(4) Vacuum hose to intake air control valve VSV
(5) Vacuum hose to EGR vacuum modulator
(6) Vacuum hose to EGR valve
42. INSTALL V–BANK COVER
Using a 5 mm hexagon wrench, install the V–bank
cover with the 2 nuts.
43. CONNECT PRESSURE HOSE TO HYDRAULIC
MOTOR
Connect the pressure hose to the water inlet.
44. CONNECT FUEL HOSES
(a) Connect the fuel return hose to the fuel pipe.
(b) Connect the fuel inlet hose to the fuel filter.
Torque: 30 N–m (300 kgf–cm, 22 ft–lbf)
45. CONNECT HEATER HOSES
Connect the 2 hoses.
EG2–119
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
46. CONNECT RADIATOR HOSES
Connect the 2 hoses.
47. INSTALL RH ENGINE MOUNTING STAY
Install the mounting stay with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 31.4 N–m (320 kgf–cm, 23 ft–lbf)
48. CONNECT GROUND STRAPS
Connect the 2 straps.
49. w/ CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM:
INSTALL CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
(a) Connect the actuator and bracket with the 3 bolts.
(b) Connect the actuator connector and clamp.
(c) Install the actuator cover with the bolt and clip.
50. INSTALL AIR CLEANER CAP, VOLUME AIR
FLOW METER AND AIR CLEANER HOSE
(a) Connect the air cleaner hose, and install the air clean–
er cap and volume air flow meter with the 4 clips.
(b) Tighten the air cleaner hose clamp bolt.
(c) Connect the PCV hose.
(d) Connect the accelerator cable clamp.
(e) Connect the volume air flow meter connector and
wire clamp.
EG2–120
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
51. CONNECT THROTTLE CABLE
52. CONNECT ACCELERATOR CABLE
53. FILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
Capacity:
8.7 liters (9.2 US qts, 7.7 Imp. qts)
54. INSTALL BATTERY TRAY AND BATTERY
55. START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR LEAKS
56. PERFORM ROAD TEST
Check for abnormal noise, shock, slippage, correct
shift points and smooth operation.
57. RECHECK ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL
EG2–121
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
CYLINDER BLOCK
COMPONENTS FOR ENGINE REMOVAL
AND INSTALLATION
EG2–122
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
EG2–123
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
EG2–124
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
ENGINE REMOVAL
(See Components for Engine Removal and Installation)
1. REMOVE BATTERY AND TRAY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ”LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. REMOVE HOOD
3. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
4. DRAIN ENGINE OIL
5. DISCONNECT ACCELERATOR CABLE
6. DISCONNECT THROTTLE CABLE
7. REMOVE AIR CLEANER CAP, VOLUME AIR FLOW
METER AND AIR CLEANER HOSE
(a) Disconnect the volume air flow meter connector and
wire clamp.
(b) Disconnect the accelerator cable clamp.
(c) Disconnect the PCV hose.
(d) Loosen the air cleaner hose clamp bolt.
(e) Disconnect the 4 air cleaner cap clips.
(f) Remove the air cleaner cap and volume air flow meter
together with the air cleaner hose.
(g) Remove the element.
(h) Remove the 3 bolts and air cleaner case.
8. w/ CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM:
REMOVE CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
(a) Remove the bolt, clip and actuator cover.
(b) Disconnect the actuator connector and clamp.
(c) Remove the 3 bolts, and disconnect the actuator with
the bracket.
EG2–125
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
9. REMOVE RADIATOR
(See page EG2–336)
10. DISCONNECT ENGINE WIRE
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and disconnect the engine relay
box.
(b) Disconnect the following wires and connectors:
(1) 5 connectors from relay box
(2) 2 igniter connectors
(3) Noise filter connector
(4) Connector from LH fender apron
(5) 2 ground straps
(c) Disconnect the wire clamp.
(d) Disconnect the connector from the LH fender apron.
(e) Remove the bolt and disconnect the ground strap.
(f) Disconnect the wire clamp.
11. DISCONNECT VACUUM HOSES
Disconnect the following vacuum hoses:
(1) Vacuum hoses from vacuum tank for intake air
control valve
EG2–126
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE – ENGINE MECHANICAL
(2) Vacuum hose from charcoal canister
(3) Brake booster vacuum hose from air intake cha–
mber
12. DISCONNECT HEATER HOSES
Disconnect the 2 hoses.
13. DISCONNECT FUEL HOSES
Disconnect the fuel inlet and return hoses.
CAUTION: Catch leaking fuel in a container.
14. DISCONNECT TRANSAXLE CONTROL CABLE
FROM TRANSAXLE
EG2–127
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
15. DISCONNECT ENGINE WIRE FROM CABIN
(a) Remove the following parts:
(1) Under cover
(2) Lower instrument panel
(3) Glove compartment door
(4) Glove compartment
(b) Disconnect the following connectors:
(1) 3 ECM connectors
(2) 5 cowl wire connectors
(3) Cooling fan ECU connector
(c) Disconnect the wire clamp.
(d) Remove the 2 nuts, and pull out the engine wire from
the cowl panel.
16. REMOVE A/C COMPRESSOR WITHOUT
DISCONNECTING HOSES
(a) Disconnect the A/C compressor connector.
(b) Remove the drive belt.
(c) Remove the 5 bolts and drive belt adjusting bar brack–
et and, disconnect the A/C compressor.
HINT: Move the compressor aside and suspend it.
EG2–128
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
17. REMOVE FRONT EXHAUST PIPE
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and exhaust pipe clamp.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts, and disconnect the bracket.
(c) Remove the 2 bolts and 2 nuts holding the front
exhaust pipe to the three–way catalytic converter.
(d) Remove the 4 nuts holding the front exhaust pipe to
the exhaust manifolds.
(e) Remove the front exhaust pipe and 3 gaskets.
18. REMOVE DRIVE SHAFTS
(See SA section)
19. DISCONNECT PS PRESSURE TUBE
(a) Disconnect the 2 PS air hoses.
(b) Remove the 2 nuts and disconnect the PS pressure
tube.
20. DISCONNECT HYDRAULIC COOLING FAN
PRESSURE HOSE
Using SST, disconnect the pressure hose.
SST 09631– 22020
21. REMOVE PS PUMP WITHOUT DISCONNECTING
HOSES
(a) Remove the PS drive belt.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts, and disconnect the PS pump from
the engine.
HINT: Move the PS pump aside and suspend it.
EG2–129
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
22. DISCONNECT LH ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
Remove the 4 bolts, and disconnect the mounting
insulator.
23. DISCONNECT RR ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
(a) Remove the 2 hole plugs.
(b) Remove the 4 nuts, and disconnect the mounting
insulator.
24. REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING SHOCK ABSORBER
Remove the 4 bolts and engine mounting shock ab–
sorber.
25. DISCONNECT FR ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
Remove the 3 bolts, and disconnect the mounting
insulator.
26. ATTACH ENGINE SLING DEVICE TO ENGINE
HANGERS
EG2–130
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
27. REMOVE COOLANT RESERVOIR TANK
(a) Disconnect the reservoir hose.
(b) Using a screwdriver, remove the reservoir tank.
28. DISCONNECT GROUND STRAPS
Disconnect the 2 straps.
29. REMOVE RH ENGINE MOUNTING STAY
Remove the 3 bolts and RH engine mounting stay.
30. REMOVE ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD AND
NO.2 RH ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET
Remove the 3 bolts, control rod and mounting brack–
et.
EG2–131
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
31. REMOVE ENGINE AND TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
PROM VEHICLE
(a) Lift the engine out of the vehicle slowly and carefully.
NOTICE: Be careful not to hit the PS gear housing or
park/neutral position switch.
(b) Make sure the engine is clear of all wiring, hoses and
cables.
(c) Place the engine and transaxle assembly onto the
stand.
32. REMOVE FR ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
Remove the 4 bolts and mounting insulator.
33. REMOVE RR ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
Remove the 4 bolts and mounting insulator.
34. REMOVE FRONT EXHAUST PIPE STAY
Remove the 2 bolts and pipe stay.
EG2–132
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
COMPONENTS FOR ENGINE &
TRANSAXLE SEPARATION AND
ASSEMBLY
ENGINE & TRANSAXLE SEPARATION
(See Components for Engine & Transaxle Separation
and Assembly)
1. DISCONNECT ENGINE WIRE
(a) Disconnect the following connector:
(1) O/D solenoid connector
(2) PNP switch speedometer
(3) Starter 50 terminal
(4) Starter B terminal
(5) Speed sensor connector
(b) Disconnect the 2 wire clamps from the transaxle.
EG2–133
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
2. REMOVE OIL DIPSTICK GUIDE AND DIPSTICK FOR
TRANSAXLE
(a) Remove the mounting bolt.
(b) Pull out the dipstick guide and dipstick from the port
of transaxle.
(c) Remove the 0–ring from the dipstick guide.
3. REMOVE STARTER
Remove the 2 bolts and starter.
4. REMOVE TRANSAXLE
A. Remove torque converter clutch mounting bolts
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and flywheel housing undercover.
(b) Turn the crankshaft pulley bolt to gain access to each
bolt.
(c) Hold the crankshaft pulley bolt with a wrench, and
remove the 6 bolts.
6. Remove transaxle
(a) Remove the bolt, 2 nuts, manifold stay and exhaust
manifold plate.
EG2–134
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b) Remove the bolt, nut and No.2 manifold stay.
(c) Remove the 2 bolts holding the No.2 oil pan to the
transaxle.
(d) Remove the 6 bolts holding the engine to the trans–
axle.
(e) Remove the transaxle together with the torque con–
verter clutch from the engine.
5. REMOVE DRIVE PLATE
Uniformly loosen and remove the drive plate bolts, in
several passes, in the sequence shown.
EG2–135
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
COMPONENTS FOR PREPARATION AND
AFTER ASSEMBLY
EG2–136
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE – ENGINE MECHANICAL
PREPARATION FOR DISASSEMBLY
(See Components for Cylinder Block Preparation of
Disassembly and After Assembly)
1. INSTALL ENGINE TO ENGINE STAND FOR
DISASSEMBLY
2. REMOVE TIMING BELT AND PULLEYS
(See pages EG2–42 to 47)
3. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD
(See pages EG2–64 to 79)
4. REMOVE GENERATOR
Remove the 2 bolts and generator.
5. REMOVE GENERATOR ADJUSTING BAR AND
BRACKET
Remove the 3 nuts, generator adjusting bar and bra–
cket.
6. REMOVE A/C COMPRESSOR HOUSING BRACKET
Remove the 3 bolts and compressor housing bracket.
7. REMOVE No.2 IDLER PULLEY BRACKET
Remove the 2 bolts and idler pulley bracket.
EG2–137
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
8. REMOVE KNOCK SENSORS
(a) Disconnect the 2 knock sensor connectors.
(b) Remove the wire band.
(c) Disconnect the engine wire clamp.
(d) Using SST, remove the 2 knock sensors.
SST 09816 – 30010
9. REMOVE WATER INLET HOUSING
Remove the 8 bolts, 2 nuts and water inlet housing.
10. REMOVE WATER PUMP
Remove the 4 bolts, 2 nuts, water pump and gasket.
11. REMOVE NO.2 OIL PAN
(a) Remove the 10 bolts and 2 nuts.
EG2–138
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b) Insert the blade of SST between the No. 1 and No.2 oil
pans, and cut off applied sealer and remove the No. 1
oil pan.
SST 09032 – 00100
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to the damage the No.2 oil pan con–
tact surface of the No.1 oil pan.
• Be careful not to damage the No.2 oil pan flange.
12. REMOVE OIL STRAINER
Remove the bolt, 2 nuts, oil strainer and gasket.
13. REMOVE NO.1 OIL PAN
(a) Remove the 17 bolts.
(b) Using a screwdriver, remove the No. 1 oil pan by
prying the portions between the cylinder block and
No.1 oil pan.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the contact surfaces
of the cylinder block and No.1 oil pan.
EG2–139
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
14. REMOVE OIL PUMP
(a) Remove the 9 bolts.
(b) Remove the oil pump by prying a screwdriver between
the oil pump and main bearing cap.
(c) Remove the 0–ring.
15. REMOVE OIL FILTER
Using SST, remove the oil filter.
SST 09816 – 30010
16. REMOVE OIL FILTER UNION
Using a 12 mm hexagon wrench, remove the oil filter
union.
17. REMOVE WATER SEAL PLATE
Remove the 2 nuts and seal plate.
EG2–140
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
18. REMOVE ENGINE COOLANT DRAIN COCK
19. REMOVE OIL PRESSURE SWITCH
Using SST, remove the oil pressure switch.
SST 09816 – 30010
20. REMOVE EGR COOLER
Remove the 3 bolts, 2 nuts, EGR cooler and gasket.
EG2–141
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
COMPONENTS FOR CYLINDER BLOCK
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY
EG2–142
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
CYLINDER BLOCK DISASSEMBLY
(See Components for Disassembly and Assembly)
1. REMOVE REAR OIL SEAL RETAINER
(a) Remove the 6 bolts.
(b) Using a screwdriver, remove the oil seal retainer by
prying the portions between the oil seal retainer and
main bearing cap.
2. CHECK CONNECTING ROD THRUST CLEARANCE
Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance
while moving the connecting rod back an forth.
Standard thrust clearance:
0.15 – 0.30 mm (0.0059 – 0.0118 in.)
Maximum thrust clearance:
0.35 mm (0.0138 in.)
If the thrust clearance is greater than maximum, re–
place the connecting rod assembly
(s). If necessary,
replace the crankshaft.
Connecting rod thickness:
20.80 – 20.85 mm (0.8189 – 0.8209 in.)
3. REMOVE CONNECTING ROD CAPS AND CHECK
OIL CLEARANCE
(a) Check the matchmarks on the connecting rod and cap
to ensure correct reassembly.
(b) Remove the 2 connecting rod cap bolts.
EG2–143
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c) Using the 2 removed connecting rod cap bolts,
remove the connecting rod cap and lower bearing by
wiggling the connecting rod cap right and left.
HINT: Keep the lower bearing inserted with the con–
necting rod cap.
(d) Clean the crank pin and bearing.
(e) Check the crank pin and bearing for pitting and scrat–
ches.
If the crank pin or bearing is damaged, replace the
bearings. If necessary, replace the crankshaft.
(f) Lay a strip of Plastigage across the crank pin.
(g) Install the connecting rod cap with the 2 bolts.
(See step 7 on page EG2–167)
Torque:
1st 24.5 N–m (250 kgf–cm. 18 ft–lbf)
2nd Turn extra 90
NOTICE: Do not turn the crankshaft.
(h) Remove the 2 bolts, connecting rod cap and lower
bearing. (See procedure (b) and (c) above)
EG2–144
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Measure the Plastigage at its widest point.
Standard oil clearance:
0.038 – 0.064 mm (0.0015 – 0.0025 in.)
Maximum oil clearance:
0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than maximum, replace
the bearings. If necessary, grind or replace the crank–
shaft.
HINT: If replacing a bearing, replace it with 1 having
the same number as marked on the connecting rod.
There are 4 sizes of standard bearings, marked ”I”,
”2”, ”3” and ”4” accordingly.
Reference:
Connecting rod big end inside diameter:
Mark ’1”
518.000 – 56.006 mm (2.2047 – 2.2050 in.)
Mark ’2’
56.006 – 56.012 mm (2.2050 – 2.2052 in.)
Mark ’3’
56.012 – 56.018 mm (2.2052 – 2.2054 in.)
Mark ”4’
56.018 – 56.024 mm (2.2054 – 2.2057 in.)
Crankshaft crank pin diameter:
52.994 – 53.000 mm (2.0864 – 2.0868 in.)
Standard sized bearing center wall thickness:
Mark ’1’
1.484 – 1.487 mm (0.0584 – 0.0585 in.)
Mark ’2’
1.487 – 1.490 mm (0.0585 – 0.0587 in.)
Mark ’3’
1.490 – 1.493 mm (0.0587 – 0.0588 in.)
Mark W
1.493 – 1.496 mm (0.0588 – 0.0589 in.)
(j) Completely remove the Plastigage.
4. REMOVE PISTON AND CONNECTING ROD
ASSEMBLIES
(a) Using a ridge reamer, remove all the carbon from the
top of the cylinder.
(b) Push the piston, connecting rod assembly and upper
bearing through the top of the cylinder block.
EG2–145
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
HINT:
• Keep the bearings, connecting rod and cap to–
gether.
• Arrange the piston and connecting rod assembl–
ies in correct order.
5. CHECK CRANKSHAFT THRUST CLEARANCE
Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance
while prying the crankshaft back and forth with a
screwdriver.
Standard thrust clearance:
0.04 – 0.24 mm (0.0016 – 0.0095 In.)
Maximum thrust clearance:
0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
If the thrust clearance is greater than maximum, re–
place the thrust washers as a set.
Thrust washer thickness:
1.930 – 1.980 mm (0.0760 – 0.0780 In.)
6. REMOVE MAIN BEARING CAPS AND CHECK OIL
CLEARANCE
(a) Uniformly loosen and remove the 8 main bearing cap
bolts and seal washers, in several passes, in the se–
quence shown.
EG2–146
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b) Uniformly loosen and remove the 16 main bearing cap
bolts, in several passes, in the sequence shown.
(c) Using a screwdriver, pry out main bearing caps,
remove the 4 main bearing caps, lower bearings and
(No.2 main bearing cap only) 2 lower thrust washers.
HINT:
• Keep the lower bearing and main bearing cap
together.
• Arrange the main bearing caps and lower thrust
washers in correct order.
(d) Lift out the crankshaft.
HINT: Keep the upper bearings together with the cyl–
inder block.
(e) Clean each main journal and bearing.
(f) Check each main journal and bearing for pitting and
scratches.
If the journal or bearing is damaged, replace the bear–
ings. If necessary, replace the crankshaft.
(g) Place the crankshaft on the cylinder block.
(h) Lay a strip of Plastigage across each journal.
EG2–147
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(i) Install the 4 main bearing caps.
(See step 4 on pages EG2–165)
12 Pointed Head Bolts:
Torque:
1 st 22 N–m (225 kgf–cm, 16 ft–lbf)
2nd Turn extra 90
Hexagon Head Bolts:
Torque: 27 N–m (275 kgf–cm, 20 ft–lbf)
NOTICE: Do not turn the crankshaft.
(j) Remove the main bearing caps.
(See procedures (a) to (c) above)
(k) Measure the Plastigage at its widest point.
Standard oil clearance:
0.026 – 0.046 mm (0.0010 – 0.0018 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than maximum, replace
the bearings. If necessary, replace the crankshaft.
HINT: If using a bearing, replace it with one having the
same number. If the number of the bearing cannot be
determined, select the correct bearing by adding to–
gether the numbers imprinted on the cylinder block
and crankshaft, then refer to the table below for the
appropriate bearing number. There are 5 standard
bearing sizes, marked ’1’, ”2”, ”3”, ”4” and ”5” accord–
ingly.
” ”: Number mark
Total number
Cylinder block (A)
+
Crankshaft ( B ) _
Use bearing
0–5
6–11
“1”
“2”
12–17
18–23
24–28
“4”
”5”
EXAMPLE: Cylinder block ”06” (A)
+ Crankshaft ”08” (B)
= Total number 14 (Use bearing ”3”)
EG2–148
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Reference:
Cylinder block main journal bore diameter
(A):
Mark ”00’
66.000 mm (2.5984 in.)
Mark ’01’
66.001 mm (2.5985 in.)
Mark ”02”
66.002 mm (2.5985 in.)
Mark ’03’
66.003 mm (2.5985 in.)
Mark ”04’
66.004 mm (2.5986 in.)
Mark ’05’
66.005 mm (2.5986 In.)
Mark ’06’
66.006 mm (2.5987 in.)
Mark ’07’
66.007 mm (2.5987 in.)
Mark ’08’
66.008 mm (2.5987 in.)
Mark ’09’
66.009 mm (2.5988 in.)
Mark ”10’
66.010 mm (2.5988 in.)
Mark ’11 ”
66.011 mm (2.5989 in.)
Mark ’12’
66.012 mm (2.5989 in.)
Mark ’13’
66.013 mm (2.5989 in.)
Mark ”14’
66.014 mm (2.5990 in.)
Mark ’15’
66.015 mm (2.5990 in.)
Mark ”16’
66.01 6 mm (2.5990 in.)
EG2–149
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Crankshaft main journal diameter (B):
Mark ’00”
61.000 mm (2.401 6 in.)
Mark ”01’
60.999 mm (2.4015 in.)
Mark ’02’
60.998 mm (2.4015 in.)
Mark ”03”
60.997 mm (2.4015 in.)
Mark ’04’
60.996 mm (2.4014 in.)
Mark ’05’
60.995 mm (2.4014 in.)
Mark ’06”
60.994 mm (2.4013 in.)
Mark ’07’
60.993 mm (2.4012 in.)
Mark ’08’
60.992 mm (2.4012 In.)
Mark ’09”
60.991 mm (2.4012 In.)
Mark ”10’
60.990 mm (2.4012 in.)
Mark ’11’
60.989 mm (2.4011 in.)
Mark ”12”
60.988 mm (2.4011 in.)
Standard sized bearing center wall thickness:
Mark ”1’
2.488 – 2.489 mm (0.0979 – 0.0980 in.)
Mark ”2
2.489 – 2.492 mm (0.0980 – 0.0981 in.)
Mark ’3”
2.492 – 2.495 mm (0.0981 – 0.0982 in.)
Mark ”4’
2.495 – 2.498 mm (0.0982 – 0.0983 in.)
Mark ”5’
2.498 – 2.501 mm (0.0983 – 0.0985 in.)
EG2–150
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Standard sized Bearing Selection Chart
Crankshaft
number mark
Cylinder block number mark
EXAMPLE: Cylinder block ”06”, Crankshaft ”08”
= Use bearing ”3”
(l) Completely remove the Plastigage.
7. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT
(a) Lift out the crankshaft.
(b) Remove the 4 upper main bearings and 2 upper thrust
washers from the cylinder block.
HINT: Arrange the main bearing caps, bearings and
thrust washers in correct order.
EG2–151
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
CYLINDER BLOCK INSPECTION AND
REPAIR
1. CLEAN CYLINDER BLOCK
A. Remove gasket material
Using a gasket scraper, remove all the gasket material
from the top surface of the cylinder block.
B. Clean cylinder block
Using a soft brush and solvent, thoroughly clean the
cylinder block.
NOTICE: If the cylinder is washed at high temperatures,
the cylinder liner sticks out beyond the cylinder block, so
always wash the cylinder block at a temperature of 45C
(113F) or less.
2. INSPECT TOP SURFACE OF CYLINDER BLOCK FOR
FLATNESS
Using a precision straight edge and feeler gauge, mea–
sure the surface contacting the cylinder head gasket
for warpage.
Maximum warpage:
0.07 mm (0.0028 In.)
If warpage is greater than maximum, replace the cylin–
der block.
3. INSPECT CYLINDER FOR VERTICAL SCRATCHES
Visually check the cylinder for vertical scratches.
If deep scratches are present, replace the cylinder
block.
EG2–152
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE – ENGINE MECHANICAL
4. INSPECT CYLINDER BORE DIAMETER
Using a cylinder gauge, measure the cylinder bore
diameter at positions A, B and C in the thrust and axial
directions.
Standard diameter:
87.500 – 87.512 mm (3.4449 – 3.4453 in.)
Maximum diameter:
87.52 mm (3.4457 in.)
If the diameter is greater than maximum, replace the
cylinder block.
5. REMOVE CYLINDER RIDGE
If the wear is less than 0.2 mm (0.008 in.), using a
ridge reamer, grind the top of the cylinder.
6. INSPECT MAIN BEARING CAP BOLTS
(for 12 Pointed Head Bolts)
Using a vernier caliper, measure the tension portion
diameter of the main bearing cap bolt.
Standard diameter:
7.500 – 7.600 mm (0.2953 – 0.2992 in.)
Minimum diameter:
7.20 mm (0.2835 In.)
If the diameter is less than minimum, replace the bolt.
EG2–153
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
PISTON AND CONNECTING ROD
DISASSEMBLY
1. CHECK FIT BETWEEN PISTON AND PISTON PIN
Try to move the piston back and forth on the piston
pin.
If any movement is felt, replace the piston and pin as
a set.
2. REMOVE PISTON RINGS
(a) Using a piston ring expander, remove the 2 compres–
sion rings.
(b) Remove the 2 side rails and oil ring by hand.
HINT: Arrange the piston rings in correct order only.
3. DISCONNECT CONNECTING ROD FROM PISTON
(a) Using a small screwdriver, pry out the 2 snap rings.
(b) Gradually heat the piston to approx. 60C (140F).
EG2–154
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c) Using a plastic–faced hammer and brass bar, lightly
tap out the piston pin and remove the connecting rod.
HINT:
• The piston and pin are a matched set.
• Arrange the pistons, pins, rings, connecting rods
and bearings in correct order.
PISTON AND CONNECTING ROD
INSPECTION
1. CLEAN PISTON
(a) Using a gasket scraper, remove the carbon from the
piston top.
(b) Using a groove cleaning tool or broken ring, clean the
piston ring grooves.
EG2–155
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c) Using solvent and a brush, thoroughly clean the
piston.
NOTICE: Do not use a wire brush.
2. INSPECT PISTON
A. Inspect piston oil clearance
(a) Using a micrometer, measure the piston diameter at
ring angles to the piston pin center line, 23.2 mm
(0.913 in.) from the piston head.
Piston diameter:
87.406 – 87.416 mm (3.4412 – 3.4416 in.)
(b) Measure the cylinder bore diameter in the thrust di–
rections. (See step 4 on page EG2–152)
(c) Subtract the piston diameter measurement from the
cylinder bore diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
0.084 – 0.106 mm (0.0033 – 0.0042 in.)
Maximum oil clearance:
0.13 mm (0.0051 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than maximum, replace
all the6 pistons. If necessary, replace the cylinder
block.
HINT: The shape of the piston varies for the RH and
LH banks. The RH piston is marked with ”R”, the LH
piston with ”L”.
B. Inspect piston ring groove clearance
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between
new piston ring and the wall of the ring groove.
Ring groove clearance:
No.1
0.020 – 0.070 mm (0.0008 – 0.0028 in.)
No.2
0.020 – 0.060 mm (0.0008 – 0.0024 In.)
If the clearance is not as specified, replace the piston.
EG2–156
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE – ENGINE MECHANICAL
C. Inspect piston ring end gap
(a) Insert the piston ring into the cylinder bore.
(b) Using a piston, push the piston ring a little beyond the
bottom of the ring travel, 105 mm (4.13 in.) from the
top of the cylinder block.
(c) Using a feeler gauge, measure the end gap.
Standard end gap:
No. 1
0.25 – 0.35 mm (0.0098 – 0.0138 in.)
No.2
0.35 – 0.45 mm (0.0138 – 0.0177 in.)
Oil (Side rail)
0.15 – 0.40 mm (0.0059 – 0.0157 in.)
Maximum end gap:
No.1
0.95 mm (0.0374 in.)
No.2
1.05 mm (0.0413 in.)
Oil (Side rail)
1.00 mm (0.0394 in.)
If the end gap is greater than maximum, replace the
piston ring. If the end gap is greater than maximum,
even with a new piston ring, replace the cylinder
block.
D. Inspect piston pin fit
At 60C (140F), you should be able to push the
piston pin into the piston pin hole with your thumb.
3. INSPECT CONNECTING ROD
A. Inspect connecting rod alignment
Using a rod aligner and feeler gauge, check the con–
necting rod alignment.
• Check for out–of–alignment.
Maximum out–of –alignment:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.) per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
If out–of–alignment is greater than maximum, re–
place the connecting rod assembly.
EG2–157
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
• Check for twist
Maximum twist:
0.15 mm (0.0059 in.) per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
If twist is greater than maximum, replace the connect–
ing rod assembly.
B. Inspect piston pin oil clearance
(a) Using a caliper gauge, measure the inside diameter of
the connecting rod bushing.
Bushing inside diameter:
22.005 – 22.014 mm (0.8663 – 0.8667 in.)
(b) Using a micrometer, measure the piston pin diameter.
Piston pin diameter:
21.997 – 22.006 mm (0.8660 – 0.8664 in.)
(c) Subtract the piston pin diameter measurement from
the bushing inside diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
0.005 – 0.011 mm (0.0002 – 0.0004 in.)
Maximum oil clearance:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than maximum, replace
the bushing. If necessary, replace the piston and
piston pin as a set.
C. If necessary, replace connecting rod bushing
(a) Using SST and a press, press out the bushing.
SST 09222 – 30010
EG2–158
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b) Align the oil holes of a new bushing and the connect–
ing rod.
(c) Using SST and a press, press in the bushing.
SST 09222–30010
(d) Using a pin hole grinder, hone the bushing to obtain
the standard specified clearance (see step B above)
between the bushing and piston pin.
(e) Check the piston pin fit at normal room temperature.
Coat the piston pin with engine oil, and push it into the
connecting rod with your thumb.
D. Inspect connecting rod bolts
Using a vernier caliper, measure the tension portion of
of the connecting rod bolt.
Standard diameter:
7.2 – 7.3 mm (0.284 – 0.287 in.)
Minimum diameter:
7.0 mm (0.276 in.)
HINT: If the tension portion diameter is less than
minimum, replace the connecting rod bolt.
EG2–159
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
CRANKSHAFT INSPECTION
1. INSPECT CRANKSHAFT FOR CIRCLE RUNOUT
(a) Place the crankshaft on V–blocks.
(b) Using a dial indicator, measure the circle runout, as
shown in the illustration.
Maximum circle runout:
0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
If the circle runout is greater than maximum, replace
the crankshaft.
2. INSPECT MAIN JOURNALS AND CRANK PINS
(a) Using a micrometer, measure the diameter of each
main journal and crank pin.
Main journal diameter:
60.988 –61.000 mm (2.4011 – 2.4016 in.)
Crank pin diameter:
52.994 – 53.000 mm (2.0864 – 2.0866 in.)
If the diameter is not as specified, check the oil clear–
ance (See steps 3 or6 on page EG2–142 or 145). If
necessary, replace the crankshaft.
(b) Check each main journal and crank pin for taper and
out–of–round as shown.
Maximum taper and out–of–round:
0.02 mm (0.0008 in.)
If the taper and out–of–round is greater than maxi–
mum, replace the crankshaft.
EG2–160
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
CRANKSHAFT OIL SEALS REPLACEMENT
HINT: There are 2 methods (A and B) to replace the oil
seal which are as follows:
1. REPLACE CRANKSHAFT FRONT OIL SEAL
A. If oil pump is removed from cylinder block:
(a) Using a screwdriver, pry out the oil seal.
(b) Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new oil seal until its
surface is flush with the oil pump body edge.
SST 09223 – 00010
(c) Apply MP grease to the oil seal lip.
B. If oil pump is installed to the cylinder block:
(a) Using a knife, cut off the oil seal lip.
(b) Using a screwdriver, pry out the oil seal.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the crankshaft. Tape
the screwdriver tip.
(c) Apply MP grease to a new oil seal lip.
(d) Using SST and a hammer, tap in the oil seal until its
surface is flush with the oil pump body edge.
SST 09223 – 00010
EG2–161
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
2. REPLACE CRANKSHAFT REAR OIL SEAL
A. If rear oil seal retainer is removed from cylinder
block:
(a) Using a screwdriver and hammer, tap out the oil seal.
(b) Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new oil seal until its
surface is flush with the rear oil seal retainer edge.
SST 09223 –15030, 09608 – 30022 (09608 – 05010)
(c) Apply MP grease to the oil seal lip.
B. If rear oil seal retainer is installed to cylinder block:
(a) Using a knife, cut off the oil seal lip.
(b) Using a screwdriver, pry out the oil seal.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the crankshaft. Tape
the screwdriver tip.
(c) Apply MP grease to a new oil seal lip.
(d) Using SST and a hammer, tap in the oil sea! until its
surface is flush with the rear oil seal retainer edge.
SST 09223–15030, 09608–30022 (09608–05010)
EG2–162
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
PISTON AND CONNECTING ROD
ASSEMBLY
1. ASSEMBLE PISTON AND CONNECTING ROD
(a) Using a small screwdriver, install a new snap ring at
one end of the piston pin hole.
HINT: Be sure that end gap of the snap ring is not
aligned with the pin hole cutout portion of the piston.
(b) Gradually heat the piston to about 60C (140F).
(c) Coat the piston pin with engine oil.
(d) Align the front marks of the piston and connecting
rod, and push in the piston pin with your thumb.
(e) Using a small screwdriver, install a new snap ring on
the other end of the piston pin hole.
HINT: Be sure that end gap of the snap ring is not
aligned with the pin hole cutout portion of the piston.
EG2–163
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
2. INSTALL PISTON RINGS
(a) Install the oil ring expander and 2 side rails by hand.
(b) Using a piston ring expander, install the 2 compres–
sion rings with the code mark facing upward.
Code mark:
No.1
1RorT
No.2
2R or 2T
(c) Position the piston rings so that the ring ends are as
shown.
NOTICE: Do not align the ring ends.
3. INSTALL BEARINGS
(a) Align the bearing claw with the groove of the connect–
ing rod or connecting cap.
(b) Install the bearings in the connecting rod and con–
necting rod cap.
EG2–164
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE – ENGINE MECHANICAL
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSEMBLY
(See Components for Disassembly and Assembly)
HINT:
• Thoroughly clean all parts to be assembled.
Before installing the parts, apply new engine oil
to all sliding and and rotating surfaces.
• Replace all gaskets, 0–rings and oil seals with
new parts.
1. INSTALL MAIN BEARINGS
HINT:
• Main bearings come in widths of 19.0 mm (0.748
in.) and 22.4 mm (0.882 in.). Install the 22.4 mm
(0.882 in.) bearings in the No. 1 and No.4 cylinder
block journal positions with the main bearing cap.
• Install the 19.0 mm (0.748 in.) bearings in the No.
2 and No.3 positions.
• Upper bearings have an oil groove and oil holes;
lower bearings do not.
(a) Align the bearing claw with the claw groove of the
cylinder block, and push in the 4 upper bearings.
NOTICE: Install the bearing with the oil hole in the cylin–
der block.
(b) Align the bearing claw with the claw groove of the
main bearing cap, and push in the 4 lower bearings.
HINT: A number is marked on each main bearing cap
to indicate the installation position.
2. INSTALL UPPER THRUST WASHERS
Install the 2 thrust washers under the No.2 journal
position of the cylinder block with the oil grooves
facing outward.
EG2–165
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
3. PLACE CRANKSHAFT ON CYLINDER BLOCK
4. INSTALL MAIN BEARING CAPS AND LOWER
THRUST WASHERS
A. Place main bearing caps and lower thrust washers
on cylinder block
(a) Install the 2 thrust washers on the No.2 bearing cap
with the grooves facing outward.
(b) Temporarily place the 4 main bearing caps level and
let them in their proper locations.
(c) Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and
under the main bearing cap bolts (12 Pointed Head
Bolts).
(d) Temporarily install the 8 main bearing cap bolts.
(e) Using a plastic–faced hammer, lightly tap the bearing
cap to ensure a proper fit.
EG2–166
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
B. Install main bearing cap bolts
(for 12 Pointed Head Bolts)
HINT:
• The main bearing cap bolts are tightened in 2
progressive steps (steps (b) and (d)).
• If any of the main bearing cap bolts is broken or
deformed, replace it.
(a) Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and
under the main bearing cap bolts.
(b) Install and uniformly tighten the 16 main bearing cap
bolts, in several passes, in the sequence shown.
Torque: 22 N–m (225 kgf–cm, 16 ft–lbf)
If any of the main bearing cap bolts does not meet the
torque specification, replace the main bearing cap
bolt.
(c) Mark the front of the main bearing cap bolts with
paint.
(d) Retighten the main bearing cap bolts by 90 in the
numerical order shown.
(e) Check that the painted mark is now at a 90 angle to
the front.
C. Install main bearing cap bolts
(for Hexagon Head Bolts)
(a) Install a new seal washer to the main bearing cap bolt.
(b) Install and uniformly tighten the 8 main bearing cap
bolts, in several passes, in the sequence shown.
Torque: 27 N–m (275 kgf–cm, 20 ft–lbf)
(c) Check that the crankshaft turns smoothly.
EG2–167
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
5. CHECK CRANKSHAFT THRUST CLEARANCE
Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance
while prying the crankshaft back and forth with a
screwdriver.
Standard thrust clearance:
0.04 – 0.24 mm (0.0016 – 0.0095 in.)
Maximum thrust clearance:
0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
If the thrust clearance is greater than maximum, re–
place the thrust washers as a set.
Thrust washer thickness:
1.930 – 1.980 mm (0.0760 – 0.0780 in.)
6. INSTALL PISTON AND CONNECTING ROD
ASSEMBLES
Using a piston ring compressor, push the correctly
numbered piston and connecting rod assemblies into
each cylinder with the front mark of the piston facing
forward.
HINT: The shape of the piston varies for the RH and
LH banks. The RH piston is marked with ”R”, the LH
piston with ”L”.
7. INSTALL CONNECTING ROD CAPS
A. Place connecting rod cap on connecting rod
(a) Match the numbered connecting rod cap with the
connecting rod.
(b) Align the pin dowels of the connecting rod cap with
the pins of the connecting rod, and install the con–
necting rod.
EG2–168
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c) Check that the protrusion of the connecting rod cap is
facing in the correct direction.
B. Install connecting rod cap bolts
HINT:
• The connecting rod cap bolts are tightened in 2
progressive steps (steps (b) and (d)).
• If any of the connecting rod cap bolts is broken or
deformed, replace it.
(a) Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and
under the heads of the connecting rod cap bolts.
(b) Install and alternately tighten the 2 connecting rod
cap bolts in several passes.
Torque: 24.5 N–m (250 kgf–cm, 18 ft–lbf)
If any of the connecting rod cap bolts does not meet
the torque specification, replace the connecting rod
cap bolts.
(c) Mark the front of the connecting cap bolts with paint.
(d) Retighten the cap bolts by 90 as shown.
(e) Check that the painted mark is now at a 90 angle to
the front.
(f) Check that the crankshaft turns smoothly.
EG2–169
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
8. CHECK CONNECTING ROD OIL CLEARANCE
Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance
while moving the connecting rod back and forth.
Standard thrust clearance:
0.15 – 0.30 mm (0.0059 – 0.0118 in.)
Maximum thrust clearance:
0.35 mm (0.0138 in.)
If the thrust clearance is greater than maximum, re–
place the connecting rod assembly
(s). If necessary,
replace the crankshaft.
Connecting rod thickness:
20.80 – 20.85 mm (0.8189 – 0.8209 in.)
9. INSTALL REAR OIL SEAL RETAINER
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be care–
ful not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces of the
oil seal retainer and cylinder block.
• Using a razor blade and gasket scraper, remove
all the oil packing (FIPG) material from the gasket
surfaces and sealing grooves.
• Thoroughly clean all components to remove all
the loose material.
• Using a non–residue solvent, clean both sealing
surfaces.
(b) Apply seal packing to the oil seal retainer as shown in
the illustration.
Seal packing:
Part No. 08826–00080 or equivalent
• Install a nozzle that has been cut to a 2 – 3 mm
(0.08 – 0.12) opening.
• Parts must be assembled within 3 minutes of
application. Otherwise the material must be re–
moved and reapplied.
• Immediately remove nozzle from the tube and
reinstall cap.
EG2–170
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c) Install the oil seal retainer with the 6 bolts.
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–lbf)
AFTER ASSEMBLY
(See Components for Cylinder Block Preparation of
Disassembly and After Assembly)
1. INSTALL EGR COOLER
Install a new gasket and the EGR cooler with the 3
bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 9 N–m (90 kgf–cm, 78 in.–lbf)
2. INSTALL OIL PRESSURE SWITCH
(a) Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08833–00080. THREE BOND 1344,
LOCTITE 242 or equivalent
(b) Using SST, install the oil pressure switch.
SST 09816 – 30010
Torque: 13 N–m (130 kgf–cm, 9 ft–lbf)
3. INSTALL ENGINE COOLANT DRAIN COCK
(a) Apply seal packing to 2 or 3 threads.
Seal packing:
Part No. 08826–00100 or equivalent
EG2–171
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b) Install the drain cock.
Torque: 39 N–m (400 kgf–cm, 29 ft–lbf)
HINT: After applying the specified torque, rotate the
drain cock clockwise until it is in the position shown.
4. INSTALL WATER SEAL PLATE
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be care–
ful not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces of the
seal plate and cylinder block.
• Using a razor blade and gasket scraper, remove
all the old packing (FIPG) material from the
gasket surfaces and sealing groove.
• Thoroughly clean all components to remove all
the loose material.
• Using a non–residue solvent, clean both sealing
surfaces.
(b) Apply seal packing to the seal plate as shown in the
illustration.
Seal packing:
Part No. 08826–00100 or equivalent
• Install a nozzle that has been cut to a 3–5 mm
(0.12 – 0.20 in.) opening.
• Parts must be assembled within 3 minutes of
application. Otherwise the material must be re–
moved and reapplied.
• Immediately remove nozzle from the tube and
reinstall cap.
(c) Install the seal plate with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 14.5 N–m (145 kgf–cm. 10 ft–lbf)
EG2–172
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
5. INSTALL OIL FILTER UNION
Using a 12 mm hexagon wrench, install the oil filter
union.
Torque: 13 N–m (130 kgf–cm, 9 ft–lbf)
6. INSTALL OIL FILTER
(a) Apply clean engine oil to the gasket of anew oil filter.
(b) Lightly screw the oil filter into place, and tighten it
until the gasket contacts the seat.
(c) Using SST, tighten it an additional 3/4 turn.
SST 09228–07500
7. INSTALL OIL PUMP
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be care–
fuI not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces of the
oil pump and cylinder block.
• Using a razor blade and gasket scraper, remove
all the old packing (FIPG) material from the
gasket surfaces and sealing grooves.
• Thoroughly clean all components to remove all
the loose material.
• Using a non–residue solvent, clean both sealing
surfaces.
EG2–173
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b) Apply seal packing to the oil pump as shown in the
illustration.
Seal packing:
Part No. 08826–00080 or equivalent
• Install a nozzle that has been cut to a 2–3 mm
(0.08–0.12 in.) opening.
HINT: Avoid applying an excessive amount to the
surface.
• Parts must be assembled within 3 minutes of
application. Otherwise the material must be re–
moved and reapplied.
• Immediately remove nozzle from the tube and
reinstall cap.
(c) Place a new O–ring in position on the cylinder block.
(d) Engage the spline teeth of the oil pump drive gear with
the large teeth of the crankshaft, and slide the oil
pump on the crankshaft.
(e) Install the oil pump with the 9 bolts.
Torque:
8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–lbf) for 10 mm head bolt
19.5 N–m (200 kgf–cm,14 ft–lbf) for 12 mm head bolt
EG2–174
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
8. INSTALL N0.1 OIL PAN
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be care–
ful not to drop any oil on the contact surface of the
No.1 oil pan and cylinder block.
• Using a razor blade and gasket scraper, remove
all the old packing (FIPG) material from the
gasket surfaces and sealing grooves.
• Thoroughly clean all components to remove all
the loose material.
• Using a non–residue solvent, clean both sealing
surfaces.
NOTICE: Do not use a solvent which will affect the paint–
ed surfaces.
(b) Apply seal packing to the No.2 oil pan as shown in the
illustration.
Seal packing:
Part No. 08826–00080 or equivalent
Region ”x” is at the outer side of the bolt hole.
Region ”*” is at the inner side of the bolt hole.
• Install a nozzle that has been cut to a 4–5 m m
(0.16 – 0.20 in.) opening.
HINT: Avoid applying an excessive amount to the
surface.
• Parts must be assembled within 3 minutes of
application. Otherwise the material must be re–
moved and reapplied.
• Immediately remove nozzle from the tube and
reinstall cap.
(c) Install the No.1 oil pan with the 17 bolts.
Torque:
8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–lbf) for 10 mm head bolt
19.5 N–m (200 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf) for 12 mm head bolt
9. INSTALL OIL STRAINER
Install a new gasket and the oil strainer with the bolt
and 2 nuts.
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in–lbf)
EG2–175
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
10. INSTALL NO.2 OIL PAN
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be care–
ful not to drop any oil on the contact surface of the
No.1 and No.2 oil pans.
• Using a razor blade and gasket scraper, remove
all the old packing (FIPG) material from the
gasket surfaces and sealing grooves.
• Thoroughly clean all components to remove all
the loose material.
• Using a non–residue solvent, clean both sealing
surfaces.
NOTICE: Do not use a solvent which will affect the point–
ed surfaces.
(b) Apply seal packing to the No.2 oil pan as shown in the
illustration.
Seal packing:
Part No. 08828–00080 or equivalent
• Install a nozzle that–has been cut to a 4–5 mm
(0.16 – 0.20 in.) opening.
HINT: Avoid applying an excessive amount to the
surface.
• Parts must be assembled within 3 minutes of
application. Otherwise the material must be re–
moved and reapplied.
• Immediately remove nozzle from the tube and
reinstall cap.
(c) Install the No.2 oil pan with the 10 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–lbf)
11. INSTALL WATER PUMP
Install a new gasket and the water pump with the 4
bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–Ibf)
NOTICE: Do not got oil on the gasket.
EG2–176
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
12. INSTALL WATER INLET HOUSING
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be care–
ful not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces of the
water inlet housing and cylinder block.
• Using a razor blade and gasket scraper, remove
all the old packing (FIPG) material from the
gasket surfaces and sealing grooves.
• Thoroughly clean all components to remove all
the loose material.
• Using a non–residue solvent, clean both sealing
surfaces.
(b) Apply seal packing to the water inlet housing as
shown in the illustration.
Seal packing:
Part No. 08826–00100 or equivalent
• Install a nozzle that has been cut to a 3–5 mm
(0.12–0.20 in.) opening.
HINT: Avoid applying an excessive amount to the
surface.
• Parts must be assembled within 3 minutes of
application. Otherwise the material must be re–
moved and reapplied.
• Immediately remove nozzle from the tube and
reinstall cap.
(c) Install the water inlet housing with the 8 bolts and 2
nuts, in the several passes, in the sequence shown.
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–lbf)
13. INSTALL KNOCK SENSORS
(a) Using SST, install the 2 knock sensors.
SST 09816 – 30010
Torque: 39 N–m (400 kgf–cm, 29 ft–lbf)
EG2–177
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b) Connect the 2 knock sensor connectors.
(c) Install the wire band.
(d) Connect the engine wire clamp.
14. INSTALL NO.2 IDLER PULLEY BRACKET
Install the pulley bracket with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 28 N–m (290 kgf–cm, 21 ft–lbf)
15. INSTALL A/C COMPRESSOR HOUSING BRACKET
Install the compressor housing bracket with the 3
bolts.
Torque: 25 N–m (250 kgf–cm. 18 ft–lbf)
16. INSTALL GENERATOR BRACKET AND ADJUSTING
BAR
Install the generator bracket and adjusting bar with
the 3 nuts.
Torque: 43 N–m (440 kgf–cm, 32 ft–lbf)
17. INSTALL GENERATOR
Install the generator with the 2 bolts. Do not tighten
the bolts yet.
18. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD
(See pages EG2–96 to 118)
19. INSTALL TIMING PULLEYS AND BELT
(See pages EG2–49 to 55)
20. REMOVE ENGINE STAND
EG2–178
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
ENGINE & TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
(See Components for Engine & Transaxle Separation
and Assembly)
1. INSTALL DRIVE PLATE
(a) Install the front spacer on the crankshaft with the
chamfered end facing the shaft.
(b) Install the drive pate and rear spacer on the crank–
shaft.
(c) Clean the threads of the bolt with the gasoline.
(d) Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the mount bolt.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08833–00070. THREE BOND 1324 or
equivalent
(e) Install and uniformly tighten the mounting bolts, in the
several passes, in the sequence shown.
Torque: 83 N–m (850 kgf–cm, 61 ft–Ibf)
2. CHECK TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH
INSTALLATION
Using a scale and a straight edge, measure from the
installed surface to the front surface of the transaxle
housing.
Correct distance:
13.7 mm (0.539 in.) or more
EG2–179
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
3. INSTALL TRANSAXLE TO ENGINE
A. Install transaxle
(a) Attach the transaxle to the engine.
(b) Install the6 bolts.
Torque: 64 N–m (650 kgf–cm, 47 ft–lbf)
(c) Install the 2 bolts holding the No.2 oil pan to the
transaxle.
Torque: 46 N–m (470 kgf–cm, 34 ft–lbf)
(e) Install the No.2 manifold stay with the bolt and nut.
Torque: 20 N–m (200 kgf–cm. 14 ft–lbf)
(f) Install the manifold stay, exhaust manifold plate with
the bolt and 2 nuts.
Torque: 20 N–m (200 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
HINT: Install the manifold so that the tip of the stay
touches the head of the differential retainer installa–
tion bolt as shown in the illustration.
B. Install torque converter clutch mounting bolts
(a) Clean the threads of the bolt with the gasoline.
(b) Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the mount bolt.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08833–00070, THREE BOND 1324 or
equivalent
EG2–180
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c) Hold the crankshaft pulley bolt with a wrench, and
install the 6 bolts evenly.
Torque: 41 N–m (420 kgf–cm, 30 ft–lbf)
HINT: First install the dark green colored bolt, then
install the other bolts.
(d) Install the flywheel housing under cover with the 2
bolts.
Torque: 18 N–m (185 kgf–cm, 13 ft–lbf)
4. INSTALL OIL DIPSTICK GUIDE AND DIPSTICK
FOR TRANSMISSION
(a) Install a new 0–ring to the dipstick guide.
(b) Apply soapy water to the 0 – ring.
(c) Connect the dipstick guide end to the dipstick tube of
the oil pan.
(d) Install the dipstick guide with the bolt.
(e) Install the dipstick.
5. CONNECT ENGINE WIRE
(a) Connect the following parts:
(1) O/D solenoid connector
(2) PNP switch speedometer
(3) Starter 50 terminal
(4) Starter B terminal
(5) Speed sensor connector
(b) Disconnect the 2 wire clamps from the transaxle.
(c) Install the 2 wire clamps to the transaxle.
EG2–181
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
81
ENGINE INSTALLATION
(See Components for Engine Removal and Installation)
1. INSTALL FRONT EXHAUST PIPE STAY
Install the pipe stay with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 21 N–m (210 kgf–cm, 16 ft–lbf)
2. INSTALL RR ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
Install the mounting insulator with the 4 bolts.
Torque:63.7 N–m (650 kgf–cm, 47 ft–lbf)
3. INSTALL FR ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
Install the mounting insulator with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 6.74 N–m (650 kgf–cm, 47 ft–lbf)
4. INSTALL ENGINE AND TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY IN
VEHICLE
(a) Attach the engine sling device to the engine hangers.
(b) Lower the engine into the engine compartment.
Tilt the transaxle downward, lower the engine and
clear the LH mounting.
NOTICE: Be careful not to hit the PS gear housing or
neutral start switch.
(c) Keep the engine level, and align RH and LH mountings
with the body bracket.
EG2–182
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
5. INSTALL N0.2 ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET AND
ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD
Install the engine moving control rod and No.2 engine
mounting bracket with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 63.7 N–m (650 kgf–cm, 47 ft–lbf)
6. INSTALL RH ENGINE MOUNTING STAY
Install the RH mounting stay with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 31.4 N–m (320 kgf–cm, 23 ft–Ibf)
7. CONNECT GROUND STRAPS
Connect the 2 straps.
8. INSTALL COOLANT RESERVOIR TANK
(a) Install the reservoir tank.
(b) Connect the reservoir hose.
9. CONNECT FR ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
Connect the mounting insulator with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 80.4 N–m (820 kgf–cm, 59 ft–lbf) for TMC made
Torque: 65.7 N–m (670 kgf–cm, 48 ft–lbf) for TMM made
EG2–183
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
10. INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING ABSORBER
Install the engine mounting absorber with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 48 N–m (490 kgf–cm, 35 ft–lbf)
11. CONNECT RR ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
(a) Connect the mounting insulator with the 4 nuts.
Torque: 65.7 N–m (670 kgf–cm, 48 ft–lbf)
(b) Install the 2 hole plugs.
12. CONNECT LH ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
Connect the mounting insulator with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 63.7 N–m (650 kgf–cm, 47 ft–lbf)
13. REMOVE ENGINE SLING DEVICE
14. INSTALL PS PUMP
(a) Install the PS pump with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 43 N–m (440 kgf–cm, 31 ft–lbf)
(b) Install the drive belt.
15. CONNECT HYDRAULIC COOLING FAN PRESSURE
HOSE
Using SST, connect the pressure hose.
SST 09631– 22020
Torque: 44 N–m (450 kgf–cm, 33 ft–lbf)
EG2–184
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
16. CONNECT PS PRESSURE TUBE
(a) Connect the PS pressure tube with the 2 nuts.
(b) Connect the 2 PS air hoses.
17. INSTALL DRIVE SHAFTS (See SA section)
18. INSTALL FRONT EXHAUST PIPE
(a) Temporarily install 3 new gaskets and the front ex–
haust pipe with the 2 bolts and 6 nuts.
(b) Tighten the 4 nuts holding the exhaust manifolds to
the front exhaust pipe.
Torque: 62 N–m (630 kgf–cm, 46 ft–lbf)
(c) Tighten the 2 bolts and 2 nuts holding the three–way
catalytic converter to the front exhaust pipe.
Torque: 56 N–m (570 kgf–cm, 41 ft–lbf)
(d) Connect the bracket with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 19 N–m (195 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
(e) Connect the front exhaust pipe clamp with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 29 N–m (300 kgf–cm, 22 ft–lbf)
19. INSTALL A/C COMPRESSOR
(a) Install the A/C compressor and drive belt adjusting
bar bracket with the 5 bolts.
Torque: 25 N–m (250 kgf–cm, 18 ft–lbf)
EG2–185
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
20. CONNECT ENGINE WIRE TO CABIN
(a) Push in the engine wire through the cowl panel. Install
the 2 nuts.
(b) Connect the wire clamp.
(c) Connect the following connectors:
(1) 3 engine ECM connectors
(2) 5 cowl wire connectors
(3) Cooling fan ECU connector
(d) Install the following parts:
(1) Glove compartment
(2) Glove compartment door
(3) Lower instrument panel
(4) Under cover
21. CONNECT TRANSAXLE CONTROL CABLE TO
TRANSAXLE
EG2–186
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
22. CONNECT FUEL HOSES
(a) Connect the fuel return hose to the fuel pipe.
(b) Connect the fuel inlet hose to the fuel filter.
Torque: 30 N–m (300 kgf–cm, 22 ft–lbf)
23. CONNECT HEATER HOSES
Connect the 2 hoses.
24. CONNECT VACUUM HOSES
Connect the following vacuum hoses:
(1) Brake booster vacuum hose to air intake chamber
(2) Vacuum hose to charcoal canister
(3) Vacuum hoses to vacuum tank for intake air
control valve
EG2–187
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
25. CONNECT ENGINE WIRE
(a) Connect the wire clamps.
(b) Connect the ground strap with the bolt.
(c) Connect the connector to the LH fender apron.
(d) Connect the wire clamps
(e) Connect the following wires and connectors:
(1) 2 igniter connectors
(2) Noise filter connector
(3) Connector to LH fender apron
(4) 2 ground straps
(5) 5 connectors to relay box
(f) Connect the engine relay box with the 2 bolts.
26. INSTALL RADIATOR
(See page EG2–342)
27. w/ CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM:
INSTALL CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
(a) Connect the actuator and bracket with the 3 bolts.
(b) Connect the actuator connector and clamp.
(c) Install the actuator cover with the bolt and clip.
EG2–188
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
28. INSTALL AIR CLEANER CAP, VOLUME AIR
FLOW METER AND AIR CLEANER HOSE
(a) Connect the air cleaner hose, and install the air clean–
er cap and volume air flow meter with the 4 clips.
(b) Tighten the air cleaner hose clamp bolt.
(c) Connect the PCV hose.
(d) Connect the accelerator cable clamp.
(e) Connect the volume air flow meter connector and
wire clamp.
29. CONNECT THROTTLE CABLE
30. CONNECT ACCELERATOR CABLE
31. FILL ENGINE WITH OIL
Capacity:
Drain and refill
w/ Oil filter change
4.7 liters (5.0 US qts, 4.1 Imp. qts)
w/o Oil filter change
4.5 liters (4.8 US qts, 4.0 Imp. qts)
Dry fill
5.5 liters (5.8 US qts, 4.8 Imp. qts)
32. FILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
Capacity:
8.7 liters (9.2 US qts, 7.7 Imp. qts)
33. INSTALL BATTERY TRAY AND BATTERY
34. START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR LEAKS
35. PERFORM ROAD TEST
Check for abnormal noise, shock, slippage, correct
shift points and smooth operation.
36. RECHECK ENGINE COOLANT AND ENGINE OIL
LEVELS
EG2–189
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
EXHAUST SYSTEM
COMPONENTS
EG2–190
1MZ–FE ENGINE
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE DATA
Engine
tune – up
Intake
manifold
vacuum
Compression
pressure
Tinning belt
tensioner
–
– ENGINE MECHANICAL
EG2–191
1MZ–FE ENGINE
Cylinder head
Valve guide
bushing
Valve
Valve spring
Valve lifter
Camshaft
Air intake
chamber
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
EG2–192
1MZ–FE ENGINE
Intake
manifold
Exhaust
manifold
Cylinder block
Piston and
piston ring
Connecting
rod
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
EG2–193
1MZ–FE ENGINE
Connecting
rod (Cont’d)
Crankshaft
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part tightened
Cylinder head cover x Cylinder head
Spark plug x Cylinder head
Ignition coil x Cylinder head cover
Air intake chamber x Intake manifold
EGR pipe x Exhaust manifold
EGR pipe x Air intake chamber
No.1 engine hanger x Air intake chamber
No.1 engine hanger x Cylinder heed
Air intake chamber stay x Air intake chamber
Air intake chamber stay x Cylinder head
Emission control valve set x Air intake chamber
Timing belt plate x Oil pump
No.1 idler pulley x Oil pump
No.2 idler pulley x No.2 idler pulley bracket
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
EG2–194
1MZ–FE ENGINE
Camshaft timing pulley x Camshaft (For use with SST)
Camshaft timing pulley x Camshaft
Timing belt tensioner x Oil pump
Engine RH mounting bracket x Cylinder block
No.2 timing belt cover x No.3 timing belt cover
No.1 timing belt cover x Oil pump
Crankshaft pulley x Crankshaft
No.2 generator bracket x Engine RH mounting bracket
Engine moving control rod x Engine RH mounting bracket
Engine moving control rod x RH fender apron
RH engine mounting stay x Water outlet
RH engine mounting stay x Engine moving control rod
RH engine mounting stay x No.2 RH engine mounting bracket
Camshaft bearing cap x Cylinder head
Cylinder head x Cylinder block – 12–pointed head bolt (1 st)
Cylinder head x Cylinder block – 12–pointed head bolt (2nd)
Cylinder head x Cylinder block – Recessed head bolt
Camshaft position sensor x Cylinder head
Exhaust manifold x Cylinder head
EGR pipe x RH exhaust manifold
EGR pipe x EGR cooler
Exhaust manifold stay x Exhaust manifold
Exhaust manifold stay x Transmission housing
Oxygen sensor x Exhaust manifold
PS bracket x RH cylinder head
Oil dipstick guide x LH cylinder head
No.2 engine hanger x LH cylinder head
Water outlet x Intake manifold
No.3 timing belt cover x Cylinder head
Intake manifold x Cylinder head
Delivery pipe x Intake manifold
No. 1 fuel pipe x Intake manifold
Cylinder head rear plate x LH cylinder head
Water inlet pipe x LH cylinder head
Front exhaust pipe x Exhaust manifold
Front exhaust pipe x Three–way catalytic converter
Front exhaust pipe bracket x Sub frame
Front exhaust pipe clamp x Front exhaust pipe stay
EGR valve x Air intake chamber
Throttle body x Air intake chamber
Intake air control valve x Air intake chamber
Fuel inlet hose x Fuel filter
Connecting rod cap x Connecting rod – 1 at
Connecting rod cap x Connecting rod – 2nd
Main bearing cap x Cylinder block – 1 st (12 pointed head bolt)
Main bearing cap x Cylinder block – 2nd (12 pointed head bolt)
Main bearing cap x Cylinder block (Hexagon head bolt)
Rear oil seal retainer x Cylinder block
EGR cooler x Cylinder block
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
EG2–195
1MZ–FE ENGINE
Oil pressure switch x Cylinder block
Engine coolant drain cock x Cylinder block
Water seal plate x Cylinder block
Oil filter union x Cylinder block
Oil pump x Cylinder block (10 mm head bolt)
Oil pump x Cylinder block (12 mm head bolt)
No.1 oil pan x Cylinder block
No.1 oil pan x Oil pump
No.1 oil pan x Rear oil seal retainer
Oil strainer x Main bearing cap
Oil strainer x Oil pump
No.2 oil pan x No. 1 oil pan
Water pump x Cylinder block
Water inlet housing x Cylinder block
Knock sensor x Cylinder block
No.2 idler pulley bracket x Cylinder block
A/C compressor housing bracket x Cylinder block
Generator bracket x Cylinder block
Drive plate x Crankshaft
Transaxle x Engine
No.2 oil pan x Transaxle
Drive plate x Torque convertor clutch
Front exhaust pipe stay x No.1 oil pan
RR engine mounting insulator x Cylinder block
FR engine mounting insulator x Cylinder block
FR engine mounting insulator x Front suspension member (TMC
made)
FR engine mounting insulator x Front suspension member
(TM M made)
Engine mounting absorber x Front suspension member
Engine mounting absorber x Transaxle
RR engine mounting insulator x Front suspension member
LH engine mounting insulator x Transaxle
PS pump x PS pump bracket
PS pump x Hydraulic cooling fan pressure hose
A/C compressor x Generator bracket
A/C compressor x Cylinder block
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
EG2–196
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE – EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
DESCRIPTION
The emission control systems are installed to reduce the amount of HC, CO and NOx emitted from
the engine, and to also prevent release of evaporated fuel from the gasoline tank and prevent
atmospheric release of blow–by gas.
The system consists of the PCV, EVAP, EGR and TWC.
The function of each system is shown in the following table.
System
Positive crankcase ventilation
Evaporative emission control
Exhaust gas recirculation
Three–way catalytic converter
Sequential multiport fuel injection’
Abbreviation
PCV
EVAP
EGR
TWC
SFI
*For inspection and repair of the SFI system, refer to the SFI section.
Purpose
Reduces blow–by gas
Reduces evaporative HC
Reduces NOx
Reduces C0, HC and NOx
Regulates all engine conditions for reduction
of exhaust emissions.
EG2–197
1MZ–FE ENGINE
COMPONENT LAYOUT
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
EG2–198
1MZ–FE ENGINE
SCHEMATIC DRAWING
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
EG2–199
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
PREPARATION
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOL)
09843–18020 Diagnosis Check Wire
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082–00050 TOYOTA Electrical Tester Set
EQUIPMENT
Tachometer
Torque wrench
Vacuum gauge
SSM (SPECIAL SERVICE MATERIALS)
08833–00070 Adhesive 1311,
THREE BOND 1311 or equivalent
TVV
EG2–200
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION (PCV) SYSTEM
DESCRIPTION
To reduce HC emission, crankcase blow–by gas is routed through the PCV valve to the air intake
chamber for combustion in the cylinders.
OPERATION
Engine not Running
Normal Operation
Idling or Deceleration
Acceleration or High Load
EG2–201
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
PCV VALVE INSPECTION
1. REMOVE PCV VALVE
(a) Disconnect the PCV hose from the PCV valve.
(b) Remove the PCV valve.
2. INSTALL CLEAN HOSE TO PCV VALVE
3. INSPECT PCV VALVE OPERATION
(a) Blow air into the cylinder head side, and check that air
passes through easily.
CAUTION: Do not suck sir through the valve.
Petroleum substances inside the valve are harmful.
(b) Blow air into the intake manifold side, and check that
air passes through with difficulty.
If operation is not as specified, replace the PCV valve.
4. REMOVE CLEAN HOSE FROM PCV VALVE
5. REINSTALL PCV VALVE
PCV HOSES AND CONNECTORS
INSPECTION
VISUALLY INSPECT HOSES, CONNECTIONS AND
GASKETS
Check for cracks, leaks or damage.
EG2–202
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) CONTROL SYSTEM
DESCRIPTION
To reduce HC emission, evaporated fuel from the fuel tank is routed through the charcoal canister
to the intake manifold for combustion in the cylinders.
OPERATION
Engine
Coolant
Temp.
Below
40C (104F)
Above
59C (138F)
TVV
Throttle Valve
Position
Canister Check Valve
Check
Valve in
Tank Cap
Evaporated Fuel (HC)
CLOSED
OPEN
HC from tank is absorbed
into the canister.
Positioned below
port P
CLOSED
Positioned above
port P
OPEN
HC from canister is led
into air intake chamber.
Nigh pressure
in tank
OPEN
CLOSED
CLOSED
High vacuum
in take
CLOSED
OPEN
OPEN
HC from tank is absorbed
into the canister.
Air is led into the fuel
tank
EG2–203
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
FUEL VAPOR LINES, FUEL TANK AND
TANK CAP INSPECTION
1. VISUALLY INSPECT LINES AND CONNECTIONS
Look for loose connections, sharp bends or damage.
2. VISUALLY INSPECT FUEL TANK
Look for deformation, cracks or fuel leakage.
3. VISUALLY INSPECT FUEL TANK CAP
Check if the cap and/or gasket are deformed or
damaged.
If necessary, repair or replace the cap.
CHARCOAL CANISTER INSPECTION
1. REMOVE CHARCOAL CANISTER
2. VISUALLY INSPECT CHARCOAL CANISTER
Look for cracks or damage.
3. CHECK FOR CLOGGED FILTER AND STUCK CHECK
VALVE
(a) Blow low pressure compressed air (4.71 kPa, 48
gf/cm2. 0.68 psi) into port A and check that air flows
without resistance from the other ports.
(b) Blow low pressure compressed air (4.71 kPa, 48
gf/cm2, 0.68 psi) into port B and check that air does
not flow from the other ports.
If a problem is found, replace the charcoal canister.
EG2–204
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
4. CLEAN FILTER IN CANISTER
Clean the filter by blowing 294 kPa (3 kgf/cm2, 43 psi)
of compressed air into port A while holding port B
closed.
NOTICE:
• Do not attempt to wash the canister.
• No activated carbon should come out.
5. REINSTALL CHARCOAL CANISTER
TVV INSPECTION
1. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
2. REMOVE TVV FROM INTAKE MANIFOLD
3. INSPECT TVV OPERATION
(a) Cool the TVV to below 40C (104F) with cool water.
(b) Check that air does not flow from the upper port to
lower port.
(c) Heat the TVV to above 59C (138F) with hot water.
(d) Check that air flows from the upper port to lower port.
If operation is not as specified, replace the TVV.
4. REINSTALL TVV
Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the TVV, and
install it.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08833–00070, THREE BOND 1324
or equivalent
Torque: 30 N–m (305 kgf–cm, 22 ft–lbf)
5. REFILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
EG2–205
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE – EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
CHECK VALVE INSPECTION
1. REMOVE CHECK VALVE
2. INSPECT CHECK VALVE
(a) Check that air flows from the yellow port to the black
port.
(b) Check that air does not flow from the black port to the
yellow port.
If operation is not as specified, replace check valve.
3. REINSTALL CHECK VALVE
HINT: Reinstall the check valve with the black port
facing the purge port side.
EG2–206
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SYSTEM
DESCRIPTION
To reduce NOx emission, part of the exhaust gases are recirculated through the EGR valve to the
intake manifold to lower the maximum combustion temperature.
OPERATION
EG2–207
1MZ–FE ENGINE
Engine
Coolant
Temp.
VSV
Below
55°C
(131°F)
ON
OPENS passage
to atmosphere
Throttle Valve
Position
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
Pressure in the EGR
Valve Pressure Chamber
EG R Vacuum
Modulator
Exhaust
Gas
Not
CLOSED recirculated
Positioned below
port E
Above
60°C
(140°F)
EG R
Valve
CLOSED
(1)
LOW
OFF
Positioned between
CLOSED passage port E and port R
(2)
to atmosphere
HIGH
Positioned above
port R
(3)
HIGH
*Pressure con–
stantly alternating
between low and
high
OPENS passage
to atmosphere
Not
recirculated
Not
CLOSED recirculated
CLOSES passage
OPEN
to atmosphere’
Recirculated
CLOSES passage,
OPEN
to atmosphere
Recirculated
(increase)
* Pressure increase → Modulator closes → EGR valve opens→ Pressure drops
EGR valve closes← Modulator opens
** When the throttle valve is positioned above port R, the EGR vacuum modulator will close the atmosphere passage
and open the EGR valve to increase the EGR gas, even if the exhaust pressure is insufficiently low.
EGR SYSTEM INSPECTION
1. CHECK AND CLEAN FILTER IN EGR VACUUM
MODULATOR
(a) Remove the cap and filter.
(b) Check the filter for contamination or damage.
(c) Using compressed air, clean the filter.
(d) Reinstall the filter and cap.
HINT: Install the filter with the coarser surface facing
out to the atmospheric side.
2. INSTALL VACUUM GAUGE
Using a 3–way connector, connect a vacuum gauge
to the hose between the EGR valve and EGR VSV.
3. INSPECT SEATING OF EGR VALVE
Check that the engine starts and runs at idle.
4. CONNECT TERMINALS TE1 AND E1
Using SST, connect terminal TE1 and E1 of the data
link connector 1.
SST 09843–18020
EG2–208
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
5. INSPECT VSV OPERATION WITH COLD ENGINE
(a) The engine coolant temperature should be below
55 C (1131F).
(b) Check that the vacuum gauge indicates zero at 2,800
rpm.
(c) Check that the EGR pipe is not hot.
6. INSPECT OPERATION OF VSV AND EGR VACUUM
MODULATOR WITH HOT ENGINE
(a) Warm up the engine to above 80C (176° F).
(b) Check that the vacuum gauge indicates low vacuum
at 2,800 rpm.
(c) Disconnect the vacuum hose from port R of the EGR
vacuum modulator and connect port R directly to the
intake manifold with another hose.
(d) Check that the vacuum gauge indicates high vacuum
at 3,500 rpm.
HINT: As exhaust gas is increasingly recirculated, the
engine will start to misfire.
7. DISCONNECT TERMINALS TE1 AND E1
Remove the SST from the data link connector 1.
SST 09843–18020
EG2–209
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
8. REMOVE VACUUM GAUGE
Remove the vacuum gauge, and reconnect the
vacuum hoses to their proper locations.
9. INSPECT EGR VALVE
(a) Apply vacuum directly to the EGR valve with the
engine idle.
(b) Check that the engine runs rough or dies.
(c) Reconnect the vacuum hoses to their proper loca–
tions.
IF NO PROBLEM IS FOUND DURING THIS
INSPECTION, SYSTEM IS NORMAL; OTHERWISE
INSPECT EACH PART
VSV INSPECTION
1. REMOVE VSV
2. INSPECT VSV
A. Inspect VSV for open circuit
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between the terminals.
Resistance:
33 – 39 at 20C (68F)
If there is no continuity, replace the VSV.
B. Inspect VSV for ground
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity
between each terminal and the body.
!f there is continuity, replace the VSV.
EG2–210
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
C. Inspect VSV operation
(a) Check that the air flows from ports E to G.
(b) Apply battery voltage across the terminals.
(c) Check that the air flows from port E to the gas filter.
If operation is not as specified, replace the VSV.
3. REINSTALL VSV
EGR VACUUM MODULATOR INSPECTION
1. DISCONNECT VACUUM HOSES FROM EGR
VACUUM MODULATOR
Disconnect the following vacuum hoses:
(1) Vacuum hose from P port
(2) Vacuum hose from Q port
(3) Vacuum hose from R port
2. INSPECT EGR VACUUM MODULATOR OPERATION
(a) Block ports P and R with your finger.
(b) Blow air into port Q, and check that the air passes
through to the air filter side freely.
(c) Start the engine, and maintain speed at 3,500 rpm.
(d) Repeat the above test. Check that there is a strong
resistance to air flow.
EG2–211
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
3. RECONNECT VACUUM HOSES TO EGR VACUUM
MODULATOR
Connect the following vacuum hoses:
(1) Vacuum hose to P port
(2) Vacuum hose to Q port
(3) Vacuum hose to R port
EGR VALVE INSPECTION
1. REMOVE EGR PIPE
Remove the 4 nuts, EGR pipe and 2 gaskets.
2. DISCONNECT EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR
CONNECTOR AND CLAMP
3. REMOVE EGR VALVE AND VACUUM MODULATOR
ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the following hoses: .
(1) Vacuum hose from P port of EGR vacuum modu–
lator
(2) Vacuum hose from Q port of EGR vacuum modu–
lator
(3) Vacuum hose from R port of EGR vacuum modu–
lator
(4) Vacuum hose from EGR valve
(b) Remove the 3 nuts, EGR valve and vacuum modulator
assembly and gasket.
EG2–212
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
4. SEPARATE EGR VALVE AND VACUUM
MODULATOR
(a) Remove the nut and disconnect the EGR vacuum
modulator.
(b) Disconnect the pressure hose from the EGR valve and
remove the EGR vacuum modulator.
5. REMOVE EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR
6. INSPECT EGR VALVE
Check for sticking and heavy carbon deposits.
If a problem is found, replace the EGR valve.
EG2–213
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
7. REINSTALL EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Torque: 20 N–m (200 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
8. REASSEMBLE EGR VALVE AND VACUUM
MODULATOR
(a) Connect the pressure hose to the EGR valve.
(b) Install the EGR vacuum modulator with the nut.
Torque: 12 N–m (120 kgf–cm, 9 ft–lbf)
9. REINSTALL EGR VALVE AND VACUUM
MODULATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the EGR valve and vacuum modulator assembly
to the air intake chamber.
EG2–214
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
(b) Install and torque the 3 nuts.
Torque: 12 N–m (120 kgf–cm, 9 ft–lbf)
(c) Connect the following vacuum hoses:
(1) Vacuum hose to P port of EGR vacuum modula–
tor
(2) Vacuum hose to a port of EGR vacuum modula–
tor
(3) Vacuum hose to R port of EGR vacuum modula–
tor
(4) Vacuum to EGR valve
10. RECONNECT EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR
CONNECTOR AND CLAMP
11. REINSTALL EGR PIPE
Install 2 new gaskets and the EGR pipe with the 4
nuts.
Torque: 12 N–m (120 kgf–cm, 9 ft–lbf)
EG2–215
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
THREE–WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER (TWC) SYSTEM
DESCRIPTION
To reduce HC. CO and NOx emissions, they are oxidized, reduced and converted to nitrogen (N2),
carbon dioxide (C02) and water (H20) by the three–way catalytic converter.
OPERATION
Exhaust port
TWC
HC, CO, AND NOx
OXIDATION AND
REDUCTION
Exhaust Gas
CO2
H2O
N2
EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY INSPECTION
1. CHECK CONNECTIONS FOR LOOSENESS OR
DAMAGE
2. CHECK CLAMPS FOR WEAKNESS. CRACKS OR DAMAGE
THREE–WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER
INSPECTION
CHECK FOR DENTS OR DAMAGE
If any part of the protector is damaged or dented to
the extent that it contacts the three–way catalytic
converter, repair or replace it.
EG2–216
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
HEAT INSULATOR INSPECTION
1. CHECK HEAT INSULATOR FOR DAMAGE
2. CHECK FOR ADEQUATE CLEARANCE BETWEEN
CATALYTIC CONVERTER AND HEAT INSULATOR
THREE–WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER
REPLACEMENT
1. REMOVE CONVERTER
(a) Jack up the vehicle.
(b) Check that the converter is cool.
(c) Remove the 4 bolts and nuts holding the pipes to the
converter.
(d) Remove the converter and 2 gaskets.
2. REINSTALL CONVERTER
(a) Place 2 new gaskets on the front and rear pipes.
(b) Install the converter with the bolts and nuts. Torque
the bolts and nuts.
Torque: 43 N–m (440 kgf–cm, 32 ft–lbf)
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE DATA
VSV for EGR
Resistance
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part tightened
TVV x Cylinder heed
EGR gas temperature x EGR valve
EGR vacuum modulator x EGR valve
EGR valve x Air intake chamber
EGR pipe x Air intake chamber
EGR pipe x EGR cooler
Three –way catalytic converter x Front exhaust pipe
Three–way catalytic converter x Center exhaust pipe
et 20 C (68 F) 33 –39
EG2–217
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
SFI SYSTEM
DESCRIPTION
EG2–218
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
The SFI (Sequential Multiport Fuel Injection) system is composed of 3 basic sub–systems: Fuel,
Air Induction and Electronic Control Systems.
FUEL SYSTEM
Fuel is supplied under constant pressure to the SFI injectors by an electric fuel pump. The
injectors inject a metered quantity of fuel into the intake manifold in accordance with signals
from the ECM (Engine Control Module).
AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
The air induction system provides sufficient air for engine operation.
ELECTRONIC CONTROL SYSTEM
The 1 MZ–FE engine is equipped with a TOYOTA Computer Controlled System (TCCS) which
centrally controls the SFI, ESA, IAC, diagnosis systems etc. by means of ECM–formerly SFI
computer employing a microcomputer.
The ECM controls the following functions:
1. Sequential Multiport Fuel Injection (SFI)
The ECM receives signals from various sensors indicating changing engine operation conditions
such as:
Intake air volume
Intake air temperature (IAT)
Engine coolant temperature (ECT)
Engine speed (RPM)
Acceleration/deceleration
Exhaust oxygen content etc.
The signals are utilized by the ECM to determine the injection duration necessary for an optimum
air–fuel ratio.
2. Electronic Spark Advance (ESA)
The ECM is programmed with data for optimum ignition timing under all operating conditions.
Using data provided by sensors which monitor various engine functions (RPM, ECT, etc.), the
ECM triggers the spark at precisely the right instant.
3. Idle Air Control (IAC)
The ECM is programmed with target idling speed values to respond to different engine conditions
(ECT, A/C (air conditioning) ON/OFF, etc.). Sensors transmit signals to the ECM which control the
flow of air through the throttle valve bypass and adjust idle speed to the target value.
4. Diagnosis
The ECM detects any malfunctions and abnormalities in the sensor network and lights a
malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) on the combination meter. At the same time, the trouble is
identified and a diagnostic trouble code is recorded by the ECM. The diagnostic trouble codes are
referred in the Engine Troubleshooting. (See page EG2–404)
5. Fail–Safe Function
In the event of the sensor malfunctioning, a back–up circuit will take over to provide minimal
driveability, and the malfunction indicator lamp will illuminate.
EG2–219
1MZ–FE ENGINE
SYSTEM CIRCUIT
–
SFI SYSTEM
EG2–220
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
OPERATION
FUEL SYSTEM
Fuel is pumped up by the fuel pump, which flows through the fuel filter under pressure through
the fuel pipe to the delivery pipe where it is distributed to each injector.
The fuel pressure regulator adjusts the pressure of the fuel from the fuel line (high pressure side)
to a pressure 284 kPa (2.9 kgf/cm2, 41 psi) higher than the pressure inside the intake manifold,
and excess fuel is returned to the fuel tank through the return tube.
When the engine is hot, the fuel pressure is increased to control percolation in the fuel system
and improve restartability and idling stability.
The pulsation damper absorbs the slight fluctuations in fuel pressure caused by the injector.
Fuel is injected into the intake manifold according to signals from the ECM.
EG2–221
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
Air filtered through the air cleaner passes through the MAF meter and the amount flowing to the
air intake chamber is determined by the throttle valve opening in the throttle body and the engine
speed. The MAF meter measures the intake flow to the engine by measuring the air’s cooling
effect on the thermistor which is heated by the heater.
Located in the throttle body is the throttle valve, which regulates the volume of air intake to the
engine. Air intake controlled by the throttle valve opening is distributed from the intake chamber
to the manifold of each cylinder and is drawn into the combustion chamber.
At low air temperatures the IAC valve opens and the air flows through the IAC valve, as well as
the throttle body, into the air intake chamber. During engine warm up, fast idle is accomplished
by air flowing into the intake chamber via the IAC valve, even when the throttle valve is
completely closed. In this way the IAC valve controls the idle speed to suit the operating
conditions.
The air intake chamber prevents pulsation of the intake air, reduces the influence of the MAF
meter and increases the air intake volume. It also prevents intake air interference in each cylinder.
There is also the intake air control valve attached to the air intake chamber. Part of the ACIS, the
ECM provides signals to the VSV to open or close. This valve opens or closes the vacuum source
to the actuator, which in turn opens or closes the intake air control valve. The intake air control
valve is designed to modify the effective manifold length in 2 stages for increased power in all
driving ranges.
EG2–222
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
ELECTRONIC CONTROL SYSTEM
The control system consists of sensors which detect various engine conditions, and an ECM
which determines the injection volume (timing) based on the signals from the sensors.
The various sensors detect the intake air volume, engine speed, oxygen density in the exhaust
gas, engine coolant temperature and intake air temperature etc. and convert the information into
an electrical signal which is sent to the ECM; Based on these signals, the ECM calculates the
optimum ignition timing for the current conditions and operates the injectors.
The ECM not only controls the fuel injection timing, but also the self diagnostic function which
records the occurrence of a malfunction, fuel volume and timing injection control, idle speed
control, fuel pressure control, knock sensor control and EGR control.
EG2–223
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
PREPARATION
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
09268–41045 Injection Measuring Tool Set
(09268–41080) No.6 union
(09268–41090) No.7 Union
(90405–09015) No.1 Union
09268–45012 EFI Fuel Pressure Gauge
09631 –22020 Power Steering Hose Nut
14 x 17 mm Wrench Set
Fuel line flare nut
09842–30070 Wiring ”F” EFI Inspection
09843–18020 Diagnosis Check Wire
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082–00050 TOYOTA Electrical Tester Set
09200–00010 Engine Adjust Kit
09258–00030 Hose Plug Set
Plug for the vacuum hose, fuel
hose etc.
EG2–224
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
EQUIPMENT
Graduated cylinder
Injector
Carburetor cleaner
Throttle body
Sound scope
Injector
Tachometer
Torque wrench
Vacuum gauge
Soft brush
Throttle body
SSM (SPECIAL SERVICE MATERIALS)
08826–00080 Seal packing or equivalent
Intake air control valve
COOLANT
Item
Engine coolant
Capacity
8.7 liters (9.2 US qts, 7.7 Imp. qts)
Classification
Ethylene–glycol base
EG2–225
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1. Before working on the fuel system, disconnect the
negative (–) terminal cable from the battery.
HINT: Any diagnostic trouble code retained by the
computer will be erased when the battery terminal is
removed.
Therefore, if necessary, read the diagnosis before
removing the battery terminal.
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the Ignition switch is turned to the ”LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. Do not smoke or work near an open flame when
working on the fuel system.
3. Keep gasoline away from rubber or leather parts.
MAINTENANCE PRECAUTIONS
1. CHECK CORRECT ENGINE TUNE–UP
(See page EG2–8)
2. PRECAUTIONS WHEN CONNECTING GAUGE
(a) Use the battery as the power source for the timing
light, tachometer, etc.
(b) Connect the tester probe of a tachometer to the termi–
nal IG(–) of the DLC1.
3. IN EVENT OF ENGINE MISFIRE, FOLLOWING PRE–
CAUTIONS SHOULD BE TAKEN
(a) Check proper connection of battery terminals, etc.
(b) After repair work, check that the ignition coil termi–
nals and all other ignition system lines are reconne–
cted securely.
(c) When cleaning the engine compartment, be especially
careful to protect the electrical system from water.
4. PRECAUTIONS WHEN HANDLING OXYGEN
SENSOR
(a) Do not allow oxygen sensor to drop or hit against an
object.
(b) Do not allow the sensor to come into contact with
water.
EG2–226
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
IF VEHICLE IS EQUIPPED WITH MOBILE
RADIO SYSTEM (HAM, CB, ETC.)
If the vehicle is equipped with a mobile communica–
tion system, refer to the precaution in the IN section.
AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
1. Separation of the engine oil dipstick, oil filler cap, PCV
hose, etc. may cause the engine to run out of tune.
2. Disconnection, looseness or cracks in the parts of the
air induction system between the throttle body and
cylinder head will allow air suction and cause the
engine to run out of tune.
ELECTRONIC CONTROL SYSTEM
1. Before removing SFI wiring connectors, terminals,
etc., first disconnect the power by either turning the
ignition switch to LOCK or disconnecting the negative
(–) terminal cable from the battery.
HINT: Always check the diagnostic trouble code
before disconnecting the negative (–) terminal cable
from the battery.
2. When installing the battery, be especially careful not
to incorrectly connect the positive (+) and negative
(–) cables.
3. Do not permit parts to receive a severe impact during
removal or installation. Handle all SFI parts carefully,
especially the ECM.
4. Do not be careless during troubleshooting as there are
numerous transistor circuits and even slight terminal
contact can cause further troubles.
5. Do not open the ECM cover.
6. When inspecting during rainy weather, take care to
prevent entry of water. Also, when washing the
engine compartment, prevent water from getting or
the SFI parts and wiring connectors.
7. Parts should be replaced as an assembly.
EG2–227
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
8. Care is required when pulling out and inserting wiring
connectors.
(a) Release the lock and pull out the connector, pulling on
the connectors.
(b) Fully insert the connector and check that it is locked.
9. Use SST for inspection or test of the injector or its
wiring connector.
SST 09842–30070
FUEL SYSTEM
1. When disconnecting the high fuel pressure line, a
large amount of gasoline will spill out, so observe the
following procedures:
(a) Put a container under the connection.
(b) Slowly loosen the connection.
(c) Disconnect the connection.
(d) Plug the connection with a rubber plug.
2. When connecting the flare nut or union bolt on the
high pressure pipe union, observe the following proce–
dures:
Union Bolt Type:
(a) Always use 2 new gaskets.
(b) Tighten the union bolt by hand.
(c) Tighten the union bolt to the specified torque.
Torque: 30 N–m (310 kgf–cm, 22 ft–lbf)
EG2–228
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
Flare Nut Type:
(a) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the flare nut, and
tighten the flare nut by hand.
M Using SST, tighten the flare nut to specified torque.
SST 09631– 22020
NOTICE: Do not rotate the fuel pipe, when tightening the
flare nut.
Torque:
28 N–m (285 kgf–cm, 21 ft–lbf) for fuel pump side
30 N–m (310 kgf–cm, 22 ft–lbf) for others
HINT: Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of
30 cm (111.81 in.).
3. Observe the following precautions when removing
and installing the injectors.
(a) Never reuse the O–ring.
(b) When placing a new 0 –ring on the injector, take care
not to damage it in any way.
(c) Coat a new 0 –ring with spindle oil or gasoline before
installing– never use engine, gear or brake oil.
4. Install the injector to the delivery pipe and intake
manifold as shown in the illustration.
5. Check that there are no fuel leaks after performing
any maintenance on the fuel system.
(a) Using SST, connect terminals +B and FP of the DLC
1.
SST 09843–18020
EG2–229
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
(b) With engine stopped, turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Pinch the fuel return hose.
The pressure in the high pressure line will rise to
approx. 392 kPa (4 kgf/cm2 57 psi). In this state,
check to see that there are no leaks from any part of
the fuel system.
NOTICE: Always pinch the hose. Avoid bending as it may
cause the hose to crack.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to LOCK.
(e) Remove the SST from the DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
EG2–230
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
FUEL PUMP
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1. CHECK FUEL PUMP OPERATION
(a) Using SST, connect terminals +B and FP of the DLC
1.
SST 09843–18020
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
NOTICE: Do not start the engine.
(c) Check that there is pressure in the fuel inlet hose from
the fuel filter.
HINT: If there is fuel pressure, you will hear the sound
of fuel flowing.
If there is no pressure, check the following parts:
• Fusible link
• Fuses (AM2 30A, IGN 7.5A)
• EFI main relay
• Fuel pump
• ECM
• Wiring connections
(d) Turn the ignition switch to LOCK.
EG2–231
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
(e) Remove the SST from the DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
2. CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
(a) Check the battery voltage is above 12 V.
(b) Disconnect the negative (–) terminal cable from the
battery.
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch Is turned to the ”LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
(c) Remove the union bolt and 2 gaskets, and disconnect
the fuel inlet hose from the fuel filter outlet.
CAUTION:
• Put a shop towel under the fuel filter.
• Slowly loosen the union bolt.
(d) Install the fuel inlet hose and SST (pressure gauge) to
the fuel filter outlet with 3 new gaskets and the union
bolt.
SST 09268–45012
Torque: 29 N–m (300 kgf–cm, 22 ft–lbf)
(e) Wipe off any splattered gasoline.
EG2–232
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
(f) Using SST, connect terminals +B and FP of the DLC
1.
(g) Reconnect the negative (–) terminal cable to the
battery.
(h) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(i) Measure the fuel pressure.
Fuel pressure:
266 – 304 kPa (2.7 – 3.1 kgf/cm2, 38 – 44 psi)
If pressure is high, replace the fuel pressure regulator.
If pressure is low, check the following parts:
• Fuel hoses and connections
• Fuel pump
• Fuel filter
• Fuel pressure regulator
(j) Remove the SST from the DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
(k) Start the engine.
(l) Disconnect the vacuum sensing hose from the fuel
pressure regulator, and plug the hose end.
EG2–233
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
(m) Measure the fuel pressure at idle.
Fuel pressure:
265 – 304 kPa (2.7 – 3.1 kgf/cm2, 39 – 44 psi)
(n) Reconnect the vacuum sensing hose to the fuel pres–
sure regulator.
(o) Measure the fuel pressure at idle.
Fuel pressure:
226 – 265 kPa (2.3 – 2.7 kgf/cm2, 33 – 38 psi)
If pressure is not as specified, check the vacuum
sensing hose and fuel pressure regulator.
(p) Stop the engine.
(q) Check that the fuel pressure remains as specified for 5
minutes after the engine has stopped.
Fuel pressure:
147 kPa (1.5 kgf/cm2, 21 psi) or more
If pressure is not as specified, check the fuel pump,
pressure regulator and/or injectors.
(r) After checking fuel pressure, disconnect the negative
(–) terminal cable from the battery and carefully
remove the SST to prevent gasoline from splashing.
SST 09268–45012
EG2–234
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
Sf=I SYSTEM
(s) Connect the fuel inlet hose with 2 new gaskets and
the union bolt.
Torque: 29 N–m (300 kgf–cm, 22 ft–lbf)
(t) Reconnect the negative (–) terminal cable to the
battery.
(u) Check for fuel leakage.
(See page EG2–228)
FUEL PUMP INSPECTION
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ”LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION
3. INSPECT FUEL PUMP
A. Inspect fuel pump resistance
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
terminals 4 and 5.
Resistance:
0.2–3.0 at 20C (88 F)
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the fuel
pump.
B. Inspect fuel pump operation
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 4 of the connector, and the negative (–) lead
to terminal
5. Check that the fuel pump operates.
NOTICE:
• These tests must be performed quickly (within 10
seconds) to prevent the coil burning out.
• Keep the fuel pump as far away from the battery as
possible.
• Always perform switching at the battery side.
If operation is not as specified, replace the fuel pump
or lead wire.
4. REINSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION
5. RECONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
TO BATTERY
EG2–235
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
FUEL PUMP REMOVAL
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
CAUTION: Do not smoke or work near an open flame
when working on the fuel pump.
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION
EG2–236
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
3. REMOVE FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER
(a) Disconnect the fuel pump connector.
(b) Remove the 5 screws and service hole cover.
4. REMOVE FUEL PUMP LEAD WIRE
NOTICE: Do not lift the fuel pump up with the wire
harness picking.
5. DISCONNECT FUEL PIPE AND HOSE FROM FUEL
PUMP BRACKET
CAUTION: Remove the fuel filter cap to prevent the fuel
from flowing out.
(a) Using SST, disconnect the outlet pipe from the pump
bracket.
SST 09631– 22020
(b) Disconnect the return hose from the pump bracket.
6. REMOVE FUEL PUMP BRACKET ASSEMBLY FROM
FUEL TANK
(a) Remove the 8 bolts.
(b) Pull out the pump bracket assembly.
(c) Remove the gasket from the pump bracket.
EG2–237
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
COMPONENTS FOR DISASSEMBLY AND
ASSEMBLY
FUEL PUMP DISASSEMBLY
(See Components for Disassembly and Assembly)
1. REMOVE FUEL PUMP FROM FUEL PUMP BRACKET
(a) Remove the fuel pump lead wire.
(b) Pull off the lower side of the fuel pump from the pump
bracket.
(c) Disconnect the fuel hose from the fuel pump, and
remove the fuel pump.
(d) Remove the rubber cushion from the fuel pump.
2. REMOVE FUEL SENDER GAUGE FROM FUEL PUMP
BRACKET
(a) Disconnect the fuel sender gauge connector.
(b) Remove the 2 screws and sender gauge.
EG2–238
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
3. REMOVE FUEL PUMP FILTER FROM FUEL PUMP
(a) Using a small screwdriver, remove the clip.
(b) Pull out the pump filter.
4. REMOVE CONNECTOR
Remove the 2 screws, connector support, connector
and gasket.
FUEL PUMP ASSEMBLY
(See Components for Disassembly and Assembly)
1. INSTALL CONNECTOR
Install new gasket, the connector and connector sup–
port with the 2 screws.
2. INSTALL FUEL PUMP FILTER TO FUEL PUMP
Install the pump filter with a new clip.
3. INSTALL FUEL SENDER GAUGE TO FUEL PUMP
BRACKET
(a) Install the sender gauge with the 2 screws.
(b) Connect the fuel sender gauge connector.
4. INSTALL FUEL PUMP TO FUEL PUMP BRACKET
(a) Install the rubber cushion to the fuel pump.
(b) Connect the fuel hose to the outlet port of the fuel
pump.
(c) Install the fuel pump by pushing the lower side of the
fuel pump.
(d) Install the fuel pump connector.
EG2–239
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
FUEL PUMP INSTALLATION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. INSTALL FUEL PUMP BRACKET ASSEMBLY TO
FUEL TANK
(a) Install a new gasket to the pump bracket.
(b) Insert the pump bracket assembly into the fuel tank.
NOTICE:
• Do not damage the fuel pump filter.
• Be careful that the arm of the sender gauge should
not bent.
(c) Install the pump bracket with the 8 screws.
Torque: 4 N–m (40 kgf–cm, 35 in.–lbf)
2. CONNECT FUEL PIPE AND HOSE TO FUEL PUMP
BRACKET
(a) Using SST, connect the outlet pipe to the pump
bracket.
SST 09631– 22020
Torque: 28 N–m (285 kgf–cm, 21 ft–lbf) for use with SST
(b) Connect the return hoses to the pump bracket.
3. CONNECT FUEL PUMP LEAD WIRE
4. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
TO BATTERY
6. CHECK FOR FUEL LEAKAGE
(See page EG2–228)
Connect the fuel pump (with fuel sender gauge) con–
nector.
6. INSTALL FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER
Install the service hole cover with the 5 screws.
7. INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION
EG2–240
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
(See page EG2–231)
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
EG2–241
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR REMOVAL
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. DISCONNECT VACUUM SENSING HOSE FROM
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR
3. DISCONNECT FUEL RETURN HOSE FROM FUEL
PRESSURE REGULATOR
CAUTION: Put a shop rag under the pressure regulator.
4. REMOVE FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR
(a) Remove the 2 bolts, and pull out the pressure regula–
tor.
(b) Remove the 0–ring from the pressure regulator.
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR
INSTALLATION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. INSTALL FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR
(a) Apply a light coat of gasoline to a new 0–ring, and
install it to the pressure regulator.
EG2–242
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
(b) Attach the pressure regulator to the delivery pipe.
(c) Check that the pressure regulator rotates smoothly.
NOTICE: If it does not rotate smoothly, the O–ring may
be pinched, so remove the pressure regulator and repeat
steps (a) to (e) above.
(d) Install the pressure regulator with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–lbf)
2. CONNECT FUEL RETURN HOSE TO FUEL PRES–
SURE REGULATOR
NOTICE: Be sure insert the hose up to the stopper and
clip It.
3. CONNECT VACUUM SENSING HOSE TO FUEL
PRESSURE REGULATOR
4. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
TO BATTERY
5. CHECK FOR FUEL LEAKS
(See page EC–228)
EG2–243
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
INJECTOR
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. REMOVE V–BANK COVER
Using a 5 mm hexagon wrench, remove the 2 cap nuts
and V–bank cover.
EG2–244
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
3. INSPECT INJECTOR OPERATION
Check operation sound from each injector.
(a) With the engine running or cranking, use a sound
scope to check that there is normal operating noise in
proportion to engine speed.
(b) If you have no sound scope, you can check the injec–
tor operating vibration with your finger.
If no sound or unusual sound is heard, check the
wiring connector, injector or injection signal from the
ECM.
4. INSPECT INJECTOR RESISTANCE
(a) Disconnect the injector connector.
(b) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
the terminals.
Resistance:
Approx. 13.8 at 20° C (68° F)
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the injec–
tor.
(c) Reconnect the injector connector.
5. REINSTALL V–BANK COVER
Using a 5 mm hexagon wrench, install the V–bank
cover with the 2 cap nuts.
HINT: For fixing the V–bank cover, push on the cover
until sense of ”click” is felt.
6. RECONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
TO BATTERY
EG2–245
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
EG2–246
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
INJECTORS REMOVAL
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the Ignition switch is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
3. DISCONNECT ACCELERATOR CABLE
4. DISCONNECT THROTTLE CABLE
6. REMOVE AIR CLEANER HOSE
(a) Disconnect the PCV hose.
(b) Loosen the 2 hose clamps, and remove the air cleaner
hose.
6. REMOVE V–SANK COVER
Using a 5 mm hexagon wrench, remove the 2 cap nuts
and v–bank cover.
7. REMOVE EMISSION CONTROL VALVE SET
(a) Disconnect the following vacuum hoses:
(1) Vacuum hose from VSV for ACIS
(2) Vacuum hose from EGR vacuum modulator
(3) Vacuum hose from EGR valve
(4) Vacuum hose (from cylinder head rear plate)
(5) Vacuum hose from air intake chamber
(6) Vacuum hose from fuel pressure regulator
EG2–247
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
(b) Disconnect the following connectors:
(1) VSV connector for ACIS
(2) VSV connector for EGR
(3) VSV connector for fuel pressure control
(c) Remove the 2 nuts and emission control valve set.
8. REMOVE No.2 EGR PIPE
Remove the 4 nuts, EGR pipe and 2 gaskets.
9. DISCONNECT HYDRAULIC MOTOR PRESSURE
PIPE
Remove the 2 bolts, and disconnect the pressure pipe
from the water inlet and air intake chamber.
10. REMOVE AIR INTAKE CHAMBER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the 2 PS air hoses.
(b) Remove the bolt holding the air intake chamber stay
to the air intake chamber.
EG2–248
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
(c) Disconnect the following connectors:
(1) A/C idle–up valve connector
(2) EGR gas temperature sensor connector
(3) Throttle position sensor connector
(4) IAC valve connector
(d) Disconnect the following vacuum hoses:
(1) Vacuum hose from charcoal canister
(2) Vacuum hose from air intake chamber
(3) 2 vacuum hoses from throttle body
(e) Disconnect the following hoses:
(1) 2 water bypass hoses from throttle body
(2) Air assist hose from throttle body
(f) Disconnect the following hoses:
(1) Brake booster vacuum hose
(2) PCV hose
(3) Actuator vacuum hose
(g) Disconnect the DLC1.
(h) Remove the nut and disconnect the 2 ground straps.
EG2–249
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
(i) Remove the nut and disconnect the PS pressure tube.
(j) Remove the bolt holding the No.1 engine hanger to
the air intake chamber.
(k) Remove the bolt, and disconnect the ground strap.
Using a 8 mm hexagon wrench, remove the 2 bolts, 2
nuts, air intake chamber assembly and gasket.
11. DISCONNECT INJECTOR CONNECTORS
12. REMOVE AIR ASSIST HOSES AND PIPE
(a) Disconnect the air assit pipe from the bracket on the
No.1 fuel pipe.
(b) Remove the air assist hoses from the intake manifold.
13. DISCONNECT FUEL INLET AND RETURN HOSES
(a) Disconnect the fuel return hose from the No.1 fuel
pipe.
(b) Disconnect the fuel inlet hose from the fuel filter.
CAUTION: Catch leaking fuel in a container.
EG2–250
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
14. REMOVE DELIVERY PIPES AND INJECTORS
NOTICE: Be careful not to drop the injectors when rem–
oving the delivery pipes.
(a) Loosen the 2 union bolts holding the No.2 fuel pipe to
the delivery pipes.
(b) Disconnect the fuel return hose from the fuel pressure
regulator.
(c) Remove the union bolt for the RH delivery pipe, 2
gaskets, 2 bolts, LH delivery pipe together with the 3
injectors and No.2 fuel pipe.
(d) Remove the union bolt for the LH delivery pipe and 2
gaskets from the No.2 fuel pipe.
(e) Remove the 3 bolts, RH delivery pipe together with
the 3 injectors and No.1 fuel pipe.
(f) Remove the 4 spacers from the intake manifold.
(g) Pull out the 6 injectors from the delivery pipes.
(h) Remove the 2 0 – rings and 2 grommets from each
injector.
INJECTORS INSPECTION
1. INSPECT INJECTOR INJECTION
CAUTION: Keep injector clear of sparks during the test.
EG2–251
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
(a) Disconnect the fuel hose from the fuel filter outlet.
(b) Connect SST (union an hose) to the fuel filter outlet
with 2 new gaskets and the union bolt.
SST 09268–41045 (90405–09015)
HINT: Use the vehicle’s fuel filter.
(c) Remove the fuel pressure regulator.
(d) Connect the fuel return hose, SST (hose) and SST
(union) to the fuel pressure regulator.
SST 09268–41045 (09268–41090)
(e) Install a new O–ring to the injector.
(f) Connect SST (union and hose) to the injector, and hold
the injector and union with SST (clamp).
SST 09268–41045
(g) Put the injector into the graduated cylinder.
HINT: Install a suitable vinyl hose onto the injector to
prevent gasoline from splashing out.
(h) Using SST, connect terminals +B and FP of the DLC1.
SST 00843–18020
(i) Reconnect the negative (–) terminal cable to the
battery.
(j) Turn the ignition switch ON.
NOTICE: Do not start the engine.
EG2–252
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE – SFI SYSTEM
(k) Connect SST (wire) to the injector and battery for 15
seconds, and measure the injection volume with a
graduated cylinder. Test each injector 2 or 3 times.
SST 09842–30070
Volume:
54 – 64 cm3 (3.3 – 3.9 cu in.) per 15 sec.
Difference between each injector:
5 cm3 (0.3 cu in.) or less
If the ignition volume is not as specified, replace the
injector.
2. INSPECT LEAKAGE
(a) In the condition above, disconnect the test probes of
SST (wire) from the battery and check the fuel leakage
from the injector.
SST 09842–30070
Fuel drop:
1 drop or less per minute
(b) Disconnect the negative (–) terminal cable to the
battery.
(c) Remove SST.
SST 09268–41045 and 09843–18020
(d) Reinstall the fuel pressure regulator to the delivery
pipe. (See step 1 on pages EG2–241 and 242)
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–lbf)
INJECTORS INSTALLATION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. INSTALL INJECTORS AND DELIVERY PIPES
(a) Install 2 new grommets to each injector.
(b) Apply a light coat of spindle oil or gasoline to 2 new 0
–rings and install them to each injector.
(c) While turning the injector clockwise and counter–
clockwise, push it to the delivery pipes. Install the 6
injectors.
(d) Position the injector connector outward.
EG2–253
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE – SFI SYSTEM
(e) Place the 4 spacers in position on the intake manifold.
(f) Place the RH delivery pipe and No.1 fuel pipe together
with the 3 injectors in position on the intake manifold.
(g) Temporarily install the 2 bolts holding the RH delivery
pipe to the intake manifold.
(h) Temporarily install the bolt holding the No.1 fuel pipe
to the intake manifold.
(i) Place the LH delivery pipe and No.2 fuel pipe together
with the 3 injectors in position on the intake manifold.
(j) Connect the fuel return hose to the fuel pressure
regulator.
(k) Temporarily install the 2 bolts holding the LH delivery
pipe to the intake manifold.
(l) Temporarily install the No.2 fuel pipe to the LH deliv–
ery pipe with the union bolt and 2 new gaskets.
(m) Check that the injectors rotate smoothly.
HINT: If injectors do not rotate smoothly, the probable
cause is incorrect installation of 0–rings. Replace the
O – rings.
(n) Position the injector connector outward.
(o) Tighten the 4 bolts holding the delivery pipes to the
intake manifold.
Torque: 10 N–m (100 kgf–cm, 7 ft–lbf)
(p) Tighten the bolt holding the No.1 fuel pipe to the
intake manifold.
Torque: 19.5 N–m (200 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
(q) Tighten the 2 union bolts holding the No.2 fuel pipe to
the delivery pipes.
Torque: 32.5 N–m (330 kgf–cm, 24 ft–lbf)
EG2–254
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
2. CONNECT FUEL INLET AND RETURN HOSES
(a) Connect the fuel inlet hose to the fuel filter with the 2
new gaskets and union bolt.
Torque: 30 N–m (300 kgf–cm, 22 ft–lbf)
(b) Connect the fuel return hose to the No.1 fuel pipe.
HINT: Pass the fuel return hose under the heater
hoses.
3. INSTALL AIR ASSIST HOSES AND PIPE
(a) Connect the air assist hoses to the intake manifold.
(b) Install the air assist pipe to the bracket on the No.1
fuel pipe.
4. CONNECT INJECTOR CONNECTORS
5. INSTALL AIR INTAKE CHAMBER ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a 8 mm hexagon wrench, install a new gasket
and the air intake chamber assembly with the 2 bolts
and 2 nuts.
Torque: 43 N–m (440 kgf–cm, 32 ft–lbf)
(b) Connect the ground strap with the bolt.
(c) Install the bolt holding the No.1 engine hanger to the
air intake chamber.
Torque: 39 N–m (400 kgf–cm, 29 ft–lbf)
(d) Connect the PS pressure tube with the nut.
EG2–255
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
(e) Connect the following hoses:
(1) Brake booster vacuum hose
(2) PCV hose
(3) Actuator vacuum hose
(f) Connect the DLC1.
(g) Connect the 2 ground straps with the nut.
Torque: 14.5 N–m (145 kgf–cm. 10 ft–lbf)
(h) Connect the following hoses:
(1) 2 water bypass hoses to throttle body
(2) Air assist hose to throttle body
(i) Connect the following vacuum hoses:
(1) Vacuum hose to air intake chamber
(2) 2 vacuum hoses to throttle body
(3) Vacuum hose to charcoal canister
(j) Connect the following connectors:
(1) A/C idle–up valve connector
(2) EGR gas temperature sensor connector
(3) Throttle position sensor connector
(4) IAC valve connector
EG2–256
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE – SFI SYSTEM
(k) Install the bolt holding the air intake chamber stay to
the air intake chamber.
Torque: 19.5 N–m (200 kgf–cm. 14 ft–lbf)
(1) Connect the 2 PS air hoses.
6. CONNECT HYDRAULIC MOTOR PRESSURE PIPE
Connect the pressure pipe to the air intake chamber
and water inlet with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–lbf)
7. INSTALL NO.2 EGR PIPE
Install 2 new gaskets and the EGR pipe with the 4
nuts.
Torque: 12 N–m (120 kgf–cm, 9 ft–lbf)
8. INSTALL EMISSION CONTROL VALVE SET
(a) Install the emission control valve set with 2 bolts.
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–lbf)
(b) Connect the following connectors:
(1) VSV connector for ACIS
(2) VSV connector for EGR
(3) VSV connector for fuel pressure control
EG2–257
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
(c) Connect the following vacuum hoses:
(1) Vacuum hose to VSV for ACIS
(2) Vacuum hose to EGR vacuum modulator
(3) Vacuum hose to EGR valve
(4) Vacuum hose (from cylinder head rear plate)
(5) Vacuum hose from air intake chamber
(6) Vacuum hose to fuel pressure regulator
9. INSTALL V–BANK COVER
Using a 5 mm hexagon wrench, install the V– bank
cover with the 2 cap nuts.
HINT: For fixing the V – bank cover, push on the cover
until sense of ”click” is felt.
10. INSTALL AIR CLEANER HOSE
(a) Connect the air cleaner hose with the 2 hose clamps.
(b) Connect the PCV hose.
11. CONNECT THROTTLE CABLE
12. CONNECT ACCELERATOR CABLE
13. FILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
Capacity:
8.7 liters (9.2 US qts. 7.7 Imp. qts)
14. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
TO BATTERY
EG2–258
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
FUEL TANK AND LINE
COMPONENTS
EG2–259
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
PRECAUTIONS
1. Always use new gaskets when replacing the fuel
tank or component parts.
2. Apply the proper torque to all parts tightened.
FUEL LINES AND CONNECTIONS
INSPECTION
(a) Check the fuel lines for cracks or leakage, and all
connections for deformation.
(b) Check the fuel tank vapor vent system hoses and
connections for looseness, sharp bends or damage.
(c) Check the fuel tank for deformation, cracks, fuel leak–
age or tank band looseness.
(d) Check the filler neck for damage or fuel leakage.
(e) Hose and pipe connections are as shown in the illus–
tration.
If a problem is found, repair or replace the parts as
necessary.
EG2–260
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) METER
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
EG2–261
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
MAF METER REMOVAL
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the Ignition switch is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable Is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. REMOVE AIR CLEANER NOSE
(a) Disconnect the PCV hose.
(b) Loosen the 2 hose clamps, and remove the air cleaner
hose.
3. REMOVE MAP METER
(a) Disconnect the MAF meter connector.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and MAF meter.
MAF METER INSPECTION
1. INSPECT MAF METER RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
terminals THA and E2.
Between
terminals
Resistance
Temperature
THA – E2
10–20k
– 20 C (–4 F)
THA – E2
4 –7k
0C (32 F)
20C (68F)
THA – E2
2 –3k
0.9 – 1.3 k
40 C (104 F)
THA = E2
0.4 – 0.7 k
60 C (140 F)
THA – E2
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the MAF
meter.
EG2–262
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
2. INSPECT MAF METER OPERATION
(a) Connect the MAF meter connector.
(b) Using a voltmeter, connect the positive (+) tester
probe to terminal VG, and negative (–) tester probe to
terminal E21.
(c) Blow air into the MAF meter, and check that the
voltage fluctuates.
If operation is not as specified, replace the MAF
meter.
(d) Disconnect the MAF meter connector.
MAF METER INSTALLATION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. INSTALL MAF METER
(a) Insert the MAF meter end into the air cleaner case.
(b) Install the MAF meter with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 6.9 N–m (70 kgf–cm, 61 in.–Ibf)
(c) Connect the MAF meter connector.
2. INSTALL AIR CLEANER HOSE
(a) Install the air cleaner hose with the 2 hose clamps.
(b) Connect the PCV hose.
3. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
TO BATTERY
EG2–263
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
THROTTLE BODY
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1. INSPECT THROTTLE BODY
(a) Check that the throttle linkage moves smoothly.
(b) Check the vacuum at each port.
• Start the engine.
• Check the vacuum with your finger.
Port name
At idle
3,000 rpm or more
No vacuum
Vacuum
No vacuum
Vacuum
No vacuum
Vacuum
EG2–264
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
2. INSPECT THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
(a) Apply vacuum to the throttle opener.
(b) Disconnect the sensor connector.
(c) Insert a thickness gauge between the throttle stop
screw and stop lever.
(d) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
each terminal.
Clearance between
fever and stop screw
Between
terminals
Resistance
0.28 – 6.4 k
0.35 mm (0.014 in.)
VTA – E2
IDL – E2
0.70 mm (0.028 in.)
IDL– E2
Infinity
Throttle valve
fully open
VTA – E2
0 mm (0 in.)
VC –E2
0.5 k or less
2.0 – 11.6 k
2.7 – 7.7 k
(e) Reconnect the sensor connector.
3. INSPECT THROTTLE OPENER
A. Warm up engine
Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating
temperature.
B. Check idle speed
Idle speed:
700 ± 50 rpm
C. Check throttle opener setting speed
(a) Disconnect the vacuum hose from the throttle opener,
and plug the hose end.
EG2–265
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
(b) Check the throttle opener setting speed.
Throttle opener setting speed:
900–1,950 rpm
If the throttle opener setting is not as specified, re–
place the throttle body.
(c) Stop the engine.
(d) Reconnect the vacuum hose to the throttle opener.
(e) Start the engine and check that the idle speed returns
to the correct speed.
EG2–266
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
THROTTLE BODY REMOVAL
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
3. DISCONNECT ACCELERATOR CABLE
4. DISCONNECT THROTTLE CABLE
EG2–267
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
5. REMOVE AIR CLEANER HOSE
(a) Disconnect the PCV hose.
(b) Loosen the 2 hose clamps, and remove the air cleaner
hose.
6. REMOVE THROTTLE BODY
(a) Disconnect the throttle position sensor connector.
(b) Disconnect the IAC valve connector.
(c) Remove the hose clamp.
(d) Disconnect the following vacuum hoses:
(1) Vacuum hose (from charcoal canister)
(2) Vacuum hose (from port R of EGR vacuum
modulator)
(3) Vacuum hose (from port E of EGR vacuum
modulator)
(4) Vacuum hose (from upper port of TVV)
(5) Vacuum hose (from lower port of TVV)
(e) Disconnect the following hoses:
(1) Water bypass hose (from intake manifold)
(2) Water bypass hose (from water inlet housing)
(3) Air assist hose
(f) Remove the 2 bolts, 2 nuts, EGR gas temperature
sensor bracket, throttle body and gasket.
EG2–268
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
THROTTLE BODY INSPECTION
1. CLEAN THROTTLE BODY
(a) Using a soft brush and carburetor cleaner, clean the
cast parts.
(b) Using compressed air, clean all the passages and
apertures.
NOTICE: To prevent deterioration, do not clean the throt–
tle position sensor.
2. INSPECT THROTTLE VALVE
(a) Apply vacuum to the throttle opener.
(b) Check that there is no clearance between the throttle
stop screw and throttle lever when the throttle valve
is fully closed.
3. INSPECT THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
(a) Apply vacuum to the throttle opener.
(b) Insert a thickness gauge between the throttle stop
screw and stop lever.
(c) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
each terminal.
Clearance between
lever and stop screw
Between
terminals
Resistance
0 mm (0 in.)
VTA –.E2
0.35 mm (0.014 in.)
IDL – E2
0.5 k( or less
0.70 mm (0.028 in.)
IDL – E2
Infinity
Throttle valve fully
open
VTA – E2
VC – E2
0.28 – 6.4 k
2.0 – 11.6 k
2.7 – 7.7 k
4. IF NECESSARY, ADJUST THROTTLE POSITION
SENSOR
(a) Loosen the 2 set screws of the sensor.
EG2–269
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
(b) Apply vacuum to the throttle opener.
(c) Insert a 0.54 mm (0.021 in.) thickness gauge, between
the throttle stop screw and stop lever.
(d) Connect the test probe of an ohmmeter to the termi–
nals IDL and E2 of the sensor.
(e) Gradually turn the sensor clockwise until the ohmme–
ter deflects, and secure it with the 2 set screws.
(f) Recheck the continuity between terminals IDL and E2.
Clearance between
lever and stop screw
Continuity (IDL – E2)
0.35 mm (0.014 in.)
Continuity
0.70 mm (0.028 in.)
No continuity
THROTTLE BODY INSTALLATION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. INSTALL THROTTLE BODY
(a) Place a new gasket on the air intake chamber.
(b) Install the throttle body, EGR gas temperature sensor
bracket with the 2 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 19.5 N–m (200 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
(c) Connect the following hoses:
(1) Water bypass hose (from intake manifold)
(2) Water bypass hose (from water inlet housing)
(3) Air assist hose
EG2–270
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
(d) Connect the following vacuum hoses:
(1) Vacuum hose (from charcoal canister)
(2) Vacuum hose (from port R of EGR vacuum
modulator)
(3) Vacuum hose (from port R of EGR vacuum
modulator)
(4) Vacuum hose (from upper port of TVV)
(5) Vacuum hose (from lower port of TVV)
(e) Install the hose clamp.
(f) Connect the IAC valve connector.
(g) Connect the throttle position sensor connector.
2. INSTALL AIR CLEANER HOSE
(a) install the air cleaner hose with the 2 hose clamps.
(b) Connect the PCV hose.
3. CONNECT THROTTLE CABLE
4. CONNECT ACCELERATOR CABLE
5. FILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
Capacity:
8.7 liters (9.2 US qts, 7.7 Imp.qts)
6. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
TO BATTERY
EG2–271
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
IDLE AIR CONTROL (IAC) VALVE
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1. INSPECT IAC VALVE OPERATION
(a) Initial conditions:
• Engine at normal operating temperature
• Idle speed set correctly
• Transmission in neutral position
• A/C switch OFF
(b) Using SST, connect terminals TE1 and E1 of the DLC
1.
SST 09843–18020
(c) After engine speed are kept at approx. 1,000 rpm for
5 seconds, check that they return to idle speed.
If the engine speed operation is not as specified,
check the IAC valve, wiring and ECM.
EG2–272
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
(d) Remove the SST from the DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
2. INSPECT IAC VALVE RESISTANCE
(a) Disconnect the IAC valve connector.
(b) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
terminal +B and other terminals (RSC, RSO).
Resistance:
19.3 – 22.3Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If resistance is not as specified, replace the IAC valve.
(c) Reconnect the IAC valve connector.
3. INSPECT AIR ASSIST SYSTEM
(a) Initial conditions:
• Engine at normal operating temperature
• Idle speed set correctly
• Transmission in neutral position
• A/C switch OFF
(b) Using SST, connect terminals TE1 and E1 of the DLC
1.
SST 09843–18020
(c) After engine speed are kept at 900 – 1,300 rpm for
10 seconds, check that they return to idle speed.
(d) Stop the engine.
(e) Disconnect the air assist hose from the air pipe, and
block off the IAC valve exit and the entry to the pipe.
(f) Start the engine and check that the idle speed reaches
500 rpm or below (the engine may stall).
If the idle does not reach 500 rpm or below, check for
a leak between the air pipe and injector.
EG2–273
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
(g) Remove the SST from the DLC 1.
SST 09843–18020
(h) Reconnect the air assist hose to the air pipe.
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
EG2–274
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
IAC VALVE REMOVAL
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. REMOVE THROTTLE BODY
(See page EG2–266)
2. REMOVE IAC VALVE
Remove the 4 screws, IAC valve and gasket.
IAC VALVE INSPECTION
INSPECT IAC VALVE OPERATION
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal +B and negative (–) lead to terminal RSC,
and check that the valve is closed.
(b) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal +B and negative (–) lead to terminal RSO,
and check that the valve is open.
If operation is not as specified, replace the IAC valve.
IAC VALVE INSTALLATION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. INSTALL IAC VALVE
(a) Place a new gasket on the throttle body.
(b) Install the IAC valve with the 4 screws.
2. INSTALL THROTTLE BODY
(See page EG2–269)
EG2–275
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
ACOUSTIC CONTROL INDUCTION
SYSTEM (ACIS)
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
INSPECT INTAKE AIR CONTROL VALVE
(a) Using a 3–way connector, connect vacuum gauge to
the actuator hose.
(b) Start the engine.
(c) While the engine is idling, check that the vacuum
gauge needle does not move.
(d) Rapidly depress the accelerator pedal to fully open
position and check that the vacuum gauge needle
momentarily fluctuates up to approx. 26.7 kPa (200
mmHg, 7.9 in.Hg). (The actuator rod is pulled out.)
EG2–276
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
COMPONENTS FOR INTAKE AIR CONTROL
VALVE REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
INTAKE AIR CONTROL VALVE REMOVAL
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ”LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. DISCONNECT HOSES FROM INTAKE AIR CONTROL
VALVE
(a) Disconnect the following hoses:
(1) Brake booster vacuum hose
(2) A/C idle–up air hose
(3) Actuator vacuum hose
(b) Disconnect the DLC1.
EG2–277
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
3. REMOVE INTAKE AIR CONTROL VALVE
(a) Remove the 4 nuts and DLC1 bracket, and disconnect
the 2 ground straps.
(b) Remove the intake air control valve by prying a screw–
driver between the intake air control valve and air
intake chamber.
(c) Remove the gasket.
INTAKE AIR CONTROL VALVE AND
COMPONENTS INSPECTION
1. INSPECT INTAKE AIR CONTROL VALVE
(a) With 26.7 kPa (200 mmHg, 7.9 in.Hg) of vacuum
applied to the actuator, check that the actuator rod
moves.
(b) One minute after applying the vacuum in (a), check
that the actuator rod does not return.
If the operation is not as specified, replace the intake
air control valve.
2. INSPECT VACUUM TANK
LOCATION: The LH side member under the battery
tray.
(a) Check that air flows from port B to port A.
(b) Check that air does not flow from port A to port B.
(c) Plug port B with your finger, and apply 26.7 kPa (200
mrnHg, 7.9 in.Hg) of vacuum to port A, and check that
there is no change in vacuum after one minute.
If the operation is not as specified, replace the
vacuum tank.
3. INSPECT VSV
(See page EG2–293)
EG2–278
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
INTAKE AIR CONTROL VALVE
INSTALLATION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. INSTALL INTAKE AIR CONTROL VALVE
(a) Install a new gasket to the air intake chamber.
(b) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the rubber portions.
(c) Apply seal packing to the positions of the intake air
control valve shown in the
Seal packing:
Part No.08826–00080 or equivalent illustration.
(d) Install the intake air control valve, DLC 1 bracket and 2
ground straps with the 4 nuts.
Torque: 14.5 N–m (145 kgf–cm, 10 ft–lbf)
2. CONNECT HOSES TO INTAKE AIR CONTROL
VALVE
(a) Connect the following hoses:
(1) Brake booster vacuum hose
(2) A/C idle–up air hose
(3) Actuator vacuum hose
(b) Install the DLC1.
3. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
TO BATTERY
4. CHECK FOR FUEL LEAKAGE
(See page EG2–228)
EG2–279
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
EFI MAIN RELAY
EFI MAIN RELAY INSPECTION
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch Is turned to the ”LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. REMOVE EFI MAIN RELAY
LOCATION: In the engine compartment relay box.
3. INSPECT EFI MAIN RELAY
A. Inspect relay continuity
(a) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals 1 and 2.
(b) Check that there is no continuity between terminals 3
and 5.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
B. Inspect relay operation
(a) Apply battery voltage across terminals 1 and 2.
(b) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals 3 and 5.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
4. REINSTALL EFI MAIN RELAY
5. RECONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
TO BATTERY
EG2–280
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND NOW
INSTALLATION
CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY INSPECTION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch 1s turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable Is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. REMOVE CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
3. INSPECT CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
A. Inspect relay continuity
(a) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals ST and E1.
(b) Check that there is continuity between terminals +B
and FC.
(c) Check that there is no continuity between terminals +
B and FP.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
EG2–281
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
B. Inspect relay operation
(a) Apply battery voltage across terminals ST and El.
M Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals +B and FP.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
4. REINSTALL CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
5. RECONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
TO BATTERY
EG2–282
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
(ECT) SENSOR
ECT SENSOR INSPECTION
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ”LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
3. REMOVE ECT SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the ECT sensor connector.
(b) Using a 19 mm deep socket wrench, remove the ECT
sensor and gasket.
4. INSPECT ECT SENSOR
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
the terminals.
Resistance:
Refer to the graph
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the ECT
sensor.
5. REINSTALL ECT SENSOR
(a) Install a new gasket to the ECT sensor.
(b) Using a 19 mm deep socket, install the ECT sensor.
Torque: 20 N–m (200 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
(c) Connect the ECT sensor connector.
6. REFILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
Capacity:
8.7 liters (9.2 US qts, 7.7 Imp. qts)
7. RECONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
TO BATTERY
EG2–283
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
VSV FOR FUEL PRESSURE CONTROL
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
(See step 2 on page EG2–231)
EG2–284
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
EG2–285
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE – SFI SYSTEM
VSV INSPECTION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. REMOVE V–BANK COVER
Using a 5 mm hexagon wrench, remove the 2 cap nuts
and V–bank cover.
3. REMOVE EMISSION CONTROL VALVE SET
(See step 7 on page EG2–246)
4. REMOVE VSV
(a) Disconnect the 2 vacuum sensing hoses from the
VSV.
(b) Remove the screw and VSV.
5. INSPECT VSV
A. Inspect VSV for open circuit
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between the terminals.
Resistance:
33 – 39 Ω at 20C (68 F)
If there is no continuity, replace the VSV.
B. Inspect VSV for ground
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity
between each terminal and the body.
If there is continuity, replace the VSV.
EG2–286
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE – SFI SYSTEM
C. Inspect VSV operation
(a) Check that the air flows from ports E to G.
(b) Apply battery voltage across the terminals.
(c) Check that the air flows from port E to the filter.
If operation is not as specified, replace the VSV.
6. REINSTALL EMISSION CONTROL VALVE SET
(See step 8 on page EG2–256)
7. REINSTALL VSV
(a) Install the VSV with the screw.
(b) Connect the 2 vacuum sensing hoses to the VSV.
8. REINSTALL V–BANK COVER
Using a 5 mm hexagon wrench, install the V–bank
cover with the 2 cap nuts.
HINT: For fixing the V–bank cover, push on the cover
until sense of ”click” is felt.
9. RECONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
TO BATTERY
EG2–287
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
VSV FOR EGR
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
EGR SYSTEM INSPECTION
(See steps 2 to 6 on pages EG2–207 and 208)
EG2–288
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
EG2–289
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
VSV INSPECTION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the Ignition switch Is turned to the ”LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. REMOVE V–BANK COVER
Using a 5 mm hexagon wrench, remove the 2 cap nuts
and V – bank cover.
3. REMOVE EMISSION CONTROL VALVE SET
(See step 7 on page EG2–246)
4. REMOVE VSV
(a) Remove the filter.
(b) Disconnect the 2 vacuum hoses from the VSV.
(c) Remove the screw and VSV.
5. INSPECT VSV
A. Inspect VSV for open circuit
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between the terminals.
Resistance:
33 – 39 at 20° C (68° F)
If there is no continuity, replace the VSV.
B. Inspect VSV for ground
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity
between each terminal and the body.
If there is continuity, replace the VSV.
1MZ-FE ENGINE –
-Memo
EG2–291
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
VSV FOR ACIS
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
INSPECT INTAKE AIR CONTROL VALVE
(See page EG2–275)
EG2–292
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
EG2–293
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
VSV INSPECTION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ”LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. REMOVE V – BANK COVER
Using a 5 mm hexagon wrench, remove the 2 cap nuts
and V–bank cover.
3. REMOVE EMISSION CONTROL VALVE SET
(See step 7 on page EG2–246)
4. REMOVE VSV
(a) Disconnect the 2 vacuum hoses from the VSV.
(b) Remove the screw and VSV.
5. INSPECT VSV
A. Inspect VSV for open circuit
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between each terminals.
Resistance:
33 – 39 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If there is no continuity, replace the VSV.
B. Inspect VSV for ground
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity
between each terminal and the body.
If there is continuity, replace the VSV.
EG2–294
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
C. Inspect VSV operation
(a) Check that air flows from pipe E to the filter.
(b) Apply battery voltage across the terminals.
(c) Check that air flows from pipe E to pipe F.
If operation is not as specified, replace the VSV.
6. REINSTALL EMISSION CONTROL VALVE SET
(See step 8 on page EG2–256)
7. REINSTALL VSV
(a) Install the VSV with the screw.
(b) Connect the 2 vacuum to the VSV.
8. REINSTALL V–BANK COVER
Using a 5 mm hexagon wrench, install the V – bank
cover with the 2 cap nuts.
HINT: For fixing the V–bank cover, push on the cover
until sense of ”click” is felt.
9. RECONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
TO BATTERY
EG2–295
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
AC IDLE–UP VALVE
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
INSPECT A/C IDLE–UP VALVE OPERATION
(a) Initial conditions:
• Engine at normal operating temperature
• Idle speed set correctly
• Transmission in neutral position
• A/C switch ON
(b) Using SST, connect terminals TE1 and E1 of the DLC
1, check that idle–up occurs for approx. 3 seconds.
SST 09843–18020
Valve operation is faulty if during the idle–up period
the engine speed drops by 100 rpm or more, rough
idle occurs, or the engine stalls.
(c) Observe the idle speed for approx. 3 to 15 seconds.
During this time the idle –up valve should go off, the
IAC valve half –open and idle –up should occur.
EG2–296
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE – SFI SYSTEM
(d) Check that the idle speed after approx. 15 seconds,
does not vary greatly from the idle speed observed in
step
(c). The idle–up valve should now be in ON
position.
If the idle speed is increases by more 100 rpm, using
a 4 mm hexagon wrench, turn the idle–up valve
adjustment screw to correct the idle–up valve.
(e) Remove the SST from the DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
(f) A/C switch OFF.
EG2–297
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
A/C IDLE–UP VALVE INSPECTION
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch Is turned to the ”LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. REMOVE A/C IDLE–UP VALVE
(a) Disconnect the idle–up valve connecter.
(b) Disconnect the 2 air hoses.
(c) Remove the 2 bolts and idle–up valve.
3. INSPECT A/C IDLE– UP VALVE
A. Inspect idle–up valve for open circuit
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between the terminals.
Resistance:
30 – 33 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If there is no continuity, replace the idle–up valve.
B. Inspect A/C idle–up valve for ground
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity
between each terminal and the body.
If there is continuity, replace the idle–up valve.
C. Inspect A/C idle–up valve operation
(a) Check that the air does not flow from port E to port F.
EG2–298
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
(b) Apply battery voltage across the terminals.
(c) Check that the air flows from port E to port F.
If operation is not as specified, replace the idle–up
valve.
4. REINSTALL A/C IDLE– UP VALVE
(a) Install the idle–up valve with the 2 bolts.
(b) Connect the air hose.
(c) Connect the idle–valve connector.
5. RECONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
TO BATTERY
EG2–299
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
KNOCK SENSOR
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
EG2–300
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
KNOCK SENSORS INSPECTION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. REMOVE AIR INTAKE CHAMBER ASSEMBLY
(See steps 1 to 10 on pages EG2–246 to 249)
2. DISCONNECT INJECTOR CONNECTORS
3. REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the heater hose from the intake manifold.
(b) Remove the 9 bolts, 2 nuts, 2 plates washers and
intake manifold assembly.
4. REMOVE RH ENGINE MOUNTING STAY AND
WATER OUTLET
(a) Disconnect the following hoses and connectors:
(1) Radiator inlet hose
(2) Engine coolant reservoir hose
(3) ECT sensor connector
(4) ECT switch connector
(5) Ground strap connector
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and RH mounting stay.
(c) Remove the wire band.
(d) Disconnect the water bypass hose from the inlet hous–
ing.
(e) Remove the 2 bolts, 2 nuts, 2 plate washers and water
outlet.
EG2–301
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
(f) Remove the 2 gaskets.
5. REMOVE KNOCK SENSORS
(a) Disconnect the knock sensor connector.
(b) Remove the knock sensor.
6. INSPECT KNOCK SENSORS
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity
between the terminal and body.
If there is continuity, replace the sensor.
7. REINSTALL KNOCK SENSORS
(a) Install the knock sensor.
Torque: 39 N–m (400 kgf–cm. 29 ft–lbf)
(b) Connect the knock sensor connector.
8. REINSTALL WATER OUTLET AND RH ENGINE
MOUNTING STAY
(a) Install 2 new gaskets on the cylinder head.
(b) Install the water outlet with the the 2 bolts, 2 plate
washers and 2 nuts.
Torque: 15 N–m (150 kgf–cm, 11 ft–lbf)
NOTICE: Do not scratch the seal surface of the water
outlet with the stud bolt.
(c) Connect the water bypass hose to the inlet housing.
(d) Install the wire band.
(e) Install the RH mounting stay with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 31.4 N–m (320 kgf–cm, 23 ft–lbf)
EG2–302
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
(f) Connect the following hoses and connectors:
(1) Radiator inlet hose
(2) Engine coolant reservoir hose
(3) ECT sensor connector
(4) ECT switch connector
(5) Ground strap connector
9. REINSTALL INTAKE MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the intake manifold assembly with the 9 bolts, 2
plate washers and 2 nuts.
Torque: 15 N–m (150 kgf–cm, 11 ft–lbf)
(b) Connect the heater hose to the intake manifold.
10. RECONNECT INJECTOR CONNECTORS
11. RETIGHTENING WATER OUTLET MOUNTING BOLTS
AND NUTS
Torque: 15 N–m (150 kgf–cm, 11 ft–lbf)
12. REINSTALL AIR INTAKE CHAMBER ASSEMBLY
(See steps 5 to 14 on pages EG2–254 to 257)
EG2–303
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR
EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR
INSPECTION
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch Is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. REMOVE NO.2 EGR PIPE
Remove the 4 nuts, EGR pipe and 2 gaskets.
3. DISCONNECT EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR
CONNECTOR AND CLAMP
4. REMOVE EGR VALVE AND VACUUM MODULATOR
ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the following hoses:
(1) Vacuum hose from port P of EGR vacuum
modulator
(2) Vacuum hose from port Q of EGR vacuum
modulator
(3) Vacuum hose from port R of EGR vacuum
modulator
(4) Vacuum hose from EGR valve
(b) Remove the 3 nuts, EGR valve and vacuum modulator
assembly and gasket.
EG2–304
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
5. REMOVE EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR
6. INSPECT EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
the terminals.
Resistance:
64 – 97 k at 50C (112 F)
11 – 16 k et 100C (212F)
2 – 4 k at 150C (302F)
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the
sensor.
7. REINSTALL EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Torque: 20 N–m (200 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
8. REINSTALL EGR VALVE AND VACUUM
MODULATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the EGR valve and vacuum modulator assembly
with the 3 nuts.
Torque: 12 N–m (120 kgf–cm, 9 ft–lbf)
EG2–305
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE – SFI SYSTEM
(b) Connect the following vacuum hoses:
(1) Vacuum hose to port P of EGR vacuum
modulator
(2) Vacuum hose to port Q of EGR vacuum
modulator
(3) Vacuum hose to port R of EGR vacuum
modulator
(4) Vacuum to EGR valve
9. RECONNECT EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR
CONNECTOR AND CLAMP
10. REINSTALL N0.2 EGR PIPE
Install 2 new gaskets and the EGR pipe with the 4
nuts.
Torque: 12 N–m (120 kgf–cm, 9 ft–lbf)
11. RECONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
TO BATTERY
EG2–306
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
OXYGEN SENSOR
OXYGEN SENSORS INSPECTION
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. INSPECT HEATER RESISTANCE OF MAIN HEATED
OXYGEN SENSORS
(a) Disconnect the oxygen sensor connectors.
(b) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
the terminals + B and HT.
Resistance:
11 – 16Ω at 20 C (68 F)
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the
sensor.
Torque: 44 N–m (450 kgf–cm, 31 ft–lbf)
(c) Reconnect the oxygen sensor connectors.
3. RECONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
TO BATTERY
EG2–307
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
Sub Heated Oxygen Sensor
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
EG2–308
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
OXYGEN SENSOR INSPECTION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. INSPECT HEATER RESISTANCE OF SUB HEATED
OXYGEN SENSOR
(a) Remove the passenger’s seat.
(b) Take out the consol box side of the floor carpet.
(c) Disconnect the oxygen sensor connector.
(d) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
the terminals + B and HT.
Resistance:
11 – 16 at 20 C (68 F)
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the
sensor.
(e) Reconnect the oxygen sensor connector.
(f) Reinstall the floor carpet.
(g) Reinstall the passenger’s seat.
3. RECONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
TO BATTERY
1MZ-FE ENGINE –
-Memo
EG2–310
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SFI SYSTEM
FUEL CUT RPM
FUEL CUT OFF INSPECTION
1. REMOVE V– BANK COVER
Using a 5 mm hexagon wrench, remove the 2 cap nuts
and V–bank cover.
2. WARM UP ENGINE
Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating
temperature.
3. CONNECT TACHOMETER TO ENGINE
Connect the test probe of a tachometer to terminal IG
(1) of the DLC1.
NOTICE:
• NEVER allow the tachometer terminal to touch
ground as It could result in damage to the igniter
and/or ignition coil.
• As some tachometers are not compatible with this
ignition system, we recommend that you confirm
the compatibility of your until before use.
4. INSPECT FUEL CUT OFF PRM
(a) Increase the engine speed to at least 3,500 rpm.
(b) Use a sound scope to check for injector operating
noise.
(c) Check that when the throttle lever is released, injector
operation noise stops momentarily and then resumes.
HINT: Measure with the A/C OFF.
Fuel return rpm:
1,200 rpm
5. DISCONNECT TACHOMETER
6. REINSTALL V–BANK COVER
Using a 5 mm hexagon wrench, install the V– bank
cover with the 2 cap nuts.
HINT: For fixing the V– bank cover, push on the cover
until sense of ”click” is felt.
EG2–311
1MZ–FE ENGINE
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE DATA
Fuel pressure
regulator
Fuel pump
Injector
MAF meter
Throttle body
Throttle
position
sensor
IAC valve
VSV for Fuel
pressure
control
VSV for ACIS
VSV for EGR
A/C idle–up
valve
ECT sensor
EGR gas
temperature
sensor
Main heated
oxygen sensor
Sub heated
oxygen sensor
Fuel cut rpm
–
SFI SYSTEM
EG2–312
1MZ–FE ENGINE
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part tightened
Fuel line (Union bolt type)
Fuel line (Flare nut type for fuel pump side)
Fuel line (Flare nut type for others)
Fuel tank band x Body
Fuel pump x Fuel tank
Fuel pressure regulator x Delivery pipe
Delivery pipe x Cylinder head
No.1 fuel pipe x Intake manifold
No.2 fuel pipe x Delivery pipe
Air intake chamber x Intake manifold
EGR pipe x EGR vacuum modulator
EGR pipe x RH exhaust manifold
No. 1 engine hanger x Air intake chamber
Air intake chamber stay x Air intake chamber
Ground stop x Intake air control valve
Emission control valve set x Air intake chamber
MAF meter x Air cleaner
Throttle body x air intake chamber
Intake air control valve x Air intake chamber
ECT switch x Water outlet
Knock sensor x Cylinder head
Water outlet x Cylinder head
RH engine mounting stay x Water outlet
RH engine mounting stay x No.2 RH engine mounting bracket
Intake manifold x Cylinder head
EGR gas temperature sensor x EGR valve
EGR valve x Air intake chamber
Main heated oxygen sensor x Exhaust manifold
Sub heated oxygen sensor x Exhaust pipe
–
SFI SYSTEM
EG2–313
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
COOLING SYSTEM
DESCRIPTION
This engine utilizes a pressurized forced circulation cooling system which includes a thermostat
equipped with a bypass valve mounted on the inlet side.
OPERATION
EG2–314
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
The cooling system is composed of the water jacket (inside the cylinder block and cylinder head),
radiator, water pump, thermostat, electronically controlled hydraulic cooling fan, hoses and other
components.
Coolant which is heated in the water jacket is pumped to the radiator, through which a cooling
fan blows air to cool the coolant as it passes through. Coolant which has been cooled is then sent
back to the engine by the water pump, where it cools the engine.
The water jacket is a network of channels in the shell of the cylinder block and cylinder head
through which coolant passes. It is designed to provide adequate cooling of the cylinders and
combustion chambers which become heated during engine operation.
RADIATOR
The radiator, mounted in the front of the vehicle, performs the function of cooling the coolant
which has passed through the water jacket and become hot. The radiator consists of an upper
tank and lower tank, and a core which connects the two tanks. The upper tank contains the inlet
for coolant from the water jacket. The lower tank has an outlet and drain plug for the coolant. The
core contains many tubes through which coolant flows from the upper tank to the lower tank as
well as cooling fins which radiate heat away from the coolant in the tubes.
The air sucked through the radiator by the cooling fan, as well as the wind generated by the
vehicle’s travel, passes through the radiator, cooling the coolant. Models with an automatic
transmission include an automatic transmission fluid cooler built into the lower tank of the
radiator. A cooling fan is mounted behind the radiator to assist the flow of air through the
radiator. When the coolant temperature is low, the fan operates slowly to help the engine warm
up, and when the coolant temperature becomes high, the fan speed is increased to provide the air
flow required for cooling.
EG2–315
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
RADIATOR CAP (on water outlet)
The radiator cap is a pressure–type cap which seals the engine coolant circuit and the resulting
pressurization of the engine as the coolant expands. The pressurization prevents the coolant from
boiling even when the coolant temperature exceeds 100C (212F). A relief valve (pressurization
valve) and a vacuum valve (negative pressure valve) are built into the radiator cap. The relief valve
opens and lets steam escape through the overflow pipe when the pressure generated inside the
cooling system exceeds the limit (coolant temperature: 110 – 120C (230 – 248F), pressure:
83 – 113 kPa (0.85 – 1.15 kgf/cm2,12.1 – 16.4 psi). The vacuum valve opens to alleviate the
vacuum which develops in the coolant system after the engine is stopped and the coolant
temperature drops. The valve’s opening allows the coolant in the reservoir tank to return to the
cooling system.
RESERVOIR TANK
The reservoir tank is used to catch coolant which overflows the cooling system as a result of
volumetric expansion when the coolant is heated. The coolant in the reservoir tank returns to the
water outlet when the coolant temperature drops thus keeping the radiator full at all times and
avoiding needless coolant loss. Check the reservoir tank level to learn if the coolant needs to be
replenished.
WATER PUMP
The water pump is used for forced circulation of coolant through the cooling system. It is
mounted on the front of the cylinder block and driven by a timing belt.
THERMOSTAT
The thermostat has a wax type bypass valve and is mounted in the water inlet housing. The
thermostat includes a type of automatic valve operated by fluctuations in the coolant tempera–
ture. This valve closes when the coolant temperature drops, preventing the circulation of coolant
through the engine and thus permitting the engine to warm up rapidly. The valve opens when the
coolant temperature has risen, allowing the circulation of coolant. Wax inside the thermostat
expands when heated and contracts when cooled. Heating the wax thus generates pressure
which overpowers the force of the spring which keeps the valve closed, thus opening the valve.
When the wax cools, its contraction allows the force of the spring to take effect once more,
closing the valve. The thermostat in this engine operates at a temperature of 82 C (180 F).
ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED HYDRAULIC COOLING FAN (See page EG2–346)
EG2–316
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE – COOLING SYSTEM
PREPARATION
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
09230–01010 Radiator Service Tool Set
09249–63010 Torque Wrench Adaptor
RH camshaft timing pulley
09620–30010 Steering Gear Box Replacer Set
(09627–30010) Steering Sector Shaft Bushing
Replacer
(09631 –00020) Handle
Hydraulic motor oil seal
Hydraulic motor oil seal
09843–18020 Diagnosis Check Wire
09960–10010 Variable Pin Wrench Set
(09962–01000) Variable Pin Wrench Arm Assy
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09025–00010 Smell Torque Wrench
09082–00050 TOYOTA Electrical Tester Set
09905–00013 Snap Ring Pliers
For measuring preload
EG2–317
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
EQUIPMENT
Caliper gauge
Heater
ECT sensor
Precision straight edge
Radiator cap tester
Micrometer
Thermometer
ECT sensor
Torque wrench
Vernier calipers
LUBRICANT
Item
Power steering fluid (Total)
(Hydraulic cooling fan fluid)
Capacity
2.2 liters (2.3 US qts, 1.9 Imp. qts)
Classification
ATF DEXRON II
COOLANT
Item
Engine coolant
Capacity
8.7 liters (9.2 US qts, 7.7 Imp. qts)
Classification
Ethylene–glycol base
EG2–318
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
COOLANT CHECK
1. CHECK ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL AT RESERVOIR
TANK
The engine coolant level should be between the
”LOW” and ”FULL” lines.
If low, check for leaks and add engine coolant up to
the ”FULL’ line.
2. CHECK ENGINE COOLANT QUALITY
(a) Remove the radiator cap from the water outlet.
CAUTION: To avoid the danger of being burned, do not
remove the radiator cap while the engine and radiator are
still hot, as fluid and steam can be blown out under
pressure.
(b) There should not be any excessive deposits of rust or
scale around the radiator cap or water outlet filler
hole, and the coolant should be free from oil.
If excessively dirty, clean the coolant passages and
replace the coolant.
(c) Reinstall the radiator cap.
EG2–319
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
COOLANT REPLACEMENT
1. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
(a) Remove the radiator cap from the water outlet.
CAUTION: To avoid the danger of being burned, do not
remove the radiator cap while the engine and radiator are
still hot, as fluid and steam can be blown out under
pressure.
(b) Loosen the drain cock (for the radiator) and drain
plugs (for the engine), and drain the coolant.
(c) Close the drain plugs and cock.
Torque:
7 N–m (70 kgf–cm, 61 in.–lbf) for RH drain plug
13 N–m (130 kgf–cm, 9 ft–lbf) for LH drain plug
2. FILL ENGINE COOLANT
(a) Slowly fill the system with coolant.
• Use a good brand of ethylene–glycol base cool–
ant and mix it according to the manufacturer’s
directions.
• Using coolant which includes more than 50%
ethylene–glycol (but not more than 70 96) is
recommended.
NOTICE:
• Do not use an alcohol type coolant.
• The coolant should be mixed with demineralized
water or distilled water.
Capacity:
8.7 liters (9.2 US qts. 7.7 Imp. qts)
(b) Install the radiator cap.
(c) Start the engine, and bleed the cooling system.
(d) If necessary, refill coolant into the reservoir tank up to
the ”FULL” line.
3. CHECK ENGINE COOLANT FOR LEAKS
EG2–320
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
WATER PUMP
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
EG2–321
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
EG2–322
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
WATER PUMP REMOVAL
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
3. REMOVE TIMING BELT
(See steps 2 to 20 on pages EG2–41 to 45)
EG2–323
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
4. REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEYS
(a) Using SST, remove the bolt and RH timing pulley.
SST 09249–63010, 09960–10010 (09962–01000)
(b) Using SST, remove the bolt and LH timing pulley.
SST 09960–01000 (09962–01000)
HINT: Arrange the camshaft timing pulleys (RH and
LH sides).
5. REMOVE NO.2 IDLER PULLEY
Remove the bolt and idler pulley.
EG2–324
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
6. DISCONNECT ENGINE WIRE
Disconnect the 3 clamps and engine wire from the No.
3 timing belt cover.
7. REMOVE NO.3 TIMING BELT COVER
Remove the 6 bolts and belt cover.
8. REMOVE WATER PUMP
Remove the 4 bolts, 2 nuts, water pump and gasket.
WATER PUMP INSPECTION
INSPECT WATER PUMP
Turn the pulley and check that the water pump bear–
ing moves smoothly and quietly.
EG2–325
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
WATER PUMP INSTALLATION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. INSTALL WATER PUMP
Install a new gasket and the water pump with the 4
bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–lbf)
NOTICE: Do not get oil on the gasket.
2. INSTALL N0.3 TIMING BELT COVER .
(a) Check that the timing belt cover gaskets have no
cracks or peeling, etc.
If the gaskets do have cracks or peeling, etc., replace
them using the following steps.
(1) Using a screwdriver and gasket scraper, remove
all the old gasket material.
(2) Thoroughly clean all components to remove all
the loose material.
(3) Remove the backing paper from a new gasket
and install the gasket evenly to the part of the
belt cover shaded black in the illustration.
NOTICE: When joining gaskets, do not leave a gap be–
tween them. Cut off any excess gasket.
(4) After installing the gasket, press down on it so
that the adhesive firmly sticks to the belt cover.
(b) Install new gaskets to the No.3 belt cover.
(c) Install the belt cover with the6 bolts.
Torque: 8.5 N–m (85 kgf–cm, 74in.–Ibf)
EG2–326
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE – COOLING SYSTEM
3. CONNECT ENGINE WIRE
Connect the engine wire with the 3 clamps.
4. INSTALL N0.2 IDLER PULLEY
(a) Install the idler pulley with the bolt.
Torque: 43 N–m (440 kgf–cm, 32 ft–lbf)
(b) Check that the idler pulley moves smoothly.
5. INSTALL RH CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
(a) Install the timing pulley, facing the flange side out–
ward.
(b) Align the knock pin hole of the camshaft with the
knock pin groove of the timing pulley as shown.
(c) Using SST, install and torque the bolt.
SST 09249–63010, 09960–10010 (09962–01000)
Torque: 88 N–m (900 kgf–cm, 65 ft–lbf)
HINT: Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of
340 mm (13.39 in.)
EG2–327
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
6. INSTALL LH CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
(a) Install the timing pulley, facing the flange side inward.
(b) Align the knock pin hole of the camshaft with the
knock pin groove of the timing pulley as shown.
(c) Using SST, install and torque the bolt.
SST 09960–10010 (09962–01000)
Torque: 125 N–m (1,300 kgf–cm, 94 ft–lbf)
7. INSTALL TIMING BELT
(See steps6 to 27 on pages EG2–51 to 56)
8. FILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
Capacity:
8.7 liters (9.2 US qts, 7.7 Imp. qts)
9. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE TO
BATTERY
10. START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR LEAKS
11. RECHECK ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL
EG2–328
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
THERMOSTAT
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
THERMOSTAT REMOVAL
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
HINT: Removal of the thermostat would have an ad–
verse effect, causing a lowering of cooling efficiency.
Do not remove the thermostat, even if the engine
tends to overheat.
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the Ignition switch is turned to the ”LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
EG2–329
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
3. REMOVE AIR CLEANER CAP, VOLUME AIR FLOW
METER AND AIR CLEANER HOSE
(a) Disconnect the volume air flow meter connector and
wire clamp.
(b) Disconnect the accelerator cable clamp.
(c) Disconnect the PCV hose.
(d) Loosen the air cleaner hose clamp bolt.
(e) Disconnect the 4 air cleaner cap clips.
(f) Remove the air cleaner cap and volume air flow meter
together with the air cleaner hose.
4. DISCONNECT HEATER HOSE
5. DISCONNECT PRESSURE HOSE OF HYDRAULIC
MOTOR
Remove the bolt and disconnect the pressure hose
from the water inlet.
6. DISCONNECT ENGINE WIRE
Remove the 2 nuts and disconnect the engine wire
from the water inlet and cylinder head.
7. DISCONNECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
(ECT) SENSOR CONNECTOR
8. DISCONNECT WATER INLET PIPE
(a) Remove the bolt holding the water inlet pipe to the
cylinder head.
(b) Disconnect the water inlet pipe and remove the 0–
ring.
EG2–330
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
8. REMOVE WATER INLET
Remove the 3 nuts and water inlet from the water
inlet housing.
10. REMOVE THERMOSTAT AND GASKET
THERMOSTAT INSPECTION
INSPECT THERMOSTAT
HINT: The thermostat is numbered with the valve
opening temperature.
(a) Immerse the thermostat in water and gradually heat
the water.
(b) Check the valve opening temperature.
Valve opening temperature:
80 – 84°C (176 – 183°F)
If the valve opening temperature is not as specified,
replace the thermostat.
(c) Check the valve lift.
Volvo lift:
10.0 mm (0.394 In.) or more at 95° C (203 F)
If the valve lift is not as specified, replace the thermo–
stat.
(d) Check that the valve spring is tight when the thermo–
stat is fully closed.
If not closed, replace the thermostat.
EG2–331
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
THERMOSTAT INSTALLATION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. PLACE THERMOSTAT IN WATER PUMP
(a) Install a new gasket to the thermostat.
(b) Align the jiggle valve of the thermostat with stud bolt
(A), and insert the thermostat in the water inlet hous–
ing.
HINT: The jiggle valve may be set within 30 of either
side of the prescribed position.
2. INSTALL WATER INLET
Install the water inlet with the 3 nuts.
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–Ibf)
3. INSTALL WATER INLET PIPE
(a) Install a new 0 – ring to the water inlet pipe.
(b) Apply soapy water to the 0 – ring.
(c) Connect the water inlet pipe to the water inlet.
(d) Install the bolt holding the water inlet pipe to the
cylinder head.
Torque: 19.5 N–m (200 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
EG2–332
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
4. CONNECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SENSOR (ECT) CONNECTOR
5. CONNECT ENGINE WIRE
Connect the engine wire to the water inlet and cylin–
der head with the 2 nuts.
6. CONNECT HYDRAULIC MOTOR PRESSURE HOSE
Connect the pressure hose with the bolt.
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–Ibf)
7. CONNECT HEATER HOSE
8. REINSTALL AIR CLEANER CAP, VOLUME AIR
FLOW METER AND AIR CLEANER HOSE
(a) Connect the air cleaner hose, and install the air clean–
er cap and volume air flow meter with the 4 clips.
(b) Tighten the air cleaner hose clamp bolt.
(c) Connect the PCV hose.
(d) Connect the accelerator cable clamp.
(e) Connect the volume air flow meter connector and
wire clamp.
9. FILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
Capacity:
8.7 liters (9.2 US qts, 7.7 Imp. qts)
10. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE TO
BATTERY
11. START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR LEAKS
12. RECHECK ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL
EG2–333
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
RADIATOR
RADIATOR CLEANING
Using water or a steam cleaner, remove any mud and
dirt from the radiator core.
NOTICE: If using a high pressure type cleaner, be careful
not to deform the fins of the radiator core. If the cleaner
nozzle pressure is 2,942 – 3,432 kPa (30 – 35 kgf/cm2,
427 – 498 psi), keep a distance of at least 40 cm (15.75
in.) between the radiator core and cleaner nozzle.
RADIATOR INSPECTION
1. REMOVE RADIATOR CAP FROM WATER OUTLET
CAUTION: To avoid the danger of being burned, do not
remove the radiator cap while the engine and radiator are
still hot, as fluid and steam can be blown out under
pressure.
2. INSPECT RADIATOR CAP
NOTICE: When performing steps (a) and (b) below, keep
the radiator pump tester at an angle of over 30 above
the horizontal.
(a) Using a radiator cap tester, slowly pump the tester
and check that air is coming from the relief valve.
Pump speed:
1 push/3 seconds or more
NOTICE: Push the pump at a constant speed.
If air is not coming from the relief valve, replace the
radiator cap.
(b) Pump the tester several times and measure the relief
valve opening pressure.
Pump speed:
1 at time
1 push/1 second or less
2nd time or more
Any speed
Standard opening pressure:
83 – 113 kPa
(0.85 – 1.15 kgf/cm2, 12.1 – 16.4 psi)
Minimum opening pressure:
69 kPa (0.7 kgf/cm2, 10.0 psi)
If the opening pressure is less than minimum, replace
the radiator cap.
EG2–334
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
3. INSPECT COOLING SYSTEM FOR LEAKS
(a) Fill the radiator and engine with coolant and attach a
radiator cap tester.
(b) Warm up the engine.
(c) Pump it to 127 kPa (1.3 kgf/cm2, 18.5 psi), and check
that the pressure does not drop.
If the pressure drops, check the hoses, radiator or
water pump for leaks. If no external leaks are found,
check the heater core, cylinder block and cylinder
head.
4. REINSTALL RADIATOR CAP
EG2–335
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
EG2–336
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
RADIATOR REMOVAL
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
3. DISCONNECT PRESSURE HOSE
Remove the union bolt and gasket, and disconnect the
pressure hose from the hydraulic motor.
NOTICE: Catch leaking oil in a container.
4. DISCONNECT UPPER RADIATOR HOSE
5. DISCONNECT HYDRAULIC MOTOR RETURN HOSE
6. DISCONNECT LOWER RADIATOR HOSE FROM
WATER INLET PIPE
7. DISCONNECT OIL COOLER HOSES FROM OIL
COOLER PIPES
Disconnect the 2 hoses.
8. Canada only:
REMOVE NO.7 RELAY BLOCK
EG2–337
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
9. DISCONNECT CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR WIRE
CLAMP
10. REMOVE RADIATOR AND HYDRAULIC COOLING
FAN
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and 2 upper supports.
(b) Lift out the radiator.
11. REMOVE A/T OIL COOLER HOSES
Remove the 2 hoses.
12. REMOVE RADIATOR LOWER HOSE
13. REMOVE HYDRAULIC COOLING FAN FROM
RADIATOR
Remove the 6 bolts and cooling fan.
14. REMOVE LOWER RADIATOR SUPPORTS
Remove the 2 lower radiator supports.
EG2–338
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
COMPONENTS FOR DISASSEMBLY AND
ASSEMBLY
RADIATOR DISASSEMBLY
(See Components for Disassembly and Assembly)
ASSEMBLY OF SST
09230 – 01010
(a) Install the claw to the overhaul handle, inserting it in
the hole in part ”A” as shown in the diagram.
(b) While gripping the handle, adjust the stopper bolt so
that dimension ”B” shown in the diagram is 0.2–0.5
mm (0.008–0.020 in.).
NOTICE: If this adjustment is not performed, the claw
may be damaged.
EG2–339
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
2. UNCAULK LOCK PLATES
Using SST to release the caulking, squeeze the handle
until stopped by the stopper bolt.
SST 09230 – 01010
3. REMOVE TANKS AND O–RINGS
(a) Lightly tap the bracket of the radiator (or radiator
hose inlet or outlet) with a soft–faced hammer and
remove the tank.
(b) Remove the O–ring.
4. REMOVE OIL COOLER FROM LOWER TANK
(a) Remove the pipes.
HINT: Make a note of the direction to face the pipes.
(b) Remove the nuts, and plate washers.
(c) Remove the oil cooler and 0–rings.
RADIATOR ASSEMBLY
(See Components for Disassembly and Assembly)
1. INSTALL OIL COOLER TO LOWER TANK
(a) Clean the O–ring contact surface of the lower tank
and oil cooler.
(b) Install new 0–rings (1) to the oil cooler (2).
(c) Install the oil cooler with the 0–rings to the lower
tank (3).
(d) Install the plate washers (4), and nuts (5). Torque the
nuts.
Torque: 8.3 N–m (85 kgf–cm, 74 ft–lbf)
(e) Install the pipes (6).
Torque: 14.7 N–m (150 kgf–cm, 11 ft–lbf)
HINT: Face the pipes in the same direction as before
disassembly.
EG2–340
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
2. INSPECT LOCK PLATE
Inspect the lock plate for damage.
HINT:
• If the sides of the lock plate groove are deformed,
reassembly of the tank will be impossible.
• Therefore, first correct any deformation with
pliers or similar object. Water leakage will result
if the bottom of the lock plate groove is damaged
or dented, Therefore, repair or replace if neces–
sary.
3. INSTALL NEW O–RINGS AND TANKS
(a) After checking that there are no foreign objects in the
lock plate groove, install the new 0–ring without
twisting it.
HINT: When cleaning the lock plate groove, lightly rub
it with sand paper without scratching it.
(b) Install the tank without damaging the 0 – ring.
(c) Tap the lock plate with a soft–faced hammer so that
there is no gap between it and the tank.
4. ASSEMBLY OF SST
SST 09230 – 01010
(a) Install the punch assembly to the overhaul handle,
inserting it in the hole in part ”A” as shown in the
illustration.
(b) While gripping the handle, adjust the stopper bolt so
that dimension ”B” shown in the diagram is 7.7 mm
(0.30 in.).
5. CAULK LOCK PLATE
(a) Lightly press SST against the lock plate in the order
shown in the illustration. After repeating this a few
times, fully caulk the lock plate by squeezing the
handle until stopped by the stopper plate.
SST 09230 – 01010
EG2–341
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
HINT:
• Do not stake the areas protruding around the
pipes, brackets or tank ribs.
• The points shown in the illustration and oil cooler
near here cannot be staked with the SST. Use a
plier or similar object and be careful not to
damage the core plates.
(b) Check the lock plate height (H) after completing the
caulking.
Plate height:
7.75 – 8.25 mm (0.305 – 0.325 in.)
If not within the specified height, adjust the stopper
bolt of the handle again and perform the caulking
again.
6. PAINT LOCK PLATES
EG2–342
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
RADIATOR INSTALLATION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. INSTALL RADIATOR SUPPORTS
Install the 2 supports.
2. INSTALL HYDRAULIC COOLING FAN TO
RADIATOR
Install the cooling fan with the6 bolts.
Torque: 4.9 N–m (50 kgf–cm, 43 in.–Ibf)
3. INSTALL RADIATOR LOWER HOSE
4. INSTALL A/T OIL COOLER HOSES
Install the 2 hoses.
6. INSTALL RADIATOR AND HYDRAULIC COOLING
FAN
Place the radiator in position, and install the 2 upper
supports with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 12.8 N–m (130 kgf–cm, 9 ft–lbf)
HINT: After installation, check that the rubber cushion
(A) of the support is not depressed.
6. CONNECT CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR WIRE
CLAMP
EG2–343
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
7. Canada only:
INSTALL NO.7 RELAY BLOCK
8. CONNECT OIL COOLER HOSES
9. CONNECT LOWER RADIATOR HOSE
10. CONNECT HYDRAULIC MOTOR RETURN HOSE
11. CONNECT UPPER RADIATOR HOSE
12. CONNECT PRESSURE HOSE TO HYDRAULIC
MOTOR
Connect the pressure hose with a new gasket and the
union bolt.
Torque: 63.7 N–m (650 kgf–cm, 47 ft–lbf)
13. FILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
Capacity:
8.7 liters (9.2 US qts, 7.7 Imp. qts)
14. FILL COOLING FAN (PS) RESERVOIR TANK WITH
FLUID
15. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE TO
BATTERY
16. START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR LEAKS
EG2–344
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
17. BLEED ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED
HYDRAULIC COOLING FAN SYSTEM
(See page EG2–348)
18. CHECK AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID
LEVEL
NOTICE: Do not overfill.
19. RECHECK ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL
EG2–345
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED HYDRAULIC COOLING FAN
SYSTEM
Description
In this system, the cooling fan ECU controls the hydraulic pressure acting on the hydraulic motor,
thus controlling the speed of the cooling fan steplessly in response to the condition of the engine
and air conditioning.
System Circuit
EG2–346
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
Operation
The hydraulic pump is integrated with the PS pump and is driven by a drive belt. The solenoid
valve adjusts the volume of oil sent from the hydraulic pump to the hydraulic motor which drive;
the fan directly, thereby controlling the fan speed.
Oil which has passed through the hydraulic motor is cooled by the oil cooler before returning to
the PS pump reservoir tank.
The solenoid valve is controlled by the cooling fan ECU in accordance with the engine rpm, engine
coolant temperature and A/C signals.
EG2–347
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
On–Vehicle Inspection
FLUID LEVEL INSPECTION
1. KEEP VEHICLE LEVEL
2. INSPECT FLUID LEVEL
(a) Using SST, connect terminals OP1 and E1 of the data
link connector 1.
SST 09843–18020
HINT: When terminals OP1 and E1 are connected, the
circuit of the ECT sensor is grounded, fixing the cool–
ing fan speed at approx. 1,100 rpm. (Fail–safe opera–
tion occurs.)
(b) Keep the engine speed at 2,000 rpm until the fluid
temperature reaches the specified temperature.
Fluid temperature:
70 – 90°C (158 – 195°F)
(c) Check that there is no foaming and emulsification of
the fluid in the reservoir tank.
(d) Measure the fluid level with the engine running.
(e) Stop the engine, and measure the fluid level.
(f) Subtract level (d) from (e).
Maximum level difference:
5 mm (0.20 in.)
(g) Check the fluid level.
If low, add fluid.
Fluid:
ATF DEXRON II
HINT: Check that fluid level is within the ”HOT” level
on reservoir tank. If the fluid is cold, check that it is
within the ”COLD” level on the reservoir tank.
(h) Remove the SST from the data link connector 1.
SST 09843–18020
EG2–348
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
HYDRAULIC COOLING FAN SYSTEM
BLEEDING
1. CHECK FLUID LEVEL IN RESERVOIR TANK
If low, add fluid.
Fluid:
ATF DEXRONII
HINT: Check that fluid level is within the ”HOT” level
on reservoir tank. If the fluid is cold, check that it is
within the ”COLD” level on the reservoir tank.
2. BLEED COOLING SYSTEM
(a) Using SST, connect terminals OP1 and E1 of the data
link connector 1.
SST 09843–18020
HINT: When terminals OP1 and E1 are connected, the
circuit of the ECT sensor is grounded, fixing the cool–
ing fan speed at approx. 1,100 rpm. (Fail–safe opera–
tion occurs.)
(b) Start the engine without depressing the accelerator
pedal.
(c) Leave the engine running for several seconds.
(d) Check that there is no foaming and emulsification of
the fluid in the reservoir tank.
(e) Remove the SST from the data link connector 1.
SST 09843–18020
EG2–349
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
OIL PRESSURE INSPECTION
1. DISCONNECT PRESSURE HOSE FROM HYDRAULIC
MOTOR, AND INSTALL OIL PRESSURE GAUGE
(a) Remove the union bolt and gasket, and disconnect the
pressure hose from the hydraulic motor.
(b) Connect the gauge side of a pressure gauge to pres–
sure hose, and the valve side to the hydraulic motor.
2. INSPECT OIL PRESSURE
HINT: Before inspecting the oil pressure, first check
that the A/C is off.
(a) Using SST, connect terminals OP1 and E1 of the data
link connector 1.
SST 09843–18020
HINT: When terminals OP1 and E1 are connected, the
circuit of the ECT sensor is grounded, fixing the cool–
ing fan speed at approx. 1,100 rpm. (Fail–safe opera–
tion occurs.)
(b) Bleed the hydraulic cooling system.
(See page EG2–348)
(c) Keep the engine speed at 2,000 rpm until the fluid
temperature reaches the specified temperature.
Fluid temperature:
70 – 90 C (158 – 195 F)
(d) Check the fluid level is correct.
EG2–350
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE – COOLING SYSTEM
(e) Measure the oil pressure at idling.
Oil pressure:
981 – 1,961 kPa
(10 – 20 kgf/cm2, 142 – 284 pal)
(f) Remove the SST from the data link connector 1.
SST 09843–18020
(g) Check that the oil pressure decreases.
3. REMOVE OIL PRESSURE GAUGE, AND
RECONNECT PRESSURE HOSE TO HYDRAULIC
MOTOR
(a) Remove the pressure gauge.
(b) Connect the pressure hose to the hydraulic motor
with a new gasket and the union bolt.
Torque: 63.7 N–m (650 kgf–cm, 47 ft–lbf)
Hydraulic Pump (PS pump)
(See SR section)
EG2–351
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
Hydraulic Motor
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
EG2–352
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
HYDRAULIC MOTOR REMOVAL
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. REMOVE RADIATOR
(See page EG2–336)
2. REMOVE HYDRAULIC COOLING FAN
Remove the 6 bolts and hydraulic cooling fan.
3. REMOVE COOLING FAN FROM HYDRAULIC
MOTOR
Loosen the fan mounting nut clockwise, and remove
the nut, plate washer and fan.
4. REMOVE HYDRAULIC MOTOR FROM FAN SHROUD
Remove the 3 bolts and hydraulic motor.
EG2–353
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
COMPONENTS FOR DISASSEMBLY AND
ASSEMBLY
HYDRAULIC MOTOR DISASSEMBLY
(See Components for Disassembly and Assembly)
1. MOUNT MOTOR HOUSING
Carefully mount the motor housing in a vise.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the motor housing.
2. REMOVE MOTOR COVER
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and motor cover.
(b) Remove the 0–ring from the motor housing.
3. REMOVE REAR THRUST WASHER
4. REMOVE DRIVE SHAFT
EG2–354
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
5. REMOVE DRIVE AND DRIVEN ROTORS
6. REMOVE FRONT THRUST WASHER
HYDRAULIC MOTOR INSPECTION
1. INSPECT DRIVE AND DRIVEN ROTORS
(a) Install the drive and driven rotors to the motor hous–
ing with the dot mark facing upward.
(b) Using a feeler gauge and precision straight edge, mea–
sure the side clearance between the rotor and preci–
sion straight edge.
Standard side clearance:
0.01 – 0.04 mm (0.0004 – 0.0016 in.)
Maximum side clearance:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the clearance is greater than maximum, replace the
rotors as a set. If necessary, replace the motor assem–
bly.
HINT: When replacing the rotors, select a new rotor
set according to the imprinted mark on the motor
housing.
Imprinted mark on housing
Rotor set
16906–50010
16906–50020
16906–50030
EG2–355
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
2. INSPECT CLEARANCE OF DRIVE SHAFT
(a) Using a caliper gauge, measure the, shaft hole inside
diameter of the housing and cover.
Shaft hole inside diameter:
14.000 – 14.011 mm (0.5512 – 0.5516 in.)
(b) Using a micrometer, measure the drive shaft diameter.
Shaft diameter:
13.973 – 13.984 mm (0.5501 – 0.5506 in.)
(c) Subtract the drive shaft diameter measurement from
the shaft hole diameter measurement.
Standard clearance:
0.016 – 0.038 mm (0.0006 – 0.0015 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.04 mm (0.0016 In.)
If the clearance is greater than maximum, replace the
shaft. If necessary, replace the motor assembly.
EG2–356
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE – COOLING SYSTEM
OIL SEAL REPLACEMENT
1. REMOVE OIL SEAL
(a) Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring and plate
washer.
(b) Using a screwdriver, pry out the oil seal.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the housing.
2. INSTALL OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new oil seal to a
depth of 4.5 – 5.5 mm (0.177 – 0.217 in.) from the
housing edge.
SST 09620–30010 (09627–30010, 09631– 00020)
(b) Using snap ring pliers, install the plate washer and
snap ring.
(c) Apply fluid to the oil seal lip.
EG2–357
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
HYDRAULIC MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(See Components for Disassembly and Assembly)
HINT:
• Thoroughly clean all parts to be assembled.
• Before installing the parts, apply new fluid to all
sliding and rotating surfaces.
1. MOUNT MOTOR HOUSING
Slightly mount the motor housing in a vise.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the motor housing.
2. INSTALL FRONT THRUST WASHER
3. INSTALL DRIVEN AND DRIVE ROTORS
Install the drive and driven rotors with the dot mark
facing upward.
4. INSTALL DRIVE SHAFT
5. INSTALL REAR THRUST WASHER
6. INSTALL MOTOR COVER
(a) Install a new 0–ring to the motor housing groove.
(b) Install the motor cover with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 28 N–m (290 kgf–cm, 21 ft–lbf)
EG2–358
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
7. INSPECT DRIVE SHAFT PRELOAD
(a) Check that the drive shaft rotates smoothly without
abnormal noise.
(b) Temporarily install the pulley nut, and check the rotat–
ing torque.
Rotating torque:
0.3 N–m (3.0 kgf–cm, 2.6 in.–lbf)
HYDRAULIC MOTOR INSTALLATION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. INSTALL HYDRAULIC MOTOR TO FAN SHROUD
Install the hydraulic motor with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 4.9 N–m (50 kgf–cm. 43 in.–lbf)
2. INSTALL COOLING FAN TO HYDRAULIC MOTOR
Install the fan with the plate washer and nut. Tighten
the nut by turning it counterclockwise.
Torque: 15 N–m (150 kgf–cm, 11 ft–lbf)
3. INSTALL HYDRAULIC COOLING FAN
Install the hydraulic cooling fan with the6 bolts.
Torque: 4.9 N–m (50 kgf–cm, 43 In.–Ibf)
4. INSTALL RADIATOR
(See page EG2–342)
EG2–359
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE – COOLING SYSTEM
Oil Cooler
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
OIL COOLER REMOVAL
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. REMOVE UPPER RADIATOR SEAL
Remove the 12 clips and radiator seal.
2. REMOVE RADIATOR GRILLE
Remove the 2 mounting screws and radiator grille.
EG2–360
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
3. REMOVE RH PARKING LIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the screw.
(b) Disconnect the connector and remove the parking
light assembly.
4. REMOVE RH HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and nut.
(b) Disconnect the 2 connectors and remove the head–
light assembly.
5. DISCONNECT HOSES FROM OIL COOLER
Disconnect the following hoses:
(1) Outlet hose (to reservoir tank)
(2) Inlet hose (from hydraulic motor)
6. REMOVE UNDERCOVER
7. REMOVE OIL COOLER
(a) Pull aside the shroud to expose the bolt in the stay.
Remove the bolt.
(b) Remove the 2 nuts and remove the oil cooler.
EG2–361
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
OIL COOLER INSPECTION
INSPECT OIL COOLER
Check the oil cooler for damage or clogging.
If necessary, replace the oil cooler.
OIL COOLER INSTALLATION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. INSTALL OIL COOLER
(a) Install the oil cooler with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–lbf)
(b) Install the bolt while pulling aside the shroud.
2. INSTALL UNDERCOVER
3. CONNECT HOSES TO OIL COOLER
Connect the following hoses:
(1) Outlet hose (to reservoir)
(2) Inlet hose (from hydraulic motor)
4. INSTALL RH HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the 2 connectors.
(b) Install the headlight assembly with the 3 bolts and
nut.
EG2–362
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
5. INSTALL RH PARKING LIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the connector.
(b) Install the parking light assembly with the screw.
6. INSTALL RADIATOR GRILLE
Install the radiator grille with the 2 mounting screws.
7. INSTALL UPPER RADIATOR SUPPORT SEAL
Install the support seal with the 12 clips.
8. FILL PS RESERVOIR TANK WITH FLUID
(See page EG2–347)
9. BLEED ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED
HYDRAULIC COOLING FAN SYSTEM
(See page EG2–348)
EG2–363
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
Cooling Fan ECU
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
COOLING FAN ECU INSPECTION
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. DISCONNECT COOLING FAN ECU CONNECTOR
(See Components)
(a) Remove the instrument panel undercover.
(b) Remove the instrument lower panel.
(c) Remove the glove compartment door.
(d) Remove the glove compartment.
(e) Disconnect the cooling fan ECU connector.
EG2–364
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE – COOLING SYSTEM
3. INSPECT COOLING FAN ECU
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (–) terminal of the
battery.
(b) Check the connector on the wiring harness side as
shown in the chart.
Check for
Condition
Tester connection
Specified value
Voltage
1 – Ground
Ignition switch ON
Battery voltage
Resistance
2–3
Solenoid valve at cold (25°C (77°F) )
7.6 – 8.0
Continuity
4 – Ground
Continuity
5 – Ground
Continuity
Resistance
Continuity
Throttle valve open
No continuity
Throttle valve closed
Continuity
A/C pressure SW connector disconnected
No continuity
A/C pressure SW connector connected
Continuity
Coolant temperature at 80°C (176°F)
1.48 – 1.58 k
8 – Ground
9–10
(c) Disconnect the cable from the negative (–) terminal
of the battery.
4. RECONNECT COOLING FAN ECU CONNECTOR
5. RECONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE TO
BATTERY
ECT SENSOR INSPECTION
INSPECT ECT SENSOR
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
the terminals.
Resistance:
1.48 – 1.58 Ω at 80° C (176° F)
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the
sensor.
EG2–365
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
COOLING SYSTEM
A/C High –Pressure Switch
A/C HIGH–PRESSURE SWITCH
INSPECTION
1. DISCONNECT A/C HIGH–PRESSURE SWITCH
CONNECTOR
2. INSTALL MANIFOLD GAUGE SET
(See page AC–23)
3. INSPECT A/C HIGH–PRESSURE SWITCH
(a) When the A/C switch is OFF, check that there is
continuity between terminals 2 and 3. (When the pressure is
1,226 kPa (12.5 kgf/cm2, 178 psi) or lower.)
(b) When the A/C and blower switches are ON, check
that there is no continuity between terminals 2 and 3.
(When the pressure is 1,520 kPa (15.5 kgf/cm2, 220
psi) or higher.)
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
4. REMOVE MANIFOLD GAUGE SET
5. RECONNECT A/C HIGH–PRESSURE SWITCH
CONNECTOR
Solenoid Valve
SOLENOID VALVE INSPECTION
INSPECT SOLENOID VALVE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
the terminals
Resistance:
7.6 – 8.0Ω at 25°C (77°F)
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the sole–
noid valve.
EG2–366
1MZ–FE ENGINE
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE DATA
Thermostat
Radiator cap
Radiator
On–vehicle
inspection
for hydraulic–
driven cooling
motor
Hydraulic
motor
ECT sensor
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part tightened
RH Drain plug x Cylinder block
LH Drain plug x Cylinder block
Water pump x Cylinder block
No.3 timing belt cover x Cylinder head
No.2 idler pulley x Cylinder heads
Camshaft pulley x Camshaft
Camshaft pulley x Camshaft (For use with SST)
Water inlet x Water inlet housing
Water inlet pipe x LH cylinder head
Hydraulic motor pressure hose x Water inlet
Radiator oil cooler x Radiator lower tank
Radiator pipe x Radiator lower tank
Pressure hose x Hydraulic motor
Radiator support bolt
Hydraulic motor housing x Motor cover
Hydraulic motor x Fan shroud
Cooling fen x Hydraulic motor
Hydraulic cooling fan x Radiator
Oil cooler (for hydraulic cooling fan)
x RadiAtor lower support
–
COOLING SYSTEM
EG2–367
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
DESCRIPTION
A fully pressurized, fully filtered lubrication system has been adopted for this engine.
OPERATION
CAMSHAFT GEARS
VALVE LIFTERS & STEMS
CAMSHAFT GEARS
VALVE LIFTERS & STEM
CAMS
PISTONS
CAMS
CAMSHAFT JOURNALS
CAMSHAFT JOURNALS
CYLINDER HEAD
(FOR LEFT BANK)
CYLINDER HEAD
(FOR RIGHT BANK)
CONNECTING RODS
CRANKSHAFT
MAIN OIL HOLE
RELIEF VALVE
OIL FILTER
RELIEF VALVE
OIL PUMP
OIL STRAINER
OIL PAN
EG2–368
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
A pressure feeding lubrication system has been adopted to supply oil to the moving parts of this
engine. The lubrication system consists of an oil pan, oil pump, oil filter and other external parts
which supply oil to the moving parts in the engine block. The oil circuit is shown in the illustration
at the top of the previous page. Oil from the oil pan is pumped up by the oil pump. After it passes
through the oil filter, it is fed through the various oil holes in the crankshaft and cylinder block.
After passing through the cylinder block and performing its lubricating function, the oil is
returned by gravity to the oil pan. A dipstick on the center left side of the cylinder block is
provided to check the oil level.
OIL PUMP
The oil pump pumps up oil from the oil pan and feeds it under pressure to the various parts of the
engine. An oil strainer is mounted in front of the inlet to the oil pump to remove impurities. The
oil pump itself is a trochoid type pump, inside of which there is a drive rotor and a driven rotor.
When the drive rotor rotates, the driven rotor rotates in the same direction, and since the axis of
the drive rotor shaft is different from the center of the driven rotor, the space between the two
rotors changes as they rotate. Oil is drawn in when the space is wide and is discharged when the
space in narrow.
OIL PRESSURE REGULATOR (RELIEF VALVE)
At high engine speeds, the engine oil supplied by the oil pump exceeds the capacity of the engine
to utilize it. For that reason, the oil pressure regulator works to prevent an oversupply of oil.
–During normal oil supply, a coil spring and valve keep the bypass closed, but when too much oil
is being fed, the pressure become extremely high, overpowering the force of the spring and
opening the valves. This allows the excess oil to flow through the relief valve and return to the oil
pan.
OIL FILTER
The oil filter is a full flow type filter with a built–in paper filter element. Particles of metal from
wear, airborne dirt, carbon and other impurities can get into the oil during use and could cause
accelerated wear or seizing if allowed to circulate through the engine. The oil filter, integrated into
the oil line, removes these impurities as the oil passes through it. The filter is mounted outside the
engine to simplify replacement of the filter element. A relief valve is also included ahead of the
filter element to relieve the high oil pressure in case the filter element becomes clogged with
impurities. The relief valve opens when the oil pressure overpowers the force of the spring. Oil
passing through the relief valve bypasses the oil filter and flows directly into the main oil hole in
the engine.
EG2–369
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
PREPARATION
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
09032–00100 Oil Pan Seal Cutter
No.2 oil pan
09223–00010 Cover & Seal Replacer
Crankshaft front oil seal
09226–07500 Oil Filter Wrench
09816–30010 Oil Pressure Switch Socket
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09200–00010 Engine Adjust Kit
EQUIPMENT
Oil pressure gauge
Precision straight edge
Oil pump
Torque wrench
LUBRICANT
Item
Engine oil
Dry fill
Drain and refill
w/ Oil filter change
w/o Oil filter change
Capacity
Classification
5.5 liters (5.8 US qts, 4.8 Imp. qts)
API grade SG or SH, Energy–Conserving II
or ILSAC multigrade and recommended
viscosity oil with SAE 5W–30
being the preferred engine oil
4.7 liters (5.0 US qts, 4.1 Imp. qts)
4.5 liters (4.8 US qts, 4.0 Imp. qts)
EG2–370
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
SSM (SPECIAL SERVICE MATERIALS)
08826–00080 Seal packing or equivalent
Oil pump
No.1 oil pan
No.2 oil pan
08833–00080 Adhesive 1344,
THREE BOND 1344,
LOCTITE 242 or equivalent
Oil pressure switch
OIL PRESSURE CHECK
1. CHECK ENGINE OIL QUALITY
Check the oil for deterioration, entry of water, dis–
coloring or thinning.
If the quality is visibly poor, replace the oil.
Oil grade:
API grade SG or SH, Energy – Conserving II or
ILSAC multigrade engine oil. Recommended viscosi–
ty is as shown in the illustration with SAE 5W–30
being the preferred engine oil.
2. CHECK ENGINE OIL LEVEL
The oil level should be between the ”L” and ”F” marks
on the dipstick.
If low, check for leakage and add oil up to the ”F”
mark.
NOTICE:
• Do not fill with engine oil above the ”F” mark.
• Install the oil dipstick facing the direction shown in
the illustration.
3. REMOVE OIL PRESSURE SWITCH, AND INSTALL
OIL PRESSURE GAUGE
(a) Using SST, remove the oil pressure switch.
SST 09816 – 30010
EG2–371
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
(b) Install the oil pressure gauge.
4. WARM UP ENGINE
Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating
temperature.
5. CHECK OIL PRESSURE
Oil pressure:
At idle speed
29 kPa (0.3 kgf/cm2, 4.3 psi) or more
At 3,000 rpm
294 – 539 kPa (3.0 – 5.5 kgf/cm2, 43 – 78 psi)
6. REMOVE OIL PRESSURE GAUGE AND REINSTALL
OIL PRESSURE SWITCH
(a) Remove the oil pressure gauge.
(b) Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the oil pressure
switch.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08833–00080, THREE BOND 1344,
LOCTITE 242 or equivalent
(c) Using SST, reinstall the oil pressure switch.
SST 09816–30010
Torque: 13 N–m (130 kgf–cm, 9 ft–lbf)
7. START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR LEAKS
EG2–372
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
OIL AND FILTER REPLACEMENT
CAUTION:
• Prolonged and repeated contact with mineral oil will
result in the removal of natural fats from the skin,
leading to dryness, irritation and dermatitis. In addi–
tion, used engine oil contains potentially harmful
contaminants which may cause skin cancer.
• Exercise caution in order to minimize the length and
frequency of contact of your skin to used oil. Wear
protective clothing end gloves. Wash your skin thor–
oughly with soap and water, or use waterless hand
cleaner, to remove any used engine oil. Do not use
gasoline, thinners, or solvents.
• In order to preserve the environment, used oil and
used oil filter must be disposed of only at designated
disposal sites.
1. DRAIN ENGINE OIL
(a) Remove the oil filler cap.
(b) Remove the oil drain plug, and drain the oil into a
container.
2. REPLACE OIL FILTER
(a) Using SST, remove the oil filter.
SST 09228–07500
(b) Check and clean the oil filter installation surface.
EG2–373
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
(c) Apply clean engine oil to the gasket of a new oil filter.
(d) Lightly screw the oil filter into place, and tighten it
until the gasket contacts the seat.
(e) Using SST, tighten it an additional 3/4 turn.
SST 09228–07500
3. REFILL WITH ENGINE OIL
(a) Clean and install the oil drain plug with a new gasket.
Torque: 37 N–m (375 kgf–cm, 27 ft–lbf)
(b) Fill with fresh engine oil.
Oil grade:
API grade SG or SH, Energy – Conserving II or
ILSAC multigrade and recommended viscosity oil,
with SAE 5W–30 being the preferred engine oil.
Capacity:
Drain and refill
w/ Oil filter change
4.7 liters (5.0 US qts, 4.1 Imp. qts)
w/o Oil filter change
4.5 liters (4.8 US qts, 4.0 Imp. qts)
Dry fill
5.5 liters (5.8 US qts, 4.8 Imp. qts)
(c) Reinstall the oil filler cap.
4. START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR OIL LEAKS
5. RECHECK ENGINE OIL LEVEL
EG2–374
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
OIL PUMP
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
EG2–375
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
EG2–376
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
EG2–377
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
OIL PUMP REMOVAL
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
HINT: When repairing the oil pump, the oil pan and
strainer should be removed and cleaned.
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the Ignition switch is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable Is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. DRAIN ENGINE OIL
3. REMOVE OIL DIPSTICK
4. REMOVE TIMING BELT
(See step 2 to 20 on pages EG2–41 to 45)
5. REMOVE TIMING PULLEYS
(See step 21 to 24 on pages EG2–45 to 47)
6. DISCONNECT ENGINE WIRE
(a) Disconnect the crankshaft position sensor connector.
(b) Disconnect the engine wire from the wire clamp.
(c) Disconnect the generator connector.
(d) Remove the nut and disconnect the generator wire.
(e) Disconnect the engine wire from the 3 clamps.
7. REMOVE No.3 TIMING BELT COVER
Remove the 6 bolts and belt cover.
EG2–378
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
8. REMOVE GENERATOR
Remove the 2 bolts and generator.
9. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
Remove the bolt and position sensor.
10. REMOVE OIL HOLE COVER PLATE
Remove the 4 bolts and cover plate.
11. REMOVE A/C COMPRESSOR WITHOUT
DISCONNECTING HOSES
(a) Disconnect the A/C compressor connector.
(b) Remove the drive belt.
(c) Remove the 5 bolts, 2 nuts and drive belt adjusting
bar bracket, and disconnect the A/C compressor.
(d) Move the compressor aside and suspend it.
12. REMOVE A/C COMPRESSOR HOUSING
BRACKET
Remove the 3 bolts and A/C compressor housing
bracket.
EG2–379
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
13. REMOVE FRONT EXHAUST PIPE
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and exhaust pipe clamp.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts, and disconnect the bracket.
(c) Remove the 2 bolts and 2 nuts holding the front
exhaust pipe to the three–way catalytic converter.
(d) Remove the 4 nuts holding the front exhaust pipe to
the exhaust manifolds.
(e) Remove the front exhaust pipe and 3 gaskets.
14. REMOVE FRONT EXHAUST PIPE STAY
Remove the 2 bolts and pipe stay.
15. REMOVE FLYWHEEL HOUSING UNDERCOVER
Remove the 2 bolts and undercover.
16. REMOVE BOLTS HOLDING NO.1 OIL PAN TO
TRANSAXLE
Remove the 2 bolts.
EG2–380
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
17. REMOVE NO.2 OIL PAN
(a) Remove the 10 bolts and 2 nuts.
(b) Insert the blade of SST between the No. 1 and No.2 oil
pans, and cut off applied sealer and remove the No. 1
oil pan.
SST 09032 – 00100
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to the damage the No.2 oil pan con–
tact surface of the No.1 oil pan.
• Be careful not to damage the No..2 oil pan flange.
18. REMOVE OIL STRAINER
Remove the bolt, 2 nuts, oil strainer and gasket.
19. REMOVE NO.1 OIL PAN
(a) Remove the 17 bolts.
EG2–381
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
(b) Using a screwdriver, remove the No. 1 oil pan by
prying the portions between the cylinder block and
No.1 oil pan.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the contact surfaces
of the cylinder block and No.1 oil pan.
20. REMOVE OIL PAN BAFFLE PLATE
Remove the 6 bolts and baffle plate.
21. REMOVE OIL PUMP
(a) Remove the 9 bolts.
(b) Remove the oil pump by prying a screwdriver between
the oil pump and main bearing cap.
(c) Remove the 0–ring.
EG2–382
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
COMPONENTS FOR DISASSEMBLY AND
ASSEMBLY
OIL PUMP DISASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE RELIEF VALVE
Remove the plug, gasket, spring and relief valve.
2. REMOVE DRIVE AND DRIVEN ROTORS
Remove the 9 screws, pump body cover, drive and
driven rotors.
EG2–383
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
OIL PUMP INSPECTION
1. INSPECT RELIEF VALVE
Coat the valve with engine oil and check that it falls
smoothly into the valve hole by its own weight.
If it does not, replace the relief valve. If necessary,
replace the oil pump assembly.
2. INSPECT DRIVE AND DRIVEN ROTORS
A. Place drive and driven rotors into oil pump body
Place the drive and driven rotors into the oil pump
body with the mark facing upward.
B. Inspect rotor side clearance
Using a feeler gauge and precision straight edge, mea–
sure the clearance between the rotors and precision
straight edge.
Standard side clearance:
0.030 – 0.090 mm (0.0012 – 0.0035 in.)
Maximum side clearance:
0.15 mm (0.0059 in.)
If the side clearance is greater than maximum, replace
the rotors as a set. If necessary, replace the oil pump
assembly.
C. Inspect rotor tip clearance
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between
the drive and driven rotor tips.
Standard tip clearance:
0.110 – 0.240 mm (0.0043 – 0.0094 In.)
Maximum tip clearance:
0.35 mm (0.0138 in.)
If the tip clearance is greater than maximum, replace
the rotors as a set.
EG2–384
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
D. Inspect rotor body clearance
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between
the driven rotor and body.
Standard body clearance:
0.100 – 0.175 mm (0.0039 – 0.0069 In.)
Maximum body clearance:
0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
If the body clearance is greater than maximum, re–
place the rotors as a set. If necessary, replace the oil
pump assembly.
CRANKSHAFT FRONT OIL SEAL
REPLACEMENT
HINT: There are 2 methods (A and B) to replace the oil
seal which are as follows:
REPLACE CRANKSHAFT FRONT OIL SEAL
A. If oil pump is removed from cylinder block:
(a) Using a screwdriver, pry out the oil seal.
(b) Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new oil seal until its
surface is flush with the oil pump body edge.
SST 09223 – 00010
(c) Apply MP grease to the oil seal lip.
B. If oil pump is installed to the cylinder block:
(a) Using a knife, cut off the oil seal lip.
(b) Using a screwdriver, pry out the oil seal.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the crankshaft. Tape
the screwdriver tip.
EG2–385
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
(c) Apply MP grease to a new oil seal lip.
(d) Using SST and a hammer, tap in the oil seal until its
surface is flush with the oil pump body edge.
SST 09223 – 00010
OIL PUMP ASSEMBLY
(See Components for Disassembly and Assembly)
1. INSTALL DRIVE AND DRIVEN ROTORS
(a) Place the drive and driven rotors into pump body with
the marks facing the pump body cover side.
(b) Install the pump body cover with the 9 screws.
2. INSTALL RELIEF VALVE
(a) Insert the relief valve and spring into the pump body
hole.
(b) Install the plug with a new gasket.
Torque: 36.8 N–m (375 kgf–cm, 37 ft–lbf)
EG2–386
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE – LUBRICATION SYSTEM
OIL PUMP INSTALLATION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. INSTALL OIL PUMP
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be care–
ful not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces of the
oil pump and cylinder block.
• Using a razor blade and gasket scraper, remove
all the old packing (FIPG) material from the
gasket surfaces and sealing grooves.
• Thoroughly clean all components to remove all
the loose material.
• Using a non–residue solvent, clean both sealing
surfaces.
(b) Apply seal packing to the oil pump as shown in the
illustration.
Seal packing:
Part No. 08826–00080 or equivalent
• Install a nozzle that has been cut to a 2–3 mm
(0.08–0.12 in.) opening.
HINT: Avoid applying an excessive amount to the
surface.
• Parts must be assembled within 3 minutes of
application. Otherwise the material must be re–
moved and reapplied.
• Immediately remove nozzle from the tube and
reinstall cap.
(c) Place a new 0 – ring in position on the cylinder block.
(d) Engage the spline teeth of the oil pump drive gear with
the large teeth of the crankshaft, and slide the oil
pump on the crankshaft.
EG2–387
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
(e) Install the oil pump with the 9 bolts.
Torque:
8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–lbf) for 10 mm head bolt
19.5 N–m (200 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf) for 12 mm head bolt
2. INSTALL OIL PAN BAFFLE PLATE
Install the baffle plate with the 6 bolts.
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–Ibf)
3. INSTALL NO.1 OIL PAN
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be care–
f uI not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces of the
oil pan, oil pump and cylinder block.
• Using a razor blade and gasket scraper, remove
all the old packing (FIPG) material from the
gasket surfaces and sealing grooves.
• Thoroughly clean all components to remove all
the loose material.
• Using a non–residue solvent, clean both sealing
surfaces.
(b) Apply seal packing to the oil pan as shown in the
illustration.
Seal packing:
Part No. 08826–00080 or equivalent
Region “X” is at the outer side of the bolt hole.
Region “Y” Is at the inner side of the bolt hole.
• Install a nozzle that has been cut to a 4–5 mm
(0.16–0.20 in.) opening.
HINT: Avoid applying an excessive amount to the
surface.
• Parts must be assembled within 3 minutes of
application. Otherwise the material must be re–
moved and reapplied.
• Immediately remove nozzle from the tube and
reinstall cap.
EG2–388
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
(c) Install the oil pan with the 17 bolts.
Torque:
8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–lbf) for 10 mm head bolt
19.5 N–m (200 kgf–cm. 14 ft–lbf) for 12 mm head bolt
4. INSTALL OIL STRAINER
Install a new gasket and the oil strainer with the bolt
and 2 nuts.
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–lbf)
5. INSTALL NO.2 OIL PAN
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be care.
ful not to drop any oil on the contact surface of the
No. 1 and No.2 oil pans.
• Using a razor blade and gasket scraper, remove
all the old packing (FIPG) material from the
gasket surfaces and sealing grooves.
• Thoroughly clean all components to remove al
the loose material.
• Using a non–residue solvent, clean both sealing surfaces.
NOTICE: Do not use a solvent which will affect the paint
ed surfaces.
(b) Apply seal packing to the No.2 oil pan as shown in the
illustration.
Seal packing:
Part No. 088218–00080 or equivalent
• Install a nozzle that has been cut to a 4–5 mm
(0.16 – 0.20 in.) opening.
HINT: Avoid –applying an excessive amount to the
surface.
• Parts must be assembled within 3 minutes an
application. Otherwise the material must be re–
moved and reapplied.
• Immediately remove nozzle from the tube and
reinstall cap.
EG2–389
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
(c) Install the No.2 oil pan with the 10 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–lbf)
6. INSTALL BOLTS HOLDING NO.1 OIL PAN TO
TRANSAXLE
Install the 2 bolts.
Torque: 37 N–m (380 kgf–cm, 27 ft–lbf)
7. INSTALL FLYWHEEL HOUSING UNDERCOVER
Install the undercover with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 7.8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–lbf)
8. INSTALL FRONT EXHAUST PIPE STAY
Install the pipe stay with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 21 N–m (210 kgf–cm, 15 ft–lbf)
9. INSTALL FRONT EXHAUST PIPE
(a) Temporarily install 3 new gaskets and the front ex–
haust pipe with the 2 bolts and6 nuts.
(b) Tighten the 4 nuts holding the exhaust manifolds to
the front exhaust pipe.
Torque: 62 N–m (630 kgf–cm, 46 ft–lbf)
(c) Tighten the 2 bolts and 2 nuts holding the three–way
catalytic converter to the front exhaust pipe.
Torque: 56 N–m (570 kgf–cm, 41 ft–lbf)
(d) Connect the bracket with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 19 N–m (195 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
EG2–390
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
(e) Connect the front exhaust pipe clamp with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 29 N–m (300 kgf–cm, 22 ft–lbf)
10. INSTALL A/C COMPRESSOR HOUSING BRACKET
Install the housing bracket with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 26 N–m (250 kgf–cm, 18 ft–lbf)
11. INSTALL A/C COMPRESSOR
(a) Install the A/C compressor and drive belt adjusting
bar bracket with the 5 bolts.
Torque: 25 N–m (250 kgf–cm, 18 ft–lbf)
12. INSTALL OIL HOLE COVER PLATE
Install a new gasket and the hole cover plate (J mark
facing outward) with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–Ibf)
13. INSTALL CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
Install the position sensor with the bolt.
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 89 in.–lbf)
EG2–391
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
14. INSTALL GENERATOR
Install the generator with the 2 bolts. Do not tighten
the bolts yet.
15. INSTALL NO.3 TIMING BELT COVER
(a) Check that the timing belt cover gaskets have no
cracks or peeling, etc.
If the gaskets do have cracks or peeling etc., replace
them using the following steps.
(1) Using a screwdriver and gasket scraper, remove
all the old gasket material.
(2) Thoroughly clean all components to remove all
the loose material.
(3) Remove the backing paper from a new gasket
and install the gasket evenly to the part of the
belt cover shaded black in the illustration.
NOTICE: When joining gaskets, do not leave a gap be–
tween them. Cut off any excess gasket.
(4) After installing the gasket, press down on it so
that the adhesive firmly sticks to the belt cover.
(b) Install new gaskets to the No.3 belt cover.
(c) Install the belt cover with the 6 bolts.
Torque: 8.5 N–m (85 kgf–cm. 74 in.–lbf)
16. CONNECT ENGINE WIRE
(a) Connect the generator connector.
(b) Connect the generator wire with the nut.
(c) Connect the engine wire with the 3 clamps.
EG2–392
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
(d) Connect the crankshaft position sensor connector.
(e) Connect the engine wire with the wire clamp.
17. INSTALL TIMING PULLEYS
(See steps 1 to 5 on pages EG2–49, 50)
18. INSTALL TIMING BELT
(See steps6 to 27 on pages EG2–51 to 66)
19. FILL ENGINE WITH OIL
Capacity:
Drain and refill
w/ Oil filter change
4.7 liters (5.0 US qts, 4.1 Imp. qts)
w/o Oil filter change
4.5 liters (4.8 US qts, 4.0 Imp. qts)
20. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE TO
BATTERY
21. START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR LEAKS
22. RECHECK ENGINE ENGINE OIL LEVEL
EG2–393
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE DATA
Oil pressure
At idle speed (normal operating temperature)
At 3,000 rpm (normal operating temperature)
Oil pump
Side clearance
STD
Maximum
Body clearance
STD
Maximum
Tip clearance
STD
Maximum
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Pert tightened
Oil pressure switch x Cylinder block
No.2 oil pan x Drain plug
Oil pump x Plug (for relief valve)
Oil pump x Cylinder block (10 mm head bolt)
Oil pump x Cylinder block (12 mm head bolt)
Oil pan baffle plate x No.1 oil pan
No.1 idler pulley x Oil pump
No. 1 oil pan x Cylinder block
No. 1 oil pan x Oil pump
No.1 oil pan x Rear oil seal retainer
Oil strainer x Main bearing cap
Oil strainer x Oil pump
No.2 oil pan x No. 1 oil pan
Flywheel housing under cover x Transaxle
Exhaust pipe stay x No.1 oil pan
Exhaust pipe clamp x Exhaust pipe stay
A/C compressor housing bracket x Cylinder block
A/C compressor x A/C compressor housing bracket
Oil hole cover plate x No.2 oil pan
No.1 oil pan x Transaxle case
Front exhaust pipe x Exhaust manifold
Front exhaust pipe x Converter
Crankshaft position sensor x Oil pump
No.3 timing belt cover x Cylinder head
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
EG2–394
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
1MZ–FE ENGINE TROUBLESHOOTING
EG2–395
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
EG2–396
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
The Engine Control System broadly consists of the sensors, ECM and actuators. The ECM receives signals
from various sensors, judges the operating conditions and determines the optimum injection duration,
timing, ignition timing and idle speed.
In general, the Engine Control System is considered to be a very intricate system to troubleshoot. But, the
fact is that if you inspect each circuit in order following the procedures in this manual, troubleshooting of
this system is not complex.
When troubleshooting OBDll vehicles, use an OBDII scan tool complying with SAE J1978 or TOYOTA
hand–held –tester to confirm the diagnostic trouble codes, freezed frame data and engine data.
This will enable you to determine the system causing the problem.
This section explains the best method of troubleshooting and how to carry out the necessary repairs.
(1) CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
Using the customer problem analysis check sheet for reference, ask the customer in detail about the
problem.
(2) CONNECT OBDII SCAN TOOL OR TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER TO DLC 3
Connect the OBDII scan tool complying with SAE J1978 or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the
vehicle’s data link connector 3.
NOTICE: For OBDII scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester operating instructions, see the in–
struction booklet accompanying the scan tool or tester.
If your display shows ”UNABLE” TO CONNECT TO VEHICLE” when you have connected the scan
tool/TOYOTA hand–held tester cable to DLC 3, turn the ignition switch ON and operate the scan
tool/TOYOTA hand–held tester, inspect DLC (See page EG2–401)
(3) CHECK DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE AND FREEZED FRAME DATA (PRECHECK)
First check the diagnostic trouble codes. If a code is output, make a note of it.
Also check and note the freezed frame data.
HINT: Output of the malfunction code indicates a circuit malfunction. However, it does not indicate
whether the malfunction is still occurring or occurred in the past and returned to normal. To determine
this, first confirm the problem symptoms in (7) and then recheck the diagnostic trouble code in (9).
If troubleshooting started based only on the malfunction code in the diagnostic trouble code check
in (3) , it could result in a misdiagnosis and troubleshooting of circuits which are normal, making it
more difficult to locate the cause of the problem.
(4) CLEAR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE AND FREEZED FRAME DATA
Use the OBDII scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to erase the diagnostic trouble codes and
freezed frame data.
NOTICE: For OBDII scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester operating instructions, see the in–
struction booklet accompanying the scan tool.
(5) VISUAL INSPECTION
EG2–397
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
(6) SETTING CHECK MODE DIAGNOSIS
(7) PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
If the engine does not start, first carry out steps (10) and (12) while referring to the diagnostic trouble
codes confirmed in step (4) .
(8) SYMPTOM SIMULATION
To find the trouble more quickly, set the diagnosis check to check mode and confirm the problem
symptoms with the higher sensing ability of the ECM. If the trouble does not reappear, use the
symptom simulation method to make sure the trouble can be reproduced.
(9) DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK IN CHECK MODE
Check the diagnostic trouble code in check mode. If a malfunction code is output, proceed to step
(11) of the Diagnostic Trouble Code Chart. If a malfunction code is not output, proceed to step (10)
Basic Inspection.
(10) BASIC INSPECTION
Carry out basic inspection such as the spark check and fuel pressure check, etc.
(11) DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a malfunction code is displayed, inspect the circuit indicated by the chart for each code.
(12) MATRIX CHART OF PROBLEM SYMPTOMS
If a diagnostic trouble code is not displayed in the diagnosis in check mode, troubleshoot according
to the inspection order in the Matrix Chart of Problem Symptoms.
(13) CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Determine if the malfunction is in the sensor, actuator, wire harness, connector or the ECM.
(14) PARTS INSPECTION
When the Matrix Chart of Problem Symptoms instructs you to check the parts, refer to the parts
inspection section in this manual.
(15) CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
By checking for intermittent problems, you can isolate the place where momentary interruptions or
momentary shorts are occurring due to poor contacts.
(16) ADJUSTMENT, REPAIR
After you locate the cause of the problem, follow the inspection and replacement procedures in this
manual and adjust or repair as necessary.
(17) CONFIRMATION TEST
After completing adjustment or repairs, confirm not only that the malfunction is eliminated, but also
test drive the vehicle, to make sure the entire Engine Control System is operating normally.
EG2–398
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
Titles inside
are titles of pages in
this manual, with the page number indi–
cated in the bottom portion. See the indicated pages for detailed explanations.
Vehicle Brought to workshop
Customer Problem Analysis
P EG2–399
Connect the OBDII scan tool or Toyota hand–held tester to DLC3. P. EG2–402
If the display indicates a communication fault in the tool, inspect DLC3.
See page EG2–401
Check Diagnostic Trouble Code and Freezed Frame Data Check
Record or print DTC and Freezed Frarne Data. P. EG2–402
Clear Diagnostic Trouble Code and Freezed Frame Data P. EG2–403
Visual Inspection
Setting the Check Mode Diagnosis P EG2–403
Problem Symptom Confirmation
if the engine does not start, perform steps 10 and 12 first
Malfunction does not occur.
Symptom Simulation P IN–24
Malfunction
occurs.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Check P EG2–403
Normal
Basic Inspection EG2–420
Malfunction code.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Chart P. EG2–404
Matrix Chart of Problem Symptoms P EG2–435
Circuit Inspection P EG2–444
Parts Inspection
ldentification of Problem
Adjustment, Repair.
Confirmation Test
END
Check for Intermittent Problems P EG2–417
EG2–399
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK SHEET
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK SHEET
ENGINE CONTROL System Check Sheet
Inspector’s
Name
EG2–400
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
DESCRIPTION
When troubleshooting OBDII vehicles, the only difference
from the usual troubleshooting procedure is that you connect
to the vehicle the OBDll scan tool complying with SAE J1978
or TOYOTA hand–held tester, and read off various data output
from the vehicle’s ECM.
OBDll regulations require that the vehicle’s on–board com–
puter lights up the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) on the
instrument panel when the computer detects a malfunction in
the computer itself or in drive system components which af–
fect vehicle emissions. In addition to the MIL lighting up
when a malfunction is detected, the applicable diagnostic
trouble codes prescribed by SAE J2012 are recorded in the
ECM memory. (See page EG2–404)
If the malfunction does not reoccur in 3 trips, the MIL goes off
but the diagnostic trouble codes remain recorded in the ECM
memory.
To check the diagnostic trouble codes, connect the OBDII
scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to Data Link Connec–
tor 3 on the vehicle. The OBDII scan tool or TOYOTA hand–
held tester also enables you to erase the diagnostic trouble
codes and check freezed frame data and various forms of
engine data. (For operating instructions, see the OBDII scan
tool’s instruction book.)
Diagnostic trouble codes include SAE controlled codes and
Manufacturer controlled codes.
SAE controlled codes must be set as prescribed by the SAE,
while Manufacturer controlled codes can be set freely by the
manufacturer within the prescribed limits.
(See diagnostic trouble code chart on page EG2–404)
The diagnosis system operates in normal mode during normal
vehicle use. It also has a check mode for technicians to simu–
late malfunction symptoms and troubleshoot. Most diagnos–
tic trouble codes use 2 trip detection logic*to prevent erro–
neous detection and ensure thorough malfunction detection.
By switching the ECM to check mode when troubleshooting,
the technician can cause the MIL to light up for a malfunction
that is only detected once or momentarily. (TOYOTA hand–
held tester only)
(See page EG2–403)
*2 trip detection logic
When a logic malfunction is first detected, the malfunction is
temporarily stored in the ECM memory. If the same malfunc–
tion is detected again during the second drive test, this sec–
ond detection causes the MIL to light up.
The 2 trip repeats the same mode a 2nd time. (However, the
IG switch must be turned OFF between the 1 st trip and 2nd
trip).
EG2–401
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
Freeze frame data:
Freeze frame data records the engine condition when a
misfire (DTC P0300 – P0306) or fuel trim malfunction
(DTC P0171, P0172), or other malfunction (first malfunc–
tion only), is detected.
Because freeze frame data records the engine conditions
(fuel system, calculator load, engine coolant temperature,
fuel trim, engine speed, vehicle speed, etc.) when the mal–
function is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped,
the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich,
etc. at the time of the malfunction.
Priorities for Troubleshooting:
If troubleshooting priorities for multiple diagnostic codes
are given in the applicable diagnostic chart, these should be
followed.
If no instructions are given, troubleshoot diagnostic trouble
codes according to the following priorities.
(1) Diagnostic trouble codes other than fuel trim malfunc–
tion (DTC P0171, P0172) and EGR (DTC P0401, P0402) and
misfire (DTC P0300 – P0306).
(2) Fuel trim malfunction (DTC P0171, P0172) and EGR (DTC
P0401, P0402)
(3) Misfire (DTC P0300 – P0306).
DATA LINK CONNECTOR 3 INSPECTION
The vehicle’s ECM uses V.P.W. (Variable Pulse Width) for
communication to comply with SAE J1850. The terminal ar–
rangement of DLC 3 complies with SAE J1962 and matches
the V. P.W. format.
Terminal No.
Connection
Bus (+) Line
Voltage or Resistance
Condition
Pulse generation
During transmission
Chassis Ground
↔ Body Ground 1 0 or less
Always
Signal Ground
↔ Body Ground 1 0 or less
Always
Battery Positive
↔ Body Ground 9 – 14 V
Always
HINT: If your display shows ”UNABLE TO CONNECT TO
VEHICLE” when you have connected the cable of the OBDII
scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to DLC 3, turned the
ignition switch ON and operated the scan tool, there is a
problem on the vehicle side or tool side.
1) If communication is normal when the tool is connected
to another vehicle, inspect DLC 3 on the original vehicle.
2) If communication is still not possible when the tool is
connected to another vehicle, the problem is probably in
the tool itself, so consult the Service Department listed in
the tool’s instruction manual.
EG2–402
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
Diagnosis Inspection (Normal Mode)
MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP CHECK
1. The malfunction indicator lamp comes on when the igni–
tion switch is turned ON and the engine is not running.
HINT: If the malfunction indicator lamp does not light
up, troubleshoot the combination meter.
(See page BE–64).
2. When the engine is started, the malfunction indicator
lamp should go off. If the lamp remains on, the diagnosis
system has detected a malfunction or abnormality in the
system.
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK
NOTICE (TOYOTA hand–held tester only): When the diag–
nosis system is switched from normal mode to check mode,
it erases all diagnostic trouble codes and freezed frame
data recorded in normal mode. So before switching modes,
always check the diagnostic trouble codes and freezed
frame data, and note them down.
1. Prepare the OBDII scan tool (complying with SAE
J1978) or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
2. Connect the OBDll scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held
tester to data link connector 3 in the fuse box at the lower
left of the instrument panel.
3. Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the OBDII scan tool
or TOYOTA hand–held tester switch ON.
4. Use the OBDII scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to
check the diagnostic trouble codes and freezed frame
data, note them down. (For operating instructions, see
the OBDll scan tool’s instruction book.)
5. See page EG2–404 to confirm the details of the diagnostic
trouble codes.
NOTICE: When simulating symptoms with an OBDll scan
tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester) to check the di–
agnostic trouble codes, use normal mode. For codes on the
diagnostic trouble code chart subject to ”2 trip detection
logic”, turn the ignition switch OFF after the symptom is
simulated the first time. Then repeat the simulation process
again. When the problem has been simulated twice, the MIL
lights up and the diagnostic trouble codes are recorded in
the ECM .
Diagnosis Inspection (Check Mode)
TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER only
Compared to the normal mode, the check mode has an in–
creased sensitivity to detect malfunctions.
Furthermore, the same diagnostic items which are detected in
the normal mode can also be detected in the check mode.
EG2–403
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK
1. Initial conditions.
(a) Battery positive voltage 11 V or more.
(b) Throttle valve fully closed.
(c) Transmission in park or neutral position.
(d) Air conditioning switched OFF.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Prepare the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
4. Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to data link con–
nector 3 in the fuse box at the lower left of the instrument
panel.
5. Turn the ignition switch ON and switch the TOYOTA
hand–held tester ON.
6. Switch the TOYOTA hand–held tester normal mode to
check mode. (Check that the MIL flashes.)
7. Start the engine. (The MIL goes out after the engine
start.)
8. Simulate the conditions of the malfunction described by
the customer.
NOTICE: Leave the ignition switch ON until you have
checked the diagnostic trouble codes, etc.
9. After simulating the malfunction conditions, use the
TOYOTA hand–held tester diagnosis selector to check
the diagnostic trouble codes and freezed frame data, etc.
HINT: Take care not to turn the ignition switch OFF.
Turning the ignition switch OFF switches the diagnosis
system from check mode to normal mode, so all diagnos–
tic codes, etc. are erased.
10. After checking the diagnostic trouble code, inspect the
applicable circuit.
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CLEARANCE
The following actions will erase the diagnostic trouble codes
and freezed frame data.
1. Operating the OBDII scan tool (complying with SAE
J1978) or TOYOTA hand–held tester to erase the codes.
(See the OBDII scan tool’s instruction book for operat–
ing instructions.)
2. Disconnecting the battery terminals or EFI fuse.
NOTICE: If the TOYOTA hand–held tester switches the
ECM from normal mode to check mode or vice–versa, or if
the ignition switch is turned from ON to ACC or OFF during
check mode, the diagnostic trouble codes and freezed
frame data will be erased.
EG2–404
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART (SAE Controlled)
HINT: Parameters listed in the chart may not be exactly the same as your reading due to the type of
instrument or other factors.
DTC No.
Detection Item
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
P0100
Mass Air Flow Circuit
Malfunction
Open or short in mass air flow meter circuit with engine speed 4,000 rpm
or less.
P0101
Mass Air Flow Circuit
Range/ Performance
Problem
Conditions a) and b) continue with engine speed 900 rpm or less.
(2 trip detection logic)
a) Closed throttle position switch: ON
b) Mass air flow meter output ) 2.2 V
P0110
Intake Air Temp. Circuit
Malfunction
Open or short in intake air temp. sensor circuit.
P0115
Engine Coolant Temp.
Circuit Malfunction
Open or short in engine coolant temp. sensor circuit.
P0116
Engine Coolant Temp.
Circuit Range/
Performance Problem
20 min. or more after starting engine, engine coolant temp. sensor
value is 30C (86F) or less.
(2 trip detection logic)
P0120
Throttle Position Circuit
Malfunction
Condition a) or b) continues.
a) VTA ( 0.1 V, and closed throttle position switch is OFF.
b) VTA ) 4.9 V
P0121
Throttle Position Circuit
Range/ Performance
Problem
When closed throttle position switch is ON, condition a) continues.
(2 trip detection logic)
a ) VTA ) 2.0 V
P0125
Insufficient Coolant
Temp. for Closed Loop
Fuel Control
After the engine is warmed up, heated oxygen sensor output does not
indicate RICH even once when conditions a) and b) continue for at
least 2 minutes.
a) Engine speed: 1,500 rpm or more
b) Vehicle speed: 40 km/h (25 mph) or more
P01 30
Heated Oxygen Sensor
Circuit Malfunction
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Voltage output of heated oxygen sensor remains at 0.4 V or more, or 0.55 V or
less, during idling after the engine is warmed up.
(2 trip detection logic)
P0133
Heated Oxygen Sensor
Circuit Slow Response
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Response time for the heated oxygen sensor’s voltage output to change from
rich to lean, or from lean to rich, is 1 sec. or more during idling after the
engine is warmed up.
(2 trip detection logic)
EG2–405
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a malfunction code is displayed during the diagnostic trouble code check in check mode, check the
circuit for that code listed in the table below (Proceed to the page given for that circuit).
Trouble Area
MIL
Memory
See Page
•
•
•
Open or short in mass air flow meter circuit.
Mass air flow meter
ECM
EG2–444
•
Mass air flow meter
EG2–450
•
•
•
Open or short in intake air temp. sensor circuit.
Intake air temp. sensor
ECM
•
•
•
Open or short in engine coolant temp. sensor circuit.
Engine coolant temp. sensor
ECM
EG2–457
•
•
Engine coolant temp. sensor
Coolant system
EG2–462
•
•
•
Open or short in throttle position sensor circuit.
Throttle position sensor.
ECM
EG2–463
EG2–451
• Throttle position sensor
EG2–472
•
•
Open or short in heated oxygen sensor circuit.
Heated oxygen sensor.
EG2–473
•
•
Heated oxygen sensor
Fuel trim malfunction
EG2–476
•
Heated oxygen sensor
EG2–480
EG2–406
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART (Cont’d)
DTC No.
P0135
Detection Item
Heated Oxygen Sensor
Heater Circuit Malfunction
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
When the heater operates, heater current exceeds 2 A or voltage drop for the
heater circuit exceeds 5 V.
(2 trip detection logic)
Heater current of 0.25 A or less when the heater operates.
(2 trip detection logic)
P0136
Heated Oxygen Sensor
Circuit Malfunction
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
Voltage output of the heated oxygen sensor (bank1 sensor 2) remains at
0.4 V or more or 0.5 V or less when the vehicle is driven at 50 km/h
(31 mph) or more after the engine is warmed up.
(2 trip detection logic)
P0141
Heated Oxygen Sensor
Heater Circuit Malfunction
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
Same as DTC No. P01 35.
P0150
Heated Oxygen Sensor
Circuit Malfunction
(Bank 2 Sensor 1)
Same as DTC No. P01 30.
P0153
Heated Oxygen Sensor
Circuit Slow Response
(Bank 2 Sensor 1)
Same as DTC No. P01 33.
P0155
Heated Oxygen Sensor
Heater Circuit Malfunction
(Bank 2 Sensor 1)
Same as DTC No. P01 35.
P0171
System too Lean
(Fuel Trim)
When the air fuel ratio feedback is stable after engine warming up, the fuel
trim is considerably in error on the RICH side.
(2 trip detection logic)
P0172
System too Rich
(Fuel Trim)
When the air fuel ratio feedback is stable after engine warming up, the fuel
trim is considerably in error on the LEAN side.
(2 trip detection logic)
P0201
P0202
P0203
P0204
P0205
P0206
Injector Circuit
Malfunction
– Cylinder 1
– Cylinder 2
– Cylinder 3
– Cylinder 4
– Cylinder 5
– Cylinder 6
A specified cylinder misfire continuously.
(2 trip detection logic)
EG2–407
1MZ–FE ENGINE
Trouble Area
–
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
MIL
Memory
See Page
•
•
•
Open or short in heater circuit of heated oxygen sensor.
Heated oxygen sensor heater
ECM
EG2–481
•
Heated oxygen sensor
EG2–484
•
Same as DTC No. P01 35.
EG2–481
•
Same as DTC No. P01 30.
EG2–476
•
Same as DTC No. P01 33.
EG2–480
•
Same as DTC No. P01 35.
EG2–481
•
•
•
•
•
•
Air intake (hose loose)
Fuel line pressure
Injector blockage
Heated oxygen sensor malfunction
Mass air flow meter
Engine coolant temp. sensor
EG2–486
•
•
•
•
•
Fuel line pressure
Injector leak, blockage
Heated oxygen sensor malfunction
Mass air flow meter
Engine coolant temp. sensor
EG2–486
•
•
•
•
•
Open or short in injector circuit
Injector blockage, seized
Ignition system
Valve clearance not to specification
Compression pressure
EG2–491
EG2–408
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART (Cont’d)
DTC No.
P0300
P0301
P0302
P0303
P0304
P0305
P0306
Detection Item
Random Misfire
Detected
Misfire Detected
– Cylinder 1
– Cylinder 2
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Misfiring of multiple cylinders is detected during the same 200 or
1,000 revolutions.
For each 200 revolutions of the engine, misfiring is detected which can cause
catalyst overheating.
(This causes MIL to blink.)
– Cylinder 3
– Cylinder 4
– Cylinder 5
– Cylinder 6
For each 1,000 revolutions of the engine, misfiring is detected which causes
emissions deterioration.
(2 trip detection logic)
P0325
Knock Sensor 1 Circuit
Malfunction
No knock sensor 1 signal to ECM with engine speed 2,000 rpm or more.
P0330
Knock Sensor 2 Circuit
Malfunction
No knock sensor 2 signal to ECM with engine speed 2,000 rpm or more.
P0335
Crankshaft Position
Sensor Circuit
Malfunction
No crankshaft position sensor signal to ECM during cranking.
(2 trip detection logic)
No crankshaft position sensor signal to ECM during engine running.
P0336
Crankshaft Position
Sensor Circuit
Range/ Performance
P0340
Camshaft Position
Sensor Circuit
Malfunction
Deviation in crankshaft position sensor signal and camshaft position
sensor signal.
(2 trip detection logic)
No camshaft position sensor signal to ECM during cranking.
(2 trip detection logic)
No camshaft position sensor signal to ECM during engine running.
P0401
Exhaust Gas
Recirculation
Flow Insufficient
Detected
After the engine is warmed up and run at 80 km/h (50 mph) for 3 to 5
minutes, the EGR gas temperature sensor value does not exceed 40C (104F)
above the ambient air temperature,
(2 trip detection logic)
EG2–409
1MZ–FE ENGINE
Trouble Area
–
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
MIL
Memory
See Page
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Ignition system
Injector
Fuel line pressure
EG R
Compression pressure
Valve clearance not to specification
Valve timing
Mass air flow meter
Engine coolant temp. sensor
EG2–493
•
•
•
Open or short in knock sensor 1 circuit.
Knock sensor 1 (looseness)
ECM
EG2–499
•
•
•
Open or short in knock sensor 2 circuit.
Knock sensor 2 (looseness)
ECM
EG2–499
•
•
•
•
Open or short in crankshaft position sensor circuit.
Crankshaft position sensor
Starter
ECM
EG2–503
•
EG2–507
•
Mechanical system malfunction
(skipping teeth of timing belt, belt stretched)
ECM
•
•
•
•
Open or short in camshaft position sensor circuit.
Camshaft position sensor
Starter
ECM
EG2–508
•
•
•
•
•
EGR valve stuck closed
Short in EGR VSV circuit
Open in EGR gas temp. sensor circuit
EGR hose disconnected
ECM
EG2–512
EG2–410
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART (Cont’d)
DTC No.
P0402
Detection Item
Exhaust Gas
Recirculation
Flow Excessive
Detected
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
EG R gas temp. sensor value is high during EGR cut–off when engine is
cold (Race engine at about 4,000 rpm without load so that vacuum is
applied to port E).
(2 trip detection logic)
EG R valve is always open.
(2 trip detection logic)
P0420
Catalyst System
Efficiency Below
Threshold
After the engine is warmed up and the vehicle driven for 5 min. at
32 – 80 km/h (20 – 50 mph), the waveforms of the heated oxygen
sensors, bank 1, 2 sensor 1 and bank 1 sensor 2 have the same amplitude.
P0500
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Malfunction
No vehicle speed sensor signal to ECM under conditions a) and b).
a) Park/neutral position switch is OFF.
b) Vehicle is being driven.
P0505
Idle Control System
Malfunction
Idle speed continues to vary greatly from the target speed.
(2 trip detection logic)
P0510
Closed Throttle
Position Switch
Malfunction
The closed throttle position switch does not turn ON even once when the
vehicle is driven.
(2 trip detection logic)
EG2–411
1MZ–FE ENGINE
Trouble Area
–
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
MIL*1
Memory
See Page
•
•
•
•
•
EGR valve stuck open
EGR VSV open malfunction
Open in EGR VSV circuit
Short in EGR gas temp. senor circuit
ECM
•
•
•
Three–way catalytic converter
Open or short in heated oxygen sensor circuit
Heated oxygen sensor
EG2–534
•
•
•
•
Open or short in vehicle speed sensor circuit.
Vehicle speed sensor
Combination meter
ECM
EG2–537
•
•
•
•
IAC valve is stuck or closed
Open or short in IAC valve circuit
Air conditioner idle up VSV
Air intake (hose loose)
EG2–541
•
•
•
Open in closed throttle position switch circuit.
Closed throttle position switch
ECM
EG2–546
*1.... MIL does not light up
O .... MIL lights up
O .... MIL lights up, 0/D OFF indicator light blinks
O
*2.... MIL lights up only on USA specification vehicles.
EG2–527
EG2–412
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART (Cont’d)
DTC No.
Detection Item
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
P0720
Output Speed Sensor
Circuit Malfunction
(for Electronically
Controlled Transaxle)
DTC No. P0500 is detected.
P0750
Shift Solenoid A
Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid
Valve No.1)
During normal driving the gear required by the ECM does not match
the actual gear,
(2 trip detection logic)
P0753
Shift Solenoid A
Electrical
(Shift Solenoid
Valve No,1)
Open or short in shift solenoid valve No.1 circuit.
P0755
Shift Solenoid6
Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid
Valve No.2)
Same as for DTC No. P0750.
P0758
Shift Solenoid B
Electrical
(Shift Solenoid
Valve No.2)
Open or short in shift solenoid valve No.2 circuit.
Shift Solenoid E
Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid
Valve SL)
Lock–up does not occur when driving in the lock–up range (normal driving
at 80 km/h [50 mph]), or lock–up remains ON in the lock–up OFF range.
(2 trip detection logic)
Shift Solenoid E
Electrical
(Shift Solenoid
Valve SL)
Open or short in shift solenoid valve SL circuit.
(2 trip detection logic)
P0770
P0773
EG2–413
1MZ–FE ENGINE
Trouble Area
–
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
MIL*
Memory
See Page
•
Same as for DTC No. P0500.
AX2–92
•
•
Shift solenoid valve No.1 is stuck open or closed.
Valve body is blocked up or stuck.
AX2–96
•
•
•
Open or short in shift solenoid valve No.1 circuit.
Shift solenoid valve No.1
ECM
AX2–98
•
Shift solenoid valve No.2 is stuck open or closed.
AX2–96
•
•
•
Open or short in shift solenoid valve No.2 circuit.
Shift solenoid valve No.2
ECM
•
•
Shift solenoid valve SL is stuck open or closed.
Lock–up clutch
9 Valve body is blocked up or stuck.
AX2–102
•
•
•
Open or short in shift solenoid valve SL circuit.
Shift solenoid valve SL
ECM
AX2–104
* – . . . . . MIL does not light up
O . . . . .MIL lights up
O . . . . MIL lights up, 0/D OFF indicator light blinks
O
AX2–98
EG2–414
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
(Manufacturer Controlled)
DTC No.
Detection Item
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
P1300
Igniter Circuit
Malfunction
No IGF signal to ECM for 6 consecutive IGT signals during engine running.
P1500
Starter Signal Circuit
Malfunction
No starter signal to ECM.
P1600
ECM BATT
Malfunction
Open in back up power source circuit.
P1605
Knock Control
CPU Malfunction
Engine control computer malfunction (for knock control).
”NC2” Revolution
Sensor Circuit
Malfunction
(Direct Clutch
Speed Sensor)
Output of direct clutch speed sensor (NC2) is 300 rpm or less under
conditions a) and b).
(2 trip detection logic)
a) Vehicle speed: 32 km/h (20 mph) or more
b) Park/neutral position switch: OFF
Linear Solenoid for
Accumulator Pressure
Control Circuit
Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid
Valve SLN)
After the engine is warmed up, the current flow to the shift solenoid valve
SLN is 0.2 A or less for at least 1 sec. under condition a) or b).
(2 trip detection logic)
a) Engine speed: 500 rpm or more
b) Park/neutral position switch: ON (P or N position)
P1705
P1765
Two or more switches are ON simultaneously for ”N”, ”2” and ”L” position.
(2 trip detection logic)
P1780
Park/Neutral
Position Switch
Malfunction
When driving under conditions a) and b)for 30 sec. or more, the
park/neutral position switch is ON (N position).
(2 trip detection logic)
a) Vehicle speed: 70 km/h (44 mph) or more
b) Engine speed: 1,500 – 2,500 rpm
EG2–415
1MZ–FE ENGINE
Trouble Area
–
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
MIL*
Memory
See Page
•
•
•
Open or short in IGF or IGT circuit from igniter to ECM.
Igniter
ECM
EG2–550
•
•
•
Open or short in starter signal circuit.
Open or short in ignition switch or starter relay circuit,
ECM
EG2–557
•
•
Open in back up power source circuit.
ECM
EG2–559
•
ECM
EG2–561
•
•
•
Open or short in direct clutch speed sensor circuit.
Direct clutch speed sensor
ECM
•
•
•
Open or short in shift solenoid valve SLN circuit.
Shift solenoid valve SLN
ECM
AX2–112
•
•
•
Short in park/neutral position switch circuit.
Park/neutral position switch
ECM
EG2–562
*: – . . . . . MIL does not light up
O . . . . MIL lights up
O . . . . MIL lights up, 0/D OFF indicator light blinks
O
AX2–108
EG2–416
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
SAFE CHART
FAIL–SAFE CHART
If any of the following codes is recorded, the ECM enters fail–safe mode.
Fail–Safe Operation
DTC No.
•
•
Fail–safe Deactivation Conditions
Ignition timing fixed at 5 BTDC.
Injection time fixed
Starting ............... 11.0 m sec.
CTP Switch ON ....... 3.5 m sec.
CTP Switch OFF ....... 6.3 m sec.
Returned to normal condition
P0110
Intake air temp. is fixed at 68F (20C).
Returned to normal condition
P0115
Engine coolant temp. is fixed at 176F (80C).
Returned to normal condition
P0100
P0120
P0135
P0141
P0155
P0325
P0330
P0720
P0753
P0758
VTA is fixed at 0.
The following condition must be repeated at least
2 times consecutively.
When closed throttle position switch is ON:
0.1 V VTA 0.95 V
The heater circuit in which an abnormality is
detected is turned off.
Ignition switch OFF
Max. timing retardation.
Ignition switch OFF
Gears are shifted according to the engine rpm and
throttle angle.
Returned to normal condition
Power to the solenoid valve and lock–up solenoid
valve is cut off.
Returned to normal condition
Power to the solenoid valve and lock–up solenoid
valve is cut off.
Returned to normal condition
P0773
Power to the solenoid valve is cut off.
Returned to normal condition
P1300
Fuel cut
IGF signal is detected for 6 consecutive ignitions.
P1605
Max. timing retardation.
Returned to normal condition
P1766
Power to the solenoid valve is cut off.
Returned to normal condition
Back–up Function
If there is trouble with the program in the ECM and ignition signals (IGT) are not output from the
microcomputer, the ECM controls fuel injection and ignition timing at predetermined levels as a back–up
function to make it possible to continue to operate the vehicle.
Furthermore, the injection duration is calculated from the starting signal (STA) and the closed throttle
position switch signal (IDL). Also, the ignition timing is fixed at 5 BTDC, without relation to the engine
speed,
HINT: If the engine is controlled by the back–up function, the malfunction indicator lamp lights up to
warn the driver of the malfunction but the diagnostic trouble code is not output.
EG2–417
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT
PROBLEMS
TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER only
By putting the vehicle’s ECM in check mode, 1 trip detection
logic is possible instead of 2 trip detection logic and sensitivity
to detect open circuits is increased. This makes it easier to
detect intermittent problems.
CLEAR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES
See page EG2–403
SET CHECK MODE
See page EG2–403
PERFORM A SIMULATION TEST
Using the symptom simulation (see page IN–24), shake and
pull lightly on the wire harness, connector or terminals in the
circuit indicated by the malfunction code. In this test, if the
malfunction indicator lamp lights up, it indicates that the place
where the wire harness, connector or terminals being pulled or
shake has faulty contact. Check that point for loose connec–
tions, dirt on the terminals, poor fit or other problems and
repair as necessary.
HINT: After cancelling out the diagnostic trouble code in
memory and setting the check mode, if the malfunction indi–
cator lamp does not go off after the engine is started, check
thoroughly for faulty contacts, etc., then try the check again.
If the malfunction indicator lamp still does not go off, check
and replace the ECM.
EG2–418
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
CONNECTOR CONNECTION AND TERMINAL
INSPECTION
When checking for an open circuit or short circuit, it is impor–
tant to check the connector connection and the condition of
the terminals.
OPEN CIRCUIT:
This could be due to a disconnected wire harness, faulty con–
tact in the connector, a connector terminal pulled out, etc.
HINT:
1. A wire rarely breaks in the middle of it’s length. Most
cases occur at the connector. In particular, carefully
check the connectors of sensors and actuators.
2. Faulty contact could be due to rusting of the connector
terminals, to foreign materials entering the terminals or a
drop in the contact pressure between the male and fe–
male terminals of the connector. Simply disconnecting
and reconnecting the connectors once changes the con–
dition of the connection and may result in a return to
normal operation. Therefore, in troubleshooting, if no
abnormality is found in the wire harness and connector
check, but the problem disappears after the check, them
the cause is considered to be in the wire harness or con–
nectors.
SHORT CIRCUIT:
This could be due to a short circuit between the wire harness
and the body ground or to a short inside the switch, etc.
HINT:
When there is a short between the wire harness and body
ground, check thoroughly whether the wire harness is caught
in the body or is clamped properly.
EG2–419
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
VISUAL CHECK AND CONTACT
PRESSURE CHECK
(a) Disconnect the connectors at both ends.
(b) Check for rust or foreign material, etc. on the terminals of
the connectors.
(c) Check crimped portions for looseness or damage and
check if the terminals are secured in the lock position.
HINT: The terminals should not come out when pulled
lightly.
(d) Prepare a test male terminal and insert it in the female
terminal, then pull it out.
NOTICE: When testing a gold–plated female terminal,
always use a gold–plated male terminal.
HINT: When the test terminal is pulled out more easily
than others, there may be poor contact in that section.
CONNECTOR HANDLING
When inserting tester probes into a connector, insert them
from the rear of the connector. When necessary, use mini test
leads. For water resistant connectors which cannot be ac–
cessed from behind, take good care not to deform the connec–
tor terminals.
EG2–420
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
BASIC INSPECTION
BASIC INSPECTION
When the normal code is displayed in the diagnostic trouble code check, troubleshooting should be
performed in the order for all possible circuits to be considered as the causes of the problems.
In many cases, by carrying out the basic engine check shown in the following flow chart, the location
causing the problem can be found quickly and efficiently. Therefore, use of this check is essential in engine
troubleshooting.
1
Is battery positive voltage 11 V or more when engine is stopped?
YES
2
Charge or replace battery.
Is engine cranked?
Proceed to page ST–47, 63 and continue
to troubleshoot.
YES
3
Does engine start?
YES
4
Go to step
Check air filter.
Remove air filter.
Visually check that the air cleaner element is not
damaged or excessively oily.
If necessary, clean element with compressed air.
First blow from inside thoroughly, then blow from
outside of element.
Repair or replace.
Go to step
EG2–421
1MZ–FE ENGINE
5
–
BASIC INSPECTION
Check idle speed.
(1) Warm up engine to normal operating temper–
ature.
(2) Switch off all accessories.
(3) Switch off air conditioning.
(4) Shift transmission into ”N” position.
(5) Connect the OBDII scan tool or TOYOTA
hand–held tester to data link connector 3 on
the vehicle.
Use CURRENT DATA to check the engine
idle speed.
Idle speed: 650 – 750 rpm
Proceed to matrix chart of problem
symptoms on page EG2–435.
6
Check ignition timing.
(1) Warm up engine to normal operating temper–
ature.
(2) Shift transmission into ”N” position.
(3) Keep the engine speed at idle.
(4) Using SST, connect terminals TE1 and E1 of
data link connector 1.
SST 09843–18020
(5) Using a timing light, connect the tester to
check wire. (See page IG–81)
Check ignition timing.
Ignition timing: 10 BTDC at idle
Proceed to page IG–80 and continue to
troubleshoot.
Proceed to matrix chart of problem symptoms on
page EG2–435.
EG2–422
1MZ–FE ENGINE
7
–
BASIC INSPECTION
Check fuel pressure.
(1) Be sure that enough fuel is in the tank.
(2) Turn ignition switch ON.
(3) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to
data link connector 3 on the vehicle.
(4) Use ACTIVE TEST mode to operate the fuel
pump.
Check that the pulsation damper screw rises up
when the fuel pump operates.
Proceed to page EG2–230 and continue to
troubleshoot.
8
Check for spark.
(1) Remove ignition coil (See page IG–89). .
(2) Remove spark plug.
(3) Install the spark plug to the ignition coil, and
connect the ignition coil connector.
(4) Ground the spark plug.
(5) Disconnect injector connector.
Check if spark occurs while engine is being
cranked.
NOTICE: To prevent excess fuel being injected from
the injectors during this test, don’t crank the
engine for more than 5 –10 seconds at a time.
Proceed to page IG–87 and continue to
troubleshoot.
Proceed to matrix chart of problem systems on
page EG2–435.
EG2–423
1MZ–FE ENGINE
PARTS LOCATION
–
PARTS LOCATION
EG2–424
1MZ–FE ENGINE
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
WIRING DIAGRAM
EG2–425
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
WIRING DIAGRAM
EG2–426
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
TERMINALS OF ECM
TERMINALS OF ECM
When measuring the voltage or resistance of the connector part of the ECM, always insert the test probe
into the connector from the wire harness side.
Terminal
No.
Symbol
Connection
Terminal
No.
E7–15
Symbol
Connection
IG T3
Igniter
IG T2
Igniter
Shift solenoid SLN
Shift Solenoid No.2
Injector (No.6)
Injector (No.5)
Injector (No.4)
Injector ( No.3 )
RSC
IAC valve
Injector (No.2)
RSO
IAC valve
Injector (No.1)
IGT1
Igniter
Shift solenoid No.1
FPU
Fuel pressure up VSV
Igniter
IGT4
Igniter
Starter relay
Park/Neutral position switch
Shift solenoid SL
E03
Oxygen sensor heater ground
EG2–427
1MZ–FE ENGINE
Terminal
No.
Symbol
Connection
–
TERMINALS OF ECM
Terminal
No.
Connection
Symbol
Igniter
Heated oxygen sensor
(Bank 2 Sensor 1)
Igniter
Engine coolant temp. sensor
Intake air temp. sensor
Throttle position sensor
Sensor ground
Power ground
A/C idle–up VSV
Power ground
Throttle position sensor
Malfunction indicator lamp
Data link connector 1
Direct clutch speed sensor
Intake air control valve VSV
Crankshaft position sensor
Mass air fIow meter
Crankshaft position sensor
Throttle position sensor
Mass air flow meter
Heated oxygen sensor heater
(Bank 2 Sensor 1 )
Direct clutch speed sensor
Heated oxygen sensor heater
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
EGR VSV
EG R gas temp. sensor
Heated oxygen sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Knock sensor 2
ECM ground
Knock sensor 1
Camshaft position sensor
Park/Neutral position switch
Camshaft position sensor
Electronically controlled
transmission select switch
Circuit opening relay
EG2–428
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
TERMINALS OF ECM
TERMINALS OF ECM (Cont’d)
Terminal
No.
Connection
Symbol
Terminal
No.
Symbol
Connection
A/C control assembly
0/D main switch
Cruise control ECU
A/C control assembly
Defogger relay
Taillight relay
Park/Neutral position switch
EFI Main relay
EFI Main relay
Vehicle speed sensor
Stop light switch
Stop light
Tachometer
Heated oxygen sensor heater
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
Battery
Heated oxygen sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
Park/Neutral position switch
Data link connector 3
EG2–429
1MZ–FE ENGINE
– MEMO –
–
EG2–430
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
STANDARD VALUE OF ECM TERMINALS
STANDARD VALUE OF ECM TERMINALS
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
STD Voltage (V)
Condition
Always
IG switch ON
IG switch ON
IG switch 0 N
Throttle valve fully closed.
IG switch ON
Throttle valve fully open.
IG switch ON
Throttle valve fully closed.
IG switch O N
Throttle valve fully open.
Idling, P or N Position, A/C switch off.
Idling, Intake air temp. 20C (68F)
Idling, Engine coolant temp. 80C (176F)
Cranking
IG switch 0 N
Pulse generation
(See page
EG2–492)
Idling
Pulse generation
(See page
EG2–556)
Idling
IG switch ON
Pulse generation
(See page
EG2–556)
Pulse generation
(See page
EG2–505)
Pulse generation
(See page
EG2–505)
Idling
Idling
Idling
IG switch ON
Restarting at high engine coolant temp.
Defogger switch and taillight switch ON.
Defogger switch and taillight switch OFF.
IG switch ON
IG switch ON
EG2–431
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
STANDARD VALUE OF ECM TERMINALS
STANDARD VALUE OF ECM TERMINALS (Cont’d)
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
STD Voltage (V)
Condition
IG switch ON
Disconnect (E7)of ECM connector
Idling, A/C switch ON
Idling, A/C switch OFF
Maintain engine speed at 2,500 rpm for
2 mins. after warming up.
Idling
IG switch 0 N
Idling
IG switch ON
Other shift position in ”P”, ”N” position
IG switch ON
Shift position in ”P”, ”N” position
IG switch 0 N
Rotate driving wheel slowly.
IG switch ON
IG switch ON
Idling, A/C switch ON
Idling, A/C switch OFF
Idling, A/C switch ON
Idling, A/C switch OFF
EG2–432
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
ENGINE OPERATING CONDITION
ENGINE OPERATING CONDITION
NOTICE: The values given below for ”Normal Condition” are representative values, so a vehicle may
still be normal even if its value varies from those listed here. So do not decide whether a part
is faulty or not solely according to the ”Normal Condition” here.
CARB Mandated Signals
TOYOTA hand–held
tester display
Measurement Item
Normal Condition
FUEL SYS #1
Fuel System Bank 1
OPEN: Air–fuel ratio feedback stopped
CLOSED: Air–fuel ratio feedback operating
Idling after warning up:
CLOSED
FUEL SYS #2
Fuel System Bank 2
OPEN: Air–fuel ratio feedback stopped
CLOSED: Air–fuel ratio feedback operating
Idling after warning up,
CLOSED
CALC LOAD
Calculator Load:
Current intake air volume as a proportion of max.
intake air volume
Idling: 12.9 – 25.2%
Racing without load (2,500 rpm):
11.7 – 23.9%
COOLANT TEMP
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Value
After warning up:
80 – 95C (176 – 203F)
SHORT FT #1
Short–term Fuel Trim Bank 1
0 ± 20%
LONG FT #1
Long–term Fuel Trim Bank 1
0 ± 20%
SHORT FT #2
Short–term Fuel Trim Bank 2
0 ± 20%
LONG FT #2
Long–term Fuel Trim Bank 2
0 ± 20%
ENGINE SPD
Engine Speed
Idling: 700 ± 50 rpm
VEHICLE SPD
Vehicle Speed
Vehicle Stopped: p km/h
mph
IGN ADVANCE
Ignition Advance
Ignition Timing of Cylinder No.1
Idling: BTDC 12 ±5
INTAKE AIR
Intake Air Temperature Sensor Value
Equivalent to Ambient Temp.
MAF
Air Flow Rate Through Mass Air Flow Meter
Idling: 2.4 – 4.8 gm/sec
Racing without load (2,500 rpm):
7.9 –.– 16.2 gm/sec
THROTTLE POS
Voltage Output of Throttle Position Sensor
Calculated as a Percentage
0 V→ 0%, 5 V → 100%
Throttle
Fully Closed: 7 – 11%
Fully Open: 65 – 75%
02S B1, S1
Voltage Output of Oxygen Sensor
Bank 1, Sensor 1
Idling: 0.1 – 0.9 V
If no conditions are specifically stated for ”Idling”, it means the shift lever is at N or P position, the A/C
switch is OFF and all accessory switches are OFF.
EG2–433
1MZ–FE ENGINE
TOYOTA hand–held
tester display
–
ENGINE OPERATING CONDITION
Measurement Item
Normal Condition
O2FT B1, S1
Oxygen Sensor Fuel Trim Bank 1, Sensor 1
(Same as SHORT FT #1)
O2S B1, S2
Voltage Output of Oxygen Sensor
Bank 1, Sensor 2
Driving (50 km/h, 31 mph):
0.1 – 0.9 V
O2S B2, S1
Voltage Output of Oxygen Sensor
Bank 2, Sensor 1
Idling: 0.1 – 0.9 V
O2FT B2, S1
Oxygen Sensor Fuel Trim Bank 2, Sensor 1
(Same as SHORT FT #2)
0 ± 20%
0 ± 20%
TOYOTA Enhanced Signals
TOYOTA hand–held
tester display
Measurement Item
Normal Condition
MISFIRE RPM
Engine RPM for first misfire range
Misfire 0: 0 RPM
MISFIRE LOAD
Engine load for first misfire range
Misfire 0: 0 g/r
INJECTOR
Fuel injection time for cylinder No.1
Idling: 2.2 – 5.1 ms
IAC DUTY RATIO
Intake Air Control Valve Duty Ratio
Opening ratio rotary solenoid type IAC valve
Idling: 30 – 40%
STARTER SIG
Starter Signal
Cranking: ON
CTP SW
Closed Throttle Position Switch Signal
Throttle Fully Closed: ON
A/C SIG
A/C Switch Signal
A/C ON: ON
PNP SW
Park/Neutral Position Switch Signal
P or N position: ON
ELCTRCL LOAD SIG
Electrical Load Signal
Defogger S/W ON: ON
STOP LIGHT SW
Stop Light Switch Signal
Stop light switch ON: ON
FC IDL
Fuel Cut Idle: Fuel cut when throttle valve fully
closed, during deceleration
Fuel cut operating: ON
FC TAU
Fuel Cut TAU: Fuel cut during very light load
Fuel cut operating: ON
CYL #1
CY L #6
Ratio of revolution variation for each cylinder
when variation is large
IGNITION
Ignition rate for all cylinders every
1,000 revolutions
EGRT GAS
EGR Gas Temperature Sensor Value
EG R not operating:
Temperature between intake air
temp. and engine coolant temp.
INTAKE CTRL VSV
Intake Air Control Valve VSV Signal
VSV operating: ON
EGR SYSTEM
EG R system operating condition
Idling: OFF
FUEL PRES UP VSV
Fuel Pressure Up VSV Signal
High temp. restarting: ON
A/C CUT SIG
A/C Cut Signal
A/C S/W OFF: ON
A/C IDLE U P VSV
A/C Idle Up Signal
A/C S/W ON & D position
& headlight ON: ON
0 – 3,000
EG2–434
1MZ–FE ENGINE
TOYOTA hand–held
tester display
–
ENGINE OPERATING CONDITION
Measurement Item
Normal Condition
TOTAL FT B1
Total Fuel Trim Bank 1: Average value for fuel
trim system of bank 1
Idling: 0.8 – 1.2
TOTAL FT B2
Total Fuel Trim Bank 2: Average value for fuel
trim system of bank 2
Idling: 0.8 – 1.2
02 LR B1, S1
Oxygen Sensor Lean Rich Bank 1, Sensor 1
Response time for oxygen sensor output to switch
from lean to rich.
Idling after warned up:
0 – 1,000 m sec.
02 LR B2, S1
Oxygen Sensor Lean Rich Bank 2, Sensor 1
Response time for oxygen sensor output to switch
from lean to rich.
Idling after warned up:
0 – 1,000 msec.
02 RL B1, S1
Oxygen Sensor Rich Lean Bank 1, Sensor 1
Response time for oxygen sensor output to switch
from rich to lean.
Idling after warned up:
0 – 1,000 msec.
02 RL B2, S1
Oxygen Sensor Rich Lean Bank 2, Sensor 1
Response time for oxygen sensor output to switch
from rich to lean.
Idling after warned up:
0 – 1,000 msec.
*; If no conditions are specifically stated for ”Idling”, it means the shift lever is at Nor P position, the A/C
switch is OFF and all accessory switches are OFF.
EG2–435
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
MATRIX CHART OF PROBLEM SYMPTOMS
MATRIX CHART OF PROBLEM SYMPTOMS
Does not
start
Engine does not crank
No initial combustion
No complete combustion
Difficult to
start
Under normal condition
Cold engine
Hot engine
High engine idle speed
Engine
stall
Poor
Drive–
ability
Poor Idling
Low engine idle speed
Rough idling
Hunting
Hesitation/Poor acceleration
Surging
Soon after starting
During A/C operation
AX2–81
IN–36
Engine control module
(ECM)
EG2–36
A/T faulty
Compression
AC–36
ST–47, 63
Starter and Starter relay
EG2–586
Fuel pressure control VSV circuit
Fuel pump control circuit
ECM power source circuit
Symptom
Starter signal circuit
Suspect area
A/C signal circuit (Compressor circuit)
EG2–575
See page
EG2–565
EG2–557
When the malfunction code is not confirmed in the diagnostic trouble code check and the problem still can
not be confirmed in the basic inspection, then proceed to this step and perform troubleshooting according
to the numbered order given in the table below.
EG2–436
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
LOCATION OF CONNECTORS
LOCATION OF CONNECTORS
Location of Connectors in Engine Compartment
C17
Camshaft
Position Sensor
Engine Coolant Temp.
Sensor
C18
Crankshaft
Position Sensor
Heated Oxygen
Sensor
( Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Data Link Connector 1
Heated Oxygen
Sensor
(Bank 2 Sensor 1)
EGR Gas
Temp. Sensor
Idle Air Control
Valve
EG2–437
1MZ–FE ENGINE
ign¿ter
Injector No.4
Ignition Coil
No.1
Ignition Coil
No.6
Park/Neutral Position
Switch
–
Injector No.1
LOCATION OF CONNECTORS
Injector No.2¿
Ignition Coil
No.4
Ignition Coil
No.3
Ignition Coil
No.2
Knock Sensor 1
Starter
Igniter
Injector No.6
Injector No.5
Injector No.3
Knock Sensor 2
Throttle Position
Sensor
Ignition Coil
No.3
Mass Air Flow Meter
VSV (for A/C
Idle Up)
EG2–438
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
LOCATION OF CONNECTORS
Location of Connectors in Engine Compartment (Cont’d)
EG2–439
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
LOCATION OF CONNECTORS
Location of Connectors in Instrument Panel
A/C Amplifier
Engine Control Module
Data Link Connector 2
Data Link Connector 3
Engine Control Module Engine Control Module Engine Control Module
EG2–440
1MZ–FE ENGINE
Heated Oxygen
Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
Ignition Switch
–
LOCATION OF CONNECTORS
EG2–441
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
LOCATION OF CONNECTORS
Location of Connectors in Instrument Panel (Cont’d)
EG2–442
1MZ–FE ENGINE
Location of Connectors in Body
–
LOCATION OF CONNECTORS
EG2–443
1MZ–FE ENGINE
Wagon
Fuel Pump
–
LOCATION OF CONNECTORS
EG2–444
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC P0100 Mass Air Flow Circuit Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The mass air flow meter uses a platinum hot wire. The
hot wire air flow meter consists of a platinum hot
wire, thermistor and a control circuit installed in a
plastic housing. The hot wire air flow meter works on
the principle that the hot wire and thermistor located
in the intake air bypass of the housing detect any
changes in the intake air temperature.
The hot wire is maintained at the set temperature by
controlling the current flow through the hot wire.
This current flow is then measured as the output
voltage of the air flow meter.
The circuit is constructed so that the platinum hot
wire and thermistor provide a bridge circuit, with the
power transistor controlled so that the potential of
(A) and (B) remains equal to maintain the set tem–
perature.
DTC No.
P0l00
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Open or short in mass air flow meter circuit with
engine speed 4,000 rpm or less.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Open or short in mass air flow meter circuit
Mass air flow meter
ECM
If the ECM detects diagnostic trouble code ”P01 00” it operates the fail safe function, keeping the ignition
timing and injection volume constant and making it possible to drive the vehicle.
EG2–445
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
HINT: After confirming DTC P01 00 use the OBDll scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to confirm the
mass air flow ratio from ”CURRENT DATA”.
Mass Air Flow Value (gm/sec.)
Malfunction
0.0
•
•
+ B circuit open
VG circuit open or short
271.0 or more
•
VG– circuit open
WIRING DIAGRAM
EG2–446
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
1
Connect the OBDII scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held
tester, and read value of mass air flow rate.
Type
II
Go to step
Type
I
2
3
4
Check voltage of mass air flow meter power source.
Check for open in harness and connector
between EFI main relay and mass air flow
meter.
Check voltage between terminal VG and body
ground.
Check and replace ECM.
Check for open and short in harness and connector
between mass air flow meter and ECM.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Replace mass air flow meter.
5
Check continuity between terminal VG– and body
ground.
Check and replace ECM.
6
Check for open in harness and connector between
mass air flow meter and ECM.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Replace mass air flow meter.
EG2–447
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Connect the OBDII scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester, and read
value of mass air flow rate.
(1) Remove the fuse cover on the instrument
panel.
(2) Connect the OBDII scan tool or TOYOTA
hand–held tester to the DLC 3.
(3) Turn ignition switch ON and OBDII scan tool
or TOYOTA hand–held tester main switch
ON.
(4) Start the engine.
Read mass air flow rate on the OBDII scan
tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
Mass air flow rate
Type
I
2
Type
II
Type I
0.0 gm/sec.
TypeII
271.0 gm/sec. or more
Go to step
Check voltage of mass air flow meter power source.
(1) Disconnect the mass air flow meter connec–
tor.
(2) Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminal 1 of mass air
flow meter connector and body ground.
Voltage: 9 –14 V
Check for open in harness and connector
between EFI main relay and mass air flow
meter (See page IN–31).
EG2–448
1MZ–FE ENGINE
3
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check voltage between terminal VG of ECM and body ground.
(1) Remove glove compartment.
(See page EG2–309)
(2) Start the engine.
Measure voltage between terminal VG of ECM and
body ground while engine is idling.
Voltage: 1.1 – 1.5 V
(P position and A/C switch OFF)
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
4
Check for open and short in harness and connector between mass
air flow meter and ECM (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Replace mass air flow meter.
EG2–449
1MZ–FE ENGINE
5
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check continuity between terminal VG of ECM and body ground.
Remove glove compartment (See page EG2–309).
Check continuity between terminal VG– of ECM
and body ground.
Continuity (1 or less)
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
6
Check for– open in harness and connector between mass air flow
meter– and ECM (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Replace mass air flow meter.
EG2–450
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC P0101 Mass Air Flow Circuit Range Performance
Problem
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to mass air flow circuit malfunction on page EG2–444.
DTC No.
P0101
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Conditions a) and b) continue with engine speed
900 rpm or less.
(2 trip detection logic)
a) Closed throttle position switch: ON
b) Mass air flow meter output ) 2.2 V
•
Mass air flow meter
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to mass air flow circuit malfunction on page EG2–445.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
1
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P0101)
being output?
Replace mass air flow meter.
YES
Go to relevant diagnostic trouble code
chart.
EG2–451
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC P0110 Intake Air Temp Circuit Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The intake air temp. sensor is built into the air flow meter and
senses the intake air temperature.
A thermistor built in the sensor changes the resistance value
according to the intake air temperature.
The lower the intake air temperature, the greater the thermistor
resistance value, and the higher the intake air temperature, the
lower the thermistor resistance value (See Fig. 1.).
The intake air temperature sensor is connected to the ECM
(See next page). The 5V power source voltage in the ECM is
applied to the intake air temperature sensor from the terminal
THA via a resistor R.
That is, the resistor R and the intake air temperature sensor are
connected in series. When the resistance value of the intake air
temperature sensor changes in accordance with changes in
the intake air temperature, the potential at terminal THA also
changes. Based on this–signal, the ECM increases the fuel
injection volume to improve driveability during cold engine
operation.
(Reference )
If the ECM records the diagnostic trouble code ”P0110”, it
Intake Air Temp.
°C (° F)
operates the fail safe function in which the intake temperature
is assumed to be 20C (68F). Intake Air Ter
DTC No.
P0110
Voltage
M
Trouble Area
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Open or short in intake air temp. sensor circuit.
Resistance
(k)
•
•
•
Open or short in intake air temp. sensor circuit.
Intake air temp. sensor
ECM
Hint; After confirming DTC P01 10 use the OBDII scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to confirm the
intake air temperature from ”CURRENT DATA”.
Temperature Displayed
Malfunction
– 40C (–40F)
Open circuit
120C (248F) or more
Short circuit
EG2–452
1MZ–FE ENGINE
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
EG2–453
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
HINT; If diagnostic trouble codes ”P0110” (intake air temp. circuit malfunction), ”P0115” (engine
coolant temp. circuit malfunction), ”P0120” (throttle position circuit malfunction) are output
simultaneously, E2 (sensor ground) may be open.
1
Connect the OBDII scan tool or TOYOTA hand–
held tester and read value of intake air temp.
– 40C (– 40F) ......... Go to step
120C (248F) or more .. Go to step
Check for intermittent problems.
2
3
Check for open in harness or ECM.
Confirm good connection at sensor.
If OK, replace mass air flow meter.
Check for open in harness or ECM.
Open in harness between ECM and intake
air temp. sensor.
Confirm good connection at ECM. If OK, replace ECM.
4
5
Check for short in harness and ECM.
Replace mass air flow meter.
Check for short in harness or ECM.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECM.
EG2–454
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT: If diagnostic trouble codes ”P0110” (intake air temp. circuit malfunction), ”P0115” (engine
coolant temp. circuit malfunction), ”P0120” (throttle position circuit malfunction) are output
simultaneously, E2 (sensor ground) may be open.
1
Connect the OBDII scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester, and read
value of intake air temperature.
(1) Remove the fuse cover on the instrument
panel.
(2) Connect the OBDII scan tool or TOYOTA
hand–held tester to the DLC 3.
(3) Turn ignition switch ON and OBDII scan tool
or TOYOTA hand–held tester main switch
ON.
Read temperature value on the OBDII scan tool or
TOYOTA hand–held tester.
Same as actual intake air temperature.
If there is open circuit, OBDII scan tool or
TOYOTA hand–held tester indicates – 40C
(– 40 F).
If there is short circuit, OBDII scan tool or
TOYOTA hand–held tester indicates 120C
(248F) or more.
– 40C (– 40 F) ........... Go to step
120 C (248F) or more ... Go to step
Check for intermittent problems.
(See page EG2–417)
EG2–455
1MZ–FE ENGINE
2
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check for open in harness or ECM.
(1) Disconnect the mass air flow meter connec–
tor.
(2) Connect sensor wire harness terminals to–
gether.
(3) Turn ignition switch ON.
Read temperature value on the OBDll scan tool or
TOYOTA hand–held tester.
Temperature value: 120C (248F) or more
Confirm good connection at sensor.
If OK, replace mass air flow meter.
3
Check for open in harness or ECM.
(1) Remove glove compartment.
(See page EG2–309)
(2) Connect between terminals THA and E2 of
ECM E8 connector.
HINT: Mass air flow meter connector is disconnected.
Before checking, do a visual and contact pres–
sure check for the ECM connector. (See page
EG2–418)
(3) Turn ignition switch ON.
Read temperature value on the OBDII scan tool or
TOYOTA hand–held tester.
Temperature value: 120C (248F) or more
Open in harness between terminals E2 or
THA, repair or replace harness.
Confirm good connection at ECM.
If OK, replace ECM..
EG2–456
1MZ–FE ENGINE
4
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check for short in harness and ECM.
(1) Disconnect the mass air flow meter connec–
tor.
(2) Turn ignition switch ON.
Read temperature value on the 0BDII scan tool or
TOYOTA hand–held tester.
Temperature value: – 40C (– 40F).
Replace mass air flow meter.
5
Check for short in harness or ECM.
(1) Remove glove compartment.
(See page EG2–309)
(2) Disconnect the E8 connector of ECM.
HINT: Mass air flow meter connector is disconnected.
(3) Turn ignition switch ON.
Read temperature value on the OBDll scan tool or
TOYOTA hand–held tester.
Temperature value: –40C (–40F)
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
EG2–457
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC P0115 Engine Coolant Temp Circuit Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
A thermistor built into the engine coolant temperature sensor changes the resistance value according to
the coolant temperature.
The structure of the sensor and connection to the ECM is the same as in the intake air temp. circuit
malfunction shown on page EG2–451.
If the ECM records the diagnostic trouble code P01 15, it operates the fail safe function, keeping the engine
coolant temp. at a constant 80C (176F).
DTC No.
Trouble Area
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
•
P0115
Open or short in engine coolant temp. sensor
circuit.
•
•
Open or short in engine coolant temp. sensor
circuit.
Engine coolant temp. sensor.
ECM
HINT: After confirming DTC P01 15 use the OBDll scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to confirm the
engine coolant temperature from ”CURRENT DATA”.
Temperature Displayed Malfunction
– 40C (– 40F)
Open circuit
120C (248F) or more
Short circuit
WIRING DIAGRAM
EG2–458
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
HINT: If diagnostic trouble codes ”P0110” (intake air temp. circuit malfunction), ”P0115” (engine
coolant temp. circuit malfunction) and ”P0120” (throttle position circuit malfunction) are output
simultaneously, E2 (sensor ground) may be open.
1
Connect the OBDII scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held
tester and read value of engine coolant temp.
– 40C (– 40F) ......... Go to step
120C (248F) or more .. Go to step
Check for intermittent problems.
2
Check for open in harness or ECM.
Confirm good connection at sensor.
If OK, replace engine coolant temp. sensor.
3
Check for open in harness or ECM.
Open in harness between ECM and engine
coolant temp. sensor.
Confirm connection at ECM. If OK, replace ECM.
4
Check for short in harness and ECM.
Replace engine coolant temp. sensor.
5
Check for short in harness or ECM.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECM.
EG2–459
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT; If diagnostic trouble codes ”P0110” (intake air temp. circuit malfunction), ”P0115” (engine
coolant temp. circuit malfunction), ”P0120” (throttle position circuit malfunction) are output
simultaneously, E2 (sensor ground) may be open.
1
Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester, and read
value of engine coolant temperature.
(1) Remove the fuse cover on the instrument
panel.
(2) Connect the 0BDII scan tool or TOYOTA
hand–held tester to the DLC 3.
(3) Turn ignition switch ON and OBDII scan tool
or TOYOTA hand–held tester main switch
ON.
Read temperature value on the OBDII scan tool or
TOYOTA hand–held tester.
Same as actual engine coolant temperature.
If there is open circuit, OBD II scan tool or
TOYOTA hand–held tester indicates – 40C
(– 40 F).
If there is short circuit, OBD II scan tool or
TOYOTA hand–held tester indicates 120C
(248F) or more.
– 40C (– 40F) .......... Go to step
120 C (248F) or more . . Go to step
Check for intermittent problems.
(See page EG2–417)
2
3
EG2–460
1MZ–FE ENGINE
2
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check for open in harness or ECM.
(1) Disconnect the engine coolant temp. sensor
connector.
(2) Connect sensor wire harness terminals to–
gether.
(3) Turn ignition switch ON.
Read temperature value on the OBDII scan tool or
TOYOTA hand–held tester.
Temperature value: 120C (248F) or more
Confirm good connection at sensor. If OK,
replace engine coolant temp. sensor.
3
Check for open in harness or ECM.
(1) Remove glove compartment.
(See page EG2–309)
(2) Connect between terminals THW and E2 of
ECM E8 connector.
HINT: Engine coolant temp. sensor connector is dis–
connected. Before checking, do a visual and
contact pressure check for the ECM connector.
(See page EG2–418)
(3) Turn ignition switch ON.
Read temperature value on the OBDII scan tool or
TOYOTA hand–held tester.
Temperature value: 120C (248F) or more
Open in harness between terminals E2 or
THW, repair or replace harness.
Confirm good connection at ECM.
If OK, replace ECM .
EG2–461
1MZ–FE ENGINE
4
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check for short in harness and ECM.
(1) Disconnect the engine coolant temp. sensor
connector.
(2) Turn ignition switch ON.
Read temperature value on the OBDII scan tool or
TOYOTA hand–held tester.
Temperature value: – 40C (– 40F)
Replace engine coolant temp. sensor.
5
Check for short in harness or ECM.
(1) Remove glove compartment.
(See page EG2–309)
(2) Disconnect the E8 connector of ECM.
HINT: Engine coolant temp. sensor connector is dis–
connected.
(3) Turn ignition switch ON.
Read temperature value on the OBDII scan tool or
TOYOTA hand–held tester.
Temperature value: –40C (–40F)
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
EG2–462
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC P0116 Engine Coolant Temp Circuit Range Performance
Problem
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to engine coolant temp. circuit malfunction on page EG2–457.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
P0116
20 min. or more after starting engine, engine
coolant temp. sensor value is 30C (86F) or less.
(2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
•
•
Engine coolant temp. sensor.
Cooling system.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
HINT: If diagnostic trouble codes ”P0115” (engine coolant temp. circuit malfunction) and ”P0116”
(engine coolant temp. circuit range/ performance) are output simultaneously, engine coolant
temp. sensor circuit may be open.
Perform troubleshooting of diagnostic trouble code P0115 first.
1
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P0116)
being output?
Replace engine coolant temp. sensor. (See page EG2–282)
YES
Go to relevant diagnostic trouble code
chart.
EG2–463
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC P0120 Throttle Position Circuit Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The throttle position sensor is mounted in the throttle body
and detects the throttle valve opening angle. When the throt–
tle valve is fully closed, the IDL contacts in the throttle posi–
tion sensor are on, so the voltage at the terminal IDL of the
ECM becomes 0V. At this time, a voltage of approximately 0.7
V is applied to terminal VTA of the ECM. When the throttle
valve is opened, the IDL contacts go off and thus the power
source voltage of approximately 12 V in the ECM is applied to
the terminal IDL of the ECM. The voltage applied to the termi–
nal VTA of the ECM increases in proportion to the opening
angle of the throttle valve and becomes approximately 3.5 –
5.0 V when the throttle valve is fully opened. The ECM judges
the vehicle driving conditions from these signals input from
terminals VTA and IDL, and uses them as one of the condi–
thins for deciding the air–fuel ratio correction, power increases
correction and fuel–cut control etc.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
DTC No.
P0120
Condition a) or b) continues.
a) VTA ( 0.1 V, and closed throttle position
switch is OFF.
b ) VTA ) 4.9 V
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Open or short in throttle position sensor circuit.
Throttle position sensor.
ECM
HINT:
• If there is open circuit in IDL line, diagnostic trouble code P0120 does not indicate,
• After confirming DTC P0120 use the OBDll scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to confirm
the throttle valve opening percentage and closed throttle position switch condition.
Throttle valve opening position
expressed as percentage
Trouble Area
Throttle valve
fully closed
Throttle valve
fully open
VC line open
VTA line open or short
0%
Approx. 99%
Approx. 100%
E2 line open
EG2–464
1MZ–FE ENGINE
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
EG2–465
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
HINT: If diagnostic trouble codes P0110, P01 15 and P0120 are output simultaneously, E2 (sensor
ground) may be open.
TOYOTA hand–held tester
Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester and read
the throttle valve opening percentage.
Check for intermittent problems.
Read closed throttle position switch condition.
G o to step
Check voltage of terminal VC.
Go to step
Check throttle position sensor.
Replace throttle position sensor.
Check voltage of terminal VTA and E2 of ECM.
Check for open and short in harness and
connector between ECM and throttle
position sensor (VTA line).
Check and replace ECM.
Check voltage of terminal VC and E2 of ECM.
Check for open in harness and connector between ECM and
sensor (VC line).
Check and replace ECM.
EG2–466
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
OBDII scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
Connect the OBDII scan tool and read the throttle
valve opening percentage.
Check for intermittent problems.
Check voltage of terminal IDL and E2 of ECM.
Go to step
Check voltage of terminal VC on wire harness side
connector.
G o to step
Check throttle position sensor.
Replace throttle position sensor.
Check voltage of terminal VTA and E2 of ECM.
Check for open and short in harness and
connector between ECM and throttle
position sensor (VTA line).
Check and replace ECM.
Check voltage of terminal VC and E2 of ECM.
Check for open in harness and connector between ECM
and sensor (VC line).
Check and replace ECM.
EG2–467
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
TOYOTA hand–held tester
HINT: If diagnostic trouble codes P01 10, P01 15 and P0120 are output simultaneously, E2 (sensor
ground) may be open.
Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester and read the throttle valve
opening percentage.
(1) Remove the fuse cover on the instrument
panel.
(2) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the
DLC 3.
(3) Turn ignition switch ON and TOYOTA hand–
held tester main switch ON.
Read the throttle valve opening percentage.
Throttle valve
Throttle valve opening
position expressed as
percentage
Fully open
Approx. 70%
Fully closed
Approx. 10%
Check for intermittent problems
(See page EG2–417).
Read closed throttle position switch condition.
(1) Remove the fuse cover on the instrument
panel.
(2) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the
DLC 3.
(3) Turn ignition switch ON and TOYOTA hand–
held tester main switch ON.
Read closed throttle position switch condition.
Throttle valve
Closed throttle position
switch condition
Fully open
OFF
Fully closed
Go to step
EG2–468
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check voltage between terminal VC of wire harness side connector
and body ground.
(1) Disconnect the throttle position sensor con–
nector.
(2) Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminal VC of wire har–
ness side connector and body ground.
Voltage: 4.5 – 5.5 V
Go to step
Check throttle position sensor.
Disconnect the throttle position sensor connector.
Measure resistance between terminals 4, 3 and 1
of throttle position sensor.
Terminals
Throttle valve
1 –4
1 –3
Resistance
4.25 – 8.25 k
Fully closed
0.3 – 6.3 k
Fully open
3.5 – 10.3 k
Replace throttle position sensor.
EG2–469
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check voltage between terminals VTA and E2 of ECM.
(1) Remove glove compartment.
(See page EG2–309)
(2) Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminals VTA and E2 of
ECM.
Throttle Valve
Voltage
Fully closed
0.3 – 0.8 V
Fully open
2.7 – 5.2 V
Check for open and short in harness and
connector between ECM and throttle position sensor (VTA line) (See page IN–31).
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
Check voltage between terminals VC and E2 of ECM.
(1) Remove glove compartment.
(See page EG2–309)
(2) Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminals VC and E2 of
engine control module connector.
Voltage: 4.5 – 5.5 V
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
Check for open in harness and connector between
ECM and sensor (VC line) (See page IN–31).
EG2–470
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
HINT: If diagnostic trouble codes P0110, P0115, and P0120 are output simultaneously, E2 (sensor
ground) may be open.
Connect the OBD II scan tool and read the throttle valve opening
percentage (See page EG2–467, step 1 ).
Check for intermittent problems.
(See page EG2–417)
Check voltage of terminal IDL and E2 of ECM.
(1) Remove glove compartment.
(See page EG2–309)
(2) Turn ignition Switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminals IDL and E2 of
ECM.
Throttle Valve
Voltage
Fully closed
0 – 3.0 V
Fully open
9–14V
Go to step
Check voltage between terminal VC of wire harness side connector
and body ground (See page EG2–468, step 3).
Go to step
Check throttle position sensor (See page EG2–468, step 4).
Replace throttle position sensor.
EG2–471
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check voltage between terminals VTA and E2 of ECM
(See page EG2–469, step 5).
Check for open and short in harness and
connector between ECM and throttle
position sensor (VTA line)
(See page IN–31).
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
Check voltage terminals VC and E2 of ECM
(Seepage EG2–469, step 6).
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
Check for open in harness and connector between
ECM and sensor (VC line) (See page IN–31).
EG2–472
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC P0121 Throttle Position Circuit Range Performance
Problem
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to throttle position circuit malfunction on page EG2–463.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
P0121
When closed throttle position switch is ON,
condition a) continues.
(2 trip detection logic)
a ) VTA ) 2.0 V
Trouble Area
•
Throttle position sensor.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P0121)
being output?
Replace throttle position sensor.
YES
Go to relevant diagnostic trouble code
chart.
EG2–473
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC P0125 Insufficient Coolant Temp for Closed
Loop Fuel Control
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
To obtain a high purification rate for the C0, HC and NOx components of the exhaust gas, a three–way
catalytic converter is used, but for the most efficient use of the three–way catalytic converter, the air–fuel
ratio must be precisely controlled so that it is always close to the stoichiometric air–fuel ratio.
The oxygen sensor has the characteristic whereby its output voltage changes suddenly in the vicinity of
the stoichiometric air–fuel ratio. This characteristic is used to detect the oxygen concentration in the
exhaust gas and provide feedback to the computer for control of the air–fuel ratio.
When the air–fuel ratio becomes LEAN, the oxygen concentration in the exhaust increases and the oxygen
sensor informs the ECM of the LEAN condition (small electromotive force: 0 V).
When the air–fuel ratio is RICHER than the stoichiometric air–fuel ratio the oxygen concentration in the
exhaust gas is reduced and the oxygen sensor informs the ECM of the RICH condition (large electromotive
force:1V)
The EMC judges by the electromotive force from the oxygen sensor whether the air–fuel ration is RICH or
LEAN and controls the injection time accordingly. However, if malfunction of the oxygen sensor causes output of abnormal electromotive force, the EMC is unable to perform accurate air–fuel ration control.
The main heated oxygen sensors include a heater which heats the Zirconia element. The heater is controlled
by the EMC. When the intake air volume is low (the temperature of the exhaust gas is low) current flows
to the heater to heat the sensor for accurate oxygen concentration detection.
DTC No.
P0125
Trouble Area
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
After the engine is warmed up, heated oxygen
sensor output does not indicate RICH even once
when conditions a) and b) continue for at least
2 minutes.
a) Engine speed: 1,500 rpm or more
b) Vehicle speed: 40 km/h (25 mph) or more
•
•
Open or short in heated oxygen sensor circuit.
Heated oxygen sensor.
HINT: After confirming DTC P0125 use the 0BDll scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to confirm
voltage output of heated oxygen sensor from current data.
If voltage output of heated oxygen sensor is 0 V, heated oxygen sensor circuit may be open or
short.
EG2–474
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Connect the OBDll scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held
tester and read value for voltage output of heated
oxygen sensor.
Check and replace ECM.
Check for open and short in harness and connector
between ECM and heated oxygen sensor.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Replace heated oxygen sensor.
WIRING DIAGRAM
EG2–475
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Connect the OBDII scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester and
read value for voltage output of heated oxygen sensor.
(1 ) Remove the fuse cover on the instrument
panel.
(2) Connect the OBDll scan tool or TOYOTA
hand–held tester to the DLC 3.
(3) Warm up engine to normal operating temper–
ature.
Read voltage output of heated oxygen sensor
(bank 1,2 sensor 1) when engine is suddenly
raced.
Perform quick racing to 4,000 rpm three times us–
ing accelerator pedal.
Both heated oxygen sensors [(bank 1 sensor 1)
(bank 2 sensor 1)] output a RICH signal (0.45 V
or more) at least once.
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM
and heated oxygen sensor (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Replace heated oxygen sensor.
EG2–476
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC P0130 P0150 Heated Oxygen Sensor Circuit Malfunction
(Bank 1 Sensor 1 Bank 2 Sensor 1)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to ”Insufficient coolant temp. for closed loop fuel control” on page EG2–473.
DTC No.
P0130
P0150
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Voltage output of heated oxygen sensor remains
at 0,4 V or more, or 0,55 V or less, during idling
after the engine is warmed up.
(2trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
•
•
Heated oxygen sensor
Fuel trim malfunction
H I NT: Bank 1 refers to the bank that includes cylinder No.1.
Bank 2 refers to the bank that does not include cylinder No,1.
Sensor 1 refers to the sensor closer to the engine body.
The heated oxygen sensor’s output voltage and the short–term
fuel trim value can be read using the OBDll scan tool or TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
EG2–477
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
(1)Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC 3.
(2)Switch the TOYOTA hand–held tester from normal mode to check mode (See page EG2–403).
(3) Start the engine and warm it up with all accessory switches OFF.
(4) After the engine is warmed up, drive at 50 – 65 km/h (31 – 40 mph) for 1 – 3 minutes to warm
up the heated oxygen sensor.
(5) After driving let the engine idle for 1 minute.
HINT: If a malfunction exists, the MIL will light up during step (5) .
NOTICE: If the conditions in this test are not strictly followed, detection of the malfunction will not
be possible.
If you do not hove a TOYOTA hand–held tester, turn the ignition switch OFF after perform–
ing steps (3) to (5), then perform steps (3) to (5) again.
EG2–478
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check for open and short in harness and connector
between ECM and heated oxygen sensor.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check heated oxygen sensor data.
Check fuel trim system.
Check output voltage of heated oxygen sensor.
Perform confirmation driving pattern.
Replace heated oxygen sensor.
WIRING DIAGRAM
EG2–479
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM and heated
oxygen sensor (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check for heated oxygen sensor data.
(1) Remove the fuse cover on the instrument
panel.
(2) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA
hand–held tester to the DLC 3.
(3) Warm up engine to normal operating
temperature.
Read the heated oxygen sensor output voltage and
short–term fuel trim.
Read the values for the same bank.
Pattern
Heated oxygen
sensor output voltage
Short–term
fuel trim
Lean condition
(Changes at 0.55 V or less)
Changes at
about +20%
Rich condition
(Changes at 0.4 V or more)
Changes at
about –20%
Except (1) and (2)
(1),(2)
Check fuel trim system.
(See page EG2–486).
Check the output voltage of heated oxygen sensor during idling.
Warm up the heated oxygen sensor with the engine
at 2,500 rpm for approx. 90 sec.
Use the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held
tester read the output voltage of the heated ox–
ygen sensor during idling.
Heated oxygen sensor output voltage:
Alternates repeatedly between less than 0.4 V
and more than 0.55 V (See the adjacent table).
Perform confirmation driving pattern.
(See page EG2–477).
Replace heated oxygen sensor.
EG2–480
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC P0133 P0153 Heated Oxygen Sensor Circuit Slow
Response (Bank 1 Sensor 1 Bank 2 Sensor 1)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to ”Insufficient coolant temp. for closed loop fuel control” on page EG2–473.
DTC No.
P0133
P0153
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Response time for the heated oxygen sensor’s
voltage output to change from rich to lean, or from
lean to rich, is 1 sec. or more during idling after
the engine is warmed up.
(2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
•
Heated oxygen sensor
HINT: Bank 1 refers to the bank that includes cylinder No.1.
Bank 2 refers to the bank that does not include cylinder No.1.
Sensor 1 refers to the sensor closer to the engine body.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P0133,
P0153) being output?
Replace heated oxygen sensor.
YES
Go to relevant diagnostic trouble code
chart.
EG2–481
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC P0135 P0141 P0155 Heated Oxygen Sensor Heater
Circuit Malfunction
(Bank 1 Sensor 1 – Bank 1 Sensor 2 – Bank 2 Sensor 1)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to ”Insufficient coolant temp. for closed loop fuel control” on page EG2–473.
DTC No.
P0135
P0141
P0155
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
When the heater operates, heater current exceeds 2 A
or voltage drop for the heater circuit exceeds 5 V.
(2 trip detection logic)
Heater current of 0.25 A or less when the heater
operates.
(2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Open or short in heater circuit of heated oxygen
sensor.
Heated oxygen sensor heater
ECM
H I NT: Bank 1 refers to the bank that includes cylinder No.1.
Bank 2 refers to the bank that does not include cylinder No.1.
Sensor 1 refers to the sensor closer to the engine body.
Sensor 2 refers to the sensor farther away from the engine body.
EG2–482
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage of terminals HTR, HTS, HTL.
Check and replace ECM.
Check resistance of heated oxygen sensor heater.
Replace heated oxygen sensor.
Check and repair harness or connector between main relay
and heated oxygen sensor and ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
EG2–483
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminals HTR, HTS, HTL of ECM
connector and body ground.
(1) Remove glove compartment
(See page EG2–309).
(2) Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminals HTR, HTS,
HTL of ECM connector and body ground.
Connect terminal HTR to bank 1 sensor 1.
Connect terminal HTS to bank 1 sensor 2.
Connect terminal HTL to. bank 2 sensor 1.
Voltage: 9 –14 V
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
Check resistance of heated oxygen sensor heater.
Disconnect heated oxygen sensor connector.
Measure resistance between terminals 1
and 2 of heated oxygen sensor connector.
Resistance: 11 –16 at 20C (68F)
Replace heated oxygen sensor.
Check and repair harness or connector between
main relay and heated oxygen sensor and ECM.
EG2–484
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC P0136 Heated Oxygen Sensor Circuit Malfunction
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to ”Insufficient coolant temp. for closed loop fuel control” on page EG2–473.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
DTC No.
P01 36
Voltage output of the heated oxygen sensor (bank 1
sensor 2) remains at 0.4 V or more or 0.5 V or
less when the vehicle is driven at 50 km/h
(31 mph) or more after the engine is warmed up.
(2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
•
Heated oxygen sensor
HINT: Bank 1 refers to the bank that includes cylinder No.1.
Sensor 2 refers to the sensor farther away from the engine body.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P01 36)
being output?
YES
Go to relevant diagnostic trouble code
chart.
Check for open and short in harness and connector
between ECM and heated oxygen sensor.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check the output voltage of the heated oxygen
sensor.
Check that each connector is properly
connected.
Replace heated oxygen sensor.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to page EG2–482 for the WIRING DIAGRAM.
EG2–485
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P0136) being output?
YES
Go to relevant diagnostic trouble code
chart.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM
and heated oxygen sensor (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check the output voltage of heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2).
(1) Remove the fuse cover on the instrument
panel.
(2) Connect the OBDII scan tool or TOYOTA
hand–held tester to the DLC 3.
(3) After warming up the engine, race the engine
at 2,500 rpm for 3 mins.
Read the output voltage of heated oxygen sensor
(bank 1 sensor 2) when racing the engine after 3
mins. have elapsed.
Heated oxygen sensor output voltage:
Alternates from 0.4 V or less to 0,5 V or
more.
Check that each connector is properly
connected.
Replace heated oxygen sensor.
EG2–486
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC P0171 System too Lean (Fuel Trim)
DTC P0172 System too Rich (Fuel Trim)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
”Fuel trim” refers to the feedback compensation value compared against the basic injection time. Fuel trim
includes short–term fuel trim and long–term fuel trim.
”Short–term fuel trim” is the short–term fuel compensation used to maintain the air–fuel ratio at its ideal
theoretical value. The signal from the heated oxygen sensor indicates whether the air–fuel ratio is RICH or
LEAN compared to the ideal theoretical value, triggening a reduction in fuel volume if the air–fuel ratio is
rich, and an increase in fuel volume if it is lean.
”Long–term fuel trim” is overall fuel compensation carried out long–term to compensate for continual
deviation of the short–term fuel trim from the central value due to individual engine differences, wear over
time and changes in the usage environment.
If both the short–term fuel trim and long–term fuel trim are LEAN or RICH beyond a certain value, it is
detected as a malfunction and the MIL lights up.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
P0171
When the air fuel ratio feedback is stable after
engine warming up, the fuel trim is considerably in
error on the RICH side.
(2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
•
•
Air intake (hose loose)
Fuel line pressure
Injector blockage
Heated oxygen sensor malfunction
Mass air flow meter
Engine coolant temp. sensor
P0172
When the air fuel ratio feedback is stable after
engine warming up, the fuel trim is considerably in
error on the LEAN side.
(2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
•
Fuel line pressure
Injector leak, blockage
Heated oxygen sensor malfunction
Mass air flow meter
Engine coolant temp. sensor
Trouble Area
HINT;
• When DTC P0171 is recorded, the actual air–fuel ratio is on the LEAN side. When DTC P0172 is
recorded, the actual air–fuel ratio is on the RICH side,
• Fuel trim applies separately to bank 1 and bank 2, so the ECM lights up the MIL if a problem occurs with
either bank.
• You can tell which bank is malfunctioning by looking at the short–term fuel trim and long–term fuel trim,
thus allowing you to focus your inspection.
• If the total of the short–term fuel trim value and long–term fuel trim value for each bank is within
± 25%, the system is functioning normally.
EG2–487
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check air induction system.
Repair or replace.
Check heated oxygen sensor data.
Check heated oxygen sensor.
Check fuel pressure.
Check and repair fuel pump, pressure
regulator, fuel pipe line and filter.
Check injector injection.
Replace injector.
Check mass air flow meter and engine coolant
temp. sensor
Repair or replace.
Check for spark and ignition.
Repair or replace.
Check and replace ECM.
EG2–488
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check air induction system (See page EG2–221).
Repair or replace.
Check for– heated oxygen sensor data.
(1) Remove the fuse cover on the instrument
panel.
(2) Connect the OBDII scan tool or TOYOTA
hand–held tester to the DLC 3.
(3) Warm up engine to normal operating temper–
ature.
Read the heated oxygen sensor output voltage and
short–term fuel trim.
Read the values for the same bank.
Pattern
Heated oxygen sensor
out put voltage
Short–term
fuel trim
Lean condition
Changes at 0.55 V or
less
Changes at
about + 20%
Rich condition
Changes at 0.4 V or
more
Changes at
about – 20%
Check for heated oxygen sensor
(See page EG2–476).
EG2–489
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check fuel pressure.
(1) Install the SST (pressure gauge) to the fuel
filter output (See page EG2–231).
SST 09268–45012
(2) Turn ignition switch ON.
(3) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to
data link connector 3 on the vehicle.
(4) Use ACTIVE TEST mode to operate the fuel
pump.
Connecting terminals B and FP of data link con–
nector 1 allows the fuel pump to be operated.
Measure the fuel pressure
Fuel pressure: 265 – 304 kPa
(2.7 – 3.1 kg f/cm2, 38 – 44 psi)
Check and repair fuel pump, pressure
regulator, fuel pipe line and filter.
(See page EG2–230).
Check injector injection.
Remove the delivery pipe and injectors from the
bank that has the malfunction (See page EG2–246).
Check injection volume of injector
(See page EG2–250) .
Injection volume:
56 – 69 cm3/15 sec. (3.4 – 4.2 cu in.)
Difference between each injector:
Less than 6 cm3 (0.4 cu in.)
Fuel drop (leakage):
One drop or less per minute.
Replace injector.
EG2–490
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check mass air flow meter– and engine coolant temp. sensor
(See page EG2–444, 457).
Repair or replace.
Check for spark and ignition (See page IG–84).
Repair or replace.
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
EG2–491
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC P0201 P0202 P0203 P0204 P0205 P0206 Injector
Circuit Malfunction (Cylinder 1–6)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The injectors are located in the intake manifold. They inject fuel into the cylinders based on signals from
the ECM.
The ECM detects a malfunction of the injector circuit by counting the number of misfires of a specific
cylinder.
For an explanation of misfire detection requirements, see page DTC P0301.
DTC No.
P0201
P0202
P0203
P0204
P0205
P0206
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
A specified cylinder misfire continuously.
(2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
•
Open or short in injector circuit
Injector blockage, seized
Ignition system
Valve clearance not to specification
Compression pressure
See the Diagnostic Chart and Inspection Procedure under ”Misfiring”.
EG2–492
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
WIRING DIAGRAM
Reference INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
INJECTOR SIGNAL WAVEFORM
• With the engine idling, measure between terminals #10 – #60 and E01 of ECM.
HINT: The correct waveform appears as shown in the illustration below.
EG2–493
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC P0300 Random Misfire Detected
DTC P0301 P0302 P0303 P0304 P0305 P0306 Misfire
Detected (Cylinder 1–6)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Misfire: The ECM uses the crankshaft position sensor and camshaft position sensor to monitor changes
in the crankshaft rotation for each cylinder.
The ECM counts the number of times the engine speed change rate indicates that misfire has occurred.
And when the misfire rate equals or exceeds the count indicating that the engine condition has deteriorated, the MIL lights up.
If the misfire rate is high enough and the driving conditions will cause catalyst overheating, the MIL blinks
when misfiring occurs.
DTC No.
P0300
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Misfiring of multiple cylinders is detected during the
same 200 or 1,000 revolutions.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Ignition system
Injector
Fuel line pressure
EG R
Compression pressure
Valve clearance not to specification
Valve timing
Mass air flow meter
Engine coolant temp. sensor
P0301 For each 200 revolutions of the engine, misfiring is
P0302 detected which can cause catalyst overheating.
(This causes MIL to blink)
P0303
P0304 For each 1,000 revolutions of the engine, misfiring is
which causes emissions deterioration.
P0305 detected
(2 trip detection logic)
P0306
HINT; When the code for a misfiring cylinder is recorded repeatedly but no Random Misfire code is
recorded, it indicates that the misfires were detected and recorded at different times.
EG2–494
1MZ–FE ENGINE
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
EG2–495
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
FE ENGINE TROUBLESHOOTING – CIRCUIT
INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check spark plug and spark of misfiring cylinder.
Replace or check ignition system.
Check voltage of ECM terminal for injector of failed
cylinder.
Go to step
Check injector of misfiring cylinder.
Replace injector.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between
injector and ECM.
Check fuel pressure.
Repair or replace fuel pump.
Check injector injection.
Replace injector.
Check EGR system.
Repair EGR system.
Check mass air flow meter and engine coolant
temp. sensor.
Repair or replace.
Check engine mechanical systems.
EG2–496
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check spark plug and spark of misfiring cylinder.
(1) Remove ignition coil (See page IG–87).
(2) Remove spark plug.
(1) Check the carbon deposits on electrode.
(2) Check electrode gap.
(1) No large carbon deposit present.
Not wet with gasoline or oil.
(2) Electrode gap: 1.1 – 1.3 mm
(0.043 – 0.051 in.)
(1) Install the spark plug to the ignition coil, and
connect the ignition coil connector.
(2) Ground the spark plug.
(3) Disconnect injector connector.
Check if spark occurs while engine is being
cranked.
NOTICE: To prevent excess fuel being injected from
the injectors during this test, don’t crank
the engine for more than 5–10 seconds at a
time.
Spark jumps across electrode gap.
Replace or check ignition system
(See page IG–84).
Check voltage of ECM terminal for injector of failed cylinder.
(1) Remove glove compartment
(See page EG2–309) .
(2) Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure voltage between applicable terminal of
ECM and body ground.
Voltage: 9 – 14 V
Go to step
EG2–497
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check injector of misfiring cylinder.
Disconnect injector connector
(See page EG2–243) .
Measure resistance of injector.
Resistance: 5 – 23 Ω at 20C (68F)
Replace injector.
Check for open and short in harness and
connector between injector and ECM
(See page IN–31).
Check fuel pressure.
(1) Install the SST (pressure gauge) to the fuel
filter outlet. (See page EG2–231) .
SST 09268–45012
(2) Turn ignition switch ON.
(3) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the
DLC3.
(4) Use ACTIVE TEST mode to operate the fuel
pump.
HINT: The fuel pump can be operated by connecting
terminals B and FP of data link connector 1.
Measure the fuel pressure.
Fuel pressure: 265 – 304 kPa
(2.7 – 3.1 kgf/cm2, 38 – 44 psi)
Check and repair fuel pump, pressure
regulator, fuel pipe line and filter
(See page EG2–230).
EG2–498
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check injector injection.
Remove delivery pipe and injectors
(See page EG2–246) .
Check injection volume of injector
(See page EG2–250) .
Injection volume:
56 – 69 cm3/15 sec. (3.4 – 4.2 cu in.)
Difference between each injector:
Less than 6 cm3 (0.4 cu in.)
Fuel drop (leakage):
One drop or less per minute.
Replace injector.
Check EGR system (See page EG2–207).
Repair EGR system.
Check mass air flow meter and engine coolant temp. sensor
(See page EG2–444, 457).
Repair or replace.
Check engine mechanical systems.
• Compression pressure (See page EG2–36 ).
• Valve clearance (See page EG2–13 ).
• Valve timing (See page EG2–52 ).
EG2–499
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC P0325 P0330 Knock Sensor Circuit Malfunction
(Knock Sensor 1 Knock Sensor 2)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Knock sensors are fitted one each to the right bank and left bank of the cylinder block to detect engine
knocking. This sensor contains a piezoelectric element which generates a voltage when it becomes
deformed, which occurs when the cylinder block vibrates due to knocking. If engine knocking occurs,
ignition timing is retarded to suppress it.
DTC No.
Trouble Area
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
P0325
No knock sensor 1 signal to ECM with engine
speed 2,000 rpm or more.
•
•
•
Open or short in knock sensor 1 circuit.
Knock sensor 1 (looseness).
ECM
P0330
No knock sensor 2 signal to ECM with engine
speed 2,000 rpm or more.
•
•
•
Open or short in knock sensor 2 circuit.
Knock sensor 2 (looseness).
ECM
If the ECM detects the above diagnosis conditions, it operates the fail safe function in which the corrective
retard angle value is set to the maximum value.
WIRING DIAGRAM
EG2–500
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
HINT: DTC P0325 is for the right bank knock sensor circuit.
DTC P0330 is for the left bank knock sensor circuit.
Check knock sensor circuit.
Type
II
G o to step
Type
I
Check for open and short in harness and connector
between EE1 connector and ECM.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECM.
Check for open and short in harness and connector
between EE1 connector and knock sensor.
Replace knock sensor.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
EG2–501
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Connect the OBDII scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester and
check the knock sensor circuit.
(1) Remove the fuse cover on the instrument
panel.
(2) Connect the OBDII scan tool or TOYOTA
hand–held tester to the DLC 3.
(3) Disconnect the wire to wire connector EE1.
(4) Connect the terminals of the disconnected
EE1 male connector and EE1 female as follows.
Male connector ↔ Female connector
Terminal 1↔ Terminal 2
Terminal 2↔ Terminal 1
(5) Turn ignition switch ON and OBDII scan tool
or TOYOTA hand–held tester main switch
ON.
(6) After the engine is warmed up, perform quick
racing (4,000 rpm) three times.
Check the diagnostic trouble code.
Type
I
Type
II
Type I
DTC same as when vehicle brought in.
P0325→ P0325 or P0330→ P0330
Type II
DTC different to when vehicle brought in.
P0325→ P0330 or P0330→ P0325
Go to step
Check for open and short in harness and connector between EE1
connector and ECM (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
EG2–502
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check for open and short in harness and connector between EE1
connector and knock sensor (See page IN–31).
HINT: If DTC P0325 has changed to P0330, check the knock sensor circuit on the right bank side.
If DTC P0330 has changed to P0325, check the knock sensor circuit on the left bank side.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Replace knock sensor.
Reference
INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
• With the engine racing (4,000 rpm) measure be–
tween terminals KNKR, KNKL of ECM and body
ground.
HINT: The correct waveform appears as shown i n the
illustration on the left.
• Spread the time on the horizontal axis, and confirm
that period of the wave is 141 µ sec.
(Normal mode vibration frequency of knock sen–
sor: 7.1 KHz).
HINT: If normal mode vibration frequency is not 7.1
KHz, the sensor is malfunctioning.
EG2–503
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC P0335 Crankshaft Position Sensor Circuit Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Crankshaft position sensor (NE signal) consist of a signal plate and pick up coil.
The NE signal plate has 34 teeth and is mounted on the crankshaft. The NE signal sensor generates 34
signals for every engine revolution. The ECM detects the standard crankshaft angle based on the G22
signals, and the actual crankshaft angle and the engine speed by the NE signals.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
No crankshaft position sensor signal to ECM
during cranking.
(2 trip detection logic)
P4335
No crankshaft position sensor signal to ECM
during engine running.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Open or short in crankshaft position sensor circuit.
Crankshaft position sensor.
Starter
ECM
EG2–504
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
HINT: Perform troubleshooting of diagnostic trouble code P0335 first, If no trouble is found, trou–
bleshoot the following mechanical systems.
Check resistance of crankshaft position sensor.
Replace sensor.
Check for open and short in harness and connector
between ECM and crankshaft position sensor.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Inspect sensor installation and teeth of signal plate.
Tighten the sensor.
Replace signal plate.
Check and replace ECM.
EG2–505
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check resistance of crankshaft position sensor.
Disconnect crankshaft position sensor connector.
Measure resistance of crankshaft position sensor.
Resistance
Cold
1,630 – 2,740 Ω
Hot
2,065 – 3,225 Ω
”Cold” is from –10C (14 F) to 50C (122 F) and
”Hot” is from 50C (122F) to 1 00C (212F).
Reference
INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
• During cranking or idling, check between terminals
G22(+) and G22 (–) , NE(+) and NE (–) of engine
control module.
HINT: The correct waveforms appear as shown in the
illustration on the left.
Replace crankshaft position sensor.
EG2–506
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM
and crankshaft position sensor (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Inspect sensor installation and teeth of signal plate.
Tighten the sensor.
Replace signal plate.
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
EG2–507
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC P0336 Crankshaft Position Sensor Circuit
Range Performance
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to crankshaft position sensor circuit malfunction on page EG2–503.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
P0336
Deviation in crankshaft position sensor signal and
camshaft position sensor signal.
(2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
•
•
Mechanical system malfunction.
(Skipping teeth of timing belt, belt stretched.)
ECM
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check valve timing (Check for loose and jumping
teeth of timing belt) (See page EG2–52).
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
Adjust valve timing.
(Repair or replace timing belt.)
EG2–508
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC P0340 Camshaft Position Sensor Circuit
Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Camshaft position sensor (G22 signal) consist of a signal plate and pick up coil.
The G22 signal plate has one tooth, on its outer circumference and is mounted on the left bank camshafts.
When the camshafts rotate, the protrusion on the signal plate and the air gap on the pick up coil change,
causing fluctuations in the magnetic field and generating an electromotive force in the pick up coil.
The NE signal plate has 34 teeth and is mounted on the crankshaft. The NE signal sensor generates 34
signals for every engine revolution. The ECM detects the standard crankshaft angle based on the G22
signal and the actual crankshaft angle and the engine speed by the NE signals.
DTC No.
P0340
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
No camshaft position sensor signal to ECM during
cranking.
(2 trip detection logic)
No camshaft position sensor signal to ECM during
engine running.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Open or short in camshaft position sensor circuit.
Camshaft position sensor.
Starter.
ECM
EG2–509
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check resistance of camshaft position sensor.
Replace sensor.
Check for open and short in harness and connector
between ECM and camshaft position sensor.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Inspect sensor installation.
Tighten the sensor.
Check and replace ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
EG2–510
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check resistance of camshaft position sensor.
Disconnect camshaft position sensor connector.
Measure resistance of camshaft position sensor.
Resistance
Cold
835 – 1,400
Hot
1,060 – 1,645
”Cold is form –10C (140F) to 50C (122F) and
”Hot” is form 50C (122 F) to 100C ( 212F).
Reference
INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
• During cranking or idling, check between terminals
G 22(+) and G22(–), NE(+) and NE (–) of engine control
module.
HINT: The correct waveforms appear as shown in the
illustration on the left.
Replace camshaft position sensor.
EG2–511
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check for open and short in harness and connector between
ECM and camshaft position sensor (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Inspect sensor installation.
Tighten the sensor.
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
EG2–512
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC P0401 Exhaust Gas Recirculation Flow
Insufficient Detected
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The EGR system recirculates exhaust gas, which is controlled to the proper quantity to suit the driving
conditions, into the intake air mixture to slow down combustion, reduce the combustion temperature and
reduce NOx emissions. The amount of EGR is regulated by the EGR vacuum modulator according to the
engine load.
If even one of the following conditions is fulfilled,
the VSV is turned ON by a signal from the ECM.
This results in atmospheric air acting on the EGR
valve, closing the EGR valve and shutting off the
exhaust gas (EGR cut–off).
Under the following conditions, EGR is cut to
maintain driveability.
• Coolant temp. below 60C (140F).
• During deceleration (throttle valve closed).
• Light engine load (amount of intake air very
small).
• Engine racing.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
P0401
After the engine is warmed up and run at 80 km/h
(50 mph) for 3 to 5 minutes, the EGR gas
temperature sensor value does not exceed 40C
(104F) above the ambient air temperature.
(2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
•
EGR valve stuck closed.
Short in EGR VSV circuit.
Open in EGR gas temp. sensor circuit.
EGR hose disconnected.
ECM
EG2–513
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SYSTEM CHECK DRIVING PATTERN
Connect the OBDII scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC 3.
Start and warm up the engine with all accessories switched OFF.
After the engine is warmed up, run the vehicle at 70 – 90 km/h (43 – 56 mph) for 3 min, or more.
After driving, idle the engine for about 2 mins.
After idling, check the ”READINESS TESTS”. If ”COMPL” (test completed) is displayed and the MIL
does not light up, the system is normal. If ”INCPL” is displayed, run the vehicle again and check it.
HINT: If a malfunction exists, the MIL will light up during step (4).
EG2–514
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
TOYOTA hand–held tester
Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester and read
value of EGR gas temperature.
Go to step
Check for open in harness or ECM.
Confirm good connection at sensor.
If OK, replace EGR gas temp. sensor.
Check for open in harness or ECM.
Open in harness between terminals E2
or THG. Repair or replace harness.
Confirm connection at ECM, If OK, replace ECM.
Check connection of vacuum hose, EGR hose.
Repair or replace.
Check the VSV for EG R,
Go to step
Check operation of the VSV for EG R.
Replace VSV for EG R.
Check for short in harness and connector between VSV
and ECM.
EG2–515
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check EGR Vacuum modulator.
Repair or replace.
Check EGR Valve.
Repair or replace.
Check value of EGR gas temp. sensor.
Replace EGR gas temp. sensor.
Check and replace ECM.
EG2–516
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
Check resistance of EGR gas temp. sensor.
Check and replace EGR gas temp. sensor.
Check for open in harness or ECM.
Go to step
Check for open in harness or ECM.
Open in harness between terminals E2 or
THG. Repair or replace harness.
Confirm connection at ECM. If OK, replace ECM.
Check connection of vacuum hose, EGR hose.
Repair or replace.
Check the VSV for EG R.
Go to step
Check operation of the VSV for EG R.
Replace VSV for EG R.
Check for open in harness and connector between J/B No,2
and ECM.
EG2–517
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check EGR vacuum modulator.
Repair or replace.
Check EGR valve.
Repair or replace.
Check resistance of EGR gas temp. sensor.
Replace EGR gas temp. sensor.
Check and replace ECM.
EG2–518
1MZ–FE ENGINE
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
EG2–519
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
TOYOTA hand–held tester
Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester and read value of EGR
gas temperature value.
(1) Remove the fuse cover on the instrument
panel.
(2) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the
D LC 3.
(3) Turn ignition switch ON and TOYOTA hand–
held tester main switch ON.
Read EGR gas temperature on the TOYOTA hand–
held tester.
EGR gas temp.: 10C (50F) or more.
If there is an open circuit, the TOYOTA
hand–held tester indicates 3.1 C (37.6F).
Go to step
Check for open in harness or ECM.
(1) Disconnect the EGR gas temp. sensor con–
nector.
(2) Connect sensor wire harness terminals to–
gether.
(3) Turn ignition switch ON.
Read EGR gas temperature on the TOYOTA hand–
held tester.
EGR gas temp.: 159.3C (318.7F)
Confirm good connection at sensor.
If OK, replace EGR gas temp. sensor.
EG2–520
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check for open in harness or ECM.
(1) Remove glove compartment
(See page EG2–309).
(2) Connect between terminals THG and E2 of
ECM E8 and E9 connectors.
HINT: EGR gas temp. sensor connector is discon–
nected.
Before checking, do a visual check and contact
pressure check for the ECM connector (See
page EG2–418).
Read EGR temperature on the TOYOTA hand–held
tester.
EGR gas temp.: 159.3C (318.7F)
Open in harness between terminals E2 or
THG. Repair or replace harness.
Confirm connection at ECM.
If OK, replace ECM.
Check the connection of the vacuum hose, EGR hose
(See page EG2–287).
Repair or replace.
EG2–521
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check the VSV for EGR.
Select the active test mode on the TOYOTA hand–
held tester.
Check operation of EGR VSV, when it is operated
by the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
EGR system is OFF:
The air from pipe E is flowing out
through the air fitter.
EGR system is ON:
The air from pipe E is flowing out pipe G.
Go to step
EG2–522
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check operation of the VSV for EGR.
(1) Remove EGR VSV.
(2) Disconnect EGR VSV connector.
(1) Measure resistance between terminals.
(2) Measure resistance between each terminal
and the body.
(1 ) Resistance: 26 – 46 at 20C (68F)
(2) Resistance: 1 M or higher.
Check operation of EGR VSV when battery voltage
is applied, and is not applied to the terminals of
EGR VSV connector.
Battery voltage is applied:
The air from pipe E flows out through the air
filter.
Battery voltage is not applied:
The air from pipe E flows out through pipe G.
Replace VSV for EGR.
Check for short in harness and connector
between VSV and ECM (See page IN–31).
EG2–523
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check EGR vacuum modulator (See page EG2–210).
Repair or replace.
Check EGR valve (See page EG2–211).
Repair or replace.
Check value of EGR gas temp. sensor.
(1) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the
DLC3.
(2) Turn ignition switch ON and TOYOTA hand–
held tester main switch ON’
(3) Select the active test mode on the TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
(EGR system ON)
(4) Race the engine at 4,000 rpm for 3 mins.
Measure the EGR gas temp. while racing engine at
4,000 rpm.
EGR gas temp. after 3 mins.: 140C (284F)
or more
Replace EGR gas temp. sensor.
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
EG2–524
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
OBDII scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
Check resistance of EGR gas temp. sensor.
Disconnect EGR gas temp. sensor connector.
Measure resistance between terminals of EGR gas
temp. sensor connector.
Resistance: 600 k or less.
If there is open circuit, ohmmeter indicates 720 k
or more.
Check and replace EGR gas temp. sensor
(See page EG2–303).
Check for open in harness or ECM.
Disconnect EGR gas temp. sensor connector.
Measure voltage between terminals of EGR gas
temp. sensor wire harness side connector.
Voltage: 4.5 – 5.5 V
Go to step
Check for open in harness or ECM.
(1) Remove glove compartment (See page EG2–
309 ) .
(2) Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminals THG and E2 of
ECM.
HINT: EG R gas temp. sensor connector is dis–
connected.
Voltage: 4.5 – 5.5 V
Open in harness between terminals E2 or
THG. repair or replace harness.
Confirm connection at ECM.
If OK, replace ECM.
EG2–525
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check connection of vacuum hose, EGR hose (See page EG2–287).
Repair or replace.
Check the VSV for EGR.
(1) Remove glove compartment
(See page EG2–309).
(2) Turn ignition switch ON.
Check EGR VSV function
(1) Connect between terminal EGR of ECM and
body ground. (ON)
(2) Disconnect between terminal EGR of ECM
and body ground (OFF).
(1) VSV is ON:
The air from pipe E flows out through the air
filter.
(2) VSV is OFF:
The air from pipe E flows out through pipe
G.
Go to step
Check operation of the VSV for– EGR (See page EG2–522, step
Replace VSV for EGR.
Check for open in harness and connector
between J/B No.2 and ECM (See page IN–31).
EG2–526
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check EGR vacuum modulator (See page EG2–210).
Repair or replace.
Check EGR valve (See page EG2–211).
Repair or replace.
Check resistance of EGR gas temp. sensor.
(1) Disconnect EGR gas temp. sensor connector.
(2) Start the engine and warm it up.
(3) Disconnect EGR VSV connector.
(4) Race the engine at 4,000 rpm for 3 mins.
Measure the resistance of the EGR gas temp. sen–
sor while racing the engine at 4,000 rpm.
Resistance of EGR gas temp. sensor after 3 mins:
4.3 k or Iess
Resistance: 188.6 – 439.0 k at 20C (68F)
Replace EGR gas temp. sensor.
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
EG2–527
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC P0402 Exhaust Gas Recirculation Flow
Excessive Detected
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to Exhaust gas recirculation flow insufficient detected on page EG2–512.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
P0402
EG R gas temp. sensor value is high during EG R
cut–off when engine is cold (Race engine at
about 4,000 rpm without load so that vacuum is
applied to port E).
(2 trip detection logic)
EG R valve is always open
(2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
•
EGR valve stuck open
EGR VSV open malfunction
Open in EGR VSV circuit
Short in EGR gas temp. sensor circuit
ECM
See DTC P0401 for System Check Driving Pattern and Wiring Diagram.
EG2–528
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
TOYOTA hand–held tester
Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester and read
value of EGR gas temperature.
G o to step
Check for short in harness and ECM.
Replace EGR gas temp. sensor.
Check for short in harness or ECM.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECM.
Check the VSV for EG R.
Check EGR valve.
Check operation of the VSV for EG R.
Replace VSV for EG R.
Check for open in harness and connector between J/B
No.2 and ECM.
EG2–529
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
Check resistance of EGR gas temp. sensor.
Replace EGR gas temp. sensor.
Check for short in harness and connector between
EGR gas temp. sensor and ECM.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check the VSV for EG R.
Check EGR valve.
Check operation of the VSV for EG R.
Replace VSV for EG R.
Check for open in harness and connector between
J/B No.2 and ECM.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECM.
EG2–530
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
TOYOTA hand–held tester
Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester and read EGR gas
temperature value.
(1) Remove the fuse cover on the instrument
panel.
(2) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the
D LC 3.
(3) Turn ignition switch ON and TOYOTA hand–
held tester main switch ON.
Read EGR gas temperature on the TOYOTA hand–
held tester.
EGR gas temp.: 150C (302F) or less.
(Not immediately after driv–
ing)
If there is a short circuit, the TOYOTA hand–held
tester indicates 159.3C (318.7F) .
G o to step
Check for short in harness and ECM.
Disconnect the EGR gas temperature sensor con–
nector.
Rear EGR gas temperature on the TOYOTA hand–
held tester.
EGR gas temp.: 3.1C (37.6F)
Replace EGR gas temp. sensor.
EG2–531
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check for short in harness or ECM.
(1) Remove glove compartment
(See page EG2–309) .
(2) Disconnect the E9 connector of ECM.
HINT: EGR gas temp. sensor is disconnected.
Read EGR gas temp. on the TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
EGR gas temp.: 3.1 C (37.6F)
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
Check the VSV for EGR.
Select the active test mode on the TOYOTA hand–
held tester.
Check operation of EGR VSV, when it is operated
by the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
EGR system is OFF:
The air from pipe E flows out through the air
filter.
EG R system is ON:
The air from pipe E flows out through pipe G.
Check EGR valve (See page EG2–211).
EG2–532
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check operation of the VSV for EGR.
(1) Remove EGR VSV.
(2) Disconnect EGR VSV connector.
(1) Measure resistance between terminals.
(2) Measure resistance between each terminal
and the body.
(1) Resistance: 26 – 46 at 20C (68F)
(2) Resistance: 1 M or higher.
Check operation of EGR VSV when battery voltage
is applied, and not applied to the terminals of EGR
VSV connector or not.
Battery voltage is applied:
The air from pipe E flows out through the air
filter.
Battery voltage is not applied:
The air from pipe E flows out through pipe G.
Replace VSV for EG R.
Check for open in harness and connector
between J/B No.2 and ECM (See page IN–31).
EG2–533
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
OBDII scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
Check resistance of EGR gas temp. sensor.
Disconnect EGR gas temp. sensor connector (See
page EG2–303) .
Measure resistance between terminals of EGR gas
temp. sensor connector.
Resistance: 2.5 k or more.
(Not immediately after driving)
If there is short circuit, ohmmeter indicates 200
or less.
Replace EG R gas temp. sensor.
Check for short in harness and connector between EGR gas temp.
sensor and ECM (See page IN–31)..
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check the VSV for EGR (See page EG2–525, step
Check EGR valve (See page EG2–211).
Check operation of the VSV for EGR (See page EG2–532, step
Replace VSV for EG R.
Check for open in harness and connector between J/B No.2 and
ECM (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
EG2–534
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC P0420 Catalyst System Efficiency Below Threshold
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ECM compares the waveform of the oxygen sensor located before the catalyst with the waveform of
the oxygen sensor located after the catalyst to determine whether or not catalyst performance has deteri–
orated.
Air–fuel ratio feedback compensation keeps the waveform of the oxygen sensor before the catalyst repeatedly changing back and forth from rich to lean.
If the catalyst is functioning normally, the waveform of the oxygen sensor after the catalyst switches back
and forth between rich and lean much more slowly than the waveform of the oxygen sensor before the
catalyst.
But when both waveforms change at a similar rate, it indicates that catalyst performance has deteriorated.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
P0420
After the engine is warmed up and the vehicle
driven for 5 min. at 32 – 80 km/h (20 – 50
mph), the waveforms of the heated oxygen
sensors, bank 1, 2 sensor 1 and bank 1 sensor 2
have the same amplitude.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Three–way catalytic converter
Open or short in heated oxygen sensor circuit
Heated oxygen sensor
HINT: Only on U.S. vehicles does the MIL light up when a malfunction is detected.
EG2–535
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SYSTEM CHECK DRIVING PATTERN
Connect the OBDII scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
Start and warm up the engine with all accessories switched OFF.
After the engine is warmed up, run the vehicle at 50 – 65 km/h (31 – 40 mph) for 5 – 10 min.
HINT: If a malfunction exists, the MIL will light up during step (3) .
EG2–536
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P0420)
being output?
Check heated oxygen sensor. (See page EG2–476).
Replace three–way catalytic converter.
YES
Go to relevant diagnostic trouble code
chart.
Repair or replace.
EG2–537
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC P0500 Vehicle Speed Sensor Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The vehicle speed sensor outputs a 4–pulse signal for every revolution of the rotor shaft, which is rotated
by the transmission output shaft via the driven gear. After this signal is converted into a more precise
rectangular waveform by the waveform shaping circuit inside the combination meter, it is then transmitted
to the ECM. The ECM determines the vehicle speed based on the frequency of these pulse signals.
DTC No.
P0500
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
No vehicle speed sensor signal to ECM under
conditions (a) and (b).
(a) Park/neutral position switch is OFF.
(b) Vehicle is being driven.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Open or short in vehicle speed sensor circuit.
Vehicle speed sensor
Combination meter
ECM
EG2–538
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check operation of speedometer.
Check speedometer circuit
Check for short in harness and connector between
terminal SP1 and body ground.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check voltage of terminal SP1.
Check for open in harness and connector
between J/B No.3 and ECM.
Check for open in harness and connector between
J/6 No.3 and combination meter.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECM.
EG2–539
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check operation of speedometer.
Drive the vehicle and check if the operation of the speedometer in the combination meter is normal,
HINT: The vehicle speed sensor is operating normally if the speedometer display is normal.
Check speedometer circuit. See
combination meter troubleshooting on
page BE–66.
Check for short in harness and connector between terminal SP1 of
ECM and body ground.
(1) Remove glove compartment
(See page EG2–309).
(2) Disconnect the E10 ECM connector.
Check continuity between terminal SP1 of ECM
and body ground.
No continuity (1 M or higher)
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check voltage between terminal SP1 of ECM and body ground.
Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminal SP1 of ECM
and body ground.
Voltage: 9 –14 V
Check for open in harness and connector
between J/B No.3 and ECM (See page
IN–31).
EG2–540
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check for open in harness and connector between J/B No.3 and
combination meter (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
EG2–541
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC P0505 Idle Control System Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The rotary solenoid type IAC valve is located in front of the intake air chamber and intake air bypassing
the throttle valve is directed to the IAC valve through a passage.
In this way the intake air volume bypassing the throt–
tle valve is regulated, controlling the engine speed.
The ECM operates only the IAC valve to perform
idle–up and provide feedback for the target idling
speed and a VSV for idle–up control is also added (for
air conditioning).
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
P0505
Idle speed continues to vary greatly from the target
speed.
(2 trip detection logic)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
IAC valve is stuck or closed
open or short in IAC valve circuit
Air conditioner idle up VSV
Air intake (hose loose)
EG2–542
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check air induction system.
Repair or replace.
Check A/C idle up VSV.
Repair or replace.
Check voltage terminals RSO, RSC.
G o to step
Check IAC valve.
Replace IAC valve.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between
J/B No.2 and IAC valve, IAC valve and ECM.
Check operation of the IAC valve.
Check and replace ECM.
Repair or replace IAC valve.
EG2–543
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check air induction system (See page EG2–221).
Repair or replace.
Check A/C idle up VSV (See page EG2–570).
Repair or replace.
Check voltage terminals RSO, RSC.
(1) Remove glove compartment
(See page EG2–309).
(2) Disconnect the ECM connector (P).
(3) Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminals RSO, RSC of
ECM connector and body ground.
Voltage: 9 –14 V
Go to step
EG2–544
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check IAC valve.
Disconnect the IAC valve connector.
Check continuity between terminals RSO,
RSC and B of IAC valve connector.
Terminals
RSO and B
Continuity
(Reference value 10 – 30)
Terminals
RSC and B
Continuity
(Reference value 10 – 30)
Replace IAC valve.
Check for open and short in harness and
connector between J/B No.2 and IAC valve,
IAC valve and ECM (See page IN–31).
EG2–545
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check operation of the IAC valve
Remove IAC valve (See page EG2–274).
(1) Connect the positive (+) lead from the bat–
tery to terminal B and negative (–) lead to
terminal RSC, and check that the valve is
closed.
(2) Connect the positive (+) lead from the bat–
tery to terminal B and negative (–) lead to
terminal RSO, and check that the valve is
open.
(1) The valve moves to close direction.
(2) The valve moves to open direction.
The ACTIVE TEST mode of the TOYOTA hand–
held tester can be used to change the duty of the
IAC valve as desired.
Repair or replace IAC valve.
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
EG2–546
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC P0510 Closed Throttle Position Switch Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to throttle Position Circuit on page EG2–463.
DTC No.
P0510
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
The closed throttle position switch does not turn ON
even once when the vehicle is driven,
(2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Open in closed throttle position switch circuit.
Closed throttle position switch.
ECM
HINT: After confirming DTC P0510 use the TOYOTA hand–held tester to confirm the closed throttle
position switch signal from ”CURRENT DATA”.
Throttle Valve
Closed throttle position
switch signal
Malfunction
Fully Closed
OFF
Open Circuit
Fully Open
WIRING DIAGRAM
Short Circuit
EG2–547
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
HINT: If diagnostic trouble codes ”P0110” (intake air temp. circuit malfunction), ”P0115” (engine
coolant temp. circuit malfunction) and ”P0120” (throttle position circuit malfunction) are output
simultaneously, E2 (sensor ground) may be open.
TOYOTA hand–held tester
Check for open in harness or ECM.
Confirm good connection at sensor.
If OK, replace throttle position sensor.
Check for open in harness or ECM.
Open in harness between ECM and
throttle position sensor.
Confirm connection at ECM. If OK, replace ECM.
OBDII scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
Check for open in harness or ECM.
Confirm good connection at sensor.
If OK, replace throttle position sensor.
Check for open in harness and connector between
throttle position sensor and ECM.
Open in harness between ECM and throttle
position sensor.
Confirm connection at ECM. If OK, replace ECM.
EG2–548
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT: If diagnostic trouble codes P0110, P0115 and P0120 are output simultaneously, E2 (sensor
ground) may be open.
TOYOTA hand–held tester
Check for open in harness or ECM.
(1) Remove the fuse cover on the instrument
panel.
(2) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the
DLC 3.
(3) Disconnect the throttle position sensor con–
nector.
(4) Connect sensor wire harness terminals be–
tween terminals 1 and 2.
(5) Turn ignition switch ON.
Read CTP switch signal on the TOYOTA hand–
held tester.
CTP switch signal: ON
Confirm good connection at sensor. If OK,
replace throttle position sensor.
Check for open in harness or ECM.
(1) Remove glove compartment.
(See page BO–309)
(2) Connect between terminals IDL and E2 of
ECM connectors.
H I NT: Throttle position sensor connector is disconnected.
Before checking, do a visual check and contact
pressure –check for the connector.
(See page EG2–418)
(3) Turn ignition switch ON.
Read CTP switch signal on the TOYOTA hand–
held tester.
CTP switch signal: ON
Open in harness between ECM and
throttle position sensor, repair or replace
harness.
Confirm connection at ECM. If OK, replace ECM.
EG2–549
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
OBDII scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
Check for open in harness or ECM.
(1) Disconnect the throttle position sensor con–
nector.
(2) Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminals 1 and 2 of
throttle position sensor connector.
Voltage: 9 –14 V
Confirm good connection at sensor.
If OK, replace throttle position sensor.
Check for open in harness and connector between throttle position
sensor and ECM (See page IN–31).
Open in harness between ECM and
throttle position sensor.
Confirm connection at ECM. If OK, replace ECM.
EG2–550
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC P1300 Igniter Circuit Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ECM determines the ignition timing, turns on Tr1 at a predetermined angle (”CA) before the desired
ignition timing and outputs an ignition signal (IGT) ”1” to the igniter.
Since the width of the IGT signal is constant, the dwell angle control circuit in the igniter determines the
time the control circuit starts primary current flow to the ignition coil based on the engine rpm and ignition
timing one revolution ago, that is, the time the Tr2 turns on.
When it reaches the ignition timing, the ECM turns Tr1 off and outputs the IGT signal ”0”.
This turns Tr2 off, interrupting the primary current flow and generating a high voltage in the secondary coil
which causes the spark plug to spark. Also, by the counter electromotive force generated when the primary
current is interrupted, the igniter sends an ignition confirmation signal (IGF) to the ECM.
The ECM stops. fuel injection as a fail safe function when the IGF signal is not input to the ECM.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
•
P1300
No IGF signal to ECM for 6 consecutive IGT
signals during engine running.
WIRING DIAGRAM
•
•
Open or short in IGF or IGT circuit from igniter
to ECM.
Igniter
ECM
EG2–551
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage igniter power source.
Check and repair igniter power source
circuit.
Check voltage between terminals 2 – 7 of igniter
connector (12) and body ground.
G o to step
Check ignition coil.
Replace ignition coil.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between
J/B No.1 and ignition coil, ignition coil and igniter.
Check continuity between terminal 7 of igniter and
body ground.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check voltage between terminal 8 of igniter
connector (115) and body ground.
Go to step
Check for open and short in IGF circuit.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECM.
EG2–552
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check for open and short in IGT circuit.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check voltage between terminals IGT 1 – 6 of
ECM and body ground.
Replace igniter.
Check and replace ECM.
EG2–553
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminal 1 of igniter connector (12) and
body ground.
(1) Disconnect igniter connector (12)
(2) Turn ignition switch ON.
Connector 12 color is dark gray
Measure voltage between terminal 1 of igniter connector 12 and body ground.
Voltage: 9 –14 V
Check and repair igniter power source
circuit.
Check voltage between terminals 2 – 7 of igniter connector
and body ground.
Measure voltage between terminals 2 – 7 of ig–
niter connector (12) and body ground.
Voltage: 9 – 14 V
Go to step
EG2–554
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check ignition coil.
Disconnect ignition coil connector.
(See page IG–87).
Refer to the wiring diagram and inspect the igni–
tion coil connected to the terminal which was
without voltage in step (2) .
Measure resistance between terminals of ignition
coil connector.
Resistance
Cold
0.54 – 0.84
Hot
0.68 – 0.98
”Cold” is from –10C (14F) to 50C (122F) and
”Hot” is from 50C (122F) to 100C (212F).
Replace ignition coil.
Check for open and short in harness and
connector between J/B No.1 and ignition coil,
ignition coil and igniter (See page IN–31).
Check continuity between terminal 7 of igniter connector (I15) and
body ground.
Disconnect igniter connector(I15)
Connector (I15) is black.
Check continuity between terminal 7 of igniter connector (I15) and body ground.
Continuity (1 or less)
Repair or replace harness or connector.
EG2–555
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check voltage between terminal 8 of igniter connector (I15) and
body ground.
Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminal 8 of igniter
connector (I15) and body ground.
Voltage: 4.5 – 5.5 V
Go to step (7)
Check for open and short in harness and connector between
terminal IGF of ECM and igniter (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
EG2–556
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check for open and short in harness and connector between
terminals IGT1 – of ECM and igniter (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check voltage between terminals IGT1 – 6 of ECM and body
ground.
Remove glove compartment
(See page EG2–309).
Leave igniter connector 115 disconnected.
Measure voltage between terminals IGT1 – 6 of
ECM and body ground when engine is cranked.
Voltage: 0.5 – 1.0 v (Neither 0 v nor 5 v)
Replace igniter.
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
Reference
INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
• During idling, check waveform between terminal
IGT1, IGF and E1 of ECM.
HINT: The correct waveform appears as shown in the
illustration on the left, with rectangular waves.
IGT2, IGT3, IGT4, IGT5 and IGT6 signal wave–
forms are the same as the IGT1 signal waveform.
EG2–557
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC P1500 Starter Signal Circuit Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the engine is cranked, the intake air flow is slow, so fuel vaporization is poor. A rich mixture is
therefore necessary in order to achieve good startability. While the engine is being cranked, the battery
voltage is applied to terminal STA of the ECM. The starter signal is mainly used to increase the fuel injection volume for the starting injection control and after–start injection control.
DTC No.
P1500
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
No starter signal to ECM.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Open or short in starter signal circuit.
Open or short in ignition switch or starter relay
circuit.
ECM
HINT: In this circuit, diagnosis can only be made in the check mode.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
HINT: This diagnostic chart is based on the premise that the engine is cranked normally. If the engine is
not cranked, proceed to the matrix chart of problem symptoms on page EG2–435.
Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester and check
STA signal.
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart.
Check for open in harness and connector between
ECM and starter relay.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
EG2–558
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester and check STA signal.
(1) Remove the fuse cover on the instrument
panel.
(2) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the
DLC 3.
(3) Turn ignition switch ON and TOYOTA hand–
held tester main switch ON.
Read STA signal on the TOYOTA hand–held tester
while starter operates.
Ignition Switch Position
STA Signal
OFF
START
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart (See page EG2–435).
Check for open in harness and connector between ECM and
starter relay (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
EG2–559
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC P1600 EMC BATT Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Battery voltage is supplied to terminal BATT of the ECM even when the ignition switch is OFF for use by
the diagnostic trouble code memory and air–fuel ratio adaptive control value memory, etc.
DTC No.
P1600
Trouble Area
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Open in back up power source circuit.
•
•
Open in back up power source circuit.
ECM
HINT: If DTC P1600 appear, the ECM does not store another diagnostic trouble code.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage of terminal BATT.
Check and replace ECM.
Check EFI fuse.
Check for short in all the harness and
components connected to EFI fuse.
Check and repair harness or connector between battery,
EFI fuse and ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
EG2–560
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminal BATT of ECM connector and
body ground.
Remove glove compartment.
(See page EG2–309)
Measure voltage between terminal BATT of ECM
connector and body ground.
Voltage: 9 –14 V
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
Check EFI fuse.
Remove EFI fuse from J/B No.2.
Check continuity of EFI fuse.
Continuity
Check for short in all the harness and
components connected to EFI fuse.
Check and repair harness or connector between
battery, EFI fuse and ECM.
EG2–561
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC P1605 Knock Control CPU Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to knock sensor 1 circuit malfunction on page EG2–499.
DTC No.
P1605
Trouble Area
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Engine control computer malfunction.
(for knock control)
•
ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to knock sensor 1 circuit malfunction on page EG2–499.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P1605)
being output?
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
YES
Go to relevant diagnostic trouble code
chart.
EG2–562
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC P1780 Park Neutral Position Switch Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The park/neutral position switch goes on when the shift lever is in the N or P shift position. When it goes
on terminal NSW of the ECM is grounded to body ground via the starter relay thus the terminal NSW
voltage becomes 0 V, When the shift lever is in the D, 2, L or R position, the park/neutral position switch
goes off, so the voltage of ECM terminal NSW becomes battery voltage, the voltage of the ECM internal
power source.
If the shift lever is moved from the N position to the D position, this signal is used for air–fuel ratio correction and for idle speed control (estimated control), etc.
DTC No.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Two or more switches are ON simultaneously for
”N”, ”2” and ”L” position.
(2 trip detection logic)
P1780
When driving under conditions a) and b) for 30 sec.
or more the park/neutral position switch is ON
( N position).
(2 trip detection logic)
a) Vehicle speed; 70 km/h (44 mph) or more
b) Engine speed; 1,500 – 2,500 rpm
•
•
•
Short in park/neutral position switch circuit.
Park/neutral position switch.
ECM
HINT: After confirming DTC P1780 use the TOYOTA hand–held tester to confirm the PNP switch
signal from ”CURRENT DATA”.
EG2–563
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check park/neutral position switch.
Replace park/neutral position switch.
Check voltage between terminal NSW of ECM
connector and body ground.
Check and replace ECM.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between
ECM and park/neutral position switch.
WIRING DIAGRAM
EG2–564
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check park/neutral position switch.
Disconnect park/neutral position switch connec–
tor.
Check continuity between each terminal shown
below when the shift lever is positioned to each
range.
Continuity
Terminal
Shift
Position
Replace park/neutral position switch.
Check voltage between terminal NSW of ECM connector and
body ground.
Remove glove compartment.
(See page EG2–309)
(1) Turn ignition switch ON.
(2) Measure voltage between terminal NSW of
ECM connector and body ground when the
shift lever is positioned to the following positions.
Shift lever position
Voltage
P or N
L,2,D or R
9–14V
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
Check for open and short in harness and
connector between ECM and park/neutral
position switch (See page IN–31).
EG2–565
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
ECM Power Source Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the ignition switch is turned ON, battery voltage is applied to the coil, closing the contacts of the
EFI main relay and supplying power to the terminals + B and + B1 of the ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
EG2–566
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Check voltage of ECM power source.
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart .
Check continuity between terminal E1 and body
ground.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check EFI main relay.
Replace EFI main relay.
Check EFI fuse.
Check for short in all the harness and
components connected to EFI fuse.
Check for open in harness and connector between
main relay and battery, main relay and ECM.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check I G N fuse.
Check for short in all the harness and
components connected to IGN fuse.
Check ignition switch.
Replace ignition switch.
Check for open in harness and connector between IG switch
and main relay, main relay and body ground.
EG2–567
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminals + B, + B1 and E1 of ECM
connector.
(1) Remove glove compartment.
(See page EG2–309)
(2) Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminals + B, + 1B and
E1 of ECM connector.
Voltage: 9 –14 V
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart (See page EG2–435).
Check for open in harness and connector between terminal E1 of
ECM and body ground (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
EG2–568
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check EFI main relay.
Remove EFI main relay from J/B No–2.
Check continuity between terminals of EFI main
relay shown below.
Terminals 3 and 5
Terminals 1 and 2
Open
Continuity
(Reference value 72)
(1) Apply battery voltage between terminals 1
and 2.
(2) Check continuity between terminals 3 and 5.
Terminals 3 and 5
Continuity
Replace EFI main relay.
Check EFI fuse.
Remove EFI fuse from J/B No.2.
Check continuity of EFI fuse.
Continuity
Check for short in all the harness and
components connected to EFI fuse.
EG2–569
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check for open in harness and connector between main relay
and battery, main relay and ECM (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check IGN fuse.
Remove IGN fuse from J/B No–1
Check continuity of IGN fuse.
Continuity
Check for short in all the harness and
components connected to IGN fuse.
Check ignition switch (See page BE–14).
Replace ignition switch.
Check for open in harness and connector between
IG switch and main relay, main relay and body
ground (See page IN–31).
EG2–570
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
AC Idle Up Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the air conditioning operates (increased engine load), this circuit switch is on the VSV and increases
the amount of bypass air to increase the idle speed, thus maintaining driveability.
WIRING DIAGRAM
EG2–571
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
TOYOTA hand–held tester
Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester and check
operation of A/C idle–up VSV.
Check and repair air hose and air pipe.
Check A/C idle–up VSV.
Replace A/C idle–up VSV.
Check for open and short in harness and connector
between EFI main relay and ECM.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECM.
OBDII scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
Check A/C idle–up VSV.
Replace A/C idle–up VSV.
Check voltage between terminal ACV and body
ground.
Check and repair harness or connector.
Check air hose and air pipe.
Repair or replace.
Check and replace ECM.
EG2–572
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
TOYOTA hand–held tester
Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester and check operation of A/C
idle–up VSV.
(1) Remove the fuse cover on the instrument
panel.
(2) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the
DLC 3.
(3) Turn ignition switch ON and TOYOTA hand–
held tester main switch ON.
(4) Select the active test mode on the TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
Check operation of A/C idle–up VSV when A/C
idle–up VSV is operated by the TOYOTA hand–
held tester.
A/C idle–up VSV is ON:
The air from port E is flowing out through port F.
A/C idle–up VSV is OFF:
The air does not flow from port E to port F.
Check and repair air hose and air pipe.
(See page EG2–295)
EG2–573
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check A/C idle–up VSV.
(1) Remove A/C idle–up VSV.
(2) Disconnect A/C idle–up VSV connector.
(1) Measure resistance between terminals.
(2) Measure resistance between each terminal
and the body.
(1) Resistance: 22 – 42 at 20C (68F)
(2) Resistance: 1 M or higher
Check operation of A/C idle–up VSV when battery
positive voltage is applied to the terminals of A/C
idle–up VSV connector or not.
Battery positive voltage is applied:
The air from pipe E is flowing out through pipe F.
Battery positive voltage is not applied:
The air from pipe E is not flowing out through
pipe F.
Replace A/C idle–up VSV.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between EFI
main relay and ECM (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
EG2–574
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
OBDII scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
Check A/C idle–up VSV (See page EG2–573, step 2)
Replace A/C idle–up VSV.
Check voltage between terminal ACV of ECM connector and body
ground.
(1) Remove glove compartment.
(See page EG2–309)
(2) Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminal ACV of ECM
connector and body ground.
Voltage: 9 –14 V
Check for open and short in harness and
connector between EFI main relay and
ECM (See page IN–31).
Check air hose and air pipe (See page EG2–295).
Repair or replace.
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
EG2–575
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Fuel Pump Control Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Fuel pump control
The fuel pump is switched on (low voltage at terminal FC) when STA is on or while the NE signal is input
to the ECM.
In the diagram below, when the engine is cranked, current flows from terminal ST of the ignition switch
to the starter relay coil, the starter relay switches on and current flows to coil L1 of the circuit opening relay.
Thus the circuit opening relay switches on, power is supplied to the fuel pump and the fuel pump operates.
When the STA signal and NE signal are input to the ECM, Tr is turned ON, current flows to coil L2 of the
circuit opening relay, the relay switches on and the fuel pump operates.
While the NE signal is generated (engine running), the ECM keeps Tr ON (circuit opening relay ON) and
the fuel pump also keeps operating.
EG2–576
1MZ–FE ENGINE
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
EG2–577
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
TOYOTA hand – held tester
Check fuel pump operation.
Go to step
Check for ECM power source circuit.
Repair or replace.
Check fuel pump.
Repair or replace fuel pump.
Check for open in harness and connector between terminal
FP of DLC1 and fuel pump. fuel pump and body ground.
Connect the TOYOTA hand – held tester and check
operation of fuel pump.
Go to step
Check circuit opening relay.
Replace circuit opening relay.
Check voltage terminal FC.
Check and replace ECM.
Check for open in harness and connector between ER
main relay and circuit opening relay, circuit opening relay
and ECM.
EG2–578
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check circuit opening relay.
Replace circuit opening relay.
Check voltage terminal 3 of circuit opening relay.
Check for starter signal circuit.
Check for open in harness and connector between terminal
6 of circuit opening relay and body ground,
EG2–579
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
OBD ll scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand – held tester)
Check fuel pump operation.
Go to step
Check for ECM power source circuit.
Repair or replace.
Check fuel pump.
Repair or replace fuel pump.
Check for open in harness and connector between terminal
FP of DLC1 and fuel pump, fuel pump and body ground.
Check circuit opening relay.
Replace circuit opening relay.
Check voltage terminal FC.
Check and replace ECM.
Check for open in harness and connector between
EFI main relay and ECM.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check voltage terminal 3 of circuit opening relay.
Check for starter signal circuit.
Check for open in harness and connector between terminal
6 of circuit opening relay and body ground.
EG2–580
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
TOYOTA hand–held tester
Check fuel pump operation.
(1) Be sure that enough fuel is in the tank.
(2) Turn ignition switch ON.
(3) Using SST, connect terminals FP and + B of
DLC 1,
SST 09843–18020
Check that pulsation damper screw rises up when
terminals are connected.
Never make a mistake with the terminal connec–
tion position as this will cause a malfunction.
The pulsation damper screw rises up.
Go to step
Check for ECM power source circuit (See page EG2–565).
Repair or replace.
Check fuel pump (See page EG2–234).
Repair or replace fuel pump.
Check for open in harness and connector between
terminal FP of DLC 1 and fuel pump, fuel pump
and body ground (See page IN–31).
EG2–581
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester and check operation of fuel
pump.
(1) Remove the fuse cover on the instrument
panel.
(2) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the
DLC 3.
(3) Turn ignition switch ON and TOYOTA hand–
held tester main switch ON.
(4) Select the active test mode on the TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
Check that pulsation damper screw rises up when
fuel pump is on by TOYOTA hand–held tester.
The pulsation damper screw rises up.
Go to step
EG2–582
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check circuit opening relay.
Remove circuit opening relay from R/B No.6.
(1) Apply battery voltage between terminals 2
and 4.
(2) Measure voltage between terminals 1 and 4.
Terminals 1 and 4
Same as battery
Replace circuit opening relay.
Check voltage between terminal FC of ECM and body ground.
(1) Remove glove compartment (see page
EG2–309).
(2) Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminal FC of ECM and
body ground.
Voltage: 9 –14 V
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
Check for open in harness and connector between
EFI main relay and circuit opening relay, circuit
opening relay and ECM (See page IN–31).
EG2–583
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check circuit opening relay.
(1) Remove glove compartment
(See page EG2–309).
(2) Remove circuit opening relay from R/B No.6.
(1) Apply battery voltage between terminals 3
and 6.
(2) Check continuity between terminals 1 and 2.
Terminals 1 and 2
Continuity
Replace circuit opening relay.
Check voltage between terminal 3 of R/B No.6 (for circuit opening
relay) and body ground.
Measure voltage between terminal 3 of R/B No.6
(for circuit opening relay) and body ground when
engine is cranked.
Voltage: 9 –14 V
Check for starter signal circuit
(See page EG2–557).
Check for open in harness and connector
between terminal 6 of R/6 No.6 (for circuit
opening relay) and body ground (See page IN–31).
EG2–584
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
OBDII scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
Check fuel pump operation (See page EG2–580, step
Go to step
Check for ECM power source circuit (See page EG2–565).
Repair or replace.
Check fuel pump (See page EG2–234).
Repair or replace fuel pump.
Check for open in harness and connector
between terminal FP of DLC1 and fuel pump,
fuel pump and body ground (See page IN–31).
Check circuit opening relay.
(1) Remove glove compartment
(See page EG2–309).
(2) Remove circuit opening relay from R/B No.6.
Check continuity between terminals of circuit
opening relay shown below.
Terminals 1 and 2
Open
Terminals 3 and 6
Continuity
(Reference value 30)
(1) Apply battery voltage between terminals 3
and 6.
(2) Check continuity between terminals 1 and 2.
Terminals 1 and 2
Continuity
Replace circuit opening relay.
EG2–585
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check voltage between terminal FC of ECM and body ground
(Seepage EG2–582, step 6 .
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
Check for open in harness and connector between ER main relay and
circuit opening relay, circuit opening relay and ECM (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check voltage between terminal 3 of R/B No–6 (for circuit opening
relay) and body ground (See page EG2–583, step 8 ).
Check for starter signal circuit
(See page EG2–557).
Check for open in harness and connector
between terminal 6 of circuit opening relay and
body ground (See page IN–31).
EG2–586
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Fuel Pressure Control VSV Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ECM turns on a VSV (Vacuum Switching
Valve) to draw the air into the diaphragm chamber
of the pressure regulator if it detects that the temper–
ature of the engine coolant is too high during engine
starting.
The air drawn into the chamber increases the fuel
pressure to prevent fuel vapor lock at high engine
temperature in order to help the engine start when it
is warm.
Fuel pressure control ends approx. 120 sec. after the
engine is started.
WIRING DIAGRAM
EG2–587
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
TOYOTA hand–held tester
Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester and check
operation of fuel pressure control VSV.
Check and repair fuel pressure regulator.
Check fuel pressure control VSV.
Replace fuel pressure control VSV.
Check for open and short in harness and connector
between EFI main relay and ECM.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECM.
OBDII scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
Check fuel pressure control VSV.
Replace fuel pressure control VSV.
Check voltage between terminal FPU and body
ground.
Check and repair harness or connector.
Check fuel pressure regulator.
Repair or replace.
Check and replace ECM.
EG2–588
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
TOYOTA hand–held tester
Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester and check operation of fuel
pressure control VSV.
(1) Remove the fuse cover on the instrument
panel.
(2) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the
DLC 3.
(3) Turn ignition switch ON and TOYOTA hand–
held tester main switch ON.
(4) Select the active test mode on the TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
Check operation of fuel pressure control VSV
when fuel pressure control VSV is operated by the
TOYOTA hand–held tester.
Fuel pressure control VSV is ON:
The air from pipe E is flowing out through the air
filter.
Fuel pressure control VSV is OFF:
The air from pipe E is flowing out through pipe
G.
Check and repair fuel pressure regulator
(See page EG2–240).
EG2–589
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check fuel pressure control VSV.
(1) Remove fuel pressure control VSV.
(2) Disconnect fuel pressure control VSV con–
nector.
(1) Measure resistance between terminals.
(2) Measure resistance between each terminal
and the body.
(1) Resistance: 26 – 46 at 20C (68F)
(2) Resistance: 1 M or higher
Check operation of fuel pressure control VSV
when battery positive voltage is applied to the ter–
minals of fuel pressure control VSV connector or
not.
Battery positive voltage is applied:
The air from pipe E is flowing out through the air
filter.
Battery positive voltage is not applied:
The air from pipe E is flowing out through pipe
G.
Replace fuel pressure control VSV.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between EFI
main relay and ECM (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
EG2–590
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
OBDII scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
Check fuel pressure control VSV (See page EG2–589, step
Replace fuel pressure control VSV.
Check voltage between terminal FPU of ECM connector and
body ground.
(1) Remove glove compartment
(See page EG2–309).
(2) Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminal FPU of ECM
connector and body ground.
Voltage: 9 –14 V
Check for open and short in harness and
connector between EFI main relay and
ECM (See page IN–31).
Check fuel pressure regulator (See page EG2–240).
Repair or replace.
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
EG2–591
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
AC Cut Control Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit cuts air conditioning operation during vehicle acceleration in order to increase acceleration
performance. During acceleration with the vehicle speed at 25 km/h (16 mph) or less, engine speed at
1,600 rpm or less and throttle valve opening angle at 60 or more, the A/C magnet switch is turned OFF
for several seconds.
WIRING DIAGRAM
EG2–592
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
TOYOTA hand–held tester
Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester and check
operation of air conditioning cut control.
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart.
Check for open and short in harness and connector
between ECM and A/C amplifier.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check voltage terminal ACT.
Check and replace A/C amplifier.
Check and replace ECM.
OBDII scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
Check voltage terminal ACT.
Check and replace ECM.
Check for open and short in harness and connector
between ECM and A/C amplifier.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace A/C amplifier.
EG2–593
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
TOYOTA hand–held tester
Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester and check operation of air
conditioning cut control.
(1) Remove the fuse cover on the instrument
panel.
(2) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the
DLC3.
(3) Turn ignition switch ON and TOYOTA hand–
held tester main switch ON.
(4) Start the engine and air conditioning switch
ON.
HINT: A/C magnet clutch is turned ON.
(5) Select the active test mode on the TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
Check operation of A/C magnet clutch cut when
air conditioning cut control is operated by the
TOYOTA hand–held tester.
A/C magnet clutch is turned OFF.
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown
on matrix chart (See page EG2–435).
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM
and A/C amplifier (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check voltage between terminal ACT of ECM and body ground.
(1) Remove glove compartment
(See page EG2–309).
(2) Start the engine.
Measure voltage between terminal ACT of ECM
connector and body ground when A/C switch is
turned to ON and OFF.
A/C switch condition
Voltage
4.5 – 5.5 V
OFF
0 –2 V
Check and replace A/C amplifier.
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
EG2–594
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
OBDII scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
Check voltage between terminal ACT of ECM and body ground
(See page EG2–593, step 3 .
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM
and A/C amplifier (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace A/C amplifier.
EG2–595
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
IACV Control VSV Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit opens and closes the IACV (Intake Air Control Valve) in response to the engine load in order
to increase the intake efficiency (ACIS: Acoustic Control Induction System).
When the engine speed is 3,700 rpm or less and the throttle valve opening angle is 60 or more, the ECM
turns the VSV ON and closes the IACV. At all other times, the VSV is OFF, so the IACV is open.
WIRING DIAGRAM
EG2–596
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
TOYOTA hand–held tester
Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester and check
operation of IACV control VSV.
Check for vacuum tank.
Check IACV control VSV.
Replace IACV control VSV.
Check for open and short in harness and connector
between EFI main relay and ECM.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECM.
OBDII scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
Check IACV control VSV.
Replace IACV control VSV.
Check voltage between terminal ACIS and body
ground.
Check and repair harness or connector.
Check vacuum tank.
Repair or replace.
Check and replace ECM.
EG2–597
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
TOYOTA hand–held tester
Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester and check operation of IACV
control VSV.
(1) Remove the fuse cover on the instrument
panel.
(2) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the
D LC3.
(3) Turn ignition switch ON and TOYOTA hand–
held tester main switch ON.
(4) Select the active test mode on the TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
Check operation of IACV control VSV when IACV
control VSV is operated by TOYOTA hand–held
tester.
IACV control VSV is ON:
The air from port E is flowing out through port F.
IACV control VSV is OFF:
The air from port E is flowing through the air
filter.
Check for
EG2–277).
vacuum
tank
(See
page
EG2–598
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Check IACV control VSV.
(1) Remove IACV control VSV.
(2) Disconnect IACV control VSV connector.
(1) Measure resistance between terminals.
(2) Measure resistance between each terminal
and the body.
(1) Resistance: 26 – 46 at 20C (68F)
(2) Resistance: 1 M or higher.
Check operation of IACV control VSV when bat–
tery positive voltage is applied to the terminals of
IACV control VSV connector or not.
Battery positive voltage is applied:
The air from pipe E is following out through pipe
F.
Battery positive voltage is not applied:
The air from pipe E is flowing out through the air
filter.
Replace IACV control VSV.
Check for open and short in harness and connector between EFI
main relay and ECM (See page IN–31).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
EG2–599
1MZ–FE ENGINE
–
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
OBDII scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
Check IACV control VSV (See page EG2–598, step 2)
Replace IACV control VSV.
Check voltage between terminal ACIS of ECM connector and
body ground.
(1) Remove glove compartment
(See page EG2–309).
(2) Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminal ACIS of ECM
connector and body ground.
Voltage: 9 –14 V
Check for open and short in harness and
connector between EFI main relay and
ECM (Seepage IN–31).
Check for vacuum tank (See page EG2–277).
Repair or replace.
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–36).
IG–1
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
IGNITION SYSTEM
IG–2
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE California)
(5S–FE California)
DESCRIPTION
The engine control module (ECM) is programmed with data for optimum ignition timing unndr all
operating conditions. Using data provided by sensors which monitor various engine functions
(rpm, intake air volume, engine temperature, etc.), the ECM triggers the spark at precisely the
right instant.
The ECM monitors the engine condition by signals from each sensor, calculates the ignition
timing and sends an ignition signal to the igniter. High voltage from the ignition is distributed to
each spark plug in the appropriate order to generate a spark between the electrodes, which
ignites the air–fuel mixture.
IGNITER
The igniter temporarily interrupts the primary current with the ignition signal (lGT signal) from the
ECM and generates sparks at the spark plug. Also, as a fail–safe measure, when ignition occurs
an ignition confirmation signal (IGF signal) is sent to the ECM.
IGNITION COIL
The ignition coil uses a closed core coil with the primary coil wrapped around the core and the
secondary coil wrapped around the primary coil. This allows the generation of a high voltage
sufficient to cause a spark to jump across the spark plug gap.
DISTRIBUTOR
This correctly distributes high voltage to the spark plug of each cylinder in the specified ignition
order.
PICKUP COILS
The NE coil detects the crankshaft angle, and the G 1 and G2 coils detect the camshaft position.
IG–3
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE California)
PRECAUTION
1. Do not leave the ignition switch on for more than 10
minutes if the engine does not start.
2. With a tachometer connected to the system, con–
nect the tester probe of the tachometer to terminal
IG(–) of the data link connector 1.
3. As some tachometers are not compatible with this
ignition system, we recommend that you confirm
the compatibility of yours before use.
4. Never allow the tachometer terminals to touch
ground as it could result in damage to the igniter
and/or ignition coil.
Do not disconnect the battery while the engine is
running.
6. Check that the igniter is properly grounded to the
body.
IG–4
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE California)
SYSTEM CIRCUIT
OPERATION
To maintain the most appropriate ignition timing, the ECM sends a control signal so that the
igniter sends current to the ignition coil and the spark plugs produce a spark.
IG–5
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE California)
PREPARATION
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
09240–00020 Wire Gauge Set
Air gap
09843–18020 Diagnosis Check Wire
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082–00050 TOYOTA Electrical Tester Set
09200–00010 Engine Adjust Kit
EQUIPMENT
Spark plug cleaner
Tachometer
Timing light
Ignition timing
IG–6
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE California)
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
SPARK TEST
CHECK THAT SPARK OCCURS
(a) Disconnect the high–tension cord (from the ignition
coil) from the distributor cap.
(b) Hold the end approx. 12.5 mm (0.50 in.) from the body
ground.
(c) See if spark occurs while engine is being cranked.
HINT: To prevent gasoline from being injected from
injectors during this test, crank the engine for no more
than 1–2 seconds at time.
If the spark does not occur, perform the test as fol–
lows:
SPARK TEST
CHECK CONNECTION OF IGNITION COIL,
IGNITER AND DISTRIBUTOR CONNECTOR
CHECK RESISTANCE OF HIGH–TENSION
CORD (See Page IG–7)
Maximum resistance: 25 k per cord
CHECK POWER SUPPLY TO IGNITION
COIL AND IGNITER
1. Turn ignition switch to ON.
2. Check that there is battery voltage at
ignition coil positive (+) terminal.
CHECK RESISTANCE OF IGNITION COIL
See page IG–10)
Resistance: Cold Hot
Primary 0.36–0.55 0 0.45–0.65
Secondary 9.0–15.4 k 11.4–18.1 k
CHECK RESISTANCE OF SIGNAL
GENERATOR (PICKUP COIL)
See page (IG–12)
Resistance: Cold HotG1 and G–125–200160–235
G 2 and G–125–200160–235
N E and G–155–250190–290
Connect securely.
BAD
Replace the cord
BAD
Check wiring between ignition switch
to ignition coil and igniter.
BAD
Replace the ignition coil.
BAD
Replace the distributor housing
assembly.
BAD
CHECK AIR GAP OF DISTRIBUTOR
(See page IG–11 )
Air gap: 0.2–0.5 mm (0.008–0.020 in.)
BAD
CHECK IGT SIGNAL FROM ECM
(See page EG–344)
BAD
TRY ANOTHER IGNITER
(s).
Replace the distributor housing
assembly.
Check wiring between ECM, distributor
and igniter, only then try another ECM.
IG–7
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE California)
HIGH–TENSION CORDS INSPECTION
1. DISCONNECT HIGH–TENSION CORDS FROM
SPARK PLUGS
Disconnect the high–tension cords at the rubber
boot. Do not pull on the high–tension cords.
NOTICE: Pulling on or bending the cords may damage the
conductor inside.
2. DISCONNECT HIGH–TENSION CORD FROM
IGNITION COIL
3. DISCONNECT HIGH–TENSION CORDS FROM
DISTRIBUTOR CAP
4. INSPECT HIGH–TENSION CORD RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance.
Maximum resistance:
25 k per cord .
If the resistance is greater than maximum, check the
terminals. If necessary, replace the high–tension
cord.
6. RECONNECT HIGH–TENSION CORDS TO
DISTRIBUTOR CAP
6. RECONNECT HIGH–TENSION CORD TO IGNITION
COIL
7. RECONNECT HIGH–TENSION CORDS TO SPARK
PLUGS
IG–8
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE California)
SPARK PLUGS INSPECTION
NOTICE:
• Never use a wire brush for cleaning.
• Never attempt to adjust the electrode gap on a used
spark plug.
• Spark plugs should be replaced every 100.000 km
(60.000 miles).
1. DISCONNECT HIGH–TENSION CORDS FROM
SPARK PLUGS
Disconnect the high–tension cords at the rubber
boot. Do not pull on the cords.
NOTICE: Pulling on or bending the cords may damage the
conductor inside.
2. INSPECT ELECTRODE
Using a megger (insulation resistance meter), measure
the insulation resistance.
Standard correct insulation resistance:
10 M or more
If the resistance is less than specified, proceed to step
4.
HINT: If a megger is not available, the following simple
method of inspection provides fairly accurate results.
Simple Method:
(a) Quickly race the engine to 4,000 rpm 5 times.
(b) Remove the spark plug. (See step 4)
(c) Visually check the spark plug.
If the electrode is dry ... OK
If the electrode is wet ... Proceed to step 5
(d) Reinstall the spark plug. (See step 8)
3. REMOVE SPARK PLUGS
Using a 16 mm plug wrench, remove the 4 spark
plugs.
IG–9
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE California)
4. VISUALLY INSPECT SPARK PLUGS
Check the spark plug for thread damage and insulator
damage.
If abnormal, replace the spark plug.
Recommended spark plug:
PK20R11 for ND
BKR6EP11 for NGK
5. INSPECT ELECTRODE GAP
Maximum electrode gap for used spark plug:
1.3 mm (0.051 In.)
If the gap is greater than maximum, replace the spark
plug.
Correct electrode gap for new spark plug:
1.1 m m (0.043 in.)
NOTICE: if adjusting the gap of a new spark plug, bend
only the base of the ground electrode. Do not touch the
tip. Never attempt to adjust the gap on the used plug.
6. CLEAN SPARK PLUGS
If the electrode has traces of wet carbon, allow it to
dry and then clean with a spark plug cleaner.
Air pressure:
Below 588 kPa (6 kgf/cm2, 85 psi)
Duration:
20 seconds or less
HINT: If there are traces of oil, remove it with gasoline
before using the spark plug cleaner.
7. REINSTALL SPARK PLUGS
Using a 16 mm plug wrench, install the 4 spark plugs.
Torque: 18 N–m (180 k9f–cm. 13 ft–lbf)
8. RECONNECT HIGH–TENSION CORDS T4 SPARK
PLUGS
IG–10
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE California)
IGNITION COIL INSPECTION
NOTICE: ’Cold’ and ’Hot’ in the following sentences ex–
press the temperature of the coils themselves. ’Cold’ is
from–10C (14F) to 50C (122F) and ’Hot’ is from
60C
(122” F) to 100C (212F).
1. DISCONNECT IGNITION COIL CONNECTOR
2. DISCONNECT HIGH–TENSION CORD FROM
IGNITION COIL
3. INSPECT PRIMARY COIL RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
the positive (+) and negative (–) terminals.
Primary coil resistance (Cold):
0.36–0.55
Primary coil resistance (Hot):
0.45–O.65
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the igni–
tion coil.
4. INSPECT SECONDARY COIL RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
the positive (+) and high–tension terminals.
Secondary coil resistance (Cold):
9.0–15.4 k
Secondary coil resistance (Hot):
11.4–18.1 k
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the igni–
tion coil.
6. RECONNECT HIGH–TENSION CORD TO IGNITION
COIL
6. RECONNECT IGNITION COIL CONNECTOR
IG–11
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE California)
DISTRIBUTOR INSPECTION
NOTICE: ’Cold’ and “Hot’ in the following sentences ex–
press the temperature of the coils themselves. ’Cold’ is
from–10C (14F) to 50C (122F) and ’Hot’ is from
50C (122F) to 100C (212F).
1. REMOVE DISTRIBUTOR CAP
Remove the 2 bolts, and disconnect the distributor
cap from the distributor housing.
2. REMOVE ROTOR
3. REMOVE DUSTPROOF COVER
4. INSPECT AIR GAP
Using SST (G1 and G2 pickups) and a feeler gauge (NE
pickup), measure the air gap between the signal rotor
and pickup coil projection.
SST 09240–00020 for G 1 and G2 pickups
Air gap:
0.2–0.5 mm (0.008–0.020 in.)
If the air gap is not as specified, replace the distributor
housing assembly.
6. DISCONNECT DISTRIBUTOR CONNECTOR
6. REMOVE DISTRIBUTOR HOUSING ASSEMBLY
Remove the bolt, pull out the distributor housing.
IG–12
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE California)
7. INSPECT SIGNAL GENERATOR (PICKUP COIL)
RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
terminals.
Pickup coil resistance (Cold):
G1 and GE)
125–200
G2 and G(–)
125–200
NE and G(–)
155–2500
Pickup coil resistance (Hot):
G 1 and G(–)
160–235
G2 and G(–)
160–235
NE and G(–)
190–290
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the distributor
housing assembly.
8. REINSTALL DISTRIBUTOR HOUSING ASSEMBLY
(See steps 1 and 2 on pages IG–17 and 18)
9. RECONNECT DISTRIBUTOR CONNECTOR
10. REINSTALL DUSTPROOF COVER
11. REINSTALL ROTOR
12. REINSTALL DISTRIBUTOR CAP
Install a new packing and distributor cap with the 2
bolts.
13. ADJUST IGNITION TIMING
(See page IG–19)
IGNITER INSPECTION
(See Spark Test procedure on page IG–6)
IG–13
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE California)
DISTRIBUTOR
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
DISTRIBUTOR REMOVAL
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the Ignition switch Is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nacted from the battery.
2. DISCONNECT ACCELERATOR CABLE FROM
THROTTLE BODY
IG–14
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE California)
3. REMOVE AIR CLEANER CAP, RESONATOR AND
AIR CLEANER HOSE
(a) Disconnect the intake air temperature sensor connec–
tor.
(b) Disconnect the air hose from the air cleaner hose.
(c) Loosen the air cleaner hose clamp bolt.
(d) Disconnect the 4 air cleaner cap clips.
(e) Disconnect the air cleaner hose from the throttle
body, and remove the air cleaner cap together with
the resonator and air cleaner hose.
4. DISCONNECT DISTRIBUTOR CONNECTOR
5. DISCONNECT NIGH–TENSION CORD FROM
IGNITION COIL
6. DISCONNECT HIGH–TENSION CORDS FROM
SPARK PLUGS
(a) Disconnect the high–tension cords from the cord
clamps.
(b) Disconnect the 4 high–tension cords from the spark
plugs.
Disconnect the high–tension cords at the rubber
boot. Do not pull on the high–tension cords.
NOTICE: Pulling on or bending the cords may damage the
conductor Inside.
7. REMOVE DISTRIBUTOR
(a) Remove the hold–down bolt, and pull out the distrib–
utor.
(b) Remove the 0–ring from the distributor housing.
IG–15
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE California)
COMPONENTS FOR DISASSEMBLY AND
ASSEMBLY
DISTRIBUTOR DISASSEMBLY
(See Components for Disassembly and Assembly)
1. REMOVE DISTRIBUTOR CAP
Remove the 2 bolts, distributor cap and packing.
2.REMOVE ROTOR
Remove the 2 screws and rotor.
IG–16
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE California)
3. REMOVE DUST PROOF COVER
(a) Remove the dust proof seal.
(b) Remove the dust proof cover.
DISTRIBUTOR INSPECTION
INSPECT SHAFT
Turn the shaft and check that it is not rough or worn.
If it feels rough or worn, replace the distributor hous–
ing assembly.
DISTRIBUTOR ASSEMBLY
(See Components for Disassembly and Assembly)
1. INSTALL DUST PROOF COVER
(a) Install the dust proof cover.
(b) Install the dust proof.seal.
IG–17
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE California)
2. INSTALL ROTOR
(a) Align the hollow of the signal rotor with the protrusion
of the rotor.
(b) Install the rotor with the 2 screws.
3. INSTALL DISTRIBUTOR CAP
(a) Install a new packing to the distributor housing.
(b) Install the distributor cap with the 2 bolts.
DISTRIBUTOR INSTALLATION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. SET NO. 1 CYLINDER TO TDC/COMPRESSION
Turn the crankshaft clockwise, and position the slit of
the intake camshaft as shown in the illustration.
IG–18
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE California)
2. INSTALL DISTRIBUTOR
(a) Install a new O–ring to the housing.
(b) Apply a light coat of engine oil on the 0–ring.
(c) Align the cutout of the coupling with the line of the
housing.
(d) Insert the distributor, aligning the center of the flange
with that of bolt hole on the cylinder head.
(e) Lightly tighten the hold–down bolt.
(f) Connect the high–tension cords to the clamp on the
cylinder head cover.
3. CONNECT HIGH–TENSION CORDS TO SPARK
PLUGS
Firing order:
1–3–4–2
4. CONNECT HIGH–TENSION CORD TO IGNITION
COIL
5. CONNECT DISTRIBUTOR CONNECTOR
6. INSTALL AIR CLEANER CAP, RESONATOR AND
AIR CLEANER HOSE
(a) Connect the air cleaner hose to the throttle body.
(b) Install the air cleaner cap together with the resonator
and air cleaner hose.
(c) Connect the air hose to the air cleaner hose.
(d) Connect the intake air temperature sensor connector.
IG–19
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE California)
7. CONNECT AND ADJUST ACCELERATOR CABLE
8. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE TO
BATTERY
9. WARM UP ENGINE
Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating
temperature.
10. CONNECT TACHOMETER AND TIMING LIGHT TO
ENGINE
Connect the test probe of a tachometer to terminal IGE) of the
data link connector 1.
NOTICE:
• NEVER allow the tachometer terminal to touch
ground as It could result In damage to the igniter
and/or ignition coil.
• As some tachometers are not compatible with this
ignition system, we recommend that you confirm
the compatibility of yours before use. .
11. ADJUST IGNITION TIMING
(a) Using SST, connect terminals TE1 and E1 of the data
link connector 1.
SST 09843–18020
HINT: After engine speed is kept at 1,000–1,300
rpm for 5 seconds, check that it returns to idle speed.
(b) Using a timing light, check the ignition timing.
Ignition timing:
10 BTDC 0 idle
(Transmission in neutral position)
IG–20
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE California)
(c) Loosen the hold–down bolt, and adjust by turning
the distributor.
(d) Tighten the hold–down bolt, and recheck the ignition
timing.
Torque: 19 N–m (195 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
(e) Remove the SST.
SST 09843–18020
12. FURTHER CHECK IGNITION TIMING
Ignition timing:
0–10 BTDC 0 idle
(Transmission in neutral position)
HINT: The timing mark moves in a range between 0
and 10.
13. DISCONNECT TACHOMETER AND TIMING LIGHT
FROM ENGINE
IG–21
IGNITION SYSTEM
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE DATA
Ignition timing
w/ Terminals TE1 and E1 connected of DLC1
Firing order
High–tension
cord
Resistance
Spark plug
Recommended spark plug
Ignition coil
Correct electrode gap
Primary coil resistance
Secondary coil resistance
Distributor
Air gap
Pickup coil resistance
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part tightened
Spark plug x Cylinder head
Distributor x Cylinder head
–
(5S–FE California)
IG–22
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE Except California)
(5S–FE Except California)
DESCRIPTION
The engine control module (ECM) is programmed with data for optimum ignition timing under all
operating conditions. Using data provided by sensors which monitor various engine functions
(rpm, intake air volume, engine temperature, etc.), the ECM triggers the spark at precisely the
right instant.
The ECM monitors the engine condition by signals from each sensor, calculates the ignition
timing and sends an ignition signal to the igniter. High voltage from the ignition is distributed to
each spark plug in the appropriate order to generate a spark between the electrodes, which
ignites the air–fuel mixture.
IGNITER
The igniter temporarily interrupts the primary current with the ignition signal (lGT signal) from the
ECM and generates sparks at the spark plug. Also, as a fail–safe measure, when ignition occurs
an ignition confirmation signal (IGF signal) is sent to the ECM.
IGNITION COIL
The ignition coil uses a closed core coil with the primary coil wrapped around the core and the
secondary coil wrapped around the primary coil. This allows the generation of a high voltage
sufficient to cause a spark to jump across the spark plug gap.
DISTRIBUTOR
This correctly distributes high voltage to the spark plug of each cylinder in the specified ignition
order.
The NE coil detects the crankshaft position, and the G coil detects the camshaft position.
The NE coil detects the crankshaft position, and the G coil detects the camshaft position.
IG–23
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE Except California)
PRECAUTION
1. Do not leave the ignition switch on for more then 10
minutes if the engine does not start.
2. With a tachometer connected to the system, con–
nect the test probe of the tachometer to terminal IG
of the data link connector 1.
3. As some tachometers are not compatible with this
ignition system, we recommend that you confirm
the compatibility of yours before use.
4. NEVER allow the tachometer terminals to touch
ground as it could result in damage to the igniter
and/or ignition coil.
6. Do not disconnect the battery while the engine is
running.
6. Check that the igniter is properly grounded to the
body.
IG–24
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE Except California)
SYSTEM CIRCUIT
OPERATION
To maintain the most appropriate ignition timing, the ECM sends a control signal so that the
igniter sends current to the ignition coil and the spark plugs produce a spark.
IG–25
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE Except California)
PREPARATION
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
09843–18020 Diagnosis Check
Wire
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082–00050 TOYOTA Electrical Tester Set
09200–00010 Engine Adjust Kit
EQUIPMENT
Megger insulation resistance meter
Insulation resistance meter
Spark plug cleaner
Tachometer
Ignition timing
Timing light
SSM (SPECIAL SERVICE MATERIALS)
08826–00080 Seal packing or
equivalent
Ignition coil
IG–26
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE Except California)
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
SPARK TEST
CHECK THAT SPARK OCCURS
(a) Disconnect the high–tension cords from the spark
plugs. (See page IG–28)
(b) Remove the spark plugs. (See page IG–28)
(c) Install the spark plugs to the each high–tension cord.
(d) Ground the spark plug.
(e) Check if spark occurs while engine is being cranked.
HINT: To prevent gasoline from being injected from
injectors during this test, crank the engine for no more
than 1–2 seconds at a time. If the spark does not
occur, perform the test as follows:
SPARK TEST
CHECK CONNECTION OF DISTRIBUTOR
CONNECTORS
CHECK RESISTANCE OF HIGH–TENSION
CORD (See page IG–27)
Maximum resistance: 25 k per cord
CHECK POWER SUPPLY TO IGNITION
COIL
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Check that there is battery voltage at
ignition coil positive (+) terminal.
CHECK RESISTANCE OF IGNITION COIL
(See page IG–30)
Resistance: Cold
Hot
Primary 0.36–0.55 0.45–0.65
Secondary 9.0–15.4 k 11.4–18.1 k
CHECK RESISTANCE OF SIGNAL
GENERATOR (PICKUP COIL)
(See page IG–31)
Resistance: Cold Hot
G (+) and IG (–) 185–275 240–325
N E (+) and NE (–) 370–550 475–650
Connect securely.
BAD
Replace the cord (s) .
BAD
Check wiring between ignition switch
and ignition coil.
BAD
Replace the ignition coil.
BAD
Replace distributor housing assembly.
BAD
CHECK AIR GAP OF DISTRIBUTOR
(See page IG–30)
Air gap: 0.2–0.4 mm (0.008–0.016 in.)
BAD
CHECK IGT SIGNAL FROM ECM
(See page EG–344)
BAD
TRY ANOTHER IGNITER
Replace the distributor housing
assembly.
Check wiring between ECM, distributor
and igniter, and then try another ECM.
IG–27
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE Except California)
HIGH–TENSION CORDS INSPECTION
1. DISCONNECT HIGH–TENSION CORDS FROM
SPARK PLUGS
Disconnect the high–tension cords at the rubber
boot.
DO NOT pull on the cords.
NOTICE: Pulling on or bending the cords may damage the
conductor inside.
2. DISCONNECT HIGH–TENSION CORDS FROM
DISTRIBUTOR CAP
3. INSPECT HIGH–TENSION CORD RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance.
Maximum resistance:
25 k per cord
If the resistance is greater than maximum, check the
terminals. If necessary, replace the high–tension
cord.
4. RECONNECT HIGH–TENSION CORDS TO
DISTRIBUTOR CAP
5. RECONNECT HIGH–TENSION CORDS TO SPARK
PLUGS .
IG–28
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE Except California)
SPARK PLUGS INSPECTION
NOTICE:
•
•
Never use e wire brush for cleaning.
Never attempt to adjust the electrode gap on a used
spark plug.
•
Spark plugs should be replaced every 100.000 km
(60.000 miles).
1. DISCONNECT HIGH–TENSION CORDS FROM
SPARK PLUGS
2. INSPECT ELECTRODE
Using a megger (insulation resistance meter), measure
the insulation resistance.
Standard correct insulation resistance:
10 M or more
If the resistance is less than specified, proceed to step
3.
HINT: If a megger is not available, the following simple
method of inspection provides fairly accurate results.
Simple Method:
(a) Quickly race the engine to 4,000 rpm 5 times.
(b) Remove the spark plug. (See step 3)
(c) Visually check the spark plug.
If the electrode is dry ... OK
If the electrode is wet ... Proceed to step 4
(d) Reinstall the spark plug.
(See step 7 on page IG–29)
3. REMOVE SPARK PLUGS
Using a 16 mm plug wrench, remove the spark plug.
IG–29
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE Except California)
4. VISUALLY INSPECT SPARK PLUGS
Check the spark plug for thread damage and insulator
damage.
If abnormal, replace the spark plug.
Recommended spark plug:
PK20R 11 for N D
BKR6EP11 for NGK
5. INSPECT ELECTRODE GAP
Maximum electrode gap:
1.3 mm (0.051 in.)
If the gap is greater than maximum, replace the spark
plug.
Correct electrode gap of new spark plug:
1.1 mm (0.043 in.)
NOTICE: If adjusting the gap of a new spark plug, bend
only the base of the ground electrode. Do not touch the
tip. Never attempt to adjust the gap on the used plug.
6. CLEAN SPARK PLUGS
If the electrode has traces of wet carbon, allow it to
dry and then clean with a spark plug cleaner.
Air pressure:
Below 588 kPa (6 kgf/cm2, 85 psi)
Duration:
20 seconds or less
HINT: If there are traces of oil, remove it with gasoline
before using the spark plug cleaner.
7. INSTALL SPARK PLUGS
Using a 16 mm plug wrench, install the spark plug.
Torque: 18 N–m (180 kgf–cm, 13 ft–lbf)
8. RECONNECT HIGH–TENSION CORDS TO SPARK
PLUGS
IG–30
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE Except California)
DISTRIBUTOR INSPECTION
NOTICE: ’Cold’ and ’Hot’ in the following sentences ex–
press the temperature of the coils themselves. ’Cold’ is
from–10C (14F) to 50C (122F) and ’Hot’ is from
50C (122F) to 100C (212F).
1.
2.
3.
4.
DISCONNECT DISTRIBUTOR CONNECTORS
REMOVE DISTRIBUTOR CAP
REMOVE ROTOR
REMOVE IGNITION COIL DUST COVER
Ignition Coil
5. INSPECT PRIMARY COIL RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between–
the positive (+) and negative (–) terminals.
Primary coil resistance (Cold):
0.38–0.550
Primary coil resistance (Hot):
0.45–0.650
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the igni–
tion coil.
6. INSPECT SECONDARY COIL RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
positive (+) and high–tension terminals.
Secondary coil resistance (Cold):
9.0–15.4 k
Secondary coil resistance (Hot):
11.4–18.1 k
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the igni–
tion coil.
Distributor
7. INSPECT AIR GAP
Using a thickness gauge, measure the air gap between
the signal rotor and pickup coil projection.
Air gap:
0.2–0.4 mm (0.008–0.018 in.)
If the air gap is not as specified, replace the distributor
housing assembly.
IG–31
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE Except California)
8. INSPECT SIGNAL GENERATOR (PICKUP COIL)
RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
the terminals (G and G, NE and NE).
Pickup coil resistance (Cold):
G and G
185–2750
NE and NE
370–5500
Pickup coil resistance (Hot):
G and G
240–3250
NE and NE
475–6500
If the resestance is not as specified, replace the dis–
tributor housing assmebly.
9. REINSTALL IGNITION COIL DUST COVER
10. REINSTALL ROTOR
11. REINSTALL DISTRIBUTOR CAP
12. RECONNECT DISTRIBUTOR CONNECTORS
IGNITER INSPECTION
(See Spark Test procedure on page IG–26)
IG–32
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE Except California)
DISTRIBUTOR
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
DISTRIBUTOR REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch (: turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. DISCONNECT ACCELERATOR CABLE FROM
THROTTLE LINKAGE
IG–33
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE Except California)
3. REMOVE AIR CLEANER CAP, RESONATOR AND
AIR CLEANER HOSE
(a) Disconnect the intake air temperature sensor connec–
tor.
(b) Loosen the air cleaner hose clamp bolt.
(c) Disconnect the 4 air cleaner cap clips.
(d) Disconnect the air cleaner hose from the throttle
body, and remove the air cleaner cap together with
the resonator and air cleaner hose.
4. DISCONNECT DISTRIBUTOR CONNECTORS
5. DISCONNECT HIGH–TENSION CORDS FROM
SPARK PLUGS
(a) Disconnect the 4 high–tension cords from the spark
plugs.
(b) Disconnect the high–tension cords from the clamp
on the cylinder head cover.
6. REMOVE DISTRIBUTOR
(a) Remove the 2 hold–down bolts, and pull out the
distributor.
(b) Remove the 0–ring from the distributor housing.
IG–34
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE Except California)
COMPONENTS FOR DISASSEMBLY
AND ASSEMBLY
DISTRIBUTOR DISASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE DISTRIBUTOR CAP WITHOUT DISCONNECTING
HIGH–TENSION CORDS
2. REMOVE ROTOR
3. REMOVE IGNITION COIL DUST COVER
4. REMOVE IGNITION COIL
(a) Remove the 2 nuts, and disconnect the 3 wires from
the ignition coil terminals.
IG–35
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE Except California)
(b) Remove the 4 screws and ignition coil.
B. REMOVE DISTRIBUTOR WIRE
Remove the distributor wire from the distributor hous–
ing.
6. REMOVE CONDENSER
Remove the screw and condenser.
DISTRIBUTOR INSPECTION
INSPECT SHAFT
Turn the shaft and check that it is not rough or worn.
If it feels rough or worn, replace the distributor hous–
ing assembly.
DISTRIBUTOR ASSEMBLY
(See Components for Disassembly and Assembly)
1. INSTALL CONDENSER
Install the condenser with the screw.
IG–36
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE Except California)
2. INSTALL DISTRIBUTOR WIRE
Install the grommet of the wire to the distributor
housing.
3. INSTALL IGNITION COIL
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material.
(b) Apply seal packing to the ignition coil installing sur–
face of the housing as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing:
Part No. 08826–00080 or equivalent
(c) Install the ignition coil with the 4 screws.
(d) Connect the 3 wires to the ignition coil terminals with
the 2 nuts.
NOTICE:
•
When connecting the wires to the ignition coil.
insert both properly into their grooves found on the
side of the Ignition coil.
•
Be sure the wires do not contact with signal rotor or
distributor housing.
IG–37
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE Except California)
4. INSTALL IGNITION COIL DUST COVER
5. INSTALL ROTOR
6. INSTALL DISTRIBUTOR CAP AND HIGH–TENSION
CORDS
DISTRIBUTOR INSTALLATION
(See Components for Disassembly and Assembly)
1. SET NO. 1 CYLINDER TO TDC/COMPRESSION
Turn the crankshaft clockwise, and position the slit of
the intake camshaft as shown in the illustration.
2. INSTALL DISTRIBUTOR
(a) Install a new O–ring to the housing.
(b) Apply a light coat of engine oil on the 0–ring.
(c) Align the cutout of the coupling with the line of the
housing.
(d) Insert the distributor, aligning the center of the flange
with that of bolt hole on the cylinder head.
(e) Lightly tighten the 2 hold–down bolts.
(f) Connect the high–tension cords to the clamp on the
cylinder head cover. .
IG–38
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE Except California)
3. CONNECT HIGH–TENSION CORDS TO SPARK PLUGS
Firing order:
1–3–4–2
4. CONNECT DISTRIBUTOR CONNECTORS
5. INSTALL AIR CLEANER CAP, RESONATOR AND AIR
CLEANER HOSE
(a) Connect the air cleaner hose to the throttle body.
(b) Install the air cleaner cap together with the resonator
and air cleaner hose.
(c) Connect the intake air temperature sensor connector.
6. CONNECT AND ADJUST ACCELERATOR CABLE
7. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE TO BATTERY
8. WARM UP ENGINE
Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating
temperature.
9. CONNECT TACHOMETER
Connect the test probe of a tachometer to terminal IG
E) of the data link connector 1.
NOTICE:
•
NEVER allow the tachometer terminal to touch
ground as it could result in damage to the igniter
and/or ignition coil.
•
As some tachometers are not compatible with this
ignition system, we recommend that you confirm
the compatibility of yours before use.
10. ADJUST IGNITION TIMING
(a) Using SST, connect terminals TE 1 and E 1 of the data
link connector 1.
SST 09843–18020
HINT: After engine speed is kept at 1,000–1,300
rpm for 5 seconds, check that it returns to idle speed.
IG–39
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE Except California)
(b) Using a timing light, check the ignition timing.
Ignition timing:
10 BTDC 0 Idle
(Transmission In neutral position)
(c) Loosen the 2 hold–down bolts, and adjust by turning
the distributor.
(d) Tighten the hold–down bolts, and recheck the igni–
tion timing.
Torque: 19 N–m (195 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
(e) Remove the SST.
SST 09843–18020
11. FURTHER CHECK IGNITION TIMING
Ignition timing:
0–10 BTDC 0 idle
(Transmission In neutral position)
HINT: The timing mark moves in a range between 0
and 10.
12. DISCONNECT TACHOMETER AND TIMING LIGHT
FROM ENGINE
IG–40
IGNITION SYSTEM
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE DATA
Ignition timing
w/ Terminals TE1 end E1 connected of DLC1
Firing order
High–tension
cord
Resistance
Spark plug
Recommended spark plug
Correct electrode gap
Ignition coil
Primary coil resistance
Secondary coil resistance
Distributor
Air gap
Pickup coil resistance
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part tightened
Spark plug x Cylinder heed
Distributor x Cylinder head
–
(5S–FE Except California)
IG–41
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
(1 MZ–FE)
DESCRIPTION
The engine control module (ECM) is programmed with data for optimum ignition timing under all
operating conditions. Using data provided by sensors which monitor various engine functions
(RPM, intake air volume, engine temperature, etc.), the ECM triggers the spark at precisely the
right instant.
The ECM monitors the engine condition by signals from each sensor, calculates the ignition
timing and sends an ignition signal to the igniter. High voltage from the ignition is distributed to
each spark plug in the appropriate order to generate a spark between the electrodes, which
ignites the air–fuel mixture.
IGNITER
The igniter interrupts the primary current with the ignition signal (lGT signal) from the ECM and
generates sparks at the spark plug. Also, as a fail–safe measure, when ignition occurs an ignition
confirmation signal (lGF signal) is sent to the ECM.
IGNITION COILS
The ignition coil uses a closed core coil with the primary coil wrapped around the core and the
secondary coil wrapped around the primary coil. This allows the generation of a high voltage
sufficient to cause a spark to jump across the spark plug gap.
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
The camshaft position sensor detect the camshaft position.
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
The crankshaft position sensor detect the crankshaft position.
IG–42
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
PRECAUTION
1. Do not leave the ignition switch on for more than 10
minutes if the engine does not start.
2. With a tachometer connected to the system, con–
nect the tester probe of the tachometer to terminal
IG of the DLC 1.
3. With a timing tight connected to the system, con–
nect the timing light pickup clip to the green lead
wire for the No.4 ignition coil.
4. As some tachometers are not compatible with this
ignition system, we recommend that you confirm
the compatibility of your unit before use.
5. Never allow the tachometer terminals to touch
ground as it could result in damage to the igniter
and/or ignition coil.
6. Do not disconnect the battery while the engine is
running.
7. Check that the igniter is properly grounded to the
body.
IG–43
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
SYSTEM CIRCUIT
OPERATION
To maintain the most appropriate ignition timing, the ECM sends a control signal so that the
igniter is pass the current to the ignition coils and the spark plugs produce a spark.
IG–44
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082–00050 TOYOTA Electrical Tester Set
09200–00010 Engine Adjust Kit
EQUIPMENT
Megger insulation resistance meter
Spark plug cleaner
Thermometer
Timing light
Spark plug
IG–45
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
SPARK TEST
CHECK THAT SPARK OCCURS
(a) Remove the ignition coil.
(See steps 1 to 3 on page IG–50)
(b) Remove the spark plug.
(See step 3 on page IG–47)
(c) Install the spark plug to the ignition coil, and connect
the ignition coil connecter.
(d) Ground the spark plug.
(e) Check if spark occurs while engine is being cranked.
HINT: To prevent gasoline from being injected from
injectors during this test, crank the engine for no more
than 1–2 seconds at time.
If the spark does not occur, perform the test as fol–
lows:
SPARK TEST
CHECK CONNECTION OF IGNITION COIL AND
IGNITER
CHECK POWER SUPPLY TO IGNITION COIL
AND IGNITER
1. Turn ignitioin switch ON.
2. Check that there is battery voltage at
Ignition coil positive (+) terminal.
CHECK RESISTANCE OF IGNITION COIL
(See page IG–48)
Resistance:
Primary Cold : 0.54–0.84II, Hot : 0.68–0.98 n
CHECK RESISTANCE OF CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(See page IG–49)
Resistance:
Cold : 835–1,4000, Hot : 1,060–1,6450
CHECK RESISTANCE OF CRANKSHAFT POSITION
SENSOR
(See page IG–54)
Resistance:
Cold : 1,630–2,7400, Hot : 2,065–3,2250
CHECK IGT SIGNAL FROM ECM
(See page EG–550)
TRY ANOTHER IGNITER
BAD
BAD
BAD
BAD
BAD
BAD
Connect securely.
Check wiring between ignition
switch
to ignition coil and igniter.
Replace the ignition coil.
Replace the camshaft position sensor.
Replace the crankshaft position sensor.
Check wiring between ECM, and igniter, and then try another ECM.
IG–46
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
(f) Reinstall the spark plug.
(See step 7 on page IG–47)
(g) Reinstall the ignition coil.
(See steps 1 to 3 on page IG–51)
SPARK PLUGS INSPECTION
NOTICE:
•
Never use a wire brush for cleaning.
•
Never attempt to adjust the electrode gap on a used
spark plug.
•
Spark plugs should be replaced every 100,000 km
(60,000 miles).
1. REMOVE IGNITION COILS
(See steps 1 to 3 on page IG–b0)
2. INSPECT ELECTRODE
Using a megger (insulation resistance meter), measure
the insulation resistance.
Standard correct Insulation resistance:
10 M or more
If the resistance is less than specified, proceed to step
4.
HINT: If a megger is not available, the following simple
method of inspection provides fairly accurate results.
Simple Method:
(a) Quickly race the engine to 4,000 rpm 5 times.
(b) Remove the spark plug. (See step 3)
(c) Visually check the spark plug.
If the electrode is dry ... OK
If the electrode is wet ... Proceed to step 4
(d) Reinstall the spark plug. (See step 7)
IG–47
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
3. REMOVE SPARK PLUGS
Using a 16 mm plug wrench, remove the ^ spark plugs
from the RH and LH cylinder heads.
4. VISUALLY INSPECT SPARK PLUGS
Check the spark plug for thread damage and insulator
damage.
If abnormal, replace the spark plug.
Recommended spark plug:
PK20R11 for ND
BKR6EP–11 for NGK
5. INSPECT ELECTRODE GAP
Maximum electrode gap for used spark plug:
1.3 mm (0.051 in.)
If the gap is greater than maximum, replace the spark
plug.
Correct electrode gap for now spark plug:
1.1 mm (0.043 in.)
NOTICE: If adjusting the gap of a new spark plug, bend
only the base of the ground electrode. Do not touch the
tip. Never attempt to adjust the gap on the used plug.
6. CLEAN SPARK PLUGS
If the electrode has traces of wet carbon, allow it to
dry and then clean with a spark plug cleaner.
Air pressure:
Below 588 kPa (6 kgf/cm2, 85 psi)
Duration:
20 seconds or less
HINT: If there are traces of oil, remove it with gasoline
before using the spark plug cleaner.
7. REINSTALL SPARK PLUGS
Using a 16 mm plug wrench, install the6 spark plugs
to the RH and LH cylinder heads.
Torque: 18 N–m (180 kgf–cm. 13 ft–lbf)
8. REINSTALL IGNITION COILS
(See steps 1 to 3 on page IG–51)
IG–48
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
IGNITION COIL INSPECTION
NOTICE: ’Cold’ and ’Hot’ in the following sentences ex–
press the temperature of the coils themselves. “Cold” is
from–10C (14F) to 50C (1122* F) and ’Hot’ is from 60
C (122F) to 100C (212F).
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the “LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. REMOVE V–BANK COVER
Using a 5 mm hexagon wrench, remove the 2 cap nuts
and V–bank cover.
3. DISCONNECT IGNITION COIL CONNECTORS
4. INSPECT PRIMARY COIL RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
the positive (+) and negative (–) terminals.
Primary coil resistance (Cold):
0.54–0.84
Primary coil resistance (Hot):
0.68–0.980
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the igni–
tion coil. (See page I G–50)
IG–49
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
5. RECONNECT IGNITION COIL CONNECTORS
6. REINSTALL V–BANK COVER
Using a 5 mm hexagon wrench, install the V–bank
cover with the 2 cap nuts.
HINT: For fixing the V–bank cover, push on the
cover until sense of “click” is felt.
7. RECONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
TO BATTERY
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
INSPECTION
NOTICE: ’Cold’ and ’Hot’ in the following sentences ex–
press the temperature of the sensors themselves. ’Cold’
Is from–10C (14F) to 50C (122F) and “Hot’ is from
50C 0 22F) to 100C (212P).
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the Ignition switch Is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. DISCONNECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
CONNECTOR
3. INSPECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
terminals.
Resistance (Cold):
835–1,4000
Resistance (Hot):
1,060–1,645 0
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the cam–
shaft position sensor. (See page IG–52)
4. RECONNECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
CONNECTOR
5. RECONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
TO BATTERY
IGNITER INSPECTION
(See procedure Spark Test on page IG–46)
IG–50
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
IGNITION COIL
IGNITION COILS REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the Ignition switch is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. REMOVE V–BANK COVER
Using a 5 mm hexagon wrench, remove the 2 cap nuts
and V–bank cover.
3. REMOVE IGNITION COILS
(a) Disconnect the 6 connectors from the RH and LH
cylinder heads.
(b) Remove the 8 bolts and6 ignition coils from the RH
and LH cylinder heads.
HINT: Arrange the ignition coils in correct order.
IG–51
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
IGNITION COIL INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL IGNITION COILS
(a) Install the6 ignition coils to the RH and LH cylinder
heads with the ^ bolts.
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm. 89 in.Ibf)
(b) Connect the 6 ignition coil connectors.
2. INSTALL V–BANK COVER
Using a 5 mm hexagon wrench, install the V–bank
cover with the 2 cap nuts.
HINT: For fixing the V–bank cover, push on the cover
until sense of “click” is felt.
3. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
TO BATTERY
IG–52
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the “LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. REMOVE CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the camshaft position sensor connector.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and camshaft position sensor.
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.ibf)
2. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
TO BATTERY
IG–53
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
REMOVAL
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the Ignition switch is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. REMOVE RH ENGINE UNDER COVER
3. REMOVE RH FENDER APRON SEAL
IG–54
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
4. DISCONNECT ENGINE WIRE
Remove the 3 nuts and disconnect the engine wire.
5. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Remove the bolt and disconnect the crankshaft posi–
tion sensor.
(b) Disconnect the crankshaft position sensor conecter.
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
INSPECTION
NOTICE: ’Cold’ and ’Hot’ in the following sentences ex–
press the temperature of the sensors themselves. ’Cold’
is from–10C (14F) to 50C (122F) and ’Hot’ is from
50C (122F) to 100C (212F).
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
terminals.
Resistance (Cold):
1,630–2,740 0
Resistance (Hot):
2,060–3,225 0
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the crank
shaft position sensor.
IG–55
IGNITION SYSTEM
–
(1MZ–FE)
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
INSTALLATION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. INSTALL CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.lbf)
2. CONNECT ENGINE WIRE
3. INSTALL RH FENDER APRON SEAL
4. INSTALL RH ENGINE UNDER COVER
6. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
TO BATTERY
IG–56
IGNITION SYSTEM
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE DATA
Ignition timing
w/ Terminals TE1 and E1 connected of DLC1
Firing order
Spark plug
Recommended spark plug
Correct electrode gap for new plug
Maximum electrode gap for used plug
Ignition coil
Primary coil resistance
Camshaft
position
sensor
Resistance
Crankshaft
position
sensor
Resistance
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part tightened
Spark plug x Cylinder heed
Ignition coil x Cylinder head
Camshaft position sensor x Cylinder head
Crankshaft position sensor x Oil pump
–
(1MZ–FE)
IN–1
INTRODUCTION
–
INTRODUCTION
IN–2
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
INDEX
An INDEX is provided on the first page of each section to guide you to the item to be repaired.
To assist you in finding your way through the manual, the Section Title and major heading are
given at the top of every page.
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
At the beginning of each section, a General Description is given that pertains to all repair
operations contained in that section.
Read these precautions before starting any repair task.
TROUBLESHOOTING
TROUBLESHOOTING tables are included for each system to help you diagnose the problem and
find the cause. The fundamentals of how to proceed with troubleshooting are described on page
IN –19. Be sure to read this before performing troubleshooting.
PREPARATION
Preparation lists the SST (Special Service Tools), recommended tools, equipment, lubricant and
SSM (Special Service Materials) which should be prepared before beginning the operation and
explains the purpose of each one.
REPAIR PROCEDURES
Most repair operations begin with an overview illustration. It identifies the components and
shows how the parts fit together.
Example:
IN–3
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
The procedures are presented in a step–by–step format:
• The illustration shows what to do and where to do it.
• The task heading tells what to do.
• The detailed text tells how to perform the task and gives other information such as
specifications and warnings.
Example:
This format provides the experienced technician with a FAST TRACK to the information needed.
The upper case task heading can be read at a glance when necessary, and the text below it
provides detailed information. Important specifications and warnings always stand out in bold
type.
REFERENCES
References have been kept to a minimum. However, when they are required you are given the
page to refer to.
SPECIFICATIONS
Specifications are presented in bold type throughout the text where needed. You never have to
leave the procedure to look up your specifications. They are also found at the end of each section,
for quick reference.
IN–4
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
CAUTIONS, NOTICES, HINTS:
• CAUTIONS are presented in bold type, and indicate there is a possibility of injury to you or
other people.
• NOTICES are also presented in bold type, and indicate the possibility of damage to the
components being repaired.
• HINTS are separated from the text but do not appear in bold. They provide additional
information to help you perform the repair efficiently.
S1 UNIT
The UNITS given in this manual are primarily expressed according to the SI UNIT (International
System of Unit), and alternately expressed in the metric system and in the English System.
Example;
Torque: 30 N–m (310 kgf–cm, 22 ft–lbf)
IN–5
INTRODUCTION
–
IDENTIFICATION INFORMATION
IDENTIFICATION INFORMATION
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
The vehicle identification number is stamped on the
vehicle identification number plate and certification
label.
A. Vehicle Identification Number Plate
B. Certification Label
ENGINE SERIAL NUMBER
The engine serial number is stamped on the engine
block as shown.
IN–6
INTRODUCTION
–
GENERAL REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
GENERAL REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
1. Use fender, seat and floor covers to keep the vehicle
clean and prevent damage.
2. During disassembly, keep parts in the appropriate
order to facilitate reassernbly.
3. Observe the following:
CAUTION: Work must be started after approx 90 sec–
onds from the time the ignition switch is turned to the
“LOOK” position and the negative (–) terminal cable is
disconnected from the battery (See page RS–2).
(a) Before performing electrical work, disconnect
the negative cable from the battery terminal.
(b) If it is necessary to disconnect the battery for
inspection or repair, always disconnect the cable
from the negative (–) terminal which is grounded
to the vehicle body.
(c) To prevent damage to the battery terminal post,
loosen the terminal nut and raise the cable strai–
ght up without twisting or prying it.
(d) Clean the battery terminal posts and cable termi–
nals with a clean shop rag. Do not scrape them
with a file or other abrasive objects.
(e) Install the cable terminal to the battery post with
the nut loose, and tighten the nut after installa–
tion. Do not use a hammer to tap the terminal
onto the post.
(f) Be sure the cover for the positive (+) terminal is
properly in place.
4. Check hose and wiring connectors to make sure that
they are secure and correct.
5. Non – reusable parts
(a) Always replace cotter pins, gaskets, 0–rings and
oil seals etc. with new ones.
(b) Non–reusable parts are indicated in the compo–
nent illustrations by the “” symbol.
6. Precoated parts
Precoated parts are bolts and nuts, etc. that are
coated with a seal lock adhesive at the factory.
(a) If a precoated part is retightened, loosened or
caused to move in any way, it must be recoated
with the specified adhesive.
IN–7
INTRODUCTION
–
GENERAL REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
(b) When reusing precoated parts, clean off the old
adhesive and dry with compressed air. Then
apply the specified seal lock adhesive to the bolt,
nut or threads.
(c) Precoated parts are indicated in the component
illustrations by the “” symbol.
7. When necessary, use a sealer on gaskets to prevent
leaks.
8. Carefully observe all specifications for bolt tightening
torques. Always use a torque wrench.
9. Use of special service tools (SST) and special service
materials (SSM) may be required, depending on the
nature of the repair. Be sure to use SST and SSM
where specified and follow the proper work proce–
dure. A list of SST and SSM can be found in the
preparation part at the front of each section in this
manual.
10. When replacing fuses, be sure the new fuse has the
correct amperage rating. DO NOT exceed the rating or
use one with a lower rating.
Illustration
Symbol
Part Name
Abbreviation
FUSE
FUSE
MEDIUM CURRENT FUSE
M–FUSE
HIGH CURRENT FUSE
H–FUSE
FUSIBLE LINK
CIRCUIT BREAKER
IN–8
INTRODUCTION
–
GENERAL REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
11. Care must be taken when jacking up and supporting
the vehicle. Be sure to lift and support the vehicle at
the proper locations (See page IN–37)
(a) If the vehicle is to be jacked up only at the front
or rear end, be sure to block the wheels at the
opposite end in order to ensure safety.
(b) After the vehicle is jacked up, be sure to support
it on stands. It is extremely dangerous to do any
work on a vehicle raised on a jack alone, even for
a small job that can be finished quickly.
12. Observe the following precautions to avoid damage to
the parts:
(a) Do not open the cover or case of the ECU, ECM,
PCM or TCM unless absolutely necessary. (If the
IC terminals are touched, the IC may be destr–
oyed by static electricity.)
(b) To disconnect vacuum hoses, pull on the end, not
the middle of the hose.
(c) To pull apart electrical connectors, pull on the
connector itself, not the wires.
(d) Be careful not to drop electrical components,
such as sensors or relays. If they are dropped on
a hard floor, they should be replaced and not
reused.
(e) When steam cleaning an engine, protect the dis–
tributor, air filter, and VCV from water.
(f) Never use an impact wrench to remove or install
temperature switches or temperature sensors.
(g) When checking continuity at the wire connector,
insert the tester probe carefully to prevent termi–
nals from bending.
(h) When using a vacuum gauge, never force the
hose onto a connector that is too large. Use a
step–down adapter instead. Once the hose has
been stretched, it may leak.
13. Tag hoses before disconnecting them:
(a) When disconnecting vacuum hoses, use tags to
identify how they should be reconnected.
(b) After completing a job, double check that the
vacuum hoses are properly connected. A label
under the hood shows the proper layout.
IN–9
INTRODUCTION
–
GENERAL REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
14. Unless otherwise stated, all resistance is measured at
an ambient temperature of 20C (68F). Because the
resistance may be outside specifications if measured
at high temperatures immediately after the vehicle
has been running, measurements should be made
when the engine has cooled down.
IN–10
INTRODUCTION
–
FOR VEHICLES WITH DATA LINK CONNECTOR 2
(DLC2)
FOR VEHICLES WITH DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 2 (DLC2)
The DLC2 is provided inside the cabin (located under
the left side instrument panel) as a connector exclu–
sively for diagnosis of data from the engine, automatic
transmission, ABS, A/C, Airbag and Cruise Control
System to improve serviceability. The DLC1 inside
the engine compartment is used for engine adjust–
ment.
Connecting the following terminals of the DLC2 to
terminal E, selects the diagnosis mode shown.
NOTICE: Never make a mistake with the terminal connec–
tion position as this will cause a malfunction.
Terminal
TE2 and TE1
System
Engine and automatic transmission (Normal mode)
Engine and automatic transmission (Test mode)
ABS, A/C, Airbag and Cruise Control System
Automatic transmission
Refer to the respective system for the inspection
method.
HINT: By connecting the DLC2 up to a monitor specif–
ically designed for use with the DLC2, the diagnosis
result for each system can be read easily.
IN–11
INTRODUCTION
–
PRECAUTION
PRECAUTION
FOR VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH SRS
AIRBAG
The 1994 CAMRY specifications is equipped with an
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) airbag.
Failure to carry out service operations in the correct
sequence could cause the airbag system to unexpect–
edly deploy during servicing, possibly leading to a
serious accident.
Further, if a mistake is made in servicing the airbag
system, it is possible the airbag may fail to operate
when required. Before performing servicing (including
removal or installation of parts, inspection or replace–
ment), be sure to read the following items carefully,
then follow the correct procedure described in this
manual.
Locations of Airbag Components
IN–12
INTRODUCTION
–
PRECAUTION
1. Malfunction symptoms of the airbag system are diffi–
cult to confirm, so the diagnostic codes become the
most important source of information when trouble–
shooting. When troubleshooting the airbag system,
always inspect the diagnostic codes before dis–
connecting the battery (See page RS–55).
2. Work must be started after approx 90 seconds from
the time the Ignition switch is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is dis–
connected from the battery.
(The airbag system is equipped with a back–up
power source so that if work is started within 90
seconds of disconnecting the negative (–) terminal
cable of the battery, the airbag may be deployed.)
When the negative (–) terminal cable is disconnected
from the battery, memory of the clock and audio
systems will be cancelled. So before starting work,
make a record of the contents memorized by each
memory system. Then when work is finished, reset
the clock and audio systems as before.
To avoid erasing the memory of each memory system,
never use a back–up power supply from outside the
vehicle.
3. Even in cases of a minor collision where the airbag
does not deploy, the front airbag sensors ,
passenger ’s airbag assembly and the steering wheel
pad should be inspected (See page RS–17, 29, 43).
4. Never use airbag parts from another vehicle. When
replacing parts, replace them with new parts.
5. Before repairs, remove the airbag sensors if shocks
are likely to be applied to the sensors during repairs.
6. The center airbag sensor assembly contains mercury.
After performing replacement, do not destroy the old
part. When scrapping the vehicle or replacing the
center airbag sensor assembly itself, remove the
center airbag sensor assembly and dispose of it as
toxic waste.
7. Never disassemble and repair the front airbag sensors,
center airbag sensor assembly or steering wheel pad
in order to reuse it.
8. If the front airbag sensors, center airbag sensor as–
sembly or steering wheel pad have been dropped, or if
there are cracks, dents or other defects in the case,
bracket or connector, replace them with new ones.
9. Do not expose the front airbag sensors, center airbag
sensor assembly or steering wheel pad directly to hot
air or flames.
10. Use a volt/ohmmeter with high impedance (10 k/V
minimum) for troubleshooting of the electrical circuit.
IN–13
INTRODUCTION
–
PRECAUTION
11. Information labels are attached to the periphery of the
airbag components. Follow the notices.
12. After work on the airbag system is completed, per–
form the airbag warning light check (See page RS–
55).
Front Airbag Sensor
1. Never reuse the front airbag sensors involved in a
collision when the airbag has deployed. (Replace both
left and right airbag sensors.)
2. Install the front airbag sensor with the arrow on the
sensor facing toward the front of the vehicle.
3. The front airbag sensor set bolts have been anti –rust
treated. When the sensor is removed, always replace
the set bolts with new ones.
4. The front airbag sensor is equipped with an electrical
connection check mechanism. Be sure to lock this
mechanism securely when connecting the connector.
If the connector is not securely locked, a malfunction
code will be detected by the diagnosis system (See
page RS–13).
Spiral Cable (in Combination Switch)
The steering wheel must be fitted correctly to the
steering column with the spiral cable at the neutral
position; otherwise cable disconnection and other tro–
ubles may result. Refer to page RS–19 concerning
correct steering wheel installation.
IN–14
INTRODUCTION
–
PRECAUTION
Steering Wheel Pad (with Airbag)
1. When removing the steering wheel pad or handling
a new steering wheel pad, it should be placed with
the pad top surface facing up.
1n this case, the twin –lock type connector lock lever
should be in the locked state and care should be taken
to place it so the connector will not be damaged. And
do not store a steering wheel pad on top of another
one. (Storing the pad with its metallic surface up may
lead to a serious accident if the airbag inflates for
some reason.)
2. Never measure the resistance of the airbag squib.
(This may cause the airbag to deploy, which is very
dangerous.)
3. Grease should not be applied to the steering wheel
pad and the pad should not be cleaned with deter–
gents of any kind.
4. Store the steering wheel pad where the ambient tem–
perature remains below 93C (200F), without high
humidity and away from electrical noise.
5. When using electric welding, first disconnect the
airbag connector (yellow color and 2 pins) under the
steering column near the combination switch connec–
tor before starting work.
6. When disposing of a vehicle or the steering wheel
pad alone, the airbag should be deployed using an
SST before disposal (See page RS–22). Perform the
operation in a place away from electrical noise.
IN–15
INTRODUCTION
–
PRECAUTION
Front Passenger Airbag Assembly
1. Always store a removed or new front passenger
airbag assembly with the airbag door facing up.
Storing the airbag assembly with the airbag door
facing down could cause a serious accident if the
airbag inflates.
2. Never measure the resistance of the airbag squib.
(This may cause the airbag deploy, which is very
dangerous.)
3. Grease should not be applied to the front passenger
airbag assembly and the airbag door should not be
cleaned with detergents of any kind.
4. Store the airbag assembly where the ambient temper–
ature remains below 93C (200F), without high hu–
midity and away from electrical noise.
5. When using electric welding, first disconnect the
airbag connector (yellow color and 2 pins) installed on
the glove compartment finish plate at the left side of
the glove compartment before starting work.
6. When disposing of a vehicle or the airbag assembly
alone, the airbag should be deployed using an SST
before disposal (See page RS–35).
Perform the operation in a safe place away from
electrical noise.
IN–16
INTRODUCTION
–
PRECAUTION
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
The connector to the center airbag sensor assembly
should be connected or disconnected with the sensor
mounted on the floor. If the connector is connected
or disconnected while the center airbag sensor as–
sembly is not mounted to the floor, it could cause
undesired ignition of the airbag system.
Wire Harness and Connector
The airbag system’s wire harness is integrated with
the cowl wire harness assembly. The wires for the
airbag wire harness are encased in a yellow cor–
rugated tube. All the connectors for the system are
also a standard yellow color. If the airbag system wire
harness becomes disconnected or the connector bec–
omes broken due to an accident, etc., repair or replace
it as shown on page RS–50.
IN–17
INTRODUCTION
–
PRECAUTION
FOR VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A CATALYTIC CONVERTER
CAUTION: If large amounts of unburned gasoline flow into the converter, It may overheat and create
a fire hazard. To prevent this, observe the following precautions and explain them to your customer.
1. Use only unleaded gasoline.
2. Avoid prolonged idling.
Avoid running the engine at idle speed for more than 20 minutes.
3. Avoid spark jump test.
(a) Perform spark jump test only when absolutely necessary. Perform this test as rapidly as possible.
(b) While testing, never race the engine.
4. Avoid prolonged engine compression measurement.
Engine compression tests must be done as rapidly as possible.
5. Do not run engine when fuel tank is nearly empty.
This may cause the engine to misfire and create an extra load on the converter.
6. Avoid coasting with ignition turned off and prolonged braking.
7. Do not dispose of used catalyst along with parts contaminated with gasoline or oil.
FOR VEHICLES WITH AN AUDIO SYSTEM
WITH BUILT–IN ANTI–THEFT SYSTEM
Audio System displaying the sign ”ANTI –THEFT
SYSTEM” shown on the left has a built–in anti–theft
system which makes the audio system soundless if
stolen.
If the power source for the audio system is cut even
once, the anti–theft system operates so that even if
the power source is reconnected, the audio system
will not produce any sound unless the ID number
selected by the customer is input again. Accordingly,
when performing repairs on vehicles equipped with
this system, before disconnecting the battery termi–
nals or removing the audio system the customer
should be asked for the ID number so that the techni–
cian can input the ID number afterwards, or else a
request made to the customer to input the ID number.
For the method to input the ID number or cancel the
anti–theft system, refer to the Owner’s Manual.
IN–18
INTRODUCTION
–
PRECAUTION
IF VEHICLE IS EQUIPPED WITH MOBILE
COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
For vehicles with mobile communication systems
such as two–way radios and cellular telephones, ob–
serve the following precautions.
(1) Install the antenna as far as possible away from the
ECM, ECU and sensors of the vehicle’s electronic
system.
(2) Install the antenna feeder at least 20 cm (7.87 in.)
away from the ECM, ECU and sensors of the vehicle’s
electronics systems. For details about ECM, ECU and
sensors locations, refer to the section on the applica–
ble component.
(3) Do not wind the antenna feeder together with the
other wiring. As much as possible, also avoid running
the antenna feeder parallel with other wire harnesses.
(4) Confirm that the antenna and feeder are correctly
adjusted.
(5) Do not install powerful mobile communications
system.
INTRODUCTION
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
– SYSTEMS
IN–19
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
A large number of ECU controlled systems are used in the TOYOTA CAMRY*. In general, the ECU controlled system is considered to be a very intricate system requiring a high level of technical knowledge and
expert skill to troubleshoot. However, the fact is that if you proceed to inspect the circuits one by one, troubleshooting of these systems is not complex. If you have adequate understanding of the system and a basic
knowledge of electricity, accurate diagnosis and necessary repair can be performed to locate and fix the problem. Thismanual is designed through emphasis of the above standpoint to help service technicians perform
accurate and effective troubleshooting, and is compiled for the following major ECU controlled systems:
Repair Manual
Vol. 1
Vol. 2
System
Page
5S–FE Engine
EG–291
1MZ–FE Engine
EG–394
A140E Automatic Transaxle
AX–39
A541E Automatic Transaxle
AX–49
Anti–Lock Brake
BR–90
Supplemental Restraint System
RS–53
Cruise Control
BE–161
The troubleshooting procedure and how to make use of it are described on the following pages.
IN–20
INTRODUCTION
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
– SYSTEMS
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
Carry out troubleshooting in accordance with the procedure on the following page. Here, only the basic proce–
dure is shown. Details are provided in each section, showing the most effective methods for each circuit.
Confirm the troubleshooting procedures first for the relevant circuit before beginning troubleshooting of that
circuit.
Vehicle Brought to Workshop
Customer Problem
Analysis
Ask the customer about the conditions and the
environment when the problem occurred.
Symptom Confirmation and
Diagnostic Trouble Code
Check
Symptom Simulation
Diagnostic Trouble Code Chart
Matrix Chart of Problem
Symptoms
Circuit Inspection or Parts
Inspection
Confirm the symptoms and the problem conditions,
and check the diagnostic trouble codes.
(When the problem symptoms do not appear dur–
ing confirmation, use the symptom simulation
method described later on.)
Check the results obtained in Step 2 , then confirm the inspection procedure for the system or the part which should
be checked using the diagnostic trouble code chart or the
matrix chart of problem symptoms.
Check and repair the affected system or part in
accordance with the instructions in Step 6 .
Repair
Confirmation Test
End
After completing repairs, confirm that the problem
has been eliminated.
(If the problem is not reproduced, perform the con–
firmation test under the same conditions and in
the same environment as when it occurred for the
first time.)
INTRODUCTION
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
– SYSTEMS
IN–21
1 CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
In troubleshooting, the problem symptoms must be confirmed accurately and all preconceptions must be
cleared away in order to give an accurate judgement. To ascertain just what the problem symptoms are,
it is extremely important to ask the customer about the problem and the conditions at the time it occurred.
Important Points in the Problem Analysis
The following 5 items are important points in the problem analysis. Past problems which are thought to be
unrelated and the repair history, etc. may also help in some cases, so as much information as possible
should be gathered and its relationship with the problem symptoms should be correctly ascertained for reference in troubleshooting. A customer problem analysis table is provided in the troubleshooting section for
each system for your use.
Important Points in the Customer Problem Analysis
• What
Vehicle model, system name
• When
Date, time, occurrence frequency
• Where
Road conditions
• Under what conditions?
Running conditions, driving conditions, weather conditions
• How did it happen?
Problem symptoms
(Sample) Engine control system check sheet.
IN–22
INTRODUCTION
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
– SYSTEMS
2 SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION AND DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK
The diagnostic system in the TOYOTA CAIVIRY fulfills various functions. The first function is the Diagnostic
Trouble Code Check in which a malfunction in the signal circuits to the ECU is stored in code in the ECU
memory atthetime of occurrence, to be output bythetechnician during troubleshooting. Another function is the
Input Signal Check which checks if the signals from various switches are sent to the ECU correctly. By using
these check functions, the problem areas can be narrowed down quickly and troubleshooting can be performed effectively. Diagnostic functions are incorporated in the following systems in the TOYOTA CAMRY
System
Diagnostic Trouble
Code Check
Input Signal Check
(Sensor Check)
Other Diagnosis
Function
5S–FE
Engine
Diagnostic Test
Mode
1MZ–FE
A140E
Automatic Transaxle
Diagnostic Test
Mode
A540E
Anti–Lock Brake
Supplemental Restraint System
Cruise Control
In diagnostic trouble code check, it is very important to determine whether the problem indicated by the diagnostic trouble code is still occurring or occurred in the past but returned to normal at present. In addition, it
must be checked in the problem symptom check whether the malfunction indicated by the diagnostic trouble
code is directly related to the problem symptom or not. For this reason, the diagnostic trouble codes should be
checked before and after the symptom confirmation to determine the current conditions, as shown in the table
below. If this is not done, it may depending on the case, result in unnecessary troubleshooting for normally operating systems, thus making it more difficult to locate the problem, or in repairs not pertinent to the problem.
Therefore, always follow the procedure in correct order and perform the diagnostic trouble code check.
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK PROCEDURE
Diagnostic Trouble
Code Check (Make a
note of and then clear)
Diagnostic Trouble
Code Display
Confirmation of
Symptoms
Problem symptoms
exist
Diagnostic Trouble
Code Check
Same diagnostic trouble
code is displayed
Problem is still occurring in the diagnostic
circuit.
Normal code is
displayed
The problem is still occurring in a place other than
in the diagnostic circuit.
(The diagnostic trouble code displayed first is either
for a past problem or it is a secondary problem.)
No problem
symptoms exist
Normal Code Display
Problem Condition
The problem occurred, in the diagnostic circuit in
the past.
Problem symptoms
exist
Normal code is
displayed
The problem is still occurring in a place other than
in the diagnostic circuit.
No problem
symptoms exist
Normal code is
displayed
The problem occurred in a place other than in the
diagnostic circuit in the past.
INTRODUCTION
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
– SYSTEMS
IN–23
Taking into account the above points, a flow chart showing how to proceed with troubleshooting using the
diagnostic trouble code check is shown below. This flow chart shows how to utilize the diagnostic trouble
code check effectively, then by carefully checking the results, indicates how to proceed either to diagnostic
trouble code troubleshooting or to troubleshooting of problem symptoms.
Diagnostic trouble code check
Making a note of and clearing of the diagnostic
trouble codes displayed
Symptom confirmation
No problem symptoms
Problem symptoms
exist
exist
Simulation test using the symptom
simulation methods
Diagnostic trouble code check
• Diagnostic trouble code
displayed
• Problem symptoms exist
• Normal code displayed
• Problem symptoms exist
• Normal code displayed
• No problem symptoms
exist
System Normal
Troubleshooting of problem
indicated by diagnostic
trouble code
Troubleshooting of each
problem symptom
If a diagnostic trouble code was displayed in
the initial diagnostic trouble code check, it
indicates that the trouble may have occurred
in a wire harness or connector in that circuit
in the past. Therefore, check the wire harness and connectors (See page IN–31 )
IN–24
INTRODUCTION
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
– SYSTEMS
3 SYMPTOM SIMULATION
The most difficult case in troubleshooting is when there are no problem symptoms occurring. In such cases, a thorough customer problem analysis must be carried out, then¿simulate the same or similar conditions and environment
in which the problem occurred in the customer’s vehicle. No matter now much experience a technician has, or how
skilled he may be, if he proceeds to troubleshoot without confirming the problem symptoms he will tend to overlook
something important in the repair operation and make a wrong guess somewhere, which will only lead to a standstill.
For example, for a problem which only occurs when the engine is cold, or for a problem which occurs due to vibration
caused by the road during driving, etc., the problem can never be determined so long as the symptoms are confirmed
with the engine hot condition or the vehicle at a standstill. Since vibration, heat or water penetration (moisture) are
likely causes for problems which are difficult to reproduce, the symptom simulation tests introduced here are effective
measures in that the external causes are applied to the vehicle in a stopped condition.
Important Points in the Symptom Simulation Test
In the symptom simulation test, the problem symptoms should of course be confirmed, but the problem area or parts
must also be found out. To do this, narrow down the possible problem circuits according to the symptoms before starting this test and connect a tester beforehand. After that, carry out the symptom simulation test, judging whether the
circuit being tested is defective or normal and also confirming the problem symptoms at the same time. Refer to the
matrix chart of problem symptoms for each system to narrow down the possible causes of the symptom.
VIBRATION METHOD: When vibration seems to be the major cause.
CONNECTORS
Slightly shake the connector vertically and horizontally.
WIRE HARNESS
Slightly shake the wire harness vertically and horizon–
tally. The connector joint, fulcrum of the vibration, and
body through portion are the major areas to be
checked thoroughly.
PARTS AND SENSORS
Apply slight vibration with a finger to the part of the
sensor considered to be the problem cause and check
if the malfunction occurs.
HINT: Applying strong vibration to relays may result
in open relays.
INTRODUCTION
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
– SYSTEMS
HEAT METHOD: When the problem seems to occur when the suspect area is heated.
Heat the component that is the likely cause of the malfunction
with a hair dryer or similar object. Check to see if the malfunction occurs.
NOTICE:
(1) Do not heat to more than 60C (140F). (Temperature
limit that no damage is done to the component).
(2) Do not apply heat directly to parts in the ECU.
When the malfunction seems to occur on a rainy day
WATER SPRINKLING METHOD: or in a high–humidity condition.
Sprinkle water onto the vehicle and check to see if the malfunction
occurs.
NOTICE:
(1) Never sprinkle water directly into the engine compartment,
but indirectly change the temperature and humidity by applying water spray onto the radiator front surface.
(2) Never apply water directly onto the electronic com–
ponents.
(Service hint)
If a vehicle is subject to water leakage, the leaked water
may contaminate the ECU. When testing a vehicle with a water leakage problem, special caution must be used.
OTHER: When a malfunction seems to occur when electrical load is excessive.
Turn on all electrical loads including the heater blower, head
lights, rear window defogger, etc. and check to see if the
malfunction occurs.
IN–25
IN–26
INTRODUCTION
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
– SYSTEMS
4 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
The inspection procedure is shown in the table below. This table permits efficient and accurate troubleshooting using the diagnostic trouble codes displayed in the diagnostic trouble code check. Proceed with
troubleshooting in accordance with the inspection procedure given in the diagnostic chart corresponding
to the diagnostic trouble codes displayed. The engine diagnostic trouble code chart is shown below as an
example.
• DTC No.
• Detection Item
Indicates the diagnostic trouble code.
Indicates the system of the problem or
contents of the problem.
• Diagnostic Trouble Code
Detecting Condition
Indicates the diagnostic
trouble code set parameter.
• Trouble Area
Indicates the suspect area of the
problem .
• Page or Instructions
Indicates the page where the inspection procedure
for each circuit is to be found, or gives instructions
for checking and repairs.
INTRODUCTION
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
– SYSTEMS
IN–27
5 MATRIX CHART OF PROBLEM SYMPTOMS
The suspect circuits or parts for each problem symptom are shown in the table below. Use this table to
troubleshooting the problem when a ”Normal” code is displayed in the diagnostic trouble code check but
the problem is still occurring. Numbers in the table indicate the inspection order in which the circuits or
parts should be checked.
HINT: When the problem is not detected by the diagnostic system even though the problem symptom is
present, it is considered that the problem is occurring outside the detection range of the diagnostic system, or that the problem is occurring in a system other than the diagnostic system.
• Page
Indicates the page where the flow chart for
each
circuit is located.
• Problem Symptom
• Circuit or Part Name
Indicates the circuit or part which needs to
be checked.
• Circuit Inspection, Inspection Order
Indicates the circuit which needs to be
checked for each problem symptom. Check
in the order indicated by the numbers.
IN–28
INTRODUCTION
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
– SYSTEMS
6 CIRCUIT INSPECTION
How to read and use each page is shown below.
• Diagnostic Trouble Code No.
and Detection Item
• Circuit Description
The major role and operation, etc. of the cir–
cuit and its component parts are explained.
• Indicates the diagnostic
trouble code, diagnostic
trouble code set parameter and suspect area of the
problem.
• Diagnostic Chart
The troubleshooting procedure for the circuit is shown in
a flow chart. Use it to determine
if the circuit is normal or abnormal, and, if it is abnormal, use
it to determine whether the
problem is located in the sen–
sors, actuators, wire harness
or ECU. For details of each in–
spection, the page number of
the related ”Inspection Proce–
dure” is included.
WIRING DIAGRAM
• Wiring Diagram
This shows a wiring diagram of the circuit. Use thi:
diagram together with the location of connector to
thoroughly understand the circuit.
INTRODUCTION
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
– SYSTEMS
IN–29
Location of Connectors in Engine Compartment
• Location of connectors
This diagram shows the wire harnesses and connectors used in one system. The connector shows the harness side connector, so when checking the part side connector (sensor, actuator, etc.), be careful not to mistake the terminal positions.
IN–30
INTRODUCTION
• Indicates the position of the ignition switch during
the check.
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
– SYSTEMS
• Inspection Procedure
This shows the inspection
procedure on the diagnostic
chart in detail.
Ul
Check voltage between terminals VTA and E2 of ECM.
Check and replace
ECM (See page IN–36).
Preparation
Check
Check
• Indicates the place to check the voltage or resistance.
• Indicates the connector position to be checked, from the front or back side.
Check from the connector back side.
(with harness)
Check from the connector front side (without harness)
In this case, care must be taken not to bend the terminals.
• Indicates the condition of the connector of ECU during the check.
INTRODUCTION
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
– SYSTEMS
IN–31
HOW TO USE THE DIAGNOSTIC CHART AND INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1. For troubleshooting, diagnostic trouble code charts or problem symptom charts are provided for each circuit
with detailed inspection procedures on the following page.
2. When all the component parts, wire harnesses and connectors of each circuit except the ECU are found
to be normal in troubleshooting, then it is determined that the problem is in the ECU.
Accordingly, if diagnosis is performed without the problem symptoms occurring, the instruction will
be to check and replace the ECU, even if the problem is not in the ECU. So, always confirm that the
problem symptoms are occurring, or proceed with inspection while using the symptom simulation method.
3. The instructions ”Check wire harness and connector” and ”Check and replace ECU” which appear in the
inspection procedure, are common and applicable to all diagnostic trouble codes. Follow the procedure outlined
below whenever these instructions appear.
Check Wire Harness and Connector
The problem in the wire harness or connector is an open circuit or a short circuit.
OPEN CIRCUIT:
This could be due to a disconnected wire harness, faulty contact in the connector, a connector terminal
pulled out, etc.
HINT:
1. It is rarely the case that a wire is broken in the middle of it. Most cases occur at the connector. In partic–
ular, carefully check the connectors of sensors and actuators.
2. Faulty contact could be due to rusting of the connector terminals, to foreign materials entering termi–
nals or a drop in the contact pressure between the male and female terminals of the connector. Simply
disconnecting and reconnecting the connectors once changes the condition of the connection and may
result in a return to normal operation.
Therefore, in troubleshooting, if no abnormality is found in the wire harness and connector check, but
the problem disappears after the check, then the cause is considered to be in the wire harness or con–
nectors.
SHORT CIRCUIT:
This could be due to a short circuit between the wire harness and the body ground or to a short inside the
switch, etc.
HINT:
• When there is a short between the wire harness and body ground, check thoroughly whether the wire
harness is caught in the body or is clamped properly.
IN–32
INTRODUCTION
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
– SYSTEMS
1. CONTINUITY CHECK (OPEN CIRCUIT CHECK)
(1) Disconnect the connectors at both ECU and sensor
sides.
(2) Measure the resistance between the applicable ter–
minals of the connectors.
Resistance: 1 or less
HINT:
• Measure the resistance while lightly shaking the wire
harness vertically and horizontally.
• When tester probes are inserted into a connector, insert
the probes from the back. For waterproof connectors
in which the probes cannot be inserted from the back,
be careful not to bend the termianls when inserting the
tester probes.
2. RESISTANCE CHECK (SHORT CIRCUIT CHECK)
(1) Disconnect the connectors at both ends.
(2) Measure the resistance between the applicable ter–
minals of the connectors and body ground. Be sure
to carry out this check on the connectors on both
ends.
Resistance: 1 M or higher
HINT: Measure the resistance while lightly shaking the
wire harness vertically and horizontally.
3. VISUAL CHECK AND CONTACT PRESSURE CHECK
(1) Disconnect the connectors at both ends.
(2) Check for rust or foreign material, etc. on the termi–
nals of the connectors.
(3) Check crimped portions for looseness or damage and
check if the terminals are secured in the lock position.
HINT: The terminals should not come out when pulled
lightly.
(4) Prepare a test male terminal and insert it in the female
terminal, then pull it out.
HINT: When the test terminal is pulled out more easily
than others, there may be poor contact in that section.
INTRODUCTION
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
– SYSTEMS
IN–33
Actual examples of the inspection method for open circuit and short circuit are explained below.
1. OPEN CIRCUIT CHECK
For the open circuit in the wire harness in Fig. 1, perform “(a) Continuity Check” or “(b) Voltage Check”
to locate the section.
(a) Continuity Check
(1) Disconnect connectors (A) and (C) and measure the resistance betwen them.
In the case of Fig. 2,
Between terminal 1 of connector (A) and terminal 1 of connector (C)→ No continuity (open)
Between terminal 2 of connector (A) and terminal 2 of connector (C)→ Continuity
Therefore, it is found out that there is an open circuit between terminal 1 of connector (A) and terminal 1 of connector (C).
(2) Disconnect connector (B) and measure the resistance between connectors (A) and (B), (B) and(C),
In the case of Fig. 3,
Between terminal 1 of connector (A) and terminal 1 of connector (B)→Continuity
Between terminal 1 of connector (B) and terminal 1 of connector (C)→No Continuity (open)
Therefore, it is found out that there is an open circuit between terminal 1 of connector (B) and termi
nal 1 of connector (C).
IN–34
INTRODUCTION
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
– SYSTEMS
(b) Voltage Check
In a circuit in which voltage is applied (to the ECU connector terminal), an open circuit can be
checked for by conducting a voltage check.
(1) As shown in Fig. 4, with each connector still connected, measure the voltage between body ground
and terminal 1 of connector (A) at the ECU 5 V output terminal, terminal 1 of connector (B), and
terminal 1 of connector (C), in that order.
If the results are:
5 V: Between Terminal 1 of connector (A) and Body Ground
5 V: Between Terminal 1 of connector (B) and Body Ground
0 V: Between Terminal 1 of connector (C) and Body Ground
then it is found out that there is an open circuit in the wire harness between terminal 1 of (B)
and terminal 1 of (C).
2. SHORT CIRCUIT CHECK
If the wire harness is ground shorted as in Fig. 5, locate the section by conducting a “continuity check
with ground”.
INTRODUCTION
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
– SYSTEMS
IN–35
(a) Continuity Check with Ground
(1) Disconnect connectors (A) and (C) and measure the resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of connector
(A) and body ground.
In the case of Fig. 6,
Between terminal 1 of connector (A) and body ground → Continuity
Between terminal 2 of connector (A) and body ground → No continuity (open)
Therefore, it is found out that there is a short circuit between terminal 1 of connector (A) and terminal
1 of connector (C).
(2) Disconnect connector (B) and measure the resistance between terminal 1 of connector (A) and body
ground, and terminal 1 of connector (B) and body ground.
Between terminal 1 of connector (A) and body ground → No continuity (open)
Between terminal 1 of connector (B) and body ground → Continuity
Therefore, it is found out that there is a short circuit between terminal 1 of connector (B) and terminal
1 of connector (C).
IN–36
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
Check and Replace ECU
First check the ECU ground circuit. If it is faulty, repair it. If it
is normal, the ECU could be faulty, so replace the ECU with a
known good one and check if the symptoms appear.
(1) Measure the resistance between the ECU ground
terminal and the body ground.
Resistance: 1 or less
(2) Disconnect the ECU connector, check the ground
terminals on the ECU side and the wire harness
side for bend and check the contact pressure.
IN–37
INTRODUCTION
–
VEHICLE LIFT AND SUPPORT LOCATIONS
VEHICLE LIFT AND SUPPORT LOCATIONS
IN–38
INTRODUCTION
–
ABBREVIATIONS USED IN THIS MANUAL
ABBREVIATIONS USED IN THIS
MANUAL
ABS
Anti–Lock Brake System
ALR
Automatic Locking Retractor
A/T
Automatic Transaxle
ATF
Automatic Transmission Fluid
BDC
Bottom Dead Center
BTDC
Before Top Dead Center
Calif.
California
Circuit Breaker
CRS
Child Restraint System
Dash Pot
ECU
Electronic Control Unit
ELR
Emergency Locking Retractor
ESA
Electronic Spark Advance
Exhaust (Manifold, Valve)
Ex.
Except
FIPG
Formed in Place Gasket
Fusible Link
Front
Ignition
Intake (Manifold, Valve)
J/B
Junction Block
LED
Light Emitting Diode
Left – Hand
LSPV
Load Sensing Proportioning Valve
Max.
Maximum
Min.
Minimum
Multipurpose
M/T
Menusl Trsnsaxls
0/D, OD
Overdrive
0/S
PCV
Positive Crankcase Ventilation
PKB
Parking Brake
Oversize
Power Steering
Right–Hand
Rear
SRS
Supplemental Restraint System
SSM
Special Service Materials
SST
Special Service Tools
STD
Standard
Switch
IN–39
INTRODUCTION
–
ABBREVIATIONS USED IN THIS MANUAL
TDC
Top Dead Center
TEMP.
T/M
Temperature
Transmission
TMC
Toyota Motor Corporation
TM M
Toyota Motor Manufacturing U.S.A., Inc.
u/s
vcv
Undersize
Vacuum Control Valve
VSV
Vacuum Switching Valve
VTV
Vacuum Transmitting Valve
With
W/O
Without
IN–40
INTRODUCTION
–
GLOSSARY OF SAE AND TOYOTA TERMS
GLOSSARY OF SAE AND TOYOTA TERMS
This glossary lists all SAE–J1930 terms and abbreviations used in this manual in compliance
with SAE recommendations, as well as their Toyota equivalents.
SAE ABBREVI–
ATIONS
TOYOTA TERMS
( )–ABBREVIATIONS
SAE TERMS
A/C
Air Conditioning
Air Conditioner
ACL
Air Cleaner
Air Cleaner
AIR
Secondary Air Injection
Air Injection (AI)
Accelerator Pedal
Battery Positive Voltage
+ B, Battery Voltage
BARO
Barometric Pressure
CAC
Charge Air Cooler
Intercooler
CARB
Carburetor
Carburetor
CFI
Continuous Fuel Injection
CKP
Crankshaft Position
Crank Angle
Closed Loop
Closed Loop
CM P
CPP
Camshaft Position
Cam Angle
CTOX
Continuous Trap Oxidizer
CTP
Closed Throttle Position
Idle ON (IDL ON)
D FI
Direct Fuel Injection (Diesel)
Direct Injection (DI)
DLC1
DLC2
DLC3
Data Link Connector 1
Data Link Connector 2
Data Link Connector 3
1: Check Connector
2: Toyota Diagnosis Comunication Link (TDCL)
3: OBDII Diagnostic Connector
DTC
Diagnostic Trouble Code
Diagnostic Code
DTM
Diagnostic Test Mode
EC L
Engine Control Level
ECM
Engine Control Module
ECT
Engine Coolant Temperature
Coolant Temperature, Water Temperature (THW)
EEPROM
Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only
Memory
Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
(EEPROM).
Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory (EPROM)
EFE
Early Fuel Evaporation
Cold Mixture Heater (CMH), Heat Control Valve (HCV)
EG R
Exhaust Gas Recirculation
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR)
Electronic Ignition
Toyota Distributorless Ignition (TDI)
Clutch Pedal Position
Distributor Ignition
EPROM
EVAP
Engine ECU (Electronic Control Unit)
Engine Modification
Engine Modification (EM)
Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
Programmable Read Only Memory (PROM)
Evaporative Emission
Evaporative Emission Control (EVAP)
Fan Control
FEEPROM
Flash Electrically Erasable Programmable
Read Only Memory
FEPROM
Flash Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
Flexible Fuel
Fuel Pump
Fuel Pump
Generator
Alternator
GND
Ground
Ground (GND)
H02S
Heated Oxygen Sensor
Heated Oxygen Sensor (H02S)
GEN
IN–41
INTRODUCTION
–
GLOSSARY OF SAE AND TOYOTA TERMS
Idle Air Control
Idle Speed Control (ISC)
IAT
Intake Air Temperature
Intake or Inlet Air Temperature
ICM
Ignition Control Module
IAC
Indirect Fuel Injection
Indirect Injection
IFS
Inertia Fuel–Shutoff
ISC
Idle Speed Control
Knock Sensor
Knock Sensor
MAF
Mass Air Flow
Air Flow Meter
MAP
Manifold Absolute Pressure
Manifold Pressure
Intake Vacuum
Mixture Control
Electric Bleed Air Control Valve (EBCV)
Mixture Control Valve (MCV)
Electric Air Control Valve (EACV)
MDP
Manifold Differential Pressure
MFI
M ultiport Fuel Injection
Electronic Fuel Injection (EFI)
MIL
Malfunction Indicator Lamp
Check Engine Light
MST
Manifold Surface Temperature
MVZ
Manifold Vacuum Zone
NVRAM
Non–Volatile Random Access Memory
O2S
Oxygen Sensor
Oxygen Sensor, Ot Sensor (OtS)
On –Board Diagnostic
On–Board Diagnostic (OBD)
Oxidation Catalytic Converter
Oxidation Catalyst Converter (OC), CCo
Open Loop
Open Loop
PAIR
Pulsed Secondary Air Injection
Air Suction (AS)
PCM
Powertrain Control Module
OBD
PNP
Park/Neutral Position
PROM
Programmable Read Only Memory
PSP
Power Steering Pressure
PTOX
Periodic Trap Oxidizer
Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF)
Diesel Particulate Trap (DPT)
RAM
Random Access Memory
Random Access Memory (RAM)
Relay Module
ROM
Read Only Memory
Read Only Memory (ROM)
RPM
Engine Speed
Engine Speed
Supercharger
SCB
Supercharger
Supercharger Bypass
SFI
Sequential Multiport Fuel Injection
Electronic Fuel Injection (EFI), Sequential Injection
SPL
Smoke Puff Limiter
SRI
Service Reminder Indicator
S RT
System Readiness Test
Scan Tool
Throttle Body
Throttle Body
Throttle Body Fuel Injection
Single Point Injection
Central Fuel Injection (Ci)
Turbocharger
Turbocharger
TCC
Torque Converter Clutch
TCM
Transmission Control Module
Torque Converter
Transmission ECU (Electronic Control Unit)
Throttle Position
Throttle Position
TBI
Transmission Range
IN–42
INTRODUCTION
–
GLOSSARY OF SAE AND TOYOTA TERMS
TVV
Thermal Vacuum Valve
Bimetallic Vacuum Switching Valve (BVSV)
Thermostatic Vacuum Switching Valve (TVSV)
TWC
Three–Way Catalytic Converter
Three–Way Catalytic (TWC)
CCRo
TWC+OC
Three–Way + Oxidation Catalytic Converter
CCR+ CCo
VAF
Volume Air Flow
Air Flow Meter
Voltage Regulator
Voltage Regulator
VSS
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Vehicle Speed Sensor (Read Switch Type)
WOT
Wide Open Throttle
Full Throttle
WU–OC
Warm Up Oxidation Catalytic Converter
WU –TWC
Warm Up Three–Way Catalytic Converter
3GR
Third Gear
4G R
Fourth Gear
Manifold Converter
IN–43
INTRODUCTION
–
STANDARD BOLT TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
STANDARD BOLT TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
HOW TO DETERMINE BOLT STRENGTH
Class
Mark
Hexagon
head bolt
4–
5–
6–
7–
8–
9–
10–
11–
4T
5T
6T
7T
8T
9T
10T
11T
Mark
Stud bolt
No mark
Hexagon
flange bolt
w/ washer
hexagon bolt
Hexagon
head bolt
Hexagon
flange bolt
w/ washer
hexagon bolt
Hexagon
head bolt
Hexagon
head bolt
No mark
2
protruding
lines
2
protruding
lines
3
protruding
lines
4
protruding
lines
Welded bolt
Class
IN–44
INTRODUCTION
–
STANDARD BOLT TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
SPECIFIED TORQUE FOR STANDARD BOLTS
Class
1 OT
11T
Diameter
mm
Pitch
mm
Specified torque
Hexagon head bolt
Hexagon flange bolt
MA–1
MAINTENANCE
–
MAINTENANCE
MA–2
MAINTENANCE
–
(5S–FE)
(5S–FE)
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE
SCHEDULE A
CONDITIONS:
Towing a trailer, using a camper or car top carrier.
Repeated short trips of less than 8 km (5 miles) with outside temperature remaining below
freezing.
Extensive idling and/or low speed driving for long distances, such as police, taxi or door–to
–door delivery use.
Operating on dusty, rough, muddy or salt spread roads.
Maintenance operation: A = Check and adjust if necessary.
R = Replace, change or lubricate.
I = Inspect and correct or replace if necessary.
System
Service interval
(Use odometer
reading or months,
whichever comes first)
Maintenance services beyond 96,000 km (60,000 miles) should continue to be performed at the same intervals
shown for each maintenance schedule.
1,000 km
Maintenance items
ENGINE
1,000 miles
3.75
11.25
18.75
22.5
26.25
33.75
41.25
Drive belts
Engine coolant
EVA P
BRAKES
Months
56.25
MA–6
(item 1)
MA–10
A: Every 72 months (item 12)
MA–6
(item 2)
I: First period 96,000 km (60,000 miles) or 72 months.
I: After that every 12,000 km (7,500 miles) or 12 months.
R: Every 6 months
Engine oil and oil filter*
IGNITION
52.5
Timing belt (1)
Valve clearance
FUEL
48.75
See page
(item No.)
MA–8
(item 6)
MA–8
(item 7)
R: First period 72,000 km (46,000 miles) or 36 months.
R: After that every 48,000 km (30,000 miles) or 24 months.
Exhaust pipes and mountings
I: Every 24 months
MA–10
(item 11)
Air filter (2)*
I: Every 6 months
A: Every 36 months
MA–7
(item 3, 4)
Fuel lines end connections (3)
I: Every 36 months
MA–9
(item 10)
Fuel tank cap gasket
R; Every 72 months
MA–9
(item 9)
Spark plugs (Platinum tipped type)
R; Every 72 months
MA–7
(item 5)
Charcoal canister (4)
I; Every 72 months
MA–9
(item 8)
Brake linings and drums (6)
I: Every 12 months
MA–1 1
(item 15)
Brake pads and discs (Front and rear)
I; Every 12 months
MA–10
(item 14)
Brake line pipes and hoses
I: Every 24 months
MA–10
(item 13)
MA–3
MAINTENANCE
System
Service interval
(Use odometer
reading or months,
whichever comes first)
Maintenance items
CHASSIS
–
(5S–FE)
Maintenance services beyond 96,000 km (60,000 miles) should continue to be performed at the same intervals
shown for each maintenance schedule. ,
1,000 km
1,000 miles
Months
3.75
11.25
18.75 22.5 26.25
Drive shaft boots
baIl joints and dust covers
Manual t
anaaxle, automatic
tansaxie and differential (6)
Steering gear housing oil (7)
Bolts and nuts on chassis and
body (8)
33.75 37.5 41.25
48.75
56.25
I: Every 12 months
Steering linkage
SRS
airbag
See page
(item No.)
MA–12
(item 16)
MA–12
(item 17)
I; First period 10 years.
I: After that every 2 years.
I; Every 12 months MA–13
(item 19)
I: Everv 12 month:
MA–1 3
(item 20)
MA–14
R; Every 24 months (item 21, 22)
I: Every 24 months
MA–1 3
(item 18)
f: Every 12 months
MA–1 5
(item 23)
* marks indicates maintenance which is part of the warranty conditions for the Emission Control
Systems. The warranty period is in accordance with the owner’s guide or the warranty booklet.
*: California and New York specification vehicles
(1) Applicable to vehicles operated under conditions of extensive idling and/or low speed driving for
long distances such as police, taxi or door–to–door delivery use.
(2) Applicable when operating mainly on dusty roads.
(3) Includes inspection of fuel tank band and vapor vent system.
(4) Non –maintenance item except for California and New York.
(5) Also applicable to drum lining for parking brake. For other usage conditions, refer to SCHEDULE
B.
(6) Check for leakage.
(7) Check for oil leaks from steering gear housing.
(8) Applicable only when operating mainly on rough, muddy roads. The applicable parts are listed
below. For other usage conditions, refer to SCHEDULE B.
Front and rear suspension member to cross body.
Strut bar bracket to body bolts.
Bolts for seat installation.
MA–4
MAINTENANCE
–
(5S–FE)
SCHEDULE B
CONDITIONS:
Conditions others than those listed for SCHEDULE A.
Maintenance operation: A = Check and adjust if necessary.
R = Replace, change or lubricate.
I = Inspect and correct or replace if necessary.
system
Service interval
(Use odometer reading or
months, whichever comes first)
Maintenance services beyond 96,000 km (60,000 miles) should continue to be performed
at the same Intervals shown for each maintenance schedule.
Maintenance items
ENGINE
1,000 km
1,000 miles
Months
7.6
22.5
37.5
A: Every 72 months
Volvo clearance
Drive belt
I: First period 96,000 km (60,000 miles) or 72 months.
I: After that every 12,000 km (7,500 miles) or 12 months.
R: Every 12 months
Engine oil and oil filter*
Engine coolant
FUEL
IGNITION
EVAP
BRAKES
CHASSIS
See page
(item No.)
R: First period 72,000 km (45,000 miles) or 36 months.
R: After that every 48,000 km (30,000 miles) or 24 months.
Exhaust pipes and mountings
I: Every 36 months
Air filter*
R: Every 36 months
MA–10 (item 12)
MA–6 (item 2)
MA– 8 (item 6)
MA–8 (item 7)
MA–1 0 (item 11)
MA–7 (item 3, 4)
Fuel line’ and connections (1)
I: Every 36 month:
MA– 9 (item 10)
Fuel tank cap gasket
R: Every 72 months
MA–9 (item 9)
Spark pluq:(Platinum tipped type)
R: Every 72 months
MA–7 (item 5)
Charcoal canister (2)
I; Every 72 months
MA– 9 (item 8)
Brake linings end drums (3)
I: Even 24 months
MA–1 1 (item 15)
Brake pads and discs
I: Every 24 months
MA– 10 (item 14)
Brake line pipes and hoses (Front and rear)
I: Every 24 months
MA–10 (item 13)
Steering linkage
!: Every 24 months
MA–12 (item 16)
SRS airbag
MA–12 (item 17)
I: First period 10 years. I: After that every 2 years.
I: Every 24 months
MA–1 3 (item 19)
i: Every 24 months
MA– 13 (item 20)
Man^aI transaxle, automatic transaxle
and differential (4)
I: Every 24 months
MA– 14 (item 21, 22)
Steering goof housing oil (5)
I: Every 24 months
MA–13 (item 18)
Bolts and nuts on chassis and body (6y
I: Every 24 months
MA–1 5 (item 23)
Drive shaft boots
^aII joints and dust covers
* marks indicates maintenance which is part of the warranty conditions for the Emission Control
Systems. The warranty period is in accordance with the owner’s guide or the warranty booklet,
*; California and New York specification vehicles
(1) Includes inspection of fuel tank band and vapor vent system.
(2) Non–maintenance item except for California and New York.
(3) Also applicable to drum lining for parking brake.
(4) Check for leakage.
(5) Check for oil leaks from steering gear housing.
(6) The applicable parts are listed below.
• Front and rear suspension member to cross body.
• Strut bar bracket to body bolt.
Bolts for seat installation.
MA–5
MAINTENANCE
–
(5S–FE)
PREPARATION
EQUIPMENT
Belt tension gauge
Dial indicator or dial indicator with magnetic base
Micrometer
Brake hose
Mirror
Steel square
Tachometer
Torque wrench
Vernier calipers
COOLANT
Item
Engine coolant (w/ Heater)
Capacity
6.3 liters (6.7 US qts, 5.5 Imp. qts)
Classification
Ethylene–glycol base
LUBRICANT
Item
Engine oil (M/T)
Dry fill
Drain and refill
w/ Oil filter change
w/o Oil filter change
Engine oil (A/T)
Dry fill
Drain and refill
w/ Oil filter change
w/o Oil filter change
Capacity
4.2 liters (4.4 US qts, 3.7 Imp. qts)
Classification
API grade SG or SH, Energy –Conserving
ΙΙ
mutigrade engine oil or ILSAC multigrade
engine oil and recommended viscosity oil
3.6 liters (3.8 US qts, 3.2 Imp. qts)
3.4 liters (3.6 US qts, 3.0 Imp. qts)
4.3 liters (4.5 US qts, 3.8 Imp. qts)
3.18 liters (3.8 US qts, 3.2 Imp. qts)
3.4 liters (3.6 US qts, 3.0 Imp. qts)
Manual transaxle oil
(w/ Differential oil)
2.6 liters (2.7 US qts, 2.3 Imp. qts)
AN GL–3 SAE 75W–90
In case the above is unvailable
API GL–4 or GL–5
SAE 75w–90
Automatic transaxle fluid
Dry fill
Drain and refill
Differential oil
5.18 liters (5.9 US qts, 4.9 Imp. qts)
2.5 liters (2.6 US qts, 2.2 Imp. qts)
1.6 liters (1.7 US qts, 1.4 Imp. qts)
ATF DEXRON ΙΙ
ATF DEXRON ΙΙ
MA–6
MAINTENANCE
–
(5S–FE)
MAINTENANCE OPERATIONS
Cold Engine Operations
1. REPLACE TIMING BELT
(a) Remove the timing belt.
(See page EG–26)
(b) Install the timing belt.
(See page EG–33)
2. INSPECT DRIVE BELTS
(a) Visually check the belt for excessive wear, frayed
cords etc.
If necessary, replace the drive belt.
HINT: Cracks on the rib side of a belt are considered
acceptable. If the belt has chunks missing from the
ribs, it should be replaced.
(b) Using a belt tension gauge, measure the drive belt
tension.
Belt tension gauge:
Nippondenso BTG–20 (95506–00020)
Borroughs No.BT – 33 – 73F
Drive belt tension:
Generator (w/ A/C)
New belt
175 ± 5 lbf
Used belt
130 ± 10 lbf
Generator (w/o A/C)
New belt
125 ± 25 lbf
Used belt
95 ± 20 Ibf
PS pump
New belt
125 ± 25 lbf
Used belt
80 ± 20 lbf
If necessary, adjust the drive belt tension.
HINT:
• ”New belt” refers to a belt which has been used
less than 5 minutes on a running engine.
• Used belt” refers to a belt which has been used
on a running engine for 5 minutes or more.
• After installing the belt, check that it fits properly
in the ribbed grooves.
MA–7
MAINTENANCE
–
(5S–FE)
• Check by hand to confirm that .the belt has not
slipped out of the groove on the bottom of the
pulley.
• After installing a new belt, run the engine for
about 5 minutes and recheck the belt tension.
3. INSPECT AIR FILTER
(a) Visually check that the air filter is not damaged or
excessively oily.
If necessary, replace the air filter element.
(b) Clean the air filter with compressed air.
First blow from the inside thoroughly, then blow off
the outside of the air filter.
4. REPLACE AIR FILTER
Replace the air filter with a new one.
5. REPLACE SPARK PLUGS
(a) Disconnect the spark plug cords at the rubber boot.
DO NOT pull on the cords.
(b) Using a 16 mm plug wrench, remove the spark plugs.
(c) Check the electrode gap of new spark plugs.
Correct electrode gap:
1.1 mm (0.043 In.)
Recommended spark plugs:
PK20R11 for ND
BKR6EP11 for NGK
NOTICE: If adjusting the gap of a now plug, bend only the
base of the ground electrode. Do NOT touch the tip.
Never attempt to adjust the gap on a used plug.
MA–8
MAINTENANCE
–
(5S–FE)
(d) Using a 16 mm plug wrench, reinstall the spark
plugs.
Torque: 18 N–m (180 kgf–cm, 13 ft–lbf)
(e) Reconnect the spark plug cords.
6. REPLACE ENGINE OIL AND OIL FILTER
(See page EG–274)
Oil grade:
API grade SG or SH, Energy–Conserving II multi–
grade engine oil or ILSAC multigrade engine oil.
Recommended viscosity Is as shown in the illustra–
tion.
Drain and refill capacity:
M/T
w/ Oil filter change
3.6 liters (3.8 US qts, 3.2 Imp. qts)
w/o Oil filter change
3.4 liters (3.6 US qts, 3.0 Imp. qts)
A/T
w/ Oil filter change
3.6 liters (3.8 US qts, 3.2 Imp. qts)
w/o Oil filter change
3.4 liters (3.6 US qts, 3.0 Imp. qts)
7. REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT
(See page EG–241)
HINT:
• Use a good brand of ethylene–glycol base
engine coolant and mix it according to the
manufacturer ’s instructions.
• Using engine coolant which includes more than
5096 ethylene–glycol (but not more than 70%) is
recommended.
NOTICE:
• Do not use alcohol type coolant.
• The engine coolant should be mixed with demineral–
ized water or distilled water.
Capacity (w/ Heater):
6.3 liters (6.7 US qts, 5.5 Imp. qts)
MA–9
MAINTENANCE
–
(5S–FE)
8. INSPECT CHACOAL CANISTER
(a) Visually inspect the canister case.
(b) Check for clogged filter and stuck check valve.
• Using low pressure compressed air (4.71 kPa,
48 gf/cmT, 0.68 psi), blow into port A and check
that air flows without resistance from the other
ports.
• Blow low pressure compressed air (4.71 kPa, 48
gf/cm2, 0.68 psi) into port B and check that air
does not flow from the other ports.
If a problem is found, replace the charcoal canister.
(c) Clean filter in canister.
• Clean the filter by blowing 294 kPa (3 kgf/cm’,
43 psi) of compressed air into port A while hold–
ing port B closed.
NOTICE:
• Do not attempt to wash the canister.
• No activated carbon should come out.
9. REPLACE GASKET IN FUEL TANK CAP
(a) Remove the old gasket from the tank cap.
NOTICE: Do not damage the tank cap.
(b) Install a new gasket by hand.
(c) Check the cap for damage or cracks.
(d) Reinstall the cap and check the torque limiter.
10. INSPECT FUEL LINES AND CONNECTIONS
Visually check the fuel lines for cracks, leakage, loose
connections, deformation or tank band looseness.
MA–10
MAINTENANCE
–
(5S–FE)
11. INSPECT EXHAUST PIPES AND MOUNTINGS
Visually check the pipes, hangers and connections for
severe corrosion, leaks or damage.
12. ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE
(See page EG –12)
Valve clearance (Cold):
Intake
0.19 – 0.29 mm (0.007 – 0.011 In.)
Exhaust
0.28 – 0.38 mm (0.011 – 0.015 In.)
BRAKES
13. INSPECT BRAKE LINE PIPES AND HOSES
HINT: Check in a well lighted area. Check the entire
circumference and length of the brake hoses using a
mirror as required. Turn the front wheels fully right or
left before checking the front brake.
(a) Check all brake lines and hoses for:
•
Damage
•
Wear
•
Deformation
•
Cracks
•
Corrosion
•
Leaks
•
Bends
•
Twists
(b) Check all clamps for tightness and connections for
leakage.
(c) Check that the hoses and lines are clear of sharp
edges, moving parts and the exhaust system.
(d) Check that the lines installed in grommets pass thr–
ough the center of the grommets.
14. INSPECT FRONT AND REAR BRAKE PADS AND DISCS
(a) Check the thickness of the disc brake pads and check
for irregular wear.
Minimum pad thickness:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
MA–11
MAINTENANCE
–
(5S–FE)
HINT: If a squealing or scraping noise comes from the
brake during driving, check the pad wear indicator to
see if it is contacting the disc rotor. If so, the disc pad
should be replaced.
(b) Check the disc for wear or runout.
Minimum disc thickness:
Front
26.0 mm (1.024 in.)
Rear
9.0 mm (0.354 In.)
Maximum disc runout:
Front
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Rear
0.15 mm (0.0059 in.)
15. INSPECT BRAKE LININGS AND DRUMS
(a) Check the lining – to – drum contact condition and
lining wear.
Minimum lining thickness:
1.0 mm (0.0039 in.)
(b) Check the brake drums for scoring or wear.
Maximum drum inside diameter:
Drum brake
230.6 mm (9.079 in.)
Disc brake
171.0 mm (6.732 in.)
(c) Clean the brake parts with a damp cloth.
NOTICE: Do not use compressed air to clean the brake
parts.
(d) Disc brake:
Settle the parking brake shoes and drum. When per–
forming the road test in item 25, do the following:
• Drive the vehicle at approx. 50 km/h (30 mph) on
a safe, level and dry road.
• With the parking brake release knob pushed in,
pull on the lever with 88 N (9 kgf, 20 lbf) of force.
• Drive the vehicle for approx. 400 m (1 /4 mile) in
this condition.
• Repeat this procedure 2 or 3 times.
Check parking lever travel.
If necessary, adjust the parking brake.
MA–12
MAINTENANCE
–
(5S–FE)
CHASSIS
I6. INSPECT STEERING LINKAGE
(a) Check the steering wheel freeplay.
Maximum steering wheel freeplay:
30 mm (1.18 In.)
With the vehicle stopped and the front wheels point–
ing straight ahead, rock the steering wheel gently
back and forth with light finger pressure.
(b) Check the steering linkage for looseness or damage.
Check that:
• Tie rod ends do not have excessive play.
• Dust seals and boots are not damaged.
• Boot clamps are not loose.
17. INSPECT SRS AIRBAG
Driver Airbag:
Visually inspect the steering wheel pad (airbag and
inflater).
• Use the diagnosis check to check if there are
abnormalities.
• Check that there are no cuts, cracks or noticeable
color changes on the surface of the steering
wheel pad or in the center groove of the pad.
• Remove the steering wheel pad from the vehicle
and check the wiring and steering wheel for
damage and corrosion due to rusting, etc.
If necessary, replace the steering wheel pad.
Front Passenger Airbag:
Visually inspect the front passenger airbag assembly
(airbag and inflater).
• Use the diagnosis check to check if there are
abnormalities.
• Check that there are no cuts, cracks or noticeable
color changes in the front passenger airbag door.
MA–13
MAINTENANCE
–
(5S–FE)
• Remove the front passenger airbag assembly
from the vehicle and check the wiring and front
passenger airbag door for damage and corrosion
due to rusting, etc.
If necessary, replace the front passenger airbag as–
sembly.
CAUTION:
• For removal and replacement of the steering wheel
pad or front passenger airbag assembly, see page
RS–19 or 31 and be sure to perform the operation
in the correct order.
• Before disposing of the steering wheel pad or front
passenger airbag assembly, it must first be deployed
by using SST (See page RS–22 or 35).
18. INSPECT STEERING GEAR HOUSING OIL
Check the steering gear housing for oil leakage.
19. INSPECT DRIVE SHAFT BOOTS
Check the drive shaft boots for clamp looseness, leak–
age or damage.
20. INSPECT BALL JOINTS AND DUST COVERS
(a) Inspect the ball joints for excessive looseness.
•
Jack up the front of the vehicle and place
wooden blocks with a height of 180–200 mm
(7.09–7.87 in.) under the front tires.
•
Lower the jack until there is about half a load on
the front coil spring. Place stands under the vehi–
cle for safety.
•
Check that the front wheels are in a straight
forward position, and block them with chocks.
Using a lever, pry up the end of the lower arm,
and check the amount of play.
Maximum ball joint vertical play:
0 mm (0 in.)
If there is play, replace the ball joint.
(b) Check the dust cover for damage.
MA–14
MAINTENANCE
–
(5S–FE)
21. CHECK TRANSAXLE OIL (FLUID)
(a) Visually check the transaxle for oil (fluid) leakage.
If leakage is found, check for the cause and repair.
22. REPLACE TRANSAXLE OIL (FLUID)
A. M/T:
Replace transaxle oil
(a) Remove the filler and drain plugs, and drain the oil.
(b) Reinstall the drain plug securely.
(c) Add new oil until it begins to run out of the filler hole.
Recommended transaxle oil:
Oil grade API GL–3
Viscosity SAE 75W–90
Capacity:
2.6 liters (2.7 US qts, 2.3 Imp. qts)
In case the above oil grade is unavailable, use type A
or B.
Type A:
Oil grade API GL–4
Viscosity SAE 75W–90
Type B:
Oil grade API GL–5
Viscosity SAE 75W–90
(d) Reinstall the filler plug securely.
B. A/T:
Replace transaxle fluid
Transmission:
(a) Using a 10 mm hexagon wrench, remove the drain
plug and drain the fluid.
(b) Reinstall the drain plug securely.
(c) With the engine OFF, add new fluid through the dip–
stick tube.
Transmission fluid:
ATF DEXRON II
Drain and refill capacity:
2.5 liters (2.6 US qts, 2.2 Imp. qts)
(d) Start the engine and shift the selector into all posi–
tions from “P” through “L”, and then shift into “P”.
MA–15
MAINTENANCE
–
(5S–FE)
(e) With the engine idling, check the fluid level. Add fluid
up to the “COOL” level on the dipstick.
NOTICE: Do not overfill. The transmission and differen–
tial are separate units.
(f) Recheck the fluid level at the normal operating tem–
perature (70 – 80 C (158 –176 F)) and add as neces–
sary.
Differential:
(a) Remove the filler plug.
(b) Using a 10 mm hexagon wrench, remove the drain
plug and drain the fluid.
(c) Reinstall the drain plug securely.
(d) Add new fluid until it begins to run out of the filler
hole.
Differential fluid:
ATF DEXRON II
Capacity:
1.6 liters (1.7 US qts, 1.4 Imp. qts)
(e) Reinstall the filler plug securely.
23. TIGHTEN BOLTS AND NUTS ON CHASSIS AND
BODY
Tighten the following parts:
• Front seat mount bolts
Torque: 37 N–m (375 kgf–cm, 27 ft–lbf)
• Front suspension member–to–body mounting
bolts
Torque: 181 N–m (1,850 kgf–cm, 134 ft–lbf)
MA–16
MAINTENANCE
–
(5S–FE)
• Rear suspension member – to – body mounting
nuts
Torque: 51 N–m (520 kgf–cm, 38 ft–lbf)
24. BODY INSPECTION
(a) Check the body exterior for dents, scratches and rust.
(b) Check the underbody for rust and damage.
If necessary, replace or repair.
25. ROAD TEST
(a) Check the engine and chassis for abnormal noises.
(b) Check that the vehicle does not wander or pull to one
side.
(c) Check that the brakes work properly and do not drag.
26. FINAL INSPECTION
(a) Check the operation of the body parts:
Hood:
Auxiliary catch operates properly
Hood locks securely when closed
• Front and rear doors:
Door lock operates properly
Doors close properly
• Luggage compartment door and back door:
Door lock operates properly
Seats:
Seat adjusts easily and locks securely in any
position
Front seat back locks securely in any position
Folding–down rear seat backs lock securely
(b) Be sure to deliver a clean car. Especially check:
• Steering wheel
• Shift lever knob
• All switch knobs
• Door handles
• Seats
MA–17
MAINTENANCE
GENERAL MAINTENANCE
These are some maintenance and inspec–
tion items which are considered to be the
owner’s responsibility. They can be perfo–
rmed by the owner or he can have them
done at a service shop. These items in–
clude those which should be checked on a
daily basis, those which, in most cases, do
not require (special) tools and those which
are considered to be reasonable for the
owner to perform. Items and procedures
for general maintenance are as follows:
OUTSIDE VEHICLE
1. TIRES
(a) Check the pressure with a gauge. Adjust if
necessary.
(b) Check for cuts, damage or excessive wear.
2. WHEEL NUTS
When checking the tires, check the nuts
for looseness or for missing nuts. If neces–
sary, tighten them.
3. TIRE ROTATION
It is recommended that tires be rotated
every 12,000 km (7,500 miles).
4. WINDSHIELD WIPER BLADES
Check for wear or cracks whenever they
do not wipe clean. Replace if necessary.
6. FLUID LEAKS
(a) Check underneath for leaking fuel, oil,
water or other fluid.
(b) If you smell gasoline fumes or notice any
leak, have the cause found and corrected.
6. DOORS AND ENGINE HOOD
(a) Check that all doors including the trunk lid
and back door operate smoothly, and that
all latches lock securely.
(b) Check that the engine hood secondary
latch secures the hood from opening
when
the primary latch is released.
INSIDE VEHICLE
7. LIGHTS
(a) Check that the headlights, stop lights,
taillights, turn signal lights, and other
lights are all working.
(b) Check the headlight aim.
6. WARNING LIGHTS AND BUZZERS
–
(5S–FE)
Check that all warning lights and buzzers
function properly.
9. HORN
Check that it is working.
10. WINDSHIELD GLASS
Check for scratches, pits or abrasions.
11. WINDSHIELD WIPER AND WASHER
(a) Check operation of the wipers and washer.
(b) Check that the wipers do not streak.
12. WINDSHIELD DEFROSTER
Check that the air comes out from the
defroster outlet when operating the heater
or air conditioner at defroster mode.
13. REAR VIEW MIRROR
Check that it is mounted securely.
14. SUN VISORS
Check that they more freely and mounted
securely.
15. STEERING WHEEL
Check that it has the specified freeplay. Be
alert for changes in steering condition,
such as hard steering, excessive freeplay
or strange noise.
16. SEATS
(a) Check that all front seat controls such as
seat adjusters, seatback recliner, etc. op–
erate smoothly.
(b) Check that all latches lock securely in any
position.
(c) Check that the locks hold securely in any
latches position.
(d) Check that the head restraints move up
and down smoothly and that the locks
hold securely in any latched position.
(e) For folding–down rear seat backs, check
that the latches look securely.
17. SEAT BELTS
(a) Check that the seat belt system such as
buckles, retractors and anchors operate
properly and smoothly.
(b) Check that the belt webbing is not cut,
frayed, worn or damaged.
18. ACCELERATOR PEDAL
Check the pedal for smooth operation and
uneven pedal effort or catching.
19. CLUTCH PEDAL (See page CL–6)
Check the pedal for smooth operation.
Check that the pedal has the proper
freeplay.
MA–18
MAINTENANCE
20. BRAKE PEDAL (See page BR–8)
(a) Check the pedal for smooth operation.
(b) Check that the pedal has the proper re–
serve distance and freeplay.
(c) Check the brake booster function.
21. BRAKES
At a safe place, check that the brakes do
not pull to one side when applied.
22. PARKING BRAKE (See page BR–10)
(a) Check that the lever has the proper travel.
(b) On a safe incline, check that the vehicle is
help securely with only the parking brake
applied.
23. AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION PARK
MECHANISM
(a) Check that lock release button of the se–
lector lever for proper and smooth opera–
tion.
(b) On a safe incline, check that the vehicle is
held securely with the selector lever in
the ”P” position and all brakes released.
UNDER HOOD
24. WINDSHIELD WASHER FLUID
Check that there is sufficient fluid in the
tank.
25. ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL
Check that the coolant level is between
the ”FULL” and ”LOW” lines on the see–
through reservoir.
28. RADIATOR AND HOSES
(a) Check that the front of the radiator is
clean and not blocked with leaves, dirt or
bugs.
(b) Check the hoses for cracks, kinks, rot or
loose connections.
27. BATTERY ELECTROLYTE LEVEL
Check that the electrolyte level of all bat–
tery cells is between the upper and lower
level lines on the case. If level low, add
distilled water only.
28. BRAKE AND CLUTCH FLUID LEVELS
(a) Check that the brake fluid level is near the
upper level line on the see –through reser–
voir.
(b) Check that the clutch fluid level is within
±5 mm (0.20 in.) of the reservoir filling
line.
–
(5S–FE)
29. ENGINE DRIVE BELTS
Check all drive belts for fraying, cracks,
wear or oiliness.
30. ENGINE OIL LEVEL
Check the level on the dipstick with the
engine turned off.
31. POWER STEERING FLUID LEVEL
Check the level.
The level should be in the “HOT” or “COLD”
range depending on the fluid temperature.
32. AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID
LEVEL
(a) Park the vehicle on a level surface.
(b) With the engine idling and the’ parking
brake applied, shift the selector into all
positions from ”P” to ”L” and then shift
into ”P”.
(c) Pull out the dipstick and wipe off the fluid
with a clean rag. Re–insert the dipstick
and check that the fluid– level is in the HOT
ran nge.
(d) Perform this check with the fluid at normal
driving temperature (70 – 80 C or 158–
176’ F).
NOTE: Wait about 30 minutes before che–
cking the fluid level after extended driving
at high speeds in hot weather, driving in
heavy traffic or with a trailer.
33. EXHAUST SYSTEM
Visually inspect for cracks, holes or loose
supports.
If any change in the sound of the exhaust
or smell of the exhaust fumes is noticed,
have the cause located and corrected.
MA–19
MAINTENANCE
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE DATA
Drive belt tension
Generator (w/ A/C)
New belt
Generator (w/ A/C)
Used belt
Generator (w/o A/C)
New belt
Generator (w/o A/C)
Use belt
PS pump
New belt
PS pump
Spark plug
Spark plug
Spark plug
Recommended spark plug
Used belt
Recommended spark plug
ND
Correct electrode gap
NGK
Firing order
Valve clearance
Intake
Valve clearance
Exhaust
Front and rear brake
Pad thickness
Minimum
Disc thickness
Front
Disc thickness
Rear
Minimum
Disc runout
Front
Maximum
Disc runout
Rear
Maximum
Minimum
Parking brake
Lining thickness
Minimum
Drum inside diameter
Drum brake
Maximum
Drum inside diameter
Disc brake
Maximum
Front axle and suspension
Ball joint vertical play
Maximum
Steering wheel freeplay
Maximum
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part tightended
Front seat mounting bolts
Front suspension member x Body
Rear suspension member x Body
–
(5S–FE)
MA–20
MAINTENANCE
–
(5S–FE)
(1MZ–FE)
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE
SCHEDULE A
CONDITIONS:
• Towing a trailer, using a camper or car top carrier.
• Repeated short trips of less than 8 km (5 miles) with outside temperature remaining below
freezing.
• Extensive idling and/or low speed driving for long distances, such as police, taxi or door–to
–door delivery use.
• Operating on dusty, rough, muddy or salt spread roads.
Maintenance operation: A = Check and adjust if necessary.
R = Replace, change or lubricate.
I = Inspect and correct or replace if necessary.
System
Service interval
(Use odometer
reading or months,
whichever comes first.)
Maintenance services beyond 98,000 km (60.000 miles) should continue to be poformed at the same intervals
shown for each maintenance schedule.
Maintenance items
ENGINE
x 1,000 km
X 1,000 miles
3.75
11.25
18.75
22.5
I6.t6
33.76
37.6
Drive belt
Engine coolant
A: Evan 72 month:
R: Every 6 months
CHASSIS
MA–27
(item 6)
MA–27
(item 7)
R: first period 72,040 km (46,000 mile:) or 36 months.
R: After that every 48,000 km (30,000 miles) or 24 months.
1: Every 24 months
MA–29
(item 11)
Fuel tank cap gasket
1: Every 6 months MA–25
R: Every 36 month: (item 3, 4)
M^–29
i: Every 36 months (item 10)
MA–28
R: Even 72 months (item 9)
Spark plugs (Platinum tipped type)
R: Every 72 month:
MA–25
(item 5)
Charcoal canister (4)
I: Every 72 month:
MA–28
(item 8)
Broke linings and drums (6)
I: Every 12 months
MA–30
(item 15)
Air filter ^ty*
Fuel lines and connections (3)
BRAKES
MA–29
(item 12)
MA–24
(item 2)
i: First period 96.000 km (80,000 miles) or 72 months.
I: After that every 12,000 km (7,500 miles) or 12 month:.
Exhavst pipe* and mountings
EVAP
See page
(item No.)
MA–24
(item 1)
Engine oil and oil filter*
IGNITION
Month=
Timing belt (1)
valve clearance
FUEL
48,7a
58.Z5
Broke pads and discs (Front and rev)
I: Even 12 months
MA–30 (item
14)
Broke line pipes and hoses
I: Every 24 month:
MA–29
(item 13)
I: Every 12 months
MA–31
(item 16)
Steering linkage
SRS ahbap
MA–¿¿ 1
(item 17)
l: First period 10 years.
I: After that every 2 years.
Ba1I joints and dust covtr:
I: Every 12 months
Drive shaft boots
I: Ev..y 12 months
Automatic transmission and
differential oil
Steering gear housing oil (6)
Bob and nuts on chassis and body (7)
MA–33
(item 20)
MA–32
(item 19)
MA–33
R: Every 24 months
(item 22)
MA–32
I: Even 24 month: (item 18)
I: Every 12 months
MA–34
(item 23)
MA–21
MAINTENANCE
–
(1MZ–FE)
.mark indicates maintenance which is part of the warranty conditions for the Emission Control
Systems. The warranty period is in accordance with the owner’s guide or the warranty booklet.
(: California and New York specification vehicles)
(1) Applicable to vehicles operated under conditions of extensive idling and/or low speed driving for
long distances such as police, taxi or door–to–door delivery use.
(2) Applicable when operating mainly on dusty roads. If not, apply SCHEDULE B.
(3) Includes inspection of fuel tank band and vapor vent system.
(4) Non –maintenance item except for California and New York.
(5) Also applicable to drum lining for parking brake. For other usage conditions, refer to SCHEDULE
B.
(6) Check for oil leaks from steering gear housing.
(7) Applicable only when operating mainly on rough, muddy roads. The applicable parts are listed
below. For other usage conditions, refer to SCHEDULE B.
• Front and rear suspension member to cross body.
• Strut bar bracket to body.
• Bolts for seat installation.
MA–22
MAINTENANCE
–
(1MZ–FE)
SCHEDULE B
CONDITIONS:
Conditions others than those listed for SCHEDULE A.
Maintenance operation: A = Check and adjust if necessary.
R = Replace, change or lubricate.
I = Inspect and correct or replace if necessary.
system
Service interval
(Use odometer reading or
months, whichever comes first)
Maintenance Items
ENGINE
Maintenance services beyond 98,000 km (84,000 mile:) should continue to be performed
at the same Intervals shown for each maintenance schedule,
1,000 km
1,000 miles
7.5
22.6
37.5
52.5
A; Every 72 months
Valve clearance
Drive belt
I: First period 98,000 km (60,000 miles) or 72 months.
I: After that every 12,000 km (7,600 miles) or 12 months.
Engine oil and oil filter*
Engine coolant
R; Every 12 months
R: First period 72,000 km (46,000 miles) or 36 months.
R: After that every 48,000 km (30,000 miles) or 24 months.
I; Every 36 month:
Exhaust pipes and mountings
FUEL
IGNITION
EVAP
BRAKES
See page
(item No.)
MA–29 (item 12)
MA–24 (item 2)
MA–27 (item6)
MA–27 (item 7)
MA–24 (item 11)
R: Every 36 months
MA–25 (item 4)
Fuel lines and connections (1)
I: Every 36 months
MA–29 (item 10)
Fuel tank cap gasket
R: Every 72 months
MA–28 (item 9)
R; Every 72 months
MA–25 (item 5)
nk filter*
spark plugs (Platinum tipped type)
Charcoal canister (2)
Broke linings and drums (3)
Brake pads and disc (Front and rear)
CHASSIS
Months
I; Every 72 months
MA–28 (item 8)
I: Every 24 months
MA–30 (item 15)
I: Every 24 months
MA–30 (item 14)
Stake line pipes and hoses
I: Every 24 months
MA–29 (item 13)
Steering linkage
I; Every 24 months
MA–31 (item 16)
MA–31 (item 17)
I; First period 10 years. I: After that every 2 years.
I; Every 24 month:
MA–33 (item 20)
Drive shaft boots
I: Every 24 months
MA–32 (item 19)
Automatic transmission and differential oil (4)
I: Every 24 months
MA–33 (item 22)
i: Every 24 months
MA–32 (item 18)
Ball Jolnta and dust covers
Steering gear housing oil (6)
Bolts end nuts on chassis end body (6)
I; Every 24 months
MA–34 (item 23)
* mark indicates maintenance which is part of the warranty conditions for the Emission Control
Systems. The warranty period is in accordance with the owner’s guide or the warranty booklet.
(*: California and New York specification vehicles)
(1) Includes inspection of fuel tank band and vapor vent system.
(2) Non–maintenance item except for California and New York.
(3) Also applicable to drum lining for parking brake.
(4) Check for leakage.
(5) Check for oil leaks from steering gear housing.
(6) The applicable parts are listed below.
Front and rear suspension member to cross body.
Strut bar bracket to body.
Bolts for seat installation.
MA–23
MAINTENANCE
–
(1MZ–FE)
PREPARATION
EQUIPMENT
Belt tension gauge
Dial indicator with magnetic base
Micrometer
Brake hose
Mirror
Steel square
Thermometer
Torque wrench
Vernier calipers
COOLANT
Item
Capacity
8.7 liters (9.2 US qts. 7.7 Imp. qts)
Engine coolant
Classification
Ethylene–glycol base
LUBRICANT
Capacity
Claasifioation
Engine oil
Drain and refill
w/ Oil filter change
w/o Oil filter change
4.7 liters (5.0 US qts, 4.1 Imp. qts)
4.5 liters (4.8 US qts, 4.0 Imp. qts)
Automatic transaxle fluid
Drain end refill
API grade SG or SH, Energy –Conserving
ΙΙ
or ILSAC multigrede and recommended
viscosity oil with SAE bW–30
being the preferred engine oil
ATF DEXRON ΙΙ
3.5 liters (3.7 US qts, 3.1 Imp. qts)
Differential fluid
0.95 liters (1.0 US qts, 0.8 Imp. qts)
Item
ATF DEXRON ΙΙ
MA–24
MAINTENANCE
–
(1MZ–FE)
MAINTENANCE OPERATIONS
Cold Engine Operations
1. REPLACE TIMING BELT
(a) Remove the timing belt.
(See page EG–41)
(b) Install the timing belt.
(See page EG–49)
2. INSPECT DRIVE BELT
(a) Visually check the belt for excessive wear, frayed
cords etc.
If necessary, replace the drive belt.
HINT: Cracks on the rib side of a belt are considered
acceptable. If the belt has chunks missing from the
ribs, it should be replaced.
(b) Using a belt tension gauge, measure the drive belt
tension.
Belt tension gauge:
Nippondenso BTG–20 (95508–00020)
Borroug hs No. BT–33–73F
Drive belt tension:
Generator
New belt
175 ± 5 lbf
Used belt
115 + 20 lbf
PS pump
New belt
150 – 185 lbf
Used belt
115± 20 lbf
If nesessary, adjust the drive belt tension.
HINT:
“New belt” refers to a belt which has been used 5
miniutes or less on a running engine.
“Used belt” refers to a belt which has been used
on a running engine for 5 minutes or more.
After installing the belt, check that it fits properly
in the ribbed grooves.
Check by hand to confirm that the belt has not
slipped out of the groove on the bottom of the
pulley.
After installing a new belt, run the engine for
about 5 minutes and recheck the belt tension.
MA–25
MAINTENANCE
–
(1MZ – FE)
3. INSPECT AIR FILTER
(a) Visually check that the air filter is not excessively
damaged or oily.
(b) Clean the element with compressed air.
First blow from the inside thoroughly, then blow off
the outside of the air filter.
4. REPLACE AIR FILTER
Replace the air filter with a new one.
5. REPLACE SPARK PLUGS
(a) Using a 5 mm hexagon wrench, remove the 2 nuts and
V–bank cover.
(b) Disconnect the 6 ignition coil connectors from the RH
and LH cylinder heads.
(c) Remove the6 bolts and6 ignition coils from the RH
and LH cylinder heads.
HINT: Arrange the ignition coils in the correct order.
MA–26
MAINTENANCE
–
(1MZ–FE)
(e) Using a 16 mm plug wrench, remove the 6 spark plugs
from the RH and LH cylinder heads.
(f) Check the electrode gap of new spark plugs.
Correct electrode gap:
1.1 mm (0.043 In.)
Recommended spark plugs:
PKZOR11 for ND
BKR6EP–11 for NGK
NOTICE: If adjusting the gap of a new plug, bend only the
base of the ground electrode. DO NOT touch the tip.
Never attempt to adjust the gap on a used plug.
(g) Using a 16 mm plug wrench, reinstall the 6 spark
plugs.
Torque: 18 N–m (180 kgf.cm, 13 ft–lbf)
(h) Reinstall the6 ignition coil with the6 bolts.
Torque: 8 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 89 in.–lbf)
(i) Reconnect the 6 ignition coil connectors.
MA–27
MAINTENANCE
–
(1MZ–FE)
(j) Using a 5 mm hexagon wrench, reinstall the V–
bank cover with the 2 nuts.
6. REPLACE ENGINE OIL AND OIL FILTER
(See page EG–372)
Oil grade:
API grade SG or SH, Energy–Conserving ΙΙ or
ILSAC multigrade engine oil. Recommended visco
sity is as shown in the Illustration with SAE 5W–30
being the preferred engine oil.
Capacity:
Drain and refill
w/ 0il filter change
4.7 liters (5.0 US qts, 4.1 Imp. qts)
w/o Oil filter change
4.5 liters (4.8 US qts, 4.0 Imp. qts)
7. REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT
(See page EG–319)
HINT:
• Use a good brand of ethylene–glycol base
engine coolant and mix it according to the
manufacturer ’s instructions.
• Using engine coolant which includes more than
5096 ethylene–glycol (but not more than 7096) is
recommended.
NOTICE:
Do not use alcohol type coolant.
The engine coolant should be mixed with demineral–
ized water or distilled water.
Capacity:
8.7 liters (9.2 US qts, 7.7 Imp. qts)
MA–28
MAINTENANCE
–
(1MZ–FE)
8. INSPECT CHARCOAL CANISTER
(a) Visually inspect the canister case.
(b) Check for clogged filter and stuck check valve.
Blow low pressure compressed air (4.71 kPa, 48
gf/cm, 0.68 psi) into port A and check that air
flows without resistance from the other ports.
• Blow low pressure compressed air (4.71 kPa, 48
gf/cm, 0.68 psi) into port B and check that air
does not flow from the other ports.
If a problem is found, replace the charcoal canister.
(c) Clean filter in canister.
Clean the filter by blowing 294 kPa (3 kgf/cm,
43 psi) of compressed air into port A while hold–
ing port B closed.
NOTICE:
•
•
Do not attempt to wash the canister.
No activated carbon should come out.
9. REPLACE GASKET IN FUEL TANK CAP
(a) Remove the old gasket from the tank cap. Do not
damage the cap.
(b) Install a new gasket by hand.
(c) Check the cap for damage or cracks.
(d) Install the cap and check the torque limiter.
MA–29
MAINTENANCE
–
(1MZ–FE)
10. INSPECT FUEL LINES AND CONNECTIONS
Visually check the fuel lines for cracks, leakage, loose
connections, deformation or tank band looseness.
11. INSPECT EXHAUST PIPES AND MOUNTINGS
Visually check the pipes, hangers and connections for
severe corrosion, leaks or damage.
12. ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE
(See page EG –13)
Valve clearance (Cold):
Intake
0.15 – 0.25 mm (0.006 – 0.010 in.)
Exhaust
0.25 – 0.35 mm (0.010 – 0.014 in.)
BRAKES
13. INSPECT BRAKE LINE PIPES AND HOSES
HINT: Check in a well lighted area. Check the entire
circumference and length of the brake hoses using a
mirror as required. Turn the front wheels fully right or
left before checking the front brake.
(a) Check all brake lines and hoses for:
• Damage
• Wear
• Deformation
• Cracks
• Corrosion
• Leaks
• Bends
• Twists
• (b) Check all clamps for tightness and connections for
leakage.
(c) Check that the hoses and lines are clear of sharp
edges, moving parts and the exhaust system.
(d) Check that the lines installed in grommets pass
through the center of the grommets.
MA–30
MAINTENANCE
–
(1MZ–FE)
14. INSPECT FRONT AND REAR BRAKE PADS AND
DISCS
(See BR section)
(a) Check the thickness of the disc brake pads and check
for irregular wear.
Minimum pad thickness:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
HINT: If a squealing or scraping noise comes from the
brake durings driving, check the pad wear indicator to
see if it is contacting the disc. If so, the disc pad
should be replaced.
(b) Check the disc for wear or runout.
Minimum disc thickness:
Front
26.0 mm (1.024 In.)
Rear
9.0 mm (0.354 in.)
Maximum disc runout:
Front
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Rear
0.15 mm (0.0059 in.)
15. INSPECT PARKING BRAKE LININGS AND DRUMS
(See BR section)
(a) Check the lining – to – drum contact condition and
lining wear.
Minimum lining thickness:
1.0 mm (0.0039 in.)
(b) Check the brake drums for scoring or wear.
Maximum drum Inside diameter:
171.0 mm (8.732 in.)
(c) Clean the brake parts with a damp cloth.
NOTICE: Do not use compressed sir to clean the brake
parts.
MA–31
MAINTENANCE
–
(1MZ–FE)
(d) Settle the parking brake shoes and drum. When per–
forming the road test in item 24, do the following:
•
Drive the vehicle at approx. 50 km/h (30 mph) on
a safe, level and dry road.
•
Center lever type parking brake:
With the parking brake release knob pushed in,
pull on the lever with 88 N (9 kgf, 20 lbf) of force.
•
Pedal type parking brake:
•
Depress the pedal with 147 N (15 kgf, 33 lbf) of
force.
•
Drive the vehicle for approx. 400 m (1 /4 mile) in
this condition.
•
Repeat this procedure 2 or 3 times.
Check parking lever travel.
CHASSIS
16. INSPECT STEERING LINKAGE
(a) Check the steering wheel freeplay.
Maximum steering wheel freeplay:
30 mm (1.18 In.)
With the vehicle stopped and pointed straight ahead,
rock the steering wheel gently back and forth with
light finger pressure.
(b) Check the steering linkage for looseness or damage.
Check that:
•
•
•
Tie rod ends do not have excessive play.
Dust seals and boots are not damaged.
Boot clamps are not loose.
17. INSPECT SRS AIRBAG
Driver Airbag:
Visually inspect the steering wheel pad (airbag and
inflater).
• Use the diagnosis check to check if there are
abnormalities.
• Check that there are no cuts, cracks or noticeable
color changes on the surface of the steering
wheel pad or in the center groove of the pad.
MA–32
MAINTENANCE
–
(1MZ–FE)
Remove the steering wheel pad from the vehicle
and check the wiring and steering wheel for
damage and corrosion due to rusting, etc.
If necessary, replace the steering wheel pad.
Front Passenger Airbag:
Visually inspect the front passenger airbag assembly
(airbag and inflater).
• Use the diagnosis check to check if there are
abnormalities.
• Check that there are no cuts, cracks or noticeable
color changes in the front passenger airbag door.
• Remove the front passenger airbag assembly
from the vehicle and check the wiring and front
passenger airbag door for damage and corrosion
due to rusting, etc.
If necessary, replace the front passenger airbag as–
sembly.
CAUTION:
• For removal and replacement of the steering wheel
pad or front passenger airbag assembly, see page
RS section and be sure to perform the operation in
the correct order.
• Before disposing of the steering wheel pad or front
passenger airbag assembly the airbag must first be
deployed by using SST (See page RS section).
18. INSPECT STEERING GEAR HOUSING OIL
Check the steering gear housing for oil leakage.
19. INSPECT DRIVE SHAFT BOOTS
Check the drive shaft boots for clamp looseness,
grease leakage or damage.
MA–33
MAINTENANCE
–
(1MZ–FE)
20. INSPECT BALL JOINTS AND DUST COVERS
(a) Inspect the ball joints for excessive looseness.
• Jack up the front of the vehicle and place
wooden blocks with a height of 180–200 m m
(7.09–7.87 in.) under the front tires.
• Lower the jack untiI there is about half a load onthe front coil
springs. Place stands under the
vehicle for safety.
• Check that the front wheels are in a straight
forward position, and block them with chocks.
• Using a lever, pry up the end of the lower arm,
and check the amount of play.
Maximum ball joint vertical play:
0 mm (0 in.)
If there is play, replace the ball joint.
(b) Check the dust cover for damage.
21. CHECK TRANSAXLE FLUID
Visually check the transaxle for fluid leakage.
If leakage is found, check for cause and repair.
22. REPLACE TRANSAXLE FLUID
A. Replace transaxle (transmission) fluid
(a) Using a 10 mm hexagon wrench, remove the drain
plug and drain the fluid.
(b) Reinstall the drain plug securely.
(c) With the engine OFF, add new fluid through the dip–
stick tube.
Transaxle fluid:
ATF DEXRON ΙΙ
Drain and refill capacity:
3.5 liters (3.7 US qts, 3.1 Imp. qts)
(d) Start the engine and shift the selector into all posi–
tions from “P” through “L”, and then shift into “P”.
(e) With the engine idling, check the fluid level. Add fluid
up to the ”COOL” level on the dipstick.
NOTICE: Do not overfill. The transmission and differen–
tial are separate units.
(f) Recheck the fluid level at the normal operating tem–
perature (70 – 80°C (158 – 176°F)) and add as necessary.
MA–34
MAINTENANCE
–
(1MZ–FE)
B. Replace differential fluid
(a) Remove the filler plug.
(b) Using a 10 mm hexagon wrench, remove the drain
plug and drain the fluid.
(c) Using a 10 mm hexagon wrench, install the drain plug
securely.
(d) Add new fluid until it begins to run out of the filler
hole.
(e) Check that the fluid comes to within 5 mm (0.20 in.) of
the bottom edge of the filler hole.
Fluid type:
ATF DEXRON ΙΙ
Capacity:
0.95 liters (1.0 US qts, 0.8 Imp. qts)
(f) Reinstall the filler plug securely.
23. TIGHTEN BOLTS AND NUTS ON CHASSIS AND
BODY
Tighten the following parts:
• Front seat mount bolts
Torque: 37 N–m (375 kgf–cm, 27 ft–lbf)
• Front suspension member –to body mounting
bolts
Torque: 181 N–m (1,850 kgf–cm, 134 ft–lbf)
MA–35
MAINTENANCE
–
(1MZ–FE)
• Rear suspension member–to–body mounting
nuts
Torque: 51 N–m (520 kgf–cm. 38 ft–lbf)
24. FINAL INSPECTION
(a) Check the operation of the body parts:
•
Hood
Auxiliary catch operates properly
Hood locks securely when closed
•
Front and rear doors
Door lock operates properly
Doors close properly
•
Luggage compartment door or back door
Door lock operates properly
•
Seats
Seat adjusts easily and locks securely in any
position
Front seat back locks securely in any position
Folding–down rear seat backs lock securely
(b) Road test:
•
Check the engine and chassis for abnormal
noises.
Check that the vehicle does not wander or pull to
one side.
•
Check that the brakes work properly and do not
drag.
•
Perform bedding down of the parking brake
shoes and drum. (See page MA–31)
(c) Be sure to deliver a clean car and especially check:
•
Steering wheel
•
Shift lever knob
•
All switch knobs
•
Door handles
•
Seats
MA–36
MAINTENANCE
GENERAL MAINTENANCE
These are the maintenance and inspection
items which are considered to be the
owner’s responsibility. They can be perfo–
rmed by the owner or they can have them
done at a service shop. These items in–
clude those which should be checked on a
daily basis, those which, in most cases, do
not require (special) tools and those which
are considered to be reasonable for the
owner to perform. Items and procedures
for general maintanance are as follows:
OUTSIDE VEHICLE
1. TIRES
(a) Check the pressure with a gauge. Adjust if
necessary.
(b) Check for cuts, damage or excessive wear.
2. WHEEL NUTS
Wheel checking the tires, check the nuts
for looseness or for missing nuts. If neces–
sary, tighten them.
3. TIRE ROTATION
It is recommended that tires be rotated
every 12,000 km (7,500 miles).
4. WINDSHIELD WIPER BLADES
Check for wear or cracks whenever they
do not wipe clean. Replace if necessary.
5. FLUID LEAKS
(a) Check underneath for leaking fuel, oil,
water or other fluid.
(b) If you smell gasoline fumes or notice any
leak, have the cause found and corrected.
6. DOORS AND ENGINE HOOD
(a) Check that all doors including the trunk lid
operate smoothly, and that all latches lock
securely.
(b) Check that the engine hood secondary
latch secures the hood from opening when
the primary latch is released.
INSIDE VEHICLE
7. LIGHTS
(a) Check that the headlights, stop lights,
taillights, turn signal lights, and other
lights are all working.
(b) Check the headlight aiming.
–
(1MZ–FE)
8. WARMING LIGHT AND BUZZERS
Check that all warning lights and buzzers
function properly.
9. HORN
Check that it is working.
10. WINDSHIELD GLASS
Check for scratches, pits or abrasions.
11. WINDSHIELD WIPER AND WASHER
(a) Check operation of the wipers and washer.
(b) Check that the wipers do not streak.
12. WINDSHIELD DEFROSTER
Check that air comes out from the defrost–
er outlet when operating the heater air
conditioner at defroster mode.
13. REAR VIEW MIRROR
Check that it is mounted securely.
14. SUN VISORS
Check that they move freely and are mou
nted securely.
15. STEERING WHEEL
Check that it has the specified freeplay. Be
alert for changes in steering condition,
such as hard steering, excessive freeplay
or strange noises.
16. SEATS
(a) Check that all front seat controls such as
seat adjusters, seatback recliner, etc. op–
erate smoothly.
(b) Check that all latches lock securely in any
position.
(c) Check that the locks hold securely in any
latched position.
(d) Check that the head restraints move up
and down smoothly and that the locks
hold securely in any latched position.
(e) For folding–down rear seat backs, check
that the latches lock securely.
17. SEAT BELTS
(a) Check that the seat belt system such as
buckles, retractors and anchors operate
properly and smoothly.
(b) Check that the belt webbing is not cut,
frayed, worn or damaged.
18. ACCELERATOR PEDAL
Check the pedal for smooth operation and
uneven pedal effort or catching.
MA–37
MAINTENANCE
19. BRAKE PEDAL (See BR section)
(a) Check the pedal for smooth operation.
(b) Check that the pedal has the proper re–
serve distance and freeplay.
(c) Check the brake booster function.
20. BRAKES
At a safe place, check that the brakes do
not pull to one side when applied.
21. PARKING BRAKE (See BR section)
(a) Check that the lever has the proper travel.
(b) On a safe incline, check that the vehicle is
help securely with only the parking brake
applied.
22. AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION ”PARK”
MECHANISM
(a) Check the lock release button of the selec–
tor lever for proper and smooth operation.
(b) On a safe incline, check that the vehicle is
help securely with the selector lever in
the “P” position and all brakes released.
UNDER HOOD
23. WINDSHIELD WASHER FLUID
Check that there is sufficient fluid in the
tank.
24. ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL
Check that the coolant level is between
the ”FULL” and ”LOW” lines on the see–
through reservoir.
25. RADIATOR AND HOSES
(a) Check that the front of the radiator is
clean and not blocked with leaves, dirt
or bugs.
(b) Check the hoses for cracks, kinks, rot or
loose connections.
26. BATTERY ELECTROLYTE LEVEL
Check that the electrolyte level of all bat–
tery cells is between the upper and lower
level lines on the case.
27. BRAKE FLUID LEVEL
Check that the brake fluid level is near the
upper level line on the see–through reser–
voir.
28. ENGINE DRIVE BELTS
Check all drive belts for fraying, cracks,
wear or oiliness.
29. ENGINE OIL LEVEL
Check that level on the dipstick with the
–
(1MZ–FE)
engine turned off.
30. POWER STEERING FLUID LEVEL
Check the level.
The level should be in the “HOT” or “COLD”
range depending on the fluid temperature.
31. AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID
LEVEL
(a) Park the vehicle on a level surface.
(b) With the engine idling and the parking
brake applied, shift the selector into all
positions from “P” to ”L” and then shift
into ”P” position.
(c) Pull out the dipstick and wipe off the fluid
with a clean rag.
Re–insert the dipstick and check that the
fluid level is in the “HOT” range.
(d) Perform this check with the fluid at normal
driving temperature (70–80C, 158 –
176F).
HINT: Wait about 30 minutes before che–
cking the fluid level after extended driving
at high speeds in hot weather, driving in
heavy traffic or with a trailer.
32. EXHAUST SYSTEM
Visually inspect for cracks, holes or loose
supports.
If any change in the sound of the exhaust
or smell of the exhaust fumes is noticed,
have the cause located and corrected.
MA–38
MAINTENANCE
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE DATA
Drive belt tension
Generator
New belt
Generator
Used belt
PS pump
New belt
PS pump
Used belt
Spark plug
Recommended spark plug
ND
Spark plug
Recommended spark plug
NGK
Spark plug
Correct electrode gap
Firing order
Valve clearance
Intake
Valve clearance
Exhaust
Front and rear brake
Minimum
Pad thickness
Disc thickness
Front
Minimum
Disc thickness
Rear
Minimum
Disc runout
Front
Maximum
Disc runout
Rear
Maximum
Parking brake
Lining thickness
Minimum
Drum inside diameter
Maximum
Front axle and suspension
Ball joint vertical play
Maximum
Steering wheel freeplay
Maximum
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Pert tightened
Front seat mount bolts
Front suspension member x Body
Rear suspension member x Body
–
(1MZ–FE)
MX–1
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
MX–2
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
DESCRIPTION
DESCRIPTION
GENERAL
• A triple–cone type synchromesh mechanism is used in the 2nd gear to improve the shift
feeling characteristics. This helps to reduce the shifting effort.
• A reverse synchromesh mechanism is used to suppress gear engagement noise in reverse
gear shifting.
Type of Transaxle
Type of Engine
Gear Ratio
Differential Gear Ratio
Oil Capacity
Oil Viscosity
Oil Grade
1st gear
2nd gear
3rd gear
4th gear
5th gear
Reverse gear
MX–3
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
OPERATION
OPERATION
The illustration below show the engagements of transaxle gears.
MX–4
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
PREPARATION
PREPARATION
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
09308–00010 Oil Seal Puller
Input shaft front bearing
Output shaft front bearing
09309–12020 5th Driven Gear Replacer
09310–17010 Transaxle Gear Remover &
Replacer
(09310–07010) Plate
(09310–07020) Center Bolt
(09310–07030) Set Bolt
09310–35010 Countershaft Bearing Replacer
Input shaft front bearing
Output shaft front bearing
09316–60010 Transmission & Transfer Bearing
Replacer
(09316–00010) Replacer Pipe
(09316–00040) Replacer ’C’
09350–32014 TOYOTA Automatic Transmission
Tool Set
(09351–32120) Overdrive Bearing Replacer
(09351–32130) Handle
Differential side bearing
MX–5
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
PREPARATION
(09351–32150) Oil Seal Replacer
Differential side bearing
Oil seal (Transaxle case side)
09502–10012 Differential Side Bearing Puller
09564–32011 Differential Preload Adaptor
09608–12010 Front Hub & Drive Pinion Bearing
Replacer Set
(09608–00070) Drive Pinion Rear Bearing Cone
Replacer
lnput shaft rear bearing
4th drive gear and rear bearing
09608–20012 Front Nub & Drive Pinion Bearing
Tool Set
(09608–00080) Replacer
Input shaft front oil seal
Control shaft cover oil seal
(09608–03020) Handle
(09608–03060) Replacer
Differential taper roller bearing
outer race
09612–22011 Tilt Handle Bearing Replacer
Output shaft rear bearing
No.3 clutch hub
09950–00020 Bearing Remover
09950–00030 Bearing Remover Attachment
09950–20017 Universal Puller
MX–6
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09025–00010 Small Torque Wrench
Differential preload
09031–00030 Pin Punch
09905–00012 Snap Ring No. 1 Expander
EQUIPMENT
Dial indicator
Torque wrench
Feeler gauge
LUBRICANT
Item
Manual transaxle oil
Capacity
2.6 liters (2.7 US qts, 2.3 Imp.qts)
Classification
API GL–3, GL–4 or GL–5
SAE 75W–90
SSM (SPECIAL SERVICE MATERIALS)
08826–00090 Seal Packing 1281,
THREE BOND 1281 or equivalent
(FIPG)
Transmission case x Transaxle
case
Transmission case x Case cover
08833–00080 Adhesive 1344,
THREE BOND 1344,
LOCTITE 242 or equivalent
Straight screw plug
Control shaft cover bolt
Trouble
Noise
Oil leakage
Hard to shift or will not shift
Jumps out of gear
MX–20
MX–20
MX–70
MX–20
MX–20
MX–20
MX–20
MX–33, 40
Oil seal (Worn or damaged)
O–Ring (Worn or damaged)
Control cable (Faulty)
Locking ball spring (Damaged)
Shift fork (Worn)
Gear (Worn or damaged)
Bearing (Worn or damaged)
Synchronizer ring (Worn or
damaged)
Shifting key spring (Damaged)
–
MX–33,40
–
MX–20
Parts
Nacre
Gasket
(Damaged)
Oil (Level too high)
MX–2
See Page
Oil (Wrong)
Oil (Level low)
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
TROUBLESHOOTING
MX–7
TROUBLESHOOTING
Use the table below to help you find the cause of the problem. The numbers indicate the priority
of the likely cause of the problem. Check each part in order. If necessary, replace these parts.
MX–8
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
PRECAUTION
PRECAUTION
When working with FIPG material, you must observe the following.
• Using a razor blade and gasket scraper, remove all the old FIPG material from the gasket
surfaces.
• Thoroughly clean all components to remove all the loose material.
• Clean both sealing surfaces with a non–residue solvent.
• Apply the FIPG in an approx. 1 mm (0.04 in.) wide bead along the sealing surface.
• Parts must be assembled within 10 minutes of application. Otherwise, the FIPG material
must be removed and reapplied.
MX–9
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
Remove and install the parts as shown below.
MX–10
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRANSAXLE REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch 1: turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. REMOVE AIR CLEANER CASE ASSEMBLY WITH AIR HOSE
3. REMOVE CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
(a) Remove the cruise control actuator cover.
(b) Disconnect the connector.
(c) Remove the 3 nuts and cruise control actuator with
bracket.
4. REMOVE CLUTCH RELEASE CYLINDER AND TUBE
CLAMP
5. REMOVE STARTER
(a) Disconnect the connector and wire from the starter.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and starter.
6. DISCONNECT BACK–UP LIGHT SWITCH CONNECTOR
MX–11
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
7. DISCONNECT WIRES CLAMP
8. REMOVE EARTH CABLES
9. DISCONNECT CONTROL CABLES
(a) Remove the clips and washers.
(b) Remove the clips from the cables.
10. REMOVE TRANSAXLE MOUNTING THREE BOLTS OF
TRANSAXLE CASE UPPER SIDE
11. DISCONNECT VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
MX–12
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
12. INSTALL ENGINE SUPPORT FIXTURE
13. TIE STEERING GEAR HOUSING TO ENGINE SUPPORT
FIXTURE BY CORD OR EQUIVALENT
14. REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
15. RAISE VEHICLE
NOTICE: Be sure the vehicle is securely supported.
16. REMOVE UNDER COVERS AND SIDE COVERS
17. DRAIN TRANSAXLE OIL
18. REMOVE DRIVE SHAFT
(See page SA–38)
19. DISCONNECT STEERING GEAR HOUSING FROM FRONT
SUSPENSION MEMBER
(a) Remove the 4 bolts.
(b) Remove the stabilizer bar bush bracket.
(c) Remove the 2 set bolts and nuts.
(d) Disconnect the steering gearbox from the suspension member.
HINT: Suspend the steering gear box with cord.
20. REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE
(a) Remove the 3 nuts.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and nuts.
MX–13
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
(c) Remove 2 bolts and exhaust pipe.
21. REMOVE STIFFENER PLATE
Remove the 3 bolts and the stiffener plate.
22. DISCONNECT ENGINE FRONT MOUNTING FROM SUSPENSION MEMBER
Remove the 2 bolts and a nut.
23. DISCONNECT ENGINE REAR MOUNTING FROM FRONT
SUSPENSION MEMBER
(a) Remove the 2 hole plugs.
(b) Remove the 3 nut.
24. REMOVE ENGINE LEFT MOUNTING
(a) Raise the transaxle and engine slightly with a jack and
wooden block in between.
(b) Remove the 2 hole plugs and nuts.
MX–14
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
(c) Remove the 3 bolts and engine left mounting.
25. DISCONNECT STEERING COOLER PIPE FROM SUSPENSION MEMBER
26. REMOVE FRONT SUSPENSION MEMBER
(a) Remove the 2 fender liner set screws.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and 4 nuts.
(c) Remove the 4 bolts.
(d) Remove the 2 front lower brace, rear lower brace and
front suspension member.
27. REMOVE TRANSAXLE
(a) Remove the transaxle mounting bolts from the engine.
(b) Lower the engine left side and remove the transaxle
from the engine.
MX–15
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRANSAXLE INSTALLATION
(See page MX–9)
1. INSTALL TRANSAXLE TO ENGINE
Align the input shaft spline with the clutch disc and
install the transaxle to the engine.
Bolt A
Torque: 64 N–m (650 kgf–cm, 47 ft–lbf)
Bolt B
Torque: 46 N–m (470 kgf–cm, 34 ft–lbf)
2. INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION MEMBER
(a) Install the front suspension member, rear lower brace,
front lower brace and 4 bolts.
(b) Torque the 4 bolts.
Torque: 181 N–m (1,850 kgf–cm, 134 ft–lbf)
(c) Install and torque the 2 bolts and 4 nuts.
Bolt
Torque: 32 N–m (330 kgf–cm, 24 ft–lbf)
Nut
Torque: 36 N–m (370 kgf–cm, 27 ft–lbf)
(d) Install the 2 fender liner set screws.
3. CONNECT STEERING COOLER PIPE TO FRONT SUSPENSION MEMBER
4. INSTALL ENGINE LEFT MOUNTING
(a) Install the engine left mounting.
(b) Install and torque the 3 bolts.
Torque: 52 N–m (530 kgf–cm, 38 ft–lbf)
MX–16
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
(c) Install and torque the 2 nuts.
Torque: 80 N–m (820 kgf–cm, 59 ft–lbf)
(d) Install the 2 hole plugs.
5. CONNECT ENGINE REAR MOUNTING TO FRONT SUSPENSION MEMBER
(a) Install and torque the 3 nuts.
Torque: 80 N–m (820 kgf–cm, 59 ft–lbf)
(b) Install the 2 hole plugs.
6. CONNECT ENGINE FRONT MOUNTING TO FRONT SUSPENSION MEMBER
Install and torque the 2 bolts and a nut.
Torque: 80 N–m (820 kgf–cm, 59 ft–lbf)
7. INSTALL STIFFENER PLATE
Torque: 37 N–m (380 kgf–cm, 27 ft–lbf)
8. CONNECT STEERING GEAR HOUSING TO FRONT SUSPENSION MEMBER
(a) Connect the steering gear housing to the front sus–
pension member.
(b) Install and torque the 2 set bolts and nuts.
Torque: 181 N–m (1,850 kgf–cm, 134 ft–lbf)
MX–17
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
(c) Install the stabilizer bar bush bracket.
(d) Install and torque the 4 bolts.
Torque: 19 N–m (195 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
9. INSTALL DRIVE SHAFT
(See page SA–40)
10. INSTALL EXHAUST FRONT PIPE
(a) Install the exhaust front pipe.
(b) Install and torque the 2 bolts and nuts.
Front side
Torque: 62 N–m (630 kgf–cm, 46 ft–lbf)
Rear side
Torque: 43 N–m (440 kgf–cm, 32 ft–lbf)
(c) Connect the exhaust front pipe to the front suspen–
sion member.
(d) Torque the 2 bolts.
11. FILL TRANSAXLE WITH GEAR OIL
Oil:
Gear oil super (08885–02106) or equivalent
Recommended oil
oil grade:
API GL–3, GL–4 or GL–5
Viscosity:
SAE 75 W–90
Above –18 C (0 F) SAE 90
Below –18 C (0 F) SAE 75 W
Capacity:
2.6 liters (2.7 US qts, 2.3 Imp.qts)
12. INSTALL UNDER COVERS AND SIDE COVERS
13. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL AND LOWER VEHICLE
Torque: 103 N–m (1,050 kgf–cm, 76 ft–lbf)
MX–18
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
14. UNTIE STEERING GEAR HOUSING FROM ENGINE
SUPPORT FIXTURE
15. REMOVE ENGINE SUPPORT FIXTURE
16. CONNECT VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
17. CONNECT CONTROL CABLES
(a) Install the clips to the cables
(b) Connect the cables to the linkage with washers and
clips.
18. INSTALL EARTH CABLES
19. CONNECT WIRE HARNESS CLAMP
MX–19
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
20. CONNECT BACK – UP LIGHT SWITCH CONNECTOR
21. INSTALL STARTER
(a) Install the starter.
(b) Install and torque the 2 bolts.
Torque: 39 N–m (400 kgf–cm, 29 ft–lbf)
(c) Connect the connector and wire to the starter.
22. INSTALL CLUTCH RELEASE CYLINDER AND TUBE
CLAMP
Torque: 13 N–m (130 kgf–cm, 9 ft–lbf)
23. INSTALL CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
(a) Install the cruise control actuator bracket with the 3
nuts.
(b) Connect the connector.
(c) Install the cruise control actuator cover.
24. INSTALL AIR CLEANER CASE ASSEMBLY WITH
AIR HOSE
25. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE TO BATTERY
26. INSPECT FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
(See page SA–4)
27. PERFORM ROAD TEST
Check for abnormal noise and smooth shifting.
MX–20
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
COMPONENTS
MX–21
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
MX–22
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
BASIC SUBASSEMBLY SEPARATION
(See page MX–20 and MX–21)
1. REMOVE RELEASE FORK, BEARING BACK – UP LIGHT
SWITCH AND VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
2. REMOVE RELEASE BEARING RETAINER
3. REMOVE ENGINE MOUNT BRACKET AND SELECTING
BELLCRANK
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and engine mount bracket.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and selecting bellcrank.
4. REMOVE TRANSMISSION CASE COVER
(a) Remove the 8 bolts.
(b) Using a plastic hammer, tap off the transmission case
cover.
5. REMOVE LOCK BALL ASSEMBLY AND PLUG
(a) Remove the lock ball.
MX–23
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
(b) Using a hexagon wrench, remove the plug.
6. REMOVE SHIFT AND SELECT LEVER ASSEMBLY
7. REMOVE OUTPUT SHAFT LOCK NUT
(a) Unstake the nut.
(b) Engage the gear double meshing.
(c) Remove the lock nut clockwise and remove it.
HINT: The lock nut has LH threads.
(d) Disengage the gear double meshing.
8. REMOVE NO.3 HUB SLEEVE AND NO.3 SHIFT FORK
(a) Remove the No.3 shift fork set bolt.
MX–24
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
(b) Remove the No.3 hub sleeve and No.3 shift fork.
9. REMOVE 5TH DRIVEN GEAR
Using SST, remove the 5th driven gear.
SST 09950–20017
10. MEASURE 5TH GEAR THRUST CLEARANCE
Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance.
Standard clearance:
0.20–0.40 mm (0.0079–0.0157 In.)
Maximum clearance:
0.45 mm (0.0177 in.)
11. MEASURE 5TH GEAR RADIAL CLEARANCE
Using a dial indicator, measure the radial clearance.
Standard clearance:
0.009–0.050 m m (0.0004–0.0020 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the
gear, needle roller bearing or input shaft.
12. REMOVE NO.3 CLUTCH HUB AND 5TH GEAR
(a) Using 2 screwdrivers and a hammer, tap out the snap
ring.
MX–25
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
(b) Using SST, remove the No–3 clutch hub with syn–
chronizer ring.
SST 09310–17010 (09310–07010, 09310–07020.
09310–07030)
(c) Remove the 5th gear.
13. REMOVE NEEDLE ROLLER BEARING
14. REMOVE REAR BEARING RETAINER
15. REMOVE BEARING SNAP RINGS
Using a snap ring expander, remove the 2 snap rings.
HINT: If it is difficult to remove the snap rings, pull up
the shafts.
16. REMOVE REVERSE IDLER GEAR SHAFT LOCK BOLT
17. REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL SIDE BEARING RETAINER AND
SHIM
MX–26
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
18. REMOVE TRANSMISSION CASE
(a) Remove the 17 bolts.
(b) Using a plastic hammer, tap off the transmission case.
19. REMOVE REVERSE IDLER GEAR AND SHAFT
(a) Pull out the shaft.
(b) Remove the idler gear and thrust washer.
20. REMOVE REVERSE SHIFT ARM
(a) Shift the fork shaft into reverse.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and pull off the reverse shift arm.
21. REMOVE NO.1 SHIFT FORK SHAFT, NO.1 SHIFT
HEAD, NO.1 AND NO.2 SHIFT FORKS, REVERSE
SHIFT FORK WITH INTERLOCK PIN, INPUT AND
OUTPUT SHAFTS ASSEMBLY
Remove the input shaft assembly and output shaft
assembly together with the No. 1 fork shaft, shift head
and shift forks with the interlock pin from the trans–
axle case.
22. REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL CASE ASSEMBLY
MX–27
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
23. REMOVE MAGNET FROM TRANSAXLE CASE
24. REMOVE NO.2 FORK SHAFT
(a) Using a hexagon wrench, remove the straight screw
plug.
(b) Using a pin punch and hammer, drive out the slotted
spring pin.
(c) Pull out the shaft.
25. SEPARATE NO.1 FORK SHAFT, NO.1 SHIFT HEAD,
NO.1, NO.2 SHIFT FORKS AND REVERSE SHIFT
FORK
(a) Mount the shift forks to the vise.
(b) Using a pin punch and hammer, drive out the slotted
spring pin from the No.1 fork shaft.
(c) Using a pin punch and hammer, drive out the slotted
spring pin from the No. 1 fork shaft as shown in the
illustration.
MX–28
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
(d) Separate the No.1 shift fork shaft, No.1 shift head,
No.1, No.2 shift forks and reverse shift fork.
26. REMOVE NO.5 SYNCHRONIZER RING WITH KEY
SPRING FROM NO.3 CLUTCH HUB
(a) Remove the No.5 synchronizer ring with key spring
from No.3 clutch hub.
(b) Using a screwdriver, remove the snap ring.
HINT: Wrap vinyl tape on the screwdriver to prevent
damaging the synchronizer ring.
(c) Remove the synchronizer rings.
MX–29
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
COMPONENT PARTS INSPECTION
1. INSPECT N0.5 SYNCHRONIZER RINGS
(a) Check for wear or damage.
(b) Check the braking effect of the synchronizer ring.
Turn the middle No.5 synchronizer ring in one direc–
tion while pushing it to the outer No.5 synchronizer
ring. Check that the ring locks.
If the braking effect is insufficient, replace the syn–
chronizer ring.
2. INSPECT CLEARANCE OF NO.3 SHIFT FORK AND
NO.3 HUB SLEEVE
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the
hub sleeve and shift fork.
Maximum clearance:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the
shift fork or hub sleeve.
3. IF NECESSARY, REPLACE INPUT SHAFT FRONT
BEARING
(a) Remove the bolt and transaxle case receiver.
(b) Using SST, pull out the bearing.
SST 09308–00010
(c) Using SST, press in a new bearing.
SST 09310–35010
MX–30
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
(d) Install the transaxle case receiver and torque the bolt.
Torque: 7.4 N–m (75 kgf–cm, 65 in–lbf)
4. IF NECESSARY, REPLACE OUTPUT SHAFT FRONT
BEARING
(a) Remove the bolt and bearing lock plate.
(b) Using SST, pull out the bearing.
SST 09308–00010
(c) Using SST, press in a new bearing.
SST 09310–35010
(d) Install the bearing lock plate and torque the bolt.
Torque: 18 N–m (185 kgf–cm, 13 ft–lbf)
MX–31
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
5. IF NECESSARY, REPLACE INPUT SHAFT FRONT
OIL SEAL
(a) Using a screwdriver, pry out the oil seal.
(b) Using SST, drive in a new oil seal.
SST 09608–20012 (09608–00080, 09608–03020)
Drive in depth:
0–0.5 mm (0–0.012 in.)
(c) Coat the lip of the oil seal with MP grease.
6. IF NECESSARY, REPLACE REVERSE RESTRICT PIN
(a) Using a hexagon wrench, remove the straight screw
plug.
(b) Using a pin punch and hammer, drive out the slotted
spring pin.
(c) Replace the reverse restrict pin.
MX–32
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
(d) Using a pin punch and hammer, drive in the slotted
spring pin.
Drive In depth:
13.5 ± 0.5 mm (0.531 t 0.020 in.)
(e) Apply sealant to the plug threads.
Sealant:
Part No.08833 – 00080, THREE BOND 1344, LOC–
TITE 242 or equivalent
(f) Using a hexagon wrench, install and torque the strai–
ght screw plug.
Torque: 13 N–m (130 kgf–cm, 9 ft–lbf)
MX–33
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
INPUT SHAFT
INPUT SHAFT
COMPONENTS
INPUT SHAFT DISASSEMBLY
1. INSPECT 3RD AND 4TH GEAR THRUST CLEAR–
ANCE
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance.
Standard clearance:
3rd gear
0.10–0.25 mm (0.0039–0.0098 in.)
4th gear
0.20–0.45 mm (0.0079–0.0177 in.)
Maximum clearance:
3rd gear
0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
4th gear
0.50 mm (0.0197 in.)
MX–34
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
INPUT SHAFT
2. INSPECT 3 RD AND 4 TH GEAR RADIAL CLEARANCE
Using dial indicator, measure the radial clearance be–
tween the gear and shaft.
Standard clearance:
0.009–0.053 mm (0.0004–0.0021 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.070 mm (0.0028 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the
gear, needle roller bearing or shaft.
3. REMOVE SNAP RING
Using 2 screwdrivers and a hammer, tap out the snap
ring.
4. REMOVE REAR BEARING, 4 TH GEAR, NEEDLE
ROLLER BEARINGS, SPACER AND SYNCHRONIZER
RING FROM INPUT SHAFT
(a) Using SST and a press, remove the 4th gear and rear
bearing.
SST 09950–00020
(b) Remove the needle roller bearings, spacer and syn–
chronizer ring.
5. REMOVE SNAP RING
Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring.
6. REMOVE NO. 2 HUB SLEEVE ASSEMBLY, 3 RD
GEAR SYNCHRONIZER RING AND NEEDLE ROLLERBEARINGS
Using SST and a press, remove the No.2 hub sleeve,
3rd gear, synchronizer ring and needle roller bearings.
SST 09950–00020
NOTICE: Be careful not to confuse the synchronizer ring
for 3rd gear and synchronizer ring for 4th gear.
MX–35
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
INPUT SHAFT
7. REMOVE N0.2 HUB SLEEVE, SHIFTING KEYS AND
SPRINGS FROM NO.2 CLUTCH HUB
Using a screwdriver, remove the 3 shifting keys and 2
springs from the No.2 clutch hub.
M%C^t–^
INPUT SHAFT COMPONENTS INSPECTION
1. INSPECT SYNCHRONIZER RINGS
(a) Check for wear or damage.
(b) Check the braking effect of the synchronizer ring.
Turn the synchronizer ring in one direction while push–
ing it to the gear cone. Check that the ring locks.
If the braking effect is¿insufficient, apply a small
amount of fine lapping compound between the syn–
chronizer ring and gear cone.
Lightly rub the synchronizer ring and gear cone to–
gether.
NOTICE: Ensure the fine lapping compound is completely
washed off after rubbing.
(c) Check again the braking effect of the synchronizer
ring.
(d) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between
the synchronizer ring back and gear spline end.
Minimum clearance:
0.6 mm (0.024 fn.)
HINT:
• When replacing either a synchronizer ring or
gear, apply a small amount of fine lapping com–
pound between the synchronizer ring and gear
cone.
Lightly rub the synchronizer ring and gear cone together.
• When replacing both the synchronizer ring and
gear, there is no need to apply any compound or to rub them together.
NOTICE: Ensure the fine lapping compound is completely
washed off after rubbing.
MX–36
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
INPUT SHAFT
2. INSPECT CLEARANCE OF N0.2 SHIFT FORK AND HUB
SLEEVE
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between
the hub sleeve and shift fork.
Maximum clearance:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace shift
fork or hub sleeve.
3. INSPECT INPUT SHAFT
(a) Check the input shaft for wear or damage.
(b) Using a micrometer, measure the outer diameter of
the input shaft journal surface.
Minimum outer diameter:
Part A
26.970 mm (1.0618 in.)
Part B
32.470 mm (1.2783 in.)
Part C
33.090 mm (1.3028 in.)
Part D
29.970 mm (1.1799 in.)
If the outer diameter is less than the minimum, replace
the input shaft.
(c) Using a dial indicator, check the shaft runout.
Maximum runout:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the outer diameter exceeds the maximum, replace
the input shaft.
MX–37
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
INPUT SHAFT
INPUT SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(See page MX–33)
HINT: Coat all of the sliding and rotating surface with
gear oil before assembly.
1. INSTALL NO.2 CLUTCH HUB INTO HUB SLEEVE
(a) Install the clutch hub and shifting keys to the hub
sleeve.
(b) Install the shifting key springs under the shifting keys.
NOTICE: Install the key springs positioned so that their
and gaps are not line.
2. INSTALL 3RD GEAR, NEEDLE ROLLER BEARINGS.
SYNCHRONIZER RING AND NO.2 HUB SLEEVE AS–
SEMBLY TO INPUT SHAFT
(a) Apply gear oil to the needle roller bearings.
(b) Place the synchronizer ring (for 3rd gear) on the gear
and align the ring slots with the shifting keys.
NOTICE: Do not install the synchronizer ring for 4th gear.
(c) Using a press, install the 3rd gear and No.2 hub
sleeve.
3. INSTALL SNAP RING
(a) Select a snap ring that will allow minimum axial play.
Mark
Thickness mm (in.)
(b) Using a snap ring expander, install the snap ring.
MX–38
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
INPUT SHAFT
4. INSPECT 3RD GEAR THRUST CLEARANCE
Using a feeler gauge, measure the 3rd gear thrust
clearance.
Standard clearance:
0.10–0.25 mm (0.0039–0.0098 in.)
5. INSTALL SYNCHRONIZER RING, NEEDLE ROLLER
BEARINGS, SPACER, 4TH GEAR AND REAR BALL
BEARING
(a) Apply gear oil to the needle roller bearings.
(b) Install the spacer and needle roller bearings.
(c) Place the synchronizer ring on the gear.
HINT: Align the ring slots with the shifting keys, and
the ring projections with the hub slots.
(d) Using SST and a press, install the rear ball bearing.
SST 09608–12010 (09608–00070)
6. INSTALL SNAP RING
(a) Select a snap ring that will allow minimum axial play.
Mark
Thickness mm (in.)
MX–39
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
INPUT SHAFT
(b) Using a screwdriver and hammer, tap in the snap ring.
7. INSPECT 4TH GEAR THRUST CLEARANCE
Using a feeler gauge, measure 4th gear thrust clear–
ance.
Standard clearance:
0.20–0.45 mm (0.0079–0.0177 in.)
MX–40
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
OUTPUT SHAFT
OUTPUT SHAFT
COMPONENTS
OUTPUT SHAFT DISASSEMBLY
1. INSPECT 1ST AND 2ND GEAR THRUST CLEAR–
ANCE
Using a feeler gauge, measure the thrust clearance.
Standard clearance:
1st gear
0.10–0.29 mm (0.0039–0.0114 in.)
2nd gear
0.20–0.44 mm (0.0079–0.0173 in.)
Maximum clearance:
1st gear
0.35 mm (0.0138 in.)
2nd gear
0.50 mm (0.0197 in.)
MX–41
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
OUTPUT SHAFT
2. INSPECT 1 ST AND 2 ND GEAR RADIAL CLEARANCE
Using dial indicator, measure the radial clearance be–
tween the gear and shaft.
Standard clearance:
0.009–0–053 m m (0.0004–0.0021 In.)
Maximum clearance:
0.070 mm (0.0028 In.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the
gear, needle roller bearing or shaft.
3. REMOVE REAR BALL BEARING, 4TH DRIVEN GEAR AND
OUTPUT GEAR SPACER
(a) Using SST and a press, remove the rear ball bearing
and 4th driven gear.
SST 09950–00020
(b) Remove the output gear spacer and bait.
4. REMOVE 3RD DRIVEN GEAR, 2ND GEAR, NEEDLE ROLLER BEARING AND SYNCHRONIZER RING
(a) Shift the No. 1 hub sleeve into the 1 st gear.
(b) Using SST and a press, remove the 3rd driven gear
and 2nd gear.
SST 09950–00020
(c) Remove the needle roller bearing and synchronizer
rings.
5. REMOVE NO.1 HUB SLEEVE ASSEMBLY, 1ST GEAR, SYNCHRONIZER RING, NEEDLE ROLLER BEARING,
THRUST WASHER AND LOCKING BALL
(a) Using a press, remove the No.1 hub sleeve, 1st gear
and synochronizer ring.
(b) Remove the needle roller bearing and locking ball.
MX–42
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
OUTPUT SHAFT
(c) Using a screwdriver and hammer, drive out the thrust
washer.
6. REMOVE NO.1 HUB SLEEVE, SHIFTING KEYS AND
SPRINGS FROM NO.1 CLUTCH HUB
MX–43
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
OUTPUT SHAFT
OUTPUT SHAFT COMPONENT PARTS
INSPECTION
1. INSPECT 1ST GEAR SYNCHRONIZER RING
(a) Check for wear or damage.
(b) Check the braking effect of the synchronizer ring.
Turn the synchronizer ring in one direction while push–
ing it to the gear cone. Check that the ring locks.
If the braking effect is insufficient, apply a small
amount of fine lapping compound between the syn–
chronizer ring and gear cone. Lightly rub the synchronizer ring and gear cone together.
NOTICE: Ensure the fine lapping compound is completely
washed off after rubbing.
(c) Check again the braking effect of the synchronizer
ring.
(d) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between
the synchronizer ring back and the gear spline end.
Minimum clearance:
0.6 mm (0.024 in.)
HINT:
• When replacing either a synchronizer ring or
gear, apply a small amount of fine lapping compound between the synchronizer ring and gear
cone.
Lightly rub the synchronizer ring and gear cone
together.
• When replacing both the synchronizer ring and
gear, there is no need to apply any compound or
to rub them together.
NOTICE: Ensure the fine lapping compound is completely
washed off after rubbing.
2. INSPECT 2ND GEAR SYNCHRONIZER RING
(a) Check for wear or damage.
(b) Check the braking effect of the synchronizer direction
while pushing it to the gear cone. Check that the ring
locks.
If the braking effect is insufficient, replace the syn–
chronizer ring.
MX–44
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
OUTPUT SHAFT
(c) Measure the clearance between the synchronizer ring
back and gear spline end.
Minimum clearance:
0.7 mm (0.028 in.)
If the clearance is less than the limit, replace the
synchronizer ring.
3. INSPECT SHIFT FORKS AND HUB SLEEVES CLEAR–
ANCE
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between
the hub sleeve and shift fork.
Maximum clearance:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the
shift fork or hub sleeve.
4. INSPECT OUTPUT SHAFT
(a) Using a micrometer, measure the outer diameter of
the output shaft journal surface.
Minimum outer diameter:
Part A
31.970 mm 11.2587 In.)
Part B
37.970 mm (1.4949 In.)
Part C
31.990 mm 11.2594 In.)
If the outer diameter is less than the minimum, replace
the output shaft.
(b) Using a dial indicator, check the shaft runout.
Maximum runout:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the runout exceeds the maximum, replace the
output shaft.
MX–45
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
OUTPUT SHAFT
OUTPUT SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(See page MX–40)
HINT: Coat all of the sliding and rotating surface with
gear oil before assembly.
1. INSTALL NO.1 CLUTCH HUB INTO HUB SLEEVE
(a) Install the 3 springs and shifting keys to the clutch
hub.
(b) Install the hub sleeve to the clutch hub.
HINT: Direct identification groove of the hub sleeve to
front of the transmission.
2. INSTALL THRUST WASHER, 1 ST GEAR, NEEDLE
ROLLER BEARING, SYNCHRONIZER RING AND
NO.1 HUB SLEEVE TO OUTPUT SHAFT
(a) Using SST and a press, install the thrust washer.
SST 09316–60010 (09316–00040)
(b) Apply gear oil to the needle roller bearing.
(c) Place the synchronizer ring on the gear and align the
ring slots with the shifting keys.
(d) Using a press, install the 1 st gear and No. 1 hub sleeve.
3. INSPECT 1ST GEAR THRUST CLEARANCE
Using a feeler gauge, measure the 1st gear thrust
clearance.
Standard clearance:
0.10–0.29 mm (0.0039–0.0114 in.)
MX–46
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
OUTPUT SHAFT
4. INSTALL SYNCHRONIZER RINGS, 2 ND GEAR,
NEEDLE ROLLER BEARING AND 3RD DRIVEN
GEAR
(a) Install the ball.
(b) Fit the 2nd gear bushing groove securely over the ball
when installing the 2nd gear bushing on the shaft.
(c) Place the synchronizer rings on the 2nd gear.
(d) Apply gear oil to the needle roller bearing and install it.
(e) Install the 2nd gear.
NOTICE: Align the clutch hub grooves with the projec–
tions on the synchronizer ring.
(f) Using SST and a press, install the 3rd driven gear.
SST 09316–60010 (09316–00010)
5. INSPECT 2ND GEAR THRUST CLEARANCE
Using a feeler gauge, measure the 2nd gear thrust
clearance.
Standard clearance:
0.20–0.44 mm (0.0079–0.0173 in.)
MX–47
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
OUTPUT SHAFT
6. INSTALL OUTPUT GEAR SPACER, 4TH DRIVEN
GEAR AND RADIAL BALL BEARING
(a) Install the outer gear spacer.
(b) Using a press, install the 4th driven gear and bearing.
7. INSTALL REAR BEARING
Using SST and a press, install the rear bearing.
SST 09612–22011
MX–48
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
SHIFT AND SELECT LEVER SHAFT
SHIFT AND SELECT LEVER SHAFT
COMPONENTS
SHIFT AND SELECT LEVER SHAFT
DISASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE CONTROL SHIFT LEVER, DUST BOOT
AND CONTROL SHAFT COVER
(a) Remove the nut and washer.
(b) Remove the lever lock pin.
(c) Remove the control shift lever.
(d) Remove the dust boot.
(e) Remove the control shaft cover.
2. REMOVE SELECT SPRING SEAT NO.2 AND SHIFT
INNER LEVER NO.2
(a) Using a screwdriver, pry out the E–ring.
MX–49
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
SHIFT AND SELECT LEVER SHAFT
(b) Remove the reverse restrict pin holder, spring and
shift inner lever No.2.
3. REMOVE SHIFT INTERLOCK PLATE, SHIFT INNER LEVER
NO.1 AND SELECT SPRING SEAT
(a) Using a pin punch and hammer, drive out the slotted
spring pin.
(b) Remove the shift interlock plate, shift inner lever No.1
and select spring seat.
4. REMOVE E – RING FROM SHIFT AND SELECT LEVER
SHAFT
Using a screwdriver, pry out the E–ring.
MX–50
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
SHIFT AND SELECT LEVER SHAFT
SHIFT AND SELECT LEVER SHAFT
ASSEMBLY
(See page MX–48)
1. APPLY MP GREASE TO PARTS, AS SHOWN
2. IF NECESSARY, REPLACE CONTROL SHAFT COVER OIL
SEAL
(a) Using a screwdriver, pry out the oil seal.
(b) Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new oil seal until its
surface is flush with the shaft cover surface.
SST 09608–20012 (09608–00080, 09608–03020)
(c) Coat the lip of the oil seal with MP grease.
3. INSTALL E–RING TO SHIFT AND SELECT LEVER SHAFT
MX–51
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
SHIFT AND SELECT LEVER SHAFT
4. INSTALL SELECT SPRING SEAT, SHIFT INNER
LEVER NO.1 AND SHIFT INTERLOCK PLATE
(a) Install the select spring seat and Spring.
(b) Install the shift inner lever No. 1 with the shift interlock
plate.
HINT: One of the spline teeth of the shift and select
lever shaft has been eliminated. Therefore, be certain
to correctly align this portion to the matching portions
on the parts during assembly.
(c) Using a pin punch and hammer, drive in the slotted
spring pin.
Drive in depth:
23.5 ± 1.0 mm (0.925 ± 0.039 in.)
6. INSTALL SHIFT INNER LEVER NO.2 AND SELECT SPRING
SEAT NO.2
(a) Install the shift inner lever No.2, spring and select
spring seat No.2.
(b) Using a screwdriver and hammer, tap in the E–ring.
MX–52
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
SHIFT AND SELECT LEVER SHAFT
6. INSTALL CONTROL SHAFT COVER, DUST BOOT AND
CONTROL SHIFT LEVER
(a) Install the control shaft cover and dust boot.
HINT: Make sure to install the boot in correct direc–
tion. Position the air bleed of the boot downward.
(b) Install the control shift lever.
(c) Install the lever lock pin to the control shift lever.
(d) Install the washer and lock nut.
Torque: 6.4 N–m (65 kgf–cm, 56 in.–lbf)
MX–53
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
DIFFERENTIAL CASE
DIFFERENTIAL CASE
COMPONENTS
DIFFERENTIAL CASE DISASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE SIDE BEARING FROM DIFFERENTIAL
CASE (SPEED SENSOR DRIVE GEAR SIDE)
(a) Using SST, remove the bearing from drive gear side of
the case.
SST 09950–00020, 09950–00030
(b) Remove the speed sensor drive gear.
2. REMOVE RING GEAR
(a) Place matchmarks on the ring gear and the case.
MX–54
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(b) Using a chisel and hammer, unstake the lock plates.
(c) Remove the 8 bolts and 4 lock plates.
(d) Using a copper hammer, tap on the ring gear to
remove it from the case.
3. REMOVE SIDE BEARING FROM DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(RING GEAR SIDE)
Using SST, remove the bearing from ring gear of side
of the case.
SST 09950–00020, 09950–00030
4. INSPECT SIDE GEAR BACKLASH
Using a dial indicator, measure the backlash of one
side gear while holding one pinion toward the case.
Standard backlash:
0.05–0.20 mm (0.0020–0.0079 In.)
If the backlash does not meet specification, install the
correct thrust washer to the side gears.
6. DISASSEMBLY DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(a) Using a pin punch and hammer, drive out the straight
pin.
MX–55
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(b) Remove the pinion shaft from the case.
(c) Remove the 2 pinions and 2 side gears with the 4
thrust washers from each gear.
6. TRANSMISSION CASE SIDE:
IF NECESSARY, REPLACE DIFFERENTIAL SIDE
BEARING RETAINER OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST and a hammer, drive out the oil seal from
the retainer.
SST 09608–20012 (09608–03020, 09608–03060)
(b) Using SST and a hammer, drive in a new oil seal until
its surface is flush with the case surface.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32130, 09351–32150)
(c) Coat the lip of the oil seal with MP grease.
7. TRANSAXLE CASE SIDE:
IF NECESSARY, REPLACE SIDE OIL SEAL
(a) Using a screwdriver and hammer, drive out the oil
seal.
(b) Using SST and a hammer, drive in a new oil seal until
its surface is flush with the case surface.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32130, 09351–32150)
(c) Coat the lip of oil seal with MP grease.
MX–56
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
DIFFERENTIAL CASE
8. TRANSMISSION CASE SIDE:
IF NECESSARY, REPLACE SIDE BEARING OUTER
RACE
(a) Using a brass bar and hammer, drive out the bearing
outer race.
(b) Install the bearing retainer without an O–ring.
(c) Install and torque the bearing retainer bolts.
Torque: 18 N–m (185 kgf–cm, 13 ft–lbf)
(d) Place the thinnest shim into the case.
(e) Using SST and a press, install a new bearing outer
race.
SST 09608–20012 (09608–03020, 09608–03060)
(f) Remove the retainer bolts.
(g) Remove the bearing retainer and shim.
9. TRANSAXLE CASE SIDE:
IF NECESSARY, REPLACE SIDE BEARING OUTER
RACE
(a) Using a brass bar and hammer, drive out the bearing
outer race and shim.
MX–57
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(b) Place the shim into the case.
(c) Using SST and a press, install a new bearing outer
race.
SST 09608–20012 (09608–03020, 09608–03060)
DIFFERENTIAL CASE ASSEMBLY
(See page MX–53)
1. ASSEMBLY DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(a) Install the correct thrust washers and side gears.
Referring to the table below, select thrust washers
which will ensure that the backlash is within specifica–
tion. Try to select washers of the same size for both
sides.
Standard backlash:
0.05–0.20 mm (0.0020–0.0079 in.)
Thickness mm (in.)
Thickness mm (in.)
0.95 (0.0374)
1.10 (0.0433)
1.00 (0.0394)
1.15 (0.0453)
1.05 (0.0413)
1.20 (0.0472)
Install the thrust washers and side gears in the differ–
ential case.
(b) Install the pinion shaft.
(c) Inspect the side gear backlash.
Measure the side gear backlash while holding one
pinion gear toward the case.
Standard backlash:
0.05–0.20 mm (0.0020–0.0079 in.)
If the backlash is not within specification, install a
thrust washer of different thickness.
(d) Using a pin punch and hammer, drive in the straight
pin through the case and hole in the pinion shaft.
MX–58
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(a) Stake the differential case.
2. INSTALL RING GEAR ON DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(a) Clean the contact surface of the differential case and
the threads of the ring gear and differential case.
(b) Heat the ring gear in boiling water.
(c) Carefully remove the ring gear from the water.
(d) After moisture on the ring gear has completely evapo–
rated, quickly install the ring gear to the differential
case.
HINT: Align the matchmarks on the differential case
and contact the ring gear.
(e) Temporarily install the 8 bolts and 4 lock plates.
NOTICE: The ring gear set bolts should not be torqued
until the ring gear has cooled sufficiently.
(f) After the ring gear has cooled sufficiently, torque the
ring gear set bolts.
Torque: 90 N–m (920 kgf–cm, 67 ft–lbf)
(g) Using a pin punch and hammer, stake the lock plates.
HINT: Stake one claw flush with the flat surface of the
bolt. For the claw contacting the protruding portion of
the bolt, stake only the tightened side.
3. INSTALL SIDE BEARING TO DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(a) Using SST and a press, install the side bearing to the
transmission case side.
SST 09316–60010 (09316–00010)
09350–32014 (09351–32120)
MX–59
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(b) Install the speed sensor drive gear to the transaxle
case side.
(c) Using SST and a press, install the side bearing to the
transaxle case side.
SST 09316–60010 (09316–00010)
09350–32014 (09351–32120)
NOTICE: Install the black cage bearing on the speed
sensor drive gear side.
4. ADJUST DIFFERENTIAL CASE SIDE BEARING PRE–
LOAD
(a) Install the differential to the transaxle case.
(b) Install the transmission case.
(c) Install and torque the case bolts.
Torque: 29 N–m (300 kgf–cm, 22 ft–lbf)
(d) Install the shim into the transmission case.
(e) Install the bearing retainer without an O–ring.
(f) Install and torque the retainer bolts.
Torque: 18 N–m (185 kgf–cm, 13 ft–lbf)
MX–60
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(g) Using SST and torque meter, measure the preload.
SST 09564–32011
Preload (at starting):
0.8–1.6 N–m (8–16 kgf–cm,6.9–13.9 in.–lbf)
If the preload is not within specification, remove the
transmission case side bearing retainer.
Select another shim.
HINT: The preload will change about 0.3–0.4 N–m
(3–4 kgf–cm, 2.6–3.5 in.–lbf) with each shim thick–
ness.
Mark
Thickness mm (in.)
Mark
Thickness mm (in.)
1.90 (0.0748)
2.40 (0.0945)
1.95 (0.0768)
2.45 (0.0965)
2.00 (0.0787)
2.50 (0.0984)
2.05 (0.0807)
2.55 (0.1004)
2.10 (0.0827)
2.60 (0.1024)
2.15 (0.0846)
2.65 (0.1043)
2.20 (0.0866)
2.70 (0.1063)
2.25 (0.0886)
2.75 (0.1083)
2.30 (0.0906)
2.80 (0.1102)
2.35 (0.0925)
(h) Remove the retainer bolts.
(i) Remove the bearing retainer and shim.
(j) Remove the case bolts.
(k) Remove the transmission case.
MX–61
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
BASIC SUBASSEMBLY REASSEMBLY
(See page MX–20 and MX–21)
HINT: Coat all of the sliding and rotating surface with
gear oil before assembly.
1. INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL SIDE BEARING PRELOAD
(See step 4 on page MX–59)
2. INSTALL MAGNET TO TRANSAXLE CASE
3. INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL CASE ASSEMBLY
4. . ASSEMBLE NO.1 SHIFT FORK SHAFT, NO.1 SHIFT HEAD,
NO.1 AND NO.2 SHIFT FORKS
(a) Assemble the No.1 shift fork shaft, No.1 shift head,
No.1 and No.2 shift forks.
(b) Mount the shift forks to the vise.
(c) Using a pin punch and hammer, drive in the slotted
spring pin to the No.1 fork shaft as shown in the
figure.
MX–62
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
(d) Coat the interlock pin with MP grease.
(e) Using a screwdriver, install the interlock pin into the
reverse shift fork hole.
(f) Install the reverse shift fork to the No.1 shift fork
shaft.
HINT: When installing the reverse shift fork with inter–
lock pin to the No.1 shift fork shaft, make sure the
interlock pin does not drop out.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the bushing.
(g) Using a pin punch and hammer, drive in the slotted
spring pin to the No.1 fork shaft.
5. INSTALL NO.1 SHIFT FORK SHAFT, NO.1 SHIFT
HEAD, NO.1, NO.2 SHIFT FORKS, REVERSE SHIFT
FORK WITH INTERLOCK PIN, INPUT AND OUTPUT
SHAFT ASSEMBLY
Install the input and output shaft assembly together
with the No.1 fork shaft, shift head and shift forks
with the interlock pin to the transaxle case.
6. INSTALL NO.2 FORK SHAFT
(a) Install the No.2 fork shaft to the transaxle case thr–
ough the reverse shift fork.
(b) Using a pin punch and hammer, drive in the slotted
spring pin.
MX–63
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
(c) Apply sealant to the plug threads.
Sealant:
Part No.08833 – 00080. THREE BOND 1344, LOC–
TITE 242 or equivalent
(d) Using a hexagon wrench, install the straight screw
plug.
Torque: 13 N–m (130 k9f¿cm, 9 ft–lbf)
7. INSTALL REVERSE SHIFT ARM
(a) Put the reverse shift fork pivot into the reverse shift
arm and install the reverse shift arm to the transaxle
case.
(b) Shift the reverse shift arm into the reverse.
(c) Install and torque the 2 bolts.
Torque: 18 N–m (185 kgf–cm, 13 ft–lbf)
(d) Shift the reverse shift arm to the neutral position.
8. INSTALL REVERSE IDLER GEAR AND SHAFT
(a) Install the washer and reverse idler gear to the shaft.
(b) Install the reverse idler gear and shaft as shown.
9. INSTALL TRANSMISSION CASE
(a) Remove any FIPG material and be careful not to drop
oil on the contacting surface of the transaxle case or
transmission case.
(b) Apply FIPG to the transmission case as shown.
FIPG:
Part No.08833–00090, THREE BOND 1281 or equi–
valent
MX–64
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
(c) Install and torque the 17 bolts.
Torque: 29 N–m (300 kgf–cm, 22 ft–lbf)
10. INSTALL SHIM AND SIDE BEARING RETAINER
WITH O–RING
(a) Install a new O–ring on the retainer.
(b) Instal) the shim and retainer.
(c) Apply sealant to the bolt threads.
Sealant:
Part No.08833–00080, THREE BOND 1344, LOC–
TITE 242 or equivalent
(d) Install and torque the 6 bolts.
Torque: 18 N–m (185 kgf–cm, 13 ft–lbf)
11. INSTALL AND TORQUE REVERSE IDLER GEAR
SHAFT LOCK BOLT
Torque: 29 N–m (300 kgf–cm, 22 ft–lbf)
12. INSTALL BEARING SNAP RINGS
Using a snap ring expander, install the 2 snap rings.
HINT: If it is difficult to install the snap ring, pull up the
shafts.
MX–65
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
13. INSTALL REAR BEARING RETAINER
(a) Apply sealant to the bolt threads.
Sealant:
Part No.08833–00070, THREE BOND 1324 or equi–
valent
(b) Install and torque the 5 bolts.
Torque: 42 N–m (430 kgf–cm, 31 ft–lbf)
14. INSTALL 5TH DRIVEN GEAR
Using SST, install the 5th driven gear.
SST 09309–12020
15. INSTALL SPACER, NEEDLE ROLLER BEARINGS,
5TH GEAR AND SYNCHRONIZER RING
(a) Install the spacer.
(b) Apply gear oil to the needle roller bearings.
(c) Install the 5th gear with the needle roller bearings and
synchronizer ring.
16. INSTALL NO.5 SYNCHRONIZER RINGS WITH KEY
SPRING TO NO.3 CLUTCH HUB
(a) Assemble the No.5 synchronizer rings.
(b) Using a screwdriver, install the snap ring.
HINT: Wrap vinyl tape on the screwdriver to prevent
damaging the synchronizer ring.
(c) Install the No.5 synchronizer rings with key springs to
the No.3 clutch hub.
HINT: Align the holes of the clutch hub with key
spring.
MX–66
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
17. INSTALL N0.3 CLUTCH HUB
Using SST and a press, install the No.3 clutch hub
assembly.
SST 09612–22011
NOTICE: Align the holes of the 5th gear and synchronizer
ring.
18. INSTALL SHIFTING KEY RETAINER AND SNAP
RING
(a) Install the retainer.
(b) Select a snap ring that will allow minimum axial play.
Mark
Thickness mm (in.)
Mark
Thickness mm (in.)
2.20–2.25
(0.0866–0.0886)
2.60–2.65
(0.1024–0.1043)
2.25–2.30
(0.0886–0.0906)
2.65–2.70
(0.1043–0.1063)
2.30–2.35
(0.0906–0.0925)
2.70–2.75
(0.1063–0.1083)
2.35–2.40
(0.0925–0.0945)
2.75–2.80
(0.1083–0.1102)
2.40–2.45
(0.0945–0.0965)
2.80–2.85
(0.1102–0.1122)
2.45–2.50
(0.0965–0.0984)
2.85–2.90
(0.1122–0.1142)
2.50–2.55
(0.0984–0.1004)
2.90–2.95
(0.1142–0.1161)
2.55–2.60
(0.1004–0.1024)
(c) Using a screwdriver and hammer, tap in the snap ring.
19. INSPECT 6TH GEAR THRUST CLEARANCE
Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance.
Standard clearance:
0.20–0.40 mm (0.0079–0.0157 in.)
MX–67
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
20. INSTALL NO. 3 HUB SLEEVE WITH NO. 3 SHIFT
FORK
(a) Install No.3 hub sleeve with No.3 shift fork to the
No.3 clutch hub.
(b) Install and torque the set bolt.
Torque: 18 N–m (185 kgf–cm, 13 ft–lbf)
21. INSTALL OUTPUT SHAFT LOCK NUT
(a) Engage the gear double meshing.
(b) Install and torque the new lock nut.
Torque: 123 N–m (1,250 kgf–cm. 90 ft–lbf)
HINT: The lock nut has LH threads.
(c) Stake the lock nut.
(d) Disengage the gear double meshing.
MX–68
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
22. INSTALL SHIFT AND SELECT LEVER ASSEMBLY
(a) Apply FIPG to the underside of the flanged portion of
the control shaft cover.
FIPG:
Part No.08826–00090. THREE BOND 1281 or equi–
valent
(b) Install the shift and select lever assembly and torque
the control shaft cover.
Torque: 37 N–m (375 kgf–cm, 27 ft–lbf)
23. INSTALL PLUG
(a) Apply sealant to plug threads.
Sealant:
Part No.08833–00080. THREE BOND 1344, LOC–
TITE 242 or equivalent
(b) Using a hexagon wrench, install and torque the plug.
Torque: 23 N–m (230 kgf–cm, 17 ft–lbf)
24. INSTALL LOCK BALL
Install and torque the No.1 lock ball.
Torque: 29 N–m (300 kgf–cm, 22 ft–lbf)
25. INSTALL TRANSMISSION CASE COVER
(a) Remove the FIPG material and be careful not to drop
oil on the contacting surface of the transmission case
or tranmission case cover.
(b) Apply FIPG to the transmission case cover as shown.
FIPG:
Part No.08826–00090, THREE BOND 1281 or equi–
valent
(c) Install the transmission case cover.
(d) Apply sealant to the bolt threads.
Sealant:
Part No.08833–00080, THREE BOND 1344, LOC–
TITE 242 or equivalent
(e) Install and torque the 8 bolts.
Torque: 29 N–m (300 kgf–cm, 22 ft–lbf)
MX–69
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
26. INSTALL SELECTING BELLCRANK AND ENGINE
MOUNT BRACKET
(a) Install the selecting bellcrank and 2 bolts.
Torque: 37 N–m (380 kgf–cm. 27 ft–lbf)
(b) Install the engine mount bracket and torque the 3
bolts.
Torque: 52 N–m (530 kgf–cm, 38 ft–lbf)
27. INSTALL RELEASE BEARING RETAINER
Install the release bearing retainer and torque the 3
bolts.
Torque: 7.4 N–m (75 kgf–cm, 65 in.¿lbf)
28. INSTALL BACK–UP LIGHT SWITCH
Torque: 44 N–m 1450 kgf–cm, 33 ft.–lbf
29. INSTALL VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
30. INSTALL RELEASE FORK AND BEARING
(a) Apply molybdenum disulphide lithium base grease to
the following parts:
•
Input shaft spline
•
Release fork contact surface
(b) Apply MP grease to the front surface of the release
bearing.
MX–70
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
–
SHIFT LEVER AND CONTROL CABLE
SHIFT LEVER AND CONTROL CABLE
COMPONENTS
MX–71
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE DATA
Input shaft
Roller bearing journal diameter
Limit
3rd gear journal diameter
Limit
4th gear journal diameter
Limit
5th gear journal diameter
Limit
Runout
Limit
Output shaft
Roller bearing journal diameter
Limit
1 st gear journal diameter
Limit
2nd gear journal diameter
Limit
Runout
Limit
Gear thrust clearance 1 st
STD
Limit
Gear thrust clearance 2nd
STD
Limit
Gear thrust clearance 3rd
STD
Limit
Gear thrust clearance 4th
STD
Limit
Gear thrust clearance 5th
STD
Limit
Gear radial clearance 1 st, 2nd, 3rd and 4th
STD
Limit
Gear radial clearance 5th
STD
Limit
Shift fork to hub sleeve clearance
Limit
Synchronizer ring to gear clearance 1 at, 3rd and 4th
Limit
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
MX–72
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
Synchronizer ring to gear clearance 2nd
Limit
Input shaft snap ring thickness
Differential side bearing adjusting shim thickness
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
MX–73
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
Shift lever preload adjusting shim thickness
Differential case side bearing preload (at starting)
Differential pinion to side gear backlash
Differential side gear thrust washer thickness
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
MX–74
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part tightened
Transmission case x Transaxle case
Transmission case x Case cover
Transmission case protector
Rear bearing retainer
Output shaft front bearing lock plate
Input shaft oil receiver
5th driven gear lock nut
Reverse idler shaft lock bolt
Control shaft cover
Control shift lever x lever shaft
Ring gear x Differential case
Selecting bellcrank x Transmission case
Reverse shift arm bracket
No.3 shift fork x Shift fork shaft
Lock ball assembly
Plug
Filler plug
Drain plug
Back–up light switch
Side bearing retainer
Clutch release bearing retainer
Straight screw plug (Shift fork shaft)
Straight screw plug (Reverse restrict pin)
Transaxle x Engine (12mm bolt)
Transaxle x Engine (l0 mm bolt)
Engine left mounting x Transmission case
Engine left mounting x Sub frame
Engine front mounting x Sub frame
Engine rear mounting x Sub frame
Sub frame x Body
Lower brace x Body (Bolt)
Lower brace x Body (Nut)
Exhaust front pipe x Catalytic converter
Exhaust front pipe x Exhaust center pipe
Stiffener plate x Clutch housing
Stiffener plate x Engine
Steering gear housing x Sub frame
Stabilizer bar bush bracket x Sub frame
Starter x Clutch housing
Clutch release cylinder x Clutch housing
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
RS–1
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
RS–2
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The 1994 CAMRY is equipped with an SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) such as the
driver airbag and front passenger airbag. Failure to carry out service operations in the correct
sequence could cause the SRS to unexpectedly deployed during servicing, possibly leading
to a serious accident. Further, if a mistake is made in servicing the supplemental restraint
system, it is possible the SRS may fail to operate when required. Before performing servicing
(including removal or installation of parts, inspection or replacement), be sure to read the
following items carefully, then follow the correct procedure described in the repair manual.
1. Malfunction symptoms of the supplemental restraint system are difficult to confirm, so the
diagnostic trouble codes become the most important source of information when troubleshoot–
ing. When troubleshooting the supplemental restraint system, always inspect the diagnostic
trouble codes before disconnecting the battery (See page RS–61).
2. Work must be started after 90 seconds from the time the ignition switch turned to the ”LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery. (The supple–
mental restraint system is equipped with a back–up power source so that if work is started
within 90 seconds of disconnecting the negative (–) terminal cable of the battery, the SRS
may be deployed.) When the negative (–) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery,
memory of the clock and audio systems will be canceled. So before starting work, make a
record of the contents memorized by the audio memory system. When work is finished, reset
the audio systems as before and adjust the clock. To avoid erasing the memory of each
memory system, never use a back–up power supply from outside the vehicle.
3. Even in cases of a minor collision where the SRS does not deploy, and the front airbag sensors,
the steering wheel pad and front passenger airbag assembly should be inspected (See page RS–
17, 29, 43 and 46).
4. Never use SRS parts from another vehicle. When replacing parts, replace them with new parts.
5. Before repairs, remove the airbag sensor if shocks are likely to be applied to the sensors during
repairs.
6. Never disassemble and repair the front airbag sensors, center airbag sensor assembly or steering
wheel pad or front passenger airbag assembly in order to reuse it.
7. If the front airbag sensors, center airbag sensor assembly or steering wheel pad or front
passenger airbag assembly have been dropped, or if there are cracks, dents or dents or other
defects in the case, bracket or connector, replace them with new ones.
8. Do not expose the front airbag sensors, center airbag sensor assembly, steering wheel pad and
front passenger airbag assembly directly to hot air or flames.
9. Use a volt/ohmmeter with high impedance (10 k/V minimum) of troubleshooting of the
electrical circuit.
10. Information labels are attached to the periphery of the SRS components. Follow the instructions
on the notices.
11. After work on the supplemental restraint system is completed, perform the SRS warning light
check (See page RS–61).
12. If the vehicle is equipped with a mobile communication system, refer to the precaution in the IN
section.
RS–3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR
1. Never reuse the front airbag sensor involved in a collision when the airbag has deployed. (Replace
both the left and right airbag sensors.)
2. Install the front airbag sensor with the arrow on the sensor facing toward the front of the vehicle.
3. The front airbag sensor set bolts have been anti–rust treated.
When the sensor is removed, always replace the set bolts with new ones.
4. The front airbag sensors is equipped with an electrical connection check mechanism. Be sure to
lock this mechanism securely when connecting the connector.
If the connector is not securely locked, a malfunction code will be detected by the diagnosis
system (See page RS–13).
SPIRAL CABLE (in COMBINATION SWITCH)
The steering wheel must be fitted correctly to the steering column with the spiral cable at the
neutral position, otherwise cable disconnection and other troubles may result. Refer to page RS
–20 of this manual concerning correct steering wheel installation.
RS–4
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
STEERING WHEEL PAD (with AIRBAG)
1. When removing the steering wheel pad or handling a new steering wheel pad, it should be
placed with the pad top surface facing up.
In this case, the twin–lock type connector lock lever should be in the locked state and care
should be taken to place it so the connector will not be damaged. And do not store a steering
wheel pad on top of another one. (Storing the pad with its metallic surface up may lead to a
serious accident if the airbag inflates for some reason.
2. Never measure the resistance of the airbag squib.
(This may cause the airbag to deploy, which is very dangerous.)
3. Grease should not be applied to the steering wheel pad and the pad should not be cleaned
with detergents of any kind.
4. Store the steering wheel pad where the ambient temperature below 93C (200 F), without
high humidity and away from electrical noise.
5. When using electric welding, first disconnect the airbag connector (yellow color and 2 pins)
installed on the glove compartment finish plate at the left side of the glove compartment
before starting work.
6. When disposing of a vehicle or the steering wheel pad alone, the airbag should be deployed
using an SST before disposal (See page RS–23). Perform the operation in a place away from
electrical noise.
RS–5
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
1. Always store a removed or new front passenger airbag assembly with the airbag door facing
up. Store the airbag assembly with the airbag door facing down could cause a serious
accident if the airbag inflates.
2. Never measure the resistance of the airbag squib.
(This may cause the airbag to deploy, which is very dangerous.)
3. Grease should not be applied to the front passenger airbag and the door should not be cleaned
with detergents of any kind.
4. Store the front passenger airbag assembly where the ambient temperature remains below
93C (200F), without high humidity and away from electrical noise.
5. When using electric welding, first disconnect the airbag connector (yellow color and 2 pins)
installed on the glove compartment finish plate at the left side of the glove compartment
before starting work.
6. When disposing of a vehicle or the front passenger airbag assembly alone, the airbag should
be deployed using an SST before disposal (See page RS–36). Perform the operation in a place
away from electrical noise.
RS–6
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
1. Never. reuse the center airbag sensor assembly involved in a collision when the airbag has
deployed.
2. The connectors to the center airbag sensor assembly should be connected or disconnected
with the sensor mounted on the floor. If the connectors are connected or disconnected while
the center airbag sensor assembly is not mounted to the floor, it could cause undesired
ignition of the supplemental restraint system.
3. Work must be started after 90 seconds from the time the ignition switch is turned to ”LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery even just
loosing the set bolts of center airbag sensor assembly.
WIRE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
The SRS wire harness is integrated with the cowl wire harness assembly. The wires for the SRS
wire harness are encased in a yellow corrugated tube. All the connectors for the system are also
a standard yellow color. If the SRS wire harness becomes disconnected or the connector
becomes broken due to an accident etc., repair or replace it as shown on page RS–49.
RS–7
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
DESCRIPTION
DESCRIPTION
The SRS (Supplemental Restraint System), together with the seat belt, is designed to help protect
the driver. In a collision, the airbag sensor detect the shock, and if the front–to–rear shock is
greater than a specified value, an airbag stored in the steering wheel pad and front passenger
airbag assembly are inflated instantaneously. These operation help to reduce the shock to the
driver and front passenger airbag assembly.
LOCATION OF COMPONENTS
RS–8
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
DESCRIPTION
RS–9
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
DESCRIPTION
CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
CONNECTORS
Connector
No.
Symbol
Terminal Name
Electrical Connection Check Mechanism
Electrical Connection Check Mechanism
Squib(–) (Front Passenger)
Squib(+) (Front Passenger)
Squib(+) (Driver)
Squib(–) (Driver)
Ground
Ground
Diagnosis
Front Airbag Sensor RH(+)
Front Airbag Sensor RH(–)
Front Airbag Sensor LH(–)
Front Airbag Sensor LH(+)
SRS Warning Light
Power Source (AM2 Fuse)
Power Source (CIG Fuse)
RS–10
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
OPERATION
OPERATION
FUNCTION OF COMPONENTS
1. FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR
A front airbag sensor is mounted inside each of the
front fenders. The sensor unit is a mechanical type.
When the sensor detects deceleration force above a
predetermined limit in a collision, the contacts in the
sensor make contact, sending a signal to the center
airbag sensor assembly. The sensor cannot be dis–
assembled.
2. SPIRAL CABLE (in COMBINATION SWITCH)
A spiral cable is used as an electrical joint from the
vehicle body side to the steering wheel.
3. STEERING WHEEL PAD (with AIRBAG)
The inflater and bag of the supplemental restraint
system are stored in the steering wheel pad and
cannot be disassembled. The inflater contains a squib,
ignite charge, gas generant, etc., and inflates the bag
in case of a frontal collision.
4. FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
The inflater and bag of the supplemental restraint
system are stored in the front passenger airbag as–
sembly and cannot be disassernbled. The inflater con–
tains a squib, igniter charge, gas generant, etc., and
inflates the bag in case of a frontal collision.
5. SRS WARNING LIGHT
The SRS warning light is located on the combination
meter. It goes on the alert the driver of trouble in the
system when a malfunction is detected in the center
airbag sensor assembly self – diagnosis. In normal
operating condition when the ignition switch is turned
to the ACC or ON position, the light goes on for about
6 seconds and then goes off.
RS–11
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
OPERATION
6. CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
The center airbag sensor assembly is mounted on the
floor inside the console box. The center airbag sensor
assembly consists of a center airbag sensor, saving
sensors, ignition control and drive circuit, diagnosis
circuit, etc. It receives signals from the airbag sensors,
judges whether the SRS must be activated or not and
diagnosis system malfunctions.
7. SRS CONNECTORS
A11 connectors in the supplemental restraint system
are colored yellow to distinguish them from other
connectors. Connectors having special function and
specifically designed for SRS are used in the locations
shown below to ensure high reliability. These connec–
tors use durable gold–plated terminals.
No.
Item
Application
Terminal Twin–Lock Mechanism
Connectors (1), (2), (3), (4), (5), (6), (7)
Airbag Activation Prevention Mechanism
Connectors (1), (4), (5), (6)
Electrical Connection Check Mechanism
Connectors (1), (2), (3)
Connector Twin–Lock Mechanism
Connectors (4), (5), (6), (7)
RS–12
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
OPERATION
(1) Terminal Twin–Lock Mechanism
Each connector has a two–piece construction con–
sisting of a housing and a spacer. This design secures
the locking of the terminal by two locking devices (the
spacer and the lance) to prevent terminals from
coming out.
(2) Airbag Activation Prevention Mechanism
Each connector contains a short spring plate. When
the connector is disconnected, The short spring plate
automatically connects the power source and ground–
ing terminals of the squib.
• When Connector is Connected
• When Connector is Connected
• When Connector is Disconnected
• When Connector is Disconnected
HINT: The illustration shows connectors S and¿¿.
Connector (1) has a short spring plate on the female
terminal side, but the operating principle is the same.
RS–13
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
OPERATION
(3) Electrical Connection Check Mechanism
This mechanism is designed to electrically check if
connectors are connected correctly and completely.
The electrical connection check mechanism is desig–
ned so that the connection detection pin connects
with the diagnosis terminals when the connector hou–
sing lock is in the locked condition.
•
Half Connection
•
Complete Connection
HINT: The illustration shows connector (5) Connector
(1) also has the same operating principle.
RS–14
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
OPERATION
(4) Connector Twin–Lock Mechanism
With this mechanism connectors (male and female
connectors) are locked by two locking devices to
increase connection reliability. If the primary lock is
incomplete, ribs interfere and prevent the secondary
lock.
RS–15
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
OPERATION
When the vehicle is involved in a frontal collision in
the hatched area (Fig. 1) and the shock is larger than
a predetermined level, the SRS is activated automati–
cally. Safing sensors are designed to go on at a sma–
ller deceleration rate than the front and center airbag
sensors. As illustrated in Fig. 2 below, ignition is
caused when current flows to the squib, which hap–
pens when a safing sensor and a front airbag sensor
and/or the center airbag sensor go on simultaneously.
When a deceleration force acts on the sensor, it
causes the squib to ignite. Gas is then generated,
increasing the pressure inside the bag rapidly. The
inflated bag breaks open the steering wheel pad and
front passenger airbag assembly. Bag inflation then
ends, and the gas is discharged through discharge
holes provided behind the bag. The bag becomes
deflated as a result.
RS–16
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
PREPARATION
PREPARATION
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS
09082–00700 SRS Airbag Deployment Tool
09213–31021 Crankshaft Pulley Puller
Steering wheel
09843–18020 Diagnosis Check Wire
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09042–00010 Torx Socket T30
Steering wheel pad
09042–00020 Torx Socket T40
Center airbag sensor assembly
09082–00050 TOYOTA Electrical Tester Set
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
Bolt Length: 35 mm (1.38 in.) Pitch: 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Diam.: 6.0 mm (0.236 in.)
Airbag disposal
Tire Width: 185 mm (7.28 in.) Inner diam.: 360mm (14.17 in.)
Airbag disposal
Tire with disk wheel Width: 185 mm (7028 in.)
Inner diem.: 360 mm (14.17 in.)
Airbag disposal
Vinyl bag
Airbag disposal
RS–17
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
STEERING WHEEL PAD AND SPIRAL CABLE
STEERING WHEEL PAD AND SPIRAL
CABLE
INSPECTION ITEMS
1. VEHICLES NOT INVOLVED IN A COLLISION
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (See page RS–
61).
(b) Perform a visual check which includes the following
items with the steering wheel pad (with airbag) in–
stalled in the vehicle.
Check for cuts, minute cracks or marked discol–
oration of the steering wheel pad top surface and
grooved portion.
2. VEHICLES INVOLVED IN A COLLISION
IF THE AIRBAG IS NOT DEPLOYED
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (See page RS–
61).
(b) Perform a visual check which includes the following
items with the steering wheel pad (with airbag) re–
moved from the vehicle.
• Check for cuts or cracks in, or marked discolora–
tion of the steering wheel pad top surface and
grooved portion.
• Check for cuts and cracks in, or chipping of
connectors and wire harness.
• Check for deformation of the horn button contact
plate of the steering wheel.
HINT:
• If the horn button contact plate of the steering
wheel is deformed, never repair it. Always re–
place the steering wheel assembly with a new
one.
• There should be no interference between the
steering wheel pad and the steering wheel, and
the clearance should be uniform all the way
around when the new steering wheel pad is in–
stalled on the steering wheel.
CAUTION: For removal and installation of the steering
wheel pad, see page RS–19. REMOVAL AND INSTAL–
LATION’ and be sure to follow the correct procedure.
RS–18
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
STEERING WHEEL PAD AND SPIRAL CABLE
IF THE AIRBAG IS DEPLOYED
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (See page RS–
61).
(b) Perform a visual check which includes the following
items with the steering wheel pad (with airbag) re–
moved from he vehicle.
• Check for deformation of the horn button contact
plate of the steering wheel.
• Check for damage to the spiral cable connector
and wire harness.
HINT:
• If the horn button contact plate of the steering
wheel is deformed, never repair it. Always re–
place the steering wheel assembly with a new
one.
• There should be no interference between the
steering wheel pad and the steering wheel, and
the clearance should be uniform all the way
around when the new steering pad is installed on
the steering wheel.
REPLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS
In the following cases, replace the steering wheel pad,
steering wheel or spiral cable.
CAUTION: For replacement of the steering wheel pad,
see page RS– 19.’STEERING WHEEL PAD AND SPIRAL
CABLE REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION’ and be sure to
follow the correct procedure.
• If the airbag has been deployed.
• If the steering wheel pad or spiral cable has been
found to be faulty in troubleshooting.
• If the steering wheel pad, steering wheel or spiral
cable has been found to be faulty during the
check in item 1–(b) or 2–(b).
• If the steering wheel pad has been dropped.
RS–19
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
STEERING WHEEL PAD AND SPIRAL CABLE
COMPONENTS
STEERING WHEEL PAD AND– SPIRAL
CABLE REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
NOTICE:
• If the wiring connector of the supplemental re–
straint system is disconnected with the ignition
switch at ON or ACC, diagnostic trouble codes will
be recorded.
• Never use SRS parts from another vehicle. When
replacing parts, replace with new parts.
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery (See page RS–2).
RS–20
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
STEERING WHEEL PAD AND SPIRAL CABLE
2. REMOVE STEERING WHEEL PAD
(a) Remove negative terminal (–) from the battery and
wait at least 90 seconds.
(b) Place the front wheels facing straight ahead.
(c) Using a torx wrench, loosen the screws.
Produced by TMC: 3 screws
Produced by TMM: 2 screws
Torx wrench: T30 (Part No. 09042–00010 or locally
manufactured tool)
(d) Loosen the torx screws until the groove along the
screw circumference catches on the screw case.
(e) Pull the wheel pad out from the steering wheel and
disconnect the airbag connector.
NOTICE: When removing the wheel pad, take care not to
pull the airbag wire harness.
CAUTION:
• When storing the wheel pad, keep the upper surface
of the pad facing upward (See pages RS–4).
• Never disassemble the wheel pad.
3. REMOVE STEERING WHEEL
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the set nut.
(c) Place matchmarks on the steering wheel and main
shaft.
(d) Using SST, remove the steering wheel.
SST 09213–31021
4. REMOVE AND INSTALL SPIRAL CABLE FROM/TO
COMBINATION SWITCH
NOTICE: Do not disassemble the spiral cable or apply oil
to it.
5. CENTER SPIRAL CABLE
(a) Check that the front wheels are facing straight ahead.
(b) Turn the spiral cable counterclockwise by hand until it
becomes harder to turn the cable.
(c) Then rotate the spiral cable clockwise about 3 turns to
align the red mark.
HINT: The spiral cable will rotate about 3 turns to
either left or right of the center.
RS–21
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
STEERING WHEEL PAD AND SPIRAL CABLE
6. INSTALL STEERING WHEEL
(a) Align matchmarks on the steering wheel and main
shaft, and install the steering wheel to the main shaft.
(b) Install and torque the set nut.
Torque: 35 N–m (360 kgf–cm, 26 ft–Ibf)
(c) Connect the connector.
7. INSTALL STEERING WHEEL PAD
(a) Connect the airbag connector.
(b) Install the wheel pad after confirming that the circum–
ference groove of the torx screws is caught on the
screw case.
(c) Using a torx wrench, tighten the screws.
Produced by TMC: 3 screws
Produced by TMM: 2 screws
Torque: 8.8 N–m (90 kgf–cm. 78 in.–lbf)
NOTICE:
• Make sure the wheel pad is installed to the specified
torque.
• If the wheel pad has been dropped, or there are
cracks, dents or other defects in the case or connec–
tor, replace the wheel pad with a now one.
• When installing the wheel pad, take care that the
wirings do not interfere with other parts and are not
pinched between other parts.
8. CHECK STEERING WHEEL CENTER POINT
9. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE TO
BATTERY
RS–22
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
STEERING WHEEL PAD AND SPIRAL CABLE
STEERING WHEEL PAD (WITH AIRBAG)
DISPOSAL
When scrapping vehicles equipped with a supplemen–
tal restraint system or disposing of a steering wheel
pad (with airbag), always first deploy the airbag in
accordance with the procedure described below.
If any abnormality occurs with the airbag deployment,
contact the SERVICE DEPT. of TOYOTA MOTOR
SALES, U.S.A., INC..
Never dispose of a steering wheel pad which has an
undeployed airbag.
When disposing of a steering wheel pad with an
airbag deployed in a collision, follow the same proce–
dure given under ”When Scrapping Vehicle, part 5,
DISPOSAL OF STEERING WHEEL PAD (WITH
AIRBAG)”.
PRECAUTIONS FOR AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT
• The airbag produces a sizeable exploding sound
when it deploys, so perform the operation out–
of–doors and where it will not create a nuisance
to nearby residents.
• When deploying the airbag, always use the speci–
fied SST; SRS AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT TOOL
(SST 09082 –00700). Perform the operation in a
place away from electrical noise.
• When deploying an airbag, perform the operation
from at least 10 m (33 ft) away from the steering
wheel pad.
• The steering wheel pad is very hot when the
airbag is deployed, so leave it alone for at least 30
minutes after deployment.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a
steering wheel pad with deployed airbag.
• Always wash your hands with water after com–
pleting the operation.
• Do not apply water, etc. to a steering wheel pad
with deployed airbag.
RS–23
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
STEERING WHEEL PAD AND SPIRAL CABLE
When scrapping vehicle
HINT: Have a battery ready as the power source to
deploy the airbag.
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery (See page RS–2).
2. CONFIRM FUNCTIONING OF SST
(See page RS–28)
SST 09082–00700
3. INSTALL SST
CAUTION: Check that there is no looseness in the steer–
ing wheel and steering wheel pad.
(a) Remove the No.1 under cover.
(b) Disconnect the airbag connector of the spiral cable.
(c) Connect the SST connector to the airbag connector of
the spiral cable.
SST 08082–00700
(d) Move the SST to at least 10 m (33 ft) from the front of
the vehicle.
(e) Close all the doors and windows of the vehicle.
NOTICE: Take care not to damage the SST wire harness.
(f) Connect the SST red clip to the battery positive (+)
terminal and the black clip to the battery negative (–)
terminal.
RS–24
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
STEERING WHEEL PAD AND SPIRAL CABLE
4. DEPLOY AIRBAG
(a) Confirm that no–one is inside the vehicle or within 10
m (33 ft) of the vehicle.
(b) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the airbag.
HINT: The airbag deploys simultaneously as the LED
of the SST activation switch lights up.
5. DISPOSAL OF STEERING WHEEL PAD (WITH
AIRBAG)
CAUTION:
• The steering wheel pad is very hot when the airbag
is deployed, so leave it alone for at least 30 minutes
after deployment.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a ste–
ering wheel pad with deployed airbag.
• Do not apply water, etc. to a steering wheel pad
with deployed airbag.
• Always wash your hands with water after complet–
ing the operation.
(a) When scrapping a vehicle, deploy the airbag and scrap
the vehicle with the steering wheel pad still installed.
(b) When moving a vehicle for scrapping which has a
steering wheel pad with deployed airbag, use gloves
and safety glasses.
When disposing of steering wheel pad only
When disposing of the steering wheel pad (with airbag)
only, never use the customer’s vehicle to deploy the
airbag.
Remove the steering wheel pad from the vehicle and
be sure to follow the procedure given below when
deploying the airbag.
HINT: Have a battery ready as the power source
deploy the airbag.
1. REMOVE STEERING WHEEL PAD (Seepage RS–20)
CAUTION:
• When removing the steering wheel pad (with
airbag), work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the Ignition switch is turned to the LOCK
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is dis–
connected from the battery.
• When storing the steering wheel pad, keep the
upper surface of the pad facing upward.
RS–25
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
STEERING WHEEL PAD AND SPIRAL CABLE
2. REMOVE STEERING WHEEL PAD CONNECTOR
Remove the connector on the steering wheel pad rear
surface from the inflater cover.
3. FIX STEERING WHEEL PAD TO DISC WHEEL WITH
TIRE
(a) Install bolts with washer in the 3 bolt holes in the
steering wheel pad.
Bolt:
L 35.0 mm (1.4 in.)
M 6.0 mm
Pitch 1.0 mm
NOTICE: Tighten the bolts by hand until the bolts become
difficult to turn.
Do not tighten the bolts too much.
(b) Using a service–purpose wire harness for vehicle tie
down the steering wheel pad to the disc wheel.
Wire harness:
Stripped wire harness section 1.25 mm2 or more
(0.002 in2 or more)
HINT: To calculate the square of the stripped wire
harness section
Square = 3.14 x (Diameter)2 divided by 4
CAUTION: If a wire harness which is too thin or some
other thing is used to tie down the steering wheel pad it
may be snapped by the chock when the airbag is deplo–
yed, this is highly dangerous. Always use a wire harness
for vehicle use which is at least 1.25 mm2 (0.002 in2.).
(1) Using 3 wire harnesses, wrap the wire harnesses at
least 2 times each around the bolts installed on the
left and right sides of the steering wheel pad.
CAUTION: Tightly wind the wire harness around the
bolts so that there is no slack.
If there is slackness in the wire harness, the steering
wheel pad may come loose due to the shock when the
airbag is deployed, this is highly dangerous.
RS–26
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
STEERING WHEEL PAD AND SPIRAL CABLE
(2) Face the upper surface of the steering wheel pad
upward.
Separately tie the left and right sides of the steering
wheel pad to the disc wheel through the hub nut
holes.
Position the steering wheel pad connector so that it
hangs downward through a hub hole in the disc wheel.
CAUTION:
• Make sure that the wire harness is tight. It is very
dangerous if looseness in the wire harness results in
the steering wheel pad coming free through the
shock of the airbag deploying.
• Always tie down the steering wheel pad with the
pad side facing upward. It is very dangerous if the
steering wheel pad is tied down with the metal surface
facing upward as the wire harness will be
cut by the shock of the airbag deploying and the
steering wheel pad will be thrown into the air.
HINT: The disc wheel will be marked by airbag deploy–
ment, so use a redundant disc wheel.
4. CONFIRM FUNCTIONING OF SST
(See page RS–28)
SST 09082–00070
5. INSTALL SST
CAUTION: Place the disc wheel on level ground.
(a) Connect the SST connector to the steering wheel pad
connector.
SST 09082–00700
NOTICE: To avoid damaging the SST connector and wire
harness, do not lock the secondary lock of the twin lock.
Also provide some slack for the SST wire harness inside
the disc wheel.
(b) Move the SST to at least 10 m (33 ft) away from the
steering wheel pad tied down on the disc wheel.
6. COVER STEERING WHEEL PAD WITH CARDBOARD
BOX OR TIRES
(Covering Method Using Cardboard Box)
RS–27
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
STEERING WHEEL PAD AND SPIRAL CABLE
Cover the steering wheel pad with the cardboard box
and weigh the cardboard box down in four places with
a at least 196 N (20 kgf. 44 lbf).
Size of cardboard box:
Must exceed the following dimensions
x= 460 mm (18.11 in.)
When dimension y of the cardboard box exceeds the
diameter of the disc wheel with tire the steering wheel
pad is tied to–
x = 460 mm (18.11 in.) + width of tire
y = 650 mm (25.59 in.)
NOTICE: It a cardboard box smaller than the size speci–
fied is used, the cardboard box will be broken by the
shock of the airbag deployment.
(Covering Method Using Tires)
Place at least three tires without disc wheel on top of
the disc wheel with tire to which with tire to which the
steering wheel pad is tied.
Tire size: Must exceed the following dimensions–
Width 185 mm (7.28 in.)
Inner diam 360 mm (14.17 in.)
CAUTION: Do not use tires with disc wheels.
NOTICE: The tires by marked by the airbag deployment,
so use redundant tires.
7. AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT
(a) Connect the SST red clip to the battery positive (+)
terminal and the black clip to the battery negative (–)
terminal.
(b) Confirm that no–one is within 10 m (33 ft) of the disc
wheel the steering wheel pad is tied to.
(c) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the airbag.
HINT: The airbag deploys simultaneously as the LED
of the SST activation switch lights up.
RS–28
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
STEERING WHEEL PAD AND SPIRAL CABLE
8. DISPOSAL OF STEERING WHEEL PAD (WITH
AIRBAG)
CAUTION:
• The steering wheel pad is battery hot when the
airbag is deployed, so leave it alone for at least 30
minutes after deployment.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a ste–
ering wheel pad with deployed airbag.
• Do not apply water, etc. to a steering wheel pad
with deployed airbag.
• Always wash your hands with water after complet–
ing the operation.
(a) Remove the steering wheel pad from the disc wheel.
(b) Place the steering wheel pad in a vinyl bag, tie the end
tightly and dispose of it the same way as other general
parts.
CONFIRM FUNCTIONING OF SST
When deploying the airbag, always use the specified
SST: SRS AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT TOOL.
SST 09082–00700
1. CONNECT SST TO BATTERY
Connect the red clip of the SST to the battery positive
(+) terminal and the black clip to the battery negative
(–) terminal.
HINT: Do not connect the yellow connector which
connects with the airbag system.
2. CONFIRM FUNCTIONING OF SST
Press the SST activation switch, and confirm the LED
of the SST activation switch lights up.
CAUTION: If the LED lights up when the activation
switch is not being pressed, SST malfunction is probable,
so definitely do not use the SST.
RS–29
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG
ASSEMBLY
INSPECTION ITEMS
1. VEHICLES NOT INVOLVED IN A COLLISION
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (See page RS–
61).
(b) Perform a visual check which includes the following
items with the front passenger airbag assembly in–
stalled in the vehicle.
• Check for cuts, minute cracks or marked discolora–
tion of the front passenger airbag door.
2. VEHICLE INVOLVED IN A COLLISION
IF THE AIRBAG IS NOT DEPLOYED
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (See page RS–
61).
(b) Perform a visual check which includes the following
items with the airbag assembly removed from the
vehicle.
• Check for cuts, cracks in, or marked discoloration of
the front passenger aribag door.
• Check for cuts, cracks in, or chipping of connectors
and wire harness.
• Check for deformation of the safety pad and instru–
ment panel reinforcement.
HINT:
• If the safety pad and instrument panel reinforce–
ment is deformed, never repair it. Always replace
it with a new one.
• There should be no interfernce between the
safety pad and front passenger airbag door. The
clearance should be uniform all the way around
when the new airbag assembly is installed on the
safety pad.
CAUTION: For removal and installation of the airbag
assembly, see page RS–31, and be sure to follow the
correct procedure.
RS–30
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
IF THE AIRBAG IS DEPLOYED
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (See page RS–
61).
(b) Perform a visual check which includes the following
items with the airbag assembly removed from vehicle.
• Check for deformation of the safety pad, instrument
panel reinforcement, glove compartment and door.
• Check for damage to the connector and wire har–
ness.
HINT:
• If the safety pad, instrument panel reinforcement,
connector and wire harness is deformed, never
repair it. Always replace it with a new one.
• There should be no interference between the
safety pad and front passenger airbag door. The
clearance should be uniform all the way around
when the new aribag assembly is installed on the
safety pad.
REPLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS
In the following case, replace the airbag assembly,
instrument panel, instrument panel reinforcement,
glove compartment and door.
CAUTION: For replacement of the airbag assembly, see
page RS–31, and be sure to follow the correct proce–
dure.
• If the airbag has been deployed.
• If the front passenger airbag assembly has been
found to be fautly in troubleshooting.
• If the front passenger airbag assembly, instru–
ment panel, reinforcement, glove compartment
or glove compartment door has been found to be
fautly during the check in item 1–(b) or 2– (b).
• If the front passenger airbag assembly has been
dropped.
RS–31
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
COMPONENTS
RS–32
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
NOTICE: Never use airbag parts from another vehicle.
When replacing parts, replace with new parts.
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 second from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ”LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery (See page RS–2).
2. DISCONNECT FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG CON–
NECTOR
(a) Remove negative (–) terminal from the battery and
wait at least 90 seconds.
(b) Remove the glove compartment door finish plate
inside the glove compartment.
3. DISCONNECT AIRBAG CONNECTER
Disconnect the airbag connector.
NOTICE: When disconnecting the front passenger airbag
connector, take care not to pull the airbag wire harness.
RS–33
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
4. REMOVE AND DISCONNECT FOLLOWING PARTS:
• Remove steering wheel pad
(See page RS–20)
• Remove steering wheel
(See page RS–20)
(See page BO –108)
• Remove under cover No.2
• Remove instrument lower panel
• Remove compartment panel
• Remove compartment door
• Remove combination switch
• Remove center cluster finish panel
• Remove radio
• Remove cluster finish panel
• Remove heater control panel
5. REMOVE FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG
(a) Remove the RH side installation bolt.
(b) Remove the 5 bolts.
(c) Remove the front passenger airbag assembly.
CAUTION:
• Do not store the front passenger airbag assembly
with the airbag door facing down.
• Never disassembly the front passenger airbag
assembly.
6. INSTALL AIRBAG DOOR AND FRONT PASSENGER
AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (W/O AIRBAG DOOR)
CAUTION: Make sure to replace the new airbag door and
the new airbag assembly (w/o Airbag door) in combina–
tion, no alone.
(a) Install the airbag door with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 8.0 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 89in.–lbf)
RS–34
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(b) Using a reveter, install the 2 new rivet.
6. INSTALL FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the front passenger airbag assembly with the 6
bolts.
(b) To instrument panel reinforcement.
Diameter = 8 mm (0.32 in.)
Torque: 20 N–m (210 kgf–cm, 15 ft–Ibf)
To instrument panel
Diameter = 6 mm (0.24 in.)
Torque: 8.0 N–m (80 kgf–cm, 69 in.–Ibf)
NOTICE:
• Make sure the front passenger airbag assembly is
installed to the specified torque.
• If the front passenger airbag assembly has been
dropped, or there are cracks, dents or other defects
in the case or connector, replace the front passen–
ger airbag assembly with a new one.
• When installing the front passenger airbag assem–
bly, take care that the wiring do not interfere with
other parts and are not pinched between other
parts.
7. INSTALL FOLLOWING PARTS REMOVAL SE–
QUENCE IN REVERSE
• Steering wheel
Torque: 35 N–m (360 kgf–cm, 26 ft–Ibf)
HINT: When installing the glove compartment, pull the
airbag wire harness out from the glove compartment
opening hole.
NOTICE: Do not pull the airbag wire harnesses too stron–
gly
8. CONNECT AIRBAG CONNECTOR
(a) Connect the airbag connector.
(b) Put the connector on the glove compartment door
finish plate.
(c) Install the glove compartment door finish plate to the
glove compartment.
9. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE TO
BATTERY
RS–35
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
DISPOSAL
When scrapping vehicles equipped with an supple–
mental restraint system or disposing of a front pas–
senger airbag assembly, always first deploy the airbag
in accordance with the procedure described below.
If any abnormality occurs with the airbag deployment,
contact the SERVICE DEPT. of TOYOTA MOTOR
SALES, U.S.A., INC..
Never dispose of a front passenger airbag assembly
which has an undeployed airbag.
When disposing of a front passenger airbag assembly
with an airbag deployed in a collision, follow the same
procedure given under ”WHEN SCRAPPING THE VE–
HICLE, part 5, DISPOSAL OF FRONT PASSENGER
AIRBAG ASSEMBLY”.
PRECAUTIONS FOR AIRBAG
DEPLOYMENT
• The airbag produces a sizeable exploding sound
when it deploys, so perform the operation out–
of–doors and where it will not create a nuisance
to nearby residents.
• When deploying the airbag, always use the speci–
fied SST: SRS AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT TOOL
(SST 09082–00700). Perform the operation in a
place away from electrical noise.
• When deploying an airbag, perform the operation
from at least 10 m (33 ft) away from the front
passenger airbag assembly.
• The front passenger airbag assembly is very hot
when the airbag is deployed, so leave it alone for
at least 30 minutes after deployment.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a
front passenger airbag assembly with deployed
airbag.
• Always wash your hands with water after com–
pleting the operation.
• Do not apply water, etc., to a front passenger
airbag assembly deployed airbag.
RS–36
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
When scrapping vehicle
HINT: Have a battery ready as the power source to
deploy the airbag.
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM THE BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery (See page RS–2).
2. CONFIRM FUNCTIONING OF SST
(See page RS–42)
SST 09082–00700
3. DISCONNECT CONNECTOR
CAUTION: Check that there is no looseness in the front
passenger airbag assembly.
(a) Remove the glove compartment door finish plate
inside the glove compartment.
(b) Disconnect the center airbag sensor assembly con–
nector from the wiring harness connector.
4. INSTALL SST
(a) Connect the SST connector to the airbag connector
and lock the secondary lock of the twin lock.
SST 09082–00700
RS–37
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(b) Move the SST to at least 10 m (33 ft) from the front of
the vehicle.
(c) close all the doors and windows of the vehicle.
NOTICE: Take care not change the SST wire harness.
(d) Connect the SST red clip to the battery positive (+)
terminal and the black clip to the battery negative (–)
terminal.
6. DEPLOY AIRBAG
(a) Confirm that no–one is inside the vehicle or within 10
m (33 ft) of the vehicle.
(b) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the airbag.
HINT: The airbag deploys simultaneously as the LED
of the SST activation switch lights up.
6. DISPOSAL OF FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG AS–
SEMBLY
NOTICE:
• The front passenger airbag assembly is very out not
when the airbag is deployed, so leave it alone for at
least 30 minutes after deployment.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a front
passenger airbag assembly with deployed airbag.
• Do not apply water, etc., to a front passenger airbag
asssembly with deployed airbag.
• Always wash your hands with water after complet–
ing the operation.
When scrapping a vehicle, deploy the airbag and scrap
the vehicle with the front passenger airbag assembly
still installed.
RS–38
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
When disposing of front passenger airbag
assembly only
When disposing of the front passenger airbag assem–
bly (w/ airbag) only, never use the customer’s vehicle
to deploy the airbag.
Remove the front passenger airbag assembly from the
vehicle and be sure to follow the procedure given
below when diploying the airbag.
HINT: Have a battery ready as the power source to
deploy the airbag.
1. REMOVE FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
CAUTION:
• When removing the front passenger airbag assem–
bly, work must be started after 90 seconds from the
time the ignition switch is turned to the ”LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is dis–
connected from the battery (See page RS–2).
• Store the front passenger airbag assembly with the
airbag door facing up.
2. FIX FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY TO
TIRE
(a) Install bolts with washers in the 2 bolt holes in the
front passenger airbag assembly.
Bolt:
L 35.0 mm (1.4 in.)
M 6.0 m m
Pitch 1.0 mm
NOTICE: Tighten the bolts by hand until the bolts become
difficult to turn.
Do not tighten the bolts too much.
RS–39
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(b) Using a service–purpose wire harness for vehicle, tie
down the front passenger airbag assembly to the tire.
Wire harness–. Stripped wire harness section 1.25 mm2
or more (0.002 in2 or more).
HINT: To calculate the square of the stripped wire
harness section –
Square = 3.14 x (Diarneter)2 divided by 4
CAUTION: If a wire harness which is too thin or some
other thing is used to tie down the front passenger airbag
assembly, it may be snapped by the shock when the
airbag is deployed, this is highly dangerous.
Always use a wire harness for vehicle use which is at
least 1.25 mm2 (0.002 in 2).
(1) Using 3 wire harness, wrap the wire harnesses at least
2 times each around the bolts installed on the left and
right side of the front passenger airbag assembly.
CAUTION: Tightly wind the wire harness around the
bolts so that there is o slack. lf there is slackness in the
wire harness, the front passenger airbag assembly may
come loose due to the shock when the airbag is deployed,
this is highly dangerous.
(2) Position the front passenger airbag assembly inside
the tire with the airbag door facing inside.
Tie the wire harness to the tire.
Tire size: Must exceed the following dimensions
Width 185 mm (7.28 in.)
Inner diameter 360 mm (14.17 in.)
CAUTION:
• Make sure the wire harness is tight. It is very dan–
gerous if a loose wire harness results in the front
passenger airbag assembly coming free due to the
shock of the airbag deploying.
• Always tie down the front passenger airbag assem–
bly with the airbag door facing inside.
NOTICE: The tire will be marked by the airbag deploy–
ment, so use a redundant tire.
RS–40
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
3. CONFIRM FUNCTIONING OF SST
(See page RS–42)
SST 09082–00700
4. PLACE TIRES
(a) Place at least 2 tires under the tire to which the front
passenger airbag assembly is tied.
(b) Place at least 2 tires over the tire to which the front
passenger airbag assembly is tied. The top tire should
have the wheel installed.
(c) Tie the tires together by 2 wire harnesses.
CAUTION: Make sure that the wire harnesses are tight. It
is very dangerous if loose wire harnesses result in the
tires coming free due to the shock of the airbag deploy–
ing.
HINT: Place the SST connect and wire harness inside
tires. Provide at least a meter 1 m (3 ft) of slack for the
wire harness.
5. INSTALL SST
(a) Connect the front passenger airbag assembly connec–
tor and lock the secondary lock of the twin lock.
(b) Connect the SST connector and lock the secondary
lock of the twin lock.
SST 09082–00700
6. AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT
(a) Connect the SST red clip to the battery positive (+)
terminal and the black clip to the battery negative (–)
terminal.
(b) Confirm that no–one is within 10 m (33 ft) of the tire
the front passenger airbag assembly is tied to.
(c) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the airbag.
HINT: The airbag deploys simultaneously as the LED
of the SST activation switch lights up.
RS–41
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
7. DISPOSAL OF FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG AS–
SEMBLY
CAUTION:
• The front passenger airbag assembly is very hot
when the airbag is deployed, so leave it alone for at
least 30 minutes after deployment.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a front
passenger airbag asssembly with deployed airbag.
• Do not apply water, etc., to a front passenger airbag assembly with deployed airbag.
• Always wash your hand with water after completing
the operation.
(a) Remove the front passenger airbag assembly from the
tire.
(b) Place the front passenger airbag assembly in a vinyl
bag, tie the end tightly and dispose of it the same way
as other general parts.
RS–42
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
CONFIRM FUNCTIONING OF SST
When deploying the airbag, always use the specified
SST: SRS AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT TOOL.
SST 09082–00700
1. CONNECT SST TO BATTERY
Connect the red clip of the SST to the battery positive
(+) terminal and the black clip to the battery negative
(–) terminal.
HINT: Do not connect the yellow connector which
connects with the supplemental restraint system.
2. CONFIRM FUNCTIONING OF SST
Press the SST activation switch, and confirm the LED
of the SST activation switch lights up.
CAUTION: If the LED lights up when the activation
switch is not being pressed, SST malfunction is probable,
so definitely do not use the SST.
RS–43
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR
FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR
INSPECTION ITEMS
1. VEHICLES NOT INVOLVED IN A COLLISION
• Perform a diagnostic system check (See page RS–61).
2. VEHICLES INVOLVED IN A COLLISION
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (See page RS–61).
(b) If the front fender of the car or its periphery is dam–
aged, perform visual check for damage to the front
airbag sensor, which includes the following items
even if the airbag was not deployed:
• Bracket deformation.
• Peeling of paint from the bracket.
• Cracks, dents or chips in the case.
• Cracks and dents in, or chipping and scratches of
the connector.
• Peeling off of the label or damage to the series
number.
Also refer to the body dimension drawings check the
dimensions and mounting surface angle of the body
area where the front airbag sensors are mounted. (The
SRS may malfunction, or may not work, if the mount–
ing angle or dimensions of the sensor mount are not
correct.)
REPLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS
In the following cases, replace the front airbag sensor.
NOTICE: for replacement of the front airbag sensor, see
page RS–45,’FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION’.
• If the SRS has been deployed in a collision.
(Replace both the left and right airbag sensors.)
• If the front airbag sensor has been found to be
faulty in troubleshooting.
• If the front airbag sensor has been found to be
faulty during the check in item 2–(b).
• If the front airbag sensor has been dropped.
RS–44
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR
COMPONENTS
FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
NOTICE:
• If the wiring connector of the supplemental re–
straint system is disconnected with the ignition
switch at ON or ACC, diagnostic trouble codes will
be recorded.
• Never use SRS parts from another vehicle. When
replacing parts, replace with now parts.
• Never reuse the sensor involved in a collision when
the SRS has deployed.
• Never repair a sensor in order to reuse it.
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable Is discon–
nected from the battery (See page RS–2).
RS–45
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR
2. REMOVE FENDER LINER
3. REMOVE FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the bolt and sensor.
4. INSTALL FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR
Install the sensor with the arrow on the sensor facing
toward the front of the vehicle.
Torque: 25 N–m (260 kgf–cm, 19 ft–lbf)
NOTICE:
• Make sure the sensor is installed to the specified
torque.
• If the sensor has been dropped, or there are cracks
dents or other defects in the case, bracket or con–
nector, replace the sensor with a new one.
• The sensor set bolts have been anti–rust treated
When the sensor is removed, always replace the set
bolts with new ones.
• After installation, shake the sensor to check that
there is no looseness.
• The front sensor is equipped with an electrical con–
nection check mechanism. Be sure to lock this mech–
anism securely when connecting the connector. If
the connector is not securely locked, a malfunction
code will be detected by the diagnosis system.
• Check that the dimensions of the body where the
front airbag sensor is installed match those in the
body dimension drawings in the BODY section.
(The SRS may malfunction, or may not work, if the
mounting angle or dimensions of the sensor mount
are not correct.)
5. INSTALL FENDER LINER
6. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE TO
BATTERY
RS–46
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
INSPECTION ITEMS
1. VEHICLES NOT INVOLVED IN A COLLISION
• Perform a diagnostic system check (See page RS–61).
2. VEHICLES INVOLVED IN A COLLISION
IF THE SRS IS NOT DEPLOYED
• Perform a diagnostic system check (See page RS–61).
IF THE SRS IS DEPLOYED
• Replace the center airbag sensor assembly certain–
ly.
REPLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS
In the following cases, replace the center airbag
sensor assembly.
NOTICE: For replacement of the center airbag sensor
assembly, see page RS–47, ’CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION”.
• If the SRS has been deployed in a collision.
• If the center airbag sensor assembly has been
found to be faulty in troubleshooting.
• If the center airbag sensor assembly has been
dropped.
RS–47
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
COMPONENTS
CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
NOTICE:
• Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU and
various computers unless absolutely necessary. (If
the IC terminals are touched, the IC may be destr–
oyed by static electricity.)
• Never use SRS parts from another vehicle. When
replacing parts, replace with new parts.
• Never reuse the center airbag sensor assembly in–
volved in a collision when the airbag has deployed.
• Never repair a sensor in order to reuse it.
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery (See page RS–2).
RS–48
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
2. REMOVE AND INSTALL CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a torx wrench, loosen and tighten the 3 screws.
Torx wrench: T40 (Part No. 09042–00020 or locally
manufactured tool)
(b) Disconnect and connect connector.
NOTICE: Removal and installation of the connector is
done with the sensor assembly installed.
(c) Using a torx wrench, tighten the 3 screws.
Torx wrench: T40 (Part No. 09042–00020 or locally
manufactured tool)
Torque: 20 N–m (200 kgf–cm, 14 ft–lbf)
NOTICE:
• Make sure the sensor assembly is installed to the
specified torque.
• If the sensor assembly has been dropped, or there
are cracks, dents or other defects in the case, brack–
et or connector, replace the sensor assembly with a
new one.
• When installing the sensor assembly, take care that
the airbag wiring does not interfere with other parts
and is not pinched between other parts.
• After installation, shake the sensor assembly to
check that there is no looseness.
3. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE TO
BATTERY
RS–49
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
WIRE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
WIRE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
HINT: The SRS wire harness is integrated with the
cowl wire harness assembly and floor wire harness
assembly.
The wires for the SRS wire harness are encased in a
yellow corrugated tube and all the connectors in the
system are a standard yellow color.
INSPECTION ITEMS
1. VEHICLES NOT INVOLVED IN A COLLISION
• Perform a diagnostic system check (See page RS–61).
2. VEHICLES INVOLVED IN A COLLISION
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check
(See page RS–61).
(b) If there is a break in any of the wires in the SRS wire
harness, or if conductors are exposed.
(c) In the SRS wire harness connectors are cracked or
chipped.
RS–50
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
WIRE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
REPLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS
In the following cases, replace the wire harness or
connector.
• If any part of the SRS wire harness or any con–
nector has been found to be faulty in troublesh–
ooting.
• If any pant of the SRS wire harness or any con–
nector has been found to be faulty during the
check in item 2–(b) or (c).
NOTICE: If the wire harness used in the SRS is damaged,
replace the whole wire harness assembly.
When the connector to the front airbag sensors can be
repaired alone (when there is no damaged to the wire
harness), use the repair wire specially designed for the
purpose (See page RS–13).
REPAIR WIRE FOR FRONT AIRBAG
SENSOR REPLACEMENT
Repair wire with 2 pressure–contact sleeves (Part
No. 82988–24010) has been prepared for exclusive
use in repairing connector damage etc. caused by
frontal collision of the vehicle.
When repairing the front airbag sensor connector on
the wire harness side, always use the special repair
wire.
NOTICE: Do not replace the connector housing or termi–
nal only.
AIRBAG REPAIRWIRE REPLACEMENT
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery (See page RS–2).
1. DISCONNECT WIRE HARNESS AT VEHICLE SIDE
(a) Remove the cover at the rear of the connect housing
and expose the wire harness.
(b) Cut the wire harness behind the connector housing.
HINT: The operation is performed more easily if the
wire harness is left as long as possible.
RS–51
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
WIRE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
2. CONNECT FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR WIRE HAR–
NESS AT VEHICLE SIDE AND REPAIR WIRE
(a) Start stripping at least 8 mm (0.31 in.) to 11 mm (0.43
in.) away from the end of the existing harness at
vehicle side and also from the end of the repair wire.
NOTICE: Take care not to damage the wire when stripp–
ing the wire harness lead. After finishing the operation,
visually inspect the wire. If there Is any damaged. per–
form the operation again.
(b) Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends inside of the pres–
sure–contact sleeve as illustrated in the left.
HINT: The blue pressure–contact sleeve (Part No.
82999–12020) is available individually.
HINT: You might find it easier if you use a miniature
screwdriver as a guide as you insert wires into the
sleeve.
(c) The crimping tool (AMP Part No. 69060) has color
marks on it. Place the sleeve in the correct section of
the tool according to the color of the sleeve itself.
RS–52
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
WIRE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
(d) with the center of the sleeve correctly placed be–
tween the crimping jaws, squeeze the crimping tool
until either end comes into contact at the section
marked by ”CLOSE HERE”.
HINT: Check to see that the sleeve and wires are still
in the correct position before closing the crimping tool
ends with steady pressure.
(e) Pull the joined wires to either end. Make sure that they
are joined firmly by the sleeve.
NOTICE: If the joined wire come loose the splice is defec–
tive, so replace the sleeve and repeat the procedure.
(f) Crimp both ends of the sleeve with the crimping tool
at the ”INS” position.
3. PROTECT JOINED SECTION
Wrap silicon tape around the joins to protect them
from water.
HINT:
• Before starting the operation, thoroughly wipe
dirt and grease off the sections to be joined.
• If the adhesive surfaces of two tapes come in
contact they will stick together and will not come
apart, so do not remove the backing film except
when using the tape.
• Do not let oil and dust, etc., get on the tape
surface.
(a) Ready about 100 mm (3.94 in.) of silicon tape (Part
No. 08231–00045) and peel oft the film.
(b) Stretch the silicon tape until its width is reduced by
half.
(c) About 10 mm (0.39 in.) from the end of the pressure
contact sleeve, wrap the silicon tape around the
sleeve 3 or more times while stretching the tape.
RS–53
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
WIRE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
(d) Wrap the remaining part of sleeve with half of the
tape overlapping at each turn.
(e) Firmly wrap the tap 2 times or more about 10 mm
(0.39 in.) from the other end of the pressure contact
sleeve, then wrap the tap back towards the start again
and firmly finish winding the tape around the center of
the sleeve.
(f) Fix the corrugated tube to the wire using silicon tape.
(g) After applying the silicon tape, apply vinyl tape on the
corrugated tube of repair wire side over to the cor–
rugated tube of vehicle wire harness side.
RS–54
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
– MEMO
–
–
WIRE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
RS–55
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
TROUBLESHOOTING
RS–56
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
Malfunction symptoms of the supplemental restraint system are difficult to confirm, so the diagnostic trou–
ble codes become the most important source of information when troubleshooting. Perform troubleshooting
of the supplemental restraint system in accordance with the following procedure:
HINT: Do not disconnect the battery negative (–) terminal cable until step [3] , Diagnostic Trouble Code
Check and Recording, has been completed.
[1] CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
Using the CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK SHEET (See page RS–60) for reference, ask the
customer in as much detail as possible about the problem.
[2] WARNING LIGHT CHECK
Check the SRS warning light. If the light remains on, a malfunction is stored in the center airbag sensor,
assembly, so proceed to step [3] . If the SRS warning light is not on, a malfunction has occurred in the
SRS warning light circuit, so perform troubleshooting for SRS Warning Light System Malfunction.
HINT: Code 22 is recorded when a malfunction occurs in the SRS warning light system.
If an open malfunction occurs in the SRS warning light system, the SRS warning light does not light up,
so that until the malfunction is repaired, the diagnostic trouble codes cannot be confirmed.
[3] DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK AND RECORDING
Check the diagnostic trouble codes and make a note of any malfunction codes which are output. If a
normal code is output, an abnormality in the power source circuit may have occurred, so perform
troubleshooting for source voltage in step [8] .
If code 22 is output, skip steps [4] and [5] and proceed to step [7] .
[4] MALFUNCTION CODE CLEARANCE
Clear the malfunction code.
HINT: The malfunction code output in step [3] indicates that a malfunction has occurred in the circuit
designated by the malfunction code, but does not indicate whether the malfunction is still occurring or
whether it was in the past. ,
Accordingly, it is necessary to find out the present condition of the malfunction occurrence by clearing
the malfunction code and performing the diagnostic trouble code check again. If this operation is
neglected and troubleshooting is performed using only the malfunction code confirmed in step [3] ,
isolating the problem component becomes difficult and invites mistaken diagnosis.
[5] DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK AND RECORDING
After repeating ignition switch ON–OFF operation (ON: wait 20 secs., OFF: wait 20 secs.) 5 times, check
the diagnostic trouble code. If any code is output, the malfunction is still occurring, so proceed to step
[7].
Bearing in mind that a malfunction code was registered in step [3] , provided that the normal code is
presently output, use the methods described in step [6] to simulate the malfunction.
NOTICE: When connecting the battery after clearing the malfunction code, always do it with the
ignition switch in ”LOCK” position. When the battery has been reconnected, turn the ignition switch
to ACC or ON position after at least 2 seconds have elapsed.
If the battery is reconnected with the ignition switch in ACC or ON position, or the ignition switch is
turned to ACC or ON within 2 seconds of connecting the battery, it is possible that the diagnosis
system will not operate normally.
RS–57
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
[6] SYMPTOM SIMULATION
[7] DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
Proceed to the appropriate flow chart in step [8] in accordance with the malfunction code found in
step [5] or [6] .
[8] CIRCUIT INSPECTION [9] REPAIR
Find out if the problem lies in a sensor, actuator or wire harness and connector, and repair the problem.
After the problem part is repaired, reinstall the disassembled parts. Do not start work until 90 seconds
after the ignition switch is turned to the LOCK position and the negative (–) terminal cable is dis–
connected.
CAUTION: If incorrect procedure is used, a malfunction may occur in the system or there is
the danger that airbag may be accidentally deploy during the repair operation. Carefully read
the GENERAL DESCRIPTION (See page RS–2) and the cautions for each operation, perform
repairs in the correct order using the correct methods.
HINT: The following illustration for the CIRCUIT INSPECTION shows each connector for the SRS
squib circuit.
RS–58
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
[10] MALFUNCTION CODE CLEARANCE
When all the malfunction codes found in steps [5] and [6] have been repaired, clear the malfunction
codes.
[11] DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK
After repeating ignition switch ON–OFF operation (ON: wait 20 secs., OFF: wait 20 secs.) 5 times,
check
the diagnostic trouble codes. If a code is displayed, return to step [7] and troubleshoot the displayed
malfunction code.
NOTICE: When connecting the battery after clearing the malfunction code, always do it with the
ignition switch in ”LOCK” position. When the battery has been reconnected, turn the ignition switch
to ACC or ON position after at least 20 seconds have elapsed.
If the battery is reconnected with the ignition switch in ACC or ON position, or the ignition switch is
turned to ACC or ON within 20 seconds of connecting the battery, it is possible that the diagnosis
system will not operate normally.
[12] CONFIRMATION TEST
Check the warning light again and confirm that all the malfunctions have been repaired. If the warning
light indicates and abnormally, repeat the operation again from step [2] .
RS–59
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Vehicle Brought to Workshop
Customer Problem Analysis
RS–60
Warning Lignt Check
Does Not Light Up
RS–61
Remains ON
Diagnostic Trouble Code Check and Recording
Normal Code
RS–61
Malfunction Code
Malfunction Code Clearance
RS–65
Diagnostic Trouble Code Check and Recording
Normal Code
Symptom Simulation
Normal Code
RS–67
RS–61
Malfunction Code
Malfunction Code
Diagnostic Trouble Code Matrix Chart
RS–69
Circuit Inspection
RS–76
Identification of problems
Repair
Malfunction Code Clearance
RS–65
Malfunction Code
Diagnostic Trouble Code Check
RS–61
Confirmation Test
END
: Diagnostic steps permitting the use of
the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
RS–60
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK SHEET
RS–61
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DIAGNOSIS INSPECTION
SRS warning light check
(a) Turn the ignition switch to ACC or ON and check that the
SRS warning light lights up.
(b) Check that the SRS warning light goes out after approx. 6
seconds.
HINT:
• When the ignition switch is at ACC or ON and the SRS
warning light remains on, the center airbag sensor as–
seemly has detected a malfunction code.
• If, after approx. 6 seconds have elapsed, the SRS warn–
ing light sometimes lights up or the SRS warning light
lights up even when the ignition switch is OFF, a short
in the SRS warning light circuit can be considered like–
ly. Proceed to SRS warning light system (always lit up,
when ignition switch LOCK position) on page RS–146.
Diagnostic trouble code check
Using diagnosis check wire:
1. OUTPUT DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE
(a) Turn the ignition switch to ACC or ON position and wait
Approx. 20 seconds.
(b) Using SST, connect terminals Te and El of the DLC1 or
DLC2.
SST 09843 – 18020
NOTICE: Never make a mistake with the terminal connec–
tion position as this will cause a malfunction.
RS–62
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
2. READ DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE
Read the 2–digit diagnostic trouble code as indicated by the
number of times the SRS warning light blinks. As an
example, the blinking patterns, normal, 11 and 31 are as
shown on the illustration.
• Normal code indication
The light will blink 2 times per second.
• Malfunction code indication
In the event of a malfunction, the light will blink. The
number represented by the first blink code output
indicates the first digit of a 2–digit diagnostic trouble
code. After a 1.5 second pause, the second blink code
will indicate the second digit.
If there are 2 or more codes, there will be a 2.5 second
pause between each. After all the codes have been
output, there will be a 4.0 second pause and they will all
be repeated.
HINT:
• In the event of a number of trouble codes, indication will
1st from the smallest numbered code to the larger.
• If it does not output a diagnostic trouble code or outputs
a diagnostic trouble code without terminal connection,
proceed to the Tc terminal circuit inspection on page RS–
127.
Using TOYOTA hand–held Tester
(a) Hook up the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC1 or
DLC2.
(b) Read the diagnostic trouble codes by following the prompts
on the tester screen.
HINT: Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester
operator’s manual for further details.
RS–63
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES
DTC
No.
(Nor–
mal)
Blink Pattern
Diagnosis
•
System normal
•
Source voltage drop
•
Short in squib circuit or
front airbag sensor
circuit (to ground)
Front airbag sensor or
malfunction
Center airbag sensor
assembly malfunction
•
•
•
•
•
22*
Short in squib circuit
(to +B)
Open in front airbag
circuit
Short in squib circuit
(between D+ wire
harness and D– wire
harness)
Trouble Area
SRS Warning
Light
OFF
•
•
Battery
Center airbag sensor assembly
•
•
Steering wheel pad (squib)
Front passenger airbag sensor
(squib)
Front airbag sensor
Spiral cable
Center airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Steering wheel pad (squib)
Front passenger airbag sensor
(squib)
Front airbag sensor
Spiral cable
Center airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
•
Steering wheel pad (squib)
Spiral cable
Center airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
•
Open in driver side
airbag squib circuit
•
•
•
•
Steering wheel pad (squib)
Spiral cable
Center airbag sensor assembly
wire harness
•
Open in front airbag
sensor circuit
•
•
•
Front airbag sensor
Center airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
•
SRS warning light
system malfunction
•
•
•
SRS warning light
Center airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
•
Open in center airbag
sensor assembly
connector malfunction
•
•
Center airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
•
Center airbag sensor
assembly malfunction
•
Center airbag sensor assembly
•
Short in passenger
airbag squib circuit
(between P+ wire
harness and P+ wire
harness)
•
•
•
•
Front passenger airbag assembly
Wiring harness
Center airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
•
Open in passenger
airbag squib circuit
•
•
•
•
Front passenger airbag assembly
Wiring harness
Center airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
RS–64
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
• When the SRS warning light remains lit up and the diagnostic trouble code in the normal code, this
means a source voltage drop.
This malfunction is not stored in memory by the center airbag sensor Assembly and if the power source
voltage returns to normal, after approx. 10 seconds the SRS warning light will automatically go out.
• Code 22 is recorded when a malfunction occurs in the SRS warning light system.
If an open malfunction occurs in the SRS warning light system, the SRS warning light does not light up,
so that until the malfunction is repaired, the diagnostic trouble codes (including code 22) cannot be con–
firmed.
• When 2 or more codes are indicated, the lowest numbered code will appear first.
• If a code not listed on the chart is displayed, then the center airbag sensor assembly is faulty.
RS–65
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
CLEARING OF DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE
Using diagnosis check wire:
(a) Connect service wires to terminals Tc and AB of the check
connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ACC or ON and wait approx. 6
seconds.
(c) Starting with the Tc terminal, apply body ground alternate–
ly to terminal Tc and terminal AB twice each in cycles of 1.0
±0.5 seconds. (Confirm that body ground is absolute.)
Finally, keep applying body ground to terminal Tc.
HINT: When alternately grounding terminals Tc and AB,
release ground from one terminal and immediately apply
it to the other terminal. This action must be done within the
time limits shown below. If you are not within the time
limits, repeat the above procedure until you clear the
codes.
(d) Several seconds after performing the clearing procedure,
the SRS warning light will blink in a 50 m sec. cycle to
indicate the codes have been cleared.
RS–66
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Using TOYOTA hand–held tester
(a) Hook up the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC1 or
DLC2.
(b) Clear the diagnostic trouble codes by following the prompts
on the tester screen.
HINT: Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester
operator’s manual for further details.
RS–67
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
SYMPTOM SIMULATION
”Intermittent troubles or problems” are the malfunctions about which the customer has a complaint, but
which do not occur and can not be conformed in the workshop. The intermittent problems also include
complaints about the SRS warning light going on and off erratically.
The self–diagnostic system stores the circuit of the intermittent problem in memory even if the ignition switch
is turned off.
And, for accurate diagnosis of the problems, ask the customer to obtain information as much as possible
following the customer problem analysis check sheet (See page RS–60) and try to reproduce the intermittent
problem.
The problem simulation methods described below are the effective ways for this nature of problem to pro–
duce the problem conditions by applying vibration, heat, and humidity.
VIBRATION METHOD: when vibration seems to be the major cause.
CONNECTORS
Slightly shake the connector vertically and horizontally.
(inspection of connectors)
(a) Does the wire harness connecting with its cor–
responding part have insufficient slack?
(b) Are the terminals dirty?
(c) Are the terminals making loose contact due to ter–
minals spread?
WIRE HARNESS
Slightly shake the wire harness vertically and horizon–
tally. The connector joint, fulcrum of the vibration, and
body through portion are the major areas to be checked
thoroughly.
PARTS AND SENSORS
Apply vibration slightly by a finger to the part or sensor
considered to be the problem cause and check if the
malfunction will occur.
CAUTION: Do not apply vibration to the center
airbag sensor assembly.
RS–68
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
HEAT METHOD: When the problem seems to occur when the
suspect area is heated.
Heat the component that is likely the cause of the mal–
function with a hair dryer or similar object. Check to
see if the malfunction will occur.
NOTICE:
• Do not heat to more than 60C (140F) (Tempera–
ture limit that the component can be touched with a
hand.).
• Do not apply heat directly to part in the ECU.
WATER SPRINKLING When the malfunction seems to occur on a
METHOD: rainy day or in a high–humidity condition.
Sprinkle water onto the vehicle and check to see if
the malfunction will occur.
NOTICE: Never apply water directly onto the electronic components.
HINT:
• If a vehicle is subject to water leakage, the leaked
water may contaminate the ECU. When testing a vehicle with a water leakage problem, special caution
must be paid.
OTHER: when a malfunction seems to occur when electrical load is excessive.
Turn on all electrical loads including the heater blower, headlights, rear window defogger, etc. and check
to see if the malfunction will occur.
RS–69
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE MATRIX CHART
If a malfunction code is displayed during the diagnostic trouble code check, check the circuit listed for that
code in the table below (Proceed to the page given for that circuit.).
Diagnosis
DTC No.
(Normal)*1
22*2
Page
•
Source volatage drop
RS–76
•
Short in squib circuit or front airbag sensor circuit (to ground)
RS–80
•
Short in squib circuit or front airbag sensor circuit (to +B)
RS–88
•
Short in squib circuit (between D+ wire harness and D– wire harness)
RS–96
•
Open in squib circuit (between D+ wire harness and D– wire harness)
RS–104
•
Open in front airbag sensor circuit
RS–110
•
SRS warning light system malfunction
RS–116
•
Open in center airbag sensor assembly connector malfunction
RS–122
•
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
RS–126
•
Short in squib circuit (between P+ wire harness and P– wire harness)
RS–128
•
Open in squib circuit (between P+ wire harness and P– wire harness)
RS–134
HINT:
*1 When the SRS warning light remains lit up and the diagnostic trouble code is the normal code, this
means a source voltage drop.
*2 Code 22 is recorded when a malfunction occurs in the SRS warning light system.
If an open malfunction occurs in the SRS warning light system, the SRS warning light does not light up,
so that until the malfunction is repaired, the diagnostic trouble codes (including code 22) cannot be
confirmed.
PROBLEM SYMPTOM CHART
Proceed with troubleshooting of each circuit in the table below.
Problem Symptom
Inspection Item
Page
RS–140
•
With the ignition switch at ACC on ON, the SRS warning light
does not lights up.
•
SRS warning light malfunc–
tion.
•
With the ignition switch at ACC or ON, the SRS warning light
sometimes lights up after approx. 6 seconds have elapsed.
SRS warning light lights up even when ignition switch is in the
LOCK position.
•
SRS Warning light system
(Always lit up when ignition
switch is LOCK position)
Diagnostic trouble code not displayed.
Diagnostic trouble code continuously displayed.
•
•
•
•
Te terminal circuit
RS–146
RS–148
RS–70
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
LOCATION OF CONNECTORS
Location of Connectors in Engine Compartment
1 MZ–FE
5S–FE
RS–71
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
RS–72
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Jl6 No. 2
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
RS–73
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Location of Connectors in Instrument Panel
RS–74
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
JIB No. 1
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
RS–75
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
J/B No. 3
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
RS–76
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC (Normal) Source Voltage Drop
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The supplemental restraint system is equipped with a voltage – increase circuit (DC–DC converter)
in the center airbag sensor assembly in case the source voltage drops.
When the battery voltage drops, the voltage – increase circuit (DC–DC converter) functions to increase the voltage of the supplemental restraint system to normal voltage.
The diagnosis system malfunction display for this circuit is different to other circuits – when the SRS
warning light remains lit up and the diagnostic trouble code is a normal code, source voltage drop
is indicated. Malfunction in this circuit is not recorded in the center airbag sensor assembly, and
approx. 10 seconds after the source voltage returns to normal, the SRS warning light automatically
goes off.
Diagnosis
DTC No.
(Normal)
Source voltage drop.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Preparation.
Does SRS warning light turnoff after approx.
10 seconds?
YES
Check battery and charging system
(See CHARGING SYSTEM).
Check diagnostic trouble code, and
if a malfunction code is output,
perform troubleshooting according
to malfunction code. If a normal
code is output, replace center air–
bag sensor assembly.
RS–77
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
RS–78
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURES
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Preparation
Check
Preparation.
(1) Turn ignition switch LOCK.
(2) Disconnect battery negative (–) terminal ca–
ble, and wait at least 90 seconds.
(3) Connect battery negative (–) terminal cable.
(4) Disconnect center airbag sensor assembly
connector.
(5) Turn ignition switch O
N. But do not start
engine.
(6) Measure voltage at IG2 or ACC on connector
wire harness side of center airbag sensor as–
sembly and operate electric system (defogger,
wiper, headlight, heater blower, etc.).
Voltage: 6 V – 11.5 V at IG2 and ACC.
(7) Turn electric system switch OFF.
(8) Turn ignition switch LOCK.
(9) Disconnect battery negative (–) terminal ca–
ble, and wait at least 90 seconds.
(10) Remove voltmeter and connect center airbag
sensor assembly connector.
(11) Connect battery negative (–) terminal cable.
Does SRS warning light turn off?
Turn ignition switch ON.
Operate electric system checked in
check that SRS warning light goes off.
YES
Check battery and charging system .
(5) and
Check diagnostic trouble code, and if a malfunc–
tion code is output, perform troubleshooting
according to malfunction code. If a normal code
is output, replace center airbag sensor assembly.
RS–79
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
– MEMO –
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
RS–80
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DTC 11 Short in Squib Circuit or Front Airbag Sensor Circuit
(to Ground)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The squib circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly, spiral cable, steering wheel pad
(squib), wire harness connector and front passenger airbag assembly(squib). It causes the airbag to
operate when the airbag operation conditions are satisfied.
The front airbag sensor detects the deceleration force in a frontal collision and is located in front
fender on the left and right sides.
For details of the function of each component, see FUNCTION OF COMPONENTS on page RS–10.
Diagnostic trouble code 11 is recorded when ground short is detected in the squib circuit or front airbag sensor circuit.
DTC No.
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Diagnosis
Short circuit in squib wire harness (to ground).
Squib malfunction.
Short circuit in front airbag sensor +S, D+, D–, P+, P–, wire harness (to ground).
Front airbag sensor malfunction.
Short circuit between +S wire harness and –S wire harness of front airbag sensor.
Spiral cable malfunction.
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction.
RS–81
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Preparation.
Check front airbag sensor circuit. (Measure resis–
tance between terminals +SR and –SR, +SL and –SL
of center airbag sensor assembly connector.)
Go to step [9] on next page.
Check front airbag sensor circuit. (Measure resis–
tance between terminals +SR, +SL of center airbag
sensor assembly connector and body ground.)
Repair or replace harness or connector
between front airbag sensor and center
airbag sensor assembly (See page RS–
50).
Check D squib circuit. (Measure resistance between
terminals D+, D– of center airbag assembly con–
nector and body ground.)
Go to step [10] on next page.
Check P squib circuit. (Measure resistance between
terminals P+, P– of center airbag assembly con–
nector and body ground.)
Repair or replace harness or connector
between front airbag sensor and center
airbag sensor assembly (See page RS–
50).
Check center airbag sensor assembly.
Replace center airbag sensor assembly.
Check D squib.
Replace steering wheel pad.
Check P squib.
Replace front passenger airbag assembly.
From the results of the above inspection, the
malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to
check.
RS–82
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DIAGNOSTIC CHART (Cont’d)
Check front airbag sensor.
Replace front airbag sensor.
Repair or replace harness or connector between
front airbag sensor and center airbag sensor
assembly (See page RS–50).
Check spiral cable.
Repair or replace harness or connector between
center airbag sensor assembly and spiral cable.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Repair or replace spiral cable.
RS–83
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Preparation
Check
Preparation.
(1) Disconnect battery negative (–) terminal cable,
and wait at least 90 seconds.
(2) Remove steering wheel pad (See page RS–
20).
(3) Disconnect connectors of front passenger
airbag assembly. (See page RS–29)
Store the steering wheel pad with the front
surface facing upward.
Check front airbag sensor circuit. (Measure resistance between terminals
+SR and –SR, +SL and –SL of center airbag sensor assembly connector.)
Disconnect center airbag sensor assembly con–
nectors.
Measure resistance between terminals +SR and
–SR, +SL and –SL of harness side connector of
center airbag sensor assembly.
Resistance: 755 Ω – 885 Ω
Go to step
RS–84
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Check front airbag sensor circuit. (Measure resistance between terminals
+SR, +SL of center airbag sensor assembly connector and body ground.)
Measure resistance between terminals +SR,
+SL of harness side connector of center airbag
sensor assembly and body ground.
Resistance: 1 M or higher.
Repair or replace harness or connector between front airbag sensor and center airbag
sensor assembly (See page RS–50).
Check D squib circuit.
For the connector (on the spiral cable side) between the spiral cable and steering wheel pad,
measure the resistance between D+, D– and
body ground.
Resistance: 1 M or higher
Go to step
RS–85
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Check P squib circuit.
For the connector (on the wiring harness connector
side) between the wiring harness connector and
front passenger airbag assembly, measure the re–
sistance between P+, P– and body ground.
Resistance: 1 M or higher
Repair or replace harness of connector between the center airbag sensor assembly and
front passenger airbag assembly.
Check center airbag sensor assembly.
(1) Connect connectors to center airbag sensor
assembly.
(2) Using a service wire, connect D+ and D– on
spiral cable side of connector between spiral
cable and steering wheel pad.
(3) Using a service wire, connect P+ and P– on
center airbag sensor assembly side of connec–
tor between center airbag sensor assembly
and front passenger airbag assembly.
(4) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to battery,
and wait at least 2 seconds.
(5) Turn ignition switch ACC or ON, and wait at
least 20 seconds.
Clear malfunction code (See page RS–65).
Turn ignition switch LOCK and wait at least
20 seconds.
(1) Turn ignition switch ACC or ON and wait at
least 20 seconds.
(2) Using SST, connect terminals Tc and El of
DLC1 or DLC2.
SST 09843–18020
(3) Check diagnostic trouble code.
Diagnostic trouble code 11 is not output.
Codes other than code 11 may be output at this
time, but they are not relevant to this check.
Replace center airbag sensor assembly.
RS–86
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Check D squib.
(1) Turn ignition switch LOCK.
(2) Disconnect battery negative (–) terminal cable,
and wait at least 90 seconds.
(3) Connect steering wheel pad (squib) connec–
tor.
(4) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to battery,
and wait at least 2 seconds.
(5) Turn ignition switch ACC or ON, and wait at
least 20 seconds.
Clear malfunction code. Turn ignition switch
LOCK, and wait at least 20 seconds.
(1) Turn ignition switch ACC or ON, and wait at
least 20 seconds.
(2) Using SST, connect terminals Tc and El of
DLC1 or DLC2.
SST 09843–18020
(3) Check diagnostic trouble code.
Diagnostic trouble code 11 is not output.
Codes other than code 11 may be output at this
time, but they are not relevant to this check.
Replace steering wheel pad.
Check P squib.
(1) Turn ignition switch LOCK.
(2) Disconnect battery negative (–) terminal cable,
and wait at least 90 seconds.
(3) Connect front passenger airbag assembly
(squib) connector.
(4) Disconnect steering wheel pad (squib) con–
nector.
(5) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to battery,
and wait at least 2 seconds.
(6) Turn ignition switch ACC or ON, and wait at
least 20 seconds.
Clear malfunction code. Turn ignition switch
LOCK, and wait at least 20 seconds.
(1) Turn ignition switch ACC or ON, and wait at
least 20 seconds.
(2) Using SST, connect terminals Tc and El of
DLC1 or DLC2.
(3) Check diagnostic trouble code.
Diagnostic trouble code 11 is not output.
Codes other than code 11 may be output at this
time, but they are not relevant to this check.
Replace front passenger airbag assembly.
RS–87
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
Check front airbag sensor.
Disconnect front airbag sensor connector.
Measure resistance between each terminal of
front airbag sensor.
Terminal
(+)S – (+)A
(+)S – (–) S
Resistance
Below 1 Ω
M CI or higher
(–)S – (–) A
755 Ω – 885 Ω
• Do not press ohmmeter probes strongly against
terminals of front airbag sensor.
• Make sure the front airbag sensor connector is
properly connected.
NG
Replace front airbag sensor.
Repair or replace harness or connector between center airbag sensor assembly and front
airbag sensor (See page RS–27).
Check spiral cable.
Disconnect connector between center airbag sen–
sor assembly and spiral cable.
Measure resistance between D+, D– on spiral ca–
ble side of connector between spiral cable and
steering wheel pad and body ground.
Resistance: 1 M Ω or higher
Repair or replace spiral cable.
Repair or replace harness or connector between center airbag sensor assembly and spiral
cable.
RS–88
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DTC 12 Short in Squib Circuit (to B+)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The squib circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly, spiral cable and the steering wheel
pad (squib). It causes the airbag to deploy when the airbag deployment conditions are satisfied.
The front airbag sensor detects the deceleration force in a frontal collision and is located in the front
fender on the left and right sides.
For details of the function of each component, see FUNCTION OF COMPONENTS on page RS–10–
Diagnostic trouble code 12 is recorded when a +B short is detected in the squib circuit or the front airbag sensor circuit.
Diagnosis
DTC No.
•
•
•
•
•
•
Short circuit in squib wire harness (to +B).
Squib malfunction.
Short circuit in front airbag sensor +S wire harness (to +B).
Open circuit in RH and LH front airbag sensor harness.
Spiral cable malfunction.
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction.
WIRING DIAGRAM
RS–89
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Preparation.
Check front airbag sensor circuit.
(Measure resistance between terminals +SR and –
SR, +SL and –SL of center airbag sensor assembly
connector.)
Check front airbag sensor circuit.
(Measure voltage between terminal +SR or +SL of
center airbag sensor assembly connector and body
ground.)
Check front airbag sensor circuit. (Measure voltage
between terminals D+ and D– of center airbag
sensor assembly connector and body ground.)
Check front airbag sensor circuit. (Measure voltage
between terminals P+ and P’ of center airbag
sensor assembly connector and body ground.)
Check center airbag sensor assembly.
Check D squib.
Check P squib.
Go to Code 15 (See page RS–110).
Repair or replace harness or connector
between center airbag sensor assembly
and front airbag sensor (See page RS–50).
Go to step [9]
Repair or replace harness or connector
between front airbag sensor and center
airbag sensor assembly. (See page RS–50).
Replace center airbag sensor assembly.
Replace steering wheel pad.
Replace front passenger airbag assem–
bly.
From the results of the above inspection, the
malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to
check.
Check spiral cable.
Repair or replace harness or connecter between
center airbag sensor assembly and spiral cable.
Repair or replace spiral cable.
RS–90
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURES
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Preparation
Check
Preparation.
(1) Disconnect battery negative H terminal cable,
and wait at least 90 seconds.
(2) Remove steering wheel pad (See page RS–
20).
(3) Disconnect connectors of front passenger
airbag assembly. (See page RS–29)
Store the steering wheel pad with the front
surface facing upward.
Check front airbag sensor circuit. (Measure resistance between terminals
+SR and –SR, +SL and –SL of center airbag sensor assembly connector.)
Disconnect center airbag sensor assembly con–
nector.
Measure resistance between terminals +SR and
–SR, +SL and –SL of harness side connector of
center airbag sensor assembly.
Resistance: 755 – 885
Go to Code 15 (See page RS–110).
RS–91
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Check front airbag sensor circuit. (Measure voltage between terminal +SR
or +SL of center airbag sensor assembly connector and body ground.)
(1) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to battery.
(2) Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure voltage between terminals +SR or +SL
of
harness side connector of center airbag sensor
assembly and body ground.
Voltage: Below 1 V
Repair or replace harness or connector between center airbag sensor assembly and
front airbag sensor (See page RS–50).
Check D squib circuit.
Measure voltage at D+ on spiral cable side of
connector between spiral cable and steering
wheelpad.
Voltage: Below 1 V
G o to step
RS–92
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Check P squib circuit.
Measure voltage at P+ on center airbag sensor
assembly side of connector between center airbag sensor assembly and front passenger airbag
assembly.
Voltage: Below 1 V
Repair or replace harness or connector
between front airbag sensor and center
airbag sensor assembly. (See page RS–50).
Check D squib circuit.
(1) Turn ignition switch LOCK.
(2) Disconnect negative H terminal cable from
battery.
(3) Connect connector to center airbag sensor
assembly.
(4) Using a service wire, connect D+ and D– on
spiral cable side of connector between spiral
cable and steering wheel pad.
(5) Using a service wire, connect P+ and P– on
wire harness connector and front passenger
airbag assembly.
(6) Connect negative H terminal cable to battery,
and wait at least 2 seconds.
(7) Turn ignition switch ACC on ON and wait at
least 20 seconds.
Clear malfunction code. Turn ignition switch
LOCK, and wait at least 20 seconds.
(1) Turn ignition switch ACC or ON, and wait at
least 20 seconds.
(2) Using SST, connect terminals Tc and El of
DLC1 or DLC2.
SST 09843–18020
(3) Check diagnostic trouble code.
Diagnostic trouble code 12 is not output.
Codes other than code 12 may be output at this
time, but they are not relevant to this check.
Replace center airbag sensor assembly.
RS–93
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Check D squib.
(1) Turn ignition switch LOCK.
(2) Disconnect battery negative 1–) terminal cable,
and wait at least 90 seconds.
(3) Connect steering wheel pad (squib) connector.
(4) Connect negative H terminal cable to battery,
and bait at least 2 seconds.
(5) Turn ignition switch, ACC or ON, and wait at
least 20 seconds.
Clear malfunction code. Turn ignition switch
LOCK, and wait at least 20 seconds.
(1) Turn ignition switch ACC or ON, and wait at
least 20 seconds
(2) Using SST, connect terminals Tc and El of
DLC1 or DLC2.
SST 09843–18020
(3) Check diagnostic trouble code.
Diagnostic trouble code 12 is not output.
Code other than code 12 may be output at this
time, but they are not relevant to this check.
Replace steering wheel pad.
Check P squib.
(1) Turn ignition switch LOCK.
(2) Disconnect battery negative (–) terminal cable,
and wait at least 90 seconds.
(3) Connect front passenger airbag assembly
(squib) connector.
(4) Disconnect steering wheel pad (squib)connector.
(5) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to battery,
and wait at least 2 seconds.
(6) Turn ignition switch ACC or ON and wait at
least 20 seconds.
Clear malfunction code. Turn ignition switch
LOCK, and wait at least 20 seconds.
(1) Turn ignition switch ACC or ON, and wait at
least 20 seconds.
(2) Using SST, connect terminals Tc and El of
DLC1 or DLC2.
(3) Check diagnostic trouble code.
Diagnostic trouble code 12 is not output.
Codes other than code 12 may be output at this
time, but they are not relevant to this check.
Replace center airbag sensor assembly.
RS–94
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
SUPPTROUBLESHOOTING
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered
normal. To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
Check spiral cable.
(1) Turn ignition switch LOCK.
(2) Disconnect connector between center airbag
sensor assembly and spiral cable
(3) Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure voltage at D+ on spiral cable side of
con–
nector between spiral cable and steering wheel
pad.
Voltage: Below 1 V
Repair or replace spiral cable.
Repair or replace harness or connector between center airbag sensor assembly and spiral
cable.
RS–95
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
– MEMO –
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
RS–96
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DTC 13 Short in Squib Circuit (Between D+ Wire
Harness and D– Wire Harness)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The squib circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly, spiral cable and the steering wheel
pad (squib). It causes the airbag to deploy when the airbag deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see FUNCTION OF COMPONENTS on page RS–10–
Diagnostic trouble code 13 is recorded when a short is detected in the D+ wire harness and D– wire
harness of the squib circuit.
Diagnosis
DTC No.
•
•
•
•
Short circuit between D+ wire harness and D– wire harness of squib.
Squib malfunction.
Spiral cable malfunction.
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Preparation.
Check D squib circuit.
Go to step
Check center airbag sensor assembly.
Replace center airbag sensor as–
sembly.
Check D squib.
Replace steering wheel pad.
From the results of the above inspection,
the malfunctioning part can now be con–
sidered normal. To make sure of this, use
the simulation method to check.
on next page.
RS–97
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DIAGNOSTIC CHART (Cont’d)
Check spiral cable.
Repair or replace spiral cable.
Check harness between center airbag sen–
sor assembly and spiral cable.
Repair or replace harness or con–
nector between center airbag sen–
sor assembly and spiral cable.
Check center airbag sensor assembly.
Replace center airbag sensor as–
sembly.
From the results of the above inspection,
the malfunctioning part can now be con–
sidered normal. To make sure of this, use
the simulation method to check.
WIRING DIAGRAM
RS–98
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Preparation
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check
Preparation.
(1) Disconnect battery negative (–) terminal cable,
and wait at least 90 seconds.
(2) Remove steering wheel pad (See page RS–
20).
(3) Disconnect connectors of front passenger
airbag assembly and seat belt pretensioners.
(See page RS–29)
Store the steering wheel pad with the front surface facing upward.
Check D squib circuit.
Measure resistance between D+ and D– on spiral
cable side of connector betwen spiral cable and
steering wheel pad.
Resistance: 1 k or higher
Go to step
RS–99
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Check center airbag sensor assembly.
(1) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to battery.
(2) Clear malfunction.
(3) Turn ignition switch LOCK, and wait at least
20 seconds.
(1) Turn ignition switch ACC or ON, and wait at
least 20 seconds.
(2) Using SST, connect terminals Tc and El of
DLC1 or DLC2.
SST 09843–18020
(3) Check diagnostic trouble code.
Diagnostic trouble code 13 is not output.
Codes other than code 13 may be output at this
time, but they are not relevant to this check.
Replace center airbag sensor assembly.
Check D squib.
(1) Turn ignition switch LOCK.
(2) Disconnect battery negative (–) terminal cable,
and wait at least 90 seconds.
(3) Connect steering wheel pad (squib) connector.
(4) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to battery.
(5) Clear malfunction.
(6) Turn ignition switch LOCK, and wait at least
20 seconds.
(1) Turn ignition switch ACC or ON and wait at
least 20 seconds.
(2) Using SST, connect terminals Tc and El of
DLC1 or DLC2.
SST 09843–18020
(3) Check diagnostic trouble code.
Diagnostic trouble code 13 is not output.
Codes other than code 13 may be output at this
time, but they are not relevant to this check.
Replace steering wheel pad.
RS–100
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal. To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
Check spiral cable.
(1) Disconnect connector between center airbag
sensor assembly and spiral cable.
(2) Release airbag activation prevention mecha–
nism on center airbag sensor assembly side
of spiral cable connector (See page RS–102).
Measure resistance between D+ and D– on spiral
cable side of connector between spiral cable
and steering wheel pad.
Resistance: 1 M or higher
Repair or replace spiral cable.
Check harness between center airbag sensor assembly and spiral cable.
(1) Disconnect center airbag sensor assembly
connector.
(2) Release airbag activation prevention mecha–
nism on center airbag sensor assembly con–
nector (See page RS–50).
Measure resistance between D+ and D– on center airbag sensor assembly side of connector between center airbag sensor assembly and spiral
cable.
Resistance: 1 M or higher
Repair or replace harness or connector between center airbag sensor assembly and
spiral cable.
RS–101
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
TROUBLESHOOTING
7. Check center airbag sensor assembly.
P
Front Passenger
Airbag Assembly
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Spiral
Cable
0
Steering Wheel
Pad (Squib)
Connect center airbag sensor assembly connector.
Measure resistance between D+ and D– on center airbag sensor assembly side of connector
between center airbag sensor assembly and spiral cable.
Resistance: 1 KM Ω or higher
805905
AB0068
Replace center airbag sensor assembly.
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal. To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
RS–102
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
RELEASE METHOD OF AIRBAG ACTIVATION PREVENTION MECHANISM
An airbag activation prevention mechanism is built into the connector for the squib circuit of the
supplemental restraint system. When release of the airbag activation prevention mechanism is directed
in the troubleshooting procedure, as shown in the illustration of the connector T and 0 below, insert
paper which is the same thickness as the male terminal, between the terminal and the short spring
CAUTION:
• NEVER RELEASE the airbag activation prevention mechanism on the steering wheel pad connector.
NOTICE:
• Do not release the airbag activation prevention mechanism unless specifically directed by the
troubleshooting procedure.
• If the paper inserted is too thick the terminal and short spring may be damaged, so always use paper
the same thickness as the male terminal.
RS–103
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
– MEMO –
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
RS–104
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DTC 14 Open in D Squib Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The squib circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly, spiral cable and the steering wheel
pad (squib). It causes the airbag to deploy when the airbag deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see FUNCTION OF COMPONENTS on page RS–10.
Diagnostic trouble code 14 is recorded when an open is detected in the squib circuit.
Diagnosis
DTC No.
•
•
•
•
Open circuit in D+ wire harness or D‘ wire harness of squib.
Squib malfunction.
Spiral cable malfunction.
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction.
RS–105
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Preparation.
Check D squib circuit.
Go to step
Check spiral cable.
Repair or replace spiral cable.
Check harness between center airbag sen–
sor assembly and spiral cable.
Repair or replace harness or con–
nector between center airbag sen–
sor assembly and spiral cable.
Check center airbag sensor assembly.
Replace center airbag sensor as–
sembly.
Check D squib.
Replace steering wheel pad.
From the results of the above inspection,
the malfunctioning part can now be con–
sidered normal. To make sure of this, use
the simulation method to check.
WIRING DIAGRAM
RS–106
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Preparation
Check
Preparation.
(1) Disconnect battery negative (–) terminal cable,
and wait at least 90 seconds.
(2) Remove steering wheel pad (See page RS–20).
(3) Disconnect connectors of front passenger
airbag assembly. (See page RS–29)
Store the steering wheel pad with the front
surface facing upward.
Check D squib circuit.
Disconnect center airbag sensor assembly con–
nectors.
Measure resistance between D+ and D– on spiral
cable side of connector between spiral cable and
steering wheel pad.
Resistance: Below 1
Go to step
RS–107
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Check spiral cable.
Disconnect connector between center airbag sen–
sor assembly and spiral cable.
Measure resistance between D+ and D– on spiral
cable side of connector between spiral cable and
steering wheel pad.
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
Repair or replace spiral cable.
Check harness between center airbag sensor assembly and spiral cable.
Measure resistance between D+ and D– on center
airbag sensor assembly side of connector between
center airbag sensor assembly and spiral cable.
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
Repair or replace harness or connector
between center airbag sensor assembly
and spiral cable.
RS–108
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Check center airbag sensor assembly.
(1) Connect connector to center airbag sensor
connector.
(2) Connect connector between center airbag
sensor assembly and spiral cable.
(3) Using a service wire, connect D+ and D– on
spiral cable side of connector between spiral
cable and steering wheel pad.
(4) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to battery,
and wait at least 2 seconds.
(5) Turn ignition switch ACC on ON and wait at
least 20 seconds.
Clear malfunction code. Turn ignition switch
LOCK, and wait at least 20 seconds.
(1) Turn ignition switch ACC or ON, and wait at
least 20 seconds.
(2) Using SST, connect terminals Tc and El of
DLC1 or DLC2.
SST 09843–18020
(3) Check diagnostic trouble code.
Diagnostic trouble code 14 is not output.
Codes other than code 14 may be output at this
time, but they are not relevant to this check.
Replace center airbag sensor assembly.
Check D squib.
(1) Turn ignition switch LOCK.
(2) Disconnect battery negative H terminal cable,
and wait at least 90 seconds.
(3) Connect steering wheel pad (squib) con–
nector.
(4) Connect negative (–y terminal cable to bat–
tery, and wait at least 2 seconds.
(5) Turn ignition switch ACC or ON, and wait at
least 20 seconds.
(6) Clear malfunction code. Turn ignition switch
LOCK, and wait at least 20 seconds.
Turn ignition switch ACC or ON, and wait at
least 20 seconds
(2) Using SST, connect terminals Tc and El of
DLC1 or DLC2.
SST 09843–18020
(3) Check diagnostic trouble code.
Diagnostic trouble code 14 is not output.
Code other than code 14 may be output at this
time, but they are not relevant to this check.
Replace steering wheel pad.
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal. To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
RS–109
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
– MEMO –
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
RS–110
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DTC 15 Open in Front Airbag Sensor Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The front airbag sensor detects the deceleration force in a frontal collision and is located in the front
fender on the left and right sides.
For details of the function of each component, see FUNCTION OF COMPONENTS on page
RS–10.
Diagnostic trouble code 15 is recorded when an open is detected in the front airbag sensor circuit.
NOTICE: The front airbag sensor connector is equipped with an electrical connection check mech–
anism for the purpose of detecting an open in the front airbag sensor (See page RS–13). This mech–
anism is constructed so that when the terminals of the front airbag sensor have been connected
(when the connector housing lock is in the locked condition), the connection detection pin on the
wire harness
side connects with the terminals for diagnosis use on the sensor side. If the connector is not properly
connected, the diagnosis system, may detect only a malfunction code, even though the supplemental restraint system is functioning normally. When connecting the front airbag sensor connector,
make sure it is connected properly. If diagnostic trouble code 15 is displayed after the front airbag
sensor connector has been connected, check again that it is properly connected.
Diagnosis
DTC No.
•
•
•
•
•
Open circuit in +S wire harness or –S wire harness of front airbag sensor.
Short circuit in front airbag sensor +S wire harness (to +B).
Front airbag sensor malfunction.
Malfunction of electrical connection check mechanism of front airbag sensor.
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction.
WIRING DIAGRAM
RS–111
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Preparation.
Check front airbag sensor circuit
(Measure resistance between terminals +SR
and –SR, +SL and –SL of center airbag sensor
assembly connector).
Go to step
Check front airbag sensor circuit
(Measure voltage between terminal +SR or
+SL. and of center airbag assembly con–
nector and body ground).
Repair or replace harness or con–
nector between center airbag sen–
sor assembly and front airbag
sensor. (See page RS–50).
Check center airbag sensor assembly.
Replace center airbag sensor as–
sembly.
From the results of the above inspection,
the malfunctioning part can now be con–
sidered normal. To make sure of this, use
the simulation method to check.
Check front airbag sensor.
Replace front airbag sensor.
Check harness between center airbag sen–
sor assembly and front airbag sensor.
Repair or replace harness or con–
nector between center airbag sen–
sor. assembly and front airbag
sesor. (See page RS–50).
Replace front airbag sensor connector (See
page RS–50).
RS–112
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Preparation
Check
Preparation.
(1) Disconnect battery negative (–) terminal cable,
and wait at least 90 seconds.
(2) Remove steering wheel pad (See page RS–
20).
(3) Disconnect connectors of front passenger
airbag assembly. (See page RS–29)
Store the steering wheel pad with the front
surface facing upward.
Check front airbag sensor circuit (Measure resistance between terminals
+SR and –SR, +SL and –SL of center airbag sensor assembly connector.).
Disconnect center airbag sensor assembly con–
nectors.
Measure resistance between terminals +SR and
–SR, +SL and –SL of harness side connector of
center airbag sensor assembly.
Resistance: 755 – 885
Go to step
RS–113
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Check front airbag sensor circuit. (Measure voltage between terminal +SR
or +SL of center airbag sensor assembly connector and body ground.)
(1) Connect negative H terminal cable to battery.
(2) Turn ignition SWitch ON.
Measure voltage between terminals +SR or +SL
ofharness side connector of center airbag sensor
assembly and body ground.
Voltage: Below 1 V
Repair or replace harness or connector between center airbag sensor assembly and
front airbag sensor (See page RS–50).
Check center airbag sensor assembly.
(1) Turn ignition switch LOCK.
(2) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from
battery.
(3) Connect connector to center airbag sensor
assembly.
(4) Using a service wire, connect D+ and D– on
spiral cable side of connector between spiral
cable and steering wheel pad.
(5) Using a service wire, connect P+ and P– on
wire harness connector side of connector be–
tween wire harness connector and front pas–
senger airbag. .
(6) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to battery,
and wait at least 2 seconds.
(7) Turn ignition switch ACC or ON and wait at
least 20 seconds.
Clear malfunction code. Turn ignition switch
LOCK and wait at least 20 seconds.
(1) Turn ignition switch ACC or ON and wait at
least 20 seconds.
(2) Using SST, connect terminals Tc and El of
DLC1 or DLC2.
SST 09843–18020
(3) Check diagnostic trouble code.
Diagnostic trouble code 15 is not output.
Codes other than code 15 may be output at this
time, but they are not relevant to this check.
Replace center airbag sensor assembly.
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal. To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
RS–114
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Check front airbag sensor.
Disconnect front airbag sensor connector.
Measure resistance between each terminal of
front
airbag sensor.
Terminal
Resistance
• Do not press ohmmeter probes too strongly
against terminals of front airbag sensor.
• Make sure the front airbag sensor connector is
properly connected.
Replace front airbag sensor.
Check harness between center airbag sensor assembly and front airbag
sensor.
(1) Disconnect center airbag sensor assembly
connectors.
(2) Using service wires, connect +SR and –SR,
+SL and –SL on the wire harness side of the
center airbag sensor assembly connectors.
Measure resistance between terminals +SR and
–SR, +SL and –SL of harness side connector of
front airbag sensor.
• Lightly touch ohmmeter probes at position
shown in illustration.
• Make sure the front airbag sensor connector is
properly connected.
Resistance: Below 1
Repair or replace harness or connector between center airbag sensor assembly and
front airbag sensor (See page RS–50).
Replace front airbag sensor connector (See page RS–50).
RS–115
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
– MEMO –
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
RS–116
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DTC 22 SRS Warning Light System Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The SRS warning light is located on the cluster finish panel.
when the SRS is normal, the SRS warning light lights up for approx.6 seconds after the ignition switch
is turned from LOCK position to ACC or ON position, and then turns off automatically.
If there is a malfunction in the SRS, the SRS warning light lights up to inform the driver of the
abnormality.
When terminals Tc and E1of the DLC1 or DLC2 are connected, the diagnostic trouble code is displayed
by the blinking of the SRS warning light.
The SRS warning light circuit is equipped with an electrical connection check mechanism which detects
when the connector to the center airbag sensor assembly is not properly connected.
If the connector to the center airbag sensor assembly is not properly connected, the SRS warning light
will not light up.
Diagnostic trouble code 22 is recorded when a malfunction occurs in the SRS warning light system. If
an OPEN malfunction occurs in the SRS warning light system, the SRS warning light does not light up,
so that until the malfunction is repaired, the diagnostic trouble codes (including code 22f cannot be
confirmed.
DTC No.
•
•
Diagnosis
Open circuit in SRS warning light system.
Center– airbag sensor assembly malfunction.
RS–117
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Troubleshooting for this system is different for when the SRS warning light does not light up and for
when diagnostic trouble code 22 is output. Confirm the problem symptoms first before selecting the
appropriate troubleshooting procedure.
HINT: If SRS warning light does not light up, perform the following troubleshooting:
Check ECU–B Fuse.
G o to step
Check connection of center airbag sensor
assembly connector.
Repair.
Preparation.
Check SRS warning light circuit.
Does SRS warning light come on?
YES
Repair SRS warning light circuit.
Check terminal LA of center airb–
ag sensor assembly and electrical
connection check mechanism. If
normal, replace center airbag sensor assembly.
From the results of the above inspection,
the malfunctioning part can now be con–
sidered normal. To make sure of this, use
the simulation method to check.
Is ECU–B Fuse burnt out again?
YES
Check harness between ECU–B fuse and
SRS warning. light.
Using simulation method, repro–
duce malfunction symptoms (See
page RS–67).
RS–118
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
HINT: If diagnostic trouble code 22 is output, perform the following troubleshooting:
NO Using simulation m
Using simulation method, repro–
Is diagnostic trouble code 22 output again?
duce malfunction symptoms (See
page RS–67).
YES
Replace center airbag sensor assembly.
WIRING DIAGRAM
RS–119
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Preparation
INSPECTION PROCEDURES
HINT: IF SRS warning light does not light up, perform the following troubleshooting:
Check
Check ECU–B fuse.
Remove ECU–B fuse.
Check continuity of ECU–13 fuse.
Continuity
• Fuse may be burnt out even if it appears to be
OK during visual inspection.
• If fuse is OK, instal it.
Go to step
Check connection of center airbag sensor assembly connector.
Repair.
Preparation.
(1) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from
the battery, and wait at least 90 seconds.
(2) Remove steering wheel pad (See page RS–
20).
(3) Disconnect connector of front passenger
airbag assembly. (See page RS–29).
Store the steering wheel pad with the front
surface facing upward.
RS–120
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Check SRS warning light circuit.
(1) Disconnect center airbag sensor assembly
connector.
(2) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to battery.
(3) Turn ignition switch ACC or ON.
Measure voltage LA terminal of harness side con–
nector of center airbag sensor assembly.
Voltage: Battery positive voltage
Repair SRS warning light circuit.
Does SRS warning light come on?
(1) Disconnect negative H terminal cable from
the battery.
(2) Connect center airbag sensor assembly con–
nector.
(3) Connect negative 1–y terminal cable to battery,
and wait at least 2 seconds.
(4) Turn ignition switch ACC or ON.
Check operation of SRS warning light.
SRS warning light comes on.
YES
Check terminal LA of center airbag sensor assembly and electrical connection check mechanism.
If normal, replace center airbag sensor assembly.
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered
normal. To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
Is new ECU–B fuse burnt out again?
YES
Using simulation method, reproduce malfunction symptoms (See page RS–67).
Check harness between ECU–B fuse and SRS warning
light.
RS–121
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT: If diagnostic trouble code 22 is output, perform the following troubleshooting:
Is diagnostic trouble code 22 output again?
(1) Turn ignition switch LOCK, and wait at least
2 seconds.
(2) Turn ignition switch ACC or ON, and wait at
least 20 seconds.
(3) Clear malfunction code stored in memory.
(See page RS–65)
(4) Turn ignition switch LOCK, and wait at least
20 seconds.
(5) Turn ignition switch ACC or ON, and wait at
least 20 seconds.
(6) Using SST, connect terminals Te and El of
DLC1 or DLC2.
SST 09843–18020
(7) Check diagnostic trouble code.
YES
Replace center airbag sensor assembly.
Using simulation method, reproduce malfunction symptoms (See page RS–67).
RS–122
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DTC 24 Open in Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
Connectors Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The center airbag sensor assembly detects partial connection of connectors.
For details of the function of each component, see FUNCTION OF COMPONENTS on page RS–10.
When the center airbag sensor assembly detects an open in the electrical connection check mechanism of the center airbag sensor connector or in the center airbag sensor circuit, trouble code 24 is recorded.
Diagnosis
DTC No.
•
•
Malfunction of electrical connection check mechanism of center airbag sensor assembly connectors.
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction.
RS–123
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Are connectors of center airbag sensor
assembly properly connected?
Check unfitting detector pin in the center
airbag sensor assembly connector.
Check center airbag sensor assembly.
From the results of the above inspection, the
malfunctioning part can now be considered
normal. To make sure of this, use the simula–
tion method to check.
Connect connectors.
Repair or replace center airbag sensor
assembly connector.
Replace center airbag sensor asse–
mbly.
RS–124
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Preparation
Check
Are connector of center airbag sensor assembly properly connected?
Connect connectors.
Check unfitting detector pin in the center airbag sensor assembly
connector.
(1) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable
from battery.
(2) Disconnect center airbag sensor assembly.
Test for continuity.
Continuity exists.
Repair or replace center airbag
sensor assembly connector.
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered
normal. To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
RS–125
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Check center– airbag sensor assembly.
(1) Disconnect negative (–y terminal cable from
battery.
(2) Connect center airbag sensor assembly.
(3) Connect negative H terminal cable to battery.
(4) Turn ignition switch ACC or ON.
Check diagnostic trouble code.
Diagnostic trouble code 24 is not output.
Replace center airbag sensor assembly.
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be
considered normal. To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
RS–126
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DTC 31 Center Airbag Sensor Assembly Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The center airbag sensor assembly consists of a center airbag sensor, safing sensor, ignition control
and drive circuit, diagnosis circuit, etc.
It receives signals from the airbag sensors, judges whether or not the airbag must be deploy, and
diagnosis system malfunction.
Diagnostic trouble code 31 is recorded with occurrence of a malfunction in the center airbag sensor
assembly is detected.
Diagnosis
DTC No.
•
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
HINT: When a malfunction code other than code 31 is displayed at the same time, first repair the
malfunction indicated by the malfunction code other than code 31.
Is diagnostic trouble code 31 output again?
YES
Replace center airbag sensor assembly.
NO
Using simulation method, repro–
duce malfunction symptoms (See
INTRODUCTION).
RS–127
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT: When a malfunction code other than code 31 is displayed at the same time, first repair the malfunc–
tion indicated by the malfunction code other than code 31.
Preparation
Check
Is diagnostic trouble code 31 output again?
Clear malfunction code.
(1) Turn ignition switch LOCK, and wait at least
20 seconds.
(2) Turn ignition switch ACC or ON, and wait at
least 20 seconds.
(3) Repeat operation in step
(1) and
(2) at least 5
times.
(4) Using SST, connect terminals Tc and El of
DLC1 or DLC2.
SST 09843–18020
(5) Check diagnostic trouble code.
YES
Replace center airbag sensor assembly.
Using simulation method, reproduce malfunction symptoms (See INTRODUCTION).
RS–128
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DTC 53 Short in P Squib Circuit (Between P+ Wire Harness
and P– Wire Harness)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The squib circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly, (squib). It causes the airbag to deploy
when the airbag deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see FUNCTION OF COMPONENTS. on page RS–10–
Diagnostic trouble code 53 is recorded when a short is detected in the P+ wire harness and P– wire
harness of the squib circuit.
Diagnosis
DTC No.
•
•
•
Short circuit between P+ wire harness and P– wire harness of squib.
Squib malfunction.
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Preparation.
on next page.
Check P squib circuit.
G o to step
Check center airbag sensor assembly.
Replace center airbag sensor as–
sembly.
Check P squib.
Replace front passenger airbag
assembly.
From the results of the above inspection,
the malfunctioning part can now be con–
sidered normal. To make sure of this, use
the simulation method to check.
RS–129
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DIAGNOSTIC CHART (Cont’d)
Check P circuit.
Check center airbag sensor assembly.
From the results of the above inspection,
the malfunctioning part can now be con–
sidered normal. To make sure of this, use
the simulation method to check.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Repair or replace harness or con–
nector between center airbag sen–
sor assembly and front passenger
airbag assembly.
Replace center airbag sensor as–
sembly.
RS–130
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Preparation
Check
Preparation.
(1) Disconnect battery negative H terminal cable,
and wait at least 90 seconds.
t2y Remove steering wheel pad (See page RS–
20).
(3) Disconnect connectors of front passenger
airbag assembly (See page RS–29).
Store the steering wheel pad with the front
surface
facing upward.
Check Psquib circuit.
For the connector (on the center airbag sensor
assembly side) between the center airbag sensor
assembly and front passenger airbag assembly,
measure the resistance between P+ and P’.
Resistance: 1 k or higher
Go to step
RS–131
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Check center airbag sensor assembly.
(1) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to battery,
and wait at least 2 seconds.
(2) Clear malfunction code stored in memory
(See page RS–65).
(3) Turn ignition switch LOCK, and wait at least
20 seconds.
(1) Turn ignition switch ACC or ON and wait at
least 20 seconds.
(2) Using SST, connect terminals Tc and El of
D LC 1 or D LC2 .
SST 09843–18020
(3) Check diagnostic trouble code.
Diagnostic trouble code 53 is not output.
Codes other than code 53 may be output at this
time, but they are not relevant to this check.
Replace center airbag sensor assembly.
RS–132
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Check P squib.
(1)Turn ignition switch–LOCK.
(2) Disconnect battery negative (–) terminal cable
and wait at least 90 seconds.
(3) Connect front passenger airbag assembly
connector.
(4) Connect negative H terminal cable to battery,
and wait at least 2 seconds.
(5)Clear malfunction code (See page RS–65).
(6) Turn ignition switch ACCor ON, and wait at
least 20 seconds.
(1)Turn ignition switch ACC or ON and wait at
least 20 seconds
(2)Using SSt, connect terminals Tc and E1 of
DLC1 or DLC2.
SST 09843–18020
(3) Check diagnostic trouble code.
Diagnostic trouble code 53 is not output.
Codes other than code 54 may be output at this
time, but they are not relevant to this check.
Replace front passenger airbag assembly.
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal. To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
RS–133
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Check P circuit
(1) Disconnect center airbag sensor assembly
connector.
(2) Release airbag activation prevention mecha–
nism on center airbag sensor assembly con–
nector (See page RS–102).
For the connector (on the center airbag sensor as–
sembly side) between the center airbag sensor
assembly and front passenger airbag assembly,
measure the resistance between P+ and P–.
Resistance: 1 k or higher
Repair or replace harness or connector between center airbag sensor assembly and
front passenger airbag assembly.
Check center airbag sensor assembly.
Connect center airbag sensor assembly connec–
tor.
For the connector (on the center airbag sensor
assembly side) between the center airbag sensor
assembly and front passenger airbag assembly,
measure the resistance between P+ and P–.
Resistance: 1 k or higher
Replace center airbag sensor assembly.
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered
normal. To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
RS–134
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DTC 54 Open in P Squib Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The squib circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly, wiring harness connector and front
passenger airbag assembly. It causes the airbag to deploy when the airbag deployment conditions
are satisfied. For details of the function of each component, see FUNCTION OF COMPONENTS on
page RS–10.
Diagnostic trouble code 54 is recorded when an open is detected in the squib circuit.
Diagnosis
DTC No.
•
•
•
Open circuit in P+ wire harness and P– wire harness of squib.
Squib malfunction.
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction.
RS–135
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Preparation.
Check P squib circuit.
Check center airbag sensor assembly.
Check P squib.
From the results of the above inspection,
the malfunctioning part can now be con–
sidered normal. To make sure of this, use
the simulation method to check.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Repair or replace harness or con–
nector between center airbag sen–
sor assembly and front airbag
sensor (See page RS–13).
Replace center airbag sensor as–
sembly.
Replace front passenger airbag
assembly.
RS–136
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Preparation
Check
Preparation.
(1) Disconnect battery negative (–) terminal cable,
and wait at least 90 seconds.
(2) Remove steering wheel pad (See page RS–20).
(3) Disconnect connectors of front passenger
airbag assembly (See page RS–29).
Store the steering wheel pad with the front
surface
facing upward.
Check P squib circuit.
Disconnect center airbag sensor assembly con–
nector.
For the connector (on the center airbag sensor
assembly side) between the center airbag sensor
assembly and front passenger airbag assembly,
measure the resistance between P+ and P–.
Resistance: Below 1
Repair or replace harness or connector between center airbag sensor assembly and
front passenger airbag assembly.
RS–137
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Check center airbag sensor assembly.
(1) Connect connectors to center airbag sensor
assembly.
(2) Using a service wire, connect D+ and D– on
spiral cable side of connector between spiral
cable and steering wheel pad.
(3) Using a service wire, connect P+ and P’ on
center airbag sensor assembly side of connec–
tor between center airbag sensor assembly
and front passenger airbag assembly.
(4) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to battery,
and wait at least 2 seconds.
(5)Turn ignition switch ACC or ON ON
(6)Clear malfunction code stored in memory
(see page RS–65)
(7)Turn ignition switch LOCK, and wait at least
20 seconds.
(1)Turn ignition switch ACC or ON and wait at
least 20 seconds
(2)Using SSt, connect terminals Tc and E1 of
DLC1 or DLC2.
SST 09843–18020
(3) Check diagnostic trouble code.
Diagnostic trouble code 54 is not output.
Codes other than code 54 may be output at this
time, but they are not relevant to this check.
Replace center airbag sensor assembly.
RS–138
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Check P squib.
Turn ignition switch LOCK.
(2) Disconnect battery negative 1–y terminal cable
and wait at least 90 seconds.
(3) Connect front passenger airbag assembly
connector.
(4) Connect negative 1–y terminal cable to battery,
and wait at least 2 seconds.
(5) Turn ignition switch ACC or ON and wait at
least 20 seconds.
(6) Clear malfunction code stored in memory
(See page RS–65).
(7) Turn ignition switch LOCK, and wait at least
20 seconds.
(1) Turn ignition switch ACC or ON, and wait at
least 20 seconds.
(2) Using SST, connect terminals Tc and E, of
DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
(3) Check diagnostic trouble code.
Diagnostic trouble code 54 is not output.
Codes other than code 54 may be output at this
time, but they are not relevant to this check.
Replace front passenger airbag assembly.
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal. To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
RS–139
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
– MEMO –
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
RS–140
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
SRS Warning Light System Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The SRS warning light is located on the combination meter.
When the supplemental restraint system is normal, the SRS warning light lights up for approx. 6
seconds after the ignition switch is turned from LOCK position to ACC or ON position, and then
turns off automatically. If there is a malfunction in the supplemental restraint system, the SRS warning light lights up to inform the driver of the abnormality.
When terminals Tc and El of the check connector are connected, the diagnostic trouble code is
displayed by the blinking of the SRS warning light.
RS–141
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Troubleshooting for this system is different for when the SRS warning light does not light up. Confirm
the problem symptoms first before selecting the appropriate troubleshooting procedure.
HINT: If SRS warning light does not light up, perform the following troubleshooting:
Check SRS fuse.
NG
Go to step
Preparation.
Check SRS warning light circuit.
Repair SRS warning light circuit
(See page BE–61).
Does SRS warning light come on?
Check terminal LA of center airbag
sensor assembly and electrical
connection check mechanism. If
normal, replace center airbag sensor assembly.
YES
From the results of the above inspection,
the malfunctioning part can now be con–
sidered normal. To make sure of this, use
the simulation method to check.
Is new SRS fuse burnt out again?
YES
Check harness between SRS fuse and SRS
warning light, and SRS fuse and center
airbag sensor assembly.
Using simulation method, repro–
duce malfunction symptomes (See
INTRODUCTION).
RS–142
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
RS–143
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Preparation
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT: If SRS warning light does not light up, perform the following troubleshooting:
Check
Check SRS fuse.
Go to step
Preparation.
Disconnect battery negative H terminal cable,
and wait at least 90 seconds.
(2) Remove steering wheel pad (See page
RS–20).
(3) Disconnect connectors of front passenger
airbag assembly. (See page RS–29).
Store the steering wheel pad with the front
surface facing upward.
RS–144
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Check SRS warning light circuit.
(1) Disconnect center airbag sensor assembly.
(2) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to battery.
(3) Turn ignition switch ACC or ON.
Measure voltage LA terminal of harness side con–
nector of center airbag sensor assembly.
Battery Voltage: 10 – 14 V
Repair SRS warning light circuit (See page
BE–61).
Does SRS warning light come on?
(1) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from
battery.
(2) Connect center airbag sensor assembly.
(3) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to battery.
(4) Turn ignition switch ACC or ON.
(1) Turn ignition switch OFF, and wait at least 6
seconds.
(2) Turn ignition switch ON.
YES
Check terminal LA of center airbag sensor assembly and electrical connection check mechanism.
If normal, replace center airbag sensor assembly.
Is now SRS fuse burnt out again?
YES
Using simulation method, reproduce malfunction symptoms (See INTRODUCTION).
Check harness between SRS fuse and SRS warning light, and SRS fuse and center airbag
sensor assembly.
RS–145
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
– MEMO –
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
RS–146
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
SRS Warning Light System
(Always Lit Up when ignition switch is LOCK position)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The SRS warning light is located on the combination meter.
When the supplemental restraint system is normal, the SRS warning light lights up for approx. 6
seconds after the ignition switch is turned from LOCK position to ACC or ON position, and then turns
off automatically.
If there is a malfunction in the supplemental restraint system, the SRS warning light lights up to inform the driver of the abnormality.
When terminals Tc and El of the DLC1 or DLC2 are connected, the diagnostic trouble code is displayed by the blinking of the SRS warning light.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
HINT: If the SRS warning light is always lit up by a DTC check procedure, perform Tc terminal circuit
check procedure (See page RS–148).
Does SRS warning light turn off?
YES
Replace center airbag sensor assembly.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Check SRS warning light circuit or
terminal AB circuit of DLC1 or
DLC2.
RS–147
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Preparation
Check
Does SRS warning light turn off?
Turn ignition switch LOCK.
(2) Disconnect negative H terminal cable from
battery and wait at least 90 seconds.
(3) Remove steering wheel pad (See page RS–
20).
(4) Disconnect connectors of front passenger
airbag assembly. (See page RS–29)
(5) Disconnect center airbag sensor assembly
connector.
(6) Connect negative H terminal cable to battery.
Check operation of SRS warning light.
Ignition Switch is LOCK position.
YES
Replace center airbag sensor assembly.
Check SRS warning light circuit or terminal
AB circuit DLC1 or DLC2.
RS–148
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Tc Terminal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
By connecting terminals Tc and El of the DLC1 or DLC2, the center airbag sensor assembly is set in
the diagnostic trouble code output mode. The diagnostic trouble codes are displayed by the blinking
of theSRS warning light.
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
Troubleshooting for this system is different depending on whether the diagnostic trouble code is not
displayed SRS warning light is always lit up with a DTC check procedure, or is displayed without a
DTC check procedure. Confirm the problem symptoms first before selecting the appropriate troubleshooting procedure.
HINT: If the diagnostic trouble code is not displayed or SRS warning light is always lit up with a
DTC check procedure perform the following troubleshooting:
Check voltage between terminals Tc and E,
of DLC1 or DLC2.
OK
G o to step
Check voltage between terminal Tc of DLC1
or DLC2 and body ground.
Check harness between terminal
E1 of DLC1 or DLC2 and body
ground.
Check center airbag sensor assembly.
Check harness between center
airbag sensor assembly and DLC1
or DLC2.
Replace center airbag sensor assembly.
HINT: If the diagnostic trouble code is continuously displayed without a DTC check procedure, per–
form the following troubleshooting:
Check resistance between terminal Tc of
center airbag sensor assembly and body
ground.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
Replace center airbag sensor as–
sembly.
RS–149
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC CHART
WIRING DIAGRAM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
RS–150
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Preparation
Check
HINT: If the diagnostic trouble code is not displayed, perform the following troubleshooting:
Check voltage between terminals Te and El of DLC1 or DLC2.
Turn ignition switch ACC or ON.
Measure voltage between terminals Tc and El of
DLC1 or DLC2.
Battery Voltage: 10 – 14 V
Go to step 3
Check voltage between terminal Te of DLC1 or DLC2 and body ground.
Measure voltage between terminal Tc of DLC1 or
DLC2 and body ground.
Battery Voltage: 10 – 14 V
Check harness between terminal El of DLC1
or DLC2 and body ground.
RS–151
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Check center airbag sensor assembly.
(1) Turn ignition switch LOCK.
(2) Disconnect battery negative (–) terminal cable,
and wait at least 90 seconds.
(3) Remove steering wheel pad (See page RS–
20).
(4) Disconnect connectors of front passenger
airbag assembly. (See page RS–29).
Check operation of SRS warning light.
SRS warning light comes on.
Check harness between center airbag sensor
assembly and DLC1 or DLC2.
Replace center airbag sensor assembly.
RS–152
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT: If the diagnostic trouble code is continuously displayed, perform the following troubleshooting.
Check resistance between terminal Tc of center airbag sensor assembly
and body ground.
Turn ignition switch LOCK.
(2) Disconnect center airbag sensor assembly
connector.
(3) Disconnect battery negative (–) terminal cable,
and wait at least 90 seconds.
(4) Remove steering wheel pad (See page RS–
20).
(5) Disconnect connectors of front passenger
airbag assembly. (See page RS–29).
Check resistance between terminal Tc of center
airbag sensor assembly and body ground.
Resistance: 1 M or higher
Replace center airbag sensor assembly.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
RS–153
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE DATA
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part tightened
Steering Wheel
Steering wheel pad
Front passenger airbag assembly
Seat belt shoulder anchor bolt
Front seat outer belt
Front airbag sensor
Center airbag sensor
to instrument panel
reinforcement
to instrument panel
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SA–1
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
SA–2
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
TROUBLESHOOTING
Wander/pulls
Bottoming
Sways/pitches
Front wheel shimmy
Abnormal tire wear
SA–63
SA–10
Ball joint
Hub bearings
SA–3
SA–52
Shock absorber
Wheel
balance
SA–66
Stabilizer bar
Overloaded
SA–52
Springs
Suspension parts
SA–4
SA–6
Wheel alignment
Trouble
Steering
gear
SA–96
Cold tire inflation
pressure
Parts
Name
Steering linkage
SA–3
See Page
Tires
Use the table below to help you find the cause of the problem. The numbers indicate the priority
of the likely cause of the problem. Check each part in order. If necessary, replace these parts.
SA–3
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
GENERAL INSPECTION
GENERAL INSPECTION
1. INSPECT TIRE
(a) Check the tires for wear and for the proper inflation
pressure.
Cold inflation pressure:
See page SA–96
(b) Check the tire runout.
Tire runout:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.) or less
2. INSPECT WHEEL BALANCE
(a) Check and adjust the Off–the–car balance.
(b) If necessary, check and adjust the On–the–car bal–
ance.
Unbalance after adjustment:
8.0 g (0.018 Ib) or less
3. CHECK WHEEL BEARING LOOSENESS
(a) Check the backlash in bearing shaft direction.
Maximum: 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
(b) Check the axle hub deviation.
Maximum: 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
4.
5.
6.
7.
CHECK FRONT SUSPENSION FOR LOOSENESS
CHECK STEERING LINKAGE FOR LOOSENESS
CHECK BALL JOINT FOR EXCESSIVE LOOSENESS
CHECK SHOCK ABSORBERS WORK PROPERLY
•
Check for oil leaks
•
Check mounting bushings for looseness
•
Bounce the vehicle up and down several times to
stabilize the suspension.
SA–4
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
WHEEL ALIGNMENT
WHEEL ALIGNMENT
FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
1. MEASURE VEHICLE HEIGHT
Front vehicle height:
SEDAN/COUPE:
Tire size
P195/70R14
Front
210 mm (8.27 in.)
P205/65 R15
213 mm (8.39 in.)
WAGON:
Tire size
P 195/70R 14
Front
210 mm (8.27 in.)
P205/65R15
214 mm (8.43 in.)
Measuring point:
Measure from the ground to the center of the front
side lower arm mounting bolt.
NOTICE: Before inspecting the wheel alignment, adjust
the vehicle height to specification.
If the vehicle height is not standard, try to adjust it by
pushing down on or lifting the body.
2. INSTALL CAMBER – CASTER – KINGPIN GAUGE
ONTO VEHICLE OR POSITION VEHICLE ON WHEEL
ALIGNMENT TESTER
Follow the specific instructions of the equipment
manufacturer.
3. INSPECT CAMBER, CASTER AND STEERING AXIS
INCLINATION
SEDAN/COUPE
Cambar
(Left –right error)
–035’ ± 45’
(45’ or less)
WAGON
–0 35’±45’
(45’ or less)
Caster
(Left–right error)
1 10’ ±45’
(45’ or less)
1 05’±45’
(45’ or less)
Steering axis
inclination
13 05’ ±45’
1300’±45’
HINT: Camber, caster and steering axis inclination are
not adjustable. If measurements are not within speci–
fication, inspect the suspension parts for damaged
and/or worn out parts and replace them as necessary.
SA–5
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
WHEEL ALIGNMENT
4. INSPECT TOE–IN
Toe–in (total):
A+B 0 ± 0.2
(C–D 0 ± 2 mm, 0 ± 0.08 in.)
If the toe–in is not within specification, adjust it at
the tie rod end.
5. ADJUST TOE–IN
(a) Remove the boot clamps.
(b) Loosen the tie rod end lock nuts.
(c) Turn the left and right tie rod ends an equal amount to
adjust the toe–in.
HINT: Ensure that the lengths of the left and right tie
rod end length are the same.
Tie rod end length difference:
1.5 mm (0.059 in.) or less
(d) Torque the tie rod end lock nuts.
Torque: 74 N⋅m (750 kgf⋅cm, 54 ft⋅lbf)
(e) Place the boot on the seat and install the clamp.
HINT: Make sure that the boots are not twisted.
7. INSPECT WHEEL ANGLE
Wheel angle:
SEDAN/COUPE:
Tire size
Inside wheel
Outside wheel
(reference)
P195/70R14
37 20’± 2
32 10’
P205/65R15
3600’ ± 2
31 15’
WAGON:
Tire size
Inside wheel
Outside wheel
(reference)
P195/70R14
3720’ ± 2
32 15’
P205/65R15
36 00’ ± 2
31 20’
If the wheel angles differ from specification, check the
left and right tie rod end length.
Tie rod end length difference:
1.5 mm (0.059 in.) or less
SA–6
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
WHEEL ALIGNMENT
REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT
7. MEASURE VEHICLE HEIGHT
Rear vehicle height:
SEDAN/COUPE:
Tire size
P 19 5/78 R 14
Rear
262 mm (10.31 in.)
P205/65R15
267 mm (10.51 in.)
WAGON:
Tire size
P195/70R14
Rear
272 mm (10.71 in.)
P205/65 R15
277 mm (10.91 in.)
Measuring point:
Measure from the ground to the center of the strut
rod mounting bolt.
NOTICE: Before inspecting the wheel alignment, adjust
the vehicle height to specification.
If the vehicle height is not standard, try to adjust it by
pushing down on or lifting the body.
2. INSTALL CAMBER – CASTER – KINGPIN GAUGE
ONTO VEHICLE OR POSITION VEHICLE ON WHEEL
ALIGNMENT TESTER
Follow the specific instructions of the equipment
manufacturer.
3. INSPECT CAMBER
Camber
(Left–right error)
SEDAN/COUPE
– 0 26’ ± 45’
(45’ or less)
WAGON
–0 15’ ± 45’
(45’ or less)
HINT: Camber is not adjustable, if measurement is not
within specification, inspect and replace the suspen–
sion parts as necessary.
4. INSPECT TOE–IN
Toe–in (total):
A+B 0.4 ± 0.2
(C – D 4 ± 2 mm, 0.16 ± 0.08 in.)
If the toe–in is not within the specification, adjust it
at the No.2 lower suspension arm.
SA–7
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
WHEEL ALIGNMENT
5. ADJUST TOE–IN
(a) Measure the length of the left and right No.2 lower
suspension arm.
Left–right difference:
1 mm (0.04 in.) or less
If the left–right difference is greater than the specifi–
cation, adjust the length.
(b) Loosen the lock nuts.
(c) Turn the left and right adjusting tubes an equal
amount to adjust toe–in.
HINT: One full turn of each adjusting tube will adjust
the toe–in by about O.6(6.7 mm, 0.264 in.).
(d) Torque the lock nuts.
Torque: 56 N⋅m (570 kgf⋅cm, 41 ft⋅lbf)
SA–8
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT AXLE
FRONT AXLE
DESCRIPTION
The wheel bearings are double–row angular ball bearings combined with the oil seal. They have
a small rolling resistance and are free from maintenance.
The preload of the bearings can be determined only by tightening the axle hub nut to a specified
torque, improving serviceability.
SA–9
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT AXLE
PREPARATION
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
09310–35010 Countershaft Bearing Replacer
Bearing removal
Axle shaft installation
09316–60010 Transmission & Transfer Bearing
Replacer
Dust deflector Installation
(09316–00010) Replacer Pipe
(09316–00040) Replacer “C“
09520–00031 Rear Axle Shaft Puller
09608–32010 Steering Knuckle Oil Seal
Replacer
Bearing installation
Axle hub installation
Dust deflector installation
09628–10011 Ball Joint Puller
Hub bolt removal
09628–62011 BaII ,Joint Puller
09950–00020 Bearing Remover
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09905–00013 Snap Ring Pliers
EQUIPMENT
Dial indicator
Torque wrench
SA–10
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT AXLE
FRONT AXLE HUB
COMPONENTS
SA–11
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT AXLE
STEERING KNUCKLE WITH AXLE HUB
REMOVAL
1. JACK UP VEHICLE, REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
2. CHECK BEARING BACKLASH AND AXLE HUB DE–
VIATION
(a) Remove the 2 brake caliper set bolts.
(b) Hang up the brake caliper using wire, etc.
(c) Remove the disc.
(d) Place the dial indicator near the center of the axle hub
and check the backlash in the bearing shaft direction.
Maximum:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If greater than the specified maximum, replace the
bearing.
(e) Using a dial indicator, check the deviation at the
surface of the axle hub outside the hub bolt.
Maximum:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If greater than the specified maximum, replace the
axle hub.
3. REMOVE DRIVE SHAFT LOCK NUT
(a) Install the disc and brake caliper.
(b) Remove the cotter pin and lock cap.
(c) While applying the brakes, remove the nut.
(d) Remove the brake caliper and disc.
4. w/ ABS:
REMOVE ABS SPEED SENSOR
Remove the ABS speed sensor from the steering knuckle.
5. LOOSEN NUTS ON LOWER SIDE OF SHOCK ABS–
ORBER
HINT: Do not remove the bolts.
SA–12
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT AXLE
6. DISCONNECT TIE ROD END FROM STEERING KNU–
CKLE
(a) Remove the cotter pin and remove the nut.
(b) Using SST, disconnect the tie rod end from the steer–
ing knuckle.
SST 09628–62011
7. DISCONNECT LOWER BALL JOINT FROM LOWER
ARM
Remove the bolt and the two nuts.
8. REMOVE STEERING KNUCKLE WITH AXLE HUB
(a) Remove the 2 nuts and bolts on lower side of the
shock absorber.
(b) Remove the steering knuckle with axle hub.
FRONT AXLE HUB DISASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE DUST DEFLECTOR
Using a screwdriver, remove the dust deflector.
SA–13
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT AXLE
2. REMOVE LOWER BALL JOINT
(a) Remove the cotter pin and nut.
(b) Using SST, remove the lower ball joint.
SST 09628–62011
3. REMOVE AXLE HUB
(a) Using SST, remove the axle hub.
SST 09520–00031
(b) Using SST and a press, remove the inner race (outside)
from the axle hub.
SST 09950–00020
4. REMOVE DUST COVER
Remove the 4 bolts and dust cover–.
5. REMOVE BEARING FROM STEERING KNUCKLE
(a) Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring.
SA–14
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT AXLE
(b) Place the inner race on the outside of the bearing.
(c) Using SST and a hammer, remove the bearing.
SST 09310–35010
FRONT AXLE HUB ASSEMBLY
1. INSTALL BEARING
(a) Using SST and a press, install a new bearing to the
steering knuckle.
SST 09608–32010
(b) Using snap ring pliers, install a new snap ring.
2. INSTALL DUST COVER
Place the dust cover and torque the 4 bolts.
Torque: 8.3 N⋅m (85 kgf⋅cm, 74 in.⋅Ibf)
3. INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB
Using SST and a press, install the axle hub.
SST 09310 – 35010, 09608 – 32010
SA–15
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT AXLE
4. INSTALL LOWER BALL JOINT
(a) Install the lower ball joint and torque the nut.
Torque: 123 N⋅m (1,250 kgf⋅cm. 90 ft⋅lbf)
(b) Install a new cotter pin.
5. INSTALL DUST DEFLECTOR
Using SST and a hammer, install a new dust deflector.
SST 09316–60010(09316–00010, 09316–00040)
09608–32010
HINT: Align the holes for the ABS speed sensor in the
dust deflector and steering knuckle.
STEERING KNUCKLE WITH AXLE HUB
INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL STEERING KNUCKLE
(a) Place the steering knuckle and temporarily install the
2 bolts and nut on lower side of shock absorber.
HINT: Coat the threads of nuts with engine oil.
(b) Connect the lower ball joint to the lower arm and
tighten the bolt and nuts.
Torque: 127 N⋅m (1,300 kgf⋅cm. 94 ft⋅lbf)
2. CONNECT TIE ROD END TO STEERING KNUCKLE
(a) Connect the tie rod end to the steering knuckle and
tighten the nut.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
(b) Install a new cotter pin.
SA–16
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT AXLE
3. TORQUE BOLTS ON LOWER SIDE OF SHOCK ABS–
ORBER
Torque: 211 N⋅m (2,150 kgf⋅cm, 156 ft⋅Ibf)
4. w/ ABS:
INSTALL ABS SPEED SENSOR
Torque: 7.8 N⋅m (80 kgf⋅cm, 69 in.⋅Ibf)
5. INSTALL FRONT BRAKE CALIPER
(a) Install the disc.
(b) Install the brake caliper.
Torque: 107 N⋅m (1,090 kgf⋅cm, 79 ft⋅lbf)
6. INSTALL DRIVE SHAFT LOCK NUT
(a) While applying the brakes, install the nut.
Torque: 294 N⋅m (3,000 kgf⋅cm, 217 ft⋅lbf)
(b) Install the lock cap and a new cotter pin.
7. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL AND LOWER VEHICLE
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
8. INSPECT FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
(SEE PAGE SA–4)
HUB BOLT REPLACEMENT
1. JACK UP VEHICLE AND REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
2. REMOVE FRONT BRAKE CALIPER AND DISC
3. REMOVE HUB BOLT
Using SST, remove the hub bolt.
SST 09628 –10011
SA–17
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT AXLE
4. INSTALL HUB BOLT
(a) Install washer and nut to the hub bolt as shown in the
illustration.
(b) Install the hub bolt with torquing the nut. Install the
hub bolt with torquing the nut.
5. INSTALL FRONT DISC AND BRAKE CALIPER
Torque: 107 N⋅m (1,090 kgf⋅cm, 79 ft⋅Ibf)
6. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL AND LOWER VEHICLE
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅Ibf)
SA–18
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT(1mz–fe)
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
(1 MZ–FE)
DESCRIPTION
The drive shaft has a cross–groove type CVJ (Constant Velocity Joint) on the differential side
and Rzeppa type CVJ on the wheel side.
SA–19
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT(1MZ–FE)
PREPARATION
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
09608–1 6041 Front Hub Bearing Adjusting Tool
(09608–02020) Bolt & Nut
(09608–02040) Retainer
09628–62011 Ball ,Joint Puller
Tie rod end
09726–10010 Lower Suspension Arm Bushing
Remover & Replacer
(09726–00030) Spacer
Drive shaft inboard joint
09923–00020 Hexagon 8 mm Wrench
09950–00020 Bearing Remover
Center drive shaft dust
cover
09521–24010 Drive Shaft Boot Clamping
Tool
09240–00020 Wire Gauge Set
09242–00190 Wire Gauge
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09905–00012 Snap Ring No. 1 Expander
Corrected 6/07/01 – MH
For removing and installing snap
ring
SA–20
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT(1MZ–FE)
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
LUBRICANT
Drive shaft
Toyota type
Item
Outboard joint grease
Inboard joint grease
Capacity
120–130 g (4.2–4.6 oz.)
133–153 g (4.7–5.4 oz.)
SSM (SPECIAL SERVICE MATERIALS)
08826–00801 Seal Packing 1121,
THREE BOND 1121 or equivalent
Drive shaft inboard joint cover
SA–21
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT(1MZ–FE)
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
COMPONENTS
SA–22
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT(1MZ–FE)
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT REMOVAL
NOTICE: The hub bearing could be damaged if it is sub–
jected to the vehicle weight, such as when moving the
vehicle with the drive shaft removed.
Therefore, if it is absolutely necessary to place the vehi–
cle weight on the hub bearing, first support it with SST.
SST 09608–16041(09608–02020, 09608–02040)
1. REMOVE FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL
2. REMOVE COTTER PIN, LOCK NUT CAP AND LOCK
NUT
(a) Remove the cotter pin and lock nut cap.
(b) Loosen the bearing lock nut while depressing the
brake pedal.
3. DRAIN TRANSAXLE OIL
4. DISCONNECT TIE ROD END FROM STEERING KNU–
CKLE
(a) Remove the cotter pin and nut from the tie rod end.
(b) Using SST, disconnect the tie rod end from the steer–
ing knuckle.
SST 09628–62011
5. DISCONNECT STABILIZER BAR LINK FROM
LOWER ARM
Remove the nut and disconnect the stabilizer bar link
from lower arm.
SA–23
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT(1MZ–FE)
6. DISCONNECT STEERING KNUCKLE FROM LOWER
BALL JOINT
(a) Remove the bolt and the 2 nuts.
(b) Disconnect the steering knuckle from the lower ball
joint.
7. LOOSEN 6 BOLTS HOLDING DRIVE SHAFT TO DIF–
FERENTIAL SIDE GEAR SHAFT OR CENTER DRIVE
SHAFT
(a) Place matchmarks on the drive shaft and side gear
shaft or center drive shaft.
NOTICE: Do not use a punch to mark the matchmarks.
Use paint, etc.
(b) Using SST, loosen the 6 hexagon bolts while depress–
ing the brake pedal.
SST 09923 – 00020
HINT: Do not remove the bolts, leave them finger tight
to avoid drop ping the drive shaft.
8. DISCONNECT DRIVE SHAFT FROM AXLE HUB
(a) Using a plastic hammer, discontinued the drive shaft
from the axle hub.
NOTICE: Cover the drive shaft boot with cloth to protect
it from damage.
(b) Push the front axle hub toward the outside of the
vehicle, and separate the drive shaft from the axle
hub.
9. REMOVE LH DRIVE SHAFT
(a) Using hub nut wrench and hammer handle or equiva–
lent, pull out the drive shaft as shown.
SA–24
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT(1MZ–FE)
(b) Using a screwdriver, remove the snap ring.
10. REMOVE RH DRIVE SHAFT
(a) Remove the bearing lock bolt.
(b) Using pliers, remove the snap ring, and pull out the
drive shaft.
SA–25
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT(1MZ–FE)
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL LH DRIVE SHAFT
(a) Using pliers, install a new snap ring.
(b) Coat gear oil to the side gear shaft and differential
case sliding surface.
(c) Using a brass bar and hammer, tap in the drive shaft
until it makes contact with the pinion shaft.
HINT:
•
Before installing the drive shaft, set the snap ring
opening side facing downward.
•
Whether or not the side gear shaft is making
contact with the pinion shaft can be known by
the sound or feeling when driving it in.
2. CHECK INSTALLATION OF LH DRIVE SHAFT
(a) Check that there is 2–3 mm (0.08–0.12 in.) of play in
the axial direction.
(b) Check that the drive shaft can not be removed by
hand.
3. INSTALL RH DRIVE SHAFT
(a) Coat gear oil to the inboard joint and differential
sliding surface.
(b) Install the drive shaft to the transaxle through the
bearing bracket.
NOTICE: Do not damage the oil seal lip.
(c) Using pliers, install a new snap ring.
(d) Install a new bearing lock bolt and tighten it.
Torque: 32 N⋅m (330 kgf⋅cm, 24 ft⋅lbf)
SA–26
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT(1MZ–FE)
4. CONNECT DRIVE SHAFT TO AXLE HUB
Install the outboard joint side of the drive shaft to the
axle hub.
NOTICE: Do not damage the boot.
5. CONNECT STEERING KNUCKLE TO LOWER ARM
Torque: 127 N⋅m (1,300 kgf⋅cm, 94 ft⋅lbf)
6. TIGHTEN6 HEXAGON BOLTS
Using SST, tighten the6 hexagon bolts while depress–
ing the brake pedal.
SST 09043–88010
Torque: 65 N⋅m (660 kgf⋅cm, 48 ft⋅lbf)
7. CONNECT STABILIZER BAR LINK TO LOWER ARM
Torque: 39 N⋅m (400 kgf⋅cm, 29 ft⋅lbf)
8. CONNECT TIE ROD END TO STEERING KNUCKLE
(a) Connect the tie rod end to the steering knuckle and
torque the nut.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
(b) Install a new cotter pin.
HINT: If the cotter pin hole does not line up, correct by
tightening the nut by the smallest amount possible.
SA–27
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT(1MZ–FE)
9. INSTALL BEARING LOCK NUT, LOCK NUT CAP
AND NEW COTTER PIN
(a) Install and torque the bearing look nut
Torque: 294 N⋅m (3,000 kgf⋅cm, 217 ft⋅lbf)
(b) Install the lock nut cap and secure it with a new cotter
pin.
10. FILL TRANSAXLE WITH GEAR OIL
11. INSTALL FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL
12. CHECK FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT DISASSEMBLY
1. CHECK DRIVE SHAFT
(a) Check to see that there is no play in the inboard and
outboard joints.
(b) Check to see that the inboard joint slides smoothly in
the thrust direction.
(c) Check to see that there is no significant play in the
radial direction of the inboard joint.
(d) Check the boot for damage.
2. DISCONNECT CENTER DRIVE SHAFT OR SIDE
GEAR SHAFT
(a) Using SST, remove the 6 bolts and 3 washers, and
disconnect the center drive shaft or side gear shaft
from the drive shaft.
SST 09923–00020
NOTICE: Do not compress the inboard boot.
(b) Remove the joint end cover gasket from the drive
shaft.
(c) Use bolts, nuts and washers to keep the inboard joint
together.
NOTICE: Tighten the bolts by hand to avoid scratching
the flange surface.
SA–28
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT(1MZ–FE)
3. TOYOTA TYPE:
REMOVE INBOARD AND OUTBOARD JOINT BOOT
CLAMPS
Using a screwdriver, remove the inboard and outboard
joint clamps.
GKN TYPE:
REMOVE INBOARD AND OUTBOARD JOINT BOOT
CLAMPS
(a) Using a boot clamp tool, draw hooks together and
remove the clamps.
(b) Using side cutters, cut the small boot clamps and
remove them.
4. DISASSEMBLE INBOARD JOINT
(a) Place matchmarks on the inboard joint and drive
shaft.
(b) Using a snap ring expander remove the snap ring.
SA–29
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT(1MZ–FE)
(c) Using SST, a socket wrench and a press, remove the
inboard joint from the drive shaft.
SST 09726–10010(09726–00030)
(d) Remove the bolts, nuts and washers.
(e) Using a screwdriver and a hammer, pry around the
whole perimeter of the inboard joint cover.
(f) Using a screwdriver, remove the inboard joint from
inboard joint cover.
NOTICE: When lifting the inboard joint, hold onto the
inner race and outer race.
5. REMOVE BOOTS
Remove the inboard joint boot and outboard joint
boot.
6. LH DRIVE SHAFT:
DISASSEMBLE SIDE GEAR SHAFT
Using a screwdriver, remove the dust cover.
7. RH DRIVE SHAFT:
DISASSEMBLE CENTER DRIVE SHAFT
(a) Using a press, press out the transaxle side dust cover.
SA–30
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT(1MZ–FE)
(b) Using SST and a press, press out the drive shaft side
dust cover.
SST 09950–00020
(c) Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring.
(d) Using a press, press out the bearing.
(e) Remove the snap ring.
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY
1. RH DRIVE SHAFT:
ASSEMBLE CENTER DRIVE SHAFT
(a) Install a new snap ring to the center drive shaft.
(b) Using a press and extension bar, press in a new
bearing.
(c) Using a snap ring expander, install a new snap ring.
SA–31
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT(1MZ–FE)
(d) Using a press, press in a new drive shaft side dust
cover.
HINT: The clearance between the dust cover and the
bearing should be kept in the range shown in the
illustration.
(e) Using a press, press in a new transaxle side dust
cover.
2. LH DRIVE SHAFT:
ASSEMBLE SIDE GEAR SHAFT
Using a press, press in a new dust cover.
3. INSTALL NEW OUTBOARD JOINT BOOT AND NEW
BOOT CLAMP
HINT:
•
Before installing the boot, wrap vinyl tape around
the spline of the shaft to prevent damaging the
boot.
•
Temporarily install the new boot and new clamps
to the outboard joint.
4. ASSEMBLE BOOT TO OUTBOARD JOINT
Before assembling the boot, pack in grease.
HINT: Use the grease supplied in the boot kit.
Grease capacity:
135–155 g (4.8–5.5 oz.)
5. INSTALL NEW BOOT CLAMPS AND INBOARD
JOINT BOOT
Temporarily install the 2 new boot clamps and inboard
joint boot.
SA–32
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT(1MZ–FE)
6. ASSEMBLE NEW INBOARD JOINT COVER
(a) Clean contacting surfaces of any residual packing
material using cleaner.
(b) Apply seal packing to the inboard joint cover as
shown in the illustration.
Seal packing:
Part No. 08826–00801. THREE BOND 1122 or equi–
valent
HINT: Avoid applying an excess amount to the sur–
face.
(c) Align the bolt holes of the cover with those of the
inboard joint, then insert the hexagon bolts.
(d) Use a plastic hammer to tap the rim of the inboard
joint cover into place. Do this in the order shown, and
repeat several times.
(e) Use bolts, nuts and washers to keep the inboard joint
together.
NOTICE: Tighten the bolts by hand to avoid scratching
the flange surface.
7. ASSEMBLE INBOARD JOINT
(a) Align the matchmarks placed before disassembly.
(b) Using a brass bar and hammer, tap the inboard joint
onto the drive shaft.
NOTICE: Check that the brass bar is touching the inner
race, and not the cage.
(c) Using a snap ring expander, install a new snap ring.
NOTICE: Work carefully so that the outer race does not
come off.
SA–33
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT(1MZ–FE)
8. ASSEMBLE INBOARD JOINT BOOT TO INBOARD
JOINT
Pack in grease to the inboard tulip and boot.
HINT: Use the grease supplied in the boot kit.
Grease capacity:
140–150 g (4.9–5.3 oz.)
9. ASSEMBLE BOOT CLAMPS TO BOTH BOOTS
(a) Be sure the boots are in the shaft groove.
(b) Ensure that the boots are not stretched or contracted
when the drive shaft is at standard length.
Drive shaft standard length:
452.352.0 mm (17.8090 0.079 in.)
(c) Holding the clamp near the closing hooks, using pliers,
position the holers in the clamp’s free end over the closing hooks.
(d) Secure clamp by drawing the closing hooks together.
(e) Check that the clamp at closed position is the same as
that shown in the illustration.
(f) Secure the clamp onto the boot.
(g) Place SST onto the clamp
SST 09521 – 24010
SA–34
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT(1MZ–FE)
(h) Tighten SST so that the clamp is pinched.
HINT: Pinch the inboard side of the boot clamp, as shown in
the illustration.
NOTICE: Do not overtighten the SST.
(i) Using SST, adjust the clearance of the clamp.
SST 09240 – 00020
Clearance:
1.9 mm(0.0075 in.) or less
10. PACK IN GREASE TO CENTER DRIVE SHAFT OR
SIDE GEAR SHAFT
Pack grease into the center drive shaft or side gear
shaft.
Grease capacity:
50–60 g (1.8–2.1 oz.)
HINT: Use the grease supplied in the boot kit.
11. CONNECT DRIVE SHAFT AND CENTER DRIVE
SHAFT OR SIDE GEAR SHAFT
(a) Remove the bolts, nuts and washers.
(b) Align the matchmarks on the drive shaft and center
drive shaft or side gear shaft.
(c) Place a new gasket on the inboard joint.
(d) Install the center drive shaft or side gear shaft to the
drive shaft.
NOTICE: When moving the drive shaft, do not compress
the inboard boot.
(e) Install the 3 washers and 6 hexagon bolts, and using
SST, temporarily tighten them.
SST 09923–00020
12. CHECK DRIVE SHAFT
(a) Check to see that there is no play in the inboard joint
and outboard joint.
(b) Check to see that inboard joint slides smoothly in the
thrust direction.
SA–35
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT(5s–fe)
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
(5S–FE)
DESCRIPTION
The drive has a tripod type CVJ (Constant Velocity Joint) on the differential side and Rzeppa type
CVJ on the wheel side.
SA–36
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT(5S–FE)
PREPARATION
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
0950fi–35010 Differential Drive Pinion Rear
Bearing Replacer
09608–1fi041 Front Hub Bearing Adjusting Tool
(09608–02020) Bolt & Nut
(09608–02040) Retainer
09628–62011 Ball ,Joint Puller
09950–00020 Bearing Remover
Tie rod end
Center drive shaft dust cover
09521–24010 Drive Shaft Boot Clamping Tool
09240–00020 Wire Gauge Set
(09242–00190) Wire Gauge
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09905–00012 Snap Ring No. 1 Expander
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
For removing and installing snap
ring
SA–37
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT(5S–FE)
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
COMPONENTS
SA–38
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT(5S–FE)
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT REMOVAL
NOTICE: The hub bearing could be damaged if it is sub–
jected to the vehicle weight, such as when moving the
vehicle with the drive shaft removed. Therefore, if it is
bearing first support it with SST.
SST 09608–16041(09608–02020,09608–02040)
1. REMOVE FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL
2. REMOVE COTTER PIN, LOCK NUT CAP AND LOCK
NUT
(a) Remove the cotter pin and lock nut cap.
(b) Loosen the bearing lock nut while depressing the
brake pedal.
3. DRAIN TRANSAXLE OIL
4. DISCONNECT TIE ROD END FROM STEERING KNU–
CKLE
(a) Remove the cotter pin and nut from the steering
knuckle.
(b) Using SST, disconnect the tie rod end from the steer–
ing knuckle.
SST 09628–62011
5. DISCONNECT STABILIZER BAR LINK FROM
LOWER ARM
Remove the nut and disconnect the stabilizer bar link
from lower arm.
SA–39
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT(5S–FE)
6. DISCONNECT STEERING KNUCKLE FROM LOWER
BALL JOINT
(a) Remove the bolt and the 2 nuts.
(b) Disconnect the steering knuckle from lower ball joint.
7. DISCONNECT DRIVE SHAFT FORM AXLE HUB
Using a plastic hammer, disconnect the drive shaft
from the axle hub.
NOTICE: Cover the drive shaft boot with cloth to protect
it from damage.
8. REMOVE LH DRIVE SHAFT
(a) Using hub nut wrench and hammer handle or an
equivalent, pull out the drive shaft as shown.
(b) Using a screwdriver, remove the snap ring.
9. REMOVE RH DRIVE SHAFT
(a) Remove the bearing lock bolt.
SA–40
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT(5S–FE)
(b) Using pliers, remove the snap ring, and pull out the
drive shaft.
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL LH DRIVE SHAFT
(a) Using a snap ring expander, install a new snap ring.
(b) Coat gear oil to the inboard joint tulip and differential
case sliding surface.
(c) Using a brass bar and hammer, tap in the drive shaft
until it makes contact with the pinion shaft.
HINT:
•
Before installing the drive shaft, set the snap ring
opening side facing downward.
•
Whether or not the drive shaft is making contact
with the pinion shaft can be known by the sound
or feeling when driving it in.
2. CHECK INSTALLATION OF LH DRIVE SHAFT
(a) Check that there is 2–3 mm (0.08–0.12 in.) of play in
the axial direction.
(b) Check that the drive shaft can not be removed by
hand.
3. INSTALL RH DRIVE SHAFT
(a) Coat gear oil to the inboard joint and differential
sliding surface.
(b) Install the drive shaft to the transaxle through the
bearing bracket.
NOTICE: Do not damage the oil seal lip.
(c) Using pliers, install a new snap ring.
SA–41
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT(5S–FE)
(d) Install a new bearing lock bolt and tighten it.
Torque: 32 N⋅m (330 kgf⋅cm, 24 ft⋅lbf)
4. CONNECT DRIVE SHAFT TO AXLE HUB
Install the outboard joint side of the drive shaft to the
axle hub.
NOTICE: Do not damage the boot.
5. CONNECT STEERING KNUCKLE TO LOWER ARM
Torque: 127 N⋅m (1,300 kgf⋅cm, 94 ft⋅lbf)
6. CONNECT STABILIZER BAR LINK TO LOWER ARM
Torque: 39 N⋅m (400 kgf⋅cm, 29 ft⋅lbf)
7. CONNECT TIE ROD END TO STEERING KNUCKLE
(a) Connect the tie rod end to the steering knuckle and
torque the nut.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
(b) Install a new cotter pin.
HINT: (f the cotter pin hole does not line up, correct by
tightening the nut by the smallest amount possible.
SA–42
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT(5S–FE)
8. INSTALL BEARING LOCK NUT, LOCK NUT CAP
AND NEW COTTER PIN
(a) Install and torque the bearing lock nut.
Torque: 284 N⋅m (3,000 kgf⋅cm, 217 ft⋅lbf)
(b) Install the lock nut cap and secure it with a new cotter
pin.
9. FILL TRANSAXLE WITH FLUID
10. INSTALL FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL
11. CHECK FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT DISASSEMBLY
1. CHECK DRIVE SHAFT
(a) Check to see that there is no play in the outboard
joint.
(b) Check to see that the inboard joint slides smoothly in
the thrust direction.
(c) Check to see that there is not significant play in the
radial direction of the inboard joint.
(d) Check for damage to boots.
2. TOYOTA TYPE:
REMOVE INBOARD AND OUTBOARD JOINT BOOT
CLAMPS
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the 4 boot clamps.
(b) Slide the inboard joint boot toward the outboard joint.
GKN TYPE:
REMOVE INBOARD AND OUTBOARD JOINT BOOT
CLAMPS
(a) Using a boot clamp tool, draw hooks together and
remove the 2 large clamps.
SA–43
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT(5S–FE)
(b) Using side cutters, cut small boot clamp and remove
them.
(c) Slide the inboard joint toward the outboard joint.
3. DISASSEMBLE INBOARD JOINT TULIP
(a) Place matchmarks on the tripod and inboard joint tulip
or center drive shaft.
NOTICE: Do not punch the marks.
(b) Remove the inboard joint tulip or center drive shaft
from the drive shaft.
4. REMOVE TRIPOD JOINT
(a) Using a snap ring expander remove the snap ring.
(b) Using a snap ring expander, temporarily, slide the
snap ring toward the outboard joint side.
(c) Place matchmarks on the drive shaft and tripod.
(d) Using a brass bar and a hammer, remove the tripod
joint from the drive shaft.
SA–44
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT(5S–FE)
(e) Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring.
5. REMOVE INBOARD AND OUTBOARD JOINT BOOTS
Slide out the two boots.
NOTICE: Do not disassemble the outboard joint.
6. REMOVE DUST COVER
LH Drive Shaft:
Using SST and a press, press out the dust cover from
the inboard joint tulip.
SST 09950–00020
RH Drive Shaft:
Using a press, press out the dust cover from the
center drive shaft.
7. RH DRIVE SHAFT:
DISASSEMBLE CENTER DRIVE SHAFT
(a) Using SST and a press, press out the dust cover.
SST 09950–00020
(b) Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring.
SA–45
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT(5S–FE)
(c) Using a press, press out the bearing.
(d) Remove the snap ring.
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY
1. RH DRIVE SHAFT:
ASSEMBLE CENTER DRIVE SHAFT
(a) Install a new snap ring to the center drive shaft.
(b) Using a steel plate and press, press in the bearing.
(c) Using a snap ring expander, install a new snap ring.
(d) Using SST, an extension bar and press, press in a new
dust cover.
SST 09506 – 35010
HINT: The clearance between the dust cover and the
bearing should be kept in the range shown in the
illustration.
2. INSTALL DUST COVER
LH Drive Shaft:
Using a press, install a new dust cover.
SA–46
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT(5S–FE)
RH Drive Shaft:
Using a steel plate and press, press in a new dust
cover until the distance from the tip of the center
drive shaft to the dust cover falls within the specifica–
tion as shown in the illustration.
3. TEMPORARILY INSTALL OUTBOARD JOINT BOOT
AND NEW BOOT CLAMPS
Temporarily install the boot and 2 new boot clamps
for the outboard joint to the drive shaft.
HINT: Before installing the boot, wrap vinyl tape
around the spline of the drive shaft to prevent damag–
ing the boot.
4. TEMPORARILY INSTALL INBOARD JOINT BOOT
AND NEW BOOT CLAMPS
Temporarily install the boot and 2 new boot clamps
for the inboard joint to the drive shaft.
5. INSTALL TRIPOD JOINT
(a) Using a snap ring expander, install a new snap ring.
(b) Place the beveled side of the tripod joint axial spline
toward the outboard joint.
(c) Align the matchmarks placed before removal.
SA–47
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT(5S–FE)
(d) Using a brass bar and hammer, tap in the tripod joint
to the drive shaft.
NOTICE: Do not tap the roller.
(e) Using a snap ring expander, install a new snap ring.
6. INSTALL BOOT TO OUTBOARD JOINT
Before assembling the boot, fill grease into the out–
board joint and boot.
HINT: Use the grease supplied in the boot kit.
Grease capacity:
TOYOTA Type:
120–130 g (4.2–4.6 oz.)
GKN Type:
140–160 9 (4.9–5.6 oz.)
Grease color:
Black
7. INSTALL INBOARD JOINT TULIP TO FRONT DRIVE
SHAFT
(a) Pack in the grease to the boot and inboard joint tulip.
HINT:– Use the grease supplied in the boot kit.
Grease capacity:
TOYOTA Type:
232–242 g (8.2–8.5 oz.)
GKN Type:
185–215 g (6.5–7.6 oz.)
Grease color:
Yellow ocher
SA–48
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT(5S–FE)
(b) Align the matchmarks placed before removal, and
install the inboard joint tulip to the drive shaft.
(c) Install the boot to the inboard joint tulip.
S. TOYOTA TYPE:
ASSEMBLE BOOT CLAMPS TO BOTH BOOTS
(a) Be sure the boot is in the shaft groove.
(b) Ensure that the boot is not stretched or contracted
when the drive shaft is at standard length.
Drive shaft standard length:
LH 608.1 ±5.0 mm (23.941±0.197 in.)
RH 866.2±5.0 mm (34.102±0.197 in.)
(c) Using a screwdriver, bend the band and lock it as
shown in the illustration.
GKN TYPE:
ASSEMBLE BOOT CLAMPS TO BOTH BOOT
(a) Be sure the boots are in the shaft groove.
(b) Ensure that the boot is not stretched or contracted
when the drive shaft is at standard length.
Drive shaft standard length:
LH609Z±2.0 mm (23.984±0.079 in.)
RH 880.8±2.0 mm (34.677±0.079 in.)
(c) Using a boot clamp tool, place pincer jaws in closing
hooks of large clamps.
(d) Secure clamp by drawing closing hooks together.
SA–49
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT(5S–FE)
(e) Check that the clamp at closed position is the same as
in the illustration.
(f) Secure the clamp onto the boot.
(g) Place SST onto the clamp.
SST 09521 – 24010
(h) Tighten SST so that the clamp is pinched.
HINT: Pinch the inboard side of the boot clamp, as shown in
the illustration.
NOTICE: Do not overtighten the SST.
(i) Using SST, adjust the clearance of the clamp.
SST 09240 – 00020
Clearance:
1.9 mm (0.075 in.) or less
Corrected 12/27/93
SA–50
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT SUSPENSION
FRONT SUSPENSION
DESCRIPTION
The front suspension is MacPherson strut type suspension with L–shape lower arm.
SA–51
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT SUSPENSION
PREPARATION
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
09316–60010 Transmission & Transfer Bearing
Replacer
Dust deflector installation
(09316–00010) Replacer Pipe
(09316–00040) Replacer ’C’
09608–32010 Steering Knuckle Oil Seal
Replacer
09628–62011 Ball Joint Puller
09727–00045 Arm Set “B”
09727–30020 Coil Spring Compressor
09729–22031 Front Spring Upper Seat Holder
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09025–00010 Small Torque Wrench
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
Dust deflector installation
SA–52
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT SUSPENSION
FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER
COMPONENTS
SA–53
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT SUSPENSION
FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER REMOVAL
1. JACK UP VEHICLE AND REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
2. REMOVE BRAKE HOSE AND ABS SPEED SENSOR
WIRE (W/ ABS) FROM SHOCK ABSORBER
3. DISCONNECT SHOCK ABSORBER FROM STEERING
KNUCKLE
Remove the 2 nuts and bolts and disconnect the
shock absorber from the steering knuckle.
4. REMOVE SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
(a) Remove the 3 nuts on upper side of the shock ab–
sorber.
(b) Remove the shock absorber with coil spring.
5. REMOVE COIL SPRING
(a) Using SST, compress the coil spring.
SST 09727–00045,09727–30020
NOTICE: When holding the shock absorber with the coil
spring removed, do not hold it by the spring lower seat.
Also, do not knock the spring lower seat.
(b) Install a bolt and 2 nuts to the bracket at the lower
portion of the shock absorber and secure it in a vise.
SA–54
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT SUSPENSION
(c) Using SST to hold the upper support remove the nut.
SST 09729–22031
(d) Remove the following parts.
•
Suspension upper support
•
Upper insulator
•
Coil spring
•
Spring bumper
•
Lower insulator
NOTICE: Do not disassemble the spring lower seat.
FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER INSPECTION
1. INSPECT SHOCK ABSORBER
Compress and extend the shock absorber rod and
check that there is no abnormal resistance or unusual
operation sounds.
If there is any abnormality, replace the shock absorber
with a new one.
NOTICE: When discarding the shock absorber, use the
following procedure.
FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER DISPOSAL
1. FULLY EXTEND SHOCK ABSORBER ROD
2. DRILL HOLE TO REMOVE GAS FROM CYLINDER
Using a drill, make a hole in the cylinder as shown to
remove the gas inside.
CAUTION: The gas coming out is harmless, but be careful
of chips which may fly up when drilling.
SA–55
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT SUSPENSION
FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER INSTALLATION
7. INSTALL LOWER INSULATOR ONTO SHOCK ABS–
ORBER
2. INSTALL SPRING BUMPER TO PISTON ROD
3. INSTALL COIL SPRING
(a) Using SST, compress the coil spring.
SST 09727–00045,09727–30020
(b) Install the coil spring to the shock absorber.
HINT: Fit the lower end of the coil spring into the gap
of the lower seat.
4. INSTALL UPPER INSULATOR AND UPPER SUP–
PORT
(a) Install the upper insulator to the upper support.
SA–56
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT SUSPENSION
(b) Install the upper support to the piston rod.
(c) Using SST to hold the upper support, install a new nut.
SST 09729–20031
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
(d) Rotate the upper support so that the lowest bolt on
the upper support is aligned with the projection part
of the spring lower seat shown in the illustration.
(e) Remove the SST.
HINT: After removing SST, again check the direction
of the upper support.
5. INSTALL SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
Place the shock absorber and install the 3 nuts.
Torque: 80 N⋅m (820 kgf⋅cm, 59 ft⋅lbf)
6. CONNECT SHOCK ABSORBER TO STEERING KNU–
CKLE
(a) Coat the threads of the nuts with engine oil.
(b) Install the 2 bolts and nuts.
Torque: 211 N⋅m (2,150 kgf⋅cm, 156 ft⋅lbf)
SA–57
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT SUSPENSION
7. INSTALL BRAKE HOSE AND ABS SPEED SENSOR
WIRE (W/ ABS) TO SHOCK ABSORBER
Brake hose
Torque: 29 N⋅m (300 kgf⋅cm, 22 ft⋅lbf)
ABS wire
Torque: 5.4 N⋅m (55 kgf⋅cm, 48 in.⋅lbf)
8. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL AND LOWER VEHICLE
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
9. INSPECT FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
(See page SA–4)
SA–58
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT SUSPENSION
LOWER SUSPENSION ARM
COMPONENTS
SA–59
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT SUSPENSION
LOWER ARM REMOVAL
1. JACK UP VEHICLE AND REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
2. REMOVE FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL
3. REMOVE DRIVE SHAFT LOCK NUT
(a) Remove the cotter pin and lock cap.
(b) While applying the brakes, remove the nut.
4. DISCONNECT TIE ROD END FROM STEERING KNU–
CKLE
(a) Remove the cotter pin and remove the nut.
(b) Using SST, disconnect the tie rod end from the steer–
ing knuckle.
SST 09628–62011
5. REMOVE LEFT AND RIGHT STABILIZER END BRA–
CKETS FROM LOWER ARMS
6. DISCONNECT LOWER ARM FROM LOWER BALL
JOINT
Remove the bolt and 2 nuts.
SA–60
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT SUSPENSION
7. REMOVE DRIVE SHAFT PROM AXLE HUB
(a) Remove the drive shaft from the axle hub.
(b) Hang up the drive shaft using wire, etc.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the drive shaft boot
and ABS sensor rotor.
8. REMOVE LOWER ARM
(a) Remove the 2 bolts on front side of the lower arm.
(b) Remove the bolt and nut on rear side of the lower arm.
(c) Remove the lower arm.
(d) Remove the lower arm bushing stopper from the
lower arm shaft.
LOWER ARM INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL LOWER ARM
(a) Place the lower arm and temporarily install the rear
side bolt and nut
SA–61
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT SUSPENSION
(b) Install the lower arm bushing stopper to the lower arm
shaft.
(c) Install the 2 bolts on the front side of the lower arm.
Torque: 206 N⋅m (2,100 kgf⋅cm, 152 ft⋅lbf)
(d) Tighten the bolt on rear side of the lower arm.
Torque: 206 N⋅m (2,100 kgf⋅cm, 152 ft⋅lbf)
2. INSTALL DRIVE SHAFT TO AXLE HUB
3. CONNECT LOWER ARM TO LOWER BALL JOINT
Install the bolt and 2 nuts.
Torque: 127 N⋅m (1,300 kgf⋅cm, 94 ft⋅lbf)
4. INSTALL LEFT AND RIGHT STABILIZER END BRA–
CKETS TO LOWER ARMS
Torque: 56 N⋅m (570 kgf⋅cm, 41 ft⋅lbf)
SA–62
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT SUSPENSION
5. CONNECT TIE ROD END TO STEERING KNUCKLE
(a) Connect the tie rod end to the steering knuckle and
tighten the nut.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm. 36 ft⋅lbf)
(b) Install a new cotter pin.
6. INSTALL DRIVE SHAFT LOCK NUT
(a) While applying the brakes, install the nut.
Torque: 294 N⋅m (3,000 kgf⋅cm, 217 ft⋅lbf)
(b) Install the lock cap and a new cotter pin.
7. INSTALL FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL
8. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL AND LOWER VEHICLE
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅Ibf)
9. INSPECT FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
(See page SA–4)
SA–63
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT SUSPENSION
LOWER BALL JOINT
COMPONENTS
SA–64
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT SUSPENSION
LOWER BALL JOINT REMOVAL
1. REMOVE STEERING KNUCKLE WITH AXLE HUB
(See page SA–11)
2. REMOVE LOWER BALL JOINT
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the dust deflector.
(b) Remove the cotter pin and nut.
(c) Using SST, remove the lower ball joint.
SST 09628–62011
LOWER BALL JOINT INSPECTION
1. INSPECT BALL JOINT FOR ROTATION CONDITION
(a) As shown, flip the ball joint stud back and forth 5
times before installing the nut.
(b) Using a torque gauge, turn the nut continuously one
turn per 2–4 seconds and take the torque reading on
the 5th turn.
Turning torque:
1.0–2.9 N⋅m (10–30 kgf⋅cm, 8.7–26 in.⋅lbf)
LOWER BALL JOINT INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL LOWER BALL JOINT
(a) Install the lower ball joint and tighten the nut.
Torque: 123 N⋅m (1,250 kgf⋅cm, 90 ft⋅lbf)
(b) Install a new cotter pin.
SA–65
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT SUSPENSION
2. INSTALL DUST DEFLECTOR
Using SST and a hammer, install a new dust deflector.
SST 09316–60010 (09316–00010, 09316–00040)
09608–32010
HINT: Align the hoses for the ABS speed sensor in the
dust deflector and steering knuckle.
3. INSTALL STEERING KNUCKLE WITH AXLE HUB
(See page SA–15)
SA–66
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT SUSPENSION
STABILIZER BAR
COMPONENTS
SA–67
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT SUSPENSION
STABILIZER BAR REMOVAL
1. JACK UP VEHICLE AND REMOVE LEFT AND RIGHT
FRONT WHEELS
2. REMOVE LEFT AND RIGHT FENDER APRON SEALS
3. DISCONNECT LEFT AND RIGHT TIE ROD ENDS
FROM STEERING KNUCKLES
(a) Remove the cotter pin and nut.
(b) Using SST, disconnect the tie rod end from the steer–
ing knuckle.
SST 09628–62011
4. REMOVE LEFT AND RIGHT STABILIZER BAR LINKS
5. REMOVE LEFT AND RIGHT STABILIZER BAR BUSH–
INGS
(a) Remove the left and right bushing retainers.
(b) Remove the stabilizer bar bushings.
6. REMOVE EXHAUST FRONT PIPE
5S–FE Engine:
(See page EG–139)
1 MZ–FE Engine:
(See page EG–188)
7. REMOVE STEERING GEAR BOX MOUNTING BOLTS
AND NUTS
SA–68
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT SUSPENSION
8. REMOVE STABILIZER BAR
HINT: Lift the steering gear box and remove the stabi–
lizer bar.
STABILIZER BAR LINK INSPECTION
1. INSPECT BALL JOINT FOR ROTATION CONDITION
(a) Flip the ball joint stud back and forth 5 times as
shown in the illustration, before installing the nut.
(b) Using a torque gauge, turn the nut continuously one
turn every 2–4 seconds and take the torque reading
on the fifth turn.
Turning torque:
0.05–1.0 N⋅m (0.5–10 kgf⋅cm, 0.4–8.7 in.⋅lbf)
If not within specification, replace the stabilizer bar
link.
STABILIZER BAR INSTALLATION
1. POSITION STABILIZER BAR
HINT: Lift the steering gear box and position the
stabilizer bar.
2. INSTALL STEERING GEAR BOX MOUNTING BOLTS
AND NUTS
Torque: 181 N⋅m (1.850 kgf⋅cm, 134 ft⋅lbf)
3. INSTALL EXHAUST FRONT PIPE
SS–FE Engine:
(See page EG–139)
1 MZ–FE Engine:
(See page EG–189)
SA–69
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT SUSPENSION
4. INSTALL LEFT AND RIGHT STABILIZER BAR BUSH–
INGS
(a) Install the stabilizer bar bushings.
(b) Install the bushing retainers and bolts.
Torque: 19 N⋅m (195 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
5. INSTALL LEFT AND RIGHT STABILIZER BAR LINKS
Torque: 39 N⋅m (400 kgf⋅cm. 29 ft⋅Ibf)
6. CONNECT LEFT AND RIGHT TIE ROD ENDS TO
STEERING KNUCKLES
(a) Connect the tie rod end to the steering knuckle and
tighten the nut.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
(b) Install a new cotter pin.
7. INSTALL LEFT AND RIGHT FENDER APRON SEALS
8. INSTALL FRONT WHEELS AND LOWER VEHICLE
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅Ibf)
SA–70
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR AXLE
REAR AXLE
DESCRIPTION
The rear axle uses oil–sealed double–row angular ball bearings for wheel bearings.
There is no need for bearing grease maintenance or preload adjustment.
SA–71
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR AXLE
PREPARATION
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
EQUIPMENT
Dial indicator
Torque wrench
09608–32010 Steering Knuckle oil Seal
Replacer
Axle hub installation
(w/o A8S)
09628–10011 Ball Joint Puller
Hub bolt removal
09636–20010 Upper Ball Joint Dust Cover
Replacer
Axle hub installation
(w/o ASS)
09950–20017 Universal Puller
(w/o ABS)
SA–72
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR AXLE
REAR AXLE HUB
COMPONENTS
SA–73
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR AXLE
REAR AXLE HUB REMOVAL
1. JACK UP VEHICLE AND REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2. W/ DISC BRAKE:
REMOVE BRAKE CALIPER AND DISC
(a) Remove the 2 brake caliper set bolts.
(b) Hang up the brake caliper using wire, etc.
(c) Remove the disc.
3. w/ DRUM BRAKE:
REMOVE BRAKE DRUM
4. CHECK BEARING BACKLASH AND AXLE HUB DE–
VIATION
(a) Place the dial indicator near the center of the axle hub
and check the backlash in the bearing shaft direction.
Maximum:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If greater than the specified maximum, replace the
bearing.
(b) Using a dial indicator, check the deviation at the
surface of the axle hub outside the hub bolt.
Maximum:
0.47 mm (0.0028 in.)
If greater then the specified maximum, replace the
axle shaft and bearing.
6. REMOVE REAR AXLE HUB
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and rear axle hub.
(b) Remove the O–ring.
SA–74
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR AXLE
REAR AXLE HUB DISASSEMBLY
NOTICE: If equipped with ABS, do not disassemble the
rear axle shaft and bearing.
1. REMOVE LOCK NUT
(a) Using a hammer and chisel, release the nut caulking.
(b) Remove the lock nut.
2. REMOVE AXLE SHAFT FROM BEARING
(a) Using SST, remove the axle shaft from bearing.
SST 09950 – 20017
(b) Using SST, remove the inner race (outside) from the
axle shaft.
SST 09950–20017
REAR AXLE HUB ASSEMBLY
1. INSTALL AXLE SHAFT TO BEARING
(a) Using SST and a press, install the axle shaft to a new
bearing.
ST 09608–32010,09636–20010
(b) Install a new lock nut.
Torque: 123 N⋅m (1250 kgf⋅cm, 90 ft⋅lbf)
(c) Stake the lock nut.
SA–75
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR AXLE
REAR AXLE HUB INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL REAR AXLE HUB
(a) Install a new 0–ring.
HINT: Coat the 0–ring with MP grease.
(b) Install the rear axle hub with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 80 N⋅m (820 kgf⋅cm, 59 ft⋅lbf)
2. w/ DISC BRAKE:
INSTALL DISC AND BRAKE CALIPER.
(a) Install the disc.
(b) Install the brake caliper.
Torque: 47 N⋅m (475 kgf⋅cm, 34 ft⋅lbf)
3. w/ DRUM BRAKE:
INSTALL BRAKE DRUM
4. INSTALL REAR WHEEL AND LOWER VEHICLE
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm. 76 ft⋅lbf)
HUB BOLT REPLACEMENT
1. JACK UP VEHICLE AND REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2. REMOVE REAR DISC OR DRUM
3. REMOVE HUB BOLT
Using SST, remove the hub bolt.
SST 09628–10011
4. INSTALL HUB BOLT
Install washer– and nut to the hub bolt as shown in the
illustration, and install the hub bolt by tightening the
nut.
5. INSTALL REAR DISC OR DRUM
6. INSTALL REAR WHEEL AND LOWER VEHICLE
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅Ibf)
SA–76
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR AXLE
REAR AXLE CARRIER
COMPONENTS
SA–77
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR AXLE
REAR AXLE CARRIER REMOVAL
1. REMOVE REAR AXLE HUB
2. w/ DRUM BRAKE:
REMOVE BRAKE HOSE FROM SHOCK ABSORBER
3. REMOVE BACKING PLATE FROM REAR AXLE CAR–
RIER
Hang up the backing plate using wire, etc.
4. w/ ABS:
REMOVE ABS SPEED SENSOR
Remove the ABS speed sensor from rear axle carrier.
5. WAGON only:
REMOVE LSPV SPRING
Disconnect the LSPV spring from the lower arm.
6. REMOVE REAR AXLE CARRIER
(a) Loosen the 3 nuts.
HINT: Do not remove the bolts.
SA–78
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR AXLE
(b) Remove the bolt and nut and disconnect the strut rod
from the rear axle carrier.
(c) Remove the 3 nuts and bolts.
(d) Remove the rear axle carrier.
REAR AXLE CARRIER INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL REAR AXLE CARRIER
(a) Place the rear axle carrier and temporarily install the 3
bolts and nuts.
(b) Connect the strut rod to the rear axle carrier.
(c) Temporarily install the bolt and nut.
(d) Torque the 3 nuts.
Lower side of shock absorber:
Torque: 255 N⋅m (2,600 kgf⋅cm, 188 ft⋅lbf)
Lower arm:
Torque: 181 N⋅m (1,850 kgf⋅cm, 134 ft⋅lbf)
SA–79
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR AXLE
2. w/ ABS:
INSTALL ABS SPEED SENSOR
Install the ABS speed sensor to the rear axle carrier.
Torque: 7.8 N⋅m (80 kgf⋅cm, 69 in.⋅lbf)
3. WAGON only:
INSTALL LSPV SPRING
Connect the LSPV spring to the lower arm.
Torque: 13 N⋅m (130 kgf⋅cm, 9.4 ft⋅Ibf)
4. INSTALL BACKING PLATE AND REAR AXLE HUB
(a) Place the backing plate.
(b) Install a new O–ring.
(c) Install the rear axis hub.
Torque: 80 N⋅m (820 kgf⋅cm, 59 ft⋅Ibf)
5. w/ DRUM BRAKE:
INSTALL BRAKE LINE TO SHOCK ABSORBER
Torque: 29 N⋅m (300 kgf⋅cm, 22 ft⋅lbf)
6. STABILIZE SUSPENSION
(a) Install the rear wheel and lower the vehicle.
(b) Bounce the vehicle up and down several times to
stabilize the suspension.
7. TORQUE STRUT ROD BOLT
(a) Jack up the vehicle and support the body.
(b) Remove the rear wheel.
(c) Support the rear axle carrier with a jack.
(d) Torque the bolt.
Torque: 113 N⋅m (1,150 kgf⋅cm, 83 ft⋅lbf)
8. INSTALL REAR WHEEL AND LOWER VEHICLE
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
SA–80
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR SUSPENSION
REAR SUSPENSION
DESCRIPTION
The rear suspension is a dual–link strut independent suspension type composed of two lower
arms in parallel at the side, and strut rods which extend forward.
SA–81
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR SUSPENSION
PREPARATION
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
09727–30020 Coil Spring Compressor
09729–22031 Front Spring Upper Seat Holder
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09025–00010 Small Torque Wrench
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
SA–82
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR SUSPENSION
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER
COMPONENTS
SA–83
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR SUSPENSION
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER REMOVAL
1. SEDAN/COUPE
REMOVE REAR SEAT AND PACKAGE TRAY TRIM
(SEE THE BO SECTION)
WAGON:
REMOVE REAR SIDE SEATBACK AND TONNEAU
SIDE COVER
(SEE PAGE BO SECTION)
2. JACK UP VEHICLE AND REMOVE REAR WHEEL
3. WAGON ONLY:
DISCONNECT LSPV SPRING FROM LOWER ARM
4. REMOVE ABS SPEED SENSOR WIRE (w/ ABS) AND
BRAKE HOSE FROM SHOCK ABSORBER
5. DISCONNECT STABILIZER BAR LINK FROM
SHOCK ABSORBER
6. REMOVE SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
(a) Loosen the 2 nuts on lower side of shock absorber.
SA–84
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR SUSPENSION
(b) Support the rear axle carrier with a jack.
(c) Remove the 3 nuts of upper support.
(d) Lower the rear axle carrier and remove the 2 bolts.
(e) Remove the shock absorber with coil spring.
7. REMOVE COIL SPRING
(a) Remove the cap.
(b) Using SST, compress the coil spring.
SST 09727–30020
(c) Install a bolt and 2 nuts to the bracket at the lower
portion of the shock absorber and secure it in a visa.
SA–85
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR SUSPENSION
(d) Using SST to hold the upper support, remove the nut.
SST 09729–22031
(e) Remove the following parts.
•
Suspension upper support
•
Upper insulator
•
Coil spring
•
Spring bumper
•
Lower insulator
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER INSPECTION
INSPECT SHOCK ABSORBER
Compress and extend the shock absorber rod and
check that there is no abnormal resistance or unusual
operation sounds.
If there is any abnormality, replace the shock absorber
with a new one.
NOTICE: When discarding the shock absorber, use the
following procedure.
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER DISPOSAL
1. FULLY EXTEND SHOCK ABSORBER ROD
2. DRILL HOLE TO REMOVE GAS FROM CYLINDER
Using a drill, make a hole in the cylinder as shown to
remove the gas inside.
CAUTION: The gas coming out is harmless, but be careful
of chips which may fly up when drilling.
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL LOWER INSULATOR ONTO SHOCK ABS–
ORBER
SA–86
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR SUSPENSION
2. INSTALL SPRING BUMPER TO PISTON ROD
3. INSTALL COIL SPRING
(a) Using SST, compress the coil spring
SST 09727–30020
(b) Install the coil spring to the shock absorber.
HINT: Fit the lower end of the coil spring into the gap
of the lower seat.
4. INSTALL UPPER INSULATOR AND UPPER SUP–
PORT
(a) Before installing the upper support and insulator,
apply the lithium or silicon based grease as shown in
the illustration.
(b) Install the upper insulator to the upper support.
HINT: Match the bolt of the upper support with the
cut–off part of the insulator.
SA–87
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR SUSPENSION
(c) Install the upper support to the piston rod.
(d) Using SST to hold the upper support, install a new nut.
SST 09729–22031
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
(e) Rotate the upper support and set it in the direction
shown in the illustration.
(f) Remove the SST.
HINT: After removing SST, again check the direction
of the upper support.
(g) Install the cap.
5. INSTALL SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
Install the shock absorber and install the 3 nuts of
upper support.
Torque: 39 N⋅m (400 kgf⋅cm, 29 ft⋅Ibf)
6. CONNECT SHOCK ABSORBER TO REAR AXLE CAR–
RIER
(a) Coat the threads of the nuts with engine oil.
(b) Install the 2 bolts and nuts.
Torque: 255 N⋅m (2,600 kgf⋅cm, 188 ft⋅lbf)
SA–88
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR SUSPENSION
7. CONNECT STABILIZER BAR LINK TO SHOCK ABS–
ORBER
Torque: 64 N⋅m (650 kgf⋅cm, 47 ft⋅Ibf)
8. INSTALL ABS SPEED SENSOR WIRE (w/ ABS) AND
BRAKE HOSE TO SHOCK ABSORBER
Broke hose
Torque: 29 N⋅m (300 kgf⋅cm, 22 ft⋅lbf)
ABS wire
Torque: 5.4 N⋅m (55 kgf⋅cm. 48 in.⋅lbf)
9. WAGON only:
CONNECT LSPV SPRING FROM LOWER ARM
Torque: 13 N⋅m (130 kgf⋅cm, 9 ft⋅lbf)
10. INSTALL REAR WHEEL AND LOWER VEHICLE
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm. 76 ft⋅lbf)
11. SEDAN/COUPE:
INSTALL PACKAGE TRAY TRIM AND
REAR SEAT
(See the BO section)
WAGON:
INSTALL TONNEAU SIDE COVER AND REAR SIDE
SEATBACK
(See the BO section)
SA–89
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR SUSPENSION
LOWER SUSPENSION ARM AND
STRUT ROD
COMPONENTS
SA–90
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR SUSPENSION
4^T–06
LOWER SUSPENSION ARM AND STRUT
ROD REMOVAL
1. JACK UP VEHICLE AND REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2. REMOVE STRUT ROD
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and nuts.
(b) Remove the strut rod.
3. WAGON only:
DISCONNECT LSPV SPRING FROM LOWER ARM
4. REMOVE NO.2 LOWER SUSPENSION ARM
(a) Remove the 2 nuts and washers.
(b) Remove the No.2 lower suspension arm.
5. REMOVE LEFT AND RIGHT STABILIZER BUSHING
RETAINER
6. REMOVE EXHAUST CENTER PIPE AND TALE PIPE
5S–FE Engine:
(See page EG1–139)
1MZ–FE Engine:
(See page EG2–189)
7. REMOVE NO.1 LOWER SUSPENSION ARM
(a) Support the suspension member with a jack.
SA–91
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR SUSPENSION
(b) Remove the 6 nuts and the left and right suspension
member lower stopper.
(c) Lower the suspension member.
(d) Remove the No. 1 lower suspension arm with the 2
bolts and the washer.
NO.2 LOWER SUSPENSION ARM
DISASSEMBLY
1. DISASSEMBLE NO.2 LOWER SUSPENSION ARM
(a) Loosen the 2 lock nuts.
(b) Turn the adjusting tube and disassemble the No.2
lower suspension arm.
(c) Remove the lock nuts from the arms.
NO.2 LOWER SUSPENSION ARM
ASSEMBLY
1. ASSEMBLE NO.2 LOWER SUSPENSION ARM
(a) Install the lock nuts to the arms.
(b) Turn the adjusting tube and assemble the No.2 lower
suspension arm.
SA–92
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR SUSPENSION
HINT: When assembling the No.2 lower suspension
arm, try to make dimensions A and B shown in the
illustration as close as possible.
Maximum difference:
3 mm (0.12 in.)
(c) Adjust the No.2 lower suspension arm length by turn–
ing the adjusting tube.
Arm length:
584.2 mm (23.000 in.)
(d) Temporarily tighten the 2 lock nuts.
HINT: After adjusting the rear wheel alignment,
torque the lock nuts.
401W–06
LOWER SUSPENSION ARM AND STRUT
ROD INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL NO.1 LOWER SUSPENSION ARM
Install the No. 1 lower suspension arm with the washer
and the 2 bolts.
HINT: Face the paint mark to the rear.
2. INSTALL SUSPENSION MEMBER TO BODY
(a) Jack up the suspension member.
(b) Install the suspension member lower supports and the
6 nuts.
Nut A:
Torque: 51 N⋅m (520 kgf⋅cm, 38 ft⋅lbf)
Nut B:
Torque: 38 N⋅m (390 kgf⋅cm, 28 ft⋅lbf)
3. INSTALL LEFT AND RIGHT STABILIZER BUSHING
RETAINERS
Torque: 19 N⋅m (195 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
4. INSTALL EXHAUST CENTER PIPE AND TALE PIPE
5S–FE Engine:
(See page EG1–139)
1MZ–FE Engine:
(See page EG2–189)
SA–93
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR SUSPENSION
5. INSTALL NO.2 LOWER SUSPENSION ARM
(a) Install the No.2 lower suspension arm with the 3
washers.
HINT: Face the paint mark to the rear.
(b) Temporarily install the 2 lock nuts.
6. WAGON only:
CONNECT LSPV SPRING TO LOWER ARM
Torque: 13 N⋅m (130 kgf⋅cm, 9.4 ft⋅lbf)
7. INSTALL STRUT ROD
Place the strut rod and temporarily install the 2 bolts
and nuts.
8. TORQUE BOLTS AND NUTS
(a) Torque the nut on outside of the lower arm.
Torque: 181 N⋅m (1,850 kgf⋅cm, 134 ft⋅lbf)
(b) Install the rear wheel and lower the vehicle.
(c) Bounce the vehicle up and down several times to
stabilize the suspension.
(d) Jack up the vehicle and support the body with stands.
(e) Remove the rear wheel.
(f) Support the rear axle carrier with a jack.
(g) Torque the nut on inside of lower arm.
Torque: 181 N⋅m (1.850 kgf⋅cm, 134 ft⋅lbf)
SA–94
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR SUSPENSION
(h) Torque the strut rod set bolts.
Torque: 113 N⋅m (1,150 kgf⋅cm, 83 ft⋅lbf)
9. INSTALL REAR WHEEL AND LOWER VEHICLE
10. INSPECT AND ADJUST REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT
(See page SA–6)
11. TORQUE NO.2 LOWER SUSPENSION ARM LOCK
NUTS
Torque: 56 N⋅m (570 kgf⋅cm. 41 ft⋅lbf)
SA–95
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR SUSPENSION
STABILIZER BAR
COMPONENTS
STABILIZER BAR LINK INSPECTION
INSPECT BALL JOINT FOR ROTATION CONDITION
(a) Flip the ball joint stud back and forth 5 times as
shown in the illustration, before installing the nut.
(b) Using a torque gauge, turn the nut continuously one
turn every 2–4 seconds and take the torque reading
on the fifth turn.
Turning torque:
0.05–1.0 N⋅m (0.5–10 kgf⋅cm, 0.4–8.7in.⋅lbf)
If not within specification, replace the stabilizer bar
link.
SA–96
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE DATA
SEDAN/COUPE
Cold tire
inflation
pressure
Tire runout
Wheel balance
Front
Rear
Unbalance after adjustment
Vehicle
height
Front wheel
alignment
Pressure
Tire size
Height
Tire size
Front
Rear
Inside wheel
Outside wheel
(reference)
Toe – in (total)
Tire size
Wheel angle
Camber
Left–right error
Caster
Left–right error
Rear wheel
alignment
Front axle
Front suspension
Steering axis inclination
Toe–in (total)
Camber
Left – right error
Axle bearing backlash
Axle hub deviation
Lower ball joint turning torque
Stabilizer bar link turning torque
Rear axle
Axle bearing backlash
Axle hub deviation
Rear suspension
Stabilizer bar link turning torque
1l04727
SA–97
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
WAGON
Cold tire
inflation
pressure
Tire size
Pressure
Front
Rear
For all roads
including full
rated loads
Optional
inflation for
reduced loads
(1 or 4
passengers)
Tire runout
Wheel balance
Unbalance after adjustment
Vehicle
height
Front wheel
alignment
Height
Tire size
Front
Toe –in (total)
Tire size
Wheel angle
Camber
Left–right error
Caster
Left–right error
Rear wheel
alignment
Front axle
Steering axis inclination
Toe–in (total)
Camber
Left – right error
Axle bearing backlash
Axle hub deviation
Front suspension
Rear
Lower ball joint turning torque
Stabilizer bar link turning torque
Rear axle
Axle bearing backlash
Rear suspension
Axle hub deviation
Stabilizer bar link turning torque
Inside wheel
Outside wheel
(reference)
SA–98
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
FRONT
Part tightened
Tie rod end lock nut
Steering knuckle x Shock absorber
Steering knuckle x Brake caliper
Steering knuckle x Tie rod end
Axle hub nut
Ball joint x Lower arm
Ball joint x Steering knuckle
Steering knuckle x Disc brake dust cover
Drive shaft x Side gear shaft (1 MZ–FE)
Drive shaft center bearing lock bolt
Suspension upper support x Body
Suspension upper support x Piston rod
Brake hose x Shock absorber
ABS speed sensor wire x Shock absorber
Lower arm set bolt
Lower arm x Stabilizer bar link bracket
Stabilizer bar bushing retainer
Stabilizer bar link set nut
Steering gear box set bolt
Front exhaust pipe stay x Clamp (1 MZ–FE)
Front exhaust pipe stay x Body (1 MZ–FE)
REAR
Part tightened
Brake caliper x Rear axle carrier
Axle bearing set bolt
Bearing lock nut (w/o ABS)
Shock absorber x Rear axle carrier
Brake hose x Shock absorber
ABS speed sensor set bolt
ABS speed sensor wire x Shock absorber
Suspension upper support x Body
Suspension upper support x Piston rod
Lower suspension arm x Suspension member
Lower suspension arm X Rear axis carrier
Strut rod x Body
Strut rod x Rear axle carrier
Suspension member x Body (17mm)
Suspension member x Body (14mm)
LSPV spring x Lower suspension arm
Stabilizer bar bushing retainer
Stabilizer bar link set nut
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SA–37
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT(5S–FE)
LUBRICANT
Drive shaft
Item
Capacity
Toyota type
Outboard joint grease
Inboard joint grease
120–130 g (4.2–4.6 oz.)
232–242 g (8.2–8.5 oz.)
GKN type
Outboard joint grease
Inboard joint grease
140–160 g (4.9–5.6 oz.)
185–215 g (6.5–7.6 oz.)
SR–1
STEERING
–
STEERING
SR–2
STEERING
–
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
• Care must be taken to replace parts properly because they could affect the performance of
the steering system and result in a driving hazard.
• The steering wheel pad has an airbag built in, so take all due precautions when handling it. For
more details, see the SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) section.
TROUBLESHOOTING
Hard steering
Poor return
Excessive play
Abnormal noise
Front wheel bearing (Worn)
Steering gear housing
Sliding yoke (Worn)
Steering column (Binding)
SA–10
SA–63,
72
SR–24
Drive belt (Loose)
Suspension arm ball joints (Worn)
SR–24
Fluid level (Low)
Steering system joints (Worn)
SA–4
Trouble
Front wheel alignment (Incorrect)
Parts
Name
SA–4
See page
Tires (improperly inflated)
Use the table below to help you find the cause of the problem.
The numbers indicate the priority of the likely cause of the problem. Check each parts in order. If
necessary, replace these parts.
SR–3
STEERING
–
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
CHECK THAT STEERING WHEEL FREEPLAY IS COR–
RECT
With the vehicle stopped and tires pointed straight
ahead, rock the steering wheel gently back and forth
with light finger pressure.
Freeplay should not exceed the maximum.
Maximum freeplay:
30 mm (1.18 In.)
If incorrect, repair.
SR–4
STEERING
–
STEERING COLUMN
STEERING COLUMN
PREPARATION
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
09213–31021 Crankshaft Pulley Puller
Steering wheel
09612–22011 Tilt Handle Bearing Replacer
09309–37010 Transmission Bearing Replacer
09236–00101 Water Pump Overhaul Tool Set
(09237–00010) Water Pump Bearing Remover &
Replacer
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09042–00010 Torx Socket T30
09904–00010 Expander Set
(09904–00050) No. 4 Claw
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
Steering wheel pad
SR–5
STEERING
–
STEERING COLUMN
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
Remove and install the parts, as shown.
SR–6
STEERING
–
STEERING COLUMN
MAIN POINTS OF REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
NOTICE:
• If the SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) connec–
tor is disconnected with the ignition switch at ON or
ACC, diagnostic trouble codes will be recorded.
• Never use SRS parts from another vehicle. When
replacing parts, replace with new parts.
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ”LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
(See RS section)
2. REMOVE STEERING WHEEL PAD
(a) Place the front wheels facing straight ahead.
(b) Remove the No.2 and No.3 covers.
(c) Using a torx wrench, loosen the screws.
Produced by TMC: 3 screws
Produced by TMM: 2 screws
Torx wrench: T30 (Part No. 09042–00010 or locally
manufactured tool)
HINT: Loosen the torx screws until groove along the
screw circumference catches on the screw case.
(d) Pull the wheel pad out from the steering wheel and
disconnect the SRS connector.
NOTICE: When removing the wheel pad, take care not to
pull the airbag wire harness.
CAUTION:
• When storing the wheel pad, keep the upper surface
of the pad facing upward.
• Never disassemble the wheel pad.
SR–7
STEERING
–
STEERING COLUMN
3. REMOVE STEERING WHEEL
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the set nut.
(c) Place matchmarks on the steering wheel and main
shaft.
(d) Using SST, remove the steering wheel.
SST 09213–31021
4. INSTALL STEERING WHEEL
(a) Align matchmarks on the steering wheel and main
shaft, and install the wheel to the shaft.
(b) Tighten the wheel set nut.
Torque: 35 N–m (360 kgf–cm, 26 ft–lbf)
(c) Connect the connector.
5. INSTALL STEERING WHEEL PAD
(a) Connect the SRS connector.
(b) Install the wheel pad after confirming that the circum–
ference groove of the torx screws is caught on the
screw case.
(c) Using a torx wrench, tighten the screws.
Produced by TMC: 3 screws
Produced by TMM: 2 screws
Torque: 8.8 N–m (90 kgf–cm, 78 in–lbf)
NOTICE:
• Make sure the wheel pad is installed to the specified
torque.
• If the wheel pad has been dropped, or there are
cracks, dents or other defects in the case or connec–
tor, replace the wheel pad with a new one.
• When installing the wheel pad, take care that the
wirings do not interfere with other parts and are not
pinched between other parts.
(d) Install the No.2 and No.3 covers.
SR–8
STEERING
–
STEERING COLUMN
6. CHECK STEERING WHEEL CENTER POINT AFTER
INSTALLING STEERING COLUMN
7. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE TO
BATTERY
SR–9
STEERING
–
STEERING COLUMN
STEERING COLUMN
COMPONENTS
SR–10
STEERING
–
STEERING COLUMN
STEERING COLUMN DISASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE IGNITION KEY CYLINDER ILLUMINATION
2. REMOVE COLUMN UPPER BRACKET
(a) Using a centering punch, mark the center of the 2
tapered–head bolts.
(b) Using a 3–4 mm (0.12–0.16 in.) drill, drill into the 2
tapered–head bolts.
(c) Using a screw extractor, remove the 2 tapered–head
bolts.
(d) Remove the column upper clamp bracket and the
column tube.
3. ALIGN STEERING COLUMN
Align the upper column tube and lower column tube.
4. REMOVE MAIN SHAFT
(a) Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring.
SR–11
STEERING
–
STEERING COLUMN
(b) Using a screwdriver, loosen the staked parts of the
upper column tube.
(c) Using a plastic hammer, tap the main shaft until the
main stopper contacts the collar.
(d) Using SST, set the steering column on a press, as
shown.
SST 09236 –00101 (09237–00010)
(e) Using a brass bar, press out the main shaft.
NOTICE: To prevent damage to the main shaft avoid
dropping it.
5. REMOVE MAIN SHAFT COLLAR AND BUSHING
(a) Remove the collar from the main shaft.
(b) Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring.
SR–12
STEERING
–
STEERING COLUMN
(c) Using a brassbar, tap the bushing off the main shaft.
STEERING COLUMN INSPECTION AND
REPLACEMENT
1. INSPECT STEERING LOCK OPERATION
Check that the steering lock mechanism operates pro–
perly.
2. IF NECESSARY, REPLACE KEY CYLINDER
(a) Place the ignition key at the ACC position.
(b) Push down the stop pin with a thin rod, and pull out
the key cylinder.
(c) Make sure the ignition key is at the ACC position.
(d) Install a new key cylinder.
3. INSPECT UPPER BEARING
Check the upper bearing condition by manually turn–
ing the load bearing surface inside the column tube.
If there is resistance to turning, or an uneven force is
required to turn the bearing surface, replace the
column tube.
4. INSPECT LOWER BEARING
Check the lower bearing condition by manually turn–
ing the load bearing surface outside the main shaft.
If there is resistance to turning, or an uneven force is
required to turn the bearing surface, replace the main
shaft.
SR–13
STEERING
–
STEERING COLUMN
5. (A/T)
INSPECT KEY INTERLOCK SOLENOID
(See AX section)
6. (A/T)
IF NECESSARY, REPLACE KEY INTERLOCK SOLE–
NOID
(a) Remove the 2 screws and the solenoid.
(b) Install a new solenoid with the 2 screws.
STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
1. COAT ALL RUBBING PARTS WITH MOLYBDENUM
DISULPHIDE LITHIUM BASE GREASE
2. INSTALL MAIN SHAFT BUSHING AND COLLAR
(a) Using SST, tap the bushing onto the main shaft.
SST 09612–22011
(b) Using snap ring pliers, install the snap ring.
(c) Install the collar on the bushing.
(d) Insert the main shaft in the column tube.
(e) Using SST, tap in the collar to the column tube.
SST 09309–37010
SR–14
STEERING
–
STEERING COLUMN
(f) Using SST, a 27 mm socket wrench (insert extension
bar into the socket 19 mm) and a 19mm deep socket
wrench, press in the main shaft.
SST 09612 – 22011
(g) Using a pin punch and hammer, stake the upper
column tube.
(h) Using snap ring pliers, install the snap ring.
3. INSTALL UPPER BRACKET
(a) Install the upper bracket with 2 new tapered–head
bolts.
(b) Tighten the 2 tapered–head bolts until the bolt head
breaks off.
4. INSTALL IGNITION KEY CYLINDER ILLUMINATION
SR–15
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
POWER STEERING
DESCRIPTION
POWER STEERING PRINCIPLES
Power steering is a hydraulic device which utilizes engine power to reduce steering effort.
Consequently, the engine is used to drive a pump to develop fluid pressure, and this pressure acts
on a piston within the power cylinder so that the piston assists the rack effort. The amount of this
assistance depends on the extent of pressure acting on the piston. Therefore, if more steering
force is required, the pressure must be raised. The variation in the fluid pressure is accomplished
by a control valve which is linked to the steering main shaft.
NEUTRAL (STRAIGHT–AHEAD) POSITION
Fluid from the pump is sent to the control valve. If the control valve is in the neutral position, all
the fluid will flow through the control valve into the relief port and back to the pump. At this time,
hardly any pressure is created and because the pressure on the cylinder piston is equal on both
sides, the piston will not move in either direction.
SR–16
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
WHEN TURNING
When the steering main shaft is turned in either direction, the control valve also moves, closing
one of the fluid passages. The other passage then opens wider, causing a change in fluid flow
volume and, at the same time, a differential pressure is created between both sides of the piston.
Consequently, the piston moves in the direction of the lower pressure so that the fluid in the
cylinder is forced back to the pump through the control valve.
SERVICE HINT
Trouble with the power steering system usually involves hard steering resulting from lack of
assistance. In such cases, before attempting to make repairs, you should determine whether the
trouble lies with the pump or with the gear housing. To do this, use a pressure gauge to perform
an on–vehicle inspection.
(1MZ – FE Engine)
This model is fitted with a hydraulic cooling fan system which is driven by the power steering
flu,id. Accordingly, when inspecting the power steering system, you should also inspect the fluid
passages of the hydraulic cooling fan system.
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
Power steering is a hydraulic device and problems are normally due to insufficient fluid pressure
acting on the piston. This could be caused by either the pump not producing the specified fluid
pressure or the control valve in the gear housing not functioning properly so that the proper fluid
pressure can not be obtained.
If the fault lies with the pump, the same symptoms will generally occur whether the steering
wheel is turned fully to the right or left. On the other hand, if the fault lies with the control valve,
there will generally be a difference between the amount of assistance when the steering wheel is
turned to the left and right, causing harder steering. However, if the piston seal of the power
cylinder is worn, there will be a loss of fluid pressure whether the steering wheel is turned to the
right or left and the symptoms will be the same for both.
Before performing an on–vehicle inspection, a check must first be made to confirm that the
SR–17
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
power steering system is completely free of any air. If there is any air in the system, the volume
of this air will change when the fluid pressure is raised, causing a fluctuation in the fluid pressure
so that the power steering will not function properly. To determine if there is any air in the
system, check if there is a change of fluid level in the reservoir tank when the steering wheel is
turned fully to the right or left.
If there is air in the system, it will be compressed to a smaller volume when the steering wheel is
turned, causing a considerable drop in the fluid level. If the system is free of air, there will be very
little change in the level even when the fluid pressure is raised. This is because the fluid, being a
liquid, does not change volume when compressed. The small change in the fluid level is due to
expansion of the hoses between the pump and gear housing when pressure rises.
Also, air in the system sometimes causes abnormal noise in the pump or gear housing when the
steering wheel is fully turned in either direction.
This on–vehicle inspection must be performed every time after overhauling or repairing the
pump or gear housing to ensure that the power steering system is working properly.
VANE PUMP
The main component parts of the vane pump, such as the cam ring, rotor, vanes and flow control
valve are high precision parts and must be handled carefully. Also, because this pump produces
a very high fluid pressure, 0–rings are used for sealing each part. When reassembling the pump,
always use new 0 – rings.
In the flow control valve, there is a relief valve which controls the maximum pressure of the pump.
The amount of this maximum pressure is very important; if it is too low, there will be insufficient
power steering assistance and if too high, it will have an adverse effect on the pressure hoses, oil
seals, etc. If the maximum pressure is either too high or too low due to a faulty relief valve, do not
disassemble or adjust the relief valve, but replace the flow control valve as an assembly.
The clearance between the flow control valve and pump body installation hole is very important.
After manufacture, the factory measures the size of the installation hole and outer circumference
of the flow control valve, and punches a mark accordingly. Therefore, when replacing the flow
control valve, be sure to do so with one having the same mark in order to ensure the proper
clearance.
SR–18
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
The functional parts of the pump which produce fluid pressure are the cam ring, rotor and vanes,
and these should be checked for wear. If the clearance between each is not within standard when
reassembling, any worn parts should be replaced.
In this case, the replaced cam ring and rotor should be of the same length (have the same mark),
and the vanes should be replaced with those having a length corresponding to that mark,
otherwise the proper thrust clearance cannot be obtained. If there is too much thrust clearance,
there will be insufficient fluid pressure at low speeds. If there is too little thrust clearance, it may
result in seizure of the vanes.
GEAR HOUSING
If the gear housing is secured directly in a vise during overhaul, there is danger of deforming it,
so always first secure it in the SST provided (rack and pinion steering rack housing stand) before
placing it in the vise.
The oil seals on both sides of the power cylinder are for the prevention of leakage of the high
pressure fluid which acts on the piston. Always use new oil seals when reassembling and be very
careful not to scratch or damage them.
SR–19
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
Because of the high pressure, even the slightest scratch will cause fluid leakage, resulting in an
inoperative power steering system.
Also, be very careful not to scratch the sliding portion of the rack which makes contact with the
oil seals. When removing the rack ends from the rack, it is very easy to cause a burr when holding
the tip of the rack with a wrench. Therefore, before assembling the rack, first check the tip for
burrs and remove any with an oil stone.
Teflon rings are used for the piston and control valve. These teflon rings are highly durable
against wear, but if it is necessary to replace them, be careful not so stretch the new ones. After
installing a teflon ring into its groove, snug it down into the groove before assembly of the
cylinder or housing to prevent possible damage.
As with the rack and pinion type steering, preload is very important. If the preload is not correct,
it could result in such trouble as steering wheel play or shimmy or lack of durability, so always
make sure that it is correct.
IDLE–UP DEVICE
The pump produces the maximum fluid pressure when the steering wheel is turned fully to the
right or left and, at this time, there is a maximum load on the pump which causes a decrease in
engine idle rpm. To solve this problem, vehicles are equipped with an idle– up device which acts
to raise the engine idle rpm whenever there is a heavy load on the pump.
On EFI engines, when the piston of the air control valve is pushed by fluid pressure, the air valve
opens and the volume of air by–passing the throttle valve is increased to regulate engine rpm.
SR–20
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
PREPARATION
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
09238–47012 Water Pump Bearing Remover &
Replacer
PS pump bearing (3VZ–FE)
09608–12010 Front Hub & Drive Pinion Bearing
Replacer Set
Gear housing oil seal
(09608–00080) Replacer
09612–00012 Rack & Pinion Steering Rack
Housing Stand
09612–22011 Tilt Handle Bearing Replacer
09612–24014 Steering Gear Housing Overhaul
Tool Set
(09613–22011) Steering Rack Shaft Bushing
Puller
(09617–24020) Steering Pinion Bearing
Adjusting Screw Lock Nut Wrench
(09617–24030) Steering Rack End Wrench
09616–00010 Steering Worm Bearing Adjusting
Socket
09616–30020 Steering Worm Bearing Adjusting
Screw Wrench
09617–14010 Steering Rack End Wrench
09620–30010 Steering Gear Box Replacer Set
Control valve oil seal
SR–21
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
(09623–30010) Steering Worm Bearing & Oil Seal
Replacer
(09631 –00020) Handle
09628–62011 Ball Joint Puller
09630–24013 Steering Rack Oil Seal Tool Set
(09620–24010) Valve Cup Oil Seal Remover
(09620–24020) Valve Cup Oil Seal Replacer
09631–10021 Rack Stopper Wrench
09631 –10030 Oil Seal Remover
09631 –12020 Handle
09631–12071 Steering Rack Oil Seal Test Tool
09631–16010 Cylinder End Stopper Nut Wrench
09631–20081 Seal Ring Tool
09631–22020 Power Steering Hose Nut
14 x 17 mm Wrench Set
09631–33010 Steering Rack Cover ”I”
Tie rod end
SR–22
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
POWER STEERING PUMP
(1 MZ–FE)
POWER STEERING PUMP REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
Remove and install the parts, as shown.
SR–23
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
10. REMOVE SELF– LOCKING NUT
Using SST to hold the control valve, remove the self–
locking nut.
SST 09616 – 00010
11. REMOVE CONTROL VALVE HOUSING
(a) Remove the dust cover.
(b) Place matchmarks on the valve housing and rack
housing.
(c) Remove the 2 bolts.
(d) Pull out the valve with the valve housing.
(e) Remove the gasket from the rack housing.
12. REMOVE CONTROL VALVE FROM HOUSING
Tap out the control valve and oil seal.
13. REMOVE N0.2 BRACKET
(a) Place matchmarks on the bracket and rack housing.
(b) Using a screwdriver, pry a part the clasp of the No.2
bracket.
(c) Remove the bushing and bracket from the rack hous–
ing.
(d) Remove the bushing from the bracket.
SR–24
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
DRIVE BELT TENSION CHECK
Using a belt tension gauge, check the drive belt ten–
sion.
Belt tension gauge:
Nippondenso BTG–20 (95506–00020) or
Borroughs No.BT–33–73F
Drive belt tension:
1 MZ–FE
New belt
667–824 N (68–84 kgf, 150–185 lbf)
Used belt
422–598 N (43–61 kgf, 95–135 lbf)
5S–FE
New belt
441–667 N (45–68 kgf, 100–150 lbf)
Used belt
275–441 N (28–45 kgf,60–100 lbf)
HINT:
• ”New belt’” refers to a belt which has been less
than 5 minutes on a running engine.
• ”Used belt’ refers to a belt which has been used
on a running engine for 5 minutes or more.
• After installing the drive belt, check that it fits
properly in the ribbed grooves.
FLUID LEVEL CHECK
1. KEEP VEHICLE LEVEL
2. BOOST FLUID TEMPERATURE
With the engine idling at 1,000 rpm or less, turn the
steering wheel from lock to lock several times to
boost fluid temperature.
Fluid temperature:
80C (176F)
3. CHECK FOR FOAMING OR EMULSIFICATION
HINT: Foaming and emulsification indicate either the
existence of air in the system or that the fluid level is
too low.
4. CHECK FLUID LEVEL IN OIL RESERVOIR
Check the fluid level and add fluid if necessary.
Fluid:
ATF DEXRONll
SR–25
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
HINT: Check that the fluid level is within the HOT
LEVEL of the tank. If the fluid is cold, check that it is
within the COLD LEVEL of the tank.
IDLE–UP CHECK
1. WARM UP ENGINE
2. TURN AIR CONDITIONER SWITCH OFF
3. CHECK IDLE–UP
(a) Fully turn the steering wheel.
(b) Check that the engine rpm decreases when the air
control valve hose is pinched.
(c) Check that the engine rpm increases when the air
control valve hose is released.
POWER STEERING FLUID REPLACEMENT
1. JACK UP FRONT OF VEHICLE AND SUPPORT IT
WITH STANDS
SR–26
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
2. REMOVE FLUID RETURN HOSE FROM OIL RESER–
VOIR AND DRAIN FLUID INTO CONTAINER
3. TURN STEERING WHEEL FROM LOCK TO LOCK
WHILE DRAINING FLUID
4. FILL OIL RESERVOIR WITH FRESH FLUID
Fluid:
ATF DEXRONII
SR–27
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
5. START ENGINE AND RUN IT AT 1,000 RPM
After 1 or 2 seconds, fluid will begin to discharge from
the return hose. Stop the engine immediately at this
time.
NOTICE: Take care that some fluid remains left in the oil
reservoir.
6. REPEAT STEPS 5 AND6 FOUR OR FIVE TIMES
UNTIL THERE IS NO MORE AIR IN FLUID
7. CONNECT RETURN HOSE TO OIL RESERVOIR
8. BLEED POWER STEERING SYSTEM
POWER STEERING SYSTEM BLEEDING
1. CHECK FLUID LEVEL IN OIL RESERVOIR
Check the fluid level and add fluid if necessary.
Fluid:
ATF DEXRON ll
HINT: Check that the fluid level is within the HOT
LEVEL of the dipstick of the oil reservoir. If the fluid is
cold, check that it is within the COLD LEVEL of the
dipstick.
2. START ENGINE AND TURN STEERING WHEEL
FROM LOCK TO LOCK 3 OR 4 TIMES
With the engine speed below 1,000 rpm, turn the
steering wheel to left or right full lock and keep it
there for 2–3 seconds, then turn the wheel to the
opposite full lock and keep it there for 2–3 seconds.
3. CHECK THAT FLUID IN OIL RESERVOIR IS NOT
FOAMY OR CLOUDY AND DOES NOT RISE OVER
MAXIMUM WHEN ENGINE IS STOPPED
Measure the fluid level with the engine running. Stop
the engine and measure the fluid level.
Maximum rise:
5 mm (0.20 in.)
If a problem is found, repeat steps 5 to6 on page SR–27.
Repair the PS if the problem persists.
SR–28
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
OIL PRESSURE CHECK
1. CONNECT OIL PRESSURE GAUGE
1 MZ–FE
(a) Using SST, disconnect the pressure line joint.
SST 09631 –22020
(b) Connect the gauge side of the pressure gauge to the
PS pump side and the valve side to the gear housing
side.
2. BLEED POWER STEERING SYSTEM
(See page SR–27)
5S–FE
(a) Disconnect the pressure tube from the PS pump.
(b) Connect the gauge side of the pressure gauge to the
PS pump and the valve side to the pressure line.
3. BLEED POWER STEERING SYSTEM
(See page SR–27)
4. START ENGINE AND RUN IT AT IDLE
5. BOOST FLUID TEMPERATURE
With the engine idling at 1,000 rpm or less, turn the
steering wheel from lock to lock several times to
boost fluid temperature.
Fluid temperature: 80 C (176 F)
SR–29
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
6. CHECK FLUID PRESSURE READING WITH VALVE
CLOSED
Close the oil pressure gauge valve and observe the
reading on the gauge.
Minimum pressure:
1 MZ – FE
9,120 kPa (93 kgf/cm2, 1,323 psi)
5S–FE
8,336 kPa (85 kgf/cm2, 1,209 psi)
NOTICE:
• Do not keep the valve closed for more than 10
seconds.
• Do not let the fluid temperature become too high.
If pressure is low, repair or replace the PS pump.
7. OPEN VALVE FULLY
8. CHECK AND RECORD PRESSURE READING AT
1,000 RPM
9. CHECK AND RECORD PRESSURE READING AT
3,000 RPM
Check that there is 490 kPa (5 kgf/cm2, 71 psi) or less
difference in pressure between the 1,000 rpm and
3,000 rpm checks.
If the difference is excessive, repair or replace the
flow control valve of the PS pump.
SR–30
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
10. CHECK PRESSURE READING WITH STEERING
WHEEL TURNED TO FULL LOCK
Be sure the pressure gauge valve is fully opened and
the engine idling.
Minimum pressure:
1 MZ–FE
9,120 kPa (93 kgf/cm2, 1,323 psi)
5S–FE
8,336 kPa (85 kgf/cm2, 1,209 psi)
NOTICE:
• Do not maintain lock position for more than 10
seconds.
• Do not let the fluid temperature become too high.
If pressure is low, the gear housing has an internal
leak and must be repaired or replaced.
11. MEASURE STEERING EFFORT
(a) Center the steering wheel and run the engine at idle.
(b) Using a spring scale, measure the steering effort in
both directions.
Maximum steering effort:
39 N (4 kgf, 8.8 lbf)
If steering effort is excessive, repair the PS unit.
HINT: Be sure to consider the tire type, pressure and
contact surface before making your diagnosis.
SR–31
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
POWER STEERING PUMP
(5S–FE)
POWER STEERING PUMP REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
Remove and install the parts, as shown.
MAIN POINTS OF REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
1. ADJUST DRIVE BELT TENSION AFTER INSTALL–
ING PS PUMP
2. BLEED POWER STEERING SYSTEM
SR–32
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
COMPONENTS
SR–33
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
~1 –01
POWER STEERING PUMP DISASSEMBLY
1. MOUNT POWER STEERING PUMP IN VISE
NOTICE: Do not tighten the vise too tight.
2. REMOVE PS PUMP PULLEY
(a) Using SST, remove the pulley set nut.
SST 09960–10010 (09963–01000)
(b) Remove the pump pulley from the shaft.
3. REMOVE SUCTION PORT UNION
(a) Remove the bolt and union.
(b) Remove the O–ring from the union.
4: REMOVE AIR CONTROL VALVE
(a) Remove the air control valve.
(b) Remove the gasket.
5. REMOVE FLOW CONTROL VALVE
(a) Remove the pressure port union.
(b) Remove the 0–ring from the union.
(c) Remove the flow control valve and spring.
6. REMOVE PUMP BRACKET
(a) Remove the 3 bolt.
(b) Remove the pump bracket from the pump assy.
SR–34
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
7. REMOVE REAR HOUSING
(a) Remove the 4 bolt.
(b) Remove the rear housing.
(c) Remove the wave washer.
(d) Remove the side plate.
8. REMOVE PUMP SHAFT, CAM RING AND VANE
PLATES
(a) Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring.
(b) Remove the cam ring and 10 vane plates from the
front housing.
9. REMOVE ROTER
(a) Remove the roter from the pump shaft.
SR–35
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
(b) Remove the 2 straight pins from the front housing.
(c) Remove the gasket.
(d) Remove the pump shaft.
POWER STEERING PUMP INSPECTION
AND REPLACEMENT
1. MEASURE OIL CLEARANCE OF SHAFT AND BUSH–
ING
Using a micrometer and calipers, measure the oil cle–
arance.
Standard clearance:
0.03–0.05 mm (0.0012–0.0020 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
If more than maximum, replace the entire power steer–
ing pump.
2. INSPECT ROTOR AND VANE PLATES
(a) Using a micrometer, measure the height, thickness
and length of the vane plates.
Minimum height:
8.6 mm (0.339 in.)
Minimum thickness:
1.4 mm (0.055 in.)
Minimum length:
14.99 mm (0.5902 in.)
SR–36
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
(b) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between
the rotor groove and vane plate.
Maximum clearance:
0.03 mm (0.0012 in.)
If more than maximum, replace the vane plate and/or
rotor with one having the same mark stamped on the
cam ring.
Inscribed mark:
1, 2, 3, 4 or None
HINT: There are 5 vane lengths with the following
rotor and cam ring marks:
Rotor and cam
ring mark
Vane length mm (in.)
None
14.999 –15.001 (0.59051 –0.59059)
14.997–14.999 (0.59043–0.59051)
14.995–14.997 (0.59035–0.59043)
14.993–14.995 (0.59027–0.59035)
14.911 –14.993 (0.59020–0.59027)
3. INSPECT FLOW CONTROL VALVE
(a) Coat the valve with power steering fluid and check
that it falls smoothly into the valve hole by its own
weight.
(b) Check the flow control valve for leakage.
Close one of the holes and apply compressed air [392
–490 kPa (4–5 kgf/cm2, 57–71 psi)] into the oppo–
site side, and confirm that air does not come out from
the end holes.
If necessary, replace the valve with one having the
same letter as inscribed on the front housing.
Inscribed mark:
A, B, C, D, E or F
SR–37
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
4. INSPECT FLOW CONTROL SPRING
Using a scale, measure the free length of the spring.
Spring length:
36–38 mm (1.42–1.49 in.)
If not within specification, replace the spring.
5. IF NECESSARY, REPLACE OIL SEAL
(a) Using a screwdriver, pry out the oil seal.
(b) Coat a new oil seal lip with power steering fluid.
NOTICE: Make sure you install the oil seal facing the
correct direction.
(c) Using a socket wrench (24mm) and hummer, drive in
a new oil seal.
POWER STEERING PUMP ASSEMBLY
1. COAT ALL SLIDING SURFACES WITH POWER STE–
ERING FLUID BEFORE ASSEMBLY
2. INSTALL PUMP SHAFT
3. INSTALL GASKET
4. INSTALL STRAIGHT PINS
Using a plastic hammer, drive the 2 straight pin to the
front plate.
SR–38
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
5. INSTALL CAM RING, ROTOR AND VANE PLATES
(a) Install the roter to the shaft with the inscribed mark
facing outward.
(b) Align the holes of the cam ring and straight pins, and
install the cam ring with the inscribed mark facing
outward.
(c) Using snap ring pliers, install the snap ring.
(d) Coat the vane plates with power steering fluid.
(e) Install the 10 vane plates with the round end facing
outward.
6. INSTALL SIDE PLATE AND WAVE WASHER
(a) Align the holes of the side plate with the pins, and
install the plate.
(b) Install the wave washer.
SR–39
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
7. INSTALL REAR HOUSING
Install and torque the 4 bolts.
Torque: 43 N–m (440 kgf–cm, 22 ft–lbf)
8. MEASURE PUMP SHAFT PRELOAD
(a) Check that the shaft rotates smoothly without abnor–
mal noise.
(b) Temporarily install the pulley nut and check the rotat–
ing torque.
Rotating torque: 0.3 N–m (2.8 kgf–cm, 2.4 in.–lbf) or less
9. INSTALL PUMP BRACKET
Install the pump bracket with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 17 N–m (170 kgf–cm, 12 ft–lbf)
10. INSTALL FLOW CONTROL VALVE
(a) Install the spring and flow control valve into the hous–
ing.
(b) Coat a new O–ring with power steering fluid, and
install it to the pressure port union.
(c) Install and torque the pressure port union.
Torque: 83 N–m (850 kgf–cm, 62 ft–lbf)
11. INSTALL AIR CONTROL VALVE
(a) Install a new gasket.
(b) Install the air control valve.
Torque: 69 N–m (700 kgf–cm. 51 ft–lbf)
SR–40
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
12. INSTALL SUCTION PORT UNION
(a) Coat a new O–ring with power steering fluid, and
install it to the suction port union.
(b) Install the suction port union.
(c) Install and torque the bolt.
Torque: 13 N–m (130 kgf–cm, 9 ft–lbf)
13. INSTALL PS PUMP PULLEY
(a) Install the pump pulley to the shaft.
(b) Using SST, install and torque the pulley set nut.
SST 09960–10010 (09963–01000)
Torque: 43 N–m (440 kgf–cm, 32 ft–lbf)
SR–41
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
POWER STEERING PUMP
(1MZ–FE)
POWER STEERING PUMP REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
Remove and install the parts, as shown.
SR–42
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
MAIN POINTS OF REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
1. REMOVE PRESSURE TUBES
Using SST, remove the pressure tubes.
SST 09631–22020
2. ADJUST DRIVE BELT TENSION AFTER INSTALL–
ING PS PUMP
3. BLEED POWER STEERING SYSTEM
SR–43
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
COMPONENTS
SR–44
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
POWER STEERING PUMP DISASSEMBLY
1. MOUNT POWER STEERING PUMP IN VISE
NOTICE: Do not tighten the vise to tight.
2. REMOVE PS PUMP PULLEY
(a) Using SST, remove the pulley set nut.
SST 09960–10010 (09963–01000)
(b) Remove the pump pulley from the shaft.
3. REMOVE CONTROL VALVE
(a) Using SST, remove the control valve.
SST 09612–24014 (09617–24030)
(b) Remove the O–ring from the control valve.
(c) Remove the O–ring from the rear housing.
4. REMOVE SUCTION PORT UNIONS
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and 2 suction port unions.
(b) Remove the O–ring from each suction port union.
5. REMOVE FLOW CONTROL VALVE
For PS:
(a) Remove the pressure port union.
(b) Remove the 0–ring from the pressure port union.
SR–45
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
(c) Using a magnetic finger, remove the flow control
valve and spring.
NOTICE: Be careful not to confute the flow control valve
of the PS with that of the hydraulic cooling fan system.
6. REMOVE FLOW CONTROL VALVE
For Hydraulic Cooling Fan System:
(a) Remove the pressure port union.
(b) Remove the O–ring from the pressure port union.
(c) Using a magnetic finger, remove the flow control
valve and spring.
NOTICE: Be careful not to confuse the flow control valve
of the hydraulic cooling fan system with that of the PS.
7. REMOVE REAR HOUSING
Using a hexagon wrench (8 mm), remove the 4 bolts,
rear housing and gasket.
8. REMOVE CAM RING, ROTOR AND VANE PLATE
For Hydraulic Cooling Fan System:
Remove the cam ring, rotor and 10 vane plates.
NOTICE: Be careful not to confuse the cam ring, rotor
and vane plates of the hydraulic cooling fan system with
those of the PS.
SR–46
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
9. REMOVE FRONT SIDE PLATE AND 2 REAR SIDE
PLATES
(a) Remove the front side plate and 2 rear side plates.
(b) Remove the 2 0–rings from the rear side plate.
10. REMOVE CAM RING, ROTOR AND VANE PLATES
For PS:
Remove the cam ring, rotor and 10 vane plates.
NOTICE: Be careful not to confuse the cam ring, rotor
and vane plates of the PS with those of the hydraulic
cooling fan system.
11. REMOVE STRAIGHT PINS
Put each straight pin in the vise and rotate the hous–
ing to pull the straight pin out from the housing.
12. REMOVE PUMP SHAFT
(a) Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring.
(b) Using a plastic hammer, tap out the pump shaft.
SR–47
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
13. REMOVE REAR SIDE PLATE AND WAVE WASHER
FROM REAR HOUSING
(a) Install a suitable bolt and plate washer to the rear
plate.
(b) Using SST, remove the rear plate.
SST 09910 – 00015 (09911– 00011, 09912 – 00010)
(c) Remove the 2 0– rings from the rear side plate.
(d) Remove the wave washer.
POWER STEERING PUMP INSPECTION
AND REPLACEMENT
NOTICE: Be careful not to confuse the parts of the PS
with those of the hydraulic cooling fan system.
1. MEASURE OIL CLEARANCE OF SHAFT AND BUSH–
ING
Using a micrometer and calipers, measure the oil cle–
arance.
Standard clearance:
0.03–0.05 mm (0.0012–0.0020 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
If more than maximum, replace the entire power steer–
ing pump.
2. INSPECT ROTOR AND VANE PLATES
(a) Using a micrometer, measure the height, thickness
and length of the vane plates.
For PS
Minimum height:
8.6 mm (0.339 in.)
Minimum thickness:
1.4 mm (0.055 in.)
Minimum length:
14.99 mm (0.5902 in.)
SR–48
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
For Hydraulic Cooling Fan System
Minimum height:
8.1 mm (0.319 in.)
Minimum thickness:
1.8 mm (0.071 in.)
Minimum length:
14.98 mm (0.5898 in.)
(b) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between
the rotor groove and vane plate.
Maximum clearance:
0.035 mm (0.0014 in.)
If more than maximum, replace the vane plate and/or
rotor.
HINT: There are 5 lengths with the following rotor and
cam ring marks.
Power Steering Vane Lengths
Cam ring mark
Rotor mark
Vane length mm (in.)
Hydraulic Cooling Fan System Vane Lengths
Cam ring mark
Rotor mark
Vane length mm (in.)
SR–49
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
3. INSPECT FLOW CONTROL VALVE
(a) Coat the valve with power steering fluid and check
that it falls smoothly into the valve hole by its own
weight.
(b) Check the flow control valve for leakage.
Close one of the holes and apply compressed air [392
–490 kPa (4–5 kgf/cm2, 57–71 psi)] into the oppo–
site side, and confirm that air does not come out from
the end holes.
If necessary, replace the valve with one having the
same letter as inscribed on the front housing.
Inscribed mark:
A, B, C, D, E or F
4. INSPECT FLOW CONTROL SPRING
Using a scale, measure the free length of the spring.
Spring length:
37–39 mm (1.46–1.54 in.)
5. IF NECESSARY, REPLACE OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST and a hammer, drive out the oil seal.
SST 09631–10030
SR–50
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
(b) Coat a new oil seal lip with power steering fluid.
NOTICE: Make sure you install the oil seal facing the
correct direction.
(c) Using a socket wrench (24 mm) and hammer, drive in
a new oil seal.
6. IF NECESSARY, REPLACE BALL BEARING
(a) Using a press, remove the ball bearing from the pump
shaft.
(b) Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring from the
pump shaft.
(c) Using snap ring pliers, install the snap ring to the
pump shaft.
(d) Using a press and deep socket wrench (17 mm), install
a new ball bearing to the pump shaft.
SR–51
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
POWER STEERING PUMP ASSEMBLY
1. COAT ALL SLIDING SURFACES WITH POWER STE–
ERING FLUID BEFORE ASSEMBLY
2. INSTALL PUMP SHAFT
(a) Using SST and a press, install the pump shaft with the
ball bearing.
SST 09238–47012
(b) Using snap ring pliers, install the snap ring.
3. INSTALL STRAIGHT PINS
Using a plastic hammer, tap in the 2 straight pins.
4. INSTALL CAM RING, ROTOR AND VANE PLATES
For PS:
(a) Align the holes of the cam ring and straight pins, and
install the cam ring with the inscribed mark facing
outward.
(b) Install the rotor to the shaft with the inscribed mark
facing outward.
(c) Coat the vane plates with power steering fluid.
(d) Install the 10 vane plates with the round end facing
outward.
5. INSTALL FRONT SIDE PLATE AND 2 REAR SIDE
PLATES
(a) Install 2 new 0–rings to the rear side plate.
(b) Align the holes of the plates and straight pins, and
install the plates.
SR–52
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
6. INSTALL CAM RING, ROTOR AND VANE PLATES
For Hydraulic Cooling Fan System:
(a) Align the holes of the cam ring and straight pins, and
install the cam ring with the inscribed mark facing
outward.
(b) Install the rotor to the shaft with the inscribed mark
facing outward.
(c) Coat the vane plates with power steering fluid.
(d) Install the 10 vane plates with the round end facing
outward.
7. INSTALL REAR SIDE PLATE AND WAVE WASHER
(a) Install 2 new 0–rings to the rear side plate.
(b) Align the holes of the side plate with the pins, and
install the plate.
(c) Install the wave washer.
8. INSTALL REAR HOUSING
(a) Install a new gasket and the rear housing.
HINT: Be careful when aligning the gasket.
(b) Using a hexagon wrench (8 mm), install and torque the
4 bolts.
Torque: 46 N–m (470 kgf–cm, 34 ft–lbf)
9. MEASURE PUMP SHAFT PRELOAD
(a) Check that the shaft rotates smoothly with out abnor–
mal noise.
(b) Temporarily install the pulley nut and check the rotat–
ing torque.
Rotating torque:
0.3 N–m (2.8 kgf–cm, 2.4 in.–lbf) or less
10. INSTALL FLOW CONTROL VALVE
For Hydraulic Cooling Fan System:
(a) Install the spring and flow control valve into the hous–
ing.
SR–53
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
(b) Coat a new O–ring with power steering fluid, and
install it to the pressure port union.
(c) Install and torque the pressure port union.
Torque: 69 N–m (700 kgf–cm, 61 ft–lbf)
11. INSTALL FLOW CONTROL VALVE
For PS:
(a) Install the spring and flow control valve into the hous–
ing.
(b) Coat a new O–ring with power steering fluid, and
install it to the pressure port union.
(c) Install and torque the pressure port union.
Torque: 69 N–m (700 kgf–cm, 51 ft–Ibf)
12. INSTALL SUCTION PORT UNIONS
(a) Coat 2 new 0–rings with power steering fluid, and
install them to each suction port union.
(b) Install the suction port union with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 13 N–m (130 kgf–cm, 9 ft–lbf)
13. INSTALL CONTROL VALVE
(a) Coat a new O–ring with power steering fluid, and
install it to the rear housing.
(b) Install a new O–ring to the control valve.
SR–54
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
(c) Using SST, install and torque the control valve.
SST 09612–24014 (09617–24030)
Torque: 59 N–m (600 kgf–cm, 43 ft–lbf)
HINT: Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of
340 mm (13.39 in.).
14. INSTALL PS PUMP PULLEY
(a) Install the pump pulley to the shaft.
(b) Using SST, install and torque the pulley set nut.
SST 09960–10010 (09963–01000)
Torque: 43 N–m (440 kgf–cm, 32 ft–lbf)
SR–55
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
GEAR HOUSING
STEERING GEAR HOUSING REMOVAL
AND INSTALLATION
Remove and install the parts, as shown.
MAIN POINTS OF REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
NOTICE: When disconnecting the sliding yoke during re–
moval of the gear housing, remove the steering wheel
and perform centering of the spiral cable.
(See page RS–20)
If the operation is performed without removing the steer–
ing wheel, use the procedure below to make sure the
steering wheel is firmly fixed in position and cannot turn.
SR–56
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
1. DISCONNECT SLIDING YOKE
(a) Position the front wheels facing straight ahead.
(b) Using the seat belt of the driver’s seat, fix the steering
wheel so that it does not turn.
(c) Place matchmarks on the sliding yoke and control
valve shaft.
(d) Loosen the bolt on the upper side of the sliding yoke,
remove the bolt on the lower side and disconnect the
sliding yoke.
2. DISCONNECT TIE ROD ENDS
(a) Remove the cotter pins and nuts.
(b) Using SST, disconnect the tie rod end from the knuck–
le arm.
SST 09628–62011
3. DISCONNECT PRESSURE AND RETURN TUBES
Using SST, disconnect and connect the pressure and
return tubes.
SST 09631 –22020
Torque: 25 N–m (250 kgf–cm, 18 ft.–lbf)
4. REMOVE STABILIZER BAR SET BOLTS
Remove the 4 stabilizer bar set bolts.
SR–57
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
5. REMOVE GEAR HOUSING
(a) Remove the 2 set bolts.
(b) Slide the gear housing to the RH side.
NOTICE: Do not damage the turn pressure tube.
6. CONNECT SLIDING YOKE
(a) Set the gear housing so that it matches the dimen–
sions shown below, with the gear housing at the
center point.
(b) Align matchmarks on the sliding yoke and control
valve shaft and connect them.
7. CENTER SPIRAL CABLE
If the steering wheel has been removed, or the steer–
ing wheel may have moved during the operation,
always perform centering of the spiral cablle.
(See page RS–20)
8. CHECK STEERING WHEEL CENTER POINT
9. CHECK TOE–IN
SR–58
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
COMPONENTS
SR–59
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
STEERING GEAR HOUSING DISASSEMBLY
1. CLAMP GEAR HOUSING IN VISE
Using SST, secure the steering gear in a vise.
SST 09612–00012
2. REMOVE LEFT AND RIGHT TURN PRESSURE
TUBES
(a) Using SST, remove the turn pressure tubes.
SST 09630–00020
(b) Remove the 0–rings from the turn pressure tubes.
3. REMOVE TIE ROD ENDS
(a) Loosen the lock nut and place matchmarks on the tie
rod end and rack end.
(b) Remove the tie rod ends and lock nuts.
4. REMOVE RACK BOOTS
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the clips and clamps.
(b) Remove the rack boots.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the rack boots and
rack housing.
5. REMOVE RACK ENDS AND CLAW WASHERS
(a) Unstake the claw washers.
NOTICE: Avoid any impact to the rack.
SR–60
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
(b) Using SST, remove the rack ends.
SST 09617–14010
(e) Mark the left and right rack ends accordingly.
(d) Remove the claw washers.
6. REMOVE RACK GUIDE SPRING CAP LOCK NUT
Using SST, remove the rack guide spring cap lock nut.
SST 09612 – 24014 (09617 – 24020)
7. REMOVE RACK GUIDE SPRING CAP
Using SST, remove the rack guide spring cap.
SST 09631 –10021
8. REMOVE RACK GUIDE SPRING, RACK GUIDE AND
SEAT
9. REMOVE RACK HOUSING GAP
SR–61
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
10. REMOVE SELF– LOCKING NUT
Using SST to hold the control valve, remove the self–
locking nut.
SST 09616 – 00010
11. REMOVE CONTROL VALVE HOUSING
(a) Remove the dust cover.
(b) Place matchmarks on the valve housing and rack
housing.
(c) Remove the 2 bolts.
(d) Pull out the valve with the valve housing.
(e) Remove the gasket from the rack housing.
12. REMOVE CONTROL VALVE FROM HOUSING
Tap out the control valve and oil seal.
13. REMOVE N0.2 BRACKET
(a) Place matchmarks on the bracket and rack housing.
(b) Using a screwdriver, pry a part the clasp of the No.2
bracket.
(c) Remove the bushing and bracket from the rack hous–
ing.
(d) Remove the bushing from the bracket.
SR–62
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
14. REMOVE CYLINDER END STOPPER
(a) Using SST, turn the cylinder end stopper clockwise
until the wire end comes out.
SST 09631 –16010
(b) Using SST, turn the cylinder end stopper counter–
clockwise, and remove the wire.
SST 09631 –16010
15. REMOVE RACK BUSHING AND RACK
(a) Using a brass bar, tap out the rack with the rack
busing.
(b) Remove the 0–ring from the bushing.
16. REMOVE CYLINDER SIDE OIL SEAL AND SPACER
Using SST and a brass bar, drive out the oil seal and
spacer.
SST 09620–30010 (09623–30010)
W” –01
STEERING GEAR HOUSING INSPECTION
AND REPLACEMENT
1. INSPECT RACK
(a) Using a dial indicator, check the rack for runout and
for tooth wear or damage.
Maximum runout:
0.3 mm (0.012 in.)
(b) Check the back surface for wear or damage.
If faulty, replace it.
2. IF NECESSARY, REPLACE CONTROL VALVE HOUS–
ING OIL SEAL AND UPPER BEARING
(a) Using SST, press out the oil seal and upper bearing.
SST 09620–30010 (09631 –00020)
09630–24013 (09620–24020)
SR–63
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
(b) Coat a new oil seal with power steering fluid.
(c) Using SST, press in a new oil seal, as shown.
SST 09620–30010 (09631–00020)
09630–24013 (09620–24020)
(d) Using SST, press in a new upper bearing, as shown.
SST 09620–30010 (09631–00020)
09630–24013 (09620–24020)
NOTICE: Press in the bearing so that the inscribed mark
on the bearing can be seen.
3. IF NECESSARY, REPLACE CONTROL VALVE
LOWER BEARING AND CENTER BEARING
(a) Using a brass bar, drive out the lower bearing.
(b) Using SST, remove the center bearing.
SST 09612 – 24014 (09613 – 22011)
(c) Coat a new center bearing with grease.
(d) Using SST, press in a new center bearing, as shown.
SST 09630–24013 (09620–24020),
09631–12020
SR–64
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
(e) Using SST, press in a new lower bearing.
SST 09630–24013 (09620–24020),
09631 –12020
4. IF NECESSARY, REPLACE RACK BUSHING OIL
SEAL
(a) Using SST, remove the oil seal.
SST 09612 – 24014 (09613 – 22011)
(b) Coat a new oil seal with power steering fluid.
(c) Using SST, press in the oil seal.
SST 09631–32010
5. IF NECESSARY, REPLACE STEERING RACK
TEFLON RING AND O–RING
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the teflon ring and 0–
ring.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the groove for the
teflon ring.
(b) Coat a new O–ring with power steering fluid and
install it.
(c) Expand a new teflon ring with your fingers.
NOTICE: Be careful not to over–expand the teflon ring.
SR–65
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
(d) Install the teflon ring to the rack.
(e) Install the expanded teflon ring to the steering rack
and snug it down with your fingers.
6. IF NECESSARY, REPLACE CONTROL VALVE
TEFLON RINGS
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the 4 teflon rings.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the grooves for the
teflon ring.
(b) Expand 4 new teflon rings with your fingers.
NOTICE: Be careful not to over–expand the teflon ring.
(c) Install the 4 teflon rings to the control valve.
(d) Coat the 4 teflon rings with power steering fluid and
snug them down with your fingers.
(e) Carefully slide the tapered end of the SST over the
teflon rings to seat the rings.
SST 09631– 20081
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the teflon rings.
SR–66
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
7. IF NECESSARY, REPLACE HYDRAULIC REACTION
CHAMBER TEFLON RINGS AND O–RINGS
(a) Remove the teflon rings and 0–rings.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the control valve.
(b) Install new 0–rings to the control valve.
(c) Install the expanded new teflon rings to the control
valve.
(d) Carefully position the teflon rings into the control
valve grooves.
NOTICE: Be careful not over–expand the teflon rings.
(e) Coat the teflon rings with power steering fluid, and
snug them down with your fingers.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the teflon rings.
STEERNG GEAR HOUSING ASSEMBLY”
1. INSTALL CYLINDER HOUSING OIL SEAL AND
SPACER
(a) Coat a new oil seal lip with power steering fluid.
(b) Tape the showing part of SST before use.
(c) Install the oil seal to SST, and press in it.
SST 09608–12010 (09608–00080),
09631 –12020
2. INSTALL RACK
(a) Install SST to the rack.
HINT: If necessary, scrape the burrs off the rack teeth
end and burnish.
SST 09631 –33010
(b) Coat SST with power steering fluid.
(e) Insert the rack into the cylinder.
(d) Remove SST.
SR–67
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
3. INSTALL RACK BUSHING AND CYLINDER END
STOPPER
(a) To prevent oil seal lip damage, wind vinyl tape on the
steering rack end, and apply power steering fluid.
(b) Coat a new O–ring with power steering fluid and
install it to the bushing.
(c) Push in the rack bushing and cylinder end stopper
until the wire installation hole appears.
4. INSTALL WIRE
(a) Insert a new wire end into the hole.
(b) Using SST, turn the cylinder end stopper clockwise
until the wire end disappears.
SST 09631–16010
NOTICE: Take care to avoid tightening the rack more
than needed.
5. AIR TIGHTNESS TEST
(a) Install SST to the unions of the cylinder housing.
SST 09631–12071
(b) Apply 53.3 kPa (400 mmHg, 15.75 in.Hg) of vacuum
for about 30 seconds.
(c) Check that there is no change in the vacuum.
If there is change in the vacuum, check the installation
of the rack housing oil seal.
6. INSTALL NO.2 BRACKET
(a) Coat the grommets inner edge with the grease.
(b) Install the bushing to the bracket.
(c) Install the bushing and bracket to the rack housing.
HINT: Align the matchmarks on the bracket and rack
housing.
SR–68
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
(d) Place the No.2 bracket in a vise and tighten the vise to
fasten the clasp.
NOTICE: Take care not to drop the from the No.2 bracket.
7. INSTALL CONTROL VALVE
(a) Wind vinyl tape on the control valve.
(b) Coat the teflon rings with power steering fluid.
(c) Push the control valve into the housing.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the teflon rings and oil
seal.
(d) Coat a new oil seal with power steering fluid.
(e) Using SST, press in the new oil seal.
SST 09612–22011
8. INSTALL CONTROL VALVE HOUSING
(a) Place a new gasket on the rack housing.
(b) Align the matchmarks on the valve housing and rack
housing.
(c) Torque the 2 bolts.
Torque: 18 N–m (185 kgf–cm, 13 ft–lbf)
(d) Install the dust cover.
9. INSTALL SELF– LOCKING NUT
Using SST to hold the control valve, install a new self
–locking nut.
SST 09616 – 00010
Torque: 25 N–m (250 kgf–cm, 18 ft–lbf)
NOTICE: Take care to avoid tightening the rack more
than needed.
SR–69
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
10. INSTALL RACK HOUSING CAP
(a) Apply sealant to 2 or 3 threads of the housing cap.
Sealant:
Part No.08833 – 00080, THREE BOND 1344, LOC–
TITE 242 or equivalent
(b) Install the rack housing cap.
Torque: 59 N–m (600 kgf–cm, 43 ft–Ibf)
(c) Using a center punch, stake the housing at 2 places.
11. INSTALL RACK GUIDE SEAT, RACK GUIDE AND
SPRING
(a) Coat the fitting surfaces between the rack guide seat
and the rack guide with grease.
(b) Install the rack guide seat, rack guide and spring.
12. ADJUST TOTAL PRELOAD
(a) Apply sealant to 2 or 3 threads of the spring cap.
Sealant:
Part No.08833–00080, THREE BOND 1344, LOC–
TITE 242 or equivalent
(b) Using SST, install and torque the spring cap.
SST 09631 –10021
Torque: 25 N–m (250 kgf–cm, 18 ft–Ibf)
(c) Using SST, return the rack guide spring cap 12.
SST 09631–10021
(d) Turn the control valve shaft right and left 1 or 2 times.
(e) Loosen the spring cap until the rack guide compres–
sion spring is not functioning.
SR–70
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
(f) Using SST and torque meter, tighten the rack guide
spring cap until the preload is within specification.
SST 09616–00010, 09631 –10021
Preload (turning):
0.8–1.4 N–m (8–14 kgf–cm, 6.9–12.2 in.–Ibf)
13. INSTALL RACK GUIDE SPRING CAP LOCK NUT
(a) Apply sealant to 2 or 3 threads of the lock nut.
Sealant:
Part No.08833–00080, THREE BOND 1344, LOC–
TITE 242 or equivalent
(b) Using SST, install and torque the lock nut.
SST 09612–24014 (09617–24020),
09631–10021
Torque: 55 N–m (560 kgf–cm. 41 ft–lbf)
HINT: Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of
300 mm (11.81 in.).
(c) Recheck the total preload.
14. INSTALL RACK ENDS
(a) Install a new claw washer.
(b) Using SST, install the rack ends.
SST 09617 –14010
Torque: 72 N–m (730 kgf–cm, 53 ft–lbf)
HINT: Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of
340 mm (13.39 in.).
(c) Using a brass bar and hammer, stake the claw wash–
ers.
SR–71
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING
15. INSTALL RACK BOOTS
(a) Ensure that the tube hole is not clogged with grease.
HINT: If the tube hole is clogged, the pressure inside
the boot will change after it is assembled and the
steering wheel turned.
(b) Install the boots.
HINT: Be careful not to damage or twist the boot.
(c) install the clamps and clips.
16. INSTALL TIE ROD ENDS
(a) Screw the lock nuts and tie rod ends onto the rack
ends until the matchmarks are aligned.
(b) After adjusting toe–in, torque the lock nut.
Torque: 74 N–m (750 kgf–cm, 54 ft–lbf)
17. INSTALL RIGHT AND LEFT TURN PRESSURE
TUBES
(a) Install new O–rings to the tube.
(b) Using SST, install and torque the tubes.
SST 09633–00020
Torque: 11 N–m (110 kgf–cm, 8 ft–lbf)
HINT: Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of
300 mm (11.81 in.).
SR–72
STEERING
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE DATA
Steering wheel freeplay (Maximum)
PS ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
Drive belt tension 1 MZ– FE (New belt)
Drive belt tension 1 MZ–FE (Used belt)
Drive belt tension 5S–FE (New belt)
Drive belt tension 5S–FE (Used belt)
Maximum rise of oil level
Oil pressure at idle speed with valve closed (Minimum) 1 MZ–FE
Oil pressure at idle speed with valve closed (Minimum) 5S–FE
Steering effort at idle speed (Maximum)
PS PUMP
Rotor shaft bushing oil clearance (STD) 1 MZ– FE
Rotor shaft bushing oil clearance (Maximum) 1 MZ–FE
Vane plate to rotor groove clearance (Maximum) 1 MZ–FE
Rotor shaft bushing oil clearance (STD) 5S–FE
Rotor shaft bushing oil clearance (Maximum) 5S–FE
Vane plate to rotor groove clearance (Maximum) 5S–FE
Vane plate length (Minimum) 1 MZ–FE for PS
Vane plate height (Minimum) 1 MZ–FE for PS
Vane plate thickness (Minimum) 1 MZ–FE for PS
Vane plate length (Minimum) 1 MZ–FE for Hydraulic cooling fan
Vane plate height (Minimum) 1 MZ–FE for Hydraulic cooling fan
Vane plate thickness (Minimum) 1 MZ–FE for Hydraulic cooling fan
Vane plate length (Minimum) 5S–FE
Vane plate height (Minimum) 5S–FE
Vane plate thickness (Minimum) 5S–FE
Vane plate length 1 MZ–FE for PS
(Cam ring mark) (Rotor mark)
Vane plate length 1 MZ–FE for Hydraulic cooling fan
(Cam ring mark) (Rotor mark)
Vane plate length 5S–FE
(Cam ring and rotor mark)
None
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SR–73
STEERING
Flow control valve spring length (STD) 1 MZ–FE
Flow control valve spring length (Minimum) 1 MZ–FE
Flow control valve spring length (STD) 5S–FE
Flow control valve spring length (Minimum) 5S–FE
Pump rotating torque (Maximum)
PS GEAR HOUSING
Steering rack runout (Maximum)
Total preload (Turning)
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part tightened
STEERING COLUMN
Steering main shaft x Sliding yoke
Column bracket x Body
Steering wheel
Wheel pad
Tilt lever x Column tube
POWER STEERING PUMP FOR 1 MZ–FE
Pressure port union x Pump housing
Suction port union x Pump housing
Front housing x Rear housing
Control valve assy
Pump puIly x Pump shaft
Pressure tube x Pressure port union
PS pump installation bolt
POWER STEERING PUMP FOR 5S–FE
Pressure port union x Pump housing
Suction port union x Pump housing
Pump puIly x Pump shaft
PS pump installation bolt (Adjusting bolt)
PS pump installation bolt (Through bolt)
PS pump x Pressure tube
POWER STEERING GEAR HOUSING
Control valve housing x Rack housing
Control valve self–locking nut
Rack housing cap
Lock nut
Rack x Rack end
Tie rod end lock nut
Turn pressure tube union nut
Gear housing x Sub frame
Control valve shaft x Sliding yoke
Pressure and return tube x Gear housing
Tie rod end x Steering knuckle
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
ST–1
STARTING SYSTEM
–
STARTING SYSTEM
ST–2
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
(5S–FE)
DESCRIPTION
The starter is a reduction type with a small, high–speed motor used to drive the pinion gear.
ST–3
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
SYSTEM CIRCUIT
OPERATION
When the ignition switch is turned to START position, current flows from terminal 50 to the coil
of the solenoid and the plunger is pulled by the magnetic force of the coil. When the plunger is
pulled to the left, the contact plate of the plunger allows current from the battery to flow directly
from terminal 30 to the motor, and the starter rotates.
When the engine is running and the ignition switch is returned to ON, the magnetic force of the
coil disappears and the contact plate of the plunger is returned to its original position by the
return spring. Battery voltage no longer flows from terminal 30, so the motor stops.
ST–4
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
PREPARATION
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
09286–46011 Injection Pump Spline Shaft
Puller
Armature bearing
09820–00030 Alternator Rear Bearing Replacer
Armature front bearing
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082–00050 TOYOTA Electrical Tester set
EQUIPMENT
Dial indicator
Commutator
Magnetic finger
Pull scale
Brush spring
Sandpaper
Commutator
Torque wrench
V – block
Vernier calipers
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
NOTICE: Before changing the starter, check the following Items again:
• Connector connection
• Accessory Installation, e.g.: theft deterrent system
Commutator, Brush
ST–5
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
STARTER
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
STARTER REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable Is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. w/ CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM:
REMOVE BATTERY
ST–6
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
3. w/ CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM:
REMOVE CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
(a) Remove the actuator cover.
(b) Disconnect the actuator connector.
(c) Remove the 3 bolts and cruise control actuator.
4. REMOVE STARTER
(a) Disconnect the starter connector.
(b) Remove the nut, and disconnect the starter wire.
(c) Remove the 2 bolts and starter.
ST–7
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(5S – FE)
COMPONENTS FOR DISASSEMBLY AND
ASSEMBLY
ST–8
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
STARTER DISASSEMBLY
(See Components for Disassembly and Assembly)
1. REMOVE DUST PROTECTOR
2. REMOVE FIELD FRAME AND ARMATURE
(a) Remove the nut, and disconnect the lead wire from
the magnetic switch terminal.
(b) Remove the 2 through bolts, and pull out the field
frame together with the armature.
(c) Remove the O–ring from the field frame.
3. REMOVE STARTER HOUSING, CLUTCH
ASSEMBLY AND GEAR
(a) Remove the 2 screws.
(b)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Remove the following parts from the magnetic switch:
Starter housing and clutch assembly
Return spring
Idler gear
Bearing
4. REMOVE STEEL BALL
Using a magnetic finger, remove the steel ball from
the clutch shaft hole.
ST–9
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
REMOVE BRUSH HOLDER
(a) Remove the 2 screws, 2 O–rings and end cover from
the field frame.
(b) Remove the O–ring from the field frame.
(c) Using a screwdriver, hold the spring back and discon–
nect the brush from the brush holder.
Disconnect the 4 brushes, and remove the brush
holder.
6. REMOVE ARMATURE FROM FIELD FRAME
STARTER INSPECTION AND REPAIR
Armature Coil
1. INSPECT COMMUTATOR FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between the segments of the commutator.
If there is no continuity between any segment, replace
the armature.
2. INSPECT COMMUTATOR FOR GROUND
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity
between the commutator and armature coil core.
If there is continuity, replace the armature.
ST–10
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
Commutator
1. INSPECT COMMUTATOR FOR DIRTY AND BURNT
SURFACES
If the surface is dirty or burnt, correct it with sandpa–
per (No.400) or on a lathe.
2. INSPECT COMMUTATOR CIRCLE RUNOUT
(a) Place the commutator on V – blocks.
(b) Using a dial gauge, measure the circle runout.
Maximum circle runout:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the circle runout is greater than maximum, correct it
on a lathe.
3. INSPECT COMMUTATOR4R DIAMETER
Using a vernier caliper, measure the commutator di–
ameter.
Standard diameter:
30 mm (1.18 In.)
Minimum diameter:
29 mm (1.14 in.)
If the diameter is less than minimum, replace the
armature.
4. INSPECT UNDERCUT DEPTH
Check that the undercut depth is clean and free of
foreign materials. Smooth out the edge.
Standard undercut depth:
0.6 mm (0.024 in.)
Minimum undercut depth:
0.2 mm 10.008 In.)
If the undercut depth is less than minimum, correct it
with a hacksaw blade.
Field Frame (Field Coil)
1. INSPECT FIELD COIL FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between the lead wire and field coil brush lead.
If there is no continuity, replace the field frame.
ST–11
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
2. INSPECT FIELD COIL FOR GROUND
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity
between the field coil end and field frame.
If there is continuity, repair or replace the field frame.
Brushes
INSPECT BRUSH LENGTH
Using a vernier caliper, measure the brush length.
Standard length:
15.5 mm (O.610 In.)
Minimum length:
8.5 mm (0.335 in.)
If the length is less than minimum, replace the brush
holder and field frame.
Brush Springs
INSPECT BRUSH SPRING LOAD
Take the pull scale reading the instant the brush
spring separates from the brush.
Spring installed load:
18–24N(1.79–2.41kgf,3.9–5.31bf)
If the installed load is not within specification, replace
the brush springs.
Brush Holder
INSPECT BRUSH HOLDER INSULATION
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity
between the positive (+).and negative (–) brush hol–
ders.
If there is continuity, repair or replace the brush
holder.
ST–12
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(5S– FE)
Clutch and Gears
1. INSPECT GEAR TEETH
Check the gear teeth on the pinion gear, idle gear and
clutch assembly for wear or damage.
If damaged, replace the gear or clutch assembly.
If damaged, also check the drive plate ring gear for
wear or damage.
2. INSPECT CLUTCH PINION GEAR
Hold the starter clutch and rotate the pinion gear
counterclockwise, and check that it turns freely. Try
to rotate the pinion gear clockwise and check that it
locks.
If necessary, replace the clutch assembly.
3. IF NECESSARY, REPLACE CLUTCH ASSEMBLY
A. Disassemble starter housing and clutch assembly
(a) Mount a brass bar in a vise, and install the starter
housing and clutch assembly to the brass bar.
(b) Push down the pinion gear.
(c) Using a plastic–faced hammer, tap down the stop
collar.
(d) Using a screwdriver, pry out the snap ring.
ST–13
STARTING SYSTEM
(e)
(1)
(2)
(3)
–
(5S–FE)
Remove the following parts:
Stop collar
Pinion gear
Compression spring
(f) Push down the starter housing, and remove the spring
retainer.
(g)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Disassemble the following parts:
Starter housing
Starter clutch
Compression spring
Clutch shaft
B. Assemble starter housing and clutch assembly
(a) Assemble the following parts:
(1) Starter housing
(2) Starter clutch
(3) Compression spring
(4) Clutch shaft
(b) Mount a brass bar in a vise, install the starter housing
and clutch assembly to the brass bar.
ST–14
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
(c) Push down the starter housing, and install the follow–
ing parts:
(1) Spring retainer
(2) Compression spring
(3) Pinion gear
(4) Stop collar
(d) Push down the pinion gear.
(e) Using snap ring pliers, install a new snap ring.
(f) Using pliers, compress the snap ring.
(g) Check that the snap ring fits correctly.
(h) Remove the starter housing and clutch assembly from
the brass bar.
(i) Using a plastic–faced hammer, tap the clutch shaft
and install the stop collar onto the snap ring.
Bearings
1. INSPECT REAR BEARINGS
Turn each bearing by hand while applying inward
force.
If resistance is felt or the bearing sticks, replace the
bearing.
ST–15
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
2. IF NECESSARY, REPLACE REAR BEARING
(a) Using SST, remove the bearing.
SST 09286–46011
(b) Using a press, press in a new front bearing.
3. INSPECT FRONT BEARING
Turn each bearing by hand while applying inward
force.
If resistance is felt or the bearing sticks, replace the
bearing.
4. IF NECESSARY, REPLACE FRONT BEARING
(a) Using SST, remove the bearing.
SST 09286 – 46011
(b) Using SST and a press, press in a new bearing.
NOTICE: Be careful of the bearing Installation direction.
SST 09820–00030
ST–16
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(5S– FE)
Magnetic Switch
1. PERFORM PULL–IN COIL OPEN CIRCUIT TEST
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals 50 and C.
If there is no continuity, replace the magnetic switch.
2. PERFORM HOLD–IN COIL OPEN CIRCUIT TEST
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminal 50 and the switch body.
If there is no continuity, replace the magnetic switch.
STARTER ASSEMBLY
(See Components for Disassembly and Assembly)
HINT: Use high–temperature grease to lubricate the
bearings and gears when assembling the starter.
1. PLACE ARMATURE INTO FIELD FRAME
Apply grease to the armature bearings, and insert the
armature into the field frame.
2. INSTALL BRUSH HOLDER
(a) Place the brush holder in position on the armature.
(b) Using a screwdriver, hold the brush spring back, and
connect the brush into the brush holder. Connect the
4 brushes.
NOTICE: Check that the positive (+) lead wires are not
grounded.
(c) Place a new O–ring in position on the field frame.
ST–17
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
(d) Install a new O–ring to the screw.
(e) Install the end cover to the field frame with the 2
screws.
Torque: 1.5 N⋅m (15 kgf⋅cm, 13 in.⋅Ibf)
3. INSERT STEEL BALL INTO CLUTCH SHAFT HOLE
(a) Apply grease to the steel ball.
(b) Insert the steel ball into the clutch shaft hole.
4. INSTALL STARTER HOUSING, CLUTCH ASSEM–
BLY AND GEAR
(a) Apply grease to the return spring.
(b) Insert the return spring into the magnetic switch hole.
(c) Place the following parts in position on the starter
housing:
(1) Idler gear
(2) Retainer
(d) Install the starter housing to the magnetic switch with
the 2 screws.
Torque: 5.9 N⋅m (60 kgf⋅cm. 62 in.⋅lbf)
ST–18
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(5S– FE)
5. INSTALL FIELD FRAME AND ARMATURE
ASSEMBLY
(a) Place a new O–ring in position on the field frame.
(b) Align the protrusion of the field frame with the cutout
of the magnetic switch.
(c) Install the field frame and armature assembly with the
2 through bolts.
Torque: 6.9 N⋅m (60 kgf⋅cm, 52 in.⋅lbf)
(d) Connect the lead wire to terminal C, and install the
nut.
Torque: 7.9 N⋅m (81 kgf⋅cm, 70 In.⋅Ibf)
6. INSTALL DUST PROTECTOR
ST–19
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
STARTER PERFORMANCE TEST
NOTICE: These tests must be performed within 3 to 5
seconds to avoid burning out the coil.
1. PERFORM PULL–IN TEST
(a) Disconnect the field coil lead wire from terminal C.
(b) Connect the battery to the magnetic switch as shown.
Check that the clutch pinion gear moves outward.
If the clutch pinion gear does not move, replace the
magnetic switch assembly.
2. PERFORM HOLD–IN TEST
With battery connected as above with the clutch
pinion gear out, disconnect the negative (–) lead from
terminal C. Check that the pinion gear remains out.
If the clutch pinion gear returns inward, replace the
magnetic switch assembly.
3. INSPECT CLUTCH PINION GEAR RETURN
Disconnect the negative (–) lead from the switch
body.
Check that the clutch pinion gear returns inward.
If the clutch pinion gear does not return, replace the
magnetic switch assembly.
4. PERFORM NO–LOAD PERFORMANCE TEST
(a) Connect the battery and ammeter to the starter as
shown.
(b) Check that the starter rotates smoothly and steadily
with the pinion gear moving out. Check that the am–
meter shows the specified current.
Specified current:
90 A or less at11.6V
ST–20
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
STARTER INSTALLATION
(See Components for Removal and Installation)
1. INSTALL STARTER
(a) Install the starter with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 39 N⋅m (400 kgf⋅cm, 29 ft⋅lbf)
(b) Connect the starter wire with the nut.
(c) Connect the starter connector.
2. w/ CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM:
INSTALL CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
(a) Install the cruise control actuator with the 3 bolts.
(b) Connect the actuator connector.
(c) Install the actuator cover.
3. w/ CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM:
INSTALL BATTERY
4. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE TO
BATTERY
6. CHECK THAT ENGINE STARTS
ST–21
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
STARTER RELAY
STARTER RELAY INSPECTION
1. REMOVE STARTER RELAY
2. INSPECT STARTER RELAY
A. Inspect relay continuity
(a) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals 1 and 2.
(b) Check that there is no continuity between terminals 3
and 5.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
B. Inspect relay operation
(a) Apply battery voltage across terminals 1 and 2.
(b) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals 3 and 5.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
3. REINSTALL STARTERT RELAY
ST–22
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(5S–FE)
CLUTCH START SWITCH
(M/T)
(See page CL–7)
PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION (PNP) SWITCH
(A/T)
(See page AX–92)
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE DATA
Starter
Rated voltage and output power
No–load characteristics
Brush length
Spring installed load
Commutator
Diameter
Undercut depth
Circle runout
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Pert tightened
End cover x Brush holder
Starter housing x Magnetic switch
End cover x Starter housing (Through bolt)
Lead wire x Terminal C of starter
Starter x Transaxle
ST–23
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ – FE)
(1 MZ–FE)
DESCRIPTION
The starter is a reduction type with a small, high–speed motor used to drive the pinion gear.
ST–24
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ – FE)
SYSTEM CIRCUIT
OPERATION
When the ignition switch is turned to START position, current flows from terminal 50 to the coil
of the solenoid and the plunger is pulled by the magnetic force of the coil. When the plunger is
pulled to the left, the contact plate of the plunger allows current from the battery to flow directly
from terminal 30 to the motor, and the starter rotates.
When the engine is running and the ignition switch is returned to ON, the magnetic force of the
coil disappears and the contact plate of the plunger is returned to its original position by the
return spring. Battery voltage no longer flows from terminal 30, so the motor stops.
ST–25
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ – FE)
PREPARATION
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
09286–46011 Injection Pump Spline Shaft
Puller
Armature bearing
09820–00030 Alternator Rear Bearing Replacer
Armature front bearing
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082–00050 TOYOTA Electrical Tester set
EQUIPMENT
Dial indicator
Commutator
Magnetic finger
Steel bell
Pull scale
Brush spring
Sandpaper
Commutator
Torque wrench
V–block
Commutator
Vernier calipers
Commutator, Brush
ON –VEHICLE INSPECTION
NOTICE: Before changing the starter, check the following items again:
• Connector connection
• Accessory installation, e.g.: theft deterrent system
ST–26
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ – FE)
STARTER
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION
STATER REMOVAL
(See Components for Removal and installation)
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch is turned to the ”LOCK”
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is dis–
connected from the battery.
2. w/ CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM:
REMOVE BATTERY AND TRAY
ST–27
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ – FE)
3. w/ CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM:
REMOVE CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
(a) Remove the bolt, clip and actuator cover.
(b) Disconnect the actuator connector and clamp.
(c) Remove the 3 bolts, and disconnect the actuator with
the bracket.
4. REMOVE STARTER
(a) Disconnect the starter connector.
(b) Remove the nut, and disconnect the starter wire.
(c) Remove the 2 bolts and starter.
ST–28
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ – FE)
COMPONENTS FOR DISASSEMBLY AND
ASSEMBLY
ST–29
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ – FE)
STARTER DISASSEMBLY
(See Components for Disassembly and Assembly)
1. REMOVE DUST PROTECTOR
2. REMOVE FIELD FRAME AND ARMATURE
(a) Remove the nut, and disconnect the lead wire from
the magnetic switch terminal.
(b) Remove the 2 through bolts, and pull out the field
frame together with the armature.
(c) Remove the O–ring from the field frame.
3. REMOVE STARTER HOUSING, CLUTCH
ASSEMBLY AND GEAR
(a) Remove the 2 screws.
(b)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Remove the following parts from the magnetic switch:
Starter housing and clutch assembly
Return spring
Idler gear
Bearing
4. REMOVE STEEL BALL
Using a magnetic finger, remove the steel ball from
the clutch shaft hole.
ST–30
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ – FE)
5. REMOVE BRUSH HOLDER
(a) Remove the 2 screws, 2 O–rings and end cover from
the field frame.
(b) Remove the O–ring from the field frame.
(c) Using a screwdriver, hold the spring back and discon–
nect the brush from the brush holder.
Disconnect the 4 brushes, and remove the brush
holder.
6. REMOVE ARMATURE FROM FIELD FRAME
STARTER INSPECTION AND REPAIR
Armature Coil
1. INSPECT COMMUTATOR FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between the segments of the commutator.
If there is no continuity between any segment, replace
the armature.
2. INSPECT COMMUTATOR FOR GROUND
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity
between the commutator and armature coil core.
If there is continuity, replace the armature.
ST–31
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ – FE)
Commutator
1. INSPECT COMMUTATOR FOR DIRTY AND BURNT
SURFACES
If the surface is dirty or burnt, correct it with sandpaper
(No.400) or on a lathe.
2. INSPECT COMMUTATOR CIRCLE RUNOUT
(a) Place the commutator on V – blocks.
(b) Using a dial gauge, measure the circle runout.
Maximum circle runout:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the circle runout is greater than maximum, correct it
on a lathe.
3. INSPECT COMMUTATOR DIAMETER
Using a vernier caliper, measure the commutator diameter.
Standard diameter:
30.0 mm 0.181 In.)
Minimum diameter:
29.0 mm (1.142 In.)
If the diameter is less than minimum, replace the
armature.
4. INSPECT UNDERCUT DEPTH
Check that the undercut depth is clean and free of
foreign materials. Smooth out the edge.
Standard undercut depth:
0.6 mm (0.024 In.)
Minimum undercut depth:
0.2 mm (0.008 In.)
If the undercut depth is less than minimum, correct it
with a hacksaw blade.
Field Frame (Field Coil)
1. INSPECT FIELD COIL FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between the lead wire and field coil brush lead.
If there is no continuity, replace the field frame.
ST–32
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ – FE)
2. INSPECT FIELD COIL FOR GROUND
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity
between the field coil end and field frame.
If there is continuity, repair or replace the field frame.
Brushes
INSPECT BRUSH LENGTH
Using a vernier caliper, measure the brush length.
Standard length:
15.5 mm (O.610 In.)
Minimum length:
8.5 mm (0.335 In.)
If the length is less than minimum, replace the brush
holder and field frame.
Brush Springs
INSPECT BRUSH SPRING LOAD
Take the pull scale reading the instant the brush
spring separates from the brush.
Spring installed load:
18 – 24 N (1.79 – 2.41 kgf. 3.9 – 5.3 Ibf)
If the installed load is not within specification, replace
the brush springs.
Brush Holder
INSPECT BRUSH HOLDER INSULATION
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity
between the positive (+) and negative (–) brush hol–
ders.
If there is continuity, repair or replace the brush
holder.
ST–33
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ – FE)
Clutch and Gears
1. INSPECT GEAR TEETH
Check the gear teeth on the pinion gear, idler gear and
clutch assembly for wear or damage.
If damaged, replace the gear or clutch assembly.
If damaged, also check the drive plate ring gear for
wear or damage.
2. INSPECT CLUTCH PINION GEAR
Hold the starter clutch and rotate the pinion gear
counterclockwise, and check that it turns freely. Try
to rotate the pinion gear clockwise and check that it
locks.
If necessary, replace the clutch assembly.
3. IF NECESSARY, REPLACE CLUTCH ASSEMBLY
A. Disassembly of starter housing and clutch assembly
(a) Mount a brass bar in a vise, and install the starter
housing and clutch assembly to the brass bar.
(b) Push down the pinion gear.
(c) Using a plastic–faced hammer, tap down the stop
collar.
(d) Using a screwdriver, pry out the snap ring.
ST–34
STARTING SYSTEM
(e)
(1)
(2)
(3)
–
(1MZ – FE)
Remove the following parts:
Stop collar
Pinion gear
Compression spring
(f) Push down the starter housing, and remove the spring
retainer.
(g)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Disassemble the following parts:
Starter housing
Starter clutch
Compression spring
Clutch shaft
B. Assemble starter housing and clutch assembly
(a) Assemble the following parts:
(1) Starter housing
(2) Starter clutch
(3) Compression spring
(4) Clutch shaft
(b) Mount a brass bar in a vise, install the starter housing
and clutch assembly to the brass bar.
ST–35
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ – FE)
(c) Push down the starter housing, and install the follow–
ing parts:
(1) Spring retainer
(2) Compression spring
(3) Pinion gear
(4) Stop collar
(d) Push down the pinion gear.
(e) Using snap ring pliers, install a new snap ring.
(f) Using pliers, compress the snap ring.
(g) Check that the snap ring fits correctly.
(h) Remove the starter housing and clutch assembly from
the brass bar.
(i) Using a plastic–faced hammer, tap the clutch shaft
and install the stop collar onto the snap ring.
Bearings
1. INSPECT REAR BEARINGS
Turn each bearing by hand while applying inward
force.
If resistance is felt or the bearing sticks, replace the
bearing.
ST–36
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ – FE)
2. IF NECESSARY, REPLACE REAR BEARING
(a) Using SST, remove the bearing.
SST 09286–46011
(b) Using a press, press in a new front bearing.
3. INSPECT FRONT BEARING
Turn each bearing by hand while applying inward
force.
If resistance is felt or the bearing sticks, replace the
bearing.
4. IF NECESSARY, REPLACE FRONT BEARING
(a) Using SST, remove the bearing.
SST 09286–46011
(b) Using SST and a press, press in a new bearing.
NOTICE: Be careful of the bearing Installation direction.
SST 09820–00030
ST–37
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ – FE)
Magnetic Switch
1. PERFORM PULL–IN COIL OPEN CIRCUIT TEST
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals 50 and C.
If there is no continuity, replace the magnetic switch.
2. PERFORM HOLD –IN COIL OPEN CIRCUIT TEST
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminal 50 and the switch body.
If there is no continuity, replace the magnetic switch.
STARTER ASSEMBLY
(See Components for Disassembly and Assembly)
HINT: Use high –temperature grease to lubricate the
bearings and gears when assembling the starter.
1. PLACE ARMATURE INTO FIELD FRAME
Apply grease to the armature bearings, and insert the
armature into the field frame.
2. INSTALL BRUSH HOLDER
(a) Place the brush holder in position on the armature.
(b) Using a screwdriver, hold the brush spring back, and
connect the brush into the brush holder. Connect the
4 brushes..
NOTICE: Check that the positive (+) load wires are not
grounded.
(c) Place a new O–ring in position on the field frame.
ST–38
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ – FE)
(d) Install a new 0 – ring to the screw.
(e) Install the end cover to the field frame with the 2
screws.
Torque: 1.5 N⋅m (15 kgf⋅cm, 13 in.⋅Ibf)
3. INSERT STEEL BALL INTO CLUTCH SHAFT HOLE
(a) Apply grease to the steel ball.
(b) Insert the steel ball into the clutch shaft hole.
4. INSTALL STARTER HOUSING, CLUTCH ASSEM–
BLY AND GEAR
(a) Apply grease to the return spring.
(b) Insert the return spring into the magnetic switch hole.
(c) Place the following parts in position on the starter
housing:
(1) Idler gear
(2) Retainer
(d) Install the starter housing to the magnetic switch with
the 2 screws.
Torque: 5.9 N⋅m (60 kgf⋅cm, 52 In.⋅Ibf)
ST–39
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ – FE)
5. INSTALL FIELD FRAME AND ARMATURE
ASSEMBLY
(a) Place a new 0 – ring in position on the field frame.
(b) Align the protrusion of the field frame with the cutout
of the magnetic switch.
(c) Install the field frame and armature assembly with the
2 through bolts.
Torque: 5.9 N⋅m (60 kgf⋅cm. 52 in.⋅Ibf)
(d) Connect the lead wire to terminal C, and install the
nut.
Torque: 7.9 N⋅m (87 kgf⋅cm, 70 in.⋅lbf)
ST–40
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ – FE)
STARTER PERFORMANCE TEST
NOTICE: These tests must be performed within 3 to 5
seconds to avoid burning out the coil.
1. PERFORM PULL–IN TEST
(a) Disconnect the field coil lead wire from terminal C.
(b) Connect the battery to the magnetic switch as shown.
Check that the clutch pinion gear moves outward.
If the clutch pinion gear does not move, replace the
magnetic switch assembly.
2. PERFORM HOLD–IN TEST
With battery connected as above with the clutch
pinion gear out, disconnect the negative (–) lead from
terminal C. Check that the pinion gear remains out.
If the clutch pinion gear returns inward, replace the
magnetic switch assembly.
3. INSPECT CLUTCH PINION GEAR RETURN
Disconnect the negative (–) lead from the switch
body.
Check that the clutch pinion gear returns inward.
If the clutch pinion gear does not return, replace the
magnetic switch assembly.
4. PERFORM NO –LOAD PERFORMANCE TEST
(a) Connect the battery and ammeter to the starter as
shown.
(b) Check that the starter rotates smoothly and steadily
with the pinion gear moving out. Check that the am–
meter shows the specified current.
Specified current:
90 A or less at 11.5 V
ST–41
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ – FE)
STARTER INSTALLATION
(See Components for Remove and Installation)
1. INSTALL STARTER
(a) Install the starter with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 39 N⋅m (400 kgf⋅cm. 29 ft⋅lbf)
(b) Connect the starter wire with the nut.
(c) Connect the starter connector.
2. w/ CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM:
INSTALL CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
(a) Connect the actuator and bracket with the 3 bolts.
(b) Connect the actuator connector and clamp.
(c) Install the actuator cover with the bolt and clip.
3. w/ CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM:
INSTALL BATTERY TRAY AND BATTERY
4. CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
TO BATTERY
5. CHECK THAT ENGINE STARTS
ST–42
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ – FE)
STARTER RELAY
STARTER RELAY INSPECTION
1. DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
CAUTION: Work must be started after 90 seconds from
the time the ignition switch Is turned to the ’LOCK’
position and the negative (–) terminal cable is discon–
nected from the battery.
2. REMOVE STARTER RELAY
LOCATION: In the engine compartment relay box.
Remove the relay box cover and starter relay.
3. INSPECT STARTER RELAY
A. Inspect relay continuity
(a) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals 1 and 2.
(b) Check that there is no continuity between terminals 3
and 5.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
B. Inspect relay operation
(a) Apply battery voltage across terminals 1 and 2.
(b) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals 3 and 5.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
4. REINSTALL STARTER RELAY
6. RECONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
TO BATTERY
ST–43
STARTING SYSTEM
–
(1MZ – FE)
PARK NEUTRAL POSITION (PNP) SWITCH
(See page AX–116)
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE DATA
Starter
Rated voltage and output power
No–load characteristics
Brush length
Spring installed load
Commutator
Diameter
Undercut depth
Circle runout
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part tightened
End cover x Field frame
Starter housing x Magnetic switch
Field frame x Armature assembly
Lead wire x Terminal C of starter
Starter mounting bolt
FOREWORD
This wiring diagram manual has been prepared to provide
information on the electrical system of the 1994 TOYOTA
CAMRY.
Applicable models:
SXV10 Series
MCV10 Series
For service specifications and repair procedures of the above
models other than those listed in this manual, refer to the
following manuals;
Pub. No.
Manual Name
1994 CAMRY Repair Manual
Volume 1
Volume 2
1994 Model New Car Features
RM361U1
RM361U2
NCF099U
All information in this manual is based on the latest product
information at the time of publication. However, specifications
and procedures are subject to change without notice.
TOYOTA MOTOR CORPORATION
NOTICE
When handling supplemental restraint system components (removal,
installation or inspection, etc.), always follow the direction given in the repair
manuals listed above to prevent accidents and supplemental restraint
system malfunction.
1
INTRODUCTION
This manual consists of the following 11 sections:
No.
Section
Description
INDEX
Index of the contents of this manual.
INTRODUCTION
Brief explanation of each section.
B
HOW TO USE
THIS MANUAL
Instructions on how to use this manual.
C
TROUBLE–
SHOOTING
Describes the basic inspection procedures for electrical circuits.
D
ABBREVIATIONS
Defines the abbreviations used in this manual.
E
GLOSSARY OF
TERMS AND
SYMBOLS
Defines the symbols and functions of major parts.
F
RELAY LOCATIONS
Shows position of the Electronic Control Unit, Relays, Relay Block, etc.
This section is closely related to the system circuit.
G
ELECTRICAL
WIRING ROUTING
Describes position of Parts Connectors, Splice points, Ground points, etc.
This section is closely related to the system circuit.
H
POWER SOURCE
(Current Flow Chart)
Describes power distribution from the power supply to various electrical
loads.
INDEX
Index of the system circuits.
SYSTEM CIRCUITS
Electrical circuits of each system are shown from the power supply through
ground points. Wiring connections and their positions are shown and
classified by code according to the connection method. (Refer to the
section, “How to use this manual”).
The “System Outline” and “Service Hints” useful for troubleshooting are
also contained in this section.
J
GROUND POINTS
Shows ground positions of all parts described in this manual.
K
OVERALL
WIRING DIAGRAM
Provides circuit diagrams showing the circuit connections.
A
I
2
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
This manual provides information on the electrical circuits installed on vehicles by
dividing them into a circuit for each system.
The actual wiring of each system circuit is shown from the point where the power source
is received from the battery as far as each ground point. (All circuit diagrams are shown
with the switches in the OFF position.)
When troubleshooting any problem, first understand the operation of the circuit where
the problem was detected (see System Circuit section), the power source supplying
power to that circuit (see Power Source section), and the ground points (see Ground
Points section). See the System Outline to understand the circuit operation.
When the circuit operation is understood, begin troubleshooting of the problem circuit
to isolate the cause. Use Relay Location and Electrical Wire Routing sections to find
each part, junction block and wiring harness connectors, wiring harness and wiring
harness connectors, splice points, and ground points of each system circuit. Internal
wiring for each junction block is also provided for better understanding of connection
within a junction block.
Wiring related to each system is indicated in each system circuit by arrows (from
, to ). When overall connections are required, see the Overall Wiring Diagram
at the end of this manual.
3
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
* The system shown here is an EXAMPLE ONLY. It is different to the
actual circuit shown in the SYSTEM CIRCUITS SECTION.
4
A
: System Title
B
: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only
the Relay Block No. is shown to distinguish it from the
J/B.
Example:
C
J
: Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the
numeral indicates the pin No.)
B
= Black
L
BR
= Brown
LG = Light Green
V
G
= Green
O
= Orange
W = White
P
= Pink
Y
GR = Gray
Explanation of pin use.
= Blue
= Violet
= Yellow
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the
second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Example:
L–Y
(Blue)
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only
include those in the specification.
D
R = Red
K
: Connector Color
(Yellow)
: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are “E” for the
Engine Room, “I” for the Instrument Panel, and “B” for
the Body).
Example:
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E
F
G
: (
) is used to indicate different wiring and connector,
etc. when the vehicle model, engine type, or
specification is different.
: Indicates related system.
: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness
connector. The wiring harness with male terminal is
shown with arrows (
).
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the
shaded section.
Outside numerals are pin numbers.
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and
wiring harness connector(s) indicates the component’s
location, e.g., “E” for the Engine Compartment, “I” for the
Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and “B” for the
Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second
letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g., IH1, IH2),
this indicates the same type of wiring harness and
wiring harness connector.
H
: Represents a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The
code is the same as the code used in parts position.
I
: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No.
and the connector code is shown beside it). Junction
Blocks are shaded to clearly separate them from other
parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for
further clarification).
L
: Page No.
M
: Indicates a shielded cable.
N
: Indicates a ground point.
The first letter of the code for each ground point(s)
indicates the component’s location, e.g., “E” for the
Engine Compartment, “I” for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and “B” for the Body and
Surrounding area.
O
: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male
connectors.
Example:
Numbered in order
from upper left to
lower right
Numbered in order
from upper right to
lower left
Example:
3B indicates
that it is inside
Junction Block
No. 3.
P
: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the
parts connector name used in the wire routing section
is shown in square brackets [
].
5
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
Q
SYSTEM OUTLINE
WITH THE IGNITION SW TURNED ON, THE CURRENT FLOWS TO TERMINAL 3 OF THE POWER WINDOW MASTER SW, TERMINAL 2 OF THE POWER WINDOW CONTROL RELAY
AND TERMINAL 8 OF THE POWER WINDOW SW THROUGH THE DOOR FUSE.
1.
DRIVER’S WINDOW “MANUAL UP” OPERATION BY MASTER SW
HOLDING MANUAL SW (DRIVER’S) ON “UP” POSITION LOCATED IN POWER WINDOW MASTER SW, THE CURRENT FLOWS TO TERMINAL 5 OF THE POWER WINDOW
CONTROL RELAY THROUGH TERMINAL 3 OF THE MASTER SW TERMINAL 2 TO OPERATE A POWER WINDOW CONTROL RELAY. THUS THE CURRENT INSIDE THE RELAY
FLOWS FROM TERMINAL 2 OF THE RELAY TERMINAL 1 TERMINAL 2 OF THE POWER WINDOW MOTOR TERMINAL 1 TERMINAL 4 OF THE RELAY TERMINAL
3 TO GROUND. THE MOTOR TURNS TO ASCENT THE WINDOW. RELEASING THIS SW, THE ROTATION OF MOTOR IS STOPPED AND THE WINDOWS CAN STOP AT WILL
POINT.
(FOR THE “MANUAL DOWN” OPERATION, CURRENT FLOWS IN THE REVERSE DIRECTION BECAUSE THE TERMINALS WHERE IT FLOWS ARE CHANGED).
2.
DRIVER’S WINDOW “AUTO DOWN” OPERATION BY MASTER SW
ONCE THE “AUTO DOWN” BUTTON OF THE MASTER SW IS PUSHED, THE CURRENT FLOWS TERMINAL 9 OF THE POWER WINDOW CONTROL RELAY THROUGH TERMINAL
3 OF THE MASTER SW TERMINALS 8 AND 9 TO OPERATE THE RELAY. THUS THE CURRENT INSIDE THE POWER WINDOW CONTROL RELAY FLOWS FROM TERMINAL
2 OF THE RELAY TERMINAL 4 TERMINAL 1 OF THE POWER WINDOW MOTOR TERMINAL 2 TERMINAL 1 OF THE RELAY TERMINAL 3 TO GROUND.
THE MOTOR CONTINUES THE ROTATION ENABLING TO DESCENT THE WINDOW.
THE WINDOW DESCENDS TO THE END POSITION. THE CURRENT WILL BE CUT OFF TO RELEASE THE AUTO DOWN FUNCTION BASED ON THE INCREASING CURRENT
BETWEEN TERMINAL 2 OF THE RELAY AND TERMINAL 1 IN RELAY.
3.
DRIVER’S WINDOW AUTO DOWN RELEASE OPERATION BY MASTER SW
HOLDING THE MANUAL SW (DRIVER’S) ON “UP” POSITION IN OPERATING AUTO DOWN. THE CURRENT FROM TERMINAL 3 OF THE MASTER SW PASSING TERMINAL 2
FLOWS TERMINAL 5 OF THE RELAY AND RELEASES THE AUTO DOWN FUNCTION IN THE POWER WINDOW CONTROL RELAY. RELEASING THE HAND FROM SW, WINDOW
STOPS AND CONTINUING ON TOUCHING SW, THE FUNCTION SWITCHES TO MANUAL UP OPERATION.
4.
PASSENGER’S WINDOW UP OPERATION (MASTER SW) AND WINDOW LOCK SW OPERATION
HOLDING PASSENGER’S WINDOW SW (MASTER SW) ON “UP”, THE CURRENT FLOWS FROM TERMINAL 3 OF THE MASTER SW PASSING TERMINAL 6 TO TERMINAL 3 OF
THE POWER WINDOW SW (PASSENGER’S) TERMINAL 4 TERMINAL 2 OF THE MOTOR TERMINAL 1 TERMINAL 9 OF THE POWER WINDOW SW TERMINAL
7 TERMINAL 1 OF THE MASTER SW TERMINAL 4 TO GROUND. THE MOTOR RUNS TO ASCENT THE WINDOW. RELEASING THIS SW, THE ROTATION OF MOTOR IS
STOPPED AND WINDOW CAN STOP AT WILL PLACE.
SWITCHING THE WINDOW LOCK SW IN “LOCK” POSITION, THE CIRCUIT IS OPENED AND STOPPED THE MOTOR ROTATION.
(FOR THE DOWN OPERATION, CURRENT FLOWS IN THE REVERSE DIRECTION BECAUSE THE TERMINALS WHERE IT FLOWS ARE CHANGED).
R
SERVICE HINTS
P2 POWER WINDOW CONTROL RELAY
3–GROUND: ALWAYS CONTINUITY
2–GROUND: APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
5–GROUND: APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION AND MASTER SW AT UP POSITION
8–GROUND: APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION AND MASTER SW AT AUTO DOWN POSITION
9–GROUND: APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION AND MASTER SW AT DOWN OR AUTO DOWN POSITION
P 4 POWER WINDOW MASTER SW
4–GROUND: ALWAYS CONTINUITY
3–GROUND: APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
WINDOW LOCK SW
OPEN WITH WINDOW LOCK SW AT LOCK POSITION
S
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
SEE PAGE
21
P4
21
P3
21
P5
21
T
: RELAY BLOCKS
CODE
SEE PAGE
1
U
16
RELAY BLOCK (RELAY BLOCK LOCATION)
R/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT SIDE)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
3B
SEE PAGE
14
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
J/B NO. 3 AND COWL WIRE (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT SIDE)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
V
CODE
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
ID1
26
FRONT DOOR RH WIRE AND COWL WIRE (RIGHT KICK PANEL)
IH1
26
FRONT DOOR LH WIRE AND COWL WIRE (LEFT KICK PANEL)
: GROUND POINTS
W
CODE
IC
X
SEE PAGE
24
GROUND POINT LOCATION
COWL LEFT
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
I5
6
CODE
P2
SEE PAGE
24
WIRE HARNESSES WITH SPLICE POINTS
COWL WIRE
CODE
P6
SEE PAGE
21
Q : Explains the system outline.
R : Indicates values or explains the function for reference during troubleshooting.
S
: Indicates the reference page showing the position on the vehicle of the parts in the system circuit.
Example: Part “P4” (Power Window Master SW) is on page 21 of the manual.
* The letter in the code is from the first letter of the part, and the number indicates its order
in parts starting with that letter.
Example: P 4
Part is 4th in order
Power Window Master SW
T
: Indicates the reference page showing the position on the vehicle of Relay Block Connectors in the
system circuit.
Example: Connector “1” is described on page 16 of this manual and is installed on the left side of the
instrument panel.
U : Indicates the reference page showing the position on the vehicle of J/B and Wire Harness in the system
circuit.
Example: Connector “3B” connects the Cowl Wire and J/B No. 3. It is described on page 14 of this
manual, and is installed on the instrument panel left side.
V
: Indicates the reference page describing the wiring harness and wiring harness connector (the female
wiring harness is shown first, followed by the male wiring harness).
Example: Connector “ID1” connects the front door RH wire (female) and cowl wire (male). It is
described on page 26 of this manual, and is installed on the right side kick panel.
W : Indicates the reference page showing the position of the ground points on the vehicle.
Example: Ground point “IC” is described on page 24 of this manual and is installed on the cowl left side.
X
: Indicates the reference page showing the position of the splice points on the vehicle.
Example: Splice point “I 5” is on the Cowl Wire Harness and is described on page 24 of this manual.
HINT:
Junction connector (code: J1, J2, J3, J4, J5,
J6, J7) in this manual include a short terminal
which is connected to a number of wire
harnesses. Always perform inspection with
the short terminal installed. (When installing
the wire harnesses, the harnesses can be
connected to any position within the short
terminal grouping.
Accordingly, in other vehicles, the same wire
harness from a different part.)
Wire harness sharing the same short terminal
grouping have the same color.
7
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
The “Current Flow Chart” section, describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit breakers)
transmits current to. In the Power Source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery power is supplied to each system are
explained. Since all System Circuit diagrams start from the power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
POWER SOURCE (Current Flow Chart)
The chart below shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit
Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
The next page and following pages show the parts to which each electrical source outputs current.
POWER SOURCE
8
* The system shown here is an EXAMPLE ONLY. It is different to the actual circuit shown in the SYSTEM CIRCUITS SECTION.
The ground points circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective ground points. When
troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use a common ground may help you identify the
problem ground quickly. The relationship between ground points (
,
, and
shown below) can also be
checked this way.
GROUND POINT
* The system shown here is an EXAMPLE ONLY. It is different to the actual circuit shown in the SYSTEM CIRCUITS SECTION.
9
TROUBLESHOOTING
VOLTAGE CHECK
(a)
Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the
check point.
Example:
(b)
– Ignition SW on
– Ignition SW and SW 1 on
– Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on (SW 2 off)
Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good
ground point or negative battery terminal, and the
positive lead to the connector or component terminal.
This check can be done with a test light instead of a
voltmeter.
CONTINUITY AND RESISTANCE CHECK
(a)
(b)
Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no
voltage between the check points.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the
check points.
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check
again.
When contacting the negative lead to the diode positive side
and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be
continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no
continuity.
(c)
10
Use a volt/ohmmeter with high impedance (10 kΩ/V
minimum) for troubleshooting of the electrical circuit.
FINDING A SHORT CIRCUIT
(a)
Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the
fuse.
(b) Connect a test light in place of the fuse.
(c) Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example:
– Ignition SW on
– Ignition SW and SW 1 on
– Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on (Connect the
Relay) and SW 2 off (or Disconnect SW 2)
(d) Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while
watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test
light stays lit and the connector where the light goes
out.
(e) Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking
the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION
(a)
(b)
Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless
absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals are touched,
the IC may be destroyed by static electricity.)
When replacing the internet mechanism (ECU part) of
the digital meter, be careful that no part of your body or
clothing comes in contact with the terminals of leads
from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
DISCONNECTION OF MALE AND FEMALE
CONNECTORS
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the
wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting
before pulling apart.
11
TROUBLESHOOTING
HOW TO REPLACE TERMINAL
(with terminal retainer or secondary locking
device)
1.
PREPARE THE SPECIAL TOOL
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please
construct and use the special tool or like object shown
on the left.
2.
DISCONNECT CONNECTOR
3.
DISENGAGE THE SECONDARY LOCKING DEVICE OR
TERMINAL RETAINER.
(a)
(b)
Locking device must be disengaged before the
terminal locking clip can be released and the terminal
removed from the connector.
Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the
secondary locking device or terminal retainer.
NOTICE:
Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
For Non–Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according
to the connector’s shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
“Case 1”
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary
lock position.
“Case 2”
Open the secondary locking device.
12
For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is
according to connector body.
different
Example:
Terminal Retainer: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White
: Black
“Case 1”
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up
to the temporary lock position (Pull Type).
Insert the special tool into the terminal
retainer access hole ( Mark) and pull the
terminal retainer up to the temporary lock
position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies
according to the connector’s shape
(Number of terminals, etc.), so check the
position before inserting it.
“Case 2”
Type which cannot be pulled as far as
Power Lock insert the tool straight into the
access hole of terminal retainer as shown.
13
TROUBLESHOOTING
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock
position.
(c)
4.
Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the
terminal out from rear.
INSTALL TERMINAL TO CONNECTOR
(a) Insert the terminal.
HINT:
1.
Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly.
2.
Insert the terminal until the locking lug locks firmly.
3.
Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the
temporary lock position.
(b)
5.
14
Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer
in to the full lock position.
CONNECT CONNECTOR
ABBREVIATIONS
ABBREVIATIONS
The following abbreviations are used in this manual.
ABS
ACIS
A/C
A/T
COMB.
C/P
ECU
EFI
EGR
ESA
Ex.
FL
IAC
ISC
J/B
LH
MFI
M/T
O/D
R/B
RH
RPM
S/D
SFI
SRS
SW
TEMP.
VSV
W/G
w/
w/o
*
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
Anti–Lock Brake System
Acoustic Control Induction System
Air Conditioning
Automatic Transmission
Combination
Coupe
Electronic Control Unit
Electronic Fuel Injection
Exhaust Gas Recirculation
Electronic Spark Advance
Except
Fusible Link
Idle Air Control
Idle Speed Control
Junction Block
Left-Hand
Multiport Fuel Injection
Manual Transmission
Overdrive
Relay Block
Right–Hand
Engine Speed
Sedan
Sequential Multiport Fuel Injection
Supplemental Restraint System
Switch
Temperature
Vacuum Switching Valve
Wagon
With
Without
The titles given inside the components are the names of the terminals (terminal codes) and
are not treated as being abbreviations.
15
GLOSSARY OF TERMS AND SYMBOLS
BATTERY
Stores chemical energy and
converts it into electrical energy.
Provides DC current for the auto’s
various electrical circuits.
CAPACITOR (Condenser)
A small holding unit for temporary
storage of electrical voltage.
HEADLIGHTS Current flow causes a headlight
filament to heat up and emit light.
1. SINGLE
A headlight may have either a
FILAMENT single (1) filament or a double (2)
filament.
2. DOUBLE
FILAMENT
HORN
An electric device which sounds a
loud audible signal.
CIGARETTE LIGHTER
An electric resistance heating
element.
CIRCUIT BREAKER
Basically a reusable fuse, a circuit
breaker will heat and open if too
much current flows through it. Some
units automatically reset when cool,
others must be manually reset.
IGNITION COIL
Converts low–voltage DC current
into high–voltage ignition current
for firing the spark plugs.
DIODE
A semiconductor which allows
current flow in only one direction.
(for Medium Current Fuse)
(for High Current Fuse or
Fusible Link.)
16
DIODE, ZENER
A diode which allows current flow
in one direction but blocks reverse
flow only up to a specific voltage.
Above that potential, it passes the
excess voltage. This acts as a
simple voltage regulator.
LIGHT
Current flow through a filament
causes the filament to heat up
and emit light.
DISTRIBUTOR, IIA
Channels high–voltage current
from the ignition coil to the
individual spark plugs.
LED (LIGHT EMITTING DIODE)
Upon current flow, these diodes
emit light without producing the
heat of a comparable light.
FUSE
A thin metal strip which burns
through when too much current
flows through it, thereby stopping
current flow and protecting a
circuit from damage.
METER, ANALOG
Current flow activates a magnetic
coil which causes a needle to
move, thereby providing a relative
display against a background
calibration.
FUSIBLE LINK
A heavy–gauge wire placed in
high amperage circuits which
burns through on overloads,
thereby protecting the circuit.
The numbers indicate the cross–
section surface area of the wires.
GROUND
The point at which wiring attaches
to the Body, thereby providing a
return path for an electrical circuit;
without a ground, current cannot
flow.
FUEL
M
METER, DIGITAL
Current flow activates one or
many LED’s, LCD’s, or fluorescent
displays, which provide a relative
or digital display.
MOTOR
A power unit which converts
electrical energy into mechanical
energy, especially rotary motion.
RELAY
1. NORMALLY
CLOSED
2. NORMALLY
OPEN
Basically, an electrically
operated switch which may
be normally closed (1) or
open (2).
Current flow through a
small coil creates a
magnetic field which either
opens or closes an
attached switch.
RELAY, DOUBLE THROW
A relay which passes current
through one set of contacts or the
other.
SPEAKER
An electromechanical device
which creates sound waves from
current flow.
SWITCH, MANUAL
1. NORMALLY
OPEN
2. NORMALLY
CLOSED
Opens and
closes circuits,
thereby
stopping (1) or
allowing (2)
current flow.
RESISTOR
An electrical component with a
fixed resistance, placed in a circuit
to reduce voltage to a specific
value.
SWITCH, DOUBLE THROW
A switch which continuously
passes current through one set
of contacts or the other.
RESISTOR, TAPPED
A resistor which supplies two or
more different non adjustable
resistance values.
SWITCH,
IGNITION
A key operated switch with
several positions which allows
various circuits, particularly the
primary ignition circuit, to
become operational.
RESISTOR, VARIABLE or
RHEOSTAT
A controllable resistor with a
variable rate of resistance.
Also called a potentiometer or
rheostat.
SENSOR (Thermistor)
A resistor which varies its
resistance with temperature.
SWITCH, WIPER PARK
Automatically returns wipers to
the stop position when the wiper
switch is turned off.
SENSOR, ANALOG SPEED
Uses magnetic impulses to open
and close a switch to create a
signal for activation of other
components.
TRANSISTOR
A solidstate device typically used
as an electronic relay; stops or
passes current depending on the
voltage applied at “base.”
SHORT PIN
Used to provide an unbroken
connection within a junction block.
SOLENOID
An electromagnetic coil which
forms a magnetic field when
current flows, to move a plunger,
etc.
WIRES
Wires are always
(1) NOT
CONNECTED drawn as straight lines
on wiring diagrams.
Crossed wires (1)
without a black dot at
the junction are not
joined; crossed wires
(2) with a black dot or
octagonal ( ) mark at
the junction are spliced
(2) SPLICED
(joined) connections.
17
RELAY LOCATIONS
[Engine Compartment]
[Instrument Panel]
18
[Body]
[Sedan]
[Coupe]
[Wagon]
19
RELAY LOCATIONS
,,,
,,,
,,,: J/B No. 1
20
Instrument Panel Left
(See Page 18)
[J/B No. 1 Inner Circuit]
21
RELAY LOCATIONS
,,,
,,,
,,,: J/B No. 2
22
Engine Compartment Left
(See Page 18)
[J/B No. 2 Inner Circuit]
23
RELAY LOCATIONS
,,,
,,,
,,,: J/B No. 3
Behind Combination Meter
[J/B No. 3 Inner Circuit]
24
(See Page 18)
1
: R/B No. 1
Left Kick Panel
(See Page 18)
4
: R/B No. 4
Right Kick Panel
(See Page 18)
25
RELAY LOCATIONS
5
: R/B No. 5
Engine Compartment Left
(See Page 18)
Behind Glove Box
(See Page 18)
(for 1MZ–FE)
6
: J/B No. 6
(for 5S–FE)
26
7
: R/B No. 7
Near The Battery
(See Page 18)
27
ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
Position of Parts in Engine Compartment
[1MZ–FE]
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
2 A/C Triple Pressure SW (A/C Dual and Single Pressure
SW)
3 A/C Magnetic Clutch and Lock Sensor
4 ABS Actuator
5 ABS Actuator
6 ABS Relay
7 ABS Relay
8 ABS Speed Sensor Front LH
9 ABS Speed Sensor Front RH
B
2 Brake Fluid Level SW
C
C
C
2 Cruise Control Actuator
17 Camshaft Position Sensor
18 Crankshaft Position Sensor
D
D
1 Data Link Connector 1 (Check Connector)
2 Distributor
E
E
E
1 EGR Gas Temp. Sensor
2 Electronic Controlled Transmission Solenoid
4 Engine Coolant Temp. Sensor (EFI Water Temp.
Sensor)
5 Engine Coolant Temp. Sensor (Water Temp. Sensor)
(for Cooling Fan)
E
28
F
1 Front Airbag Sensor LH
F
2 Front Airbag Sensor RH
F
3 Front Clearance Light LH
F
4 Front Clearance Light RH
F
5 Front Side Marker LH
F
6 Front Side Marker RH
F
7 Front Turn Signal Light LH
F
8 Front Turn Signal Light RH
F
9 Front Wiper Motor
F 10 Fuse Box
F 16 Fuse Box
F 18 Fuse Box
G
G
1 Generator (Alternator)
2 Generator (Alternator)
H 1
H 2
H 3
H 4
H 5
H 6
H 11
H 12
Headlight Hi LH
Headlight Hi RH
Headlight Lo LH
Headlight Lo RH
Horn LH
Horn RH
Heated Oxygen Sensor (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Heated Oxygen Sensor (Bank 2 Sensor 1)
Position of Parts in Engine Compartment
[1MZ–FE]
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
1
2
4
5
6
7
8
9
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
Idle Air Control Valve (ISC Valve)
Igniter
Injector No. 1
Injector No. 2
Injector No. 3
Injector No. 4
Injector No. 5
Injector No. 6
Igniter
Ignition Coil No. 1
Ignition Coil No. 2
Ignition Coil No. 3
Ignition Coil No. 4
Ignition Coil No. 5
Ignition Coil No. 6
J
6 Junction Connector
K
K
1 Knock Sensor 1
2 Knock Sensor 2
M
6 Mass Air Flow (Air Flow Meter)
N
1 Noise Filter (for Ignition System)
O
O
1 Oil Pressure SW
6 O/D Direct Clutch Speed Sensor
P
1 Park/Neutral Position SW (Neutral Start SW) (A/T)
S
S
S
1 Solenoid Valve (for Hydrauric Motor)
3 Starter
4 Starter
T
1 Throttle Position Sensor
V
V
V
V
V
1
2
3
4
5
W
W
1 Washer Motor
2 Water Temp. Sender
VSV (for A/C Idle–Up)
VSV (for EGR System)
VSV (for Fuel Pressure Up)
VSV (for Intake Air Control)
Vehicle Speed Sensor (Speed Sensor)
29
ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
Position of Parts in Engine Compartment
[5S–FE]
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
1 A/C Condenser Fan Motor
2 A/C Triple Pressure SW (A/C Dual and Single Pressure
SW)
3 A/C Magnetic Clutch and Lock Sensor
4 ABS Actuator
5 ABS Actuator
6 ABS Relay
7 ABS Relay
8 ABS Speed Sensor Front LH
9 ABS Speed Sensor Front RH
B
B
1 Back–Up Light SW (M/T)
2 Brake Fluid Level SW
C
2 Cruise Control Actuator
D
D
1 Data Link Connector 1 (Check Connector)
2 Distributor
E
E
E
E
E
F
F
F
F
F
F
F
F
F
F
F
F
F
G
G
30
1
2
3
4
EGR Gas Temp. Sensor
Electronic Controlled Transmission Solenoid
Electronic Controlled Transmission Solenoid
Engine Coolant Temp. Sensor (EFI Water Temp.
Sensor)
5 Water Temp. SW (for Cooling Fan)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
16
17
18
Front Airbag Sensor LH
Front Airbag Sensor RH
Front Clearance Light LH
Front Clearance Light RH
Front Side Marker LH
Front Side Marker RH
Front Turn Signal Light LH
Front Turn Signal Light RH
Front Wiper Motor
Fuse Box
Fuse Box
Fuse Box
Fuse Box
1 Generator (Alternator)
2 Generator (Alternator)
Position of Parts in Engine Compartment
[5S–FE]
H
H
H
H
H
H
1
2
3
4
5
6
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
10
Headlight Hi LH
Headlight Hi RH
Headlight Lo LH
Headlight Lo RH
Horn LH
Horn RH
Idle Air Control Valve (ISC Valve)
Igniter
Ignition Coil
Injector No. 1
Injector No. 2
Injector No. 3
Injector No. 4
Intake Air Temp. Sensor (In–Air Temp. Sensor)
K
1 Knock Sensor
M
1 Manifold Absolute Pressure Sensor (Vacuum Sensor)
N
1 Noise Filter (for Ignition System)
O
O
O
1 Oil Pressure SW
2 Oxygen Sensor (Sub)
3 Oxygen Sensor (Main)
P
1 Park/Neutral Position SW (Neutral Start SW) (A/T)
R
1 Radiator Fan Motor
S
S
3 Starter
4 Starter
T
1 Throttle Position Sensor
V
V
V
V
1
2
3
5
W
W
1 Washer Motor
2 Water Temp. Sender
VSV (for A/C Idle–Up)
VSV (for EGR System)
VSV (for Fuel Pressure Up)
Vehicle Speed Sensor (Speed Sensor)
31
ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
Position of Parts in Instrument Panel
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
22
A/C Amplifier
A/C Evaporator Temp. Sensor
A/C SW
ABS ECU
ABS ECU
Airbag Squib (Steering Wheel Pad)
Air Inlet Control Servo Motor
Air Vent Mode Control Servo Motor
Ashtray Illumination
Airbag Squib (Front Passenger Airbag Assembly)
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
3
4
5
6
7
8
10
Back Door Lock Control SW
Blower Motor
Blower Resistor
Blower SW
Buckle SW LH (w/ Power Seat)
Buckle SW LH (w/o Power Seat)
Buckle SW RH
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
Cigarette Lighter
Cigarette Lighter Illumination
Clock
Clutch Start SW (M/T)
Combination Meter
Combination Meter
Combination Meter
Combination Meter
32
C
C
C
C
C
12
13
14
15
16
D
3 Data Lik Connector 2 (TDCL (Toyota Diagnostic
Communication Link))
4 Daytime Running Light Relay (Main)
5 Diode (for Cruise Control)
6 Diode (for Idle–Up)
7 Diode (for Courtesy)
8 Door Lock Control Relay)
24 Date Link Connector 3
25 Diode (for Tension Reducer)
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
Combination SW
Combination SW
Cooling Fan ECU
Cruise Control Clutch SW (M/T)
Cruise Control ECU
6 Electronic Controlled Transmission Pattern Select SW
7 Engine Control Module (Engine and Electronic
Controlled Transmission ECU) (A/T)
8 Engine Control Module (Engine and Electronic
Controlled Transmission ECU) (A/T)
9 Engine Control Module (Engine and Electronic
Controlled Transmission ECU) (A/T)
10 Engine Control Module (Engine and Electronic
Controlled Transmission ECU) (A/T)
11 Engine Control Module (Engine ECU) (M/T)
12 Engine Control Module (Engine ECU) (M/T)
14 Engine Control Module (Engine ECU) (M/T)
Position of Parts in Instrument Panel
G
G
3 Glove Box Light
4 Glove Box Light SW
H
H
7 Hazard SW
8 Heater Control SW (for Push Control SW Type) or Air
Vent Mode Control SW (for Lever Control SW Type)
9 Heated Oxygen Sensor (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
H
I
I
I
11 Ignition Key Cylinder Light
12 Ignition SW and Unlock Warning SW
13 Integration Relay
J
J
J
J
J
1
2
3
4
7
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector (for SRS System)
Junction Connector
K
3 Key Interlock Solenoid
N
N
2 Noise Filter (for Stop Light)
3 Noise Filter (for Stop Light)
O
5 O/D Main SW and A/T Indicator Light (Shift Lever)
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Parking Brake SW (for 1MZ–FE)
Parking Brake SW (for 5S–FE)
Power Seat Control SW
Power Seat Motor (for Front Vertical Control)
Power Seat Motor (for Rear Vertical Control)
Power Seat Motor (for Reclining Control)
Power Seat Motor (for Slide Control)
R
R
R
R
R
R
2
3
4
5
6
7
Radio and Player (w/ CD Player)
Radio and Player (w/o CD Player)
Radio and Player (w/o CD Player)
Rear Window Defogger SW
Remote Control Mirror SW
Rheostat
S 5
S 8
S 9
S 10
Shift Lock ECU
Stereo Component Amplifier
Stereo Component Amplifier
Stop Light SW
33
ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
Position of Parts in Body
[Sedan]
A
A
A
19
20
21
ABS Speed Sensor Rear LH
ABS Speed Sensor Rear RH
Auto Antenna Motor and Relay
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
D
21
D
D
22
23
Door Courtesy Light Front LH
Door Courtesy Light Front RH
Door Courtesy SW Front LH
Door Courtesy SW Front RH
Door Courtesy SW Rear LH
Door Courtesy SW Rear RH
Door Key Cylinder Light and SW
Door Key Lock and Unlock SW LH
Door Key Lock and Unlock SW RH
Door Lock Control SW RH
Door Lock Motor and Door Unlock Detection SW Front
LH
Door Lock Motor and Door Unlock Detection SW Front
RH
Door Lock Motor Rear LH
Door Lock Motor Rear RH
F
F
F
F
F
11
12
13
14
15
Front Door Speaker LH
Front Door Speaker RH
Front Tweeter (Speaker) LH
Front Tweeter (Speaker) RH
Fuel Pump and Sender
H
10
High Mount Stop Light
I
14
Interior Light
L
L
1
2
34
License Plate Light
Light Failure Sensor
L
L
3
4
Luggage Compartment Light
Luggage Compartment Light SW
M
M
2
3
M
M
4
5
Moon Roof Control Relay
Moon Roof Control SW and Personal Light (w/ Moon
Roof)
Moon Roof Limit SW
Moon Roof Motor
P
P
P
P
9
10
11
12
P
P
P
P
13
14
15
16
Power Window Control SW Front RH
Power Window Control SW Rear LH
Power Window Control SW Rear RH
Power Window Master SW and Door Lock Control SW
LH
Power Window Motor Front LH
Power Window Motor Front RH
Power Window Motor Rear LH
Power Window Motor Rear RH
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
8
9
10
11
12
13
16
17
20
21
Rear Combination Light LH
Rear Combination Light LH
Rear Combination Light RH
Rear Combination Light RH
Rear Speaker LH
Rear Speaker RH
Rear Window Defogger (+)
Rear Window Defogger (–)
Remote Control Mirror LH
Remote Control Mirror RH
V
V
8
9
Vanity Light LH
Vanity Light RH
Position of Parts in Body
[Coupe]
A
A
A
19 ABS Speed Sensor Rear LH
20 ABS Speed Sensor Rear RH
21 Auto Antenna Motor and Relay
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
10
11
12
13
16
19
26
D
Door Courtesy Light Front LH
Door Courtesy Light Front RH
Door Courtesy SW Front LH
Door Courtesy SW Front RH
Door Key Cylinder Light and SW
Door Lock Control SW RH
Door Lock Motor, Door Unlock Detection SW
Door Key Lock and Unlock SW LH
27 Door Lock Motor, Door Unlock Detection SW
Door Key Lock and Unlock SW RH
28 Door Lock Control SW LH (w/o Power Window)
F
F
F
F
F
11
12
13
14
15
H
10 High Mount Stop Light
I
14 Interior Light
D
L
L
L
L
1
2
3
4
Front Door Speaker LH
Front Door Speaker RH
Front Tweeter (Speaker) LH
Front Tweeter (Speaker) RH
Fuel Pump and Sender
License Plate Light
Light Failure Sensor
Luggage Compartment Light
Luggage Compartment Light SW
M
M
M
M
2 Moon Roof Control Relay
3 Moon Roof Control SW and Personal Light
(w/ Moon Roof)
4 Moon Roof Limit SW
5 Moon Roof Motor
P 9 Power Window Control SW Front RH
P 12 Power Window Master SW and Door Lock Control
SW LH
P 13 Power Window Motor Front LH
P 14 Power Window Motor Front RH
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
8
9
10
11
12
13
16
17
20
21
Rear Combination Light LH
Rear Combination Light LH
Rear Combination Light RH
Rear Combination Light RH
Rear Speaker LH
Rear Speaker RH
Rear Window Defogger (+)
Rear Window Defogger (–)
Remote Control Mirror LH
Remote Control Mirror RH
T
T
2 Tension Reducer Solenoid LH
3 Tension Reducer Solenoid RH
V
V
8 Vanity Light LH
9 Vanity Light RH
35
ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
Position of Parts in Body
[Wagon]
A
A
A
19 ABS Speed Sensor Rear LH
20 ABS Speed Sensor Rear RH
21 Auto Antenna Motor and Relay
F
F
F
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
H 10 High Mount Stop Light
D
D
Door Courtesy Light Front LH
Door Courtesy Light Front RH
Door Courtesy SW Front LH
Door Courtesy SW Front RH
Door Courtesy SW Rear LH
Door Courtesy SW Rear RH
Door Key Cylinder Light and SW
Door Key Lock and Unlock SW LH
Door Key Lock and Unlock SW RH
Door Lock Control SW RH
Door Lock Motor and Door Unlock
Detection SW Front LH
21 Door Lock Motor and Door Unlock
Detection SW Front RH
22 Door Lock Motor Rear LH
23 Door Lock Motor Rear RH
F
F
11 Front Door Speaker LH
12 Front Door Speaker RH
D
36
I
13 Front Tweeter (Speaker) LH
14 Front Tweeter (Speaker) RH
15 Fuel Pump and Sender
14 Interior Light
L
L
L
L
1
2
3
4
M
M
2 Moon Roof Control Relay
3 Moon Roof Control SW and
Personal Light (w/ Moon Roof)
4 Moon Roof Limit SW
5 Moon Roof Motor
M
M
License Plate Light
Light Failure Sensor
Luggage Compartment Light
Luggage Compartment Light SW
9 Power Window Control SW Front
RH
P 10 Power Window Control SW Rear
LH
P
P
P
P
P
11 Power Window Control SW Rear
RH
12 Power Window Master SW and
Door Lock Control SW LH
13 Power Window Motor Front LH
14 Power Window Motor Front RH
15 Power Window Motor Rear LH
16 Power Window Motor Rear RH
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
8
9
10
11
12
13
16
17
20
21
P
Rear Combination Light LH
Rear Combination Light LH
Rear Combination Light RH
Rear Combination Light RH
Rear Speaker LH
Rear Speaker RH
Rear Window Defogger (+)
Rear Window Defogger (–)
Remote Control Mirror LH
Remote Control Mirror RH
P
V
V
8 Vanity Light LH
9 Vanity Light RH
ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
-Memo
ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
: Location of Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
: Location of Ground Points
[1MZ–FE]
: Location of Splice Points
[1MZ–FE]
38
Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
CODE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
EB1
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE AND RELAY WIRE (UNDER THE R/B NO. 5)
EC1
ENGINE WIRE AND ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE (UNDER THE J/B NO. 1)
ED1
COWL WIRE AND ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE (UNDER THE J/B NO. 1)
EE1
SENSOR WIRE AND ENGINE WIRE (SIDE OF FRONT CYLINDER HEAD)
EF1
ENGINE WIRE AND COWL WIRE (NEAR THE BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER)
39
ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
: Location of Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
: Location of Ground Points
[5S–FE]
: Location of Splice Points
[5S–FE]
40
Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
CODE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
EA1
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE AND ENGINE ROOM NO. 3 WIRE (RADIATOR FAN SHROUD)
EB1
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE AND RELAY WIRE (UNDER THE R/B NO. 5)
EC1
ENGINE WIRE AND ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE (UNDER THE J/B NO. 1)
ED1
COWL WIRE AND ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE (UNDER THE J/B NO. 1)
EF1
ENGINE WIRE AND COWL WIRE (NEAR THE BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER)
41
ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
: Location of Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
: Location of Ground Points
42
Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
CODE
IG1
IH1
IH2
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (LEFT KICK PANEL)
FRONT DOOR LH WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (LEFT KICK PANEL)
II1
COWL WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (LEFT KICK PANEL)
II2
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE AND COWL WIRE (BEHIND COMBINATION METER)
IJ1
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND COWL WIRE (LEFT KICK PANEL)
IK1
COWL WIRE AND A/C SUB WIRE (NEAR THE RADIO AND PLAYER)
IL1
COWL WIRE AND SERVO MOTOR SUB WIRE (BEHIND RADIO AND PLAYER)
IM1
IM2
IN1
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE AND CONSOLE BOX WIRE (NEAR THE RADIO AND PLAYER)
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE AND SWITCH WIRE (UNDER THE INSTRUMENT PANEL CENTER)
43
ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
: Location of Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
: Location of Splice Points
44
Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
CODE
IO1
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND SEAT WIRE (UNDER THE DRIVER’S SEAT)
IP1
IP2
ENGINE WIRE AND COWL WIRE (UNDER THE GLOVE BOX)
IP3
IQ1
IR1
IR2
IS1
IT1
IT2
IU1
IV1
IV2
ENGINE WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (UNDER THE GLOVE BOX)
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE AND COWL WIRE (RIGHT KICK PANEL)
FLOOR NO. 2 WIRE AND COWL WIRE (RIGHT KICK PANEL)
FRONT DOOR RH WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (RIGHT KICK PANEL)
FLOOR NO. 2 WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (RIGHT KICK PANEL)
ROOF WIRE AND COWL WIRE (INSTRUMENT PANEL RIGHT)
45
ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
: Location of Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
: Location of Ground Points
[Sedan]
: Location of Splice Points
[Sedan]
46
Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
CODE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
BW1
REAR DOOR LH WIRE AND FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE (LEFT CENTER PILLAR)
BX1
FUEL GAUGE WIRE AND FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE (UNDER THE REAR SEAT CUSHION)
BY1
REAR DOOR RH WIRE AND FLOOR NO. 2 WIRE (RIGHT CENTER PILLAR)
BZ1
LUGGAGE ROOM NO. 1 WIRE AND FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE (LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
Ba1
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND LUGGAGE ROOM NO. 2 WIRE (LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR)
47
ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
: Location of Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
: Location of Ground Points
[Coupe]
: Location of Splice Points
[Coupe]
48
Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
CODE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
BX1
FUEL GAUGE WIRE AND FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE (UNDER THE REAR SEAT CUSHION)
BZ1
LUGGAGE ROOM NO. 1 WIRE AND FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE (LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
Ba1
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND LUGGAGE ROOM NO. 2 WIRE (LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR)
49
ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
: Location of Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
: Location of Ground Points
[Wagon]
: Location of Splice Points
[Wagon]
50
Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
CODE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
BW1
REAR DOOR LH WIRE AND FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE (LEFT CENTER PILLAR)
BX1
FUEL GAUGE WIRE AND FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE (UNDER THE REAR SEAT CUSHION)
BY1
REAR DOOR RH WIRE AND FLOOR NO. 2 WIRE (RIGHT CENTER PILLAR)
Bb1
LUGGAGE ROOM NO. 1 WIRE AND FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE (LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
Bc1
Bc2
BACK DOOR NO. 1 (WIRE AND FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE (LEFT QUARTER TRIM INNER)
Bc3
Bd1
Bd2
BACK DOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND BACK DOOR NO. 2 WIRE (BACK DOOR LEFT)
Bd3
Be1
REAR WINDOW NO. 1 WIRE AND BACK DOOR NO. 2 WIRE (BACK DOOR LEFT)
51
POWER SOURCE (Current Flow Chart)
The chart below shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each electrical source (Fusible Link,
Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
The next page and following pages show the parts to which each electrical source outputs current.
Ignition SW
(AM2)
30A AM2
Headlight Relay
(Point Side)
Headlight Relay
(Coil Side)
40A MAIN
Starter Relay
(Point Side)
7.5A SRS
15A STOP
60A ABS
Generator
(Alternator)
Battery
FL MAIN 2.0L
Taillight Relay
(Coil Side)
100A ALT
7.5A OBD
40A DEFOG
7.5A ALT–S
Starter
10A HAZ
40A HEATER
10A HORN
Taillight Relay
(Point Side)
15A ECU–B
15A EFI
Engine Main
Relay (Point Side)
15A TEL
(5S–FE)
20A DOME
30A POWER
40A AM1
Daytime Running
Light Relay No. 2
(Coil Side)
Daytime Running
Light Relay (Main)
(Canada)
Daytime Running
Light Relay No. 2
(Point Side)
[LOCATION]
(1)
(3)
52
: J/B No. 1 (See page 20
20)
: R/B No. 1 (See page 25
20)
(2)
(7)
15A HEAD (UPR–LH)
15A HEAD (UPR–RH)
: J/B No. 2 (See page22
19)
: R/B No. 7 (See page 27
19)
7.5A IGN
(USA)
15A HEAD (LH)
15A HEAD (RH)
(Canada)
Daytime Running
Light Relay (Main)
7.5A DRL
Dimmer SW
[Comb. SW]
Integration Relay
15A HEAD (LWR–LH)
15A HEAD (LWR–RH)
Light Control SW
[Comb. SW]
(Canada)
10A STARTER
(TMM Made)
Starter
ABS Actuator
and ECU
ABS Relay
ABS Actuator
ABS ECU
(TMC Made)
ABS Relay
Integration
Relay
Light Control SW
[Comb. SW]
Defogger Relay
(Point Side)
10A MIR HTR
Heater Relay
(Point Side)
10A A/C
(M/T)
15A TAIL
30A RDI FAN
30A CDS FAN
Power Main Relay
(Point Side)
Ignition SW
(AM1)
Starter Relay
(Coil Side)
Clutch Start
SW
(A/T)
Park/Neutral
Position SW
(Neutral Start SW)
Engine Control
Module (Engine and
Electronic Controlled
Transmission ECU)
7.5A TURN
10A GAUGE
15A ECU–IG
15A CIG/RADIO
20A WIPER
* These are the page numbers of the first page on which the related
system is shown.
The part indicated is located somewhere in the system, not
necessarily on the page indicated here.
(4)
: R/B No. 4 (See page25
20)
(5)
: R/B No. 5 (See page 26
19)
(6)
R/B No. 6 (See Page26 )
53
POWER SOURCE (Current Flow Chart)
40A
AM1
15A
CIG/RADIO
40A
DEFOG
15A
ECU–1G
10A
GAUGE
7.5A
IGN
10A
MIR–HTR
30A
POWER
7.5A
SRS
15A
STOP
15A
TAIL
7.5A
TURN
20A
WIPER
30A
AM2
7.5A
ALT–S
30A
CDS FAN
20A
DOME
15A
ECU–B
15A
EFI
10A
HAZ
15A
HEAD (LWR–LH)
15A
HEAD (LWR–RH)
15A
HEAD (UPR–LH)
15A
HEAD (UPR–RH)
15A
HEAD LH
15A
HEAD RH
10A
HORN
40A
MAIN
7.5A
OBD
10A
STARTER
10A
A/C
40A
HEATER
7.5A
DRL
100A
ALT
60A
ABS
Back Door Lock Motor (W/G)
B5 B6
B7
B9 B10
Buckle SW RH
Buckle SW LH
A/C SW
A7 A10 A11 A12 A13 A14 A16 A17 A18 A21 B1 B2 B3 B4
Blower Resistor
Blower Motor
Back Door Lock Control SW
Brake Fluid Level SW
Back–Up Light SW (M/T)
Auto Antenna Motor and Relay
Ashtray Illumination
Air Vent Mode Control Servo Motor
Air Inlet Control Servo Motor
ABS ECU (TMC Made)
ABS ECU (TMC Made)
A/C Evaporator Temp. Sensor
A/C Amplifier
A6
Blower SW
A5
ABS Relay
A4
* These are the page numbers of the first page on which the related system is shown.
The part indicated is located somewhere in the system, not necessarily on the page indicated here.
[LOCATION]
(1)
(7)
54
A1 A2 A3
ABS Relay
CB or Fuse
ABS Actuator and ECU
(TMM Made)
Location
Code or
Location
ABS Actuator (TMC Made)
Parts
A/C Triple Pressure SW (A/C Dual
and Single Pressure SW)
A/C Magnetic Clutch and Lock
Sensor
ABS Actuator and ECU
(TMM Made)
A/C Condenser Fan Motor (5S–FE)
*Page Nos. of
Related Systems
242
126
242 246 246 214 210 214 210 210 246 252 126 210 210 246 246 126 222 152 236 166 246 246 246 220 160 220
252
252
252
252
224
252 252
166
252
252
: J/B No. 1 (See page 20
20)
: R/B No. 7 (See page27 )
(2)
(8)
: J/B No. 2 (See page 22
19)
: Fuse Box (F10, F17 See
on page 28 29 )
(3)
: R/B No. 1 (See page 25
23)
C2 C3 C4 C5 C6 C7
(4)
C8
C9
: R/B No. 4 (See page25
20)
(5)
C10
C11
C12
: R/B No. 5 (See page 26
19)
(6)
C13 C14 C16 D1
D3
Diode (for Courtesy) (W/G)
Door Lock Control Relay
Diode (for Courtesy)
Diode (for Idle–Up)
Daytime Running Light Relay
(Main) (CANADA)
80
Data Link Connector 2
(TDCL (Toyota Diagnostic
Communication Link))
Data Link Connector 1
(Check Connector)
Cruise Control ECU
Cooling Fan ECU (1MZ–FE)
Combination SW
Front Wiper and Washer SW)
Combination SW
(Light Control SW)
Combination SW
(Turn Signal SW)
Combination SW (Horn SW)
Combination Meter
(SRS Warning Light)
Combination Meter
(A/T Indicator Light)
Combination Meter
Combination Meter
(ABS Warning Light)
Combination Meter
(Meter Illmination)
Combination Meter
(Open Door Warning Light)
Combination Meter
(Seat Belt Warning Light)
Combination Meter
(Charge Warning Light)
Combination Meter
(High Beam Indicator Light)
Combination Meter
(Malfunction Indicator Light)
Combination Meter
(Rear Light Warning Light)
Combination Meter
Combination Meter
(Cruise Control Indicator Light)
Combination Meter
(Turn Signal Indicator Light)
Clutch Start SW (M/T)
Clock
Cigarette Lighter Illumination
Cigarette Lighter
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
Cruise Control Actuator
130
120
80
126
104 106
90
68
192 177 189 126 189
192 114
236 210 126 134 170 76 104 90 124 236 177 198 173 114 112 126 184 244 192 98
118
214
106
118
186
72
138
144
204
98
144 148
214
140
148
90 98 106 80 134 156 134
192 204
90
236
138 140 140
214
98
130
140
D4 D6 D7 D8 D9
R/B No. 6 (See Page26 )
55
POWER SOURCE (Current Flow Chart)
40A
AM1
15A
CIG/RADIO
40A
DEFOG
15A
ECU–1G
10A
GAUGE
7.5A
IGN
10A
MIR–HTR
30A
POWER
7.5A
SRS
15A
STOP
15A
TAIL
7.5A
TURN
20A
WIPER
30A
AM2
7.5A
ALT–S
30A
CDS FAN
20A
DOME
15A
ECU–B
15A
EFI
10A
HAZ
15A
HEAD (LWR–LH)
15A
HEAD (LWR–RH)
15A
HEAD (UPR–LH)
15A
HEAD (UPR–RH)
15A
HEAD LH
15A
HEAD RH
10A
HORN
40A
MAIN
7.5A
OBD
10A
STARTER
10A
A/C
40A
HEATER
7.5A
DRL
100A
ALT
60A
ABS
Engine Control Module (Engine
and Electronic Controlled
Transmission ECU) (A/T) (5S–FE)
Engine Control Module (Engine
and Electronic Controlled
Transmission ECU) (A/T) (1MZ–FE)
80
Engine Control Module (Engine
and Electronic Controlled
Transmission ECU)
80
Engine Controlled
Transmission Pattern
Select SW
Electronic Controlled Transmission
Solenoid
Electronic Controlled Transmission
Solenoid (5S–FE)
Diode (for Tension Reducer) (C/P)
Date Ling Connector 3
Door Lock Motor and Door Unlock
Detection SW Front LH
Door Lock Motor and Door Unlock
Detection SW Front RH
Door Lock Motor Rear LH
(EX. C/P)
Door Lock Motor Rear RH
(EX. C/P)
Door Lock Control SW RH
Door Key Lck and Unlock SW LH
(Ex. C/P)
Door Key Lck and Unlock SW RH
(Ex. C/P)
Door Key Cylinder Light and SW
80
90
98
198
E5
E6
E7
E8
E9
* These are the page numbers of the first page on which the related system is shown.
The part indicated is located somewhere in the system, not necessarily on the page indicated here.
[LOCATION]
(1)
(7)
56
D12 D13 D14 D15 D16 D17 D18 D19 D20 D21 D22 D23 D24 D25 E2 E3
126
198
204
242
Engine Coolant Temp. Sensor
(Water Temp. Sensor) (for
Cooling Fan) (1MZ–FE)
CB or Fuse
130
134 130 160 160 160 160 160 160 160 80 220 198 220
220
138 138
140
Door Courtesy SW Rear RH
Location
Code or
Location
Door Courtesy SW Rear LH
Parts
Door Courtesy SW Front RH
Door Courtesy SW Front LH
*Page Nos. of
Related Systems
130 130
130
134 134
138
138 138
140
140 140
: J/B No. 1 (See page 20
20)
: R/B No. 7 (See page27 )
(2)
(8)
: J/B No. 2 (See page 22
19)
: Fuse Box (F10, F17 See
on page 28 29 )
(3)
: R/B No. 1 (See page 25
23)
Front Side Marker LH
Front Side Marker RH
F3 F4
F5
F6 F7 F8 F9 F15 G2 G3 G4
(4)
: R/B No. 4 (See page25
20)
H1
(5)
H2
H3
H4
H5 H6 H7
H8
: R/B No. 5 (See page 26
19)
(6)
68 72
80 98
236
H9 H10 H11 H12 I1
72
80
Ignition Coil
Injector No. 1
80
Igniter
Heated Oxygen Sensor (Bank 1
Sensor 1) (1MZ–FE)
Heated Oxygen Sensor (Bank 2
Sensor 1) (1MZ–FE)
High Mount Stop Light
80
90
98
Idle Air Control Valve (ISC Valve)
Heater Control SW (for Push
Control SW Type)
Air Vent Mode Control SW (for
Lever Control SW Type)
Heated Oxygen Sensor (Bank 1
Sensor 2)
Hazard SW
Horn RH
Horn LH
Headlight Lo RH (CANADA)
Headlight Lo RH (USA)
Headlight Lo LH (CANADA)
Headlight Lo LH (USA)
Headlight Hi RH (CANADA)
Headlight Hi RH (USA)
Headlight Hi LH (CANADA)
Headlight Hi LH (USA)
Glove Box Light SW
Glove Box Light
Generator (Alternator)
Fuel Pump and Sender
Front Wiper Motor
Front turn Signal Light RH
Front turn Signal Light LH
Front Clearance Light RH
E10
Front Clearance Light LH
Engine Control Module (Engine
and Electronic Controlled
Transmission ECU)
80
80 90 144 144 144 144 114 114
114
98 198 148 148 148 148 118 118 184 90 76 126 126 104 106 104 106 104 106 104 106 173 173 118 126 252 80 120 80
98
124
204
126 246
236
I2
I3
I4
R/B No. 6 (See Page26 )
57
40A
AM1
15A
CIG/RADIO
40A
DEFOG
15A
ECU–1G
10A
GAUGE
7.5A
IGN
10A
MIR–HTR
30A
POWER
7.5A
SRS
15A
STOP
15A
TAIL
7.5A
TURN
20A
WIPER
30A
AM2
7.5A
ALT–S
30A
CDS FAN
20A
DOME
15A
ECU–B
15A
EFI
10A
HAZ
15A
HEAD (LWR–LH)
15A
HEAD (LWR–RH)
15A
HEAD (UPR–LH)
15A
HEAD (UPR–RH)
15A
HEAD LH
15A
HEAD RH
10A
HORN
40A
MAIN
7.5A
OBD
10A
STARTER
10A
A/C
40A
HEATER
7.5A
DRL
100A
ALT
60A
ABS
90
118
134
192
224
252
98
120
138
210
I14 I16 I17 I18 I19 I20 I21
J1
J2
J3
J4
80
154
182
190
204
126
156
189
198
236
130
156
182
214
226
234
134
160
198
222
228
236
154
168
204
224 177
230
* These are the page numbers of the first page on which the related system is shown.
The part indicated is located somewhere in the system, not necessarily on the page indicated here.
[LOCATION]
(1)
(7)
58
I13
Junction Connector (for Airbag
System)
I11 I12
Junction Connector
I9
Junction Connector
Injector Key Cylinder Light
I8
Junction Connector
Injector No. 6 (1MZ–FE)
I7
Ignition Coil No. 6 (1MZ–FE)
Injector No. 5 (1MZ–FE)
I6
Ignition Coil No. 5 (1MZ–FE)
Injector No. 4
Location
CB or Fuse
68
80
Ignition Coil No. 4 (1MZ–FE)
Injector No. 3
I5
Code or
Location
68 68
80 80
Ignition Coil No. 3 (1MZ–FE)
Injector No. 2
Parts
68
80
76
114
130
68
80 170
214
246
Ignition Coil No. 2 (1MZ–FE)
80
130
134 68
138 80
140
Interior Light
80
Integration Relay
80
Ignition SW and Unlock Warning
SW
*Page Nos. of
Related Systems
130
106 112
134 68 120 126
80 80 138 72 130 140
140 80 144 170
Ignition Coil No. 1 (1MZ–FE)
POWER SOURCE (Current Flow Chart)
: J/B No. 1 (See page 20
20)
: R/B No. 7 (See page27 )
(2)
(8)
: J/B No. 2 (See page 22
19)
: Fuse Box (F10, F17 See
on page 28 29 )
(3)
: R/B No. 1 (See page 25
23)
Junction Connector (1MZ–FE)
Key Interlock Solenoid
Light Failure Sensor
Luggage Compartment Light
Luggage Compartment Light SW
Noise Filter (for Ignition System)
Noise Filter (for Stop Light)
Noise Filter (for Stop Light)
J5 J6
J7
K3 L1 L2
L3
L4 M2 M3 M4 M5 M6 N1
N2
N3
(4)
Moon Roof Limit SW (EX. W/G)
130
134
138
140
130
168 138 168 168
168
80
: R/B No. 4 (See page25
20)
(5)
O1 O5
P1
P2
P3 P4 P5 P6 P7
: R/B No. 5 (See page 26
19)
(6)
Power Seat Motor
(for Front Vertical Control)
Power Seat Motor
(for Rear Vertical Control)
Power Seat Motor
(for Slide control)
Power Seat Motor
(for Reclining Control)
Power Window Control SW Front
RH
Power Window Control SW Rear
LH (EX. C/P)
Power Window Control SW Rear
RH (EX. C/P)
Power Window Master SW and
Door Lock control SW LH
68
72
152
198
204
Power Seat Control SW
126
236 198
204
Parking Brake SW (for 5S–FE)
198
204
210
214
Parking Brake SW (for 1MZ–FE)
120
124
182
192
Park/Neutral Position SW
(Neutral Start SW) (A/T)
198
204
210
214
O/D Main SW and A/T Indicator
Light (Shift Lever)
120
124
182
192
Oil Pressure SW
80
Mass Air Flow (Air Flow Meter)
(1MZ–FE)
Moon Roof Motor (EX. W/G)
130
134
138
140
Moon Roof Control SW and Personal
Light (w/ Moon Roof) (EX. W/G)
120
80 198 182 144 124
144
148
Moon Roof Control Relay
License Plate Light
Junction Connector (1MZ–FE)
Junction Connector (W/G)
118
180
186
224
236 236 180 180 180 180 180 156 156 156 156
160
P8 P9 P10 P11 P12
R/B No. 6 (See Page26 )
59
POWER SOURCE (Current Flow Chart)
40A
AM1
15A
CIG/RADIO
40A
DEFOG
15A
ECU–1G
10A
GAUGE
7.5A
IGN
10A
MIR–HTR
30A
POWER
7.5A
SRS
15A
STOP
15A
TAIL
7.5A
TURN
20A
WIPER
30A
AM2
7.5A
ALT–S
30A
CDS FAN
20A
DOME
15A
ECU–B
15A
EFI
10A
HAZ
15A
HEAD (LWR–LH)
15A
HEAD (LWR–RH)
15A
HEAD (UPR–LH)
15A
HEAD (UPR–RH)
15A
HEAD LH
15A
HEAD RH
10A
HORN
40A
MAIN
7.5A
OBD
10A
STARTER
10A
A/C
40A
HEATER
7.5A
DRL
100A
ALT
60A
ABS
R5 R6 R7
Stop Light LH
[Rear Comb. Light LH]
Taillight LH
[Rear Comb. Light LH]
Rear Turn Signal Light LH
[Rear Comb. Light LH]
Stop Light LH
[Rear Comb. Light LH]
Taillight LH
[Rear Comb. Light LH]
Back–up Light LH
[Rear Comb. Light LH]
Stop Light RH
[Rear Comb. Light RH]
Taillight RH
[Rear Comb. Light RH]
Rear Turn Signal Light RH
[Rear Comb. Light RH]
Taillight RH
[Rear Comb. Light RH]
Stop Light RH
[Rear Comb. Light RH]
Back–up Light RH
[Rear Comb. Light RH]
Rear Window Defogger (+)
(EX. W/G)
Rear Window Defogger (–)
(EX. W/G)
Rear Window Defogger (–)
(W/G)
Rheostat
Remote Control mirror SW
Rear Window Defogger SW
Radio and Player (w/o CD Player)
Radiator Fan Motor (5S–FE)
R3
126 154 126 120 144 114 120 144 152 120 144 114 144 120 152 190 190 190
124 148 118 148 124
190
124 148 148 124 148
R8
R10
R9
R11
R16 R17
* These are the page numbers of the first page on which the related system is shown.
The part indicated is located somewhere in the system, not necessarily on the page indicated here.
[LOCATION]
(1)
(7)
60
Radio and Player (w/ CD Player)
CB or Fuse
Power Window Motor Rear LH
(EX. C/P)
Power Window Motor Rear RH
(EX. C/P)
Location
Code or
Location
Power Window Motor Front RH
Parts
126
222
224
228
234
P13 P14 P15 P16 R1 R2
Power Window Motor Front LH
*Page Nos. of
Related Systems
156 156 156 156 242 126
: J/B No. 1 (See page 20
20)
: R/B No. 7 (See page27 )
(2)
(8)
: J/B No. 2 (See page 22
19)
: Fuse Box (F10, F17 See
on page 28 29 )
(3)
: R/B No. 1 (See page 25
23)
Stop Light SW
S5 S8 S9
S10
(4)
V1 V2
: R/B No. 4 (See page25
20)
V5
V8
(5)
: R/B No. 5 (See page 26
19)
(6)
80
90
98
198
204
Headlight Relay (Coil Side)
80
90
98
198
204
EFI Main Relay (Point Side)
80 90 130 130
130
156 156
80 98 192 134 134 184 236 134 190 190 190 160 160 112 126 68 68
186
126
72 72
198 236 138 138
138
168 168
EFI Main Relay (Coil Side)
Starter Relay (Coil Side)
Starter Relay (Point Side)
Taillight Relay (Point Side)
Taillight Relay (Coil Side)
Power Main Relay (Point Side)
Power Main Relay (Coil Side)
Defogger Relay (Point Side)
Defogger Relay (Coil Side)
Noise Filter
Diode
Water Temp. Sender
Washer Motor
Vanity Light RH
Vanity Light LH
V3 V4
Vehicle Speed Sensor
(Speed Sensor)
80
90
98
VSV (for Intake Air Control)
(1MZ–FE)
80
90
VSV (for Fuel Pressure Up)
VSV (for EGR System) (1MZ–FE)
VSV (for A/C Idle–Up)
Stereo Component Amplifier
Stereo Component Amplifier
R18 R19 R20 R21 S3
Shift Lock ECU
Starter (1MZ–FE)
Remote Control Mirror RH
Remote Control Mirror LH
Rear Wiper Relay (W/G)
Rear Wiper Motor (W/G)
120 182 80
186 186 154 154 68 182 226 226 192 198 90
72
230 230 204 210
98
214
106
V9 W1 W2
R/B No. 6 (See Page26 )
61
POWER SOURCE (Current Flow Chart)
Circuit Opening Relay (Coil Side)
Daytime Running Light Relay No. 3
(Coil Side)
Daytime Running Light Relay No. 4
(Coil Side)
Circuit Opening Relay (Coil Side)
Heater Relay (Coil Side)
Radiator Fan Relay No. 2
(Coil Side)
Radiator Fan Relay No. 2
(Point Side)
Radiator Fan Relay No. 3
(Point Side)
A/C Magnetic Clutch Relay
(Coil Side)
A/C Magnetic Clutch Relay
(Point Side)
Heater Relay (Point Side)
Turn Signal Flasher
Radiator Fan Relay (Coil Side)
Location
Horn Relay
Code or
Location
Headlight Relay (Point Side)
Parts
Radiator Fan Relay (Point Side)
*Page Nos. of
Related Systems
80 80
173 106 242 242 114 246 246 242 242 242 246 246 90 90 106 106
118
98 98
CB or Fuse
40A
AM1
15A
CIG/RADIO
40A
DEFOG
15A
ECU–1G
10A
GAUGE
7.5A
IGN
10A
MIR–HTR
30A
POWER
7.5A
SRS
15A
STOP
15A
TAIL
7.5A
TURN
20A
WIPER
30A
AM2
7.5A
ALT–S
30A
CDS FAN
20A
DOME
15A
ECU–B
15A
EFI
10A
HAZ
15A
HEAD (LWR–LH)
15A
HEAD (LWR–RH)
15A
HEAD (UPR–LH)
15A
HEAD (UPR–RH)
15A
HEAD LH
15A
HEAD RH
10A
HORN
40A
MAIN
7.5A
OBD
10A
STARTER
10A
A/C
40A
HEATER
7.5A
DRL
100A
ALT
60A
ABS
* These are the page numbers of the first page on which the related system is shown.
The part indicated is located somewhere in the system, not necessarily on the page indicated here.
[LOCATION]
(1)
(4)
(7)
62
: J/B No. 1 (See page 20
20)
: R/B No. 4 (See page25 )
: R/B No. 7 (See page27
20)
(2)
(5)
(8)
: J/B No. 2 (See page 22
19)
: R/B No. 5 (See page26 )
: Fuse Box (F10, F17 See
on page 28 29
19)
(3)
(6)
: R/B No. 1 (See page 25
23)
: R/B No. 6 (See page 26 )
POWER SOURCE (Current Flow Chart)
-Memo
37
POWER SOURCE
W
W
7
IP3
W
W
1 1E
(5S–FE)
4 EF1
W
3 EF1
W
E14 : 1MZ–FE
E23 : 5S–FE
E14 : 1MZ–FE
E15 : 5S–FE
E14 : 1MZ–FE
E20 : 5S–FE
W
W
W
W
W
4
I2
1
1
B
3
40A
AM1
G1
GENERATOR
(ALTERNATOR)
40A
HEATER
W
W
4
9 1G
4
W
W
TO ABS
ACTUATOR
2
L
W–L
1 2H
100A ALT
(1MZ–FE)
60A ABS
(5S–FE)
1 E
3
5
4
30A CDS FAN
2
1
6
2G
ENGINE
MAIN RELAY
6
2B
1 C
2
W
E , F18
FUSE BOX
B , F16
D
A , F10
C
1 D
F17
F10
30A RDI FAN
1 A (1MZ–FE)
1 B (5S–FE)
2B
B–R
W
W–B
W–B
15 3A
W–R
E6
7. 5A OBD
(5S–FE)
16 3C
15A ECU–B
15A TEL
B–R
7. 5A ALT–S
10A HORN
W–B
10A HAZ
20A DOME
B
B
2
1
30A AM2
2H
W–R
2G
15A EFI
STARTER RELAY
3
5
40A MAIN
B
FL MAIN
2. 0L
B
HEADLIGHT
RELAY
4
2
1
2C
2
5
2C
1
2F
W
3
6 EC1
1
1
W
2E
2
15A HEAD (RH)
2E
B
(CANADA)
BATTERY
(USA)
15A HEAD (LH)
5
1
DAYTIME RUNNING
LIGHT RELAY NO. 2
2
3
64
R–L
5
5
R
W–B
W
(CANADA)
2
B–R
2
15A HEAD (UPR–RH)
2H
15A HEAD (UPR–LH)
15A STOP
7. 5A SRS
W
W
4
1E
5
3
1
2
15A TAIL
TAILLIGHT
RELAY
1
POWER MAIN
RELAY
2
5
3
1
1M
30A POWER
W
2
1E
W
2
1
TO DOOR LOCK
CONTROL RELAY
40A DEFOG
1
2
5
3
2
1
I12
IGNITION SW
W
W–B
10A MIR HTR
10
1C
W–B
DEFOGGER
RELAY
4 AM1
ACC 3
P–L
IG1 2
B–Y
10
1G
3
1G
15A CIG/RADIO
15A ECU–IG
20A WIPER
ST1 7 B–W
10A GAUGE
W–R
10 AM2
B–O
IG2 9
8
1G
7. 5A TURN
7. 5A IGN
ST2
7
1A
B–R
W–B
B–R
TO STARTER
10A STARTER
B–R
B–R
17
IP1
B–R
1
E10 : 1MZ–FE
E20 : 5S–FE
E6
W
4
15A HEAD (LWR–RH)
E7
W
5
3
4
5
R–W
15A HEAD (LWR–LH)
W
W
5
1
2
5
R
EB1
W
7
2
1
7
W–R
EB
W–B
7. 5A DRL
1
W–B
W
5
IG
65
POWER SOURCE
SERVICE HINTS
TAILLIGHT RELAY
5–3 : CLOSED WITH LIGHT CONTROL SW AT TAIL OR HEAD POSITION
CLOSED WITH ENGINE RUNNING AND PARKING BRAKE LEVER RELEASED (CANADA)
ENGINE MAIN RELAY
4–5 : CLOSED WITH IGNITION SW AT ON OR ST POSITION
HEADLIGHT RELAY
2–1 : CLOSED WITH LIGHT CONTROL SW AT HEAD POSITION OR DIMMER SW AT FLASH POSITION
CLOSED WITH ENGINE RUNNING AND PARKING BRAKE LEVER RELEASED (CANADA)
I12 IGNITION SW
4–3 : CLOSED WITH IGNITION KEY AT ACC OR ON POSITION
10–9, 4–2 : CLOSED WITH IGNITION KEY AT ON OR ST POSITION
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
F10
F16
A
28
SEE PAGE
CODE
F17
E
SEE PAGE
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
B
30
F18
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
C
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
D
G1
CODE
I2
SEE PAGE
33
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
: RELAY BLOCKS
CODE
1
4
5
7
SEE PAGE
25
25
26
27
RELAY BLOCKS (RELAY BLOCK LOCATION)
R/B NO. 4 (LEFT KICK PANEL)
R/B NO. 4 (RIGHT KICK PANEL)
R/B NO. 5 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
R/B NO. 7 (NEAR THE BATTERY)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
1A
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
1C
1E
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
22
22
22
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
ENGINE WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
22
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO
NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
22
ENGINE WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
24
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO
NO. 3 (BEHIND COMBINATION METER)
1G
1M
2B
2C
2E
2F
2G
2H
3A
3C
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
EB1
EC1
EF1
IP1
IP3
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE AND RELAY WIRE
ENGINE WIRE AND ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
ENGINE WIRE AND COWL WIRE
44
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
EB
IG
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
42
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
FRONT LEFT FENDER
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE LH
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
E6
E7
E10
66
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
38 (1MZ–FE)
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE
40 (5S–FE)
38 (1MZ–FE)
CODE
E14
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
E15
E20
40 (5S–FE)
(5S FE)
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
ENGINE WIRE
E23
ENGINE WIRE
I2
44
COWL WIRE
67
STARTING AND IGNITION (1MZ–FE)
B–O
ACC
IG1
ST1 7 B–W
4 AM1
IG2 9 B–O
ST2
10 AM2
6 1G
I12
IGNITION SW
W–R
5 1E
9 1G
1 2G
B–W
B–R
1
5
1
B–W
40A
MAIN
10A
STARTER
5
3
4
N
B
STARTER
RELAY
B–W
2 2H
W
1
1 1E
17
IP1
6
5
2
5 2C
1 2F
2 2C
2 3C
B
W
3 EF1
P
1
B
30A
AM2
W–B
40A
AM1
1 EF1
B–R
2
20 3B
2 3D
1 A
B–W
B–W
E10
B–R
W–B
TO CIRCUIT OPENING
RELAY
18 3C
TO ENGINE CONTROL
MODULE (ENGINE AND
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION ECU)
A , F16
FUSE BOX
B–R
11 1C
1 1M
B
1 B
F10
100A ALT
B
6 3C
B
FL MAIN
2. 0L
1 A
1
B
W–B
B–R
M
BATTERY
S3 A , S4
B
STARTER
IG
68
P1
PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW
(NEUTRAL START SW)
W
B–W
B–O
8 1G
W–R
5 1E
B–O
IP1
B–O
B–O
B–O
B–O
B–O
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
2 A
3 A
4 A
5 A
6 A
7 A
COIL1
COIL2
COIL3
COIL4
COIL5
COIL6
GND
TACH
P
G
2
I21
IGNITON COIL NO. 6
B–O
1
I20
IGNITON COIL NO. 5
LG–B
B–O
1
I19
IGNITON COIL NO. 4
1
I18
IGNITON COIL NO. 3
1
I17
IGNITON COIL NO. 2
B–O
E13
B–O
E13
W
+B
B–O
E13
GR
1 A
E14
B–O
E12
I16
IGNITON COIL NO. 1
B–O
E14
L
B–O
I 2 A , I15 B
IGNITER
IGF
7 B
8 A
B
1 B
G–R
2 B
IGT6
R–B
3 B
IGT5
L–B
4 B
IGT4
GR–B
5 B
IGT3
Y–R
6 B
IGT2
W–G
8 B
IGT1
W–R
12
24
16
15
26
30
29
19
IGF
IGT1
IGT2
IGT3
IGT4
IGT5
IGT6
IG–
E1
D1
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 1
(CHECK
CONNECTOR)
A
J7
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
BR
E7
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ENGINE AND
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION ECU)
BR
3
W–B
TO NOISE FILTER
(FOR IGNITION SYSTEM)
16
EC
ED
69
STARTING AND IGNITION (1MZ–FE)
SERVICE HINTS
I12 IGNITION SW
4–7 : CLOSED WITH IGNITION SW AT ST POSITION
10–9 : CLOSED WITH IGNITION SW AT ON OR ST POSITION
STARTER RELAY
(6) 2– (6) 4 : CLOSED WITH CLUTCH START SW ON AND IGNITION SW AT ST POSITION (M/T)
CLOSED WITH IGNITION SW AT ST POSITION (A/T)
STARTER
POINTS CLOSED WITH CLUTCH START SW ON AND IGNITION SW AT ST POSITION
P 1 PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW (NEUTRAL START SW) (A/T)
2–3 : CLOSED WITH A/T SHIFT LEVER IN P OR N POSITION
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
D1
28
E7
CODE
I15
SEE PAGE
B
CODE
29
SEE PAGE
I21
29
33
32
I16
29
J7
F10
A
28
I17
29
P1
F16
B
28
I18
29
S3
A
29
I2
A
29
I19
29
S4
B
29
33
I20
29
I12
29
: RELAY BLOCKS
CODE
1
SEE PAGE
25
RELAY BLOCKS (RELAY BLOCK LOCATION)
R/B NO. 1 (LEFT KICK PANEL)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
1C
1E
1G
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO.
NO 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
1M
2C
22
ENGINE WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
2G
22
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
2H
22
ENGINE WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
2F
22
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
3C
24
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 3 (BEHIND COMBINATION METER)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
EF1
IP1
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
ENGINE WIRE AND COWL WIRE
44
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
EC
ED
IG
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
42
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
INTAKE MANIFOLD RH
INTAKE MANIFOLD LH
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE LH
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
E10
E12
70
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
(1MZ FE)
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
ENGINE WIRE
CODE
E13
E14
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
(1MZ FE)
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
ENGINE WIRE
71
STARTING AND IGNITION (5S–FE)
B–O
ACC
IG1
ST1 7
4 AM1
W
W–R
10 AM2
B–W
IG2 9
ST2
B–O
6 1G
I12
IGNITION SW
5 1E
B–W
B–R
9 1G
1 2G
(A/T)
1
1 EF1
3
1
1
4
STARTER
RELAY
2
5 2C
1 2F
1 EF1
IP1
B–R
17
B
B–W
W–B
2 3D
F10 A , F16
FUSE BOX
B
20 3B
B–W
W
B–R
E20
TO CIRCUIT OPENING
RELAY
6 3C
W–B
18 3C
B–R
TO ENGINE CONTROL
MODULE (ENGINE AND
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION
ECU (A/T),
ENGINE ECU (M/T))
100A ALT
B
B
11 1C
1 1M
FL MAIN
2. 0L
1 A
1
B
W–B
B–R
M
BATTERY
S3 A
,S4
B
STARTER
IG
72
B–W
6
2
(M/T)
1 A
1 B
N
2 2C
B
2 3C
3 EF1
5
5
P
B
B–W
1
B
W
2 2H
W–B
1 1E
1
B
10A
STARTER
(A/T)
40A
MAIN
(A/T)
P1
PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW
(NEUTRAL START SW)
(A/T)
B–W
30A
AM2
C7
CLUTCH START
SW (M/T)
40A
AM1
(M/T)
5
(M/T)
2
* 1 : CALIFORNIA
* 2 : EX. CALIFORNIA
* 3 : ONE BODY ASSEMBLY EX. CALIFORNIA
B–O
8 1G
W–R
6 1A
IP1
W–R
16
W–R
W–R
E20
I3
IGNITION COIL
W–R
TO NOISE FILER
(FOR IGNITION SYSTEM)
1
(* 3)
B–R
W–R
2
A (* 1) , D 2
D2
B
(*2)
DISTRIBUTOR
5
3
C–
G2
NE–
3 A (*1)
(*2)
4 A
3 B
(* 1)
(* 2)
NE
G1
E7
IGT
IG–
2
4
G2
NE–
B
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ENGINE AND
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION
ECU)
E19
B
(SHIELDED)
IP1
B
B
8
3 A
13 B
G–
A , E11
L
L
5 A
18 B
(* 2, M/T)
B
17 A
5 B
L
Y
18 A
4 B
(* 1, A/T)
R
BR
IGF
1
2 B
E16
4 A
+B
I2
IGNITER
B
2 A
4 B
G–
G–
W–R
1 A
1 B
G1
G+
W
NE
NE+
3 B
IGF
20 A (* 1, A/T)
22 B (* 2, M/T)
IGT
19
IG–
TO TACHOMETER
[COMB. METER]
D1
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 1
(CHECK CONNECTOR)
EC
73
STARTING AND IGNITION (5S–FE)
SERVICE HINTS
I12 IGNITION SW
4–7 : CLOSED WITH IGNITION SW AT ST POSITION
10–9 : CLOSED WITH IGNITION SW AT ON OR ST POSITION
C 7 CLUTCH START SW (M/T)
1–2 : CLOSED WITH CLUTCH PEDAL FULLY DEPRESSED
STARTER RELAY
(6) 2– (6) 4 : CLOSED WITH CLUTCH START SW ON AND IGNITION SW AT ST POSITION (M/T)
CLOSED WITH IGNITION SW AT ST POSITION (A/T)
STARTER
POINTS CLOSED WITH CLUTCH START SW ON AND IGNITION SW AT ST POSITION
P 1 PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW (NEUTRAL START SW) (A/T)
2–3 : CLOSED WITH A/T SHIFT LEVER IN P OR N POSITION
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
C7
D1
D2
E7
CODE
SEE PAGE
32
E11
B
32
CODE
SEE PAGE
I12
33
30
F10
A
30
A
30
F16
B
30
S3
P1
A
31
31
B
30
I2
31
S4
B
31
A
32
I3
31
: RELAY BLOCKS
CODE
1
SEE PAGE
25
RELAY BLOCKS (RELAY BLOCK LOCATION)
R/B NO. 1 (LEFT KICK PANEL)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
1A
1C
1E
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
22
ENGINE WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
22
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO
NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
22
ENGINE WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
24
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 3 (BEHIND COMBINATION METER)
1G
1M
2C
2F
2G
2H
3B
3C
3D
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
EF1
IP1
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
ENGINE WIRE AND COWL WIRE
44
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
EC
IG
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
42
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
INTAKE MANIFOLD RH
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE LH
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
E16
E19
74
SEE PAGE
40 (5S–FE)
(5S FE)
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
ENGINE WIRE
CODE
E20
SEE PAGE
40 (5S–FE)
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
ENGINE WIRE
75
CHARGING
W
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PA GE 64)
10A
GAUGE
7. 5A
IGN
3 1D
6 2C
F10
A , F10
B , F16
8
C
W
FROM DAYTIME RUNNING
LIGHT RELAY (MAIN)
(5S–FE)
9
Y
1 B
100A ALT
1 A
(1MZ–FE)
C9
CHARGE WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
W
R–L
B–O
6 1D
7. 5A
ALT–S
FUSE BOX
E
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1 C
E
Y
(CANADA)
B
Y
E
FL MAIN
2. 0L
IP3
10
R–L
2
IP3
Y
W
R–L
I18
R–L
G1 A
2 B 1 B 3 B
IG
BATTERY
L
S
TO BACK–UP SW (M/T)
TO PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION
SW (NEUTRAL START SW) (A/T)
TO VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
(SPEED SENSOR)
IC REGULATOR
76
1 A
B
, G2 B
GENERATOR
(ALTERNATOR)
SERVICE HINTS
G 1(B) GENERATOR (ALTERNATOR)
(B) 3–GROUND : 13.9–15.1 VOLTS WITH ENGINE RUNNING AT 2000 RPM AND 25°C (77°F)
13.5–14.3 VOLTS WITH ENGINE RUNNING AT 2000 RPM AND 115°C (239°F)
(B) 1–GROUND : 0–4 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION AND ENGINE NOT RUNNING
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
C9
F10
CODE
SEE PAGE
32
F16
C
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
A
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
G1
A
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
B
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
G2
B
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
CODE
SEE PAGE
J1
33
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
1D
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
2C
22
ENGINE WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
IP3
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
44
ENGINE WIRE AND COWL WIRE
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
I18
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
ENGINE WIRE
44
(1M–FE)
C9
CODE
F10
SEE PAGE
(5S–FE)
A
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
F10
B
F16
1
X X
8
G1 A
C
1
9
G2 B
BLACK
J1
DARK GRAY
1
E
1
2
E
E
3
(HINT : SEE PAGE 7)
77
ENGINE CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
SYSTEM OUTLINE
THIS SYSTEM UTILIZES AN ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ENGINE AND ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION ECU) AND
MAINTAINS OVERALL CONTROL OF THE ENGINE, TRANSMISSION AND SO ON. AN OUTLINE OF THE ENGINE CONTROL IS
EXPLAINED HERE.
1. INPUT SIGNALS
(1) ENGINE COOLANT TEMP. (WATER TEMP.) SIGNAL CIRCUIT
THE ENGINE COOLANT TEMP. SENSOR (WATER TEMP. SENSOR) DETECTS THE ENGINE COOLANT TEMP. AND HAS A
BUILT–IN THERMISTOR WITH A RESISTANCE WHICH VARIES ACCORDING TO THE WATER TEMP. IS INPUT INTO TERMINAL
THW OF ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) AS A CONTROL SIGNAL.
(2) INTAKE AIR TEMP. SIGNAL CIRCUIT
THE INTAKE AIR TEMP. SENSOR IS INSTALLED IN THE MASS AIR FLOW (AIR FLOW METER) AND DETECTS THE INTAKE AIR
TEMP., WHICH IS INPUT AS A CONTROL SIGNAL TO TERMINAL THA OF ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU).
(3) OXYGEN SENSOR SIGNAL SYSTEM
THE OXYGEN DENSITY IN THE EXHAUST GASES IS DETECTED AND INPUT AS A CONTROL SIGNAL TO TERMINAL OXL, OXR
AND OXS OF THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU). TO MAINTAIN STABLE DETECTION PERFORMANCE BY THE OXYGEN
SENSOR, A HEATER IS USED FOR WARMING THE SENSOR. THE HEATER IS ALSO CONTROLLED BY THE ENGINE CONTROL
MODULE (ECU) (HTL, HTR AND HTS).
(4) RPM SIGNAL SYSTEM
CAMSHAFT POSITION AND CRANKSHAFT POSITION ARE DETECTED BY THE CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR AND
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR. CRANKSHAFT POSITION IS INPUT AS A CONTROL SIGNAL TO TERMINAL G22+ OF THE
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU), AND ENGINE RPM IS INPUT TO TERMINAL NE+.
(5) THROTTLE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
THE THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR DETECTS THE THROTTLE VALVE OPENING ANGLE AS A CONTROL SIGNAL, WHICH IS
INPUT INTO TERMINAL VTA OF THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU). WHEN THE VALVE IS COMPLETELY CLOSED, THE
CONTROL SIGNAL IS INPUT INTO TERMINAL IDL.
(6) VEHICLE SPEED SIGNAL SYSTEM
THE VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR (SPEED SENSOR), INSTALLED INSIDE THE COMBINATION METER, DETECTS THE VEHICLE
SPEED AND INPUTS A CONTROL SIGNAL TO TERMINAL SP1 OF THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU).
(7) PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW (NEUTRAL START SW) SIGNAL SYSTEM
THE PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW (NEUTRAL START SW) DETECTS WHETHER THE SHIFT POSITION IS IN NEUTRAL OR
PARKING OR NOT, AND INPUTS A CONTROL SIGNAL TO TERMINAL NSW OF THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU).
(8) A/C SW SIGNAL SYSTEM
THE A/C AMPLIFIER INPUTS THE A/C OPERATIONS TO TEMRINAL A/C OF THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) AS A
CONTROL SIGNAL.
(9) BATTERY SIGNAL CIRCUIT
VOLTAGE IS CONSTANTLY APPLIED TO TERMINAL BATT OF THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU). WHEN THE IGNITION SW
TURNED ON, VOLTAGE FOR ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) START–UP POWER SUPPLY IS APPLIED TO TERMINALS +B
AND +B1 OF ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) VIA EFI MAIN RELAY.
(10) INTAKE AIR VOLUME SIGNAL CIRCUIT
INTAKE AIR VOLUME IS DETECTED BY THE MASS AIR FLOW (AIR FLOW METER) AND THE SIGNAL IS INPUT TO TERMINAL VG
OF THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU). AS A CONTROL SIGNAL.
(11) STA SIGNAL CIRCUIT
TO CONFIRM WHETHER THE ENGINE IS CRANKING, THE VOLTAGE APPLIED TO THE STARTER MOTOR DURING CRANKING IS
DETECTED AND THE SIGNAL IS INPUT INTO TERMINAL STA OF THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) AS A CONTROL
SIGNAL.
(12) ENGINE KNOCK SIGNAL CIRCUIT
ENGINE KNOCKING IS DETECTED BY THE KNOCK SENSOR NO. 1 AND NO. 2 AND THE SIGNALS ARE INPUT INTO TERMINALS
KNKR AND KNKL AS A CONTROL SIGNAL.
78
2. CONTROL SYSTEM
* SFI (SEQUENTIAL MULTIPORT FUEL INJECTION) (EFI (ELECTRONIC FUEL INJECTION) SYSTEM
THE EFI SYSTEM MONITORS THE ENGINE CONDITION THROUGH THE SIGNALS INPUT FROM EACH SENSOR (INPUT SIGNALS
FROM (1) TO (12) ETC.). THE BEST FUEL INJECTION VOLUME IS DECIDED BASED ON THIS DATA AND THE PROGRAM MEMORIZED
BY THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU), AND THE CONTROL SIGNAL IS OUTPUT TO TERMINALS #10, #20, #30, #40, #50 AND #60
OF THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) TO OPERATE THE INJECTOR (INJECT THE FUEL). THE EFI SYSTEM PRODUCES
CONTROL OF FUEL INJECTION OPERATION BY THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) IN RESPONSE TO THE DRIVING
CONDITIONS.
* ESA (ELECTRONIC SPARK ADVANCE) SYSTEM
THE ESA SYSTEM MONITORS THE ENGINE CONDITION THROUGH THE SIGNALS INPUT TO THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU)
FROM EACH SENSOR (INPUT SIGNALS FROM (1), (3), (4) TO (12) ETC.). THE BEST IGNITION TIMING IS DECIDED ACCORDING TO
THIS DATA AND THE MEMORIZED DATA IN THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) AND THE CONTROL SIGNAL IS OUTPUTS TO
TERMINALS IGT1, IGT2, IGT3, IGT4, IGT5 AND IGT6. THIS SIGNAL CONTROLS THE IGNITER TO PROVIDE THE BEST IGNITION
TIMING FOR THE DRIVING CONDITIONS.
* HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (OXYGEN SENSOR) HEATER CONTROL SYSTEM
THE OXYGEN SENSOR HEATER CONTROL SYSTEM TURNS THE HEATER ON WHEN THE INTAKE AIR VOLUME IS LOW (TEMP. OF
EXHAUST EMISSIONS IS LOW), AND WARMS UP THE OXYGEN SENSOR (NO. 1 AND NO. 2) TO IMPROVE DETECTION
PERFORMANCE OF THE SENSOR.
THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) EVALUATES THE SIGNALS FROM EACH SENSOR (INPUT SIGNALS FROM (1), (4), (9) TO (10)
ETC.), AND OUTPUT CURRENT TO TERMINALS HTL, HTR AND HTS AND CONTROL THE HEATER.
* IAC (IDLE AIR CONTROL (ISC)) SYSTEM
THE IAC (ISC) SYSTEM (ROTARY SOLENOID TYPE) INCREASES THE RPM AND PROVIDES IDLE STABILITY FOR FAST IDLE–UP
WHEN THE ENGINE IS COLD, AND WHEN THE IDLE SPEED HAS DROPPED DUE TO ELECTRICAL LOAD AND SO ON, THE ENGINE
CONTROL MODULE (ECU) EVALUATES THE SIGNALS FROM EACH SENSOR (INPUT SIGNALS FROM (1), (4), (5), (8), (9) ETC.),
OUTPUTS CURRENT TO TERMINALS RSO AND RSC TO CONTROL IDLE AIR CONTROL VALVE.
* EGR CONTROL SYSTEM
THE EGR CONTROL SYSTEM DETECTS THE SIGNAL FROM EACH SENSOR (INPUT SIGNALS FROM (1), (4), (9), (10), ETC)., AND
OUTPUTS CURRENT TO TERMINAL EGR TO CONTROL THE EGR VALVE.
* ACIS (ACOUSTIC CONTROL INDUCTION SYSTEM)
ACIS INCLUDES A VALVE IN THE BULKHEAD SEPARATING THE SURGE TANK INTO TWO PARTS. THIS VALVE IS OPENED AND
CLOSED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE DRIVING CONDITIONS TO CONTROL THE INTAKE MANIFOLD LENGTH IN TWO STAGES FOR
INCREASED ENGINE OUTPUT IN ALL RANGES FROM LOW TO HIGH SPEEDS.
THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) JUDGES THE ENGINE SPEED BY THE SIGNALS ((4), (5)) FROM EACH SENSOR AND
OUTPUTS SIGNALS TO THE TERMINAL ACIS TO CONTROL THE VSV (FOR OPENING AND CLOSING THE INTAKE CONTROL VALVE)
3. DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
WITH THE DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM, WHEN THERE IS A MALFUNCTION IN THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) SIGNAL SYSTEM, THE
MALFUNCTIONING SYSTEM IS RECORDED IN THE MEMORY.
4. FAIL–SAFE SYSTEM
WHEN A MALFUNCTION HAS OCCURRED IN ANY SYSTEM, IF THERE IS A POSSIBILITY OF ENGINE TROUBLE BEING CAUSED BY
CONTINUED CONTROL BASED ON THE SIGNALS FROM THAT SYSTEM, THE FAIL–SAFE SYSTEM EITHER CONTROLS THE SYSTEM
BY USING DATA (STANDARD VALUES) RECORDED IN THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) MEMORY OR ELSE STOPS THE
ENGINE.
79
ENGINE CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
B–O
B–W
4 AM1
B–W
ST1 7 B–W
L–B
B–O
B–O
W–R
9 1G
1 2G
IG2 9 B–O
8 1G
I12
IGNITION SW
FROM POWER SOURCE
SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
9 1D
B–O
W
10 AM2
10A
STARTER
7. 5A
IGN
2
4
16
1
30A
AM2
B–W
B–W
B–O
6 1A
B–O
40A
AM1
IP1
20 3B
2 3C
1
I20
6
9
2
B–O
15
B–O
E12
B–O
6
I18
4
6
B–O
B–O
B–O
B–O
B–O
B–O
W–B
I18
1
6
6
13 3A
IJ1
L–B
18 3C
W–B
2
4 BX1
11 1C
L–B
1
1 1M
G–R
W–B
Y
1
I5
INJECTOR NO. 2
I8
INJECTOR NO. 5
1
2
R
2
L
1
I7
INJECTOR NO. 4
I6
INJECTOR NO. 3
1
2
GR
I9
INJECTOR NO. 6
1
W
FL MAIN
2. 0L
2
G
B
I4
INJECTOR NO. 1
B
16
2
L–B
B–O
B
A , F16
FUSE BOX
F10
B–O
L–B
I18
E12
IP3
CIRCUIT
OPENING
RELAY
G–R
W
100A ALT
6
3
1 B
B–O
IP1
3 EF1
1 A
4
IP1
B–W
B–O
B
W
B–O
2 3D
L–B
2 2H
1 1E
Y
R
L
BATTERY
GR
G
W
IG
80
B–O
B–O
B–W
B–W
L–B
L–B
B–O
B–O
A
A
B–O
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IP1
P
2
1
18
IP3
ELS
B–L
B–R
14 A
13 A
23 A
22 A
1 C
12 C
25 A
NSW
STA
RSO
A , E8
RSC
B ,E9
ACV
C , E10
B–O
11
B–O
IP1
6 C
FPU
ACIS
D
7 A
8 A
5 A
10 A
L
GR
G
W
# 10
6 A
R
# 60
9 A
Y
# 30
22 D
B–O
# 40
23 D
B–O
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
(ENGINE AND ELECTRONIC
CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION ECU)
+B
+B1
# 20
# 50
B–O
EGR
R–Y
W–L
B–R
21 D
Y–B
W–L
14 D
D6
DIODE
(FOR IDLE–UP)
E7
B–O
2
IP3
BATT
L–B
2
1 EF1
2
I23
2
G–B
12
3
1
3
W–G
4 2D
B–O
W–B
B–O
I18
B–W
3 2C
B–O
1
1
B–W
2 2B
5 1E
5 3C
B–W
5
G
2
1
B–W
B–O
EFI MAIN
RELAY
5 3D
1
V4
VSV
(FOR INTAKE AIR CONTROL)
B–O
6 1G
E11
V3
VSV
(FOR FUEL PRESSURE UP)
B–O
3
V1
VSV
(FOR A/C IDLE–UP)
G
2
1
B–O
E12
B–O
10 1A
B–O
E10
V2
VSV
(FOR EGR)
B–O
2 2D
14 1D
B–O
I18
B–O
10A
MIR–
HTR
15A
TAIL
15A
EFI
I1
ILDE AIR CONTROL VALVE
(ISC VALVE)
B–O
18
B–O
B–W
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
B–O
A
I23
F15
FUEL PUMP
L–B
4
M
5
W–B
5
BX1
B–O
20
G–R
G–R
IP1
Y
R
L
GR
G
EB
W–B
W–B
W
BL
81
ENGINE CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
B–O
B–O
B
W–B
B–O
B–O
B–O
E13
B–O
E14
B–O
E14
L–B
L–B
B–O
15 A
26 A
30 A
29 A
IGT2
IGT3
IGT4
IGT5
E7
BR
25 D
OXS
B ,E9
C , E10
B–O
I18
11 C
19 B
OXR
R–L
HTR
W–B
10 C
OXL
HTL
D
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE(ENGINE AND ELECTRONIC
CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION ECU)
THW
THA
T1
THROTTLE
POSITION
SENSOR
E2
4
BR
M6
MASS AIR FLOW
(AIR FLOW METER)
I18
BR
E01
E02
34 A
15 B
W
3 EE1 1 EE1
W–B
2
1
1
I18
BR
I18
ED
82
KNKR
E03
28 A
G–B
33 A
W
VG–
1
A/C
20 D
BR
3
BR
VG
5
ACT
5 D
BR
+B
2
2
E4
ENGINE COOLANT TEMP. SENSOR
(EFI WATER TEMP. SENSOR)
FROM COOLING
FAN ECU
G–R
1
G–Y
2
B–O
E1
EGR GAS
TEMP. SENSOR
3
L
B–Y
4
I18
L–W
L–R
BR
L–B
R–B
R
G–R
L–W
20 B
(SHIELDED)
THG
14 C
(SHIELDED)
IDL
32 A
K1
KNOCK SENSOR 1
VTA
7 B
W–B
VC
W–B
E2
22 B 1 B
FROM
A/C AMPLIFIER
THA
21 B
B–Y
VG–
LG–R
VG
8 B 7 C
TO
A/C AMPLIFIER
FC
18 B
B–O
(SHIELDED)
(SHIELDED)
W–B
BR
H12
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
(BANK2 SENSOR1)
B–O
BR
L–B
R–L
13 B
HTS
V–R
II1
1
R–L
8
I18
26 D
IGT6
A ,E8
II1
HT
3
R–L
16 A
IGT1
10
OX
HT
1
L–B
24 A
IGF
II1
P–B
12 A
9
E
R–L
B
G–R
1 A
R–B
2 A
L–B
3 A
IGT6
GR–B
4 A
IGT5
Y–R
5 A
IGT4
W–G
6 A
IGT3
W–R
8 A
IGT2
(SHIELDED)
IGT1
OX
3
4
+B
W
IGNITER
H11
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
(BANK1 SENSOR1)
W
B–O
GND
TACH
2
E
(SHIELDED)
COIL6
1
4
+B
HT
3
P–B
7 B 8 B 7 A
COIL4
COIL5
2
E
B
5 B 6 B
COIL3
(SHIELDED)
4 B
COIL2
W
3 B
IGF
4
OX
COIL1
(SHIELDED)
IQ1
+B
2 B
BR
BR
H9
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
(BANK1 SENSOR2)
B–O
I20
IGNITION
COIL NO. 5
P
LG–B
2
5
2
1 B
I 2 A , I 15 B
B–O
W–B
I21
IGNITION
COIL NO. 6
2
L–B
2
B
B–O
B–O
B–O
I18
IGNITION
COIL NO. 3
G
I16
IGNITION
COIL NO. 1
GR
1
2
4 IQ1
B–O
2
BR
1
I19
IGNITION
COIL NO. 4
1
2
B–O
I18
BR
1
I17
IGNITION
COIL NO. 2
1
1
B–O
I18
E13
B–O
B–O
E13
B–O
B–O
E12
+B
B–O
I18
1
(SHIELDED)
W–B
8
5
1C
1M
BR
BR
BR
BR
BR
BR
BR
BR
BR
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
J7
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
(SHIELDED)
A
B
(SHIELDED)
A
G
I18
22 3D
A
A
A
A
A
IP2
14
G
R
12
16
W–B
IP3
SPEED
BR
4
BR
I18
(SHIELDED)
(SHIELDED)
E14
V–Y
BR
(SHIELDED)
L
B–W
(SHIELDED)
W
(SHIELDED)
BR
IP2
5
BR
A
3
A
A
10 3D
BR
BR
R–L
11
I18
4 EE1 2 EE1
R–L
2
BR
SP1
12 D
(SHIELDED)
BR
R
L
E1
16 C
W–B
5 B 6 B
17 B
2
V–Y
NE+ NE–
BR
16 B
B–W
14 B
G22–
G
G22+
BR
D
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE(ENGINE AND ELECTRONIC
CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION ECU)
KNKL
BR
C , E10
BR
B ,E9
1
1
W
SDL
V5
VEHICLE SPEED
SENSOR
(SPEED SENSOR)
LG
A , E8
3 C
28 D
TE2
E7
C
G
11 D
TE1
BR
IP1
B–O
W–B
5 C
R–L
G–R
19
IP3
V–Y
IM1
G–R
B–O
6 A
R–L
W
G–W
2
2
C
P
IP1
12 3D
6 1B
B
1
R–L
2
6
1D
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
SDL
B
BATT
16
10A
GAUGE
G–B
3 3D
15
G–W
A , C10 B
R–L
4
3 B
MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP
(CHECK ENGINE WARNING LIGHT)
[COMB. METER]
2
18 3D
E1
C9
8
3
5
SG
CG
D24
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 3
OX2
3 3D
C8
COMBINATION
METER
TE2 OX1
4
BR
BR
TE1
GR–B
D1
DATA LINK CONNECTOR
1 (CHECK CONNECTOR)
7 3D
G–R
7. 5A
OBD
E1
I23
(SHIELDED)
L–B
3
FP
BR
D3
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR
2 (TDCL)
B–O
1
+B
W–B
B
12
IG–
F
J1
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
(SHIELDED)
FROM POWER
SOURCE SYSTEM F
(SEE PAGE 64)
N1
NOISE FILTER
(FOR IGNITION
SYSTEM)
B–O
19
W–B
W–B
L–B
(SHIELDED)
(SHIELDED)
(SHIELDED)
B
BR
BR
W–B
BR
C17
CAMSHAFT POSITION
SENSOR
K2
KNOCK SENSOR 2
2
1
W–B
1
1
C18
CRANKSHAFT POSITION
SENSOR
BR
BR
2
EC
ED
IE
83
ENGINE CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
SERVICE HINTS
CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
2–1 : CLOSED WITH STARTER RUNNING OR MEASURING PLATE (VOLUME AIR FLOW (AIR FLOW METER)) OPEN
EFI MAIN RELAY
2–4 : CLOSED WITH IGNITION SW AT ON OR ST POSITION
E 4 ENGINE COOLANT TEMP. SENSOR (EFI WATER TEMP. SENSOR)
1–2 : 10.0 – 20.0 K (–20°C, –4°F)
: 4.0 – 7.0 K (0°C, 32°F)
: 2.0 – 3.0 K (20°C, 68°F)
: 0.9 – 1.3 K (40°C, 104°F)
: 0.4 – 0.7 K (60°C, 140°F)
: 0.2 – 0.4 K (80°C, 176°F)
E 7(A), E 8(B), E 9(C), E10(D)
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ENGINE AND ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION ECU)
VOLTAGE AT ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) WIRING CONNECTOR
BATT – E1 : ALWAYS 9.0–14.0 VOLTS
+B – E1 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS (IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION)
+B1 – E1 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS (IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION)
IDL – E1 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS (IGNITION SW ON AND THROTTLE VALVE FULLY OPEN)
0–3.0 VOLTS (IGNITION SW ON AND THROTTLE VALVE FULLY CLOSED)
VC – E1 : ALWAYS 4.5–5.5 VOLTS (IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION)
VTA – E1 : 0.3–0.8 VOLTS (IGNITION SW ON AND THROTTLE VALVE FULLY CLOSED)
3.2–4.9 VOLTS (IGNITION SW ON AND THROTTLE VALVE FULLY OPEN)
VG – E1 : 4.0–5.5 VOLTS (IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION)
THA – E1 : 0.5–3.4 VOLTS (IGNITION SW ON AND INTAKE AIR TEMP. 20°C, 68°F)
THW – E1 : 0.2–1.0 VOLTS (ENGINE IDLING AND COOLANT TEMP. 80°C, 176°F)
#10, #20, #30, #40, #50, #60
– E01 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS (IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION)
PULSE GENERATION (ENGINE IDLING)
IGT1, IGT2, IGT3
IGT4, IGT5, IGT6 – E1 : PULSE GENERATION (ENGINE IDLING)
IGF – E1 : 4.5–5.5 VOLTS (IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION)
PULSE GENERATION (ENGINE IDLING)
G22+ – G– : PULSE GENERATION (ENGINE IDLING)
NE+ – G– : PULSE GENERATION (ENGINE IDLING)
RSC, RSO – E1 : PULSE GENERATION (ENGINE IDLING AND A/C OPERATION)
OXS, OXL, OXR – E1 : PULSE GENERATION (MAINTAIN ENGINE SPEED AT 2500 RPM FOR TWO MINUTES AFTER WARMING UP)
HTS, HTL, HTR – E01 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS (IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION)
0–3.0 VOLTS (ENGINE IDLING)
KNKL, KNLR – E1 : PULSE GENERATION (ENGINE IDLING)
NSW – E1 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS (IGNITION SW ON AND OTHER SHIFT POSITION IN P OR N POSITION)
BELOW 3.0 VOLTS (IGNITION SW ON AND SHIFT POSITION IN P OR N POSITION)
SP1 – E1 : PULSE GENERATION (IGNITION SW ON AND ROTATE DRIVING WHEEL SLOWLY)
TE1 – E1 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS (IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION)
TE2 – E1 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS (IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION)
W – E1 : BELOW 3.0 VOLTS (MULFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP ON)
9.0–14.0 VOLTS (MULFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP OFF AND ENGINE RUNNING)
A/C – E1 : BELOW 1.5 VOLTS (ENGINE IDLING AND A/C SW ON)
7.5–14.0 VOLTS (A/C SW OFF)
ACT – E1 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS (ENGINE IDLING AND A/C SW ON)
BELOW 1.5 VOLTS (A/C SW OFF)
ACIS – E01 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS (IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION)
STA – E1 : 6.0 VOLTS OR MORE (ENGINE CRANKING)
I 4, I 5, I 6, I 7, I 8, I 9 INJECTOR
1–2 : APPROX. 13.8
T 1 THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
3–1 : 0.2–5.7 K WITH CLEARANCE BETWEEN LEVER AND STOP SCREW 0 MM (0 IN.)
2–1 : LESS THAN 2.3 K WITH CLEARANCE BETWEEN LEVER AND STOP SCREW 0.5 MM (0.020 IN.)
WITH CLEARANCE BETWEEN LEVER AND STOP SCREW 0.7 MM (0.0276 IN.)
3–1 : 2.0–10.2 K WITH THROTTLE VALVE FULLY OPEN
84
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
C8
CODE
32
F16
H9
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
B
28
I20
29
D
C9
A
32
33
I21
29
C10
B
32
H11
28
J1
33
C17
28
H12
28
J2
33
C18
28
I1
29
J6
39
D1
28
29
J7
33
D3
32
I4
28
K1
29
D6
32
I5
29
K2
29
D24
32
I6
29
M6
29
E1
28
I7
29
N1
29
E4
28
I8
29
T1
29
I9
29
V1
29
29
V2
29
I2
A
E7
A
32
E8
B
32
E9
C
32
I16
29
V3
29
E10
D
32
I17
29
V4
29
F10
A
28
I18
29
V5
29
30
I19
29
F15
F15
B
: RELAY BLOCKS
CODE
SEE PAGE
RELAY BLOCKS (RELAY BLOCK LOCATION)
1
25
R/B NO. 1 (LEFT KICK PANEL)
6
26
R/B NO. 6 (BEHIND GLOVE BOX)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
1A
1B
1C
1D
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
22
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
22
ENGINE WIRE AND J/B NO
NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
2G
22
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
2H
22
ENGINE WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
24
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO
NO. 3 (BEHIND COMBINATION METER)
1E
1G
1M
2B
2C
2D
3A
3B
3C
3D
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
EE1
40 (1MZ–FE)
ENGINE WIRE AND SENSOR WIRE
EF1
38 (1MZ–FE)
ENGINE WIRE AND COWL WIRE
II1
42
COWL WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
IJ1
42
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND COWL WIRE
IM1
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE AND CONSOLE BOX WIRE
44
ENGINE WIRE AND COWL WIRE
44
ENGINE WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
IP1
IP2
IP3
IQ1
46 (S/D)
BX1
48 (C/P)
FUEL GAUGE WIRE AND FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE
50 (W/G)
85
ENGINE CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
EB
38 (1MZ–FE)
FRONT LEFT FENDER
EC
38 (1MZ–FE)
INTAKE MANIFOLD RH
ED
38 (1MZ–FE)
INTAKE MANIFOLD LH
IE
42
LEFT KICK PANEL
IG
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE LH
46 (S/D)
BL
48 (C/P)
UNDER THE LEFT QUARTER PILLAR
50 (W/G)
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
E10
E11
E12
E13
86
38 (1MZ–FE)
(1MZ FE)
ENGINE WIRE
CODE
SEE PAGE
E14
38 (1MZ–FE)
I18
44
I20
I23
44
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
ENGINE WIRE
COWL WIRE
87
ENGINE CONTROL (5S–FE)
SYSTEM OUTLINE
THIS SYSTEM UTILIZES AN ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ENGINE ECU (M/T), ENGINE AND ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION ECU (A/T)) AND MAINTAINS OVERALL CONTROL OF THE ENGINE, TRANSMISSION AND SO ON. AN OUTLINE OF THE
ENGINE CONTROL IS EXPLAINED HERE.
1. INPUT SIGNALS
(1) ENGINE COOLANT TEMP. (WATER TEMP.) SIGNAL SYSTEM
THE ENGINE COOLANT TEMP. SENSOR (EFI WATER TEMP. SENSOR) DETECTS THE ENGINE COOLANT TEMP. AND HAS A
BUILT–IN THERMISTOR WITH A RESISTANCE WHICH VARIES ACCORDING TO THE ENGINE COOLANT TEMP. (WATER TEMP.)
THUS THE ENGINE COOLANT TEMP. (WATER TEMP.) IS INPUT IN THE FORM OF A CONTROL SIGNAL TO TERMINAL THW OF
THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU).
(2) INTAKE AIR TEMP. SIGNAL SYSTEM
THE INTAKE AIR TEMP. SENSOR (IN–AIR TEMP. SENSOR) IS DETECTS THE INTAKE AIR TEMP., WHICH IS INPUT AS A
CONTROL SIGNAL TO TERMINAL THA OF THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU).
(3) OXYGEN SENSOR SIGNAL SYSTEM
THE OXYGEN DENSITY IN THE EXHAUST GASES IS DETECTED AND INPUT AS A CONTROL SIGNAL TO TERMINAL OX1 AND
OX2 OF THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU).
(4) RPM SIGNAL SYSTEM
CRANKSHAFT POSITION AND ENGINE RPM ARE DETECTED BY THE PICK–UP COIL INSTALLED INSIDE THE DISTRIBUTOR.
CRANKSHAFT POSITION IS INPUT AS A CONTROL SIGNAL TO TERMINALS G+ AND G2 (CALIFORNIA), OF THE ENGINE
CONTROL MODULE (ECU), AND RPM IS INPUT TO TERMINAL NE+.
(5) THROTTLE SIGNAL SYSTEM
THE THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR DETECTS THE THROTTLE VALVE OPENING ANGLE, WHICH IS INPUT AS A CONTROL
SIGNAL TO TERMINAL VTA OF THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU), OR WHEN THE VALVE IS FULLY CLOSED, TO
TERMINAL IDL
(6) VEHICLE SPEED SIGNAL SYSTEM
THE VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR (SPEED SENSOR), INSTALLED INSIDE THE COMBINATION METER, DETECTS THE VEHICLE
SPEED AND INPUTS A CONTROL SIGNAL TO TERMINAL SPD OF THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU).
(7) PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW (NEUTRAL START SW) SIGNAL SYSTEM (A/T)
THE PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW (NEUTRAL START SW) DETECTS WHETHER THE SHIFT POSITION ARE IN NEUTRAL AND
PARKING OR NOT, AND INPUTS A CONTROL SIGNAL TO TERMINAL NSW OF THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU).
(8) A/C SW SIGNAL SYSTEM
THE A/C AMPLIFIER INPUTS THE A/C OPERATIONS TO TARMINAL ACA OF THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) AS A
CONTROL SIGNAL.
(9) BATTERY SIGNAL CIRCUIT
VOLTAGE IS CONSTANTLY APPLIED TO TERMINAL BATT OF THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU). WHEN THE IGNITION SW
TURNED ON, THE VOLTAGE FOR ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) START–UP POWER SUPPLY IS APPLIED TO TERMINALS
+B AND +B1 OF ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) VIA EFI MAIN RELAY. THE CURRENT FLOWING THROUGH THE IGN FUSE
FLOWS TO TERMINAL IGSW OF THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU).
(10) INTAKE AIR VOLUME SIGNAL SYSTEM
INTAKE AIR VOLUME IS DETECTED BY THE MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE SENSOR (VACUUM SENSOR) (FOR MANIFOLD
PRESSURE) AND IS INPUT AS A CONTROL SIGNAL TO TERMINAL PIM OF THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU).
(11) STA SIGNAL CIRCUIT
TO CONFIRM WHETHER THE ENGINE IS CRANKING, THE VOLTAGE APPLIED TO THE STARTER MOTOR DURING CRANKING IS
DETECTED AND THE SIGNAL IS INPUT INTO TERMINAL STA OF THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) AS A CONTROL
SIGNAL.
(12) ENGINE KNOCK SIGNAL CIRCUIT
ENGINE KNOCKING IS DETECTED BY KNOCK SENSOR AND THE SIGNAL IS INPUT INTO TERMINAL KNK AS A CONTROL
SIGNAL.
(13) ELECTRICAL LOAD SIGNAL SYSTEM
THE SIGNAL WHEN SYSTEMS SUCH AS THE REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER, HEADLIGHTS, ETC. WHICH CAUSE A HIGH
ELECTRICAL BURDEN ARE ON IS INPUT TO TERMINAL ELS AS A CONTROL SIGNAL.
88
2. CONTROL SYSTEM
* MFI (MULTIPORT FUEL INJECTION (EFI)) SYSTEM
THE MFI (EFI) SYSTEM MONITORS THE ENGINE CONDITION THROUGH THE SIGNALS INPUT FROM EACH SENSOR (INPUT
SIGNALS FROM (1) TO (13) ETC.) TO THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU). THE BEST FUEL INJECTION VOLUME IS DECIDED
BASED ON THIS DATA AND THE PROGRAM MEMORIZED BY THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU), AND THE CONTROL SIGNAL
IS OUTPUT TO TERMINALS #10, #20, #30 AND #40 (CALIFORNIA), TERMINALS #10 AND #20 (EX. CALIFORNIA) OF THE ENGINE
CONTROL MODULE (ECU) TO OPERATE THE INJECTOR. (INJECT THE FUEL). THE MFI (EFI) SYSTEM PRODUCES CONTROL OF
FUEL INJECTION OPERATION BY THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) IN RESPONSE TO THE DRIVING CONDITIONS.
* ESA (ELECTRONIC SPARK ADVANCE) SYSTEM
THE ESA SYSTEM MONITORS THE ENGINE CONDITION THROUGH THE SIGNALS INPUT TO THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU)
FROM EACH SENSOR (INPUT SIGNALS FROM (1), (2), (4) TO (12) ETC.) THE BEST IGNITION TIMING IS DETECTED ACCORDING TO
THIS DATA AND THE MEMORIZED DATA IN THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) AND THE CONTROL SIGNAL IS OUTPUT TO
TERMINAL IGT. THIS SIGNAL CONTROLS THE IGNITER TO PROVIDE THE BEST IGNITION TIMING FOR THE DRIVING CONDITIONS.
* IAC (IDLE AIR CONTROL (ISC)) SYSTEM
THE IAC (ISC) SYSTEM (ROTARY SOLENOID TYPE) INCREASES THE RPM AND PROVIDES IDLING STABILITY FOR FAST IDLE–UP
WHEN THE ENGINE IS COLD AND WHEN THE IDLE SPEED HAS DROPPED DUE TO ELECTRICAL LOAD, ETC. THE ENGINE
CONTROL MODULE (ECU) EVALUATES THE SIGNALS FROM EACH SENSOR (INPUT SIGNALS (1), (4) TO (8), (13) ETC.), OUTPUTS
CURRENT TO TERMINALS ISCO AND ISCC, AND CONTROLS THE IDLE AIR CONTROL VALVE (ISC VALVE).
* FUEL PUMP CONTROL SYSTEM
THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) OPERATION OUTPUTS TO TERMINAL FC AND CONTROLS THE CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
AND THUS CONTROLS THE FUEL PUMP DRIVE SPEED IN RESPONSE TO CONDITIONS.
* A/C IDLE–UP SYSTEM
IN ORDER TO PREVENT THE ENGINE IDLING SPEED FROM DROPPING WHEN THE A/C IS OPERATING, THE A/C IDLE–UP SYSTEM
CONTROLS THE VSV (FOR A/C IDLE–UP) TO INCREASE THE ENGINE IDLING SPEED AND KEEP IT STABLE.
* EGR CONTROL SYSTEM
THE EGR CUT CONTROL SYSTEM CONTROLS THE VSV (FOR EGR) BY EVALUATING THE SIGNALS FROM EACH SENSOR INPUT TO
THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) (INPUT SIGNALS (1), (5), (6), (9) ETC.) AND BY SENDING OUTPUT TO TERMINAL THG OF
THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU).
* A/C CUT CONTROL SYSTEM
WHEN THE VEHICLE SUDDENLY ACCELERATES FROM LOW ENGINE SPEED, THIS SYSTEM CUTS OFF AIR CONDITIONING
OPERATION FOR A FIXED PERIOD OF TIME IN RESPONSE TO THE VEHICLE SPEED AND THROTTLE VALVE OPENING ANGLE IN
ORDER TO MAINTAIN ACCELERATION PERFORMANCE.
THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) RECEIVES INPUT SIGNALS ((5), (6) ETC.), AND OUTPUTS SIGNALS TO TERMINAL ACT.
3. DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
WITH THE DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM, WHEN THERE IS A MALFUNCTIONING IN THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) SIGNAL SYSTEM,
THE MALFUNCTION SYSTEM IS RECORDED IN THE MEMORY. THE MALFUNCTIONING SYSTEM CAN THEN BE FOUND BY READING
THE DISPLAY (CODE) OF THE MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP (CHECK ENGINE WARNING LIGHT).
4. FAIL–SAFE SYSTEM
WHEN A MALFUNCTION OCCURS IN ANY SYSTEM, IF THERE IS A POSSIBILITY OF ENGINE TROUBLE BEING CAUSED BY
CONTINUED CONTROL BASED ON THE SIGNALS FROM THAT SYSTEM, THE FAIL–SAFE SYSTEM EITHER CONTROLS THE SYSTEM
BY USING DATA (STANDARD VALUES) RECORDED IN THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) MEMORY OR ELSE STOPS THE
ENGINE.
89
ENGINE CONTROL (5S–FE A/T AND CALIFORNIA M/T)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
16
IP1
W–R
W–R
AM1
B–O
W–G
W–R
B–O
IP1
E18
B–O
E18
(* 1)
B–O
B–O
3
1
B–O
B–O
2
11
V2
VSV
(FOR EGR)
3 2C
1
2
IP1
1
W–R
W–L
G–R
G–Y
LG
G
B–O
W–B
1 A
9 C
10 C
7 C
23 C
12 A
W–R
E11
C , E12
B , E14
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ENGINE ECU)(M/T)
5 1E
(* 1)
B–W
(* 4)
(* 4)
I18
I21
B–W
(* 2)
I2
14 1A
(* 2)
6 1G
B–W
W
B–W
I18
Y
22 A
B–W
W (* 2)
Y
NSW
# 30
25 C
(* 5)
Y (* 2)
# 10
12 C
B–W
1
R–B (* 1)
#20
11 C
Y
1
I7
INJECTOR NO. 4
I6
INJECTOR NO. 2
I5
INJECTOR NO. 3
# 40
24 C
A
(* 1)
2
+B
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ENGINE AND ELECTRONIC
CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION ECU)(A/T)
R–L
W–R
2
EGR
B , E10 A
W (* 1)
W–R
2
ISCV
C ,E8
W (* 2)
W–R
2
ISCO
E7
Y (* 1)
W–R
E20
ISCC
(* 5)
W–R
I23
BATT
1
(* 1)
E17
B–O
W–R
2 2B
4 (* 1)
5 (* 2)
2
V1
VSV
(FOR A/C IDLE–UP)
3
2
I1
IDLE AIR CONTROL
VALVE
(ISC VALVE)
EFI MAIN
RELAY
B–O
W–R
IP3
B–O
12
IP1
W (* 2)
B–O
E20
2 (* 1)
3 (* 2)
E20
W (* 1)
B–O
2 2D
1
1
E20
I4
INJECTOR NO. 1
B–O
4 2D
B–O
(EX. CALIFORNIA M/T)
B–W
W–R
18
I20
B–W
W–B
(EX. CALIFORNIA M/T)
EB
90
E17
9 1D
6 1A
B–W
(*2)
B–O
7
8 1G
1
B–O
15A
EFI
B–O
(* 1)
E17
7. 5A
IGN
9
9
B–O
IG1
ST1
ACC
ST2
IG2
I12
IGNITION SW
AM2
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
TO PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW
(NEUTRAL START SW)
B–O
* 1 : CALIFORNIA
* 2 : EX. CALIFORNIA
* 4 : FOR CANADA IN TMM MADE
W–R
W–R
* 5 : EX. * 4
W–R
E20
B–O
B–O
B–O
W–R
B–O
B
W–R
E20
TO TACHOMETER
[COMB. METER]
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
B–O
15A
TAIL
10A
MIR–HTR
ONE BODY ASSEMBLY
EX. CALIFORNIA
W–R
(* 1)
10 1A
E19
5 3D
B–R
2
3
4
5 3C
5
D2
DISTRIBUTOR
3
G2(* 1)
NE–(* 2)
NE
1
1
3
2
4
3
2
4
R
L
B
Y
G+
B–R
1
G–
2 A
4 C
IGT
2
(* 1)
(* 2)
17 C
NE–
G2
18 C
3 C
G+ (* 2)
G1 (* 1)
G–
G–
20 C
IGF
IGT
E7
C ,E8
B , E10
A ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ENGINE AND ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION ECU)(A/T)
E11
C , E12
B , E14
A ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ENGINE ECU)(M/T)
B–Y
L
I18
R
I18
1
E17
THG
1
E17
BR
BR
9 B
2
1
E18
BR
I18
BR
E18
BR
BR
L
R
E2
16 B
GR
2
BR
E21
10 B
BR
2
FROM CRUISE
CONTROL ECU
THA
3 B
BR
THW
4 B
E1
EGR GAS TEMP.
SENSOR
PIM
2 B
I10
INTAKE AIR TEMP. SENSOR
(IN–AIR TEMP. SENSOR)
L–B
BR
12 B
L
IDL
11 B
B
VTA
1 B
BR
5 C
NE+
NE
R
VC
IGF
1
I2
IGNITER
(* 2)
ELS
FPU
IG–
(SHIELDED)
E4
ENGINE COOLANT TEMP. SENSOR
(EFI WATER TEMP. SENSOR)
LG
BR
B–R
8 C
(*1)
B–O
13 A
+B
W
COIL–
W–R
G
1
2
+B1
B
1
W–R
P
2
D6
DIODE
(FOR IDLE–UP)
V3
VSV
(FOR PRESSURE UP)
G
B
14 1D
I3
IGNITION COIL
4
3
2
1
3
VC
2
PIM
1
E2
M1
MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE
PRESSURE SENSOR
(VACUUM SENSOR)
T1
THROTTLE POSITION
SENSOR
91
ENGINE CONTROL (5S–FE A/T AND CALIFORNIA M/T)
W–R
W–R
B–O
B–O
B–O
B–O
B
B
G–R
G–R
I13
IP3
R–L
G–R
C9
V–Y
10 3D
TE2
TE1
7
2
1
R–W
G–W
Y–G
TT
5
BR–B
(* 3)
Y–G
3 3D
G–W
6 A
12 3D
18 3D
R–W
3 B
G–R
BR
A , C10
22 3D
ENG
3
BR
(* 4)
G–R
7 3D 19 3D
C
B
V–Y
G–R
R–L
C
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C8
COMBINATION
METER
4
E1
G–R (* 4)
SPEED
6 1B
G–R (* 5)
12
W
D3
DATA LINK CONNECTOR 2
(TDCL)
1D
R–L
5
8
MALFUNCTION INDICATOR
LAMP (CHECK ENGINE
WARNING LIGHT)
[COMB. METER]
IP3
(* 4)
6
TO PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION
SW (NEUTRAL START SW)
TO GENERATOR (ALTERNATOR)
14
G
IP3
I13
10A
GAUGE
R–L
3
LG
2
G–R
2
(* 5)
1
G–B
11
R–L
I18
P
V5
VEHICLE
SPEED SENSOR
(SPEED SENSOR)
R–L
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM
(SEE PAGE 64)
BR
(SHIELDED)
9 A
5 A
SP1
W
E7
C ,E8
B , E10
A
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ENGINE AND ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION ECU)(A/T)
E11
C , E12
B , E14
A
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ENGINE ECU)(M/T)
1
ACT
ACA
KNK
E16
BR
E15
BR
BR
W
(SHIELDED)
13 B
2
O2
OXYGEN SENSOR
(SUB)
1
K1
KNOCK
SENSOR
A10
A/C AMPLIFIER
1
R–L
7
E02
26 C
W–B
E01
13 C
W–B
B–Y
ACA
10 A
LG–B
ACT
21 A
R–L
BR
BR
ED
92
*1
*2
*3
*4
:
:
:
:
CALIFORNIA
EX. CALIFORNIA
EX. CALIFORNIA M/T
FOR CANADA IN TMM MADE
* 5 : EX. * 4
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
W–R
B–O
B–O
10A
STARTER
12
13
R–W
VF1
4
OX1
4
E1
3
2 3C
20
3B
B–W
B–O
L–B
G–W
IP1
6
I18
15
6
IP3
2
R–W
19
IP3
R–W
BR
16
IP3
BR
3
I18
G–W
R–W
B–W
15 B
14 B
8 B
11 A
L–B
W–R
GR
(SHIELDED)
(* 3)
BR–B
CIRCUIT
OPENING
RELAY
1
4
6
C ,E8
B , E10
TE2
VF
STA
A
A
1
(SHIELDED)
FC
5 B
6 B
14 A
G–R
BR
14 C
OX1
W
OX2
R–L
E1
2
W
4 BX1
L–B
I18
(SHIELDED)
BR
I18
F15
FUEL
PUMP
(SHIELDED)
W
BR
(SHIELDED)
I18
M
5
1 1M
R–L
BR
BR
1
R–L
O3
OXYGEN SENSOR (MAIN)
BR
BR
5 BX1
(SHIELDED)
W–B
BR
BR
BR
E16
BR
BR
18 3C
W–B
I18
13 3A
11 1C
4
I18
E17
IJ1
BR
BR
I18
16
L–B
B , E14
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ENGINE ECU)(M/T)
N1
NOISE FILTER
(FOR IGNITION SYSTEM)
C , E12
W–B
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ENGINE AND ELECTRONIC
CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION ECU)(A/T)
E11
6
W–B
E7
TE1
L–B
TT
6
G–R
7 B
6
W–B
1
BR
W
I18
R–L
2 3D
GR
IP3
G–W
OX2
15
IP1
I18
(* 3)
13
Y–G
(* 3)
BR–B
BR–B
IP1
(* 3)
TE2
9
1
FP
B–W
15
BR–B
TE1
8
G–W
TT
GR
IG–
W
+B
D1
DATA LINK CONNECTOR 1
(CHECK CONNECTOR)
17
4
1
B–W
19
2
L–B
B–O
G–R
B–O
19
IP1
G–R
B–O
B
BR
EC
ED
BL
IG
93
ENGINE CONTROL (5S–FE A/T AND CALIFORNIA M/T)
SERVICE HINTS
E 7(C), E 8(B), E10(A) ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ENGINE AND ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION ECU) (A/T)
E11(C), E12(B), E14(A) ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ENGINE ECU) (M/T)
VOLTAGE AT ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) WIRING CONNECTOR
BATT – E1 : ALWAYS 9.0–14.0 VOLTS
+B – E1 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS (IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION)
+B1 – E1 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS (IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION)
IDL – E2 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS (IGNITION SW ON AND THROTTLE VALVE OPEN)
VC – E2 : 4.5– 5.5 VOLTS (IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION)
VTA – E2 : 0.3– 0.8 VOLTS (IGNITION SW ON AND THROTTLE VALVE FULLY CLOSED)
: 3.2– 4.9 VOLTS (IGNITION SW ON AND THROTTLE VALVE OPEN)
PIM – E2 : 3.3– 3.9 VOLTS (IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION)
#10, #20 – E01, E02 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS (IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION) (EX. CALIFORNIA)
#10, #20,
#30, #40 – E01, E02 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS (IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION) (CALIFORNIA)
THA – E2 : 0.5– 3.4 VOLTS (IGNITION SW ON AND INTAKE AIR TEMP. 20°C, 68°F)
THW – E2 : 0.2– 1.0 VOLTS (IGNITION SW ON AND COOLANT TEMP. 80°C, 176°F)
STA – E1 : 6.0–14.0 VOLTS (ENGINE CRANKING)
IGT – E1 : PULSE GENERATION (ENGINE CRANKING OR IDLING)
W – E1 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS (NO TROUBLE AND ENGINE RUNNING)
ACT – E1 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS (IGNITION SW ON AND AIR CONDITIONING ON)
ACA – E1 : 7.5–14.0 VOLTS (IGNITION SW ON AND AIR CONDITIONING ON)
TE1 – E1 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS (IGNITION SW ON)
NSW – E1 : 0– 3.0 VOLTS (IGNITION SW ON AND PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW (NEUTRAL START SW)
POSITION P OR N POSITION)
9.0–14.0 VOLTS (IGNITION SW ON AND EX. PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW
(NEUTRAL START SW) POSITION P OR N POSITION)
RESISTANCE AT ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) WIRING CONNECTORS
(DISCONNECT WIRING CONNECTOR)
IDL – E2 : INFINITY (THROTTLE VALVE OPEN)
2.3 KΩ OR LESS (THROTTLE VALVE FULLY CLOSED)
VTA – E2 : 3.3 –10.0 KΩ (THROTTLE VALVE FULLY OPEN)
0.2 – 0.8 KΩ (THROTTLE VALVE FULLY CLOSED)
VC – E2 : 3.0 –7 0 KΩ
THA – E2 : 2.0 –3.0 KΩ (INTAKE AIR TEMP. 20°C, 68°F)
THW – E2 : 0.2 –0.4 KΩ (COOLANT TEMP. 80°C, 176°F)
G1, NE – G– : 0.17–0.21 KΩ
ISCC, ISCO– +B, +B1 : 19.3–22.3 Ω
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
A10
C8
CODE
SEE PAGE
32
E11
A
32
CODE
SEE PAGE
J1
33
32
E12
C
32
K1
31
C9
A
32
E14
B
32
M1
31
C10
C
32
F15
A
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
N1
31
D1
30
I1
31
O2
31
D2
30
I2
31
O3
31
D3
32
I3
31
T1
31
D6
32
I4
31
V1
31
E1
30
I5
31
V2
31
E4
30
I6
31
V3
31
V5
31
E7
C
32
I7
31
E8
B
32
I10
31
E10
A
32
I12
33
: RELAY BLOCKS
CODE
94
SEE PAGE
RELAY BLOCKS (RELAY BLOCK LOCATION)
1
25
R/B NO. 1 (LEFT KICK PANEL)
6
26
R/B NO. 6 (BEHIND GLOVE BOX)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
1A
1B
1C
1D
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO.
NO 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
22
ENGINE WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
24
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO
NO. 3 (BEHIND COMBINATION METER)
1G
1M
2D
3A
3B
3C
3D
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
IJ1
IP1
IP3
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
42
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND COWL WIRE
44
ENGINE WIRE AND COWL WIRE
46 (S/D)
BX1
48 (C/P)
FUEL GAUGE WIRE AND FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE
50 (W/G)
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
EB
40 (5S–FE)
FRONT LEFT FENDER
EC
40 (5S–FE)
INTAKE MANIFOLD RH
ED
40 (5S–FE)
INTAKE MANIFOLD LH
IG
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE LH
46 (S/D)
BL
48 (C/P)
UNDER THE LEFT QUARTER PILLAR
50 (W/G)
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
CODE
E15
I2
E16
I13
E17
E18
E19
40 (5S–FE)
(5S FE)
ENGINE WIRE
I18
I20
I23
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
44
COWL WIRE
44
ENGINE WIRE
44
COWL WIRE
E20
95
ENGINE CONTROL (5S–FE A/T AND CALIFORNIA M/T)
96
* 1 : CALIFORNIA
2 : EX. CALIFORNIA
ENGINE CONTROL (5S–FE M/T EX. CALIFORNIA)
97
ENGINE CONTROL (5S–FE M/T EX. CALIFORNIA)
W–R
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
B–O
AM1
15A
EFI
7. 5A
IGN
B–O
I12
IGNITION SW
IG1
ST1
ACC
9 1D
A4 2C
B–O
B–O
9
18
IP1
B–O
B–O
E20
E18
B–O
E18
B–O
E17
B–O
B–O
8 1G
W–G
ST2
IG2
AM2
B–O
E17
11
3
1
2
1
2
W–R
G–Y
LG
G
2 C
9 A
10 A
1 A
23 A
B–O
B–O
G–R
W–B
W–L
I23
W–R
E20
1
IP1
B–O
5
3 2C
W–R
2
2 2B
2
V2
VSV
(FOR EGR)
I1
IDLE AIR CONTROL
VALVE
(ISC VALVE)
W–R
EFI MAIN
RELAY
IP1
B–O
3
I20
9
B–O
IP3
V1
VSV
(FOR A/C IDLE–UP)
1
12
B–O
W–R
2 2D
B–O
6 1A
W–R
E20
E20
E11
1
2
25 A
A , E12
ISCV
7 C
+B
EGR
B , E14 C
# 10
12 A
VC
11 B
VTA
10 B
IDL
12 B
L
B
R
W
FROM CRUISE
CONTROL ECU
Y
2
I7
INJECTOR NO. 4
1
I5
INJECTOR NO. 2
I6
INJECTOR NO. 3
I4
INJECTOR NO. 1
1
2
ISCO
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ENGINE ECU)
# 20
2
ISCC
W–R
W–R
W–R
W–R
BATT
1
L
Y
Y
W
W
I18
R
I18
4
EB
98
3
2
W
W–B
I18
L
R
I18
T1
THROTTLE POSITION
SENSOR
BR
1
16
IP1
W–R
W–R
W–R
W–R
E20
B–O
B–O
B–O
W–R
B–O
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
B
W–R
E20
B
10 1A
W–R
14 1D
10A
MIR–HTR
TO
TACHOMETER
[COMB. METER]
15A
TAIL
B
G
I3
IGNITION COIL
E19
D2
DISTRIBUTOR
G+
2
3
4
Y
G–
1
B
NE–
B
4
+B
IGF
IGT
1
2
W
NE
1
3
I2
IGNITER
L
D6
B–O
3
5
COIL–
R
DIODE
(FOR IDLE–UP)
G
B–R
W–R
2
W–R
1
5 3C
B–R
P
5 3D
B–R
B–O
2
(SHIELDED)
4 A
NE+
A , E12 B , E14 C
G–
22 A
IGF
IGT
2
2
2
E2
9 B
1
BR
1
BR
BR
1
E21
16 B
BR
13 B
GR
THG
3 B
L–B
THA
4 B
E4
ENGINE COOLANT
TEMP. SENSOR
(EFI WATER TEMP.
SENSOR)
B–Y
G+
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ENGINE ECU)
THW
2 B
3 A
5 A
LG
PIM
18 A
NE–
E1
EGR GAS TEMP.
SENSOR
E11
17 A
BR
ELS
I10
INTAKE AIR
TEMP. SENSOR
(IN–AIR TEMP.
SENSOR)
+B1
(*2)
12 C
1 C
R
BR
E17
BR
BR
E17
BR
E18
BR
I18
BR
E18
BR
BR
3
VC
2
PIM
1
E2
M1
MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE
PRESSURE SENSOR
(VACUUM SENSOR)
99
ENGINE CONTROL (5S–FE M/T EX. CALIFORNIA)
W–R
W–R
B–O
B–O
B–O
B–O
B
B
G–R
G–R
G
12
R–L
C
R–L
G–B
R–L
5
C 9 A , C10 B
MALFUNCTION
INDICATOR LAMP
(CHECK ENGINE
WARNING LIGHT)
[COMB. METER]
C8
COMBINATION
METER
V–Y
Y–G
3 3D
I13
6 A
SPEED
METER
4
1
E1
C
IP3
TE1
2
G–W
2
TE2
7
R–W
IP3
ENG
3
G–W
12 3D
3 B
7 3D
19 3D
R–W
G–R
22 3D
G–R
14
6 1B
G–R
IP3
W
D3
DATA LINK CONNECTOR 2
(TDCL)
G–R
11
8
BR
R–L
G–R
(* 2)
6
1D
R–L
I18
10A
GAUGE
R–L
P
TO BACK–UP LIGHT SW
TO GENERATOR (ALTERNATOR)
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1
R–L
3
LG
2
G–R
V5
VEHICLE
SPEED SENSOR
(SPEED SENSOR)
I13
(* 1)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
BR
18 3D
V–Y
10 3D
(SHIELDED)
11 C
8 C
SPD
W
E11
A , E12
B , E14 C
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ENGINE ECU)
ACT
3 C
E02
26 A
E01
E1
KNK
13 A
5 B
24 A
BR
6 C
ACA
(SHIELDED)
(SHIELDED)
W
W–B
(SHIELDED)
(SHIELDED)
E15
I18
7
1
ACT
ACA
BR
BR
W–B
BR
B–Y
LG–B
I18
I18
BR
1
A10
A/C AMPLIFIER
K1
KNOCK
SENSOR
BR
BR
BR
ED
100
* 1 : TMC MADE
* 2 : TMM MADE
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
W–R
B–O
B–O
1
A6 2C
FP
4
VF1
OX1 OX2
13
4
15
E1
3
B–W
IP3
B–W
R–W
GR
G–W
18
G–W
1
IP1
G–W
R–W
19
IP3
R–W
L–B
BR
15
2 3D
IP3
I18
6
2
L–B
W–R
I18
3
BR
CIRCUIT
OPENING
RELAY
B–W
R–W
GR
IP3
G–W
BR
I18
6
16
1
(SHIELDED)
4
6
7 B
TE1
TE2
VF
STA
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ENGINE ECU)
1
OX1
6 B
4 C
2
W
I18
13 3A
16
IJ1
BR
R–L
(SHIELDED)
G–R
W
1 B
FC
G–R
B , E14 C
OX2
6
L–B
A , E12
6
2 A
N1
NOISE FILTER
(FOR IGNITION
SYSTEM)
E11
8 B
6
L–B
15 B
3B
B–W
GR
B–O
13
IP3
R–L
W
2 3C
Y–G
(* 2)
TE2
9
B–O
TE1
8
IP1
B–W
B
W–B
12
IG–
W
L–B
(*1)
19
2
D1
DATA LINK CONNECTOR 1
(CHECK CONNECTOR)
B–W
G–R
B–O
19
IP1
G–R
10A
STARTER
B–O
B
18 3C
4 BX1
W–B
R–L
L–B
I18
11 1C
W
R–L
(SHIELDED)
4
BR
F15
FUEL
PUMP
O3
OXYGEN SENSOR
(MAIN)
1
M
1 1M
5
5 BX1
(SHIELDED)
BR
BR
BR
W–B
E17
BR
BR
W–B
BR
W–B
O2
OXYGEN SENSOR
(SUB)
1
2
BR
EC
ED
BL
IG
101
ENGINE CONTROL (5S–FE M/T EX. CALIFORNIA)
SERVICE HINTS
E11(A), E12(B), E14(C) ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ENGINE ECU)
VOLTAGE AT ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) WIRING CONNECTOR
BATT – E1 : ALWAYS 9.0–14.0 VOLTS
+B – E1 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS (IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION)
+B1 – E1 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS (IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION)
IDL – E1 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS (IGNITION SW ON AND THROTTLE VALVE OPEN)
PIM – E2 : 3.3– 3.9 VOLTS (IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION)
#10, #20 – E01, E02 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS (IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION)
THA – E2 : 0.5– 3.4 VOLTS (IGNITION SW ON AND INTAKE AIR TEMP. 20°C, 68°F)
THW – E2 : 0.2– 1.0 VOLTS (IGNITION SW ON AND COOLANT TEMP. 80°C, 176°F)
STA – E1 : 6.0–14.0 VOLTS (ENGINE CRANKING)
IGT – E1 : 0.8–1.2 VOLTS (ENGINE CRANKING OR IDLING)
ISCC, ISCO– E1 : 8.0–14.0 VOLTS (IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION)
W – E1 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS (IGNITION SW ON, NO TROUBLE AND ENGINE RUNNING)
ACT – E1 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS (IGNITION SW ON AND AIR CONDITIONING ON)
ACA – E1 : 7.5–14.0 VOLTS (IGNITION SW ON AND AIR CONDITIONING ON)
TE1 – E1 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS (IGNITION SW ON)
RESISTANCE AT ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) WIRING CONNECTORS
(DISCONNECT WIRING CONNECTOR)
IDL – E1 : INFINITY (THROTTLE VALVE OPEN)
0 Ω (THROTTLE VALVE FULLY CLOSED)
THA – E2 : 2.0 –3.0 KΩ (INTAKE AIR TEMP. 20°C, 68°F)
THW – E2 : 0.2 –0.4 KΩ (COOLANT TEMP. 80°C, 176°F)
G+ – G– : 0.17–0.21 KΩ
ISCC, ISCO– +B, +B1 : 19.3–22.3 KΩ
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
A10
32
C8
CODE
E14
SEE PAGE
C
CODE
SEE PAGE
30
K1
31
32
F15
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
M1
31
C9
A
32
I1
31
N1
31
C10
B
32
I2
31
O2
31
D1
30
I3
31
O3
31
D2
30
I4
31
T1
31
D3
32
I5
31
V1
31
D6
32
I6
31
V2
31
E1
30
I7
31
V3
31
E4
30
I10
31
V5
31
E11
A
30
I12
33
E12
B
30
J1
33
: RELAY BLOCKS
CODE
6
SEE PAGE
26
RELAY BLOCKS (RELAY BLOCK LOCATION)
R/B NO. 6 (BEHIND GLOVE BOX)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
1A
1B
1C
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO.
NO 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
2A
22
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
2C
22
ENGINE WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
24
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 3 (BEHIND COMBINATION METER)
1D
1G
1M
3A
3C
3D
102
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
IJ1
IP1
IP3
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
42
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND COWL WIRE
44
ENGINE WIRE AND COWL WIRE
46 (S/D)
BX1
48 (C/P)
FUEL GAUGE WIRE AND FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE
50 (W/G)
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
EB
40 (5S–FE)
FRONT LEFT FENDER
EC
40 (5S–FE)
INTAKE MANIFOLD RH
ED
40 (5S–FE)
INTAKE MANIFOLD LH
IG
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE LH
46 (S/D)
BL
48 (C/P)
UNDER THE LEFT QUARTER PILLAR
50 (W/G)
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
E15
E20
40 (5S–FE)
ENGINE WIRE
E16
I13
44
COWL WIRE
I18
44
ENGINE WIRE
44
COWL WIRE
E17
40 (5S–FE)
(5S FE)
ENGINE WIRE
E18
I20
E19
I23
103
W–B
104
LOW
W–B
LIGHT
CONTROL
SW
C12
COMBINATION SW
11
R–B
4
W
FL MAIN
2. 0L
3
R–B
13
14
IE
I5
14
I2
R–B
R–Y
2
R
1
1
H3
HEADLIGHT LO LH
W–B
13
R
5 ED1
5 2A
R–Y
E4
1 2A
H4
HEADLIGHT LO RH
W–B
2 2A
R–Y
R–Y
1
1 2E
H2
HEADLIGHT HI RH
R–B
R–Y
R–B
2 2E
3
7 2G
C9
HIGH BEAM INDICATOR
LIGHT [COMB. METER]
R–B
R–B
2 2H
R–B
R–Y
I13
INTEGRATION RELAY
BATTERY
40A
MAIN
2
1
2
H1
HEADLIGHT HI LH
R–B
4
W–B
W–B
DIMMER SW
B
HEADLIGHT (FOR USA)
15A
HEAD
(RH)
15A
HEAD
(LH)
HEADLIGHT
RELAY
2
6 2A
1
2
E3
E4
8
ED1
OFF
12
TAIL
HEAD
HIGH
FLASH
9
I5
EB
SERVICE HINTS
HEADLIGHT RELAY
2–1 : CLOSED WITH LIGHT CONTROL SW AT HEAD POSITION OR DIMMER SW AT FLASH POSITION
LIGHT AUTO TURN OFF OPERATION
PLEASE REFER TO THE LIGHT AUTO TURN OFF SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 102)
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
C9
32
H2
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
C12
32
H3
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
H1
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
H4
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
I13
SEE PAGE
33
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
2A
22
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE AND J/B NO
NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
2G
22
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
2H
22
ENGINE WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
2E
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
38 (1MZ–FE)
ED1
COWL WIRE AND ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE
40 (5S–FE)
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
38 (1MZ–FE)
EB
IE
FRONT LEFT FENDER
40 (5S–FE)
42
LEFT KICK PANEL
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
CODE
38 (1MZ–FE)
E3
E4
40 (5S–FE)
E4
SEE PAGE
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE
44
COWL WIRE
I2
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE
38 (1MZ–FE)
I5
C9
C12 BLACK
X
X X
1
X
H 1, H 2
X
13 14
X
H 3, H 4
BROWN
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
40 (5S–FE)
9
11
1
BLACK
2
12 13 14
I13
2
3 4
105
HEADLIGHT (FOR CANADA)
W
B
2
B
W
2H
4
2
40A
MAIN
HEADLIGHT
RELAY
R–B
1
1 2E
W
3 2G
I7
R–B
L–Y
I13
INTEGRATION RELAY
4
3
3
7 2G
R–B
W
15A
ECU–B
4 EF1
2
R–B
13
2
14
5
G–R
15
OFF
TAIL
HEAD
LOW
HIGH
W–B
11
9
12
R–Y
FLASH
W–B
DIMMER SW
B
B
2 C
B
G
R–Y
C12
COMBINATION SW
LIGHT
CONTROL
SW
100A ALT
C
B , F16
A , F10
F10
FUSE BOX
I7
L–Y
9 3A
R–B
1 A (1MZ–FE)
1 B (5S–FE)
11 3B
G–R
W
1
FL MAIN
2. 0L
16
D4
DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY
(MAIN)
I5
W–B
BATTERY
W–B
W–B
I5
IE
106
W–B
W
W
B
B
W
W
FROM POWER SOURCE
SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
6
EC1
B
R–L
4 1E
5
1
5
DAYTIME
RUNNING LIGHT
RELAY NO. 2
TAILLIGHT
RELAY
10A
GAUGE
3
8 1B
5
R–L
7 1B
2
5
R
2
3
R–L
1
8 ED1
G–R
17 3A
R–L
R
18 3A
D4
DAYTIME RUNNING
LIGHT RELAY (MAIN)
R–W
1
P3
PARKING
BRAKE SW
W–B
R–W
A
R–Y
(1MZ–FE)
II1
(5S–FE)
TO GENERATOR
(ALTERNATOR) ” L”
4
12 3A
1
P2
PARKING
BRAKE SW
FROM
COMBINATION METER
R–W
8 3C
R–W
8 3D
A
18 3C
W–B
10 3A
13
W–B
18
W–B
11 1C
1 1M
W–B
8
17
R–Y
11
Y
2
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G–R
IG
107
HEADLIGHT (FOR CANADA)
W
E6
1
EB1
E7
W
W
W
R–L
W
W
2 2E
7
5
2
1
15A
HEAD
(LWR–LH)
7. 5A
DRL
2 2A
R
2
7
4
3
7
R–G
7
3
EB1
7
W–B
4
1
3
2
E3
W–B
W–B
R–B
W–B
R–G
13
14
5 EB1
4 EB1
W–B
C9
HIGH BEAM INDICATOR
LIGHT [COMB. METER]
R–G
2
R–B
H2
HEADLIGHT
HI RH
R–B
R–B
H1
HEADLIGHT
HI LH
2
R–B
E4
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
E4
EB
108
2
7
7
5 ED1
1
R–W
2
W–B
R–G
1
W–B
1
7
7
DAYTIME RUNNING
LIGHT RELAY NO. 3
7
5
1
R–B
H3
HEADLIGHT
LO LH
W–R
2
1
5
R
R
7
E4
5
DAYTIME RUNNING
LIGHT RELAY NO. 4
2
EB1
R–G
4
W–R
5 2A
R–B
1
15A
HEAD
(LWR–RH)
H4
HEADLIGHT
LO RH
15A
HEAD
(UPR–RH)
3
W–B
15A
HEAD
(UPR–LH)
5
SYSTEM OUTLINE
CURRENT FROM THE BATTERY IS ALWAYS FLOWING FROM THE FL MAIN → HEADLIGHT RELAY (COIL SIDE) → TERMINAL 5 OF THE
DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY (MAIN) AND TERMINAL 14 OF THE DIMMER SW, HEADLIGHT RELAY (COIL SIDE) → TERMINAL 3 OF
THE INTEGRATION RELAY → TERMINAL 4 → TERMINAL 13 OF THE LIGHT CONTROL SW, FL MAIN → DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT
RELAY NO. 2 (COIL SIDE) → TERMINAL 17 OF THE DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY.
1. DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT OPERATION
WHEN THE ENGINE IS STARTED, VOLTAGE GENERATED AT TERMINAL L OF THE GENERATOR (ALTERNATOR) IS APPLIED TO
TERMINAL 11 OF THE DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY (MAIN).
IF THE PARKING BRAKE LEVER IS PULLED UP (PARKING BRAKE SW ON) AT THIS TIME, THE RELAY IS NOT ENERGIZED, SO THE
DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM DOES NOT OPERATE. IF THE PARKING BRAKE LEVER IS RELEASED (PARKING BRAKE LEVER
SW OFF), THE SIGNAL IS INPUT TO TERMINAL 8 OF THE RELAY. THIS ACTIVATES THE RELAY ALSO, CURRENT FROM FL MAIN
FLOWES TO DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY NO. 2 (POINT SIDE) → HEAD (UPR–LH) FUSE → TERMINAL 1 OF THE HEAD LH–HI →
TERMINAL 2 → TERMINAL 2 OF THE HEAD RH–HI → TERMINAL 1 → TERMINAL 4 OF THE DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY NO. 3 →
TERMINAL 2 → TO GROUND, SO BOTH TAIL AND HEADLIGHT UP.
THIS IS HOW THE DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM OPERATES. ONCE THE DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM OPERATES AND
HEAD HAVE LIGHT UP, HEAD REMAIN ON EVEN IF THE PARKING BRAKE LEVER IS PULLED UP (PARKING BRAKE SW ON).
EVEN IF THE ENGINE STALLS WITH THE IGNITION SW ON AND THERE IS NO VOLTAGE FROM TERMINAL L OF THE GENERATOR
(ALTERNATOR), HEAD REMAIN ON. IF THE IGNITION SW IS THEN TURNED OFF, AND HEAD ARE TURNED OFF.
IF THE ENGINE IS STARTED WHILE THE PARKING BRAKE LEVER IS RELEASED (PARKING BRAKE SW OFF), THE DAYTIME RUNNING
LIGHT SYSTEM OPERATES AND TAIL, HEADLIGHT UP AS THE ENGINE STARTS.
2. HEADLIGHT OPERATION
*(WHEN THE LIGHT CONTROL SW AT THE HEAD POSITION)
WHEN THE LIGHT CONTROL SW IS SET TO HEAD POSITION, THE CURRENT FLOWING TO THE HEADLIGHT RELAY (COIL SIDE)
FLOWS TO TERMINAL 3 OF THE INTEGRATION RELAY → TERMINAL 4 → TERMINAL 13 OF THE LIGHT CONTROL SW → TERMINAL 11
→ GROUND, TURNING THE HEADLIGHT RELAY ON.
THIS CAUSES THE CURRENT FLOWING TO THE HEADLIGHT RELAY (POINT SIDE) → DRL FUSE → DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY
NO. 3 (COIL SIDE) AND DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY NO. 4 (COIL SIDE) → GROUND, TURNING THE DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT
RELAY NO. 3 AND NO. 4 ON. ALSO, CURRENT FROM THE HEADLIGHT RELAY (POINT SIDE) TO HEAD (LWR) FUSES → TERMINAL 1
OF THE HEADLIGHTS (LO) → TERMINAL 2 → GROUND, SO THE HEADLIGHTS (LO) LIGHT UP.
*(DIMMER SW AT FLASH POSITION)
WHEN THE DIMMER SW IS SET TO FLASH POSITION, CURRENT FLOWS FROM HEADLIGHT RELAY (COIL SIDE) → TERMINAL 14 OF
THE DIMMER SW → TERMINAL 9 → GROUND, TURNING THE HEADLIGHT RELAY ON. AT THE SAME TIME, SIGNALS ARE OUTPUT
FROM TERMINAL 12 AND TERMINAL 14 OF THE DIMMER SW TO TERMINAL 16 AND TERMINAL 5 OF THE DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT
RELAY (MAIN), ACTIVATING THE DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY (MAIN) AND ALSO THE DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY NO. 2.
WHEN THE HEADLIGHT RELAY AND DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY (MAIN) ARE ACTIVATED, THE HEADLIGHTS (LO AND HI) THEN
LIGHT UP.
*(DIMMER SW AT HIGH POSITION)
WHEN THE LIGHT CONTROL SW IS SET TO HEAD POSITION, A SIGNAL IS OUTPUT FROM TERMINAL 13 OF THE LIGHT CONTROL SW
→ TERMINAL 4 OF THE INTEGRATION RELAY → TERMINAL 3 → TERMINAL 5 OF THE DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY (MAIN).
WHEN THE DIMMER SW IS SET TO HIGH POSITION, A SIGNAL IS OUTPUT FROM TERMINAL 12 OF THE DIMMER SW TO TERMINAL 16
OF THE DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY (MAIN). THESE SIGNALS ACTIVATE DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY NO. 2, SO CURRENT
FLOWS FROM DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY NO. 2 (POINT SIDE) → HEAD (UPR–LH) FUSE → TERMINAL 1 OF THE HEADLIGHT
LH–HI → TERMINAL 2 → DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY NO. 4 (POINT SIDE) → GROUND, AND CURRENT ALSO SIMUTANEOUSLY
FLOWS FROM HEAD (UPR–RH) FUSE → DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY NO. 3 (POINT SIDE) → TERMINAL 1 OF THE HEADLIGHT
RH–HI → TERMINAL 2 → DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY NO. 4 (POINT SIDE), CAUSING THE HEADLIGHTS (HI SIDE) TO LIGHT UP.
SERVICE HINTS
D 4 DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY (MAIN)
2–GROUND
15–GROUND
8–GROUND
13–GROUND
:
:
:
:
APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH THE IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
ALWAYS APPROX. 12 VOLTS
CONTINUITY WITH THE PARKING BRAKE LEVER PULLED UP (PARKING BRAKE SW ON)
ALWAYS CONTINUITY
109
HEADLIGHT (FOR CANADA)
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
C9
32
C12
32
H1
D4
32
H2
A
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
B
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
F10
F16
SEE PAGE
C
CODE
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
SEE PAGE
I13
33
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
J1
33
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
P2
33
H3
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
P3
33
H4
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
1B
1C
1D
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
22
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE AND J/B NO
NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
2G
22
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
2H
22
ENGINE WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
24
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO
NO. 3 (BEHIND COMBINATION METER)
1E
1M
2A
2E
3A
3B
3C
3D
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
EB1
EC1
ED1
EF1
II1
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
42
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE AND RELAY WIRE
ENGINE WIRE AND ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE
COWL WIRE AND ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE
ENGINE WIRE AND COWL WIRE
COWL WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
EB
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
FRONT LEFT FENDER
IE
42
LEFT KICK PANEL
IG
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE LH
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
E3
E4
E6
110
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
38 (1MZ–FE)
E6
40 (5S–FE)
38 (1MZ–FE)
CODE
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE
E7
40 (5S–FE)
I5
38 (1MZ–FE)
I7
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
40 (5S–FE)
38 (1MZ–FE)
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE
40 (5S–FE)
44
COWL WIRE
111
* 1 : 1MZ–FE
* 2 : 5S–FE
LIGHT AUTO TURN OFF
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
B
W
4 1E
2 2H
1
5
4
20A
DOME
2
TAILLIGHT
RELAY
10A
GAUGE
2
3
3
TO TAIL
FUSE
8 1B
C12 BLACK
HEADLIGHT
RELAY
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM
(SEE PAGE 64)
2 X
1
7 2G
2 2G
X
X
11
TO HEAD
FUSE
R
R–B
G–R
D12
1 EF1
1
1 1C
2 A
1
3 A
(* 1) F10
A
(* 2) F10
B
S
R
Q
R
S
Q
100A ALT
1 A (* 1)
1 B (* 2)
FUSE BOX
F10
A , F10
B , F16
C
W
7
6
1 C
I13
1 A
A
4 A
G
INTEGRATION RELAY
10
1 1M
B
C12
COMBINATION SW
LIGHT
CONTROL SW
R–G
B
R–Y
2 1H
FL MAIN
2. 0L
2
13
OFF
1
TAIL
HEAD
11
1
F16
C
D12
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT LH
1
W–B
W–B
BATTERY
I13 A
1 2 3 4
IE
112
IG
X
13
SYSTEM OUTLINE
WITH THE IGNITION SW TURNED ON, THE CURRENT FLOWS TO TERMINAL 7 OF THE INTEGRATION RELAY THROUGH GAUGE FUSE.
VOLTAGE IS APPLIED AT ALL TIMES TO TERMINAL (A) 2 OF THE INTEGRATION RELAY THROUGH THE TAILLIGHT RELAY (COIL SIDE),
AND TO TERMINAL (A) 3 THROUGH THE HEADLIGHT RELAY (COIL SIDE).
1. NORMAL LIGHTING OPERATION
(TURN TAILLIGHT ON)
WITH LIGHT CONTROL SW TURNED TO TAILLIGHT POSITION, A SIGNAL IS INPUT INTO TERMINAL (A) 1 OF THE INTEGRATION
RELAY. ACCORDING TO THIS SIGNAL, THE CURRENT FLOWING TO TERMINAL (A) 2 OF THE RELAY FLOWS FROM TERMINAL (A) 1 →
TERMINAL 2 OF THE LIGHT CONTROL SW → TERMINAL 11 → TO GROUND AND TAILLIGHT RELAY CAUSES TAILLIGHT TO TURN ON.
(TURN HEADLIGHT ON)
WITH LIGHT CONTROL SW TURNED TO HEADLIGHT POSITION, A SIGNAL IS INPUT INTO TERMINALS (A) 1 AND (A) 4 OF THE
INTEGRATION RELAY. ACCORDING TO THIS SIGNAL, THE CURRENT FLOWING TO TERMINAL (A) 3 OF THE RELAY FLOWS TO
TERMINAL (A) 4 → TERMINAL 13 OF THE LIGHT CONTROL SW → TERMINAL 11 → TO GROUND IN THE HEADLIGHT CIRCUIT, AND
CAUSES TAILLIGHT AND HEADLIGHT RELAY TO TURN THE LIGHT ON. THE TAILLIGHT CIRCUIT IS SAME AS ABOVE.
2. LIGHT AUTO TURN OFF OPERATION
WITH LIGHTS ON AND IGNITION SW TURNED OFF (INPUT SIGNAL GOES TO TERMINAL 7 OF THE RELAY), WHEN DOOR ON DRIVER’S
SIDE IS OPENED (INPUT SIGNAL GOES TO TERMINAL 6 OF THE RELAY), THE RELAY OPERATES AND THE CURRENT IS CUT OFF
WHICH FLOWS FROM TERMINAL (A) 2 OF THE RELAY TO TERMINAL (A) 1 IN TAILLIGHT CIRCUIT AND FROM TERMINAL (A) 3 TO
TERMINAL (A) 4 IN HEADLIGHT CIRCUIT. AS A RESULT, ALL LIGHTS ARE TURNED OFF AUTOMATICALLY.
SERVICE HINTS
I13 INTEGRATION RELAY
(A)
(A)
(A)
(A)
7–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
1–GROUND : ALWAYS APPROX. 12 VOLTS
3–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH LIGHT CONTROL SW AT OFF OR TAIL POSITION
2–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH LIGHT CONTROL SW AT OFF POSITION
6–GROUND : CONTINUITY WITH FRONT LH DOOR OPEN
4–GROUND : CONTINUITY WITH LIGHT CONTROL SW AT HEAD POSITION
1–GROUND : CONTINUITY WITH LIGHT CONTROL SW AT TAIL OR HEAD POSITION
10–GROUND : ALWAYS CONTINUITY
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
C12
32
D12
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
CODE
F10
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
A
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
F16
C
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
B
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
I13
A
33
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
1B
1C
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
1E
1H
20
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
1M
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
2G
22
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
2H
22
ENGINE WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
EF1
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
ENGINE WIRE AND COWL WIRE
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
IE
42
LEFT KICK PANEL
IG
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE LH
113
TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING LIGHT (S/D, C/P)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
10A
HAZ
2 2F
W
H7
HAZARD SW
2 1A
L
7. 5A
TURN
10
8
C12
TURN SIGNAL SW
[COMB. SW]
OFF
RH
HAZARD
TURN
1
1
1
8
G–Y
5
G–W
6
G–B
5
G–Y
9
G–B
7
G–W
TURN SIGNAL
FLASHER
2
LH
G–R
ON
G–B
1
G–W
3
G–Y
1
G–Y
I7
G–Y
I11
G–B
G–Y
2
B
4 ED1
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1 ED1
4 1A
LH
RH
B
16 1H
C8
TURN SIGNAL
INDICATOR LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
G–Y
IJ1
3
G–B
9
G–Y
W–B
G–B
F
1
W–B
F
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G–B
I11
G–Y
G–B
W–B
G–B
G–Y
I7
6 3D
5
2
W–B
11 1C
1 1M
W–B
W–B
5
1
F8
FRONT TURN SIGANL
LIGHT RH
1
18 3C
W–B
G–Y
1
R10
REAR TURN SIGNAL LIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
11 BZ1
W–B
2
R8
REAR TRUN SIGNAL LIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
1
W–B
W–B
F7
FRONT TURN SIGNAL
LIGHT LH
5 1M
10 BZ1
G–B
G–B
8 1C
IE
114
EB
BO
EA
IG
SERVICE HINTS
TURN SIGNAL FLASHER
(1) 2–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW ON OR HAZARD SW ON
(1) 1–GROUND : CHANGES FROM APPROX. 12 TO 0 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW ON AND TURN SIGNAL SW LEFT OR RIGHT, OR
HAZARD SW ON
(1) 3–GROUND: ALWAYS CONTINUITY
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
C8
32
F8
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
R8
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
C12
32
H7
33
R10
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
F7
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
J1
33
: RELAY BLOCKS
CODE
1
SEE PAGE
25
RELAY BLOCKS (RELAY BLOCK LOCATION)
R/B NO. 1 (LEFT KICK PANEL)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
1A
1C
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO.
NO 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
1H
20
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
1M
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
2F
22
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
24
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO
NO. 3 (BEHIND COMBINATION METER)
3C
3D
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
ED1
IJ1
BZ1
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
42
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
COWL WIRE AND ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND COWL WIRE
46 (S/D)
48 (C/P)
LUGGAGE ROOM NO.
NO 1 WIRE AND FLOOR NO.
NO 1 WIRE
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
EA
EB
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
FRONT RIGHT FENDER
FRONT LEFT FENDER
IE
42
LEFT KICK PANEL
IG
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE LH
BO
46 (S/D)
48 (C/P)
LEFT QUARTER PILLAR
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
I7
SEE PAGE
44
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
COWL WIRE
CODE
I11
SEE PAGE
44
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
COWL WIRE
115
TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING LIGHT (S/D, C/P)
116
TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING LIGHT (W/G)
117
TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING LIGHT (W/G)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
2 1A
2 2F
W
H7
HAZARD SW
10A
HAZ
L
7. 5A
TURN
10
8
C12
TURN SIGNAL SW
[COMB. SW]
OFF
RH
HAZARD
TURN
1
1
8
G–Y
G–W
1
5
G–B
6
G–Y
5
G–B
9
G–W
TURN SIGNAL
FLASHER
2
LH
7
G–R
ON
G–B
1
G–W
3
1
G–Y
I7
G–Y
G–Y
I11
G–B
W–B
G–B
G–Y
G–B
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G–Y
4 1A
1 ED1
LH
C8
TURN SIGNAL
INDICATOR LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
G–Y
G–Y
W–B
C
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1
2
W–B
EB
BL
11 1C
1 1M
W–B
C
F8
FRONT TURN SIGANL
LIGHT RH
3
18 3C
W–B
3
4
R10
REAR TURN SIGNAL LIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
4
W–B
2
R8
REAR TRUN SIGNAL LIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
1
W–B
F7
FRONT TURN SIGNAL
LIGHT LH
5 1M
W–B
6 3D
4 Bb1
G–Y
G–B
G–B
IJ1
3
W–B
16 1H
W–B
8 1C
118
RH
B
2
IE
2
B
4 ED1
G–B
F
1
W–B
F
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G–B
I11
G–Y
I7
BQ
EA
IG
SERVICE HINTS
TURN SIGNAL FLASHER
(1) 2–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW ON OR HAZARD SW ON
(1) 1–GROUND : CHANGES FROM APPROX. 12 TO 0 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW ON AND TURN SIGNAL SW LEFT OR RIGHT,
OR HAZARD SW ON
(1) 3–GROUND: ALWAYS CONTINUITY
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
C8
32
F8
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
C12
32
H7
F7
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
J1
SEE PAGE
J5
36
33
R8
36 (W/G)
33
R10
36 (W/G)
: RELAY BLOCKS
CODE
1
SEE PAGE
25
RELAY BLOCKS (RELAY BLOCK LOCATION)
R/B NO. 1 (LEFT KICK PANEL)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
1A
1C
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO.
NO 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
1H
20
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
1M
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
2F
22
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
24
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO
NO. 3 (BEHIND COMBINATION METER)
3C
3D
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
ED1
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
COWL WIRE AND ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE
IJ1
42
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND COWL WIRE
Bb1
50 (W/G)
LUGGAGE ROOM NO. 1 WIRE AND FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
EA
EB
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
FRONT RIGHT FENDER
FRONT LEFT FENDER
IE
42
LEFT KICK PANEL
IG
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE LH
46 (S/D)
BL
48 (C/P)
UNDER THE LEFT QUARTER PILLAR
50 (W/G)
BQ
50 (W/G)
LOWER BACK PANEL CENTER
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
I7
SEE PAGE
44
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
COWL WIRE
CODE
I11
SEE PAGE
44
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
COWL WIRE
119
STOP LIGHT (S/D, C/P)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
15A
STOP
3 1M
10A
GAUGE
9 1H
6 1B
2 A
N2
R–L
G–R
G–W
C
1 A
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A , N3 B
NOISE FILTER
(FOR STOP LIGHT)
R–L
Y
1 B
G–W
17 1H
C
2 B
G–W
6 1M
6
G–W
2
C9
REAR LIGHT WARNING
INDICATOR LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
S10
STOP LIGHT
SW
B10 : S/D
B26 : C/P
3
Y–G
2 BZ1
BZ1
Y
G–W
DELAY
HOLD
8
BZ1
G–W
1
Ba1
G–R
W–B
W–B
1
1
H10
HIGH MOUNT
STOP LIGHT
2
2
3
2
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
B17 : S/D
B29 : C/P
4 Ba1
W–B
W–B
W–B
3
5
B14 : S/D
B28 : C/P
120
2
R11
STOP LIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT]
R9
STOP LIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT]
G–R
2
B16 : S/D
B29 : C/P
BO
G–R
R
G–R
B16 : S/D
B29 : C/P
G–R
9
BZ1
(W/ REAR SPOILER)
W–B
Ba1
G–R
W–B
Y–G
R
W–B
5
B12 : S/D
B28 : C/P
G–R
2
R10
STOP LIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
R8
STOP LIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
B13 : S/D
B28 : C/P
G–R
11
3
BZ1
(W/O REAR SPOILER)
5
G–W
Y–G
H10
HIGH MOUNT
STOP LIGHT
R
4
G–W
1
G–R
2
IJ1
8
W–B
G–W
17
L2
LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR
7
7
BZ1
W–B
W–B
B 9 : S/D
B25 : C/P
B10 : S/D
B25 : C/P
W–B
G–W
1
4
BL
BO
SYSTEM OUTLINE
CURRENT IS APPLIED AT ALL TIMES THROUGH A STOP FUSE TO TERMINAL 2 OF THE STOP LIGHT SW.
WHEN THE IGNITION SW IS TURNED ON, CURRENT FLOWS FROM THE GAUGE FUSE TO TERMINAL 8 OF THE LIGHT FAILURE
SENSOR, AND ALSO FLOWS THROUGH THE REAR LIGHT WARNING LIGHT TO TERMINAL 4 OF THE LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR.
STOP LIGHT DISCONNECTION WARNING
WHEN THE IGNITION SW IS TURNED ON AND THE BRAKE PEDAL IS PRESSED (STOP LIGHT SW ON), IF THE STOP LIGHT CIRCUIT IS
OPEN, THE CURRENT FLOWING FROM TERMINALS 7 OF THE LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR TO TERMINALS 1, 2 CHANGES, SO THE
LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR DETECTS THE DISCONNECTION AND THE WARNING CIRCUIT OF THE LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR IS
ACTIVATED.
AS A RESULT, THE CURRENT FLOWS FROM TERMINAL 4 OF THE LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR → TERMINAL 11 → GROUND AND TURNS
THE REAR LIGHT WARNING LIGHT ON. BY PRESSING THE BRAKE PEDAL, THE CURRENT FLOWING TO TERMINAL 8 OF THE LIGHT
FAILURE SENSOR KEEPS THE WARNING CIRCUIT ON HOLD AND THE WARNING LIGHT ON UNTIL THE IGNITION SW IS TURNED OFF.
SERVICE HINTS
S10 STOP LIGHT SW
2–1 : CLOSED WITH BRAKE PEDAL DEPRESSED
L 2 LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR
1, 2, 7–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH STOP LIGHT SW ON
4, 8–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
11–GROUND : ALWAYS CONTINUITY
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
C9
32
N2
H10
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
N3
J1
33
R8
L2
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
R9
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
CODE
SEE PAGE
A
33
R10
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
B
33
R11
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
S10
33
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
1B
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
1H
20
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
1M
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
IJ1
BZ1
Ba1
SEE PAGE
42
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND COWL WIRE
46 (S/D)
48 (C/P)
46 (S/D)
48 (C/P)
LUGGAGE ROOM NO.
NO 1 WIRE AND FLOOR NO.
NO 1 WIRE
FLOOR NO.
NO 1 WIRE AND LUGGAGE ROOM NO.
NO 2 WIRE
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
46 (S/D)
BL
48 (C/P)
UNDER THE LEFT QUARTER PILLAR
50 (W/G)
BQ
50 (W/G)
LOWER BACK PANEL CENTER
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
B9
B10
SEE PAGE
46 (S/D)
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
FLOOR NO.
NO 1 WIRE
B12
B13
B17
46 (S/D)
LUGGAGE ROOM NO. 1 WIRE
46 (S/D)
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
46 (S/D)
LUGGAGE ROOM NO. 2 WIRE
48 (C/P)
FLOOR NO.
NO 1 WIRE
B28
48 (C/P)
LUGGAGE ROOM NO. 1 WIRE
B29
48 (C/P)
LUGGAGE ROOM NO. 2 WIRE
B25
B26
B14
B16
CODE
LUGGAGE ROOM NO. 2 WIRE
121
STOP LIGHT (S/D, C/P)
122
STOP LIGHT (W/G)
123
STOP LIGHT (W/G)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
15A
STOP
3 1M
10A
GAUGE
9 1H
6 1B
2 A
N2 A ,N3
R–L
G–R
G–W
C
1 A
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
NOISE FILTER
(FOR STOP LIGHT)
R–L
Y
1 B
G–R
17 1H
C
2 B
G–W
6 1M
6
1
C9
REAR LIGHT
WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
S10
STOP LIGHT
SW
G–W
3
Y–G
2
17
L2
LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR
7
8
4
+
–
Y–G
DELAY
HOLD
11
3
2
4
R
G–R
1
2
4
2
B38
W–B
C
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
C
BL
124
BQ
BR
W–B
R9
STOP LIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
R10
STOP LIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
1
B38
W–B
G–R
W–B
R8
STOP LIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
W–B
C
G–R
6 Bb1
G–R
W–B
3
5
Bd2
G–R
B36
1
G–R
R11
STOP LIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
4
Bc2
G–R
4
Bd2
R
H10
HIGH MOUNT
STOP LIGHT
5
Bc2
G–R
R
W–B
1
G–R
2
IJ1
SYSTEM OUTLINE
CURRENT IS APPLIED AT ALL TIMES THROUGH A STOP FUSE TO TERMINAL 2 OF THE STOP LIGHT SW.
WHEN THE IGNITION SW IS TURNED ON, CURRENT FLOWS FROM THE GAUGE FUSE TO TERMINAL 8 OF THE LIGHT FAILURE
SENSOR, AND ALSO FLOWS THROUGH THE REAR LIGHT WARNING LIGHT TO TERMINAL 4 OF THE LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR.
STOP LIGHT DISCONNECTION WARNING
WHEN THE IGNITION SW IS TURNED ON AND THE BRAKE PEDAL IS PRESSED (STOP LIGHT SW ON), IF THE STOP LIGHT CIRCUIT IS
OPEN, THE CURRENT FLOWING FROM TERMINALS 7 OF THE LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR TO TERMINALS 1, 2 CHANGES, SO THE
LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR DETECTS THE DISCONNECTION AND THE WARNING CIRCUIT OF THE LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR IS
ACTIVATED.
AS A RESULT, THE CURRENT FLOWS FROM TERMINAL 4 OF THE LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR → TERMINAL 11 → GROUND AND TURNS
THE REAR LIGHT WARNING LIGHT ON. BY PRESSING THE BRAKE PEDAL, THE CURRENT FLOWING TO TERMINAL 8 OF THE LIGHT
FAILURE SENSOR KEEPS THE WARNING CIRCUIT ON HOLD AND THE WARNING LIGHT ON UNTIL THE IGNITION SW IS TURNED OFF.
SERVICE HINTS
S10 STOP LIGHT SW
2–1 : CLOSED WITH BRAKE PEDAL DEPRESSED
L 2 LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR
1, 2, 7–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH STOP LIGHT SW ON
4, 8–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
11–GROUND : ALWAYS CONTINUITY
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
C9
32
H10
36 (W/G)
N2
J1
33
N3
J5
36 (W/G)
SEE PAGE
L2
CODE
SEE PAGE
36 (W/G)
R9
36 (W/G)
A
33
R10
36 (W/G)
B
33
R11
36 (W/G)
36 (W/G)
S10
33
R8
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
1B
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
1H
20
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
1M
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
IJ1
42
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND COWL WIRE
Bb1
50 (W/G)
LUGGAGE ROOM NO. 1 WIRE AND FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE
Bc2
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE
Bd2
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND BACK DOOR NO. 2 WIRE
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
46 (S/D)
BL
48 (C/P)
UNDER THE LEFT QUARTER PILLAR
50 (W/G)
BQ
50 (W/G)
LOWER BACK PANEL CENTER
BR
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR CENTER
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
B36
SEE PAGE
50 (W/G)
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE
CODE
B38
SEE PAGE
50 (W/G)
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
BACK DOOR NO. 2 WIRE
125
ILLUMINATION
G
5
G
1
TAILLIGHT
RELAY
15A
TAIL
2
3
8 1B
14 1D
9 3D
20 3C
G
4
3C
G
C
G–R
1
G
5
4
B
B
B
G
BATTERY
2
2
R5
REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER SW
3
1
1
B
2
A18
ASHTRAY
ILLUMINATION
I13
INTEGRATION
RELAY
H7
HAZARD SW
2
FL MAIN
2. 0L
C5
CIGARETTE LIGHTER
ILLUMINATION
1 C
G
TO CLOCK
100A ALT
G
G
I9
B
F10
A , F10
B , F16
1 A (1MZ–FE)
1 B (5S–FE)
G
I12
W
4 EF1
21 3D
G
W
5 3D
FUSE BOX
21 3C
G
4 1E
20 3D
I9
LIGHT
CONTROL
SW
B
2
OFF
TAIL
I12
B
HEAD
C12
COMBINATION SW
11
11 3C
11 3D
W–B
1 3D
IE
126
B
B
B
2 1D
5 1B
1 1D
8 1L
12
II2
B
I16
1
C
B
2
4
C
C
1
2
1
IN1
G
IN1
1
R7
RHEOSTAT
3
J2
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
2
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G3
GLOVE BOX LIGHT
2
G
G
A
E6
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION PATTERN
SELECT SW
B
O5
A/T INDICATOR LIGHT
(SHIFT LEVER)
A
G–W
9 C
5 B
(W/O CD PLAYER)
G
G
B
2
G
G
(W/ CD PLAYER)
G
G
A
C11
A/T INDICATOR LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
G
2 C
10 A
B
B
I16
G4
GLOVE BOX SW
A ,R4
G
10 IM2
B
HEATER CONTROL SW
A
(PUSH SW TYPE)
(LEVER SW TYPE)
A/C SW
B
(PUSH SW TYPE)
(LEVER SW TYPE)
G
I14
B
(W/O CD PLAYER)
(W/ CD PLAYER)
(W/ CD PLAYER)
B
G
G
G
16
W–B
W–G
C ,R3
15 A
3 B
W–B
I14
(W/O CD PLAYER)
H8
A12
8 A
7 B
14 A
4 B
RADIO AND PLAYER
R2
A
BLOWER SW
6 A
6 B
B
13 A
B6
16 B
B
B
11 1D
(W/ CD PLAYER)
B
B
B
A , C9
7
1L
W–B
B
COMBINATION METER
C8
G
10 1D
G
4 1B
II2
G
I17
(W/ CD PLAYER)
G
J2
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
A
A
C
2
1
C
1
2
5 IM1
B
B
B
IF
127
ILLUMINATION
SERVICE HINTS
TAILLIGHT RELAY
5–3 : CLOSED WITH LIGHT CONTROL SW AT TAIL OR HEAD POSITION (WHEN LIGHT AUTO TURN OFF SYSTEM IS OFF)
CLOSED WITH ENGINE RUNNING AND PARKING BRAKE LEVER RELEASED (CANADA)
R 7 RHEOSTAT
3–2 : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH RHEOSTAT FULLY TURNED COUNTERCLOCKWISE AND 0 VOLTS WITH FULLY TURNED CLOCKWISE
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
A12
SEE PAGE
B
A18
B6
CODE
32
32
A
32
B
32
C5
SEE PAGE
E6
F10
F16
CODE
32
SEE PAGE
J2
33
A
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
B
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
R2
C
33
C
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
R3
A
33
R4
B
33
32
G3
33
O5
33
C8
A
32
G4
33
R5
33
C9
B
32
H7
33
R7
33
C11
32
C12
H8
32
A
I13
33
33
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
1B
1D
1E
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO.
NO 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
24
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO
NO. 3 (BEHIND COMBINATION METER)
1L
3C
3D
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
EF1
II2
IM1
IM2
IN1
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
ENGINE WIRE AND COWL WIRE
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE AND COWL WIRE
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE AND CONSOLE BOX WIRE
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE AND SWITCH WIRE
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
IE
IF
SEE PAGE
42
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
LEFT KICK PANEL
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
I9
I12
I14
128
CODE
I16
44
COWL WIRE
I17
SEE PAGE
44
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
129
INTERIOR LIGHT (S/D, C/P w/ KEY ILLUMINATED ENTRY)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
20A
DOME
R
2 2G
1 1C
5 1C
R
12 1K
R
II2
R
3
A
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
14 3C
INTEGRATION RELAY
A
R
1
R–B
14 3D
16 IH2
R
I11
IGNITION KEY
CYLINDER LIGHT
(* 2)
R–Y
3
D7
DIODE
(FOR COURTESY)
I8
6
10
2 1B
15
1K
8
II2
G–R
7
1K
R–G
6
II2
R–W
9
1K
R–Y
2
II2
R–Y
1
1K
1
2
DIODE
R–Y
1 R–Y
W–B
G–R
R–G
R–W
R–W
R–W 2
R–B
4
G–R
IJ1
3 1B
II2
2
(* 2)
R
17
15
I8
2
IJ1
R–L
W–B
11 IH1
1
(* 2)
R–Y
15
1
G–R
4
C9
OPEN DOOR
WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
2
(*1)(S/D)
R–B
3
4
5
D16
DOOR KEY CYLINDER
LIGHT AND SW
9 IH1
FROM DOOR LOCK
CONTROL RELAY
10 IH1
R
R
16 3A
2 1H
19 1H
1 1M
130
B
IF
1
W–B
D14
DOOR COURTESY SW
REAR LH
R–W
1
W–B
D15
DOOR COURTESY
SW REAR RH
R–Y
D13
DOOR COURTESY
SW FRONT RH
1
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
16 IU1
IU1
R–W
6
D12
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT LH
R–G
B
1
IG
W–B
BK
R–W
1
2
R
1
L3
LUGGAGE
COMPARTMENT LIGHT
R
2
R–Y
W–B
V9
VANITY LIGHT RH
R
R
(* 1)(S/D)
(* 2)
R
B 4 : S/D
B20 : C/P
R–W
(* 2)
W–B
W–B
1
(C/P)
6
R
(*2)
1I
(S/D)
1I
6
(*2)
W–B
W–B
V8
VANITY LIGHT LH
R
1
(* 1)(S/D)
B 5 : S/D
B20 : C/P
R
(W/ MOON ROOF)
OFF
ON
DOOR
I14
INTERIOR LIGHT
B 4 : S/D
B20 : C/P
W–B
RH
(* 2)
R–W
1
(W/ MOON ROOF)
LH
4
M3
PERSONAL LIGHT
R–W
IV2
(* 1)(S/D)
(* 2)
4
R–W
* 1 : TMC MADE
* 2 : TMM MADE
6 1H
IV2
R
1
2
2
IV2
1I
1
5 1M
5 BZ1
4
1
L4
LUGGAGE
COMPARTMENT
LIGHT SW
IE
131
INTERIOR LIGHT (S/D, C/P w/ KEY ILLUMINATED ENTRY)
* 1 : TMC MADE
* 2 : TMM MADE
SERVICE HINTS
INTEGRATION RELAY
4–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH DOOR CLOSED
0 VOLTS WITH EACH DOOR OPEN
D12, D13, D14, D15 DOOR COURTESY SW
1–GROUND : CLOSED WITH DOOR OPEN
L 4 LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT LIGHT SW
1–GROUND : CLOSED WITH LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR OPEN
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
C9
32
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
D16
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
L4
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
D7
32
I11
33
M3
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
D12
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
I14
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
V8
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
D13
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
J1
33
V9
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
D14
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
J3
33
D15
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
L3
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
1B
1C
1H
1I
1K
1M
2G
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO.
NO 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
20
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
20 (*1)
ROOF WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL) TMC MADE
20 (*2)
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL) TMM MADE
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO.
NO 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
22
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
24
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 3 (BEHIND COMBINATION METER)
3A
3C
3D
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
IH1
IH2
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
42
FRONT DOOR LH WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
II2
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE AND COWL WIRE
IJ1
42
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND COWL WIRE
IU1
44
FLOOR NO. 2 WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
IV2
44
ROOF WIRE AND COWL WIRE MADE IN USA
BZ1
46 (S/D)
48 (C/P)
LUGGAGE ROOM NO.
NO 1 WIRE AND FLOOR NO.
NO 1 WIRE
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
IF
42
LEFT KICK PANEL
IG
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE LH
BK
46 (S/D)
48 (C/P)
ROOF LEFT
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
I8
44
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
B5
46 (S/D)
B4
46 (S/D)
ROOF WIRE
B20
48 (C/P)
132
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
ROOF WIRE
133
INTERIOR LIGHT (W/G w/ KEY ILLUMINATED ENTRY)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
20A
DOME
R
2 2G
1 1C
R
1 Bc2
R
II2
R
3
5 1C
R
6 1H
R
12 1K
A
1
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R
14 3C
L3
LUGGAGE
COMPARTMENT
LIGHT
A
R–B
16 3A
14 3D
134
R–Y
G–R
R–Y
D9
DIODE
(FOR COURTESY)
2 1B
15
G–R
6
II2
R–W
9
1K
2
II2
R–Y
1
1K
7
1K
1
2
DIODE
19 1H
R–W
L4
LUGGAGE
COMPARTMENT
LIGHT SW
R–W
1
IF
IJ1
BR
B34
D14
DOOR COURTESY
SW REAR LH
R–W
1
B
W–B
D15
DOOR COURTESY
SW REAR RH
R–Y
1
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
16 IU1
D13
DOOR COURTESY
SW FRONT RH
R–W
IU1
2
R–W
8
II2
2
B
6
1
1K
W–B
D7
DIODE
(FOR COURTESY)
R–Y
I8
15
2
1
R–B
R–Y
1 R–Y
II2
W–B
G–R
R–G
R–W
R–W
R–W 2
4
5
3
15
I8
R–W
16 IH2
2 Bc3
R–W
W–B
11 IH1
R–W
1
2 Bd2
R–W
R–B
4
D16
DOOR KEY CYLINDER
LIGHT AND SW
R
2
FROM DOOR LOCK
CONTROL RELAY
3
G–R
B38
I11
IGNITION KEY
CYLINDER LIGHT
R
R
9 IH1
C9
OPEN DOOR
WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
10 IH1
R–W
2
1
W–B
W–B
4
IG
1I
1
4
1
BP
B31
1
2
6
6
(* 1)
R
1
W–B
2
V9
VANITY LIGHT RH
V8
VANITY LIGHT LH
R
R
1
(* 1)
W–B
1
R
1
(W/ MOON ROOF)
OFF
ON
B33
W–B
4
DOOR
R
RH
10
LH
4
R–W
I14
INTERIOR LIGHT
INTEGRATION RELAY
W–B
2 1H
2
M3
PERSONAL LIGHT
R–W
3
W–B
D12
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT LH
R–G
* 1 : LE AND GL GRADE IN CANADA
II
IV1
R
(* 1)
R
(* 1)
R
1
IV1
2
B30
IV1
1 1M
1I
5 1M
IE
135
INTERIOR LIGHT (W/G w/ KEY ILLUMINATED ENTRY)
SERVICE HINTS
INTEGRATION RELAY
4–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH DOOR CLOSED
0 VOLTS WITH EACH DOOR OPEN
D12, D13, D14, D15 DOOR COURTESY SW
1–GROUND : CLOSED WITH DOOR OPEN
L 4 LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT LIGHT SW
2–1 : CLOSED WITH LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR OPEN
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
C9
32
D15
36 (W/G)
D7
32
D16
D9
36
I11
D12
36 (W/G)
D13
D14
CODE
SEE PAGE
L3
36 (W/G)
36 (W/G)
L4
36 (W/G)
33
M3
36 (W/G)
I14
36 (W/G)
V8
36 (W/G)
36 (W/G)
J2
33
V9
36 (W/G)
36 (W/G)
J3
33
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
1B
1C
1H
1I
1K
1M
2G
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO.
NO 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
20
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
20
ROOF WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL) TMC MADE
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL) TMM MADE
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO.
NO 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
22
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
24
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 3 (BEHIND COMBINATION METER)
3A
3C
3D
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
IH1
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
42
FRONT DOOR LH WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
II2
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE AND COWL WIRE
IJ1
42
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND COWL WIRE
44
FRONT DOOR RH WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
IU1
44
FLOOR NO. 2 WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
IV1
44
ROOF WIRE AND COWL WIRE
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR NO.
NO 1 WIRE AND FLOOR NO.
NO 1 WIRE
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND BACK DOOR NO. 2 WIRE
IH2
IT1
IT2
Bc2
Bc3
Bd2
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
IE
IF
SEE PAGE
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
42
LEFT KICK PANEL
IG
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE LH
BP
50 (W/G)
BACK PANEL CENTER
BR
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR CENTER
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
I8
B30
B31
136
SEE PAGE
44
50 (W/G)
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
ROOF WIRE
CODE
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
B33
50 (W/G)
ROOF WIRE
B39
50 (W/G)
ROOF WIRE NO. 1 WIRE
137
1
138
1
IJ1
3
R–L
6
1K
2
II2
R–Y
1
1K
1
19 1H
1
2 1H
B7
1
IG
3
DIODE
R–L
IV2
R–W
2
1B
R
1
(W/ MOON ROOF)
(* 2)
R–W
L3
LUGGAGE
COMPARTMENT
LIGHT
OFF
ON
2
4
BK
1
R–Y(C/P)
1B
DOOR
R
R
R
R
(* 2)
R
(* 2)
R
(* 1)(S/D)
R
6
1H
R–W(S/D)
R–W
2
RH
6
II2
B 4 : S/D
B20 : C/P
L4
LUGGAGE
COMPARTMENT
LIGHT SW
(* 2)
10
(* 1)(S/D)
1
I14
INTERIOR LIGHT
R
1
LH
R–Y
G–R
I11
IGNITION KEY
CYLINDER LIGHT
INTEGRATION RELAY
(W/ MOON ROOF)
IU1
(* 2)
R–Y
R
5 1C
M3
PERSONAL LIGHT
D7
DIODE
(FOR COURTESY)
7
IJ1
W–B
16
I8
R
15
(* 2)
5
2
W–B
R
C9
OPEN DOOR
WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
4
R–G
1 R–Y
(* 1)(S/D)
FROM DOOR LOCK
CONTROL RELAY
14 3D
R–W
R–Y
R–G
R–W
14 3C
D12
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT LH
IU1
10 3A
D14
DOOR COURTESY
SW REAR LH
R–W
R–Y
6
R–W 2
D15
DOOR COURTESY
SW REAR RH
R–W
I8
D13
DOOR COURTESY
SW FRONT RH
R–W
R
INTERIOR LIGHT (S/D, C/P w/o KEY ILLUMINATED ENTRY)
* 1 : TMC MADE
* 2 : TMM MADE
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
20A
DOME
2 2G
1 1C
R
1 1I
1 1V2
1
2
3
1I
R–W
(* 2)
2
1 1M
1
5 BZ1
* 1 : TMC MADE
* 2 : TMM MADE
SERVICE HINTS
INTEGRATION RELAY
6–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH DOOR CLOSED
0 VOLTS WITH EACH DOOR OPEN
D12, D13, D14, D15 DOOR COURTESY SW
1–GROUND : CLOSED WITH DOOR OPEN
L 4 LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT LIGHT SW
1–GROUND : CLOSED WITH LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR OPEN
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
C9
32
D14
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
J3
33
D7
32
D15
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
L3
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
D12
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
I11
33
L4
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
D13
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
I14
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
M3
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
1B
1C
1H
1I
1K
1M
2G
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO.
NO 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
20
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
20 (*1)
ROOF WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL) TMC MADE
20 (*2)
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL) TMM MADE
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO.
NO 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
22
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
24
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 3 (BEHIND COMBINATION METER)
3A
3C
3D
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
II2
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE AND COWL WIRE
IJ1
42
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND COWL WIRE
IU1
44
FLOOR NO. 2 WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
IV2
44
ROOF WIRE AND COWL WIRE MADE IN USA
BZ1
46 (S/D)
LUGGAGE ROOM NO.
NO 1 WIRE AND FLOOR NO.
NO 1 WIRE
48 (C/P)
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
IG
BK
SEE PAGE
42
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE LH
46 (S/D)
ROOF LEFT
48 (C/P)
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
I8
44
B4
46 (S/D)
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
CODE
B6
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
B7
ROOF WIRE
B20
C9
D7
1
X X
L3
1
4 5
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
46 (S/D)
FLOOR NO.
NO 1 WIRE
48 (C/P)
ROOF WIRE
I11
D12, D13, D14, D15
1
1
L4
2
2
BLACK
SEE PAGE
1
GRAY
2
BLUE
I14
1
2
M3
1
4
139
INTERIOR LIGHT (W/G w/o KEY ILLUMINATED ENTRY)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
20A
DOME
R
2 2G
1 1C
5 1C
R
R
6 1H
14 3C
R–W
1 Bc2
L3
LUGGAGE
COMPARTMENT
LIGHT
R
I11
IGNITION KEY
CYLINDER LIGHT
1
4
C9
OPEN DOOR
WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
2
R–Y
2
Bc3
R–Y
G–R
R–W
3
FROM DOOR LOCK
CONTROL RELAY
R–W
1
5
R–W
2
B39
14 3D
R
16 3A
D9
DIODE
(FOR COURTESY)
15
2
IJ1
2
1B
R–W
R–G
1
6
II2
I8
R–W
2
1
R–Y
I8
R–Y
2
II2
1K
1
1K
R–Y
1
2
DIODE
19 1H
2 1H
R–W
R–Y
R–W
D7
DIODE
(FOR COURTESY)
R–W
9
R–L
R–W
R–W
2 Bd2
B35
R–W
R–G
1
L4
LUGGAGE
COMPARTMENT
LIGHT SW
1
1
1
W–B
1
D13
DOOR COURTESY
SW FRONT RH
140
2
16 IU1
R–Y
IU1
R–W
6
D15
DOOR COURTESY
SW REAR RH
BR
D14
DOOR COURTESY
SW REAR LH
D12
DOOR COURTESY
SW FRONT LH
1I
R
1
IV1
R
1
INTEGRATION RELAY
B33
R
1
R
(W/ MOON ROOF)
M3
PERSONAL
LIGHT
LH
R–W
1
RH
10
4
3
3
1I
IV1
R–W
IG
W–B
(W/ MOON ROOF)
1 1M
W–B
2
DOOR
I14
INTERIOR
LIGHT
1
OFF
ON
2
BP
141
INTERIOR LIGHT (W/G w/o KEY ILLUMINATED ENTRY)
SERVICE HINTS
INTEGRATION RELAY
6–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH DOOR CLOSED
0 VOLTS WITH EACH DOOR OPEN
D12, D13, D14, D15 DOOR COURTESY SW
1–GROUND : CLOSED WITH DOOR OPEN
L 4 LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT LIGHT SW
2–1 : CLOSED WITH LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR OPEN
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
C9
32
D14
36 (W/G)
D7
32
D15
D9
36 (W/G)
I11
D12
36 (W/G)
I14
36 (W/G)
D13
36 (W/G)
J3
33
CODE
SEE PAGE
L3
36 (W/G)
36 (W/G)
L4
36 (W/G)
33
M3
36 (W/G)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
1B
1C
1H
1I
1K
1M
2E
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO.
NO 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
20
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
20
ROOF WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL) TMC MADE
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL) TMM MADE
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO.
NO 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
22
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
24
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 3 (BEHIND COMBINATION METER)
3A
3C
3D
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
IH1
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
42
FRONT DOOR LH WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
II2
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE AND COWL WIRE
IJ1
42
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND COWL WIRE
44
FRONT DOOR RH WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
IU1
44
FLOOR NO. 2 WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
IV1
44
ROOF WIRE AND COWL WIRE
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR NO.
NO 1 WIRE AND FLOOR NO.
NO 1 WIRE
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND BACK DOOR NO. 2 WIRE
IH2
IT1
IT2
Bc2
Bc3
Bd2
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
IG
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE LH
BP
50 (W/G)
BACK PANEL CENTER
BR
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR CENTER
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
I8
B33
142
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
44
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
B35
50 (W/G)
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE
50 (W/G)
ROOF WIRE
B39
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR NO. 1 WIRE
143
TAILLIGHT (S/D, C/P)
1
5
TAILLIGHT
RELAY
2
4 1E
15A
TAIL
3
7
1H
12
BZ1
G
G
8 1B
G
W
14 1D
4 EF1
G
100A ALT
G
3 ED1
1 C
B
F10
A , F10
B , F16
1 A (1MZ–FE)
1 B (5S–FE)
FUSE BOX
4 3D
G–R
C
W
5 3D
E4
2
G
I13
INTEGRATION
RELAY
G
FL MAIN
2. 0L
1
E4
IE
W–B
W–B
E4
EB
2
W–B
E4
EA
G
1
2
W–B
G
G
2
F6
FRONT SIDE
MARKER RH
2
1
W–B
11
W–B
C12
COMBINATION SW
1
W–B
HEAD
1
F4
FRONT CLEARANCE
LIGHT RH
TAIL
W–B
F3
FRONT CLEARANCE
LIGHT LH
LIGHT
CONTROL SW
2
OFF
F5
FRONT SIDE
MARKER LH
G
BATTERY
144
G
G
E4
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
B12 : S/D
B28 : C/P
10A
GAUGE
G
6
1B
G
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–L C
C
R–L
6
C9
REAR LIGHT
WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
Y
9 1H
Y–G
3
2 BZ1
IJ1
Y
Y–G
17
3 BZ1
3
8
–
+
11
LG
9
B12 : S/D
B28 : C/P
LG
13
BZ1
LG
2
Ba1
LG
B16 : S/D
B29 : C/P
LG
B13 : S/D
B28 : C/P
Y–G
DELAY
CIRCUIT
W–B
G
L2
LIGHT FAILURE
SENSOR
4
3
W–B
R9
TAILLIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
3
1
W–B
B14 : S/D
B28 : C/P
W–B
B15 : S/D
B28 : C/P
W–B
R8
REAR COMBINATION
LIGHT LH
W–B
5
1
W–B
W–B
R10
REAR COMBINATION
LIGHT RH
R11
TAILLIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
5
4
TAILLIGHT
LH
TAILLIGHT
RH
2
6
W–B
LG
4
REAR SIDE
MARKER LH
G
6
REAR SIDE
MARKER RH
1
W–B
L1
LICENSE PLATE
LIGHT
G
LG
G
LG
LG
LG
B13 : S/D
B28 : C/P
B16 : S/D
B29 : C/P
7 BZ1
W–B
W–B
W–B
4 Ba1
W–B
B 9 : S/D
B25 : C/P
W–B
BL
W–B
BO
145
TAILLIGHT (S/D, C/P)
SYSTEM OUTLINE
WHEN THE LIGHT CONTROL SW IS TURNED TO TAIL OR HEAD POSITION, THE CURRENT FLOWS TO TERMINAL 3 OF THE LIGHT
FAILURE SENSOR THROUGH THE TAIL FUSE.
WHEN THE IGNITION SW IS TURNED ON, THE CURRENT FLOWS FROM THE GAUGE FUSE TO TERMINAL 8 OF THE LIGHT FAILURE
SENSOR, AND ALSO FLOWS THROUGH THE REAR LIGHTS WARNING LIGHT TO TERMINAL 4 OF THE LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR.
TAILLIGHT DISCONNECTION WARNING
WHEN THE IGNITION SW ON AND THE LIGHT CONTROL SW TURNED TO TAIL OR HEAD POSITION, IF THE TAILLIGHT CIRCUIT IS
OPEN, THE LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR DETECTS THE FAILURE BY THE CHANGE IN CURRENT FLOWING FROM TERMINAL 3 OF THE
LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR TO TERMINAL 9 AND THE WARNING CIRCUIT OF THE LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR IS ACTIVATED.
AS A RESULT, THE CURRENT FLOWS FLOM TERMINAL 4 OF THE LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR → TERMINAL 11 → GROUND AND TURNS
THE REAR LIGHT WARNING LIGHT ON, WHICH REMAINS ON UNTIL THE LIGHT CONTROL SW IS TURNED OFF.
SERVICE HINTS
TAILLIGHT RELAY
1–4 : CLOSED WITH LIGHT CONTROL SW AT TAIL OR HEAD POSITION
L 2 LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR
4, 8–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
3–GROUND : APPROX 12 VOLTS WITH LIGHT CONTROL SW AT TAIL OR HEAD POSITION
11–GROUND : ALWAYS CONTINUITY
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
C9
32
C12
32
D4
32
F3
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
F4
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
F5
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
CODE
SEE PAGE
F6
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
SEE PAGE
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
L2
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
R8
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
C
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
R9
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
I13
33
R10
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
J1
33
R11
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
F16
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
1H
20
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
3D
24
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 3 (BEHIND COMBINATION METER)
1E
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
ED1
EF1
IJ1
BZ1
Ba1
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
42
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
COWL WIRE AND ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE
ENGINE WIRE AND COWL WIRE
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND COWL WIRE
46 (S/D)
48 (C/P)
46 (S/D)
46 (S/D)
LUGGAGE ROOM NO.
NO 1 WIRE AND FLOOR NO.
NO 1 WIRE
FLOOR NO.
NO 1 WIRE AND LUGGAGE ROOM NO.
NO 2 WIRE
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
EA
EB
IE
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
42
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
FRONT RIGHT FENDER
FRONT LEFT FENDER
LEFT KICK PANEL
46 (S/D)
BL
48 (C/P)
UNDER THE LEFT QUARTER PILLAR
50 (W/G)
BQ
146
50 (W/G)
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
B
1B
1D
SEE PAGE
L1
A
F10
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
CODE
LOWER BACK PANEL CENTER
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
E4
B9
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
46 (S/D)
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE
B12
B13
46 (S/D)
LUGGAGE ROOM NO. 1 WIRE
CODE
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
B15
46 (S/D)
LUGGAGE ROOM NO. 1 WIRE
B16
46 (S/D)
LUGGAGE ROOM NO. 2 WIRE
B25
48 (C/P)
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE
B28
48 (C/P)
LUGGAGE ROOM NO. 1 WIRE
B29
48 (C/P)
LUGGAGE ROOM NO. 2 WIRE
B14
147
TAILLIGHT (W/G)
1
5
TAILLIGHT
RELAY
2
4 1E
15A
TAIL
3
7
1H
G
8 1B
G
W
14 1D
4 EF1
C
W
5 3D
100A ALT
G
G–R
4 3D
G
3 ED1
1 C
B
FUSE BOX
F10
A , F10
B , F16
1 A (1MZ–FE)
1 B (5S–FE)
E4
2
G
I13
INTEGRATION
RELAY
G
FL MAIN
2. 0L
1
E4
G
E4
IE
148
W–B
W–B
E4
EB
2
W–B
E4
EA
G
1
2
W–B
G
G
2
F6
FRONT SIDE
MARKER RH
2
1
W–B
11
W–B
C12
COMBINATION SW
1
W–B
HEAD
1
F4
FRONT CLEARANCE
LIGHT RH
TAIL
W–B
F3
FRONT CLEARANCE
LIGHT LH
LIGHT
CONTROL SW
2
OFF
F5
FRONT SIDE
MARKER LH
G
G
BATTERY
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
10A
GAUGE
G
6
1B
G
B37
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
R–L
C
R–L
9 1H
6
Y
G
C9
REAR LIGHT
WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
Y–G
3
IJ1
Y–G
17
3
8
4
G
L2
LIGHT FAILURE
SENSOR
2 Bc2
1 Bd2
–
+
DELAY
CIRCUIT
11
LG
3
Bc2
LG
6
Bd2
LG
B38
LG
B36
W–B
LG
9
7
LG
B36
3
1
4
LG
R9
TAILLIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
R11
TAILLIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
3
2
W–B
2
R8
TAILLIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
1
R10
TAILLIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
2
1
4
C
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
W–B
BQ
BL
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
C
W–B
L1
LICENSE PLATE
LIGHT
LG
LG
LG
G
Bb1
BR
149
TAILLIGHT (W/G)
SYSTEM OUTLINE
WHEN THE LIGHT CONTROL SW IS TURNED TO TAIL OR HEAD POSITION, THE CURRENT FLOWS TO TERMINAL 3 OF THE LIGHT
FAILURE SENSOR THROUGH THE TAIL FUSE.
WHEN THE IGNITION SW IS TURNED ON, THE CURRENT FLOWS FROM THE GAUGE FUSE TO TERMINAL 8 OF THE LIGHT FAILURE
SENSOR, AND ALSO FLOWS THROUGH THE REAR LIGHTS WARNING LIGHT TO TERMINAL 4 OF THE LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR.
TAILLIGHT DISCONNECTION WARNING
WITH THE IGNITION SW ON AND THE LIGHT CONTROL SW TURNED TO TAIL OR HEAD POSITION, IF THE TAILLIGHT CIRCUIT IS
OPEN, THE LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR DETECTS THE FAILURE BY THE CHANGE IN CURRENT FLOWING FROM TERMINAL 3 OF THE
LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR TO TERMINAL 9 AND THE WARNING CIRCUIT OF THE LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR IS ACTIVATED.
AS A RESULT, THE CURRENT FLOWS FROM TERMINAL 4 OF THE LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR → TERMINAL 11 → GROUND AND TURNS
THE REAR LIGHT WARNING LIGHT ON, WHICH REMAINS ON UNTIL THE LIGHT CONTROL SW IS TURNED OFF.
SERVICE HINTS
TAILLIGHT RELAY
3–5 : CLOSED WITH LIGHT CONTROL SW AT TAIL OR HEAD POSITION
L 2 LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR
4, 8–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
3–GROUND : APPROX 12 VOLTS WITH LIGHT CONTROL SW AT TAIL OR HEAD POSITION
11–GROUND : ALWAYS CONTINUITY
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
C9
32
C12
32
F3
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
F4
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
F5
F6
CODE
SEE PAGE
B
C
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
L2
36 (W/G)
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
R8
36 (W/G)
I13
33
R9
36 (W/G)
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
J1
33
R10
36 (W/G)
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
J5
36 (W/G)
R11
36 (W/G)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
1B
1D
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
1H
20
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
3D
24
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 3 (BEHIND COMBINATION METER)
1E
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
ED1
EF1
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
COWL WIRE AND ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE
ENGINE WIRE AND COWL WIRE
IJ1
42
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND COWL WIRE
Bb1
50 (W/G)
LUGGAGE ROOM NO. 1 WIRE AND FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE
Bc2
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE
Bd2
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND BACK DOOR NO. 2 WIRE
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
EA
EB
IE
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
42
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
FRONT RIGHT FENDER
FRONT LEFT FENDER
LEFT KICK PANEL
46 (S/D)
BL
48 (C/P)
UNDER THE LEFT QUARTER PILLAR
50 (W/G)
BQ
50 (W/G)
LOWER BACK PANEL CENTER
BR
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR CENTER
150
SEE PAGE
36 (W/G)
F16
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
CODE
L1
F10
A
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
E4
B36
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
50 (W/G)
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE
CODE
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
B37
50 (W/G)
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE
B38
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR NO. 2 WIRE
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE
151
BACK–UP LIGHT
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
10A
GAUGE
R–L
6 1D
IP3
R–L
R–L
R–L
R–L
I18
(A/T)
2
(M/T)
TO VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
(SPEED SENSOR)
TO GENERATOR (ALTERNATOR)
2
B1
BACK–UP
LIGHT SW
R–B
8
(A/T)
P1
BACK–UP LIGHT SW
[PARK/NEUTRAL
POSITION SW
(NEUTRAL START SW)]
R–B
1
(M/T)
IP3
R–B
1
R–L
I18
(A/T)
TO VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
(SPEED SENSOR)
TO GENERATOR (ALTERNATOR)
(A/T)
R–L
(M/T)
(M/T)
2
R–B
R–B
6 Bc2
3 Ba1
R–B
R–B
3 Bd2
(S/D, C/P)
R–B
IJ1
(W/G)
10
R–B
B38
(W/G)
R–B
R–B
(W/G)
B16
(S/D, W/G)
R–B
(S/D, C/P)
4 A (S/D, C/P)
3 B (W/G)
R9
4 A (S/D, C/P)
3 B (W/G)
A , B
R11
BACK–UP LIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
3 A (S/D, C/P)
4 B (W/G)
A , B
BACK–UP LIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
3 A (S/D, C/P)
4 B (W/G)
W–B
(S/D, C/P)
W–B
W–B
B16
BR
152
W–B
4
Ba1
W–B
(W/G)
W–B
(W/G)
(S/D, C/P)
BL
SERVICE HINTS
B 1 BACK–UP LIGHT SW
2–1 : CLOSED WITH SHIFT LEVER IN R POSITION
P 1 BACK–UP LIGHT SW [PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW (NEUTRAL START SW)]
6–5 : CLOSED WITH SHIFT LEVER IN R POSITION
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
B1
30
R9
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
P1
29 (1MZ–FE), 31 (5S–FE)
R11
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
SEE PAGE
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
1D
SEE PAGE
20
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
IJ1
42
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND COWL WIRE
IP3
44
ENGINE WIRE AND COWL WIRE
Ba1
46 (S/D)
48 (C/P)
FLOOR NO.
NO 1 WIRE AND LUGGAGE ROOM NO.
NO 2 WIRE
Bc2
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE
Bd2
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND BACK DOOR NO. 2 WIRE
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
46 (S/D)
BL
48 (C/P)
UNDER THE LEFT QUARTER PILLAR
50 (W/G)
BR
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR CENTER
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
I18
44
ENGINE WIRE
B16
46 (S/D)
LUGGAGE ROOM NO. 2 WIRE
B1
B38
GRAY
P1
X
1
2
CODE
GRAY
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
50 (W/G)
R9
BACK DOOR NO. 2 WIRE
A ,
B
, R11
A , B
2
8
3 4
153
REMOTE CONTROL MIRROR
* 1 : TMC MADE
* 2 : TMM MADE
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
15A
CIG/RADIO
L–R
9 1L
II2
L–R
9
B
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
L–R
B
RIGHT
UP
SELECT SW
LEFT
UP
5
2
W–B
3
LG–R
6
RH
LG–B
7
BR–Y
BR–W
LH
LG
RH
1
DOWN
UP
RIGHT
LEFT
LH
OPERATION SW
R6
REMOTE CONTROL MIRROR SW
8
B
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R20
A , B
REMOTE CONTROL
MIRROR LH
154
LG–R
LG
8
IT2
1 A
3 B
3 A
1 B
M
M
R21
7
B
IT2
W–B
M
IT2
LG–R
M
2 A (* 1, EX. C/P)
2 B (* 2)
6
LG
3 A
1 B
IH1
LG–B
1 A
3 B
5
LG–R
4 IH1
BR–W
IH1
BR–Y
6
LG–R
BR–Y
I4
2 A (* 1, EX. C/P)
2 B (* 2)
A , B
REMOTE CONTROL
MIRROR RH
IF
SERVICE HINTS
R 6 REMOTE CONTROL MIRROR SW
8–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ACC OR ON POSITION
5–2 : CONTINUITY WITH OPERATION SW AT UP OR LEFT POSITION
5–8 : CONTINUITY WITH OPERATION SW AT DOWN OR RIGHT POSITION
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
J2
33
R6
33
J3
33
R20
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
CODE
R21
SEE PAGE
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
1L
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
IH1
42
FRONT DOOR LH WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
II2
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE AND COWL WIRE
IT2
44
FRONT DOOR RH WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
IF
SEE PAGE
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
42
LEFT KICK PANEL
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
I4
SEE PAGE
44
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
J2
J3
B
B B
B B
B B
B
B
(* 1, EX. C/P) R20
R6
B
B B B B
1 2
3
A , R21
A
1 2 3
X 5 6 7 8
B B
(HINT : SEE PAGE 7)
(HINT : SEE PAGE 7)
(* 2) R20
B , R21
B
3 2 1
155
POWER WINDOW
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
2
10A
GAUGE
8 1K
30A
POWER
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
4
R–L
II2
R–L C
5
R–L
C L–R
6 1L
1
D8
DOOR LOCK
CONTROL RELAY
1
R–L
II2
15
IG
5
1
RLY
POWER
MAIN RELAY
+B
8
2
3
1 1M 11 1K
2 1K
L
10 1K
W–B
10
II2
L
6
IH2
17
II2
W–L
L
W–L
L
B1
L
L
I3
L
L
9 B
7 A
(* 1)
8 A (* 2)
UP
POWER WINDOW MASTER SW
DOWN
B
UP
A ,
DOWN
P12
LOCK
NORMAL
IH2
1 IH2
W–B
156
IF
2 1
M
R–L
G–W
DOWN
2 1
M
2 1
2 1
P13
POWER WINDOW
MOTOR FRONT LH
IT1
L
R–L
P14
POWER WINDOW
MOTOR FRONT RH
(* 2)
4
(* 2)
(* 1)
(* 1)
(* 1)
R
G
(* 2)
(* 1)
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IG
3
1
B
B
2
9
G
R
G
IH2
IT1
R
16
4
5
W–B
W–B
W–B
B1
IT1
G–W
10
(* 2)
W–B
13 A (* 2)
4 B (* 1)
6 A
3 B
UP
2 A
6 B
P9
POWER WINDOW CONTROL
SW FRONT RH
1 A
W–B
L
5
R–L
G–W
+
–
5 A (* 2)
7 B (* 1)
12 A
10 B
–
+
* 1 : C/P
* 2 : S/D, W/G
L
L
7
2
M
1
P16
POWER WINDOW
MOTOR REAR RH
DOWN
L
L
13
IG1
5 BW1
2
3
L
6 BW1
(W/G)
7 BW1
R–Y
5 BY1
(S/D)
L
IG1
R–Y
12
R–B
IG1
G–Y
4
DOWN
5
1
4
R
4
G
1
IU1
R
UP
DOWN
5
IH2
G–B
3
II2
L
L
2
2
L
6 BY1
13
L
R–B
7 BY1
R–B
IU1
G–B
12
G–B
IU1
G
P11
POWER WINDOW CONTROL
SW REAR RH
4
R–B
G–B
I24
IH2
R–Y
L
R–Y
G–Y
IH2
G–Y
12
UP
IH2
P10
POWER WINDOW CONTROL
SW REAR LH
11
18
9 A (* 2)
10 A
R–B
14 A
G–B
11 A
UP
UP
DOWN
L
P12
POWER WINDOW MASTER SW
2
M
1
P15
POWER WINDOW
MOTOR REAR LH
157
POWER WINDOW
SYSTEM OUTLINE
WHEN THE IGNITION SW IS TURNED ON, CURRENT FLOWS THROUGH THE GAUGE FUSE TO TERMINAL 1 OF THE POWER MAIN
RELAY → TERMINAL 2 → TO GROUND. THIS ACTIVATES THE RELAY AND THE CURRENT FLOWING TO TERMINAL 5 OF THE RELAY
FROM POWER FUSE FLOWS TO TERMINAL 3 OF THE RELAY → TERMINAL 7 OR 8 (EX. C/P), 9 (C/P) OF THE POWER WINDOW
MASTER SW → TO TERMINAL 5 OF THE POWER WINDOW SW.
1. MANUAL OPERATION (DRIVER’S WINDOW)
WITH THE IGNITION SW TURNED ON AND WITH THE POWER WINDOW MASTER SW (MANUAL SW) IN UP POSITION. THE CURRENT
FLOWING TO TERMINAL 7 OR 8 (EX. C/P), 9 (C/P) OF THE POWER WINDOW MASTER SW FLOWS TO TERMINAL 6 (EX. C/P), 3 (C/P) OF
THE MASTER SW → TEMINAL 2 OF THE POWER WINDOW MOTOR → TERMINAL 1 → TERMINAL 13 (EX. C/P), 4 (C/P) OF THE MASTER
SW → TERMINAL 2 OR 1 (EX. C/P), 6 (C/P) → TO GROUND AND CAUSES THE POWER WINDOW MOTOR TO ROTATE IN THE UP
DIRECTION. THE WINDOW ASCENDS ONLY WHILE THE SW IS BEING PUSHED. IN DOWN OPERATION, THE FLOW OF CURRENT
FROM TERMINAL 7 OR 8 (EX. C/P), 9 (C/P) OF THE POWER WINDOW MASTER SW TO TERMINAL 13 (EX. C/P), 4 (C/P) OF THE MASTER
SW CAUSES THE FLOW OF CURRENT FROM TERMINAL 1 OF THE MOTOR → TERMINAL 2 → TERMINAL 6 (EX. C/P), 3 (C/P) OF THE
MASTER SW → TERMINAL 2 OR 1 (EX. C/P), 3 (C/P) → TO GROUND, FLOWING IN THE OPPOSITE DIRECTION TO MANUAL UP
OPERATION AND CAUSING THE MOTOR TO ROTATE IN REVERSE LOWERING THE WINDOW.
2. AUTO DOWN OPERATION
WITH THE IGNITION SW ON AND WITH THE AUTO SW OF THE POWER WINDOW MASTER SW IN DOWN POSITION, CURRENT
FLOWING TO TERMINAL 7 OR 8 OF THE MASTER SW FLOWS TO TERMINAL 13 (EX, C/P), 4 (C/P) OF THE MASTER SW → TERMINAL 1
OF THE POWER WINDOW MOTOR → TERMINAL 2 → TERMINAL 6 (EX. C/P), 3 (C/P) OF THE MASTER SW → TERMINAL 2 (EX. C/P), 6
(C/P) → TO GROUND, CAUSING THE MOTOR TO ROTATE TOWARDS THE DOWN SIDE THEN THE SOLENOID IN THE MASTER SW IS
ACTIVATED AND IT LOCKS THE AUTO SW BEING PUSHED, CAUSING THE MOTOR TO CONTINUE TO ROTATE IN AUTO DOWN
OPERATION. WHEN THE WINDOW HAS COMPLETELY DESENDED, THE CURRENT FLOW BETWEEN TERMINAL 6 (EX. C/P), 3 (C/P) OF
THE MASTER SW AND TERMINAL 2 (EX. C/P), 6 (C/P) INCREASES. AS A RESULT, THE SOLENOID STOPS OPERATING, THE AUTO SW
TURNS OFF AND FLOW FROM TERMINAL 7 (EX. C/P), 9 (C/P) OF THE MASTER SW TO TERMINAL 13 (EX. C/P), 4 (C/P) IS CUT OFF,
STOPPING THE MOTOR SO THAT AUTO STOP OCCURS.
3. STOPPING OF AUTO DOWN AT DRIVER’S WINDOW
HEN THE MANUAL SW (DRIVER’S) IS PUSHED TO THE UP SIDE DURING AUTO DOWN OPERATION, A GROUND CIRCUIT OPENS IN
THE MASTER SW AND CURRENT DOES NOT FLOW FROM TERMINAL 6 (EX. C/P), 3 (C/P) OF THE MASTER SW → TO GROUND, SO
THE MOTOR STOPS, CAUSING AUTO DOWN OPERATION TO STOP. IF THE MASTER SW IS PUSHED CONTINUOUSLY, THE MOTOR
ROTATES IN THE UP DIRECTION IN MANUAL UP OPERATION.
4. MANUAL OPERATION BY POWER WINDOW SW (PASSENGER’S WINDOW)
WITH POWER WINDOW SW (PASSENGER’S) PULLED TO THE UP SIDE, CURRENT FLOWING FROM TERMINAL 5 OF THE POWER
WINDOW SW FLOWS TO TERMINAL 1 OF THE POWER WINDOW SW → TERMINAL 2 OF THE POWER WINDOW MOTOR → TERMINAL
1 → TERMINAL 4 OF THE POWER WINDOW SW → TERMINAL 3 → TERMINAL 5 (EX. C/P), 7 (C/P) OF THE MASTER SW → TERMINAL 1
OR 2 (EX. C/P), 6 (C/P) → TO GROUND AND CAUSES THE POWER WINDOW MOTOR (PASSENGER’S) TO ROTATE IN THE UP
DIRECTION. UP OPERATION CONTINUES ONLY WHILE THE POWER WINDOW SW IS PULLED TO THE UP SIDE. WHEN THE WINDOW
DECENDS, THE CURRENT FLOWING TO THE MOTOR FLOWS IN THE OPPOSITE DIRECTION, FROM TERMINAL 1 TO TERMINAL 2,
AND THE MOTOR ROTATES IN REVERSE. WHEN THE WINDOW LOCK SW IS PUSHED TO THE LOCK SIDE, THE GROUND CIRCUIT TO
THE PASSENGER’S WINDOW BECOMES OPEN. AS A RESULT, EVEN IF OPEN/CLOSE OPERATION OF THE PASSENGER’S WINDOW IS
TRIED, THE CURRENT FROM TERMINAL 1 OR 2 (EX. C/P), 6 (C/P) OF THE POWER WINDOW MASTER SW IS NOT GROUNDED AND
THE MOTOR DOES NOT ROTATE, SO THE PASSENGER’S WINDOW CAN NOT BE OPERATED AND WINDOW LOCK OCCURS.
FURTHERMORE REAR LH RH WINDOW OPERATE THE SAME AS THE ABOVE CIRCUIT.
5. KEY OFF POWER WINDOW OPERATION
WITH IGNITION SW TURNED FROM ON TO OFF DOOR LOCK CONTROL RELAY OPERATES AND CURRENT FLOWS FROM POWER
FUSE TO TERMINAL 8 OF THE RELAY → TERMINAL 15 → TERMINAL 1 OF POWER MAIN RELAY → TERMINAL 2 → TO GROUND FOR
ABOUT 60 SECOND. THE SAME AS NORMAL OPERATION, THE CURRENT FLOWS FROM POWER FUSE → TERMINAL 5 OF THE
POWER MAIN RELAY → TERMINAL 3 → TERMINAL 7 OR 8 (EX. C/P), TERMINAL 9 (C/P) OF THE POWER WINDOW MASTER SW AND
TERMINAL 3 OF THE POWER MAIN RELAY → TO TERMINAL 5 OF THE POWER WINDOW SW. AS A RESULT, FOR ABOUT 60 SECOND
AFTER THE IGNITION SW IS TURNED OFF, THE FUNCTIONING OF THIS RELAY MAKES IT POSSIBLE TO RAISE AND LOWER THE
POWER WINDOW. ALSO, BY OPENING THE FRONT DOOR (DOOR OPEN DETECTION SW ON) WITHIN ABOUT 60 SECOND AFTER
TURNING THE IGNITION SW TO OFF, A SIGNAL IS INPUT TO DOOR LOCK CONTROL RELAY. AS A RESULT, THE RELAY TURNS OFF
AND UP AND DOWN MOVEMENT OF THE POWER WINDOW STOPS.
158
* 1 : C/P
* 2 : S/D, W/G
SERVICE HINTS
P12 POWER WINDOW MASTER SW (C/P)
9–GROUND
6–GROUND
3–GROUND
4–GROUND
: APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
: ALWAYS CONTINUITY
: APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW ON AND MASTER SW (DRIVER’S WINDOW) UP
: APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW ON AND MASTER SW (DRIVER’S WINDOW) AT DOWN OR AUTO DOWN
POSITION
P12 POWER WINDOW MASTER SW (EX. C/P)
7, 8–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
1, 2–GROUND : ALWAYS CONTINUITY
6–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW ON AND MASTER SW (DRIVER’S WINDOW) UP
13–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW ON AND MASTER SW (DRIVER’S WINDOW) AT DOWN OR AUTO DOWN
POSITION
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
D8
32
P10
J2
33
P11
J3
33
P9
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
P12
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
P13
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
P14
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
A
34 (S/D), 36 (W/G)
P15
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
B
35 (C/P)
P16
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
1K
1L
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
1M
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
IG1
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
42
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
42
FRONT DOOR LH WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
IT1
44
FRONT DOOR RH WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
IU1
44
FLOOR NO. 2 WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
IH1
IH2
BW1
BY1
46 (S/D)
50 (W/G)
46 (S/D)
50 (W/G)
REAR DOOR LH WIRE AND FLOOR NO.
NO 1 WIRE
REAR DOOR RH WIRE AND FLOOR NO.
NO 2 WIRE
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
IF
42
LEFT KICK PANEL
IG
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE LH
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
I3
I24
SEE PAGE
44
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
CODE
B1
SEE PAGE
46 (S/D)
50 (W/G)
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
FRONT DOOR LH WIRE
159
DOOR LOCK
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
30A
POWER
1
5
2
3
POWER
MAIN
RELAY
6 1L
5
II2
R–L
II2
W–L
10
R–L
W–L
2 1K
L
W–B
1 1M 11 1K
8
15
D8
DOOR LOCK
CONTROL RELAY
LOCK
TIMER
II2
L
17
6
UNLOCK
TIMER
IH2
4
5
L–R
Y
16
160
IJ
L–R
Y
(* 1)
B
7 B
4 A
5 B
2 A
6
IT1
Y
IT1
L–B
16
L–R
(* 1)
L–B
M
A , D27
L–B
D22
DOOR LOCK MOTOR
REAR LH
L–R
1
2
IT1
6 B (*2)
3 A (*1)
M
1 A (*1)
4 B (*2)
W–B
M
W–B
B9
BACK DOOR
LOCK MOTOR
W–B
W–B
IG
2
8 BW1
DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND
DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION SW
FRONT RH
3 Bd3
(* 1)
1 Bd3
L–B
L–R
L–B
4
3 BW1
11
(* 1)
L–B
4 Bc1
(* 1)
L–R
2 Bc1
L–R
I3
15 IG1
L–B
(* 1)
L–R
5 IG1
L–R
16 IG1
L–R
6 IG1
L
L–B
I3
L–R
I3
(W/G)
L–B
L–B
I3
D21
L–B
(W/G)
L–R
L–R
B11 : EX. C/P
B27 : C/P
W–B
* 1 : S/D, W/G
* 2 : C/P
* 3 : W/ POWER WINDOW
* 4 : W/ POWER WINDOW, C/P
* 5 : W/O POWER WINDOW
D8
DOOR LOCK
CONTROL RELAY
CONTROL
CIRCUIT
3
9
6
L
L–B
L
L–R
19
IT1
W–B
B
B
B
W–B
W–B
IF
W–B
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
16
IH2
W–B
W–B
W–B
3
IH2
D17
DOOR KEY LOCK AND
UNLOCK SW LH
L
5 C (* 5)
2 B (* 4)
4 A (* 3)
4
1
1 A
6 B
3 C
B 2 : *3
B 1 : *4
B18 : * 5
2 A (* 3)
(* 4)
(* 5)
IH2
L–W
LG
G
IH2
3
LOCK
2
W–B
1 A (* 2)
4 B (* 1)
9 B
8 A
10
W–B
M
L
6 B (* 2)
3 A (* 1)
IH2
1 C
1 B
3 A
W–B
5 B
2 A
13
IH2
A , B , C
7 B
4 A
9
L–R
IH2
DOOR LOCK
CONTROL SW LH
D20
M
19
L–W
P12
B
A , D26
D23
DOOR LOCK MOTOR
REAR RH
2
IH2
L–B
L–B
(* 1)
14
L–B
L–R
(* 1)
L–B
LG
(* 1)
8 BY1
(* 1)
3 BY1
4
L–R
IU1
L–B
15
L–R
(* 1)
IU1
L–R
5
(* 1)
L–R
I22
G
L–R
L–R
L–B
(* 1)
I22
DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND
DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION SW
FRONT LH
L–B
UNLOCK
L–R
SEQURITY
W–B
W–B
W–B
B 2 : *3
B 1 : *4
B18 : * 5
B 1 : EX. C/P
B18 : C/P
161
* 1 : W/ POWER WINDOW EX. C/P
* 2 : W/O POWER WINDOW EX. C/P
DOOR LOCK
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
10A
GAUGE
R–L
8 1K
II2
R–L
4
C
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
L–R
C
D8
DOOR LOCK
CONTROL RELAY
LG
L–W
I22
G
I22
II2
R–W
R–G
R–L
19
I22
14
6
II2
14 1K
9 1K
2 1G
2 1H
6
IU1
W–B
5 B (* 2)
3 A (* 1)
1
5
4 A (* 1)
3 B (* 2)
4 1G
W–B
1 1M
W–B
B11 : EX. C/P
B27 : C/P
IG
162
1
R–W
IT1
D13
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT RH
1 B
2 A
5
D12
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT LH
R–G
G
W–B
2
D19 A , B
DOOR LOCK
CONTROL SW RH
3
LOCK
1
IT1
LG
12
LOCK
IT1
UNLOCK
1
L–W
IT1
D18
DOOR KEY LOCK AND
UNLOCK SW RH
LG–R
UNLOCK
2
I12
UNLOCK WARNING SW
[IGNITION SW]
W–B
R–L
L–W
L–W
2
R–W
LG
7
R–L
G
10
LG
L–W
L
G
11
LG
12
G
13
LG–R
1
1
SYSTEM OUTLINE
CURRENT ALWAYS FLOWS TO TERMINAL 8 OF THE DOOR LOCK CONTROL RELAY THROUGH THE POWER FUSE.
WHEN THE IGNITION SW IS TURNED ON, THE CURRENT FLOWING THROUGH THE GAUGE FUSE FLOWS THROUGH THE COIL SIDE
OF THE POWER MAIN RELAY TO GROUND, CAUSING THE RELAY TO OPERATE. THE CURRENT FLOWING THROUGH THE POWER
FUSE FLOWS TO THE LH DOOR LOCK CONTROL SW, CAUSING THE INDICATOR LIGHT TO LIGHT UP.
1. MANUAL LOCK OPERATION
WHEN THE DOOR LOCK CONTROL SW AND KEY SW ARE PUSHED TO LOCK POSITION, A LOCK SIGNAL IS INPUT TO TERMINAL 10,
12 OF THE DOOR LOCK CONTROL RELAY AND CAUSES THE RELAY TO FUNCTION. CURRENT FLOWS FROM TERMINAL 8 OF THE
RELAY → TERMINAL 4 → TERMINAL 4 OF THE DOOR LOCK MOTORS, (EX. C/P FRONT DOOR) OR TERMINAL 7 (C/P FRONT DOOR),
OF THE DOOR LOCK MOTOR TERMINAL 2 OF THE BACK DOOR LOCK MOTOR → TERMINAL 2 OF THE DOOR LOCK MOTORS, (EX.
C/P FRONT DOOR) OR TERMINAL 5 (C/P FRONT DOOR) OF THE DOOR LOCK MOTOR TERMINAL 1 OF THE BACK DOOR LOCK
MOTOR → TERMINAL 3 OF THE RELAY → TERMINAL 16 → TO GROUND AND THE DOOR LOCK MOTOR CAUSES THE DOOR TO
LOCK.
2. MANUAL UNLOCK OPERATION
WHEN THE DOOR LOCK CONTROL SW AND KEY SW RH TO UNLOCK POSITION, AN UNLOCK SIGNAL IS INPUT TO TERMINAL 11, 13
OF THE DOOR LOCK RELAY AND CAUSES THE RELAY TO FUNCTION. CURRENT FLOWS FROM TERMINAL 8 OF THE RELAY →
TERMINAL 3 → TERMINAL 2 OF THE DOOR LOCK MOTORS, (EX. C/P FRONT DOOR) OR TERMINAL 5 (C/P FRONT DOOR) OF THE
DOOR LOCK MOTOR TERMINAL 1 OF THE BACK DOOR LOCK MOTOR → TERMINAL 4 OF THE DOOR LOCK MOTORS, (EX. C/P
FRONT DOOR) OR TERMINAL 7 (C/P FRONT DOOR), OF THE DOOR LOCK MOTOR TERMINAL 2 OF THE BACK DOOR LOCK MOTOR →
TERMINAL 4 OF THE RELAY → TERMINAL 16 → TO GROUND AND DOOR LOCK MOTORS CAUSES DOOR TO UNLOCK.
3. DOUBLE OPERATION UNLOCK OPERATION
WHEN THE DOOR LOCK KEY SW (DRIVER’S) IS TURNED TO THE UNLOCK SIDE, ONLY THE DRIVER’S DOOR IS MECHANICALLY
UNLOCKED. TURNING THE DOOR LOCK KEY SW (DRIVER’S) TO THE UNLOCK SIDE CAUSES A SIGNAL TO BE INPUT TO TERMINAL 9
OF THE RELAY, AND IF THE SIGNAL IS INPUT AGAIN WITHIN 3 SECONDS BY TURNING THE SW TO THE UNLOCK SIDE AGAIN,
CURRENT FLOWS TERMINAL 3 → TERMINAL 2 OF DOOR LOCK MOTORS, (EX. C/P FRONT DOOR) OR TERMINAL 5 (C/P FRONT
DOOR) OF THE DOOR LOCK MOTOR TERMINAL 1 OF THE BACK DOOR LOCK MOTOR → TERMINAL 4 OF THE DOOR LOCK MOTORS,
(EX. C/P FRONT DOOR) OR TERMINAL 7 (C/P FRONT DOOR), OF THE DOOR LOCK MOTOR TERMINAL 2 OF THE BACK DOOR LOCK
MOTOR → TERMINAL 4 OF THE RELAY → TERMINAL 16 → GROUND, CAUSING THE DOOR LOCK MOTORS TO OPERATE AND
UNLOCK THE DOORS.
4. IGNITION KEY REMINDER OPERATION
* OPERATING DOOR LOCK KNOB (OPERATION OF DOOR LOCK MOTORS)
WITH IGNITION KEY IN CYLINDER (UNLOCK WARNING SW ON), WHEN THE DOOR IS OPENED AND LOCKED USING DOOR LOCK
KNOB (DOOR LOCK MOTOR), THE DOOR IS LOCKED ONCE BUT EACH DOOR IS UNLOCKED SOON BY THE FUNCTION OF RELAY.
AS A RESULT, THE CURRENT FLOWS FROM TERMINAL 8 OF THE RELAY → TERMINAL 3 → TERMINAL 2 OF THE DOOR LOCK
MOTORS, (EX. C/P FRONT DOOR) OR TERMINAL 5 (C/P FRONT DOOR) OF THE DOOR LOCK MOTOR TERMINAL 2 OF THE BACK
DOOR LOCK MOTOR → TERMINAL 4 OF THE DOOR LOCK MOTORS, (EX. C/P FRONT DOOR) OR TERMINAL 7 (C/P FRONT DOOR),
OF THE DOOR LOCK MOTOR TERMINAL 1 OF THE BACK DOOR LOCK MOTOR → TERMINAL 4 OF THE RELAY → TERMINAL 16 →
TO GROUND AND CAUSES ALL THE DOORS TO UNLOCK.
* OPERATING DOOR LOCK CONTROL SW OR DOOR LOCK KEY SW
WITH IGNITION KEY IN CYLINDER (UNLOCK WARNING SW ON), WHEN THE DOOR IS OPENED AND LOCKED USING DOOR LOCK
CONTROL SW OR KEY SW, THE DOOR IS LOCKED ONCE BUT EACH DOOR IS UNLOCK BY THE FUNCTION OF SW CONTAINED IN
MOTORS, WHICH THE SIGNAL IS INPUT TO TERMINAL 6 (DRIVER’S) OR 5 (PASSENGER’S) OF THE RELAY. ACCORDING TO THIS
INPUT SIGNAL, THE CURRENT IN ECU FLOWS FROM TERMINAL 8 OF THE RELAY → TERMINAL 3 → TERMINAL 2 OF THE DOOR
LOCK MOTORS, (EX. C/P FRONT DOOR) OR TERMINAL 5 (C/P FRONT DOOR) OF THE DOOR LOCK MOTOR TERMINAL 2 OF THE
BACK DOOR LOCK MOTOR → TERMINAL 4 OF THE DOOR LOCK MOTORS, TERMINAL 1 OF THE BACK DOOR LOCK MOTOR →
TERMINAL 4 OF THE RELAY → TERMINAL 16 → TO GROUND AND CAUSES ALL THE DOOR TO UNLOCK.
* IN CASE OF KEY LESS LOCK
WITH IGNITION KEY IN CYLINDER (UNLOCK WARNING SW ON), WHEN THE UNLOCK FUNCTION IS DISTURBED MORE THAN 0.2
SECONDS, FOR EXAMPLE PUSHING THE DOOR LOCK KNOB ETC., THE DOOR HOLDS ON LOCK CONDITION. CLOSING THE DOOR
AFTER, DOOR COURTESY SW INPUTS THE SIGNAL INTO TERMINAL 2 OR 14 OF THE RELAY. BY THIS INPUT SIGNAL, THE ECU
WORKS AND CURRENT FLOWS FROM TERMINAL 8 OF THE RELAY → TERMINAL 3 → TERMINAL 2 OF THE DOOR LOCK MOTORS,
(EX. C/P FRONT DOOR) OR TERMINAL 5 (C/P FRONT DOOR) OF THE DOOR LOCK MOTOR TERMINAL 1 OF THE BACK DOOR LOCK
MOTOR → TERMINAL 4 OF THE DOOR LOCK MOTORS, (EX. C/P FRONT DOOR) OR TERMINAL 7 (C/P FRONT DOOR), OF THE
DOOR LOCK MOTOR TERMINAL 2 OF THE BACK DOOR LOCK MOTOR → TERMINAL 4 OF THE RELAY → TERMINAL 16 → TO
GROUND AND CAUSES ALL THE DOORS TO UNLOCK.
163
DOOR LOCK
SERVICE HINTS
D8 DOOR LOCK CONTROL RELAY
16–GROUND : ALWAYS CONTINUITY
2–GROUND : CONTINUITY WITH DRIVER’S DOOR OPEN
8–GROUND : ALWAYS APPROX. 12 VOLTS
3–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS 0.2 SECONDS WITH FOLLOWING OPERATION
*DOOR LOCK CONTROL SW UNLOCKED
*DOOR LOCK CONTROL SW LOCKED WITH IGNITION KEY IN CYLINDER AND DRIVER’S DOOR OPEN
(IGNITION KEY REMINDER FUNCTION)
*DOOR LOCK KNOB LOCKED WITH IGNITION KEY IN CYLINDER AND DRIVER’S DOOR OPEN
(IGNITION KEY REMINDER FUNCTION)
*UNLOCKING THE DRIVER’S, PASSENGER’S DOOR CYLINDER WITH KEY
4–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS 0.2 SECONDS WITH FOLLOWING OPERATION
*DOOR LOCK CONTROL SW LOCKED
*LOCKING THE DRIVER’S, PASSENGER’S DOOR CYLINDER WITH KEY
10–GROUND : 0 VOLTS WITH DOOR LOCK CONTROL SW LOCKED
14–GROUND : CONTINUITY WITH PASSENGER’S DOOR OPEN
6–GROUND : CONTINUITY WITH DRIVER’S DOOR LOCK KNOB UNLOCKED
5–GROUND : CONTINUITY WITH PASSENGER’S DOOR LOCK KNOB UNLOCKED
11–GROUND : 0 VOLTS WITH DOOR LOCK CONTROL SW UNLOCKED, PASSENGER’S DOOR LOCK CYLINDER UNLOCKED WITH KEY
13–GROUND : 0 VOLTS WITH PASSENGER’S DOOR LOCK CYLINDER UNLOCKED WITH KEY
1–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ACC POSITION
9–GROUND : 0 VOLTS WITH DRIVER’S DOOR LOCK CYLINDER UNLOCKED WITH KEY
12–GROUND : 0 VOLTS WITH DRIVER’S, PASSENGER’S DOOR LOCK CYLINDER LOCKED WITH KEY
D12, D13 DOOR COURTESY SW
1–GROUND : CLOSED WITH EACH DOOR OPEN
D17, D18 DOOR KEY LOCK AND UNLOCK SW
3–2 : CLOSED WITH DOOR LOCK CYLINDER LOCKED WITH KEY
1–2 : CLOSED WITH DOOR LOCK CYLINDER UNLOCKED WITH KEY
D20, D21 DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION SW (C/P)
1–3 : CLOSED WITH UNLOCK POSITION
D20, D21 DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION SW (EX. C/P)
6–4 : CLOSED WITH UNLOCK POSITION
I12 UNLOCK WARNING SW [IGNITION SW]
1–5 : CLOSED WITH IGNITION KEY IN CYLINDER
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
B9
36
CODE
D19
SEE PAGE
34 (S/D), 36 (W/G)
J2
A
34 (S/D), 36 (W/G)
J3
B
35 (C/P)
D8
32
D12
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
D13
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
D21
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
D17
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
D22
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
D18
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
D23
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
34 (S/D), 36 (W/G)
I12
33
D19
A
D20
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
1G
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
1H
20
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
1K
1L
1M
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
IG1
42
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
IH2
42
FRONT DOOR LH WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
II2
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE AND COWL WIRE
IT1
44
FRONT DOOR RH WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
IU1
44
FLOOR NO. 2 WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
BW1
BY1
46 (S/D)
50 (W/G)
46 (S/D)
50 (W/G)
REAR DOOR LH WIRE AND FLOOR NO.
NO 1 WIRE
REAR DOOR RH WIRE AND FLOOR NO.
NO 2 WIRE
Bc1
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE
Bd3
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND BACK DOOR NO. 2 WIRE
164
CODE
B
P12
SEE PAGE
33
33
A
34 (S/D), 36 (W/G)
B
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
C
35 (C/P)
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
IF
42
LEFT KICK PANEL
IG
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE LH
IJ
42
RIGHT KICK PANEL
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
I3
I22
B1
B2
SEE PAGE
44
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
46 (S/D)
B2
B11
46 (S/D)
50 (W/G)
CODE
FRONT DOOR LH WIRE
SEE PAGE
50 (W/G)
46 (S/D)
50 (W/G)
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
FRONT DOOR LH WIRE
FRONT DOOR RH WIRE
B18
48 (C/P)
FRONT DOOR LH WIRE
B27
48 (C/P)
FRONT DOOR RH WIRE
165
BACK DOOR LOCK (W/G w/o POWER WINDOW)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
30A
POWER
W–L
2 1K
II2
B3
BACK DOOR LOCK
CONTROL SW
L
10
LOCK
5
UNLOCK
6
1
3
16
L–B
L–B
IG1
4
3
L–B
Bc1
L–B
Bd3
L–R
W–B
1
M
B9
BACK DOOR
LOCK MOTOR
2
6
L–R
L–R
IG1
2
1
L–R
Bc1
L–R
Bd3
IJ
SERVICE HINTS
B 3 BACK DOOR LOCK CONTROL SW
6–GROUND : ALWAYS APPROX. 12 VOLTS
5–GROUND : ALWAYS CONTINUITY
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
B3
32
CODE
SEE PAGE
B9
CODE
36 (W/G)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
IK
SEE PAGE
20
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
IG1
38
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (LEFT KICK PANEL)
IT2
40
FRONT DOOR RH WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (RIGHT KICK PANEL)
Bc1
44 (W/G)
BACK DOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE (LEFT QUARTER TRIM INNER)
Bd3
44 (W/G)
BACK DOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND BACK DOOR NO. 2 WIRE (BACK DOOR LEFT)
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
IJ
SEE PAGE
38
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
RIGHT KICK PANEL
B3
1
B 9 GRAY
X
3 X 5 6
1
166
2
SEE PAGE
* 1 : TMC MADE
* 2 : TMM MADE
MOON ROOF
SERVICE HINTS
POWER MAIN RELAY
5–3 : CLOSED WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
M 2 MOON ROOF CONTROL RELAY
11–GROUND : ALWAYS CONTINUITY
6–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
4–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW ON, AND MOON ROOF CONTROL SW AT CLOSE OR UP POSITION
(EXCEPT APPROX. 100 MM (3.941 IN.) IN THE BEFORE CLOSED POSITION)
5–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW ON, AND MOON ROOF CONTROL SW AT OPEN OR DOWN POSITION
12–GROUND : ALWAYS APPROX. 12 VOLTS
M 3 MOON ROOF CONTROL SW
5–4 : CLOSED WITH MOON ROOF CONTROL SW AT UP POSITION
6–4 : CLOSED WITH MOON ROOF CONTROL SW AT CLOSE POSITION
2–4 : CLOSED WITH MOON ROOF CONTROL SW AT DOWN POSITION
3–4 : CLOSED WITH MOON ROOF CONTROL SW AT OPEN POSITION
4–GROUND : ALWAYS CONTINUITY
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
D8
32
M2
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
M4
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
J3
33
M3
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
M5
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
1C
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
20
ROOF WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL) TMC MADE
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL) TMM MADE
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
2E
22
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
2G
22
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
1I
1K
1L
1M
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
II2
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE AND COWL WIRE
IV1
44
ROOF WIRE AND COWL WIRE
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
IG
BK
BP
SEE PAGE
42
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE LH
46 (S/D)
48 (C/P)
50 (W/G)
ROOF LEFT
BACK PANEL CENTER
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
B4
B5
B21
SEE PAGE
46 (S/D)
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
CODE
B31
ROOF WIRE
B32
SEE PAGE
50 (W/G)
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
ROOF WIRE
48 (C/P)
167
* 1 : S/D TMC MADE
* 2 : S/D TMM MADE, W/G
MOON ROOF
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
10A
GAUGE
30A
POWER
20A
DOME
1
2 1K
W–L
R
IV1 (W/G)
IV2 (S/D, C/P)
R
1
1
II2
M2
MOON ROOF CONTROL RELAY
(*2)
1 1I
(* 2)
D8
DOOR LOCK
CONTROL RELAY
1
L–R
IG
8
+B
R–L 15
RLY
II2
R
C
10
(* 1)
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
5
C
1 1C
W–L
II2
R–L
4
R
2 2G
R–L
8 1K
R–L
12
BUZZER
6 1L
S
1
5
TIMER
R Q
POWER
MAIN
RELAY
5
TIMER
1I
L
1 1M
3
(* 2)
2
TIMER
5 IV1 (W/G)
5 IV2 (S/D,
C/P)
L
P
G–Y
2
1
3
5
2
3
6
UP
M
2
M5
MOON ROOF
MOTOR
4
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
IG
168
B 5 : S/D
B32 : W/G
B21 : C/P
B 4 : S/D
B31 : W/G
B21 : C/P
BK : S/D, C/P
BP : W/G
CLOSE
2
OPEN
G
1
R–W
R–L
1
11
DOWN
4
G–W
7
R–Y
5
W–B
9
M4
4
MOON ROOF
LIMIT SW
3
R
8
NO. 2
W–B
6
(* 2)
NO. 1
L
(* 1)
Q
R
S
M3
MOON ROOF
CONTROL SW
SYSTEM OUTLINE
CURRENT IS APPLIED AT ALL TIMES THROUGH POWER FUSE TO TERMINAL 5 OF POWER MAIN RELAY AND ALSO THROUGH DOME
FUSE TO TERMINAL 12 OF MOON ROOF CONTROL RELAY.
WITH THE IGNITION SW TURNED ON, THE CURRENT FLOWS FROM TERMINAL 1 OF POWER MAIN RELAY → TERMINAL 2 → TO
GROUND THROUGH GAUGE FUSE. AS A RESULT, POWER MAIN RELAY IS ACTIVATED AND THE CURRENT TO TERMINAL 5 OF
POWER MAIN RELAY FLOWS FROM TERMINAL 3 OF RELAY TO TERMINAL 6 OF MOON ROOF CONTROL RELAY.
1. SLIDE OPEN OPERATION
WHEN THE IGNITION SW IS TURNED ON AND THE MOON ROOF CONTROL SW IS PUSHED TO THE OPEN POSITION, A SIGNAL IS
INPUT FROM TERMINAL 3 OF MOON ROOF CONTROL SW TO TERMINAL 1 OF MOON ROOF CONTROL RELAY. MOON ROOF LIMIT SW
NO. 2 ON AT THIS TIME.
WHEN THIS OCCURS, THE RELAY IS ACTIVATED AND THE CURRENT TO TERMINAL 6 OF MOON ROOF CONTROL RELAY FLOWS
FROM TERMINAL 5 → TERMINAL 1 OF MOON ROOF MOTOR → TERMINAL 3 → TERMINAL 4 OF MOON ROOF CONTROL RELAY →
TERMINAL 11 → TO GROUND AND ROTATES THE MOTOR TO OPEN THE MOON ROOF WHILE THE SW IS BEING PUSHED TO OPEN
POSITION.
2. SLIDE CLOSE OPERATION
WITH THE IGNITION SW TURNED ON, THE MOON ROOF COMPLETELY OPEN AND MOON ROOF LIMIT SW NO. 1 AND NO. 2 BOTH ON,
WHEN THE MOON ROOF CONTROL SW IS PUSHED TO THE CLOSE POSITION A SIGNAL IS INPUT FROM TERMINAL 6 OF MOON
ROOF CONTROL SW TO TERMINAL 2 OF MOON ROOF CONTROL RELAY.
WHEN THIS OCCURS, THE RELAY IS ACTIVATED AND THE CURRENT TO TERMINAL 6 OF MOON ROOF CONTROL RELAY FLOWS
FROM TERMINAL 4 → TERMINAL 3 OF MOON ROOF MOTOR → TERMINAL 1 → TERMINAL 5 OF MOON ROOF CONTROL RELAY →
TERMINAL 11 → TO GROUND AND ROTATES THE MOTOR TO CLOSE THE MOON ROOF WHILE THE SW IS BEING PUSHED TO CLOSE
POSITION.
MOON ROOF LIMIT SW NO. 1 TURNS OFF (LIMIT SW NO. 2 IS ON) AND A 100 MM BEFORE FULLY CLOSE POSITION, SIGNAL IS INPUT
FROM TERMINAL 1 OF LIMIT SW NO. 1 TO TERMINAL 8 OF MOON ROOF CONTROL RELAY. THIS SIGNAL ACTIVATES THE RELAY AND
STOPS CONTINUITY FROM TERMINAL 6 OF MOON ROOF CONTROL RELAY TO TERMINAL 11. AS A RESULT, THE MOON ROOF
STOPS AT THIS POSITION.
TO CLOSE THE MOON ROOF COMPLETELY, PUSHING THE MOON ROOF CONTROL SW AGAIN TO THE CLOSE SIDE CAUSES A
SIGNAL TO BE INPUT AGAIN TO TERMINAL 2 OF MOON ROOF CONTROL RELAY. THIS ACTIVATES THE RELAY AND THE MOON ROOF
WILL CLOSE AS LONG AS THE MOON ROOF CONTROL SW IS BEING PUSHED, ALLOWING THE MOON ROOF TO FULLY CLOSE.
3. TILT UP OPERATION
WHEN THE MOON ROOF CONTROL SW IS PUSHED TO TILT UP POSITION, WITH THE IGNITION SW TURNED ON AND THE MOON
ROOF COMPLETELY CLOSED (MOON ROOF LIMIT SW NO. 2 IS OFF), A SIGNAL IS INPUT FROM TERMINAL 5 OF MOON ROOF
CONTROL SW TO TERMINAL 3 OF MOON ROOF CONTROL RELAY. AS A RESULT, THE RELAY IS ACTIVATED AND THE CURRENT TO
TERMINAL 6 OF RELAY FLOWS FROM TERMINAL 4 OF RELAY → TERMINAL 3 OF MOON ROOF MOTOR → TERMINAL 1 → TERMINAL
5 OF RELAY → TERMINAL 11 TO GROUND AND ROTATES THE MOTOR SO THAT TILT UP OPERATION OCCURS AS LONG AS THE
MOON ROOF CONTROL SW IS PUSHED ON THE TILT UP SIDE.
4. TILT DOWN OPERATION
WHEN THE MOON ROOF CONTROL SW IS PUSHED TO TILT DOWN POSITION, WITH THE IGNITION SW TURNED ON AND THE MOON
ROOF TILTED UP (NO. 1 AND NO. 2 MOON ROOF LIMIT SWITCHES ARE BOTH OFF), A SIGNAL IS INPUT FROM TERMINAL 2 OF MOON
ROOF CONTROL SW TO TERMINAL 7 OF MOON ROOF CONTROL RELAY.
AS A RESULT, THE RELAY IS ACTIVATED AND THE CURRENT TO TERMINAL 6 OF RELAY FLOWS FROM TERMINAL 5 OF RELAY →
TERMINAL 1 OF MOON ROOF MOTOR → TERMINAL 3 → TERMINAL 4 OF RELAY → TERMINAL 11 → TO GROUND AND ROTATES THE
MOTOR SO THAT TILT DOWN OPERATION OCCURS AS LONG AS THE MOON ROOF CONTROL SW IS PUSHED ON THE TILT DOWN
SIDE. (DURING TILT DOWN, LIMIT SW NO. 1 IS CHANGED OFF TO ON.)
5. TILT UP REMINDER SYSTEM
WHEN THE IGNITION SW IS TURNED FROM ON TO ACC OR OFF WITH THE MOON ROOF STILL TILTED UP THE CURRENT DOES NOT
FLOW TO TERMINAL 6 OF MOON ROOF CONTROL RELAY.
THIS IS RECEIVED BY THE RELAY AS A SIGNAL THAT THE IGNITION SW IS TURNED OFF. AT THIS TIME, MOON ROOF LIMIT SW NO.1
AND NO. 2 ARE OFF, SO SIGNALS ARE INPUT TO TERMINALS 8 AND 9 OF MOON ROOF CONTROL RELAY THAT THE MOON ROOF IS
IN THE TILT OPERATION POSITION. WHEN THESE SIGNALS ARE INPUT TO THE MOON ROOF CONTROL RELAY, THE TIMER BUILT
INTO THE RELAY OPERATES.
THUS THE CURRENT TO TERMINAL 12 OF MOON ROOF CONTROL RELAY FLOWS THROUGH BUZZER OF MOON ROOF CONTROL
RELAY AND TERMINAL 11 OF MOON ROOF CONTROL RELAY TO GROUND AND THE BUZZER SOUNDS ABOUT 8 TIMES TO NOTIFY
THAT THE MOON ROOF IS STILL IN THE TILT UP CONDITION.
169
UNLOCK AND SEAT BELT WARNING
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
10A
GAUGE
R–L
C
C
R–L
20A
DOME
6
1B
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
2 2G
6
R
C9
SEAT BELT
WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
R–W
7
7 1C
1 1C
INTEGRATION RELAY
9
7
1
BUZZER
6
8
2 1G
2 1H
5 1H
2 IO1
W–B
5
1
4 1G
1
D12
DOOR COURTESY
SW FRONT LH
R–Y
(W/O POWER SEAT)
R–Y
I12
UNLOCK
WARNING SW
[IGNITION SW]
2
B7
BUCKLE
SW
2
1
W–B
W–B
1 1M
B8
BUCKLE
SW
(W/G)
1
(W/ POWER SEAT)
R–Y
5
R–L
10
R–G
TIMER
W–B
170
BL
W–B
(S/D, C/P)
C
C
IG
W–B
C
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
(S/D, C/P)
W–B
W–B
(W/G)
5 IO1
SYSTEM OUTLINE
CURRENT ALWAYS FLOWS TO TERMINAL 1 OF THE INTEGRATION RELAY THROUGH THE DOME FUSE.
1. SEAT BELT WARNING SYSTEM
WHEN THE IGNITION SW IS TURNED ON, CURRENT FLOWS FROM THE GAUGE FUSE TO THE TERMINAL 7 OF THE INTEGRATION
RELAY AT THE SAME TIME, CURRENT FLOWS TO TERMINAL 9 OF THE RELAY FROM THE GAUGE FUSE THROUGH THE SEAT BELT
WARNING LIGHT. THIS CURRENT ACTIVATES THE SEAT BELT WARNING RELAY AND, CURRENT FLOWING THROUGH THE WARNING
LIGHT FLOWS FROM TERMINAL 9 OF THE RELAY→ TERMINAL 10 → GROUND, CAUSING THE WARNING LIGHT TO LIGHT UP. AT THE
SAME AS THE WARNING LIGHT LIGHTS UP. A BUCKLE SW OFF SIGNAL IS INPUT TO TERMINAL 8 OF THE RELAY, THE CURRENT
FLOWING TO TERMINAL 1 OF THE RELAY FLOWS FROM TERMINAL 10 → GROUND AND THE SEAT BELT WARNING BUZZER SOUNDS
FOR APPROX. 4–8 SECONDS. HOWEVER, IF SEAT BELT IS PUT ON DURING THIS PERIOD (WHILE THE BUZZER IS SOUNDING),
SIGNAL INPUT TO TERMINAL 8 OF THE RELAY STOPS AND THE CURRENT FLOW FROM TERMINAL 1 OF THE RELAY → TERMINAL 10
→ GROUND IS CUT, CAUSING THE BUZZER TO STOP.
2. UNLOCK WARNING SYSTEM
WITH THE IGNITION KEY INSERTED IN THE KEY CYLINDER (UNLOCK WARNING SW ON), THE IGNITION SW STILL OFF AND DOOR
OPEN (DOOR COURTESY SW ON), WHEN A SIGNAL IS INPUT TERMINAL 5 AND 6 OF THE RELAY, THE INTEGRATION RELAY
OPERATES, CURRENT FLOWS FROM TERMINAL 1 OF THE RELAY → TERMINAL 10 → GROUND AND THE UNLOCK WARNING
BUZZER SOUNDS.
SERVICE HINTS
B 7, B 8 BUCKLE SW
1–2 : CLOSED WITH DRIVR’S LAP BELT IN USE
D12 DOOR COURTESY SW FRONT LH
1–GROUND : CLOSED WITH FRONT LH DOOR OPEN
INTEGRATION RELAY
10–GROUND : ALWAYS CONTINUITY
6–GROUND : CONTINUITY WITH FRONT LH DOOR OPEN
5–GROUND : CONTINUITY WITH IGNITION KEY IN CYLINDER
8–GROUND : CONTINUITY UNLESS DRIVER’S LAP BELT IN USE
9–GROUND : 0 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW ON AND BUCKLE SW OFF
1–GROUND : ALWAYS APPROX. 12 VOLTS
7–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
I12 UNLOCK WARNING SW [IGNITION SW]
1–5 : CLOSED WITH IGNITION KEY IN CYLINDER
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
B7
32
D12
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
B8
32
I12
33
C9
32
J1
33
CODE
J5
SEE PAGE
36 (W/G)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
1B
1C
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
1G
1H
20
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
1M
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
2E
22
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
IO1
SEE PAGE
42
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND SEAT WIRE
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
IG
SEE PAGE
42
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE LH
46 (S/D)
BL
48 (C/P)
UNDER THE LEFT QUARTER PILLAR
50 (W/G)
171
UNLOCK AND SEAT BELT WARNING
172
HORN
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
10A
HORN
2
HORN
RELAY
5 2G
3 2A
G–W
3
G–B
1
G–W
10
C12
HORN SW
[COMB. SW]
1
1
H5
HORN
LH
H6
HORN
RH
SERVICE HINTS
HORN RELAY
2–3 : CLOSED WITH HORN SW ON
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
C12
CODE
32
H5
SEE PAGE
CODE
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
H6
SEE PAGE
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
2A
2E
SEE PAGE
22
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE AND J/B NO
NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
C12 BLACK
H 5, H 6
BLACK
1
X
X
X
X
10
173
SRS (SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM)
NOTICE: When inspecting or repairing the SRS (supplemental restraint system), perform the operation in
accordance with the following precautionary instructions and the procedure and precautions in the Repair
Manual for the applicable model year.
Malfunction symptoms of the supplemental restraint system are difficult to confirm, so the diagnostic trouble
codes become the most important source of information when troubleshooting.
When troubleshooting the supplemental restraint system, always inspect the diagnostic trouble codes before
disconnecting the battery.
Work must be started after 90 seconds from the time the Ignition SW is set to the “LOCK” position and the
negative (–) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery.
(The supplemental restraint system is equipped with a back–up power source so that if work is started within
90 seconds of disconnecting the negative (–) terminal cable of the battery, the SRS may be activated.)
When the negative (–) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery, memory of the clock and audio systems
will be cancelled. So before starting work, make a record of the contents momorized by each memory system.
When work is finished, reset the clock and audio system as before and adjust the clock. This vehicle has tilt
and telescopic steering, power seat and outside rear view mirror and power shoulder belt anchorage, which
are all equipped with memory function, it is not possible to make a record of the customer, and ask the
customer to adjust the features and reset the memory.
To avoid erasing the memory of each memory system, never use a back–up power supply from outside the
vehicle.
When removing the steering wheel pad or handling a new steering wheel pad, keep the pad upper surface
facing upward. Also, lock the lock lever of the twin lock type connector at the rear of the pad and take care
not to damage the connector.
(Storing the pad with its metallic surface up may lead to a serious accident if the SRS inflates for some reason.)
Store the steering wheel pad where the ambient temperature remains below 93°C (200°F), without high
humidity and away from electrical noise.
Never use SRS parts from another vehicle. When replacing SRS parts, replace them with new parts.
Never disassemble and repair the steering wheel pad, center SRS sensor assembly or front airbag sensors.
Before repairing the body, remove the airbag sensors if during repair shocks are likely to be applied to the
sensors due to vibration of the body or direct tapping with tools or other parts.
Do not reuse a steering wheel pad or front airbag sensors.
After evaluating whether the center airbag sensor assembly is damaged or not, decide whether or not to reuse
it. (See the Repair Manual for the method for evaluating the center airbag sensor assembly.)
When troubleshooting the supplemental restraint system, use a high–impedance (Min. 10k/V) tester.
The wire harness of the supplemental restraint system is integrated with the cowl wire harness assembly and
engine wire harness assembly.
The vehicle wiring harness exclusively for the airbag system is distinguished by corrugated yellow tubing, as
are the connectors.
Do not measure the resistance of the airbag squib.
(It is possible this will deploy the airbag and is very dangerous.)
If the wire harness used in the supplemental restraint system is damaged, replace the whole wire harness
assembly.
When the connector to the airbag front sensors can be repaired alone (when there is no damage to the wire
harness), use the repair wire specially designed for the purpose.
(Refer to the Repair Manual for the applicable Model year for details of the replacement method.)
INFORMATION LABELS (NOTICES) are attached to the periphery of the SRS components. Follow the
instructions on the notices.
174
The supplemental restraint system has connectors which possess the functions described below:
1. SRS ACTIVATION PREVENTION MECHANISM
Each connector contains a short spring plate. When the
connector is disconnected, the short spring plate
automatically connects the power source and grounding
terminals of the squib to preclude a potential difference
between the terminals.
2. ELECTRICAL CONNECTION CHECK MECHANISM
This mechanism is designed to electrically check if
connectors are connected correctly and completely.
The electrical connection check mechanism is designed so
that the connection detection pin connects with the
diagnosis terminals when the connector housing lock is in
the locked condition.
175
SRS (SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM)
3. CONNECTOR TWIN–LOCK MECHANISM
With this mechanism connectors (male and female
connectors) are locked by two locking devices to increase
connection reliability. If the primary lock is incomplete, ribs
interfere and prevent the secondary lock.
176
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
15A
CIG/RADIO
9 1F
7. 5A
SRS
5 1F
3 1F
D3
DATA LINK CONNECTOR 2
(TDCL)
AB
D1
DATA LINK CONNECOR 1
(CHECK CONNECTOR)
TC
AB
4
TC
5
11
W–R
C10
SRS WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
2
IP1
8
IP3
LG–R
Y–B
12
B–Y
P–L
B–O
B–Y
12
LG–R
7. 5A
IGN
B–Y
16 3D
1
Y–B
B–Y
17 3D
B
B
B–Y
B
13
14
IG2
C
C
J4
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
(FOR SRS)
12
ACC
C
Y–B
B
7
LA
TC
3
4
B
B
W
2
1
1
2
B
2
CONNECTION
DETECTION
PIN
A
D–
B
F2
FRONT AIRBAG
SENSOR RH
E1
5
E2
6
1 1F
2 1F
1 1M
5 1M
SPIRAL
CABLE
2
F1
FRONT AIRBAG
SENSOR LH
D+
W–B
A
P+
W–B
2
CONNECTION
DETECTION
PIN
P–
W–B
1
W–B
9
W
B
+SR
8
W
+SL
1
–SR
10
B
–SL
11
W
C3
CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
1
A22
AIRBAG SQUIB
(FRONT PASSENGER
AIRBAG ASSEMBLY)
A15
AIRBAG SQUIB
(STEERING
WHEEL PAD)
IG
IE
177
SRS (SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM)
SYSTEM OUTLINE
THE SRS (SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM) IS A DRIVER AND PASSENGER PROTECTION DEVICE WHICH HAS A
SUPPLEMENTAL ROLE TO THE SEAT BELTS.
WHEN THE IGNITION SW IS TURNED TO ACC OR ON, CURRENT FROM THE CIG/RADIO FUSE FLOWS TO TERMINAL 14 OF THE
CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY. ONLY WHEN THE IGNITION SW IS ON DOES THE CURRENT FROM THE IGN FUSE FLOW TO
TERMINAL 13.
IF AN ACCIDENT OCCURS WHILE DRIVING, DECELERATION CAUSED BY A FRONTAL IMPACT IS DETECTED BY EACH SENSOR AND
SWITCH, AND WHEN THE FRONTAL IMPACT EXCEEDS A SET LEVEL (WHEN THE SAFING SENSOR BUILT INTO THE CENTER AIRBAG
SENSOR ASSEMBLY IS ON AND THE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR IS ON, FRONT AIRBAG SENSORS ARE OFF), CURRENT FROM THE
CIG/RADIO OR IGN FUSE FLOWS TO TERMINALS 2, 3 OF THE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY → TERMINAL 1 OF THE AIRBAG
SQUIB → SQUIB → TERMINAL 2 → TERMINALS 1, 4 OF CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY → TERMINAL 6, TERMINAL 5 OR BODY
GROUND → GROUND.
WHEN THE SAFING SENSOR BUILT INTO THE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY IS ON AND THE FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR LH OR
RH IS ON, CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR IS OFF CURRENT FROM THE CIG/RADIO OR IGN FUSE FLOWS TO TERMINALS 2, 3 OF THE
CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY → TERMINAL 1 OF THE AIRBAG SQUIB → SQUIB → TERMINAL 2 → TERMINALS 1, 4 OF
CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY → TERMINAL 8 OR 11 → TERMINAL 1 OF FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR → TERMINAL 2 →
TERMINAL 9 OR 10 OF CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY → TERMINAL 6, TERMINAL 5 OR BODY GROUND → GROUND.
WHEN THE SAFING SENSOR BUILT INTO THE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY IS ON, AND THE FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR LH OR
RH IS ON AND CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR IS ON ONE OF THE ABOVE–MENTIONED CIRCUITS IS ACTIVATED SO THAT CURRENT
FLOWS TO THE AIRBAG SQUIB AND CAUSES IT TO OPERATE. THE BAG STORED INSIDE THE STEERING WHEEL PAD IS
INSTANTANEOUSLY EXPANDED TO SOFTEN THE SHOCK TO THE DRIVER.
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
A15
32
D1
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
F2
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
C3
32
D3
32
J4
33
C10
32
F1
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
1F
1M
3D
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO.
NO 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
24
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 3 (BEHIND COMBINATION METER)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
IP1
IP3
SEE PAGE
44
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
ENGINE WIRE AND COWL WIRE
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
IE
42
LEFT KICK PANEL
IG
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE LH
178
179
POWER SEAT
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
30A
POWER
R–W
20 1H
IO1
R–W
4
P4
POWER SEAT CONTROL SW
10
FR
RR
UP
DOWN
UP
DOWN
FR
RR
5
8
2
6
12
11
4
7
L–B
L–Y
R
L–R
W–B
9
W–B
C
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
(W/G)
C
BL
180
M
1
P8
POWER SEAT MOTOR
(FOR SLIDE CONTROL)
(W/G)
W–B
(S/D, C/P)
2
1
M
2
P5
POWER SEAT MOTOR
(FOR REAR VERTICAL
CONTROL)
1
M
2
P6
POWER SEAT MOTOR
(FOR FRONT VERTICAL
CONTROL)
2
R–B
M
(EX. C/P)
R–G
(EX. C/P)
L–W
L
5 IO1
1
P7
POWER SEAT MOTOR
(FOR RECLINING MOTOR
CONTROL)
SERVICE HINTS
P 4 POWER SEAT CONTROL SW
10–GROUND : ALWAYS APPROX. 12 VOLTS
9–GROUND : ALWAYS CONTINUITY
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
J5
36 (W/G)
P5
33
P7
33
P4
33
P6
33
P8
33
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
1H
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
20
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
IO1
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
42
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND SEAT WIRE
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
46 (S/D)
BL
48 (C/P)
UNDER THE LEFT QUARTER PILLAR
50 (W/G)
J5
P4
C C
C C
C
C
ORANGE
P6
1
1
2
2
ORANGE
P8
2
X
5
4
X
8
7
C C
(HINT : SEE PAGE 7)
WHITE
P5
C C
6
P7
GRAY
12 11
10
9
GREEN
1
1
2
2
181
SHIFT LOCK
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
15A
CIG/RADIO
9 1L
15A
ECU–IG
15A
STOP
2 1L
3 1M
L–R
B–R
G–R
G–W
2 A
1 A
N2 A ,N3 B
NOISE FILTER
(FOR STOP LIGHT)
11
II2
4 1L
2 B
1 B
G–R
II2
L–R
9
G–W
6 1M
1
B
B–R
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G–W
B
S10
STOP LIGHT
SW
2
II2
G–W
L–R
20
1
3
S5
SHIFT LOCK ECU
6
SHIFT LOCK
CONTROL SW
P1
G–R
P
G
P2
G–W
SL–
L–R
SHIFT LOCK
SOLENOID
SL+
5
L–B
4
W–B
II1
L–B
3
B
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
2
K3
KEY INTERLOCK
SOLENOID
B
IE
182
W–B
W–B
1
IF
L–R
SYSTEM OUTLINE
WHEN THE IGNITION SW IS TURNED TO ACC POSITION THE CURRENT FROM THE CIG/RADIO FUSE FLOWS TO TERMINAL 1 OF THE
SHIFT LOCK ECU. WHEN THE IGNITION SW IS TURNED TO ON POSITION THE CURRENT FROM THE ECU–IG FUSE FLOWS TO
TERMINAL 3 OF THE ECU.
1. SHIFT LOCK MECHANISM
WITH THE IGNITION SW ON, WHEN A SIGNAL THAT THE BRAKE PEDAL IS DEPRESSED (STOP LIGHT SW ON) AND A SIGNAL THAT
THE SHIFT LEVER IS PUT IN “P” POSITION (CONTINUITY BETWEEN P1 AND P OF THE SHIFT LOCK CONTROL SW) IS INPUT TO THE
ECU, THE ECU OPERATES AND CURRENT FLOWS FROM TERMINAL 3 OF THE ECU → TERMINAL SL+ OF THE SHIFT LOCK
SOLENOID → SOLENOID → TERMINAL SL– → TERMINAL 5 OF THE ECU → GROUND. THIS CAUSES THE SHIFT LOCK SOLENOID TO
TURN ON (PLATE STOPPER DISENGAGES) AND THE SHIFT LEVER CAN SHIFT INTO OTHER POSITION THAN THE “P” POSITION.
2. KEY INTERLOCK MECHANISM
WITH THE IGNITION SW IN ON OR ACC POSITION, WHEN THE SHIFT LEVER IS PUT IN “P” POSITION (NO CONTINUITY BETWEEN P2
AND P OF SHIFT LOCK CONTROL SW), THE CURRENT FLOWING FROM TERMINAL 4 OF THE ECU → KEYINTERLOCK SOLENOID IS
CUT OFF. THIS CAUSES THE KEYINTERLOCK SOLENOID TO TURN OFF (LOCK LEVER DISENGAGES FROM LOCK POSITION) AND
THE IGNITION KEY CAN BE TURNED FROM ACC TO LOCK POSITION.
SERVICE HINTS
S 5 SHIFT LOCK ECU
1–GROUND :
3–GROUND :
5–GROUND :
6–GROUND :
4–GROUND :
APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ACC OR ON POSITION
APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
ALWAYS CONTINUITY
APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH BRAKE PEDAL DEPRESSED
0 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ACC POSITION AND SHIFT LEVER POSITION IN P POSITION
6–12 VOLTS WITH SHIFT LEVER POSITION IN EXCEPT P POSITION
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
J2
33
N2
J3
33
N3
K3
33
SEE PAGE
A
33
B
33
S5
CODE
S10
SEE PAGE
33
33
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
1L
1M
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO.
NO 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
II1
42
COWL WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
II2
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE AND COWL WIRE
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
IE
IF
SEE PAGE
42
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
LEFT KICK PANEL
J2
J3
K3
N2 A
B
B B
B B B
B B
1
B B
B
B
2
2
1
B B
(HINT : SEE PAGE 7)
(HINT : SEE PAGE 7)
S5
N3 B
1
2
S10
1
X
3
4
5
6
1
BLUE
2
183
FRONT WIPER AND WASHER
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
C13 BLACK
X 4 X
X X
F9
X 7
13 X
W 1 BLACK
8 X
18 X
16
BLACK
1
2
3
X
5
6
1
20A
WIPER
2
L
2 1M
L
L
I5
17
IR1
L
WASHER
HIGH
LOW
INT
MIST
OFF
C13
FRONT WIPER AND WASHER SW (W/ WIPER RELAY)
[COMB. SW]
8
11
L–W
L–W 1
2
IR1
L
M
E1
W1
WASHER MOTOR
L
16
4
L–Y
7
L–B
13
L–O
IR1
14
2
3
6
5
M
1
W–B
F9
FRONT WIPER MOTOR
IE
184
IR1
L–Y
15
L
IR1
L–B
16
L–O
W–B
18
EA
SYSTEM OUTLINE
WITH THE IGNITION SW TURNED ON, THE CURRENT FLOWS TO TERMINAL 18 OF THE WIPER AND WASHER SW, TERMINAL 2 OF
THE WASHER MOTOR AND TERMINAL 4 OF THE WIPER MOTOR THROUGH THE WIPER FUSE.
1. LOW SPEED POSITION
WITH WIPER SW TURNED TO LOW POSITION, THE CURRENT FLOWS FROM TERMINAL 18 OF THE WIPER AND WASHER SW →
TERMINAL 7 → TERMINAL 3 OF THE WIPER MOTOR → WIPER MOTOR → TERMINAL 1 → TO GROUND AND CAUSES TO THE WIPER
MOTOR TO RUN AT LOW SPEED.
2. HIGH SPEED POSITION
WITH WIPER SW TURNED TO HIGH POSITION, THE CURRENT FLOWS FROM TERMINAL 18 OF THE WIPER AND WASHER SW →
TERMINAL 13 → TERMINAL 2 OF THE WIPER MOTOR → WIPER MOTOR → TERMINAL 1 → TO GROUND AND CAUSES TO THE WIPER
MOTOR TO RUN AT HIGH SPEED.
3. INT POSITION
WITH WIPER SW TURNED TO INT POSITION, THE RELAY OPERATES AND THE CURRENT WHICH IS CONNECTED BY RELAY
FUNCTION FLOWS FROM TERMINAL 18 OF THE WIPER AND WASHER SW → TERMINAL 16 → TO GROUND. THIS FLOW OF CURRENT
OPERATES THE INTERMITTENT CIRCUIT AND THE CURRENT FLOWS FROM TERMINAL 18 OF THE WIPER AND WASHER SW →
TERMINAL 7 → TERMINAL 3 OF THE WIPER MOTOR → TERMINAL 1 → TO GROUND AND THE WIPER FUNCTIONS.
THE INTERMITTENT OPERATION IS CONTROLLED BY A CONDENSER’S CHARGED AND DISCHARGED FUNCTION INSTALLED IN
RELAY AND THE INTERMITTENT TIME IS CONTROLLED BY A TIME CONTROL SW TO CHANGE THE CHARGING TIME OF THE
CONDENSER.
4. WASHER CONTINUOUS OPERATION
WITH WASHER SW TURNED TO ON, THE CURRENT FLOWS FROM TERMINAL 2 OF THE WASHER MOTOR → TERMINAL 1 →
TERMINAL 8 OF THE WIPER AND WASHER SW → TERMINAL 16 → TO GROUND AND CAUSES TO THE WASHER MOTOR TO RUN AND
WINDOW WASHER TO JET. THIS CAUSES THE CURRENT TO FLOW TO WASHER CONTINUOUS OPERATION CIRCUIT IN TERMINAL 18
OF THE WIPER AND WASHER SW → TERMINAL 7 → TERMINAL 3 OF THE WIPER MOTOR → TERMINAL 1 → TO GROUND AND THE
WIPER FUNCTION.
SERVICE HINTS
C13 FRONT WIPER AND WASHER SW (W/ WIPER RELAY) [COMB. SW]
16–GROUND : ALWAYS CONTINUITY
18–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
7–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH WIPER AND WASHER SW AT LOW OR MIST POSITION
APPROX. 12 VOLTS 2 TO 12 SECONDS INTERMITTENTLY WITH WIPER SW AT INT POSITION
4–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW ON UNLESS WIPER MOTOR AT STOP POSITION
13–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH WIPER AND WASHER SW AT HIGH POSITION
F 9 FRONT WIPER MOTOR
5–6 : CLOSED UNLESS WIPER MOTOR AT STOP POSITION
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
C13
CODE
32
F9
SEE PAGE
CODE
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
W1
SEE PAGE
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
1H
20
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
1M
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
IR1
SEE PAGE
44
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE AND COWL WIRE
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
EA
IE
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
42
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
FRONT RIGHT FENDER
LEFT KICK PANEL
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
E1
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE
CODE
I5
SEE PAGE
44
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
COWL WIRE
185
REAR WIPER AND WASHER
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
C13
REAR WIPER AND WASHER SW
[COMB. SW]
20A
WIPER
WASHER
OFF
15 1H
2 1M
INT
ON
L
18
L–O
W–B
P–B
I7
L–O
IR1
P–G
L
IR1
W1
WASHER MOTOR
2
3
L–O
M
16
(CANADA)
17
10
P–G
1
L–O
2
(USA)
L
WASHER
L
8
IJ1
P–G
IJ1
8
6
3
4
L
B36
14
P–B
R19
REAR WIPER RELAY
IJ1
L–O
4
6 Bd1
8 Bd1
7 Bd1
W–B
7 Bc3
L–W
6 Bc3
L–Y
L–W
7
L
8 Bc3
1
L–Y
2
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
L–W
L–Y
L
C
3
4
M
W–B
2
R18
REAR WIPER
MOTOR
W–B
1
W–B
L
C
BR
186
BL
IE
SYSTEM OUTLINE
WHEN THE IGNITION SW IS TURNED ON, CURRENT FLOWS TO TERMINAL 2 OF WASHER MOTOR, TERMINAL 4 OF REAR WIPER
RELAY AND TERMINAL 1 OF REAR WIPER MOTOR THROUGH THE WIPER FUSE.
1. REAR WIPER NORMAL OPERATION
WITH THE IGNITION SW TURNED ON AND REAR WIPER AND WASHER SW TURNED ON, THE CURRENT FLOWING TO TERMINAL 4
OF REAR WIPER RELAY FLOWS TO TERMINAL 6 OF RELAY → TERMINAL 1 OF REAR WIPER AND WASHER SW → TERMINAL 16 →
TO GROUND. THUS, THE RELAY COIL IS ACTIVATED AND THE CURRENT TO TERMINAL 4 OF RELAY FLOWS TO TERMINAL 1 →
TERMINAL 4 OF REAR WIPER MOTOR → MOTOR → TERMINAL 2 → TO GROUND AND CAUSES THE MOTOR TO OPERATE THE
WIPER.
2. REAR WIPER INTERMITTENT OPERATION
WITH THE IGNITION SW TURNED ON AND REAR WIPER AND WASHER SW TURNED TO INT POSITION, THE CURRENT FLOWING TO
TERMINAL 4 OF REAR WIPER RELAY FLOWS TO TERMINAL 3 OF RELAY → TERMINAL 10 OF WIPER SW → TERMINAL 16 → TO
GROUND. AS A RESULT, THE RELAY OPERATES AND CURRENT FLOWS FROM TERMINAL 4 OF RELAY → TERMINAL 1 → TERMINAL
4 OF REAR WIPER MOTOR → MOTOR → TERMINAL 2 → TO GROUND, CAUSING THE MOTOR TO ROTATE TO OPERATE THE WIPER.
AT THIS TIME THE CONTACT IN THE WIPER MOTOR CLOSED AND THE CURRENT FLOWS FROM TERMINAL 1 OF REAR WIPER
MOTOR → TERMINAL 3 → TERMINAL 2 OF REAR WIPER RELAY → TERMINAL 1 → TERMINAL 4 OF REAR WIPER MOTOR →
TERMINAL 2 → TO GROUND.
THUS, THE INTERMITTENT–STOP CIRCUIT OPERATES, THE CONDENOR IN THE CIRCUIT CHARGES AND THE WIPER CONTINUES TO
OPERATE UNTIL REACHING THE STOP POSITION. AFTER THE WIPER STOPS, CURRENT DOES NOT FLOW TO THE
INTERMITTENT–STOP CIRCUIT FROM TERMINAL 2 OF RELAY, BUT THE CONDENSER DISCHARGES CURRENT INTO THE
INTERMITTENT CIRCUIT AND THE CIRCUIT OPERATES UNTIL THE CONDENSER DISCHARGE ENDS. AS A RESULT, THIS DISCHARGE
INTERVAL BECOMES THE INTERMITTENT TIME.
WHEN THE CURRENT IS DISCHARGED COMPLETELY, THE CURRENT FLOWING TO TERMINAL 4 OF RELAY FLOWS TO TERMINAL 3
→ TERMINAL 10 OF REAR WIPER AND WASHER SW → TERMINAL 16 → TO GROUND.
THEN, THE CURRENT IN TERMINAL 4 OF RELAY FLOWS FROM TERMINAL 1 → TERMINAL 4 OF MOTOR → MOTOR → TERMINAL 2 →
TO GROUND AND ROTATES THE MOTOR. THROUGH REPEITION OF THIS PROCESS, INTERMITTENT OPERATION OF THE REAR
WIPER OCCURS.
3. WASHER OPERATION
WITH THE IGNITION SW ON AND THE REAR WIPER AND WASHER SW IS TURNED STRONGLY (WASHER SW ON), CURRENT FLOWS
FROM TERMINAL 2 OF WASHER MOTOR → TERMINAL 3 → TERMINAL 2 OF REAR WIPER AND WASHER SW → TERMINAL 16 → TO
GROUND SO THAT THE WASHER MOTOR ROTATES AND WINDOW WASHER EJECTS THE SPRAY, ONLY THE WHILE THE REAR
WASHER SW IS TURNED, WHEN THE REAR WIPER SW IS OFF, AND THE REAR WIPER AND WASHER SW IS THEN TURNED IN THE
OFF DIRECTION, WASHER LIQUID WILL ALSO SPLAY.
SERVICE HINTS
R19 REAR WIPER RELAY
4–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
7–GROUND : ALWAYS CONTINUITY
1–4 : POINTS CHANGES EVERY APPROX. 9–15 SECONDS INTERMITTENTLY WITH IGNITION SW ON AND WIPER SW AT
INT POSITION
W 1 WASHER MOTOR
2–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
3–GROUND : CONTINUITY WITH WASHER SW TURNED ON
187
REAR WIPER AND WASHER
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
C13
32
R18
36 (W/G)
J5
36 (W/G)
R19
36 (W/G)
CODE
W1
SEE PAGE
29 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
1H
20
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
1M
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
IJ1
42
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND COWL WIRE
IR1
44
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE AND COWL WIRE
Bc1
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE
Bd1
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND BACK DOOR NO. 2 WIRE
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
IE
SEE PAGE
42
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
LEFT KICK PANEL
46 (S/D)
BL
48 (C/P)
UNDER THE LEFT QUARTER PILLAR
50 (W/G)
BR
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR CENTER
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
I7
188
SEE PAGE
44
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
COWL WIRE
CODE
B36
SEE PAGE
50 (W/G)
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE
CIGARETTE LIGHTER AND CLOCK
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
SERVICE HINTS
15A
CIG/RADIO
C 4 CIGARETTE LIGHTER
2–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT
ACC OR ON POSITION
1–GROUND : ALWAYS CONTINUITY
C 6 CLOCK
3–GROUND : ALWAYS APPROX. 12 VOLTS (POWER FOR
CLOCK)
4–GROUND : APPROX .12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT
ACC OR ON POSITION
(POWER FOR INDICATION)
2–GROUND : APPROX .12 VOLTS WITH LIGHT CONTROL
SW AT TAIL OR HEAD POSITION
APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH ENGINE
RUNNING AND PARKING BRAKE RELEASED
(CANADA)
1–GROUND : ALWAYS CONTINUITY
20A
DOME
2 2G
L–R
7 1D
L–R
L–R
R
I7
C4
2
4
C6
C4
CIGARETTE
LIGHTER
1
C6
CLOCK
2
1
1
2
3
4
2
G
1
W–B
BLACK
3
W–B
J2
DARK GRAY
F
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
21 3C
W–B
F
F
F
F
9 3D
(HINT : SEE PAGE 7)
G
8 1C
5 1M
W–B
FROM TAIL FUSE
IE
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
C4
32
CODE
C6
SEE PAGE
CODE
32
J2
SEE PAGE
33
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
1B
1C
1D
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO.
NO 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
22
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
1M
2E
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
IE
SEE PAGE
42
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
LEFT KICK PANEL
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
I7
SEE PAGE
44
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
COWL WIRE
189
REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
10A
GAUGE
40A
DEFOG
2
R–L
6 1D
3
TIMER
6
Y–L
8
1D
2
5
DEFOGGER
RELAY
R5
REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER SW
2
1
1
3
2
NOISE
FILTER
1 1M
B
(W/G)
W–B
10 1C 10 1H
W–B
I7
B
(S/D, C/P)
W–B
B
1 Bc1
2 Bd3
F
B
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
F
D
B
1 B (W/G)
1 D (S/D, C/P)
190
BS
B
B
IE
(W/G)
W–B
5 1M
1 A (W/G)
1 C (S/D, C/P)
(S/D, C/P)
8 1C
R16 A C , R17 B
REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER
W–B
1 Be1
BN
IG
SERVICE HINTS
DEFOGGER RELAY
5–3 : CLOSED WITH IGNITION SW ON, DEFOGGER SW ON
REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER SW
R5
3–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
2–GROUND : ALWAYS CONTINUITY
3–6 : CONTINUITY WITH DEFOGGER SW ON
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
J2
33
R5
33
CODE
R16
SEE PAGE
CODE
A
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
C
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
R17
SEE PAGE
B
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
D
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
1C
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO.
NO 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
1H
20
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
1M
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
1D
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
Bc1
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE
Bd3
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND BACK DOOR NO. 2 WIRE
Be1
50 (W/G)
REAR WINDOW NO. 1 WIRE AND BACK DOOR NO. 2 WIRE
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
IE
42
LEFT KICK PANEL
IG
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE LH
BN
BS
46 (S/D)
UNDER THE RIGHT QUARTER PILLAR
48 (C/P)
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR RIGHT
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
I7
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
44
CODE
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
COWL WIRE
J2
DARK GRAY
R5
BLUE
R16
A
, R 17 B
R16
C BLACK , R17
D BLACK
1
F
F
X
2
3
6
1
F
(HINT : SEE PAGE 7)
191
CRUISE CONTROL
I12
IGNITION SW
AM1
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
10A
GAUGE
IG1
ST1
ACC
15A
ECU–IG
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
C
7
7 1A
6 1D
6 1B
R–L
R–L
C8
B–R
16 3C
A
R–L
B–W
6 1G
B , C9
COMBINATON METER
6 A
6
(A/T)
O
(* 2)
(* 1)
G–L
19 3B
20
5
SPD
CMS
A/D
PI
TC
R–W
I13
17
15 3B
12 3B
16 3D
8 3D
RESUME/
ACCEL
20
8
C13
CRUISE CONTROL SW
[COMB. SW]
11
1C
1
1M
TC
W–B
IG
192
1
P3
PARKING
BRAKE SW
W–B
II1
IP3
11
18 3C
R–W
4
5 3B
R–W
14 3B
CANCEL
D1
DATA LINK CONNECTOR 1
(CHECK CONNECTOR)
LG–R
W–B
2
R–W
W–B
LG–R
SET/
COAST
8 3C
1
P2
PARKING
BRAKE SW
C15
CRUISE CONTROL
CLUTCH SW
(M/T)
W–B
LG–R
B
1
(M/T)
17 3B
3
W
MAIN
18 3B
(M/T)
TO STARTER RELAY
7 3B
PKB
8
(1MZ–FE)
15
CCS
18
(5S–FE)
4
W–L
GND
13
B
2
W–B
N&C
(* 1)
(* 2)
O
10
B
B
9 3B
G–L
2
V5
VEHICLE
SPEED SENSOR
(SPEED SENSOR)
G–Y
3
C16
CRUISE CONTROL ECU
14
B
10 3B
IP3
O
1
11
(* 2)
D3
DATA LINK CONNECTOR 2
(TDCL)
1
R–L
IP3
(* 1)
N
8 3B
V–Y
14
B–R
2
9 B
R–L
I18
D5
DIODE
(FOR CRUISE
CONTROL)
5
P
22 3D
P
(A/T)
B–W
(A/T)
1 EF1
TO BACK–UP LIGHT SW (M/T)
TO PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW
(NEUTRAL START SW)(A/T)
TO GENERATOR (ALTERNATOR)
G
16 3B
R–L
14 1A
B–W
P1
PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW
(NEUTRAL START SW)
B–W
5 1E
IP3
4 B
LG
2
5 B
V–Y
12 B
G–B
CRUISE
SPEED
* 1 : TMC MADE
* 2 : TMM MADE
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
15A
STOP
3 1M
G–R
C (A/T)
B ,E8
32 A
12 C
A ,N3
OD1
3
S10
STOP
LIGHT SW
2 A
7 B (1MZ–FE)
(5S–FE)
17 A
2
1 B
2 B
1
G–W
G–W
S2
N2
IDL
B
1 A
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
(ENGINE AND ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION ECU)
NOISE FILTER
(FOR STOP LIGHT)
A , E10
C (M/T)
G–R
E7
E14
G–B
G–R
4
R–Y
12 1A
(A/T)
P–L
G–W
G–R
G–R
Y–B
15 1A
(A/T)
L
6 1M
(5S–FE)
L–W
(1MZ–FE)
I23
19 3C
IP1
23
22
13 3B
G–W
V–R
5
(A/T)
IP3
L
17
IDL
ECT
9
1
OD
STP+
15
16
BATT
STP–
L
12
R–B
R–G
3
IR1
2
IR1
1
IR1
R–Y
IR1
R–G
7
R–B
IR1
R–Y
L
8
C16
CRUISE CONTROL ECU
L–B
IR1
G–B
MO
11
L
MC
24
L–B
VR1
25
L–R
9
VR2
26
L–R
VR3
10
3
2
1
7
6
5
M
C2
CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
4
W–B
8
6
2E
2B
W–B
EB
193
CRUISE CONTROL
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
C2
CODE
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
SEE PAGE
D5
CODE
32
N3
SEE PAGE
B
33
C8
B
32
E7
A
32
P1
29 (1MZ–FE), 31 (5S–FE)
C9
A
32
E8
C
32
P2
33
C13
32
E10
B
32
P3
33
C15
32
E14
C
32
S10
33
C16
32
I12
33
V5
29 (1MZ–FE), 31 (5S–FE)
D1
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
J1
33
D3
32
N2
A
33
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
1A
1B
1C
1D
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
22
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE AND J/B NO
NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
24
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 3 (BEHIND COMBINATION METER)
1E
1G
1M
2B
2E
3B
3C
3D
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
EF1
II1
IP1
IP3
IR1
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
ENGINE WIRE AND COWL WIRE
42
COWL WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
44
ENGINE WIRE AND COWL WIRE
44
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE AND COWL WIRE
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
EB
IG
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
42
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
FRONT LEFT FENDER
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE LH
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
I13
44
COWL WIRE
I18
44
ENGINE WIRE
194
CODE
I23
SEE PAGE
44
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
COWL WIRE
195
CRUISE CONTROL
SYSTEM OUTLINE
CURRENT IS APPLIED AT ALL TIMES THROUGH STOP FUSE TO TERMINAL 1 OF THE CRUISE CONTROL ECU AND TERMINAL 2 OF
STOP LIGHT SW, AND ALSO THROUGH THE STOP FUSE TO TERMINAL 15 OF CRUISE CONTROL ECU.
WITH THE IGNITION SW TURNED TO ON, THE CURRENT FLOWS THROUGH GAUGE FUSE TO TERMINAL (A) 6 OF COMBINATION
METER AND THE CURRENT THROUGH ECU–IG FUSE FLOWS TO TERMINAL 14 OF CRUISE CONTROL ECU.
WHEN THE IGNITION SW IS ON AND THE CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SW IS TURNED ON, A SIGNAL IS INPUT FROM TERMINAL 15 OF
CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SW TO TERMINAL 4 OF CRUISE CONTROL ECU. AS A RESULT, THE CRUISE CONTROL ECU FUNCTIONS
AND THE CURRENT TO TERMINAL 14 OF CRUISE CONTROL ECU TO TERMINAL 13 OF CRUISE CONTROL ECU → GROUND, AND
THE CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM IS IN A CONDITION READY FOR OPERATION.
AT THE SAME TIME, THE CURRENT THROUGH THE GAUGE FUSE FLOWS FROM TERMINAL (A) 6 OF CRUISE CONTROL INDICATOR
LIGHT → TERMINAL (B) 9 → TERMINAL 5 OF CRUISE CONTROL ECU → TERMINAL 13 → TO GROUND, CAUSING THE CRUISE
CONTROL INDICATOR LIGHT TO LIGHT UP, INDICATING THAT THE CRUISE CONTROL IS READY FOR OPERATION.
1. SET OPERATION
WHEN THE CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SW IS TURNED ON AND THE SET SW IS TURNED ON WITH THE VEHICLE SPEED WITHIN THE
SET LIMIT (APPROX. 40 KM/H, 25 MPH TO 200 KM/H, 124 MPH), A SIGNAL IS INPUT TO TERMINAL 18 OF THE CRUISE CONTROL ECU
AND THE VEHICLE SPEED AT THE TIME THE SET SW IS RELEASED IS MEMORIZED IN THE ECU AS THE SET SPEED.
2. SET SPEED CONTROL
DURING CRUISE CONTROL DRIVING, THE ECU COMPARES THE SET SPEED MEMORIZED IN THE ECU WITH THE ACTUAL VEHICLE
SPEED INPUT INTO TERMINAL 20 OF THE CRUISE CONTROL ECU FROM THE VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR (SPEED SENSOR), AND
CONTROLS THE CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR TO MAINTAIN THE SET SPEED.
WHEN THE ACTUAL SPEED IS LOWER THAN THE SET SPEED, THE ECU CAUSES THE CURRENT TO THE CRUISE CONTROL
ACTUATOR TO FLOW FROM TERMINAL 12 → TERMINAL 6 OF CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR → TERMINAL 7 → TERMINAL 11 OF
CRUISE CONTROL ECU. AS A RESULT, THE MOTOR IN THE CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR IS ROTATED TO OPEN THE THROTTLE
VALVE AND THE THROTTLE CABLE IS PULLED TO INCREASE THE VEHICLE SPEED. WHEN THE ACTUAL DRIVING SPEED IS HIGHER
THAN THE SET SPEED, THE CURRENT TO CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR FLOWS FROM TERMINAL 11 OF ECU → TERMINAL 7 OF
CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR → TERMINAL 6 → TERMINAL 12 OF CRUISE CONTROL ECU.
THIS CAUSES THE MOTOR IN THE CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR TO ROTATE TO CLOSE THE THROTTLE VALVE AND RETURN THE
THROTTLE CABLE TO DECREASE THE VEHICLE SPEED.
3. COAST CONTROL
DURING THE CRUISE CONTROL DRIVING, WHILE THE COAST SW IS ON, THE CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR RETURNS THE
THROTTLE CABLE TO CLOSE THE THROTTLE VALVE AND DECREASE THE DRIVING SPEED. THE VEHICLE SPEED WHEN THE COAST
SW IS TURNED OFF IS MEMORIZED AND THE VEHICLE CONTINUES AT THE NEW SET SPEED.
4. ACCEL CONTROL
DURING CRUISE CONTROL DRIVING, WHILE THE ACCEL SW IS TURNED ON, THE CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR PULLS THE
THROTTLE CABLE TO OPEN THE THROTTLE VALVE AND INCREASE THE DRIVING SPEED.
THE VEHICLE SPEED WHEN THE ACCEL SW IS TURNED OFF IS MEMORIZED AND THE VEHICLE CONTINUES AT THE NEW SET
SPEED.
5. RESUME CONTROL
UNLESS THE VEHICLE SPEED FALLS BELOW THE MINIMUM SPEED LIMIT (APPROX. 40 KM/H, 25 MPH) AFTER CANCELING THE SET
SPEED BY THE CANCEL SW, PUSHING THE RESUME SW WILL CAUSE THE VEHICLE TO RESUME THE SPEED SET BEFORE
CANCELLATION.
6. MANUAL CANCEL MECHANISM
IF ANY OF THE FOLLOWING OPERATIONS OCCURS DURING CRUISE CONTROL OPERATION, CURRENT FLOW TO MAGNETIC
CLUTCH OF THE ACTUATOR IS CUT TURNS OFF AND THE MOTOR ROTATES TO CLOSE THE THROTTLE VALVE AND THE CRUISE
CONTROL IS RELEASED.
∗ PLACING THE SHIFT LEVER IN “N” POSITION (PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW (NEUTRAL START SW ON). “SIGNAL INPUT TO
TERMINAL 2 OF ECU” (A/T)
∗ DEPRESSING THE CLUTCH PEDAL (CLUCH SW ON). “SIGNAL INPUT TO TERMINAL 2 OF THE ECU” (M/T)
∗ DEPRESSING THE BRAKE PEDAL (STOP LIGHT SW ON). “SIGNAL INPUT TO TERMINAL 16 OF ECU”
∗ PUSH THE CANCEL SW (CANCEL SW ON). “SIGNAL INPUT TO TERMINAL 18 OF ECU”
∗ DEPRESSING THE PARKING BRAKE PEDAL (PARKING BRAKE SW ON). “SIGNAL INPUT TO TERMINAL 3 OF ECU” (3VZ–FE)
∗ PULLING THE PARKING BRAKE LEVER (PARKING BRAKE SW ON). “SIGNAL INPUT TO TERMINAL 3 OF THE ECU” (5S–FE)
196
7. AUTO CANCEL FUNCTION
A) IF ANY OF THE FOLLOWING OPERATING CONDITIONS OCCURS DURING CRUISE CONTROL OPERATION, THE SET SPEED IS
ERASED, CURRENT FLOW TO MAGNETIC CLUTCH IS CUT OFF AND THE CRUISE CONTROL IS RELEASED. (MAIN SW TURNS OFF).
WHEN THIS OCCURS, THE IGNITION SW MUST BE TURNED OFF ONCE BEFORE THE MAIN SW WILL TURN ON AGAIN.
∗ OVER CURRENT TO TRANSISTOR DRIVING MOTOR AND/OR MAGNETIC CLUTCH.
∗ WHEN CURRENT CONTINUED TO FLOW TO THE MOTOR INSIDE THE ACTUATOR IN THE THROTTLE VALVE “OPEN” DIRECTION.
∗ OPEN CIRCUIT IN MOTOR AND/OR MAGNETIC CLUTCH.
∗ MOMENTARY INTERRUPTION OF VEHICLE SPEED SIGNAL.
∗ SHORT CIRCUIT IN CRUISE CONTROL SW.
∗ MOTOR DOES NOT OPERATE DESPITE THE MOTOR DRIVE SIGNAL BEING OUTPUT.
B) IF ANY OF THE FOLLOWING CONDITIONS OCCURS DURING CRUISE CONTROL OPERATION, THE SET SPEED IS ERASED AND
THE CRUISE CONTROL IS RELEASED. CURRENT FLOW TO MAGNETIC CLUTCH IS CUT OFF UNTIL THE SET SW IS “ON” AGAIN.)
∗ WHEN THE VEHICLE SPEED HAS FALLEN BELOW THE MINIMUM SPEED LIMIT, APPROX. 40 KM/H (25 MPH)
∗ WHEN THE VEHICLE SPEED HAS FALLEN MORE THAN 16 KM/H (10 MPH) BELOW THE SET SPEED, E.G. ON AN UPWARD SLOPE.
∗ WHEN POWER TO THE CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM IS MOMENTARILY CUT OFF.
C)
IF ANY OF THE FOLLOWING CONDITIONS OCCURS DURING CRUISE CONTROL OPERATION, THE CRUISE CONTROL IS
RELEASED.
∗ OPEN CIRCUIT FOR TERMINAL 1 OF CRUISE CONTROL ECU.
8. AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION CONTROL FUNCTION
∗ IN OVERDRIVE. IF THE VEHICLE SPEED BECOMES LOWER THAN THE OVERDRIVE CUT SPEED (SET SPEED MINUS APPROX. 4
KM/H, 2.5 MPH) DURING CRUISE CONTROL OPERATION, SUCH AS DRIVING UP A HILL, THE OVERDRIVE IS RELEASED AND THE
POWER INCREASED TO PREVENT A REDUCTION IN VEHICLE SPEED.
∗ AFTER RELEASING THE OVERDRIVE, IF VEHICLE SPEED BECOMES HIGHER THAN THE OVERDRIVE RETURN SPEED (SET
SPEED MINUS APPROX. 2 KM/H, 1.2 MPH) AND THE ECU JUDGES BY THE SIGNALS FROM POTENTIOMETER OF THE ACTUATOR
THAT THE UPWARD SLOPE HAS FINISHED, OVERDRIVE IS RESUMED AFTER A WHILE.
SERVICE HINTS
C 2 CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1–3 : APPROX. 2 K
5–4 : APPROX. 38
C13 CRUISE CNTROL SW MAIN [COMB. SW]
15–20 : CONTINUITY WITH MAIN SW ON
20–17 : APPROX. 418 WITH CANCEL SW ON
APPROX. 68 WITH RESUME/ACCEL SW ON
APPROX. 198 WITH SET/COAST SW ON
C16 CRUISE CONTROL ECU
14–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
1,15–GROUND : ALWAYS APPROX. 12 VOLTS
3–GROUND : CONTINUITY WITH PARKING BRAKE SW ON (ONE OF THE CANCEL SW) OR BRAKE LEVEL WARNING SW ON
20–GROUND : 4 PULSE WITH 1 ROTATION OF ROTOR SHAFT
18–GROUND : APPROX. 418 WITH CANCEL SW ON IN CONTROL SW
APPROX. 68 WITH RES/ACC SW ON IN CONTROL SW
APPROX. 198 WITH SET/COAST SW ON IN CONTROL SW
13–GROUND : ALWAYS CONTINUITY
2–GROUND : CONTINUITY WITH SHIFT LEVER AT N POSITION (A/T) OR CLUTCH PEDAL DEPRESSED (M/T)
197
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION AND A/T INDICATOR (1MZ–FE)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
15A
EFI
7. 5A
IGN
15A
STOP
W–B
9 1D
3 1M
2 2B
2
G–R
G–W
3
EFI MAIN
RELAY
2 A
1 A
5
2 2D
3 2C
4 2D
R–Y
B–O
W–G
N2
1
B
12
IP3
1 B
G–W
G–R
1
2
G–W
15 1A
2 B
FROM
CRUISE CONTROL ECU
IP1 11
B–O
B–O
IP1
S10
STOP LIGHT SW
B–O
6 1M
18
A ,N3
NOISE FILTER
(FOR STOP LIGHT)
B–O
W–L
23 D
22 D
14 D
24 D
+B
+B1
E7
G–W
B–O
B–O
4 3B
BATT
A ,E8
Y–B
19 3C
I23
7 D
STP
B ,E9
C , E10
OD1
D
17 A
L–Y
V
4
2
3
E01
E02
33 A
E03
28 A
NC2–
E1
16 A
O6
O/D DIRECT CLUTCH
SPEED SENSOR
TO CRUISE
CONTROL ECU
P–L
EB
198
BR
W–B
E2
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
NC2+
4 B
9 B
1
2
BR
W–B
B–O
1
W–B
6
W–B
B–O
A
I18
P–L
A
J7
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
P–L
34 A
Y–L
S2
11 A
W–L
S1
27 A
Y–L
SL
3 A
Y–G
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ENGINE AND ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION ECU)
SLN–
ED
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
10A
GAUGE
BR
BR
6
1D
BR
I18
R–L
L–R
3
6
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
R–L
R–L
L–R
C
32 A
7 B
IDL
A ,E8
B ,E9
C , E10
VTA
1 B
3
IN1
R–L
L–R
IN1
I18
3
TO
COMBINATION
METER
L–R
NORMAL
6
POWER
BR
L–W
G
L
E6
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION
PATTERN SELECT SW
B–Y
I18
L–R
6
E7
II1
C
4
L–W
2
L–W
THW
L–R
II2
R–L
4
2
20 B
I6
L–R
FROM
CRUISE CONTROL ECU
FROM
COOLING FAN ECU
E4
ENGINE COOLANT TEMP.
SENSOR (EFI WATER
TEMP. SENSOR)
1
L–R
8 1K
T1
THROTTLE POSITION
SENSOR
1
R–L
22 B
3 D
E2
P
VC
D
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ENGINE AND ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION ECU)
TE1
12 D
6 D
G–O
10 3D
D
D
GR–B
IP1
8
TE2
TE1
4
C8
COMBINATION
METER
SPEED
5
12
D1
DATA LINK CONNECTOR 1
(CHECK CONNECTOR)
11
G
G–B
E1
BR
G–O
V–Y
2
3
G–O
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
22 3D
G–W
1
OD2
SP1
5 C
G–W
11 D
V–Y
TE2
IP3
14
IP3
A
J7
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
LG
BR
P
A
2
3
V5
VEHICLE SPEED
SENSOR
(SPEED SENSOR)
1
R–L
199
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION AND A/T INDICATOR (1MZ–FE)
* 1 : W/ A/T INDICATOR LIGHT
R–L
2
IP3
R–L
R–L
TO GENERATOR (ALTERNATOR)
R–L
I18
R–L
L–R
P1
A/T INDICATOR SW
[PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW
(NEUTRAL START SW)]
2
R–L
2
D
N
R
P
4
3
10
9
8
7
G–W
13 IQ1
R–B
14 IQ1
8 IQ1
1
IP3
9 IQ1
R–B
O
7 IQ1
TO BACK–UP LIGHT
I18
R–B
Y–L
R
O
B–O
13
IP1
I18
O
Y–L
Y–L
6
IP1
O
Y–L
L
15 D
2
R
I19
R–B
10 D
L
R–B
2 D
L
5
2
D
C11
A/T INDICATOR LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
4
N
6
(* 1)
9
G–O
7
(* 1)
II1
10
W–B
2
11
POWER
13
O/D
8
B
G–O
I6
G–O
1
W–B
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
B
W–B
O5
O/D MAIN SW
3
200
IF
(* 1)
G–W
R–B
G–O
R–L
II1
R–B
5
(* 1)
R
(* 1)
(* 1)
B–O
O
(* 1)
(* 1)
Y–L
(* 1)
L–R
(* 1)
E 7 B , E 8 C , E10 A
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
(ENGINE AND ELECTRONIC
CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION ECU)
R–L
I1
3
R
P
SYSTEM OUTLINE
PREVIOUS AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSIONS HAVE SELECTED EACH GEAR SHIFT USING MECHANICALLY CONTROLLED THROTTLE
HYDRAULIC PRESSURE, GOVERNOR HYDRAULIC PRESSURE AND LOCK–UP HYDRAULIC PRESSURE. THE ELECTRONIC
CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION, HOWEVER, ELECTRICALLY CONTROLS THE LINE PRESSURE AND LOCK–UP PRESSURE ETC.,
THROUGH THE SOLENOID VALVE. ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ENGINE AND ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION ECU)
CONTROL OF THE SOLENOID VALVE BASED ON THE INPUT SIGNALS FROM EACH SENSOR MAKES SMOOTH DRIVING POSSIBLE BY
SHIFT SELECTION FOR EACH GEAR WHICH IS MOST APPROPRIATE TO THE DRIVING CONDITIONS AT THAT TIME.
1. GEAR SHIFT OPERATION
DURING DRIVING, THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) SELECTS THE SHIFT FOR EACH GEAR WHICH IS MOST APPROPRIATE TO
THE DRIVING CONDITIONS, BASED ON INPUT SIGNALS FROM THE ENGINE COOLANT TEMP. SENSOR (EFI WATER TEMP. SENSOR)
TO TERMINAL THW OF THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU), AND ALSO THE INPUT SIGNALS TO TERMINAL NC2+ OF THE ENGINE
CONTROL MODULE (ECU) FROM THE VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR (SPEED SENSOR) DEVOTED TO THE ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION. CURRENT IS THEN OUTPUT TO THE ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION SOLENOIDS. WHEN SHIFTING TO
1ST SPEED, CURRENT FLOWS FROM TERMINAL S1 OF THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) → TERMINAL 3 OF THE ELECTRONIC
CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION SOLENOIDS → GROUND, AND CONTINUITY TO THE NO. 1 SOLENOID CAUSES THE SHIFT.
FOR 2ND SPEED, CURRENT FLOWS FROM TERMINAL S1 OF THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) → TERMINAL 3 OF THE
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION SOLENOIDS → GROUND, AND FROM TERMINAL S2 OF THE ENGINE CONTROL
MODULE (ECU) → TERMINAL 1 OF THE ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION SOLENOIDS → GROUND, AND CONTINUITY TO
SOLENOIDS NO. 1 AND NO. 2 CAUSES THE SHIFT.
FOR 3RD SPEED, THERE IS NO CONTINUITY TO NO. 1 SOLENOID, ONLY TO NO. 2, CAUSING THE SHIFT.
SHIFTING INTO 4TH SPEED (OVERDRIVE) TAKES PLACE WHEN THERE IS NO CONTINUITY TO EITHER NO. 1 OR NO. 2 SOLENOID.
2. LOCK–UP OPERATION
WHEN THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) JUDGES FROM EACH SIGNAL THAT LOCK–UP OPERATION CONDITIONS HAVE BEEN
MET, CURRENT FLOWS FROM TERMINAL SL OF THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) → TERMINAL 2 OF THE ELECTRONIC
CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION SOLENOID → GROUND, CAUSING CONTINUITY TO THE LOCK–UP SOLENOID AND CAUSING
LOCK–UP OPERATION.
3. STOP LIGHT SW CIRCUIT
IF THE BRAKE PEDAL IS DEPRESSED (STOP LIGHT SW ON) WHEN DRIVING IN LOCK–UP CONDITION, A SIGNAL IS INPUT TO
TERMINAL STP OF THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU), THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) OPERATES AND CONTINUITY TO
THE LOCK–UP SOLENOID IS CUT.
4. OVERDRIVE CIRCUIT
* O/D MAIN SW ON
WHEN THE O/D MAIN SW IS TURNED ON (O/D OFF INDICATOR LIGHT TURNS OFF), A SIGNAL IS INPUT TO TERMINAL OD2 OF THE
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) AND ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) OPERATION CAUSES GEAR SHIFT WHEN THE
CONDITIONS FOR OVERDRIVE ARE MET.
* O/D MAIN SW OFF
WHEN THE O/D MAIN SW IS TURNED TO OFF, THE CURRENT FLOWING THROUGH THE O/D OFF INDICATOR LIGHT FLOWS
THROUGH THE O/D MAIN SW TO GROUND. CAUSING THE INDICATOR LIGHT TO LIGHT UP. AT THE SAME TIME, A SIGNAL IS INPUT
TO TERMINAL OD2 OF THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) AND ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) OPERATION PREVENTS
SHIFT INTO OVERDIRVE.
5. ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION PATTERN SELECT SW CIRCUIT
IF THE ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION PATTERN SELECT SW IS CHANGED FROM NORMAL TO POWER, THE CURRENT
FLOWING THROUGH THE POWER INDICATOR FLOWS TO GROUND, CURRENT FLOWS TO TERMINAL P OF THE ENGINE CONTROL
MODULE (ECU), THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) OPERATES, AND SHIFT UP AND SHIFT DOWN OCCUR AT HIGHER VEHICLE
SPEEDS THAN WHEN THE SW IS IN NORMAL POSITION.
201
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION AND A/T INDICATOR (1MZ–FE)
SERVICE HINTS
E 7(B), E 8 (C), E10(A) ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ENGINE AND ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION ECU)
(TURN ON THE IGNTION SW)
S1, S2– E1 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS WITH SOLENOID ON
0–1.5 VOLTS WITH SOLENOID OFF
P– E1 : 7.5–14.0 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW ON AND PATTERN SELECT SW AT POWER POSITION
L– E1 : 7.5–14.0 VOLTS WITH SHIFT LEVER AT L POSITION
2– E1 : 7.5–14.0 VOLTS WITH SHIFT LEVER AT 2 POSITION
R– E1 : 7.5–14.0 VOLTS WITH SHIFT LEVER AT R POSITION
STP– E1 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS WITH BRAKE PEDAL DEPRESSED
THW– E2 : 0.2–1.0 VOLTS WITH WITH ENGINE COOLANT TEMP. 60°C (140°F) –120°C (248°F)
IDL– E2 : 0–1.5 VOLTS WITH THROTTLE VALVE FULLY CLOSED
9.0–14.0 VOLTS WITH THROTTLE VALVE FULLY OPENED
VTA–E2 : 0.3–0.8 VOLTS WITH THROTTLE VALVE FULLY CLOSED
3.2–4.9 VOLTS WITH THROTTLE VALVE FULLY OPENED
VC– E2 : 4.5–5.5 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
OD1– E1 : 4.5–5.5 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
OD2– E1 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS WITH O/D MAIN SW TURNED OFF
0–3.0 VOLTS WITH O/D MAIN SW TURNED ON
IGSW– E1 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
+B– E1 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
+B1– E1 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
E 2 ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
1, 2, 6–GROUND : EACH 11–15 Ω
O 5 O/D MAIN SW
1–3 : CLOSED WITH O/D MAIN SW OFF, OPEN WITH O/D MAIN SW ON
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
C8
32
E9
C11
32
E10
D1
28
J1
E2
28
E4
E6
SEE PAGE
O5
33
D
32
O6
29
33
P1
29
J2
33
S10
33
28
J3
33
T1
29
32
J7
33
V5
29
A
32
N2
A
33
E8
B
32
N3
B
33
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
1A
1D
1K
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO.
NO 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
22
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
22
ENGINE WIRE AND J/B NO
NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
24
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 3 (BEHIND COMBINATION METER)
1M
2B
2C
2D
3B
3C
3D
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
II1
42
COWL WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
II2
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE AND COWL WIRE
IN1
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE AND SWITCH WIRE
44
ENGINE WIRE AND COWL WIRE
44
ENGINE WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
IP1
IP3
IQ1
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
EB
38 (1MZ–FE)
FRONT LEFT FENDER
ED
38 (1MZ–FE)
INTAKE MANIFOLD LH
IF
42
LEFT KICK PANEL
202
SEE PAGE
32
E7
CODE
CODE
C
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
CODE
I1
44
COWL WIRE
I19
I6
44
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
I23
I18
44
ENGINE WIRE
SEE PAGE
44
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
COWL WIRE
203
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION AND A/T INDICATOR (5S–FE)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
3 1M
B–O
9 1D
G–R
1 B
G–R
2 2B
3 2C
W–G
B–O
IP1
12
1
R
BR
R
2
15 1A
IP3
B–O
I18
BR
E18
BR
E17
I18
B1
(* 3)
BR
13 A
B
BR
12 A
1 B
11 B
9 B
16 B
G–W
B–O
B–O
4 3B
B
I23
R
W–L
19 3C
B–W
11
3
1
G–W
W–B
6 1M
4 2D
4
BR
5
2
L
2
G–W
EFI MAIN
RELAY
FROM IGNITION
SW ” ST1”
3
S10
STOP LIGHT SW
1
N2
2 2D
BR
2 B
G–W
B
1 A
A ,N3
2 A
NOISE FILTER
(FOR STOP LIGHT)
T1
THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
IP1
B–O
18
G–W
FROM MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE
PRESSURE SENSOR
(VACUUM SENSOR)
15A
STOP
15A
EFI
TO MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE
PRESSURE SENSOR
(VACUUM SENSOR)
7. 5A
IGN
1 A
4 A
BATT
22 A
B/K
12 B
NSW
IDL
VC
VTA
E2
E21
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ENGINE AND ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION ECU)
E 7 C , E 8 B , E 10 A
S2
S1
SL
E1
15 C
2 C
1 C
14 C
E01
13 C
SP1
E02
9 A
26 C
V–Y
22
3D
10
3D
V–Y
4
C8
COMBINATION
METER
W
5
12
IP3
G
14
IP3
LG
11
P
W–B
W–B
BR
1 B
NO. 3
(LOCK–UP)
NO. 1
NO. 2
E2 A ,E3 B
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
G–B
V
3 A
L–Y
P–L
1 A
B
SPEED
2
3
V5
VEHICLE SPEED
SENSOR
(SPEED SENSOR)
1
R–L
W–B
BR
BR
EB
204
EC
BR
ED
16
IP3
BR
* 1 : W/ A/T INDICATOR LIGHT
* 2 : W/O A/T INDICATOR LIGHT
* 3 : EX. CALIFORNIA
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
10A
GAUGE
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
C R–L
R–L
C
R–L
I18
R–L
P1
A/T INDICATOR SW
[PARK/NEUTRAL
POSITION SW
(NEUTRAL START SW)]
L–R
L
2
D
N
R
P
4
3
10
9
8
7
Y–L
I18
1
IP3
R–L
L–R
6
IP1
G–W
Y–L
R–B
I6
TO
COMBINATION METER
13
O
I18
I1
R–B
G–O
E1
R–B
7
5
4
3
(* 1)
G–W
9 IQ1
(* 1)
II1
R–B
5
(* 1)
R
10
(* 1)
B–O
O
11
(* 1)
O
13
P
R
N
D
2
L
POWER
G–O
O/D OFF
C11
A/T INDICATOR LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
9
6
9
TT
(* 1)
5
W–B
D
(* 1)
D1
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 1
(CHECK CONNECTOR)
TT
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
D
BR–B
BR–B
17
D
IP1
G–O
15
8
13 IQ1
7 A
E 7 C , E 8 B , E10 A
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
(ENGINE AND ELECTRONIC
CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION
ECU)
BR–B
G–O
BR–B
I18
OD2
14 IQ1
TO BACK–UP LIGHT
TT
7 B
Y–L
2
(* 1)
L
8 IQ1
Y–L
P
THW
7 IQ1
(* 1)
18 A
L–R
19 A
(* 1)
O
6 A
LG
Y–L
2
R–L
L–R
IP1
R–B
(* 2)
R
B–O
L–R
I13
4 B
ECT
2
II1
E1
3
BR
3
R–L
TO GENERATOR
(ALTERNATOR)
L–R
L–R
E4
ENGINE COOLANT TEMP. SNESOR
(EFI WATER TEMP. SENSOR)
BR
1
R–L
IP3
2
3
IN1
L–R
II1
2
R–L
O
3
6
8 1K
4
II2
NORMAL
6
R–L
R–L
6
IN1
R–L
POWER
E6
ELECTRONIC
CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION
PATTERN SELECT SW
6
1D
D3
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 2
(TDCL)
G–O
I6
G–O
O5
O/D MAIN SW
1
3
B
W–B
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
B
R–L
BR
12
3D
3
3D
W–B
BR
IF
205
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION AND A/T INDICATOR (5S–FE)
SYSTEM OUTLINE
PREVIOUS AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSIONS HAVE SELECTED EACH GEAR SHIFT USING MECHANICALLY CONTROLLED THROTTLE
HYDRAULIC PRESSURE, GOVERNOR HYDRAULIC PRESSURE AND LOCK–UP HYDRAULIC PRESSURE. THE ELECTRONIC
CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION, HOWEVER, ELECTRICALLY CONTROLS THE LINE PRESSURE AND LOCK–UP PRESSURE ETC.,
THROUGH THE SOLENOID VALVE. ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ENGINE AND ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION ECU)
CONTROL OF THE SOLENOID VALVE BASED ON THE INPUT SIGNALS FROM EACH SENSOR MAKES SMOOTH DRIVING POSSIBLE BY
SHIFT SELECTION FOR EACH GEAR WHICH IS MOST APPROPRIATE TO THE DRIVING CONDITIONS AT THAT TIME.
1. GEAR SHIFT OPERATION
DURING DRIVING, THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) SELECTS THE SHIFT FOR EACH GEAR WHICH IS MOST APPROPRIATE TO
THE DRIVING CONDITIONS, BASED ON INPUT SIGNALS FROM THE ENGINE COOLANT TEMP. SENSOR (EFI WATER TEMP. SENSOR)
TO TERMINAL THW OF THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU), AND ALSO THE INPUT SIGNALS TO TERMINAL SP1 OF THE ENGINE
CONTROL MODULE (ECU) FROM THE VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR (SPEED SENSOR) DEVOTED TO THE ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION. CURRENT IS THEN OUTPUT TO THE ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION SOLENOIDS. WHEN SHIFTING TO
1ST SPEED, CURRENT FLOWS FROM TERMINAL S1 OF THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) → TERMINAL (A)3 OF THE
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION SOLENOIDS → GROUND, AND CONTINUITY TO THE NO. 1 SOLENOID CAUSES THE
SHIFT.
FOR 2ND SPEED, CURRENT FLOWS FROM TERMINAL S1 OF THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) → TERMINAL (A)3 OF THE
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION SOLENOIDS → GROUND, AND FROM TERMINAL S2 OF THE ENGINE CONTROL
MODULE (ECU) → TERMINAL (A)1 OF THE ELECTRONIC CONTROL TRANSMISSION SOLENOIDS → GROUND, AND CONTINUITY TO
SOLENOIDS NO. 1 AND NO. 2 CAUSES THE SHIFT.
FOR 3RD SPEED, THERE IS NO CONTINUITY TO NO. 1 SOLENOID, ONLY TO NO. 2, CAUSING THE SHIFT.
SHIFTING INTO 4TH SPEED (OVERDRIVE) TAKES PLACE WHEN THERE IS NO CONTINUITY TO EITHER NO. 1 OR NO. 2 SOLENOID.
2. LOCK–UP OPERATION
WHEN THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) JUDGES FROM EACH SIGNAL THAT LOCK–UP OPERATION CONDITIONS HAVE BEEN
MET, CURRENT FLOWS FROM TERMINAL SL OF THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) → TERMINAL (B)1 OF THE ELECTRONIC
CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION SOLENOID → GROUND, CAUSING CONTINUITY TO THE LOCK–UP SOLENOID AND CAUSING
LOCK–UP OPERATION.
3. STOP LIGHT SW CIRCUIT
IF THE BRAKE PEDAL IS DEPRESSED (STOP LIGHT SW ON) WHEN DRIVING IN LOCK–UP CONDITION, A SIGNAL IS INPUT TO
TERMINAL B/K OF THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU), THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) OPERATES AND CONTINUITY TO
THE LOCK–UP SOLENOID IS CUT.
4. OVERDRIVE CIRCUIT
* O/D MAIN SW ON
WHEN THE O/D MAIN SW IS TURNED ON (O/D OFF INDICATOR LIGHT TURNS OFF), A SIGNAL IS INPUT TO TERMINAL OD2 OF THE
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) AND ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) OPERATION CAUSES GEAR SHIFT WHEN THE
CONDITIONS FOR OVERDRIVE ARE MET.
* O/D MAIN SW OFF
WHEN THE O/D MAIN SW IS TURNED TO OFF, THE CURRENT FLOWING THROUGH THE O/D OFF INDICATOR LIGHT FLOWS
THROUGH THE O/D MAIN SW TO GROUND. CAUSING THE INDICATOR LIGHT TO LIGHT UP. AT THE SAME TIME, A SIGNAL IS INPUT
TO TERMINAL OD2 OF THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) AND ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) OPERATION PREVENTS
SHIFT INTO OVERDRIVE.
5. ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION PATTERN SELECT SW CIRCUIT
IF THE ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION PATTERN SELECT SW IS CHANGED FROM NORMAL TO POWER, THE CURRENT
FLOWING THROUGH THE POWER INDICATOR FLOWS TO GROUND, CURRENT FLOWS TO TERMINAL P OF THE ENGINE CONTROL
MODULE (ECU), THE ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECU) OPERATES, AND SHIFT UP AND SHIFT DOWN OCCUR AT HIGHER VEHICLE
SPEEDS THAN WHEN THE SW IS IN NORMAL POSITION.
SERVICE HINTS
E 7(C), E 8 (B), E10(A) ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ENGINE AND ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION ECU)
(TURN ON THE IGNTION SW)
S1, S2 –E1 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS WITH SOLENOID ON
0–1.5 VOLTS WITH SOLENOID OFF
P –E1 : 7.5–14.0 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW ON AND PATTERN SELECT SW AT POWER POSITION
L– E1 : 7.5–14.0 VOLTS WITH SHIFT LEVER AT L POSITION
2– E1 : 7.5–14.0 VOLTS WITH SHIFT LEVER AT 2 POSITION
R– E1 : 7.5–14.0 VOLTS WITH SHIFT LEVER AT R POSITION
B/K– E1 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS WITH BRAKE PEDAL DEPRESSED
THW– E2 : 0.2–1.0 VOLTS WITH WITH ENGINE COOLANT TEMP. 60°C (140°F) –120°C (248°F)
IDL– E2 : 0–1.5 VOLTS WITH THROTTLE VALVE FULLY CLOSED
9.0–14.0 VOLTS WITH THROTTLE VALVE FULLY OPENED
206
SERVICE HINTS
VTA–E2 : 0.3–0.8 VOLTS WITH THROTTLE VALVE FULLY CLOSED
3.2–4.9 VOLTS WITH THROTTLE VALVE FULLY OPENED
VC– E2 : 4.5–5.5 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
OD2– E1 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS WITH O/D MAIN SW TURNED ON
0–3.0 VOLTS WITH O/D MAIN SW TURNED OFF
IGSW– E1 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
+B– E1 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
+B1– E1 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
M–REL– E1 : 9.0–14.0 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
E 2(A), E 3(B) ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
(A)1, (A)3, (B)1–GROUND : EACH 11–15 Ω
O 5 O/D MAIN SW
1–3 : CLOSED WITH O/D MAIN SW OFF, OPEN WITH O/D MAIN SW ON
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
C8
32
C11
32
E7
D1
30
E8
D3
32
E10
SEE PAGE
E6
CODE
SEE PAGE
32
N2
A
33
C
32
N3
B
32
O5
B
33
33
A
32
P1
31
E2
A
30
J1
33
S10
33
E3
B
30
J2
33
T1
31
30
J3
33
V5
31
E4
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
1A
1D
1K
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO.
NO 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
22
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
22
ENGINE WIRE AND J/B NO
NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
24
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 3 (BEHIND COMBINATION METER)
1M
2B
2C
2D
3B
3C
3D
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
II1
42
COWL WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
II2
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE AND COWL WIRE
IN1
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE AND SWITCH WIRE
44
ENGINE WIRE AND COWL WIRE
44
ENGINE WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
IP1
IP3
IQ1
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
EB
40 (5S–FE)
FRONT LEFT FENDER
EC
40 (5S–FE)
INTAKE MANIFOLD RH
ED
40 (5S–FE)
INTAKE MANIFOLD LH
IF
42
LEFT KICK PANEL
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
E17
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
40 (5S–FE)
(5S FE)
ENGINE WIRE
I1
44
COWL WIRE
I6
44
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
E18
CODE
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
I13
44
COWL WIRE
I18
44
ENGINE WIRE
I23
44
COWL WIRE
207
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION AND A/T INDICATOR (5S–FE)
208
ABS (ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM) (TMC MADE)
209
ABS (ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM) (TMC MADE)
60A ABS
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
F18
FUSE BOX
R–L
R–L
W–L
1
3 EC1
W–L
W–L
E4
6
A
G–W
W–L
7 EC1
A6
B , A7
A
ABS RELAY
1 B
2 A
4 A
A4
A , A5
B
ABS ACTUATOR
2 A
5 A
3 B
1 A
13 A
26 A
14 A
18 A
6 A
W–R
E6
W–B
W–B
23 A
24 A
11 A
R–
SR
SFR
W–B
MR
SFL
SRR
SRL
AST
A , A 14 B
A13
ABS ECU
FL+
FSS
10 A
FR–
FR+
3 A
16 A
BR
9 A
R
FL–
22 A
G
W–B
GND
15 A
W–B
E
2 A
(SHIELDED)
E4
IR2
7
IR2
5 IR2
B
6
W
BR
I25
R
G
W–B
(SHIELDED)
1
2
W–B
A8
ABS SPEED SENSOR
FRONT LH
EA
210
1
2
A9
ABS SPEED SENSOR
FRONT RH
MT
1 B
W–B
6 A
W–R
3 A
R–W
W
4 A
R
1 A
G–R
4 B
L–R
5 A
G–W
1 A
L–W
3 B
GR–G
GR–L
W–R
2 B 4 B
GR–R
W–B
M
* 1 : USA
* 2 : CANADA
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
10A
GAUGE
15A
STOP
15A
ECU–IG
15A
ECU–B
R–L
R–L
LG–R
B–R
L–Y
B
A , N3
NOISE FILTER
(FOR STOP LIGHT)
15 3C
2 3B
1
L–Y
2
19 3C
1
IR2
4
IR2
IR2
TC
15 B
13 B
6 B
TS
W
L–Y
G–W
5 A
D/G
7 3C
G–B
LG–R
13 3C
4 B
11 3B
B–R
2
12 3C
1 B
16 3C
B–R
G–B
R–G
17 3C
3 3C
3 2G
G–R
C 9 A , C10 B
LG–R
G–B
4 B
R–L
16 3D
15 1A
2 B
G–R
6 1M
6 A
17 3D
7 1A
1 A
G–W
IP3
S10
STOP LIGHT SW
3
G–W
IP1
2 A
C
ABS WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
3
IP3
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–L
22
8
3 1M
G–W
C
WA
R–Y
TS
16
Y–B
C
TC
11
R–G
Y–B
C
6 1B
SHORT PIN
LG–R
TC
4
D3
J3
DATA LINK
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR 2
CONNECTOR (TDCL)
ABS
14
WB
N2
D1
DATA LINK CONNECTOR 1
(CHECK CONNECTOR)
23
12 A
25 A
STP
A13
A , A14
IG1
BAT
B
ABS ECU
RL+
RSS
7 B
RR–
RR+
16 B
PKB
8 B
14 B
(SHIELDED)
(* 2)
W
(* 1)
Y
(* 2)
B
BR
3 3B
8 3C
19
IJ1
6
IJ1
4
IS1
5
IS1
6
8 3D
IS1
R–W
Y
BR
R
R–W
(SHIELDED)
(SHIELDED)
(1MZ–FE)
IJ1
G
4
1
A19
ABS SPEED SENSOR
REAR LH
2
II1
1
A20
ABS SPEED SENSOR
REAR RH
R–W
2
P2
PARKING BRAKE
SW
12
1
1
P3
PARKING BRAKE
SW
BR
I21
(* 1)
BR
BR
I21
R
G
(SHIELDED)
R–W
BR
9 B
(5S–FE)
RL–
1 B
211
ABS (ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM) (TMC MADE)
SYSTEM OUTLINE
THIS SYSTEM CONTROLS THE RESPECTIVE BRAKE FLUID PRESSURES ACTING ON THE DISC BRAKE CYLINDERS OF THE RIGHT
FRONT WHEEL, LEFT FRONT WHEEL AND REAR WHEELS WHEN THE BRAKES ARE APPLIED IN A PANIC STOP SO THAT THE
WHEELS DO NOT LOCK. THIS RESULTS IN IMPROVED DIRECTIONAL STABILITY AND STEERABILITY DURING PANIC BRAKEING.
1. INPUT SIGNALS
(1) SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL
THE SPEED OF THE WHEELS IS DETECTED AND INPUT TO TERMINALS FL+, FR+, RL+ AND RR+ OF THE ABS ECU.
(2) STOP LIGHT SW SIGNAL
A SIGNAL IS INPUT TO TERMINAL STP OF THE ABS ECU WHEN BRAKE PEDAL IS OPERATED.
(3) PARKING BRAKE SW SIGNAL
A SIGNAL IS INPUT TO TERMINAL PKB OF THE ABS ECU WHEN THE PARKING BRAKE IS OPERATED.
2. SYSTEM OPERATION
DURING SUDDEN BRAKEING THE ABS ECU, WHICH HAS SIGNALS INPUT FROM EACH SENSOR, CONTROLS THE CURRENT
FLOWING TO THE SOLENOID INSIDE THE ACTUATOR AND LETS THE HYDRAULIC PRESSURE ACTING ON EACH WHEEL CYLINDER
ESCAPE TO THE RESERVOIR. THE PUMP INSIDE THE ACTUATOR IS ALSO OPERATING AT THIS TIME AND IT RETURNS THE BRAKE
FLUID FROM THE RESERVOIR TO THE MASTER CYLINDER, THUS PREVENTING LOCKING OF THE VEHICLE WHEELS.
IF THE ECU JUDGES THAT THE HYDRAULIC PRESSURE ACTING ON THE WHEEL CYLINDER IS INSUFFICIENT, THE CURRENT
ACTING ON THE SOLENOID IS CONTROLLED AND THE HYDRAULIC PRESSURE IS INCREASED. HOLDING OF THE HYDRAULIC
PRESSURE IS ALSO CONTROLLED BY THE ECU, BY THE SAME METHOD AS ABOVE. BY REPEATED PRESSURE REDUCTION,
HOLDING AND INCREASE ARE REPLATED TO MAINTAIN VEHICLE STABILITY AND TO IMPROVE STEERBILITY DURING SUDDEN
BRAKING.
SERVICE HINTS
A 4(A), A 5(B) ABS ACTUATOR
(A)1, (A)3, (A)4, (A)6 – (A)2 : APPROX. 6 Ω
(A)2–GROUND : APPROX. 5 Ω
A 6(B), A 7(A) ABS RELAY
(A)1–(B) 3 : 60 Ω–100 Ω
(A)4–(B) 3 : 60 Ω–100 Ω
(A)1, (B) 2–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS
(A)6–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS
A 8, A 9 ABS SPEED SENSOR FRONT LH, RH
1–2 : 0.8 K–1.3 KΩ
A19, A20 ABS SPEED SENSOR REAR LH, RH
1–2 : 1.1 K–1.5 KΩ
A13(A), A14(B) ABS ECU
(CONNECT THE ECU CONNECTORS)
(A) 5–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION AND DATA LINK CONNECTOR 1 (CHECK CONNECTOR)
TS–EI NOT CONNECTED
(B)15–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION AND DATA LINK CONNECTOR 1 (CHECK CONNECTOR)
TS–EI NOT CONNECTED
(A) 1–GROUND, (A) 13–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION AND ABS WARNING LIGHT GOES OFF
(A)14–GROUND, (A) 1–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION AND ABS WARNING LIGHT GOES OFF
(A)26–GROUND, (A) 18–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION AND ABS WARNING LIGHT GOES OFF
(A) 2–GROUND : ALWAYS CONTINUITY
(A)15–GROUND : ALWAYS CONTINUITY
(A)12–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
(B) 6–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH BRAKE PEDAL DEPRESSED
(A)25–GROUND : ALWAYS APPROX. 12 VOLTS
212
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
A19
CODE
34
SEE PAGE
A4
A
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
A5
B
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
34
N2
A
33
A6
B
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
C9
A
32
N3
B
33
A7
A
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
C10
B
32
P2
33
A20
J3
33
A8
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
D1
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
P3
33
A9
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
D3
32
S10
33
A13
A
32
F10
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
A14
B
32
J1
33
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
1A
1B
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
22
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
24
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 3 (BEHIND COMBINATION METER)
1M
2G
3B
3C
3D
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
EC1
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
ENGINE WIRE AND ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE
II1
42
COWL WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
IJ1
42
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND COWL WIRE
IP3
44
ENGINE WIRE AND COWL WIRE
IR2
44
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE AND COWL WIRE
IS1
44
FLOOR NO. 2 WIRE AND COWL WIRE
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
EA
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
FRONT RIGHT FENDER
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
E4
E6
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
38 (1MZ–FE)
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE
CODE
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
E6
40 (5S–FE)
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE
I21
44
COWL WIRE
I25
44
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE
213
ABS (ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM) (TMM MADE)
F18
FUSE BOX
60A ABS
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
15A
STOP
15A
ECU–IG
1
3 1M
2 A
6 1M
B–R
G–R
G–W
7 1A
1 A
N2 A
16 3C
,N3 B
NOISE FILTER
(FOR STOP LIGHT)
2 B
1 B
15 3C
B–R
2
G–W
7 3C
1
G–R
W–L
19 3C
S10
STOP LIGHT SW
G–W
G–W
15 1A
1
IR2
B–R
IR1
G–W
19
W–L
7 EC1
1 B
9 A
2 B
+BS
STP
IG
A4 A
, A5
B
ABS ACTUATOR AND ECU
FR+
FR–
11 A
5 A
FL+
FL–
13 A
7 A
R
G
(SHIELDED)
I14
(SHIELDED)
W–B
W–B
IR2
6
IR2
5
IR2
B
W
W–B
7
(SHIELDED)
W–B
R
G
I21
6
2
1
A9
ABS SPEED SENSOR
FRONT RH
214
2
1
A8
ABS SPEED SENSOR
FRONT LH
IJ1
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
D1
DATA LINK CONNECTOR 1
(CHECK CONNECTOR)
D3
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 2
(CHECK
CONNECTOR)
TS
IP3
3
WA
23
R–G
Y–B
8
C
WB
16
LG–R
11
IP1
6 1B
22
3 EC1
3
R–L
TC
4
IP3
C
G–B
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
G–B
I13
G–B
Y–B
LG–R
C
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–L
TC
SHORT PIN
G–B
ABS
10A
GAUGE
G–W
14
16 3D
6 A
3 3C
C9
G–W
R–G
17 3D
A , C10
B
ABS WARNING
LIGHT
(COMB. LIGHT)
13 3C
12 3C
4 B
G–B
LG–R
17 3C
G–B
12 IR1
4 IR2
12 A
15 A
3 B
1 A
TC
TS
LP
W
A4
G–B
R–G
IR2
LG–R
2
A ,A5
B
ABS ACTUATOR AND ECU
RR–
GND
14 A
4 B
(SHIELDED)
W–B
B
R
RR+
6 A
W
RL–
2 A
G
RL+
4 A
(SHIELDED)
W–B
W–B
13
IR1
20 IR1
3
IR2
I13
8 IR2
(SHIELDED)
W–B
B
R
G
W
(SHIELDED)
IJ1
12
IJ1
4
IS1
6
IS1
5
1
IS1
2
A19
ABS SPEED SENSOR
REAR RH
B
W
(SHIELDED)
G
(SHIELDED)
R
19
1
2
A20
ABS SPEED SENSOR
REAR LH
EA
215
ABS (ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM) (TMM MADE)
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
A4
A5
SEE PAGE
CODE
A
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
C9
B
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
C10
SEE PAGE
A
32
B
CODE
SEE PAGE
J3
33
32
N2
A
33
A8
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
D1
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
N3
B
33
A9
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
D3
32
A19
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
F18
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
A20
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
J1
33
S10
33
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
1A
1B
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
24
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO
NO. 3 (BEHIND COMBINATION METER)
1M
3C
3D
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
EC1
IJ1
IP1
IP3
IR1
IR2
IS1
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
ENGINE WIRE AND ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE
42
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND COWL WIRE
44
ENGINE WIRE AND COWL WIRE
44
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE AND COWL WIRE
44
FLOOR NO. 2 WIRE AND COWL WIRE
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
EA
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
FRONT RIGHT FENDER
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
I13
I14
216
SEE PAGE
44
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
COWL WIRE
CODE
I21
SEE PAGE
44
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
COWL WIRE
217
ABS (ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM) (TMM MADE)
SYSTEM OUTLINE
THIS SYSTEM CONTROLS THE RESPECTIVE BRAKE FLUID PRESSURES ACTING ON THE DISC BRAKE CYLINDERS OF THE RIGHT
FRONT WHEEL, LEFT FRONT WHEEL AND REAR WHEELS WHEN THE BRAKES ARE APPLIED IN A PANIC STOP SO THAT THE
WHEELS DO NOT LOCK. THIS RESULTS IN IMPROVED DIRECTIONAL STABILITY AND STEERABILITY DURING PANIC BRAKEING.
1. INPUT SIGNALS
(1) SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL
THE SPEED OF THE WHEELS IS DETECTED AND INPUT TO TERMINALS FL+, FR+, RL+ AND RR+ OF THE ABS ECU.
(2) STOP LIGHT SW SIGNAL
A SIGNAL IS INPUT TO TERMINAL STP OF THE ABS ECU WHEN BRAKE PEDAL IS OPERATED.
2. SYSTEM OPERATION
DURING SUDDEN BRAKEING THE ABS ECU, WHICH HAS SIGNALS INPUT FROM EACH SENSOR, CONTROLS THE CURRENT
FLOWING TO THE SOLENOID INSIDE THE ACTUATOR AND LETS THE HYDRAULIC PRESSURE ACTING ON EACH WHEEL CYLINDER
ESCAPE TO THE RESERVOIR. THE PUMP INSIDE THE ACTUATOR IS ALSO OPERATING AT THIS TIME AND IT RETURNS THE BRAKE
FLUID FROM THE RESERVOIR TO THE MASTER CYLINDER, THUS PREVENTING LOCKING OF THE VEHICLE WHEELS.
IF THE ECU JUDGES THAT THE HYDRAULIC PRESSURE ACTING ON THE WHEEL CYLINDER IS INSUFFICIENT, THE CURRENT
ACTING ON THE SOLENOID IS CONTROLLED AND THE HYDRAULIC PRESSURE IS INCREASED. HOLDING OF THE HYDRAULIC
PRESSURE IS ALSO CONTROLLED BY THE ECU, BY THE SAME METHOD AS ABOVE. BY REPEATED PRESSURE REDUCTION,
HOLDING AND INCREASE ARE REPLATED TO MAINTAIN VEHICLE STABILITY AND TO IMPROVE STEERBILITY DURING SUDDEN
BRAKING.
SERVICE HINTS
A 8, A 9 ABS SPEED SENSOR FRONT LH, RH
1–2 : 0.8 K–1.3 KΩ
A19, A20 ABS SPEED SENSOR REAR LH, RH
1–2 : 1.1 K–1.5 KΩ
A 4(A), A 5(B) ABS ECU
(CONNECT THE ECU CONNECTORS)
(A)12–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION AND DATA LINK CONNECTOR 1 (CHECK CONNECTOR)
TS–EI NOT CONNECTED
(A)15–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION AND DATA LINK CONNECTOR 1 (CHECK CONNECTOR)
TS–EI NOT CONNECTED
(B) 4–GROUND : ALWAYS CONTINUITY
(B) 2–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
(A) 9–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH BRAKE PEDAL DEPRESSED
(B) 1–GROUND : ALWAYS APPROX. 12 VOLTS
218
ABS ( ANTI – LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM) (TMM MADE)
-Memo
37
ELECTRIC TENSION REDUCER
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
15A
ECU–IG
B–R
7 1A
16 3C
14
3A
B–R
B–R
5 3D
3
IS1
B–R
IJ1
B–R
1
2
2
T2
TENSION
REDUCER
SOLENOID LH
1
R
1
T3
TENSION
REDUCER
SOLENOID RH
D25
DIODE
(FOR TENSION REDUCER)
G
1
R–Y
2
2
2
1
1
W–B
BL
220
B10
BUCKLE
SW RH
W–B
B 7, B 8
BUCKLE
SW LH
* 1 W/ POWER SEAT
* 2 W/O POWER SEAT
SERVICE HINTS
B 7, B 8 BUCKLE SW LH
1–2 : CLOSED WITH DRIVER’S LAP BELT IN USE
B10 BUCKLE SW RH
1–2 : CLOSED WITH PASSENGER’S LAP BELT IN USE
T 2, T 3 TENSION REDUCER SOLENOID LH, RH
2–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
B7
32
B10
32
T2
35
B8
32
D25
32
T3
35
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
1A
3A
3C
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
24
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO
NO. 3 (BEHIND COMBINATION METER)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
IJ1
42
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND COWL WIRE
IS1
44
FLOOR NO. 2 WIRE AND COWL WIRE
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
46 (S/D)
BL
48 (C/P)
UNDER THE LEFT QUARTER PILLAR
50 (W/G)
(* 1)
B7
(* 2) B 8
2 1
1
B10
D25 BLACK
1
2
1
2
T2
T3
2
1
2
1
2
X X
221
AUTO ANTENNA (S/D, C/P)
* 1 : 6 SPEAKER
* 2 : 4 SPEAKER
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
20A
DOME
15A
CIG/RADIO
1 1L
9 1L
S8
STEREO COMPONENT
AMPLIFIER
1 1C
L–R
B–R
R
2 2G
15A
ECU–IG
ACC
12 1K
9
II2
9
II2
W
L–R
R
13
R2
RADIO AND PLAYER (* 1)
B
II2
B–R
3
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
8
R
B
3
A
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
1 IU1
RADIO SW
B–R
8
R
1
OFF
GR
L–R
IM2
ON
PLAYER
SW
2 IU1
(* 1)
P–L
(* 1)
B–R
L–R
B–R
R
9 IM2
R3
RADIO AND PLAYER (* 2)
GR
3
B–R
8
RADIO SW
OFF
(* 2)
P–L
(* 2)
IU1
B–R
L–R
B–R
P–L
6
4
3
1
R–G
B
R–W
W–B
1
4
5
7
8
6
R
5
Y
10 IU1
2
2
A21
AUTO ANTENNA MOTOR
AND CONTROL RELAY
222
IU1
L–Y
9
L
M
B
W–B
3
W–B
3
9
ON
PLAYER
SW
BM
SERVICE HINTS
A21 AUTO ANTENNA MOTOR AND RELAY
9–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
5–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ACC OR ON POSITION
7–GROUND : ALWAYS APPROX. 12 VOLTS
8–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ACC OR ON POSITION AND RADIO SW ON
3–GROUND : CONTINUITY (UPPER LIMIT SW ON) UNLESS ANTENNA AT UP STOP
2–GROUND : CONTINUITY (DOWN LIMIT SW ON) UNLESS ANTENNA AT DOWN STOP
4–3 : CLOSED WITH IGNITION SW AT ACC OR ON POSITION AND RADIO SW ON AND PLAYER SW OFF UNTIL ANTENNA AT
UPPERMOST POSITION
1–2 : CLOSED WITH IGNITION SW AT ACC OR ON POSITION AND RADIO SW OFF AND PLAYER SW OFF UNTIL ANTENNA AT
LOWERMOST POSITION
1–2: CLOSED WITH IGNITION SW OFF UNTIL ANTENNA AT LOWERMOST POSITION
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
A21
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
R2
33
J3
33
R3
33
CODE
S8
SEE PAGE
33
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
1C
1K
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
22
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
1L
2G
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
II2
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE AND COWL WIRE
IM2
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE AND CONSOLE BOX WIRE
IU1
44
FLOOR NO. 2 WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
BM
SEE PAGE
46 (S/D)
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
UNDER THE LEFT QUARTER PILLAR
48 (C/P)
A21
1
J3
2
A A B
3 4 5 6
R2
R3
B
A A B B B B
(HINT : SEE PAGE 7)
BLUE
3
1
8
3
8
9
X
S8
X
X 9
223
AUTO ANTENNA (W/G)
* 1 : 8 SPEAKER
* 2 : 6 SPEAKER
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
20A
DOME
15A
ECU–IG
1 1L
9 1L
S8
STEREO COMPONENT
AMPLIFIER
1 1C
L–R
B–R
R
2 2G
15A
CIG/RADIO
ACC
6 1H
9
II2
9
II2
W
L–R
13
R2
RADIO AND PLAYER (* 1)
B
B
3
B
8
B–R
IM2
R
1 IG1
RADIO SW
8
OFF
GR
L–R
R
B–R
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
ON
PLAYER
SW
1
2 IG1
(* 1)
P–L
(* 1)
B–R
L–R
B–R
9 IM2
R3
RADIO AND PLAYER (* 2)
GR
3
B–R
8
RADIO SW
OFF
(* 2)
P–L
(* 2)
B–R
L–R
B–R
P–L
5
6
4
3
1
R–G
B
R–W
W–B
1
4
5
7
8
6
R
2
Y
10 IG1
L–Y
A21
AUTO ANTENNA MOTOR
AND RELAY
9 IG1
9
ON
PLAYER
SW
W–B
C
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
L
M
B
3
W–B
2
BL
224
SERVICE HINTS
A21 AUTO ANTENNA MOTOR AND RELAY
9–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
5–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ACC OR ON POSITION
7–GROUND : ALWAYS APPROX. 12 VOLTS
8–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ACC OR ON POSITION AND RADIO SW ON
3–GROUND : CONTINUITY (UPPER LIMIT SW ON) UNLESS ANTENNA AT UP STOP
2–GROUND : CONTINUITY (DOWN LIMIT SW ON) UNLESS ANTENNA AT DOWN STOP
4–3 : CLOSED WITH IGNITION SW AT ACC OR ON POSITION AND RADIO SW ON AND PLAYER SW OFF UNTIL ANTENNA
AT UPPERMOST POSITION
1–2 : CLOSED WITH IGNITION SW AT ACC OR ON POSITION AND RADIO SW OFF AND PLAYER SW OFF UNTIL ANTENNA
AT LOWERMOST POSITION
1–2 : CLOSED WITH IGNITION SW OFF UNTIL ANTENNA AT LOWERMOST POSITION
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
A21
36 (W/G)
J5
36 (W/G)
R3
33
J3
33
R2
33
S8
33
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
1C
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
1H
20
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
1L
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
2G
22
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
II2
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE AND COWL WIRE
IM2
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE AND CONSOLE BOX WIRE
IG1
42
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
46 (S/D)
48 (C/P)
BL
UNDER THE LEFT QUARTER PILLAR
50 (W/G)
A21
1
J3
2
J5
B
3 4 5 6
R2
B
B B B B
C C
C C
C C
C
C
1
3
C C
(HINT : SEE PAGE 7)
8
X
(HINT : SEE PAGE 7)
R3
BLUE
3
S8
X
X 9
8
9
225
RADIO AND PLAYER (S/D, C/P 6 SPEAKER)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
TO AUTO ANTENNA MOTOR
AND RELAY
15A
CIG/RADIO
B–R
20A
DOME
2 2G
9 1L
B–R
R
9 IU1
L–R
1 1C
8 IM2
B–R
12 1K
R
TO AUTO ANTENNA MOTOR
AND RELAY
R2
RADIO AND PLAYER
8
ANT
II2
ACC
3
B
MUTE
FR
5
FL
7
RR
6
RL
15
14
BR
B
L
G
Y
3 A
9 A
B
AMP
S8
R
1 A
ACC
12 A
4 A
6 A
5 A
14 A
13 A
(SHIELDED)
I15
7 A
11 A
W
B
R
(SHIELDED)
R
R
10 B
BEEP
13
I15
GR
3 IM2
L–Y
GR
B
4 IM2
SGND
12
A , S9
ACC
10 A
GND
SGND
BEEP
MUTE
FR
FL
RR
RL
B
STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
LG
L
1
2
F10
FRONT DOOR
SPEAKER LH
IH
226
2
R12
REAR SPEAKER
LH
1
L
9
LG
2
R13
REAR SPEAKER
RH
IT2
IT2
1
2
F13
FRONT TWEETER
(SPEAKER) RH
1
2
F11
FRONT DOOR
SPEAKER RH
L
V
F12
FRONT TWEETER
(SPEAKER) LH
1
4
LG
B
V
P
P
BR
2
5 B
L
17 IG1
W
7 IG1
R
18 IG1
Y
8 IG1
P
13 IH1
1 B
LG
W
5 IM2
W
R
1 IM2
R
Y
3 IM1
Y
1 IM1
B
6 IM1
1
4 B
FR–
2 IM1
IH1
3 B
FR+
6 IM2
8
9 B
RR–
2 IM2
7 IM2
8 B
RR+
2 B
V
6 B
RL–
7 B
B
RL+
V
FL–
P
FL+
BR
E
(SHIELDED)
9 IM2
A
GND
11
W
B
B
4
1
BR
A
AMP
P–L
L–R
9
R
II2
L–Y
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
3
SERVICE HINTS
S 8(A), S 9(B) STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
(A) 7–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON OR ACC POSITION
(B) 7–GROUND : ALWAYS CONTINUITY
(B)10–GROUND : ALWAYS APPROX. 12 VOLTS
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
F10
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
J3
33
S8
A
33
S9
B
33
F11
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
R2
33
F12
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
R12
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
F13
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
R13
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
1C
1K
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
22
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
1L
2G
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
IG1
42
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
IH1
42
FRONT DOOR LH WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
II2
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE AND COWL WIRE
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE AND CONSOLE BOX WIRE
IT2
44
FRONT DOOR RH WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
IU1
44
FLOOR NO. 2 WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
IM1
IM2
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
IH
SEE PAGE
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE RH
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
I15
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
44
CODE
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
CONSOLE BOX WIRE
F10, F11 BLACK
F12, F13
J3
A A B
R2
B
A A B B B B
1
1
2
(HINT : SEE PAGE 7)
2
S8 A
1 X 3
R12, R13
BLUE
1
8
3 4
X 11 12 13
5 6
7
2 1
14 15
S9 B
4 5 6
7 X 9 10 11 12 13 14
1 2
3 4
5 6 7 8 9 10
227
RADIO AND PLAYER (S/D, C/P 4 SPEAKER)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
20A
DOME
15A
CIG/RADIO
9 1L
R
2 2G
L–R
1 1C
R
12 1K
A
B
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IU1
BR
IH
228
RR–
W
R
2
R12
REAR SPEAKER
LH
1
2
R13
REAR SPEAKER
RH
FR–
1 B
5 B
4
L
R
17 IG1
1
FR+
3 A
7 IG1
B
F10
FRONT DOOR
SPEAKER LH
RR+
1 A
18 IG1
V
2
RL–
6 A
8 IG1
V
P
BR
1
RL+
2 A
13 IH1
P
IH1
A
ACC
Y
FL–
6 B
B , R4
RADIO AND PLAYER
Y
FL+
B
R3
IT2
9
IT2
L
ANP
2 B
8
3 B
B
E
7 B
4 B
LG
9 B
GR
P–L
8 B
B
L–Y
B–R
A
ANT
II2
LG
10
9
W
9 IU1
II2
L–R
P–L
B–R
3
R
TO AUTO ANTENNA MOTOR
AND RELAY
1
2
F11
FRONT DOOR
SPEAKER RH
SERVICE HINTS
R 3(B) RADIO AND PLAYER
(B) 3–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON OR ACC POSITION
(B) 4–GROUND : ALWAYS APPROX. 12 VOLTS
(B) 7–GROUND : ALWAYS CONTINUITY
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
F10
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
R3
F11
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
R4
J3
33
SEE PAGE
B
33
A
33
R12
CODE
R13
SEE PAGE
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
1C
1K
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
22
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
1L
2G
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
IG1
42
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
IH1
42
FRONT DOOR LH WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
II2
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE AND COWL WIRE
IT2
44
FRONT DOOR RH WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
IU1
44
FLOOR NO. 2 WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
IH
SEE PAGE
42
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE RH
F10, F11 BLACK
J3
A A B
R3 B
B
1
2
5
6
BLUE
3
4
R4 A
1
BLUE
R12, R13
2
A A B B B B
1
2
7
8
9
3
X
6
2 1
(HINT : SEE PAGE 7)
229
RADIO AND PLAYER (W/G 8 SPEAKER)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
TO AUTO ANTENNA MOTOR
AND RELAY
L–R
1 1C
B–R
B–R
8 IM2
R2
RADIO AND PLAYER
8
R
12 1K
9 IG1
B–R
9 1L
R
2 2G
15A
CIG/RADIO
TO AUTO ANTENNA MOTOR
AND RELAY
20A
DOME
ANT
II2
B
ACC
4
GND
3
11
B
5
FR
FL
7
RR
6
15
RL
14
B
L
G
Y
12 A
4 A
6 A
5 A
14 A
13 A
(SHIELDED)
3 A
AMP
S8
BR
1 A
ACC
R
7 A
11 A
W
B
R
(SHIELDED)
R
I15
R
10 B
MUTE
I15
GR
3 IM2
L–Y
GR
B
4 IM2
BEEP
13
A ,S9
9 A
B
10 A
ACC
GND
SGND
BEEP
MUTE
FR
FL
RR
RL
B
STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
RL+
7 IM2
8 IH1
2 IM1
6 IM1
Y
Y
9 B
8 IG1
18 IG1
13 IH1
D
Y
6 IM2
RL–
8 B
B
V
2 IM2
V
6 B
B
2 B
B
7 B
P
FL–
P
FL+
BR
E
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
E
D
E
B
Y
4 Bc3
Y
1 Bc3
4 Bd1
1 Bd1
1
IH
230
2
F11
FRONT DOOR
SPEAKER LH
1
2
R14
REAR TWEETER
(SPEAKER) LH
Y
B
V
B
F13
FRONT TWEETER
(SPEAKER) LH
P
Y
5 Bc3
10 Bc3
B
2
E
Y
1
B
V
P
BR
D
1
2
R12
REAR SPEAKER
LH
(SHIELDED)
9 IM2
A
SGND
12
W
B
1
BR
A
AMP
P–L
L–R
9
R
II2
L–Y
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
3
S8
A ,S9
B
STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
RR–
R
17
IG1
1
IM2
5 IM2
B
L
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
LG
W
R
IG1
A
5 B
LG
W
3 IM1
FR–
1 B
W
R
1 IM1
7
FR+
4 B
L
RR+
3 B
B
A
4
IT2
9
IT2
L
LG
W
1 Bb1
1
2
F14
FRONT TWEETER
(SPEAKER) RH
W
2 Bd1
2 Bb1
R
W
L
LG
R
5 Bd1
R
3 Bc3
W
9 Bc3
R
W
B
R
A
1
2
R13
REAR SPEAKER
RH
1
2
R15
REAR TWEETER
(SPEAKER) RH
1
2
F12
FRONT DOOR
SPEAKER RH
231
RADIO AND PLAYER (W/G 8 SPEAKER)
SERVICE HINTS
S 8(A), S 9(B) STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
(A) 7–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON OR ACC POSITION
(B) 7–GROUND : ALWAYS CONTINUITY
(B)10–GROUND : ALWAYS APPROX. 12 VOLTS
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
F11
36 (W/G)
F12
F13
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
J5
36
R15
36 (W/G)
36 (W/G)
R2
33
S8
A
33
36 (W/G)
R12
36 (W/G)
S9
B
33
F14
36 (W/G)
R13
36 (W/G)
J3
33
R14
36 (W/G)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
1C
1K
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
22
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
1L
2G
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
IG1
42
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
IH1
42
FRONT DOOR LH WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
II2
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE AND COWL WIRE
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE AND CONSOLE BOX WIRE
IM1
IM2
IT2
44
FRONT DOOR RH WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
Bb1
50 (W/G)
LUGGAGE ROOM NO. 1 WIRE AND FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE
Bc3
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE
Bd1
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND BACK DOOR NO. 2 WIRE
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
IH
SEE PAGE
42
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE RH
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
I15
232
SEE PAGE
44
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
CONSOLE BOX WIRE
CODE
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
RADIO AND PLAYER (W/G 6 SPEAKER)
SERVICE HINTS
R 3(B) RADIO AND PLAYER
(B) 3–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON OR ACC POSITION
(B) 4–GROUND : ALWAYS APPROX. 12 VOLTS
(B) 7–GROUND : ALWAYS CONTINUITY
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
F11
36 (W/G)
R3
F12
36 (W/G)
R4
J3
33
R12
36 (W/G)
J5
36
R13
36 (W/G)
CODE
SEE PAGE
B
33
R14
36 (W/G)
A
33
R15
36 (W/G)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
1C
1K
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
22
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
1L
2G
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
IG1
42
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
IH1
42
FRONT DOOR LH WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
II2
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE AND COWL WIRE
IT2
44
FRONT DOOR RH WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
IU1
44
FLOOR NO. 2 WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
Bb1
50 (W/G)
LUGGAGE ROOM NO. 1 WIRE AND FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE
Bc3
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE
Bd1
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND BACK DOOR NO. 2 WIRE
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
IH
SEE PAGE
42
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE RH
233
RADIO AND PLAYER (W/G 6 SPEAKER)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
20A
DOME
9 1L
R
2 2G
15A
CIG/RADIO
L–R
1 1C
R
12 1K
A
B
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
9 IU1
10 IU1
B
B–R
P–L
4 B
GR
B
L–Y
A
P–L
II2
B–R
9
L–R
II2
R
3
TO AUTO ANTENNA MOTOR
AND RELAY
3 B
8 B
9 B
ACC
R3
ANT
B , R4
ANP
A
RADIO AND PLAYER
RL+
RL–
8 IG1
18 IG1
D
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
Y
Y
6 A
B
2 A
B
V
FL–
6 B
P
FL+
2 B
BR
E
7 B
E
D
E
13 IH1
B
Y
1 Bc3
10 Bc3
4 Bc3
B
Y
4 Bd1
1 Bd1
B
B
1
2
BR
F11
FRONT DOOR
SPEAKER LH
IH
234
1
2
R14
REAR TWEETER
(SPEAKER) LH
Y
Y
5 Bc3
Y
E
B
D
V
P
8 IH1
1
2
R12
REAR SPEAKER
LH
R3
B ,R4
A
RADIO AND PLAYER
RR+
RR–
A
FR–
1 B
5 B
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IG1
L
W
17
LG
R
IG1
R
7
FR+
3 A
W
1 A
B
B
A
4
W
1 Bb1
2 Bb1
L
IT2
W
R
2 Bd1
9
R
W
5 Bd1
IT2
LG
R
3 Bc3
W
9 Bc3
R
W
B
R
A
1
2
R13
REAR SPEAKER
RH
1
2
R15
REAR TWEETER
(SPEAKER) RH
1
2
F12
FRONT DOOR
SPEAKER RH
235
COMBINATION METER
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
6 1D
6 1B
R–L
R–L
10A
GAUGE
FROM ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
(ENGINE AND ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION ECU)(A/T)
FROM ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
(ENGINE ECU)(M/T)
FROM CRUISE CONTROL ECU
C
2
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IP3
V–Y
R–L
B , C10 C
7 C
5 A
12 A
4 C
12 3C
Y–G
IP3
14
IP3
(* 6)
G–B
TAC
(* 7)
B
A
C14
COOLING FAN
ECU
(* 6)
A
ED
236
LG
2
3
6
I2
IGNITER
J7
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
BR
BR
4
F15
FUEL SENDER
B
IP3
R–L
V5
VEHICLE SPEED
SENSOR
(SPEED SENSOR)
5
IP3
1
1
R–L
16
(* 6)
3
(* 7)
2
B
BR
1
IP1
BR
Y–L
12 3D
8
P
W2
WATER TEMP.
SENDER
13 3D
3 BX1
Y–R
2 BX1
BR
Y–L
Y–R
1
1 BX1
Y–B
R–W
13 3C
11
Y–B
IJ1
O1
OIL PRESSURE
SW
18
TO INTEGRATION
RELAY
IJ1
12 1D
B
11
IP3
I9
BR
IJ1
10 B
G–B
G–B
6
5
7 B
13 1D
BR
Y–L
Y–R
I9
BR
OIL
ABS
SPEED
11 B
G
8 C
Y–G
6 A
SEAT BELT
4 A
TACHO
WATER TEMP.
7 A
BR
8 A
BR
FUEL
FUEL
A ,C9
COMBINATION METER
TO ABS ECU
C8
6 B
B
R–L
C
I18
R–L
TO BACK–UP LIGHT SW (M/T)
TO PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW
(NEUTRAL START SW)(A/T)
TO GENERATOR (ALTERNATOR)
5 1M
8 1C
1
8 3D
II1
2
8 3C
I6
1
D
E
B
B
II1
(CANADA)
E
(USA)
1 C
W–B
D
HIGH BEAM
R–Y
(CANADA)
R–G
(USA)
FROM ” HEAD (UPR–RH)” FUSE
FROM ” HEAD RH” FUSE
W–R
2 C
R–B
SRS
9 B
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
8 B
B–Y
10 A
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B–O
7. 5A
IGN
TO DIMMER SW
[COMB. SW]
10 3A
CHARGE
(* 1)
3 1D
TO CENTER AIRBAG
SENSOR ASSEMBLY
R–W
Y
(* 1)
10A
STARTER
B–Y
8
O/D OFF
TO LIGHT FAILURE
SENSOR
B–W
1
TO GENERATOR (ALTERNATOR)
PKB
Y
R–Y
G–O
A
(* 2)
BRK
G–O
12 B
G–O
G–O
18
D4
DAYTIME RUNNING
LIGHT RELAY
(MAIN)
(CANADA)
G–O
A
(1MZ–FE A/T)
Y–G
3 B
TO O/D MAIN SW
4
REAR LIGHT
B–W
B , C10 C
15 B
P2
PARKING
BRAKE SW
A
(USA)
BULB
CHECK
BRAKE
20 3B
FROM A/T
INDICATOR LIGHT
IE
R–Y
R–Y
2 3C
R–W
2
R–W
R–Y
(* 3)
COMBINATION METER
(EX. 1MZ–FE A/T)
F
R–W
F
P3
PARKING
BRAKE SW
19 3D
B2
BRAKE FLUID
LEVEL SW
1
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
19 3B
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
18 3D
W–B
(* 5)
3 C
W–B
8 3B
G–R
(* 4)
O
CRUISE
A ,C9
W–B
(* 5)
9 A
G–R
(* 4)
O
G–L
C8
TO ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
(ENGINE AND ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION ECU)(A/T)
TO ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
(ENGINE ECU)(M/T)
TO CRUISE CONTROL ECU
G–L
* 1 : W/O A/T INDICATOR LIGHT
* 2 : W/ A/T INDICATOR LIGHT
* 3 : MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP
(CHECK ENGINE WARNING LIGHT)
*4
*5
*6
*7
:
:
:
:
TMC MADE
TMM MADE
1MZ–FE
5S–FE
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
7. 5A
SRS
4
3 1F
13 B
14 B
IF
237
W–B
TO RHEOSTAT
R–Y
C8
238
A ,C9
B , C10 C
13 A
11 A
R
2 A
1 A
3 A
2 1D
6 3D
8 1L
18 3C
11 1C
1 1M
IG
OPEN DOOR
G
G–B
L–R
R
FROM HAZARD SW (TL)
FROM HAZARD SW (TR)
I13
TURN LH
16 B
L–R
G–Y
4 3C
6
II1
(* 1)
L–R
5 3D
TURN RH
11
1D
(* 1)
G
10
1D
POWER
METER
ILLUMINATION
20 3D
R
TO ENGINE CONTROL
MODULE (ENGINE AND
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION ECU)
FROM ELECTRONIC
CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION PATTERN
SELECT SW
14 1D
W–B
B
L–R
G
15A
TAIL
TO DOOR COURTESY SW
W–B
B
G
COMBINATION METER
* 1 : W/O A/T INDICATOR
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
20A
DOME
2 2G
1 1C
5 1C
9 3D
14 3C
16 3A
4 B
COMBINATION METER
5 B
SERVICE HINTS
B 2 BRAKE FLUID LEVEL SW
1–2 : CLOSED WITH FLOAT DOWN
C 8(A), C 9(B), C10(C) COMBINATION METER
(A)2, (B)6, (B)9–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH IGNITION SW AT ON POSITION
(A)3, (B)14, (C)8–GROUND : ALWAYS CONTINUITY
F15 FUEL SENDER
2–3 : APPROX. 3 WITH FUEL FULL
APPROX. 110.0 WITH FUEL EMPTY
O 1 OIL PRESSURE SW
1–GROUND : CLOSED WITH OIL PRESSURE BELOW 0.2 KG/CM2 (2.84 PSI, 19.61 KPA)
P 2 PARKING BRAKE SW (1MZ–FE A/T)
1–GROUND : CLOSED WITH PARKING BRAKE PEDAL DEPRESSED
P 3 PARKING BRAKE SW (EX. 1MZ–FE A/T)
1–GROUND : CLOSED WITH PARKING BRAKE LEVER PULLED UP
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
B2
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
D4
32
P2
33
C8
A
32
F15
34 (S/D), 35 (C/P), 36 (W/G)
P3
33
C9
B
32
I2
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
V5
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
C10
C
32
J2
33
W2
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
32
O1
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
C14
: RELAY BLOCKS
CODE
1
SEE PAGE
25
RELAY BLOCKS (RELAY BLOCK LOCATION)
R/B NO. 1 (LEFT KICK PANEL)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
1B
1C
1D
1F
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO.
NO 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
22
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
24
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO
NO. 3 (BEHIND COMBINATION METER)
1L
1M
2G
3A
3B
3C
3D
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
II1
42
COWL WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
IJ1
42
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND COWL WIRE
44
ENGINE WIRE AND COWL WIRE
IP1
IP3
46 (S/D)
BX1
48 (C/P)
FUEL GAUGE WIRE AND FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE
50 (W/G)
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
ED
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
INTAKE MANIFOLD LH
IE
IF
IG
42
LEFT KICK PANEL
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE LH
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
I6
44
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
I13
44
COWL WIRE
I9
44
COWL WIRE
I18
44
ENGINE WIRE
239
COMBINATION METER
240
RADIATOR FAN AND CONDENSER FAN (5S–FE)
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
A1
30
E5
30 (5S–FE)
A2
30 (5S–FE)
R1
30 (5S–FE)
CODE
SEE PAGE
: RELAY BLOCKS
CODE
5
SEE PAGE
26
RELAY BLOCKS (RELAY BLOCK LOCATION)
R/B NO. 5 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
1A
2B
2E
3A
3C
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
22
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE AND J/B NO
NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
24
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO
NO. 3 (BEHIND COMBINATION METER)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
EA1
SEE PAGE
40 (5S–FE)
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE AND ENGINE ROOM NO. 3 WIRE
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
EB
SEE PAGE
40 (5S–FE)
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
FRONT LEFT FENDER
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
E5
SEE PAGE
40 (5S–FE)
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE
241
RADIATOR FAN AND CONDENSER FAN (5S–FE)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
15A
ECU–IG
30A
CDS FAN
30A
RDI FAN
4 2B
B–R
7 1A
W
16 3C
15 3A
B–O
2
M
6 2G
1
5
2E
1
L
3
2
4
8 2E
3 2B
R
RADIATOR
FAN RELAY
5
1 2B
B
L
A2
A/C SINGLE
PRESSURE SW
B–R
L–B
5
6 2E
2
2
3
4
RADIATOR
FAN RELAY
NO. 2
1
B–R
W–R
B–W
B–R
FROM A/C
MAGNETIC
CLUTCH RELAY
5
2
R1
RADIATOR
FAN MOTOR
5
M
1
RADIATOR
FAN RELAY
NO. 3
1
2
3
E5
WATER
TEMP. SW
(FOR COOLING
FAN)
5
W–B
B–R
W–B
5
1 EA1
2
5
B
5
W–B
E5
W–B
W–B
5
5
5
3
1
A1
A/C CONDENSER
FAN MOTOR
EB
242
W–B
W–B
2 EA1
EB
SYSTEM OUTLINE
FAN MOTOR OPERATION
WITH THE IGNITION SW IS TURNED ON, CURRENT FLOWS FROM ECU–IG FUSE TO RADIATOR FAN RELAY NO. 1 (COIL SIDE) AND
RADIATOR FAN RELAY NO. 2 (COIL SIDE) → TERMINAL 2 OF THE A/C SINGLE PRESSURE SW → TERMINAL 3 → TERMINAL 2 OF THE
WATER TEMP. SW → TERMINAL 1 → GROUND, AND RADIATOR FAN RELAY NO. 1 AND NO. 2 ARE TURNED ON.
∗ RADIATOR FAN MOTOR OPERATION
WHEN THE IGNITION SW IS TURNED ON, RADIATOR FAN RELAY NO. 1 IS TURNED ON. IF AT THIS TIME THE ENGINE COOLANT
TEMPERATURE IS APPROX. 90°C (194°F) OR HIGHER, THE WATER TEMP. SW IS TURNED OFF, RADIATOR FAN RELAY NO. 1 IS
TURNED OFF.
AS A RESULT, CURRENT FROM THE RDI FAN FUSE TO RADIATOR FAN RELAY NO. 1 (POINT SIDE) → TERMINAL 2 OF THE
RADIATOR FAN MOTOR → TERMINAL 1 → GROUND, THUS ACTIVATING THE ROTATION OF THE RADIATOR FAN MOTOR.
∗ LOW SPEED OPERATION
WHEN THE IGNITION SW IS TURNED ON AND THE A/C ACTIVATED, RADIATOR FAN RELAY NO. 1 AND RADIATOR FAN RELAY NO. 2
ARE TURNED ON, CURRENT FLOWS FROM A/C MAGNETIC CLUTCH RELAY (POINT SIDE) TO RADIATOR FAN RELAY NO. 3 (COIL
SIDE) → GROUND, AND RADIATOR FAN RELAY NO. 3 IS TURNED ON.
AS A RESULT, CURRENT FLOWS FROM CDS FAN FUSE TO TERMINAL 2 OF THE A/C CONDENSER FAN MOTOR → TERMINAL 1 →
RADIAOTR FAN RELAY NO. 2 (POINT SIDE) → RADIATOR FAN RELAY NO. 3 (POINT SIDE) → TERMINAL 2 OF THE RADIATOR FAN
MOTOR → TERMINAL 1 → GROUND, FLOWING TO EACH FAN MOTOR IN SERIES, CAUSING THE FAN TO AT LOW SPEED.
∗ HIGH SPEED OPERATION OF THE FAN MOTOR DUARING A/C OPERATION
WHEN THE A/C OPERATION, THE REFRIGERRANT PRESSURE BECOME HIGHER THAN OR DINARY LEVEL (APPROX. 15.58 KG/CM2
(221.2 PSI, 1527 KPA)) THE A/C SINGLE PRESSURE SW IS TURNED OFF. AS A RESULT, RADIATOR FAN RELAY NO. 1 AND RADIATOR
FAN RELAY NO. 2 ARE TURNED OFF, AND CURRENT FLOWS FROM RDI FUSE TO RADIATOR FAN RELAY NO. 1 (POINT SIDE) →
TERMINAL 2 OF THE RADIATOR FAN MOTOR → TERMINAL 1 → GROUND, AND CURRENT FLOWS FROM CDS FAN FUSE TO
TERMINAL 2 OF THE A/C CONDENSER FAN MOTOR → TERMINAL 1 → RADIATOR FAN RELAY NO. 2 (POINT SIDE) → GROUND, AND
TO EACH FAN MOTOR IN PARALLEL, THUS CAUSING THE FAN MOTORS OPERATE HIGH SPEED.
NOTE THAT, BECAUSE THE CURRENT FLOWS IN THE SAME MENNER EVEN IF THE ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE IS APPROX.
90°C (194°F) OR HIGHER, THE FAN MOTOR OPERATE AT HIGH SPEED.
SERVICE HINTS
A 2 A/C SINGLE PRESSURE SW
2–3 : OPEN ABOVE APPROX. 15.58 KG/CM2 (221.2 PSI, 1527 KPA)
CLOSE BELOW APPROX. 15.56 KG/CM2 (178.4 PSI, 1231 KPA)
A1
1
BLACK
A2
BLACK
2
E5
1
2
R1
GRAY
2
3
1
2
243
ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED HYDRAULIC COOLING FAN (1MZ–FE)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
15A
ECU–IG
B–R
7 1A
TO COMBINATION
METER
FROM THROTTLE
POSITION SENSOR
16 3C
FROM ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
(ENGINE AND ELECTRONIC
CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION ECU)
L
L
I18
IP2
L
W–R
7
B
B–R
15 3A
1
6
IGB
TAC
5
IDL
SOL–
2
3
10
TH–
TH+
HP
9
8
Y–L
L–R
BR
L–W
SOL+
L–Y
E
4
Y
C14
COOLING FAN ECU
I18
L–W
L–R
1
1
L–W
8 EC1
2
6
3
2
OPT
S1
SOLENOID VALVE
(FOR HYDRAULIC MOTOR)
D1
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 1
(CHECK
CONNECTOR)
A2
A/C SINGLE
PRESSURE SW
2
BR
W–B
E5
ENGINE COOLANT
TEMP. SENSOR
(WATER TEMP. SENSOR)
(FOR COOLING FAN)
EC
244
EB
SYSTEM OUTLINE
THE COOLING FAN ECU RECEIVES VARIOUS SIGNAL, I.E., THE ENGINE RPM SIGNAL FROM THE IGNITER, COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SIGNAL FROM THE ENGINE COOLANT TEMP. SENSOR (WATER TEMP. SENSOR), A/C REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SIGNAL FROM A/C
SINGLE PRESSURE SW.
THE COOLING FAN ECU JUDGES THE ENGINE BASED ON SIGNALS FROM ABOVE MENTION, DRIVES THE SOLENOID VALVE AND
CONTROLS THE SPEED OF THE COOLING FAN STEPLESSLY
FAIL–SAFE FUNCTION
WHEN THE MALFANCTION IS DETECTED BY THE ENGINE COOLANT TEMP. SENSOR (WATER TEMP. SENSOR) OR SOLENOID VALVE,
THE FAIL–SAFE FUNCTION OF THE COOLING FAN ECU JUDGES THE SITUATION TO ALLOWS THE COOLING SYSTEM TO CONTINUE
OPERATION.
SERVICE HINTS
A 2 A/C SINGLE PRESSURE SW
2–3 : OPEN ABOVE APPROX. 15.58KG/CM2 (221.2PSI, 1527KPA)
CLOSED BELOW APPROX. 12.56 KG/CM2 (178.4PSI, 1231KPA)
C14 COOLING FAN ECU
1–GROUND : APPROX. 12 VOLTS WITH THE IGNITION SW ON
9–10 : 2.5 VOLTS AT 20°C (68°F) AND IGNITION SW ON
1.2 VOLTS AT 80°C (176°F) AND IGNITION SW ON
8– 4 : 10–14 VOLTS AT A/C PRESSURE SW ON (OPEN)
0–3 VOLTS AT A/C PRESSURE SW OFF (CLOSE)
4–GROUND : ALWAYS CONTINUITY
E 5 ENGINE COOLANT TEMP. SENSOR (WATER TEMP. SENSOR) (FOR COOLING FAN)
1–2 : 1.5K AT 80°C (176°F)
0.7K AT 110°C (230°F)
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
A2
28
D1
28
C14
32
E5
30
CODE
S1
SEE PAGE
29
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
SEE PAGE
1A
3A
3C
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
24
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO
NO. 3 (BEHIND COMBINATION METER)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
SEE PAGE
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
EC1
38 (1MZ–FE)
ENGINE WIRE AND ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE
IP2
44
ENGINE WIRE AND COWL WIRE
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
EB
38 (1MZ–FE)
FRONT LEFT FENDER
EC
38 (1MZ–FE)
INTAKE MANIFOLD RH
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
I18
44
A2
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
BLACK
C14 GRAY
1 2
D1
BLACK
E5
BROWN
S1
1
3 4
5 6 X 8 9 10
2
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
ENGINE WIRE
1
3
6
X
X
X
X
X
2
2
X
X
X
X
245
AIR CONDITIONING (PUSH CONTROL SW TYPE)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
B
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
40A
HEATER
10A
GAUGE
4
4
L
R–L
6 1B
4
5
R–L
4
1
R–L
I5
HEATER
RELAY
R–L
2
4
3
4
C
4
R–L
I7
C
B
4
I7
R–L
R–L
B4
BLOWER MOTOR
B
W–B
R–L
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–L
B
I21
C
2
W–B
L–W
M
R–L
B–R
1
5
B5
BLOWER RESISTOR
IK1
1
W–B
12
2
3
L–O
L–B
B–W
3
IK1
IK1
4
B–W
W–B
I13
W–B
1
2
W–B
4
M4
M3
M2
M1
LO
OFF
I14
7
L–W
5
W–B
I13
W–B
M5
L–B
L–O
B6
BLOWER SW
W–B
I12
B–W
I14
HI
IK1
W–B
IK1
II
246
W–B
2
1
W–B
B
6
IG
W–B
1
H8
HEATER CONTROL SW
W–B
B
R–L
R–B
4
R–W
3
A16
AIR INLET CONTROL
SERVO MOTOR
FRESH/RECIRC
10A
A/C
R–L
M
DEF
F/D
FOOT
B/L
FACE
F
L–Y
4
3
2
M
R–L
4
A17
AIR VENT MODE CONTROL SERVO MOTOR
R
R
4
DEF
F/D
FOOT
B/L
R–L
R–L
7
IL1
W–B
6
CONTROL
CIRCUIT
FACE
B
5
IL1
5
4
3
2
G–W
R
L–W
6
11
A/C
RECIRC/FRESH
IL1
FACE
3
10
2
BI–LEVEL
FOOT
L–O
L–Y
5
L–B
R–W
4
2
IL1
L–R
R–B
8
1
3
IL1
L
Y–G
4
IL1
7
1
R–Y
7
B–Y
A
L–B
W–B
6
IL1
R
R–L
9
FOOT/DEF
DEF
H8
HEATER CONTROL SW
W–B
W–B
247
248
W–B
I2
IGNITER
8
TACH
4
G
2
8
9
13
14
12
2
4
4
12 1D
IP1
6
TAC C14
COOLING FAN
ECU
IP3
B–W(* 2)
B–W
R–L
L–Y
R–L
R–L
R–W
5
5
3
5
5
7
G
I19
L–Y
(* 2)
B–W
R–L
B–Y
L–Y
(* 2)
L–B(* 1)
TO RADIATOR
FAN RELAY NO. 3
W–L(* 2)
4
TO ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
(ENGINE AND ELECTRONIC
CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION
ECU)(A/T)
OR ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
(ENGINE ECU)(M/T)
1 1B
LG–B
10
L–W(* 1)
W–L
W–R
IR1
FROM ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
(ENGINE AND ELECTRONIC
CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION
ECU)(A/T)
OR ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
(ENGINE ECU)(M/T)
5
B
W–R
IP3
(* 1)
B
9
(* 2)
B
A11
A/C EVAPORATOR
TEMP. SENSOR
W–R
L–W
1
R–B
R–L
B
W–B
2
R–W
AIR CONDITIONING (PUSH CONTROL SW TYPE)
E6
* 1 : 1MZ–FE
* 2 : 5S–FE
R–B
5
1
A/C MAGNETIC
CLUTCH RELAY
2
5
B–W
(* 1)
W–R
4 EC1
1
4
A3
A/C MAGNETIC
CLUTCH AND
LOCK SENSOR
A2
A/C DUAL
PRESSURE SW
1
4
IR1
6
A10
A/C AMPLIFIER
1
IR1
SYSTEM OUTLINE
1. AIR INLET CONTROL SERVO MOTOR OPERATION (FOR PUSH SW TYPE)
(SWITCHING FROM FRESH TO RECIRC)
WITH THE IGNITION SW ON, CURRENT FROM THE GAUGE FUSE FLOWS TO TERMINAL 1 OF THE SERVO MOTOR. WHEN THE
RECIRC SW IS TURNED ON, THE CURRENT FLOWS FROM SERVO MOTOR → TERMINAL 3 → TERMINAL 5 OF THE HEATER
CONTROL SW → TERMINAL 1 → GROUND, THE MOTOR ROTATES AND THE DAMPER MOVES TO THE RECIRC SIDE. WHEN IT IS IN
THE RECIRC POSITION, THE CIRCUIT IS CUT INSIDE THE SERVO MOTOR AND THE DAMPER STOPS IN THAT POSITION.
WHEN THE CIRCUIT FOR THE INDICATOR LIGHT, CURRENT FLOWS FROM THE GAUGE FUSE → TERMINAL 12 OF THE HEATER
CONTROL SW → INDICATOR LIGHT → TERMINAL 1 → GROUND AND THE INDICATOR LIGHT CONTINUES TO LIGHT UP WHILE THE
RECIRC SW IS ON.
(SWITCHING FROM RECIRC TO FRESH)
WHEN THE IGNITION IS ON AND THE FRESH SW IS TURNED ON, CURRENT FLOWS FROM TERMINAL 2 OF THE SERVO MOTOR →
TERMINAL 6 OF THE HEATER CONTROL SW → TERMINAL 1 → GROUND, THE MOTOR ROTATES AND THE DAMPER MOVES TO THE
FRESH SIDE. WHEN THE DAMPER IS IN THE FRESH POSITION, THE CIRCUIT IS CUT INSIDE THE SERVO MOTOR AND THE DAMPER
STOPS IN THAT POSITION.
2. OPERATION OF AIR VENT MODE CONTROL SERVO MOTOR
WHEN THE IGNITION SW ON, CURRENT FLOWS FROM THE GAUGE FUSE TO TERMINAL 12 OF THE HEATER CONTROL SW,
TERMINAL 6 OF THE AIR VENT MODE CONTROL SERVO MOTOR.
WHEN THE DAMPER IS IN FACE POSITION AND THE BI–LEVEL OF THE HEATER CONTROL SW IS THEN TURNED ON, CURRENT
FLOWS FROM TERMINAL 3 OF THE HEATER CONTROL SW → TERMINAL 4 OF THE AIR VENT MODE CONTROL SERVO MOTOR SO
THAT A SINGAL THAT THE GROUND CIRCUIT IS ACTIVATED IS INPUT TO TERMINAL “B” OF THE CONTROL CIRCUIT INSIDE THE AIR
VENT MODE CONTROL SERVO MOTOR.
SIMULTANEOUSLY, A SIGNAL THAT THE GROUND CIRCUIT IS NOT ACTIVATED IS INPUT TO TERMINAL “A” OF THE CONTROL
CIRCUIT INSIDE THE SERVO MOTOR. THESE TWO SIGNALS ACTIVATE THE CONTROL CIRCUIT SO THAT CURRENT FROM THE
GAUGE FUSE TO THE SERVO MOTOR, CAUSING THE SERVO MOTOR TO OPERATE AND THE DAMPER TO MOVE TO BI–LEVEL
POSITION. WHEN THE DAMPER REACHES BI–LEVEL POSITION, A GROUND CUT SIGNAL IS INPUT TO TERMINAL “B” OF THE
CONTROL CIRCUIT, THE CONTROL CIRCUIT OPERATES, THE SERVO MOTOR STOPS ROTATING AND THE DAMPER STOPS AT
BI–LEVEL.
WHEN ANOTHER MODE POSITION IS SWITCHED TO, INPUT OF SIGNALS TO TERMINAL “A” AND TERMINAL “B” OF THE CONTROL
CIRCUIT THAT GROUND IS MADE OR GROUND IS NOT MADE (AS EXPLAINED ABOVE) ACTIAVTES THE CONTROL CIRCUIT AND
MOVES THE SERVO MOTOR TO THE DESIRED POSITION.
3. AIR CONDITIONING OPERATION
WHEN THE IGNITION SW ON, CURRENT FLOWS FROM GAUGE FUSE TO TERMINAL 12 OF THE HEATER CONTROL SW, TERMINAL 6
OF THE AIR VENT MODE CONTROL SERVO MOTOR.
WHEN THE BLOWER SW IS ON, CURRENT FLOWS FROM THE GAUGE FUSE → HEATER RELAY (COIL SIDE) → TERMINAL 7 OF THE
BLOWER SW → TERMINAL 5 → GROUND, ACTIVATING THE HEATER RELAY. THIS CAUSES CURRENT TO FLOW FROM THE HEATER
FUSE TO THE HEATER RELAY (POINT SIDE) → A/C FUSE → TERMINAL 7 OF THE HEATER CONTROL SW (A/C SW). IF THE HEATER
CONTROL (A/C SW) IS THEN TURNED ON AT THIS TIME, A SIGNAL IS INPUT TO THE A/C AMPLIFIRE. THIS ACTIVATES THE A/C
AMPLIFIER AND A/C MAGNETIC CLUTCH RELAY SO THAT CURRENT FLOWS FROM THE GAUGE FUSE TO THE A/C MAGNETIC
CLUTCH RELAY (POINT SIDE) → A/C MAGNETIC CLUTCH, CAUSING THE COMPRESSOR TO OPERATE. THE VSV (FOR A/C IDLE–UP)
IS TURNED ON SIMULTANEOUSLY TO PREVENT A DECREASE IN ENGINE SPEED DUE TO A/C OPERATION.
SERVICE HINTS
HEATER RELAY
(4)5– (4)4 : CLOSED WITH THE IGNITION SW ON AND BLOWER SW ON
A/C MAGNETIC CLUTCH RELAY
(4)5– (4)3 : CLOSED WITH THE IGNITION SW ON AND BLOWER SW ON AND A/C SW ON
A 2 A/C DUAL PRESSURE SW
1–4 : OPEN WITH PRESSURE 2.1 KG/CM (30 PSI, 206 KPA) OR ABOVE 27 KG/CM (384 PSI, 2646 KPA)
B 5 BLOWER RESISTOR
6–2 : APPROX. 1.12 Ω
2–3 : APPROX. 0.5 Ω
3–1 : APPROX. 0.2 Ω
249
AIR CONDITIONING (PUSH CONTROL SW TYPE)
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
A2
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
A17
32
CODE
SEE PAGE
H8
33
A3
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
B4
32
I2
30 (5S–FE)
A10
32
B5
32
J1
33
A11
32
B6
32
A16
32
C14
32
: RELAY BLOCKS
CODE
SEE PAGE
RELAY BLOCKS (RELAY BLOCK LOCATION)
4
25
R/B NO. 4 (RIGHT KICK PANEL)
5
26
R/B NO. 5 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
1B
1D
SEE PAGE
20
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO.
NO 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
EC1
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
ENGINE WIRE AND ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE
IK1
42
COWL WIRE AND A/C SUB WIRE
IL1
42
COWL WIRE AND SERVO MOTOR SUB WIRE
44
ENGINE WIRE AND COWL WIRE
44
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE AND COWL WIRE
IP1
IP3
IR1
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
IG
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE LH
II
42
RIGHT KICK PANEL
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
E6
I5
I7
250
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
44
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE
COWL WIRE
CODE
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
I12
I13
I14
I19
44
COWL WIRE
251
AIR CONDITIONING (LEVER CONTROL SW TYPE)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 64)
R–L
B
40A
HEATER
10A
GAUGE
4
R–L
4
5
4
1
2
A17
AIR VENT MODE CONTROL SERVO MOTOR
HEATER
RELAY
4
3
6
4
IL1
B
4
M
FACE
L–W
B
DEF
F/D
FOOT
B/L
B
I21
W–B
R–L
I5
R–L
4
I7
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–L C
C R–L
R–L
6 1B
L
4
R–L
6
CONTROL
CIRCUIT
B5
BLOWER RESISTOR
B
DEF
F/D
FOOT
B/L
A
2
2
6
1
3
G
L
Y
FACE
B4
BLOWER
MOTOR
B
M
IK1
4
L–B
L–O
B–W
W–B
I12
W–B
4
M1
LO
3
G–W
R
IL1
IL1
4
5 IL1
IL1
4
5
6
7
8
OFF
I14
L–W
W–B
1
DEF F/D FOOT B/L FACE
W–B
B6
BLOWER SW
I13
W–B
W–B
2
I13
1
252
IL1
W–B
8
M2
W–B
5
HI
3
II
1
W–B
IL1
B–W
I14
L–B
IK1
7
B–W
5
L–W
2
4
L
IK1
3
L–R
3
L–B
IK1
2
L–O
1
1
B–Y
W–B
7
R–Y
1
IG
H8
AIR VENT MODE
CONTROL SW
W–B
I19
2
13
8
I2
IGNITER
4
4
1 1B
12 1D
IP1
W–B
4
6
FACH
TAC C14
COOLING FAN
ECU
G
2
4
A3
A/C MAGNETIC
CLUTCH AND
LOCK SENSOR
14
7
A2
A/C DUAL
PRESSURE SW
B–W
(* 2)
5
G
W–R
(* 2)
L–Y
R–L
4
L–Y
2
B–W(* 2)
TO RADIATOR FAN
RELAY NO. 3
B–W
R–L
4
B–Y
5
IP3
L–B(* 1)
10A
A/C
W–L(* 2)
R–L
IR1
TO ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
(ENGINE AND ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION ECU)(A/T)
OR ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
(ENGINE ECU)(M/T)
9
LG–B
L–W(* 1)
W–R
Y–G
4
FROM ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
(ENGINE AND ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION ECU)(A/T)
OR ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
(ENGINE ECU)(M/T)
W–L
W–R
9
B
B
A11
A/C EVAPORATOR
TEMP. SENSOR
A12
A/C SW
(* 1)
B
8
B
10
5
OFF
ON
2
L–W
1
R–B
R–W
R–L
(* 2)
W–B
* 1 : 1MZ–FE
* 2 : 5S–FE
R–L
B
E6
1
5
5
A/C MAGNETIC
CLUTCH RELAY
5
1
3
2
B–W
5
5
(* 1)
W–R
4 EC1
1
1
4
IR1
6
IR1
1
IP3
12
2
A10
A/C AMPLIFIER
1
253
AIR CONDITIONING (LEVER CONTROL SW TYPE)
SYSTEM OUTLINE
CURRENT ALWAYS FLOWS FROM THE HEATER FUSE TO TERMINAL 5 OF THE HEATER RELAY. WHEN THE IGNITION SW IS TURNED
ON, CURRENT FLOWS FROM GAUGE FUSE TO TERMINAL 2 OF THE AIR VENT MODE CONTROL SERVO MOTOR AND A/C MAGNETIC
CLUTCH RELAY (COIL SIDE) → TERMINAL 12 OF THE A/C AMPLIFIER, TERMINAL 1 OF THE A/C DUAL PRESSURE SW → TERMINAL 4
→ TERMINAL 2 OF THE A/C AMPLIFIER, HEATER RELAY (COIL SIDE) → TERMINAL 3 OF THE BLOWER SW.
1. OPERATION OF AIR VENT MODE CONTROL SERVO MOTOR
WHEN THE DAMPER IS IN FACE POSITION AND THE BI–LEVEL OF THE AIR VENT MODE CONTROL SW IS THEN TURNED ON,
CURRENT FLOWS FROM TERMINAL 7 OF THE AIR VENT MODE CONTROL SW → TERMINAL 5 OF THE AIR VENT MODE CONTROL
SERVO MOTOR SO THAT A SIGNAL THAT THE GROUND CIRCUIT IS ACTIVATED IS INPUT TO TERMINAL “B” OF THE CONTROL
CIRCUIT INSIDE THE AIR VENT MODE CONTROL SERVO MOTOR. SIMULTANEOUSLY, A SIGNAL THAT THE GROUND CIRCUIT IS NOT
ACTIVATED IS INPUT TO TERMINAL “A” OF THE CONTROL CIRCUIT INSIDE THE SERVO MOTOR. THESE TWO SIGNALS ACTIVATE
THE CONTROL CIRCUIT SO THAT CURRENT FROM THE GAUGE FUSE TO THE SERVO MOTOR, CAUSING THE SERVO MOTOR TO
OPERATE AND THE DAMPER TO MOVE TO BI–LEVEL POSITION. WHEN THE DAMPER REACHES BI–LEVEL POSITION. A GROUND
CUT SIGNAL IS INPUT TO TERMINAL “B” OF THE CONTROL CIRCUIT, THE CONTROL CIRCUIT OPERATES, THE SERVO MOTOR
STOPS ROTATING AND THE DAMPER STOPS AT BI–LEVEL.
WHEN ANOTHER MODE POSITION IS SWITCHED TO, INPUT OF SIGNALS TO TERMINAL “A” AND TERMINAL “B” OF THE CONTROL
CIRCUIT THAT GROUND IS NOT MADE (AS EXPLAINED ABOVE) ACTIVATES THE CONTROL CIRCUIT AND MOVES THE SERVO
MOTOR TO THE DESIRED POSITION.
2. AIR CONDITIONING OPERATION
WHEN THE BLOWER SW IS ON, CURRENT FLOWS THE GAUGE FUSE → HEATER RELAY (COIL SIDE) → TERMINAL 3 OF THE
BLOWER SW → TERMINAL 1 → GROUND, ACTIVATING THE HEATER RELAY. THIS CAUSES CURRENT TO FLOW FROM THE HEATER
FUSE TO THE HEATER RELAY (POINT SIDE) → A/C FUSE → TERMINAL 2 OF THE A/C SW. IF THE A/C SW IS THEN TURNED ON AT
THIS TIME. A SIGNAL IS INPUT TO THE A/C AMPLIFIER. THIS ACTIVATES THE A/C AMPLIFER AND A/C MAGNETIC CLUTCH RELAY SO
THAT CURRENT FLOWS FROM THE GAUGE FUSE TO THE A/C MAGNETIC CLUTCH RELAY (POINT SIDE) → A/C MAGNETIC CLUTCH.
CAUSING THE COMPRESSOR TO OPERATE. THE VSV (FOR A/C IDLE–UP) IS TURNED ON SIMULTANEOUSLY TO PREVENT A
DECREASE IN ENGINE SPEED DUE TO A/C OPERATION.
SERVICE HINTS
HEATER RELAY
(4)5– (4)4 : CLOSED WITH THE IGNITION SW ON AND BLOWER SW ON
A/C MAGNETIC CLUTCH RELAY
(5)5– (5)3 : CLOSED WITH THE IGNITION SW ON AND BLOWER SW ON AND A/C SW ON
A 2 A/C DUAL PRESSURE SW
1–4 : OPEN WITH PRESSURE 2.1 KG/CM (30 PSI, 206 KPA) OR ABOVE 27 KG/CM (384 PSI, 2646 KPA)
B 5 BLOWER RESISTOR
6–1 : APPROX. 3.17 Ω
6–3 : APPROX. 1.38 Ω
2–6 : APPROX. 0.38 Ω
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
A2
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
A17
32
CODE
SEE PAGE
H8
33
A3
28 (1MZ–FE), 30 (5S–FE)
B4
32
I2
30 (5S–FE)
A10
32
B5
32
J1
33
A11
32
B6
32
A12
32
C14
32
: RELAY BLOCKS
CODE
SEE PAGE
RELAY BLOCKS (RELAY BLOCK LOCATION)
4
25
R/B NO. 4 (RIGHT KICK PANEL)
5
26
R/B NO. 5 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
1B
1D
254
SEE PAGE
20
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO.
NO 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
EC1
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
ENGINE WIRE AND ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE
IK1
42
COWL WIRE AND A/C SUB WIRE
IL1
42
COWL WIRE AND SERVO MOTOR SUB WIRE
44
ENGINE WIRE AND COWL WIRE
44
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE AND COWL WIRE
IP1
IP3
IR1
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
SEE PAGE
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
IG
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE LH
II
42
RIGHT KICK PANEL
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
E6
I5
I7
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
44
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE
COWL WIRE
CODE
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
I13
I14
44
COWL WIRE
I19
255
* 1 : TMC MADE
* 2 : TMM MADE
* 3 : W/ POWER WINDOW
GROUND POINT
HIGH BEAM INDICATOR
LIGHT [COMB. METER]
W–B
LIGHT CONTROL SW
[COMB. SW]
W–B
* 4 : W/O POWER WINDOW
* 5 : AIR CONDITIONING (PUSH CONTROL SW TYPE)
* 6 : AIR CONDITIONING (LEVER CONTROL SW TYPE)
4
IK1
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
I12
W–B
I5
BLOWER SW
7
IL1
W–B
I13
W–B
W–B
W–B
KEY INTERLOCK
SOLENOID
I5
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 3
W–B
W–B
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
I7
W–B
I7
W–B
REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER SW
W–B
6
3C
F
6
3D
13
COMBINATION METER
W–B
W–B
6
W–B
CIRCUIT OPENING
RELAY
DAYTIME RUNNING
LIGHT RELAY (MAIN)
(CANADA)
14
3B
W–B
CRUISE CONTROL
CLUCH SW
8 1C
18 3C
5 1M
W–B
6
IV2
(* 2)
W–B
(* 2)
(* 1)
6
IV1
W–B
6
1I
W–B
W–B
I13
CRUISE CONTROL ECU
CRUISE CONTROL SW
[COMB. SW]
W–B
W–B
5
W–B
3B
W–B
W–B
2
1F
B 4 : S/D
B30 : W/G
B20 : C/P
W–B
12
3A
W–B
W–B
VANITY LIGHT RH
W–B
I7
W–B
CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY (E2)
3A
W–B
W–B
1
TURN SIGNAL FLASHER
STARTER RELAY
F
I7
W–B
BRAKE FLUID LEVEL
SW
1
2F
W–B
I7
W–B
CIGARETTE LIGHTER
A/C AMPLIFIER
F
W–B
CLOCK
W–B
I13
10
W–B
1C
DEFOGGER RELAY
VANITY LIGHT LH
I 7 : *5
I14 : * 6
W–B
W–B
AIR VENT MODE CONTROL
SERVO MOTOR
HEATER CONTROL SW
(PUSH CONTROL SW
TYPE) OR AIR VENT
MODE CONTROL SW
(LEVER CONTROL SW
TYPE)
W–B
WIPER AND WASHER SW
[COMB. SW]
BLOWER RESISTOR
I5
W–B
DIMMER SW
[COMB. SW]
W–B
W–B
11
1C
I13
(W/G)(S/D, C/P)
NOISE FILTER
IE
MOON ROOF
CONTROL RELAY
W–B
POWER MAIN RELAY
B 5 : S/D
B21 : C/P
B32 : W/G
INTEGRATION RELAY
W–B
MOON ROOF CONTROL SW
AND PERSONAL LIGHT
W–B
W–B
4
W–B
B 4 : S/D
B21 : C/P
B31 : W/G
MOON ROOF LIMIT SW
1G
W–B
MOON ROOF MOTOR
W–B
W–B
1
1M
1
1F
W–B
UNLOCK WARNING SW
[IGNITION SW]
W–B
CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY (E1)
W–B
RADIO AND PLAYER
STEREO COMPONENT
AMPLIFIER
BK : S/D, C/P
BP : W/G
BR
(W/O CD PLAYER)
BR
7
IM2
BR
(W/ CD PLAYER)
IH
256
W–B
IG
II
4
HEATER RELAY
W–B
B
B
W–B
19
W–B
W–B
DOOR KEY LOCK
AND UNLOCK SW RH
W–B
DOOR LOCK CONTROL
SW RH
W–B
DOOR LOCK MOTOR
AND DOOR UNLOCK
DETECTION SW
FRONT RH
IT1
W–B
RHEOSTAT
B11 : EX. C/P
B27 : C/P
A/T INDICATOR LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
W–B
B
GLOVE BOX LIGHT
SW
W–B
B
REMOTE CONTROL
MIRROR SW
W–B
B11 : EX. C/P
B27 : C/P
W–B
B
W–B
B
W–B
BACK DOOR LOCK
CONTROL SW
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
DOOR KEY CYLINDER
LIGHT AND SW
DOOR KEY LOCK AND
UNLOCK SW LH
W–B
B1
W–B
POWER WINDOW
MASTER SW AND DOOR
LOCK CONTROL SW LH
B
W–B
W–B
(W/G)
IJ
BUCKLE SW
16
W–B
IH2
B 1 : * 4 EX. C/P
B 2 : * 3 EX. C/P
B18 : * 3 C/P
B
W–B
W–B
DOOR LOCK
CONTROL RELAY
POWER SEAT SW
B 1 : EX. C/P
B18 : C/P
W–B
SHIFT LOCK ECU
B
W–B
O/D MAIN SW
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IF
5
W–B
DOOR LOCK MOTOR
AND DOOR UNLOCK
DETECTION SW
FRONT LH
W–B
IO1
C
C
W–B
(W/O POWER SEAT)
W–B
C
W–B
C
W–B
(W/ POWER
SEAT)
LIGHT FAILURE
SENSOR
W–B
C
REAR COMBINATION
LIGHT LH
W–B
C
BUCKLE SW
AUTO ANTENNA MOTOR
AND RELAY
REAR WIPER RELAY
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
W–B
BX1
3
W–B
W–B
FUEL PUMP
5
W–B
Bb1
W–B
W–B
REAR COMBINATION
LIGHT RH
W–B
BL (W/G)
BQ (W/G)
W–B
3 Bc1
W–B
REAR WIPER MOTOR
4 Bd3
REAR COMBINATION
LIGHT LH
W–B
W–B
B38
W–B
B38
W–B
W–B
B38
W–B
REAR COMBINATION
LIGHT RH
W–B
HIGH MOUNT STOP
LIGHT
W–B
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT
LIGHT SW
B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
LICENSE PLATE LIGHT
BR (W/G)
REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER(–)
BS (W/G)
257
GROUND POINT
W–B
FRONT CLEARANCE
LIGHT RH
W–B
FRONT SIDE MARKER
RH
W–B
W–B (* 1)
E4
W–B
FRONT TURN SIGNAL
LIGHT RH
W–B (* 1)
E6
W–B (* 1)
I25
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B (* 1)
E4
W–B
W–B (* 2)
FRONT SIDE MARKER
LH
W–B
E4
W–B
(CANADA)
5
EB1
W–B
HEADLIGHT LO LH
W–B
7
7
DAYTIME RUNNING
LIGHT NO. 4
W–B
E4
7
W–B
(5S–FE)
2
4
W–B
2B
2E
W–B
E3
W–B
W–B
EFI MAIN RELAY
EB
W–B
(5S–FE)
W–B
E5
(5S–FE)
W–B
OXYGEN SENSOR
RADIATOR FAN RELAY
NO. 2
5
RADIATOR FAN RELAY
NO. 3
2
EA1
W–B
W–B
(5S–FE)
WATER TEMP. SW
(FOR COOLING FAN)
W–B
E5
NOISE FILER (FOR
IGNITION SYSTEM)
5
W–B
W–B
E5
ENGINE CONTROL
MODULE (ENGIN AND
ELECTRONIC
(E1)
CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION ECU)
(A/T)
ENGINE CONTROL
MODULE (ENGINE ECU)
(M/T)
CRUISE CONTROL
ACTUATOR
ENGINE MAIN RELAY
W–B
HEADLIGHT LO RH
(GND) ABS ACTUATOR
AND ECU
DAYTIME RUNNING
LIGHT RELAY NO. 3
W–B
RADIATOR FAN MOTOR
W–B
W–B
FRONT TURN SIGNAL
LIGHT LH
ABS ECU
(GND)
7
W–B
E4
(E)
EA
W–B
W–B
W–B
FRONT CLEARANCE
LIGHT LH
ABS RELAY
E4
W–B
FRON WIPER MOTOR
ABS ACTUATOR
BR
W–B
E5
A/C SINGLE
PRESSURE SW
(1MZ–FE)
BR
(5S–FE)
BR
3
3D
E17
BR
13
BR
I9
BR
I9
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 2 (TDCL)
BR
BR
BR
3D
BR
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 1
(CHECK CONNECTOR)
COMBINATION METER
12 3D
W–B
BR
EC
258
(5S–FE)
ED
3
BX1
BR
W–B
IP3
BR
BR
BR
BR
16
IJ1
BR
BR
18
(5S–FE)
W–B
FUEL SENDER
ENGINE CONTROL
MODULE (ENGINE
(E01) AND ELECTRONIC
CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION
ECU)(A/T)
(E02) ENGINE CONTROL
MODULE (ENGINE
ECU)(M/T)
NOISE FILTER (FOR
IGNITION SYSTEM)
IGNITER
HEATED OXYGEN
SENSOR
(BANK 1 SENSOR 1)
W–B
W–B
3
3D
E14
I7
BR
3
3D
BR
BR
I9
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 1
(CHECK CONNECTOR)
BR
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 2
BR
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 3
BR
I9
BR
BR
BR
HEAD OXYGEN
SENSOR
(BANK 2 SENSOR 1)
BR
BR
COMBINATION METER
12 3D
IJ1
BR
BR
BR
18
3
BR
BX1
A
A
J7
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
BR
A
(E01)
ENGINE CONTROL
MODULE ENGINE
(E02) AND ELECTRONIC
CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION
( ECU)
(E03)
BR
W–B
BR
BR
BR
BR
BR
ED
(1MZ–FE)
BR
BR
EC
(1MZ–FE)
BR
BR
I18
5
IQ1
5
BX1
W–B
HIGH MOUNT STOP
LIGHT
(W/ REAR SPOILER)
BUCKLE SW
W–B
B16
COOLING AFN ECU
BUCKLE SW RH
W–B
W–B
ENGINE CONTROL
MODULE ENGINE
(E1) AND ELECTRONIC
CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION
(ECU)
BR HEATED OXYGEN
SENSOR
(BANK 1 SENSOR 2)
W–B
FUEL PUMP
FUEL SENDER
W–B
REAR COMBINATION
LIGHT RH
W–B
REAR COMBINATION
LIGHT LH
W–B
HIGH MOUNT STOP
LIGHT
W–B
(W/O POWER SEAT)
W–B
W–B
5 IO1
AUTO ANTENNA MOTOR
AND RELAY
W–B
BL
W–B
B25
W–B
B25
W–B
7
BZ1
W–B
B28
(S/D, C/P)
B28
(S/D, C/P)
W–B
W–B
B
BN
(S/D, C/P)
W–B
LIGHT FAILURE
SENSOR
W–B
REAR COMBINATION
LIGHT LH
W–B
LICENSE PLATE
LIGHT LH
W–B
W–B
BM
REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER(–)
(W/O REAR SPOILER)
W–B
BUCKLE SW LH
4 Ba1
W–B
(W/ POWER
SEAT)
W–B
BUCKLE SW
W–B
B16
W–B
POWER SEAT SW
BO
B28
REAR COMBINATION
LIGHT RH
(S/D, C/P)
259
GROUND POINT
* 1 : TMC MADE
* 2 : TMM MADE
: PARTS LOCATION
CODE
SEE PAGE
CODE
SEE PAGE
J1
33
J5
36 (W/G)
J2
33
J7
33
: RELAY BLOCKS
CODE
SEE PAGE
RELAY BLOCKS (RELAY BLOCK LOCATION)
1
25
R/B NO. 1 (LEFT KICK PANEL)
4
25
R/B NO. 4 (RIGHT KICK PANEL)
5
26
R/B NO. 5 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
6
26
R/B NO. 6 (BEHIND GLOVE BOX)
7
27
R/B NO. 7 (NEAR THE BATTERY)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
CODE
SEE PAGE
JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
1C
1F
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
20 (*1)
ROOF WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL) TMC MADE
20 (*2)
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL) TMM MADE
20
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 1 (INSTRUMENT PANEL LEFT)
22
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE AND J/B NO
NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
22
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO. 2 (ENGINE COMPARTMENT LEFT)
24
COWL WIRE AND J/B NO
NO. 3 (BEHIND COMBINATION METER)
1G
1I
1M
2B
2E
2F
3A
3B
3C
3D
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
CODE
EA1
EB1
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS (CONNECTOR LOCATION)
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE AND ENGINE ROOM NO. 3 WIRE
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE AND RELAY WIRE
IH2
42
FRONT DOOR LH WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
IJ1
42
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND COWL WIRE
IK1
42
COWL WIRE AND A/C SUB WIRE
IL1
42
COWL WIRE AND SERVO MOTOR SUB WIRE
IM2
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE AND CONSOLE BOX WIRE
IO1
42
FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND SEAT WIRE
IP3
44
ENGINE WIRE AND COWL WIRE
IQ1
44
ENGINE WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
IT1
44
FRONT DOOR RH WIRE AND INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
IV1
44
ROOF WIRE AND COWL WIRE
IV2
44
ROOF WIRE AND COWL WIRE MADE IN USA
46 (S/D)
BX1
48 (C/P)
FUEL GAUGE WIRE AND FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE
50 (W/G)
BZ1
Ba1
46 (S/D)
48 (C/P)
46 (S/D)
48 (C/P)
LUGGAGE ROOM NO.
NO 1 WIRE AND FLOOR NO.
NO 1 WIRE
FLOOR NO.
NO 1 WIRE AND LUGGAGE ROOM NO.
NO 2 WIRE
Bb1
50 (W/G)
LUGGAGE ROOM NO. 1 WIRE AND FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE
Bc1
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND FLOOR NO. 1 WIRE
Bd3
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR NO. 1 WIRE AND BACK DOOR NO. 2 WIRE
260
CODE
SEE PAGE
: GROUND POINTS
CODE
EA
EB
EC
ED
IE
SEE PAGE
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
GROUND POINTS LOCATION
FRONT RIGHT FENDER
FRONT LEFT FENDER
INTAKE MANIFOLD RH
INTAKE MANIFOLD LH
42
LEFT KICK PANEL
IG
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE LH
IH
42
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE RH
42
RIGHT KICK PANEL
IF
II
IJ
BK
46 (S/D)
48 (C/P)
ROOF LEFT
46 (S/D)
BL
48 (C/P)
50 (W/G)
BM
BN
BO
UNDER THE LEFT QUARTER PILLAR
46 (S/D)
48 (C/P)
46 (S/D)
48 (C/P)
46 (S/D)
48 (C/P)
UNDER THE RIGHT QUARTER PILLAR
LEFT QUARTER PILLAR
BP
50 (W/G)
BACK PANEL CENTER
BQ
50 (W/G)
LOWER BACK PANEL CENTER
BR
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR CENTER
BS
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR RIGHT
: SPLICE POINTS
CODE
E3
E4
E5
SEE PAGE
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
38 (1MZ–FE)
B2
40 (5S–FE)
38 (1MZ–FE)
40 (5S–FE)
38 (1MZ–FE)
CODE
B4
ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE
B5
B11
40 (5S–FE)
SEE PAGE
46 (S/D)
50 (W/G)
46 (S/D)
46 (S/D)
50 (W/G)
WIRE HARNESS WITH SPLICE POINTS
FRONT DOOR LH WIRE
ROOF WIRE
FRONT DOOR RH WIRE
38 (1MZ–FE)
B16
46 (S/D)
LUGGAGE ROOM NO. 2 WIRE
40 (5S–FE)
B18
48 (C/P)
FRONT DOOR LH WIRE
E14
38 (1MZ–FE)
B21
48 (C/P)
ROOF WIRE
E17
40 (5S–FE)
48 (C/P)
FLOOR NO.
NO 1 WIRE
B27
48 (C/P)
FRONT DOOR RH WIRE
B28
48 (C/P)
LUGGAGE ROOM NO. 1 WIRE
50 (W/G)
ROOF WIRE
50 (W/G)
BACK DOOR NO. 2 WIRE
E6
ENGINE WIRE
I5
B26
I7
I9
44
COWL WIRE
I13
B30
I14
I18
B1
B25
B31
44
46 (S/D)
50 (W/G)
ENGINE WIRE
FRONT DOOR LH WIRE
B32
B38
261
OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
262
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
System Title
Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black L = Blue
R = Red
BR = Brown LG = Light Green V = Violet
G = Green O = Orange
W = White
GR = Gray
P = Pink
Y = Yellow
Junction Block (The number in the circle is the
J/B No. and connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Blocks are shaded to clearly
separate them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further
clarification.).
Example:
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and
the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Indicates the connector to be connected to a
part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
The position of the parts is the same as shown
in the wiring diagram and wire routing.
Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female
and male connectors.
Indicates related system.
Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows
Outside numerals are pin numbers.
is used to indicate different wiring and
connector, etc. when the vehicle model, engine
type, or specification is different.
Indicates a shielded cable.
The numbering system for the overall wiring diagram is the same as above.
Indicates a Relay Block. No Shading is used and
only the Relay Block No. is shown to distinguish
it from the J/B.
Indicates and located on ground point.
The same code occuring on the next page
indicates that the wire harness is continuous.
263
1994 Model (Location No. 1 to 36)
3–1 (1MZ–FE)
4–1 (5S–FE A/T and
California M/T)
5–1 (5S–FE Ex. A/T
and California M/T)
Rear Window Defogger
24–4 (W/G)
28–1 (S/D,C/P)
Rear Wiper and Washer
22–2
8–3 (for USA)
10–1 (for Canada)
Remote Control Mirror
20–1
Horn
18–4
Shift Lock
Illumination
15–2
SRS (Supplemental
Restraint System)
Interior Light
11–1 (S/D, C/P w/ Key
Illuminated Entry)
12–1 (W/G w/ Key
Illuminated Entry)
13–1 (S/D, C/P w/o Key
Illuminated Entry)
14–1 (W/G w/o Key
Illuminated Entry)
ABS
(Anti–Lock Brake System)
25–2 (TMC Made)
26–2 (TMM Made)
Engine Control
Air Conditioning
35–1(Lever Con–
trol SW Type)
36–1(Push Con–
trol SW Type)
Front Wiper and Washer
18–2
Headlight
Auto Antenna
27–3 (W/G)
28–3 (S/D,C/P)
Back–Up Light
Back Door Lock
(w/o Power Window)
Charging
6–7 (1MZ–FE)
7–7 (5S–FE)
22–4 (W/G)
2–4
Cigarette Lighter and
Clock
22–3
Combination Meter
33–1
Cruise Control
24–2
Power Seat
21–3
Door Lock
19–1
Power Source
1~36–1
Electrical Controlled
Transmission and
A/T Indicator
6–2 (1MZ–FE)
7–2 (5S–FE)
Power Window
20–2
Electrically Controlled
Hydraulic Cooling Fan
27–2 (1MZ–FE)
Radiator Fan and
Condenser Fan
Electric Tension Reducer
36–7
Radio and Player
Light Auto Turn Off
Moon Roof
34–2
23–2
23–3
Starting and Ignition
1–2 (1MZ–FE)
2–2 (5S–FE)
Stop Light
8–1 (W/G)
9–1 (S/D, C/P)
Taillight
16–1 (S/D, C/P)
17–1 (W/G)
Turn Signal and Hazard
Warning Light
9–3 (S/D, C/P)
18–2 (W/G)
Unlock and Seat Belt
Warning
34–1
21–1
34–3 (5S–FE)
29–1(S/D, C/P 6 Speaker)
30–1(W/G 8 Speaker)
31–1(S/D, C/P 4 Speaker)
32–2(W/G 6 Speaker)
OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
264
SYSTEM INDEX
1 CAMRY ELECTRICAL W IRING DIAGRAM
Starting and Ignition (1MZ–FE)
Power Source
1
3
2
4
IGNITER
I 2 A DARK GRAY
2 2H
B–W
(A/T)
From Diode
(for Cruise Control)
<24–1>
8 1G
1
ST1 7 B–W
6 1G
W–R
5 1E
B–W
10A
STARTER
1 EF1
4
5
S4
2
1
2
2
1
2
B–O
B–O
B–O
1
I21
IGNITION COIL NO. 6
2
1
B–O
I20
IGNITION COIL NO. 5
1
B–O
1
2
1 A
2 A
3 A
4 A
5 A
6 A
7 A
COIL1
COIL2
COIL3
COIL4
COIL5
COIL6
IGT4
IGT5
IGT6
3 B
2 B
1 B
G–R
IGT3
4 B
R–B
IGT2
5 B
L–B
IGT1
6 B
GR–B
IGF
8 B
Y–R
TACH
8 A
W–G
GND
B–O
B–O
B
W–B
W–B
W–B
1 A
To Data Link Connector 1
(Check Connector)<3–3>
To Engine Control Module
(Engine and Electronic
Controlled Transmission
ECU)<3–7>
S 3 A BLACK
A , I15
IGNITER
1 1M
STARTER
BATTERY
8
P
I2
11 1C
+B
1
B
B–R
7
LG–B
2
N1
NOISE
FILTER
(for Ignition
System)
7 B
FL MAIN
2. 0L
6
G
1
W–B
B–R
To Bulb Check Relay
[COMB. METER]
To Engine Control Module
(Engine and Electronic
Controlled
Transmission ECU)
To Circuit Opening
Relay<3–2>
100A ALT
B
5
W
B–O
FUSE BOX
1
B
1 B
4
GR
B–O
B
F10 A
FUSE BOX
3
B–O
6
18 3C
B
B–O
B–O
2 2C
B–O
6 3C
B–R
F10 A , F16
2
L
W–B
B–W
B–R
B–W
W
1 A
P1
PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW
(NEUTRAL START SW)
(A/T)
N
5 2C 1 2F
20 3B
1
16 IP1
I17
IGNITION COIL NO. 2
2
2 3C
2 3D
8
5
P
3
3 EF1
7
I15 B BLACK
I16
IGNITION COIL NO. 1
W
1
STARTER
RELAY
17 IP1
6
B
S3 A ,S4
STARTER
B
F16 B
1
1
Instrument panel
brace LH
IG
EC
Intake
manifold
RH
OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
B–W
1
5
W–R
1
1 1E
4
B–O
To Injector
<3–2>
W–R
I12
IGNITION SW
3
B–W
40A
AM1
40A
MAIN
5
W–R
ST2
W–R
2
30A
AM2
1
B–O
IG2 9 B–O
2
6 1A
B
10 AM2
9 1G
14 1A
B–O
1 2G
B–R
I19
IGNITION COIL NO. 4
IG1
I18
IGNITION COIL NO. 3
4 AM1
B–W
W
B
ACC
Starting and Ignition (5S–FE)
From Diode
(for Cruise Control)
<24–1>
B–W
8 1G
14 1A
6 1G
1
7. 5A
ALT–S
2 3C
2
2
5 2C 1 2F
B–R
W
W
1 B (5S–FE)
20 3B
B–W
B–W
W
2 3D
1 A (1MZ–FE)
6 3C
B
(M/T)
B–R
6
B
(A/T)
B–O
B–R
W–R
1
2
G2 (*1)
NE–(*2)
1
2
4
3 (*1)
1
4
3
2 (*2)
B–R
IG–
1
2
4
R–L
E
Y
(Canada)
E
1 B
L
L
B A
B
STARTER
Instrument panel
brace LH
IG
EC
Intake
manifold
RH
G1
To Data Link Connector 1
(Check Connector)
<4–7><5–3>
To Tachometer
To Engine Control Module
(Engine and Electronic
Controlled Transmission
ECU)<4–8>
To Engine Control Module
(Engine ECU)<5–4>
W–B
W–B
A , S4
E
S B
S4 B
S3
2 IP3
10 IP3
B
BATTERY
1
8
IG B
STARTER
S 3 A BLACK
B
R
11 A
Y
1
FL MAIN
2. 0L
IGF IGT
3
+B
I2
IGNITER
B
F16 C
5
C–
W
2
D2
DISTRIBUTOR
NE
G1
G–
NE+
G+
G–
W–R
B–R
1
N1
NOISE
FILTER
1 1M
9
Y
W–B
11 1C
W–R
B
1
B
I3
IGNITION COIL
P1
PARK/NEUTRAL
POSITION
SW(NEUTRAL
START SW)
(A/T)
To Engine Control Module
(Engine and Electronic
Controlled Transmission
ECU)<4–7>
To Engine Control Module
(Engine ECU)<5–4>
(5S–FE) F10 B
B–R
FUSE BOX
To Bulb Check Relay
F16 C
1 C
(*3)
B ,
To Circuit
Opening Relay
<4–3><5–1>
F10 A ,
W–R
N
1 EF1
18 3C
100A ALT
P
W–B
3 EF1
2 2C
16 IP1
5
6 1D
Y
W
1
17 IP1
3
1 EF1
C9
CHARGE WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
B–W
FUSE BOX
(1MZ–FE) F10 A
1
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
5
10A
GAUGE
3 1D
B–W
(A/T)
1
1
1 1E
7. 5A
IGN
B–W
4
C7
CLUTCH START SW(M/T)
B–W
B
(M/T)
(M/T)
I12
IGNITION SW
5 1E
10A
STARTER
W–R
40A
AM1
*1 : California
*2 : Ex. California
*3 : One Body Assembly
Ex. California
R–L
ST2
W–R
2
40A
MAIN
W–R
5
IG2 9 B–O
W–R
10 AM2
9 1G
3 1G
6
1A
ST1 7 B–W
30A
AM2
W
W
6 2C
To Daytime Running
Light Relay(Main)
<10–2>
W
2 2H
Y
1 2G
B–R
B–W
B–Y
W
IG1 2
B
ACC
4 AM1
W
4
3
2
B–Y
1
C harging
W
Power Source
1
2
3
A , G2
B
GENERATOR
(ALTERNATOR)
GENERATOR
(ALTERNATOR)
G1 A
G 2 B BLACK
1
1
2
3
OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
2 C AM RY
(Cont. next page)
3 C AM R Y
Engine Control (1MZ–FE)
P o w e r S o urce
1
1
1
1
1
OX1
B–O
R–L
C9
BR
18 3D
WA
4
22
19
A
A
(SHIELDED)
BR
R–L
G–R
G–R
B–O
G
R
L
GR
Y
W
(SHIELDED)
BR
1
EB
Instrument
panel brace
LH
IG
GR
Y
W
R
L
W–B
W–B
Front left
fender
BL
Under the left
quarter piller
7 3D
19 IP1
G
1 1M
G–R
A , C10 B
BR
(SHIELDED)
BR
3 B
BR
16
E1
3
G–R
TS
11
16 IP1
OX2
J7
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
TC
6
MALFUNCTION INDICATOR
LAMP(CHECK ENGINE
WARNING LIGHT)
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–L
R–L
To ABS
ECU<25–2>
<26–3>
B–Y
R–L
G–W
15
B
BR
2
12
6 A
G–R
2
G–R
2
B–O
B–O
2
I9
INJECTOR NO. 6
B–O
2
I8
INJECTOR NO. 5
B–O
B–O
B–O
B–O
I7
INJECTOR NO. 4
1
B–O
I6
INJECTOR NO. 3
W–B
BATTERY
11 1C
2
B–O
B–O
I4
INJECTOR NO. 1
W–B
18 3C
I5
INJECTOR NO. 2
FL MAIN
2. 0L
B–O
9 IP1
TE2
12 3D
BR
B–O
2
TE1
B
W–B
B
11
IP1
8
(Short Pin)
FP
OPT
L–B
13 3A
WB
From Igniter
<1–3>
W–B
4 BX1
W–B
1 B
B
L–B
1
C
1 IP1
23
AB
5 BX1
FUSE BOX
5
R–G
B
15 IP3
16 IJ1
G–R
B–O
B–O
B–O
F10 A , F16
5
D1
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 1
(CHECK CONNECTOR)
B–Y
L–B
4
M
1 A
L–B
L–B
2
F15
FUEL PUMP
3
3 2C 2 2B
2 2H
6
G–R
LG–R
6
To Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly<23–4>
To ABS ECU<25–3><26–3>
To Cruise Control
ECU<24–2>
6
From Center
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
<23–4>
1
C
3 3D
L–W
1
4
12
To ABS ECU
<25–3><26–3>
B–O
B–O
To Igniter
<1–3>
5
6
BR
AB
CIRCUIT
OPENING
RELAY
W–B
15A EFI
EFI MAIN RELAY
2 2D
W
30A AM2
7. 5A OBD
1 1E
10A
GAUGE
6 1B
3
E1
From Cooling Fan ECU
<27–2>
4 2D
2 IM1
B
G–L 10 A/D
2
B–O
W–R
1 2G
B–O
B
3 2D
18
IP1
G–W
GR–B
TC
9 1D
1
W
4
Y–B
3 1G
R–Y
3
100A ALT
From Cruise
Control ECU<24–3>
6
B–Y
B–O
6
G–B 14 ABS
From ABS ECU
<25–3><26–3>
6 1A
2
3 EF1
From ABS ECU
<25–2><26–2>
From Center Airbag
Sensor Assmbly<23–4>
B–O
B–O
From ABS ECU
<25–2><26–3>
(SHIELDED)
9 1G
4 IP1
B–W
W–G
7. 5A IGN
I12
IGNITION SW
B–O
B
W–R
W
8 1G
B–O
D3
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 2
(TDCL)
R–L
B–O
From ” STARTER”
Fuse<1–1>
IG2 9
ST2
40A
AM1
R–L
W–G
B–W
BR
B
B–O
GR–B
G–W
BR
BR
B–O
W–G
IG1 2
ST1 7
10 AM2
4
B–Y
ACC
4 AM1
3
2
B–W
B
* Engine Control Module(Engine and Electronic Controlled Transmission ECU)
* Malfunction Indicator Lamp(Check Engine Warning Light)
Intake manifold
LH
ED
Intake manifold
RH
EC
For the connectors of the parts listed below, see the next page.
* Fuse Box
Engine Control (1M Z–FE)
* Malfunction Indicator Lamp(Check Engine Warning Light)
BR
12
3D
BR
16
IP3
BR
2
BR
L–W
Y–L
W–L
R
NE NE–
B
17
1
2
4
EE1
EE1
EE1
2
C
21
A
A
16
34
A
33
28
3
F
A
A
BR
A
A
1
K1
KNOCK SENSOR 2
W 1
2
1
8 1C
5 1M
BR
2
BR
K2
KNOCK SENSOR 1
W 1
5 3D
W–B
A
A
F
W–B
A
5 3C
W–B
A
J7
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
BR
A
A
G
(SHIELDED)
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G
3
EE1
D
6
5
W–B
16
NC2+
ELS E1 EO1 EO2 EO3
B
B–R
14 (SHIELDED)
1
2
9
B
BR
15
A
1
R–B
From Stop
Light SW
<8–2><9–2>
L–B
B–Y
B
B
R
10 (SHIELDED)
(SHIELDED)
B–R
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
B–O
4
B
G
G
D6
DIODE
(for Idle–Up)
B
L
9
L–W
L–R
B
8
G22+ G22–
KNKR KNKL
A
G
A
2
To Cooling Fan
ECU<27–2>
To Cruise Control
ECU<24–2>
To Cooling Fan ECU<27–2>
To Tachometer
BR
B–W
E1
EGR GAS TEMP. SENSOR
7
C
W–B
BR
6
A
7
8
B
From ’ TAIL’
Fuse
<16–2><17–2>
5
IQ1
5
A
21
B
BR
1
BR
6
A
24
D
O6
O/D DIRECT
CLUTCH SPEED
SENSOR
1
2
5
G
B–O
12
A
22
B
2
(SHIELDED)
4
IQ1
B–O
A
25
A
32
A
B–O
B–O
12
C
7
B
3
TACO
VTA1
E2 STP
THA VG VG– NC2–
VCC
IDL1
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE(ENGINE AND ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION ECU)
W
3
22
C , E10 D
ACIS #60 #50 #40 #30 #20 #10
C
1
B
W
1
B–O
G–R
4
E1
A
2
V4
VSV(for
Intake Control)
3
3D
OX
FPU
D
11 IM1
B–O
H9
HEATED
OXYGEN SENSOR
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
1
2 B–O
HT +B
SP1
A
23
THG
B ,E9
V–Y
22
THW
A , E8
To Combination
Meter<33–2>
23
BATT
E7
EGR
RSC
A
V3
VSV(for Fuel
Pressure Up)
12
D
Y–B
29
D
I1
IDLE AIR CONTROL
VALVE(ISC VALVE)
From Igniter
<1–4>
30
A
G–B
26
NSW
ACT
RSO
+B +B1
A
B–O
15
A
B–O
16
IGF
IGT6
A
G–R
3
BR
A
V2
VSV(for EGR)
20 IP1
P–B
B
9 II1
8 II1
(SHIELDED)
10 II1
24
IGT5
IGT4
A
Y–R
G–R
B
P–B
18
W–G
3
G–R
25
26
(SHIELDED)
IGT3
IGT2
A
G–R
B
W–R
FC
C
L–B
W
D
GR–B
HTS
D
R–B
IGT1
OXS
B–W
A/C
ACV
13
D
THA VG VG–
(SHIELDED)
TE1
14
C
G–W
B–W
TE2
20
B
E2
4
L
STA
14
D
4
3B
L
SDL
BR
B–W
HTR
14
A
L
L
C18
CRANKSHAFT POSITION
SENSOR
OXR
5
D
2
C17
CAMSHAFT POSITION
SENSOR
HTL
20
D
3
W
OXL
1
C
2
4
M6
MASS AIR FLOW
1 (AIR FLOW METER)
B
W
C
1
W
D
2
Y
A
L
D
1
GR
C
R
B
W–L
5
C
LG–B
12 IP3
G
11
B
T1
THROTTLE
POSITION
1
SENSOR
G–Y
W–L
13
W–G
To A/C Aeplifier
<35–4><36–5>
GR–B
1 EF1
18 IP3
28
2
E4
ENGINE COOLANT TEMP.
SENSOR(EFI WATER
TEMP. SENSOR)
B–O
V1
VSV
(for A/C Idle–Up)
W–B
11
13
From
STARTER
Fuse<1–2>
B
BR
15
5 1E
B–L
10
6 1G
R–Y
19
1
B–Y
R–L
V–R
R–L
(SHIELDED)
1
SDL
G–W
3
13
SG CG
B–W
HT
12
BATT
B–W
1
OX
1
(SHIELDED)
3
2
+B
W
HT
4
E
D24
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 3
OX
B–O
2
+B
(SHIELDED)
L–B
B–O
4
E
H11
HEATED OXYGEN
SENSOR
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
R–L
B–R
H12
HEATED OXYGEN
SENSOR
(Bank 2 Sensor 1)
B–R
R–L
A
G–B
A
B–O
B–O
BR
B–W
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
BR
A
R–L
BR
R–L
G–R
G–R
B–O
G
R
L
GR
Y
W
8
G–W
R–L
W–G
B–W
BR
B
B–O
GR–B
G–W
BR
7
W–B
B–O
6
BR
5
(SHIELDED)
(SHIELDED)
(SHIELDED)
(SHIELDED)
BR
BR
Intake
manifold
LH
ED
Left
kick
panel
IE
OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
(Cont. next page)
3 CAMRY (Cont’ d)
3 CAMRY (Cont’ d)
Engine Control (1MZ–FE)
9
11
10
FUSE BOX
F10 A
F16 B
1
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
(ENGINE AND ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION ECU)
E 7 A DARK GRAY
E 8 B DARK GRAY
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
11 12
13 14
1 2 3 4 5 6
15 16
7 8
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
27 28 29 30
9 10 11
12 13 14 15 16 17
31 32 33 34
18 19
20 21 22
E 9 C DARK GRAY
1 2 3 4
5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
7
8 9 10 11
12 13 14 15 16
MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP
(CHECK ENGINE WARNING LIGHT)
[COMB. METER]
C9 A
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
C10 B GRAY
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
E10 D DARK GRAY
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
9 10
11
12 13
14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21
22 23 24
25 26 27 28
12
Engine Control (5S–FE A/T and California M/T)
P ower Source
1
*1 : California
*2 : Ex. California
3
2
4
B–Y
ACC
2 2H
B–O
18
IP1
B–O
2 2D
40A
AM1
1
B–O
1
5
B–O
4
IP1
B–O
EFI MAIN
RELAY
1 1E
W
FUSE BOX
F10 A
B–O
C
3
F16 B
B–W
6
2
C
2
3
1
3 EF1
W–B
L–B
G–R
13 3A
15 IP3
B–O
L–B
Y
G–R
7 3D
L–B
16 IJ1
19
3D
L–B
W–B
R–L
(*1)
G–R
L–B
Y
4 BX1
R–B(*1)
Y (*2)
4
R–B
(*1)
F15
FUEL PUMP
M
W
18 3C
Y
W–B
I7
INJECTOR NO. 4
2
1
W–R
6
R–L(*1)
11 1C
R–B(*1)
5
W–B
W–B
BATTERY
W–B
5 BX1
Front right
fender
EB
Under the
left quarter
pillar
BL
C9 A
1 1M
MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP
(CHECK ENGINE WARNING LIGHT)
[COMB. METER]
C10 B GRAY
W–B
FL MAIN
2. 0L
I5
INJECTOR NO. 2
2
1
W–R
3 B
18 3D
Y
(*2)
W–R
B
6
W
(*2)
W–R
R–L(*1)
W (*2)
A , C10 B
6
G–R
B
1 B
4
6
W
W
FUSE BOX
I6
INJECTOR NO. 3
2
1
W–R
1
L–B
B
C9
MALFUNCTION
INDICATOR LAMP
(CHECK ENGINE
WARNING LIGHT)
[COMB. METER]
G–R
B–O
W
100A ALT
F10 A , F16
I4
INJECTOR NO. 1
2
1
W–R
6 A
CIRCUIT OPENING
RELAY
9
IP1
W–R
1 A
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
6
3 2C 2 2B
1
B–O
W–R
I12
IGNITION SW
6 1B
From ” STARTER”
Fuse<2–1>
9 1D
R–L
9 1G
6 1A
B–W
R–L
4
2D
1 2G
B–W
B–O
ST2
10A
GAUGE
7. 5A
IGN
B–W
IG2 9
15A
EFI
W–R
W
30A
AM2
W–R
10 AM2
2
3 1G
B–O
ST1 7
B
8 1G
W–G
IG1 2
W–G
4 AM1
B–W
(Ex. California M/T)
B–W
IG
Instrument
panel brace
LH
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
(C ont. next page)
4 C AM R Y
4 CAMRY (Cont’ d)
*1 :
*2 :
*3 :
*4 :
Engine Control (5S–FE A/T and California M/T)
8
7
6
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE(ENGINE AND
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION ECU)
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
5 B
Y–G
BR–B
(A/T)
L–B
B–O
G–R
BR–B
GR
G–W
R–W
R–L
W
W
12
2
17
8
9
13
15
4
1
EC
Intake manifold
RH
TE2
VF1
TC
OX2
OX1
IG–
11
19
1
IDL
L
R
L
B
VTA
IDL
E02
26 A
2
From Distributor
<2–3>
1
K1
KNOCK
SENSOR
W–B
BR
5
B
TE1
LG–R
16
TT
From SRS
Warning Light
[COMB. METER]
<23–4>
To Cruise
Control ECU<24–2>
To Center
Airbag Sensor
Assembly<23–4>
To ABS ECU
<25–3><26–3>
From Igniter
<2–3>
3
W
B–Y
E1
DATA LINK CONNECTOR 1
TS(CHECK CONNECTOR)
AB
To ABS ECU
<25–3><26–3>
G–O
To O/D Main
SW<7–5>
B D1
R–G
G–B
FP
BR
9
From ABS ECU
<25–2><26–3>
Intake
manifold LH
W–B
14
Y–B
ED
16
IP3
ECT
4
G–L
12 3D
W–B
TT
10
From Cruise
Coutrol ECU
<24–3>
To Center
Airbag Sensor
Assembly<23–4>
To ABS ECU
<25–2><26–3>
3 3D
B–Y
W–B
R–B(*1)
12
From SRS
Warning Light
[COMB. METER]
<23–4>
R–L(*1)
W D3
ENG
TE2
TE1
DATA LINK CONNECTOR 2(TDCL)
AB
A/D
TC
ABS
R–L
G–W
1
O2
OXYGEN SENSOR
(Sub)
R–W
5
O3
OXYGEN SENSOR
(Main)
G–R
(*4)
1
VTA
BR
R
(SHIELDED)
2
E1
VC
R–L
7
3
Y
PIM
15 IP1
8
To Cruise
Control ECU
<24–2>
11 B 12 B
1 B
G1 (*1)
NE
G2
G–
G+ (*2) E01
NE+
NE–
G–
4 A 5 A 17 A 18 A
13 A
KNK
13 B
19 IP1
W
E2
(SHIELDED)
(A/T)
G–R
L–B
2 B
THG
B–O
G–R
9 B
2
EC
Intake manifold RH
ED
W–B
W
E1
14 A
10 B
3
L
W–B
OX2
6 B
4
W–B
OX1
7 B
THA
VC
R
(SHIELDED)
13 IP3
THW
VC
3
(SHIELDED)
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE(ENGINE ECU)(M/T)
1 IP1
E21
2
PIM
2
Y
B , E14 C
TT
IGT
3 B
E2
1
B–Y
W
E11 A , E12
19 IP3
IGF
4 B
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE(ENGINE AND ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION ECU)(A/T)
15 B
B/K
16 B
B , E10 C
14 B
SPD
3 A 20 A
FPU
8 B
ACA
W–R
4 C
A ,E8
TE1
ACT
9 C
E7
TE2
ELS
G–W
B–Y
B–R
21 C 10 C
V–Y
4 3B
2
2
1
B
2
T1
THROTTLE
1 POSITION SENSOR
E2
BR
19 3C
1
BR
M1
MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE
PRESSURE SENSOR
(VACUUM SENSOR)
L
1
W
G–W
15 1A
BR
BR
BR
(*2)
E4
ENGINE COOLANT TEMP. SENSOR
(EFI WATER TEMP. SENSOR)
LG
BR
From Igniter
<2–3>
To Combination Meter
<33–2>
To A/C Amplifier
<35–4><36–5>
To A/C Amplifier
<35–4><36–5>
P
6 1M
BR
I10
INTAKE AIR TEMP. SENSOR
(IN–AIR TEMP. SENSOR)
L–B
BR
BR
E1
EGR GAS TEMP. SENSOR
BR
GR
From Stop Light
SW<8–2><9–2>
From ” MIR–HTR”
Fuse<24–4><28–1>
G
1
LG–B
B–W
(*3)
B–W
(*4)
W–L
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
W
G–R
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
BR
G–R(*3)
G–R
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
R–L
Y
R–L
(*1)
25 A 24 A
3
2 C
NSW
(A/T) E10 C DARK GRAY
(M/T) E14 C DARK GRAY
EGR
VF
BATT
(A/T) E 8 B DARK GRAY
(M/T) E12 B DARK GRAY
14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
(A/T)
#40
5 3C
22 C
BR–B
#30
1 C
GR
# 20
ISCV
14 1A
1
G–W
#10
ISCC
5 1E
12 IP3
8 A
R–W
ISCO
2
D6
DIODE
(for Idle–Up)
G
V2
VSV(for EGR System)
LG
23 A
W
G–R
V1
VSV
(for A/C Idle–Up)
G–R
7 A
5 C 14 C 12 A 11 A
G–R
1
9 A
+B1
FC
2
R–B
(*1)
W
3
G–Y
B–O
I1
IDLE AIR CONTROL
VALVE(ISC VALVE)
+B
1
2
10 A
B–O
B–O
B–W
11 C 12 C 13 C
1
5 3D
B–R
(*1)
V3
VSV(for Fuel Pressure Up)
6 1G
2
(A/T) E 7 A DARK GRAY
(M/T) E11 A DARK GRAY
G–W
11 IP1
STA
From ” TAIL”
Fuse<16–2><17–2>
G
B–O
B–O
B–W
B–O
B–O
B–O
(*1)
B–O
B–O
B–O
B–O
W–G
W–G
(Ex. California M/T)
BR
5
B–W
California
Ex. California
for Canada in TMM Made
Ex. *3
Intake
manifold LH
Power
S o u rce
For the connectors of the parts listed below, see the next page.
* Fuse Box
* Engine Control Module(Engine ECU)
* Malfanction Indicator Lamp(Check Engine Warning Light)
Engine Control (5S–FE Ex. A/T and California M/T)
1
3
2
4
R–W
From ” TAIL”
Fuse<16–2><17–2>
6
C
3
10
B
C
12
B
OX2
E1
1 B 24 A
A , C10 B
MALFUNCTION
INDICATOR LAMP
(CHECK ENGINE
WARNING LIGHT)
[COMB. METER]
R–L
C9
G–R
(*1)
Y
L
19 3D 7 3D
G–R
G–R
G–R
12
8
C
C
ELS
W
4
17
A
A
18
A
5
A
NE+ NE– G– G+
IGT
KNK
IGF
B
A
W
5
B
R
IDL
P
From ” MIR–HTR”
Fuse<24–4>
<28–1>
D6
DIODE(for Idle–Up)
G
L
B
B
B–Y
B–Y
B
6
18 3D
1
2
R–L
OX1
B
P
R
BR
E1
EGR GAS TEMP. SENSOR
VTA
G–R
3
6 1B
From Distributor
<2–3>
3 B
5 3C
THA
THG E2
PIM VC
ACT ACA
VTA IDL
B , E14 C ENGINE CONTROL MODULE(ENGINE ECU)
VF
8
L
L–B
BR
I10
INTAKE AIR TEMP. SENSOR
(IN–AIR TEMP. SENSOR)
BR
LG
L
R
To A/C
Amplifier
<35–4><36–5>
11
2 B
B
5 3D
E01
SPD
A
3
E02
C
22
A
11
A
13
26
Under
the left
quarter
pillar
Intake manifold
RH
EC
11
5
Intake
EC
manifold
RH
BR
3
W–B
V–Y
W–B
To Combination Meter
<33–2>
From Igniter
<2–3>
W
W–R
G–R(*2)
G–W
Y–G
W
R–W
12
B–Y
BR
2
14
3
3D
12 3D
W–B
1
19
4
W–B
2
16
10
BR
3
Y
1
16 IP3
BR
I7
INJECTOR
NO. 4
1
G–B
1
1
From ABS ECU
<25–2><26–3>
From SRS Warning
Light[COMB. METER]
<23–4>
2
1 12
8
9
13
2
4 15
FP B TE1
TE2
VF1
W OX1 OX2
D 1 DATA LINK CONNECTOR 1
CHECK CONNECTOR)
E1
TS
IG
TC
AB
1
2
8
7
TE1
TE2
ENG W
D 3 DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 2(TDCL)
A/D TC
ABS AB
E1
G–L
Y
(*1)
From Cruise
Control ECU<24–3>
From Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly<23–4>
From ABS ECU
<25–2><26–3>
W–R
O2
OXYGEN SENSOR(Sub)
R–L
L–B
W–R
4
BX1
GR
1
I5
INJECTOR
NO. 2
R–G
2
L–B
W
B–O
(*1)
W–R
19 IP3
Y–B
1
I6
INJECTOR
NO. 3
L–B
13 IP3
BR
2
(*1)
19 IP1
W
G–R(*3)
1 IP1
W–R
K1
KNOCK SENSOR
W–R
15 IP3
R–W
G–W
GR
Y
L–B
G–R
GR
W
G–R
L–B
F15
M
FUEL PUMP
5
5
W–B
BX1
BL
TE2
7 B
2
3
2
B
From Igniter
G–W
<2–3>
To Cruise
Control ECU<24–2>
R–W
To ABS ECU
LG–R
<25–3><26–3>
To Center
G–R
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
W
<23–4>
From SRS
B–Y
R–L
Warning Light
[COMB. METER]
O3
<23–4>
OXYGEN SENSOR(Main)
W
IG
25
To ABS ECU
<25–3><26–3>
Instrument
panel
brace LH
TE1
W–B
W–B
W–B
EB
E21
THW
E11 A , E12
15 B
I4
INJECTOR
NO. 1
4
W–B
BATTERY
Front left
fender
2
9
B
3
10A
GAUGE
G–R
16 IJ1
1 1M
BATT
A
12
6
11 1C
EGR
4
13 3A
18 3C
BR
V2
VSV(for EGR System)
B–O
ISCV
A
1
6
L–B
FL MAIN
2. 0L
4
6
W–B
From STARTER Fuse
<2–1>
B
6
1
16
C
4
3 1G
R–L
C
6 A
VC
E2 PIM VC
W
ISCO ISCC
23 A
#10 #20
W–R
B–W
2
FUSE BOX
B–W
B
B
F10 A , F16
3
6
13 B
1
G
1 A
FC
CIRCUIT OPENING
RELAY
W
W–B
6
3 B
2
9
A
C
1 A
4 B
1
R–W
10
A
2
Y
W–R
W–B
B–O
3
2
T1
THROTTLE
POSITION
1 SENSOR
E2
BR BR
M1
MANIFOLD
ABSOLUTE
PRESSURE
SENSOR(VACCUM
SENSOR)
E4
ENGINE COOLANT TEMP. SENSOR
(EFI WATER TEMP. SENSOR)
BR
1
C
STA +B +B1
3 EF1
1
1
2
G–W
7
C
V1
VSV(for A/C Idle–Up)
B–O
B–O
B–O
W
2
A
4 IP1
2
1
BR
B–W
B–O
B–O
1 1E
B–O
1
2
G–R
2
3 2C 2 2B
1
B–O
I1
IDLE AIR CONTROL
VALVE(ISC VALVE)
G–Y
3
11 IP1
B–O
40A AM1
*1 : SHIELDED
*2 : TMC Made
*3 : TMM Made
W–R
B–O
B–O
1
W–L
9
IP1
B–O
EFI MAIN RELAY
5
2
6 1A
B–O
W–R
9 1G
9 1D
LG
B–O
12 IP3
4
2D
18
IP1
2 2D
100A ALT
BR
ST2
I12
IGNITION SW
1 B
BR
B–R
W–G
7. 5A
IGN
BR
W
15A
EFI
To Cruise Control ECU
<24–2>
BR
30A
AM2
IG2 9
W–G
B–O
ST1
10 AM2
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
8 1G
LG–B
2 2H
BR
1 2G
BR
IG1 2
R
4 AM1
BR
W–R
B
B–Y
B–Y
ACC
Intake
manifold
LH
ED
ED
Intake
manifold
LH
OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
(C ont. next page)
5 CAMRY
5 CAMRY (Cont’ d)
Engine Control (5S–FE Ex. A/T and California M/T)
5
7
6
8
FUSE BOX
F10 A
F16 B
1
1
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE(ENGINE ECU)
E11 A
DARK GRAY
E12 B
DARK GRAY
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP
(CHECK ENGINE WARNING LIGHT)[COMB. METER]
C9 A
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
C10 B
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
E14 C
DARK GRAY
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12
P ow er
S o u rc e
Electronic Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (1MZ–FE)
1
3
1 2G
8 1G
3 1G
R–L
2 2H
6
1D
ST2
2
R–L
R–L
W–G
B–O
R–Y
B–O
18
IP1
15 16
12 IP3
+B
OD1
12 D
14 A
SP1
B ,E9
L–R
V–Y
7 D
BATT
A , E8
C , E10 D
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE(ENGINE AND
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION ECU)
3 D
NSW
2 D 10 D 15 D
L
P
2
6 D
R
OD2
9 10 11
SLN–
4
3
6
2
TE2
VC
11 D
1 B
VTA
7 B
E2
22 B
IDL
32 A
L
See Engine Control
System<3–5>
See Engine Control
System<3–8>
FUSE BOX
To Cruise Control
ECU<24–2>
F10 A
F16 B
B–O
W–B
E10 D DARK GRAY
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
To Cruise Control
ECU<24–2>
E2
ELECTRONIC
CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION
SOLENOID
BATTERY
1
12 13
14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21
22 23 24
TE1
5 C
1
12 13 14 15 16
11
E1
16 C
P–L
8 9 10 11
9 10
E03
28 A
BR
7
E02
33 A
W–B
5 6
E01
34 A
W–B
1 2 3 4
SL
W–B
A
E 9 C DARK GRAY
S2
17 A 27 A
L–Y
B
S1
3 A 11 A
P–L
A
20 21 22
P–L
18 19
J7
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
12 13 14 15 16 17
FL MAIN
2. 0L
+B1
V
7 8
1 B
6 IP1
L–R
To Combination Meter
<33–4>
E7
23 D 22 D 14 D
1 2 3 4 5 6
Y–G
FUSE BOX
B
W–L
B–O
E 8 B DARK GRAY
F10 A , F16
Y–B
B–O
B–O
W
31 32 33 34
1 A
13 IP1
6 II1
11
IP1
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
27 28 29 30
R–B
G–O
13 14
L–R
O
E6
ELECTRONIC
CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION
PATTERN SELECT
SW
3
L–R
IN1
L–R
11 12
3 EF1
W–B
W
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
3
Y–L
R–L
L–R
4 2D
B–O
E 7 A DARK GRAY
6
POWER
B–O
3
2 2D 3 2C
4
II2
See Engine
Control System
<3–6>
1
2 2B
R–L
To Cruise Control
ECU<24–2>
1
8 1K
EFI
MAIN
RELAY
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE(ENGINE
AND ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION ECU)
1 1E
5
From Combination Meter
<33–2>
2
I12
IGNITION SW
6
IN1
R–L
9 1D
40A
AM1
R–L
C
R–B
9 1G
100A ALT
10A
GAUGE
O
B–O
7. 5A
IGN
NORMAL
IG2 9
15A
EFI
L–R
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
C
W
10 AM2
30A
AM2
B
B
W–R
ST1
Y–L
B–Y
4
L–R
IG1 2
B–Y
ACC
4 AM1
B–O
2
25 26 27 28
EB
Front left
fender
Intake manifold LH
ED
OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
(Cont. next page)
6 C AM RY
6 CAMRY (Cont’ d)
Electronic Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (1MZ–FE)
Back–Up Light (1MZ–FE)
*1 : S/D, C/P
5
8
7
6
R–L
R–L
L–R
2 IP3
Y–L
O
R–L
R–L
P1
A/T INDICATOR SW
[PARK/NEUTRAL
POSITION SW]
(NEUTRAL START SW)
(M/T)
(A/T)
R–L
2
2
B1
BACK–UP
LIGHT SW
(M/T)
R–B
7
O
R–B
R
R–B
(M/T)
R–B
(W/G)
6
Bc2
R–B
3
Bd2
O
8 IQ1
14 IQ1
R–B
(W/G)
Y–L
7 IQ1
13 IQ1
5 II1
9 IQ1
L–R
Y–L
O
B–O
R
R–B
G–W
13
11
10
7
5
4
3
BACK–UP LIGHT
[REAR COMB. LIGHT]
3 A (*1)
4 B (W/G)
R11 A , B
B
3 A (*1)
4 B (W/G)
C11
A/T INDICATOR LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
W–B
W–B
(*1)
W–B
(W/G)
1 2
3 4
B
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR B
R11
RH
W–B
(*1)
W–B
(*1)
6
BACK–UP LIGHT
[REAR COMB. LIGHT]
R9
LH
W–B
(W/G)
9
G–O
4 A (*1)
3 B (W/G)
P
R
N
D
2
R9 A , B
L
O/D OFF
POWER
R–L
8
4 A (*1)
3 B (W/G)
1 2
3 4
W–B
3
R–B
(*1)
R–B
R–B
10
IJ1
R–B
G–O
O5
O/D MAIN SW
1
From Combination
Meter<33–4>
R–B
(A/T)
3
Ba1
R–B
(*1)
G–W
1 IP3
B–O
O
G–O
G–O
1 IP3
Y–L
II1
G–O
2
1
R–B
(W/G)
P
8
R–B
(*1)
R
9
R–B
N
10
(M/T)
D
3
R–B
2
4
G–O
D
L
Y–L
D
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G–O
IF
W–B
(*1)
W–B
4 Ba1
Left kick panel
Back door
center
BR
Under the left
quarter pillar
BL
Electronic Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (5S–FE)
P o w er So urc e
*2 : w/o A/T Indicator Light
1
3
2
B
4
W–R
B–Y
ACC
W
4 AM1
IG1 2
1 2G
2 2H
B–Y
R–L
3 1G
8 1G
ST1
R–L
L–R
W–R 10 AM2
IG2 9
7. 5A
IGN
B–O
15A
EFI
30A
AM2
10A
GAUGE
R–L
6
1D
Y–L
ST2
9 1G
2
9 1D
8 1K
R–L
C
C
R–L
C R–L
2 2D
12 C
B
13 IP1
6 IP1
6 II1
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION
PATTERN SELECT SW
E 2 A BLACK
W–G
E 3 B BLACK
L–R
L–R
(*2)
1 2
1 2 3
13 C
+B
20 C
1 C
+B1
BATT
22 C
9 C
OD1
SPD
B , E10 C
6 C
NSW
19 C 18 C
P
L
2
G–O
A , E8
O
E7
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE(ENGINE AND ELECTRONIC
CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION ECU)
Y–L
B–O
B–O
B
E10 C DARK GRAY
NOMAL
L–R
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
1 B
L–R
12 IP3
W–L
F10 A , F16
11 IP1
3
IN1
L–R
4 2D
B–O
B
100A ALT
2 2B 3 2C
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
FUSE BOX
1 A
3
Y–B
W
2
To Cruise Control
ECU<24–2>
EFI
MAIN
RELAY
See Engine Control
System<4–6>
14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
3 EF1
E 8 B DARK GRAY
From Combination Meter
<33–2>
5
6 POWER 3
V–Y
1
R–L
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W
B
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
6
IN1
L–R
4 II2
E 7 A DARK GRAY
L–R
R–L
G–O
E6
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION PATTERN
SELECT SW
To Combination
Meter<33–4>
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE(ENGINE
AND ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION ECU)
1 1E
O
18 IP1
B–O
1
B–O
I12
IGNITION SW
40A
AM1
7 C
OD2
1 A
E01
P–L
EB
E02
7 B
TE1
15 B
TE2
14 B
VF
VC
8 B
1 B
See Engine Control System
(5S–FE, A/T)<4–6>
B
E2
NO. 2
NO. 1
LOCK–UP
W
BATTERY
Front left fender
14 A
BR
3 A
TT
26 A
W–B
1 B
E1
13 A
To Cruise
Control ECU
<24–2>
S2
15 A
P–L
S1
2 A
V
SL
1 A
L–Y
W–B
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
W–B
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
FL MAIN
2. 0L
A ,E3
VTA
11 B
E2
9 B
See Engine Control System
(5S–FE, A/T)<4–6>
B
ELECTRONIC
CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION
PATTERN
SELECT SW
FUSE BOX
F16 B
F10 A
Intake
manifold LH
ED
EC
Intake manifold RH
IDL
12 B
1
1
OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
(Cont. next page)
7 C AM R Y
7 CAMRY (Cont’ d)
Electronic Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (5S–FE)
5
Back–Up Light (5S–FE)
8
7
6
R–L
*1 : w/ A/T Indicator Light
*2 : w/o A/T Indicator Light
*3 : S/D, C/P
R–L
L–R
2 IP3
R–L
O
(M/T)
(A/T)
P1
A/T INDICATOR SW
[PARK/NEUTRAL
POSITION SW]
(NEUTRAL START SW)
R–L
R–L
Y–L
BACK–UP LIGHT
[REAR COMB. LIGHT]
2
R9 A
2
B1
BACK–UP LIGHT
SW (M/T)
G–O
2
D
N
R
P
4
3
10
9
8
7
R
R–B
G–W
R–B
(A/T)
R
7
5
5 II1
3 Bd2
9
G–O
(*1)
B
B
L
2
D
N
6
4
R
3
P
4 A (*3)
3 B (W/G)
4 A (*3)
3 B (W/G)
BACK–UP LIGHT
[REAR COMB. LIGHT]
R9
LH
R11
RH
4 A (*3)
4 A (*3)
3 B (W/G)
3 B (W/G)
C11
A/T INDICATOR LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
W–B
(*3)
W–B
(*1)
W–B
(W/G)
W–B
B
Left kick panel
R–B
(W/G)
W–B
(W/G)
W–B
3
POWER
O/D OFF
O5
O/D MAIN
SW
R–B
R–B
B–O
(*1)
10
6
Bc2
G–W
(*1)
O
(*1)
11
R–B
(W/G)
R–B
(*1)
Y–L
(*1)
13
(*1)
L–R
(*1)
8
10
IJ1
R–B
R–B
(*3)
9 IQ1
W–B
1 IP3
W–B
(*3)
13 IQ1
Back door
center
BR
4 Ba1
W–B
14 IQ1
R–L
(*1)
1
IF
B
1 2
3 4
R–B
(*3)
8 IQ1
3
Ba1
R–B
(*3)
R–B
(M/T)
7 IQ1
R–B
O
G–O
G–O
From Combination
Meter<33–4>
G–O
(*1)
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
,
1 IP3
Y–L
II2
G–O
From Data Link
Connector 2
(TDCL)<4–6>
R11 A
1 2
3 4
1
O
O
2
B
R–B
(M/T)
L
Y–L
Y–L
G–O
G–O
D
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B–O
D
D
,
Under the left
quarter pillar
BL
S top L ight (W /G )
P o w e r S o u rc e
1
Headlight (for USA)
3
2
4
W
W
B
FUSE BOX
ACC
3 1G
1 2E
2 2H
40A
AM1
G–W
HS
BL
3
BQ
DIMMER SW
G–R
4
H
T
R
R
R–Y
R–Y
W–B
H3
HEADLIGHT LO LH
H1
HEADLIGHT HI LH
R–B
H4
HEADLIGHT LO RH
W–B
R–B
ED HF
HI
R–B
TAIL
HEAD
8 ED1
LOW
R–B
HIGH
FLASH
NOISE FILTER
11
9
N2 A
2
Lower back panel center
2
12
OFF
W–B
4
2
2
W–B
2
H10
HIGH MOUNT
STOP LIGHT
2
1
N3 B
W–B
1
R10
STOP LIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
G–R
6 Bb1
R11
STOP LIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
G–R
G–R
LIGHT
CONTROL
SW
1
5
Bd2
14
2
1
R–B
C12
COMBINATION SW
W–B
W–B
C
G–R
13
2
1
W–B
1
14
1
BR
Back door center
IE
Left kick panel
1
1
2
W–B
7
+STP
H2
HEADLIGHT HI RH
4
4 Bd2
13
R–B
R
W–B
W–B
C
C
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
3
R8
STOP LIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
G–R
1
BATTERY
I13
INTEGRATION
RELAY
EL
4
Bc2
C9
HIGH BEAM
INDICATOR LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
5
Bc2
2
G–R
R–Y
R–B
3
1
R–B
–TR
B
L2
LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR
F16 C
G–W
9
3C
R
9
+TR
–STP
R–Y
G–W
3
E
R–B
17 1H
R
LG
Y–G
B
14 1L
5 ED1
4
11
8
(5S–FE) F10 B
1
15 1A
1
WRN
Under the left
quarter pillar
6 1M
2
To ABS ECU<25–4><26–4>
To Cruise Control ECU<24–2>
To Engine Control Module
(Engine and Electronic
Controlled Transmission ECU)
<3–8><4–7>
To Shift Lock ECU<23–2>
FUSE BOX
FL MAIN
2. 0L
6 2A
5 2A
2 B
To Taillight
[REAR COMB.
LIGHT]<17–3>
F16 C
B
B
G–R
17 IJ1
F10 A , B ,
1 C
A , N3
G–R
Y–G
To License
Plate Light
<17–3>
S10
STOP LIGHT SW
W
3
1 A (1MZ–FE)
1 B (5S–FE)
100A ALT
Y
C9
REAR LIGHT
WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
W
2 A
1 2A
NOISE FILTER
G
W
3
2 2A
N2
1 B
4
15A
HEAD
(LH)
1
R–B
R–L
1 A
6
EF1
15A
HEAD
(RH)
7 2G
W–B
W
1 1E
2
G–R
6 1B 9 1H
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
R–L C
4
3
G–W
3 1M
1
EF1
HEADLIGHT
RELAY
I12
IGNITION SW
40A
MAIN
15A
STOP
G–W
2
10A
GAUGE
R9
STOP LIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
W
B
ST1
9 1G
2 2E
4 1E
R–Y
B–Y
W–B
IG1 2
R–Y
4 AM1
W
(1MZ–FE) F10 A
Front left fender
EB
OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
8 C AM R Y
9 CAM RY
Turn Signal and
Hazard Warning Light (S/D, C/P)
S to p L ig h t (S /D , C /P )
P ow er S o urc e
1
3
2
4
B
NOISE FILTER
N3 B
W
N2 A
ACC
IG1 2
4 1E
B–Y
2
15A
STOP
G–W
W
G–Y
G–B
8
G–Y
5
Back panel
center
BO
Under the left
quarter pillar
BL
C12
TURN SIGNAL
SW [COMB. SW]
5
2
LH
RH
W–B
23
1 ED1
W–B
18 3C
1
11 1C
2
1 1M
W–B
5
1
1
6 3D
G–Y
G–Y
1
G–Y
C8
TURN SIGNAL INDICATOR
LIGHT [COMB. METER]
G–Y
G–Y
G–B
11 BZ1
R10
REAR TURN SIGNAL
LIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
W–B
G–Y
2
16 1H
10 BZ1
G–B
G–B
G–B
1 1A
R8
REAR TURN SIGNAL
LIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
W–B
G–B
4 ED1
1
W–B
B
9 IJ1
F
5 1M
B
G–B
F
8 1C
W–B
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G–B
1
3
RH
L
G–W
G–R
W–B
2
2
W–B
G–R
G–R
2
1
TURN SIGNAL
FLASHER
W–B
W–B
3
6
G–Y
LH
TR
W–B
7
BZ1
4
Ba1
2
1
3
F7
FRONT TURN SIGNAL
LIGHT LH
W–B
G–B
HS
R10
STOP LIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
5
W–B
1
TB
5
1
W–B
+STP
G–R
W–B
2
W–B
W–B
1
Ba1
R9
STOP LIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
G–R
G–R
W–B
5
R10
STOP LIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
G–R
2
9
BZ1
TL
1
W–B
G–W
G–W
1
2
W–B
W–B
R8
STOP LIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
BATTERY
7
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
L2
LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR
G–R
B2
R
R
(w/o Rear Spoiler)
–TR
8
BZ1
4 BZ1
H10
HIGH MOUNT STOP LIGHT
+TR
1
2
W–B
WRN
5
Ba1
G–W
(w/ Rear Spoiler)
8
G–W
H10
HIGH MOUNT STOP LIGHT
Y
9
–STP
F
1
G–W
9
17 1H
R
LG
G
Y–G
To ABS ECU<25–4><26–4>
To Cruise Control ECU<24–2>
To Engine Control Module
(Engine and Electronic
Controlled Transmission ECU)
<3–8><4–7>
To Shift Lock ECU<23–2>
3
E
14 1L
G–W
Y
G–W
9
3C
4
11
8
7
1
1 C
FL MAIN
2. 0L
10
ON
15 1A
F16 C
1
G–W
G–R
Y–G
2 BZ1
2 2F
OFF
6 1M
B
3 BZ1
2 1A
B1
To Taillight
[REAR COMB.
LIGHT]<16–3>
F16 C
FUSE BOX
H7
HAZARD SW
2
S10
STOP LIGHT SW
W
Y–G
To License
Plate Light
<16–3>
17 IJ1
B
G–W
W
W
C9
REAR LIGHT
WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
F10 A , B ,
A , N3
2 B
1 B
3
1 A (1MZ–FE)
1 B (5S–FE)
N2
2 A
NOISE FILTER
6
3 EF1
FUSE BOX
(1MZ–FE) F10 A
G–R
1 A
R–L
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
R–L C
1
W
2
(5S–FE) F10 B
3 1M
6 1B 9 1H
1 1E
10A
HAZ
7. 5A
TURN
FUSE BOX
40A
AM1
100A ALT
1
F8
FRONT TURN SIGNAL
LIGHT RH
W–B
G–Y
I12
IGNITION SW
2
B
1
G–B
10A
GAUGE
9 1G
4 EF1
2 2H
ST1
W
W
B
4 AM1
3 1G
Left kick
panel
IE
Front
left
fender
EB
Back panel
center
BO
EA
Front
right
fender
IG
Instrument
panel
brace
LH
H ead lig ht (fo r C an ada)
2 2E
FUSE BOX
5 2A
W
17 3A
11 3B
2
EB1
18 3A
9 3A
R
7
(5S–FE) F10 B
8 ED1
5
3
2
2
1
R–B
4
R–B
HRLY
F16 C
3
7
7
7
1
4
3 EF1
1
From Generator
(Alternator)
<2–4>
1
1M
To Parking Brake
SW<33–3>
To Brake Fluid
Level SW<33–3>
9
11
R–G
2
14
7
1
4
W–B
2
1
7
3
7
R–B
HEAD
13
DAYTIME RUNNING
LIGHT RELAY NO. 4
TAIL
1
H2
HEADLIGHT HI RH
OFF
H1
HEADLIGHT HI LH
HIGH
2
W–B
7
EL
4 EB1
5 EB1
R–B
W–B
W–B
11
1C
R–Y
H
LOW
C12
COMBINATION SW
R–W
T
R–B
A
HL HU ED
W–B
8
A
18 3C
HF
FLASH
R–B
HI
W–B
W–B
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
H
PKB
2
W–B
5 ED1
R–G
R–Y
13
W–B
R–Y
12
C9
HIGH BEAM INDICATOR
LIGHT[COMB. METER]
R–B
14
W–B
12 3A
W–B
16
R–W
18
R–Y
W–B
BRK
D4
DAYTIME RUNNING
LIGHT RELAY
(MAIN)
11
5
DRL
CHG–
Y
B
13
+B
17
DIMMER
LIGHT
CONTROL SW
SW
IG
E
R–Y
15
R–B
2
1 C
1
W–B
3 EB1
R
F16 C
FUSE BOX
BATTERY
5
R–G
F10 A , B
FL MAIN
2. 0L
W–B
L–Y
R–L
R–B
W–R
R–G
2
W–B
W
100A ALT
1 A (*1)
1 B (*2)
4
5
7
1
H
I13
INTEGRATION
RELAY
15A
HEAD
(LWR–RH)
7
2 2A
R–L
R–B
(1MZ–FE) F10 A
W
W
1
5
R
1 1E
B
2
5
15A
HEAD
(LWR–LH)
7. 5A
DRL
FUSE BOX
1
B
L–Y
40A
AM1
3 2G
R–L
I12
IGNITION SW
3
15A
HEAD
(UPR–RH)
3
R–W
7 1B
R–B
2
1
7 2G 1 2E
15A
HEAD
(UPR–LH)
5
1
R
3
ST2
9 1G
DAYTIME
RUNNING
LIGHT
RELAY
NO. 2
HEADLIGHT
RELAY
40A
MAIN
5
2
DAYTIME RUNNING
LIGHT RELAY NO. 3
IG2
15A
ECU–B
1
W–R
10A
GAUGE
2
R
W
AM2
7
5
4
H3
HEADLIGHT LO LH
2 2H
3 1G
R
IG1 2
ST1
4
W
1
EB1
W
B
B
B–Y
ACC
4 AM1
W
W
3
6
EC1
B
W
2
R–L
1
*1 : 1MZ–FE
*2 : 5S–FE
H4
HEADLIGHT LO RH
P ow e r
S ou rce
W–B
IG
Instrument panel
brace LH
IE
Left kick panel
Front left fender
EB
OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
10 CAMRY
IG
Instrument panel
brace LH
Left kick
panel
IE
1
1 1K
1
2
7 1K
15 1K
9 1K
INTEGRATION RELAY
3
1
DIODE
2
R–Y
1
16 IU1
1
2
D7
DIODE
(for Courtesy)
6 IU1
BATTERY
R–W
15 II2
R–G
1
17 IJ1
6 II2
2
2 II2
R–W
Left
kick
panel
B
1
1
IF
L3
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT
LIGHT
(w/ Moon Roof)
R
R
R
D16
DOOR KEY CYLINDER
LIGHT AND SW
R
R
Interior Light (S/D, C/P w/ Key Illuminated Entry)
LH
BK
RH
4
2 1H
5 BZ1
B
Roof left
M3
PERSONAL LIGHT
R–B
G–R
From Door Lock
Control Relay<19–3>
R–B
16 IH2
W–B
19 1H
9 IH1
G–R
R–Y
(*2)
R
C9
OPEN DOOR WARNING
LIGHT[COMB. METER]
R
V9
VANITY LIGHT RH
R
R
3
L4
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT
LIGHT SW
3 1B
11 IH1
W–B
8 II2
2
R–W(S/D)
R–Y(C/P)
5 1M
2 1B
4
W–B
1 1M
5
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
(*2)
1
From Door Lock Control Relay
<19–3>
6 1I
15 IJ1
3
R–W
6 IV2
2
R
(*2)
W–B
(*1, S/D)
1
R–Y
(*1, S/D)
2
I11
IGNITION KEY
CYLINDER LIGHT
W–B
4
R–W
4 IV2
G–R
W–B
2
16 3A
R–B
4 1I
14 3D
R–W
6
(*2)
1
14 3C
R–W
4
V8
VANITY LIGHT LH
R
1
D13
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT RH
R–G
1
1
G–R
5 1C
OFF
ON
2
D12
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT LH
R–G
R–Y
10
12 1K
2
(S/D)
FL MAIN
2. 0L
R–Y
R–L
(*2)
6 1H
DOOR
R
1
D15
DOOR COURTESY SW
REAR RH
R–Y
(S/D)
R–W
(S/D)
1 1I
I14
INTERIOR LIGHT
3 II2
R–W
(*2)
1 IV2
R–W
(*1, S/D)
A
R
A
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
Power
S o u rc e
D14
DOOR COURTESY SW
REAR LH
1 1C
R
R
(*2)
2 2H
R
R
R
(*1, S/D)
2 2G
W–B
R–W
(*2)
R
(*2)
R
B
20A
DOME
W–B
B
11 CAM RY
*1 : TMC Made
*2 : TMM Made
B
R
4
R
10 IH1
W–B
1
P ow er
S o u rc e
Interior Light (W/G w/ Key Illuminated Entry)
*1 : LE and GL Grade in Canada
1
3
2
4
B
10 IH1
R
R
B
R
R
(*1)
1
M3
PERSONAL
LIGHT
6 II2
2
DIODE
2 II2
R–W
R–Y
W–B
W–B
R–W
D7
DIODE
(for Courtesy)
1
2
B
R–W
R–W
R–Y
R–W
D9
DIODE
(for Courtesy)
2 1H
R–G
1 1K
4
2
R–Y
19 1H
1
2
RH
B
6 IV1
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
1
1 1M
R–W
R–Y
2
3
4
W–B
B
R–W
9 1K
10
R–W
LH
W–B
(*1)
R–W
R–W
3
INTEGRATION RELAY
2 Bc3
2 Bd2
From Door Lock
Control Relay
<19–3>
2
2
FL MAIN
2. 0L
1
Back door center
BR
Instrument panel
brace LH
IG
1
W–B
W–B
6 1I
1
5 1M
W–B
1
D13
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT RH
R–W
1
6 IU1
D12
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT LH
R–G
W–B
W–B
1
16 IU1
D15
DOOR COURTESY SW
REAR RH
R–Y
L4
LUGGAGE
COMPARTMENT
LIGHT SW
D14
DOOR COURTESY SW
REAR LH
R–W
2
BATTERY
W–B
(*1)
15 1K
1
V9
VANITY LIGHT RH
7 1K
R–G
4 1I
R
(*1)
R–B
15 II2
R–W
G–R
8 II2
G–R
R–W
4 IV1
16 IH2
V8
VANITY LIGHT LH
From Door Control Relay
<19–3>
R–B
9 IH1
11 IH1
R
(*1)
R
(w/ Moon Roof)
2
R
W–B
W–B
4
G–R
OFF
ON
DOOR
R
2 1B
L3
LUGGAGE
COMPARTMENT
LIGHT
1
1
2
15 IJ1
1
3
R–W
5 1C 6 1H
5
1
G–R
R–W
R
1 1I
4
R–Y
R
R
R
R
12 1K
I11
IGNITION KEY
CYLINDER LIGHT
R
C9
OPEN DOOR WARNING
LIGHT[COMB. METER]
1 Bc2
A
I14
INTERIOR LIGHT
2
3 II2
1 1C
14 3D
A
R
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
16 3A
2 2G
R
R
R
R
20A
DOME
R
1 IV1
14 3C
D16
DOOR KEY CYLINDER
LIGHT AND SW
2 2H
Left kick
panel
IF
BP
Roof right
Left kick
panel
IE
OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
12 CAMRY
13 CAMRY
Power
Source
*1 :
*2 :
*3 :
*4 :
Interior Light (S/D, C/P w/o Key Illuminated Entry)
1
3
2
TMC Made
TMM Made
w/ ABS
w/o ABS
4
B
2 2H
20A
DOME
R
2 2G
1 1C
6 1H
5 1C
R
(*1, S/D)
14 3C
R
R
(*2)
R
1 IV2
R
(*1, S/D)
R
14 3D
C9
OPEN DOOR WARNING
LIGHT[COMB. METER]
FL MAIN
2. 0L
3 1I
R–G
R–Y
(*2)
7
IJ1
R–L
(*2)
3 1B
6 II2
I11
IGNITION KEY
CYLINDER LIGHT
2
L3
LUGGAGE
COMPARTMENT
LIGHT
2 1B
2
6 1K
DIODE
1
2
R–W
3 IV2
5
IJ1
R
(*2)
R–Y
(*1, S/D)
R–W
(*2)
5
R–W
(*2)
4
R–W
(*1, S/D)
B
RH
1
1
1
LH
R
R
4
G–R
DOOR
M3
PERSONAL
LIGHT
16 3A
R–W
2
1
From Door
Control
Relay<19–3>
R
(*2)
(*2)
OFF
ON
I14
INTERIOR LIGHT
R
(*1, S/D)
R
(*2)
1 1I
INTEGRATION
RELAY
2
5 BZ1
From Door Lock
Control Relay
<19–3>
6 IU1
16
IU1
R–Y
(*3, S/D)
1
IG
Instrument panel
brace LH
R–W
1
D15
DOOR COURTESY SW
REAR RH
R–W(S/D)
R–Y(C/P)
R–W
R–W
(*3)
R–G
1
W–B
1
R–Y
(*3, S/D)
R–Y
R–W
(*4)
D7
DIODE
(for Courtesy)
1
2
1 1M
D12
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT LH
1
2
II2
R–G
R–W
(*4)
D13
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT RH
R–W
R–W
(S/D)
R–Y
D15
DOOR COURTESY SW
REAR RH
R–W
(S/D)
BK
D14
DOOR COURTESY SW
REAR LH
Roof left
1
2 1H
R–G
1 1K
From Door Lock
Control Relay
<19–3>
19 1H
(S/D)
BATTERY
From Door Lock
Control Relay
<19–3>
W–B
10
1
D13
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT RH
L4
LUGGAGE
COMPARTMENT
LIGHT SW
BP
Roof right
1
FL MAIN
2. 0L
1
R–W
1
1 1K
2 II1
1
2
1
6 IU1
R–W
R–W
6 II2
5
I11
IGNITION KEY
CYLINDER LIGHT
1
3
D9
DIODE
(for Courtesy)
2 1H
2
16 IU1
R–W
1
Instrument panel
brace LH
IG
R
R
R–W
14 3D
1
2
L3
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT
LIGHT
16 3A
R–W
G–R
R–Y
C9
OPEN DOOR WARNING
LIGHT[COMB. METER]
From Door Lock Control
Relay<19–3>
4
R–Y
R–W
9 1K
R–W
From Door Lock Control
Relay<19–3>
R
R
R
3
L4
LUGGAGE
COMPARTMENT
LIGHT SW
DIODE
R–W
3 1I
R–W
3 IV1
W–B
BATTERY
I14
INTERIOR
LIGHT
W–B
R–W
19 1H
R–G
2
D13
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT RH
4
OFF
ON
2
D7
DIODE
(for Courtesy)
M3
PERSONAL
LIGHT
R–W
1
R–G
R–Y
1 1I
D12
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT LH
R–G
R–Y
1 IV1
DOOR
R
(w/ Moon Roof)
20A
DOME
D15
DOOR COURTESY SW
REAR RH
R–Y
1
R–W
5 1C
R
R
R
B
B
1
R–W
6 1H
R–W
1 1C
R
R
2 2G
D14
DOOR COURTESY SW
REAR LH
W–B
B
P ow er
S o u rc e
Interior Light (W/G w/o Key Illuminated Entry)
4
2 2H
14 3C
1 Bc2
15 IJ1
2
Back door
center
1
2
R–W
2 Bc3
2
2 1B
2 Bd2
INTEGRATION
RELAY
1 1H
10
R–Y
2
1
BR
OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
14 CAM RY
15 C AM RY
Power
Source
*1 :
*2 :
*3 :
*4 :
Illumina tion
1
Push Control SW Type A/C
Lever Control SW Type A/C
w/ CD Player
w/o CD Player
3
2
4
COMBINATION METER
W
BLOWER SW
C9 B
C 8 A BLUE
B6 A ,
4 1E
1 2 3 4 5 6
5
TAILLIGHT
RELAY
(*1) H 8 A BLACK
7 1L
4 1B
G
12345
G
G
G
B
12
II2
B
R 3 B BLUE
1 2
4
2
5
6
3
7
3 4
5 6 7 8 9 10
1
R 4 C BLUE
1
G
G–W
G3
GLOVE BOX
LIGHT
G
4
2
1
2
1
3
2
1 IN1
C
C
C
C
C
B
B
F16 C
1
(A/T)
G
B
RADIO AND PLAYER
1
1
2
5 IM1
1
R 2 A BLUE
2
G4
GLOVE BOX
LIGHT SW
8 1L
1
B
1 1D
B
2
2 IN1
B
(A/T)
1 3D
(5S–FE) F10 B
BATTERY
A
B
(A/T)
5 1B
A
B
(A/T)
2 1D
B
(*3)
11 3D
A
E6
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION
PATTERN SELECT SW
G
B
B
B
9 A (*3)
5 C (*4)
B
(*4)
11 3C
A
2 A (*3)
10 B (*4)
RADIO AND PLAYER
B
B
G
(*3)
G
(*4)
3 B (*2)
B
FL MAIN
2. 0L
J2
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
A
O5
A/T INDICATOR LIGHT
(Shift Lever)
To Clock
<22–3>
FUSE BOX
7 8
17 18
15 A (*1)
B
1 C
10 IM2
(A/T)
B
(1MZ–FE) F10 A
5 6
11 12 13 14 15 16
G
G
(*3)
7 B (*2)
G
14 A (*1)
4 B (*2)
W–G
(*3)
C11
A/T INDICATOR
LIGHT [COMB. METER]
8 A (*1)
A HEATER CONTROL SW
6 B (*2)
A12 B A/C SW
A , B
13 A
BLOWER SW
16 B
B6
B
A , C9
COMBINATION METER
4
C8
G
R5
REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER SW
G
1
5
B
2
2
6 A (*1)
3 4
9 10
16 II2
H8
G
G
G
G
G
1
C5
CIGARETTE LIGHTER
ILLUMINATION
A18
ASHTRAY ILLUMINATION
B
H7
HAZARD SW
3
B
100A ALT
2
FUSE BOX
F10 A , B ,
F16 C
G
4 3C
1 2
W–B
11 1D
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
2
3 4 5 6
Left kick panel
IF
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
21 3D
HEATER CONTROL SW
W–B
21 3C
A/C SW
(*2) A12 B BLACK
W–B
20 3C
G
5 3D
1 A (1MZ–FE)
1 B (5S–FE)
6 7 8
G
9 3D
10 1D
R7
RHEOSTAT
20 3D
G
14 1D
G
To Integration Relay
<34–2>
W
4 EF1
2 3
5
G
G
W
1
3
G–R
8 1B
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
4
15A
TAIL
2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
7 8 9 10 11 12 13
(A/T)
1
B BLACK
Power Source
T a illig h t (S/D, C/P)
1
3
2
4
FUSE BOX
W
(1MZ–FE) F10 A
(5S–FE) F10 B
F16 C
4 1E
1
5
TAILLIGHT
RELAY
1
15A
TAIL
3
W
2
14 1D
G
G
5 3D
12 BZ1
To Diode(for Idle–Up)
<3–8><4–6><5–4>
From
Light Failure
Sensor<9–1>
LG
LG
13 BZ1
LG
I13
INTEGRATION
RELAY
F10 A , B ,
F16 C
FUSE BOX
2 Ba1
1
4
LG
6
TAILLIGHT
LH
W–B
5
R8
[REAR COMB.
LIGHT LH]
W–B
W–B
W–B
4 Ba1
W–B
W–B
W–B
Left kick panel
IE
Front left fender
EB
3
W–B
W–B
R10
[REAR COMB.
LIGHT RH]
REAR SIDE
MARKER LH
TAILLIGHT
RH
5
7 BZ1
W–B
4
W–B
W–B
REAR SIDE
MARKER RH
1
W–B
2
L1
LICENSE PLATE
LIGHT
2
W–B
BATTERY
2
W–B
W–B
11
2
2
EA
Front right fender
BL
Under the left
quarter pillar
BO
Back panel center
W–B
1
3
R9
TAILLIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
6
1
F6
FRONT SIDE
MARKER RH
HEAD
1
W–B
TAIL
1
F4
FRONT CLEARANCE
LIGHT RH
OFF
H
W–B
EL
LG
R11
TAILLIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
1
G
LG
1
G
G
G
G
G
G
G
G
2
T
LIGHT
CONTROL
G
F5
FRONT SIDE
MARKER LH
C12
COMBINATION SW
F3
FRONT CLEARANCE
LIGHT LH
B
G
1 C
FL MAIN
2. 0L
G
3 ED1
LG
2
W–B
100A ALT
1 A (1MZ–FE)
1 B (5S–FE)
G
G
4 3D
LG
G–R
4 EF1
From
Light Failure
Sensor<9–1>
7 1H
G
8 1B
W
1
OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
1 6 C AM R Y
17 CAM RY
Power
S o u rc e
T a illig h t ( W / G )
1
3
2
4
FUSE BOX
W
(1MZ–FE) F10 A
(5S–FE) F10 B
F16 C
4 1E
1
5
TAILLIGHT
RELAY
1
1
15A
TAIL
3
W
14 1D
G
G
G
5 3D
G–R
4 EF1
From
Light Failure
Sensor<8–1>
LG
To Diode(for Idle–Up)
<3–8><4–6><5–4>
4 3D
W
From
Light Failure
Sensor<8–1>
7 1H
LG
2
8 1B
LG
G
F16 C
FUSE BOX
7 Bb1
LG
LG
LG
2 Bc2
3 ED1
I13
INTEGRATION
RELAY
F10 A , B ,
6 Bd2
1
G
LG
G
G
G
1 C
G
1
LG
4
W–B
1
4
R9
TAILLIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
3
R8
TAILLIGHT LH
[REAR COMB.
LIGHT LH]
W–B
3
R10
TAILLIGHT RH
[REAR COMB.
LIGHT RH]
R11
TAILLIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
1
W–B
W–B
1
W–B
2
L1
LICENSE PLATE
LIGHT
F6
FRONT SIDE
MARKER RH
2
2
W–B
BATTERY
2
2
2
W–B
W–B
11
2
1
W–B
G
G
G
HEAD
1
F4
FRONT CLEARANCE
LIGHT RH
TAIL
H
W–B
EL
OFF
W–B
W–B
C
Left kick panel
IE
Front left fender
EB
EA
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
W–B
C
W–B
LIGHT
CONTROL
T
FL MAIN
2. 0L
1
2
F5
FRONT SIDE
MARKER LH
C12
COMBINATION SW
F3
FRONT CLEARANCE
LIGHT LH
B
1 Bd2
LG
G
100A ALT
2
G
G
3 Bc2
1 A (1MZ–FE)
1 B (5S–FE)
Front right fender
BQ
Lower back panel
center
BL
Under the left
quarter pillar
BR
Back door center
OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
18 CAM RY
P ower S ource
Turn Signal and Hazard Warning Light (W/G)
F ro n t W ip e r a n d W a s h e r
1
Horn
3
2
4
B
FUSE BOX
ACC
IG1 2
(5S–FE) F10 B
B–Y
F16 C
ST1
1
20A
WIPER
ST2
W
OFF
OFF
MIST
ON
TL
TB
TR
5
6
RH
B2
5
8
1
5 2G
B
16 1H
2 IJ1
4 Bb1
4
4
Front right
fender
EA
Left kick
panel
W–B
IE
Front left
fender
EB
Under the left
quarter pillar
BQ
Lower back
panel center
EA
G–W
HORN
G–Y
11 1C
1 1M
Front
right
fender
IG
Instrument panel
brace LH
1
H6
RH
(1MZ–FE) F10 A
W–B
2
C
BL
1
H5
LH
W–B
F9
FRONT WIPER MOTOR
10
FUSE BOX
18 3C
W–B
W–R
1
C
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
3
3
1
W–B
W–B
5 1M
3
RH
6 3D
F8
FRONT TURN SIGNAL
LIGHT RH
G–Y
M
R10
REAR TURN SIGNAL
LIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
8 1C
2
L
6
1 ED1
W–B
W–B
L–O
2
1
W–B
3
F
R8
REAR TURN SIGNAL
LIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
5
L–B
L–Y
FL MAIN
2. 0L
J1
4 ED1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
F7
FRONT TURN SIGNAL
LIGHT LH
G–B
16 IR1
W–B
15 IR1
G–B
LH
F
14 IR1
2
C12
HORN SW
[COMB. SW]
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1
W–B
W–B
B
B
G–B
1
1 C
3 2A
G–B
G–Y
G–Y
TURN SIGNAL
FLASHER
C8
TURN SIGNAL INDICATOR
LIGHT [COMB. METER]
3
FUSE BOX
4 1A
G–Y
L–W
L–W
G–Y
16
1
1
G–B
8
W–B
13
L–B
L–Y
7
L–O
4
11 IR1
F10 A , B ,
2
3
G–B
L–W
1
WIPER RELAY
1 A (1MZ–FE)
1 B (5S–FE)
BATTERY
HORN
RELAY
C12
TURN SIGNAL
SW [COMB. SW]
LOW
WASHER
F16 C
F
7
HIGH
W
B1
LH
E
INT
3 EF1
100A ALT
W
1
G–B
W
W1
M WASHER
MOTOR
1
+2
9
G–W
2
+1
8
G–W
1 1E
+S
2
10
G–Y
B
H7
HAZARD SW
G–W
G–W
18
G–R
1
2 2F
C13
FRONT WIPER AND
WASHER SW
[COMB. SW]
L
L
G–W
L
L
L
L
I12
IGNITION SW
17
IR1
L
40A
AM1
15A
HORN
2 1A
2 1M
2
G–B
9 1G
B
10A
HAZ
IG2
G–Y
AM2
1
7. 5A
TURN
G–B
4 AM1
W
2 2H
3 1G
19 CAMRY
Power Source
3
2
D20 B , D21 B
10A
GAUGE
1
12
9
13
6
4
3
L–W
L
LG–R
L–R
L–R
L–B
LG
G
L–W
4 IH2
L–R
L–B
Y
L–R
L–B
19 IH2
6 IT1
11 IT1
16 IT1
L–R(W/G)
IG
W–B
W–B
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
B
2 A (*1)
5 B (*2)
4
M
2
1 2 3 4
D19 B
IF
12345
L–R
L–B
4 Bc1
3 Bd1
L–B
(*1)
1 Bd1
M
2
DOOR LOCK CONTROL SW LH
1 2 3
4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
Left kick panel
2 Bc1
L–B
(*1)
L–R
(*1)
4
D28 B ,
C
B
W–B
D19 A
Instrument panel
brace LH
8 BY1
19 IT1
W–B
P12 A
DOOR LOCK CONTROL SW RH
3 BY1
L–B
4 B
8 BW1
12345
16 IG1
L–B
1 A
L–B
(*1)
L–R
(*1)
3 BW1
M
6 IG1
L–R
W–B
4 B (*1)
15 IU1
L–R
2 A (*1)
5 B (*2)
7 A (*2)
3 B
5 IU1
B9
BACK DOOR
LOCK MOTOR
4 B
6 A
15 IG1
L–B
(*1)
D23
DOOR LOCK MOTOR
REAR RH
L–R
(*1)
1 A
5 IG1
L–B
D22
DOOR LOCK MOTOR
REAR LH
L–R
(*1)
M
W–B
16 IH2
W–B
W–B
IJ
L–B(W/G)
L–R
Y
7 A (*1)
DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND
DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION
SW FRONT RH
4 B (*2)
6 A
L–B
3 B
D21 B , D27 A
D20 B , D26 A
2
L–R
L–R
LG–R
UNLOCK
1
W–B
W–B
3
DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND
DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION
SW FRONT LH
2
9 IH2
1 1M
Right kick
panel
L–B(*1)
L–R(*1)
W–B
W–B
1
2 IT1
W–B
6 C (*2, *3)
3
1 IT1
L
UNLOCK
D18
DOOR KEY LOCK AND
UNLOCK SW RH
L–W
LOCK
4 A (*3)
3 B (*4)
3 IH2
W–B
2 A (*3)
D17
DOOR KEY LOCK AND
UNLOCK SW LH
L–W
LOCK
G
1 B (*4)
3 A
UNLOCK
UNLOCK
2 A (*1, *3)
3 B (*4)
5 B
LOCK
3 A (*1, *3)
D19 A , B
4 A
DOOR LOCK
CONTROL SW RH
1 C (*2, *3)
1 B (*4)
5
4 1G
LG
G
LG
5 B
LOCK
P12 A , B , C
I12
UNLOCK WARNING SW
[IGNITION SW]
W–B
R–L
1
BATTERY
14 IH2
L–B
L–R
L–R
(*1)
G
12 IT1
L–W
LG
5 IT1
DOOR LOCK
CONTROL SW LH
100A ALT
2 1G
FL MAIN
2. 0L
5
R–L
From Integration
Relay<34–2>
W
W
13 IH2
2 C
1 C
LSWP
L–R
10 IH2
1
Y
LSWD
L–B
ACT–
11
14 1K
B
C
FUSE BOX
F10 A , B , F16
R–G
ACT+
10
19 II2
1 A (1MZ–FE)
1 B (5S–FE)
F16 C
1
7
4 EF1 3 EF1
W
(5S–FE) F10 B
DSWD
D8
DOOR LOCK CONTROL RELAY
L2
UL3
UL2
UL1
5
7
2
DSWP
G
W–B
L1
14
RLY
2
4
6
LG
KSW
16
R–L
15
+B
3
R–L
E
W
W
1 1E
5 II2
8
IG
R–W
L–R
1
1
4
1
10 II2
40A
AM1
R–L
R–L
4
II2
W–L
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
R–L C
8 1K
I12
IGNITION SW
2
2
3
D26 A , D27 A GRAY
2 1K
9 1G
1
L–B
(*1)
IG2
ST2
W–L
AM2
30A
POWER
FUSE BOX
(1MZ–FE) F10 A
L–R
(*1)
ST1
To Door Courtesy SW
Front RH
<11–4><12–4><13–2>
<13–4><14–3>
2
3 1G
To Door Courtesy SW
Front LH
<11–3><12–3><13–2>
<14–3>
2 1E
To Power Main Relay
<20–2>
B–Y
IG1 2
W
ACC
4 AM1
S/D, W/G
C/P
w/ Power Window
w/o Power Window
4
DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND DOOR
UNLOCK DETECTION SW
FRONT LH, RH
L–B
(*1)
1
W
W
*1 :
*2 :
*3 :
*4 :
Door Lock
4
M
2
Pow er
Source
Remote Control Mirror
1
F16 C
L–R
I12
IGNITION SW
40A AM1
From Door Lock
Control Relay<19–2>
W
9 1G
FUSE BOX
1
2
11
1K
17
II2
L
5
1I
3
L
C
V2
H2
6
IH2
L
L
L
P12 A , B
(*3)
8 A (*4)
9 B
B
L
To Moon Roof Control Relay
<21–2>
10 1K
8
V1
3 4
1 2
5 6 7 8 9 10
L(*1)
L(*2)
L
W
H1
1 2 3
4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
5
POWER MAIN
RELAY
1 1M
R6
REMOTE CONTROL MIRROR SW
E
P12 B
P12 A
3 2 1
L
1 1E
POWER WINDOW MASTER SW
(*1) R20 B , R21 B
1
1
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B L–R
L–R B
9 II2
REMOTE CONTROL MIRROR LH, RH
(*2) R20 A , R21 A
30A
POWER
1
(*5) F10 A
4
1 2 3
IG2
9 1L
*4 : S/D, W/G
*5 : 1MZ–FE
*6 : 5S–FE
2
1
ST2
W
2 1E
(*6) F10 B
15A
CIG/RADIO
2
W
FUSE BOX
ST1
AM2
R–L
10 1G
IG1
6 1L
R–L
P–L
4 AM1
3
2
ACC 3
*1 : TMC Made
*2 : TMM Made
*3 : C/P
Power Window
7 A
POWER WINDOW MASTER SW
Left kick
panel
IF
R20 A , B
R21 A , B
REMOTE CONTROL
MIRROR LH
REMOTE CONTROL
MIRROR RH
Instrument
panel
brace LH
IG
Left kick
panel
IF
(*4)
(*3)
1 2
1 2
M
P13
POWER WINDOW MOTOR
FRONT LH
1
DOWN
UP
DOWN
1
M
2
4
P14
POWER WINDOW MOTOR
FRONT RH
2
M
1
R–Y
G–Y
1
L
6 BW1
5 BW1
P16
POWER WINDOW MOTOR
REAR RH
2
3
L
7 BW1
R–B(S/D)
R–Y(W/G)
L
R–Y
13 IG1
R–Y
G–Y
12 IG1
G–Y
R–B
4
4 IG1
5
1
4
2
M
DOWN
P10
POWER WINDOW
CONTROL SW
REAR LH
B
2 IH2
R
M
G
M
R
M
W–B
M
W–B
W–B
B
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–B
3 B
3
R
2 B
G–B
2 B
G–B
3 B
UP
1 B
3 A (*1)
1 B (*2)
R
(*4)
1 A
(*3)
2 A
P9
POWER WINDOW
CONTROL SW
FRONT RH
LG–B
2 A
G
LG–R
1 A
W–B
LG–R
3 A
2
5
5
7 IH2
G–B
3
6 BY1
UP
LG
BR–Y
B
BR–W
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
BATTERY
B
7 BY1
G
8 IT2
12 IU1
5 BY1
R
(*3)
6 IT2
L
7 IT2
4 IU1
L
R
5 IH1
13 IU1
9 A (*4)
(*3)
10 A
DOWN
P11
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SW
REAR RH
UP
G
L
2
W–B
LG
6 IH1
R–B
4 IT1
12 IH2
R–B
10 IT1
11 IH2
L
16 IH2
4 IH1
UP
9 IT1
G–B
1 IH2
L
14 A
G–B
R–L
5 IH2
R–L
7
R–L
3
11 A
G–W
5
LG–B
LG–R
BR–Y
FL MAIN
2. 0L
BR–W
W–B
B
1 C
7 B
G–W
6
4 B
5 A
10 B
G–W
1
13 A
3 B
LG–R
2
6 A
6 B
W–B
FUSE BOX
W–B
LEFT
F16 C
2 A
12 A
L
1 A
RIGHT
B ,
G
DOWN
LH
F10 A ,
LG–R
100A ALT
1 A (*5)
1 B (*6)
DOWN
W
LOCK SW
UP
G
(*4)
POWER
WINDOW
RELAY
L
LEFT
UP
RIGHT
W
UP
RH
DOWN
18 II2
DOWN
3 EF1
W
4 EF1
DOWN
UP
1
P15
POWER WINDOW MOTOR
REAR LH
OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
20 C AM R Y
21 CAM RY
P ower
S o urc e
Moon Roof
1
Power Seat
*1 : TMC Made
*2 : TMM Made
3
2
4
W
B
FUSE BOX
2 2H
2 1E
(1MZ–FE) F10 A
2
20A
DOME
(5S–FE) F10 B
F16 C
1
30A
POWER
1
1
R–W
20 1H
R
W
2 2G
1 1C
4 IO1
From Power Main
Relay<20–3>
R–W
4 EF1
L
(*2)
B
5 IV1 (W/G)
5 IV2 (S/D, C/P)
M
M5
MOON ROOF
MOTOR
4
2
R–G
(EX. C/P)
R–B
(EX. C/P)
REAR
RECLINING
7
R
FRONT
4
L–Y
DOWN
6
L–W
UP
2
2
1
1
2
1
2
2
1
P8
POWER SEAT MOTOR
(for Slide Control)
C
J5
JUNCTION
CONNCTOR
W–B
(W/G)
W–B
REAR
11
M
C
Roof left(S/D)
Roof right(W/G, C/P)
SLIDE
FRONT
12
5 IO1
W–B
BP : S/D
BK : W/G, C/P
8
L–R
R
3
5
MTR+
W–B
(W/G)
G
1
2
MTR–
W–B
R–W
TILT
DOWN
4
R–L
R–Y
TILT
UP
4
5
1
W–B
M3
MOON ROOF
CONTROL SW
2
LS2
9
NO. 2
G–Y
CLOSE
5
LS1
8
W–B
P
6
E
11
G–W
7
3
DOWN
NO. 1
3
W–B
UP
2
M4
MOON ROOF LIMIT SW
CLS
1
OPEN
BATTERY
OPN
B2
L–B
6
B
L
12
W–B(S/D, C/P)
B
M2
MOON ROOF CONTROL RELAY
W–B
L
(*2)
FUSE BOX
1 C
FRONT
VERTICAL
9
R
(*2)
(S/D, C/P)
DOWN
(W/G)
REAR
VERTICAL
1 IV1
1 IV2
L
(*1)
F10 A , B ,
F16 C
FL MAIN
2. 0L
P4
POWER SEAT CONTROL SW
10
R
(*2)
R
(*1)
100A ALT
1 A (1MZ–FE)
1 B (5S–FE)
UP
W
1 1I
BL
Under the left
quarter pillar
M
P5
POWER SEAT MOTOR
(for Front Vertical
Control)
M
P6
POWER SEAT MOTOR
(for Rear Vertical
Control)
M
P7
POWER SEAT MOTOR
(for Reclining Motor
Control)
Power Source
Rear Wiper and Washer
1
3
2
B
W
B–Y
P–L
IG1 2
B–Y
4 AM1
4
FUSE BOX
P–L
ACC 3
Back Door Lock
(W/G w/o Power Window)
Cigarette Lighter and Clock
3 1G
10 1G
2 2H
2 1E
(1MZ–FE) F10 A
B
W
ST1
AM2
20A
WIPER
IG2
15A
CIG/RADIO
20A
DOME
30A
POWER
ST2
9 1G
40A
AM1
7 1D
2 1M
17
IR1
L
2 2G
2 1K
15 1H
L
W–L
W1
WASHER MOTOR
3
2
L–O
M
I12
IGNITION SW
L–R
18 IR1
10 II2
W
4 EF1
3 EF1
OFF
W
INT
E
L
R
L–R
L
L–O
L
C
6
W
2
C4
CIGARETTE
LIGHTER
L
4
3
C6
CLOCK
1
1
W
B3
BACK DOOR LOCK
CONTROL SW
2
LOCK
W
C13
REAR WIPER AND
WASHER SW
[COMB. SW]
L–R
1
1 1E
UNLOCK
2
2
5
L
L–W
L–Y
L–Y
L
L–W
6
3
8
4
1
2
8 Bd1
6 Bd1
7 Bd1
(5S–FE) F10 B
1
1
4
L–B
W–B
L–R
L–R
L–B
1 Bd3
3 Bd3
5 1M
F16 C
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
Under the left
quarter pillar
1
B9
BACK DOOR
LOCK MOTOR
M
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R18
REAR WIPER
MOTOR
M
1
2
W–B
W–B
C
BL
4 Bc1
2
3
C
2 Bc1
L–R
7
Left kick panel
G
W–B
From ” TAIL” Fuse
<15–2>
FUSE BOX
8 1C
L–Y
R19
REAR WIPER RELAY
IE
16 IG1
L–B
4 IJ1
BATTERY
6 IG1
L–B
8 IJ1
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
L–R
14 IJ1
L–O
7 Bc3
P–G
8 Bc3
P–B
B
FL MAIN
2. 0L
W–B
L–W
6 Bc3
1 C
F
W–B
FUSE BOX
3
F
L–W
F16 C
1
10
L
F10 A , B ,
P–B(USA)
P–G(Canada)
W–B
1
P–G
16
L
WASHER
1 A (1MZ–FE)
1 B (5S–FE)
100A ALT
L–O
W
ON
BR
Back door
center
IE
Left kick panel
Right kick panel
IJ
OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
22 CAM RY
23 CAM RY
4
4 1L
B
W
1
2
FUSE BOX
G–W
L–B
FL MAIN
2. 0L
1
2
CONNECTION
DETECTION
A B PIN
1
E1
5
To Data Link
Connector 2 (TDCL)
<3–3><4–5><5–3>
Y–B
Y–B
E2
6
1 1F
2 1F
1 1M
5 1M
2
CONNECTION
DETECTION
A B PIN
SPIRAL
CABLE
2
1
3 II1
L–B
(5S–FE) F10 B
2
1
K3
KEY INTERLOCK
SOLENOID
B
B
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
F1
FRONT AIRBAG
SENSOR LH
F2
FRONT AIRBAG
SENSOR RH
A22
AIRBAG SQUIB
(Front Passenger
Airbag Assembly)
A15
AIRBAG SQUIB
(Steering
Wheel Pad)
8 IP3
1
W–B
F16 C
1
Left kick panel
IE
W–B
BATTERY
From Stop
Light SW
<8–2><9–2>
16 3D
LG–R
3
B
P+
LG–R
2
W
P–
From Data Link
Connector 1
(Check Connector)
<3–3><4–7><5–3>
1
W–B
D–
9
W
–SL
W–B
D+
8
6 1M
17 3D
W–B
–SR
10
E
5
B–Y
B–Y
B–Y
+SR
11
W–B
B
4
7
TC
P2
KLS+
C
C3
CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
B
P
C
LA
W
G–W
P1
C
12
IG2
B
G
B
J4
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
(for SRS)
G–W
F16 C
C10
SRS WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
W–R
13
ACC
+SL
G–R
1 C
G–W
20 II2
SL–
SHIFT LOCK
CONTROL SW
B
Y–B
14
6
STP
L
FUSE BOX
B–Y
SL+
SHIFT LOCK
SOLENOID
W
B
ACC
B–Y
IG
12 IP1
B
1
3
L–R
B ,
1
L–R
W
W
S5
SHIFT LOCK ECU
1 A (1MZ–FE)
1 B (5S–FE)
100A ALT
3 1F
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
W
B
P–L
L–R
B–R
1
1 1E
B
1 2G
9 1F
2
B
F10 A ,
7. 5A
SRS
9 II2
40A
AM1
3 EF1
5 1F
(1MZ–FE) F10 A
L–R
B–R
I12
IGNITION SW
FUSE BOX
9 1L
11 II2
4 EF1
30A
AM2
B–O
2 1L
2
7. 5A
IGN
W–R
W
W–R
IG2 9
15A
CIG/RADIO
To Data Link Connector 1
(Check Connector)
<3–3><4–6><5–3>
15A
ECU–IG
ST2
9 1G
4 1E
B–Y
ST1
10 AM2
2 2H
W–B
IG1 2
8 1G
B–O
4 AM1
10 1G
4
B–O
P–L
3 1G
ACC 3
W
3
2
W
1
B
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System)
S hift Lo ck
W–R
P o w e r S o urce
IF
Left kick panel
Instrument panel
brace LH
IG
IE
Left kick panel
B–Y
L–B
L
R–B
R–G
G–B
17
15
3
14 3B
3 IR1
2 IR1
4
R–G
MAIN
3
2
1
7
6
To Park/Neutral
Position SW
(Neutral Start
SW)<2–3>
W–B
IG
4
7 8 9 10 11 12 13
1 A
R16 A , R17 B
REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER
1 B
8 2E
C9 B
6
2B
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 Be1
8 1C
5 1M
10 1A
2 Bd3
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
W–B
C 8 A BLUE
F
W–B
W–B
1
1M
Instrument panel
brace LH
CRUISE CONTROL INDICATOR LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
11 1C
19
3B
5
18 3C
C2
CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
10
1 1M
8 3B
F
M
BATTERY
6
9 3B
C13
CRUISE CONTROL
MAIN SW
[COMB. SW]
5 3B
2
G–L
R–B
W–B 20
10
1 Bc1
O(*1)
G–Y(*2)
1 IR1
CANCEL
9 A
W–B
FL MAIN
2. 0L
7 IR1
L
W–B
(M/T)
B–W
2
8 IR1
L–B
2
9 IR1
5
10A
MIR HTR
10
(5S–FE)
1H
P
(5S–FE)
12
3
1C
NOISE FILTER
11
1
To Engine Control Module
(Engine ECU(M/T), Engine
and Electronic Controlled
Transmission ECU(A/T))
<4–6><5–4>
24
PI
DEFOGGER
RELAY
W–B
25
L–R
D5
DIODE(for
Cruise Control)
R–L
B–R
26
SET/
COAST
W–B
1
C15
CRUISE CONTROL
CLUTCH SW(M/T)
B
(M/T)
1
FUSE BOX
L
4
B ,
F16 C
1 C
B
MO
RESUME/
ACCEL
17 3B
B
F10 A ,
PKB
MC
To Data Link
Connector 2 (TDCL)
<3–2><4–5><5–4>
7 3B
BATT
VR1
L–R
W–B
18
STP+
R5
REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER SW 3
6 B
B
ECT
STP–
C16
CRUISE CONTROL ECU
CCS CMS
VR3
VR2
W–L
13
1 A (1MZ–FE)
1 B (5S–FE)
100A ALT
IDL
W
2
B
W
W
OD
GND
14
W–B
W–B
SPD
18 3B
B
W
TC
3
B
15
1
5
B
1
2
W–B
G–R
16
C
F16 C
Y–L
G–R
22
1
8 1D
R–L
G–W
23
16 3B
R–L
V–R
(A/T)
9
1
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
O(*1)
G–L(*2)
L
20
(5S–FE) F10 B
C
B
Y–B
(A/T)
8
N&C
W
W
G–W
V–Y
W
3 EF1
LG–R
W
4 EF1
16 3C
13 3B
1 1E
2
W–B
5 IP1
FUSE BOX
6 1D
6 1B
A ,C9
15 3B
19 3C
40A
DEFOG
7 1A
C8
17 IP3
1
1
10A
GAUGE
CRUISE CONTROL
INDICATOR LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
(1MZ–FE) F10 A
12 1A
*1 : TMC Made
*2 : TMM Made
2 1E
R17 B BLACK
R–Y
1
15 1A
15A
ECU–IG
B–R
FUSE BOX
15A
STOP
6 1M
R–Y
16 3D
REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER
R16 A BLACK
To Parking Brake
SW<33–3>
40A
AM1
I12
IGNITION SW
3 1G
G–R
LG–R
2
4
4 1E
G–W
ST2
9 1G
From Engine Control Module
(Engine and Electronic
Controlled Transmission
ECU)<6–2><7–2>
8 IP3
To Combination Meter
<33–2>
IG2
From Engine Control Module
(Engine and Electronic
Controlled Transmission ECU)
<6–3><7–2>
LG–R
W
AM2
P–L
(A/T)
B–Y
From Engine Control Module
(Engine and Electronic
Controlled Transmission
ECU)<3–8><4–8><5–3><6–4>
IG1 2
ST1
From Stop
Light SW
<8–2><9–2>
L
From Data Link
Connector 1
(Check Connector)
<3–3><4–7><5–3>
ACC
3
W
B
2
R–W
1
4 AM1
Rear Window Defogger (W/G)
C ru is e C o n tr o l
S10
STOP LIGHT SW
P ow er S ource
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
Front left
fender
EB
Left kick
panel
IE
Back door
right
BS
IG
Instrument
panel
brace LH
OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
24 CAMRY
25 CAM RY
ABS (Anti–Lock Brake System) (TMC Made)
Power Source
1
2
*1 : 1MZ–FE
*2 : 5S–FE
3
B–Y
4
W–L
16 3D
G–B
LG–R
4 A
5 A
B
15 3C
2 3B
C ,
R–
D/G
15 B
13 B
TC
TS
W
G–W
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A , C10 B
ABS WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
15
6
19
G–W
G–W
1A
1M
3C
7
3C
6 B
STP
A13 A , A14
1 IR2
4 IR2
12 A
25 A
14 B
IG1
BAT
PKB
B
B
1
G
A ,A5
B
ABS ACTUATOR
3 B
1
2
A8
ABS SPEED
SENSOR FRONT LH
W–B
C10 B GRAY
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
BR
4 IS1
5 IS1
6 IS1
(SHIELDED)
1
2
A9
ABS SPEED
SENSOR FRONT RH
ABS ACTUATOR
A 4 A GRAY
W–B
R
2
1
A19
ABS SPEED
SENSOR REAR LH
Front right
fender
EA
1 2 3
4 5 6
2
1
A20
ABS SPEED
SENSOR REAR RH
ABS RELAY
A 6 A GRAY
A 7 B GRAY
A 5 B BLACK
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
6 IJ1
1 B
1
ABS WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
19 IJ1
GND
W–B
W
A4
W–B
+BM
4 B
W–R
+BS
G
(SHIELDED)
F18 D
C 9 A BLUE
12 IJ1
(SHIELDED)
1
BATTERY
5 IR2
M
F17 E
R
FL MAIN
2. 0L
(SHIELDED)
W
7 IR2
G
6 IR2
MT
RR+
8 B
Y
AST
(SHIELDED)
B
SRL
RR–
16 B
BR
SRR
RSS
7 B
BR
(SHIELDED)
W
SFL
RL+
9 B
BR
SFR
W–B
RL–
1 B
BR
5 A
FR+
16 A
BR
2 A
FR–
3 A
R
6 A
FSS
10 A
BR
3 A
FL+
9 A
R
R–W
4 A
GND FL–
2 A 22 A
G
R
1 A
GND
15 A
W–B
G–R
F16 C
L–R
W–B
W–R
FUSE BOX
1
G–W
SFR
SFL
SRR SRL
AST
MT
1 A 13 A 26 A 14 A 18 A 6 A
(*2) F10 B
L–W
D
ABS ECU
F17 E , F18
F10 A , B , F16
MR
G–B
GR–R
W
100A ALT
23 A
SR
B
B
24 A
W
W–L
(*2)
60A ABS
(*1)
1 C
C
C
R–W
C9
R–L
L–Y
13 3C
6
A
L–Y
4
B
G–B
From Stop
Light SW
<8–2><9–2>
12
3C
LG–R
To Data Link
Connector 2
(TDCL)<3–2>
<4–6><5–4>
R–G
W–R
GR–L
GR–G
W
W
17 3C
11 A
3 2G
2 A
2 IR2
1 B (*2)
1 E
11 3B
3 3C
1 A (*1)
1 D
16 3C
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
3 EF1
(*2)
7 1A
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 1E
W
6 1B
To Parking Brake
SW<33–3>
R–Y
17 3D
A14 B DARK GRAY
L–Y
R–G
C
15A
ECU–B
B–R
4 A
3 IP3
15A
ECU–IG
B–R
1 B
3 IP1
G–B
A ,A7
A6
5 B
1
ABS RELAY
W–B
(*1) F10 A
8 IP3
C
1 A
6
B
FUSE BOX
40A
AM1
3 A
B
I12
IGNITION SW
2
4 B
10A
GAUGE
v
2 B
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
Y–B
Y–B
ST2
9 1G
2 2H
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
W–L
GR–R
IG2
G–W
W–L
W
W–L
AM2
3 1G
B–R
To Data
Link
Connector 2
(TDCL)<3–2>
<4–5><5–4>
3 EC1
R–L
7 EC1
ST1
ABS ECU
A13 A DARK GRAY
To Data
Link
Connector 1
(Check
Connector)
<3–3>
LG–R
IG1 2
From Data
Link
Connector 1
(Check
Connector)
<3–3><4–7>
<5–3>
From Data Link Connector 1
(Check Connector)<3–3>
LG–R
4 AM1
R–L
W–L
B–Y
ACC
B–Y
B
B
1
2
3
4
3
2
4
1
2
3
4
5
6
16 3D
2 IR2
G–B
LG–R
R–G
15 A
3 B
1 A
TS
LP
W
FR+
11 A
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
From Stop Light
SW<8–2><9–2>
ABS WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
A4
C ,
D
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A , C10 B
FR–
5 A
FL+
13 A
FL–
7 A
A ,A5
G–W
15 3C
7 3C
1 IR2
19 IR1
2 B
9 A
IG
B
ABS ACTUATOR AND ECU
GND
4 B
RL+
4 A
STP
RL–
2 A
RR+
6 A
RR–
14 A
20 IR1
B
G
13 IR1
W
R
(*3)
1 C
(*3)
FUSE BOX
W–B
100A ALT
B , F16
F17 E , F18
C9
19 3C
C
R–L
3 IR2
8 IR2
W–B
B
5 IR2
FUSE BOX
(*2) F10 B
W
B
(*3)
G
6 IR2
R
7 IR2
W–B
G
(*3)
R
1
B
F16 C
B
(*1) F10 A
(*3)
FL MAIN
2. 0L
(*3)
1 E
F10 A ,
G–B
4 IR2
TC
+BS
C10 B GRAY
12 IR1
12 A
W
W–L
60A ABS
(*1)
(*2)
1 B
1 A (*1)
1 B (*2)
1 D
15 1A
C
6
A
G–B
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
W–L
W
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
4
B
13 3C
3 EF1
W
(*2)
6 IS1
5 IS1
1
6 IJ1
19 IJ1
12 IJ1
4 IS1
F17 E
Y–B
Y
(*3)
G
R
(*3)
W–B
R
G
BATTERY
(*3)
W
(*2)
12
3C
17 3C
C 9 A BLUE
7 EC1
3 3C
LG–R
W
ABS WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
7 1A
16 3C
R–G
1 1E
6 1B
G–W
R–L
17 3D
1
G–B
R–Y
C
6 1M
G–W
4
3 IP3
G–W
3
3 EC1
15A
ECU–IG
R–L
2
3 IP1
10A
GAUGE
G–B
1
8 IP3
C
G–W
40A
AM1
R–G
I12
IGNITION SW
LG–R
A 5 B BLACK
9 1G
Y–B
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
ST2
LG–R
Y–B
IG2
B–R
9 10 11 12 13 14 15
AM2
3 1G
B–R
W
W–L
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
B–R
A 4 A BLACK
ST1
To Data Link
Connector 1
(Check Connector)
<3–3>
From Data Link
Connector 1
(Check Connector)
<3–3>
ABS ACTUATOR AND ECU
IG1 2
From Data Link
Connector 1
(Check Connector)
<3–3><4–7><5–3>
To Data Link
Connector 2 (TDCL)
<3–2><4–5><5–4>
B–Y
ACC
4 AM1
4
B–Y
3
2
To Data Link
Connector 2
(TDCL)
<3–3><4–5><5–4>
1
2
*1 : 1MZ–FE
*2 : 5S–FE
*3 : SHIELDED
ABS (Anti Lock Brake System) (TMM Made)
P o w e r S o urce
F18 D
1
1
2
1
A9
ABS SPEED
SENSOR FRONT RH
2
1
A8
ABS SPEED
SENSOR FRONT LH
1
EA
Front right
fender
2
A19
ABS SPEED
SENSOR REAR LH
1
2
A20
ABS SPEED
SENSOR REAR RH
OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
26 C AM R Y
27 CAM RY
Power
Source
Auto Antenna (W/G)
Electronically Controlled Hydraulic Cooling Fan (1MZ–FE)
1
3
2
4
ACC 3
P–L
P–L
B
4 AM1
W
B–Y
B
IG1 2
B–Y
3 1G
10 1G
2 2H
ST1
AM2
FUSE BOX
R
L–R
13 II2
B–R
TH+
HP
2
3
9
8
L–W
10
L–Y
BR
R
SOL+
Y
4
Y–L
E
C
1 IG1
2 IG1
5
6
IG
(5S–FE) F10 B
BR
EC
Intake manifold RH
B–R
P–L
9 IG1
10 IG1
P–L
L–R
4
3
Front left
fender
C
A2
A/C SINGLE
PRESSURE SW
C
2
EB
BL
3
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
From Radio and Player
<30–1><32–2>
W–B
BATTERY
2
W–B
1
1
E5
ENGINE COOLANT
TEMP. SENSOR
(WATER TEMP. SENSOR)
(for Cooling Fan)
To Data Link Connector 1
(Check Connector)
<3–2>
2
S1
SOLENOID VALVE
(for Hydraulic Motor)
L–W
L–W
1
F16 C
1
B–R
E
B
A21
AUTO ANTENNA MOTOR AND RELAY
ANT
AMP
W–B
B
8 EC1
1
2
ACC
1 C
FL MAIN
2. 0L
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
L–R
IGB
C14
COOLING FAN ECU
SOL–
TH–
L–R
W–R
1
IDL
B–R
L
5
TAC
B
6
1 B (5S–FE)
FUSE BOX
B
7 IP2
W
1 A (1MZ–FE)
6 1H
B
B–R
B
W
8 IP1
3 EF1
1 1C
9 II2
15 3A
(1MZ–FE) F10 A
F10 A , B , F16
9 1L
16 3C
L–R
1 1E
1 1L
L–R
1
2 2G
7 1A
B–R
I12
IGNITION SW
B–R
40A
AM1
From Engine Control Module
(Engine and Electronic
Controlled Transmission
ECU)<3–8>
From Engine Control Module
(Engine and Electronic
Controlled Transmission
ECU)<3–7>
2
B
20A
DOME
ST2
9 1G
100A ALT
15A
CIG/RADIO
15A
ECU–IG
IG2
Under the left
quarter pillar
Power
Source
Rear Window Defogger (S/D, C/P)
1
Auto Antenna (S/D, C/P)
3
2
4
W
B–Y
2 1E
2 2H
1
40A
DEFOG
IG2
FUSE BOX
10A
GAUGE
15A
ECU–IG
20A
DOME
15A
CIG/RADIO
(1MZ–FE) F10 A
ST2
9 1G
10 1G
3 1G
ST1
AM2
B
P–L
IG1 2
P–L
ACC 3
4 AM1
W
B–Y
B
2
2
W–B
L–R
R
2
R
L–R
IG
1
4
P–L
E
9 IU1
10 IU1
8 1C
B
R16 A BLACK
B
A21
AUTO ANTENNA MOTOR AND RELAY
ANT
AMP
P–L
REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER
W–B
2
W–B
1 B
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
6
ACC
B–R
F
5
R
1
B–R
REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER
3
1
BATTERY
5 1M
R17 B BLACK
Instrument panel
brace LH
IG
BN
Left
quarter pillar
From Radio and Player
<29–1><31–2>
W–B
1
IE
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
2 IU1
B–R
F16 C
F
1 A
To Engine Control Module
(Engine ECU(M/T), Engine
and Electronic Controlled
Transmission ECU(A/T))
<4–6><5–4>
A
3 IU1
W–B
1 C
B
3 II2
W–B
1 1M
R16 A , R17 B
B
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1
1 IU1
FUSE BOX
FL MAIN
2. 0L
12 1K
L–R
C
6
W–B
B , F16
(5S–FE) F10 B
10
P
(5S–FE)
10 1A
B
1C
10
B
W
1 A (1MZ–FE)
1 B (5S–FE)
100A ALT
NOISE FILTER
10A
MIR HTR
W
1H
II2
B
(5S–FE)
4 EF1
1 1C
R
3
1
R5
REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER SW
B–R
W
W
DEFOGGER
RELAY
3
9
P–L
13 II2
2
Y–L
5
1 1E
F10 A ,
L–R
R
8 1D
1
3 EF1
9 1L
W–B
40A
AM1
1 1L
B–R
2 2G
6 1D
I12
IGNITION SW
Left kick
panel
BM
Under the right
quarter pillar
OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
28 CAMRY
29 CAMRY
Power
Source
Radio and Player (S/D, C/P 6 Speaker)
1
3
2
4
B
STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
ACC 3
4 AM1
P–L
S8 A
IG1
10 1G
1 2 3
4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
W
15A
CIG/RADIO
IG2
1 2
ST2
9 1G
1
3
II2
R
W
(1MZ–FE) F10 A
9
II2
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
R A
L–Y
L–R B
B
GR
4
IM2
L–Y
10
B B
3
IM2
GR
7
A ACC
R
W
(SHIELDED)
B
100A ALT
1 B (5S–FE)
F10 A , B , F16
ACC
C
GND
1 C
SGND
(5S–FE) F10 B
B–R
R
B
4
B
B
3
A B
3
W
W
9
A ACC
R
1
A AMP
1
R
11
BR
12
W
W
11
A SGND
13
R
R
12
A BEEP
5
BR
BR
4
A MUTE
7
B
B
6
A FR
6
L
L
5
A FL
15
G
G
14
A RR
14
Y
Y
13
A RL
AMP
FUSE BOX
8
ANT
BEEP
R
10
A GND
(SHIELDED)
1
F16 C
B–R
FL MAIN
2. 0L
8 IM2
P–L
MUTE
9 IM2
FL
To Auto Antenna Motor
and Relay<28–4>
1
BATTERY
FR
RR
RL
R2
RADIO AND PLAYER
2
LG
1
IM2
4
IT2
LG
F12
FRONT DOOR
SPEAKER RH
L
1
FR+ B
3 EF1
1 A (1MZ–FE)
B
LG
LG
1
5
FR– B
L
5
IM2
L
9
IT2
L
3
RR+ B
R
1
IM1
R
7
IG1
R
L
2
F14
FRONT TWEETER
(SPEAKER) RH
1
4
RR– B
W
3
IM1
W
17
IG1
W
9
RL– B
Y
6
IM1
Y
18
IG1
Y
2
R13
REAR SPEAKER
RH
2
8
RL+ B
B
2
IM1
B
8
IG1
B
6
FL– B
V
6
IM2
V
13
IH1
V
1
R12
REAR SPEAKER
LH
V
2
2
FL+ B
P
2
IM2
BR
7
IM2
8
IH1
P
P
P
7
E B
1
F13
FRONT TWEETER
(SPEAKER) LH
V
12 1K
FUSE BOX
A , S9
STEREO COMPONENT
AMPLIFIER
1 1C
1
1 1E
S8
LG
40A
AM1
L–R
I12
IGNITION SW
2 2G
P
9 1L
2
1
BR
2
B
3 4
5 6 7 8 9 10
20A
DOME
R
B
AM2
S9 B
2 2H
ST1
IH
Instrument panel brace RH
F11
FRONT DOOR
SPEAKER LH
Power
Source
Radio and Player (W/G 8 Speaker)
1
3
2
B
4
(5S–FE) F10 B
ACC 3
4 AM1
P–L
IG1
S8
10 1G
STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
2 2H
ST1
A ,S9
IG2
20A
DOME
1
FR+ B
9 1L
2
2 2G
LG
1
IM2
4
IT2
LG
LG
2
LG
5
FR– B
L
5
IM2
F14
FRONT TWEETER
(Speaker)RH
9
IT2
L
L
L
2
Bb1
R
3 4
1 2
5 6 7 8 9 10
2
R
1
R15
REAR TWEETER
(Speaker)RH
L–R
FUSE BOX
1
12 1K
3
II2
W
R
1 1E
9
II2
L–R
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A L–Y
R A
L–R B
B
GR
L–Y
10
B B
3
IM2
GR
7
A ACC
R
(SHIELDED)
1 A (1MZ–FE)
1 B (5S–FE)
B
ACC
1
Bb1
W
4
IM2
W
3 EF1
4
B
B
3
A B
3
W
W
9
A ACC
1
R
R
1
A AMP
BR
10
A GND
W
11
A SGND
3
RR+ B
R
1
IM1
7
IG1
R
A
R
B
A
A
R
9
Bc3
R
W
5
Bd1
2
R
1
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
4
RR– B
W
3
IM1
W
17
IG1
W
B
B
W
3
Bc3
W
2
Bd1
W
8
RL+ B
B
2
IM1
B
8
IG1
B
D
D
B
10
Bc3
B
4
Bd1
B
2
F16 C
AMP
FUSE BOX
8
P–L
9 IM2
FL MAIN
2. 0L
B–R
8 IM2
B–R
B
R
1 C
ANT
GND
SGND
BEEP
MUTE
BATTERY
To Auto Antenna Motor
and Relay<27–4>
FR
FL
RR
RL
11
12
BR
W
(SHIELDED)
13
R
R
12
A BEEP
5
BR
BR
4
A MUTE
7
B
B
6
A FR
6
L
L
5
A FL
15
G
G
14
A RR
14
Y
Y
13
A RL
R2
RADIO AND PLAYER
R13
REAR SPEAKER
RH
1
F10 A , B ,
9
RL– B
Y
6
IM1
18
IG1
Y
Y
E
E
E
D
Y
B
4
Bc3
Y
5
Bc3
1
Bd1
Y
2
R12
REAR SPEAKER
LH
B
1
Y
6
FL– B
V
6
IM2
13
IH1
V
V
1
Bc3
Y
2
R14
REAR TWEETER
(Speaker)LH
V
2
2
FL+ B
P
2
IM2
BR
7
IM2
8
IH1
P
F13
FRONT TWEETER
(Speaker)LH
P
P
1
V
7
E B
2
BR
100A ALT
L
F12
FRONT DOOR
SPEAKER RH
1
S9 B
1 1C
(1MZ–FE) F10 A
B
1
R
I12
IGNITION SW
40A
AM1
1
1 2 3
4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
ST2
9 1G
B
1
F16 C
STEREO COMPONENT
AMPLIFIER
S8 A
15A
CIG/
RADIO
W
B
AM2
LG
FUSE BOX
P
IH
Instrument panel brace RH
1
F11
FRONT DOOR
SPEAKER LH
OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
30 CAM RY
31 CAMRY
Radio and Player (S/D, C/P 4 Speaker)
Power Source
1
3
2
4
B
B
ACC 3
4 AM1
P–L
IG1
10 1G
2 2H
ST1
RADIO AND PLAYER
W
FUSE BOX
AM2
IG2
15A
CIG/RADIO
20A
DOME
R 3 A BLUE
R 4 B BLUE
(1MZ–FE) F10 A
ST2
9 1L
9 1G
1
2
R
3 4 5 6
2 1K
1
3 II2
R
B
A
1 B (5S–FE)
F10 A ,
B ,
A
3 A
4 A
ACC
P–L
B
L–Y
1 A (1MZ–FE)
(5S–FE) F10 B
GR
W
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
To Auto Antenna
Motor and Relay
<28–4>
B–R
3 EF1
9 II2
L–R
W
R
1 1E
1
R3
8 A
B
A , R4
B
RADIO AND PLAYER
9 A
ANT
AMP
F16 C
F16 A
FUSE BOX
FR–
LG
L
9 IT2
LG
L
W
5 A
4 IT2
18 IG1
R
B
FR+
1 A
17 IG1
Y
13 IH1
RR–
3 B
7 IG1
8 IG1
Y
8 IH1
RR+
1 B
W
RL–
6 B
R
RL+
2 B
B
FL–
6 A
P
FL MAIN
2. 0L
FL+
2 A
V
BR
B
7 A
V
E
1 C
P
100A ALT
3 4
5 6 7 8 9 10
1 1C
L–R
40A
AM1
BATTERY
1
BR
B
1 2
2 2G
I12
IGNITION SW
2
IH
2
F11
FRONT DOOR
SPEAKER LH
Instrument panel brace RH
1
2
R12
REAR SPEAKER
LH
1
2
R13
REAR SPEAKER
RH
1
2
F12
FRONT DOOR
SPEAKER RH
1
Power
Source
Radio and Player (W/G 6 Speaker)
1
3
2
4
B
ACC 3
4 AM1
P–L
R3
IG1
10 1G
2 2H
A , R4
1
FR+ A
15A
CIG/
RADIO
W
B
AM2
IG2
9 1L
2
4
IT2
LG
1
5
FR– A
2 2G
L
9
IT2
2
L
R
I12
IGNITION SW
W
1 1C
1
Bb1
1
1
12 1K
1 1E
FUSE BOX
W
3
RR+ B
R
(1MZ–FE) F10 A
9 II2
W
A
R
R
2
Bb1
R15
REAR TWEETER
(Speaker)RH
R
9
Bc3
B
A
A
2
R
R
5
Bd1
R
1
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
A
1 A (1MZ–FE)
1 B (5S–FE)
100A ALT
R
7
IG1
3 II2
L–R
3 EF1
B
B
L–Y
4
A B
GR
3
A ACC
4
RR– B
W
17
IG1
W
B
B
W
3
Bc3
W
2
Bd1
W
2
RL+ B
B
8
IG1
B
D
D
B
10
Bc3
B
4
Bd1
B
2
F16 C
FUSE BOX
1 C
B
To Auto Antenna
Motor and Relay
<27–4>
B–R
8
A ANT
P–L
9
A AMP
6
RL– B
Y
18
IG1
Y
E
E
E
D
Y
4
Bc3
B
5
Bc3
Y
1
Bd1
Y
2
1
Y
RADIO AND PLAYER
7
A E
R 3 A BLUE
6
FL– A
V
13
IH1
1
Bc3
Y
2
1
1
3 4
5 6 7 8 9 10
BR
BATTERY
2
FL+ A
R 4 B BLUE
1
2
3 4 5 6
R14
REAR TWEETER
(Speaker)LH
V
F16 C
1 2
R12
REAR SPEAKER
LH
B
(5S–FE) F10 B
1
R13
REAR SPEAKER
RH
1
F10 A , B ,
FL MAIN
2. 0L
F12
FRONT DOOR
SPEAKER RH
W
L–R
40A
AM1
B
LG
20A
DOME
ST2
9 1G
B
RADIO AND PLAYER
ST1
IH
Instrument panel brace RH
P
8
IH1
P
2
F11
FRONT DOOR
SPEAKER LH
OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
32 CAMRY
V5
VEHICLE
SPEED SENSOR
(SPEED SENSOR)
1
3
2
1
2
3
F15
FUEL SENDER
A
A
ED
1
Intake manifold
LH
(1MZ–FE) F10 A
1
2
FUSE BOX
5 IP3
F
F
R–L
5 1M
Left kick
panel
IE
R–Y
(USA)
1
R–Y
8 3D
8 1C
1
See Stop Light
System
<8–1><9–1>
R–W
10 3A
12 3B 3 3B 8 3C
D
10 A
3 A
D
18 3C
4 II1
P2
PARKING
BRAKE SW
Instrument panel
brace LH
IG
1 A
HIGH BEAM
2 A
SRS
11 A
TURN LH
L–R
(*4)
2 C
1 C
11 1C
See Headlight System
<8–4><10–3>
See SRS System
<23–3>
See Turn Signal and
Hazard Warning Light
System<9–4><18–4>
From Electronic Controlled
Transmission Pattern
Select SW<6–4><7–4>
3
See Headlight System
<8–4><10–3>
(*4)
See Illumination
System<15–2>
See Interior Light
System<10–3><11–2>
<13–2><14–4>
See Charging
System<2–4>
C ombin ation M ete r
See SRS System
<23–3>
13 A
TURN RH
POWER
16 B
W–B
(*4)
METER
ILLUMINATION
B , C10 C
W–B
G–O
(*4)
5 B
G–O
(*4) J 2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
8 B
4 B
See Illumination
System<15–2>
3 B
OPEN DOOR
9 B
See Interior Light
System<10–3><11–2>
<13–2><14–4>
15 B
CHARGE
From ” STARTER”
Fuse<1–2><2–2>
See Charging
System<2–4>
1
(*4)
O/D OFF
C9 B
To O/D Main SW
<6–5><7–5>
A
A
(*4)
B–W
6 1B
R–W
12 B
REAR LIGHT
COMBINATION METER
R–W
10 B
BULB
CHECK
BRAKE
C
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
R–W
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–Y
R–Y
3 C
B2
BRAKE FLUID
LEVEL SW
3 EF1
OIL
7 8 9 10 11 12 13
W–B
8 IP1
9 A
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
R–W
12 1D
7 B
(*5)
C 8 A BLUE
From ABS ECU<25–4>
6 IP3
4 C
A , C9
See Engine
Control System
<3–3><4–4><5–4>
2
From Cruise Control
ECU<24–3>
16 IP3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
R–W
13 1D
C8
CRUISE
6
1D
From Daytime Running
Light Relay<10–2>
12 3D
11 B
SEAT BELT
B–Y
P3
PARKING
BRAKE SW
13 3D
R–L
Power
Source
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
W–B
18 IJ1
6 B
See Cruise
Control System
<24–3>
7 C
See Unlock and
Seat Belt
Warning System
<34–2>
8 C
ABS
From Cruise
Control ECU<24–2>
See ABS System
<25–3><26–3>
R–L
IG2
W–B
3 BX1
TACHO
1 2 3 4 5 6
Y–B
A
B
IG1 2
Y–B
2 BX1
V–Y
B(*2)
11 IJ1
B
1
O1
OIL PRESSURE SW
1 BX1
WATER
TEMP.
From Engine Control Module
(Engine and Electronic
Controlled Transmission ECU)
<3–6><4–6><6–3><7–2>
From Engine Control Module
(Engine ECU)<5–4>
B(*3)
BR
BR
R–L
From Igniter
<2–3>
From Engine Control
Module(Engine and
Electronic Controlled
Transmission ECU)
<3–6>
5 IJ1
6 A
BR
1 1E
Y–G
BR
ST1
W2
WATER TEMP. SENDER
BR
BR
7 A
BR
8 A
V–Y
Y–G
11 IP3
FUEL
4 A
10
3D
10
3B
J7
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
14 IP3
22
3D
BR
(*2)
BR
5 A
Y–L
I12
IGNITION SW
Y–L
FUEL
ST2
BR
(*2)
Y–L
12 A
Y–R
2
Y–R
40A
AM1
V–Y
W
AM2
G–B
SPEED
W
4 AM1
BR
(*3)
Y–R
2 IP3
P
R–L
1 A (*2)
1 B (*3)
G
C
W
9 1G
LG
100A ALT
F10 A , B , F16
FUSE BOX
B
1 C
BATTERY
FL MAIN
2. 0L
33 C AM RY
*1 : Canada
*2 : 1MZ–FE
*3 : 5S–FE
*4 : w/o A/T Indicator
*5 : Malfunction Indicator
Lamp(Check Engine)
COMBINATION METER
C10 C GRAY
4
ACC
3 1G
10A
GAUGE
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
13 B
14 B
6 3D
1 1M
(5S–FE) F10 B
FUSE BOX
1
1
F16 C
1
P ow er S ou rce
Light Auto
Turn Off
U nlo ck a nd S ea t B e lt W a rning
1
Radiator Fan and
Condenser Fan (5S–FE)
3
2
4
B
W
ACC
4 AM1
1 2H
3 1G
2 2H
IG1 2
B–Y
1
20A
DOME
AM2
ENGINE
MAIN RELAY
W
ST1
15A
ECU–IG
10A
GAUGE
IG2
9 1G
5
3
2
30A
RDI
FAN
30A
CDS
FAN
4
ST2
2
4 2B
1
3
L
R
3
Under the left
quarter pillar
RADIATOR
FAN RELAY
NO. 2
L
B–R
4
5
B–R
M
1
5
5
3
1
5
W–B
B
1
2
5
5 IO1
W–B
(W/G)
5
1
RADIATOR
FAN RELAY
NO. 3
E5
WATER TEMP.
SW
(5S–FE) F10 B
5
5
5
2
W–B
2 EA1
W–B
(S/D, C/P)
W–B
C
BL
B–R
W–B
See Headlight
System<8–3><10–2>
See Taillight System
<16–1><17–1>
1
5
3
W–B
W–B
(W/G)
C
2
2
R1
RADIATOR
FAN MOTOR
W–B
W–B
(S/D, C/P)
W–B
(W/G)
C
J5
JUNCTION
CONNCTOR
1 EA1
R–G
2
W–B
(*1)
1
L–B
4
2 1H
D12
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT LH
B7
BUCKLE SW
LH
BATTERY
W–B
2
R–Y
(*1)
1
B8
BUCKLE SW
LH
6 2E
W–B
FUSE BOX
B–R
1 1M
R–Y
2
8 2E 3 2B
From A/C Magnetic
Clutch Relay
<35–4><36–5>
6
2 IO1
R–Y
(*2)
FL MAIN
2. 0L
1 2B
(1MZ–FE) F10 A
1
1 C
2 2B
5
W–B
5
10
5 1H
3
A1
A/C CONDENSER
FAN MOTOR
B–W
7
C
FUSE BOX
6 2B
W–R
8
6 2G
1
2
9
F10 A , B ,
1
15 3A
A2
A/C SINGLE
PRESSURE SW
1
4
7 1C
W–B
100A ALT
1 B (5S–FE)
M
2
G–R
R–W
W
W
INTEGRATION
RELAY
1 A (1MZ–FE)
2
RADIATOR
FAN RELAY
16 3C
B–O
7
1 1C
F16
See Headlight System
<8–2><10–2>
R
W
C9
SEAT BELT
WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
*1 : w/ Power Seat
*2 : w/o Power Seat
B
B
W
6
3 EF1
B
C
R–L
1 1E
From Taillight Relay
<15–1>
1
To Unlock Warning
SW<19–1>
C
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W
5
2E
B–O
R–L
I12
IGNITION SW
40A
AM1
7 1A
6 1B
B
2 2G
F16 C
IG
Instrument panel
brace LH
1
EB
Front left fender
Front left fender
EB
OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
3 4 C AM R Y
35 C AM R Y
Power
Source
Air Conditioning (Lever Control SW Type)
1
*1 : 1MZ–FE
*2 : 5S–FE
3
2
4
W
B–Y
R–L
3 1G
6
FACE
BI–
LEVEL
FOOT
FOOT/
DEF
DEF
L
G
FUSE BOX
1
5
1
8
10
4 IP3
4 IK1
8
4
3
2
1
1
7
6
5
4
1 1B
W–B
Right kick panel
IG
W–B
Instrument panel
brace LH
12
2
6 IR1
12 1D
B
(*1)
H8
AIR VENT MODE CONTROL SW
W–B
II
8
1
B
W–B
W–B
W–B
14
G
5
7
B–Y
7
4
LG–B
IL1
B
IL1
W–B
IL1
L–O
IL1
L–B
IL1
L–R
OFF
1
IL1
L
3
L–W
B6
BLOWER SW
BATTERY
5
LO
W–B
5 HI
13
A10
A/C AMPLIFIER
M2 M1
B–W
9
R–Y
7
B–Y
6
L–B
4
5
G–W
4
W–B
8
W–B
FL MAIN
2. 0L
L–W
L–O
B
1
R
2 IK1
L–B
5 IR1
8 IP1
B
(*2)
From Engine Control Module
(Engine and Electronic
Controlled Transmission
ECU)<3–6><4–6>
From Engine Control Module
(Engine ECU)<5–3>
From Igniter
<2–3>
4
A2
A/C DUAL
PRESSURE SW
1
R–L
R–L
L–B(*1)
B–W(*2)
1
1 C
3 IK1
B–W
B–W
B–W(*1)
W–R(*2)
ON
CONTROL
CIRCUIT
3
M
F16 C
4
A3
A/C MAGNETIC CLUTCH
AND LOCK SENSOR
2
2
L–Y
B
OFF
5
G
B–W
1
IK1
4 EC1
L–W(*1)
W–L(*2)
B–W
F10 A , B ,
W–R
R–L
B5
BLOWER RESISTOR
1
Y
M
1 A (*1)
1 B (*2)
9 IP3
A17
AIR VENT MODE
CONTROL SERVO MOTOR
2
B4
BLOWER MOTOR
R–W
B
W
W
2
A11
A/C EVAPORATOR
TEMP. SENSOR
1
2 W–R
A12
A/C SW
2
L–W
W
Y–G
6 IL1
B
W–R
4
L–W
3
2
W–L
R–L
R–L
HEATER
MAIN RELAY
4
W–B
C
2
B–W
To Radiator Fan
Relay No. 3<34–4>
R–B
W
4
1
4
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–L
4
C
3
5
DRIVE
CIRCUIT
1
1
R–L
5
1
A/C MAGNETIC
CLUTCH RELAY
4
R–L
R–L
4
1 1E
6 1B
F16 C
L
I12
IGNITION SW
5
100A ALT
5
2
4
3 EF1
10A
A/C
4
40A
AM1
W
10A
GAUGE
IG2
9 1G
7 IP3
5
B
W
1
40A
HEATER
2
R–L
4
1
ST1
ST2
R–L
(*2) F10 B
(*1) F10 A
4
B–Y
L–Y
IG1 2
3
AM2
R–L
FUSE BOX
ACC
4 AM1
4
IR1
Power Source
Air Conditioning (Push Control SW Type)
1
2
B–R
*1 : 1MZ–FE
*2 : 5S–FE
3
4
B–R
W
R–L
B–Y
B
R–B
ACC
R–W
B–Y
4
4
3
ST2
10A A/C
15A ECU–IG
40A
HEATER
IG2
4
R–L
L
C
R–L
R–L
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
M
C
6 IL1
2
HEATER MAIN
RELAY
R–L
R–L
W
B
4
3
2
L
3 IL1
8
4
7
L–W
1
R
Y–G
12
L–Y
R–W
L–R
R–B
2
6
5
11
1
2 IL1
4
IL1
1
W–B
6
B–W
R–L
1
IK1
5
5
IL1
L–W
L–B
1 IL1
3
L–B
W–B
B–W
100A ALT
B–W
7
7
IL1
W–B
4
B5
BLOWER
RESISTOR
1 A (*1)
1 B (*2)
3
10
2
9
B–W
1 C
4 IK1
B6
BLOWER SW
FL MAIN
2. 0L
2
L–W
3
W–B
IK1
1
L–O
BATTERY
2 IK1
4
L–B
5
W–B
7
L–W
II
Right kick panel
HI
W–B
A/C
OFF LO M1 M2 M3 M4 M5
W–B
FUSE BOX
4
B
F10 A , B , F16
C
W
B4
BLOWER MOTOR
1
2
B
M
6
R–L
3
L–O
W
4
R–Y
4
4
1
R–L
W–B
3 EF1
4
C
7 1A
L–O
5
R–L
R–L
4
W
W
1 1E
7 IP3
3
B–Y
1
R
M
L–B
I12
IGNITION SW
4
RECIRC FRESH
A17
AIR VENT MODE CONTROL SERVO MOTOR
BI–
FOOT/
FACE
FOOT
DEF
LEVEL
DEF
4
6 1B
4
Y–G
40A
AM1
2
L–Y
R
2
10A GAUGE
AM2
9 1G
R–L
3
DRIVE
CIRCUIT
W
ST1
A16
AIR INLET CONTROL
SERVO MOTOR
3 1G
G–W
IG1 2
W–B
4 AM1
IG
FRESH/RECIRC
H8
HEATER CONTROL SW
Instrument panel
brace LH
FACE
BI–LEVEL
FOOT
FOOT/DEF
DEF
OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
(Cont. next page)
36 C AM R Y
36 CAMRY (Cont’ d)
Electric Te nsion R educer
Air Conditioning (Push Control SW Type)
5
R–L
R–L
R–B
R–W
5
B–R
R–L
8
7
6
4
IR1
R–L
B–R
5
5
1
3
2
FUSE BOX
A/C MAGNETIC
CLUTCH RELAY
(*1) F10 A
B–R
B–R
B–R
2
T2
TENSION
REDUCER
SOLENOID LH
T3
TENSION
REDUCER
SOLENOID RH
1
12
2
G
F16 C
1
D25
DIODE
(for Tension Reducer)
1
2
R–Y
14
Instrument panel
brace LH
4
12 1D
1
From Engine Control Module
(Engine and Electronic
Controlled Transmission
ECU)<3–6>
B
(*1)
8
IP1
B
(*2)
From Igniter
<2–3>
BL
B10
BUKLE
SW RH
W–B
1
1 1B
W–B
B–Y
From Engine Control Module
(Engine and Electronic
Controlled Transmission
ECU)<3–6><4–6>
From Engine Control Module
(Engine ECU)<5–3>
2
B8
BUKLE
SW LH
B
1
2
B
W–B
IG
7
LG–B
A10
A/C AMPLIFIER
5
(*2) F10 B
1
R
6 IR1
G
13
5 IR1
L–Y
9
2
1
W–L
8
3 IS1
1
4 IP3
10
1 IJ1
G
L–Y
4
5 3A
B–R
R–L
A2
A/C DUAL PRESSURE SW
L–B(*1)
B–W(*2)
4
1
L–W(*1)
W–L(*2)
A3
A/C MAGNETIC CLUTCH
AND LOCK SENSOR
L–W
R–B
W–R
2
R–W
14
3A
4 EC1
9
IP3
B–W(*1)
W–R(*2)
A11
A/C EVAPORATOR
TEMP. SENSOR
1
2 W–R
16 3C
5
L–Y
B–W
(*2)
B–W
5
To Radiator Fan
Relay No. 3<34–4>
*1 : 1MZ–FE
*2 : 5S–FE
Under the left quarter pillar